Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Dodge
Model
Journey Awd
Engine and year
V6-3.5L (2009)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way >
Page 9
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way >
Page 10
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C1 (Body) 16 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 16 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way >
Page 11
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C4 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C4 - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Satellite Video Module - Removal
Entertainment System Control Module: Service and Repair Satellite Video Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Move the front passenger seat to the most
forward position.
3. Disconnect the three antenna connectors (1) and the electrical connector (2).
4. Remove the three retainers (1) securing the video module housing (2) to the floor, remove video
housing and module from vehicle.
5. Remove the video module retainers (1) to the video module housing (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Satellite Video Module - Removal
> Page 14
Entertainment System Control Module: Service and Repair Satellite Video Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the video module to the housing.
2. Install the video module into the vehicle and Install the three retainers (1) securing the video
module housing (2) to the floor.Tighten to 6 Nm (53
in. lbs.).
3. Connect the three antenna connectors (1) and the electrical connector (2). 4. Move the front
passenger seat back to the original position. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 18
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 19
Keyless Entry Module: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice
Activation Module > Component Information > Locations > Hands Free Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice
Activation Module > Component Information > Locations > Hands Free Module > Page 24
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice
Activation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Hands Free Module C1 (Instrument Panel) 22 Way
Voice Activation Module: Diagrams Hands Free Module C1 (Instrument Panel) 22 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 22 WAY
MODULE-HANDS FREE - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 22 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice
Activation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Hands Free Module C1 (Instrument Panel) 22 Way > Page 27
Voice Activation Module: Diagrams Hands Free Module C2 (UCI) (Instrument Panel) 10 Way
Connector C2 (UCI) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 10 WAY
MODULE-HANDS FREE (UCI) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Locations > Driver Door Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Locations > Driver Door Module > Page 33
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 36
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C3 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C3 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 37
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C4 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C4 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 38
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C5 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C5 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 39
Door Module: Diagrams
Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Driver Door Module C3 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C3 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 40
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Driver Door Module C4 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C4 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 41
Driver Door Module C5 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C5 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 42
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Door Module C3 (Except Base) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C3 (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 43
Passenger Door Module C4 (Except Base) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C4 (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Passenger Door Module C5 (Except Base) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C5 (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 44
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Door Module - Removal
Door Module: Service and Repair Door Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the door trim panel as necessary
to gain access to the door control module. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the door control module mounting fasteners
and remove the module from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Door Module - Removal > Page 47
Door Module: Service and Repair Door Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place the door control module into position and install the mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the
electrical connectors. 3. Install the door trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door
Trim Panel - Installation.
4. Install the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 51
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 52
Keyless Entry Module: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 56
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams
Connector - (SEAT) 10 WAY
MODULE-HEATED SEATS - (SEAT) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Module - Description
Seat Heater Control Module: Description and Operation Heated Seat Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
The heated seat module (2) is located under the driver front seat. It has a single electrical
connector (1) and a push pin style retainer that secures it to the seat pan (4). The module can be
accessed from under the Driver seat with the seat in the full back and up position.
The heated seat module is a microprocessor designed to use the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus messages from the instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment
Node (CCN). The CCN receives inputs from the heated seat switches and in turn signals the
heated seat module to operate the heated seat elements for both front seats.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Module - Description > Page 59
Seat Heater Control Module: Description and Operation Heated Seat Module - Operation
OPERATION
The heated seat module operates on fused battery current received from the ignition switch. The
module is grounded to the body at all times through the electrical connector. Inputs to the module
include Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus messages and standard hardwired 12 volt power
and ground. In response to the LIN inputs the heated seat module will control the battery current to
the appropriate heated seat elements.
When a heated seat switch LIN data bus signal is received by the heated seat module, the module
energizes the selected heated seat element. The Low heat set point is about 38° C (100.4° F), and
the High heat set point is about 42° C (107.6° F).
In addition to operating the heated seat elements, the heated seat module sends LED illumination
messages to the instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN)
via the LIN data bus. The CCN then sends the LED illumination message to the accessory switch
bank so that the appropriate LEDs are illuminated for any given heating level. Pressing the switch
once will select high-level heating. Pressing the switch a second time will select low-level heating.
Pressing the switch a third time will shut the heating elements off.
If the heated seat module detects a heated seat element OPEN or SHORT circuit, it will record and
store the appropriate Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 60
Seat Heater Control Module: Testing and Inspection
HEATED SEAT MODULE
In order to obtain conclusive testing, the heated seat system and the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus circuit must be checked. Any diagnosis of the heated seat system should begin with, the
use of a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic service information.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector pin-out
information.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the heated seat option utilize a low voltage cut-off feature. This
feature turns off power to the heated seat
system anytime vehicle voltage is below 11.7v or above 15.5v. Be certain to check the vehicle
electrical system for proper voltage anytime the power seat system appears inoperative.
Before any testing of the heated seat system is attempted, the battery should be fully-charged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Seat Module - Removal
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module - Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: The Heated Seat Module mounting tab can be damaged during module removal and
installation. Use care to properly align tab to
prevent binding that could result in tab breakage.
1. Position the driver front seat to the full rearward position. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. 3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the heated seat module (3). 4.
Unsnap the heated seat module retaining tab (2) from the seat pan (1). 5. Remove the heated seat
module (3) from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Seat Module - Removal > Page 63
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The Heated Seat Module mounting tab can be damaged during module removal and
installation. Use care to properly align tab to
prevent binding that could result in tab breakage.
1. Install the heated seat module (3) into the vehicle. 2. Position the retaining tab (2) with the
mounting hole in the seat pan (1). Firmly apply even pressure to the module (3) until the mounting
tab is
fully seated.
3. Connect the wire harness connector (4) to the heated seat module (3). 4. Connect the battery
negative cable. 5. Check for proper heated seat system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 68
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 69
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 70
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP-LEFT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 73
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Right Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP-RIGHT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 74
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Left Trailer Tow Stop/Turn Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN-LEFT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 75
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Right Trailer Tow Stop/Turn Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN-RIGHT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Relay - Description
Trailer Towing Relay: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Relay - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with an optional trailer tow preparation package have four trailer tow relays, one
each for the trailer tow stop/turn right and left and one each for the trailer stop lamp right and left.
The trailer tow relays are conventional International Standards Organization (ISO) micro relays.
Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions, current capacities,
terminal patterns, and terminal functions. Each relay is contained within a small, rectangular,
molded plastic housing and is connected to all of the required inputs and outputs through five
integral male spade-type terminals that extend from the relay base plate.
The trailer tow relays are included with the trailer tow preparation wire harness that is shipped
loose in the glove box for customer or dealer installation at the rear of the vehicle. A trailer tow
stop/turn relay is located behind the rear fascia below each outer tail lamp, while a trailer stop lamp
relay is located behind the rear fascia below each outboard end of the rear bumper reinforcement.
Each relay and connector is wrapped within an isolator envelope for sound deadening and
anti-rattle protection. Refer to the appropriate wiring information for specific relay cavity assignment
information.
Any of the trailer tow relays cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
affected unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Relay - Description > Page 78
Trailer Towing Relay: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Relay - Operation
OPERATION
The trailer tow relays are electromechanical switches that use a low current input from the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to the tail lamps to control a high current output to the trailer
brake and turn signal lamps. Within each relay are an electromagnetic coil, a movable contact and
two fixed contact points. A resistor is connected in parallel with the coil, and helps to dissipate
voltage spikes and electromagnetic interference that can be generated as the field of the relay coil
collapses.
The movable common supply contact point is held against the fixed normally closed contact point
by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field is produced by the
coil windings. This field draws the movable contact away from the normally closed contact, and
holds it against the normally open contact. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure
returns the movable contact back against the normally closed contact.
The inputs and outputs of the trailer tow relays include:
- Common Supply Terminal (30) - The common feed terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected to their respective left or right trailer tow stop/turn signal pins of the
4-way trailer tow connector at all times. The common feed terminals of both the left and right trailer
tow stop relays is connected to the normally closed (87A) terminal of their respective left or right
trailer tow stop/turn relay at all times.
- Coil Ground Terminal (85) - The coil ground terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop/turn
relays is connected to their respective left or right rear turn signal control circuits from the TIPM at
all times. The coil ground terminals of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays are connected to
the stop lamp control circuit from the TIPM at all times.
- Coil Battery Terminal (86) - The coil battery terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop/turn
relays is connected to a path to ground at all times. The coil battery terminal of both the left and
right trailer tow stop relays is connected to their respective left or right rear turn signal control
circuits from the TIPM at all times.
- Normally Open Terminal (87) - The normally open terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected to the stop lamp control circuit from the TIPM whenever that relay is
energized. The normally open terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays is connected
to a path to ground whenever that relay is energized.
- Normally Closed Terminal (87A) - The normally closed terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected are connected to the common supply (30) terminal of their respective
left or right trailer tow stop relay whenever the relay is de-energized. The normally closed terminal
of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays is not connected to any circuit in this application.
The trailer tow relays and the hard wired circuits for the relays may be diagnosed using
conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that provide some
features of the trailer tow turn and stop lamp lighting system. The most reliable, efficient, and
accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and communication related to trailer tow turn
and stop lamp lighting operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Tow Relay - Removal
Trailer Towing Relay: Service and Repair Trailer Tow Relay - Removal
REMOVAL
TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN RELAYS
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear fascia from the vehicle.
See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear
Bumper Fascia - Removal
3. Disengage the left or right trailer tow stop/turn relay and connector from the isolator envelope (3)
secured to the trailer tow wire harness (6) along
the left or right body side aperture (2) just below the outer tail lamp.
4. Pull the relay straight out from the wire harness connector.
TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP RELAYS
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear fascia from the vehicle.
See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear
Bumper Fascia - Removal
3. Disengage the left or right trailer tow stop lamp relay and connector from the isolator envelope
(4) secured to the trailer tow wire harness (6) on
the underside of the rear bumper reinforcement (1) on the left or right side of the 4-way trailer tow
connector (5).
4. Pull the relay straight out from the wire harness connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Tow Relay - Removal > Page 81
Trailer Towing Relay: Service and Repair Trailer Tow Relay - Installation
INSTALLATION
TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN RELAYS
1. Align the terminals of the left or right trailer tow stop/turn relay with the terminal receptacles of
the trailer tow wire harness connector. 2. Firmly and evenly push the relay into the connector until it
is fully seated. 3. Insert the relay and connector into the isolator envelope (3) secured to the wire
harness (6) along the left or right body side aperture (2) just below
the outer tail lamp.
4. Reinstall the rear fascia onto the vehicle. See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear
Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear
Bumper Fascia - Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP RELAYS
1. Align the terminals of the left or right trailer tow stop lamp relay with the terminal receptacles of
the trailer tow wire harness connector. 2. Firmly and evenly push the relay into the connector until it
is fully seated. 3. Insert the relay and connector into the isolator envelope (4) secured to the trailer
tow wire harness (6) on the underside of the rear bumper
reinforcement (1) on the left or right side of the 4-way trailer tow connector (5).
4. Reinstall the rear fascia onto the vehicle. See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear
Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear
Bumper Fascia - Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 86
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 47 WAY
MODULE-ANTI-LOCK BRAKES - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 47 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 87
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Description
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Brake System Module Description
DESCRIPTION
The Antilock Brake Module (ABM) is a microprocessor-based device which monitors the antilock
brake system (ABS) during normal braking and controls it when the vehicle is in an ABS stop or
when in a traction control situation. The ABM utilizes a 47-way electrical connector on the vehicle
wiring harness. The power source for the ABM is through the ignition switch in the RUN or ON
position.
NOTE: The ABM is only separately serviceable for non-HSA (Hill Start Assist) equipped vehicles.
Do not remove the ABM for vehicles
equipped with HSA.
The ABM (1) is mounted to the HCU (2) as part of the Integrated Control Unit (ICU). The ICU is
located in the engine compartment below the master cylinder on the front suspension
cradle/crossmember. For information on the ICU, See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes
/ Traction Control Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Description and
Operation/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Description - DESCRIPTION).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Description >
Page 90
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Brake System Module Operation
OPERATION
The primary functions of the Antilock Brake Module (ABM) are to:
- Monitor the antilock brake system for proper operation.
- Detect wheel locking or wheel slipping tendencies by monitoring the speed of all four wheels of
the vehicle.
- Control fluid modulation to the wheel brakes while the system is in an ABS mode.
- Store diagnostic information.
- Provide communication to the scan tool while in diagnostic mode.
- Illuminate the amber ABS warning indicator lamp.
- Illuminate the ESP function lamp in the message center on the instrument panel when a traction
control event occurs.
- Illuminate the ESP function lamp when the amber ABS warning indicator lamp illuminates.
The ABM constantly monitors the antilock brake system for proper operation. If the ABM detects a
fault, it will turn on the amber ABS warning indicator lamp and disable the antilock braking system.
The normal base braking system will remain operational.
NOTE: If the vehicle is equipped with traction control, the ESP function lamp will illuminate anytime
the amber ABS warning indicator lamp
illuminates.
The ABM continuously monitors the speed of each wheel through the signals generated by the
wheel speed sensors to determine if any wheel is beginning to lock. When a wheel locking
tendency is detected, the ABM commands the ABM command coils to actuate. The coils then open
and close the valves in the HCU that modulate brake fluid pressure in some or all of the hydraulic
circuits. The ABM continues to control pressure in individual hydraulic circuits until a locking
tendency is no longer present.
The ABM contains a self-diagnostic program that monitors the antilock brake system for system
faults. When a fault is detected, the amber ABS warning indicator lamp is turned on and the fault
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is then stored in a diagnostic program memory. A latched fault will
disable certain system functionality for the current ignition cycle. An unlatched fault will disable
certain system functionality until the fault condition disappears. These DTC's will remain in the
ABM memory even after the ignition has been turned off. The DTC's can be read and cleared from
the ABM memory by a technician using a scan tool. If not cleared with a scan tool, the fault
occurrence and DTC will be automatically cleared from the ABM memory after the identical fault
has not been seen during the next 3,500 miles. Drive-off may be required for the amber ABS
warning indicator lamp to go out on the next ignition cycle.
ABM INPUTS
- Wheel speed sensors (four)
- Brake lamp switch
- Ignition switch
- System and pump voltage
- Ground
- ESP/BAS warning indicator lamp
- Diagnostic communication
ABM OUTPUTS
- Amber ABS warning indicator lamp actuation (via BUS)
- Red BRAKE warning indicator lamp actuation (via BUS)
- Instrument cluster (MIC) communication
- ESP/BAS warning indicator lamp
- Diagnostic communication
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal
LEFT-HAND DRIVE
NOTE: The ABM is only separately serviceable for non-HSA (Hill Start Assist) equipped vehicles.
Do not remove the ABM for vehicles
equipped with HSA.
1. Disconnect the negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate it. 2. Remove the engine
appearance cover.
3. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 4. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
5. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen. Remove the cowl screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 93
6. Remove the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1) securing the wheel house brace to the strut
towers. 7. Remove the wheelhouse brace (2).
8. Remove two screws, then remove the fresh air plenum. 9. Raise and support the vehicle. See:
Maintenance
10. Loosen, but do not remove, the two mounting screws (2) attaching the ICU (1) mounting
bracket to the body. 11. Lift the ICU and mounting bracket (1) upward to near the top of the slots in
the bracket, then snug one or both of the mounting screws (2) to hold
the ICU in this position.
12. Lower the vehicle.
CAUTION: Before disassembling the ICU, the ICU must be thoroughly cleaned. This must be done
to prevent dirt particles and debris from
entering into vital areas of the ICU.
13. Thoroughly clean all surfaces of the ICU and brake tubes. Use only a solvent such as Mopar(R)
Brake Parts Cleaner or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 94
NOTE: Use this figure in the following step to release the ABM harness connector cover. It shows
the location of the release tabs.
14. Disconnect the ABM harness connector from the Antilock Brake Module (ABM). To do so:
a. Depress the tabs on each side of the connector cover, then b. Pull outward and upward on the
lower half of the cover until it locks into position pointing straight outward (2). The connector can
then be
pulled straight outward off the ABM (1).
15. Remove the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU. A Torx T20 bit approximately 2
inches long works well.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 95
CAUTION: When removing the ABM from the HCU, be sure to completely separate the two
components (approximately 38 mm (1.5 inches))
before removing the ABM. Otherwise, damage to the pressure sensor or pump motor connection
may result, requiring HCU replacement. Do not to touch the sensor terminals on the HCU side or
the contact pads on the ABM side as this may result in contamination and issues in the future.
16. Separate the ABM (1) from the HCU (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 96
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Installation
LEFT-HAND DRIVE
1. Clean any debris off the mating surfaces of the HCU and ABM.
CAUTION: When installing new O-rings or solenoid valve stem seals, do not use any type of
lubricant.
2. If the seals (1) on the solenoid valve stems (2) are not new, replace them all. Each of the
solenoid valve stem seals must be new to keep out
moisture and debris; do not reuse solenoid valve stem seals.
3. Replace the pump/motor connector O-ring (1) if it is not new. Be sure the O-ring is properly
seated in the mounting groove (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 97
4. Align components and install the ABM (1) on the HCU (2).
5. Install the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU. Tighten the mounting screws to 2
Nm (17 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 98
CAUTION: Before installing the ABM harness connector on the ABM, be sure the seal is properly
installed in the connector.
6. Insert the ABM wiring harness connector (2) into the socket of the ABM (1) and close the cover,
locking the connector in place.
7. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
8. Loosen the two mounting screws (2) as necessary and allow the ICU (1) mounting bracket to
slide down over the mounting screws and hang the
assembly in place. Tighten the two mounting screws (2) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Position the fresh air plenum and install the two mounting screws.
11. Install the wheelhouse brace (2). Install and tighten the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1)
to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 99
12. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
13. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
14. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
15. Install the engine appearance cover. 16. Connect the negative cable on the battery negative
post. 17. Hook up the scan tool to initialize the ABM and perform the following:
a. Clear any faults. b. Perform the ABS Verification Test and road test the vehicle. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 104
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
FAN MODULE-RADIATOR COOLING - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Radiator Fan High Speed Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Radiator Fan High Speed Relay > Page 109
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Radiator Fan Control Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagrams Radiator Fan Control Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RADIATOR FAN CONTROL - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Radiator Fan Control Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 112
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagrams Radiator Fan High Speed Relay (Front End Module)
5 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 5 WAY
RELAY-RADIATOR FAN HIGH - (FRONT END MODULE) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Auxiliary Heater Element Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Cabin Heater Relay 1
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Auxiliary Heater Element Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Cabin Heater Relay 1 > Page 118
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Auxiliary Heater Element Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Cabin Heater Relay 1 > Page 119
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 123
Blower Motor Relay: Diagrams
Connector (3 ZONE HVAC) - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-REAR BLOWER MOTOR (3 ZONE HVAC) - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C
OFF
Control Module HVAC: Customer Interest A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF
NUMBER: 24-008-08
GROUP: Air Conditioning
DATE: September 4, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.01 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: FLASH: Airflow Through HVAC Ducts with System Off
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin involves reprogramming the Three Zone Manual Temperature Control
module with new software.
MODELS:
2008 (RT) Grand Caravan/Town & Country
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built prior to April
16, 2008 (MDH0416XX) at Windsor Assembly plant (R in 11th VIN position) -OR- April 22, 2008
(MDH0422XX) at the St. Louis Assembly plant (B in 11th VIN position)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built before June
15, 2008 (MDH0615XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience an intermittent condition where air flow
from the HVAC vents is noticeable while driving with the HVAC system off. This may be more
noticeable with the temperature settings at medium or higher heat settings due to the temperature
differential coming out of the ducts.
Turning the blower on, and then off will force the fresh air/recirculation door closed eliminating the
airflow.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) using the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all A/C Systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are
present record them on a repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this
bulletin. If the Symptom/Condition is experienced or described by the customer, perform the Repair
Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
When performing this Repair Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN®; must be
programmed with 9.01 level software or higher. The
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C
OFF > Page 132
software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, to take
advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's network.
Make sure the StarSCAN® is configured to the dealership's network before proceeding. For
instruction on setting up your StarSCAN® for the dealer's network refer to either:
"DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) tools > Online Documentation",
or refer to the StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide. The StarSCAN(R) Quick Start
Networking Guide is also available on the website under the "Download Center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts. Set
the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash
process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process is complete.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Turn the ignition switch on.
6. Retrieve the old HVAC part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a.Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the HVAC in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK".
l. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE:
Due to the HVAC programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored
DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C
OFF > Page 133
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From
Vents With A/C OFF
Control Module HVAC: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF
NUMBER: 24-008-08
GROUP: Air Conditioning
DATE: September 4, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.01 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: FLASH: Airflow Through HVAC Ducts with System Off
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin involves reprogramming the Three Zone Manual Temperature Control
module with new software.
MODELS:
2008 (RT) Grand Caravan/Town & Country
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built prior to April
16, 2008 (MDH0416XX) at Windsor Assembly plant (R in 11th VIN position) -OR- April 22, 2008
(MDH0422XX) at the St. Louis Assembly plant (B in 11th VIN position)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built before June
15, 2008 (MDH0615XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience an intermittent condition where air flow
from the HVAC vents is noticeable while driving with the HVAC system off. This may be more
noticeable with the temperature settings at medium or higher heat settings due to the temperature
differential coming out of the ducts.
Turning the blower on, and then off will force the fresh air/recirculation door closed eliminating the
airflow.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) using the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all A/C Systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are
present record them on a repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this
bulletin. If the Symptom/Condition is experienced or described by the customer, perform the Repair
Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
When performing this Repair Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN®; must be
programmed with 9.01 level software or higher. The
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From
Vents With A/C OFF > Page 139
software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, to take
advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's network.
Make sure the StarSCAN® is configured to the dealership's network before proceeding. For
instruction on setting up your StarSCAN® for the dealer's network refer to either:
"DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) tools > Online Documentation",
or refer to the StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide. The StarSCAN(R) Quick Start
Networking Guide is also available on the website under the "Download Center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts. Set
the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash
process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process is complete.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Turn the ignition switch on.
6. Retrieve the old HVAC part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a.Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the HVAC in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK".
l. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE:
Due to the HVAC programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored
DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From
Vents With A/C OFF > Page 140
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09
> Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
Fuel Tank Vent: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
NUMBER: 14-001-09 REV. A
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: September 1, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-001-09, DATED APRIL 15,
2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Hard To Fill With Fuel Or Fuel Nozzle Shuts Off Repeatedly
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2009 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2007 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2009 (DR) Ram Truck (1500 / 2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2005 - 2009 (ND) Dakota
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2009 (J1) Sebring (China CKD)
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Sebring Convertible/Avenger
2006 - 2009 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)
2007 - 2009 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2009 (KK) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (LC) Challenger
2004 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2007 (R2) Caravan/Voyager(CKD)
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09
> Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 146
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09
> Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 147
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09
> Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 153
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09
> Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 154
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 155
Control Module HVAC: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 156
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-BLOWER-FRONT (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 159
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Rear Blower Module C1 (3 Zone ATC) (Body) 6 Way
Connector C1 (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 6 WAY
MODULE-BLOWER-REAR (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 160
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Rear Blower Module C2 (3 Zone ATC) (Body) 2 Way
Connector C2 (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-BLOWER-REAR (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
A blower motor power module is used on this model when equipped with the automatic
temperature control (ATC) heating-A/C system. Models equipped with the manual temperature
control (MTC) heating-A/C system use a blower motor resistor, instead of the blower motor power
module .
The blower motor power module is mounted to the bottom of the HVAC housing, on the passenger
side of the vehicle. The blower motor power module consists of a molded plastic mounting plate (1)
with an integral connector receptacle (2). Concealed behind the mounting plate is the power
module electronic circuitry (3) and a finned aluminum heat sink (4). The blower motor power
module is accessed for service from under the instrument panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description > Page 163
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Front Blower Motor Power Module - Operation
OPERATION
The blower motor power module is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
lead and connector of the instrument panel wire harness. A second lead and connector of the
instrument panel wire harness is connected to the blower motor. The blower motor power module
allows the microprocessor-based automatic temperature control(ATC) A/C-heater control to
calculate and provide infinitely variable blower motor speeds based upon either manual blower
switch input or the ATC programming using a pulse width modulated (PWM) circuit strategy.
The PWM voltage is applied to a comparator circuit which compares the PWM signal voltage to the
blower motor feedback voltage. The resulting output drives the power module circuitry, which
provides a linear output voltage to change or maintain the desired blower speed.
The blower motor power module is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The blower motor power module cannot be adjusted or repaired must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description > Page 164
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
A blower motor power module is used on this model when equipped with the automatic
temperature control (ATC) rear heating-A/C system. Models equipped with the manual temperature
control (MTC) rear heating-A/C system use a blower motor resistor, instead of the blower motor
power module .
The rear blower motor power module (1) is mounted to the inboard side of the rear heating-A/C
housing, located on the right side of the vehicle. The rear blower motor power module consists of a
molded plastic housing with two integral wire connector receptacles (2) for the power module
electronic circuitry, a mounting plate (3) with a gasket and a finned aluminum heat sink (4).
The rear blower motor power module can be accessed for service without removing the rear
heater-A/C housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description > Page 165
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Operation
OPERATION
The rear blower motor power module is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated lead and connector of the rear body wire harness. A second lead and connector of the
wire harness is connected to the rear blower motor. The rear blower motor power module allows
the microprocessor-based automatic temperature control (ATC) A/C-heater control to calculate and
provide infinitely variable blower motor speeds based upon either manual blower switch input or the
ATC programming using a pulse width modulated (PWM) circuit strategy.
The PWM voltage is applied to a comparator circuit which compares the PWM signal voltage to the
rear blower motor feedback voltage. The resulting output drives the power module circuitry, which
provides a linear output voltage to change or maintain the desired blower speed.
The rear blower motor power module is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear blower motor power module cannot be adjusted or repaired must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The heat sink for the blower motor power module may get very hot during normal
operation. If the blower motor was turned on
prior to servicing the blower motor power module, wait five minutes to allow the heat sink to cool
before performing diagnosis or service. Failure to take this precaution may result in possible
serious injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1)
from the blower motor power module (2) located at the bottom of the HVAC housing (3) on the
passenger side of the vehicle.
3. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the blower motor power module to the HVAC housing
and remove the power module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal > Page 168
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Front Blower Motor Power Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Position the blower motor power module (2) into the bottom of the HVAC housing (3). 2. Install
the two screws (4) that secure the blower motor power module to the HVAC housing. Tighten the
screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the blower motor
power module. 4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal > Page 169
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the rear blower motor power module (3) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (2). 2. Install
the two screws (1) that secure the rear blower motor power module to the rear heater-A/C housing.
Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in.
lbs.).
3. Connect the two wire harness connectors (4) to the rear blower motor power module. 4. Install
the right rear quarter trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service
and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
5. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal > Page 170
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove right rear quarter trim panel See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the two wire harness connectors (4) from the rear blower motor power module (3). 4.
Remove the two screws (1) that secure the rear blower motor power module to the rear heater-A/C
housing (2) and remove the module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 175
Brake Lamp Relay: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 5 WAY
RELAY-BRAKE LAMP - (BODY) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 181
Power Distribution Module: Locations Totally Integrated Power Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 182
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 183
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 186
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash)
50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 187
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 188
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 189
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26
Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 190
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16
Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 191
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams
Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 192
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 193
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 194
Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26 Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 195
Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16 Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 196
Module-Totally Integrated Power C1
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 197
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 198
Module-Totally Integrated Power C2
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 199
Module-Totally Integrated Power C3
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 200
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Module-Totally Integrated Power C4
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 201
Module-Totally Integrated Power C5
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 202
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 203
Module-Totally Integrated Power C6
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 204
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 205
Module-Totally Integrated Power C7
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 206
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 207
Totally Integrated Power Module C2 (Headlamp And Dash) 26 Way
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 208
Totally Integrated Power Module C8 (Battery) 1 Way
Connector C8 - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 209
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C5 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 210
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 211
Totally Integrated Power Module C6 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 212
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 213
Totally Integrated Power Module C7 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 214
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 215
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Description
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Description
DESCRIPTION
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The molded plastic TIPM housing is located
on the right side of the engine compartment. The TIPM housing has a molded plastic cover. The
TIPM cover is easily removed for service access and has a convenient fuse layout label affixed to
the inside surface of the cover to ensure proper component identification.
The TIPM housing is secured to the TIPM mounting bracket by four clips integral to the TIPM
housing. All of the TIPM outputs are through the integral engine compartment wire harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Description > Page 218
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Operation
OPERATION
All of the current to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) comes directly from the positive
battery cable to a stud located on the bottom of the TIPM. The cable is secured to the TIPM stud
with a nut. Internal connection of all the TIPM circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of
hard wiring and bus bars. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for complete circuit diagrams.
The fuses, relays and TIPM housing assembly are available for service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Power Distribution Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
INVERTER MODULE
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
110 VOLT POWER OUTLET DIAGNOSIS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics >
Page 221
Power Distribution Module: Programming and Relearning
PROGRAMMING
1. Install a battery charger. 2. Verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts.
NOTE: Do not allow the charger to time out during the reconfiguration process. Set the battery
charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous
charge.
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle. 5. Place the
Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN. 6. Select "ECU View". 7. Select
"TIPMCGW" or "FCMCGW". 8. Select "MISC". 9. Select "Restore Vehicle Configuration".
10. Follow prompts on StarSCAN to complete the reconfigure procedure. 11. Once complete, Wait
one minute and turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. 12. Remove the StarSCAN unit, cable
and charger from the vehicle. 13. Verify proper operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Position the front drivers seat to the full
rearward position. 3. Remove the power inverter (2) mounting retainers (1) located under the
carpet. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 5. Remove the power inverter module from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page 224
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the inverter into the vehicle and install mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the electrical
connectors. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Position the front drivers seat back to the
original position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page 225
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Release the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM) cover retaining clips and open the TIPM cover. 4. Remove the
TIPM positive cable retaining nut and remove the cable from the stud. 5. Depress the four
mounting clips to disengage and remove the TIPM housing from its mounting bracket. 6.
Disconnect each of the seven TIPM wire harness connectors. 7. Remove the TIPM from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page 226
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The original Cabin Compartment Node (CCN) and Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
must be installed and functioning properly
prior to powering up the new Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM receives vehicle
configuration data from the CCN and Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) information from the
PCM. If configuration information becomes lost or corrupted, the data can be obtained from Dealer
CONNECT
1. Position the TIPM into the engine compartment. 2. Connect each of the seven TIPM wire
harness connectors. 3. Position the TIPM onto the mounting bracket and push down until the
mounting clips are fully seated. 4. Position the TIPM positive cable onto the mounting stud and
install the retaining nut. Tighten the nut to 9 - 11 Nm (80 - 100 in. lbs.). 5. Open the TIPM cover and
fully seat the airbag fuse holder (two fuses in one yellow carrier) and the Ignition Off Draw (IOD)
fuse. 6. Connect the battery negative cable. 7. Close the hood. 8. Insert the ignition key and turn it
to the RUN position and wait twelve seconds. The TIPM will collect the necessary vehicle
configuration and
VIN data from the CCN and PCM at this time. After twelve seconds turn the ignition key to the OFF
position and then back to the ON position and verify proper vehicle systems operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Run Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Run Relay > Page 231
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Run Relay > Page 232
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Relay Box: Diagrams Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 235
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Accessory Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/ACCESSORY - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 236
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Start Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/START - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 237
Relay Box: Application and ID
Integrated Power Module 8W-13-01
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 238
Relay Box: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
An electrical Junction Block (JB) is located next to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
The JB combines the functions previously provided by a separate relay center. It also serves to
simplify and centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to
many of the accessory systems in the vehicle. It eliminates the need for numerous splice
connections and serves in place of a bulkhead connector between many of the engine
compartment, instrument panel, and body wire harnesses. The junction block is replaced as part of
the engine harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 249
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 250
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 251
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 252
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 253
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 254
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 255
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 256
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 257
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 258
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 259
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
Engine Control Module: Recalls Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control
Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function > Page 269
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In
Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 274
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition > Page 279
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 284
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 289
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function > Page 295
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory > Page 300
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition > Page 305
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set > Page 310
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 315
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 316
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 317
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 318
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 319
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 320
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 321
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 322
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 323
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 324
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 325
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000: PCM
Replacement
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine > Page 334
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function > Page 340
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory > Page 345
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev
Condition
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev
Condition > Page 350
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set > Page 355
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine > Page 360
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
366
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
367
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
368
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
369
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
370
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
371
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
372
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
373
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
374
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
375
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
376
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000: PCM
Replacement
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Powertrain Control
Module (GPEC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Powertrain Control
Module (GPEC) > Page 383
Engine Control Module: Locations Powertrain Control Module (NGC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Powertrain Control
Module (GPEC) > Page 384
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38
Way
Connector C1 (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 387
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 388
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C2 (NGC) (Engine) 38 Way
Connector C2 (NGC) - (ENGINE) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (ENGINE) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 389
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 390
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C3 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38
Way
Connector C3 (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 391
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 392
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C4 (NGC) (Transmission) 38 Way
Connector C4 (NGC) - (TRANSMISSION) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (TRANSMISSION) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 393
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module - Description
PCM
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is a digital computer containing a microprocessor. The PCM
receives input signals from various switches and sensors referred to as Powertrain Control Module
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine and vehicle operations through
devices referred to as Powertrain Control Module Outputs.
NOTE: PCM Inputs:
- Air Conditioning Pressure Transducer
- ASD/Main Relay
- Battery Voltage
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Distance Sensor (from transmission control module)
- EGR Position Feedback (if equipped)
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Heated Oxygen Sensors
- Ignition sense
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Park/Neutral (from trans range sensor)
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- Proportional Purge Sense
- CAN C Bus
- Speed Control
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+)
- Transmission Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Transmission Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Vehicle Speed
NOTE: PCM Outputs:
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Data Link Connector (CAN C Bus)
- Double Start Override
- EGR Solenoid (if equipped)
- Fuel Injectors
- Generator Field
- High Speed Fan Relay
- Ignition Coils
- Natural Vacuum Leak Detection
- Low Speed Fan Relay
- MTV Actuator
- Proportional Purge Solenoid
- SRV Valve
- Speed Control Relay
- Speed Control Vent Relay
- Speed Control Vacuum Relay
- Torque Reduction Request
- Transmission Control Relay
- Transmission Solenoids
- 5 Volt Output
Based on inputs it receives, the powertrain control module (PCM) adjusts fuel injector pulse width,
idle speed, ignition timing, and canister purge operation and EGR if equipped. The PCM regulates
the cooling fans, air conditioning and speed control systems. The PCM changes generator charge
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 396
rate by adjusting the generator field.
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on the following inputs.
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Battery Voltage
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Gas Oxygen Content (heated oxygen sensors)
- Throttle Position
The PCM adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on the following inputs.
- Brake Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Park/Neutral
- Transaxle Gear Engagement
- Throttle Position
- Vehicle Speed (from Transmission Control Module)
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on the following inputs.
- Inlet Air Temperature
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Park/Neutral (from trans range sensor)
- Transaxle Gear Engagement
- Throttle Position
The camshaft and crankshaft signals are sent to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). If the PCM
does not receive both signals within approximately one second of engine cranking, it deactivates
the fuel pump. When deactivated, power is shut off to the fuel injectors, ignition coils, fuel pump
and the heating element in each oxygen sensor.
The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes battery voltage to a regulated 5.0 volts. The
5.0 volts power the camshaft position sensor, and crankshaft position sensor. The PCM also
provides a regulated 5.0 volts supply for the, manifold absolute pressure sensor, throttle position
sensor and EGR (if equipped).
The PCM engine control strategy prevents reduced idle speeds until after the engine operates for
320 km (200 miles). If the PCM is replaced after 320 km (200 miles) of usage, update the mileage
in new PCM. Use the scan tool to change the mileage in the PCM. Refer to the appropriate
Powertrain Diagnostic Manual and the scan tool. If equipped with SKREEM, must use SKREEM
function to program VIN number in new PCM.
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CVI CALCULATION
An important function of the PCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index (CVI). CVIs represent the
volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The PCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the PCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the PCM with output shaft speed information.
By comparing the two inputs, the PCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the PCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 397
Gear ratios can be determined by using the scan tool and reading the Input/Output Speed Sensor
values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed Sensor
value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the PCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the PCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly, etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
SHIFT SCHEDULES
The PCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of shift schedules. Shift schedule
selection is dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
As driving conditions change, the PCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 398
Sensor Return - PCM Input
SENSOR RETURN - PCM INPUT
The sensor return circuit provides a low electrical noise ground reference for all of the systems
sensors. The sensor return circuit connects to internal ground circuits within the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM).
PCM Replacement
PCM REPLACEMENT
DESCRIPTION
Use the scan tool to reprogram the new pcm with the vehicle's original identification number (vin)
and the vehicle's original mileage. If this step is not done a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) may be
set.
PCM Ground
PCM GROUND
Ground is provided through multiple pins of the PCM connector. Depending on the vehicle there
may be as many as two different ground pins. There are power grounds and sensor grounds.
The power grounds are used to control the ground side of relays, solenoids, ignition coil or
injectors. The signal ground is used for any input that uses sensor return for ground, and the
ground side of any internal processing component.
The PCM case is shielded to prevent RFI and EMI. The PCM case is grounded and must be firmly
attached to a good, clean body ground.
Internally all grounds are connected together, however there is noise suppression on the sensor
ground. For EMI and RFI protection the housing and cover are also grounded via the mounting
screws AND bracket to the chassis, separately from the ground pins.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 399
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The PCM supplies two regulated 5 volts supplies - a 5V primary and a 5V secondary (auxiliary) to
the following sensors:
- Camshaft Position Sensor (5V secondary)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (5V primary)
- EGR Position feedback sensor (5V secondary) (if equipped)
- Engine coolant temperature sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Knock sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor (5V secondary)
- Oil Pressure Switch (connected to 5V internal via pullup resistor)
- Pedal Value Sensor #1 (5V Primary)
- Pedal Value Sensor #2 (5V Secondary)
- SRV Position Feedback Sensor (5V Secondary)
- Throttle Position Sensors (5V Primary)
- Variable Line Pressure Sensor (5V Secondary)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
400
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE PCM POWER AND GROUND CIRCUITS
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. PCM WIRING OR CONNECTORS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
401
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
each connector at the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 4.
Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. CHECKING THE PCM GROUND CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to 12 volts, check the PCM ground circuits. 3. Wiggle test
each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated and bright?
Yes
- Go to 3.
No
- Repair the PCM ground circuit(s) for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
3. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED B+ CIRCUITS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
402
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
1. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM power supply circuits. 2. Wiggle
test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated and bright?
Yes
- Go to 4.
No
- Repair the PCM power supply circuit(s) for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
4. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition on.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM (F202) and (F1) Fused Ignition
circuits. 3. Wiggle test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open or short in the
circuit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
403
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright with the ignition on and not illuminated with
the ignition off. Compare the brightness
to that of a direct connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated as described above?
Yes
- Go to 5.
No
- Repair the open or short in the Fused Ignition Switch circuits.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
5. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition on.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM Fused Ignition Switch circuits. 3.
Check each circuit with the ignition off, ignition on, engine not running position, and during
cranking. 4. Wiggle test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright with the ignition on and not illuminated with
the ignition off. Compare the brightness
to that of a direct connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated as described above?
Yes
- Test complete.
No
- Repair the PCM Fused Ignition Switch circuit(s) for as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Engine Control Module: Procedures
Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
PCM/TCM Programming
PCM / TCM PROGRAMMING
PCM / TCM FLASH PROGRAMING
This procedure will need to be done when one or more of the following situations are true:
1. A vehicle's Powertrain Control Module (PCM) has been replaced. 2. A diagnostic trouble code
(DTC) is set P1602 - PCM Not Programmed. 3. An updated calibration or software release is
available for either the PCM or TCM ECUs.
This procedure assumes that the wiTECH(TM) Vehicle Connection Interface (VCI) pod,
StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) devices are configured to your dealership's network with either
a wired or wireless connection. The wiTECH(TM) VCI pod, StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) must
also be running at the latest operating system and software release level. For more help on how to
network your StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) reference the StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) Quick
Start Networking Guide available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and
StarMOBILE(R) Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 406
> Online Documentation', under the Download Center. For the wiTECH(TM) VCI pod use the
"HELP" tab in the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application.
Table of contents
1. SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH PROCEDURE SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH
PROCEDURE 2. REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT: 3. TECH
TIPS and INFORMATION TECH TIPS and INFORMATION: 4. PARTS REQUIRED PARTS
REQUIRED
SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH PROCEDURE
If using StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client. Go To REPAIR PROCEDURE - Using
StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
If using wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application. Go To REPAIR PROCEDURE - wiTECH(TM)
Diagnostic Application
REPAIR PROCEDURE - Using StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood of the vehicle and install a battery charger. Verify that the charging rate provides
a continuous charge of 13.2 - 13.5 volts. 2. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) to the
vehicle data link connector located under the steering column and turn the ignition key to the
"RUN" position.
3. Power on the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R). If the StarMOBILE(R) is being used, launch the
StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client and connect to
the appropriate StarMOBILE(R) device.
4. Retrieve the old ECU part number. From the tool's Home screen,
a. Select "ECU View" b. Select "PCM/ECM" c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e.
Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM/ECM screen for later reference.
5. Program the ECU as follows:
a. Using the StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) at the Home screen, select "ECU View" b. Select
"PCM/ECM" c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Select "Browse for New File" and
follow the on screen instructions. f.
Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 4e, or by using
Year/Model/Engine and appropriate emissions selection for the vehicle being worked on. NOTE: If
you are not connected to the vehicle, you may also search for flash files by selecting the "Flash
Download" button from the Home screen.
g. Select "Download to Scantool" h. Once the download is complete, select "Close" and then
"Back" i.
Highlight the listed calibration, select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
j. When the PCM/ECM update is complete, select "OK"
k. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM/ECM screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
6. Continue to SECTION 2 - ADDITIONAL PCM / TCM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURES to
complete the process if the ECU has been
replaced.
7. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" (p/n 04275086AB) and
attach near the VECI label (See SECTION 3 AUTHORIZED MODIFCATION LABEL for details).
REPAIR PROCEDURE - wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood of the vehicle and install a battery charger. Verify that the charging rate provides
a continuous charge of 13.2 - 13.5 volts. 2. Connect the wiTECH(TM) Vehicle Connection Interface
(VCI) pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering column and turn
the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
3. Launch the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application and connect to the appropriate wiTECH(TM)
device. 4. From the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application Home screen,
a. Select "HELP" b. Select "HELP CONTENTS" c. Follow the correct "HELP TOPIC" for the ECU
being programmed
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 407
SECTION 2 - ADDITIONAL PCM / TCM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURES
NOTE: Find the PCM/TCM Type for the vehicle, read and write down the steps, and then go to the
step by step instructions for additional
information on how to perform these procedures. STEP-BY-STEP INSTRUCTIONS
If an EDC16-U31 PCM/ECM (2.0L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or
routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Program Variant Code
If an EDC16-C2 PCM/ECM (2.2L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or
routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3. IMA
Rapid Calibration Test - Only on 06 PT AND up 4. Injector Quantity Adjustment - Only on 06 PT
AND up
If an EDC16-CP31 (3.0L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning 4. NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization 5. Injector Quantity
Adjustment 6. IMA Rapid Calibration Test 7. Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization 8. Exhaust
Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position
If an EDC16-CP31-2 (2.8L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Injector Quantity Adjustment 4. Program Variant Code 5. ECU Replacement With Value Transfer if the ECU to be replaced is still responsive 6. ECU Replacement Without Value Transfer - if the
ECU to be replaced is NOT responsive 7. Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization 8. IMA Rapid
Calibration Test 9. Set Oil Dilution Mass Value
If a CM849 PCM/ECM (5.9L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped
If a CM2100 PCM/ECM (6.7l) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Enable / Disable Vehicle Features - need to enable features 4. Injector Quantity Adjustment 5.
Reset Regenerative Filter Timers 6. Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load
If an Aisin TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an EATX TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an NGC3 TCM ONLY was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an NGC4 TCM ONLY was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. Quick learn
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 408
If an EGS TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. Initialize EGS
STEP-BY-STEP INSTRUCTIONS
Check PCM/ECM VIN
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Check PCM/ECM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
ECU Replacement with Value Transfer
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "ECU Replacement with Value Transfer" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
ECU Replacement without Value Transfer
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "ECU Replacement without Value Transfer" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Enable / Disable Vehicle Features
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Enable / Disable Vehicle Features" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Exhaust Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Exhaust Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 409
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
IMA Rapid Calibration
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "IMA Rapid Calibration Test" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Initialize EGS
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Initialize EGS" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Injector Quantity Adjustment
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Injector Quantity Adjustment" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
PCM/ECM Replaced
The vehicle pin (Personal Identification Number) will be required to complete the routine. This
information may be obtained in three ways:
1. The original selling invoice 2. DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key Codes 3. Contacting the District
Manager.
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "WIN"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "PCM/ECM Replaced" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Program Variant Code
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 410
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Program Variant Code" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Quick learn
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Quick learn" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Reset Regenerative Filter Timers
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Reset Regenerative Filter Times" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Set Oil Dilution Mass Value
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Set Oil Dilution Mass Value" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
SECTION 3 - AUTHORIZED MODIFCATION LABEL
NOTE: The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM/ECM and/or TCM.
Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach near the VECI
label.
1. Powertrain Control / Transmission Control Module Part Numbers (Insert P/Ns) Used 2. Change
Authority: TSB XX--XX 3. Dealer Code: XXXXX 4. Date: XX-XX-XX
REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 411
TECH TIPS and INFORMATION:
CAUTION: Extreme care must be taken when programming a calibration into a generic PCM. Do
not randomly select a calibration. Once a
calibration is selected and programmed, the controller cannot be reprogrammed to a different
calibration. The module can only be reprogrammed to a more recent version of that calibration.
1. The wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application is the preferred method for flashing any Chrysler
vehicle ECU. For more information, training tutorials
are available under the "HELP" tab in the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application, under the 'Training
Aids' link.
2. To use the StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode requires that your StarMOBILE(R) is
connected to the dealerships network via a wired or
wireless connection. For more information on how to use the StarMOBILE in Pass-Through Mode
see the StarMOBILE(R) training tutorials available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R)
and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Training Aids', under the 'Training Aids' link.
3. If the flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted. 4. Due to the
PCM/ECM / TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other ECUs within the vehicle.
Some DTCs may cause the MIL to
illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All
Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
5. Do not allow the battery charger to time out or the charging rate to climb above 13.5 Volts during
the flash process. 6. The StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) diagnostic tools fully support Internet
connectivity and must be configured for your dealership's network.
For help on setting up your StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) for the dealership's network, refer to the
StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on 'DealerCONNECT >
Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Online Documentation', under the download
center.
7. The operating software in the StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) must be programmed with the
latest software release level. The software level is
visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
screens. For instructions on how to update your scan tool, refer to the StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R) Software Update guide available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R)
and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Online Documentation', under the download center.
PARTS REQUIRED
Module/Programming Order Replacement Guide
MODULE/PROGRAMMING ORDER REPLACEMENT GUIDE
Module Programming
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 412
MODULE PROGRAMMING
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) controls the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS), Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE). When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is in need of replacement, perform
the following steps in order:
NOTE: The PCM and the WIN should never be replaced at the same time. They should be
replaced independently of each other.
1. If applicable, first replace the PCM with the original WIN still connected to the vehicle. 2. Using a
scan tool program the new PCM. (This will ensure the transfer of the Secret Key data from the
original WIN into the new PCM). 3. Replace the WIN, using the scan tool program the new WIN
module. This will transfer the Secret Key data from the PCM into the new WIN. 4. With the scan
tool reprogram the key FOBIK to the new WIN. 5. Ensure all the customer's keys have been
programmed to the new module.
NOTE: If the original keys do not successfully program to the new WIN after the proper procedures
are followed correctly, programming
new keys will be necessary.
PROGRAMMING THE SECRET KEY TO THE WIN
The secret key is an ID code that is unique to each WIN. This code is programmed and stored in
the WIN, the PCM, and each ignition key transponder chip. When the PCM or WIN is replaced, it is
necessary to program the Secret Key Code into the new module using a diagnostic scan tool.
Follow the programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for PCM REPLACED, WIN
REPLACED, or TIPM REPLACED under MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS
CONTROL MODULE menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: Programming the PCM or WIN is done using a diagnostic scan tool and a PIN to enter
secure access mode. If three attempts are made
to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secure access mode will be locked out for
one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN position for one hour and then
enter the correct PIN. Be certain that all accessories are turned OFF. Also, monitor the battery
state and connect a battery charger if necessary.
PCM/WIN PROGRAMMING
When an PCM and the WIN are replaced at the same time, perform the following steps in order:
1. Program the new WIN. 2. Replace all ignition keys and program them to the new WIN.
PROGRAMMING THE WIN
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool.
NOTE: Have a unique vehicle PIN readily available before running the routine
CAUTION: If the PCM and WIN are replaced at the same time, the PCM MUST be programmed
before the WIN.
3. Select "ECU View." 4. Select "WIN". 5. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 6. Select "WIN
Replaced". 7. Enter the PIN when prompted. 8. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine
completion.
NOTE: If the PCM and the WIN are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new WIN.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE WIN
Each FOBIK has a unique ID code that is assigned at the time the key is manufactured. When a
key is programmed into the WIN, the module learns the transponder ID code and the transponder
acquires the unique Secret Key ID code from the WIN.
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool. 3. Have a unique vehicle PIN
readily available before running the routine.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 413
4. Ignition key should be in RUN position. 5. Select "ECU View". 6. Select "WIN Wireless Control".
7. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 8. Select "Program Ignition Keys or Key FOBs", Start 9. Enter
the PIN when prompted.
10. Verify the correct information. 11. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine completion.
NOTE: If the original keys do not successfully program to the new WIN after the proper procedures
are followed correctly, programming
new keys will be necessary.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned by the WIN. Once a key is learned by a WIN, that
key has acquired the Secret Key for that
WIN and cannot be transferred to any other WIN or vehicle.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool. 3. Have a unique vehicle PIN
readily available before running the routine. 4. Ignition key should be in RUN position.
CAUTION: If the PCM and WIN are replaced at the same time, the PCM MUST be programmed
before the WIN.
5. Select "ECU View". 6. Select "WIN Wireless Control". 7. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 8.
Select "PCM Replaced". 9. Enter the PIN when prompted.
10. Verify the correct information. 11. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine completion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 414
Engine Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Powertrain Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL - NGC CONTROLLER
NOTE: USE THE SCAN TOOL TO REPROGRAM THE NEW POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
(PCM) WITH THE VEHICLES
ORIGINAL IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) AND THE VEHICLES ORIGINAL MILEAGE. IF THIS
STEP IS NOT DONE, A DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (DTC) MAY BE SET.
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to PCM, ignition key must be off, and the negative battery
cable must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM connectors.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the 4 electrical
connectors at the PCM.
3. Remove the 3 fasteners (1) holding the PCM to the bracket.
Powertrain Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION - NGC CONTROLLER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 415
NOTE: USE THE SCAN TOOL TO REPROGRAM THE NEW POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
(PCM) WITH THE VEHICLES
ORIGINAL IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) AND THE VEHICLES ORIGINAL MILEAGE. IF THIS
STEP IS NOT DONE, A DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (DTC) MAY BE SET.
1. Install PCM to bracket with 3 fasteners (1).
2. Install and lock the 4 electrical connectors to the PCM. 3. Connect negative battery cable, tighten
nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.). 4. Use the scan tool to reprogram new PCM with vehicles original
Identification Number (VIN) and original vehicle mileage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto
Shutdown Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto
Shutdown Relay > Page 420
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto
Shutdown Relay > Page 421
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto
Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-AUTO SHUT DOWN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto
Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 424
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams PCM Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-PCM - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto
Shutdown Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto
Shutdown Relay > Page 430
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto
Shutdown Relay > Page 431
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto
Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-AUTO SHUT DOWN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto
Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 434
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams PCM Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-PCM - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 439
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way
C2-A
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
C2-B
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 442
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 443
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller (Body) 36 Way
C1-A
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 444
C1-B
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 445
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 446
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 447
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller Module (Instrument Panel) 12
Way
C2-A
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
C2-B
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 448
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 449
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller Module (Body) 36 Way
C1-A
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 450
C1-B
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 451
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 452
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Occupant Restraint Controller - Description
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation Occupant Restraint Controller - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (1) is secured with three screws to a stamped steel
mounting bracket welded onto the top of the floor panel transmission tunnel near the base of the
dash panel and just forward on the center instrument panel support in the passenger compartment
of the vehicle. Concealed within a hollow in the center of the die cast aluminum ORC housing is the
electronic circuitry of the ORC which includes a microprocessor, electronic impact sensors and an
energy storage capacitor. A stamped metal cover plate is secured to the bottom of the ORC
housing with five screws to enclose and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components.
An arrow printed on the label (2) on the top of the ORC housing provides a visual verification of the
proper orientation of the unit, and should always be pointed toward the front of the vehicle. The
ORC housing has three integral mounting tabs and two integral locating pins. The molded plastic
electrical connector (3), with two receptacles containing numerous terminal pins, exits the rearward
facing side of the ORC housing. These terminal pins connect the ORC to the vehicle electrical
system through two dedicated take outs and connectors, one from the body wire harness and one
from the instrument panel wire harness.
The impact sensors internal to the ORC are calibrated for the specific vehicle, and are only
serviced as a unit with the ORC. In addition, there are unique versions of the ORC for vehicles with
or without side curtain airbags or seat (thorax) airbags, with or without third row seating as well as
for those vehicles with domestic or export applications. These variations are necessary for both
equipment needs and for compliance with certain regulatory requirements. The ORC cannot be
repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or ineffective, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Occupant Restraint Controller - Description > Page 455
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation Occupant Restraint Controller - Operation
OPERATION
The microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) contains the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) logic circuits and controls all of the SRS components. The ORC uses
On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) and can communicate with other electronic modules in the vehicle as
well as with the diagnostic scan tool using the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus. This
method of communication is used for control of the airbag indicator in the Electro Mechanical
Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) and for SRS
diagnosis and testing through the 16-way data link connector located on the driver side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the SRS electrical circuits to determine the
system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets an active and stored
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and sends electronic messages to the EMIC over the CAN data
bus to turn ON the airbag indicator. An active fault only remains for the duration of the fault, or in
some cases for the duration of the current ignition cycle, while a stored fault causes a DTC to be
stored in memory by the ORC. For some DTCs, if a fault does not recur for a number of ignition
cycles, the ORC will automatically erase the stored DTC. For other internal faults, the stored DTC
is latched forever.
The ORC receives battery current through two circuits; a fused ignition switch output (run) circuit
through a fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM), and a fused output (run-start) circuit
through a second fuse in the TIPM. The ORC receives ground through a ground circuit and take
out of the instrument panel wire harness that is secured by a ground screw to the body sheet
metal. These connections allow the ORC to be operational whenever the ignition switch is in the
START or ON positions.
The ORC also contains an energy-storage capacitor. When the ignition switch is in the START or
ON positions, this capacitor is continually being charged with enough electrical energy to deploy
the SRS components for up to one second following a battery disconnect or failure. The purpose of
the capacitor is to provide backup SRS protection in case there is a loss of battery current supply to
the ORC during an impact.
Various impact sensors within the ORC are continuously monitored by the ORC logic. These
internal sensors, along with several external impact sensor inputs allow the ORC to determine both
the severity of an impact and to verify the necessity for deployment of any airbags. Two remote
front impact sensors are located on the back of the front end module carrier to the right and left of
the cooling module near the front of the vehicle. The electronic impact sensors are accelerometers
that sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity
of an impact.
The ORC also monitors inputs from an internal rollover sensor and up to six additional remote side
impact sensors located on the left and right front door module carriers, on the right and left lower
C-pillars and, on vehicles equipped with optional third row seating, on the right and left quarter
inner panels to control deployment of the side curtain airbag units and seat (thorax) airbags.
The impact sensors within the ORC are electronic accelerometer sensors that provide an additional
logic input to the ORC microprocessor. These sensors are used to verify the need for a SRS
component deployment by also detecting impact energy of a lesser magnitude than that of the
primary electronic impact sensors, and must exceed a safing threshold in order for the airbags to
deploy. On vehicles equipped with side curtain airbags or seat airbags, a separate impact sensor
within the ORC provides confirmation to the ORC microprocessor of side impact forces. This
separate sensor is a bi-directional unit that detects impact forces from either side of the vehicle.
Pre-programmed decision algorithms in the ORC microprocessor determine when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the impact sensors indicate an impact that is severe enough to require SRS
protection and, based upon the severity of the monitored impact, determines the level of front
airbag deployment force required for each front seating position. When the programmed conditions
are met, the ORC sends the proper electrical signals to deploy the dual multistage front airbags at
the programmed force levels, the front seat belt tensioners, the seat airbags and either side curtain
airbag unit.
The hard wired inputs and outputs for the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic
tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information. However, conventional
diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the ORC or the electronic controls
or communication between other modules and devices that provide features of the SRS. The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the ORC or the electronic controls and
communication related to ORC operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with side curtain airbags, disable
the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
before attempting any Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) diagnosis or service. The ORC
contains a rollover sensor, which enables the system to deploy the side SRS components in the
event of a vehicle rollover event. If an ORC is accidentally rolled during service while still
connected to battery power, the side SRS components will deploy. Disconnect and isolate the
battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before
performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the Occupant Restraint Controller
(ORC), as it can damage the impact
sensor or affect its calibration. The ORC contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) components. If an ORC is accidentally dropped
during service, the module must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this
warning could result in accidental, incomplete, or improper SRS component deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Remove the mini console from the top of the floor panel
transmission tunnel (3). See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Lower Bin - Removal.
3. First disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (4), followed by the body wire
harness connector (5) from the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC) (2) connector receptacles located on the rearward facing side of the module. To
disconnect the wire harness connectors from the ORC, depress the release tab and lift the lever
arm to the fully open position on each connector.
4. Remove the three screws (1) that secure the ORC to the ORC bracket that is welded onto the
top of the floor panel transmission tunnel. 5. Lift the ORC far enough to disengage the locating pins
and remove the ORC from the bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal > Page 458
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Occupant Restraint Controller - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with side curtain airbags, disable
the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
before attempting any Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) diagnosis or service. The ORC
contains a rollover sensor, which enables the system to deploy the side SRS components in the
event of a vehicle rollover event. If an ORC is accidentally rolled during service while still
connected to battery power, the side SRS components will deploy. Disconnect and isolate the
battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before
performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the Occupant Restraint Controller
(ORC), as it can damage the impact
sensor or affect its calibration. The ORC contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) components. If an ORC is accidentally dropped
during service, the module must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this
warning could result in accidental, incomplete, or improper SRS component deployment.
1. Carefully position the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (2) to the ORC bracket that is welded
onto the top of the floor panel transmission
tunnel. When the ORC is correctly positioned, the arrow on the ORC label will be pointed forward in
the vehicle and the locating pins on the bottom of the ORC will be engaged into the locating holes
in the ORC bracket.
2. Install and tighten the three screws (1) that secure the ORC to the ORC bracket. Tighten the
screws to 12.5 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: The lever arms of the wire harness connectors for the ORC MUST be in the unlatched
position before they are inserted into their
connector receptacles on the ORC or they may become damaged.
3. First reconnect the body wire harness connector (5), followed by the instrument panel wire
harness connector (4) to the ORC connector receptacles
located on the rearward facing side of the module. Be certain that the latches on both connectors
are each fully engaged.
4. Reinstall the mini console onto the top of the floor panel transmission tunnel. See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Lower Bin - Installation.
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Restraint Systems/Service and Repair.
NOTE: Service replacement ORC modules are shipped in a LOCKED OUT state and after installed
will set a ORC UNLOCKED - ALL
DEPLOYMENT DISABLED fault. Use a diagnostic scan tool to access the ORC module and go to
the MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS menu item to perform the MODULE INITIALIZATION
procedure to erase the fault and initialize the new replacement ORC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 463
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-STARTER - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
Technical Service Bulletin # J13 Date: 090609
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
May 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J13 Steering Column Control Module
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 09, 2009 through February 24,
2009 (MDH 020916 through 022417).
2009 (JK) Jeep(R) Wrangler
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 10, 2009 through February 26,
2009 (MDH 021008 through 022608).
2009 (WK) Jeep(R) Grand Cherokee
(XK) Jeep(R) Commander
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 19, 2009 through February 25,
2009 (MDH 021910 through 022509).
IMPORTANT:
Many of the vehicles within the above build period have already been inspected or repaired and,
therefore, have been excluded from this recall.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Steering Column Control Module (SCCM) on about 4,300 of the above vehicles may have the
squib connector wiring reversed for the driver airbag module. This could cause the driver side
airbag not to deploy as intended and increase the risk of injury during a crash.
Repair
The Steering Column Control Module build date code must be inspected on all vehicles. Those
vehicles that have Steering Column Control Modules with a Julian date code of 0409, 0419, or
0429 must receive an additional inspection on the driver airbag squib wires. Steering Column
Control Modules with suspect driver airbag squib wires must be replace.
Alternate Transportation
Dealers should attempt to minimize customer inconvenience by placing the owner in a loaner
vehicle if inspection determines that Steering Column Control Module replacement is required and
the vehicle must be held overnight.
Parts Information
There will be no initial parts distribution. Parts should only be ordered after inspection determines
the need for replacement.
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 474
The special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 475
approaches for this recall. This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special
equipment and is a Chrysler Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
A. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Data Label
1. Turn the steering wheel to the 6 o'clock position (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 476
2. Unsnap the knee bolster at the top of the bolster and allow it to hinge downward (Figure 2).
3. Remove the upper and lower plastic steering column shrouds.
4. Inspect the first four digits of the Julian data code (disregard the fifth digit) on the label located
on the bottom of the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 3) for the following:
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is 0409, 0419, or 0429 continue with Section B.
Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation.
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is not 0409, 0419, or 0429 the Steering Column
Control Module does not require further inspection or replacement. Continue with Step 5 of this
procedure.
5. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
6. Install the knee bolster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 477
7. Return the vehicle to the customer.
B. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation
WARNING:
To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) before attempting Steering Column Control Module replacement.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system
capacitor to discharge before proceeding. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable, then wait two minutes before proceeding.
2. Place the steering wheel in the straight ahead position.
NOTE:
The front wheels must also be in the straight ahead position.
3. Separate the driver airbag module from the steering wheel but do not disconnect the driver
airbag module squib wires.
CAUTION:
Do not allow the driver airbag module to hang by the squib wires.
NOTE:
Some models use three clips to hold the driver airbag module to the steering wheel (Figure 4).
4. Remove the black electrical tape that holds the two sets of squib wires together (Figure 5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 478
5. Inspect the driver airbag module squib wiring orientation going into the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 6):
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the left
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the right side, the Steering Column Control
Module does not require repair. Continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the right
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the left side, the Steering Column Control
Module is defective and must be replaced. Continue with Section C. Replace Steering Column
Control Module.
6. Install the driver airbag module onto the steering wheel.
7. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
8. Install the knee bolster.
9. Connect the negative battery cable.
10. Return the vehicle to the customer.
C. Replace Steering Column Control Module
CAUTION:
The clockspring in the Steering Column Control Module is shipped with the clockspring
pre-centered and with a molded plastic locking pin installed. This locking pin must not be removed
until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering column (Step 20).
1. Disconnect the driver airbag module wires and place the module aside.
2. Disconnect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
3. Remove the steering wheel retaining bolt.
4. Remove the steering wheel from the steering shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 479
5. Move the steering column to the fully lowered position.
6. Remove the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the steering
column bracket.
7. Pull the Steering Column Control Module away from the steering column far enough to access
and disconnect the three instrument panel wire
harness connectors from the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control Module case.
8. Remove the Steering Column Control Module from the steering column.
9. Transfer the right multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 7).
10. Transfer the left multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 8).
11. Transfer the multi-function switch jumper harness from the old Steering Column Control Module
onto the new Steering Column Control Module
(Figure 8).
CAUTION:
Make sure that the jumper wire connectors are locked in place by gently pulling on them.
12. Carefully slide the Steering Column Control Module down over the steering column upper shaft
far enough to reconnect the three instrument
panel wire harness connectors to the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control
Module case.
13. Position the Steering Column Control Module onto the steering column bracket.
14. Install and tighten the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the
steering column bracket to 27 in. lbs. (3 N.m) in the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 480
following sequence:
> Lower right screw
> Upper left screw
> Upper right screw
CAUTION:
Use of an improper sequence when tightening the Steering Column Control Module mounting
screws may result in an audible ticking noise as the steering wheel is rotated.
15. Install the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column.
16 Install the knee bolster.
17. Move the steering column back to the fully raised position and move the tilt release lever to the
locked position.
18. Install the steering wheel onto the steering column.
19. Install the steering wheel retaining bolt and tighten bolt to 45 ft. lbs. (61 N.m).
20. Remove the plastic locking pin that secures the clockspring rotor to the Steering Column
Control Module case.
21. Connect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
22. Connect the squib connectors to the driver airbag module.
23. Install the driver airbag module to the steering wheel.
24. Perform the Supplemental Restraints Verification Test below:
a. Connect the scan tool to the 16-way data link connector located on the driver's side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
b. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position and exit the vehicle with the scan tool.
c. Check and make certain that nobody is in the vehicle, then reconnect the negative battery cable.
d. Using the scan tool, read and record active and historical Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
e. Use the scan tool to erase the stored DTC's.
f. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position for about 15 seconds, and then back to the "ON" position.
Observe the airbag indicator lamp in the instrument cluster. It should light for six to eight seconds
and then go out. This indicates that the SRS is functioning normally and that the repairs are
complete.
g. Remove the scan tool from the vehicle.
h. Return the vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 481
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
Technical Service Bulletin # J13 Date: 090609
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
May 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J13 Steering Column Control Module
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 09, 2009 through February 24,
2009 (MDH 020916 through 022417).
2009 (JK) Jeep(R) Wrangler
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 10, 2009 through February 26,
2009 (MDH 021008 through 022608).
2009 (WK) Jeep(R) Grand Cherokee
(XK) Jeep(R) Commander
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 19, 2009 through February 25,
2009 (MDH 021910 through 022509).
IMPORTANT:
Many of the vehicles within the above build period have already been inspected or repaired and,
therefore, have been excluded from this recall.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Steering Column Control Module (SCCM) on about 4,300 of the above vehicles may have the
squib connector wiring reversed for the driver airbag module. This could cause the driver side
airbag not to deploy as intended and increase the risk of injury during a crash.
Repair
The Steering Column Control Module build date code must be inspected on all vehicles. Those
vehicles that have Steering Column Control Modules with a Julian date code of 0409, 0419, or
0429 must receive an additional inspection on the driver airbag squib wires. Steering Column
Control Modules with suspect driver airbag squib wires must be replace.
Alternate Transportation
Dealers should attempt to minimize customer inconvenience by placing the owner in a loaner
vehicle if inspection determines that Steering Column Control Module replacement is required and
the vehicle must be held overnight.
Parts Information
There will be no initial parts distribution. Parts should only be ordered after inspection determines
the need for replacement.
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
> Page 487
The special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
> Page 488
approaches for this recall. This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special
equipment and is a Chrysler Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
A. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Data Label
1. Turn the steering wheel to the 6 o'clock position (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
> Page 489
2. Unsnap the knee bolster at the top of the bolster and allow it to hinge downward (Figure 2).
3. Remove the upper and lower plastic steering column shrouds.
4. Inspect the first four digits of the Julian data code (disregard the fifth digit) on the label located
on the bottom of the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 3) for the following:
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is 0409, 0419, or 0429 continue with Section B.
Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation.
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is not 0409, 0419, or 0429 the Steering Column
Control Module does not require further inspection or replacement. Continue with Step 5 of this
procedure.
5. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
6. Install the knee bolster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
> Page 490
7. Return the vehicle to the customer.
B. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation
WARNING:
To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) before attempting Steering Column Control Module replacement.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system
capacitor to discharge before proceeding. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable, then wait two minutes before proceeding.
2. Place the steering wheel in the straight ahead position.
NOTE:
The front wheels must also be in the straight ahead position.
3. Separate the driver airbag module from the steering wheel but do not disconnect the driver
airbag module squib wires.
CAUTION:
Do not allow the driver airbag module to hang by the squib wires.
NOTE:
Some models use three clips to hold the driver airbag module to the steering wheel (Figure 4).
4. Remove the black electrical tape that holds the two sets of squib wires together (Figure 5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
> Page 491
5. Inspect the driver airbag module squib wiring orientation going into the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 6):
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the left
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the right side, the Steering Column Control
Module does not require repair. Continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the right
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the left side, the Steering Column Control
Module is defective and must be replaced. Continue with Section C. Replace Steering Column
Control Module.
6. Install the driver airbag module onto the steering wheel.
7. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
8. Install the knee bolster.
9. Connect the negative battery cable.
10. Return the vehicle to the customer.
C. Replace Steering Column Control Module
CAUTION:
The clockspring in the Steering Column Control Module is shipped with the clockspring
pre-centered and with a molded plastic locking pin installed. This locking pin must not be removed
until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering column (Step 20).
1. Disconnect the driver airbag module wires and place the module aside.
2. Disconnect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
3. Remove the steering wheel retaining bolt.
4. Remove the steering wheel from the steering shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
> Page 492
5. Move the steering column to the fully lowered position.
6. Remove the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the steering
column bracket.
7. Pull the Steering Column Control Module away from the steering column far enough to access
and disconnect the three instrument panel wire
harness connectors from the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control Module case.
8. Remove the Steering Column Control Module from the steering column.
9. Transfer the right multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 7).
10. Transfer the left multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 8).
11. Transfer the multi-function switch jumper harness from the old Steering Column Control Module
onto the new Steering Column Control Module
(Figure 8).
CAUTION:
Make sure that the jumper wire connectors are locked in place by gently pulling on them.
12. Carefully slide the Steering Column Control Module down over the steering column upper shaft
far enough to reconnect the three instrument
panel wire harness connectors to the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control
Module case.
13. Position the Steering Column Control Module onto the steering column bracket.
14. Install and tighten the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the
steering column bracket to 27 in. lbs. (3 N.m) in the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
> Page 493
following sequence:
> Lower right screw
> Upper left screw
> Upper right screw
CAUTION:
Use of an improper sequence when tightening the Steering Column Control Module mounting
screws may result in an audible ticking noise as the steering wheel is rotated.
15. Install the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column.
16 Install the knee bolster.
17. Move the steering column back to the fully raised position and move the tilt release lever to the
locked position.
18. Install the steering wheel onto the steering column.
19. Install the steering wheel retaining bolt and tighten bolt to 45 ft. lbs. (61 N.m).
20. Remove the plastic locking pin that secures the clockspring rotor to the Steering Column
Control Module case.
21. Connect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
22. Connect the squib connectors to the driver airbag module.
23. Install the driver airbag module to the steering wheel.
24. Perform the Supplemental Restraints Verification Test below:
a. Connect the scan tool to the 16-way data link connector located on the driver's side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
b. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position and exit the vehicle with the scan tool.
c. Check and make certain that nobody is in the vehicle, then reconnect the negative battery cable.
d. Using the scan tool, read and record active and historical Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
e. Use the scan tool to erase the stored DTC's.
f. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position for about 15 seconds, and then back to the "ON" position.
Observe the airbag indicator lamp in the instrument cluster. It should light for six to eight seconds
and then go out. This indicates that the SRS is functioning normally and that the repairs are
complete.
g. Remove the scan tool from the vehicle.
h. Return the vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
> Page 494
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 498
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control
Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C2
(Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector C2 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control
Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 501
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C3
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C3 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control
Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 502
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C4
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C4 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control
Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 503
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C8
(Steering Wheel) 6 Way
Connector C8 - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Steering Column Module - Description
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Control Module (SCM) that is internal to the left
multi-function switch housing (2). The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side
of the steering column, just below the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the
interior and exterior lighting systems. The only visible components of the switch are the control
stalk (1), control knob and control sleeve that extend through the steering column shrouds on the
left side of the column. The remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions and electrical
connections are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing and controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A single screw (7)
through a mounting tab integral to the back of the switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the
bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the mounting bracket integral to the clockspring
(3). A connector receptacle containing seven terminal pins is integral to the inboard end of the
switch housing and connects the SCM through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the right
(wiper) multi-function switch (6). A second connector receptacle containing four terminal pins is
integral to the back of the switch housing and connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system
through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The SCM cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged the entire left multi-function
switch must be replaced. See: Lighting and Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and
Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left Multifunction Switch - Removal. The
clockspring (with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the
SCM), the right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate
service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Steering Column Module - Description > Page 506
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Steering Column Module - Description > Page 507
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Column Control Module (SCCM). The SCCM is secured
near the top of the steering column below the steering wheel and is completely concealed beneath
the steering column shrouds. It is installed as a modular unit that supports the left (lighting)
multi-function switch (1) and right (wiper) multi-function switch (6). The controls for each of these
switches extend through appropriate clearance holes provided in the steering column shrouds.
The microprocessor-based Steering Control Module (SCM) (2) utilizes integrated circuitry and
information carried on the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus along with several hard wired
analog and multiplexed inputs to monitor both the right and left multi-function switches. The SCCM
uses a Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data bus for exterior lighting and wiper functions. The LIN
data is sent to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN then sends it out on the CAN data
bus See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Description
and Operation/Communication - Description. The SCCM is available for service replacement as a
unit or each individual component:
- Clockspring (with integral Steering Angle Sensor if equipped)
- Left Multi-Function Switch (with integral Steering Control Module)
- Right Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Steering Column Module - Description > Page 508
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 509
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Testing and Inspection
STEERING CONTROL MODULE
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
The hard wired circuits between components related to the Steering Control Module (SCM) may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair
procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector pin-out information and
location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the SCM or
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices that provide some
features of the SCM. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM or the
electronic controls and communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering
Column Control Module - Removal
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Removal
REMOVAL
SCCM
1. Place the front road wheels in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. 2. Open hood. 3. Disconnect
and isolate the battery negative cable.
WARNING: Wait two minutes for the airbag system reserve capacitor to discharge before
beginning any airbag system or component service.
Failure to do so may result in accidental airbag deployment, personal injury or death.
4. Remove steering wheel See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and
Repair/Removal. 5. Remove upper and lower steering column shrouds to gain access to the
Steering Column Control Module (SCCM)See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
6. Lock the clockspring rotor in the center position as follows: Insert a grenade pin through the hole
in the rotor at the 10 o'clock position. 7. Remove the three screws (1) to the Steering Column
Control Module (SCCM) (3).
8. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) between the SCCM (1) and the instrument panel wiring
harness at the base of the SCCM and remove from
column.
NOTE: If only removing the SCCM from column, there is no need to continue to next step.
DISASSEMBLY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering
Column Control Module - Removal > Page 512
1. Remove the left multi-function switch stalk retaining screw (2). 2. Pull the left stalk out of the
SCCM.
3. Disconnect the left stalk electrical connector. 4. Separate the left switch from the SCCM.
5. Remove the one right multi-function switch retaining screw. 6. Pull right switch out of SCCM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering
Column Control Module - Removal > Page 513
7. Disconnect the right switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering
Column Control Module - Removal > Page 514
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If SCCM is already assembled and needs to be installed, bypass ASSEMBLY and proceed
with SCCM 1.
ASSEMBLY
1. Connect the right stalk electrical connector.
2. Slide the right stalk into the groove and install the one retaining screw.
3. Connect the left stalk switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering
Column Control Module - Removal > Page 515
4. Install the left stalk switch retaining screw.
SCCM
1. Position the SCCM (3) over the steering column shaft (2). 2. Install the three screws (1).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the instrument panel harness, ensure wiring is properly
routed. Then check that the connectors, locking
tabs are properly engaged.
4. Install steering column shrouds See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation. Be sure all wires are inside of shrouds.
5. Install steering wheel ensuring the flats on hub align with the clockspring See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and
Repair/Installation. Pull the airbag leads through the larger slot. Ensure leads do not get pinched
under the steering wheel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering
Column Control Module - Removal > Page 516
NOTE: There is a small wire harness in the steering wheel and it contains the horn circuits and
speed control circuits.
6. Connect the speed control and horn wire connector into the clockspring. 7. Pull the grenade pin
out of the clockspring. 8. Install the driver airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air
Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation
WARNING: Do not connect the negative battery cable at this time. Perform the Air Bag System
Test prior to connecting the negative battery
cable See: Restraint Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
Failure to follow this warning may result in accidental air bag deployment and possible serious or
fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Learn Procedure
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Learn Procedure > Page 523
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 528
Control Module: Diagrams
Connector (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
MODULE-ALL WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Final
Drive Control Module - Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
The AWD ECM (electronic control module) mounts on the driver side cowl side panel, where it is
concealed by the instrument panel. It communicates with other systems over the high-speed
CAN-C bus.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Final
Drive Control Module - Description > Page 531
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The all-wheel-drive system requires no driver input or control. Under most driving conditions, it is
passive and power is transmitted to the front wheels alone. The system functions to optimize
traction and handling under the following conditions:
Anticipates slip by responding to pedal position unlike all-wheel drive systems that rely on pumps
or viscous fluids to transfer torque, the system requires no front-to-rear slippage for activation. This
allows the system to transfer torque in response to accelerator pedal position. If the driver is asking
for a lot of power, the system immediately starts clamping the Electronically Controlled Coupling
(ECC), transferring a high percentage of power to the rear wheels. This avoids front wheel
slippage, as power to propel the car is transmitted through all four tires. This mode of operation is
called open-loop operation in that there is no feedback to affect the torque transfer.
Modulates torque to optimize traction on slippery surfaces a second, closed loop, operating mode
uses feedback from the wheel-speed sensors to determine the appropriate torque transfer. When
the front wheels slip, the all-wheel-drive electronic control module tells the ECC to start clamping,
sending power to the rear wheels. Attempting the same aggressive launch described above with
the front wheels on ice and the rear wheels on dry pavement, the ECC sends even more torque to
the rear wheels to minimize slippage and launch the vehicle. Both modes are always active and the
maximum of the two is chosen. Power to the rear wheels is modulated during lost of traction while
traveling at freeway speeds; for example, hydroplaning on a puddle of water, will send very little
power to the rear wheels because the controller knows at those speeds a lot of power is not
needed at the rear wheels.
Prevents binding during low-speed turns a third condition, which is independent of the others, uses
the ESP steering angle sensor to determine when the vehicle is turning in a tight circle. This
condition causes the electronic control module to reduce torque to the rear wheels to prevent
binding in the driveline. The electronic control module is always checking for this condition as well.
Influences handling at moderate speeds. The AWD system is used to influence vehicle dynamics.
Other manufacturers limit AWD to aiding traction or providing off-road capability. They concentrate
on launching the vehicle or going off road at speeds up to about 25 mph (40 km/hr). Above that
speed range, they use it to limit wheel slip for traction. Additional ECM calibration controls torque to
the rear wheels for improved handling in the 25-65 mph (40-105 km/hr) range. In this speed range,
the system utilizes torque to the rear wheels during cornering with the throttle open to make the car
turn more easily - make the handling more neutral. This is more readily accomplished with an
electronically controlled system, than with viscous-coupling or gerotor systems that require some
degree of front-to-rear slip to transfer torque to the rear wheels. Above 53 mph (113 km/hr), the
control strategy
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Final
Drive Control Module - Description > Page 532
provides minimal torque to the rear wheels under normal driving conditions to aid fuel economy.
Works with ESP and Traction Control the electronic control module also interfaces with the ESP
and traction control systems. The interface allows the ESP system to use the ECC to help gain
control of the vehicle. For this purpose, torque transmitted to the rear wheels by the ECC can be
reduced. The AWD system is not traction control. It only works on situations where front-to-rear
traction varies, for instance, front wheels on ice, rear wheels on dry pavement or climbing steep
grades. AWD does not aid side-to-side traction. ESP does that through brake intervention.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive
Control Module - Removal
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the left front trim panel. 2. Remove the electrical connector. 3. Remove the mounting
nuts. 4. Remove the ECC module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive
Control Module - Removal > Page 535
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install ECC module into mounting studs. 2. Install mounting nuts and tighten to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.)
torque. 3. Install the electrical connector. 4. Install the left front trim panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 540
Heated Glass Element Relay: Diagrams
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer
Motor Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Relay - Description
Headlamp Washer Motor Relay: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Relay - Description
DESCRIPTION
The headlamp washer relay (1) is a conventional International Standards Organization (ISO)
skirted relay. Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions,
current capacities, terminal patterns (2), and terminal functions. This relay is contained within a
small, rectangular, molded plastic housing and is connected to all of the required inputs and
outputs through five integral male spade-type terminals that extend from the relay base plate.
The headlamp washer relay is located in a dedicated connector on a take out of the Front End
Module (FEM) wire harness, and is secured to the radiator closure panel to the left of the washer
reservoir in front of the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) in the engine compartment, near
the battery. The headlamp washer relay cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or
damaged, the unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer
Motor Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Relay - Description > Page 546
Headlamp Washer Motor Relay: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Relay - Operation
OPERATION
The headlamp washer relay is an electromechanical switch that uses a low current input from the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control a high current output to the headlamp washer
pump/motor unit. The movable common feed contact point is held against the fixed normally closed
contact point by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field is
produced by the coil windings. This electromagnetic field draws the movable relay contact point
away from the fixed normally closed contact point, and holds it against the fixed normally open
contact point. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure returns the movable contact
point back against the fixed normally closed contact point. A resistor is connected in parallel with
the relay coil in the relay, and helps to dissipate voltage spikes and electromagnetic interference
that can be generated as the electromagnetic field of the relay coil collapses.
The headlamp washer relay terminals are connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness. The inputs and
outputs of the headlamp washer relay include:
- Common Feed Terminal - The common feed terminal (30) is connected to battery current on a
fused B(+) circuit from a fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) at all times.
Coil Ground Terminal - The coil ground terminal (85) is connected to battery current on a fused run
relay output circuit from a fuse in the TIPM at all times. This circuit is energized by the run relay
only while the engine is running.
- Coil Battery Terminal - The coil battery terminal (86) is connected to a low side driver output from
the TIPM on a headlamp washer relay control circuit. The TIPM controls headlamp washer system
operation through this relay connection.
- Normally Open Terminal - The normally open terminal (87) is connected through a headlamp
washer relay output circuit to the headlamp washer pump/motor unit at all times. When the relay is
energized, the normally open terminal of the relay is connected to battery current from the fuse in
the TIPM.
- Normally Closed Terminal - The normally closed terminal (87A) is not connected to any circuit in
this application, but will have battery current present whenever the headlamp washer relay coil is
not energized.
The headlamp washer relay as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the relay may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or the communication between modules and other devices that provide
some features of the headlamp washer system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to
diagnose the headlamp washer relay or the electronic controls and communication related to
headlamp washer system operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 552
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-HOOD AJAR - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch
- Description
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The hood ajar switch is a normally closed, single pole, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch. This
switch has two unique versions that are used in two different applications. One switch is used only
on vehicles equipped with the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) for sale in certain export
markets where protection of the underhood area is required equipment. The second switch is used
only on domestic vehicles equipped with an optional remote starter system.
The molded plastic switch body (5) has an integral molded connector receptacle (1) on the lower
end containing two terminal pins. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out of the headlamp and dash wire harness. Two integral latches (2) lock the switch
into a keyed mounting hole in the stamped steel switch mounting bracket. The mounting bracket is
secured with screws to the right inner fender shield near the fender ledge in the engine
compartment. The underside of the hood panel inner reinforcement actuates the switch plunger as
the hood panel is closed.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) and a sleeve-like retainer ring on the
upper end of the switch body. The retainer ring has a one time, self-adjustment feature that is
activated after the switch is installed by closing the hood. The retainer ring is also color-coded to
aid in identifying the switch application. A dark brown retainer ring identifies the underhood security
switch application, while a white retainer ring identifies the remote starter system application.
An installed hood ajar switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, or requires readjustment, it must be replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch
- Description > Page 555
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The hood ajar switches are interchangeable physically, but not functionally. In each case, the hood
ajar switch is a normally closed switch that is held open as the spring-loaded switch plunger is
depressed by the inner hood panel reinforcement when the hood panel is closed and latched.
When the hood is opened, the spring-loaded switch plunger extends from the switch body and the
switch contacts are closed.
In the underhood security application (export vehicles only - dark brown retainer ring), the switch is
connected in series between ground and the hood ajar switch sense input of the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM uses an internal resistor pull up to monitor the state of the hood
ajar switch contacts.
In the remote starter system application (domestic vehicles only - white retainer ring) the switch has
a 1 kilohm diagnostic resistor connected in parallel to the switch contacts between the two switch
terminals. The switch is connected in series between an output of the TIPM and the hood ajar
switch sense input of the TIPM. The TIPM continually monitors this circuit and it will store a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that it detects.
The components of the switch self-adjustment feature include an integral stop on the shaft of the
plunger and a ribbed, ratcheting sleeve-like retainer ring at the top of the switch body from which
the plunger extends. With the switch mounting collar secured in its mounting bracket, the plunger is
depressed by the hood inner reinforcement as the hood is closed. As the plunger is depressed, the
plunger stop contacts the top of the retainer ring and it is driven downward, ratcheting through the
switch mounting collar until the hood is fully closed and latched. The ribs on the retainer ring are
engaged within the mounting collar to maintain this adjusted position.
The hood ajar switch as well as the hard-wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices related to hood ajar
switch operation that provide some features of the export vehicle theft or domestic remote starter
systems. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to hood ajar switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal
SWITCH
1. Unlatch and open the hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect
the wire harness connector (3) from the switch connector receptacle. 4. From the top of the hood
ajar switch mounting bracket (2), squeeze the two switch latch tabs together and pull the switch (1)
upward through the
hole in the mounting bracket.
5. Remove the hood ajar switch from the mounting bracket and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal > Page 558
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Installation
SWITCH
NOTE: Self-adjustment of the hood ajar switch is a one-time feature. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, removed or requires readjustment,
it must be replaced with a new unit.
1. Position the hood ajar switch (1) above the hole in the mounting bracket (2). 2. Press the switch
into the mounting hole until the integral switch latch tabs lock it into place. 3. Connect the harness
connector (3) to the switch connector receptacle. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Close
and latch the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Locations > Page 562
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 8 WAY
SWITCH-BANK - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Description and Operation > Instrument Cluster Switch
Pod - Description
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Description and Operation Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM) is located in the center stack area of the instrument
panel just below the heater and air conditioner duct and above the radio. This switch is available in
multiple configurations, which vary from a single momentary push button switch to as many as six
momentary push button switches, depending upon the optional equipment in the vehicle. The pod
may include the following switches:
- Heated Seats (if equipped) (1)
- Electronic Stability Program Off (2)
- Hazard Warning (3)
- Headlamp Leveling (export only) (4)
- Electrical Inverter On/Off (domestic only) (5)
The switch housing and the push buttons are constructed of molded plastic. Each push button has
a smooth finish and is clearly identified with the appropriate text and International Control and
Display Symbol icons. Several of the push buttons feature Light Emitting Diode (LED) units to give
the vehicle operator an indication when the function of that switch is currently active.
Four screws secure the switch to the back of the instrument panel center bezel through integral
mounting tabs that are molded into each corner of the switch housing. The back of the switch
housing has an integral connector receptacle containing terminal pins that connect the switch to the
vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness.
Panel lamps dimmer controlled illumination lamps integral to the circuit board within the switch
provide back lighting for visibility at night, but these lamps are not serviceable. The individual
switches in the ASBM cannot be repaired and are not serviced individually. If any component within
the switch pod is ineffective or damaged, the entire switch pod must be replaced.
The Domestic version of the ASBM is as follows:
- Heated Seat Switches (if equipped) - See: Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame/Seat Heater
Switch/Description and Operation/Heated Seat Switch - Description.
- ESP Off - See: Brakes and Traction Control/Description and Operation.
- Hazard Switch (all models) - See: Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Hazard Warning
Switch/Description and Operation/Hazard Warning Switch - Description.
- Electrical Inverter (domestic models).
The Export version of the ASBM will vary from the domestic:
- Heated Seat Switches (if equipped) - See: Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame/Seat Heater
Switch/Description and Operation/Heated Seat Switch - Description.
- Hazard Switch (all models) - See: Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Hazard Warning
Switch/Description and Operation/Hazard Warning Switch - Description.
- Headlamp Leveling Switch (if equipped) - .
Each individual switch is not available for service replacement. If one or more switches are
inoperative, the entire ASBM must be replaced. See: Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster Switch
Pod - Removal. To diagnose the ASBM switches, use a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic
information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Description and Operation > Instrument Cluster Switch
Pod - Description > Page 565
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Description and Operation Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Operation
OPERATION
For information covering details of operation for the individual switches or indicator contained within
the instrument panel switch pod, refer to the specific service information covering the system to
which that switch or indicator belongs.
- Heated Seat Switches (if equipped) - See: Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame/Seat Heater
Switch/Description and Operation/Heated Seat Switch - Description.
- ESP On/Off (domestic models) - See: Brakes and Traction Control/Description and Operation.
- Hazard Switch (all models) - See: Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Hazard Warning
Switch/Description and Operation/Hazard Warning Switch - Description.
- Electrical Inverter (domestic models)
- Headlamp Leveling Switch (if equipped) - .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Removal
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Service and Repair Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel center bezel.
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the switch by depressing the lock tab and pulling
connector from the ASBM. 4. Remove the four screws (1) to the Accessory Switch Bank Module
(ASBM). 5. Remove the ASBM from the instrument panel center bezel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Removal > Page 568
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Service and Repair Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the accessory switch bank module (ASBM) in the center bezel and install the four
screws (1). 2. Connect the electrical connector to the ASBM. Be sure the lock tab engages
securely into the ASBM. 3. Install the instrument panel center bezel. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch > Page 573
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch > Page 574
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch > Page 575
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
Remote Switch: Diagrams Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
SWITCH-REMOTE RADIO-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
> Page 578
Remote Switch: Diagrams Right Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
SWITCH-REMOTE RADIO-RIGHT - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
> Page 579
Remote Switch: Diagrams Left Steering Wheel Switch (EVIC) (Steering Wheel) 4 Way
Connector (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-STEERING WHEEL-LEFT (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
> Page 580
Remote Switch: Diagrams Right Steering Wheel Switch (EVIC) (Steering Wheel) 10 Way
Connector (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 10 WAY
SWITCH-STEERING WHEEL-RIGHT (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 581
Remote Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Remote radio control switches are rocker-type switch units are mounted in the upper spoke covers
of the rear (instrument panel side) steering wheel trim cover. The switch unit on the left side is the
seek switch and has seek up, seek down, and preset station advance switch functions. The switch
unit on the right side is the volume control switch and has volume up, volume down, and mode
advance switch functions.
The two remote radio switch units are each retained in a mounting hole located on opposite sides
of the rear steering wheel trim cover by four integral snap features. A plastic bracket on the back of
each switch unit provides additional support for the unit by extending towards the center of the
steering wheel where it is clamped between the steering wheel armature and the steering wheel
rear trim cover mounting boss by the trim cover mounting screw.
The two remote radio switch units share a common steering wheel wire harness with the vehicle
speed control switches. The steering wheel wire harness is connected to the instrument panel wire
harness through the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 582
Remote Switch: Testing and Inspection
REMOTE SWITCHES
Any diagnosis of the Audio system should begin with the use of the scan tool. For information on
the use of the scan tool, refer to the appropriate Diagnostic Service information.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the remote radio switch(es) from the
steering wheel. 2. Use an ohmmeter to check the switch resistances as shown in the Remote
Radio Switch Test table. If the remote radio switch resistances check
OK, go to 3. If not OK, replace the faulty switch.
REMOTE RADIO SWITCH TEST
3. Reconnect the battery negative cable. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. Check for 5
volts at the radio control circuit cavities of the
steering wheel wire harness connectors for both remote radio switches. If OK, refer to the proper
Body Diagnostic Procedures. If not OK, repair the circuit as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches - Removal
Remote Switch: Service and Repair Remote Radio Switches - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the driver side airbag module from
the steering wheel. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air
Bag - Removal.
3. Disconnect the horn connector (3). 4. Remove retainers (1) and remove the horn button
assembly (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches - Removal >
Page 585
5. Remove the speed control switch (3) See: Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control/Cruise Control
Switch/Service and Repair/Speed Control Switch
- Removal.
6. Disconnect the radio switches (1). 7. From the inside of the steering wheel rear trim cover, press
firmly and evenly outward on the back of the switch to disengage the four snap features
that secure the switch to the inside of the mounting hole.
8. From the outside of the steering wheel rear trim cover, remove the remote radio switch from the
trim cover mounting hole.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches - Removal >
Page 586
Remote Switch: Service and Repair Remote Radio Switches - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Position the remote radio switch to the mounting hole on the outside of the steering wheel rear
trim cover. Be certain that the connector receptacle
is oriented toward the bottom of the switch and pointed toward the center of the steering wheel.
2. Press firmly and evenly on the remote radio switch until each of the switch snap features is fully
engaged in the mounting hole of the steering
wheel rear trim cover.
3. Reconnect the steering wheel wire harness connector to the connector receptacle of the remote
radio switch (1).
4. Install the speed control switch (3) See: Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control/Cruise Control
Switch/Service and Repair/Speed Control Switch Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches - Removal >
Page 587
5. Install the horn button assembly (2) and install the three retainers (1). 6. Connect the horn
connector (3).
7. Install the driver side airbag module to the steering wheel See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag Installation.
8. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Door Lock Cylinder
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal
Door Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove door trim panel See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door
Trim
Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the wiring clip and pigtail wire connector. 4. Remove the Door Cylinder Lock Switch
from door lock cylinder.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Door Lock Cylinder
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal > Page 593
Door Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the Door Cylinder Lock Switch onto the door lock cylinder. 2. Connect the wiring clip and
pigtail wire connector. 3. Install door trim panel See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim
Panel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 598
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-HOOD AJAR - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Description
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The hood ajar switch is a normally closed, single pole, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch. This
switch has two unique versions that are used in two different applications. One switch is used only
on vehicles equipped with the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) for sale in certain export
markets where protection of the underhood area is required equipment. The second switch is used
only on domestic vehicles equipped with an optional remote starter system.
The molded plastic switch body (5) has an integral molded connector receptacle (1) on the lower
end containing two terminal pins. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out of the headlamp and dash wire harness. Two integral latches (2) lock the switch
into a keyed mounting hole in the stamped steel switch mounting bracket. The mounting bracket is
secured with screws to the right inner fender shield near the fender ledge in the engine
compartment. The underside of the hood panel inner reinforcement actuates the switch plunger as
the hood panel is closed.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) and a sleeve-like retainer ring on the
upper end of the switch body. The retainer ring has a one time, self-adjustment feature that is
activated after the switch is installed by closing the hood. The retainer ring is also color-coded to
aid in identifying the switch application. A dark brown retainer ring identifies the underhood security
switch application, while a white retainer ring identifies the remote starter system application.
An installed hood ajar switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, or requires readjustment, it must be replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Description > Page 601
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The hood ajar switches are interchangeable physically, but not functionally. In each case, the hood
ajar switch is a normally closed switch that is held open as the spring-loaded switch plunger is
depressed by the inner hood panel reinforcement when the hood panel is closed and latched.
When the hood is opened, the spring-loaded switch plunger extends from the switch body and the
switch contacts are closed.
In the underhood security application (export vehicles only - dark brown retainer ring), the switch is
connected in series between ground and the hood ajar switch sense input of the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM uses an internal resistor pull up to monitor the state of the hood
ajar switch contacts.
In the remote starter system application (domestic vehicles only - white retainer ring) the switch has
a 1 kilohm diagnostic resistor connected in parallel to the switch contacts between the two switch
terminals. The switch is connected in series between an output of the TIPM and the hood ajar
switch sense input of the TIPM. The TIPM continually monitors this circuit and it will store a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that it detects.
The components of the switch self-adjustment feature include an integral stop on the shaft of the
plunger and a ribbed, ratcheting sleeve-like retainer ring at the top of the switch body from which
the plunger extends. With the switch mounting collar secured in its mounting bracket, the plunger is
depressed by the hood inner reinforcement as the hood is closed. As the plunger is depressed, the
plunger stop contacts the top of the retainer ring and it is driven downward, ratcheting through the
switch mounting collar until the hood is fully closed and latched. The ribs on the retainer ring are
engaged within the mounting collar to maintain this adjusted position.
The hood ajar switch as well as the hard-wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices related to hood ajar
switch operation that provide some features of the export vehicle theft or domestic remote starter
systems. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to hood ajar switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch
- Removal
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal
SWITCH
1. Unlatch and open the hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect
the wire harness connector (3) from the switch connector receptacle. 4. From the top of the hood
ajar switch mounting bracket (2), squeeze the two switch latch tabs together and pull the switch (1)
upward through the
hole in the mounting bracket.
5. Remove the hood ajar switch from the mounting bracket and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch
- Removal > Page 604
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Installation
SWITCH
NOTE: Self-adjustment of the hood ajar switch is a one-time feature. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, removed or requires readjustment,
it must be replaced with a new unit.
1. Position the hood ajar switch (1) above the hole in the mounting bracket (2). 2. Press the switch
into the mounting hole until the integral switch latch tabs lock it into place. 3. Connect the harness
connector (3) to the switch connector receptacle. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Close
and latch the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch > Page 609
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Connector C1 - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way > Page 612
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C2 (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way > Page 613
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Except Base) (Front
Door) 10 Way
Connector (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way > Page 614
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Base) (Front Door) 8
Way
Connector (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 615
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
VOLTAGE
The following wiring test sequence determines whether or not voltage is continuous through the
body harness to switch.
1. Remove switch from door trim panel. 2. Carefully separate multiple terminal block on wiring
harness from switch body. 3. Connect one lead of test light to a ground terminal:
- Touch other test light lead to battery feed B+ terminal.
- If test light comes on, the wiring circuit between the battery and switch is functional.
- If test light does not come on, check for a blown fuse. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for circuit
information.
DOOR LOCK SWITCH
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the auto-express feature for power windows, the local interface
network (LIN) controls the lock, mirror and
window features.
Remove the non-express switch from its mounting location. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the DOOR
LOCK SWITCH CONTINUITY table to determine if the continuity is correct in the LOCK and
UNLOCK switch positions. If these results are not obtained, replace the switch.
DOOR LOCK SWITCH CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Lock Switch - Removal
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Power Lock Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative remote cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent,
carefully pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
switch wire connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Lock Switch - Removal > Page 618
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Power Lock Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect switch wire connector. 2. Install the switch by snapping into place. 3. Connect the
battery negative remote cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Mirror Switch - Removal
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair Power Mirror Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent, carefully
pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect switch wire
connector. 4. Remove switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Mirror Switch - Removal > Page 623
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair Power Mirror Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect switch wire connector. 2. Install the switch to the door trim panel. 3. Connect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 627
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (SEAT) 11 WAY
SWITCH-SEAT-DRIVER - (SEAT) 11 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Seat Switch - Description
Power Seat Switch: Description and Operation Power Seat Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The driver power seat can be adjusted in six different ways using the power seat switch. The power
seat switch (2) is located on the lower outboard side of the seat cushion (1) on the seat cushion
side shield (3). The power seat system incorporates a seat switch with a seat cushion control
paddle.
The individual components in the power seat switch assembly cannot be repaired. If the switch is
damaged or inoperative, the entire power seat switch must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Seat Switch - Description > Page 630
Power Seat Switch: Description and Operation Power Seat Switch - Operation
OPERATION
When a power seat switch is actuated, a battery feed and a ground path are applied through the
switch contacts to the power seat track adjuster motor. The selected adjuster motor operates to
move the seat through its drive unit in the selected direction until the switch is released, or until the
travel limit of the adjuster is reached. When the switch is moved in the opposite direction, the
battery feed and ground path to the motor are reversed through the switch contacts. This causes
the adjuster motor to run in the opposite direction.
No power seat switch should be held applied in any direction after the adjuster has reached its
travel limit. The power seat adjuster motors each contain a self-resetting circuit breaker to protect
them from overload. However, consecutive or frequent resetting of the circuit breaker may result in
motor damage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 631
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
POWER SEAT SWITCH
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the power seat switch from the
power seat See: Service and Repair/Power Seat Switch - Removal. 3. Use an ohmmeter to test the
continuity of the power seat switch. Refer to POWER SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY table. If not
OK, replace the
faulty power seat switch. If switch tests OK See: Body and Frame/Seats/Testing and Inspection.
POWER SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Seat Switch - Removal
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Power Seat Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the outboard seat cushion side
shield (3). 3. Disconnect the power seat switch electrical harness connector (4). 4. Using a small
flat bladed tool, gently release the four mounting tabs (1) that secure the power seat switch (2) and
separate switch from side shield
(3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Seat Switch - Removal > Page 634
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Power Seat Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the power seat switch (2) onto the seat cushion side shield (3). Gently apply pressure to
the switch until the four mounting tabs (1) are
fully seated into place.
2. Connect the power seat switch electrical connector (4). 3. Install the seat cushion outboard side
shield. 4. Connect the battery negative cable. 5. Verify normal operation of the power seat
assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Switch - Description
Seat Heater Switch: Description and Operation Heated Seat Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
Two heated seat switches are located in the center stack of the instrument panel. The switches are
located on the outer edges of the Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM). The ASBM (3) is
located just below the radio (1) and just above the heater and air conditioner controls (2) in the
center stack area of the instrument panel. If either of the switches is damaged or inoperative the
complete ASBM assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Switch - Description > Page 639
Each heated seat switch (4) provides a resistor-multiplexed signal to the instrument cluster,
sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN). Amber Light Emitting Diodes (LEDs)
on the outside edge of each switch indicate the level of heat in use: Two LEDs are illuminated for
high, one for low, and none for off. Pressing the switch once will select high-level heating. Pressing
the switch a second time will select low-level heating. Pressing the switch a third time will shut the
heating elements off.
The LED indicator lamps in each heated seat switch cannot be repaired. If the LED lamps are
inoperative or damaged, or the switch is inoperative or damaged the complete ASBM assembly
must be replaced, See: Service and Repair/Heated Seat Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Switch - Description > Page 640
Seat Heater Switch: Description and Operation Heated Seat Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The heated seat switches (4) are active any time the Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus is
active. Depressing the heated seat switch provides a switch status message to the instrument
cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN), via the LIN data bus. The
CCN is responsible for supplying the LIN data bus message to the heated seat module, signaling
the module to power the heated seat element of the selected seat and maintain the temperature
setting. If the heated seat switch is depressed to a different position (Low or High) than the
currently selected state, the CCN will go through the process again to change the temperature
setting.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 641
Seat Heater Switch: Testing and Inspection
HEATED SEAT SWITCH
In order to obtain conclusive testing, the heated seat system and the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus circuit must be checked. Any diagnosis of the heated seat system should begin with, the
use of a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic service information.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector pin-out
information.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the heated seat option utilize a low voltage cut-off feature. This
feature turns off power to the heated seat
system anytime vehicle voltage is below 11.7v or above 15.5v. Be certain to check the vehicle
electrical system for proper voltage anytime the power seat system appears inoperative.
Before any testing of the heated seat system is attempted, the battery should be fully-charged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Seat Switch - Removal
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The heated seat switches are integral to the Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM) and
cannot be serviced separately. The complete
ASBM assembly must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center bezel from the
instrument panel, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Remove the four screws (1) that secure the ASBM (2) to the back of the instrument panel center
bezel (3) and remove the ASBM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Seat Switch - Removal > Page 644
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There are different Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM) configurations available based
on the option content of the vehicle.
Ensure the ASBM being installed matches the vehicle options.
1. Position the ASBM (2) onto the back of the instrument panel center bezel (3). 2. Install the four
screws (1) that secure the ASBM to the center bezel. Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 3.
Install the center bezel onto the instrument panel, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable. 5. Verify heated seat system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 648
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
SWITCH-SUNROOF - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Sunroof Switch - Description
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Description and Operation Sunroof Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The power sunroof switch (3) is a combination push-button and rocker switch module mounted in
the overhead console assembly (1). The sunroof switch is a direct contact unit that is directly wired
to the sunroof motor/module assembly. The sunroof switch performs the following functions:
- Power sunroof open (back of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof express open (back of switch pushed and released)
- Power sunroof closed (front of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof express closed (front of switch pushed and released)
- Power sunroof vent (switch center button pushed)
The power sunroof switch cannot be repaired. If the individual components are damaged or
inoperative the switch assembly must be replaced, See: Service and Repair/Sunroof Switch Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Sunroof Switch - Description > Page 651
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Description and Operation Sunroof Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The sunroof is electrically operated from two switches located in the headliner on the
courtesy/reading lamp assembly. The power sunroof switch is hard wired to the sunroof
motor/module assembly. The "VENT" switch is a push button type switch and opens the sunroof to
the vent position only. The other switch "OPEN/CLOSED" is a rocker type switch for opening and
closing the sunroof. Pressing and releasing the open button once, the sunroof will express open
and the wind deflector will raise. If the button is pressed a second time the sunroof will stop in that
position. Pressing and releasing the close button once will express close the sunroof. If the close
button is pressed a second time during the express close operation the sunroof will stop in that
position.
The switch is grounded at one terminal and receives a 5 volt signal from the sunroof motor/module
on the remaining three terminals. The switch pulls down the 5 volt reference voltage from the
module signaling it to perform the desired function.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 652
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
SUNROOF SWITCH
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
1. Remove the overhead console, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service
and Repair/Overhead Console - Removal. 2. Disconnect the power sunroof switch wire harness
connector. 3. With the ignition key in the "RUN" position check for 5 volts on the "OPEN", "CLOSE"
and "VENT" circuits of the sunroof switch harness
connector. If OK, go to 4. If not OK, inspect the wiring harness and connectors between the
motor/module and switch for damage and repair as necessary.
4. With the ignition key in the "OFF" position check for continuity between the ground circuit of the
sunroof switch harness connector and a known
good ground. Continuity should be present. If OK, go to 5. If not OK, inspect the wiring harness and
connector and repair the ground circuit as necessary.
5. Using an ohmmeter, test the continuity of the power sunroof switch in each switch position. Refer
to the POWER SUNROOF SWITCH
CONTINUITY TABLE. If OK, inspect the wiring harness and connectors for damage and repair as
necessary. If not OK, replace the overhead console assembly, See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Removal.
POWER SUNROOF SWITCH CONTINUITY TABLE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Switch - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair Sunroof Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove overhead console, See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Removal. 3. Using
a suitable flat bladed tool, release the mounting tabs from the sides of the sunroof control switch
and pull the switch out of the overhead
console assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Switch - Removal > Page 655
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair Sunroof Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the sunroof control switch into the overhead console assembly. Push the switch until it is
securely held in place by the mounting tabs. 2. Install the overhead console, See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Installation. 3.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 660
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-BRAKE FLUID LEVEL - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 661
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The brake fluid level switch (2) is mounted through the center of the fluid reservoir. The switch can
be serviced separately from the master cylinder fluid reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Fluid Level Switch - Removal
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Brake Fluid Level Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Brakes and Traction Control/Service Precautions/Technician
Safety Information See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Service Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Remove the wiring harness connector (1) from the brake fluid level switch (2) in the master
cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
2. Push together the retaining tabs (1) that hold the brake fluid level switch in place in the brake
fluid reservoir (2). 3. Pull the brake fluid level switch out the right side of the reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Fluid Level Switch - Removal > Page 664
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Brake Fluid Level Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Align the brake fluid level switch with its mounting hole on the right side of the master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir. Push the switch into the fluid
reservoir until the switch retaining tabs (1) are expanded on the opposite side of the reservoir (2),
locking it in place.
2. Connect the wiring harness connector (1) to the switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 668
Lateral Accelerometer: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 4 WAY
SENSOR-DYNAMICS - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 669
Lateral Accelerometer: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensors are housed into one unit known as the Dynamics
Sensor (1). The sensor is used to measure side-to-side (Lateral) motion and vehicle rotational
sensing (how fast the vehicle is turning - Yaw).
The Dynamics Sensor (1) is located on the floor tunnel just forward of the center floor console (2),
below the instrument panel.
Yaw and Lateral Acceleration Sensors cannot be serviced separately. The entire Dynamics Sensor
must be replaced when necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from the battery post.
2. Remove the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below instrument panel.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness connector (3) at the dynamics sensor (1). 4. Working on each
side of the floor tunnel, remove the nuts (2) mounting the dynamics sensor to the floor pan tunnel
(4). 5. Remove the dynamics sensor (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal > Page 672
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the dynamics sensor (1) over the studs mounted to the floor pan tunnel (4). 2. Working on
each side of the floor pan tunnel (4), install the two mounting nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 9 Nm (80
in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wiring harness connector (3) to the dynamics sensor (1).
4. Install the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below the instrument panel.
5. Connect the battery negative cable to the battery post. It is important that this be performed
properly. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service
and Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection
6. Perform the Verification Test and clear any faults. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Brake
Bleeding/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 676
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 677
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 1 WAY
SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE - (BODY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
There are two unique park brake switches used on this vehicle, depending upon whether the
vehicle has a foot-operated or hand-operated park brake lever mechanism.
FOOT-OPERATED
Foot-Operated Park Brake Switch
The foot-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the cowl
side inner panel below the instrument panel, outboard of the steering column. This switch includes
a spade-type output terminal (3) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the
stationary contact within a molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive switch
location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact with an integral grounding lug (4) on
one end and an integral actuating lever and follower (2) on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The foot-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged,
it must be replaced.
HAND-OPERATED
Hand-Operated Park Brake Switch
The hand-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the floor
panel transmission tunnel below the center floor console. This switch includes a spade-type output
terminal (2) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out
and
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page 680
connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the stationary contact within a
molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab (4) on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive
switch location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact (3) with an integral grounding lug
on one end and an integral actuating lever and follower on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The hand-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or
damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page 681
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Operation
OPERATION
Both the foot-operated and hand-operated park brake switch are normally closed, mechanically
actuated leaf contact switches that are operated by the foot or hand park brake lever mechanism.
The switch is grounded through its mounting to the park brake lever mechanism and provides a
ground input to the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab
Compartment Node/CCN) on a park brake switch sense circuit whenever the park brake is applied,
and opens this circuit whenever the park brake is released. The park brake switch sense input to
the EMIC is used as a logic input by the EMIC for control of the brake indicator and may also be
used as a logic input for other electronic features in the vehicle.
The park brake switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that rely upon inputs
from the park brake switch. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the
electronic controls and communication related to park brake switch operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 682
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
PARK BRAKE SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: If the brake indicator stays ON with the ignition switch in the ON position and the park brake
released, or comes ON while driving,
the brake system must be diagnosed and repaired prior to performing the following tests. See:
Brakes and Traction Control/Testing and Inspection . If no brake system problem is found, the
following procedures will help to locate a shorted or open park brake switch sense circuit, or an
ineffective park brake switch.
INDICATOR ILLUMINATES DURING BULB TEST, BUT DOES NOT WHEN PARK BRAKE
APPLIED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Apply the parking brake. Check for continuity between the park brake switch terminal and a good
ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake
switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavities of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and the instrument panel wire harness connector for the instrument
cluster. There should be continuity. If not OK, repair the open park brake switch sense circuit
between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster as required.
INDICATOR REMAINS ILLUMINATED - BRAKE SYSTEM CHECKS OKAY
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Check for continuity between the terminal of the park brake switch and a good ground. There
should be no continuity with the park brake released, and continuity with the park brake applied. If
OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavity of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and a good ground. There should be no continuity. If not OK, repair the
shorted park brake switch sense circuit between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster
as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Apply the parking brake. 3. Reach under
the left end of the instrument panel to access and disconnect the wire harness connector from the
terminal of the park brake switch (2)
located on the park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side inner panel.
4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever mechanism. 5.
Remove the switch from the park brake lever mechanism.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the console from the floor panel
transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center
Console - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 685
3. Pull the parking brake lever (1) upward to apply the parking brake. 4. Disconnect the wire
harness connector from the terminal of the park brake switch (2) located on the right side of the
park brake lever mechanism. 5. Remove the screw (3) that secures the switch to the park brake
lever bracket. 6. Remove the switch from the park brake lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 686
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to position the park brake switch (2) onto the
park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side
inner panel. Be certain to engage the locating pin on the back of the switch insulator into the
locating slot in the lever mechanism bracket.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever
mechanism. Tighten the screw to 2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to
the terminal of the park brake switch. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the ON position and check for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake
applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Position park brake switch (2) onto the right side of the park brake lever (1) bracket. Be certain to
engage the locating pin on the back of the
switch insulator into the locating slot in the lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 687
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the switch to the lever bracket. Tighten the screw to
2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the terminal of the switch. 4.
Reinstall the console onto the floor panel transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center
Console - Installation
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 6. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and check
for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Traction Control Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
MODULE-ASBM
The ESP Off Switch (2) is part of the accessory switch bank module located in the center bezel (2)
on the instrument panel above the radio. The ESP Off switch turns the Electronic Stability Program
off whenever the switch is depressed. Depressing the switch a second time turns the ESP(R) back
on. The switch resets itself each time the ignition is cycled.
When the ESP Off switch is depressed and released, turning ESP(R) off, it does not completely
turn the system off. The ESP(R) system reduces torque management to a lesser amount, but
ESP(R) function can still occur if the system perceives the need.
The ESP Off switch is serviced as part of the accessory switch bank. There are different accessory
switch banks available based on the option content of the vehicle. Ensure the accessory switch
bank being installed matches the vehicle options.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Removal
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The ESP Off switch is integral to the accessory switch bank and cannot be serviced
separately.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the center bezel from the
instrument panel and place it on a work bench See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Remove the screws that secure the accessory switch bank to the back of the center bezel and
remove the accessory switch bank.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Removal >
Page 693
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The ESP Off switch is serviced as part of the accessory switch bank.
NOTE: There are different instrument panel accessory switch banks available based on the option
content of the vehicle. Ensure the accessory
switch bank being installed matches the vehicle options.
1. Position the accessory switch bank onto the back of the instrument panel center bezel. 2. Install
the screws that secure the accessory switch bank to the center bezel. Tighten the screws to 2 Nm
(17 in. lbs.). 3. Install the center bezel onto the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Installation.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 5. Perform the ABS Verification Test See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble
Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS Verification Test and make sure the
ESP Off switch operates properly. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Brake Bleeding/Service and
Repair
6. Verify proper operation of all components controlled by the switch bank.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 698
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 699
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 700
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-LEFT REAR - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way > Page 703
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-RIGHT REAR - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way > Page 704
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (Headlamp And Dash) 2 Way
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-LEFT FRONT - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way > Page 705
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (Headlamp And Dash) 2 Way
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-RIGHT FRONT - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wheel Speed Sensor - Description
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensor - Description
Front
DESCRIPTION
The antilock brake system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed
sensors. The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto-resistive to help increase
performance and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A Wheel
Speed Sensor (WSS) is used at each wheel. A magnetic pole encoder serves as the trigger
mechanism for each sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one
encoder.
A front wheel speed sensor (2) is attached to a mounting boss on each front knuckle (3). The
encoder is an integral part of the hub and bearing.
WSS air gaps are not adjustable.
Rear
DESCRIPTION
The antilock brake system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed
sensors. The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto-resistive to help increase
performance and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A Wheel
Speed Sensor (WSS) is used at each wheel. A magnetic pole encoder serves as the trigger
mechanism for each sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one
encoder.
The rear wheel speed sensor (2) head is mounted to the rear hub and bearing (1). The encoder is
integral to the hub and bearing assembly. The encoder is serviced as part of the rear hub and
bearing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wheel Speed Sensor - Description > Page 708
WSS air gaps are not adjustable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wheel Speed Sensor - Description > Page 709
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensor - Operation
Front
OPERATION
The ABM sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the ABM. The relationship of the magnetic pole encoder to the
permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output
of the sensor, sent to the ABM, is a DC voltage signal with changing voltage and current levels.
The ground for the IC and the current sense circuit is provided by the ABM.
When a pole is properly aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8 volts and a
constant 7 mA current is sent to the ABM. As the magnetic pole encoder rotates, the encoder shifts
the magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The ABM senses a voltage
signal of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The ABM measures the amperage of the digital signal
for each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABM as the wheel speed.
Rear
OPERATION
The ABM sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the ABM. The relationship of the magnetic pole encoder to the
permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output
of the sensor, sent to the ABM, is a DC voltage signal with changing voltage and current levels.
The ground for the IC and the current sense circuit is provided by the ABM.
When a pole is properly aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8 volts and a
constant 7 mA current is sent to the ABM. As the magnetic pole encoder rotates, the encoder shifts
the magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The ABM senses a voltage
signal of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The ABM measures the amperage of the digital signal
for each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABM as the wheel speed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Brakes and Traction Control/Service Precautions/Technician
Safety Information See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Service Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Open the hood. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable connector (2) from the wiring
harness connector (3) on top of the frame rail (1) to the inside of the strut
tower.
3. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
4. Remove the grommet (1) from the hole in the body (7) and pull the wheel speed sensor cable
out of the hole. 5. Remove the speed sensor cable routing clip (2) from the outside frame rail (6). 6.
Remove the screw fastening the cable routing clamp (3) to the outside frame rail (6).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 712
7. Remove the screw (2) securing the wheel speed sensor routing bracket (3) to the brake flex
hose bracket (4). 8. Remove the routing clip (1) securing wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle
(5).
9. Remove the mounting screw (1) fastening the wheel speed sensor head (2) to the knuckle (3).
Pull the sensor head out of the knuckle and remove
the sensor from the vehicle.
Rear
REMOVAL
1. Access and remove the rear brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 713
CAUTION: Prior to removal, clean area around sensor head to help prevent contaminants from
entering bearing when sensor head is
removed.
2. Remove the screw (3) fastening the speed sensor head (2) to the hub and bearing (1).
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor routing clip (4) from the brake tube routing bracket (1). 4.
Remove the wheel speed sensor cable from the routing clips (3) above the trailing arm.
5. Remove the wheel speed sensor head (2) from the hub and bearing (1), then pass it through the
brake shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 714
6. Remove the screw (1) fastening the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (2) to the rear
suspension crossmember (3).
7. Remove the screw (2) securing the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (1) to the trailing link.
8. Disconnect the vehicle wiring harness (3) from the wheel speed sensor connector (2) on the
body (1). 9. Disengage the wheel speed sensor connector from the routing clip fastened to the
body using a screwdriver. Pull the connector forward off the
routing clip. Or, if a NEW routing clip is available, remove the routing clip from the body with the
connector attached.
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 715
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Failure to install speed sensor cables properly may result in contact with moving parts
or an over extension of cables causing an
open circuit. Be sure that cables are installed, routed, and clipped properly.
1. Install the wheel speed sensor head (2) into the knuckle (3). Install the mounting screw (1) and
tighten it to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.).
2. Install the routing clip (1) securing the wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle (5). 3. Position
the wheel speed sensor routing bracket (3) on the brake flex hose bracket (4) and install the
mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting
screw to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 716
4. Position the wheel speed sensor cable routing clamp (4) on the outside frame rail (6) and install
the mounting screw (3). Tighten the mounting
screw to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the speed sensor cable routing clip (2) on the outside frame rail (6). 6. Insert the wheel
speed sensor cable through the hole in the body (7) and install the grommet (1) in the hole.
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Connect the wheel speed sensor cable connector (2) to the wiring harness
connector (3) on top of the frame rail (1). 9. Perform the Diagnostic Verification Test and clear any
faults. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
Rear
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 717
1. Slide the wheel speed sensor wiring connector (2) onto the routing clip mounted on the body
until it locks into place or if a NEW routing clip is
attached to the connector, push it into the mounting holes on the body.
2. Connect the vehicle wiring harness (3) to the wheel speed sensor connector (2).
3. Attach the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (2) to the rear suspension crossmember (3) using
the mounting screw (1). Tighten the mounting screw
to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
4. Attach the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (1) to the trailing link using the mounting screw (2).
Tighten the mounting screw to 20 Nm (15 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 718
5. Apply bearing grease (supplied with part) to sensor head shaft and O-ring.
CAUTION: Ensure that sensor mounting surface on bearing is clean before sensor installation.
6. Pass the wheel speed sensor head through the hole in the brake shield, then push it into the
mounting hole in hub and bearing (3) and align the
mounting screw hole.
7. Install a NEW mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting screw to 6 Nm (55 in. lbs.).
8. Install the wheel speed sensor routing clip (4) in the brake tube routing bracket (1). 9. Install the
wheel speed sensor cable into the routing clips (3) above the trailing arm.
10. Install brake rotor as well as all components necessary to access it. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service
and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
11. Perform the ABS Verification Test and clear any faults. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 722
Yaw Rate Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 4 WAY
SENSOR-DYNAMICS - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 723
Yaw Rate Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensors are housed into one unit known as the Dynamics
Sensor (1). The sensor is used to measure side-to-side (Lateral) motion and vehicle rotational
sensing (how fast the vehicle is turning - Yaw).
The Dynamics Sensor (1) is located on the floor tunnel just forward of the center floor console (2),
below the instrument panel.
Yaw and Lateral Acceleration Sensors cannot be serviced separately. The entire Dynamics Sensor
must be replaced when necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from the battery post.
2. Remove the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below instrument panel.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness connector (3) at the dynamics sensor (1). 4. Working on each
side of the floor tunnel, remove the nuts (2) mounting the dynamics sensor to the floor pan tunnel
(4). 5. Remove the dynamics sensor (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal > Page 726
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the dynamics sensor (1) over the studs mounted to the floor pan tunnel (4). 2. Working on
each side of the floor pan tunnel (4), install the two mounting nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 9 Nm (80
in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wiring harness connector (3) to the dynamics sensor (1).
4. Install the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below the instrument panel.
5. Connect the battery negative cable to the battery post. It is important that this be performed
properly. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service
and Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection
6. Perform the Verification Test and clear any faults. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Brake
Bleeding/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 734
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Normal Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 735
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any ECT circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor(s) and the
PCM.
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Turn the ignition on. 5. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the
sensor(s) and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 6. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to
set during the wiggle test.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AND CONDITION
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Check the engine coolant level and the condition of the engine coolant. Refer to the appropriate
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. THERMOSTAT
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Using the appropriate service information, determine the proper opening temperature of the
thermostat. 2. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine
was allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
3. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool. 4. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 736
NOTE: The thermostat should not open until the engine reaches the temperature specified in the
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine was
allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
2. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool and the actual coolant temperature with a
thermometer. 3. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The sensor value transition should be smooth as the engine reaches operating
temperature. The thermometer reading and the coolant
temperature value on the scan tool should remain relatively close.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 5.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
5. (K2) ECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K2) ECT Signal circuit at the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor harness
connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the
voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 737
No
- Repair the (K2) ECT Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
harness connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure
the voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor and the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 742
Cruise Control Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 3 WAY
SWITCH-SPEED CONTROL - (STEERING WHEEL) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speed Control Switch - Removal
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Speed Control Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning steering
wheel removal or installation. Allow the front
airbag system capacitor to discharge for two minutes before removing the steering wheel or any
front airbag system component. This will disable the front airbag system. Failure to disconnect the
battery could result in accidental front airbag module deployment and possible personal injury.Do
not place a non-deployed airbag face down on a hard surface as the airbag will propel into the air if
accidentally deployed, and could result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable before beginning steering wheel removal.
Allow the front airbag system capacitor to discharge
for two minutes before removing the steering wheel or any front airbag system component.
2. Turn off ignition. 3. Remove the driver's side airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air
Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Removal. 4. Disconnect electrical connector (1) from horn
switch (2). 5. Remove mounting screws (3) and horn switch (2) from steering wheel.
6. Disconnect electrical connector (1) from speed control switch (3). 7. Remove screws (4) from
speed control switch (3). 8. Remove speed control switch (3) from steering wheel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speed Control Switch - Removal > Page 745
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Speed Control Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install speed control switch (3) onto the locating pin (2) in the steering wheel. 2. Install speed
control switch mounting screws (4) and tighten screws to 1.6 Nm (15 ins. lbs.). 3. Connect electrical
connector (1) to speed control switch (3).
4. Install horn switch (2) to steering wheel. 5. Install horn switch mounting screws (3) and tighten
screws to 8 Nm (71 ins. lbs.). 6. Connect electrical connector to horn switch. 7. Install driver's side
airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag Installation. 8. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.). 9. Verify vehicle
and system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sender: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 750
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 751
Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Position an oil collecting container under switch location. 3. Disconnect
electrical connector (1). 4. Remove the oil pressure switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal > Page 756
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Thread Sealant to the switch threads. 2. Install oil pressure switch (2). 3.
Connect electrical connector (1). 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Start engine and check for leaks. 6. Check
engine oil level and adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove electrical connector at pressure
differential sensor (2). 3. Remove upstream exhaust pressure tube (4) from catalytic converter 4.
Remove downstream pressure tube (6) from catalytic converter. 5. Remove pressure differential
sensor mounting bolt. 6. Remove pressure differential sensor (2) and tubing (7) from vehicle. 7.
Remove tubing (7) from pressure differential sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 762
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Install tubing (7) on pressure differential sensor (2). 2. Position pressure differential sensor (2)
and tubing (7). 3. Install pressure differential sensor mounting bolt (3). Tighten to 10 Nm (89 in.
lbs.). 4. Install downstream pressure tube (6) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 5. Install upstream pressure tube (4) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10
Nm (89 in. lbs.) 6. Position electrical connector (1) into bracket. 7. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation > Page 767
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 772
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Ambient Temperature Sensor - Description
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation Front Ambient
Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The ambient air temperature sensor is a variable resistor that monitors the air temperature outside
of the vehicle. The ATC system uses the sensor data to maintain optimum cabin temperature
levels. The ambient air temperature sensor is mounted inside the front fascia.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Ambient Temperature Sensor - Description >
Page 775
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation Front Ambient
Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The ambient air temperature sensor is a variable resistor that operates on a 5-volt reference signal
sent by the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The ambient air temperature sensor is
connected to the TIPM through a two-wire lead and connector of the vehicle wire harness. The
ambient air temperature sensor changes its internal resistance in response to changes in the
outside air temperature, which either increases or decreases the reference signal voltage read by
the TIPM. The TIPM converts and broadcasts the sensor data over the Controller Area Network
(CAN) IHS bus, where it is read by the ATC A/C-heater control, Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
and other vehicle control modules.
The ambient air temperature sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The ambient air temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 779
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 780
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 781
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
SENSOR-EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Description
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front Evaporator
Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The evaporator temperature sensor measures the temperature of the conditioned air downstream
of the A/C evaporator. The evaporator temperature sensor is an electrical thermistor (1) mounted
on the end of a molded plastic housing (2) that is inserted into the driver side of the HVAC housing
near the coldest point of the A/C evaporator. The evaporator temperature sensor is retained in the
HVAC housing by two integral retaining tabs (3) and is connected to the vehicle electrical system
by use of a wire lead and connector (4) with two terminals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Description > Page
784
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front Evaporator
Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The evaporator temperature sensor monitors the surface temperature of A/C evaporator and
supplies an input signal to the A/C-heater control. The A/C-heater control uses the evaporator
temperature sensor input signal to optimize A/C system performance and to protect the A/C system
from evaporator freezing. The evaporator temperature sensor will change its internal resistance in
response to the temperatures it monitors and is connected to the A/C-heater control through sensor
ground circuit and a 5-volt reference signal circuit. As the temperature of the A/C evaporator
decreases, the internal resistance of the evaporator temperature sensor decreases.
The A/C-heater control uses the monitored voltage reading as an indication of evaporator
temperature. The A/C-heater control is programmed to respond to this input by requesting the
powertrain control module (PCM) or the engine control module (ECM) (depending on engine
application) to adjust the compressor swash plate angle as necessary to optimize A/C system
performance and to protect the A/C system from evaporator freezing See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Compressor HVAC/Description and Operation/A/C Compressor - Operation.
The evaporator temperature sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool.
The evaporator temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and it must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Removal
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front Evaporator Temperature
Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Illustration shown with air distribution housing removed for clarity.
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove and disassemble the HVAC housing to service the evaporator
temperature sensor. The evaporator
temperature sensor can be removed for service from underneath the instrument panel.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Reach up under the driver side of the
instrument panel and disconnect the electrical connector for the evaporator temperature sensor (1)
from the
instrument panel wire harness.
3. Using needle nose pliers, disengage the two retaining tabs (3) that secure the evaporator
temperature sensor to the HVAC housing (2) by carefully
pulling the sensor straight out of the side of the HVAC housing.
4. Route the electrical connector and wire lead of the evaporator temperature sensor out from
under the heater core tubes and remove the sensor from
the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 787
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front Evaporator Temperature
Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Illustration shown with air distribution housing removed for clarity.
1. Route the electrical connector and wire lead of the evaporator temperature sensor (1) under the
heater core tubes located on the driver side of the
HVAC housing (2).
2. Install the evaporator temperature sensor into the driver side of the HVAC housing. Make sure
the retaining tabs (3) are fully engaged to the
housing.
3. Connect the electrical connector for the evaporator temperature sensor to the instrument panel
wire harness. 4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 791
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 4 WAY
TRANSDUCER-A/C PRESSURE - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Description
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front A/C Pressure Transducer Description
DESCRIPTION
The A/C pressure transducer (1) is a switch that is installed on a fitting located on the A/C liquid
line at the right front corner of the engine compartment. An internally threaded fitting on the A/C
pressure transducer connects it to the externally threaded Schrader-type fitting. A rubber O-ring
seals the connection between the A/C pressure transducer and the A/C liquid line fitting. The A/C
pressure transducer is connected to the vehicle electrical system by a molded plastic connector
with three terminals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Description >
Page 794
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front A/C Pressure Transducer Operation
OPERATION
The A/C pressure transducer monitors the pressures in the high side of the refrigerant system
through its connection to a fitting on the A/C discharge line. The internal resistance of the A/C
pressure transducer changes in response to the pressures it monitors.
The Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) provides a five volt reference signal and a sensor
ground to the A/C pressure transducer. The TIPM then monitors the output voltage of the
transducer on a sensor return circuit to determine refrigerant pressure and sends a message to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or the Engine Control Module (ECM) (depending on engine
application) over the CAN C BUS.
With 3.5L 5-Passenger and all 7-Passenger models, the PCM is programmed to respond to this
and other sensor inputs by controlling the operation of the swash plate within the A/C compressor
and the radiator cooling fan to help optimize A/C system performance and to protect the system
components from damage. The PCM adjusts the swash plate to nearly a zero degree angle (low
compressor displacement) when high side pressure rises above 3130 kPa (454 psi) and readjusts
the swash plate to a greater angle (higher compressor displacement) when high side pressure
drops below 1999 kPa (290 psi). The A/C pressure transducer also reduces the swash plate angle
if the high side pressure drops below 200 kPa (29 psi) and will increase the swash plate angle
when the high side pressure rises above 234 - 262 kPa (34 - 38 psi). When the refrigerant pressure
rises above 1655 kPa (240 psi), the PCM will actuate the cooling fan.
With 2.4L 5-Passenger models, A/C compressor clutch engagement is controlled by the PCM or
ECM, depending on engine application. When the A/C-heater control is set to any A/C position, it
sends a request signal on the CAN-IHS bus to the TIPM, which then transfers the request on the
CAN-C Bus to the PCM/ECM, which determines if operating conditions are correct for A/C clutch
engagement. When all operating conditions have been met, the PCM/ECM sends a signal on a
dedicated hard-wired circuit back to the TIPM to energize the internal A/C clutch high side driver.
When energized, the A/C clutch high side driver provides battery current to the A/C clutch field coil.
A Schrader-type valve in the A/C discharge line fitting permits the A/C pressure transducer to be
removed or installed without disturbing the refrigerant in the A/C system.
The A/C pressure transducer is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The A/C pressure transducer cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Removal
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front A/C Pressure Transducer Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and cautions may result in possible serious or
fatal injury.
NOTE: It is not necessary to discharge the refrigerant system to replace the A/C pressure
transducer.
NOTE: Typical A/C pressure transducer shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1)
from the A/C pressure transducer (2) located on the A/C liquid line (3) at the right front corner of the
engine compartment.
3. Remove the A/C pressure transducer from the A/C liquid line and remove and discard the O-ring
seal (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Removal > Page 797
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front A/C Pressure Transducer Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Use only the specified O-ring as it is made of special material for R-134a. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type required for the A/C
compressor.
NOTE: Typical A/C pressure transducer shown.
1. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal (4) with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the A/C liquid
line (3). 2. Install the A/C pressure transducer (2) onto the A/C liquid line. Tighten the A/C pressure
transducer to 5.6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the A/C pressure
transducer. 4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Infrared Sensor (ATC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Infrared Sensor (ATC) > Page 802
Solar Sensor: Locations Sun Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Infrared Sensor (ATC) > Page 803
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Infrared Sensor (ATC) (Headliner) 4 Way
Solar Sensor: Diagrams Infrared Sensor (ATC) (Headliner) 4 Way
Connector (ATC) - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
SENSOR-INFRARED (ATC) - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Infrared Sensor (ATC) (Headliner) 4 Way > Page 806
Solar Sensor: Diagrams Sun Sensor (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SENSOR-SUN - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The infrared temperature sensor is located in the overhead console and consists of an infrared
transducer concealed behind a clear lens (2) in a molded plastic housing with an integral wire
connector receptacle (1) and mounting tab (3).
The infrared sensor is used only on models equipped with the automatic temperature control (ATC)
heating-A/C system.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 809
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Infrared Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The infrared sensor detects thermal radiation emitted by the driver and front passenger seat
occupants and surroundings and converts its data into a linear Pulse Width Modulated (PWM)
output signal which is read by the Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) A/C-heater control. The
ATC A/C-heater control uses the infrared sensor data as one of the inputs necessary to
automatically control the interior cabin temperature levels. By using thermal radiation (surface
temperature) measurement, rather than an air temperature measurement, the ATC heating-A/C
system is able to adjust itself to the comfort level as perceived by the occupants. This allows the
ATC system to compensate for other ambient conditions affecting comfort levels, such as solar
heat gain or evaporative heat loss. The ATC system logic responds to the infrared sensor message
by calculating and adjusting the air flow temperature and air flow rate needed to properly obtain
and maintain the selected comfort level temperature of the occupants. The A/C-heater control
continually monitors the infrared sensor circuits, and will store Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
for any problem it detects.
The infrared sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures.
The infrared sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 810
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Sun Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: Typical sun sensor assembly shown.
The automatic temperature control (ATC) heating-A/C system uses a sun sensor assembly (1) to
measure sun light intensity. The sun sensor assembly incorporates two sun sensors (2) within a
molded plastic case which is mounted to the instrument panel and a clear lens (3) that protrudes
through the defroster grille. The wire harness receptacle (4) connects the sun sensors to the
vehicle electrical system through a wire lead and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 811
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Sun Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The ATC dual-zone heating-A/C system uses two sun sensors to balance the system in response
to side-to-side variations in sun light intensity. Passengers in sun and shadow require different
functional settings because they experience very different temperatures. The sun sensor assembly
provides data to the A/C heater control to help determine proper mode and blend-air door positions
and blower motor speeds. The sun sensors are not thermistor type sensors, but rather photo
diodes. For this reason the sun sensors responds to sun light intensity rather than temperature.
The sun sensor assembly is also used to sense day and night conditions for automatic headlight
control, if equipped.
The sun sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures.
The sun sensor assembly cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 812
Solar Sensor: Testing and Inspection
SUN SENSOR
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in an
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
The sun sensor assembly is located so that the sun rays will hit the sensors in the same way that it
will hit the driver and the passenger. It is important that the area in front of the sun sensor
assembly be unobstructed. Check for the following:
- Windshield wipers are properly adjusted.
- Defroster grille or sun sensor is properly installed. The sun sensor lens should protrude above the
defroster grille.
- Any stickers on the windshield are not directly in front of the sun sensor.
- Any items laying on top of the instrument panel are not covering the sun sensor.
If the vehicle exhibits a lack of passenger comfort in sunny weather such as in the early afternoon,
inspect the position of the sun sensor assembly. The sun sensor lens should protrude above the
defroster grille to insure proper operation. If the sun sensor is not properly positioned, perform the
following procedure:
1. Confirm that the defroster grille is properly installed. If not, repair as required. 2. Remove the
defroster grille and verify that the sun sensor is properly installed to the instrument panel See:
Service and Repair/Sun Sensor Installation.
3. Reinstall the defroster grille.
The A/C-heater control continually monitors the sun sensor circuits and will store diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) for any problem it detects. The sun sensor can be tested in the vehicle with a scan
tool See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Using Trim Stick C-4755 or equivalent,
carefully disengage the four retaining tabs (1) that secure the infrared sensor and overhead
map/courtesy
lamp bezel (2) to the overhead console (3).
3. Disconnect the wire harness connectors (4) from the two overhead map/courtesy lamps (5) and
the infrared sensor (6) and remove the sensor, lamp
and bezel assembly from the vehicle
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 815
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Infrared Temperature Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the infrared sensor and overhead map/courtesy lamp bezel (2) to the overhead console
(3). 2. Connect the wire harness connectors (4) to the two overhead map/courtesy lamps (5) and
the infrared sensor (6). 3. Engage the four retaining tabs (1) that secure the infrared sensor and
overhead map/courtesy lamp bezel to the overhead console. Make sure the
retaining tabs are fully engaged.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 816
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Sun Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the defroster grille See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Air Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille - Removal. 3. Using Trim
Stick C-4755 or equivalent (2), gently pry between both sides of the sun sensor assembly (1) and
the instrument panel (3) to release
the snap retainers that secure the sun sensor.
4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (2) from the sun sensor assembly (1) and remove the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 817
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Sun Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the sun sensor assembly (1) to the top of the instrument panel (4) and connect the wire
harness connector (3). 2. Align the tab (2) on the sun sensor assembly with the opening in the
instrument panel. 3. Gently push the sun sensor assembly into the instrument panel until the
sensor snap retainers are securely engaged. 4. Install the defroster grille See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Air Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille - Installation. 5. Reconnect the
negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 823
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 824
Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 825
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 828
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 833
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 834
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 835
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 4 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way > Page 838
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C2 (AWD) (Fuel Tank Jumper) 2 Way
Connector C2 (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module contains the electric fuel pump, fuel pump
reservoir, fuel level sending unit, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter.
The fuel level sending unit is serviceable See: Service and Repair/Removal.
The fuel pump module, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter is serviced as an
assembly See: Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel pump modules.
The AWD fuel pump modules contains the main fuel pump module (1), auxiliary fuel pump module
(2), main fuel level sending unit, auxiliary fuel level sending unit, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure
regulator and fuel filter.
The main fuel level sending unit is located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Service and Repair/Removal. The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary
fuel pump module and is serviced as an assembly See: Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 841
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Operation
OPERATION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module is located inside the fuel tank with a fuel level
sending unit and pressure regulator. The fuel pump module is a positive displacement, gerotor,
driven by a 12 volt DC permanent magnet electric motor.
The fuel pump module draws fuel through a internal filter and pushes it through the motor to an
outlet pipe. The fuel pump module contains two check valves. One valve relieves internal fuel
pump pressure and regulates maximum pump output. The second valve, in the pump outlet,
maintains pump pressure during engine off conditions.
The fuel pump pressure regulator contains a calibrated spring which forces a diaphragm against
the fuel filter return port. When pressure exceeds the calibrated amount, the diaphragm retracts,
allowing excess fuel pressure in the fuel pump module to purge into the fuel tank.
The maximum deadhead pressure is approximately 880 kPa (130 psi). The fuel pump pressure
regulator adjusts fuel system pressure to approximately 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi).
AWD
Operation of the all wheel drive (AWD) main fuel pump module is similar to the FWD with the
addition of a auxiliary fuel pump module with a auxiliary fuel level sending unit and draws fuel from
the base of the auxiliary fuel pump module (2) through an internal tube.
The auxiliary fuel pump module flow rate is greater than the vehicle fuel consumption rate so that
the auxiliary side of the tank is emptied before fuel is depleted from the primary side.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 842
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles have a serviceable fuel level sending unit located on the fuel
pump reservoir See: Service and Repair/Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel level sending units.
The main fuel level sending unit located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Service and Repair/Removal.
The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module. The
auxiliary fuel pump module and the fuel level sending unit is serviced as an assembly See: Service
and Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Removal
REMOVAL
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Fuel Tank - Removal.
NOTE: Prior to removing the main fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel tank
opening.
2. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 3. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 4. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
5. Mark the main fuel pump module orientation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 845
WARNING: The fuel pump module reservoir does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir will spill out when the
module is removed.
NOTE: Do not spill fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
6. Raise the main fuel pump module out of the fuel tank using caution not spill fuel inside the
vehicle.
7. Tip the main fuel pump module and drain enough fuel from the main fuel pump module reservoir
to gain access to the internal fuel line without
spilling fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
8. If equipped with AWD, disconnect the internal fuel line from the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 846
9. Remove the main fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
10. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 847
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Fuel Tank - Removal.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
2. Mark the auxiliary fuel pump module orientation (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing the auxiliary fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel
tank opening.
3. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 4. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 5. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
6. Raise the auxiliary fuel pump module and disconnect the internal fuel line. 7. Remove the
auxiliary fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 848
8. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 849
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. If equipped with AWD, Connect the internal fuel line to the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 850
3. Lower the main fuel pump module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the main fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be performed for
the fuel level gauge to work properly.
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the main fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel
Tank - Installation.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 851
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. Connect the internal fuel line to the auxiliary fuel pump module. 3. Lower the auxiliary fuel pump
module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the auxiliary fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be
performed for the fuel gauge to work properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 852
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the auxiliary fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel
Tank - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 853
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel. Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked and approved containers.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Remove the fuel pump module See: Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
2. Disconnect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector (1).
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not pull the fuel level sending unit by the wires or the float arm.
3. Using your finger, press the fuel level sending unit snap tab to the left while gently pushing up on
the bottom of the fuel level sending unit and
remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 854
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not handle the new fuel level sending unit by the float arm.
1. Position the new fuel level sending unit to the fuel pump module reservoir.
2. Gently push the fuel level sending unit down until the snap tab (2) engages.
CAUTION: Ensure the fuel level sending unit wires are routed so they do not get pinched between
the coils of the spring when the module is
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 855
completely compressed.
3. Connect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector. 4. Install the fuel pump module See:
Fuel Pump Module - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Outside Temperature
Display Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Ambient Temperature Sensor - Description
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Description and Operation Ambient Temperature Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
The ambient temperature sensor (1) is a variable resistor located under the bottom right side of the
front bumper reinforcement (2). The sensor is attached to the power steering line bracket with a
pushpin style retainer and can be accessed through the right opening in the front fascia assembly.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if inoperative or damaged,
must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Outside Temperature
Display Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Ambient Temperature Sensor - Description > Page
860
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Description and Operation Ambient Temperature Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The ambient temperature sensor is a variable resistor that operates on a five-volt reference signal.
The resistance in the sensor changes as temperature changes, changing the temperature sensor
signal circuit voltage to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). Based upon the resistance in
the sensor, the instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN),
display senses a specific voltage on the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus circuit, which
corresponds to a specific temperature. The applicable instrument cluster display then displays the
proper ambient temperature.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Outside Temperature
Display Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 861
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Testing and Inspection
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor, a wiring circuit, the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus, the Local Area Network (LIN) data bus and the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM). When the sensor is exposed to temperatures above 60° C (130°
F), or if the sensor circuit is shorted, 60° C (130° F) will appear in the display in place of the
temperature. When the sensor is exposed to temperatures below - 40° C (- 40° F) or if the sensor
circuit is open, - 40° C (- 40° F) will appear in the display.
The ambient temperature sensor circuit can be diagnosed using the following Temperature System
Test, and Sensor Test. If the temperature sensor and circuit are confirmed to be OK, but the
temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, further testing of the instrument cluster may be
necessary. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster /
Carrier/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics for the appropriate
procedure.
SENSOR TEST
1. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor harness
connector. 2. Measure the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor. At - 40° C (- 40° F), the
sensor resistance is 336 kilohms. At 55° C (130° F), the sensor
resistance is 2.488 kilohms. The sensor resistance should read between these two values. If OK,
further testing of the instrument cluster may be necessary. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and
Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics for the appropriate procedure. If not OK, replace the inoperative ambient
temperature sensor.
SENSOR CIRCUIT TEST
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
NOTE: Temperature readings do not update immediately. Allow up to 60 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the "ON" position for
readings to meet test specifications.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the
ambient temperature sensor. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position. The display should
now read - 40° C (- 40° F). If OK, go to 3. If not OK, repair the shorted sensor
return circuit or ambient temperature sensor signal circuit to the ambient temperature sensor as
required.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Taking care not to damage the wire terminals,
connect a jumper wire between the two terminals in
the body half of the ambient temperature sensor harness connector.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position. The display should now read 60° C (130° F). If OK,
go to 5. If not OK, repair the open sensor
return circuit or ambient temperature sensor signal circuit to the ambient temperature sensor as
required.
NOTE: If the EVIC display does not show the ambient temperature in step 4, the vehicle may need
to be driven several miles at a speed
greater than 32 km/h (20 mph) for the temperature to update.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Remove the jumper wire. Turn the ignition switch
to the "ON" position and wait until the display
again reads - 40° C (- 40° F). Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Reconnect the ambient
temperature sensor. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position. The display should now read the
ambient temperature. If OK, the problem is intermittent. Perform further diagnosis while
manipulating the related wire harnesses and components. If not OK, go to 6
6. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes that may have been set while performing the test. Perform
further diagnosis of the CAN data bus circuit, the
LIN data bus circuit, the TIPM and the ambient temperature sensor (refer to the SENSOR TEST).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Outside Temperature
Display Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Temperature Sensor - Removal
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Service and Repair Ambient Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Working through the opening in the right
side of the front fascia, disconnect the wire harness connector from the ambient temperature
sensor (1). 3. Remove the fastener that secures the ambient temperature sensor to the power
steering line bracket. 4. Remove the ambient temperature sensor from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Outside Temperature
Display Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 864
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Service and Repair Ambient Temperature Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Working through the opening in the right side of the front fascia, position the ambient
temperature sensor (1) in the vehicle. 2. Install the fastener that secures the ambient temperature
sensor (1) to the power steering line bracket. 3. Connect the wire harness connector to the ambient
temperature sensor. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 868
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 869
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 1 WAY
SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE - (BODY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
There are two unique park brake switches used on this vehicle, depending upon whether the
vehicle has a foot-operated or hand-operated park brake lever mechanism.
FOOT-OPERATED
Foot-Operated Park Brake Switch
The foot-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the cowl
side inner panel below the instrument panel, outboard of the steering column. This switch includes
a spade-type output terminal (3) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the
stationary contact within a molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive switch
location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact with an integral grounding lug (4) on
one end and an integral actuating lever and follower (2) on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The foot-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged,
it must be replaced.
HAND-OPERATED
Hand-Operated Park Brake Switch
The hand-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the floor
panel transmission tunnel below the center floor console. This switch includes a spade-type output
terminal (2) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out
and
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page 872
connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the stationary contact within a
molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab (4) on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive
switch location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact (3) with an integral grounding lug
on one end and an integral actuating lever and follower on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The hand-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or
damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page 873
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Operation
OPERATION
Both the foot-operated and hand-operated park brake switch are normally closed, mechanically
actuated leaf contact switches that are operated by the foot or hand park brake lever mechanism.
The switch is grounded through its mounting to the park brake lever mechanism and provides a
ground input to the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab
Compartment Node/CCN) on a park brake switch sense circuit whenever the park brake is applied,
and opens this circuit whenever the park brake is released. The park brake switch sense input to
the EMIC is used as a logic input by the EMIC for control of the brake indicator and may also be
used as a logic input for other electronic features in the vehicle.
The park brake switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that rely upon inputs
from the park brake switch. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the
electronic controls and communication related to park brake switch operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 874
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
PARK BRAKE SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: If the brake indicator stays ON with the ignition switch in the ON position and the park brake
released, or comes ON while driving,
the brake system must be diagnosed and repaired prior to performing the following tests. See:
Brakes and Traction Control/Testing and Inspection . If no brake system problem is found, the
following procedures will help to locate a shorted or open park brake switch sense circuit, or an
ineffective park brake switch.
INDICATOR ILLUMINATES DURING BULB TEST, BUT DOES NOT WHEN PARK BRAKE
APPLIED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Apply the parking brake. Check for continuity between the park brake switch terminal and a good
ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake
switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavities of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and the instrument panel wire harness connector for the instrument
cluster. There should be continuity. If not OK, repair the open park brake switch sense circuit
between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster as required.
INDICATOR REMAINS ILLUMINATED - BRAKE SYSTEM CHECKS OKAY
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Check for continuity between the terminal of the park brake switch and a good ground. There
should be no continuity with the park brake released, and continuity with the park brake applied. If
OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavity of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and a good ground. There should be no continuity. If not OK, repair the
shorted park brake switch sense circuit between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster
as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Apply the parking brake. 3. Reach under
the left end of the instrument panel to access and disconnect the wire harness connector from the
terminal of the park brake switch (2)
located on the park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side inner panel.
4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever mechanism. 5.
Remove the switch from the park brake lever mechanism.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the console from the floor panel
transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center
Console - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 877
3. Pull the parking brake lever (1) upward to apply the parking brake. 4. Disconnect the wire
harness connector from the terminal of the park brake switch (2) located on the right side of the
park brake lever mechanism. 5. Remove the screw (3) that secures the switch to the park brake
lever bracket. 6. Remove the switch from the park brake lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 878
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to position the park brake switch (2) onto the
park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side
inner panel. Be certain to engage the locating pin on the back of the switch insulator into the
locating slot in the lever mechanism bracket.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever
mechanism. Tighten the screw to 2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to
the terminal of the park brake switch. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the ON position and check for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake
applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Position park brake switch (2) onto the right side of the park brake lever (1) bracket. Be certain to
engage the locating pin on the back of the
switch insulator into the locating slot in the lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 879
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the switch to the lever bracket. Tighten the screw to
2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the terminal of the switch. 4.
Reinstall the console onto the floor panel transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center
Console - Installation
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 6. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and check
for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Backup Lamp Switch - Description
Backup Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Backup Lamp Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with a manual transmission (2) have a normally open, spring-loaded plunger
type backup lamp switch (1). Vehicles with an optional electronic automatic transmission have a
Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) that is used to perform several functions, including that of the
backup lamp switch. The TRS is described in further detail elsewhere in this service information.
Refer to the service and diagnostic information for the automatic transmission type installed in the
vehicle.
The backup lamp switch is located in a threaded hole on the left facing surface of the manual
transmission housing. The switch has a threaded body and a hex formation near the plunger end of
the switch. An integral connector receptacle at the end of the switch opposite the plunger connects
the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the engine wire
harness. When installed, only the switch connector and the hex formation are visible on the outside
of the transmission housing.
The backup lamp switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire
switch unit must be replaced. Refer to the service and diagnostic information for the manual
transmission type installed in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Backup Lamp Switch - Description > Page 885
Backup Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Backup Lamp Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The backup lamp switch controls a path to ground for the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM)
on the reverse switch signal circuit. The TIPM reads this input through an internal pull-up, then
controls an output through a high side driver that regulates the flow of battery voltage to the backup
lamp bulbs as appropriate on the backup lamp feed circuit. The switch plunger is mechanically
actuated by the gearshift mechanism within the transmission, which will depress the switch plunger
and close the switch contacts whenever the REVERSE gear has been selected. The switch
receives ground at all times through a take out and eyelet terminal of the wire harness that is
secured to the body sheet metal.
The backup lamp switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that rely upon
inputs from the backup lamp switch. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose
the electronic controls and communication related to backup lamp switch operation requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 886
Backup Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
BACKUP LAMP SWITCH
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Locate and disconnect the engine wire
harness connector from the backup lamp switch connector receptacle. 3. Check for continuity
between the two terminal pins in the backup lamp switch connector receptacle.
a. With the gear selector lever in the REVERSE position, there should be continuity. b. With the
gear selector lever in any position other than REVERSE, there should be no continuity.
4. If the switch fails either of these two continuity tests, replace the ineffective backup lamp switch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Stop Lamp Switch (Early Build) (Body) 6 Way
Brake Light Switch: Diagrams Stop Lamp Switch (Early Build) (Body) 6 Way
Connector (EARLY BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
SWITCH-STOP LAMP (EARLY BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Stop Lamp Switch (Early Build) (Body) 6 Way > Page 892
Brake Light Switch: Diagrams Stop Lamp Switch (Normal Build) (Body) 6 Way
Connector (NORMAL BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
SWITCH-STOP LAMP (NORMAL BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Stop Lamp Switch - Description
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Stop Lamp Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable and both are
illustrated and described in the paragraphs that follow.
EARLY PRODUCTION
This brake lamp switch (2) is a three circuit, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch that is secured
to the brake pedal support bracket on the dash panel under the instrument panel on the driver side
of the vehicle. The molded plastic switch housing has an integral connector receptacle (1)
containing six terminal pins and featuring a Connector Position Assurance (CPA) lock. The switch
is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out of the body wire harness.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) on one end of the switch housing. The
plunger has a one time telescoping self-adjustment feature that is activated after the switch is
installed by moving an adjustment release lever (5) on the opposite end of the switch housing
clockwise, until it locks into a position that is horizontal and parallel to the connector receptacle.
This brake lamp switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged, ineffective, or
removed from its mounting position for any reason, it must be replaced with a new unit.
LATE PRODUCTION
This brake lamp switch (1) is a three circuit, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch that is secured
to the brake pedal support bracket under the instrument panel on the driver side of the vehicle. The
molded plastic switch housing has an integral connector receptacle (4) containing six terminal pins.
The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out of the body
wire harness.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (2) on one end of the switch housing. The
plunger has a telescoping self-adjustment feature that is activated after the switch is installed by
pulling the brake pedal upward to its normal at-rest position. The telescoping plunger can be pulled
outward from the switch housing to repeat the self-adjustment procedure if necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Stop Lamp Switch - Description > Page 895
This brake lamp switch cannot be repaired. If the switch is damaged or ineffective it must be
replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Stop Lamp Switch - Description > Page 896
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Stop Lamp Switch - Operation
OPERATION
Both the early and late production brake lamp switches control three independent circuits. These
circuits are described as follows:
- Brake Lamp Switch Circuit - A normally open brake lamp switch circuit receives a battery voltage
input, and supplies this battery voltage to the Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL) and the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on a brake lamp switch output circuit only when the brake
pedal is depressed (brake lamp switch plunger released).
- Brake Lamp Switch Signal Circuit - A normally closed brake lamp switch signal circuit receives a
direct path to ground, and supplies this ground input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on a
brake signal 1 circuit only when the brake pedal is released (brake lamp switch plunger is
depressed).
- Speed Control Circuit - A normally closed speed control circuit receives a battery voltage input
from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on an ignition run/start control output circuit, and
supplies this battery voltage to the PCM on a brake signal 2 circuit only when the brake pedal is
released (brake lamp switch plunger is depressed).
The PCM sends electronic brake lamp switch status messages to other electronic modules in the
vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus for use as an additional logic input for
controlling many other vehicle functions and features.
The brake lamp switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls and communication that provide some features related to brake lamp switch
operation. The most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to brake lamp switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 897
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
Early Production
Late Production
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
CAUTION: Do not remove the Eary Production-type brake lamp switch from the mounting bracket.
The self-adjusting plunger of this switch
is a one time only feature. If the switch is removed from the mounting bracket, it MUST be replaced
with a new switch.
2. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the brake lamp switch. 3. Using an ohmmeter,
perform the continuity tests at the terminal pins (1) in the brake lamp switch connector receptacle
as shown in the Brake Lamp
Switch Tests table.
4. If the switch fails any of the continuity tests, replace the ineffective brake lamp switch as
required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 898
Brake Light Switch: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT - LATE PRODUCTION TYPE ONLY
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable and, only the late
production type switch can be readjusted following initial installation using this adjustment
procedure. If the early production type switch requires readjustment for any reason, it must be
replaced with a new switch. Both switches are illustrated and described elsewhere in this service
information to assist in positive identification. See: Description and Operation/Stop Lamp Switch Description.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer pad from
below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Removal.
3. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 4. Pull the brake lamp switch
plunger all the way out of the switch housing to its fully extended position.
CAUTION: Brake booster damage may occur if the brake pedal pull exceeds about 9 kilograms (20
pounds).
5. Release the brake pedal. Then pull the pedal lightly upward to its normal at-rest position. The
pedal will set the plunger to the correct position as
the pedal pushes the plunger into the switch housing. The switch plunger will make a light audible
ratcheting noise as it self-adjusts.
6. If equipped, reinstall the silencer pad below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Stop Lamp Switch - Removal
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair Stop Lamp Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable. Both switches are
illustrated and described elsewhere in this service information to assist in positive identification.
See: Description and Operation/Stop Lamp Switch - Description.
EARLY PRODUCTION
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer pad from
below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Removal.
3. Locate the brake lamp switch (3) on the brake pedal support bracket (2) under the instrument
panel. 4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the switch.
5. Rotate the brake lamp switch housing (2) counterclockwise about 30 degrees to align the tabs
on the switch locking collar with the keyed hole in
the brake pedal support bracket (1).
6. Pull the switch straight rearward from the keyed hole to remove it from the bracket. 7. Discard
the removed brake lamp switch. The brake lamp switch self-adjusting plunger is a one time only
feature. If the switch is removed
from the bracket, it MUST be replaced with a new switch.
LATE PRODUCTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Stop Lamp Switch - Removal > Page 901
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer pad from
below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Removal.
3. Locate the brake lamp switch (2) on the brake pedal support bracket (4) under the instrument
panel. 4. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 5. Rotate the brake lamp
switch housing (2) counterclockwise about 30 degrees to align the tabs on the switch locking collar
with the keyed hole in
the brake pedal support bracket.
6. Pull the switch straight rearward from the keyed hole to remove it from the bracket. 7. Release
the brake pedal. 8. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1) from the switch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Stop Lamp Switch - Removal > Page 902
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair Stop Lamp Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable. Both switches are
illustrated and described elsewhere in this service information to assist in positive identification.
See: Description and Operation/Stop Lamp Switch - Description.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
EARLY PRODUCTION
CAUTION: The brake lamp switch self-adjusting switch plunger is a one time only feature. If the
switch is removed from the mounting
bracket, it MUST be replaced with a new switch.
1. Obtain a new brake lamp switch. The adjustment lever on the new switch should be at about a
45 degree angle to the switch connector receptacle.
If the adjustment lever is parallel with the connector receptacle, the switch adjustment has already
been set and the switch must be scrapped. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO RESET OR READJUST THE
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH.
2. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 3. Align the tabs on the brake lamp
switch (2) locking collar with the keyed hole in the brake pedal support bracket (1) below the
instrument panel. 4. Insert the tabs on the brake lamp switch locking collar through the keyed hole
in the brake pedal support bracket until the switch housing is firmly
seated against the bracket.
5. Rotate the switch housing clockwise about 30 degrees to engage the tabs on the locking collar
with the bracket.
CAUTION: Release, but do not pull up on the brake pedal before the switch plunger adjustment
has been completed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Stop Lamp Switch - Removal > Page 903
6. Release the brake pedal, but do not pull it upward. 7. Rotate the plunger adjustment release
lever (2) clockwise until it locks into place. The lever should be parallel to the brake lamp switch
connector
receptacle. This action will set the switch plunger length to a final adjustment position and cannot
be undone. If not performed properly the first time, a new brake lamp switch MUST be installed.
8. Reconnect the wire harness connector (4) to the brake lamp switch (3). 9. If equipped, reinstall
the silencer pad below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
10. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
LATE PRODUCTION
1. Be certain that the brake lamp switch (2) plunger is pulled all the way out of the switch housing
to its fully extended position. 2. Reconnect the wire harness connector (1) to the connector
receptacle on the switch. 3. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 4. Align
the tabs on the brake lamp switch locking collar with the keyed hole in the brake pedal support
bracket (2). 5. Insert the tab on the brake lamp switch locking collar through the keyed hole in the
support bracket until the switch housing is firmly seated against
the bracket.
6. Rotate the switch housing clockwise about 30 degrees to engage the tabs on the locking collar
with the support bracket.
CAUTION: Brake booster damage may occur if the brake pedal pull exceeds about 9 kilograms (20
pounds).
7. Release the brake pedal. Then pull the pedal lightly upward to its normal at-rest position. The
pedal will set the plunger to the correct position as
the pedal pushes the plunger into the switch housing. The switch plunger will make a light audible
ratcheting noise as it self-adjusts.
8. If equipped, reinstall the silencer pad below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
9. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Combination Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 909
Combination Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C2 (Steering Wheel Jumper) 7 Way
Connector C2 - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Combination Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 912
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 913
Combination Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 914
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Combination Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 917
Combination Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 922
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 923
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 924
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 927
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Hazard Warning Switch - Description
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation Hazard Warning Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The hazard switch (3) is integral to the instrument panel switch pod (1), which is secured to the
instrument panel center bezel just above the heater and air conditioner controls. A red, stencil-like
International Control and Display Symbol icon for Hazard Warning identifies the hazard switch
button. The remainder of the hazard switch circuitry is concealed within the instrument panel switch
pod.
The hazard switch button has panel lamps dimmer controlled illumination for night visibility. The
switch button latches to a slightly lowered position when the hazard warning system is activated
and the icon on the switch button will illuminate at an increased intensity while the turn signals and
turn signal indicators are flashing. The switch button unlatches to a position flush with the other
push buttons in the switch pod when the hazard warning is deactivated.
All of the circuitry and components of the hazard switch are contained within a molded black plastic
instrument panel switch pod housing. A single connector receptacle is integral to the back of the
switch pod housing. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The hazard switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire
instrument panel switch pod unit must be replaced. See: Sensors and Switches - Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster
Switch Pod - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Hazard Warning Switch - Description > Page 932
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation Hazard Warning Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The status of the hazard switch is continually monitored by the circuitry within the instrument panel
switch pod. The switch pod receives battery voltage at all times on a fused battery feed circuit, and
a path to ground at all times through the instrument panel wire harness. The only other inputs to
the switch pod consists of electronic communication with the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the single wire Local Interface
Network (LIN) data bus.
Whenever the hazard switch is in its unlatched and raised position, the hazard warning system is
selected and the switch pod circuitry provides a hard wired output to the Totally Integrated Power
Module (TIPM). When the TIPM receives a hazard switch input it then controls hazard warning
system operation and flash rate by controlling battery voltage outputs through high side drivers on
the right and left, front and rear turn signal feed circuits. The TIPM also sends the appropriate
electronic messages back to the EMIC to control the illumination and flash rate of the right and left
turn signal indicators, as well as to control the click rate of an electromechanical relay soldered
onto the EMIC electronic circuit board that emulates the sound emitted by a conventional hazard
warning flasher.
The hard wired circuits for the instrument panel switch pod may be diagnosed using conventional
diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information. However,
conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the hazard warning
switch or the electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that
provide some features of the hazard warning system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate
means to diagnose the hazard switch or the electronic controls and communication related to
hazard warning system operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 938
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C2 (Steering Wheel Jumper) 7 Way
Connector C2 - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 941
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 942
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 943
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 946
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 952
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C2 (Steering Wheel Jumper) 7 Way
Connector C2 - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 955
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 956
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 957
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 960
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 964
Horn Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
SWITCH-HORN - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Horn Switch - Removal
Horn Switch: Service and Repair Horn Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING:
On vehicles equipped with an airbag, refer to restraint systems for warnings and cautions before
servicing the horn switch.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the driver airbag. See: Restraint
Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Removal. 3. Disconnect the
connector from the clockspring. 4. Remove the three mounting fasteners. 5. Remove the horn
switch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Horn Switch - Removal > Page 967
Horn Switch: Service and Repair Horn Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the horn switch. 2. Install the three mounting fasteners. 3. Connect the electrical
connector to the clockspring. 4. Install the driver airbag. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation 5. Connect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 973
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 6 WAY
SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect air flow sensor electrical connector (4). 2. Remove constant tension clamps (1), (2)
securing the air flow sensor (3). 3. Remove air flow sensor (3) from hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 978
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Note the arrow direction on the sensor and correctly position the air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 2.
Install constant tension clamps (1), (2) to secure air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 3. Connect air flow
sensor electrical connector (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L) > Page 983
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 984
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CAMSHAFT 1/1 POSITION (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 985
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT AND CRANKSHAFT SIGNALS
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at battery. 2. Disconnect electrical connector
(3) from camshaft position (CMP) sensor (2). 3. Remove bolt (1) and CMP sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page 988
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Install camshaft position (CMP) sensor utilizing twisting motion. Make sure CMP sensor
is fully seated. Do not drive CMP sensor
into the bore with mounting screw. This may cause CMP sensor to be incorrectly seated causing a
faulty signal or no signal at all.
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the CMP sensor (2) into the timing belt cover with a twisting motion until fully seated. 2.
While holding the sensor (2) in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt (1) to 12 Nm (106
in. lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector (3) to the CMP sensor (2). 4. Connect the
negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 994
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Normal Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 995
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any ECT circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor(s) and the
PCM.
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Turn the ignition on. 5. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the
sensor(s) and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 6. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to
set during the wiggle test.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AND CONDITION
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Check the engine coolant level and the condition of the engine coolant. Refer to the appropriate
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. THERMOSTAT
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Using the appropriate service information, determine the proper opening temperature of the
thermostat. 2. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine
was allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
3. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool. 4. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 996
NOTE: The thermostat should not open until the engine reaches the temperature specified in the
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine was
allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
2. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool and the actual coolant temperature with a
thermometer. 3. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The sensor value transition should be smooth as the engine reaches operating
temperature. The thermometer reading and the coolant
temperature value on the scan tool should remain relatively close.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 5.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
5. (K2) ECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K2) ECT Signal circuit at the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor harness
connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the
voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 997
No
- Repair the (K2) ECT Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
harness connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure
the voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor and the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1001
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1002
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor is located on the driver side of the vehicle, above the
differential housing. The bottom of the sensor sits
above the drive plate.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the electrical
connector from the crankshaft position sensor. 3. Remove the sensor mounting screw and the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page 1005
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor into the transmission case with a twisting motion until
fully seated.
CAUTION: Before tightening the sensor mounting bolt, be sure the sensor is completely flush to the
mounting surface. If the sensor is not
flush, damage to the sensor mounting tang may result.
2. While holding the sensor in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the CKP sensor. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Operation > Page 1010
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove electrical connector at pressure
differential sensor (2). 3. Remove upstream exhaust pressure tube (4) from catalytic converter 4.
Remove downstream pressure tube (6) from catalytic converter. 5. Remove pressure differential
sensor mounting bolt. 6. Remove pressure differential sensor (2) and tubing (7) from vehicle. 7.
Remove tubing (7) from pressure differential sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1015
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Install tubing (7) on pressure differential sensor (2). 2. Position pressure differential sensor (2)
and tubing (7). 3. Install pressure differential sensor mounting bolt (3). Tighten to 10 Nm (89 in.
lbs.). 4. Install downstream pressure tube (6) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 5. Install upstream pressure tube (4) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10
Nm (89 in. lbs.) 6. Position electrical connector (1) into bracket. 7. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Module
Fuel Level Sensor: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Module > Page 1020
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Module > Page 1021
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Module > Page 1022
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump
Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Fuel Level Sensor: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 4 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump
Module C1 (Body) 4 Way > Page 1025
Fuel Level Sensor: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C2 (AWD) (Fuel Tank Jumper) 2 Way
Connector C2 (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Fuel Pump Module - Description
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module contains the electric fuel pump, fuel pump
reservoir, fuel level sending unit, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter.
The fuel level sending unit is serviceable See: Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel/Fuel
Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal.
The fuel pump module, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter is serviced as an
assembly See: Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel pump modules.
The AWD fuel pump modules contains the main fuel pump module (1), auxiliary fuel pump module
(2), main fuel level sending unit, auxiliary fuel level sending unit, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure
regulator and fuel filter.
The main fuel level sending unit is located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal. The
auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module and is serviced
as an assembly See: Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 1028
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Operation
OPERATION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module is located inside the fuel tank with a fuel level
sending unit and pressure regulator. The fuel pump module is a positive displacement, gerotor,
driven by a 12 volt DC permanent magnet electric motor.
The fuel pump module draws fuel through a internal filter and pushes it through the motor to an
outlet pipe. The fuel pump module contains two check valves. One valve relieves internal fuel
pump pressure and regulates maximum pump output. The second valve, in the pump outlet,
maintains pump pressure during engine off conditions.
The fuel pump pressure regulator contains a calibrated spring which forces a diaphragm against
the fuel filter return port. When pressure exceeds the calibrated amount, the diaphragm retracts,
allowing excess fuel pressure in the fuel pump module to purge into the fuel tank.
The maximum deadhead pressure is approximately 880 kPa (130 psi). The fuel pump pressure
regulator adjusts fuel system pressure to approximately 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi).
AWD
Operation of the all wheel drive (AWD) main fuel pump module is similar to the FWD with the
addition of a auxiliary fuel pump module with a auxiliary fuel level sending unit and draws fuel from
the base of the auxiliary fuel pump module (2) through an internal tube.
The auxiliary fuel pump module flow rate is greater than the vehicle fuel consumption rate so that
the auxiliary side of the tank is emptied before fuel is depleted from the primary side.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 1029
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles have a serviceable fuel level sending unit located on the fuel
pump reservoir See: Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel level sending units.
The main fuel level sending unit located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal.
The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module. The
auxiliary fuel pump module and the fuel level sending unit is serviced as an assembly See: Sensors
and Switches - Instrument Panel/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Removal
REMOVAL
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Fuel Tank - Removal.
NOTE: Prior to removing the main fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel tank
opening.
2. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 3. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 4. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
5. Mark the main fuel pump module orientation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1032
WARNING: The fuel pump module reservoir does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir will spill out when the
module is removed.
NOTE: Do not spill fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
6. Raise the main fuel pump module out of the fuel tank using caution not spill fuel inside the
vehicle.
7. Tip the main fuel pump module and drain enough fuel from the main fuel pump module reservoir
to gain access to the internal fuel line without
spilling fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
8. If equipped with AWD, disconnect the internal fuel line from the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1033
9. Remove the main fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
10. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1034
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Fuel Tank - Removal.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
2. Mark the auxiliary fuel pump module orientation (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing the auxiliary fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel
tank opening.
3. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 4. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 5. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
6. Raise the auxiliary fuel pump module and disconnect the internal fuel line. 7. Remove the
auxiliary fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1035
8. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1036
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. If equipped with AWD, Connect the internal fuel line to the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1037
3. Lower the main fuel pump module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the main fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be performed for
the fuel level gauge to work properly.
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the main fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel
Tank - Installation.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1038
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. Connect the internal fuel line to the auxiliary fuel pump module. 3. Lower the auxiliary fuel pump
module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the auxiliary fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be
performed for the fuel gauge to work properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1039
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the auxiliary fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel
Tank - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1040
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel. Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked and approved containers.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Remove the fuel pump module See: Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel/Fuel Gauge
Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
2. Disconnect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector (1).
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not pull the fuel level sending unit by the wires or the float arm.
3. Using your finger, press the fuel level sending unit snap tab to the left while gently pushing up on
the bottom of the fuel level sending unit and
remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1041
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not handle the new fuel level sending unit by the float arm.
1. Position the new fuel level sending unit to the fuel pump module reservoir.
2. Gently push the fuel level sending unit down until the snap tab (2) engages.
CAUTION: Ensure the fuel level sending unit wires are routed so they do not get pinched between
the coils of the spring when the module is
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 1042
completely compressed.
3. Connect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector. 4. Install the fuel pump module See:
Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump
Module Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1046
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1047
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable.
NOTE: Clean dirt from sensor area prior to removal from air box.
2. Disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Remove the inlet air
temperature sensor (2) from the air box (3) by turning the sensor 1/4 turn in the counter - clockwise
direction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 1050
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the inlet air temperature sensor (2) to the air box (3) by turning the sensor 1/4 turn in the
clockwise direction. 2. Connect the inlet air temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Connect
negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1054
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1055
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-KNOCK (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock
Sensor - Removal
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold, See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the knock sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock
Sensor - Removal > Page 1058
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Always use the specified torque when installing the knock sensor bolt. Over or under
tightening the sensor mounting bolt will
affect knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper spark control.
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 2. Route the knock sensor wire
in the proper location. 3. Install upper intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation.
4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1062
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1063
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1064
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE MAP SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. MAP SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1065
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any MAP Sensor circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any sensor supply or system voltage DTCs before proceeding with this
test.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
connectors between the MAP Sensor and the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or
partially broken wires. 4. Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 5. Turn the
ignition on. 6. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the sensor and wiggle test the wiring and
connectors. 7. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. If necessary,
check each sensor circuit for high resistance or a shorted
condition.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. MAP VACUUM/BAROMETRIC PRESSURE
1. With a scan tool, read the Barometric Pressure.
NOTE: The Barometric Pressure should be approximately equal to the actual barometric pressure.
If necessary, compare the Barometric
Pressure value of the tested vehicle to the value of a known good vehicle of a similar make and
model.
2. Connect a vacuum gauge to a manifold vacuum source. 3. Start the engine.
NOTE: If engine will not idle, maintain a constant RPM above idle.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
4. With the scan tool, read the MAP Sensor vacuum.
NOTE: The scan tool reading for MAP vacuum should be within 1" of the vacuum gauge reading.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. MAP SENSOR VOLTAGE
1. With the scan tool, monitor the MAP Sensor signal voltage. 2. With the engine idling in neutral or
park, snap the throttle.
NOTE: The MAP Sensor signal voltage should change from below 2.0 volts at idle to above 3.5
volts at wide open throttle.
Were any problems found?
Yes
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1066
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
4. (F856) 5 VOLT SUPPLY CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (F856) 5 Volt Supply circuit at
the MAP Sensor harness connector and by
probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are
connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 5
No
- Repair the (F856) 5 Volt Supply circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
5. (K1) MAP SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K1) MAP Signal circuit at the
MAP Sensor harness connector and by probing
the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are connected so
that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
No
- Repair the (K1) MAP Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1067
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the MAP Sensor harness connector and by
probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are
connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. MAP SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
MAP Sensor and the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the MAP Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the
MAP sensor.
3. Rotate sensor.
4. Lift to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 1070
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
3.5L
1. Install sensor.
2. Rotate sensor into position.
3. Attach electrical connector (1) to sensor (2). 4. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5
Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 1075
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 1076
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 1077
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 1078
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 1079
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1
(Gas) 4 Way
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1
(Gas) 4 Way > Page 1082
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 1/2 (Gas) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1
(Gas) 4 Way > Page 1083
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1
(Gas) 4 Way > Page 1084
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1085
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder.
See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks/Firing Order
Cylinder #1 on left side.
Cylinder #1 on right side.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
- A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1086
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE OXYGEN SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. OXYGEN SENSOR, WIRING, OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any O2 sensor or rationality DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: When performing this procedure as part of another diagnostic process, it may be necessary
to repeat this test for all of the oxygen
sensors on the vehicle.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
connectors between the Oxygen sensor and the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or
partially broken wires. 4. Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 5. Turn the
ignition on. 6. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the sensor and wiggle test the wiring and
connectors. 7. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. If necessary,
check each sensor circuit for high resistance or a shorted
condition.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. OXYGEN SENSOR VOLTAGE
1. Start the engine and allow it to reach normal operating temperature.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
2. With a scan tool, monitor all O2 Sensor voltage readings.
Is the voltage switching between 2.5 and 3.4 volts for all O2 sensors?
Yes
- Go to 3
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
3. O2 SENSOR HEATER OPERATION
1. Turn the ignition off.
NOTE: Wait a minimum of 10 minutes to allow the O2 Sensor to cool down before continuing the
test. Allow the O2 Sensor voltage to
stabilize at 5.0 volts.
2. Turn the ignition on. 3. With a scan tool, actuate the O2 Sensor heater. 4. With the scan tool,
monitor O2 Sensor voltage for at least 2 minutes.
Does the voltage stay above 4.5 volts?
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1087
Yes
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
4. O2 SENSOR
1. Turn the ignition off.
NOTE: Check for contaminants that may cause improper O2 Sensor operation, such as
contaminated fuel, unapproved silicone, or evidence
of oil or coolant.
2. Disconnect the O2 Sensor harness connector. 3. Turn the ignition on. 4. With a scan tool,
monitor the O2 Sensor voltage.
NOTE: The voltage should be approximately 5.0 volts with the connector disconnected.
5. Connect a jumper wire between the signal circuit and the return circuit in the O2 Sensor harness
connector.
NOTE: The voltage should drop from 5.0 volts to 2.5 volts with the jumper wire in place.
Is the O2 Sensor voltage displayed on the scan tool as described?
Yes
- Replace the O2 Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 5
5. O2 SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the O2 Sensor Signal circuit and
connectors between the O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Check the O2 Sensor signal circuit for a short
to ground, open circuit, short to voltage, or high resistance.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 6
6. O2 SENSOR RETURN CIRCUIT
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the O2 Sensor Return circuit and
connectors between the O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Check the O2 Sensor return circuit for a short
to ground, open circuit, short to voltage or high resistance.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1088
No
- Go to 7
7. POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3.
Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 4. Monitor the scan tool data relative to
the components tested in this procedure and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 5. Look for the
data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. 6. Search for any Technical Service
Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace and program the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
2.7, 3.5L
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/1)
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wires going into
oxygen sensor (O2S). Damage to the
oxygen sensor may occur.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect O2S wire harness mounting clips from engine or body,
if equipped. 3. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (1). 4. Remove O2S (2)
from catalytic converter (4). 5. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (5). 6.
Remove O2S (3) from catalytic converter (4).
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/1)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 1091
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wires going into
oxygen sensor (O2S). Damage to the
oxygen sensor may occur.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect O2S wire harness mounting clips from engine or body,
if equipped. 3. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (1). 4. Remove the O2S
(5) from catalytic converter (4). 5. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (2).
6. Remove O2S (3) from catalytic converter (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 1092
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
2.7, 3.5L
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/1)
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When Equipped: The oxygen sensor (O2S) pigtail harness must be clipped and/or
bolted back to their original positions on engine
or body to prevent mechanical damage to wiring.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
Threads of new oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal. DO
NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new O2S.
1. Install O2S (3) to catalytic converter (4). 2. Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring
harness (2). 3. Install the O2S (2) to catalytic converter (4). Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 4.
Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring harness (1). 5. Connect O2S wire harness mounting
clips to engine or body, if equipped.
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/1)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 1093
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When Equipped: The oxygen sensor (O2S) pigtail harness must be clipped and/or
bolted back to their original positions on engine
or body to prevent mechanical damage to wiring.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
Threads of new oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal. DO
NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new O2S.
1. Install O2S (3) to catalytic converter (4). 2. Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring
harness (5). 3. Install O2S (2) to catalytic converter (4). Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect
O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring harness (1). 5. Connect O2S wire harness mounting clips to
engine or body, if equipped.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1097
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal
2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1100
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1101
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1102
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1103
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1104
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect air flow sensor electrical connector (4). 2. Remove constant tension clamps (1), (2)
securing the air flow sensor (3). 3. Remove air flow sensor (3) from hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1110
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Note the arrow direction on the sensor and correctly position the air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 2.
Install constant tension clamps (1), (2) to secure air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 3. Connect air flow
sensor electrical connector (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Operation > Page 1115
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1120
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 6 WAY
SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Position an oil collecting container under switch location. 3. Disconnect
electrical connector (1). 4. Remove the oil pressure switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal > Page 1125
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Thread Sealant to the switch threads. 2. Install oil pressure switch (2). 3.
Connect electrical connector (1). 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Start engine and check for leaks. 6. Check
engine oil level and adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
1/1 (2.4L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
1/1 (2.4L/3.5L) > Page 1131
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1132
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CAMSHAFT 1/1 POSITION (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1133
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT AND CRANKSHAFT SIGNALS
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft
Position Sensor - Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at battery. 2. Disconnect electrical connector
(3) from camshaft position (CMP) sensor (2). 3. Remove bolt (1) and CMP sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft
Position Sensor - Removal > Page 1136
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Install camshaft position (CMP) sensor utilizing twisting motion. Make sure CMP sensor
is fully seated. Do not drive CMP sensor
into the bore with mounting screw. This may cause CMP sensor to be incorrectly seated causing a
faulty signal or no signal at all.
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the CMP sensor (2) into the timing belt cover with a twisting motion until fully seated. 2.
While holding the sensor (2) in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt (1) to 12 Nm (106
in. lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector (3) to the CMP sensor (2). 4. Connect the
negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1140
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1141
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft
Position Sensor - Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor is located on the driver side of the vehicle, above the
differential housing. The bottom of the sensor sits
above the drive plate.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the electrical
connector from the crankshaft position sensor. 3. Remove the sensor mounting screw and the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft
Position Sensor - Removal > Page 1144
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor into the transmission case with a twisting motion until
fully seated.
CAUTION: Before tightening the sensor mounting bolt, be sure the sensor is completely flush to the
mounting surface. If the sensor is not
flush, damage to the sensor mounting tang may result.
2. While holding the sensor in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the CKP sensor. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Locations
Ignition Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1148
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1151
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1152
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1153
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1154
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1155
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1156
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1157
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1158
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1159
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1160
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1161
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1162
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1163
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1164
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1165
Ignition Switch: Connector Views
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Description
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) (1). The WIN and the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch (5) located on the face of the instrument panel just to
the inboard side of the steering column.
The WIN housing is constructed of molded black plastic and it includes four integral mounting
bosses (4), which are secured to the instrument panel structure with screws. Two connector
receptacles are integral to the back of the switch housing. One (3) connects the WIN to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The other (2) is a dedicated connector for the coaxial cable input from the optional remote start
system external antenna module.
The WIN is an integrated electronic receiver that replaces the ignition switch. It communicates with
other electronic modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF)
communication. It also communicates with the TPM trigger transponders (if equipped) and steering
column lock module (if equipped) using a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus connection.
The WIN provides a switched 12-volt source through an isolated switch for the steering column lock
module required for certain export market vehicles. It also contains a key removal inhibit solenoid,
an electronic Brake Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI) solenoid, a key-in warning contact and it
serves as the real time vehicle clock by transmitting the clock information to other electronic
modules over the CAN data bus.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged, the
entire WIN must be replaced. When replacing the WIN, you must also replace the steering column
lock module (if equipped).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Description > Page 1168
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Operation
OPERATION
Following are brief descriptions of the systems that the WIN controls.
IGNITION SWITCH
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) incorporates an integral ignition switch that consists of four rotary
positions with three detent positions and one spring-loaded position. The one extreme clockwise
position is a spring-loaded momentary contact "START" position. When released from the "START"
position, the switch will automatically return to the detent "ON" position. The other position includes
a detent "ACCESSORY" position and a detent "LOCK" position.
The WIN reads the position of the ignition switch and transmits the data via the CAN data bus.
These positions include "LOCK" with ignition key-out, "LOCK" with ignition key-in,
"ACCESSORY,""RUN," and "START."
SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM (SKIS)
Upon failure of proper Sentry Key Immobilizer (SKIS) communication to the Powertrain Control
Module, (PCM), the PCM will not allow the vehicle to crank. The engine will not re-crank on the key
cycle that the failure occurred, a full key down sequence must be performed for the engine to crank
again. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Description and
Operation/Vehicle Theft Security System - Operation.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE)
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), transmitter uses Radio Frequency (RF) signals to communicate
with the WIN, and the WIN relays the RKE requests to other modules in the vehicle over the CAN
data bus. See: Body and Frame/Locks/Power Locks/Description and Operation/Power Locks Operation
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING (TPM)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system uses radio and sensor technology to monitor tire air
pressure levels. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Tire Monitoring
System/Description and Operation/Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) - Operation.
REMOTE START WITH/EXTENDED RANGE ANTENNA
Further information concerning the Remote Start System. See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Keyless Entry/Keyless Starting System/Description and
Operation/Starting System - Operation
BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFTER INTERLOCK (BTSI)
The Brake Transmission Shifter/Ignition Interlock (BTSI) is controlled by the WIN. The BTSI
prevents the transmission gear shifter from being moved out of PARK without a driver in place.
PARK SHIFT INTERLOCK
The key removal inhibit solenoid internal to the WIN prevents the FOB with Integrated KEY
(FOBIK) from being rotated in the ignition switch to the LOCK position for all vehicles with an
automatic transmission unless the transmission shift lever is in the PARK position. The WIN
module monitors a hard wired input from a switch integral to the automatic transmission shifter
module to control this feature. The key removal inhibit solenoid is electronically disabled internally
by the WIN on vehicles with a manual transmission.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Description > Page 1169
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Ignition Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN). The WIN, along with the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch located on the face of the instrument panel just to the
inboard side of the steering column. The remainder of the WIN including its mounting provisions
and electrical connections are concealed within the instrument panel.
In addition to replacing a conventional keyed ignition switch, the WIN is an integrated electronic
receiver that serves as the base station in the vehicle. It communicates with other electronic
modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF) RF
communication.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged the
entire WIN must be replaced See: Service and Repair/Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ignition Switch: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
FOBIK TRAPPED IN WIN
The Fob with Integrated Key (FOBIK) cannot be rotated to the LOCK position, allowing it to be
removed from the ignition switch also referred to as the Wireless Ignition Node/WIN. The automatic
transmission or transaxle is shifted mechanically through a cable from the gearshift lever
mechanism to the transmission or transaxle valve body. A gated park switch is physically located
on and integral to the gearshift lever mechanism and is hard wired directly to the WIN. The gated
park switch is a simple plunger-like actuated open or closed contact switch that could be
considered redundant to the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) except that it monitors the position
selected with the gearshift lever, while the TRS monitors the position or gear of the transmission or
transaxle that is actually engaged. A damaged or improperly adjusted gearshift cable could result in
a different gear being engaged than that which is selected. The WIN uses the gated park switch
input to control an internal key lock solenoid, which controls whether the FOBIK can be rotated to
the LOCK position. When the gearshift lever is not in the PARK position, the gated park switch is a
closed circuit, the key lock solenoid is energized and the FOBIK cannot be rotated to the LOCK
position for removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Removal
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the lower instrument panel knee
blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker - Removal. 3.
Remove upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument cluster bezel, reposition the instrument, and remove the upper WIN
bracket attaching screw (1). See: Instrument Panel,
Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster
- Removal.
5. Disconnect the WIN electrical connector (1) and the antenna connector (3) from the WIN. 6.
Utilize a trim stick or equivalent and gently pry WIN trim ring (2) away from the instrument panel. 7.
Remove the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 8. Remove the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Removal > Page 1174
9. Rotate the WIN (1) and (2) bracket to assist in removal from the instrument panel.
10. Remove the WIN from the instrument panel opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Removal > Page 1175
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The WIN initialization procedure is required whenever the WIN or shaft lock module is
replaced on vehicles equipped with the shaft
lock module.
1. Rotate and position the WIN (1) and bracket (2) into the to instrument panel opening.
2. Install the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4). 3. Install the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 4.
Connect the WIN electrical connector (1) and antenna connector (3) to the WIN. 5. Install the WIN
trim ring (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Removal > Page 1176
6. Install the upper WIN bracket attaching screw (1) and reposition the instrument cluster into the
instrument panel and install the instrument cluster
bezel. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service
and Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
8. Install knee blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker Installation. 9. Connect negative battery cable.
10. If necessary, program the WIN, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and
Relearning.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1180
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1181
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-KNOCK (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold, See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the knock sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal >
Page 1184
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Always use the specified torque when installing the knock sensor bolt. Over or under
tightening the sensor mounting bolt will
affect knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper spark control.
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 2. Route the knock sensor wire
in the proper location. 3. Install upper intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation.
4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1190
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1191
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1192
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1193
Impact Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1194
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1195
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1196
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1197
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1198
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1199
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 1200
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 1203
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Right Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-RIGHT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 1204
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Left Side Impact Sensor 1 (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1 - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 1205
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Left Side Impact Sensor 3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 1206
Impact Sensor: Diagrams
Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Right Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-RIGHT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 1207
Left Side Impact Sensor 1 (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1 - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Left Side Impact Sensor 3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 1208
Right Side Impact Sensor 1 (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 1 - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Right Side Impact Sensor 3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 1209
Left Side Impact Sensor 2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Right Side Impact Sensor 2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 1210
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Impact Sensor - Description
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
Two acceleration-type front impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle, one each for the left and
right sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is
internal to the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each front sensor is secured with a screw to
the back of the front end module carrier on either outboard side of the cooling module, just inboard
of each front lamp unit housing within the engine compartment. The sensor housing has an integral
connector receptacle (3), an integral locating and anti-rotation pin, and an integral mounting hole
(2).
The right and left front impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration. A cavity in the
center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the sensor
which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. The cavity is
filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components.
The front impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the front end module wire harness.
These acceleration-type front impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or
ineffective, they must be replaced.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
Two pressure-type front door side impact sensors (2) are used on this vehicle when it is equipped
with the side curtain airbags or the optional seat (also known as thorax) airbags, one each for the
left and right sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that
is internal to the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each side sensor is secured with two
screws and is sealed by a resilient gasket (1) to the front door module carrier on the inside of the
front door. The sensors are concealed behind the front door trim panel within the passenger
compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 1213
The right and left front door side impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration. The
impact sensor housing has an integral connector receptacle (3), two integral mounting tabs, and an
integral hood-like water shield (4) that extends through a hole in the front door module carrier into
the interior of the door cavity and protects the sensor orifice from contamination. A cavity in the
center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the sensor,
which includes an electronic communication chip and the pressure sensor. The housing cavity is
filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components. A
label on the sensor has a directional arrow and the word down imprinted upon it to provide
verification of the correct sensor orientation in the vehicle. The side impact sensors are each
connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the front
door wire harness.
These pressure-type front door side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if
damaged or ineffective, they must be replaced.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
Two acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle when it
is equipped with the side curtain airbags, one each for the left and right sides of the vehicle. These
sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is internal to the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC). Each side sensor is secured with a screw to the lower C-pillar just above the rear
door opening sill within the passenger compartment. The sensor housing has an integral connector
receptacle (3), an integral locating anti-rotation pin, and an integral mounting hole (2).
The right and left second row seating side impact sensors are identical in construction and
calibration. However, the connector orientation in the vehicle is reversed. The connector receptacle
faces forward on the right side of the vehicle, and faces rearward on the left side of the vehicle. A
cavity in the center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of
the sensor which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. The
cavity is filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and
components. The second row seating side impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness.
These acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted
and, if damaged or ineffective, they must be replaced.
Side - Third Row Seating
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 1214
Two acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle when it is
equipped with the side curtain airbags and seven-passenger seating, one each for the left and right
sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is internal to
the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each side sensor is secured with a screw to the right or
left quarter inner panel just above the right or left rear wheel housing within the passenger
compartment. The sensor housing has an integral connector receptacle (3), an integral locating
anti-rotation pin, and an integral mounting hole (2).
The right and left third row seating side impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration.
However, the connector orientation in the vehicle is reversed. The connector receptacle faces
forward on the right side of the vehicle, and faces rearward on the left side of the vehicle. A cavity
in the center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the
sensor which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. The
cavity is filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and
components. The third row seating side impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle electrical
system through a dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness.
These acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and,
if damaged or ineffective, they must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 1215
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Impact Sensor - Operation
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
The acceleration-type front impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that sense the rate of
vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity of an impact. Each
sensor also contains an electronic communication chip that allows the unit to communicate the
sensor status as well as sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the front passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and commands the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The
impact sensors each receive battery current and ground through dedicated left and right sensor
plus and minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by
modulating the current in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the acceleration-type front impact sensors and the ORC may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and
devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most reliable,
efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls and
communication related to acceleration-type front impact sensor operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
The pressure-type front door side impact sensors recognize a side impact in the front door area by
monitoring changes in pressure within the front door cavity, which manifests itself as a sudden
pressure wave as the door collapses during an impact. Each sensor also contains an electronic
communication chip that allows the unit to communicate the sensor status as well as sensor fault
information to the microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through dedicated left and right sensor plus and
minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating the
current in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the pressure-type front door side impact sensors and the ORC
may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate
wiring information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the
diagnosis of the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the pressure-type front door side impact
sensors or the electronic controls and communication related to side impact sensor operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
The acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that
sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity of an
impact. Each sensor also contains an electronic communication chip that allows the unit to
communicate the sensor status as well as sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through the dedicated left and right sensor plus
and minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating
the voltage in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors and
the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive
in the diagnosis of the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls
and communication related to acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensor operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Side - Third Row Seating
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 1216
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
The acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that
sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity of an
impact. Each sensor also contains an electronic communication chip that allows the unit to
communicate the sensor status as well as sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through the dedicated left and right sensor plus
and minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating
the voltage in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors and
the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive
in the diagnosis of the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls
and communication related to acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensor operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Impact Sensor - Removal
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the front impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The front impact sensor enables the system to deploy the front Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper front SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Service access for the front impact sensors is accomplished by
reaching behind the front end module carrier (2) from the top of the engine
compartment and between the inboard end of either front lamp unit housing (3) and either outboard
end of the cooling module.
3. For the left front impact sensor only, remove the fresh air intake snorkel and the air filter housing
from behind the front end module carrier for
service access.
4. Disconnect the front end module wire harness connector (5) from the connector receptacle of the
right or left front impact sensor (1). 5. Remove the screw (4) that secures the front impact sensor to
the back (engine compartment side) of the front end module carrier. 6. Pull the front impact sensor
straight back from the mounting location to disengage the anti-rotation pin on the base of the
sensor from the clearance
hole in the front end module carrier.
7. Remove the right or left front impact sensor from the engine compartment.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 1219
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Remove the trim panel from the inside of the right or left front
door. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the front door wire harness connector (3) from the side impact sensor (1) connector
receptacle. 4. Remove the two screws (2) that secure the side impact sensor to the front door
module carrier panel (4). 5. Remove the side impact sensor from the door.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Open the sliding door. 3. Remove the quarter trim panel from
the lower C-pillar (1).See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
4. Disconnect the body wire harness connector (4) from the side impact sensor (3) connector
receptacle. 5. Remove the screw (2) that secures the side impact sensor to the lower C-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 1220
6. Pull the side impact sensor straight out from the mounting location to unsnap the anti-rotation pin
on the base of the sensor from the clearance hole
in the lower C-pillar.
7. Remove the side impact sensor from the vehicle.
Side - Third Row Seating
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Remove the quarter trim panel from the quarter inner panel
over the rear wheel housing (1). See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the body wire harness connector (2) from the side impact sensor (4) above the rear
wheel housing on the quarter inner panel. 4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the side impact
sensor to the quarter inner panel. 5. Pull the side impact sensor straight out from the mounting
location to disengage the anti-rotation pin on the base of the sensor from the clearance
hole in the quarter inner panel.
6. Remove the side impact sensor from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 1221
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Impact Sensor - Installation
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the front impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The front impact sensor enables the system to deploy the front Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper front SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Service access for the front impact sensors is accomplished by reaching behind the front end
module carrier (2) from the top of the engine
compartment and between the inboard end of either front lamp unit housing (3) and either outboard
end of the cooling module.
2. Position the right or left front impact sensor (1) into the engine compartment. 3. Align and insert
the anti-rotation pin on the base of the sensor into the clearance hole on the back (engine
compartment side) of the front end
module carrier.
4. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the front impact sensor to the front end module
carrier. Tighten the screw to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 5. Reconnect the front end module wire harness
connector (5) to the connector receptacle of the front impact sensor. 6. For the left front impact
sensor only, reinstall the fresh air intake snorkel and the air filter housing behind the front end
module carrier. 7. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Restraint Systems/Service and Repair.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 1222
NOTE: Be certain that the gasket between the pressure-type side impact sensor and the front door
module carrier panel is in good condition
and positioned on the back of the sensor. There MUST be a good seal between the sensor and the
module carrier panel for the sensor to operate properly. If the gasket is in poor condition, replace
the sensor.
1. Position the side impact sensor (1) to the right or left front door module carrier panel (4). When
the sensor is correctly positioned, the arrow on the
sensor label will be pointed toward the bottom of the door.
2. Install and tighten the two screws (2) that secure the side impact sensor to the door. Tighten the
screws to 2.4 Nm (21 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the front door wire harness connector (3) to the sensor
connector receptacle. 4. Reinstall the trim panel onto the inside of the right or left front door. See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Installation.
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Restraint Systems/Service and Repair.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 1223
1. Position the side impact sensor (3) to the lower C-pillar (1). 2. Align the anti-rotation pin on the
base of the sensor with the clearance hole in the lower C-pillar, then press on the sensor firmly and
evenly to snap
the pin into place.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the side impact sensor to the lower C-pillar. Tighten
the screw to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (4) to the side
impact sensor on the lower C-pillar. 5. Reinstall the quarter trim panel onto the lower C-pillar. See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
6. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Restraint Systems/Service and Repair.
Side - Third Row Seating
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Position the side impact sensor (4) to the quarter inner panel above the rear wheel housing (1).
2. Align the anti-rotation pin on the base of the sensor with the clearance hole in the quarter inner
panel, then press on the sensor firmly and evenly to
snap the pin into place.
3. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the side impact sensor to the quarter inner panel.
Tighten the screw to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (2) to the
side impact sensor on the quarter inner panel. 5. Reinstall the quarter trim panel onto the quarter
inner panel over the rear wheel housing. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
6. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Restraint Systems/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1227
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1228
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SWITCH-SEAT BELT-DRIVER - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Seat Belt Switch - Description
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation Seat Belt Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The seat belt switch (4) is a small, normally open, single pole, single throw, plunger (3) actuated,
momentary switch. One seat belt switch is installed on the seat belt retractor frame (2) over the
retractor spool (1) for the driver side front seat. The seat belt switch includes an integral connector
that is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the body wire
harness.
The seat belt switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire front
seat belt and retractor unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Seat Belt Switch - Description > Page 1231
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation Seat Belt Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The driver side front seat belt switch is designed to control a path to ground for the seat belt switch
sense input of the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM provides electronic driver
side seat belt switch status messages to the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also
known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The EMIC controls the seat belt indicator based upon the electronic driver side seat belt switch
status message inputs.
The seat belt switch plunger is actuated by the seat belt webbing wound onto the seat belt retractor
spool. When the seat belt tip-half webbing is pulled out of the retractor far enough to engage the
seat belt buckle-half, the switch plunger is extended and closes the seat belt switch sense circuit to
ground. Conversely, when the seat belt tip-half webbing is wound onto the retractor spool the
switch plunger is depressed, opening the ground path.
The seat belt switch is connected in series between ground and the seat belt switch sense input of
the TIPM. The seat belt switch receives ground through its connection to the body wire harness
from another take out of the body wire harness. An eyelet terminal connector on that ground take
out is secured under a ground screw. The TIPM monitors the condition of the driver seat belt switch
circuits and will send an electronic message to illuminate the airbag indicator in the EMIC then
store a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that is detected.
The hard wired circuits between the driver side seat belt switch and the TIPM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the switch
or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and devices that provide
features of the supplemental restraint system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to
diagnose the driver side seat belt switch or the electronic controls and communication related to
seat belt switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Seat Track Position Sensor - Description
Seat Position Sensor: Description and Operation Seat Track Position Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The seat track position sensor (2) is a Hall Effect-type sensor used on some vehicles. This sensor
consists of a Hall Effect Integrated Circuit (IC) chip encased in potting material within a cavity of the
molded plastic sensor housing.
The sensor housing has a mounting slot containing an integral latch feature (1) and slides and
latches onto a stamped metal blade-type bracket located on the inboard side of the upper inboard
seat adjuster track near the rear of the driver side front seat. A molded connector receptacle (3)
integral to the sensor housing is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a connector
and take out of the driver side front seat wire harness beneath the front seat cushion frame.
The seat track position sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
entire sensor must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Seat Track Position Sensor - Description > Page 1236
Seat Position Sensor: Description and Operation Seat Track Position Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The seat track position sensor is designed to provide a seat position data input to the Occupant
Restraint Controller (ORC) indicating whether the driver side front seat is in a full forward or a not
full forward position. The ORC uses this data as an additional logic input for use in determining the
appropriate deployment force to be used when deploying the multistage driver airbag.
The seat track position sensor receives a nominal five volt supply from the ORC. The sensor
communicates the seat position by modulating the voltage returned to the ORC on a sensor data
circuit. The ORC also monitors the condition of the sensor circuits and will store a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that is detected. The ORC sends messages over the CAN data
bus to control the illumination of the airbag indicator in the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN).
The hard wired circuits between the seat track position sensor and the ORC may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the seat
track position sensor or the electronic controls and communication between other modules and
devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most reliable,
efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the seat track position sensor or the electronic controls
and communication related to seat track position sensor operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Track Position Sensor - Removal
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair Seat Track Position Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting
any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel
component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or
service. This is the only sure way to disable the supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the
proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Reach under the rear edge of the front seat cushion to access
the seat track position sensor (2) on a bracket (1) located on the inboard side near the
rear of the upper inboard seat track (4).
3. Using a small screwdriver, hold the latch feature (3) depressed while sliding the connector end of
the sensor off of the bracket. 4. Disconnect the seat wire harness connector (5) from the sensor
connector receptacle. 5. Remove the sensor from under the front seat.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Track Position Sensor - Removal > Page 1239
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair Seat Track Position Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting
any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel
component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or
service. This is the only sure way to disable the supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the
proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Reach under the rear edge of the front seat cushion to reconnect the seat wire harness
connector (5) to the seat track position sensor (2) connector
receptacle. Be certain that the latch on the connector is fully engaged.
2. Align the open end of the sensor to the blade of the sensor bracket (1) located on the inboard
side near the rear of the upper inboard seat track (4). 3. Push the sensor firmly onto the bracket
until the latch feature (3) snaps into place with an audible click. 4. Do not reconnect the battery
negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) verification test procedure
should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Restraint Systems/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor > Page 1244
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way
Seat Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Driver Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-DRIVER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way > Page 1247
Seat Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Passenger Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-PASSENGER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ignition Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1252
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1255
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1256
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1257
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1258
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1259
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1260
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1261
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1262
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1263
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1264
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1265
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1266
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1267
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1268
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1269
Ignition Switch: Connector Views
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) (1). The WIN and the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch (5) located on the face of the instrument panel just to
the inboard side of the steering column.
The WIN housing is constructed of molded black plastic and it includes four integral mounting
bosses (4), which are secured to the instrument panel structure with screws. Two connector
receptacles are integral to the back of the switch housing. One (3) connects the WIN to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The other (2) is a dedicated connector for the coaxial cable input from the optional remote start
system external antenna module.
The WIN is an integrated electronic receiver that replaces the ignition switch. It communicates with
other electronic modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF)
communication. It also communicates with the TPM trigger transponders (if equipped) and steering
column lock module (if equipped) using a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus connection.
The WIN provides a switched 12-volt source through an isolated switch for the steering column lock
module required for certain export market vehicles. It also contains a key removal inhibit solenoid,
an electronic Brake Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI) solenoid, a key-in warning contact and it
serves as the real time vehicle clock by transmitting the clock information to other electronic
modules over the CAN data bus.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged, the
entire WIN must be replaced. When replacing the WIN, you must also replace the steering column
lock module (if equipped).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description > Page 1272
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Operation
OPERATION
Following are brief descriptions of the systems that the WIN controls.
IGNITION SWITCH
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) incorporates an integral ignition switch that consists of four rotary
positions with three detent positions and one spring-loaded position. The one extreme clockwise
position is a spring-loaded momentary contact "START" position. When released from the "START"
position, the switch will automatically return to the detent "ON" position. The other position includes
a detent "ACCESSORY" position and a detent "LOCK" position.
The WIN reads the position of the ignition switch and transmits the data via the CAN data bus.
These positions include "LOCK" with ignition key-out, "LOCK" with ignition key-in,
"ACCESSORY,""RUN," and "START."
SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM (SKIS)
Upon failure of proper Sentry Key Immobilizer (SKIS) communication to the Powertrain Control
Module, (PCM), the PCM will not allow the vehicle to crank. The engine will not re-crank on the key
cycle that the failure occurred, a full key down sequence must be performed for the engine to crank
again. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Description and
Operation/Vehicle Theft Security System - Operation.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE)
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), transmitter uses Radio Frequency (RF) signals to communicate
with the WIN, and the WIN relays the RKE requests to other modules in the vehicle over the CAN
data bus. See: Body and Frame/Locks/Power Locks/Description and Operation/Power Locks Operation
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING (TPM)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system uses radio and sensor technology to monitor tire air
pressure levels. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Tire Monitoring
System/Description and Operation/Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) - Operation.
REMOTE START WITH/EXTENDED RANGE ANTENNA
Further information concerning the Remote Start System. See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Keyless Entry/Keyless Starting System/Description and
Operation/Starting System - Operation
BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFTER INTERLOCK (BTSI)
The Brake Transmission Shifter/Ignition Interlock (BTSI) is controlled by the WIN. The BTSI
prevents the transmission gear shifter from being moved out of PARK without a driver in place.
PARK SHIFT INTERLOCK
The key removal inhibit solenoid internal to the WIN prevents the FOB with Integrated KEY
(FOBIK) from being rotated in the ignition switch to the LOCK position for all vehicles with an
automatic transmission unless the transmission shift lever is in the PARK position. The WIN
module monitors a hard wired input from a switch integral to the automatic transmission shifter
module to control this feature. The key removal inhibit solenoid is electronically disabled internally
by the WIN on vehicles with a manual transmission.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description > Page 1273
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Ignition Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN). The WIN, along with the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch located on the face of the instrument panel just to the
inboard side of the steering column. The remainder of the WIN including its mounting provisions
and electrical connections are concealed within the instrument panel.
In addition to replacing a conventional keyed ignition switch, the WIN is an integrated electronic
receiver that serves as the base station in the vehicle. It communicates with other electronic
modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF) RF
communication.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged the
entire WIN must be replaced See: Service and Repair/Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ignition Switch: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
FOBIK TRAPPED IN WIN
The Fob with Integrated Key (FOBIK) cannot be rotated to the LOCK position, allowing it to be
removed from the ignition switch also referred to as the Wireless Ignition Node/WIN. The automatic
transmission or transaxle is shifted mechanically through a cable from the gearshift lever
mechanism to the transmission or transaxle valve body. A gated park switch is physically located
on and integral to the gearshift lever mechanism and is hard wired directly to the WIN. The gated
park switch is a simple plunger-like actuated open or closed contact switch that could be
considered redundant to the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) except that it monitors the position
selected with the gearshift lever, while the TRS monitors the position or gear of the transmission or
transaxle that is actually engaged. A damaged or improperly adjusted gearshift cable could result in
a different gear being engaged than that which is selected. The WIN uses the gated park switch
input to control an internal key lock solenoid, which controls whether the FOBIK can be rotated to
the LOCK position. When the gearshift lever is not in the PARK position, the gated park switch is a
closed circuit, the key lock solenoid is energized and the FOBIK cannot be rotated to the LOCK
position for removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the lower instrument panel knee
blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker - Removal. 3.
Remove upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument cluster bezel, reposition the instrument, and remove the upper WIN
bracket attaching screw (1). See: Instrument Panel,
Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster
- Removal.
5. Disconnect the WIN electrical connector (1) and the antenna connector (3) from the WIN. 6.
Utilize a trim stick or equivalent and gently pry WIN trim ring (2) away from the instrument panel. 7.
Remove the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 8. Remove the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 1278
9. Rotate the WIN (1) and (2) bracket to assist in removal from the instrument panel.
10. Remove the WIN from the instrument panel opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 1279
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The WIN initialization procedure is required whenever the WIN or shaft lock module is
replaced on vehicles equipped with the shaft
lock module.
1. Rotate and position the WIN (1) and bracket (2) into the to instrument panel opening.
2. Install the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4). 3. Install the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 4.
Connect the WIN electrical connector (1) and antenna connector (3) to the WIN. 5. Install the WIN
trim ring (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 1280
6. Install the upper WIN bracket attaching screw (1) and reposition the instrument cluster into the
instrument panel and install the instrument cluster
bezel. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service
and Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
8. Install knee blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker Installation. 9. Connect negative battery cable.
10. If necessary, program the WIN, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and
Relearning.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1284
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagrams
Connector (MTX) - (BODY) 3 WAY
SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK (MTX) - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION
CAUTION: The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPM system
pressures have been established for the tire size equipped on the vehicle. Undesirable system
operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same
size, type, or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause sensor damage. Do not use aftermarket tire
sealants or balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with TPM, as damage to the sensors may
result.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. Use tire
pressure sensors in original style factory wheels
only. If aftermarket wheels are installed, and therefore do not contain tire pressure sensors, the
system will not function properly and the driver will be continuously notified of a system
malfunction.
CAUTION: After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure always reinstall the valve stem cap. This
will prevent moisture and dirt from
entering the valve stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Sensor.
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensor valve stem caps and cores are specially designed for the sensors.
Due to risk of corrosion, do not use a
standard valve stem cap or core in a tire pressure sensor in place of the original equipment style
sensor cap and core.
CAUTION: Any time a sensor is to be installed in a wheel, it is necessary to install a new
sensor-to-wheel seal, metal washer and valve stem
nut, to ensure air tight sealing.
CAUTION: When installing the valve core, be sure to tighten the core to specifications See:
Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Wheels/Specifications
. Overtightening by a little as three or four inch pounds can damage the sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM), one tire pressure sensor (6) is
mounted to each wheel (5) in place of the traditional tire valve stem. Each sensor has an internal
battery that lasts up to 10 years. The battery is not serviceable. At the time of battery failure, the
sensor must be replaced.
The TPM system operates on a 433 MHz radio frequency. The 433 MHz sensors (1) can be easily
identified by the part number.
CAUTION: Although additional sensors operating at 433 MHz sensors are available and are used
in other applications, they are not
interchangeable. Always make sure the correct sensor is being used and be sure to replace the
sensor with the correct part number.
NOTE: Once mounted inside a tire and wheel assembly you are not able to visually see the
difference between this sensor and other 315 MHz
and 433 MHz sensors. At that point, the TPM/RKE Analyzer 9936, with the Scan Tool may be used
to identify the sensor frequency or the tire can be dismounted allowing visual inspection of the
sensor body and part number.
The TPM sensors are designed for original style factory wheels. It is not recommended to install a
tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel (This could cause sealing and system performance
issues). Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. If aftermarket
wheels are installed and do not contain tire pressure sensors, the system will not function properly
and the driver will be continuously notified of a system malfunction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description > Page 1292
The serviceable components of the tire pressure sensor are:
- Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2) and Metal Washer (1)
- Valve Stem Cap (4)
- Valve Stem Core
- Valve Stem Nut (with pressed-in washer) (3)
NOTE: Any time a sensor is installed on a wheel, a new Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2), Metal Washer
(1) and Valve Stem Nut (3) must be installed
to ensure air tight sealing. A service kit is available.
The valve stem caps and cores are specifically designed for the tire pressure monitoring sensors.
Although similar to standard valve stem caps and cores, they are different. The valve stem cap has
a special seal inside to keep moisture and corrosion out. The valve stem core has a special nickel
coating to protect from corrosion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description > Page 1293
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The battery operated tire pressure sensor is both a transmitter and a receiver. The TPM sensor can
be forced to transmit by using a special tool such as a TPM-RKE Analyzer. Using a TPM-RKE
Analyzer can take up to a minute to force a transmission from a sensor.
NOTE: The TPM-RKE Analyzer will not define the mode.
The TPM sensor can be in one of the following operating modes:
- OFF MODE - A new TPM sensor will be in this mode. In this mode the sensor does not transmit
periodically on its own. By forcing a transmission from the sensor with the TPM-RKE Analyzer, it
will change to the STATIONARY MODE. The sensor will also automatically change from OFF
mode to the STATIONARY MODE once it experiences a great increase in pressure (i.e. installation
into a wheel/tire assembly and then inflated).
- WAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes when the vehicle is driven over
15mph (24km/h), but only after the vehicle was previously parked for a duration of 18 minutes or
greater. In WAL MODE the sensors transmit every 33 seconds and these transmissions contain
left/right information that allows the TPM Module to determine sensor location on the vehicle. WAL
MODE lasts for the first 10 minutes of consecutive driving, then NORMAL DRIVE mode ensues.
- FACTORY MODE- This is a special case of WAL MODE. If a TPM sensor has just been taken out
of OFF MODE, then for the first 3 minutes of the WAL period (10 minutes) the sensors transmit at
an accelerated rate of every 10 seconds. After the first 20 drives, then the sensors never again
transmit out of FACTORY MODE.
- NORMAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes after the first 10 minutes of a
drive. In NORMAL MODE the sensors transmit every 66 seconds and cease transmitting left/right
information.
- SERVICE MODE- Once a vehicle stops, the sensors go into SERVICE MODE. After 18 minutes
of no driving then the sensors go into the STATIONARY MODE. If the vehicle was stopped for less
than 18 minutes and driving resumes, then the sensors go back to the NORMAL MODE.
- STATIONARY MODE - When a vehicle has been stopped for more then 18 minutes, then the
sensor is forced into STATIONARY MODE. In STATIONARY MODE the sensor never transmits
any pressure information. The sensor leaves STATIONARY MODE and enters WAL MODE when
the vehicle is driven above 15mph (24km/h).
Each sensor's (transmitter) broadcast is uniquely coded so that the TPM module can monitor the
state of each of the sensors on the four rotating road wheels. The TPM module can automatically
learn and store the sensor's ID while driving "within 20 minutes continuously above 15 mph (24
km/h)" after a sensor has been replaced. The vehicle must be stationary for more then 20 minutes
in order to initiate the learning sequence. The TPM module can also learn the sensor's ID using the
TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool following the procedure listed in the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly.
CAUTION: The cap used on this valve stem contains an O-ring seal to prevent contamination and
moisture from entering the valve stem.
Retain this valve stem cap for reuse. Do not substitute a regular valve stem cap in its place.
CAUTION: The valve stem used on this vehicle is made of aluminum and the core is nickel plated
brass. The original valve stem core must be
reinstalled and not substituted with a valve stem core made of a different material. This is required
to prevent corrosion in the valve stem caused by the different metals.
3. Dismount tire from wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions while paying special
attention to the following to avoid damaging the
pressure sensor: a. When breaking the tire bead loose from the wheel rim, avoid using the Bead
Breaker in the area of the sensor (1). That includes both outer and
inner beads of the tire.
b. When preparing to dismount the tire from the wheel, carefully insert the mounting/dismounting
tool 280° from the valve stem ± 10°, then
proceed to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use this process on both outer and inner tire beads.
4. Remove sensor nut (3) retaining sensor to wheel. While removing nut, hold pressure against
rear of metal valve stem to keep valve stem from
pushing rearward, damaging antenna strap.
5. Remove sensor (1) from wheel (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1296
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before reinstalling an existing tire pressure sensor, replace seal (2) and metal washer (1) at
base of sensor valve stem (6) to ensure
proper sealing.
1. Wipe area clean around sensor/valve stem mounting hole in wheel (5). Make sure surface of
wheel is not damaged.
CAUTION: To avoid damaging sensor antenna strap (1), if equipped, hold pressure against rear of
metal valve stem (2) while sensor is
inserted through wheel mounting hole and nut is installed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1297
2. Insert sensor (1) through wheel (2) as shown keeping pressure against rear of metal valve stem
(See Arrow). Potted side of sensor is to be
positioned toward wheel. Do not attempt to mount sensor otherwise, damage may occur.
3. Install sensor nut (with pressed-in washer) (3) by hand.
NOTE: Before tightening sensor nut, push downward on sensor housing (2) in an attempt to make
it flush with interior contour of wheel (1).
4. While holding sensor in position, tighten sensor nut to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Over-torquing the sensor nut by as little as 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.) may result in sensor
separation from the valve stem. Under this
condition, the sensor may still function. However, the condition should be corrected immediately.
5. Mount tire on wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions, paying special attention to
the following to avoid damaging tire pressure
sensor: a.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1298
Rotating Wheel Tire Changers - Once the wheel is mounted to the changer, position the sensor
valve stem (2) approximately 280° from the head of the changer (located at 1) in a clockwise
direction before rotating the wheel (also in a clockwise direction) to mount the tire. Use this
procedure on both the outer and inner tire beads.
b.
Rotating Tool Tire Changers - Position the wheel on the changer so that the sensor valve stem (1)
is located approximately 210° clockwise from the installation end of the mounting/dismounting tool
(2) once the tool is mounted for tire installation. Make sure the sensor is clear of the lower bead
breaker area (3) to avoid damaging the sensor when the breaker rises. Rotate the tool (2) in a
counterclockwise direction to mount the tire. Use this procedure on both the upper and lower tire
beads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1299
6. Adjust air pressure to that listed on Tire Inflation Pressure Label (Placard) provided with vehicle
(applied to driver's side B-pillar). Make sure
original style and color valve stem cap is securely installed to keep moisture out of sensor.
7. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) on vehicle See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and
Wheels - Installation. Tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower vehicle. 9. Perform one of the following to make the system learn the new sensor ID.
a. Use the TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool to program the WIN with the
tire pressure sensor ID. This is part of the
TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
b. Once the vehicle has remained stationary for more than 20 minutes, drive vehicle for a minimum
of 10 minutes while maintaining a continuous
speed above 15 mph (24 km/h). During this time, the system will learn the new sensor ID. This is
part of the TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
NOTE: If a sensor cannot be trained, refer to appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve
Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal > Page 1306
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1310
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Range Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal
2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1313
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1314
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1315
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1316
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Range Sensor - Removal > Page 1317
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page
1322
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page
1323
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE)
(Transmission) 2 Way
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE)
(Transmission) 2 Way > Page 1326
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Output Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE)
(Transmission) 2 Way > Page 1327
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Transfer Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-TRANSFER SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed
Sensor - Description
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed
Sensor - Description > Page 1330
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed
Sensor - Description > Page 1331
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed
Sensor - Description > Page 1332
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed
Sensor - Description > Page 1333
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed
Sensor - Description > Page 1334
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed
Sensor - Description > Page 1335
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed
Sensor - Description > Page 1336
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (3) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC
signals as rotation occurs.
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it
to the transaxle case.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed
Sensor - Description > Page 1337
The transfer shaft speed sensor (3) is located at the rear of the case (backside). It reads rotation of
the front annulus/rear carrier assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1340
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1341
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1342
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1343
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1344
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1345
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1346
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1347
Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1348
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1349
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the transfer shaft sensor (3).
2. Remove the bolt at transfer shaft sensor (1). 3. Pull up on transfer shaft sensor to remove.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor Removal > Page 1350
1. Install a new O-ring (2). on the transfer shaft speed sensor (1).
2. Install transfer shaft speed sensor (3) into case.
3. Install bolt at transfer shaft speed sensor (1) and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect
the electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rear Defogger Switch - Description
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation Rear Defogger Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: Manual tri-zone temperature A/C-heater control shown. Other A/C-heater controls similar.
The momentary push-button switch (1) for the rear window defogger (EBL) system is located in the
A/C-heater control (2) in the center of the instrument panel. An amber indicator (3) will illuminate to
indicate when the EBL system is turned on.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rear Defogger Switch - Description > Page 1356
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation Rear Defogger Switch - Operation
OPERATION
An amber indicator will illuminate when the rear window defogger switch is activated. When
activated, the switch sends a request signal to the totally integrated power module (TIPM) to
energize the internal EBL high side driver to provide battery current to the rear window defogger
grid lines and to the heated side view mirrors, when equipped.
NOTE: The EBL system turns off automatically after 10 minutes of initial operation. Each following
activation cycle of the EBL system will
last 5 minutes.
The EBL system will automatically turn off after an initial programmed time interval of about 10
minutes as long as the ignition switch is in RUN. After the initial time interval has expired, if the rear
window defogger switch is pressed to ON again during the same ignition cycle, the EBL system will
automatically turn off after about 5 minutes. The EBL system will also turn off if the ignition switch is
turned to any position other than RUN or by manually pressing the rear window defogger switch a
second time.
The rear window defogger switch is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear window defogger switch and indicator cannot be adjusted or repaired. The A/C-heater
control must be replaced if the rear window defogger switch or indicator is inoperative or damaged
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Control Assembly/Service and Repair/A/C and Heater Control Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch > Page 1361
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch > Page 1362
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch > Page 1363
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 1366
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Right Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 1367
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Connector C1 - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 1368
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C2 (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 1369
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Right Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 1370
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Connector C1 - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C2 (Front Door) 10 Way
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 1371
Connector C2 - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Except Base) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 1372
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Base) (Front Door) 8 Way
Connector (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 1373
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1374
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
For switch testing, remove the switch. See: Service and Repair/Power Window Switch - Removal.
Using an ohmmeter, refer to Window Switch Continuity Charts to determine if continuity is correct.
If the results are not obtained, replace the switch.
The master window switch has an Auto-Down feature. Actuation of the master switch to the second
down position will move the drivers side window completely down. The electronic switch will
automatically disconnect the motor approximately 1 second after the window bottoms out. Failure
of the electronic switch to detect stall current, will cause the switch to disconnect after
approximately 13 seconds. The auto down function can be canceled by any movement of that
switch.
MASTER WINDOW SWITCH TEST
PASSENGER WINDOW SWITCH TEST
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Window Switch - Removal
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Power Window Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
SWITCH - FRONT DOOR
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative remote cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent,
carefully pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
switch wire connector. 4. Remove switch assembly.
SWITCH - REAR DOOR
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent, carefully
pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect the
electrical connector. 4. Remove the switch from the handle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Window Switch - Removal > Page 1377
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Power Window Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
SWITCH - FRONT DOOR
1. Install the switch by snapping into place. 2. Connect switch wire connector. 3. Install the switch
to the door trim panel. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
SWITCH - REAR DOOR
1. Connect the electrical connector. 2. Install the switch to the door trim panel. 3. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1382
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WASHER FLUID LEVEL-FRONT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Description
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Description and Operation Washer Fluid Level Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The washer fluid level switch (3) is a two-pin conductivity sensor with no moving parts mounted on
the rearward facing side of the washer reservoir on the upper left corner of the cooling module on
the Front End Module (FEM). Only the molded plastic switch mounting flange and the integral
connector receptacle (4) are visible when the switch is installed in the reservoir.
A short nipple formation (1) extends from the inner surface of the switch mounting flange, and a
barb on the nipple is pressed through a rubber grommet seal installed in the mounting hole of the
reservoir. Two over-molded pins or electrodes (2) extend from the back of the nipple formation. The
switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of
the FEM wire harness.
The washer fluid level switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged, the switch
must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Description > Page 1385
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Description and Operation Washer Fluid Level Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The washer fluid level switch uses fluid conductivity to monitor the level of the washer fluid in the
washer reservoir. Electricity is conducted between the two switch pins or electrodes only when they
are immersed in the washer fluid, which closes the switch circuit. When the fluid level in the washer
reservoir falls below the pins, electrical current cannot be conducted and the switch becomes an
open circuit, which signals a low fluid condition.
In order to prevent an electrical charge from accumulating in the electrical leads of the switch, the
switch receives current that is pulsed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) located in
the engine compartment near the battery. The TIPM monitors the switch return signal and is
programmed to respond to three consecutive open switch readings by sending an electronic
washer fluid indicator lamp-ON request message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the Controller Area Network (CAN)
data bus. The EMIC responds to this message by illuminating the washer fluid indicator and by
sounding an audible chime tone warning.
The washer fluid level switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take
out and connector of the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness. The switch is connected in series
between a sensor return circuit and the washer fluid switch sense input to the TIPM.
The washer fluid level switch and the hard wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the washer fluid level indicator or the electronic controls or communication between other modules
and devices that provide some features of the washer system. The most reliable, efficient, and
accurate means to diagnose the washer fluid level indicator or the electronic controls and
communication related to washer fluid level switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan
tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Removal
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair Washer Fluid Level Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the washer reservoir from the
back of the cooling module on the Front End Module (FEM). See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Windshield
Washer Reservoir/Service and Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir - Removal.
3. Disconnect the FEM wire harness connector from the washer fluid level switch connector
receptacle (3) on the back of the reservoir. 4. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed
tool, gently pry the barbed nipple of the washer fluid level switch out of the rubber grommet
seal in the washer reservoir. Care must be taken not to damage the reservoir.
5. Remove the switch from the washer reservoir. 6. Remove the rubber grommet seal from the
switch mounting hole in the washer reservoir and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Removal > Page 1388
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair Washer Fluid Level Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new rubber grommet seal into the washer fluid level switch mounting hole of the washer
reservoir. Always use a new rubber grommet seal
on the reservoir.
2. Insert the nipple formation of the switch through the rubber grommet seal in the reservoir. 3.
Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly on the switch mounting flange until the barbed nipple
is fully seated in the rubber grommet seal in
the reservoir. The flat edge of the switch mounting flange should be oriented upward.
4. Reconnect the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness connector (3) to the switch connector
receptacle. 5. Reinstall the washer reservoir onto the back of the cooling module on the FEM. See:
Wiper and Washer Systems/Windshield Washer
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Windshield Washer Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-RIGHT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams
Wiper Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-RIGHT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Right Multifunction Switch - Description
Wiper Switch: Description and Operation Right Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The right (wiper) multi-function switch is located on the right side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the front and rear wiper and washer
systems. The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (1), control knob (2) and
control sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the right side of the column.
The remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions and electrical connection are
concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing and controls (6) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3). A single connector receptacle containing seven
terminal pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and is connected by a jumper wire
harness (5) directly to the Steering Control Module (SCM), which is internal to the housing (2) of
the left multi-function switch (1).
The right (wiper) multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following wiper and washer system functions:
- Continuous Front Wipers - The right multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching
for two continuous front wipe modes, low speed or high speed.
- Intermittent Front Wipers - The right multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching
for the intermittent front wipe mode with five minor detent delay interval positions.
- Front Wiper Mist Mode - The right multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary
switching of the front wiper motor low speed circuit to provide a mist mode features (sometimes
referred to as pulse wipe), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily operate the front
wipers for one or more complete cycles.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Right Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 1397
- Front Washer Mode - The right multi-function switch control stalk provides momentary switching
for control of the front washer system operation.
- Intermittent Rear Wipe Mode - The right multi-function switch control sleeve provides detent
switching for a single fixed interval intermittent rear wiper mode.
- Rear Washer Mode - The right multi-function switch control sleeve provides one momentary
switch positions for control of rear washer system operation.
The right multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Right Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 1398
Wiper Switch: Description and Operation Right Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The right (wiper) multi-function switch uses a combination of resistor multiplexing and conventional
analog switching to control the many functions and features it provides. The switch receives a
clean ground from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed and
conventional analog return outputs to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM
then sends electronic switch status messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN),
and the EMIC relays electronic wiper and washer switch request messages over the Controller
Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the right multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal
Not Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the front and rear
wiper systems. The failsafe mode will maintain the last selected front and rear wiper system
operation for the remainder of the current ignition cycle, after which both wiper systems will default
to OFF.
The right multi-function switch as well as the hard-wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Following are descriptions of how the right multi-function switch is operated to control the many
front and rear wiper and washer system functions and features it provides:
- Front Wiper Control - The control knob on the end of the right multi-function switch control stalk is
rotated to one of the two continuous wiper detents, to one of five intermittent wiper detents, or to
the OFF position to select the front wiper mode. The SCM reads the input from the right
multi-function switch and sends electronic wiper switch status messages over the LIN data bus to
the EMIC, which relays an electronic wiper switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Wiper Mist Mode - The front wiper mist mode is requested when the right multi-function
switch control stalk is depressed downward towards the floor to a momentary MIST position. The
front wiper motor will continue to operate, one complete cycle at a time, for as long as the control
stalk is held in this position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the right
multi-function switch and sends an electronic wiper switch status message over the LIN data bus to
the EMIC, which relays an electronic wiper switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Washer Control - The right multi-function switch control stalk is pulled rearward towards the
steering wheel to a momentary WASH position to activate the washer pump/motor in the front
washer mode. The washer pump/motor will continue to operate for as long as the control stalk is
held in this position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the right multi-function
switch and sends an electronic washer switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic washer switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Wiper Control - The rear wiper mode is selected when the right multi-function switch control
sleeve is rotated to the fixed interval intermittent rear wipe detent position, or the OFF detent
position. The SCM reads the input from the right multi-function switch and sends an electronic
wiper switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic wiper
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Washer Control - The right multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to one of two
momentary WASH positions, either fully forward or fully rearward, to activate the washer
pump/motor in the rear washer mode. The washer pump/motor will continue to operate in the rear
washer mode until the control sleeve is released. The SCM reads the input from the right
multi-function switch and sends an electronic washer switch status message over the LIN data bus
to the EMIC, which relays an electronic washer switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1399
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
RIGHT MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
The right multi-function switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
Steering Control Module (SCM) or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide some features of the front and rear wiper and washer systems.
The most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose the SCM or the electronic controls and
communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
1. Remove the right multi-function switch from the integral mounting bracket on the right side of the
clockspring. See: Service and Repair/Right
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
2. Using an ohmmeter, test the resistance between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
three Function Tests tables. For all functions except
those of the control stalk the values should be either less than 100 ohms (switch CLOSED) or
greater than 1 megohm (switch OPEN).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1400
3. If the switch fails any of the tests, replace the ineffective right multi-function switch as required. If
the switch tests okay, but the switch input to the
Steering Control Module (SCM) remains incorrect, be certain to check for a short or open in the
jumper harness between the right multi-function switch and the SCM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Right Multifunction Switch - Removal
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair Right Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid personal or fatal injury, on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting
any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel
component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or
service. This is the only sure way to disable the supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the
proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Remove the screw (2) that secures the right multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket
integral to the right side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
4. Slide the switch away from the clockspring far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the switch
housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
5. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (1) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the right multi-function switch (2). 6. Remove the switch from the clockspring (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Right Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 1403
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair Right Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the right multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (3) integral to
the right side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (1) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the back of the right
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket on the
clockspring (3). Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Curb Height Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Curb Height Specifications
CURB HEIGHT SPECIFICATIONS
NOTE: On some vehicles it may be necessary to remove an engine belly pan in order to gain
access to the lower control arm pivot bolt.
Front - On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance (2) from the flat surface behind the PLP
hole (1) to the floor or alignment rack/lift runway surface. It may be necessary to measure to the
bottom of a straight edge (3), placed from lift runway to runway, to get an accurate measurement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Curb Height Specifications
> Page 1409
Rear - On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance (2) from the flat surface below the rear
toe adjustment cam bolt (1) to the floor or alignment rack/lift runway surface. It may be necessary
to measure to the bottom of a straight edge (3), placed from lift runway to runway, to get an
accurate measurement.
Compare the measurements to specifications listed in the CURB HEIGHT SPECIFICATIONS
chart. Maximum left-to-right differential is not to exceed 12.5 mm (0.5 in.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1410
Alignment: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Vehicle wheel alignment is the positioning of all interrelated front and rear suspension angles.
These angles affect the handling and steering of the vehicle when it is in motion. Proper wheel
alignment is essential for efficient steering, good directional stability, and proper tire wear.
The method of checking a vehicle's front and rear wheel alignment varies depending on the
manufacturer and type of equipment used. The manufacturer's instructions should always be
followed to ensure accuracy of the alignment, except when Chrysler Corporation's wheel alignment
specifications differ.
On this vehicle, the suspension angles that can be adjusted are as follows:
Front
- Camber (with cradle shift or service adjustment bolt package)
- Caster (limited adjustment with cradle shift)
- Toe
Rear
- Toe
Check the wheel alignment and make all wheel alignment adjustments with the vehicle standing at
its proper curb height specification. Curb height is the normal riding height of the vehicle. It is
measured from a certain point on the vehicle to the ground or a designated area while the vehicle
is sitting on a flat, level surface. Refer to Curb Height Measurement for additional information. See:
Service and Repair/Curb Height Measurement
Typical wheel alignment angles and measurements are described in the following paragraphs.
CAMBER
Camber is the inward or outward tilt of the top of the tire and wheel assembly. Inward tilt (2) is
known as negative camber. Outward tilt (1) is known as
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1411
positive camber. Camber is measured in degrees of angle relative to a true vertical line. Camber is
a tire wearing angle.
- Excessive negative camber will cause tread wear at the inside of the tire.
- Excessive positive camber will cause tread wear on the outside of the tire.
CROSS CAMBER
Cross camber is the difference between left and right camber. To achieve the cross camber
reading, subtract the right side camber reading from the left. For example, if the left camber is -0.7°
and the right camber is -0.5°, the cross camber would be -0.2° (-0.7 - (-0.5) = -0.7 + 0.5 = -0.2).
CASTER
Caster is the forward or rearward tilt of the steering knuckle in reference to the position of the upper
and lower ball joints. Caster is measured in degrees of angle relative to a true vertical center line.
This line is viewed from the side of the tire and wheel assembly.
- Forward tilt (upper ball joint ahead of lower) results in a negative caster angle.
- Rearward tilt (upper ball joint trailing lower) results in a positive caster angle.
Although caster does not affect tire wear, a caster imbalance between the two front wheels may
cause the vehicle to lead to the side with the least positive caster.
CROSS CASTER
Cross caster is the difference between left and right caster. To achieve the cross caster reading,
subtract the right side caster reading from the left. For example, if the left caster is 2.5° and the
right caster is 2.7°, the cross caster would be -0.2° (2.5 - 2.7 = -0.2).
TOE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1412
Toe is the inward or outward angle of the wheels as viewed from above the vehicle.
- Toe-in (1) is produced when the front edges of the wheels on the same axle are closer together
than the rear edges.
- Toe-out (2) is produced when the front edges of the wheels on the same axle are farther apart
than the rear edges.
Toe-in and toe-out can occur at the front wheels and the rear wheels.
Toe is measured in degrees or inches. The measurement identifies the amount that the front of the
wheels point inward (toe-in) or outward (toe-out). Toe is measured at the spindle height. Zero toe
means the front and rear edges of the wheels on the same axle are equal distant.
TOE-OUT ON TURNS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1413
Toe-out on turns (1), sometimes referred to as Ackerman Steering, is the relative positioning of the
front wheels while steering through a turn. This compensates for each front wheel's turning radius.
As the vehicle encounters a turn, the outboard wheel must travel in a larger radius circle than the
inboard wheel. The steering system is designed to make each wheel follow its particular radius
circle. To accomplish this, the front wheels must progressively toe outward as the steering is turned
from center. This eliminates tire scrubbing and undue tire wear when steering a vehicle through a
turn.
DYNAMIC TOE PATTERN
Dynamic toe pattern is the inward and outward toe movement of the front and rear tires through the
suspension's jounce and rebound travel. As the vehicle's suspension moves up and down, the toe
pattern varies. Toe pattern is critical in controlling the directional stability of the vehicle while in
motion. Front and rear dynamic toe pattern is preset by the factory at the time the vehicle is
assembled.
It is not necessary to check or adjust front or rear dynamic toe pattern when doing a normal wheel
alignment. The only time dynamic toe pattern needs to be checked or adjusted is if the frame of the
vehicle has been damaged.
STEERING AXIS INCLINATION (S.A.I.)
Steering axis inclination (1) is the angle between a true vertical line starting at the center of the tire
at the road contact point and a line drawn through the center of the upper ball joint (or strut) and
the lower ball joint. S.A.I. is built into the vehicle and is not an adjustable angle. If S.A.I. is not
within specifications, a bent or damaged suspension component may be the cause.
INCLUDED ANGLE (I.A.)
Included angle (3) is the sum of the S.A.I. angle (1) plus or minus the camber angle (2), depending
on whether or not the wheel has positive or negative camber. If camber is positive, add the camber
angle to the S.A.I angle. If camber is negative, subtract the camber angle from the S.A.I. angle.
Included angle is not adjustable, but can be used to diagnose a frame misalignment or bent
suspension component (spindle, strut).
THRUST ANGLE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1414
Thrust angle is the averaged direction the rear wheels are pointing in relation to the vehicle's center
line. The presence of negative or positive thrust angle causes the rear tires to track improperly to
the left or right of the front tires (dog tracking).
- Negative thrust angle means the rear tires are tracking to the left of the front tires.
- Positive thrust angle means the rear tires are tracking to the right of the front tires.
Improper tracking can cause undue tire wear, a lead or pull and a crooked steering wheel.
Excessive thrust angle can usually be corrected by adjusting the rear wheel toe so that each wheel
has one-half of the total toe measurement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment
Alignment: Service and Repair Wheel Alignment
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
PRE-WHEEL ALIGNMENT INSPECTION
Before any attempt is made to change or correct the wheel alignment, the following inspection and
necessary corrections must be made to the vehicle to ensure proper alignment.
1. Verify the fuel tank is full of fuel. If the fuel tank is not full, the reduction in weight will affect the
curb height of the vehicle and the alignment
specifications.
2. The passenger and luggage compartments of the vehicle should be free of any load that is not
factory equipment. 3. Check the tires on the vehicle. The tires are to be inflated to the
recommended air pressure. All tires must be the same size and in good condition
with approximately the same tread wear.
4. Check the front tire and wheel assemblies for excessive radial runout. 5. Inspect all suspension
component fasteners for looseness and proper torque. 6. Inspect the lower front ball joints and all
steering linkage for looseness and any sign of wear or damage. 7. Inspect the rubber bushings on
all the suspension components for signs of wear or deterioration. If any bushings show signs of
wear or
deterioration, they should be replaced prior to aligning the vehicle.
8. Check vehicle curb height to verify it is within specifications. See:
WHEEL ALIGNMENT SETUP
1. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack. 2. Install all required alignment equipment on the
vehicle, per the alignment equipment manufacturer's instructions. On this vehicle, a four-wheel
alignment is recommended.
NOTE: Prior to reading the vehicle's alignment readouts, the front and rear of vehicle should be
jounced. Induce jounce (rear first, then
front) by grasping the center of the bumper and jouncing each end of vehicle an equal number of
times. The bumper should always be released when vehicle is at the bottom of the jounce cycle.
3. Read the vehicle's current front and rear alignment settings. Compare the vehicle's current
alignment settings to the vehicle specifications for
camber, caster and toe-in. See: Specifications/Wheel Alignment Specifications
REAR CAMBER
Rear camber settings on this vehicle are determined at the time the vehicle is designed, by the
location of the vehicle's suspension components. This is referred to as Net Build. The result is no
required adjustment of camber after the vehicle is built or when servicing the suspension
components. Thus, when performing a wheel alignment, rear camber is not considered an
adjustable angle.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to adjust the vehicle's wheel alignment by heating or bending any of the
suspension components.
FRONT CAMBER AND CASTER
Front camber and caster settings on this vehicle are determined at the time the vehicle is designed,
by the location of the vehicle's suspension components. This is referred to as Net Build. The result
is no required adjustment of camber and caster after the vehicle is built or when servicing the
suspension components. Thus, when performing a wheel alignment, caster and camber are not
normally considered adjustable angles but some adjustment can be made. Camber and caster
should be checked to ensure they meet vehicle specifications. See: Specifications/Wheel
Alignment Specifications
If individual front camber or caster is found not to meet alignment specifications, each can be
adjusted by shifting the front crossmember or by using an available service adjustment bolt
package. If an adjustment bolt package installation is necessary, inspect the suspension
components for any signs of damage or bending first.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to adjust the vehicle's wheel alignment by heating or bending any of the
suspension components.
ADJUSTMENT BY SHIFTING CROSSMEMBER
CAUTION: Always use care when shifting crossmember to avoid damaging other components on
the vehicle.
1. Loosen the four bolts fastening the front crossmember to the frame just enough to allow
movement of the crossmember. See: Body and
Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service and Repair/Crossmember - Removal
2. Loosen the bolts fastening the fore/aft crossmember to the frame just enough to allow movement
of the crossmember. See: Body and
Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service and Repair/Crossmember - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1417
CAUTION: When shifting the front crossmember, keep in mind that the front and rear engine
mounts are attached to the front crossmember
and fore/aft crossmember and should be inspected following the crossmember shift to make sure
they are properly aligned.
3. Shift front crossmember as necessary (See following tables) to bring camber or caster into
specifications. When shifting crossmember, use care not
to move other angles (camber or caster) that are within specifications, out of specifications.
4. Tighten all previously loosened fasteners (bolts) securing the crossmember to the vehicle to
specifications. See: Body and
Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service and Repair/Crossmember - Installation
5. Jounce the rear, then front of the vehicle an equal amount of times. 6. Measure camber and
caster. If camber and caster are within specifications, proceed to TOE. If camber cannot be brought
into specifications,
perform the CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT PACKAGE INSTALLATION below.
CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT PACKAGE INSTALLATION
1. Raise the vehicle until its tires are not supporting the weight of the vehicle. See:
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the front tire and wheel assembly (1).
CAUTION: The strut clevis-to-knuckle attaching bolt shanks are serrated and must not be turned
during removal. Remove the nuts while
holding the bolts stationary, then tap the bolts out using a punch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1418
3. Remove the original nuts (3, 4) and upper (1) and lower (6) bolts attaching the strut clevis
bracket (2) to the knuckle (5). 4. Separate the knuckle (5) from the strut clevis bracket (2) and
position knuckle so it is out of the way of the strut. Use care not to overextend the
brake flex hose or axle half shaft.
CAUTION: When slotting the bottom mounting hole (3) on the strut clevis bracket (4), do not
enlarge the hole beyond the indentations (2) on
the sides of the strut clevis bracket.
5. Using an appropriate grinder and grinding wheel, slot the bottom hole (3) in both sides of the
strut clevis bracket (4).
CAUTION: After slotting the strut clevis bracket hole, do not install the original attaching bolts. Only
the service package bolts and dog bone
washers must be used to attach the knuckle to the strut once the mounting hole is slotted.
6. Position the strut clevis bracket in line with the upper end of the knuckle, aligning the mounting
holes. Install the two service package bolts. Be
sure to place the bolt with the eccentric cam in the bottom (slotted) hole on strut clevis bracket.
7. Install the dog bone washers provided in the service package and nuts on the replacement bolts.
Tighten each nut just enough to hold the knuckle
in position while adjusting camber, but still allows the knuckle to move in the clevis bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1419
8. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
9. Perform the above procedure to opposite side strut as required.
10. Lower the vehicle and jounce the front and rear of the vehicle. 11. Adjust the front camber to
the preferred setting using the cam bolt in the lower mounting hole. Once camber is set to
specifications, tighten the
upper and lower strut service package bolt nuts to 140 Nm (103 ft. lbs.). Again jounce the front and
rear of the vehicle, then verify the camber settings.
12. Once camber is within specifications, adjust toe to meet the preferred specification setting.
Refer to FRONT TOE within this wheel alignment
service procedure.
TOE
1. Center the steering wheel and lock it in place using a steering wheel clamp.
NOTE: When setting toe, make sure to set rear toe to the preferred specifications before setting
front toe to the preferred specifications
REAR TOE
NOTE: Perform the following at each rear wheel as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1420
1. While holding the cam bolt head (4) stationary, loosen the toe link mounting cam bolt nut (3). 2.
Rotate the cam bolt head (4) left or right until the rear wheel toe for that rear wheel is set to the
preferred specification. See: Specifications/Wheel
Alignment Specifications
3. While holding the cam bolt head (4) stationary, tighten the toe link mounting cam bolt nut (3) to
100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
FRONT TOE
NOTE: Perform the following at each front wheel as necessary.
CAUTION: Do not twist the inner tie rod-to-steering gear boot (bellows) while turning the inner tie
rod during front toe adjustment. It may be
necessary to remove the clamp where the boot meets the inner tie rod.
1. Loosen the tie rod adjusting jam nut (1). Grasp the inner tie rod (3) and rotate it one way or the
other until the front wheel toe is set to the preferred
specification. See: Specifications/Wheel Alignment Specifications
2. Tighten the tie rod adjusting jam nut to of 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.). 3. Make sure the inner tie
rod-to-steering gear boot is not twisted. If removed, reinstall the clamp where the boot meets the
inner tie rod.
4. Remove the steering wheel clamp. 5. Remove the alignment equipment. 6. Road test the vehicle
to verify the steering wheel is straight and the vehicle does not pull or wander.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1421
Alignment: Service and Repair Curb Height Measurement
CURB HEIGHT MEASUREMENT
The wheel alignment is to be checked and all alignment adjustments made with the vehicle at its
required curb height specification.
Vehicle height is to be checked with the vehicle on a flat, level surface, preferably a vehicle
alignment rack. The tires are to be inflated to the recommended pressure. All tires are to be the
same size as standard equipment. Vehicle height is checked with the fuel tank full of fuel, and no
passenger or luggage compartment load.
Vehicle height is not adjustable. If the measurement is not within specifications, inspect the vehicle
for bent or weak suspension components. Compare the parts tag on the suspect coil spring(s) to
the parts book and the vehicle sales code, checking for a match. Once removed from the vehicle,
compare the coil spring height to a correct new or known good coil spring. The heights should vary
if the suspect spring is weak.
NOTE: Prior to reading the curb height measurement, the front and rear of the vehicle must be
jounced to settle the suspension. Induce jounce by pushing down on the center of the bumper
(fascia), using care not to damage the vehicle, moving the vehicle up and down, gradually
increasing the suspension travel with each stroke. Release the bumper at the bottom of each
stroke, repeating this action several times. Perform this to both front and rear suspensions an equal
amount of times.
Measure curb height as follows:
1. Jounce the vehicle. Refer to above note.
NOTE: On some vehicles it may be necessary to remove an engine belly pan in order to gain
access to the lower control arm pivot bolt.
2. Front - On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance 2 from the flat surface behind the PLP
hole 1 to the floor or alignment rack/lift
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1422
runway surface. It may be necessary to measure to the bottom of a straight edge 3, placed from lift
runway to runway, to get an accurate measurement.
3. Rear - On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance 2 from the flat surface below the rear
toe adjustment cam bolt 1 to the floor or
alignment rack/lift runway surface. It may be necessary to measure to the bottom of a straight edge
3, placed from lift runway to runway, to get an accurate measurement.
4. Compare the measurements to specifications listed in the following CURB HEIGHT
SPECIFICATIONS chart. Maximum left-to-right
differential is not to exceed 12.5 mm (0.5 in.).
5. If curb height is found to be out of specification and there is no sign of excessive body damage,
curb height can be changed by replacing the
applicable spring with a spring offering a different check load.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
Fuel Flow
Leakdown
Less than 10 psi in 5 minutes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Checking the Fuel Delivery System
CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. FUEL PUMP OPERATION
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With a scan tool, actuate the Fuel System test.
NOTE: It may be necessary to use a mechanics stethoscope in the next step.
3. Listen for fuel pump operation at the fuel tank. The fuel pump should operate smoothly with no
excessive noise. If the pump has excessive noise
such as grinding, the pump should be replaced.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Does the Fuel Pump sound to be operate normally?
Yes
- Go to 2
No
- Go to 7
2. FUEL PRESSURE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Install a fuel pressure gauge. 3. Ignition on, engine not running. 4. With the scan tool, actuate the
Fuel Pump and observe the fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Choose a conclusion that best matches your fuel pressure reading.
Below Specification
- Go to 3
Within Specification
- Test Complete.
Above Specification
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 1429
Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
3. RESTRICTED FUEL SUPPLY LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure even with the engine off. Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released.
2. Raise vehicle on hoist, and disconnect the fuel pressure line at the fuel pump module. 3. Install
special tool #6539 (5/16") or #6631(3/8") fuel line adapter and the fuel pressure gauge between the
fuel supply line and the fuel pump
module.
4. Ignition on, engine not running. 5. With the scan tool, actuate the Fuel Pump and observe the
fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Is the fuel pressure within specification now?
Yes
- Repair/replace fuel supply line as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. SADDLE FUEL TANK
Is the vehicle equipped with a saddle type fuel tank?
Yes
- Go to 5
No
- Go to 6
5. CHECKING FUEL TANK SIPHON HOSE AND FUEL LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Gain access to the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. 3. Inspect the following fuel
components: Fuel line and siphon hose between the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. Look for
disconnected and/or damaged lines or hoses.
- Fuel Pressure Regulator not properly seated in the module.
Were the above items in good working condition?
Yes
- Go to 6
No
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP INLET
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 1430
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Remove the Fuel Pump Module and Fuel Tank Module (if equipped), inspect the Fuel Inlet and
the bottom of the fuel tank for debris that could
cause the fuel pump inlet to be plugged.
Is the Fuel Pump Inlet plugged?
Yes
- Repair/Replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. FUEL PUMP MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Disconnect the Fuel Pump Module harness connector. 3. Using a 12-volt
test light to battery voltage, probe the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit in the Fuel Pump Module
harness connector.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Does the test light illuminate brightly.
Yes
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Repair the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 1431
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pressure Leak Down
FUEL PRESSURE LEAK DOWN
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious
or fatal injury when performing this test
procedure. Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
- Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eye wear
and clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair / replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM GAS AND DIESEL FUEL
PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 1432
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Fuel Inlet Hose 8978A-1 (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the Fuel
Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect the Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to the
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir
Assembly 534960 (4) on the floor and out of
the way so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system: Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 1433
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
2. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait 1 minute before
proceeding. 3. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4
fuel pressure specification is 552 KPa ± 34 KPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the Checking The Fuel Delivery System diagnostic procedure as directed. See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component
Tests and General Diagnostics/Checking the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAK DOWN
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Close the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1) and then wait five minutes before proceeding. 2. Read
the Fuel Inlet (2) and Fuel Outlet (3) Pressure Gauges. The pressure should not drop more than 10
psi on either gauge.
Does the fuel pressure drop more than 10 psi?
Yes - On Fuel Inlet Gauge (1)
- Replace the fuel pump module.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test.
Yes - On Fuel Outlet Gauge (2)
- Replace the leaking fuel injector(s).
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test.
No
- If directed here by another test, return to that test. Otherwise, test complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 1434
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Delivery System Output - Flow Test
FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT - FLOW TEST
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal
injury when performing this test procedure.
- Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
- Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eyewear and
clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM THE GAS AND DIESEL
FUEL PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from the Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 1435
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly 8978A-1 Fuel Inlet Hose (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect special tool Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the
Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir Assembly
534960 (4) on the floor and out of the way
so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system:
- Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 1436
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
1. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait one minute before
proceeding. 2. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 kPa ± 34 kPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4 fuel
pressure specification is 552 kPa ± 34 kPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics/Checking the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump. 3. Open the Flow
Test Valve (1) for 20 seconds, then close the Valve.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
4. Turn the ignition off. 5. Measure the amount of fuel in the Reservoir Assembly (2). The fuel
output specification is ml/s X 20 seconds = fuel flow in ml.
Does the amount of fuel in the reservoir meet or exceed the specification?
Yes
- Test complete.
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics/Checking the Fuel Delivery System
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disengage the air filter housing clips (1). 2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) forward slightly to
disengage tabs from the bottom of the air filter housing.
3. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal > Page 1442
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install air filter element into the bottom half of the air filter housing.
2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) rearward to engage the tabs into the bottom half of the air
filter housing. 3. Reengage the air filter housing clips (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
1. Remove fuel fill cap. 2. Remove fuel pump fuse from Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
For location of fuse, refer to label on underside of TIPM cover. 3. Start and run engine until it stalls.
4. Attempt restarting engine until it will no longer run. 5. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 6. Place
a rag or towel below fuel line quick-connect fitting at fuel rail. 7. Disconnect quick-connect fitting at
fuel rail See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Line Coupler/Service
and Repair. 8. When the repair is complete, reconnect fuel fittings and return fuel pump fuse to
TIPM. 9. One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) may have been stored in PCM memory
due to fuel pump fuse removal. A diagnostic scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
FIRING ORDER
2.4L
The firing order is 1-3-4-2.
3.5L
The firing order is 1-2-3-4-5-6.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head cover(s). See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Cylinder Head
Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder
Head Cover(s) - Removal
2. Using suitable locking pliers, remove the tube (1) from the cylinder head and discard tube. 3.
Clean area around spark plug with Mopar(R) Parts Cleaner or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1455
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Stud and Bearing Mount to a new tube (1) approximately 1 mm (0.039 in.) from
the end of tube, in a 3 mm (0.118 in.) wide area. 2. Install sealer end of tube (1) into the cylinder
head. Then carefully install the tube (1) using a hardwood block and mallet. Install the tube (1) until
it is seated into the bottom of the bore.
3. For spark plug tube (1) seal replacement, See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal.
4. Install cylinder head cover(s). See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Cylinder Head
Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder Head
Cover(s) - Installation - INSTALLATION)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
COMPRESSION CHECK
Compression Ratio ..............................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 10:1
Compression should not be less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from
cylinder to cylinder
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1459
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE TEST
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions.
Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good operating
condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis purposes.
1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine reaches normal
operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators such as fouled, hot, oily,
etc. Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Remove the Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay from the TIPM. 5. Install a suitable compression test
gauge into the number 1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. 6. Crank engine until maximum pressure
is reached on gauge. Record this pressure as #1 cylinder pressure. 7. Repeat the previous step for
all remaining cylinders. 8. Compression should not be less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary
more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder. 9. If one or more cylinders have abnormally low
compression pressures, repeat the compression test.
10. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second compression
test, it could indicate the existence of a problem in
the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide
to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the cause of
low compression unless some malfunction is present.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Timing Belt: Procedures
TIMING BELT
1. Remove front timing belt cover See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Timing
Components/Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine Timing
Cover(s) - Removal.
2. Inspect both sides of the timing belt. Replace belt if any of the following conditions exist:
a. Hardening of back rubber back side is glossy without resilience and leaves no indent when
pressed with fingernail. b. Cracks on rubber back. c. Cracks or peeling of canvas. d. Cracks on rib
root. e. Cracks on belt sides. f.
Missing teeth.
g. Abnormal wear of belt sides. The sides are normal if they are sharp as if cut by a knife. h.
Vehicle mileage or time at component maintenance requirement. See:
3. If none of the above conditions are seen on the belt, the front timing belt cover can be installed
See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Timing
Components/Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine Timing Cover(s) - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 1464
Timing Belt: Removal and Replacement
Timing Belt & Sprockets - Removal
TIMING BELT
1. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. See: Filters/Fuel Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service
and Repair. 2. Disconnect negative battery cable. 3. Remove both cylinder head covers. 4.
Remove the front timing belt cover See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Timing
Components/Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine
Timing Cover(s) - Removal.
5. Mark belt running direction, if timing belt is to be reused.
CAUTION: When aligning timing marks, always rotate engine by turning the crankshaft. Failure to
do so will result in valve and/or piston
damage.
6. Rotate engine clockwise until crankshaft mark aligns with the TDC mark on oil pump housing
and the camshaft sprocket timing marks are aligned
with the marks on the rear cover.
7. Remove the timing belt tensioner and remove timing belt.
8. Inspect the tensioner for fluid leakage. 9. Inspect the pivot and bolt for free movement, bearing
grease leakage, and smooth rotation. If not rotating freely, replace the arm and pulley
assembly.
10. When tensioner is removed from the engine it is necessary to compress the plunger into the
tensioner body.
CAUTION: Index the tensioner in the vise the same way it is installed on the engine. This ensures
proper pin orientation when tensioner is installed on the engine.
a. Place the tensioner into a vise and SLOWLY compress the plunger. Total bleed down of
tensioner should take about 5 minutes. b. When plunger is compressed into the tensioner body
install a pin through the body and plunger to retain plunger in place until tensioner is
installed.
Timing Belt & Sprockets - Installation
TIMING BELT
CAUTION: The 3.5L is NOT a freewheeling engine. Therefore, the valve train rocker assemblies
must be removed before attempting to rotate
either crankshaft or camshafts independently of each other.
CAUTION: If camshafts have moved from the timing marks, always rotate camshaft towards the
direction nearest to the timing marks (DO
NOT TURN CAMSHAFTS A FULL REVOLUTION OR DAMAGE to valves and/or pistons could
result).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 1465
TIMING GEAR ALIGNMENT
1. Align the crankshaft sprocket (10) with the TDC mark (9) on the oil pump cover. 2. Align the
camshaft sprockets (2, 7) timing reference marks (1, 8) with the marks on the rear cover. 3. Install
the timing belt (4) starting at the crankshaft sprocket (10) going in a counterclockwise direction.
Install the belt around the last sprocket and
maintain tension on the belt as it is positioned around the tensioner pulley (11).
NOTE: It is necessary to compress the plunger into the tensioner body and install a locking pin
prior to reinstalling the tensioner. See Timing
Belt Removal for tensioner compression procedure See: Timing Belt & Sprockets - Removal .
4. Hold the tensioner pulley (11) against the belt and install the reset (pinned) timing belt tensioner
(2) into the housing. Tighten attaching bolts to 28
Nm (250 in. lbs.).
5. When tensioner (12) is in place, pull the retaining pin to allow the tensioner to extend to the
pulley bracket. 6. Rotate the crankshaft sprocket (10) two revolutions and check the timing marks
on the camshafts and crankshaft. The marks should line up within
their respective locations. If the marks do not line up, repeat the procedure.
7. Install the front timing belt cover See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Timing
Components/Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine Timing
Cover(s) - Installation.
8. Connect the negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Component Alignment Marks > Component Information > Locations
Timing Component Alignment Marks: Locations
TIMING BELT
CAUTION: The 3.5L is NOT a freewheeling engine. Therefore, the valve train rocker assemblies
must be removed before attempting to rotate
either crankshaft or camshafts independently of each other.
CAUTION: If camshafts have moved from the timing marks, always rotate camshaft towards the
direction nearest to the timing marks (DO
NOT TURN CAMSHAFTS A FULL REVOLUTION OR DAMAGE to valves and/or pistons could
result).
TIMING GEAR ALIGNMENT
1. Align the crankshaft sprocket (10) with the TDC mark (9) on the oil pump cover. 2. Align the
camshaft sprockets (2, 7) timing reference marks (1, 8) with the marks on the rear cover. 3. Install
the timing belt (4) starting at the crankshaft sprocket (10) going in a counterclockwise direction.
Install the belt around the last sprocket and
maintain tension on the belt as it is positioned around the tensioner pulley (11).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Description and Operation
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT - WORLD ENGINE
The accessory drive belt is a Poly-V type belt. On the 2.4L engine, the accessory drive belt drives
the generator, P/S pump and air conditioning compressor.
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT -3.5L
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1472
On the 3.5L, the accessory drive belt drives the generator, P/S pump, and A/C compressor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1473
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELTS
Satisfactory performance of the belt driven accessories depends on belt condition and proper belt
tension.
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT DIAGNOSIS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Drive Belt: Procedures
Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Inspection
INSPECTION
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required:
- Excessive wear
- Frayed cords
- Severe glazing
Poly-V Belt system may develop minor cracks across the ribbed side (due to reverse bending).
These minor cracks are considered normal and acceptable. Parallel cracks are not.
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V Belts.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 1476
Drive Belt: Removal and Replacement
Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Removal
3.5L ENGINE
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT -3.5L
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove RH wheelhouse splash shield.See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal
3. Rotate accessory drive belt tensioner (3) clockwise to allow enough slack to remove accessory
drive belt (5).
Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Installation
3.5L ENGINE
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT -3.5L
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 1477
1. Position accessory drive belt (5) on all pulleys except generator (6). 2. Rotate accessory drive
belt tensioner (3) clockwise. 3. Position accessory drive belt (5) on generator pulley (6). 4. Slowly
release accessory drive belt tensioner (3). 5. Install RH wheelhouse splash shield. See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield Installation
6. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disengage the air filter housing clips (1). 2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) forward slightly to
disengage tabs from the bottom of the air filter housing.
3. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal > Page 1484
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install air filter element into the bottom half of the air filter housing.
2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) rearward to engage the tabs into the bottom half of the air
filter housing. 3. Reengage the air filter housing clips (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Description and Operation
Cabin Air Filter: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Some models are equipped with a particulate air filter (1) that helps purify the outside air entering
the HVAC housing. The filter is mounted in the passenger compartment, behind the glove box bin.
The filter should be replaced at least once a year or every 24,000 km (15,000 miles) and checked if
heating-A/C system performance seems lower than expected. The particulate air filter is labeled
with an arrow (2) to indicate the direction of air flow through the filter.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Cabin Air Filter: Procedures
WARNING: Do not remove the A/C air filter while the blower is operating or personal injury may
result.
The A/C air filter is located in the fresh air inlet behind the glove box. Perform the following steps to
replace the filter:
1. Open the glove box and remove all contents.
2. Push the retaining tab on each side of the glove box inward while gently pulling the glove box
door outward until both tabs clear the door opening
in the instrument panel.
3. Pivot the glove box downward.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1490
4. Disengage the two retaining tabs that secure the filter cover to the HVAC housing and remove
the cover. 5. Remove the A/C air filter by pulling it straight out of the housing. 6. Install the A/C air
filter with the arrow on the filter pointing toward the floor. When installing the filter cover, make sure
the retaining tabs fully
engage the cover.
CAUTION: The A/C air filter is labeled with an arrow to indicate airflow direction through the filter.
Failure to install the filter properly will result in the need to replace it more often.
7. Reinstall the glove box door. Make sure that the hinges are seated fully as you raise the door.
Otherwise, the door latch will not align properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1491
Cabin Air Filter: Removal and Replacement
Particulate Air Filter - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: Always make sure the A/C-heater system is turned off and that the ignition switch is in
the OFF position prior to servicing the
particulate air filter. Never place fingers or other objects into the filter opening of the HVAC
housing. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Remove the glove box bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Removal.
2. Disengage the two retaining tabs (1) that secure the particulate air filter cover (2) to the
passenger side of the HVAC housing (3) and remove the
cover.
3. Remove the particulate air filter (1) from the HVAC housing (2) by pulling the filter element
straight out of the housing.
Particulate Air Filter - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1492
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The particulate air filter is labeled with an arrow to indicate air flow direction through the
filter. Make sure to properly install the
particulate air filter. Failure to properly install the filter will result in the need to replace the filter
sooner than required by design.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Install the particulate air filter (1) into the filter opening in the HVAC housing (2). Insert the
particulate air filter directly into the housing with the
arrow on the filter pointing to the floor.
2. Position the particulate air filter cover (2) to the HVAC housing (3) and engage the two retaining
tabs (1) that secure the cover to the housing.
Make sure the retaining tabs are fully engaged.
3. Install the glove box bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
FLUID AND FILTER SERVICE
FLUID/FILTER SERVICE (RECOMMENDED)
NOTE: Refer to the maintenance schedules in LUBRICATION and MAINTENANCE for the
recommended maintenance (fluid/filter change)
intervals for this transaxle.
NOTE: Only fluids of the type labeled MOPAR(R) ATF+4 should be used. A filter change should be
made at the time of the transmission oil
change. The magnet (on the inside of the oil pan) should also be cleaned with a clean, dry cloth.
NOTE: If the transaxle is disassembled for any reason, the fluid and filter should be changed.
1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Refer to LUBRICATION and MAINTENANCE for proper procedures.
Place a drain container with a large opening,
under transaxle oil pan.
2. Loosen pan bolts and tap the pan at one corner to break it loose allowing fluid to drain, then
remove the oil pan. 3. Remove nuts at the oil filter. 4. Install a new filter and nuts, tighten to 5 Nm
(40 in. lbs.). 5. Install the fluid filter oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 6.
Clean the oil pan and magnet. Reinstall pan using new MOPAR(R) Silicone Adhesive sealant.
Tighten oil pan bolts to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 7. Pour four Quarts of MOPAR(R) ATF+4 through the
dipstick opening. 8. Start engine and allow to idle for at least one minute. Then, with parking and
service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
9. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 in.) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick.
10. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature 82° C
(180°F). Refer to Fluid Level and Condition Check for
the proper fluid fill procedure See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid Level and Condition Check.
11. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the
dipstick opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service
and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
1. Remove fuel fill cap. 2. Remove fuel pump fuse from Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
For location of fuse, refer to label on underside of TIPM cover. 3. Start and run engine until it stalls.
4. Attempt restarting engine until it will no longer run. 5. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 6. Place
a rag or towel below fuel line quick-connect fitting at fuel rail. 7. Disconnect quick-connect fitting at
fuel rail See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Line Coupler/Service
and Repair. 8. When the repair is complete, reconnect fuel fittings and return fuel pump fuse to
TIPM. 9. One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) may have been stored in PCM memory
due to fuel pump fuse removal. A diagnostic scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Oil Filter: Procedures
ENGINE OIL AND FILTER CHANGE
Change engine oil at mileage and time intervals described in the Maintenance Schedule. See:
WARNING: New or used engine oil can be irritating to the skin. Avoid prolonged or repeated skin
contact with engine oil. Contaminants in
used engine oil, caused by internal combustion, can be hazardous to your health. Thoroughly wash
exposed skin with soap and water. Do not wash skin with gasoline, diesel fuel, thinner, or solvents,
health problems can result. Do not pollute, dispose of used engine oil properly. Contact your dealer
or government agency for location of collection center in your area.
TO CHANGE ENGINE OIL
1. Run engine until achieving normal operating temperature. 2. Position the vehicle on a level
surface and turn engine off. 3. Open hood, remove engine oil fill cap (1). 4. Raise vehicle on hoist.
5. Place a suitable drain pan under crankcase drain.
6. Remove oil pan drain plug (1) from crankcase and allow oil to drain into pan. Inspect drain plug
threads for stretching or other damage. Replace
drain plug and gasket if damaged.
7. Remove oil filter (2). 8. Install drain plug (1) in crankcase. Tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm
(20 ft. lbs.). 9. Install new oil filter (2).
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1504
11. Fill crankcase with specified type and amount of engine oil. See: Powertrain Management/Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel/Description and
Operation
12. Install oil fill cap (1). 13. Start engine and inspect for leaks. 14. Turn engine off and inspect oil
level.
OIL FILTER SPECIFICATION
All engines are equipped with a high quality full-flow, disposable type oil filter. When replacing oil
filter, use a Mopar(R) filter or equivalent.
USED ENGINE OIL DISPOSAL
Care should be exercised when disposing used engine oil after it has been drained from a vehicle
engine. Refer to the WARNING above.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1505
Oil Filter: Removal and Replacement
Engine Oil Filter - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: When servicing the oil filter, avoid deforming the filter can. Install the remove/install tool
band strap against the base lock seam. The
lock seam joining the can to the base is reinforced by the base plate.
1. Using a suitable oil filter wrench, unscrew filter (2) from base and discard.
Engine Oil Filter - Installation
INSTALLATION
All engines are equipped with a high quality full-flow, disposable type oil filter (2). When replacing
oil filter, use a Mopar(R) filter or equivalent.
1. Wipe base clean, then inspect gasket contact surface. 2. Lubricate gasket of new filter with clean
engine oil. 3. Install and tighten oil filter (2) to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.) of torque after gasket contacts
base. Use filter wrench if necessary. 4. Start engine and check for leaks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Water Pump Inlet Tube - Removal
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair Water Pump Inlet Tube - Removal
WATER INLET TUBE
The water pump inlet tube (2) connects the water pump to the coolant adapter. This tube is sealed
by an O-ring and held in place by fasteners to the water pump housing.
1. Drain cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 2.
Remove the coolant adapter and secondary thermostat See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling
System/Thermostat/Service and Repair/Engine
Coolant Thermostat - Removal.
3. Raise and support vehicle. 4. Remove inlet tube mounting nuts (1). 5. Remove inlet tube (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Water Pump Inlet Tube - Removal > Page 1511
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair Water Pump Inlet Tube - Installation
WATER INLET TUBE
1. Inspect the O-ring for damage before installing the tube. Replace O-ring as necessary. 2.
Lubricate O-rings with soapy water. 3. Install new water inlet gasket between tube and water pump
housing (2). 4. Position water pump inlet tube (3) on water pump housing (2). Hand tighten nuts to
aide in tube alignment. 5. Install secondary thermostat and coolant adapter See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Thermostat/Service and Repair/Engine
Coolant Thermostat - Installation.
6. Tighten coolant tube nuts (1) to 24 Nm (212 in. lbs.). 7. Fill cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Discharge Line - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
The A/C discharge line (2) is the refrigerant line that carries refrigerant from the A/C compressor to
the A/C condenser.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C discharge line has no serviceable parts except for the metal gaskets (1) and rubber O-ring
seals (3) used on the fittings. The O-ring seals are made from a special type of rubber not affected
by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals and gaskets must be replaced whenever the A/C discharge
line is disconnected.
The A/C discharge line cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description > Page 1516
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Liquid Line - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: A/C liquid and suction line assembly with rear A/C shown. Front A/C only line assembly
similar.
The A/C liquid line is serviced in two sections. The front section of the A/C liquid line is the
refrigerant line that carries liquid refrigerant from the A/C condenser to the A/C receiver/drier and is
only serviced as an assembly with receiver/drier See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Receiver
Dryer/Description and Operation/Front A/C Receiver Drier - Description.
The rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) carries liquid refrigerant from the A/C receiver/drier to the
A/C expansion valve and includes the high side service port (2) and a fitting for the A/C pressure
transducer (4). The rear section of the A/C liquid line is only serviced as an assembly with the A/C
suction line (5). When equipped with rear A/C, the A/C liquid and suction line assembly includes
connections for the underbody refrigerant lines (3).
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C liquid and suction line assembly has no serviceable parts except for the metal gaskets,
rubber O-ring seals and the service port valve cores. The O-ring seals used on the connections are
made from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals and
gaskets must be replaced whenever the A/C liquid/suction line assembly is disconnected.
The A/C liquid and suction line assembly cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description > Page 1517
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Suction Line - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: A/C Suction line for 2.7L engine shown. Other engines similar.
The A/C suction line carries refrigerant from the A/C expansion valve to the A/C compressor and is
serviced in two sections. The upper section of the A/C suction line (1) includes the low side service
port (2) and is only serviced as an assembly with the rear A/C liquid line (6). When equipped with
rear A/C, the A/C liquid and suction line assembly includes connections for the underbody
refrigerant lines (3). The lower section of the A/C suction line (7) connects to the upper section of
the suction line and the connections are sealed by use of metal gaskets (5) and rubber O-ring seals
(4)
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
The lower A/C suction line and the A/C liquid and suction line assembly has no serviceable parts
except for the metal gaskets, rubber O-ring seals and the service port valve cores. The O-ring
seals used on the connections are made from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a
refrigerant. The O-ring seals and gaskets must be replaced whenever the lower A/C suction line
and/or the A/C liquid and suction line assembly is disconnected.
The lower A/C suction line and the A/C liquid and suction line assembly cannot be repaired and
must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description > Page 1518
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Underbody Lines - Description
DESCRIPTION
Models equipped with the rear heating-A/C system use metal lines attached to the vehicle
underbody to carry refrigerant and engine coolant to and from the rear A/C evaporator and heater
core. The underbody A/C lines (1) are connected to the front A/C suction and liquid lines and to the
rear A/C expansion valve extension tubes using nut type fittings (4) and O-ring seals. The
underbody heater lines (2) are connected to the front heater hoses and the rear heater core using
spring type clamps (3). The underbody lines are retained to the vehicle by seven plastic mounting
brackets (5).
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime an underbody
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals may result in a refrigerant system leak.
The underbody lines have no serviceable parts except for the refrigerant line rubber O-ring seals
and metal spring clamps. The O-ring seals used on the refrigerant line connections are made from
a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals must be replaced
whenever the underbody refrigerant lines are disconnected.
The underbody lines cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description > Page 1519
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Underbody Extension Lines - Description
DESCRIPTION
Models equipped with the rear heating-A/C system use metal lines attached to the vehicle
underbody to carry refrigerant and engine coolant to and from the rear A/C evaporator and heater
core. The underbody A/C lines are connected to the front A/C suction and liquid lines by use of
underbody A/C extension lines (2). The underbody A/C extension lines are connected to the front
and underbody refrigerant lines with nut type fittings (1 and 3) and O-ring seals.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime an underbody
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals may result in a refrigerant system leak.
The underbody A/C extension lines have no serviceable parts except for the rubber O-ring seals.
The O-ring seals used on the refrigerant line connections are made from a special type of rubber
not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals must be replaced whenever the underbody
refrigerant lines are disconnected.
The underbody A/C extension lines cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Discharge Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and cautions may result in possible serious or
fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3.
Remove the nut (5) that secures the A/C discharge line (1) to the condenser tapping block (2)
located on the right side of the condenser. 4. Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the tapping
block.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
5. Remove the nut (3) that secures the A/C discharge line (1) to the A/C compressor (2). 6.
Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the A/C compressor and remove the discharge line from
the engine compartment. 7. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and gaskets and install plugs in,
or tape over the opened discharge line fittings and the compressor and
condenser ports.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1522
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Discharge Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level . Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the
A/C system from operating as designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant
Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened discharge line fittings and the compressor and
condenser ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the discharge line fittings. Use only the
specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C discharge line (1) into the engine compartment and connect it to the A/C
compressor (2). 4. Install the nut (3) that secures the A/C discharge line to the A/C compressor.
Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect the A/C discharge line (1) to the condenser tapping block (2). 6. Install the nut (5) that
secures the A/C discharge line to the tapping block. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 7.
Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1523
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
8. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 9. Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level.
10. Charge the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1524
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Liquid Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Review safety precautions and warnings before performing this procedure See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service Precautions/Caution . Failure
to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The rear A/C liquid line is only serviced as an assembly with the upper A/C suction line.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
systemSee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle. 4. Position the front portion of the right front wheelhouse splash
shield out of the way to gain access to the A/C receiver/drier See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
5. Remove the nut (5) that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C
receiver/drier (4). 6. Disconnect the rear section of the A/C liquid line from the A/C receiver/drier
and remove and discard the O-ring seal and gasket. 7. Disconnect the lower portion of the A/C
suction line from the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C Suction Line - Removal. 8.
Remove the bolt (3) that secures the rear section of the A/C suction line (2) to the right front frame
rail.
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. If equipped with heat shield (3), remove the top nut (2) that secures the heat shield to the stud
(1) located on the dash panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1525
NOTE: Two slots are provided at the bottom of the heat shield to aid in heat shield removal, if
equipped. Complete removal of the two bottom
heat shield retaining nuts is not required.
11. If equipped, reach behind the engine and remove the two bottom nuts the that secure the heat
shield to the studs located on the dash panel and
remove the heat shield. Rotate and tilt the heat shield as required.
NOTE: It is only necessary to position the engine coolant reservoir and the power steering fluid
reservoir out of the way. Draining of the
coolant and power steering fluid is not required.
12. Remove the engine coolant reservoir from the right side of the engine compartment and
position it out of the way See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery Bottle Removal.
13. Remove the power steering fluid reservoir from the right front strut tower and position it out of
the way See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal.
14. If equipped with ABS, remove the ABS control module and pump assembly and position the
brake lines out of the way as necessary See: Brakes
and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Installation.
15. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on the
A/C liquid line and remove the transducer if required
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch/Service and Repair/Front
A/C Pressure Transducer - Removal.
16. If equipped with rear A/C, disconnect the rear A/C extension lines from the fittings (3) located
on the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See:
A/C Underbody Lines - Removal.
17. Remove the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on
the right front strut tower. 18. Remove the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly (1) to the A/C expansion valve (4). 19. Disconnect the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly from the A/C expansion valve and remove and discard the O-ring seals. 20. Remove the
A/C liquid and suction line assembly from the engine compartment. 21. Install plugs in, or tape over
all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve and receiver/drier ports.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1526
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Liquid Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level . Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the
A/C system from operating as designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant
Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve
and receiver/drier ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-rings with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the liquid and suction line fittings. Use only the
specified O-ring seals as they are made of special materials compatible to the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (1) into the engine compartment. 4. Connect
the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve (4).
CAUTION: Use care when installing the A/C lines to the A/C expansion valve. Carefully align the
tube ends with the valve prior to tightening
the A/C line retaining nut or damage to the sealing rings and tube ends may occur.
5. Install the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion
valve. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line
retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on the right front strut tower. Tighten the nut securely. 7. If
equipped with rear A/C, connect the rear A/C extension lines to the fittings (3) located on the A/C
liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C
Underbody Lines - Installation.
8. If removed, lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the
fitting for the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on
the A/C liquid line and install the pressure transducer. Tighten the A/C pressure transducer to 5.6
Nm (50 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1527
9. Connect the wire harness connector to the A/C pressure transducer.
10. If equipped with ABS, install the ABS control module and pump assembly See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation.
11. Install the power steering fluid reservoir See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power
Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation.
12. Install the engine coolant reservoir See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Installation.
13. If equipped, position the heat shield (3) onto the three studs (1) located on the dash panel in
the engine compartment and install the three retaining
nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
14. Raise and support the vehicle. 15. Install the bolt (3) that secures the upper portion of the A/C
suction line (2) to the right front frame rail. Tighten the bolt securely 16. Install the lower portion of
the A/C suction line to the upper suction line See: A/C Suction Line - Installation. 17. Connect the
rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). 18. Install the nut (5) that secures
the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15
ft. lbs.). 19. Reposition the right front wheel house splash shield to the body See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Installation.
20. Lower the vehicle. 21. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 22. If equipped with ABS, bleed
the brake system See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Installation.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1528
23. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 24. Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 25. Charge the A/C system See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1529
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair
A/C Discharge Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and cautions may result in possible serious or
fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3.
Remove the nut (5) that secures the A/C discharge line (1) to the condenser tapping block (2)
located on the right side of the condenser. 4. Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the tapping
block.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
5. Remove the nut (3) that secures the A/C discharge line (1) to the A/C compressor (2). 6.
Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the A/C compressor and remove the discharge line from
the engine compartment. 7. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and gaskets and install plugs in,
or tape over the opened discharge line fittings and the compressor and
condenser ports.
A/C Discharge Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1530
and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level . Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the
A/C system from operating as designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant
Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened discharge line fittings and the compressor and
condenser ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the discharge line fittings. Use only the
specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C discharge line (1) into the engine compartment and connect it to the A/C
compressor (2). 4. Install the nut (3) that secures the A/C discharge line to the A/C compressor.
Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect the A/C discharge line (1) to the condenser tapping block (2). 6. Install the nut (5) that
secures the A/C discharge line to the tapping block. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 7.
Reconnect the negative battery cable.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
8. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 9. Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level.
10. Charge the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1531
A/C Liquid Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Review safety precautions and warnings before performing this procedure See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service Precautions/Caution . Failure
to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The rear A/C liquid line is only serviced as an assembly with the upper A/C suction line.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
systemSee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle. 4. Position the front portion of the right front wheelhouse splash
shield out of the way to gain access to the A/C receiver/drier See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
5. Remove the nut (5) that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C
receiver/drier (4). 6. Disconnect the rear section of the A/C liquid line from the A/C receiver/drier
and remove and discard the O-ring seal and gasket. 7. Disconnect the lower portion of the A/C
suction line from the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C Suction Line - Removal. 8.
Remove the bolt (3) that secures the rear section of the A/C suction line (2) to the right front frame
rail.
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. If equipped with heat shield (3), remove the top nut (2) that secures the heat shield to the stud
(1) located on the dash panel.
NOTE: Two slots are provided at the bottom of the heat shield to aid in heat shield removal, if
equipped. Complete removal of the two bottom
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1532
heat shield retaining nuts is not required.
11. If equipped, reach behind the engine and remove the two bottom nuts the that secure the heat
shield to the studs located on the dash panel and
remove the heat shield. Rotate and tilt the heat shield as required.
NOTE: It is only necessary to position the engine coolant reservoir and the power steering fluid
reservoir out of the way. Draining of the
coolant and power steering fluid is not required.
12. Remove the engine coolant reservoir from the right side of the engine compartment and
position it out of the way See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery Bottle Removal.
13. Remove the power steering fluid reservoir from the right front strut tower and position it out of
the way See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal.
14. If equipped with ABS, remove the ABS control module and pump assembly and position the
brake lines out of the way as necessary See: Brakes
and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Installation.
15. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on the
A/C liquid line and remove the transducer if required
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch/Service and Repair/Front
A/C Pressure Transducer - Removal.
16. If equipped with rear A/C, disconnect the rear A/C extension lines from the fittings (3) located
on the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See:
A/C Underbody Lines - Removal.
17. Remove the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on
the right front strut tower. 18. Remove the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly (1) to the A/C expansion valve (4). 19. Disconnect the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly from the A/C expansion valve and remove and discard the O-ring seals. 20. Remove the
A/C liquid and suction line assembly from the engine compartment. 21. Install plugs in, or tape over
all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve and receiver/drier ports.
A/C Liquid Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level . Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the
A/C system from operating as designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant
Oil Level .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1533
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve
and receiver/drier ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-rings with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the liquid and suction line fittings. Use only the
specified O-ring seals as they are made of special materials compatible to the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (1) into the engine compartment. 4. Connect
the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve (4).
CAUTION: Use care when installing the A/C lines to the A/C expansion valve. Carefully align the
tube ends with the valve prior to tightening
the A/C line retaining nut or damage to the sealing rings and tube ends may occur.
5. Install the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion
valve. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line
retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on the right front strut tower. Tighten the nut securely. 7. If
equipped with rear A/C, connect the rear A/C extension lines to the fittings (3) located on the A/C
liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C
Underbody Lines - Installation.
8. If removed, lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the
fitting for the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on
the A/C liquid line and install the pressure transducer. Tighten the A/C pressure transducer to 5.6
Nm (50 in. lbs.).
9. Connect the wire harness connector to the A/C pressure transducer.
10. If equipped with ABS, install the ABS control module and pump assembly See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation.
11. Install the power steering fluid reservoir See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power
Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation.
12. Install the engine coolant reservoir See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1534
13. If equipped, position the heat shield (3) onto the three studs (1) located on the dash panel in
the engine compartment and install the three retaining
nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
14. Raise and support the vehicle. 15. Install the bolt (3) that secures the upper portion of the A/C
suction line (2) to the right front frame rail. Tighten the bolt securely 16. Install the lower portion of
the A/C suction line to the upper suction line See: A/C Suction Line - Installation. 17. Connect the
rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). 18. Install the nut (5) that secures
the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15
ft. lbs.). 19. Reposition the right front wheel house splash shield to the body See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Installation.
20. Lower the vehicle. 21. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 22. If equipped with ABS, bleed
the brake system See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Installation.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
23. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 24. Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 25. Charge the A/C system See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
A/C Suction Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Review safety precautions and warnings before performing this procedure See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1535
Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service Precautions/Caution . Failure
to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The A/C suction line is serviced in two sections.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
Upper A/C Suction Line
NOTE: The upper portion of the A/C suction line is only serviced as an assembly with the rear A/C
liquid line.
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
systemSee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle. 4. Position the front portion of the right front wheelhouse splash
shield out of the way to gain access to the A/C receiver/drier See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
5. Remove the nut (5) that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C
receiver/drier (4). 6. Disconnect the rear section of the A/C liquid line from the A/C receiver/drier
and remove and discard the O-ring seal and gasket. 7. Disconnect the lower portion of the A/C
suction line from the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C Suction Line - Removal. 8.
Remove the bolt (3) that secures the rear section of the A/C suction line (2) to the right front frame
rail.
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. If equipped with heat shield (3), remove the top nut (2) that secures the heat shield to the stud
(1) located on the dash panel.
NOTE: Two slots are provided at the bottom of the heat shield to aid in heat shield removal, if
equipped. Complete removal of the two bottom
heat shield retaining nuts is not required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1536
11. If equipped, reach behind the engine and remove the two bottom nuts the that secure the heat
shield to the studs located on the dash panel and
remove the heat shield. Rotate and tilt the heat shield as required.
NOTE: It is only necessary to position the engine coolant reservoir and the power steering fluid
reservoir out of the way. Draining of the
coolant and power steering fluid is not required.
12. Remove the engine coolant reservoir from the right side of the engine compartment and
position it out of the way See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery Bottle Removal.
13. Remove the power steering fluid reservoir from the right front strut tower and position it out of
the way See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal.
14. If equipped with ABS, remove the ABS control module and pump assembly and position the
brake lines out of the way as necessary See: Brakes
and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Installation.
15. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on the
A/C liquid line and remove the transducer if required
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch/Service and Repair/Front
A/C Pressure Transducer - Removal.
16. If equipped with rear A/C, disconnect the rear A/C extension lines from the fittings (3) located
on the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See:
A/C Underbody Lines - Removal.
17. Remove the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on
the right front strut tower. 18. Remove the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly (1) to the A/C expansion valve (4). 19. Disconnect the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly from the A/C expansion valve and remove and discard the O-ring seals. 20. Remove the
A/C liquid and suction line assembly from the engine compartment. 21. Install plugs in, or tape over
all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve and receiver/drier ports.
Lower A/C Suction Line
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1537
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
systemSee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle. 4. Position the front portion of the right front wheelhouse splash
shield out of the way to gain access to the A/C receiver/drier See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
5. Remove the nut (2) that secures the lower A/C suction line (3) to the upper A/C suction line (1).
6. Disconnect the lower A/C suction line to the upper A/C suction line and remove and discard the
O-ring seal and gasket.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
7. Remove the nut (2) that secures the lower A/C suction line (1) to the A/C compressor (3). 8.
Disconnect the lower A/C suction line from the A/C compressor and remove the lower line from the
engine compartment. 9. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and gaskets and install plugs in, or
tape over all the opened suction line fittings and the compressor port.
A/C Suction Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level . Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the
A/C system from operating as designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant
Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1538
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
Upper A/C Suction Line
1. Remove the tape or plugs from all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve
and receiver/drier ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-rings with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the liquid and suction line fittings. Use only the
specified O-ring seals as they are made of special materials compatible to the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (1) into the engine compartment. 4. Connect
the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve (4).
CAUTION: Use care when installing the A/C lines to the A/C expansion valve. Carefully align the
tube ends with the valve prior to tightening
the A/C line retaining nut or damage to the sealing rings and tube ends may occur.
5. Install the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion
valve. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line
retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on the right front strut tower. Tighten the nut securely. 7. If
equipped with rear A/C, connect the rear A/C extension lines to the fittings (3) located on the A/C
liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C
Underbody Lines - Installation.
8. If removed, lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the
fitting for the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on
the A/C liquid line and install the pressure transducer. Tighten the A/C pressure transducer to 5.6
Nm (50 in. lbs.).
9. Connect the wire harness connector to the A/C pressure transducer.
10. If equipped with ABS, install the ABS control module and pump assembly See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation.
11. Install the power steering fluid reservoir See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power
Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation.
12. Install the engine coolant reservoir See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1539
13. If equipped, position the heat shield (3) onto the three studs (1) located on the dash panel in
the engine compartment and install the three retaining
nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
14. Raise and support the vehicle. 15. Install the bolt (3) that secures the upper portion of the A/C
suction line (2) to the right front frame rail. Tighten the bolt securely 16. Connect the lower portion
of the A/C suction line to the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C Suction Line Installation. 17. Connect the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). 18.
Install the nut (5) that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4).
Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 19. Reposition the right front wheel house splash shield to the
body See: Body and Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
20. Lower the vehicle. 21. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 22. If equipped with ABS, bleed
the brake system See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Installation.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
23. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 24. Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 25. Charge the A/C system See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Lower A/C Suction Line
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1540
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
1. Position the lower A/C suction line (1) into the engine compartment. 2. Remove the tape or plugs
from the suction line fittings and the compressor port. 3. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with
clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the suction line fittings. Use only the
specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
4. Connect the lower A/C suction line to the A/C compressor (3). 5. Install the nut (2) that secures
the lower A/C suction line to the A/C compressor. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
6. Connect the lower portion of the A/C suction line (3) to the upper suction line (1) 7. Install the nut
(2) that secures the lower portion of the A/C suction line to the upper suction line. Tighten the nut to
20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 8. Reposition the right front wheel house splash shield to the body See: Body
and Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Installation.
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
11. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 12. Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 13. Charge the A/C system See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
A/C Underbody Lines - Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1541
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: To prevent any contaminates from entering the rear heating-A/C system, make sure that
the area around the underbody line
connections is clean of any dirt or foreign residue prior to disconnecting the lines.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3.
Drain the engine cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and
Repair. 4. Raise and support the vehicle. 5. Remove the rear section of the exhaust system See:
Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Exhaust System/Exhaust Pipe/Service and Repair/Exhaust Pipe Removal.
6. Remove the exhaust heat shields as necessary to gain access to the underbody lines See:
Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Exhaust System/Heat
Shield/Description and Operation/Description.
NOTE: Replacement of the front heater hoses will be required if the hose ends are cut for removal.
7. Release the spring type hose clamps (2) and disconnect the front heater hoses (1) from the
underbody heater lines (4). 8. Loosen the fitting nuts (6) that secure the underbody refrigerant lines
(5) to the front A/C liquid and suction lines (7). 9. Disconnect the front A/C liquid and suction lines
from the underbody refrigerant lines and remove and discard the O-ring seals.
10. Disengage the front A/C liquid and suction lines from the front underbody refrigerant line
bracket (3).
11. Remove the two nuts (3) and one screw (1) that secure the underbody line shield (2) to the
vehicle underbody and remove the shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1542
CAUTION: DO NOT apply excessive force on underbody heater lines or rear heater tubes when
disconnecting the connections. Excessive force
may damage or deform the tubes and or lines, causing an engine coolant leak.
NOTE: Replacement of the rubber heater hose ends will be required if the rubber hoses are cut for
removal.
12. Release the spring type hose clamps (4) and disconnect the underbody heater lines (5) from
the rear heater core tubes located behind the right rear
wheel housing.
13. Lower the underbody heater lines and drain any residual coolant from the lines into a suitable
container. 14. Loosen the fitting nuts (1) that secure the underbody refrigerant lines (7) to the
underbody refrigerant extension lines and sealing plate (2 and 6). 15. Disconnect the underbody
refrigerant lines from underbody refrigerant extension lines and remove and discard the O-ring
seals. 16. Remove the nut (3) that secures the underbody refrigerant extension lines and sealing
plate to the rear A/C expansion valve. 17. Disconnect the extension lines and sealing plate from the
rear A/C expansion valve and remove and discard the O-ring seals.
18. Disconnect the rear ABS wire harness lead and bracket (4) from the right side of the body (3) to
gain clearance to partially lower the right side of
the rear cradle.
NOTE: It is not necessary to disconnect the brake line to remove it from the brackets.
19. Remove the two bolts (6) that secure the right rear brake line (1) to the two brackets (2 and 5)
and remove the brake line from the brackets to gain
clearance to partially lower the right side of the rear cradle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1543
NOTE: Illustration shown with rear body cradle removed for clarity.
20. Remove the lower right rear shock retaining bolt See: Steering and
Suspension/Suspension/Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear Shock Absorber/Rear Shock Absorber, Coil-Over Removal.
WARNING: Be sure to properly support the rear cradle before removing the right side retaining
bolts. Failure to follow this warning may
result in serious or fatal injury.
21. Support the right side of the rear cradle with a suitable jack stand and remove the bolts that
secure the right side of the cradle to the body See:
Body and Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service and Repair/Crossmember - Removal.
CAUTION: Use care not to damage the ABS wire lead or the brake line when lowering the rear
cradle for clearance.
22. Carefully lower the jack stand until the right side of the rear cradle (supported by the stand) is
approximately 76-101 mm (3-4 in.) below the body.
This will allow access to remove the underbody line assembly.
23. Remove the nut (5) that secures the underbody line bracket (4) to the stud located near the
center of the underbody (6). 24. Disengage the remainder of the underbody line brackets (1, 2, and
7) from the studs located underneath the vehicle. 25. Rotate and tilt the underbody lines (3) as
necessary and remove the lines from the vehicle. 26. Install plugs in, or tape over all the opened
refrigerant line fittings and the rear expansion valve ports.
27. If required, place the extension lines and sealing plate (1) on a workbench, remove the nylon
retaining clip (4) that secures the suction extension
line (3) to the sealing plate and remove the suction line from the sealing plate.
A/C Underbody Lines - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1544
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level . Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the
A/C system from operating as designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant
Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime an underbody
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals may result in a refrigerant system leak.
1. If removed, install the suction extension line (3) into the sealing plate (1) and install the nylon
retaining clip (4).
NOTE: Illustration shown with rear body cradle removed for clarity.
2. Position the underbody lines (3) and engage the underbody line brackets (1, 2, and 7) to the
mounting studs located on the underbody (6). Rotate
and tilt the underbody lines as necessary. Make sure the brackets are fully engaged to the studs.
3. Position the underbody line bracket (4) onto the mounting stud located near the center of the
underbody and install the retaining nut (5). Tighten
the nut securely.
CAUTION: Use care not to damage the ABS wire lead or the brake line when repositioning the rear
cradle.
4. Carefully raise the jack stand until the right side of the rear cradle is positioned to the body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1545
WARNING: Be sure to properly support the rear cradle when installing the right side retaining bolts.
Failure to follow this warning may result
in serious or fatal injury.
5. Install the bolts that secure the right side of the cradle to the body and remove the jack stand
See: Body and Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service
and Repair/Crossmember - Installation.
6. Install the lower right rear shock retaining bolt See: Steering and
Suspension/Suspension/Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear Shock Absorber/Rear Shock Absorber, Coil-Over Installation.
7. Connect the rear ABS wire harness lead and bracket (4) to the right side of the body (3). 8.
Position the right rear brake line (1) onto the two brackets (2 and 5) and install the two retaining
bolts (6). Tighten the bolts securely.
CAUTION: DO NOT apply excessive force on underbody heater lines or rear heater tubes fittings
when connecting the connections. Excessive
force may damage or deform the tubes and or lines, causing an engine coolant leak.
NOTE: Replacement of the rubber heater hose ends will be required if the rubber hoses were cut
for removal.
9. Remove the tape or plugs from all the opened refrigerant line fittings and the rear expansion
valve ports.
10. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the underbody
refrigerant extension line fittings. Use only the
specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
11. Connect the underbody refrigerant extension lines and sealing plate (2 and 6) to the rear A/C
expansion valve. 12. Loosely install the nut (3) that secures the extension lines and sealing plate to
the rear A/C expansion valve. 13. Connect the underbody refrigerant lines (7) to the underbody
refrigerant extension lines and tighten the fitting nuts (1) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 14. Tighten the nut
that secures the extension lines and sealing plate to the rear A/C expansion valve to 11 Nm (97 in.
lbs.). 15. Connect the underbody heater lines (5) to the rear heater core tubes located behind the
right rear wheel housing and engage the spring type hose
clamps (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1546
16. Position the underbody line shield (2) to the vehicle underbody and install the two nuts (3) and
one screw (1). Tighten the fasteners securely.
17. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the underbody
refrigerant line fittings. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
18. Connect the front A/C liquid and suction lines (7) to the underbody refrigerant lines (5). Tighten
the fitting nuts (6) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 19. Position the front A/C liquid and suction lines into the
front underbody refrigerant line bracket (3) and engage the bracket retainer.
NOTE: Replacement of the front heater hoses will be required if the hose ends were cut for
removal.
20. Connect the front heater hoses (1) to the underbody heater lines (4) and engage the spring
type hose clamps (2). 21. Install the exhaust heat shields as necessary. 22. Install the rear section
of the exhaust system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Exhaust System/Exhaust Pipe/Service
and Repair/Exhaust Pipe Installation.
23. Lower the vehicle. 24. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 25. Fill the engine cooling system
See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 26. Evacuate the
refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System
Evacuate. 27. Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 28. Charge the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
A/C Underbody Extension Lines - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1547
NOTE: To prevent any contaminates from entering the rear heating-A/C system, make sure that
the area around the underbody line
connections is clean of any dirt or foreign residue prior to disconnecting the lines.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle. 4. Disengage the underbody A/C extension lines (4) from the front
underbody refrigerant line bracket (1). 5. Loosen the fitting nuts (3) that secure the underbody A/C
extension lines to the underbody A/C liquid and suction lines (2). 6. Disconnect the underbody A/C
extension lines from the underbody A/C liquid and suction lines and remove and discard the O-ring
seals. 7. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened refrigerant line fittings.
8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Loosen the fitting nuts (3) that secure the underbody A/C extension lines
(2) to the front A/C liquid and suction lines (1).
10. Disconnect the underbody A/C extension lines from the front A/C liquid and suction lines and
remove and discard the O-ring seals. 11. Rotate and tilt the underbody A/C extension lines as
necessary and remove the lines from the vehicle. 12. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened
refrigerant line fittings.
A/C Underbody Extension Lines - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level . Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the
A/C system from operating as designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant
Oil Level .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 1548
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime an underbody
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals may result in a refrigerant system leak.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened refrigerant extension line fittings. 2. Lubricate new
rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the refrigerant line fittings. Use
only the specified O-rings as
they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the underbody A/C extension lines (2) into the engine compartment. Rotate and tilt the
underbody A/C extension lines as necessary. 4. Connect the underbody A/C extension lines to the
front A/C liquid and suction lines (1). Tighten the fitting nuts (3) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
5. Raise and support the vehicle. 6. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened underbody
refrigerant line fittings. 7. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install
them onto the refrigerant line fittings. Use only the specified O-rings as
they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
8. Connect the underbody A/C extension lines (4) to the underbody A/C liquid and suction lines (2).
Tighten the fitting nuts (3) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 9. Position the underbody A/C extension lines into
the front underbody refrigerant line bracket (1) and engage the bracket retainer.
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 12. Evacuate the refrigerant
system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 13.
Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil
Level. 14. Charge the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Power Steering Line/Hose: Testing and Inspection
POWER STEERING PUMP AND HOSES
NOTE: This information is designed to be used in conjunction with the diagnostic charts at the
beginning of the Steering section. See: Steering
and Suspension/Steering/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CHECKING FOR WEAR OF POWER STEERING PUMP INTERNAL COMPONENTS
1. Place gear selector in PARK (or NEUTRAL) with wheels chalked. 2. With the engine idling, have
a helper turn the steering wheel. 3. Using an electronic listening tool, determine if noise is coming
from the pump. 4. Increase the engine speed and have a helper turn the steering wheel. Does the
noise change with load? 5. Replace the power steering pump if excessive noise is present. See:
Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering
Pump/Service and Repair/Power Steering Pump - Removal
CHECKING FOR POWER STEERING HOSES TOUCHING BODY OR FRAME OF VEHICLE
Check hoses and hose tubes as following:
- Inspect hoses and hose tubes for witness marks. If witness marks are present, adjust hose(s) to
the proper position by loosening, repositioning and tightening attachments to the specified torque
See: Specifications/Mechanical Specifications/Steering/System Specifications. Do not bend tubing
to adjust. Replace the hose assembly if damaged.
- Check fastener torque of hose mounting brackets and tube nuts. See: Specifications/Mechanical
Specifications/Steering/System Specifications
- Have a helper bump the steering gear off of the stops to induce pressure fluctuations which may
move the hose. If hose contact is made, adjust hose(s) to the proper position by loosening,
repositioning and tightening attachments to the specified torque See: Specifications/Mechanical
Specifications/Steering/System Specifications. Do not bend tubing to adjust. Replace the hose
assembly if damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Hose - Removal
Pressure Hose
3.5L ENGINE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Service Precautions .
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Remove the engine
appearance cover. 3. Raise and support the vehicle See: . 4. Unscrew the tube nut (3), then
remove the pressure hose (4) at the steering gear. 5. Lower the vehicle.
6. Unscrew the tube nut (3), then remove the pressure hose (1) at the pump (4). 7. Remove the
pressure hose routing clamp bolt (2) at the engine cylinder head.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 1554
8. Accessing it through the area behind the powertrain control module (3), remove the routing
clamp screw (2) securing the pressure hose (1) to the
left side of the front suspension crossmember.
9. Remove the power steering pressure hose from the vehicle.
Return Hose
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Service Precautions .
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Remove the power
steering fluid reservoir.See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering
Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal
3. Remove the coolant recovery bottle. See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Removal
4. Raise and support the vehicle. See: 5. If equipped, remove the belly pan below the engine. 6.
Remove the lower fascia valance.
7. Remove the return hose (1) at the return tube (2). If equipped with a screw-clamp, be sure to
save the original clamp for reinstallation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 1555
8. Remove the hose clamps (5) attaching the fluid return hoses (7) to the power steering fluid
cooler line (4). Separate the return hoses from the
cooler line.
9. Remove the return hose routing clamp screws (3) securing the return hose (7) to the frame rail.
10. Remove the return hose routing clamp screw (6) securing the return hose (7) to the frame rail.
11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Remove the return hose routing clamp screw (1) securing the return
hose (7) to the body. 13. Remove the return hose from the vehicle.
Supply Hose
3.5L ENGINE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Service Precautions .
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir.
2. Remove the clamp (3) securing the supply hose (2) to the power steering pump supply fitting (4),
then remove the hose from the supply fitting.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 1556
3. Remove the mounting screws (1) securing the coolant recovery container (4) in place.
4. Lift the coolant recovery container as high as its connected hoses will allow, then remove the clip
(6) securing the supply hose to the coolant
recovery container's lower mounting point.
5. Remove the hose clamp (1) securing the supply hose (2) to the power steering fluid reservoir (7).
Slide the hose off the end of the reservoir fitting
and remove from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 1557
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Hose - Installation
Pressure Hose
3.5L ENGINE
CAUTION: Power steering fluid hoses must remain away from the exhaust system, driveshafts,
vehicle components and any unfriendly surface
that can possibly damage the hoses.
1. Install the pressure hose into the engine compartment from above between the engine and the
upper radiator hose. Then route the hose down the
left side of the engine above the transmission, down to the steering gear.
2. Raise and support the vehicle See: . 3. Install the pressure hose tube (4) at the gear. Tighten the
tube nut (3) to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.). 4. Lower the vehicle.
5. Accessing it through the area behind the powertrain control module (3), position the power
steering hose (1) routing clamp at the left side of the
front suspension crossmember. Install and tighten the routing clamp screw (2) to 14 Nm (10 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 1558
6. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the open power steering pressure hose end and the power
steering pump port. Replace any used O-rings with
new. Lubricate the O-ring with clean power steering fluid.
7. Install the pressure hose (1) at the power steering pump (4). Tighten the tube nut (3) to 32 Nm
(24 ft. lbs.). 8. Position the pressure hose (1) routing clamp at the engine cylinder head. Install and
tighten the routing clamp bolt (2) to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.). 9. Fill and bleed the power steering system
See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Service and Repair/Steering - Power Steering System
Bleeding.
10. Check for leaks.
Return Hose
INSTALLATION
1. Install the power steering return hose (7) into the engine compartment. 2. Install the return hose
routing clamp screw (1) securing the return hose (7) to the body. 3. Raise and support the vehicle.
See: 4. Install the return hose routing clamp screw (6) securing the return hose (7) to the frame rail.
Tighten the screw to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.). 5. Install the screws (3) securing the return hose to the
frame rail (2). Tighten the screws to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.). 6. Install the return hose onto the cooler line
(4) and install the hose clamps (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 1559
7. Install the return hose (1) at the return tube (2) and install the clamp. If a screw-clamp is used,
tighten it to 2.5 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
8. Install the lower fascia valance. 9. If equipped, install the belly pan below the engine.
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Install the coolant recovery bottle. See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Installation
12. Install the power steering fluid reservoir. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power
Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation
13. Fill and bleed the power steering system. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Service and
Repair/Steering - Power Steering System Bleeding 14. Check for leaks.
Supply Hose
3.5L ENGINE
1. Slide hose clamps (1, 3) onto the ends of the power steering fluid supply hose (2) far enough to
clear the fittings on the reservoir and pump once
the hose is installed.
2. Place the pump end of the supply hose onto the pump supply fitting (4). Expand the hose clamp
(3) and slide it over the hose and pump supply
fitting. Secure the clamp once it is past the bead formed into the fluid supply fitting.
3. Lift the coolant recovery container as high as its connected hoses will allow, then install the clip
(6) in the mounting hole (5) securing the supply
hose to the coolant recovery container's lower mounting point.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 1560
4. Lower the coolant recovery container (4) to its mounted position and install the mounting screws
(1).
5. Place the fluid reservoir end of the supply hose (2) onto the reservoir (7) supply fitting. Expand
the hose clamp and slide it over the hose and
fitting. Secure the clamp once it is past the bead formed into the fluid reservoir fitting.
6. Fill and bleed the power steering system. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Service and
Repair/Steering - Power Steering System Bleeding 7. Check for leaks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Brake Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1566
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 1567
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Brake Master Cylinder
.......................................................................................................................................... Mopar DOT
3, SAE J1703 or equivalent
If DOT 3 brake fluid is not available, then DOT 4 is acceptable. Use only recommended brake
fluids.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 1568
Brake Fluid: Description and Operation
BRAKE FLUID
The brake fluid used in this vehicle must conform to DOT 3 specifications and SAE J1703
standards. No other type of brake fluid is recommended or approved for usage in the vehicle brake
system. Use only Mopar(R) Brake Fluid or equivalent from a tightly sealed container.
CAUTION: Never use reclaimed brake fluid or fluid from a container which has been left open. An
open container of brake fluid will absorb
moisture from the air and contaminate the fluid.
CAUTION: Never use any type of a petroleum-based fluid in the brake hydraulic system. Use of
such type fluids will result in seal damage of
the vehicle brake hydraulic system causing a failure of the vehicle brake system. Petroleum based
fluids would be items such as engine oil, transmission fluid, power steering fluid, etc.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 1569
Brake Fluid: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE FLUID CONTAMINATION
Indications of fluid contamination are swollen or deteriorated rubber parts. Swelling indicates the
presence of petroleum in the brake fluid.
To test for contamination, put a small amount of drained brake fluid in clear glass jar. If the fluid
separates into layers, there is mineral oil or other fluid contamination of the brake fluid.
If the brake fluid is contaminated, drain and thoroughly flush the brake system. Replace all the
rubber parts or components containing rubber coming into contact with the brake fluid including:
the master cylinder and reservoir; proportioning valves (non-ABS); caliper seals; wheel cylinder
seals; ABS hydraulic control unit; and all hydraulic fluid hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 1570
Brake Fluid: Service and Repair
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL CHECKING
NOTE: Brake fluid level should be checked a minimum of twice a year.
Master cylinder reservoirs are marked, FULL and ADD, indicating the allowable brake fluid level
range in the master cylinder fluid reservoir.
CAUTION: Use only Mopar(R) Brake Fluid DOT 3 Motor Vehicle or equivalent from a tightly sealed
container. Do not use petroleum-based
fluid because seal damage in the brake system will result. See: Specifications
NOTE: Although there is a range, the preferred level is FULL.
1. Remove the cap. 2. Adjust the brake fluid level to the FULL mark listed on the side of the master
cylinder fluid reservoir as necessary. Do not overfill the system. 3. Install the cap.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Clutch Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1575
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1580
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Single or Dual Zone Climate Control System
................................................................................................................................................. 9.8 qts.
(9.3 L)
Three-Zone Climate Control System
.............................................................................................................................................................
12 qts. (11.4 L)
Includes heater and coolant recovery bottle filled to MAX level.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1583
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Coolant ...................................... Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula HOAT
(Hybrid Organic Additive Technology) or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description - Engine Coolant
Coolant: Description and Operation Description - Engine Coolant
ENGINE COOLANT
GAS ENGINES
WARNING: Antifreeze is an ethylene glycol based coolant and is harmful if swallowed or inhaled. If
swallowed, drink two glasses of water and
induce vomiting. If inhaled, move to fresh air area. Seek medical attention immediately. Do not
store in open or unmarked containers. Wash skin and clothing thoroughly after coming in contact
with ethylene glycol. Keep out of reach of children. Dispose of glycol based coolant properly,
contact your government agency for location of collection center in your area. Do not open a
cooling system when the engine is at operating temperature or hot under pressure, personal injury
can result. Avoid radiator cooling fan when engine compartment related service is performed,
personal injury can result.
CAUTION: Use of propylene glycol based coolants is not recommended, as they provide less
freeze protection and less boiling protection.
The cooling system is designed around the coolant. The coolant must accept heat from engine
metal, in the cylinder head area near the exhaust valves and engine block. Then coolant carries the
heat to the radiator where the tube/fin radiator can transfer the heat to the air.
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769), or the
equivalent ethylene glycol based coolant with hybrid organic corrosion inhibitors (called HOAT, for
Hybrid Organic Additive Technology) is recommended. This coolant offers the best engine cooling
without corrosion when mixed with 50% Ethylene Glycol and 50% distilled water to obtain a freeze
point of -37°C (-35°F). If it loses color or becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with
fresh properly mixed coolant solution.
The green coolant MUST NOT BE MIXED with the orange or magenta coolants. When replacing
coolant the complete system flush must be performed before using the replacement coolant.
CAUTION: Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769) may not be
mixed with any other type of antifreeze. Doing
so will reduce the corrosion protection and may result in premature water pump seal failure. If
non-HOAT coolant is introduced into the cooling system in an emergency, it should be replaced
with the specified coolant as soon as possible.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description - Engine Coolant > Page 1586
Coolant: Description and Operation Operation
COOLANT
Coolant flows through the engine block absorbing the heat from the engine, then flows to the
radiator where the cooling fins in the radiator transfers the heat from the coolant to the atmosphere.
During cold weather the ethylene-glycol or coolant prevents water present in the cooling system
from freezing within temperatures indicated by mixture ratio of coolant to water.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
1587
Coolant: Testing and Inspection
COOLANT CONCENTRATION TESTING
Check coolant concentration when any additional coolant is added to the system, or after a coolant
drain, flush and refill. Use of a hydrometer or Refractometer Tool 8286, refractometer can be used
to test coolant concentration.
A hydrometer tests the amount of glycol in a mixture by measuring the specific gravity of the
mixture. The higher the concentration of ethylene glycol, the larger the number of balls that will
float, and the higher the freeze protection (up to a maximum of 60% by volume glycol).
A Refractometer Tool 8286 tests the amount of glycol in a coolant mixture by measuring the
amount a beam of light bends as it passes through the fluid.
Some coolant manufacturers use other types of glycols into their coolant formulations. Propylene
glycol is the most common new coolant. However, propylene glycol based coolants do not provide
the same freezing protection and corrosion protection and are not recommended.
CAUTION: Do not mix types of coolant - corrosion protection will be severely reduced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1592
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - CVT: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1597
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - M/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1602
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - Transfer Case: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1607
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1612
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
41TE/41AE Estimated Service Fill .......................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.0 qts (3.8L)
41TE/41AE Overhaul Capacity with Torque Converter Empty
....................................................................................................................... 9.2 qts (8.7L)
62TE Estimated Service Fill ................................................................................................................
............................................................. 5.5 qts (5.2L)
62TE Overhaul Capacity with Torque Converter Empty
................................................................................................................................. 9.0 qts (8.5L)
Dry fill capacity depending on type and size of internal cooler, length and inside diameter of cooler
lines, or use of an auxiliary cooler, these figures may vary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1615
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
ATF Fluid
.....................................................................................................................................................
Mopar ATF +4 Automatic Transmission Fluid
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1616
Fluid - A/T: Description and Operation
AUTOMATIC/MANUAL TRANSAXLE FLUID
NOTE: All transaxles have a common transmission and differential sump. Filling the transaxle
accommodates the differential as well.
Mopar (R) ATF+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) is required in the automatic and T355/BG6
manual transaxles. Substitute fluids can induce torque converter clutch shudder, or premature
geartrain failure.
Mopar (R) ATF+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) when new is red in color. The ATF is dyed red so
it can be identified from other fluids used in the vehicle such as engine oil or antifreeze. The red
color is not permanent and is not an indicator of fluid condition. As the vehicle is driven, the ATF
will begin to look darker in color and may eventually become brown. This is normal. ATF+4 also
has a unique odor that may change with age. Consequently, odor and color cannot be used to
indicate the fluid condition or the need for a fluid change.
FLUID ADDITIVES
Chrysler strongly recommends against the addition of any fluids to the transmission, other than
those automatic transmission fluids listed above. Exceptions to this policy are the use of special
dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks.
Various "special" additives and supplements exist that claim to improve shift feel and/or quality.
These additives and others also claim to improve converter clutch operation and inhibit
overheating, oxidation, varnish, and sludge. These claims have not been supported to the
satisfaction of Chrysler and these additives must not be used. The use of transmission "sealers"
should also be avoided, since they may adversely affect the integrity of transmission seals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fluid
Level and Condition Check
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid Level and Condition Check
FLUID LEVEL AND CONDITION CHECK
FLUID LEVEL CHECK USING THE SCAN TOOL
1. Verify that the vehicle is parked on a level surface. 2. Remove the dipstick tube cap.
WARNING: There is a risk of accident from vehicle starting off by itself when engine is running.
There is a risk of injury from contusions and
burns if you insert your hands into the engine when it is started or when it is running. Secure
vehicle to prevent it from moving off by itself. Wear properly fastened and close-fitting work clothes.
Do not touch hot or rotating parts.
3. Actuate the service brake. Start engine and let it run at idle speed in selector lever position "P".
4. Shift through the transmission modes several times with the vehicle stationary and the engine
idling.
NOTE: When inserting dipstick special tool 9336A, excess insertion force may cause the dipstick to
slip past the stop on the bracket in the
transmission oil pan. An approximate distance that the dipstick should be inserted into the fill tube
is 424 mm (16.69 in.).
5. Warm up the transmission, wait at least 2 minutes and check the oil level with the engine
running. Push the Oil Dipstick 9336A into transmission
fill tube until the dipstick tip contacts the oil pan and pull out again, read off oil level, repeat if
necessary.
NOTE: The dipstick will protrude from the fill tube when installed.
6. Check transmission oil temperature using the appropriate scan tool. 7. The transmission Oil
Dipstick 9336A has indicator marks every 10 mm. Determine the height of the oil level on the
dipstick and using the height,
the Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) as viewed with the scan too, and the Transmission Fluid
Graph, determine if the transmission oil level
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fluid
Level and Condition Check > Page 1619
is correct.
8. Add or remove oil as necessary and recheck the oil level. 9. Once the oil level is correct, install
the dipstick tube cap.
FLUID CONDITION
Along with fluid level, it is important to check the condition of the fluid. When the fluid smells
burned, and is contaminated with metal or friction material particles, a complete transaxle
recondition is probably required. Be sure to examine the fluid on the dipstick closely. If there is any
doubt about its condition, drain out a sample for a double check.
MOPAR(R) ATF+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) when new is red in color. The ATF is dyed red
so it can be identified from other fluids used in the vehicle such as engine oil or antifreeze. The red
color is not permanent and is not an indicator of fluid condition. As the vehicle is driven, the ATF
will begin to look darker in color and may eventually become brown. This is normal. ATF+4 also
has a unique odor that may change with age. Consequently, odor and color cannot be used to
indicate the fluid condition or the need for a fluid change.
After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fluid
Level and Condition Check > Page 1620
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid/Filter Service
FLUID AND FILTER SERVICE
FLUID/FILTER SERVICE (RECOMMENDED)
NOTE: Refer to the maintenance schedules in LUBRICATION and MAINTENANCE for the
recommended maintenance (fluid/filter change)
intervals for this transaxle.
NOTE: Only fluids of the type labeled MOPAR(R) ATF+4 should be used. A filter change should be
made at the time of the transmission oil
change. The magnet (on the inside of the oil pan) should also be cleaned with a clean, dry cloth.
NOTE: If the transaxle is disassembled for any reason, the fluid and filter should be changed.
1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Refer to LUBRICATION and MAINTENANCE for proper procedures.
Place a drain container with a large opening,
under transaxle oil pan.
2. Loosen pan bolts and tap the pan at one corner to break it loose allowing fluid to drain, then
remove the oil pan. 3. Remove nuts at the oil filter. 4. Install a new filter and nuts, tighten to 5 Nm
(40 in. lbs.). 5. Install the fluid filter oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 6.
Clean the oil pan and magnet. Reinstall pan using new MOPAR(R) Silicone Adhesive sealant.
Tighten oil pan bolts to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 7. Pour four Quarts of MOPAR(R) ATF+4 through the
dipstick opening. 8. Start engine and allow to idle for at least one minute. Then, with parking and
service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
9. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 in.) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick.
10. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature 82° C
(180°F). Refer to Fluid Level and Condition Check for
the proper fluid fill procedure See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid Level and Condition Check.
11. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the
dipstick opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - CVT: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1625
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - M/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1630
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - Differential: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1635
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1636
Fluid - Differential: Specifications
Rear Drive Assembly (RDA)
.......................................................................................................................... Mopar Gear Lubricant
75W-90 or equivalent
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1637
Fluid - Differential: Service and Repair
STANDARD PROCEDURE - DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY FLUID CHANGE
The drain plug (2) for the differential assembly is located in the bottom of the differential assembly
case, toward the rear of the unit.
The fill plug (3) for the differential assembly is located on the left side of the assembly case.
The correct fill level is to the bottom of the fill plug hole. Be sure the vehicle is on a level surface, or
is hoisted in a level manner, in order to obtain the correct fill level.
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Position a drain pan under the differential drain plug. 3. Remove
the drain plug and allow the fluid to drain into the pan. 4. Install the drain plug and torque to 35 Nm
(26 ft. lbs.). 5. Re-position the drain pan under the differential fill plug. 6. Remove the differential fill
plug. 7. Using a suction gun or equivalent, fill the differential assembly with 0.7 L (0.74 Quarts) of
Mopar(R) Gear and Axle Lubricant (75W-90). 8. Install the fill plug and torque to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - Transfer Case: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1642
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1643
Fluid - Transfer Case: Specifications
Power Transfer Unit (PTU)
............................................................................................................................ Mopar Gear
Lubricant 75W-90 or equivalent
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1644
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair
PTU FLUID DRAIN/FILL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. Remove bolt (1) from lower part of PTU heat shield (2).
3. Using a long prybar remove the retaining clip (1) from the side of the PTU heat shield (2).
NOTE: Position the PTU heat shield aside as necessary
4. Remove PTU drain plug (1). Drain fluid into suitable container. 5. Install drain plug (1) and torque
to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1645
6. A 10mm hex bit 7/8" long (1) and a ratcheting box angle wrench (2) will be required to remove
the PTU fill plug.
NOTE: Position the PTU heat shield aside as necessary
7. Using the ratcheting box angle wrench (1) and hex bit (3) remove the PTU fill plug (2).
8. Use a gear lube pump (1) to fill PTU with.8L (1.7 Pints.) of Mopar(R) 75W-90 Gear and Axle
Lubricant. 9. Install fill plug and torque to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1646
10. Reposition the PTU heat shield (2) to the side of the PTU, and install a new retaining clip (1).
11. Reposition the PTU heat shield (2) to the bottom of the PTU, and install bolt (1). Tighten to 12
Nm (105 in. lbs.). 12. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1651
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 5.2L (5.5 qts)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1654
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil Type ...................................................................................................................................
...................................... API SAE Certified 10W-30
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1655
Engine Oil: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL
WARNING: New or used engine oil can be irritating to the skin. Avoid prolonged or repeated skin
contact with engine oil. Contaminants in
used engine oil, caused by internal combustion, can be hazardous to your health. Thoroughly wash
exposed skin with soap and water. Do not wash skin with gasoline, diesel fuel, thinner, or solvents,
health problems can result. Do not pollute, dispose of used engine oil properly. Contact your dealer
or government agency for location of collection center in your area.
When service is required, Chrysler recommends that only Mopar(R) brand parts, lubricants and
chemicals be used. Mopar(R) provides the best engineered products for servicing Chrysler
vehicles.
Only lubricants bearing designations defined by the following organization should be used.
- Society of Automotive Engineers (SAE)
- American Petroleum Institute (API)
- National Lubricating Grease Institute (NLGI)
- Association des Constructeurs Europeens d' Automobiles (European Automobile Manufacturers
Association) (ACEA)
API CERTIFICATION AND LICENSE SYMBOL
Use an engine oil that is API Certified and Licensed to display the certification mark. MOPAR(R)
provides engine oils that meet or exceed, Material Standard MS-6395 requirement.
SAE VISCOSITY
Engine oils are designed to improve low temperature starting and vehicle fuel economy. Refer to
the engine oil filler cap for the preferred engine oil viscosity grade for each vehicle. SAE viscosity
grades are used to specify the correct viscosity oil for an engine. Use only Multi-Viscosity oils.
These are specified with a dual SAE viscosity grade which indicates the cold (5W) to hot (20, 30)
temperature performance range of the oil.
ACEA CATEGORIES
For countries that use the ACEA European Oil Categories for service fill oils, use engine oils that
meet the requirements of ACEA A1/B1, A2/B2, or A3/B3.
CONTAINER IDENTIFICATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1656
The Engine Oil Certification Mark was developed and trademarked by the API to refer customers to
those engine oils preferred by the automobile manufacturers. This symbol means that the oil has
been certified and licensed by the American Petroleum Institute (API). This certification mark will
only be found on the front of the oil containers. Those oils that do not display the "Mark" on the
front of the container should not be used.
Chrysler only recommends API Certified engine oils that meet the requirements of Material
Standard MS-6395. Use Mopar or an equivalent oil meeting the specification MS-6395.
SYNTHETIC ENGINE OILS
There are a number of engine oils being promoted as either synthetic or semi-synthetic. If you
chose to use such a product, use only those oils that are certified by the American Petroleum
Institute (API) to display the "Certification Mark" and show SAE viscosity grade recommended for
each vehicle. Follow the service schedule that describes your driving type.
ENGINE OIL ADDITIVES/SUPPLEMENTS
The manufacturer does not recommend the addition of any engine oil additives/supplements to the
specified engine oil. Engine oil additives/supplements should not be used to enhance engine oil
performance. Engine oil additives/supplements should not be used to extend engine oil change
intervals. No additive is known to be safe for engine durability and can degrade emission
components. Additives can contain undesirable materials that harm the long term durability of
engines and emission systems by:
- Increasing the level of Phosphorus and Sulfur in the engine oil. The API Certified Engine Oils
control the Phosphorus and Sulfur contents of the oil to levels that reduce the contamination effect
on the vehicles emission control system.
- Altering the viscosity characteristics of the engine oil so that it no longer meets the requirements
of the specified viscosity grade.
- Creating potential for an undesirable additive compatibility interaction in the engine crankcase.
The engine oils contain a performance additive system carefully developed to optimize the oils
performance in the engine. The addition of supplements may cause the oil to thicken prematurely,
cause excessive deposit build-up and potentially shorten engine life.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine
Oil Level Check
Engine Oil: Service and Repair Engine Oil Level Check
ENGINE OIL LEVEL CHECK
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will improve the accuracy of the oil level
reading. Remove dipstick (1), and observe oil level. Add oil only when the level is at or below the
SAFE mark. If the oil level is in the safe (2) range, do not add oil.
CAUTION: Do not operate engine if the oil level is above the MAX mark on the dipstick. Excessive
oil volume can cause oil aeration which can
lead to engine failure due to loss of oil pressure or increase in oil temperature.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine
Oil Level Check > Page 1659
Engine Oil: Service and Repair Engine Oil and Filter Change
ENGINE OIL AND FILTER CHANGE
Change engine oil at mileage and time intervals described in the Maintenance Schedule. See:
WARNING: New or used engine oil can be irritating to the skin. Avoid prolonged or repeated skin
contact with engine oil. Contaminants in
used engine oil, caused by internal combustion, can be hazardous to your health. Thoroughly wash
exposed skin with soap and water. Do not wash skin with gasoline, diesel fuel, thinner, or solvents,
health problems can result. Do not pollute, dispose of used engine oil properly. Contact your dealer
or government agency for location of collection center in your area.
TO CHANGE ENGINE OIL
1. Run engine until achieving normal operating temperature. 2. Position the vehicle on a level
surface and turn engine off. 3. Open hood, remove engine oil fill cap (1). 4. Raise vehicle on hoist.
5. Place a suitable drain pan under crankcase drain.
6. Remove oil pan drain plug (1) from crankcase and allow oil to drain into pan. Inspect drain plug
threads for stretching or other damage. Replace
drain plug and gasket if damaged.
7. Remove oil filter (2). 8. Install drain plug (1) in crankcase. Tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm
(20 ft. lbs.). 9. Install new oil filter (2).
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine
Oil Level Check > Page 1660
11. Fill crankcase with specified type and amount of engine oil. See: Powertrain Management/Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel/Description and
Operation
12. Install oil fill cap (1). 13. Start engine and inspect for leaks. 14. Turn engine off and inspect oil
level.
OIL FILTER SPECIFICATION
All engines are equipped with a high quality full-flow, disposable type oil filter. When replacing oil
filter, use a Mopar(R) filter or equivalent.
USED ENGINE OIL DISPOSAL
Care should be exercised when disposing used engine oil after it has been drained from a vehicle
engine. Refer to the WARNING above.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Power Steering Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 1665
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1666
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
Power Steering Fluid ............................................................................... Mopar Power Steering
Fluid +4, Mopar ATF +4 Automatic Transmission Fluid.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1667
Power Steering Fluid: Description and Operation
POWER STEERING FLUID
The recommended fluid for the power steering system is Mopar(R) Power Steering fluid + 4 or
Mopar(R) ATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid. Both Fluids have the same material standard
specifications (MS-9602).
Mopar(R) ATF+4 (and Mopar(R) Power Steering fluid + 4), when new, is red in color. ATF+4 is
dyed red so it can be identified from other fluids used in the vehicle such as engine oil or
antifreeze. The red color is not permanent and is not an indicator of fluid condition. As the vehicle is
driven, ATF+4 will begin to look darker in color and may eventually become brown. THIS IS
NORMAL. ATF+4 also has a unique odor that may change with age. Consequently, odor and color
cannot be used to indicate the fluid condition or the need for a fluid change.
The power steering system is filled-for-life at the factory and requires no regular maintenance.
Although not required at specific intervals, the fluid level may be checked periodically. Check the
fluid level anytime there is a system noise or fluid leak suspected. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Service and Repair/Power Steering Fluid Level Checking
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1668
Power Steering Fluid: Service and Repair
POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL CHECKING
WARNING: Fluid level should be checked with the engine OFF to prevent personal injury from
moving parts and to assure an accurate fluid
level reading.
CAUTION: Mopar(R) Power Steering Fluid + 4 or Mopar(R) ATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid is
to be used in the power steering system.
Both fluids have the same material standard specifications (MS-9602). No other power steering or
automatic transmission fluid is to be used in the system. Damage may result to the power steering
pump and system if another fluid is used. Do not overfill the system.
NOTE: Although not required at specific intervals, the fluid level may be checked periodically.
Check the fluid level anytime there is a system
noise or fluid leak suspected.
The power steering fluid level can be viewed through the side of the power steering fluid reservoir.
Compare the fluid level to the markings on the side of the reservoir. When the fluid is at normal
ambient temperature, approximately 21°C to 27°C (70°F to 80°F), the fluid level should read
between the MAX. and MIN. markings. When the fluid is hot, fluid level is allowed to read up to the
MAX. line.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
REFRIGERANT CHARGE CAPACITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1673
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Type......................................................................................................................................................
.........................................................................R-134a
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Refrigerant - Description
Refrigerant: Description and Operation Refrigerant - Description
A/C REFRIGERANT
The refrigerant used in this air conditioning system is a HydroFluoroCarbon (HFC), type R-134a.
Unlike R-12, which is a ChloroFluoroCarbon (CFC), R-134a refrigerant does not contain
ozone-depleting chlorine. R-134a refrigerant is a nontoxic, nonflammable, clear and colorless
liquefied gas.
CAUTION: R-134a refrigerant is not compatible with R-12 refrigerant in an A/C system. Even a
small amount of R-12 refrigerant added to an
R-134a refrigerant system will cause A/C compressor failure.
The A/C refrigerant system is filled-for-life at the factory and requires no regular maintenance.
Although not required at specific intervals, the charge level should be checked if system
performance deteriorates or if a noise or leak is suspected See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Refrigerant - Description > Page 1676
Refrigerant: Description and Operation Refrigerant - Operation
OPERATION
R-134a refrigerant is not compatible with R-12 refrigerant in an A/C system. Even a small amount
of R-12 refrigerant added to an R-134a refrigerant system will cause A/C compressor failure,
refrigerant oil sludge or poor A/C system performance. In addition, the poly alkylene glycol (PAG)
synthetic refrigerant oils used in an R-134a refrigerant system are not compatible with the
mineral-based refrigerant oils used in an R-12 refrigerant system.
R-134a refrigerant system service ports, service tool couplers and refrigerant dispensing bottles
have all been designed with unique fittings to ensure that an R-134a refrigerant system is not
accidentally contaminated with the wrong refrigerant (R-12). There are also labels posted in the
engine compartment of the vehicle and on the A/C compressor to identify that the A/C system is
equipped with R-134a refrigerant.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant System - Recovery
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System - Recovery
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM RECOVERY
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: If equipped with the rear heating-A/C system, use a heat gun to heat the underbody lines to
help remove any trapped refrigerant from
the rear A/C system.
When servicing the A/C system, a R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that
meets SAE standard J2788 must be used (1). Per SAE standard J2788, refrigerant recovery
stations must recover 95% of the refrigerant system within 30 minutes at 21.1° C (70° F) and be
able to measure the amount of refrigerant removed from the system to an accuracy of 28 grams (1
oz.). Refer to the operating instructions supplied by the equipment manufacturer for proper care
and use of this equipment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant System - Recovery > Page 1679
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System - Evacuate
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM EVACUATE
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system. Failure to follow this
caution will result in serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: Special effort must be used to prevent moisture from entering the A/C system oil. Moisture
in the oil is very difficult to remove and
will cause a reliability problem with the A/C compressor.
If an A/C compressor designed to use R-134a refrigerant is left open to the atmosphere for an
extended period of time. It is recommended that the refrigerant oil be drained and replaced with
new oil or a new A/C compressor be used. This will eliminate the possibility of contaminating the
refrigerant system.
If the refrigerant system has been open to the atmosphere, it must be evacuated before the system
can be filled. Moisture and air mixed with the refrigerant will raise the compressor head pressure
above acceptable operating levels. This will reduce the performance of the A/C system and
damage the A/C compressor. Moisture will boil at near room temperature when exposed to
vacuum. To evacuate the refrigerant system:
NOTE: When connecting the service equipment coupling to the line fitting, verify that the valve of
the coupling is fully closed. This will reduce
the amount of effort required to make the connection.
1. Recover the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 2. With the engine OFF, connect a suitable charging station,
refrigerant recovery machine or a manifold gauge set with vacuum pump and refrigerant
recovery equipment See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System
Recovery. Do not operate the engine with a vacuum on the A/C system.
3. Open the suction and discharge valves and start the vacuum pump. The vacuum pump should
run a minimum of 45 minutes prior to charge to
eliminate all moisture in system. When the suction gauge reads to the lowest degree of vacuum
possible (approximately -88 kPa (- 26 in. Hg) or greater) for 30 minutes, close all valves and turn
off vacuum pump. If the system fails to reach specified vacuum, the refrigerant system likely has a
leak that must be corrected. If the refrigerant system maintains specified vacuum for at least 30
minutes, start the vacuum pump, open the suction and discharge valves. Then allow the system to
evacuate an additional 10 minutes.
4. Close all valves. Turn off and disconnect the vacuum pump. 5. Charge the refrigerant system
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant System - Recovery > Page 1680
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System - Charge
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM CHARGE
WARNING: Review safety precautions and warnings before performing this procedure See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service Precautions/Caution . Failure
to follow these instructions may result in serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The Underhood HVAC Specification Label contains the refrigerant fill specification of the
vehicle being serviced.
After all refrigerant system leaks have been repaired and the refrigerant system has been
evacuated, a refrigerant charge can be injected into the system See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Specifications/Capacity Specifications.
When charging the A/C system, a R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that meets
SAE standard J2788 must be used (1). Per SAE standard J2788, refrigerant recovery stations must
charge the system to an accuracy of 14 grams (0.5 oz.). Refer to the operating instructions
supplied by the equipment manufacturer for proper care and use of this equipment.
CHARGING PROCEDURE
CAUTION: A small amount of refrigerant oil is removed from the A/C system each time the
refrigerant system is recovered and evacuated.
Before charging the A/C system, you MUST replenish any oil lost during the recovery process. See
the equipment manufacturer instructions for more information.
1. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 2. Connect a manifold gauge set or R-134a refrigerant
recovery/recycling/charging station that meets SAE standard J2788 to the refrigerant system. 3.
Measure the proper amount of refrigerant and heat it to 52° C (125° F) with the charging station.
See the operating instructions supplied by the
equipment manufacturer for proper use of this equipment.
4. Open both the suction and discharge valves, then open the charge valve to allow the heated
refrigerant to flow into the system. 5. When the transfer of refrigerant has stopped, close both the
suction and discharge valves. 6. If all of the refrigerant charge did not transfer from the dispensing
device, open all of the windows in the vehicle and set the heating-A/C system
controls so that the A/C compressor is engaged and the blower motor is operating at its lowest
speed setting. Run the engine at a steady high idle (about 1400 rpm). If the A/C compressor does
not engage, test the compressor clutch control circuit and repair as required.
7. Open the low-side valve to allow the remaining refrigerant to transfer to the refrigerant system.
WARNING: Take care not to open the discharge (high pressure) valve at this time. Failure to follow
this warning could result in possible
serious or fatal injury.
8. Disconnect the charging station and manifold gauge set from the refrigerant system service
ports. 9. Reinstall the caps onto the refrigerant system service ports.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL CAPACITIES
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1685
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Type......................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................ND-8 PAG
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Refrigerant Oil - Description
Refrigerant Oil: Description and Operation Refrigerant Oil - Description
DESCRIPTION
The refrigerant oil used in R-134a refrigerant systems is a synthetic-based, poly alkylene glycol
(PAG), wax-free lubricant. Mineral-based R-12 refrigerant oils are not compatible with PAG oils and
should never be introduced to an R-134a refrigerant system.
There are different PAG oils available and each contain a different additive package. Always use
only the type of refrigerant oil recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant system oil level when replacing an A/C compressor
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level . Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level can prevent the
A/C system from operating as designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
The A/C compressors used in this vehicle is designed to use ND-8 PAG refrigerant oil. Use only
this type of refrigerant oil in the refrigerant system.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Refrigerant Oil - Description > Page 1688
Refrigerant Oil: Description and Operation Refrigerant Oil - Operation
OPERATION
After performing any refrigerant recovery or recycling operation, always replenish the refrigerant
system with the same amount of the recommended refrigerant oil as was removed. Too little
refrigerant oil can cause A/C compressor damage, and too much can reduce A/C system
performance.
PAG refrigerant oil is more hygroscopic than mineral oil, and will absorb any moisture it comes into
contact with, even moisture in the air. The PAG oil container should always be kept tightly capped
until it is ready to be used. After use, recap the oil container immediately to prevent moisture
contamination.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 1689
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
REFRIGERANT OIL LEVEL
When an A/C system is assembled at the factory, all components except the A/C compressor are
refrigerant oil free. After the refrigerant system has been charged and operated, the refrigerant oil
in the A/C compressor is dispersed throughout the refrigerant system. The A/C receiver/drier, A/C
evaporator, A/C condenser and the A/C compressor will each retain a significant amount of the
needed refrigerant oil.
It is important to have the correct amount of refrigerant oil in the A/C system. This ensures proper
lubrication of the A/C compressor. Too little oil will result in damage to the A/C compressor, while
too much oil will reduce the cooling capacity of the A/C system and consequently result in higher
discharge air temperatures.
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant system oil level when replacing an A/C compressor.
Drain the refrigerant oil from the A/C
compressor using the procedures described below. Failure to properly drain the refrigerant oil from
the A/C compressor can prevent the A/C system from operating as designed and cause serious
compressor damage.
CAUTION: ND-8 PAG refrigerant oil is used in the A/C system. Only refrigerant oil of the same type
should be used to service this R-134a
A/C system. Do not use any other refrigerant oil. The refrigerant oil container should be kept tightly
capped until it is ready for use and then tightly capped after use to prevent contamination from
moisture and dirt. Refrigerant oil will quickly absorb any moisture it comes in contact with,
therefore, special effort must be used to keep all R-134a system components moisture-free.
Moisture in the refrigerant oil is very difficult to remove and will cause a reliability problem with the
A/C compressor.
NOTE: Most reclaim/recycling equipment will measure the amount of refrigerant oil being removed
during the recovery process. This
amount of refrigerant oil should always be added back into the refrigerant system. Refer to the
reclaim/recycling equipment manufacturers instructions.
It will not be necessary to check the oil level within the A/C refrigerant system or to add oil, unless
there has been an oil loss. A refrigerant oil loss may occur due to component replacement or a
rupture or leak from a refrigerant line, connector fitting, component or component seal. If a leak
does occurs, add 30 milliliters (1 fluid ounce) of the recommended refrigerant oil to the refrigerant
system after the repair has been made. Refrigerant oil loss will be evident at the leak point by the
presence of a wet, shiny surface around the leak.
Refrigerant oil must be added when an A/C receiver/drier, A/C evaporator or A/C condenser is
replaced. Refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities charts.
The refrigerant oil level in a new A/C compressor must first be adjusted prior to compressor
installation. Refer to the following COMPRESSOR OIL DRAIN PROCEDURE.
REFRIGERANT OIL CAPACITIES
COMPRESSOR OIL DRAIN PROCEDURE - DENSO 6SEU16 VARIABLE DISPLACEMENT
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant system oil level when replacing an A/C compressor.
The refrigerant oil in the Denso 6SEU16
A/C compressor can only be drained using the procedure described below. Failure to properly drain
the refrigerant oil from the A/C compressor can prevent the A/C system from operating as designed
and cause serious compressor damage.
If the Denso 6SEU16 A/C compressor is being replaced, some refrigerant oil must first be drained
from the replacement A/C compressor. The 6SEU16 A/C compressor is filled with 100 milliliters
(3.4 oz.) from the factory. Drain 50 milliliters (1.7 oz.) of refrigerant oil from the replacement
6SEU16 compressor. Use the following procedure to drain and measure refrigerant oil from the
Denso 6SEU16 A/C compressor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 1690
1. Place the replacement A/C compressor (2) on a workbench and remove the drain plug (1).
CAUTION: The 6SEU16 A/C compressor is filled with 100 milliliters (3.4 oz.) from the factory. Drain
50 milliliters (1.7 oz.) of refrigerant oil
from the new 6SEU16 compressor when replacing only the compressor.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, see the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart
to determine how much oil should be
removed from the replacement A/C compressor (example: new 6SEU16 compressor and
receiver/drier requires 80 ml. (2.7 oz.) of oil to be added to the system. 100 ml. (3.4 oz.) of oil is in
replacement compressor. 100 ml. (3.4 oz.) minus 80 ml. (2.7 oz.) equals 20 ml. (0.7 oz.) oil to be
drained from replacement compressor).
2. Position the replacement A/C compressor so that the refrigerant oil can drain out of the drain
port into a suitable clean measured container. Hold
the replacement A/C compressor in this position until the required amount of refrigerant oil is
drained from the compressor.
CAUTION: Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level prior to installation of a replacement
compressor can prevent the A/C system
from operating as designed and cause serious compressor damage.
3. Reinstall the drain plug. Tighten the drain plug securely. 4. Install the replacement A/C
compressor onto the engine See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Compressor HVAC/Service and
Repair/A/C
Compressor - Installation.
COMPRESSOR OIL DRAIN PROCEDURE - DENSO 10SR15 AND 10SR17 FIXED
DISPLACEMENT
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant system oil level when replacing an A/C compressor.
Failure to properly drain and measure the
refrigerant oil from the A/C compressor can prevent the A/C system from operating as designed
and cause serious compressor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 1691
damage.
The Denso 10SR15 and 10SR17 A/C compressors are filled with refrigerant oil from the factory.
Use the following procedure to drain and measure refrigerant oil from the Denso 10SR15 and
10SR17 A/C compressors.
1. Position the original A/C compressor so that the refrigerant oil can drain out of the suction and
discharge ports into a suitable clean measured
container. Hold the original A/C compressor in this position until all of the refrigerant oil is drained
from the compressor.
2. Drain all of the refrigerant oil from the replacement A/C compressor into a clean measured
container. 3. Refill the replacement A/C compressor with the same amount of refrigerant oil that
was drained out of the original compressor. Use only clean
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
CAUTION: Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level prior to installation of a replacement
compressor can prevent the A/C system
from operating as designed and cause serious compressor damage.
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Compressor HVAC/Service and Repair/A/C Compressor Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake
Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Base Brake Bleeding
BASE BRAKE BLEEDING
NOTE: This bleeding procedure is only for the vehicle's base brakes hydraulic system. For
bleeding the antilock brakes hydraulic system, See:
CAUTION: Before removing the master cylinder reservoir cap, thoroughly clean the cap and master
cylinder fluid reservoir to prevent dirt
and other foreign matter from dropping into the master cylinder fluid reservoir.
NOTE: The following wheel sequence should be used when bleeding the brake hydraulic system.
The use of this wheel sequence will ensure
adequate removal of all trapped air from the brake hydraulic system.
- Left Rear Wheel
- Right Front Wheel
- Right Rear Wheel
- Left Front Wheel
NOTE: When bleeding the brake system, some air may be trapped in the brake lines far upstream,
as much as ten feet from the bleeder screw.
Therefore, it is essential to have a fast flow of a large volume of brake fluid when bleeding the
brakes to ensure all the air gets out.
Pressure bleeding the brakes is recommended, although the brakes may be manually bled or
pressure bled. Refer to the appropriate following procedure.
PRESSURE BLEEDING PROCEDURE
Follow the pressure bleeder manufacturer's instructions for use of the pressure bleeding
equipment.
1. Install Master Cylinder Pressure Bleed Cap, Special Tool 6921, or equivalent on the master
cylinder fluid reservoir. Attach the fluid hose from the
pressure bleeder to the fitting on Special Tool 6921.
2. Attach a clear plastic hose (1) to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar (2)
containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of
the hose.
3. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain a steady stream of brake fluid. 4.
After approximately 120-240 ml (4-8 ounces) of fluid have been bled through the brake circuit and
an air-free flow is maintained in the clear
plastic hose and jar, close the bleeder screw.
5. Repeat this procedure at all the remaining bleeder screws. 6. Check and adjust brake fluid level
to the FULL mark on the reservoir. 7. Check brake pedal travel and feel. If pedal travel is excessive
or if the pedal feels excessively spongy, some air may still be trapped in the system.
Re-bleed the brakes as necessary including the IPB Caliper Brake Bleeding Procedure on the rear
calipers as listed below.
8. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
MANUAL BLEEDING PROCEDURE
NOTE: To bleed the brakes manually, the aid of a helper will be required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake
Bleeding > Page 1696
1. Attach a clear plastic hose (1) to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar (2)
containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of
the hose.
2. Have a helper pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 3. With
the pedal in the down position, open the bleeder screw at least one full turn. 4. Once the brake
pedal has dropped, close the bleeder screw. After the bleeder screw is closed, release the brake
pedal. 5. Repeat the above steps until all trapped air is removed from that wheel circuit (usually
four or five times).
6. Bleed the remaining wheel circuits in the same manner until all air is removed from the brake
system. Monitor the fluid level in the master cylinder
reservoir to make sure it does not go dry.
7. Check and adjust brake fluid level to the FULL mark. 8. Check brake pedal travel and feel. If
pedal travel is excessive or if the pedal feels excessively spongy, some air may still be trapped in
the system.
Re-bleed the brakes as necessary including the IPB Caliper Brake Bleeding Procedure on the rear
calipers as listed below.
9. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
IPB CALIPER BRAKE BLEEDING PROCEDURE
NOTE: The following procedure is normally only necessary if a rear brake caliper has been
removed and installed, or replaced.
Perform the following procedure on each rear brake caliper as necessary.
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: 2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel
assembly (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake
Bleeding > Page 1697
3. Remove the brake caliper lower guide pin bolt (1). 4. Swing the caliper assembly upward,
pivoting off the upper guide pin, until clear of the adapter bracket.
5. Remove the outboard pad (5) from the adapter bracket. 6. Return the caliper back down over the
adapter bracket into mounted position and install the lower guide pin bolt finger tight. 7. Slowly
pump the brake pedal until the caliper fingers touch the outboard surface of the brake rotor.
Release the pedal. 8. Remove the brake caliper lower guide pin bolt. 9. Swing the caliper assembly
upward, pivoting off the upper guide pin, until clear of the adapter bracket.
10. Reinstall the outboard pad in the adapter bracket. 11. Open the caliper bleeder screw at least
one full turn.
12. Seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake
Bleeding > Page 1698
e. Thread the screw drive on 8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the
caliper piston. Do not over tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
13. Close the bleeder screw. 14. Return the caliper back down over the adapter bracket into
mounted position and install the lower guide pin bolt finger tight. 15. Have a helper pump the brake
pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 16. With the pedal in the down position,
open the bleeder screw at least one full turn and let out fluid and air, if any. 17. Once the brake
pedal has dropped, close the bleeder screw. Once the bleeder screw is closed, release the brake
pedal. 18. Repeat the previous three steps until all trapped air is removed. 19. Tighten the guide
pin bolt to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.). 20. Repeat the above procedure on the opposite rear brake caliper
as necessary. 21. Check brake pedal travel and feel. If pedal travel is still excessive or if the pedal
feels excessively spongy, repeat the entire procedure as
necessary.
22. Install the tire and wheel assembly See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Install
and tighten wheel mounting nuts to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
23. Lower the vehicle. 24. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and
pedal feel is correct.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake
Bleeding > Page 1699
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System Bleeding
ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The base brake's hydraulic system must be bled anytime air enters the hydraulic system. The ABS
must always be bled anytime it is suspected that the HCU has ingested air.
Brake systems with ABS must be bled as two independent braking systems. The non-ABS portion
of the brake system with ABS is to be bled the same as any non-ABS system.
The ABS portion of the brake system must be bled separately. Use the following procedure to
properly bleed the brake hydraulic system including the ABS.
NOTE: During the brake bleeding procedure, be sure the brake fluid level remains close to the
FULL level in the master cylinder fluid
reservoir. Check the fluid level periodically during the bleeding procedure and add Mopar(R) DOT 3
brake fluid as required.
BLEEDING
When bleeding the ABS system, the following bleeding sequence must be followed to insure
complete and adequate bleeding.
1. Make sure all hydraulic fluid lines are installed and properly torqued. 2. Connect the scan tool to
the diagnostics connector. The diagnostic connector is located under the lower steering column
cover to the left of the
steering column.
3. Using the scan tool, check to make sure the ABM does not have any fault codes stored. If it
does, clear them.
WARNING: When bleeding the brake system wear safety glasses. A clear bleed tube (1) must be
attached to the bleeder screws and submerged
in a clear container filled part way with clean brake fluid (2). Direct the flow of brake fluid away from
yourself and the painted surfaces of the vehicle. Brake fluid at high pressure may come out of the
bleeder screws when opened.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding is recommended to bleed the base brake system to ensure all air is
removed from system. Manual bleeding may also
be used, but additional time is needed to remove all air from system.
4. Bleed the base brake system. See: 5. Using the scan tool, select ECU VIEW, followed by ABS
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS to access bleeding. Follow the instructions
displayed. When finished, disconnect the scan tool and proceed.
6. Bleed the base brake system a second time. Check brake fluid level in the reservoir periodically
to prevent emptying, causing air to enter the
hydraulic system.
7. Fill the master cylinder fluid reservoir to the FULL level. 8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure the
brakes are operating correctly and that the brake pedal does not feel spongy.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > Circuit Breaker 1
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > Circuit Breaker 1 > Page 1705
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM)
Circuit Breaker: Diagrams Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM)
Connector - (IN TIPM)
CIRCUIT BREAKER 1 - (IN TIPM)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM) > Page 1708
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM) > Page 1709
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM) > Page 1710
Circuit Breaker: Diagrams Power Seat Circuit Breaker (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
CIRCUIT BREAKER-POWER SEAT - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module
Fuse: Locations Totally Integrated Power Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 1715
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 1716
The Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) is located in the engine compartment near the air
cleaner assembly. This center contains fuses and relays.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 1717
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 1718
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 1719
Fuse: Locations Fuse Locations/Types
FUSES/TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (TIPM)
TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (TIPM)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 1720
The Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) is located in the engine compartment near the air
cleaner assembly. This center contains fuses and relays.
CAUTION:
- When installing the power module cover, it is important to ensure the cover is properly positioned
and fully latched. Failure to do so may allow water to get into the TIPM, and possibly result in an
electrical system failure.
- When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to use only a fuse having the correct amperage
rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than indicated may result in a dangerous electrical
system overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem in the circuit that
must be corrected.
Relays
FUSE LOCATIONS AND TYPES
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 1721
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 1722
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 1723
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1724
Fuse: Application and ID
Connector - (IN TIPM)
CIRCUIT BREAKER 1 - (IN TIPM)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1725
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1726
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Description and
Operation > IOD Fuse - Description
Fuse: Description and Operation IOD Fuse - Description
DESCRIPTION
All vehicles are equipped with an Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse that is disconnected within the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) when the vehicle is shipped from the factory. Dealer
personnel are to reconnect the IOD fuse in the TIPM as part of the preparation procedures
performed just prior to new vehicle delivery.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Description and
Operation > IOD Fuse - Description > Page 1729
Fuse: Description and Operation IOD Fuse - Operation
OPERATION
The term ignition-off draw identifies a normal condition where power is being drained from the
battery with the ignition switch in the Off position. The IOD fuse feeds the memory and sleep mode
functions for some of the electronic modules in the vehicle as well as various other accessories that
require battery current when the ignition switch is in the OFF position, including the clock. The only
reason the IOD fuse is disconnected is to reduce the normal IOD of the vehicle electrical system
during new vehicle transportation and pre-delivery storage to reduce battery depletion, while still
allowing vehicle operation so that the vehicle can be loaded, unloaded and moved as needed by
both vehicle transportation company and dealer personnel.
Dealer personnel must reconnect the IOD fuse when the vehicle is being prepared for delivery in
order to restore full electrical system operation. Once the vehicle is prepared for delivery, the IOD
function of this fuse becomes transparent and the fuse that has been assigned the IOD designation
becomes only another Fused B(+) circuit fuse. The IOD fuse serves no useful purpose to the
dealer technician in the service or diagnosis of any vehicle system or condition, other than the
same purpose as that of any other standard circuit protection device.
The IOD fuse can be used by the vehicle owner as a convenient means of reducing battery
depletion when a vehicle is to be stored for periods not to exceed about thirty days. However, it
must be remembered that disconnecting the IOD fuse will not eliminate IOD, but only reduce this
normal condition. If a vehicle will be stored for more than about thirty days, the battery negative
cable should be disconnected to eliminate normal IOD; and, the battery should be tested and
recharged at regular intervals during the vehicle storage period to prevent the battery from
becoming discharged or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Service and
Repair > IOD Fuse - Removal
Fuse: Service and Repair IOD Fuse - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: When removing or installing the Ignition Off Draw (IOD) fuse, it is important that the ignition
switch be in the OFF position. Failure
to place the ignition switch in the OFF position can cause the radio display to become scrambled
when the IOD fuse is installed. Removing and installing the IOD fuse again with the ignition switch
in the OFF position will usually correct the scrambled radio display condition.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Remove the cover from the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). 3. Pull on IOD fuse (J13) holder until it reaches the first detent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Service and
Repair > IOD Fuse - Removal > Page 1732
Fuse: Service and Repair IOD Fuse - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Push on IOD fuse until completely seated. 2. Install the cover to the Totally Integrated Power
Module (TIPM).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1737
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1738
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1739
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1740
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1741
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1742
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1743
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1744
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1745
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1746
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1747
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1748
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1749
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1750
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1751
Fuse Block: Application and ID
Integrated Power Module 8W-13-01
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1752
Fuse Block: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
An electrical Junction Block (JB) is located next to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
The JB combines the functions previously provided by a separate relay center. It also serves to
simplify and centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to
many of the accessory systems in the vehicle. It eliminates the need for numerous splice
connections and serves in place of a bulkhead connector between many of the engine
compartment, instrument panel, and body wire harnesses. The junction block is replaced as part of
the engine harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fusible Link > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Run Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Run Relay > Page 1760
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Run Relay > Page 1761
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams
> Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Relay Box: Diagrams Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams
> Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 1764
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Accessory Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/ACCESSORY - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams
> Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 1765
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Start Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/START - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 1766
Relay Box: Application and ID
Integrated Power Module 8W-13-01
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 1767
Relay Box: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
An electrical Junction Block (JB) is located next to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
The JB combines the functions previously provided by a separate relay center. It also serves to
simplify and centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to
many of the accessory systems in the vehicle. It eliminates the need for numerous splice
connections and serves in place of a bulkhead connector between many of the engine
compartment, instrument panel, and body wire harnesses. The junction block is replaced as part of
the engine harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Vehicle Information Center Setup
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Vehicle Information Center
Setup
NUMBER: 08-002-09
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: February 4, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-014-07, DATED JULY 11,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITIONAL YEARS AND MODELS.
SUBJECT: Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Oil Change Indicator System - Dealer
Preferences During Prep
MODELS:
2008 (DR) Ram Truck
**2009 (HB) Durango**
**2009 (HG) Aspen**
**2009 (JC) Journey**
**2008 - 2009 (KA) Nitro**
**2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty**
**2009 (LC) Challenger**
**2008 - 2009 (LX) 300 / Magnum / Charger**
**2008 - 2009 (RI) Caravan / Town & Country**
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a programmable EVIC.
DISCUSSION:
**Many models now include an oil change indicator system**. This system displays an "Oil Change
Required" or "Oil Change" message at appropriate intervals on the instrument cluster.
The vehicles listed above may be equipped with a programmable display on the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center, (EVIC). The "Oil Change Required message may also include the dealerships
name and phone number which can be programmed into the vehicle with the StarSCAN(R) or
StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
NOTE:
**Other vehicles may be added at any time. Dealers can determine if the feature is available by
following the procedures below. If Enable/Disable Dealer Contact Information is active, the feature
can be used to enter the servicing dealer's information.**
The following procedure describes the steps to add, delete or change a dealership name and
phone number on the display.
NOTE:
If NOT programmed during vehicle prep, customer approval MUST be obtained before adding or
changing this information.
NOTE:
When performing this Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN(R) or
StarMOBILE(R); must be programmed with the latest level software. The software release level is
visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) screen.
1. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R). (in Pass-Through Mode)
NOTE:
To use the StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode requires that StarMOBILE(R) be connected to
the dealership network via a wired or wireless connection. For more information on how to use the
StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode, see the StarMOBILE(R) training tutorials available on
DealerCONNECT > Service > Repair > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Tools link or at the
website.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Vehicle Information Center Setup > Page 1773
2. From the Home Screen, enter "ECU VIEW or "VEHICLE PREP".
3. Select "CCN".
4. Select "Misc. Functions".
5. Select "Enable/Disable Dealer Contact Information".
6. Select "Enable" or "Disable" as desired.
7. If enabled, select "Program Dealer Contact Information" and follow on screen prompts.
8. "Reset will cause display to read: "Contact Dealer" as default.
9. Select finish to exit.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair > EVIC Equipped Vehicles
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair EVIC Equipped Vehicles
Oil Change Required
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change indicator system. The Oil Change Required
message will flash in the EVIC for approximately 5 seconds after a single chime has sounded to
indicate the next scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change indicator system is duty
cycle based, which means the engine oil change interval may fluctuate dependent upon your
personal driving style.
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each time you turn the ignition switch to the ON
position. To turn off the message temporarily, press and release the MENU button on the
instrument cluster. To reset the oil change indicator system (after performing the scheduled
maintenance) perform the following procedure:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Do not start the engine). 2. Fully depress the
accelerator pedal slowly three times within 10 seconds. 3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK
position.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you start the vehicle, the oil change indicator
system did not reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair > EVIC Equipped Vehicles > Page 1776
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair Non-EVIC Equipped Vehicles
Change Oil Message (Base and Mid Line Clusters)
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change indicator system. The CHANGE OIL message
will flash in the instrument cluster odometer for approximately 12 seconds after a single chime has
sounded to indicate the next scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change indicator system
is duty cycle based, which means the engine oil change interval may fluctuate dependent upon
your personal driving style.
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each time you turn the ignition switch to the ON
position. To turn off the message temporarily, press and release the TRIP ODOMETER button on
the instrument cluster. To reset the oil change indicator system (after performing the scheduled
maintenance) perform the following procedure:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Do not start the engine). 2. Fully depress the
accelerator pedal slowly three times within 10 seconds. 3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK
position.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you start the vehicle, the oil change indicator
system did not reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Vehicle Lifting: Service and Repair
HOISTING
Refer to Owner's Manual provided with vehicle for proper emergency jacking procedures.
WARNING: The hoisting and jack lifting points provided are for a complete vehicle. When the
engine or rear suspension is removed from a
vehicle, the center of gravity is altered making some hoisting conditions unstable. Properly support
or secure vehicle to hoisting device when these conditions exist. Failure to follow these instructions
may result in personal injury or death.
CAUTION: Do not position hoisting device on suspension components, damage to vehicle can
result.Do not attempt to raise one entire side of
the vehicle by placing a floor jack midway between the front and rear wheels. This practice may
result in permanent damage to the body.
When properly positioned, a floor jack can be used to lift the vehicle and support the raised vehicle
with jack stands.
A floor jack or any lifting device, must never be used on any part of the underbody other then the
described areas.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION
CAUTION: The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPM system
pressures have been established for the tire size equipped on the vehicle. Undesirable system
operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same
size, type, or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause sensor damage. Do not use aftermarket tire
sealants or balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with TPM, as damage to the sensors may
result.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. Use tire
pressure sensors in original style factory wheels
only. If aftermarket wheels are installed, and therefore do not contain tire pressure sensors, the
system will not function properly and the driver will be continuously notified of a system
malfunction.
CAUTION: After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure always reinstall the valve stem cap. This
will prevent moisture and dirt from
entering the valve stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Sensor.
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensor valve stem caps and cores are specially designed for the sensors.
Due to risk of corrosion, do not use a
standard valve stem cap or core in a tire pressure sensor in place of the original equipment style
sensor cap and core.
CAUTION: Any time a sensor is to be installed in a wheel, it is necessary to install a new
sensor-to-wheel seal, metal washer and valve stem
nut, to ensure air tight sealing.
CAUTION: When installing the valve core, be sure to tighten the core to specifications See:
Wheels/Specifications . Overtightening by a little as
three or four inch pounds can damage the sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM), one tire pressure sensor (6) is
mounted to each wheel (5) in place of the traditional tire valve stem. Each sensor has an internal
battery that lasts up to 10 years. The battery is not serviceable. At the time of battery failure, the
sensor must be replaced.
The TPM system operates on a 433 MHz radio frequency. The 433 MHz sensors (1) can be easily
identified by the part number.
CAUTION: Although additional sensors operating at 433 MHz sensors are available and are used
in other applications, they are not
interchangeable. Always make sure the correct sensor is being used and be sure to replace the
sensor with the correct part number.
NOTE: Once mounted inside a tire and wheel assembly you are not able to visually see the
difference between this sensor and other 315 MHz
and 433 MHz sensors. At that point, the TPM/RKE Analyzer 9936, with the Scan Tool may be used
to identify the sensor frequency or the tire can be dismounted allowing visual inspection of the
sensor body and part number.
The TPM sensors are designed for original style factory wheels. It is not recommended to install a
tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel (This could cause sealing and system performance
issues). Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. If aftermarket
wheels are installed and do not contain tire pressure sensors, the system will not function properly
and the driver will be continuously notified of a system malfunction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description >
Page 1787
The serviceable components of the tire pressure sensor are:
- Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2) and Metal Washer (1)
- Valve Stem Cap (4)
- Valve Stem Core
- Valve Stem Nut (with pressed-in washer) (3)
NOTE: Any time a sensor is installed on a wheel, a new Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2), Metal Washer
(1) and Valve Stem Nut (3) must be installed
to ensure air tight sealing. A service kit is available.
The valve stem caps and cores are specifically designed for the tire pressure monitoring sensors.
Although similar to standard valve stem caps and cores, they are different. The valve stem cap has
a special seal inside to keep moisture and corrosion out. The valve stem core has a special nickel
coating to protect from corrosion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description >
Page 1788
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The battery operated tire pressure sensor is both a transmitter and a receiver. The TPM sensor can
be forced to transmit by using a special tool such as a TPM-RKE Analyzer. Using a TPM-RKE
Analyzer can take up to a minute to force a transmission from a sensor.
NOTE: The TPM-RKE Analyzer will not define the mode.
The TPM sensor can be in one of the following operating modes:
- OFF MODE - A new TPM sensor will be in this mode. In this mode the sensor does not transmit
periodically on its own. By forcing a transmission from the sensor with the TPM-RKE Analyzer, it
will change to the STATIONARY MODE. The sensor will also automatically change from OFF
mode to the STATIONARY MODE once it experiences a great increase in pressure (i.e. installation
into a wheel/tire assembly and then inflated).
- WAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes when the vehicle is driven over
15mph (24km/h), but only after the vehicle was previously parked for a duration of 18 minutes or
greater. In WAL MODE the sensors transmit every 33 seconds and these transmissions contain
left/right information that allows the TPM Module to determine sensor location on the vehicle. WAL
MODE lasts for the first 10 minutes of consecutive driving, then NORMAL DRIVE mode ensues.
- FACTORY MODE- This is a special case of WAL MODE. If a TPM sensor has just been taken out
of OFF MODE, then for the first 3 minutes of the WAL period (10 minutes) the sensors transmit at
an accelerated rate of every 10 seconds. After the first 20 drives, then the sensors never again
transmit out of FACTORY MODE.
- NORMAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes after the first 10 minutes of a
drive. In NORMAL MODE the sensors transmit every 66 seconds and cease transmitting left/right
information.
- SERVICE MODE- Once a vehicle stops, the sensors go into SERVICE MODE. After 18 minutes
of no driving then the sensors go into the STATIONARY MODE. If the vehicle was stopped for less
than 18 minutes and driving resumes, then the sensors go back to the NORMAL MODE.
- STATIONARY MODE - When a vehicle has been stopped for more then 18 minutes, then the
sensor is forced into STATIONARY MODE. In STATIONARY MODE the sensor never transmits
any pressure information. The sensor leaves STATIONARY MODE and enters WAL MODE when
the vehicle is driven above 15mph (24km/h).
Each sensor's (transmitter) broadcast is uniquely coded so that the TPM module can monitor the
state of each of the sensors on the four rotating road wheels. The TPM module can automatically
learn and store the sensor's ID while driving "within 20 minutes continuously above 15 mph (24
km/h)" after a sensor has been replaced. The vehicle must be stationary for more then 20 minutes
in order to initiate the learning sequence. The TPM module can also learn the sensor's ID using the
TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool following the procedure listed in the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly.
CAUTION: The cap used on this valve stem contains an O-ring seal to prevent contamination and
moisture from entering the valve stem.
Retain this valve stem cap for reuse. Do not substitute a regular valve stem cap in its place.
CAUTION: The valve stem used on this vehicle is made of aluminum and the core is nickel plated
brass. The original valve stem core must be
reinstalled and not substituted with a valve stem core made of a different material. This is required
to prevent corrosion in the valve stem caused by the different metals.
3. Dismount tire from wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions while paying special
attention to the following to avoid damaging the
pressure sensor: a. When breaking the tire bead loose from the wheel rim, avoid using the Bead
Breaker in the area of the sensor (1). That includes both outer and
inner beads of the tire.
b. When preparing to dismount the tire from the wheel, carefully insert the mounting/dismounting
tool 280° from the valve stem ± 10°, then
proceed to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use this process on both outer and inner tire beads.
4. Remove sensor nut (3) retaining sensor to wheel. While removing nut, hold pressure against
rear of metal valve stem to keep valve stem from
pushing rearward, damaging antenna strap.
5. Remove sensor (1) from wheel (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1791
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before reinstalling an existing tire pressure sensor, replace seal (2) and metal washer (1) at
base of sensor valve stem (6) to ensure
proper sealing.
1. Wipe area clean around sensor/valve stem mounting hole in wheel (5). Make sure surface of
wheel is not damaged.
CAUTION: To avoid damaging sensor antenna strap (1), if equipped, hold pressure against rear of
metal valve stem (2) while sensor is
inserted through wheel mounting hole and nut is installed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1792
2. Insert sensor (1) through wheel (2) as shown keeping pressure against rear of metal valve stem
(See Arrow). Potted side of sensor is to be
positioned toward wheel. Do not attempt to mount sensor otherwise, damage may occur.
3. Install sensor nut (with pressed-in washer) (3) by hand.
NOTE: Before tightening sensor nut, push downward on sensor housing (2) in an attempt to make
it flush with interior contour of wheel (1).
4. While holding sensor in position, tighten sensor nut to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Over-torquing the sensor nut by as little as 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.) may result in sensor
separation from the valve stem. Under this
condition, the sensor may still function. However, the condition should be corrected immediately.
5. Mount tire on wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions, paying special attention to
the following to avoid damaging tire pressure
sensor: a.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1793
Rotating Wheel Tire Changers - Once the wheel is mounted to the changer, position the sensor
valve stem (2) approximately 280° from the head of the changer (located at 1) in a clockwise
direction before rotating the wheel (also in a clockwise direction) to mount the tire. Use this
procedure on both the outer and inner tire beads.
b.
Rotating Tool Tire Changers - Position the wheel on the changer so that the sensor valve stem (1)
is located approximately 210° clockwise from the installation end of the mounting/dismounting tool
(2) once the tool is mounted for tire installation. Make sure the sensor is clear of the lower bead
breaker area (3) to avoid damaging the sensor when the breaker rises. Rotate the tool (2) in a
counterclockwise direction to mount the tire. Use this procedure on both the upper and lower tire
beads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1794
6. Adjust air pressure to that listed on Tire Inflation Pressure Label (Placard) provided with vehicle
(applied to driver's side B-pillar). Make sure
original style and color valve stem cap is securely installed to keep moisture out of sensor.
7. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) on vehicle See: Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Tighten wheel
mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower vehicle. 9. Perform one of the following to make the system learn the new sensor ID.
a. Use the TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool to program the WIN with the
tire pressure sensor ID. This is part of the
TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
b. Once the vehicle has remained stationary for more than 20 minutes, drive vehicle for a minimum
of 10 minutes while maintaining a continuous
speed above 15 mph (24 km/h). During this time, the system will learn the new sensor ID. This is
part of the TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
NOTE: If a sensor cannot be trained, refer to appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service Precautions
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION
CAUTION: The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPM system
pressures have been established for the tire size equipped on the vehicle. Undesirable system
operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same
size, type, or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause sensor damage. Do not use aftermarket tire
sealants or balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with TPM, as damage to the sensors may
result.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. Use tire
pressure sensors in original style factory wheels
only. If aftermarket wheels are installed, and therefore do not contain tire pressure sensors, the
system will not function properly and the driver will be continuously notified of a system
malfunction.
CAUTION: After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure always reinstall the valve stem cap. This
will prevent moisture and dirt from
entering the valve stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Sensor.
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensor valve stem caps and cores are specially designed for the sensors.
Due to risk of corrosion, do not use a
standard valve stem cap or core in a tire pressure sensor in place of the original equipment style
sensor cap and core.
CAUTION: Any time a sensor is to be installed in a wheel, it is necessary to install a new
sensor-to-wheel seal, metal washer and valve stem
nut, to ensure air tight sealing.
CAUTION: When installing the valve core, be sure to tighten the core to specifications See:
Wheels/Specifications . Overtightening by a little as
three or four inch pounds can damage the sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM), one tire pressure sensor (6) is
mounted to each wheel (5) in place of the traditional tire valve stem. Each sensor has an internal
battery that lasts up to 10 years. The battery is not serviceable. At the time of battery failure, the
sensor must be replaced.
The TPM system operates on a 433 MHz radio frequency. The 433 MHz sensors (1) can be easily
identified by the part number.
CAUTION: Although additional sensors operating at 433 MHz sensors are available and are used
in other applications, they are not
interchangeable. Always make sure the correct sensor is being used and be sure to replace the
sensor with the correct part number.
NOTE: Once mounted inside a tire and wheel assembly you are not able to visually see the
difference between this sensor and other 315 MHz
and 433 MHz sensors. At that point, the TPM/RKE Analyzer 9936, with the Scan Tool may be used
to identify the sensor frequency or the tire can be dismounted allowing visual inspection of the
sensor body and part number.
The TPM sensors are designed for original style factory wheels. It is not recommended to install a
tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel (This could cause sealing and system performance
issues). Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. If aftermarket
wheels are installed and do not contain tire pressure sensors, the system will not function properly
and the driver will be continuously notified of a system malfunction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description > Page 1801
The serviceable components of the tire pressure sensor are:
- Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2) and Metal Washer (1)
- Valve Stem Cap (4)
- Valve Stem Core
- Valve Stem Nut (with pressed-in washer) (3)
NOTE: Any time a sensor is installed on a wheel, a new Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2), Metal Washer
(1) and Valve Stem Nut (3) must be installed
to ensure air tight sealing. A service kit is available.
The valve stem caps and cores are specifically designed for the tire pressure monitoring sensors.
Although similar to standard valve stem caps and cores, they are different. The valve stem cap has
a special seal inside to keep moisture and corrosion out. The valve stem core has a special nickel
coating to protect from corrosion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description > Page 1802
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The battery operated tire pressure sensor is both a transmitter and a receiver. The TPM sensor can
be forced to transmit by using a special tool such as a TPM-RKE Analyzer. Using a TPM-RKE
Analyzer can take up to a minute to force a transmission from a sensor.
NOTE: The TPM-RKE Analyzer will not define the mode.
The TPM sensor can be in one of the following operating modes:
- OFF MODE - A new TPM sensor will be in this mode. In this mode the sensor does not transmit
periodically on its own. By forcing a transmission from the sensor with the TPM-RKE Analyzer, it
will change to the STATIONARY MODE. The sensor will also automatically change from OFF
mode to the STATIONARY MODE once it experiences a great increase in pressure (i.e. installation
into a wheel/tire assembly and then inflated).
- WAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes when the vehicle is driven over
15mph (24km/h), but only after the vehicle was previously parked for a duration of 18 minutes or
greater. In WAL MODE the sensors transmit every 33 seconds and these transmissions contain
left/right information that allows the TPM Module to determine sensor location on the vehicle. WAL
MODE lasts for the first 10 minutes of consecutive driving, then NORMAL DRIVE mode ensues.
- FACTORY MODE- This is a special case of WAL MODE. If a TPM sensor has just been taken out
of OFF MODE, then for the first 3 minutes of the WAL period (10 minutes) the sensors transmit at
an accelerated rate of every 10 seconds. After the first 20 drives, then the sensors never again
transmit out of FACTORY MODE.
- NORMAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes after the first 10 minutes of a
drive. In NORMAL MODE the sensors transmit every 66 seconds and cease transmitting left/right
information.
- SERVICE MODE- Once a vehicle stops, the sensors go into SERVICE MODE. After 18 minutes
of no driving then the sensors go into the STATIONARY MODE. If the vehicle was stopped for less
than 18 minutes and driving resumes, then the sensors go back to the NORMAL MODE.
- STATIONARY MODE - When a vehicle has been stopped for more then 18 minutes, then the
sensor is forced into STATIONARY MODE. In STATIONARY MODE the sensor never transmits
any pressure information. The sensor leaves STATIONARY MODE and enters WAL MODE when
the vehicle is driven above 15mph (24km/h).
Each sensor's (transmitter) broadcast is uniquely coded so that the TPM module can monitor the
state of each of the sensors on the four rotating road wheels. The TPM module can automatically
learn and store the sensor's ID while driving "within 20 minutes continuously above 15 mph (24
km/h)" after a sensor has been replaced. The vehicle must be stationary for more then 20 minutes
in order to initiate the learning sequence. The TPM module can also learn the sensor's ID using the
TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool following the procedure listed in the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly.
CAUTION: The cap used on this valve stem contains an O-ring seal to prevent contamination and
moisture from entering the valve stem.
Retain this valve stem cap for reuse. Do not substitute a regular valve stem cap in its place.
CAUTION: The valve stem used on this vehicle is made of aluminum and the core is nickel plated
brass. The original valve stem core must be
reinstalled and not substituted with a valve stem core made of a different material. This is required
to prevent corrosion in the valve stem caused by the different metals.
3. Dismount tire from wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions while paying special
attention to the following to avoid damaging the
pressure sensor: a. When breaking the tire bead loose from the wheel rim, avoid using the Bead
Breaker in the area of the sensor (1). That includes both outer and
inner beads of the tire.
b. When preparing to dismount the tire from the wheel, carefully insert the mounting/dismounting
tool 280° from the valve stem ± 10°, then
proceed to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use this process on both outer and inner tire beads.
4. Remove sensor nut (3) retaining sensor to wheel. While removing nut, hold pressure against
rear of metal valve stem to keep valve stem from
pushing rearward, damaging antenna strap.
5. Remove sensor (1) from wheel (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1805
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before reinstalling an existing tire pressure sensor, replace seal (2) and metal washer (1) at
base of sensor valve stem (6) to ensure
proper sealing.
1. Wipe area clean around sensor/valve stem mounting hole in wheel (5). Make sure surface of
wheel is not damaged.
CAUTION: To avoid damaging sensor antenna strap (1), if equipped, hold pressure against rear of
metal valve stem (2) while sensor is
inserted through wheel mounting hole and nut is installed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1806
2. Insert sensor (1) through wheel (2) as shown keeping pressure against rear of metal valve stem
(See Arrow). Potted side of sensor is to be
positioned toward wheel. Do not attempt to mount sensor otherwise, damage may occur.
3. Install sensor nut (with pressed-in washer) (3) by hand.
NOTE: Before tightening sensor nut, push downward on sensor housing (2) in an attempt to make
it flush with interior contour of wheel (1).
4. While holding sensor in position, tighten sensor nut to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Over-torquing the sensor nut by as little as 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.) may result in sensor
separation from the valve stem. Under this
condition, the sensor may still function. However, the condition should be corrected immediately.
5. Mount tire on wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions, paying special attention to
the following to avoid damaging tire pressure
sensor: a.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1807
Rotating Wheel Tire Changers - Once the wheel is mounted to the changer, position the sensor
valve stem (2) approximately 280° from the head of the changer (located at 1) in a clockwise
direction before rotating the wheel (also in a clockwise direction) to mount the tire. Use this
procedure on both the outer and inner tire beads.
b.
Rotating Tool Tire Changers - Position the wheel on the changer so that the sensor valve stem (1)
is located approximately 210° clockwise from the installation end of the mounting/dismounting tool
(2) once the tool is mounted for tire installation. Make sure the sensor is clear of the lower bead
breaker area (3) to avoid damaging the sensor when the breaker rises. Rotate the tool (2) in a
counterclockwise direction to mount the tire. Use this procedure on both the upper and lower tire
beads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 1808
6. Adjust air pressure to that listed on Tire Inflation Pressure Label (Placard) provided with vehicle
(applied to driver's side B-pillar). Make sure
original style and color valve stem cap is securely installed to keep moisture out of sensor.
7. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) on vehicle See: Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Tighten wheel
mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower vehicle. 9. Perform one of the following to make the system learn the new sensor ID.
a. Use the TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool to program the WIN with the
tire pressure sensor ID. This is part of the
TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
b. Once the vehicle has remained stationary for more than 20 minutes, drive vehicle for a minimum
of 10 minutes while maintaining a continuous
speed above 15 mph (24 km/h). During this time, the system will learn the new sensor ID. This is
part of the TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
NOTE: If a sensor cannot be trained, refer to appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 22-002-10 > May > 10 > Wheels/Tire - Highway Speed Vibration/Shake
Tires: Customer Interest Wheels/Tire - Highway Speed Vibration/Shake
NUMBER: 22-002-10
GROUP: Wheels/Tires
DATE: May O7, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 22-001-08, DATED APRIL 19, 2008,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE THE ADDITION OF VEHICLE MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Vehicle Vibration / Shake At Highway Speed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin provides information to diagnose vehicle vibration concerns.
MODELS:
2009-**2010** (JC) Journey
DISCUSSION: Tires used on the Journey models include nylon cap material as part of their
construction.
Tires that include Nylon can temporarily "flat spot" when vehicles are shipped by car hauler or rail
and if vehicles are stored for an extended period.
Immediately following delivery, some vehicles may exhibit a vibration / shake due to temporary tire
flat-spotting. The vibration may be felt in the steering wheel and / or seat, and may be most
noticeable at highway speeds, 60mph (96 kph). This may be misinterpreted as an out of balance
tire.
NOTE:
Do not attempt to rebalance the wheel/tire assembly until the vehicle has been driven for an
extended period (20 minutes or more) at highway speeds.
If the tires are flat-spotted, the vehicle vibration will go away after the tires are warmed up,
(normally 10 to 20 minutes of highway driving depending on outside temperatures). If highway
driving doesn't resolve the vehicle vibration, follow the procedures found in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Group 22 - Tires and Wheels > Tire and Wheel Vibration.
Replacing tires should only be done as a last resort after all appropriate wheel and tire diagnostics
have been completed. U.S. dealers can contact the MOPAR tire program if assistance is needed
with obtaining any tire.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
**TIME ALLOWANCE**:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 22-002-11 > Apr > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Alternative 19 Inch Tires
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Alternative 19 Inch Tires
NUMBER: 22-002-11
GROUP: Tires and wheels
DATE: April 02, 2011
SUBJECT: Alternative 19 Inch Tires
OVERVIEW: This bulletin specifies alternative 19 tires that should be used if the Khumo Solus
KH16 P225/55R19 991 All Season (U.S. and Canada Markets Only) is not available.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles sold in U.S. and Canada (sales code YAA and YAC) markets only.
DISCUSSION:
The following 19 tires can be used as aftermarket replacement tires for the 2009 and 2010 model
year Dodge Journey in the event that the Khumo Solus KH16 P225/55R19 991 All Season (U.S.
and Canada Markets Only) are not available.
Approved Alternative Tires:
NOTE:
It is recommended to use these tires only as sets of four.
POLICY: Information Only.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 22-002-10 > May > 10 > Wheels/Tire - Highway Speed
Vibration/Shake
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tire - Highway Speed Vibration/Shake
NUMBER: 22-002-10
GROUP: Wheels/Tires
DATE: May O7, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 22-001-08, DATED APRIL 19, 2008,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE THE ADDITION OF VEHICLE MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Vehicle Vibration / Shake At Highway Speed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin provides information to diagnose vehicle vibration concerns.
MODELS:
2009-**2010** (JC) Journey
DISCUSSION: Tires used on the Journey models include nylon cap material as part of their
construction.
Tires that include Nylon can temporarily "flat spot" when vehicles are shipped by car hauler or rail
and if vehicles are stored for an extended period.
Immediately following delivery, some vehicles may exhibit a vibration / shake due to temporary tire
flat-spotting. The vibration may be felt in the steering wheel and / or seat, and may be most
noticeable at highway speeds, 60mph (96 kph). This may be misinterpreted as an out of balance
tire.
NOTE:
Do not attempt to rebalance the wheel/tire assembly until the vehicle has been driven for an
extended period (20 minutes or more) at highway speeds.
If the tires are flat-spotted, the vehicle vibration will go away after the tires are warmed up,
(normally 10 to 20 minutes of highway driving depending on outside temperatures). If highway
driving doesn't resolve the vehicle vibration, follow the procedures found in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Group 22 - Tires and Wheels > Tire and Wheel Vibration.
Replacing tires should only be done as a last resort after all appropriate wheel and tire diagnostics
have been completed. U.S. dealers can contact the MOPAR tire program if assistance is needed
with obtaining any tire.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
**TIME ALLOWANCE**:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 22-002-11 > Apr > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Alternative 19 Inch Tires
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Alternative 19 Inch Tires
NUMBER: 22-002-11
GROUP: Tires and wheels
DATE: April 02, 2011
SUBJECT: Alternative 19 Inch Tires
OVERVIEW: This bulletin specifies alternative 19 tires that should be used if the Khumo Solus
KH16 P225/55R19 991 All Season (U.S. and Canada Markets Only) is not available.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles sold in U.S. and Canada (sales code YAA and YAC) markets only.
DISCUSSION:
The following 19 tires can be used as aftermarket replacement tires for the 2009 and 2010 model
year Dodge Journey in the event that the Khumo Solus KH16 P225/55R19 991 All Season (U.S.
and Canada Markets Only) are not available.
Approved Alternative Tires:
NOTE:
It is recommended to use these tires only as sets of four.
POLICY: Information Only.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1831
Tires: Specifications
FASTENER TORQUE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Tires
Tires: Description and Operation Tires
TIRE
Tires are designed and engineered for each specific vehicle. They provide the best overall
performance for normal operation. The ride and handling characteristics match the vehicle's
requirements. With proper care they will give excellent reliability, traction, skid resistance, and tread
life.
Driving habits have more effect on tire life than any other factor. Careful drivers will obtain, in most
cases, much greater mileage than severe use or careless drivers. A few of the driving habits which
will shorten the life of any tire are:
- Rapid acceleration
- Severe application of brakes
- High-speed driving
- Taking turns at excessive speeds
- Striking curbs and other obstacles
- Operating vehicle with over or under inflated tire pressures
Radial ply tires are more prone to irregular tread wear. It is important to follow the tire rotation
interval on Tire Rotation. This will help to achieve a greater tread-life potential.
TIRE IDENTIFICATION
Tire type, size, load index and speed rating are encoded in the letters and numbers imprinted on
the side wall of the tire. Refer to the Tire Identification chart to decipher the code. For example
purposes, the tire size P225/60 R 16 97 T is used in the chart. An All Season type tire will also
have either M + S, M AND S, or M - S (indicating mud and snow traction) imprinted on the side
wall. An Extra or Light Load marking "XL" or "LL" may also be listed on the sidewall. The absence
of an "XL" or "LL" marking infers a standard load tire.
TIRE IDENTIFICATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Tires > Page 1834
NOTE: * Height (2) ÷ Width (1) = Aspect Ratio.
NOTE: ** Consult the tire manufacturer regarding any questions on tire specifications or
capabilities.
TIRE CHAINS
Refer to the owners manual supplied with the vehicle to determine whether the use of tire chains is
permitted on this vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Tires > Page 1835
Tires: Description and Operation Spare Tire
SPARE TIRE
A compact (temporary) spare tire and wheel assembly is standard equipment on this vehicle. A
full-size spare is available on some models.
Export vehicles are equipped with the TIREFIT tire repair kit as standard equipment in place of a
spare tire. It is to be used to repair small punctures in the tire as necessary. A compact spare tire is
optional.
The compact spare tire is designed for emergency use only. The original tire should be repaired or
replaced at the first opportunity, then reinstalled. Do not exceed speeds of 80 km/h (50 mph) when
using the compact spare tire.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Tires > Page 1836
Tires: Description and Operation Replacement Tires
REPLACEMENT TIRES
WARNING: Failure to equip the vehicle with tires having adequate speed capability can result in
sudden tire failure.
WARNING: In order to maintain the speed capability of the vehicle, replacement tires must have
speed ratings equal to or higher than those
fitted to the vehicle as original equipment. If tires with lower speed ratings are fitted, the vehicle's
handling may be affected and the speed capability of the vehicle may be lowered to the maximum
speed capability of the replacement tires. To avoid an accident resulting in severe or fatal injury,
consult the tire manufacturer in regards to maximum speed ratings.
It is recommended that tires equivalent to the original equipment tires be used when replacement is
needed.
Failure to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the safety and handling of the
vehicle.
The original equipment tires provide a proper combination of many characteristics such as:
- Ride
- Noise
- Handling
- Durability
- Tread life
- Traction
- Rolling resistance
- Speed capability
The use of tires smaller than the minimum tire size approved for the vehicle can result in tire
overloading and failure.
Use tires that have the approved load rating for the vehicle and never overload them. Failure to
equip the vehicle with tires having adequate speed capability can result in sudden tire failure and
loss of vehicle control.
The use of oversize tires may cause interference with vehicle components. Under extremes of
suspension and steering travel, interference with vehicle components may cause tire damage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Tire Wear Patterns
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tire Wear Patterns
TIRE WEAR PATTERNS
Under inflation will cause wear on the shoulders of tire. Over inflation will cause wear at the center
of tire.
Excessive camber causes the tire to run at an angle to the road. One side of tread is then worn
more than the other.
Excessive toe-in or toe-out causes wear on the tread edges and a feathered effect across the
tread.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Tire Wear Patterns > Page 1839
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tread Wear Indicators
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
Tread wear indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread grooves. When tread depth is 1.6
mm (1/16 in.), the tread wear indicators will appear as a 13 mm (1/2 in.) band (3).
Tire replacement is necessary when indicators appear in two or more grooves or if localized
balding occurs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Tires: Procedures
Cleaning
TIRE CLEANING
Before delivery of a vehicle, remove the protective coating on the tires with white sidewalls or
raised white letters. To remove the protective coating, apply warm water and let it soak for a few
minutes. Afterwards, scrub the coating away with a soft bristle brush. Steam cleaning may also be
used to remove the coating.
CAUTION: DO NOT use gasoline, mineral oil, oil-based solvent or a wire brush for cleaning.
Tire Inflation Pressures
TIRE INFLATION PRESSURES
The specified tire pressures have been chosen to provide safe operation, vehicle stability, and a
smooth ride. The proper tire pressure specification can be found on the Tire And Loading
Information Label provided with the vehicle (usually on the driver's door opening (B-pillar) or rear
shutface of driver's door).
A quality air pressure gauge is recommended to check tire air pressure. Tire pressure should be
checked cold once per month. Check tire pressure more frequently when the weather temperature
varies widely. Tire pressure will decrease when the outdoor temperature drops. After checking the
air pressure, replace valve cap finger tight.
Inflation pressures specified on the Tire Inflation Pressure Label are always the cold inflation
pressure of the tire. Cold inflation pressure is obtained after the vehicle has not been operated for
at least 3 hours, or the vehicle is driven less than one mile after being inoperative for 3 hours. Tire
inflation pressures may increase from 2 to 6 pounds per square inch (psi) during operation. Do not
reduce this normal pressure buildup.
Improper inflation can cause:
- Uneven wear patterns
- Reduced tread life
- Reduced fuel economy
- Unsatisfactory ride
- The vehicle to drift.
WARNING: Over or Under inflated tires can affect vehicle handling. The tire can fail suddenly,
resulting in loss of vehicle control.
Under inflation causes rapid shoulder wear, tire flexing, and can result in tire failure (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1842
Over inflation causes rapid center wear and loss of the tire's ability to cushion shocks (1).
Tire Pressure For High Speed Operation
TIRE PRESSURE FOR HIGH SPEED OPERATION
Refer to the vehicle's Owners Manual Package.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1843
Tires: Removal and Replacement
TIRE LEAK REPAIRING
For proper repairing, a radial tire must be removed from the wheel. Repairs should only be made if
the defect, or puncture, is in the tread area (1). The tire should be replaced if the puncture is
located in the sidewall.
Deflate tire completely before attempting to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use a lubricant such
as a mild soap solution when dismounting or mounting tire. Use tools free of burrs or sharp edges
which could damage the tire or wheel rim.
Before mounting tire on wheel, make sure all rust is removed from the rim bead and repaint if
necessary.
Install wheel on vehicle, and progressively tighten the five wheel nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Chrome Clad Wheel Balancing Information
Wheels: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Chrome Clad Wheel Balancing Information
NUMBER: 22-002-09
GROUP: Wheels/Tires
DATE: July 29, 2009
SUBJECT: Chrome Clad Wheel Adapters For Proper Balancing
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper wheel adapters when mounting Chrome
Clad wheels to wheel balancing equipment.
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2007 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2004 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2008 - 2010 (JS27) Sebring Convertible
2007 - 2010 (JS41) Sebring/Avenger
2007-2010 (KA) Nitro
2002-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005-2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2001 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Chrome Clad Wheel Balancing Information > Page 1848
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This information applies to any model equipped with Chrome Clad Wheels.
DISCUSSION:
Models equipped with Chrome Clad wheels require specific piloting on balance equipment to
properly center the wheel and prevent damage to the chrome clad surface. The chrome cladding is
not removable or replaceable and has cladding tabs that extend into the wheel bore. Traditional
high-taper cones will come into contact with the cladding tabs rather than properly seat on the hub
bore chamfer. Many modern aluminum wheel designs cannot be mounted with traditional cones.
Direct-Fit Collets should be used to properly mount clad wheels on balance equipment (Fig 1).
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
This kit includes the adapters for all Dodge, Chrysler & Jeep models with clad wheels. Individual
adapters for specific wheel sizes can be ordered separately. To order a kit or individual adapters,
contact Pentastar Service Equipment @ 1-800-223-5623.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1849
Wheels: Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
BASE WHEEL
TORQUE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1850
Wheels: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
All vehicles use either steel or cast aluminum drop center wheels. The original equipment wheels
are designed for proper operation at all loads up to the specified maximum vehicle capacity.
Every wheel has raised sections between the rim flanges (1) and drop well (3) called safety humps
(2). In case of air loss, these raised sections help hold the tire in position on the wheel until the
vehicle can be brought to a safe stop. When being installed on the wheel, initial inflation of the tire
forces the tire bead over these raised sections into place.
The wheel studs and nuts are designed for specific wheel applications and must be replaced with
equivalent parts. Do not use replacement parts of lesser quality or of a substitute design. All
aluminum and steel wheels have wheel stud nuts with an enlarged nose. This enlarged nose is
necessary to ensure proper retention of the wheels.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1851
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
WHEEL INSPECTION
Inspect wheels for:
- Excessive runout
- Dents, cracks or irregular bends
- Damaged wheel stud (lug) holes
- Air Leaks
NOTE: Do not attempt to repair a wheel by hammering, heating or welding.
If a wheel is damaged, an original equipment replacement wheel should be used. When obtaining
replacement wheels, they should be equivalent in load carrying capacity. The diameter, width,
offset, pilot hole and bolt circle of the wheel should be the same as the original wheel.
WARNING: Failure to use equivalent replacement wheels may adversely affect the safety and
handling of the vehicle.
WARNING: Replacement with used wheels is not recommended. The service history of the wheel
may have included severe treatment or very
high mileage. The rim could fail without warning.
WARNING: Chrysler LLC does not recommend that customers use "reconditioned" wheels (wheels
that have been damaged and repaired)
because they can result in a sudden catastrophic wheel failure which could cause loss of control
and result in injury or death. For clarification: Cosmetic refinishing for the purpose of repairing a superficial flaw is an acceptable procedure
providing it is limited to paint or clear coat only, the wheel is not modified in any way, and there is
no exposure to paint curing heat over 200 degrees Fahrenheit (93 degrees Celsius).
- Damaged wheels are those which have been bent, broken, cracked or sustained some other
physical damage which may have compromised the wheel structure.
- Repaired indicates that the wheel has been modified through bending, welding, heating,
straightening, or material removal to rectify damage.
- Re-plating of chrome plated wheels is not an acceptable procedure nor is chrome plating of
original equipment painted or polished wheels, as this may alter mechanical properties and affect
fatigue life.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1852
Wheels: Service and Repair
WHEEL AND WHEEL TRIM CARE
All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and chrome plated, should be cleaned regularly
using mild soap and water to maintain their luster and to prevent corrosion. Wash them with the
same soap solution recommended for the body of the vehicle.
When cleaning extremely dirty wheels, care must be taken in the selection of tire and wheel
cleaning chemicals and equipment to prevent damage to the wheels. Mopar(R) Tire AND Wheel
Cleaner, Mopar(R) Wheel Treatment or Mopar(R) Chrome Cleaner is recommended. Any of the
"DO NOT USE" items listed below can damage wheels and wheel trim.
DO NOT USE:
- Any abrasive cleaner
- Any abrasive cleaning pad (such as steel wool) or abrasive brush
- Any cleaner that contains an acid which can react with and discolor the chrome surface. Many
wheel cleaners contain acids that can harm the wheel surface.
- Oven cleaner
- A car wash that uses carbide-tipped wheel cleaning brushes or acidic solutions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Wheel bearing grease ...............................................................................................................
Mopar Multi-Purpose Lubricant NLGI Grade 2 EP, GC-LB
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Front Hub and Bearing - Description
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Front Hub and Bearing - Description
DESCRIPTION
The front wheel bearing and wheel hub of this vehicle are a one piece sealed unit or hub and
bearing unit type assembly.
The hub and bearing (1) is mounted to the knuckle using four mounting bolts (2) and to the axle
half shaft using a retaining nut. The center of the hub and bearing is splined to match the outer joint
of the axle half shaft.
Each front hub and bearing has five wheel mounting studs on the hub flange for mounting the
wheel to the vehicle. The wheel mounting studs are the only replaceable components of the hub
and bearing. Otherwise, the hub and bearing is serviced as a complete assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Front Hub and Bearing - Description > Page 1858
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Rear Hub and Bearing - Description
DESCRIPTION
The rear wheel bearing and wheel mounting hub used on this vehicle are a one-piece sealed unit
or hub and bearing assembly. It is permanently lubricated when assembled and is sealed for life.
There is no periodic lubrication or maintenance recommended for these units.
The hub and bearing (1) is mounted to the rear knuckle.
All vehicles have a magnetic encoder integrated into the rear hub and bearing for speed sense.
The encoder works with the rear wheel speed sensor (2) to provide wheel speed signal.
The only serviceable components of the hub and bearing are the wheel mounting studs pressed
into the hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Hub and Bearing
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Front Hub and Bearing
HUB AND BEARING
NOTE: The wheel bearing is designed to last for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of
periodic maintenance.
The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the hub and bearing.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly, disc brake caliper and brake rotor. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
2. Rotate the wheel hub checking for resistance or roughness.
Any roughness or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the
bearing exhibits any of these conditions, the hub bearing will require replacement. Do not attempt
to disassemble the bearing for repair. If the wheel bearing is disassembled for any reason, it must
be replaced.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require hub and bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weeping from the bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the hub and bearing.
To diagnose a bent hub, measure hub runout. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Hub and Bearing > Page 1861
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Rear Hub and Bearing
HUB AND BEARING
NOTE: The wheel bearing is designed to last for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of
periodic maintenance.
The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the wheel bearing and hub.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly, disc brake caliper and brake rotor. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
2. Rotate the wheel hub checking for resistance or roughness.
Any roughness or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the
bearing exhibits any of these conditions, the hub and bearing will require replacement. Do not
attempt to disassemble the bearing for repair. If the wheel bearing is disassembled for any reason,
it must be replaced.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weapage from the bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the wheel bearing.
To diagnose a bent hub, measure hub runout. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Hub and Bearing - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, review all Warnings and Cautions. See: Steering and
Suspension/Suspension/Service Precautions/Technician Safety
Information
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See:
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the hub from rotating, remove the hub nut (1) from the
axle half shaft (2). 4. Access and remove the front brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1864
5. Remove the four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing to the knuckle (3). 6. Slide the hub and
bearing (1) off the half shaft and out of the knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1865
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Hub and Bearing - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the hub and bearing (1) by sliding it over the half shaft and into the knuckle. 2. Install the
four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing (1) to the knuckle (3). Tighten the four bolts to 82 Nm
(60 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the brake rotor, disc brake caliper and adapter. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
4. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 5. Install the hub nut (1)
on the end of the half shaft (2) and lightly tighten it. 6. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the
hub from rotating, tighten the hub nut (1) to 132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1866
7. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires
and Wheels - Installation. Install and tighten
wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1867
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Hub and Bearing - Removal
ALL-WHEEL-DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Steering and Suspension/Suspension/Service Precautions/Vehicle
Damage Warnings .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See:
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the cotter pin (2) from the hub nut (3) on the end of the axle half shaft. 4. While a helper
applies the brakes to keep the hub (1) from rotating, remove the hub nut (3) and washer (4) from
the axle half shaft. 5. Tap the end of the half shaft inward, loosening it from the hub and bearing.
This will also allow more room to access the hub and bearing
mounting bolts in a later step.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance
between the pads and the rotor to easily remove the caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be
accomplished before removal by grasping the inboard side of the caliper and pulling outward
working with the guide pins, thus retracting the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may
get damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1868
6. Remove two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) to the knuckle (3).
7. Remove the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) as an assembly from the knuckle (3) and
rotor. Hang the assembly out of the way using wire
or a bungee cord. Use care not to overextend the brake hose when doing this.
8. Remove any retaining clips, then slide the brake rotor (2) off the hub and bearing (1).
CAUTION: Prior to removal, clean area around sensor head to help prevent contaminants from
entering bearing when sensor head is
removed.
9. Remove the screw (3) fastening the speed sensor head (2) to the hub and bearing (1).
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor head (2) from the hub and bearing (1), then pass it through
the brake shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1869
11. Remove the four bolts (1) securing the hub and bearing to the knuckle. 12. Remove the hub
and bearing from the knuckle and half shaft (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1870
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Hub and Bearing - Installation
ALL-WHEEL-DRIVE
1. With the brake shield in place on the knuckle, slide the hub and bearing over the axle half shaft
and position it on the knuckle. 2. Install the four bolts (1) securing the hub and bearing to the
knuckle. Tighten the bolts to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Ensure that sensor mounting surface on bearing is clean before sensor installation.
3. Pass the wheel speed sensor head (2) through the hole in the brake shield, then push it into the
mounting hole in hub and bearing (1) and align the
mounting screw hole.
4. Install a NEW mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting screw to 6 Nm (55 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1871
5. Clean the rotor mounting face of the hub and bearing (1) to remove any dirt or corrosion. 6.
Install the brake rotor (2) over the hub and bearing (1).
CAUTION: If the brake rotor or brake pads are being replaced, the rear caliper piston must be
seated (bottomed) to compensate for the new
brake rotor or lining. Because the parking brake self-adjuster mechanism is attached to the piston,
a special seating method is required. The only acceptable method is by rotating the piston back
into the bore using Retractor, Special Tool 8807, as described below. Any other seating method will
damage the self-adjuster mechanism.
7. If necessary, seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5). e. Thread the screw drive on
8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the caliper piston. Do not over
tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1872
8. Install the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) over the knuckle and rotor as an assembly.
9. Install the two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) to the knuckle.
Tighten the mounting bolts to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
10. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 11. Install the washer
(4) and hub nut (3) on the end of the half shaft and snug it. 12. While a helper applies the brakes to
keep the hub (1) from rotating, tighten the hub nut (3) to 245 Nm (181 ft. lbs.). 13. Insert the cotter
pin (2) through the notches in the nut and the hole in half shaft. If the notches in the nut do not line
up with the hole in the half
shaft, continue to tighten the nut until they do. Do not loosen the nut.
14. Wrap the cotter pin (2) ends tightly around the lock nut.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 1873
15. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires
and Wheels - Installation. Install and tighten wheel
mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Pump the brake pedal several times to ensure the vehicle has a firm
brake pedal before moving it. Check the brake fluid level.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Cover - Removal
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Wheel Cover - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle so that tire and wheel assembly clears ground level. See:
CAUTION: When removing the bolt-on wheel cover, do not attempt to pry the wheel cover off the
wheel. It is held on by the wheel mounting
nuts.
2. Remove the five wheel mounting (lug) nuts (3) from the wheel studs. While removing the nuts,
hold the wheel cover (2) in place so it doesn't fall
off when the last nut is removed.
3. Remove the wheel cover (2) using care not to let the tire and wheel assembly (1) fall off the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Cover - Removal > Page 1878
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Wheel Cover - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Installing wheels without good metal-to-metal contact with the mounting surface could
cause loosening of the wheel mounting (lug)
nuts. This could adversely affect the safety and handling of the vehicle.
NOTE: Never use oil or grease on studs or wheel mounting (lug) nuts.
1. With the tire and wheel assembly (1) positioned on the wheel studs without the wheel mounting
(lug) nuts installed, align the valve notch in the
wheel cover with the valve stem on the wheel and install the wheel cover over the studs.
NOTE: Always use the original (OEM) style wheel mounting (lug) nuts. Do not use replacement
parts of lesser quality or substitute design.
2. Install and lightly snug all five wheel mounting (lug) nuts (3) Do not tighten at this time. 3. Lower
the vehicle.
4. Progressively tighten all wheel mounting (lug) nuts in the proper sequence shown. Tighten the
nuts to a final torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications > Front Suspension
Axle Nut: Specifications Front Suspension
Hub Nut................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications > Front Suspension > Page 1884
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear Suspension
Hub Nut................................................................................................................................................
...................................................245 Nm (181 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel Mounting (Lug) Nut....................................................................................................................
...................................................135 Nm (100 ft.lbs)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Stud - Removal
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Wheel Stud - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Use the following procedure to remove one of five studs on one wheel hub.
1. Access and remove front brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
CAUTION: Do not hammer wheel mounting studs out of the hub. Damage to the wheel bearing will
occur, leading to premature bearing
failure.
2. Install Remover 8677 (3) on the hub flange (1) and wheel stud (2). 3. Tighten the Remover,
pushing the wheel mounting stud out the rear of the hub flange. When the shoulder of the stud is
past the flange, remove the
Remover from the hub.
4. Remove the stud from the hub flange.
Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Use the following procedure to remove one of five studs on one wheel hub.
1. Access and remove rear brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
CAUTION: Do not hammer wheel mounting studs out of the hub. Damage to the wheel bearing will
occur, leading to premature bearing
failure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Stud - Removal > Page 1890
2. Install Remover (3), Special Tool 8677, on the hub flange (1) and wheel stud (2). 3. Tighten the
Remover, pushing the wheel mounting stud out the rear of the hub flange. When the shoulder of
the stud is past the flange, remove the
Remover from the hub.
4. Remove the stud from the hub flange.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Stud - Removal > Page 1891
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Wheel Stud - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Use the following procedure to install one of five studs on one wheel hub.
1. Install the NEW wheel mounting stud in the flange of the hub (2) from the rear. 2. Install several
washers (1) and a standard wheel mounting (lug) nut (3) on the stud (4). Install the mounting nut so
that the flat side of the nut is
against the washers to eliminate any binding.
3. Tighten the wheel mounting nut. This will pull the wheel mounting stud into the hub flange. When
the head of the stud is fully seated against the
rear of the hub flange, remove the wheel mounting nut and washers.
4. Install the brake rotor and all components previously removed to access it. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
Rear
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Use the following procedure to install one of five studs on one wheel hub.
1. Install the NEW wheel mounting stud in the flange of the hub (2) from the rear. 2. Install several
washers (1) and a standard wheel mounting (lug) nut (3) on the stud (4). Install the mounting nut so
that the flat side of the nut is
against the washers to eliminate any binding.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Stud - Removal > Page 1892
3. Tighten the wheel mounting nut. This will pull the wheel mounting stud into the hub flange. When
the head of the stud is fully seated against the
rear of the hub flange, remove the wheel mounting nut and washers.
4. Install the brake rotor and all components previously removed to access it. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Jump Starting > System Information > Service and Repair
Jump Starting: Service and Repair
JUMP STARTING
WARNING: Do not jump start a frozen battery, personal injury can result. Do not jump start a
vehicle when the battery fluid is below the top
of lead plates. Do not allow jumper cable clamps to touch each other when connected to a booster
source. Do not use open flame near battery. Remove metallic jewelry worn on hands or wrists to
avoid injury by accidental arcing of battery current. When using a high output boosting device, do
not allow battery voltage to exceed 16 volts. Refer to instructions provided with device being used.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury or death.
CAUTION: When using another vehicle as a booster, do not allow vehicles to touch. Electrical
systems can be damaged on either vehicle.
NOTE: For information on accessing the battery for service or replacement See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Battery - Removal
TO JUMP START A DISABLED VEHICLE:
WARNING:
- Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan whenever the hood is raised. It can start anytime the
ignition switch is ON. You can be hurt by the fan.
- Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it started. Vehicles equipped with an automatic
transaxle cannot be started this way. Unburned fuel could enter the catalytic converter and once
the engine has started, ignite and damage the converter and vehicle. If the vehicle has a
discharged battery, booster cables may be used to obtain a start from another vehicle. This type of
start can be dangerous if done improperly, so follow this procedure carefully.
- Do not use a booster battery or any other booster source with an output that exceeds 12 Volts.
WARNING:
- Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution; do not allow battery fluid to contact eyes, skin, or
clothing. Don't lean over battery when attaching clamps or allow the clamps to touch each other. If
acid splashes in eyes or on skin, flush contaminated area immediately with large quantities of
water.
- A battery generates hydrogen gas, which is flammable and explosive. Keep flame or spark away
from the vent holes.
NOTE: The battery is stored in a compartment that is located behind the left front fender and is
accessible through the wheel well. Remote
jump-start terminals are located in the engine compartment.
1. Wear eye protection and remove any metal jewelry such as watchbands or bracelets that might
make an inadvertent electrical contact. 2. When boosting from a battery in another vehicle, park
that vehicle within booster cable reach, but without allowing the vehicles to touch. Set
parking brake, place automatic transaxle in PARK, and turn ignition to LOCK for both vehicles.
WARNING: Do not permit vehicles to touch each other as this could establish a ground connection
and personal injury could result.
3. Turn off the heater, radio, and all unnecessary electrical loads.
4. Remove the protective cover (1) over the remote jump-start positive battery post (2) (+) in the
engine compartment. Connect one end of the jumper
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Jump Starting > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 1896
cable to the positive battery post (2). Connect the other end of the same cable to the positive
terminal of the booster battery.
5. Connect the other cable, first to the negative terminal of the booster battery and then to the
engine ground (-) of the vehicle with the discharged
battery (5). Make sure you have a good contact on the engine ground.
6. If the vehicle is equipped with Sentry Key Immobilizer, turn the ignition switch to the ON position
for three seconds before moving the ignition
switch to the START position.
7. Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, and
then start the engine in the vehicle with the
discharged battery.
8. When removing the jumper cables, reverse the sequence exactly. Be careful of the moving belts
and fan. 9. Reinstall the protective cover over the remote jump-start positive battery post.
WARNING: During cold weather when temperatures are below freezing point, electrolyte in a
discharged battery may freeze. Do not attempt
jump-starting because the battery could rupture or explode. The battery temperature must be
brought up above freezing point before attempting jump-start.
WARNING: Any procedure other than above could result in:
- Personal injury caused by electrolyte squirting out the battery vent;
- Personal injury or property damage due to battery explosion;
Damage to charging system of booster vehicle or of immobilized vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer
Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico
Towing Information: Service and Repair Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico
SPECIFICATION - TOWING, Trailer - NAFTA, Puerto Rico
you will find safety tips and information on limits to the type of towing you can reasonably do with
your vehicle. Before towing a trailer, carefully review this information to tow your load as efficiently
and safely as possible.
To maintain warranty coverage, follow the requirements and recommendations concerning vehicles
used for trailer towing.
Common Towing Definitions
The following trailer towing related definitions will assist you in understanding the following
information:
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
The Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) is the total allowable weight of your vehicle. This
includes driver, passengers, cargo, and tongue weight. The total load must be limited so that you
do not exceed the GVWR.
Gross Trailer Weight (GTW)
The Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) is the weight of the trailer plus the weight of all cargo,
consumables, and equipment (permanent or temporary) loaded in or on the trailer in its "loaded
and ready for operation" condition. The recommended way to measure GTW is to put your fully
loaded trailer on a vehicle scale. The entire weight of the trailer must be supported by the scale.
Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR)
The Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR) is the total permissible weight of your vehicle and
trailer when weighed in combination. (Note that GCWR ratings include a 150 lbs (68 kg) allowance
for the presence of a driver.)
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
The Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) is the maximum capacity of the front and rear axles.
Distribute the load over the front and rear axles evenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either
front or rear GAWR.
WARNING: It is important that you do not exceed the maximum front or rear GAWR. A dangerous
driving condition can result if either
rating is exceeded. You could lose control of the vehicle and have an accident. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Tongue Weight (TW)
Tongue weight (TW) is the downward force exerted on the hitch ball by the trailer. In most cases, it
should not be less than 10% or more than 15% of the trailer load. You must consider this as part of
the load on your vehicle.
Frontal Area
Frontal area is the maximum height and maximum width of the front of a trailer.
Trailer Sway Control - Electronic
For information on this system, See: Brakes and Traction Control/Description and Operation.
Trailer Sway Control - Mechanical
The trailer sway control is a telescoping link that can be installed between the hitch receiver and
the trailer tongue that typically provides adjustable friction associated with the telescoping motion to
dampen any unwanted trailer swaying motions while traveling.
Weight-Carrying Hitch
A weight-carrying hitch supports the trailer tongue weight, just as if it were luggage located at a
hitch ball or some other connecting point of the vehicle. These kinds of hitches are the most
popular on the market today and they are commonly used to tow small- and medium-sized trailers.
Weight-Distributing Hitch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer
Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 1901
Weight Distributing Hitch System
A weight-distributing system works by applying leverage through spring (load) bars. They are
typically used for heavier loads to distribute trailer tongue weight to the tow vehicle's front axle and
the trailer axle(s). When used in accordance with the manufacturers directions, it provides for a
more level ride, offering more consistent steering and brake control thereby enhancing towing
safety. The addition of a friction / hydraulic sway control also dampens sway caused by traffic and
crosswinds and contributes positively to tow vehicle and trailer stability. Trailer sway control and a
weight distributing (load equalizing) hitch are recommended for heavier Tongue Weights (TW) and
may be required depending on vehicle and trailer configuration / loading to comply with Gross Axle
Weight Rating (GAWR) requirements.
Improper Adjustment of Weight Distributing System
WARNING:
- An improperly adjusted weight distributing hitch system may reduce handling, stability, braking
performance, and could result in an accident.
- Weight distributing systems may not be compatible with surge brake couplers. Consult with your
hitch and trailer manufacturer or a reputable recreational vehicle dealer for additional information.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Trailer Hitch Classification
Your vehicle may be factory equipped for safe towing of trailers weighing over 2,000 lbs (907 kg)
with the optional Trailer Tow Prep Package. See your authorized dealer for package content.
The following chart provides the industry standard for the maximum trailer weight a given trailer
hitch class can tow and should be used to assist you in selecting the correct trailer hitch for your
intended towing condition.
All trailer hitches should be professionally installed on your vehicle.
Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer Weight Ratings)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer
Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 1902
The following chart provides the maximum trailer weight ratings towable for your given drivetrain.
Trailer and Tongue Weight
Always load a trailer with 60% to 65% of the weight in the front of the trailer. This places 10% to
15% of the Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) on the tow hitch of your vehicle. Loads balanced over the
wheels or heavier in the rear can cause the trailer to sway severely side to side which will cause
loss of control of the vehicle and trailer. Failure to load trailers heavier in front is the cause of many
trailer accidents.
Never exceed the maximum tongue weight stamped on your bumper or trailer hitch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer
Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 1903
Consider the following items when computing the weight on the rear axle of the vehicle:
- The tongue weight of the trailer.
- The weight of any other type of cargo or equipment put in or on your vehicle.
- The weight of the driver and all passengers.
NOTE: Remember that everything put into or on the trailer adds to the load on your vehicle. Also,
additional factory-installed options or
authorized dealer-installed options must be considered as part of the total load on your vehicle.
Refer to the "Tire and Loading Information" placard for the maximum combined weight of
occupants and cargo for your vehicle.
Towing Requirements
To promote proper break-in of your new vehicle drivetrain components the following guidelines are
recommended:
CAUTION:
- Avoid towing a trailer for the first 500 mi (805 km) of vehicle operation. Doing so may damage the
vehicle.
- During the first 500 mi (805 km) of trailer towing, limit the speed to 50 mph (80 km/h).
WARNING: Improper towing can lead to an injury accident. Follow these guidelines to make your
trailer towing as safe as possible:
Make certain that the load is secured in the trailer and that it will not shift during travel. When
trailering cargo that is not fully secured, dynamic load shifts can occur that may be difficult for the
driver to control. You could lose control of your vehicle and have an accident. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
- When hauling cargo or towing a trailer, do not overload your vehicle or trailer. Overloading can
cause a loss of control, poor performance, or damage to brakes, axle, engine, transaxle, steering,
suspension, chassis structure, or tires.
- Safety chains must always be used between your vehicle and trailer. Always connect the chains
to the frame or hook retainers of the vehicle hitch. Cross the chains under the trailer tongue and
allow enough slack for turning corners.
- Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a grade. When parking, apply the parking brake on
the tow vehicle. Put the tow vehicle automatic transaxle in PARK. Always, block or "chock" the
trailer wheels.
- GCWR must not be exceeded.
- Total weight must be distributed between the tow vehicle and the trailer such that the following
four ratings are not exceeded:
- GVWR
- GTW
- GAWR
- Tongue weight rating for the trailer hitch utilized. (This requirement may limit the ability to always
achieve the 10% to 15% range of tongue weight as a percentage of total trailer weight.)
Towing Requirements - Tires
- Do not attempt to tow a trailer while using a compact spare tire.
- Proper tire inflation pressures are essential to the safe and satisfactory operation of your vehicle.
Refer to "Tires-General Information" for information on tire pressures and for proper tire inflation
procedures.
- Also, check the trailer tires for proper tire inflation pressures before trailer usage.
- Check for signs of tire wear or visible tire damage before towing a trailer. Refer to "Tires-General
Information" for information on tread wear indicators and for the proper inspection procedure.
- When replacing tires, See: Wheels and Tires/Tires/Description and Operation for information on
replacement tires and for the proper tire replacement procedures. Replacing tires with a higher load
carrying capacity will not increase the vehicle's GVWR and GAWR limits.
Towing Requirements - Trailer Brakes
- Do not interconnect the hydraulic brake system or vacuum system of your vehicle with that of the
trailer. This could cause inadequate braking and possible personal injury.
- An electronically actuated trailer brake controller is required when towing a trailer with
electronically actuated brakes. When towing a trailer equipped with a hydraulic surge actuated
brake system, an electronic brake controller is not required.
- Trailer brakes are recommended for trailers over 1,000 lbs (454 kg) and required for trailers in
excess of 2,000 lbs (907 kg).
CAUTION: If the trailer weighs more than 1,000 lbs (454 kg) loaded, it should have its own brakes,
and they should be of adequate capacity.
Failure to do this could lead to accelerated brake lining wear, higher brake pedal effort, and longer
stopping distances.
WARNING: Do not connect trailer brakes to your vehicle's hydraulic brake lines. It can overload
your brake system and cause it to fail. You
might not have brakes when you need them and could have an accident. Towing any trailer will
increase your stopping distance. When towing, you should allow for additional space between your
vehicle and the vehicle in front of you. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible
serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer
Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 1904
Towing Requirements - Trailer Lights AND Wiring
4 - Pin Connector
Whenever you pull a trailer, regardless of the trailer size, stoplights and turn signals on the trailer
are required for motoring safety.
The Trailer Tow Package may include a 4- and 7-pin wiring harness. Use a factory approved trailer
harness and connector.
NOTE: Do not cut or splice wiring into the vehicles wiring harness.
The electrical connections are all complete to the vehicle but you must mate the harness to a trailer
connector. Refer to the following illustrations.
7- Pin Connector
Towing Tips
Before setting out on a trip, practice turning, stopping, and backing up the trailer in an area located
away from heavy traffic.
Towing Tips - Automatic Transaxle
The DRIVE range can be selected when towing. However, if frequent shifting occurs while in this
range, select the "3" range for 4-speed automatic or the "5" range for 6-speed automatic.
NOTE: Using the "3" or "5" range while operating the vehicle under heavy operating conditions will
improve performance and extend
transaxle life by reducing excessive shifting and heat build up. This action will also provide better
engine braking.
If you REGULARLY tow a trailer for more than 45 minutes of continuous operation, then change
the automatic transaxle fluid and filter according to the interval specified for "police, taxi, fleet, or
frequent trailer towing" in the Maintenance Schedule.
NOTE: Check the 4-speed automatic transaxle fluid level before towing. The 6-speed transaxle is
sealed and the fluid level cannot be checked.
See your authorized dealer for assistance.
Towing Tips - Electronic Speed Control (If Equipped)
- Don't use in hilly terrain or with heavy loads.
- When using the speed control, if you experience speed drops greater than 10 mph (16 km/h),
disengage until you can get back to cruising speed.
- Use speed control in flat terrain and with light loads to maximize fuel efficiency.
Towing Tips - Autostick (R) (If Equipped)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer
Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 1905
- By using the Autostick(R) modes and selecting a specific gear range, frequent shifting can be
avoided. The highest gear range should be selected that allows for adequate performance. For
example, choose "4" if the desired speed can be maintained. Choose "3" or "2" if needed to
maintain the desired speed.
- Extended driving at high RPM should be avoided to prevent excess heat generation. A reduction
in vehicle speed may be required to avoid extended driving at high RPM. Return to a higher gear
range or vehicle speed when road conditions and RPM level allows.
Cooling System
To reduce potential for engine and transmission overheating, take the following actions:
- City Driving
- When stopped for short periods of time, put transmission in neutral and increase engine idle
speed.
- Highway Driving
- Reduce speed.
- Air Conditioning
- Turn off temporarily.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer
Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 1906
Towing Information: Service and Repair Vehicle Towing
TOWING, Vehicle
WARNINGS AND PRECAUTIONS
WARNING: Do not allow towing attachment devices to contact the fuel tank or lines, fuel leakage
can result. Do not lift or tow vehicle by front
or rear bumper, or bumper energy absorber units. Do not venture under a lifted vehicle if not
supported properly on safety stands. Do not allow passengers to ride in a towed vehicle. Use a
safety chain that is independent from the towing attachment device. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury or death.
CAUTION: Do not damage brake lines, exhaust system, shock absorbers, sway bars, or any other
under vehicle components when attaching
towing device to vehicle. Do not attach towing device to front or rear suspension components. Do
not secure vehicle to towing device by the use of front or rear suspension or steering components.
Remove or secure loose or protruding objects from a damaged vehicle before towing. Refer to
state and local rules and regulations before towing a vehicle. Do not allow weight of towed vehicle
to bear on lower fascia, air dams, or spoilers.
RECOMMENDED TOWING EQUIPMENT
To avoid damage to bumper fascia and air dams use of a flat bed towing device or wheel lift is
recommended. When using a wheel lift towing device, be sure the unlifted end of disabled vehicle
has at least 100 mm (4 in.) ground clearance. If minimum ground clearance cannot be reached,
use a towing dolly. If a flat bed device is used, the approach angle should not exceed 15 degrees.
TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE
NUMBER: Without The Ignition Key
Front Wheel Drive (FWD)
Special care must be taken when the vehicle is towed with the ignition in the LOCK position. Flat
bed towing is the preferred towing method. However, if a flat bed towing vehicle is not available, a
wheel lift towing vehicle may be used. Furthermore, rear towing is not recommended with the front
wheels on the ground, as transaxle damage can result. If rear towing is the only alternative, a front
end dolly must be used. Proper towing equipment is necessary to prevent damage to the vehicle.
All Wheel Drive (AWD)
The vehicle must be transported on a flat bed truck.
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle (Flat Towing With The Key In The Ignition And All
Four Wheels On The Ground)
CAUTION:
- If the vehicle being towed requires steering, the ignition switch must be in the ON position, not in
the LOCK or ACC position.
- Do not attempt to tow this vehicle from the front with sling type towing equipment. Damage to the
front fascia will result.
- Do not push or tow this vehicle with another vehicle as damage to the bumper fascia and
transaxle may result.
If you must use the accessories (wipers, defrosters, etc.) while being towed, the key must be in the
ON position, not the ACC position. Make certain the transaxle remains in NEUTRAL.
Front Wheel Drive (FWD)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer
Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 1907
The vehicle may be towed under the following conditions: The shift lever must be in NEUTRAL, the
distance to be traveled must not exceed 15 mi (25 km), and the towing speed must not exceed 25
mph (40 km/h). Exceeding these towing limits may cause a transaxle failure. If the transaxle is not
operative, or if the vehicle is to be towed more than 15 mi (25 km), the vehicle must be transported
either with a flat bed truck or with the front wheels off the ground.
All Wheel Drive (AWD)
The vehicle may be towed under the following conditions: The shift lever must be in NEUTRAL, the
distance to be traveled must not exceed 15 mi (25 km), the towing speed must not exceed 25 mph
(40 km/h), and both front and rear wheels must be on the ground. Exceeding these towing limits
may cause a transaxle failure. If the transaxle is not operative, or if the vehicle is to be towed more
than 15 mi (25 km), the vehicle must be transported on a flat bed truck.
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle With A Tow Dolly
Front Wheel Drive (FWD)
Rear towing is not recommended with the front wheels on the ground, as transaxle damage can
result. If rear towing is the only alternative, a front end dolly must be used. Proper towing
equipment is necessary to prevent damage to the vehicle.
All Wheel Drive (AWD)
CAUTION: The manufacturer does not recommend towing an All-Wheel Drive (AWD) on a tow
dolly. Vehicle damage may occur.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer
Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 1908
Towing Information: Service and Repair Recreational Towing (Behind Motorhome, etc.)
RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND MOTORHOME, ETC.)
Recreational Towing Chart
CAUTION: ONLY vehicles equipped with a MANUAL TRANSAXLE may be recreationally towed
(flat towed) at any legal highway speed, for any
distance, if the MANUAL TRANSAXLE is in NEUTRAL and the ignition key is in the ACC position.
CAUTION:
- DO NOT FLAT TOW any vehicle equipped with an AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE. Damage to the
drivetrain will result. If these vehicles require towing, make sure all four wheels are off the ground.
- Front or rear wheel lifts should not be used. Internal damage to the transaxle will occur if a front or
rear wheel lift is used when recreational towing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service and Repair
Vehicle Lifting: Service and Repair
HOISTING
Refer to Owner's Manual provided with vehicle for proper emergency jacking procedures.
WARNING: The hoisting and jack lifting points provided are for a complete vehicle. When the
engine or rear suspension is removed from a
vehicle, the center of gravity is altered making some hoisting conditions unstable. Properly support
or secure vehicle to hoisting device when these conditions exist. Failure to follow these instructions
may result in personal injury or death.
CAUTION: Do not position hoisting device on suspension components, damage to vehicle can
result.Do not attempt to raise one entire side of
the vehicle by placing a floor jack midway between the front and rear wheels. This practice may
result in permanent damage to the body.
When properly positioned, a floor jack can be used to lift the vehicle and support the raised vehicle
with jack stands.
A floor jack or any lifting device, must never be used on any part of the underbody other then the
described areas.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
COMPRESSION CHECK
Compression Ratio ..............................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 10:1
Compression should not be less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from
cylinder to cylinder
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 1917
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE TEST
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions.
Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good operating
condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis purposes.
1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine reaches normal
operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators such as fouled, hot, oily,
etc. Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Remove the Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay from the TIPM. 5. Install a suitable compression test
gauge into the number 1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. 6. Crank engine until maximum pressure
is reached on gauge. Record this pressure as #1 cylinder pressure. 7. Repeat the previous step for
all remaining cylinders. 8. Compression should not be less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary
more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder. 9. If one or more cylinders have abnormally low
compression pressures, repeat the compression test.
10. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second compression
test, it could indicate the existence of a problem in
the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide
to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the cause of
low compression unless some malfunction is present.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
CAMSHAFT SPROCKET
Camshaft Sprocket Bolt-Right
Side.........................................................................................................................102 + 1/4 Turn
Nm (75 + 1/4 Turn ft.lbs) Camshaft Sprocket Bolt-Left
Side...........................................................................................................................102 + 1/4 Turn
Nm (75 + 1/4 Turn ft.lbs)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets - Removal
CAMSHAFT SPROCKETS
CAUTION: The 3.5L engine is NOT a free-wheeling design. Therefore, care should be taken not to
rotate the camshafts or crankshaft with the
timing belt removed.
NOTE: The camshaft timing gears are keyed to the camshaft.
1. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Fuel Pressure
Release/Service and Repair. 2. Remove front timing belt cover See: Timing Components/Timing
Cover/Service and Repair/Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal. 3. Position crankshaft sprocket to
the TDC mark on the oil pump housing by turning crankshaft in the clockwise direction 4. Install a
dial indicator in number 1 cylinder to check TDC of the piston. Rotate the crankshaft until the piston
is at exactly TDC. 5. Remove camshaft retainer/thrust plate from rear of right cylinder head.
6. Remove the cylinder head covers. 7. Remove rocker arm assemblies. 8. Remove the timing belt
tensioner and timing belt.
9. Loosen and remove the left camshaft gear retaining bolt and washer. The left bolt is 255 mm
(10.0 in.) long.
NOTE: The camshaft timing gears are keyed to the camshaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 1924
10. Hold the left camshaft sprocket with 36 mm (1 7/16 in.) box end wrench. 11. Remove the left
camshaft sprocket.
CAUTION: The camshaft must be pushed rearward approximately 3 1/2 inches to remove the
camshaft gear retaining bolt and gear. Care
must be taken not to scratch or nick the camshaft or cylinder head journals when moving camshaft.
12. Loosen and remove the right camshaft gear retaining bolt and washer. The right bolt is 213 mm
(8 3/8 in.) long.
NOTE: The camshaft timing gears are keyed to the camshaft.
13. Hold the right camshaft sprocket with 36 mm (1 7/16 in.) box end wrench and loosen the
camshaft bolt. 14. Using a floor jack, raise the right side of the engine enough to allow clearance to
remove the right camshaft bolt and washer. 15. Remove the right camshaft sprocket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 1925
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets - Installation
CAMSHAFT SPROCKETS
CAUTION: The camshaft sprockets are keyed and not interchangeable from side to side because
of the camshaft position sensor pick-up.
CAUTION: The camshafts must be pushed back into the cylinder head after the camshaft
sprockets and retaining bolts are positioned. Care
must be taken not to scratch or nick the camshaft or cylinder head journals when moving the
camshafts.
1. Install the camshaft sprockets onto the camshafts. Install NEW sprocket attaching bolts into
place. The 255 mm (10 in.) bolt is installed in the left
camshaft and the 213 mm (8 3/8 in.) bolt is installed into the right camshaft. Do not tighten the bolts
at this time, they will be tightened at a later step. Camshaft sprocket timing marks should be
aligned with inner cover timing marks at both sprockets.
2. Install the camshaft thrust plates (1) and seals. Tighten the bolts (2) to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.).
3. Install the timing belt starting first at the crankshaft sprocket, then to remaining sprockets in a
counterclockwise direction. 4. Install the belt around the last sprocket. Maintain tension on the belt
as it is positioned around the tensioner pulley. Camshaft sprocket timing
marks (1) and crankshaft sprocket timing mark (3) should still be aligned with the inner cover
marks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 1926
NOTE: It is necessary to compress the plunger into the tensioner body and install a locking pin
prior to reinstalling the tensioner. See Timing
Belt Removal for tensioner compression procedure See: Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service
and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Removal .
5. Hold the tensioner pulley against the belt and install the reset (pinned) timing belt tensioner (2)
into the housing. Tighten attaching bolts to 28 Nm
(250 in. lbs.).
6. Remove tensioner retaining pin to allow the tensioner to extend to the pulley bracket.
7. Hold the right camshaft sprocket hex with a 36 mm (1 7/16 in.) wrench and tighten the right
camshaft bolt to 102 Nm (75 ft. lbs.) +90° turn.
8. Hold the left camshaft sprocket hex with a 36 mm (1 7/16 in.) wrench and tighten the left
camshaft bolts to 102 Nm (75 ft. lbs.) +90° turn. 9. Install the rocker arm assemblies and cylinder
head covers See: Rocker Arm Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve
Rocker Arm - Installation
10. Install the front timing belt cover See: Timing Components/Timing Cover/Service and
Repair/Engine Timing Cover(s) - Installation
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 1927
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Crankshaft Sprockets - Installation
CRANKSHAFT SPROCKET
CAUTION: To ensure proper installation depth of crankshaft sprocket, Sprocket Installer 6641 must
be used.
1. Install crankshaft sprocket using Special Tools 6641 and C-4685-C1. 2. Install timing belt, See:
Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt &
Sprockets - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation > Camshaft - Description
Camshaft: Description and Operation Camshaft - Description
DESCRIPTION
A single overhead camshaft per cylinder head provides valve actuation. The left camshaft
accommodates a cam sensor pick-up wheel and is therefore longer. Each camshaft is supported
by four bearing journals. A thrust plate attached to the rear of each cylinder head controls camshaft
end play. Right and left camshaft driving sprockets support a timing mark, are keyed, and not
interchangeable because of the cam sensor pick-up wheel on the left sprocket. Camshaft bearing
lubrication is provided via a oil supply passage through each rocker shaft pedestal dowel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation > Camshaft - Description > Page 1932
Camshaft: Description and Operation Camshaft - Operation
OPERATION
The camshaft is driven by the crankshaft via drive sprockets and belt. As the crankshaft turns, the
timing belt turns the camshaft. The camshaft lobes press the lifters which in turn open the valves at
the correct time. The valve spring returns the valve to the closed state.
The camshaft has precisely machined lobes to provide accurate valve timing and duration.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Camshaft: Procedures
INSPECTION
1. Inspect camshaft bearing journals for damage and binding. If journals are binding, check the
cylinder head for damage. Also check cylinder head
oil holes for clogging.
2. Check the cam lobe and bearing surfaces for abnormal wear and damage. Replace camshaft if
defective.
NOTE: If camshaft is replaced due to lobe wear or damage, always replace the rocker arms.
3. Measure the lobe actual wear and replace camshaft if out of limit. Standard value is 0.0254 mm
(0.001 in.), wear limit is 0.254 mm (0.010 in.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1935
Camshaft: Removal and Replacement
Camshaft - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Camshafts are removed from the rear of each cylinder head.
CAUTION: Care must be taken not to nick or scratch the journals when removing the camshaft.
1. Remove the camshaft sprocket See: Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Removal.
2. Remove the rocker arm shaft assembly. See: Rocker Arm Assembly/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Rocker Arm Disassembly
3. To remove the right camshaft, remove the EGR Valve assembly. 4. Remove the camshaft thrust
plate (1) or (2). 5. Carefully remove the camshaft from the rear of the cylinder head.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1936
6. NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) in order to remove
the camshaft from the right cylinder
head.
Camshaft - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Care must be taken not to scrape or nick the camshaft journals when installing the
camshaft into position.
1. Lubricate camshaft bearing journals, camshaft lobes and camshaft seal with clean engine oil and
install camshaft into cylinder head.
2. Install the camshaft sprocket.See: Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Installation
3. Install the camshaft thrust plate (1) or (2). Clean the mating surfaces and apply the appropriate
sealer as necessary. Torque fasteners to 28 Nm
(250 in. lbs.).
4. If necessary, install the EGR Valve assembly and Powertrain Control Module (PCM). 5. Install
the rocker arm assembly.See: Rocker Arm Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Rocker Arm - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Testing and Inspection
LASH ADJUSTER (TAPPET) NOISE DIAGNOSIS
Proper noise diagnosis is essential in locating the source of a NVH complaint. Locating a lash
adjuster (tappet) type noise can sometimes be difficult. As a result, an initial misdiagnosis may
occur.
Refer to the following chart indicating possible lash adjuster (tappet) noise sources and possible
sources that could lead to a misdiagnosis.
Refer to Lash Adjuster (Tappet) Noise Chart for Possible Causes and Correction of a lash adjuster
(tappet) type noise.
LASH ADJUSTER (TAPPET) NOISE CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1940
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair
HYDRAULIC LASH ADJUSTER BLEEDING
NOTE: Use this procedure to manually bleed aerated oil from the lash adjuster and remove
sponginess.
1. Run the engine, bringing it to operating temperature in order to freshly pressurize and warm the
valvetrain system oil supply. 2. Remove cylinder head cover(s). 3. Rotate engine until the rocker
arm is positioned on the base circle of the cam (1).
4. For intake rocker arm positions:CAUTION: If probe tip breaks off within the lash adjuster, replace
the affected rocker arm.
a. Adjust the gauge pin of Release Probe 8351 (1) to extend approximately 20 mm (0.787 in.).
Then, carefully insert the release probe gauge pin
into the lash adjuster service access hole (2).
b. Gently unseat lash adjuster's internal check ball (4). c. While the internal check ball is held
unseated, press the rocker arm (3) into the valve tip (5), allowing the hydraulic lash adjuster (6)
within the
rocker arm to fully collapse. Hold fully collapsed position for at least one second, or longer.
d. Slowly release the rocker arm, thereby allowing the lash adjuster to extend, which in turn refills
the high pressure chamber with non-aerated
oil.
e. Remove Release Probe 8351 to allow check ball to seat. f.
Recheck for sponginess. If the lash adjuster sponginess is not completely or nearly eliminated,
then repeat procedure.
g. If the spongy condition cannot be removed, replace effected rocker arm(s).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1941
5. For exhaust rocker arm positions:CAUTION: If probe tip breaks off within the lash adjuster,
replace the affected rocker arm.
a. Adjust the gauge pins of two Release Probes 8351 (1) to extend approximately 20 mm (0.787
in.). Then, using the two release probes,
carefully insert gauge pins into the lash adjuster service access holes (2).
b. Gently unseat BOTH lash adjuster's internal check balls (4) at the same time. c. While the
internal check balls are held unseated, press the rocker arm (3) into the valve tip (5), allowing the
hydraulic lash adjuster (6) within
the rocker arm to fully collapse. Hold fully collapsed position for at least one second, or longer.
d. Slowly release the rocker arm, thereby allowing the lash adjuster to extend, which in turn refills
the high pressure chamber with non-aerated
oil.
e. Remove the two Release Probes 8351 to allow check balls to seat. f.
Recheck for sponginess. If the lash adjuster sponginess is not completely or nearly eliminated,
repeat procedure.
g. If the spongy condition cannot be removed, replace effected rocker arm(s).
6. Install the cylinder head cover(s).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rocker Arm - Description
Rocker Arm Assembly: Description and Operation Rocker Arm - Description
ROCKER ARM
Rocker arms are made of light weight permanent mold aluminum alloy with a roller type follower
operating against the camshaft. The valve actuating end of the rocker arms are machined to retain
hydraulic lash adjusters, eliminating the need for manual valve lash adjustment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rocker Arm - Description > Page 1946
Rocker Arm Assembly: Description and Operation Rocker Arm - Operation
OPERATION
The rocker arm is the pivot point between the camshaft lobe and the valve.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rocker Arm - Description > Page 1947
Rocker Arm Assembly: Description and Operation Rocker Arm Shaft - Description
ROCKER ARM SHAFTS
The rocker arm shafts are tubular steel and supported by several forged aluminum alloy pedestals,
which are fastened to the cylinder head. Four shafts are used, one for each intake and exhaust
rocker arm bank on each cylinder head. The shafts are hollow to provide a duct for lubricating oil
flow from the cylinder head to the valve mechanisms. One hollow dowel per pedestal is used to
locate the pedestal to the cylinder head, orient the exhaust rocker shaft, and serve as a cam
bearing oil feed passage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Rocker Arm Assembly: Procedures
INSPECTION
The rocker arm shafts are hollow and are used as lubrication oil ducts. The rocker arm and shaft
assembly on the right side of the engine has an oil passage hole from the cylinder head located at
the third rocker shaft support pedestal. The rocker arm and shaft assembly on the left side of the
engine has an oil passage hole from the cylinder head located at the second rocker shaft support
pedestal.
NOTE: To prevent air ingestion into lash adjusters, avoid turning rocker arm assembly upside
down.
CAUTION: Do not allow rocker arm assembly to rest on lash adjusters, as damage may occur to
lash adjuster and plastic retainer.
The intake and exhaust rocker arms are different. They should be identified before disassembling
the assembly.
Check rocker arms for wear or damage:
- Roller scuffing or wear
- Shaft bore scuffing or wear
- Swivel pad on lash adjuster missing or broken
- Rocker arm showing signs of fatigue or cracking
- Roller axle protruding from arm
Replace assembly as necessary if any rocker arms shows signs of wear.
CAUTION: Do not remove lash adjuster from rocker arm assembly. Damage to the adjuster and
rocker arm will result.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1950
Rocker Arm Assembly: Removal and Replacement
Valve Rocker Arm - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head covers See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal.
CAUTION: DO NOT use a number stamp or a punch to mark the rocker arms. Damage to the
rocker arms could occur.
2. Using a permanent ink or paint marker, identify the location and position on each rocker arm. 3.
Remove the rocker arm assembly bolts in the sequence shown.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1951
4. Remove the rocker arm assembly (2).
NOTE: To prevent air ingestion into the lash adjusters, avoid turning the rocker arm assembly
upside down.
CAUTION: Do not allow rocker arm assembly to rest on lash adjusters, as damage may occur to
lash adjusters and/or plastic retainers.
Valve Rocker Arm - Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
CAUTION: DO NOT use a number stamp or a punch to mark the rocker arms. Damage to the
rocker arms could occur.
1. Using a permanent ink or paint marker, identify the location and position on each rocker arm and
remove the rocker arm and shaft assembly See:
Valve Rocker Arm - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1952
2. Remove the dowel pins using a 4 mm screw, nut, spacer, and washer installed into the pin.
Thread the screw into the pin, then loosen the nut on the
screw. This will pull the dowel out of the shaft support. Do not reuse the dowel pins.
NOTE: The identification marks (notches) (1) face toward the front of the engine for the left head
and toward the rear of the engine for the
right head.
3. Remove the rocker arms and pedestals in order. 4. Check the rocker arm mounting portion of
the shafts for wear or damage. Replace if damaged or heavily worn. 5. Check the shaft oil holes for
clogging with a small wire, clean as required.
Valve Rocker Arm - Assembly
ASSEMBLY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1953
CAUTION: The rocker arm shafts are hollow and are used as lubrication oil passages. The rocker
arm and shaft assembly on the RIGHT side
of the engine has an oil passage hole from the cylinder head to the third rocker shaft support. The
rocker arm shaft assembly on the LEFT side of the engine has an oil passage hole from the
cylinder head to the second rocker shaft support.
NOTE: A new fully assembled rocker arm and shaft assembly can be installed on either the right or
left side of the engine. The identification
marks (notches) (1) face toward the front of the engine for the left head and toward the rear of the
engine for the right head.
1. Position the shafts with the notches (1) facing up. Install the rocker arms and pedestals onto the
shafts.
CAUTION: New dowel pins must be installed when reassembling.
2. Install the dowel pins (2). The dowel pins (2) pass through the pedestal (3) into the exhaust
rocker shafts. Dowel pins (2) should be pressed in until
they bottom-out against the rocker shaft in the pedestal (3).
3. Install the rocker arm and shafts assembly See: Valve Rocker Arm - Installation
Valve Rocker Arm - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1954
NOTE: The rocker arm and shaft assembly can be installed either prior to or after (preferred)
cylinder head installation.
1. Rotate camshaft gears clockwise to where the number one cylinder intake valves would just start
to open. The camshaft lobes are now in a neutral
position (no load to the valve). This will allow the rocker arm shaft assembly to be tightened into
position with little or no valve spring load on it.
NOTE: A new fully assembled rocker arm and shaft assembly can be installed on either the right or
left side of the engine. The identification
marks (notches) (1) face toward the front of the engine for the left head and toward the rear of the
engine for the right head.
2. Install the rocker arm and shaft assembly making sure that the identification marks (1) face
toward the front of engine for left head and toward the
rear of the engine for right head.
3. Tighten the rocker arm/shaft assembly bolts in the sequence shown to 31 Nm (275 in. lbs.). 4.
Install the cylinder head covers See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
CONNECTING ROD BEARING
Journal Diameter..................................................................................................................................
...........................57.982-58.002 mm (2.282-2.283 in.) Bearing Diametrical Clearance.......................
................................................................................................................0.024-0.054 mm
(0.0009-0.0021 in.) Bearing Clearance (Wear Limit)............................................................................
...............................................................................0.062 mm (0.0024 in.) Out-of-Round (MAX).........
..............................................................................................................................................................
.....0.007 mm (0.0003 in.) Journal Diametrical Taper (MAX)................................................................
......................................................................................0.006 mm (0.00025 in.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1959
Connecting Rod Bearing: Service and Repair
CONNECTING RODS AND BEARINGS
CONNECTING ROD BEARINGS
The bearing caps are not interchangeable and should be marked at removal to insure correct
assembly.
The bearing shells must be installed with the tangs inserted into the machined grooves in the rods
and caps. Install cap with the tangs on the same side as the rod.
Fit all rods on one bank until complete.
Limits of taper or out-of-round on any crankshaft journals should be held to specification limits.
Bearings are available in 0.007 mm oversize (0.0003 in oversize), standard, 0.007 mm (0.0003 in)
undersize 0.025 mm (0.001 in) undersize, and 0.254mm (0.010 in undersize. Install the bearings in
pairs. Do not use a new bearing half with an old bearing half. Do not file the rods or bearing caps.
1. For measuring main bearing clearance and connecting rod bearing clearance use Plastigauge.
For more information on using Plastigauge See:
Service and Repair/Procedures/Measuring Bearing Clearance Using Plastigage. Refer to Engine
Specifications for bearing clearance specifications See: Specifications/Engine - Specifications.
SELECT FIT ROD BEARINGS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1960
1. Connecting rod bearings use select fit to achieve improved clearance control. On a new engine,
the crankshaft journal is gaged to use a specific
bearing size. The grade is indicated on the #9 counterweight (2) of the crankshaft and listed from
left to right with the recommended size.
SELECT FIT ROD BEARING GRADES
How to Determine Rod Bearing Class
This example shows how to determine the bearing class needed for each rod bearing, assuming
that a new crankshaft is being installed in a new or existing engine block. If the code 'B' 'A' 'B' 'B' 'B'
'C' is stamped on the #9 counterweight of the crankshaft (3), then rod #1 would require Class 2
bearings, rod #2 would require Class 1 bearings, rod #3 would require Class 2 bearings, rod #4
would require Class 2 bearings, rod #5 would require Class 2 bearings, and rod #6 would require
Class 3 bearings.
EXAMPLE
CONNECTING ROD BOLTS
NOTE: The rod bearing bolts should be examined before reuse. If the threads are necked down the
bolts must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1961
1. Examine connecting rod bolts for stretching. Stretching can be checked by holding a scale or
straight edge against the threads. If all the threads do
not contact the scale the bolt must be replaced.
2. Before installing the bolts the threads should be cleaned and inspected. 3. Install clean bolts
finger tight. Then alternately torque each bolt to assemble the cap properly. 4. Tighten the
connecting rod cap bolts to specification. See: Specifications/Engine - Specifications
CONNECTING ROD SIDE CLEARANCE
1. Mount a dial indicator to a stationary point on engine. Locate probe perpendicular to and resting
against the connecting rod cap being checked.
Move connecting rod all the way to rear of its travel (toward flywheel end of crank). Zero the dial
indicator. Move connecting rod forward of to limit of travel (toward pulley end of crank) and read the
dial indicator. Compare measurement to specification listed in engine specifications See:
Specifications/Engine - Specifications. Repeat procedure for each connecting rod. Turn crankshaft
for connecting rod accessibility.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
CONNECTING ROD
Journal Diameter..................................................................................................................................
...........................57.982-58.002 mm (2.282-2.283 in.) Journal Out-of-Round (MAX)..........................
.....................................................................................................................................0.007 mm
(0.0003 in.) journal Diametrical Taper (MAX).......................................................................................
................................................................0.006 mm (0.00025 in.)
Connecting Rod
Cap-Bolts......................................................................................................................................27 +
1/4 Turn Nm (20 + 1/4 Turn ft.lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1965
Connecting Rod: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The pistons are made of a high strength aluminum alloy. Top land height has been decreased to
reduce emissions. Piston skirts are coated with a solid lubricant for scuff resistance. Connecting
rod is forged steel with a fractured connecting rod cap design. The connecting rod is also equipped
with a squirt hole and attaches to the piston with a full floating pin retained by lock rings.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Connecting Rod: Procedures
FITTING PISTONS
The pistons are machined to two different weight specifications and matched to rods based on
weight. All piston and rod assemblies weigh the same to maintain engine balance.
Piston and cylinder wall must be clean and dry. Piston diameter should be measured 90 degrees to
piston pin at size location. Cylinder bores should be measured halfway down the cylinder bore and
transverse to the engine crankshaft center line See: Specifications/Engine - Specifications. Pistons
and cylinder bores should be measured at normal room temperature, 70°F (21°C).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1968
Connecting Rod: Removal and Replacement
Piston and Connecting Rod - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder heads See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal 2. Remove the oil pan. See: Engine Lubrication/Oil
Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan - Removal 3. Remove top ridge of cylinder bores with a
reliable ridge reamer before removing pistons from cylinder block. Be sure to keep tops of pistons
covered during this operation. Pistons and connecting rods must be removed from top of cylinder
block. When removing piston and connecting rod assemblies from the engine, rotate crankshaft so
that each connecting rod is centered in cylinder bore.
4. Inspect connecting rods and connecting rod caps for cylinder identification. Identify them with a
paint mark or scribe (1). 5. Remove connecting rod cap. Install protectors on connecting rod. Push
each piston and rod assembly out of cylinder bore.
NOTE: Be careful not to nick crankshaft journals.
6. After removal, install bearing cap on the mating rod.
Piston and Connecting Rod - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the piston rings. See: Piston Ring/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Piston
Ring(s) - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1969
NOTE: The connecting rod bearing cap bolts must be examined before reuse. If the threads are
necked down(1 and 2), the bolts must be
replaced.
2. Check connecting rod bolts for necking by holding a scale or straight edge against the threads. If
all threads do not contact the scale, the bolt must
be replaced.
3. Before installing pistons and connecting rod assemblies into the bore, ensure that compression
ring gaps are staggered so that neither is in line with
oil ring rail gap.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1970
4. Immerse the piston head and rings in clean engine oil, slide the ring compressor over the piston
and tighten with the special wrench. Ensure
position of rings does not change during this operation.
5. Install connecting rod bolt protectors on rod bolts. 6. Rotate crankshaft so that the connecting
rod journal is on the center of the cylinder bore. Insert rod and piston into cylinder bore and guide
rod
over the crankshaft journal.
CAUTION: Do Not interchange piston assemblies cylinder-to-cylinder or bank-to-bank.
7. The arrow (1) on top of piston must be pointing toward front of engine and oil squirt hole on
connecting rod faces the major thrust (right) side of
the cylinder bore.
8. Tap the piston down in cylinder bore, using a hammer handle. At the same time, guide
connecting rod into position on connecting rod journal. 9. Install rod caps. Install cleaned and
inspected connecting rod bolts and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) Plus 1/4 turn.
10. Install the cylinder head(s) See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Installation 11. Install the oil pan. See: Engine Lubrication/Oil
Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
MAIN BEARING
Main Bearing Diametrical Clearance....................................................................................................
..........................0.032-0.062 mm (0.0013-0.0024 in.) Bearing Clearance (Wear Limit).......................
....................................................................................................................................0.070 mm
(0.0027 in.)
Crankshaft
DIA Out-of-Round (MAX)......................................................................................................................
..............................................0.007 mm (0.0003 in.) Diametrical Taper (MAX)....................................
...............................................................................................................................0.006 mm
(0.00025 in.) End Play..........................................................................................................................
....................................................0.048-0.260 mm (0.002-0.010 in.) End Play (MAX).........................
............................................................................................................................................................0
.330 mm (0.013 in.)
Crankshaft Main Bearing Cap
Inner Main Cap
Bolts...............................................................................................................................................20
+ 1/4 Turn Nm (15 + 1/4 Turn ft.lbs.) Outer Main Cap
Bolts...............................................................................................................................................27
+ 1/4 Turn Nm (20 + 1/4 Turn ft.lbs.) Tie Bolts (Horizontal).................................................................
................................................................................................................28 Nm (250 in.lbs)
NOTE: The main bearing cap bolts must be tightened in the proper sequence. First the inner main
cap bolts, secondly the windage tray bolts,
lastly the main cap tie (horizontal) bolts.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Procedures
CRANKSHAFT MAIN BEARING FITTING
The main bearings use a "select fit" system to achieve proper oil clearances between the bearings
and the crankshaft. When main bearings are being selected for a new crankshaft, the block and
crankshaft grade identification marks must be used to identify the correct main bearings to use.
The cylinder block main bearing bore grade codes (1) are located on the left side front of the
engine block, just below the cylinder head mounting surface. These grade marks (1, 2, 3, or 4) are
read left to right, corresponding to main bearing bore 1, 2, 3, or 4.
The grade marks for the crankshaft are located on the rearmost crankshaft counter weight. The
crankshaft journal grade marks (A, B, or C) are read left to right, corresponding with journal number
1, 2, 3, 4. For an example, if the main bore grade on the side of the engine block is 3 and the
journal grade on the #9 counterweight of the crankshaft is B, the proper select fit bearing would be
a (2) +0.003 mm (+0.0001 in.).
Refer to the EXAMPLE CRANKSHAFT MAIN BEARING SELECTION DATA for a more detailed
example of how to properly select the main bearings.
NOTE: Service main bearings have a number from (1-5) marked in ink on the bearing surface. For
verification, refer to the MAIN BEARING
SELECTION CHART for number to size identification.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1976
The upper main bearing (2) has an oil feed hole and a center groove to allow lubrication of the
main journal and must be properly positioned in the block.
MAIN BEARING SELECTION CHART
How to Determine Crankshaft Main Bearing Class
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1977
This example shows how to determine the bearing class needed for each crankshaft main journal,
assuming that a new crankshaft is being installed in a new or existing engine block. If the code 'B'
'B' 'A' 'C' is stamped on the #9 counterweight of the crankshaft (3), and the code '1' '2' '2' '3' is
stamped on the side of the engine block (1), then main #1 would require Class 4 bearings, main #2
would require Class 3 bearings, main #3 would require Class 2 bearings, and main #4 would
require Class 3 bearings.
EXAMPLE CRANKSHAFT MAIN BEARING SELECTION DATA
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1978
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Removal and Replacement
Crankshaft Main Bearing(s) - Removal
REMOVAL
Bearing caps are not interchangeable and are marked to insure correct assembly. Upper and lower
bearing halves are NOT interchangeable.
1. Remove oil pan. See: Engine Lubrication/Oil Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan - Removal
2. Remove oil pick-up tube and windage tray. 3. Identify bearing caps before removal.
4. Remove bearing caps one at a time. Remove upper half of bearing (2 and 4) by inserting Special
Main Bearing Tool C-3059A (1 and 3) into the
oil hole of crankshaft.
5. Slowly rotate crankshaft clockwise, forcing out upper half of bearing shell.
Crankshaft Main Bearing(s) - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1979
Bearing caps are not interchangeable and are marked to insure correct assembly. Upper and lower
bearing halves are NOT interchangeable.
CAUTION: Main bearings are select fit. See: Procedures
NOTE: Only one main bearing should be selectively fitted while all other main bearing caps are
properly tightened.
When installing a new upper bearing shell, slightly chamfer the sharp edges from the plain side.
1. Lubricate main bearing with clean engine oil. 2. Start bearing in place, and insert Main Bearing
Tool C-3059A into oil hole of crankshaft. 3. Slowly rotate crankshaft counterclockwise sliding the
bearing into position. Remove Special Main Bearing Tool C-3059A.
NOTE: Lubricate main bearing cap bolts with engine oil before installation.
4. Lubricate and install lower bearing half and main cap Tighten bolts finger tight.
5. For installing thrust washers (1) at the No. 2 main bearing location, use the following procedure:
a. Move crankshaft forward to limit of travel. Lubricate and install the front thrust washer by rolling
the washer (1) onto the machined shelf
between the No. 2 upper main bulk head and crankshaft thrust surface.
b. Move crankshaft rearward to limit of travel. Lubricate and install the rear thrust washer by rolling
the washer onto the machined shelf between
the No. 2 upper main bulk head and crankshaft thrust surface.
The main bearing cap bolts must be tightened in the proper sequence. First the inner main cap
bolts, secondly the windage tray bolts, lastly the main cap tie (horizontal) bolts.
6. Install each main bearing cap and tighten inner bolts finger tight. 7. Tighten inner main bearing
cap bolts to 20 Nm + 1/4 turn (15 ft. lbs. + 1/4 turn). 8. Measure crankshaft end play. See:
Crankshaft/Service and Repair/Procedures 9. Install windage tray. Lubricate bolts with engine oil
and tighten to 27 Nm + 1/4 turn (20 ft. lbs. + 1/4 turn).
10. Install the main cap tie (horizontal) bolts and tighten to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.). 11. Install oil
pick-up tube. 12. Install oil pan. See: Engine Lubrication/Oil Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil
Pan - Installation 13. Fill engine crankcase with proper oil to correct level.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Seal Retainer
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Removal
Crankshaft Seal Retainer: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine oil panSee: Engine Lubrication/Oil Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan Removal. 2. Lower the weight of the engine back onto the engine mounts.
NOTE: Before separating the transmission from the engine, use an appropriate support fixture or
lifting device to support the weight of the
engine.
3. Remove transmission from vehicle. 4. Remove the flex plate. 5. Remove the rear crankshaft oil
seal retainer bolts. 6. Remove the crankshaft oil seal and clean all mating surfaces.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Seal Retainer
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Removal > Page 1984
Crankshaft Seal Retainer: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: If a burr or scratch is present on the crankshaft edge (chamfer), clean surface using 400
grit sand paper to prevent seal damage
during installation. Make sure the rear crankshaft oil seal surface is clean and free of any abrasive
materials.
NOTE: The rear crankshaft oil seal and retainer are an assembly. DO NOT separate the seal
protector from the rear crankshaft oil seal
before installation on engine. Damage to the seal lip will occur if the seal protector is removed and
installed prior to installation on engine.
1. Apply engine oil to crankshaft seal surface.
2. If the seal protector (1) is missing or was accidentally dislodged, go to 3. Otherwise, carefully
position the oil seal retainer assembly (3), and seal
protector (1) on crankshaft and push firmly into place on engine block (during this step, the seal
protector will be pushed from the rear oil seal assembly as a result of installing the rear oil seal).
Hand tighten the rear oil seal fasteners, and go to 4.
NOTE: The seal lip (2) must always uniformly curl inward toward the engine on the crankshaft (1).
CAUTION: If for any reason the installation sleeve is missing or dislodged from rear crankshaft oil
seal prior to installation, the following
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Seal Retainer
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Removal > Page 1985
procedure must be performed.
3. Using the chamfered seal guide from Special Tool 6926, insert the tapered end (1) into the
transmission side of the rear crankshaft oil seal
assembly (2), and push the seal guide through the seal assembly. This will ensure the seal lip is
positioned toward the engine when the seal assembly is installed. When the seal lip is correctly
positioned, go to 2.
NOTE: The following steps must be performed to prevent oil leaks at sealing joints.
4. Attach Special Tools 8225 (1) to pan rail using the oil pan fasteners
.
NOTE: Special Tools 8225 (1), are use to assist with the fit of the flush mount rear main seal
retainer. The notch on tool should be located
away the seal retainer.
5. While applying firm pressure to the seal retainer against Special Tools 8225 (1), tighten seal
retainer screws to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 6. Remove special tool #8225 (1).
NOTE: Make sure that the seal flange is flush with the block oil pan sealing surface.
7. Install oil pan. Tighten the 6mm fasteners to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.) and the 8mm fasteners to 28
Nm (250 in.lbs.). 8. Install the flex plate and transmission.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
CRANKSHAFT MAIN BEARING JOURNALS
CONNECTING ROD JOURNALS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Crankshaft - Description
Crankshaft: Description and Operation Crankshaft - Description
DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft is constructed of a forged micro alloy steel. A six throw, nine counterweight
crankshaft is supported by four select fit main bearings with number two serving as the thrust
washer location. The six separate connecting rod throws are an even-firing design which reduces
torque fluctuations while a torsional vibration damper is used to control torsion caused vibration of
the crankshaft. Rubber lipped seals are used at front and rear. The front seal is retained in the oil
pump case and the rear seal is retained in a block-mounted housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Crankshaft - Description > Page 1991
Crankshaft: Description and Operation Crankshaft - Operation
OPERATION
The crankshaft transfers force generated by combustion within the cylinder to the flywheel or
flexplate.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Crankshaft: Procedures
Crankshaft - Inspection
INSPECTION
The crankshaft journals should be checked for excessive wear, taper and scoring. Limits of taper
on any crankshaft journals should be held to 0.015 mm (0.0006 in.). Limits for journal roundness
should be 0.010 mm (0.0004 in.). Journal grinding should not exceed 0.254 mm (0.010 in.) under
the standard journal diameter. DO NOT grind thrust faces of Number 2 main bearing. DO NOT nick
crank pin or bearing fillets. After grinding, remove rough edges from crankshaft oil holes and clean
out all passages.
CAUTION: With a forged steel crankshaft it is important that the final paper or cloth polish after any
journal regrind be in the same direction
as normal rotation in the engine.
Measuring Crankshaft End Play
MEASURING CRANKSHAFT END PLAY
1. Mount a dial indicator to front of engine with the locating probe on nose of crankshaft. 2. Move
crankshaft all the way to the rear of its travel. 3. Zero the dial indicator. 4. Move crankshaft all the
way to the front and read the dial indicator. Crankshaft end play must be within specification See:
Specifications/Engine Specifications.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1994
Crankshaft: Removal and Replacement
Crankshaft - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove engine from vehicle See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Removal. 2. Remove oil pan See: Engine Lubrication/Oil Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan Removal. 3. Remove oil pickup tube (1) and windage tray (3). 4. Remove front timing belt cover
See: Timing Components/Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal. 5.
Remove timing belt and tensioner See: Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets
- Removal.
6. Remove crankshaft sprocket See: Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Removal.
7. Tap dowel pin out of crankshaft. 8. Remove oil pump assembly See: Engine Lubrication/Oil
Pump/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1995
9. Remove crankshaft rear oil seal retainer (1).
NOTE: Do not use a metal stamp to mark the bearing caps. Do use a scribe or paint mark.
10. Identify rod bearing caps before removal. Also scribe a location reference mark from the #2
main bearing cap to the engine block to use as a guide
during reassembly.
11. Remove connecting rod bearing caps. Connecting rod bearing caps are not interchangeable
and should be paint marked or scribed before removal
to insure correct assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1996
12. Remove main bearing caps (1). Main bearing caps are not interchangeable and are marked to
insure correct assembly and location. 13. Remove crankshaft (4) from cylinder block (7).
NOTE: Before installing crankshaft, refer to fitting of main bearings and installation of connecting
rod bearings See: Crankshaft Main
Bearing/Service and Repair/Procedures and See: Connecting Rod Bearing/Service and Repair .
Crankshaft - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Main bearings are select fit See: Crankshaft Main Bearing/Service and
Repair/Procedures for proper bearing size selection.
1. Install crankshaft upper main bearings in cylinder block. Ensure oil holes in bearings line up with
oil holes in cylinder block See: Crankshaft Main
Bearing/Service and Repair/Procedures.
2. Install the crankshaft to cylinder block.
3. Move crankshaft forward to limit of travel. Lubricate and install the front thrust washer by rolling
the washer onto the machined shelf between the
No. 2 upper main bulk head and crankshaft thrust surface.
4. Move crankshaft rearward to limit of travel. Lubricate and install the rear thrust washer by rolling
the washer onto the machined shelf between the
No. 2 upper main bulk head and crankshaft thrust surface.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1997
5. Install lower main bearings (3) into main bearing caps (1). 6. Lubricate lower main bearings (3)
with clean engine oil.
NOTE: Lubricate main bearing cap inner bolts (2) with engine oil before installation.
7. Install each main cap (1) and tighten inner bolts (2) finger tight. Align the location reference mark
scribed on the #2 main bearing cap during
disassembly.
CAUTION: The #2 main bearing cap must be centered over the inner bolt holes located on the
block. Failure to center the bearing cap can
result in contact with the crankshaft counterweights and thrust bearing failure.
8. Verify that the #2 main bearing cap is properly centered over the inner bolt holes located in the
block. Tighten main bearing cap inner bolts to 20
Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
9. Move crankshaft (1) forward to limit of travel so that crankshaft thrust face (2) is tight against
thrust bearing.
10. Verify that a 0.25 mm (0.010 inch) shim or feeler gage will fit between the #2 main cap (rear
face) and the crankshaft thrust face. Slide the gage
side-to-side all of the way across the cap making sure that the clearance at all areas exceeds 0.25
mm (0.010 inch). The feeler gage should slide all the way down to the #2 main journal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1998
11. Move crankshaft (1) rearward to limit of travel so that crankshaft thrust face (2) is tight against
thrust bearing. 12. Verify that a 0.25 mm (0.010 inch) shim or feeler gage will fit between the #2
main cap (front face) and the crankshaft thrust face. Slide the gage
side-to-side all of the way across the cap making sure that the clearance at all areas exceeds 0.25
mm (0.010 inch). The feeler gage should slide all the way down to the #2 main journal.
13. A properly centered #2 main bearing cap has a minimum of 0.25 mm (0.010 inch) clearance in
both the forward and rearward crankshaft positions.
If measured clearance is less than 0.25 mm (0.010 inch), loosen and reposition #2 main bearing
cap until this minimum clearance can be verified by repeating this procedure.
14. Following verification of proper #2 bearing cap centering, finish tightening the main bearing cap
inner bolts an additional 90° turn.
15. Measure crankshaft end play See: Procedures.
16. Install connecting rods and measure side clearance See: Connecting Rod Bearing/Service and
Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1999
NOTE: The main bearing cap bolts must be tightened in the proper sequence. First the inner main
cap bolts, secondly the windage tray bolts,
lastly the main cap tie (horizontal) bolts.
17. Install windage tray (3). Lubricate bolts with engine oil. Finger tighten all bolts first, then tighten
to 28 Nm + 90° turn (20 ft. lbs. + 90° turn)
beginning with the inside bolts tightening outward.
18. Install oil pickup tube (1) and tighten bolt to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
19. Install the main cap tie (horizontal) bolts and tighten to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2000
20. Install rear crankshaft oil seal retainer and oil seal See: Crankshaft Seal Retainer/Service and
Repair/Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer Installation.
21. Install oil pump assembly See: Engine Lubrication/Oil Pump/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement 22. Install dowel pin in crankshaft. 23. Install crankshaft sprocket See: Timing
Components/Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Installation.
24. Install timing belt and tensioner See: Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Installation.
25. Install front timing belt cover See: Timing Components/Timing Cover/Service and
Repair/Engine Timing Cover(s) - Installation. 26. Install oil pan See: Engine Lubrication/Oil
Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan - Installation. 27. Install engine assembly See: Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine - Installation. 28. Fill engine crankcase with proper
amount of oil.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Engine Block Heater: Description and Operation
OPERATION
When power is applied (110 volt A.C.) to the block heater, the heating element transfers heat
through the aluminum engine block and into the coolant without directly penetrating the cooling
system.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2004
Engine Block Heater: Testing and Inspection
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER TESTING
If unit does not operate, test power cord for continuity with a 110-volt voltmeter or 110-volt test
light. Test heater element continuity with an ohmmeter or 12-volt test light.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Block Heater - Removal
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair Engine Block Heater - Removal
3.5L
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Detach power cord plug from heater. 3. Remove block heater attaching
screw located below heater terminals. 4. Remove block heater from cylinder block.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Block Heater - Removal > Page 2007
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair Engine Block Heater - Installation
3.5L
1. Thoroughly clean cylinder block heater cavity. 2. Insert heater assembly into block such that
mounting hole is located below heater terminals. 3. Install mounting screw and tighten to 12 Nm
(105 in. lb.).
CAUTION: To prevent damage, the power cord must be secured in its retainer clips, and not
positioned so it could contact linkages or exhaust
manifolds.
4. Attach power cord to heater. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Crankshaft Damper-Bolt.......................................................................................................................
........................................................95 Nm (70 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vibration Damper - Removal
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair Vibration Damper - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Remove the right engine mount
See: Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Engine Mount/Service and Repair/Engine
Mount Insulator Removal.
4. Remove the right front wheel and accessory drive belt splash shield. 5. Remove accessory drive
belt See: Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Drive Belt/Service and Repair/Removal
and
Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Removal.
6. Suitably support the engine. 7. Remove the lower crossmember. See: Body and
Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service and Repair/Crossmember - Removal 8. Low the engine. 9.
Remove vibration damper bolt.
10. Use Special Tool 1023 puller (1) , and insert 9020 (2), remove crankshaft damper.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vibration Damper - Removal > Page 2013
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair Vibration Damper - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install crankshaft damper using Special Tools C-4685-C1 (5.9 in.) Bolt (2), with Nut and Thrust
Bearing from 6792, and 6792-1 (1) Installer. 2. Install vibration damper bolt. Torque bolt to 95 Nm
(70 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the lower crossmember See: Body and Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service
and Repair/Crossmember - Installation. 4. Install accessory drive belt See: Drive Belts, Mounts,
Brackets and Accessories/Drive Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Installation.
5. Install the accessory drive belt splash shield and right front wheel. 6. Lower vehicle. 7. Install the
right engine mount See: Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Engine Mount/Service and
Repair/Engine Mount Insulator Installation.
8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
PISTONS
PISTONS
PISTON PINS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2017
Piston: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The pistons are made of a high strength aluminum alloy. Top land height has been decreased to
reduce emissions. Piston skirts are coated with a solid lubricant for scuff resistance. Connecting
rod is forged steel with a fractured connecting rod cap design. The connecting rod is also equipped
with a squirt hole and attaches to the piston with a full floating pin retained by lock rings.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Piston: Procedures
FITTING PISTONS
The pistons are machined to two different weight specifications and matched to rods based on
weight. All piston and rod assemblies weigh the same to maintain engine balance.
Piston and cylinder wall must be clean and dry. Piston diameter should be measured 90 degrees to
piston pin at size location. Cylinder bores should be measured halfway down the cylinder bore and
transverse to the engine crankshaft center line See: Specifications/Engine - Specifications. Pistons
and cylinder bores should be measured at normal room temperature, 70°F (21°C).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2020
Piston: Removal and Replacement
Piston and Connecting Rod - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder heads See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal 2. Remove the oil pan. See: Engine Lubrication/Oil
Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan - Removal 3. Remove top ridge of cylinder bores with a
reliable ridge reamer before removing pistons from cylinder block. Be sure to keep tops of pistons
covered during this operation. Pistons and connecting rods must be removed from top of cylinder
block. When removing piston and connecting rod assemblies from the engine, rotate crankshaft so
that each connecting rod is centered in cylinder bore.
4. Inspect connecting rods and connecting rod caps for cylinder identification. Identify them with a
paint mark or scribe (1). 5. Remove connecting rod cap. Install protectors on connecting rod. Push
each piston and rod assembly out of cylinder bore.
NOTE: Be careful not to nick crankshaft journals.
6. After removal, install bearing cap on the mating rod.
Piston and Connecting Rod - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the piston rings. See: Piston Ring/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Piston
Ring(s) - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2021
NOTE: The connecting rod bearing cap bolts must be examined before reuse. If the threads are
necked down(1 and 2), the bolts must be
replaced.
2. Check connecting rod bolts for necking by holding a scale or straight edge against the threads. If
all threads do not contact the scale, the bolt must
be replaced.
3. Before installing pistons and connecting rod assemblies into the bore, ensure that compression
ring gaps are staggered so that neither is in line with
oil ring rail gap.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2022
4. Immerse the piston head and rings in clean engine oil, slide the ring compressor over the piston
and tighten with the special wrench. Ensure
position of rings does not change during this operation.
5. Install connecting rod bolt protectors on rod bolts. 6. Rotate crankshaft so that the connecting
rod journal is on the center of the cylinder bore. Insert rod and piston into cylinder bore and guide
rod
over the crankshaft journal.
CAUTION: Do Not interchange piston assemblies cylinder-to-cylinder or bank-to-bank.
7. The arrow (1) on top of piston must be pointing toward front of engine and oil squirt hole on
connecting rod faces the major thrust (right) side of
the cylinder bore.
8. Tap the piston down in cylinder bore, using a hammer handle. At the same time, guide
connecting rod into position on connecting rod journal. 9. Install rod caps. Install cleaned and
inspected connecting rod bolts and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) Plus 1/4 turn.
10. Install the cylinder head(s) See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Installation 11. Install the oil pan. See: Engine Lubrication/Oil
Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
PISTON RINGS
PISTON RING SIDE CLEARANCE
PISTON RING WIDTH
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2026
Piston Ring: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The piston rings include a moly-filled top ring with a symmetrical barrel face. The intermediate
piston ring (2 and 3) is of the Micro-Napier design. The Micro-Napier design has a reduced "hook"
on the running face, removes the need for chroming and improves oil economy. The oil control
package consists of two steel rails and an expander spacer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Piston Ring: Procedures
PISTON RING FITTING
1. Wipe cylinder bore clean. Insert ring and push down with piston to ensure it is square in bore.
The ring gap measurement must be made with the
ring positioning at least 12 mm (0.50 in.) from bottom of cylinder bore. Check gap with feeler gauge
(1). For clearance specifications, See: Specifications/Engine - Specifications.
2. Check piston ring to groove clearance (1). For clearance specifications, See:
Specifications/Engine - Specifications.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2029
Piston Ring: Removal and Replacement
Piston Ring(s) - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove piston and connecting rod. See: Connecting Rod/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Piston and Connecting Rod - Removal 2. Remove No. 1 and No.2 piston rings from
piston using a ring expander tool. 3. Remove upper oil ring side rail. 4. Remove lower oil ring side
rail. 5. Remove oil ring expander
Piston Ring(s) - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Measure clearance of piston rings to the cylinder bore and piston. See: Procedures
The No. 1 and No. 2 piston rings have a different cross section. Ensure that which ever design No.
2 ring is installed, it is installed with manufacturers I.D. mark (dot) facing up, towards top of the
piston See: Description and Operation.
CAUTION: Install piston rings in the following order: Do not use a piston ring expander during this
step.
- Oil ring expander.
- Lower oil ring side rail.
- Upper oil ring side rail.
- No. 2 Intermediate piston ring.
- No. 1 Upper piston ring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2030
2. Install the side rail (1) by placing one end between the piston ring groove and the expander. Hold
end firmly and press down the portion to be
installed until side rail is in position.
The No. 1 and No. 2 piston rings have a different cross section. Ensure that when the No. 2 ring is
installed, it is installed with manufacturers I.D. mark facing up, towards top of the piston See:
Description and Operation.
3. Install upper side rail first and then the lower side rail. 4. Install the No. 2 piston ring and then No.
1 piston ring.
5. Position piston ring end gaps. 6. Position oil ring expander gap at least 45° from the side rail
gaps but not on the piston pin center or on the thrust direction. Staggering ring gap is
important for oil control.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
1. Remove fuel fill cap. 2. Remove fuel pump fuse from Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
For location of fuse, refer to label on underside of TIPM cover. 3. Start and run engine until it stalls.
4. Attempt restarting engine until it will no longer run. 5. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 6. Place
a rag or towel below fuel line quick-connect fitting at fuel rail. 7. Disconnect quick-connect fitting at
fuel rail See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Line Coupler/Service
and Repair. 8. When the repair is complete, reconnect fuel fittings and return fuel pump fuse to
TIPM. 9. One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) may have been stored in PCM memory
due to fuel pump fuse removal. A diagnostic scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Rocker Arm - Description
Rocker Arm Assembly: Description and Operation Rocker Arm - Description
ROCKER ARM
Rocker arms are made of light weight permanent mold aluminum alloy with a roller type follower
operating against the camshaft. The valve actuating end of the rocker arms are machined to retain
hydraulic lash adjusters, eliminating the need for manual valve lash adjustment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Rocker Arm - Description > Page 2039
Rocker Arm Assembly: Description and Operation Rocker Arm - Operation
OPERATION
The rocker arm is the pivot point between the camshaft lobe and the valve.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Rocker Arm - Description > Page 2040
Rocker Arm Assembly: Description and Operation Rocker Arm Shaft - Description
ROCKER ARM SHAFTS
The rocker arm shafts are tubular steel and supported by several forged aluminum alloy pedestals,
which are fastened to the cylinder head. Four shafts are used, one for each intake and exhaust
rocker arm bank on each cylinder head. The shafts are hollow to provide a duct for lubricating oil
flow from the cylinder head to the valve mechanisms. One hollow dowel per pedestal is used to
locate the pedestal to the cylinder head, orient the exhaust rocker shaft, and serve as a cam
bearing oil feed passage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Rocker Arm Assembly: Procedures
INSPECTION
The rocker arm shafts are hollow and are used as lubrication oil ducts. The rocker arm and shaft
assembly on the right side of the engine has an oil passage hole from the cylinder head located at
the third rocker shaft support pedestal. The rocker arm and shaft assembly on the left side of the
engine has an oil passage hole from the cylinder head located at the second rocker shaft support
pedestal.
NOTE: To prevent air ingestion into lash adjusters, avoid turning rocker arm assembly upside
down.
CAUTION: Do not allow rocker arm assembly to rest on lash adjusters, as damage may occur to
lash adjuster and plastic retainer.
The intake and exhaust rocker arms are different. They should be identified before disassembling
the assembly.
Check rocker arms for wear or damage:
- Roller scuffing or wear
- Shaft bore scuffing or wear
- Swivel pad on lash adjuster missing or broken
- Rocker arm showing signs of fatigue or cracking
- Roller axle protruding from arm
Replace assembly as necessary if any rocker arms shows signs of wear.
CAUTION: Do not remove lash adjuster from rocker arm assembly. Damage to the adjuster and
rocker arm will result.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2043
Rocker Arm Assembly: Removal and Replacement
Valve Rocker Arm - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head covers See: Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s)
- Removal.
CAUTION: DO NOT use a number stamp or a punch to mark the rocker arms. Damage to the
rocker arms could occur.
2. Using a permanent ink or paint marker, identify the location and position on each rocker arm. 3.
Remove the rocker arm assembly bolts in the sequence shown.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2044
4. Remove the rocker arm assembly (2).
NOTE: To prevent air ingestion into the lash adjusters, avoid turning the rocker arm assembly
upside down.
CAUTION: Do not allow rocker arm assembly to rest on lash adjusters, as damage may occur to
lash adjusters and/or plastic retainers.
Valve Rocker Arm - Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
CAUTION: DO NOT use a number stamp or a punch to mark the rocker arms. Damage to the
rocker arms could occur.
1. Using a permanent ink or paint marker, identify the location and position on each rocker arm and
remove the rocker arm and shaft assembly See:
Valve Rocker Arm - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2045
2. Remove the dowel pins using a 4 mm screw, nut, spacer, and washer installed into the pin.
Thread the screw into the pin, then loosen the nut on the
screw. This will pull the dowel out of the shaft support. Do not reuse the dowel pins.
NOTE: The identification marks (notches) (1) face toward the front of the engine for the left head
and toward the rear of the engine for the
right head.
3. Remove the rocker arms and pedestals in order. 4. Check the rocker arm mounting portion of
the shafts for wear or damage. Replace if damaged or heavily worn. 5. Check the shaft oil holes for
clogging with a small wire, clean as required.
Valve Rocker Arm - Assembly
ASSEMBLY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2046
CAUTION: The rocker arm shafts are hollow and are used as lubrication oil passages. The rocker
arm and shaft assembly on the RIGHT side
of the engine has an oil passage hole from the cylinder head to the third rocker shaft support. The
rocker arm shaft assembly on the LEFT side of the engine has an oil passage hole from the
cylinder head to the second rocker shaft support.
NOTE: A new fully assembled rocker arm and shaft assembly can be installed on either the right or
left side of the engine. The identification
marks (notches) (1) face toward the front of the engine for the left head and toward the rear of the
engine for the right head.
1. Position the shafts with the notches (1) facing up. Install the rocker arms and pedestals onto the
shafts.
CAUTION: New dowel pins must be installed when reassembling.
2. Install the dowel pins (2). The dowel pins (2) pass through the pedestal (3) into the exhaust
rocker shafts. Dowel pins (2) should be pressed in until
they bottom-out against the rocker shaft in the pedestal (3).
3. Install the rocker arm and shafts assembly See: Valve Rocker Arm - Installation
Valve Rocker Arm - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2047
NOTE: The rocker arm and shaft assembly can be installed either prior to or after (preferred)
cylinder head installation.
1. Rotate camshaft gears clockwise to where the number one cylinder intake valves would just start
to open. The camshaft lobes are now in a neutral
position (no load to the valve). This will allow the rocker arm shaft assembly to be tightened into
position with little or no valve spring load on it.
NOTE: A new fully assembled rocker arm and shaft assembly can be installed on either the right or
left side of the engine. The identification
marks (notches) (1) face toward the front of the engine for the left head and toward the rear of the
engine for the right head.
2. Install the rocker arm and shaft assembly making sure that the identification marks (1) face
toward the front of engine for left head and toward the
rear of the engine for right head.
3. Tighten the rocker arm/shaft assembly bolts in the sequence shown to 31 Nm (275 in. lbs.). 4.
Install the cylinder head covers See: Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal
Left
REMOVAL
WARNING: Do not start or run the engine with the cylinder head cover removed. Damage or
personal injury may occur.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect and remove the three ignition coils See: Powertrain Management/Ignition
System/Ignition Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition Coil Removal.
3. Disconnect engine harness retaining clips (2) from cylinder head cover studs. Position the
engine harness aside. 4. Disconnect the PCV hose (3) from the valve cover assembly (if required).
5. Completely loosen the eight cylinder head cover retaining bolts (4) and remove the cylinder head
cover.
Right
REMOVAL
WARNING: Do not start or run the engine with the cylinder head cover removed. Damage or
personal injury may occur.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold from the engine
See: Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3. Cover lower intake manifold
intake ports with a clean cover to prevent dirt or debris from entering the ports during service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal > Page 2052
4. Disconnect the ignition coil harness connectors (2). 5. Remove ignition coils See: Powertrain
Management/Ignition System/Ignition Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition Coil - Removal. 6.
Disconnect the engine wiring harness retainers (1) from the valve cover. 7. Disconnect the makeup
air hose (3). 8. Completely loosen the cylinder head cover retaining bolts (4) and remove the
cylinder head cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal > Page 2053
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Installation
Left
INSTALLATION
1. Clean cylinder head and all gasket sealing surfaces. Inspect and replace gasket and seals as
necessary.
2. Using a suitable pry tool, carefully remove spark plug tube seals (2). 3. Position new seal with
the part number on seal facing cylinder head cover.
4. Install seals using Camshaft Installer MD-998306 (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal > Page 2054
5. Install cylinder head cover and bolts (4). Tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
6. Install the PCV hose (3) (if required). 7. Position the wiring harness on the cylinder head cover.
8. Reinstall the wire harness retainers (2) around the perimeter of the valve cover. 9. Install the
ignition coils See: Powertrain Management/Ignition System/Ignition Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition
Coil - Installation.
10. Connect the ignition coil electrical connectors (1). 11. Connect negative battery cable.
Right
INSTALLATION
1. Clean cylinder head and cover mating surfaces. Inspect and replace gasket and seals as
necessary. 2. Using a suitable pry tool, carefully remove tube seals (2). 3. Position new seal with
the part number on seal facing cylinder head cover.
4. Install seals using Camshaft Installer MD-998306 (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal > Page 2055
5. Install cylinder head cover bolts (4) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.). 6. Reconnect the wire
harness retainers (1) to the valve cover. 7. Install the ignition coils See: Powertrain
Management/Ignition System/Ignition Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition Coil - Installation. 8. Connect
the ignition coil electrical connectors (2). 9. Reconnect the makeup air hose (3).
10. Install upper intake manifold See: Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold Installation. 11. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Valve Springs - Description
Valve Spring: Description and Operation Valve Springs - Description
DESCRIPTION
The valve springs are made from chrome silicon alloy wire and incorporate a "bee-hive" design.
Valve spring retainers and locks are common from valve-to-valve. The valve spring seat is integral
with the valve stem oil seal, which incorporates a garter spring to maintain consistent lubrication
control to the valve stem.
The valve springs are unique for intake compared to exhaust. Both have different lengths and are
wound in opposite directions. The valve springs are color coded, intake spring is right hand coil
direction with grey dye on the top coils, and the exhaust spring is left hand coil direction with a blue
dye on the top coils.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Valve Springs - Description > Page 2060
Valve Spring: Description and Operation Valve Springs - Operation
OPERATION
The valve spring returns the valve against its seat for a positive seal of the combustion chamber.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Valve Spring: Procedures
INSPECTION
When valves have been removed for inspection, reconditioning or replacement, valve springs
should be tested. As an example; the compression length of the spring to be tested is 38.00 mm
(1.496 in.). Turn table of Tool C-647 until surface is in line with the 38.00 mm (1.496 inches.) mark
on the threaded stud and the zero mark on the front. Place spring over stud on the table and lift
compressing lever to set tone device. Pull on torque wrench until ping is heard. Take reading on
torque wrench at this instant. Multiply this reading by two. This will give the spring load at test
length. Fractional measurements are indicated on the table for finer adjustments. Refer to Engine
Specifications to obtain specified height and allowable tensions See: Specifications/Engine Specifications. Replace springs that do not meet specifications.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2063
Valve Spring: Removal and Replacement
Cylinder Head Off
CYLINDER HEAD OFF
1. Compress valve spring with valve spring compressor C-3422-D and adapter 6526A See: Tools
and Equipment. 2. Remove valve retaining locks. Release valve spring compressor. Remove valve
spring retainer and valve spring. 3. Remove valve stem seal assembly. See: Seals and
Gaskets/Valve Guide Seal/Service and Repair/Valve Guide Seals - Removal
Cylinder Head On
CYLINDER HEAD ON
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. 2. Remove upper intake manifold See: Intake
Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3. Remove cylinder head cover(s) See:
Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal. 4. Remove rocker arm and
shaft assembly See: Rocker Arm Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve
Rocker Arm - Removal. 5. Remove spark plugs. 6. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, until the
number 1 piston is at TDC (Top Dead Center) on the compression stroke. 7. With air hose attached
to spark plug adapter installed in number 1 spark plug hole, apply 620.5 to 689 kPa (90 to 100 psi)
air pressure. This is to
hold valves into place while servicing components.
NOTE: It may be necessary to use accessory studs 6886, adapter arm 6887 and 6885 valve
adaptor along with MD 998772A, to compress the
valve spring on the right cylinder head exhaust valves.
8. Using Tool MD 998772A (1), with adapter 6527 (4) or equivalent, compress valve spring and
remove valve locks (5). Release tension on valve
spring, remove retainer (5) and valve spring See: Tools and Equipment.
9. Remove valve stem seal, if required. See: Seals and Gaskets/Valve Guide Seal/Service and
Repair/Valve Guide Seals - Removal
10. Follow the same procedure on the remaining 5 cylinders using the firing sequence 1-2-3-4-5-6.
Make sure piston is at TDC in each cylinder of
the valve spring that is being removed.
11. Remove spark plug adapter tool.
Cylinder Head Off
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2064
CYLINDER HEAD OFF
1. Install valves if removed. 2. Install valve stem seal/spring seat assembly (5) over valve guides on
all valve stems. Ensure that the garter spring is intact around the top of the
rubber seal.
3. Place valve spring (color-coded end facing up) (4) and valve retainer into position.
4. Compress valve spring with valve spring compressor. Install locks and release tool. If valve
and/or seat are reground, measure the installed
height of springs (B), make sure measurements are taken from top of spring seat to the bottom
surface of spring retainer. If height is greater than 38.75 mm (1.5256 in.), install a 0.762 mm (0.030
in.) spacer in head counterbore under the valve spring seat to bring spring height back within
specification.
Cylinder Head On
CYLINDER HEAD ON
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2065
1. Install new valve seal(s) if required See: Seals and Gaskets/Valve Guide Seal/Service and
Repair/Valve Guide Seals - Installation. 2. Place valve spring (color-coded end facing up) and valve
retainer into position.
NOTE: It may be necessary to use accessory studs 6886, adaptor arm 6887 and 6885 valve
adaptor along with MD 998772A, to compress the
valve spring on the right cylinder head exhaust valves.
3. Compress valve spring using Special Tool MD 998772A (1) with Adaptor 6527 (4), only enough
to install locks (5). 4. After installing locks, release tension on valve spring and verify proper
installation. 5. Remove Special Tool MD 998772A (1) and spark plug adapter tool. 6. Install rocker
arm and shaft assembly. See: Rocker Arm Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Rocker Arm - Installation
7. Install cylinder head cover(s) See: Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) Installation. 8. Install spark plugs. 9. Install upper intake manifold See: Intake Manifold/Service and
Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation.
10. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Intake and Exhaust Valves - Description
Valve: Description and Operation Intake and Exhaust Valves - Description
DESCRIPTION
Valves are made of highly heat-resistant steel and are chrome plated to prevent stem scuffing. The
intake valve is a one-piece forging, while the exhaust valve has a forged head with a welded stem
for lock groove durability. The four valves (two intake and two exhaust) employ a three-groove lock
design to help facilitate valve rotation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Intake and Exhaust Valves - Description > Page 2070
Valve: Description and Operation Intake and Exhaust Valves - Operation
OPERATION
The intake valve allows the air/fuel mixture to enter the combustion chamber. The exhaust valve
allows the burned air/fuel mixture to exit the combustion chamber. Also, the intake and exhaust
valves seal the combustion chamber during the compression and power strokes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Intake and Exhaust Valves - Inspection
Valve: Testing and Inspection Intake and Exhaust Valves - Inspection
VALVES
1. Measure valve stems for wear approximately 60 mm (2.36 in.) below the valve lock grooves. 2.
Compare measurement to specifications, See: Specifications/Engine - Specifications.
NOTE: Valve stems are chrome plated and should not be polished.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Intake and Exhaust Valves - Inspection > Page 2073
Valve: Testing and Inspection Intake and Exhaust Valve Guides - Inspection
VALVE GUIDES
1. Measure valve stem-to-guide clearance as follows: 2. Install valve into cylinder head so it is 15
mm (0.590 inch.) off the valve seat. A small piece of hose may be used to hold valve in place. 3.
Attach dial indicator Tool C-3339A to cylinder head and set it at right angle of valve stem being
measured. 4. Move valve to and from the indicator. 5. Note dial indicator reading and compare to
engine specifications. See: Specifications/Engine - Specifications
NOTE: Replace cylinder head if stem-to-guide clearance exceeds specifications, or if guide is loose
in cylinder head.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Valve: Procedures
Intake and Exhaust Valves - Cleaning
CLEANING
1. Clean all valves thoroughly and discard burned, warped and cracked valves.
Valve and Valve Seat Refacing
VALVE AND VALVE SEAT REFACING
Refer to Engine Specifications for the valve face and valve seat angles See: Specifications/Engine
- Specifications.
VALVES
1. Inspect the remaining margin after the valves are refaced See: Specifications/Engine Specifications.
VALVE SEATS
1. When refacing valve seats, it is important that the correct size valve guide pilot be used for
re-seating stones. A true and complete surface must be
obtained.
2. Measure the concentricity of valve seat using dial indicator. Total runout should not exceed
0.051 mm (0.002 inch.) total indicator reading.
3. Inspect the valve seat with Prussian blue to determine where the valve contacts the seat. To do
this, coat valve seat LIGHTLYwith Prussian blue
then set valve in place. Rotate the valve with light pressure. If the blue is transferred to the center
of valve face, contact is satisfactory. If the blue is transferred to top edge of valve face, then lower
valve seat with a 15 degree stone. If the blue is transferred to the bottom edge of valve face, then
raise valve seat with a 65 degree stone.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2076
NOTE: Valve seats which are worn or burned can be reworked, provided that correct angle and
seat width are maintained. Otherwise, the
cylinder head must be replaced.
4. When seat is properly positioned, the width of the intake seats should be 0.75 to 1.25 mm
(0.0296 to 0.0493 in.) and exhaust seats should be 1.25
to 1.75 mm (0.049 to 0.069 in.).
VALVE AND SPRING INSTALLED HEIGHT
1. Coat valve stems with clean engine oil and insert the valves into the cylinder head. 2. If valves or
seats have been refaced, check valve tip height (A). If valve tip height is greater than 43.65 mm
(1.7185 in.) intake or 45.98 mm
(1.8102 in.) exhaust, grind valve tip until within specifications. Make sure measurement is taken
from cylinder head surface to the top of valve stem.
3. Install valve seal/spring seat assembly over valve guides on all valve stems. Ensure that the
garter spring is intact around the top of the valve seal. 4. Place valve spring (color-coded end
facing up) and valve retainer into position on spring seat. 5. Compress valve springs with valve
spring compressor C-3422-D and adapter 6526A See: Tools and Equipment, install locks and
release tool.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2077
6. If valves and/or seats are refaced, measure the installed height of springs. Measurements are
taken from top of spring seat to the bottom surface of
spring retainer. If height is greater than 38.75 mm (1.5256 in.), install a 0.762 mm (0.030 in.)
spacer in head counterbore under the valve spring seat to bring spring height back within
specification.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2078
Valve: Removal and Replacement
Intake and Exhaust Valves - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head(s) See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head Removal. 2. Remove rocker arm assembly See: Rocker Arm Assembly/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Rocker Arm - Removal. 3. Remove valve spring(s) See:
Valve Spring/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Springs - Removal. 4. Before
removing valve, remove any burrs from valve stem lock grooves to prevent damage to the valve
guides. Identify valves to insure
installation in original location.
5. Remove valve(s) from cylinder head.
Intake and Exhaust Valves - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Coat valve stems with clean engine oil and insert the valves into the cylinder head. 2. If valves or
seats have been reground, check valve tip height (A). If valve tip height is greater than 43.65 mm
(1.7185 in.) intake or 45.98 mm
(1.8102 in.) exhaust, grind valve tip until within specifications. Make sure measurement is taken
from cylinder head surface to the top of valve stem.
3. Install new valve stem seals. 4. Install valve springs See: Valve Spring/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Springs - Installation. 5. Install cylinder head(s) See:
Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Description and Operation
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT - WORLD ENGINE
The accessory drive belt is a Poly-V type belt. On the 2.4L engine, the accessory drive belt drives
the generator, P/S pump and air conditioning compressor.
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT -3.5L
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2083
On the 3.5L, the accessory drive belt drives the generator, P/S pump, and A/C compressor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2084
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELTS
Satisfactory performance of the belt driven accessories depends on belt condition and proper belt
tension.
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT DIAGNOSIS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Drive Belt: Procedures
Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Inspection
INSPECTION
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required:
- Excessive wear
- Frayed cords
- Severe glazing
Poly-V Belt system may develop minor cracks across the ribbed side (due to reverse bending).
These minor cracks are considered normal and acceptable. Parallel cracks are not.
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V Belts.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2087
Drive Belt: Removal and Replacement
Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Removal
3.5L ENGINE
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT -3.5L
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove RH wheelhouse splash shield.See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal
3. Rotate accessory drive belt tensioner (3) clockwise to allow enough slack to remove accessory
drive belt (5).
Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Installation
3.5L ENGINE
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT -3.5L
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2088
1. Position accessory drive belt (5) on all pulleys except generator (6). 2. Rotate accessory drive
belt tensioner (3) clockwise. 3. Position accessory drive belt (5) on generator pulley (6). 4. Slowly
release accessory drive belt tensioner (3). 5. Install RH wheelhouse splash shield. See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield Installation
6. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner - Removal
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner - Removal
3.5L ENGINE
WARNING: Because of high spring pressure, do not attempt to disassemble automatic tensioner.
Unit is serviced as an assembly.
1. Remove the passenger side engine support bracket bolts (1).
2. Raise and support the vehicle. 3. Remove the accessory drive belt See: Drive Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Removal. 4. Remove the
belly pan retainers (1). 5. Remove the belly pan (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner - Removal > Page
2093
6. Support the engine fore/aft crossmember (2) with an appropriate stand (1).
7. Loosen the rear bolts (2) from the fore/aft crossmember (1). 8. Remove the front bolts from the
fore/aft crossmember.
9. Lower the stand supporting the fore/aft crossmember approximately 3/4" to 1".
10. Remove the tensioner assembly bolt (2). 11. Remove the accessory drive belt tensioner (1)
from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner - Removal > Page
2094
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner - Installation
3.5L ENGINE
1. Position the accessory drive belt tensioner (1) on the front engine cover (3). 2. Install the
mounting bolt (2). Tighten the bolt to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
3. Raise the fore/aft crossmember (1) approximately 3/4" to 1". 4. Install the front fore/aft
crossmember bolts. Tighten the bolts to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.). 5. Tighten the rear fore/aft
crossmember bolts (2) to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the stand (1) from the fore/aft crossmember (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner - Removal > Page
2095
7. Install the belly pan (2). 8. Install accessory drive belt See: Drive Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Installation
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Install the three bolts (1) at the passenger side engine support bracket. Tighten the bolts to 45
Nm (33 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal
Engine Mount: Service and Repair Engine Mount Insulator - Removal
Left
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove air cleaner housing assembly (4)
See: Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks/Air Cleaner Housing/Service and Repair/Air
Cleaner
Body - Removal.
3. Remove the belly pan (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal > Page 2100
4. Support transmission with floor jack and wooden block. 5. Remove the vertical bolts (1) from the
left engine mount (2) to transmission bracket.
6. Slightly lower transmission with floor jack to gain access to mount to frame rail fastener (2). 7.
Remove mount isolator (3).
Rear
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal > Page 2101
1. Remove the belly pan (2).
2. Remove the Power Transfer Unit (PTU). See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Transfer
Case/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Power
Transfer Unit - Removal
3. Remove the 3 top mount bracket bolts (1). 4. Remove the 4 lower mount to cradle bolts (2). 5.
Remove rear mount (3).
Front
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle.
2. Remove the belly pan (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal > Page 2102
3. Remove fore aft member (3) to mount (4) bolts. 4. Remove mount through bolt (1). 5. Remove
fore aft member (3) mounting bolts and remove. 6. Remove front mount (4).
Right
REMOVAL
1. Remove the belly pan (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal > Page 2103
2. Lower vehicle. Remove the load on the engine motor mounts by carefully supporting the engine
assembly from below. 3. Remove Power Steering Fluid Reservoir and set aside See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering Fluid
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal.
4. Disconnect the ground strap. 5. Remove the right engine support bracket vertical fasteners (1)
and (2) and remove support bracket (3). 6. Remove the bolts (5) attaching the right isolator (4) to
the frame rail. 7. Remove right isolator (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal > Page 2104
Engine Mount: Service and Repair Engine Mount Insulator - Installation
Left
INSTALLATION
1. Position mount isolator (3) in place, install bolts (1, 2) and tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
2. Raise transaxle into position, install bolts (2) and tighten to 98 Nm (72 ft. lbs.). 3. Remove floor
jack and wooden block.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal > Page 2105
4. Install belly pan (2).
5. Install the air cleaner housing assembly (4) See: Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks/Air
Cleaner Housing/Service and Repair/Air Cleaner
Body - Removal
6. Connect negative battery cable.
Rear
INSTALLATION
1. Position rear mount (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal > Page 2106
2. Install the 4 lower mount to cradle bolts (2) and torque to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.). 3. Install 3 top
mount bracket bolts and torque 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.). 4. Install the Power Transfer Unit (PTU). See:
Transmission and Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Power
Transfer Unit - Installation.
5. Install the belly pan (2).
Front
INSTALLATION
1. Position mount (4) and torque bolts to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.). 2. Install fore aft member (3) and
torque bolts to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.). 3. Install mount through bolt (1) and torque to 47 Nm (35 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal > Page 2107
4. Install the belly pan (2). 5. Lower vehicle.
Right
INSTALLATION
1. Position right isolator (4) and install the isolator to frame rail bolts (5). Tighten bolts to 55 Nm (40
ft. lbs.). 2. Install the engine support bracket (3) and bolts (1). Tighten bolts to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs). 3.
Install the support bracket to isolator nuts (2) and tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs). 4. Reconnect the
ground strap.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Insulator - Removal > Page 2108
5. Raise vehicle on a hoist. 6. Install the belly pan (2). 7. Install power steering reservoir See:
Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Idler Pulley - Installation
Idler Pulley: Service and Repair Accessory Drive Idler Pulley - Installation
3.5L ENGINE
1. Position idler pulley and bolt. 2. Tighten bolt to 35 Nm (25 ft. lbs.). 3. Install accessory drive belt
See: Drive Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
OIL PRESSURE
NOTE: At Normal Operating Temperatures
Pressure @ Curb Idle Speed *.............................................................................................................
.......................................34.47 kPa Min. (5 PSI MIN.) Pressure @ 3000 RPM....................................
...............................................................................................................................300-724 kPa
(45-105 PSI.)
*CAUTION: If pressure is zero at curb idle, DO NOT run engine at 3000 RPM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2117
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
Check oil pressure using a gauge at oil pressure switch location (7).
1. Remove the oil pressure switch (7) See: Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump)/Service and
Repair/Oil Pressure Switch - Removal. 2. Install oil pressure test gauge, Special Tool C-3292A with
Adapter 8406. For Special Tool identification, See: Tools and Equipment.
CAUTION: If oil pressure is 0 at idle, Do Not Run engine at 3000 RPM.
3. Warm engine to normal operating temperature. 4. Monitor gauge readings at idle and 3000 rpm.
For specifications See: Specifications/Engine - Specifications.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2122
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 5.2L (5.5 qts)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2125
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil Type ...................................................................................................................................
...................................... API SAE Certified 10W-30
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2126
Engine Oil: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL
WARNING: New or used engine oil can be irritating to the skin. Avoid prolonged or repeated skin
contact with engine oil. Contaminants in
used engine oil, caused by internal combustion, can be hazardous to your health. Thoroughly wash
exposed skin with soap and water. Do not wash skin with gasoline, diesel fuel, thinner, or solvents,
health problems can result. Do not pollute, dispose of used engine oil properly. Contact your dealer
or government agency for location of collection center in your area.
When service is required, Chrysler recommends that only Mopar(R) brand parts, lubricants and
chemicals be used. Mopar(R) provides the best engineered products for servicing Chrysler
vehicles.
Only lubricants bearing designations defined by the following organization should be used.
- Society of Automotive Engineers (SAE)
- American Petroleum Institute (API)
- National Lubricating Grease Institute (NLGI)
- Association des Constructeurs Europeens d' Automobiles (European Automobile Manufacturers
Association) (ACEA)
API CERTIFICATION AND LICENSE SYMBOL
Use an engine oil that is API Certified and Licensed to display the certification mark. MOPAR(R)
provides engine oils that meet or exceed, Material Standard MS-6395 requirement.
SAE VISCOSITY
Engine oils are designed to improve low temperature starting and vehicle fuel economy. Refer to
the engine oil filler cap for the preferred engine oil viscosity grade for each vehicle. SAE viscosity
grades are used to specify the correct viscosity oil for an engine. Use only Multi-Viscosity oils.
These are specified with a dual SAE viscosity grade which indicates the cold (5W) to hot (20, 30)
temperature performance range of the oil.
ACEA CATEGORIES
For countries that use the ACEA European Oil Categories for service fill oils, use engine oils that
meet the requirements of ACEA A1/B1, A2/B2, or A3/B3.
CONTAINER IDENTIFICATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2127
The Engine Oil Certification Mark was developed and trademarked by the API to refer customers to
those engine oils preferred by the automobile manufacturers. This symbol means that the oil has
been certified and licensed by the American Petroleum Institute (API). This certification mark will
only be found on the front of the oil containers. Those oils that do not display the "Mark" on the
front of the container should not be used.
Chrysler only recommends API Certified engine oils that meet the requirements of Material
Standard MS-6395. Use Mopar or an equivalent oil meeting the specification MS-6395.
SYNTHETIC ENGINE OILS
There are a number of engine oils being promoted as either synthetic or semi-synthetic. If you
chose to use such a product, use only those oils that are certified by the American Petroleum
Institute (API) to display the "Certification Mark" and show SAE viscosity grade recommended for
each vehicle. Follow the service schedule that describes your driving type.
ENGINE OIL ADDITIVES/SUPPLEMENTS
The manufacturer does not recommend the addition of any engine oil additives/supplements to the
specified engine oil. Engine oil additives/supplements should not be used to enhance engine oil
performance. Engine oil additives/supplements should not be used to extend engine oil change
intervals. No additive is known to be safe for engine durability and can degrade emission
components. Additives can contain undesirable materials that harm the long term durability of
engines and emission systems by:
- Increasing the level of Phosphorus and Sulfur in the engine oil. The API Certified Engine Oils
control the Phosphorus and Sulfur contents of the oil to levels that reduce the contamination effect
on the vehicles emission control system.
- Altering the viscosity characteristics of the engine oil so that it no longer meets the requirements
of the specified viscosity grade.
- Creating potential for an undesirable additive compatibility interaction in the engine crankcase.
The engine oils contain a performance additive system carefully developed to optimize the oils
performance in the engine. The addition of supplements may cause the oil to thicken prematurely,
cause excessive deposit build-up and potentially shorten engine life.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Oil Level Check
Engine Oil: Service and Repair Engine Oil Level Check
ENGINE OIL LEVEL CHECK
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will improve the accuracy of the oil level
reading. Remove dipstick (1), and observe oil level. Add oil only when the level is at or below the
SAFE mark. If the oil level is in the safe (2) range, do not add oil.
CAUTION: Do not operate engine if the oil level is above the MAX mark on the dipstick. Excessive
oil volume can cause oil aeration which can
lead to engine failure due to loss of oil pressure or increase in oil temperature.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Oil Level Check > Page 2130
Engine Oil: Service and Repair Engine Oil and Filter Change
ENGINE OIL AND FILTER CHANGE
Change engine oil at mileage and time intervals described in the Maintenance Schedule. See:
Maintenance
WARNING: New or used engine oil can be irritating to the skin. Avoid prolonged or repeated skin
contact with engine oil. Contaminants in
used engine oil, caused by internal combustion, can be hazardous to your health. Thoroughly wash
exposed skin with soap and water. Do not wash skin with gasoline, diesel fuel, thinner, or solvents,
health problems can result. Do not pollute, dispose of used engine oil properly. Contact your dealer
or government agency for location of collection center in your area.
TO CHANGE ENGINE OIL
1. Run engine until achieving normal operating temperature. 2. Position the vehicle on a level
surface and turn engine off. 3. Open hood, remove engine oil fill cap (1). 4. Raise vehicle on hoist.
5. Place a suitable drain pan under crankcase drain.
6. Remove oil pan drain plug (1) from crankcase and allow oil to drain into pan. Inspect drain plug
threads for stretching or other damage. Replace
drain plug and gasket if damaged.
7. Remove oil filter (2). 8. Install drain plug (1) in crankcase. Tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm
(20 ft. lbs.). 9. Install new oil filter (2).
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Oil Level Check > Page 2131
11. Fill crankcase with specified type and amount of engine oil. See: Powertrain Management/Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel/Description and
Operation
12. Install oil fill cap (1). 13. Start engine and inspect for leaks. 14. Turn engine off and inspect oil
level.
OIL FILTER SPECIFICATION
All engines are equipped with a high quality full-flow, disposable type oil filter. When replacing oil
filter, use a Mopar(R) filter or equivalent.
USED ENGINE OIL DISPOSAL
Care should be exercised when disposing used engine oil after it has been drained from a vehicle
engine. Refer to the WARNING above.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Oil Filter: Procedures
ENGINE OIL AND FILTER CHANGE
Change engine oil at mileage and time intervals described in the Maintenance Schedule. See:
Maintenance
WARNING: New or used engine oil can be irritating to the skin. Avoid prolonged or repeated skin
contact with engine oil. Contaminants in
used engine oil, caused by internal combustion, can be hazardous to your health. Thoroughly wash
exposed skin with soap and water. Do not wash skin with gasoline, diesel fuel, thinner, or solvents,
health problems can result. Do not pollute, dispose of used engine oil properly. Contact your dealer
or government agency for location of collection center in your area.
TO CHANGE ENGINE OIL
1. Run engine until achieving normal operating temperature. 2. Position the vehicle on a level
surface and turn engine off. 3. Open hood, remove engine oil fill cap (1). 4. Raise vehicle on hoist.
5. Place a suitable drain pan under crankcase drain.
6. Remove oil pan drain plug (1) from crankcase and allow oil to drain into pan. Inspect drain plug
threads for stretching or other damage. Replace
drain plug and gasket if damaged.
7. Remove oil filter (2). 8. Install drain plug (1) in crankcase. Tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm
(20 ft. lbs.). 9. Install new oil filter (2).
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2136
11. Fill crankcase with specified type and amount of engine oil. See: Powertrain Management/Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel/Description and
Operation
12. Install oil fill cap (1). 13. Start engine and inspect for leaks. 14. Turn engine off and inspect oil
level.
OIL FILTER SPECIFICATION
All engines are equipped with a high quality full-flow, disposable type oil filter. When replacing oil
filter, use a Mopar(R) filter or equivalent.
USED ENGINE OIL DISPOSAL
Care should be exercised when disposing used engine oil after it has been drained from a vehicle
engine. Refer to the WARNING above.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2137
Oil Filter: Removal and Replacement
Engine Oil Filter - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: When servicing the oil filter, avoid deforming the filter can. Install the remove/install tool
band strap against the base lock seam. The
lock seam joining the can to the base is reinforced by the base plate.
1. Using a suitable oil filter wrench, unscrew filter (2) from base and discard.
Engine Oil Filter - Installation
INSTALLATION
All engines are equipped with a high quality full-flow, disposable type oil filter (2). When replacing
oil filter, use a Mopar(R) filter or equivalent.
1. Wipe base clean, then inspect gasket contact surface. 2. Lubricate gasket of new filter with clean
engine oil. 3. Install and tighten oil filter (2) to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.) of torque after gasket contacts
base. Use filter wrench if necessary. 4. Start engine and check for leaks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
OIL PAN
Tighten the oil pan bolts to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
Tighten the oil pan bell housing bolts to 55 Nm (40 ft.
lbs.).
Tighten the oil pan drain bolt (1) to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Oil Pan - Removal
Oil Pan: Service and Repair Engine Oil Pan - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable (1).
2. Remove the engine oil indicator (1). 3. Remove the engine oil indicator tube bolt (3). 4. Remove
the engine oil indicator tube (2). 5. Raise and support the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Oil Pan - Removal > Page 2143
6. Remove the front crossmemberSee: Body and Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service and
Repair/Crossmember - Removal.
7. Remove the crossover pipeSee: Exhaust System/Exhaust Manifold/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Exhaust Manifold - Removal. 8. Loosen the front exhaust manifoldSee: Exhaust
System/Exhaust Manifold/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Exhaust Manifold Removal.
9. Remove the oil pan bell housing bolts (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Oil Pan - Removal > Page 2144
10. Drain the engine oil (1). 11. Remove the engine oil filter (2). 12. Remove the oil pan fasteners.
Remove the oil pan.
NOTE: A small amount of oil will remain in the oil pan. Use care when removing the oil pan from
the engine.
13. Remove oil pan gasket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Oil Pan - Removal > Page 2145
Oil Pan: Service and Repair Engine Oil Pan - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean oil pan and all gasket surfaces. 2. Apply a 1/8 inch bead of Mopar(R) Engine RTV GEN II
at the parting line of the oil pump housing and the rear seal retainer. 3. Install oil pan gasket to the
engine block.
4. Install the oil pan and tighten the oil pan bolts to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
5. Tighten the oil pan bell housing bolts to 55 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Oil Pan - Removal > Page 2146
6. All engines are equipped with a high quality full-flow, disposable type oil filter (2). When
replacing oil filter, use a Mopar(R) filter or equivalent. 7. Wipe base clean, then inspect gasket
contact surface. 8. Lubricate gasket of new filter with clean engine oil. 9. Install and tighten oil filter
(2) to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.) of torque after gasket contacts base. Use filter wrench if necessary.Lower
vehicle.
10. Install and tighten the oil pan drain bolt (1) to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 11. Tighten the front
maniverter boltsSee: Exhaust System/Exhaust Manifold/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Exhaust Manifold Removal.
12. Install the crossover pipeSee: Exhaust System/Exhaust Manifold/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Exhaust Manifold - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Oil Pan - Removal > Page 2147
13. Install the front crossmemberSee: Body and Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service and
Repair/Crossmember - Removal. 14. Lower vehicle.
15. Install the oil level indicator tube (2). 16. Tighten the oil level indicator tube bolt (3). 17. Install
the oil indicator (1). 18. Fill engine crankcase with proper oil to correct level.
19. Connect negative battery cable (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sender: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2151
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2152
Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Position an oil collecting container under switch location. 3. Disconnect
electrical connector (1). 4. Remove the oil pressure switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal > Page 2157
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Thread Sealant to the switch threads. 2. Install oil pressure switch (2). 3.
Connect electrical connector (1). 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Start engine and check for leaks. 6. Check
engine oil level and adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
OIL PRESSURE
NOTE: At Normal Operating Temperatures
Pressure @ Curb Idle Speed *.............................................................................................................
.......................................34.47 kPa Min. (5 PSI MIN.) Pressure @ 3000 RPM....................................
...............................................................................................................................300-724 kPa
(45-105 PSI.)
*CAUTION: If pressure is zero at curb idle, DO NOT run engine at 3000 RPM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2162
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
Check oil pressure using a gauge at oil pressure switch location (7).
1. Remove the oil pressure switch (7) See: Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump)/Service and
Repair/Oil Pressure Switch - Removal. 2. Install oil pressure test gauge, Special Tool C-3292A with
Adapter 8406. For Special Tool identification, See: Tools and Equipment.
CAUTION: If oil pressure is 0 at idle, Do Not Run engine at 3000 RPM.
3. Warm engine to normal operating temperature. 4. Monitor gauge readings at idle and 3000 rpm.
For specifications See: Specifications/Engine - Specifications.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Oil
Pressure Regulator Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Oil Pressure Regulator Valve: Procedures
INSPECTION
1. Inspect oil pressure relief valve (1) plunger for scoring and free operation in its bore. Small
marks may be removed with 400-grit wet or dry
sandpaper.
2. The relief valve spring (2) has a free length of approximately 49.5 mm (1.95 in.) it should test
between 101-110 N (23-25 lbs.) when compressed
to 34 mm (1.34 in.). Replace spring that fails to meet specifications.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Oil
Pressure Regulator Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2167
Oil Pressure Regulator Valve: Removal and Replacement
Oil Pressure Relief Valve - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the oil pan. See: Oil Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan - Removal 2. To remove
the relief valve, proceed as follows:
a. Remove the cotter pin that retains the retainer cap. b. Drill a 3.175 mm (1/8 inch.) hole into the
relief valve retainer cap c. Insert a self-threading sheet metal screw into cap. d. Using a suitable
slide hammer tool, remove retainer cap. Discard retainer cap e. Remove spring (2) and relief valve
(1).
Oil Pressure Relief Valve - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate relief valve (1) with oil.
CAUTION: The pressure relief valve must be installed as shown in , or engine damage may occur.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Oil
Pressure Regulator Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2168
2. Install valve (1), spring (2) and retainer cap. 3. Install new cotter pin (4). 4. Install the oil pan.
See: Oil Pan/Service and Repair/Engine Oil Pan - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications
Intake Manifold: Specifications
INTAKE MANIFOLD
Intake Manifold - Lower........................................................................................................................
....................................................28 Nm (250 in.lbs.)
Intake Manifold - Upper........................................................................................................................
....................................................12 Nm (105 in.lbs.) (Tighten bolts gradually starting in the center
working outward)
THROTTLE BODY
CAUTION:The throttle body must be torqued in a mandatory torque sequence. Tighten in a criss cross pattern to specification.
Tighten the three bolts and one stud in a mandatory torque criss - cross pattern sequence to 5.5
Nm (50 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Intake Manifold - Removal
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Intake Manifold - Removal
Lower
LOWER INTAKE MANIFOLD
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (1). 2. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. See:
Cylinder Head Assembly/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair 3. Drain the cooling system
See: Cooling System/Service and Repair.
4. Disconnect the upper radiator hose (1) from the thermostat housing (2). 5. Remove the upper
intake manifold See: . 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors to fuel injectors and coolant
temperature sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Intake Manifold - Removal > Page 2174
7. Disconnect heater supply and return hoses from the thermostat housing.
8. Disconnect the fuel line from the fuel rail.
9. Remove the 4 bolts attaching fuel rail.
10. Remove fuel rail and injectors as an assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Intake Manifold - Removal > Page 2175
11. Remove lower intake 4 bolts and position the ignition coil capacitor aside.
12. Remove the lower intake manifold (1).
Upper
REMOVAL - UPPER INTAKE MANIFOLD
1. Remove engine cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Intake Manifold - Removal > Page 2176
2. Disconnect negative battery cable.
3. Remove air cleaner housing (4) and inlet hose (1) See: Tune-up and Engine Performance
Checks/Air Cleaner Housing/Service and Repair/Air
Cleaner Body - Removal.
4. Disconnect the EGR tube See: Powertrain Management/Emission Control Systems/Exhaust Gas
Recirculation/EGR Valve/Service and
Repair/Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Removal.
5. Disconnect the following vacuum hoses from the upper intake manifold:
- Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) Valve (1)
- EVAP Purge Solenoid (2)
- EGR Tube (3)
- Power Brake Booster (4)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Intake Manifold - Removal > Page 2177
6. Disconnect electrical connectors from the following sensors and actuators:
- Manifold Tuning Valve (MTV) (1)
- Short Runner Valve (2)
- Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) (3)
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) (4)
7. Remove the Manifold Tuning Valve (5), then Remove the 2 nuts (1) and (2) from the rear intake
manifold brackets. 8. Loosen the 2 bolts (3) and (4) from rear intake manifold brackets and position
brackets aside.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Intake Manifold - Removal > Page 2178
9. Remove the 7 upper intake manifold retaining bolts (1) and the upper intake manifold (2). Clean
all gasket sealing surfaces.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Intake Manifold - Removal > Page 2179
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Intake Manifold - Installation
Lower
LOWER INTAKE MANIFOLD
1. Clean all sealing surfaces. 2. Position new gaskets and intake manifold on cylinder head
surfaces. 3. Position the ignition coil capacitor and install the intake manifold bolts. Gradually
tighten in sequence shown until a torque of 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.)
is obtained.
4. Install fuel rail and injectors as an assembly. 5. Connect fuel supply hose to fuel rail. 6. Connect
heater supply and return hoses to the intake manifold. 7. Connect electrical connectors to fuel
injectors and coolant temperature sensor. 8. Install upper intake manifold See: . 9. Connect upper
radiator hose to thermostat housing.
10. Fill cooling system See: Cooling System/Service and Repair. 11. Connect negative battery
cable See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection.
Upper
INSTALLATION - UPPER INTAKE MANIFOLD
1. Clean and inspect gasket sealing surfaces. 2. Position new gasket. 3. Install the throttle body on
the upper intake (if required)See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Throttle
Body/Service and
Repair/Throttle Body - Installation.
4. Install upper intake manifold (2) and hand start all attaching bolts (1). 5. Tighten bolts gradually
starting in the center working outward until a torque of 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) is obtained. 6. Install the
rear intake manifold brackets to the head.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Intake Manifold - Removal > Page 2180
7. Install the 2 intake manifold to bracket nut retainers.
8. Install the EGR tube See: Powertrain Management/Emission Control Systems/Exhaust Gas
Recirculation/EGR Valve/Service and Repair/Exhaust
Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Installation.
9. Connect electrical connectors to the following sensors and actuators:
- Manifold Tuning Valve (MTV) (1)
- Short Runner Valve (2)
- Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) (3)
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) (4)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Intake Manifold - Removal > Page 2181
10. Connect the following vacuum hoses to the upper intake manifold:
- Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) Valve (1)
- EVAP Purge Solenoid (2)
- EGR Tube (3)
- Power Brake Booster (4)
11. Install air cleaner housing (4) and inlet hose (1) See: Tune-up and Engine Performance
Checks/Air Cleaner Housing/Service and Repair/Air
Cleaner Body - Installation.
12. Connect negative battery cable See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service and
Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection. 13. Install the engine cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal
Camshaft Oil Seal: Service and Repair Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Perform the fuel pressure release procedure See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Fuel Pressure
Release/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable (1).
3. Drain cooling system See: Cooling System/Service and Repair. 4. Remove the engine cover.
5. Remove air cleaner element housing See: Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks/Air
Cleaner Housing/Service and Repair/Air Cleaner Body Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2187
6. Remove the coolant recovery container (1) See: Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Coolant Recovery Bottle - Removal.
7. Remove the generator.See: Starting and Charging/Charging System/Alternator/Service and
Repair/Generator - Removal.
8. Disconnect the fuel line (1) at the fuel rail (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2188
9. Remove the upper intake manifold (2)See: Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold Removal.
10. Remove the fuel rail See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Rail/Service and Repair/Fuel Rail - Removal.
11. Remove the lower intake manifold (1) See: Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold
- Removal.
12. Raise the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2189
13. Remove right exhaust manifold See: Exhaust System/Exhaust Manifold/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Exhaust Manifold Removal.
14. Remove right front tire. 15. Remove right inner splash shield.
16. Remove accessory drive belt (7). 17. Remove vibration damper (5)See: Cylinder Block
Assembly/Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley/Service and Repair/Vibration Damper Removal.
18. Remove lower accessory drive belt idler pulley (6).
19. Remove lower outer timing belt cover bolts. 20. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2190
21. Remove the upper accessory drive belt idler pulley (2). 22. Remove the belt tensioner. 23.
Support the engine with a block of wood and a floor jack. 24. Remove the upper engine mount See:
Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Engine Mount/Service and Repair/Engine Mount
Insulator Removal.
25. Remove the power steering reservoir bolts and set reservoir aside. 26. Remove the remaining
outer timing belt cover bolts and cover. 27. Remove the timing belt See: Timing
Components/Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Removal.
28. Remove the right valve cover to cylinder head ground strap.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2191
29. Remove the EGR valve (1) and tube assembly (2).
30. Remove the right cylinder head cover.
31. Remove the right rocker arm and shaft assembly (2) See: Camshaft, Lifters and Push
Rods/Rocker Arm Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Valve Rocker Arm - Disassembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2192
32. Counterhold the cam gear and loosen the right cam gear retaining bolt.
33. Remove the inner timing cover to right cylinder head retaining bolts.
34. Remove the right rear camshaft thrust plate (1). 35. Carefully push the camshaft out of the back
of the cylinder head approximately 3.5 inches. Remove the camshaft sprocket and bolt. 36. NOTE:
It may be necessary to raise the engine slightly in order to remove the camshaft sprocket bolt.
37. Remove the cylinder head bolts in REVERSE of tightening sequence.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2193
NOTE: Because of clearance restrictions when removing the right cylinder head, the front four
cylinder head bolts must be loosened, raised
and supported with rubber bands before the cylinder head can be removed.
38. Remove the cylinder head. 39. Clean and inspect all mating surfaces.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2194
Camshaft Oil Seal: Service and Repair Camshaft Seal(s) - Installation
INSTALLATION
RIGHT CYLINDER HEAD
1. Position the camshaft seal into the cylinder head (3). 2. Using Camshaft installer MD-998306 (2)
tap the seal into place using a mallet (1).
3. Apply light coat of clean engine oil to the camshaft oil seal lip (3) and Seal Protector Sleeve 6788
(2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2195
NOTE: When installing the camshaft (1) into the cylinder head (4), you must first insert Seal
Protector Sleeve 6788 (2) through the camshaft
seal (3) until the camshaft seats, then remove Seal Protector Sleeve 6788 (2) from the camshaft.
4. Install the camshaft using Seal Protector Sleeve 6788. 5. Install the right cylinder head See:
Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head Installation.
LEFT CYLINDER HEAD
1. Position the camshaft seal into the cylinder head (3). 2. Using Camshaft installer MD-998306 (2)
tap the seal into place using a mallet (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Seal(s) - Removal > Page 2196
3. Apply light coat of clean engine oil to the camshaft oil seal lip (3) and Seal Protector Sleeve 6788
(2).
NOTE: When installing the camshaft (1) into the cylinder head (4), you must first insert Seal
Protector Sleeve 6788 (2) through the camshaft
seal (3) until the camshaft seats, then remove Seal Protector Sleeve 6788 (2) from the camshaft.
4. Install the camshaft using Seal Protector Sleeve 6788. 5. Install the left cylinder head See:
Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Crankshaft Oil Seal - Removal
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair Front Crankshaft Oil Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the crankshaft sprocket. See: Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Removal.
2. Tap the dowel pin (2) out of the crankshaft.
3. Remove crankshaft seal using Special Tool 6341A (1).
CAUTION: Do not nick shaft seal surface or seal bore.
4. Shaft seal lip surface must be free of varnish, dirt or nicks. Polish with 400 grit paper if
necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Crankshaft Oil Seal - Removal > Page 2201
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair Front Crankshaft Oil Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install crankshaft seal using Special Tool 6342 (1). 2. Install the dowel pin into the crankshaft to
1.2 mm (0.047 in.) protrusion. 3. Install the crankshaft sprocket. See: Timing Components/Timing
Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Guide Seals - Installation
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair Valve Guide Seals - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. The valve stem seal/valve spring seat should be pushed firmly and squarely over the valve guide
using the valve stem as guide. Do Not Force seal
against top of guide. When installing the valve retainer locks, compress the spring only enough to
install the locks.
CAUTION: Do not remove garter spring (2) around the seal at the top of the valve stem seal.
2. Install valve spring. See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Valve Spring/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Valve Springs - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sender: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 2210
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 2211
Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Position an oil collecting container under switch location. 3. Disconnect
electrical connector (1). 4. Remove the oil pressure switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal > Page 2216
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Thread Sealant to the switch threads. 2. Install oil pressure switch (2). 3.
Connect electrical connector (1). 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Start engine and check for leaks. 6. Check
engine oil level and adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
CAMSHAFT SPROCKET
Camshaft Sprocket Bolt-Right
Side.........................................................................................................................102 + 1/4 Turn
Nm (75 + 1/4 Turn ft.lbs) Camshaft Sprocket Bolt-Left
Side...........................................................................................................................102 + 1/4 Turn
Nm (75 + 1/4 Turn ft.lbs)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets - Removal
CAMSHAFT SPROCKETS
CAUTION: The 3.5L engine is NOT a free-wheeling design. Therefore, care should be taken not to
rotate the camshafts or crankshaft with the
timing belt removed.
NOTE: The camshaft timing gears are keyed to the camshaft.
1. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Fuel Pressure
Release/Service and Repair. 2. Remove front timing belt cover See: Timing Cover/Service and
Repair/Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal. 3. Position crankshaft sprocket to the TDC mark on the
oil pump housing by turning crankshaft in the clockwise direction 4. Install a dial indicator in number
1 cylinder to check TDC of the piston. Rotate the crankshaft until the piston is at exactly TDC. 5.
Remove camshaft retainer/thrust plate from rear of right cylinder head.
6. Remove the cylinder head covers. 7. Remove rocker arm assemblies. 8. Remove the timing belt
tensioner and timing belt.
9. Loosen and remove the left camshaft gear retaining bolt and washer. The left bolt is 255 mm
(10.0 in.) long.
NOTE: The camshaft timing gears are keyed to the camshaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 2223
10. Hold the left camshaft sprocket with 36 mm (1 7/16 in.) box end wrench. 11. Remove the left
camshaft sprocket.
CAUTION: The camshaft must be pushed rearward approximately 3 1/2 inches to remove the
camshaft gear retaining bolt and gear. Care
must be taken not to scratch or nick the camshaft or cylinder head journals when moving camshaft.
12. Loosen and remove the right camshaft gear retaining bolt and washer. The right bolt is 213 mm
(8 3/8 in.) long.
NOTE: The camshaft timing gears are keyed to the camshaft.
13. Hold the right camshaft sprocket with 36 mm (1 7/16 in.) box end wrench and loosen the
camshaft bolt. 14. Using a floor jack, raise the right side of the engine enough to allow clearance to
remove the right camshaft bolt and washer. 15. Remove the right camshaft sprocket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 2224
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets - Installation
CAMSHAFT SPROCKETS
CAUTION: The camshaft sprockets are keyed and not interchangeable from side to side because
of the camshaft position sensor pick-up.
CAUTION: The camshafts must be pushed back into the cylinder head after the camshaft
sprockets and retaining bolts are positioned. Care
must be taken not to scratch or nick the camshaft or cylinder head journals when moving the
camshafts.
1. Install the camshaft sprockets onto the camshafts. Install NEW sprocket attaching bolts into
place. The 255 mm (10 in.) bolt is installed in the left
camshaft and the 213 mm (8 3/8 in.) bolt is installed into the right camshaft. Do not tighten the bolts
at this time, they will be tightened at a later step. Camshaft sprocket timing marks should be
aligned with inner cover timing marks at both sprockets.
2. Install the camshaft thrust plates (1) and seals. Tighten the bolts (2) to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.).
3. Install the timing belt starting first at the crankshaft sprocket, then to remaining sprockets in a
counterclockwise direction. 4. Install the belt around the last sprocket. Maintain tension on the belt
as it is positioned around the tensioner pulley. Camshaft sprocket timing
marks (1) and crankshaft sprocket timing mark (3) should still be aligned with the inner cover
marks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 2225
NOTE: It is necessary to compress the plunger into the tensioner body and install a locking pin
prior to reinstalling the tensioner. See Timing
Belt Removal for tensioner compression procedure See: Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Removal .
5. Hold the tensioner pulley against the belt and install the reset (pinned) timing belt tensioner (2)
into the housing. Tighten attaching bolts to 28 Nm
(250 in. lbs.).
6. Remove tensioner retaining pin to allow the tensioner to extend to the pulley bracket.
7. Hold the right camshaft sprocket hex with a 36 mm (1 7/16 in.) wrench and tighten the right
camshaft bolt to 102 Nm (75 ft. lbs.) +90° turn.
8. Hold the left camshaft sprocket hex with a 36 mm (1 7/16 in.) wrench and tighten the left
camshaft bolts to 102 Nm (75 ft. lbs.) +90° turn. 9. Install the rocker arm assemblies and cylinder
head covers See: Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods/Rocker Arm Assembly/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Rocker Arm - Installation
10. Install the front timing belt cover See: Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine Timing Cover(s)
- Installation
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 2226
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Crankshaft Sprockets - Installation
CRANKSHAFT SPROCKET
CAUTION: To ensure proper installation depth of crankshaft sprocket, Sprocket Installer 6641 must
be used.
1. Install crankshaft sprocket using Special Tools 6641 and C-4685-C1. 2. Install timing belt, See:
Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Timing Belt: Procedures
TIMING BELT
1. Remove front timing belt cover See: Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine Timing Cover(s) Removal. 2. Inspect both sides of the timing belt. Replace belt if any of the following conditions
exist:
a. Hardening of back rubber back side is glossy without resilience and leaves no indent when
pressed with fingernail. b. Cracks on rubber back. c. Cracks or peeling of canvas. d. Cracks on rib
root. e. Cracks on belt sides. f.
Missing teeth.
g. Abnormal wear of belt sides. The sides are normal if they are sharp as if cut by a knife. h.
Vehicle mileage or time at component maintenance requirement. See: Maintenance
3. If none of the above conditions are seen on the belt, the front timing belt cover can be installed
See: Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine
Timing Cover(s) - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2231
Timing Belt: Removal and Replacement
Timing Belt & Sprockets - Removal
TIMING BELT
1. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Fuel Pressure
Release/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect negative battery cable. 3. Remove both cylinder head
covers. 4. Remove the front timing belt cover See: Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine Timing
Cover(s) - Removal. 5. Mark belt running direction, if timing belt is to be reused.
CAUTION: When aligning timing marks, always rotate engine by turning the crankshaft. Failure to
do so will result in valve and/or piston
damage.
6. Rotate engine clockwise until crankshaft mark aligns with the TDC mark on oil pump housing
and the camshaft sprocket timing marks are aligned
with the marks on the rear cover.
7. Remove the timing belt tensioner and remove timing belt.
8. Inspect the tensioner for fluid leakage. 9. Inspect the pivot and bolt for free movement, bearing
grease leakage, and smooth rotation. If not rotating freely, replace the arm and pulley
assembly.
10. When tensioner is removed from the engine it is necessary to compress the plunger into the
tensioner body.
CAUTION: Index the tensioner in the vise the same way it is installed on the engine. This ensures
proper pin orientation when tensioner is installed on the engine.
a. Place the tensioner into a vise and SLOWLY compress the plunger. Total bleed down of
tensioner should take about 5 minutes. b. When plunger is compressed into the tensioner body
install a pin through the body and plunger to retain plunger in place until tensioner is
installed.
Timing Belt & Sprockets - Installation
TIMING BELT
CAUTION: The 3.5L is NOT a freewheeling engine. Therefore, the valve train rocker assemblies
must be removed before attempting to rotate
either crankshaft or camshafts independently of each other.
CAUTION: If camshafts have moved from the timing marks, always rotate camshaft towards the
direction nearest to the timing marks (DO
NOT TURN CAMSHAFTS A FULL REVOLUTION OR DAMAGE to valves and/or pistons could
result).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2232
TIMING GEAR ALIGNMENT
1. Align the crankshaft sprocket (10) with the TDC mark (9) on the oil pump cover. 2. Align the
camshaft sprockets (2, 7) timing reference marks (1, 8) with the marks on the rear cover. 3. Install
the timing belt (4) starting at the crankshaft sprocket (10) going in a counterclockwise direction.
Install the belt around the last sprocket and
maintain tension on the belt as it is positioned around the tensioner pulley (11).
NOTE: It is necessary to compress the plunger into the tensioner body and install a locking pin
prior to reinstalling the tensioner. See Timing
Belt Removal for tensioner compression procedure See: Timing Belt & Sprockets - Removal .
4. Hold the tensioner pulley (11) against the belt and install the reset (pinned) timing belt tensioner
(2) into the housing. Tighten attaching bolts to 28
Nm (250 in. lbs.).
5. When tensioner (12) is in place, pull the retaining pin to allow the tensioner to extend to the
pulley bracket. 6. Rotate the crankshaft sprocket (10) two revolutions and check the timing marks
on the camshafts and crankshaft. The marks should line up within
their respective locations. If the marks do not line up, repeat the procedure.
7. Install the front timing belt cover See: Timing Cover/Service and Repair/Engine Timing Cover(s)
- Installation. 8. Connect the negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications
Timing Belt Tensioner: Specifications
Timing Belt Tensioner-Bolts.................................................................................................................
....................................................28 Nm (250 in.lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Tensioner - Removal
Timing Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Engine Timing Tensioner - Removal
Tensioner
TENSIONER
1. For timing belt tensioner removal procedure, See: Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Removal
.
Tensioner Pulley Assembly
TENSIONER PULLEY ASSEMBLY
1. Remove the timing belt, See: Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing
Belt & Sprockets - Removal. 2. Remove the timing belt tensioner pulley and bracket assembly by
unscrewing the pivot bolt from the oil pump housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Tensioner - Removal > Page 2238
Timing Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Engine Timing Tensioner - Inspection
Tensioner
TENSIONER
1. Inspect hydraulic tensioner for fluid loss around the plunger seal. Replace tensioner if leaking.
Tensioner Pulley Assembly
TENSIONER PULLEY ASSEMBLY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Tensioner - Removal > Page 2239
NOTE: The tensioner pulley, bracket, and pivot bolt is serviced as an assembly.
1. Inspect pulley for free movement. Replace if pulley is loose, seized, or rough turning. 2. Inspect
pulley bearing and seal. Replace if damaged. 3. Inspect pivot bolt for free movement in assembly
housing. Replace assembly if seized or excessive looseness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Tensioner - Removal > Page 2240
Timing Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Engine Timing Tensioner - Installation
Tensioner Pulley Assembly
TENSIONER PULLEY ASSEMBLY
1. Install the timing belt tensioner pulley (1) assembly. Tighten the pivot bolt (2) to 61 Nm (45 ft.
lbs.). 2. Install the timing belt, See: Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Installation.
Tensioner
TENSIONER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Tensioner - Removal > Page 2241
1. For timing belt tensioner installation procedure, See: Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Component Alignment
Marks > Component Information > Locations
Timing Component Alignment Marks: Locations
TIMING BELT
CAUTION: The 3.5L is NOT a freewheeling engine. Therefore, the valve train rocker assemblies
must be removed before attempting to rotate
either crankshaft or camshafts independently of each other.
CAUTION: If camshafts have moved from the timing marks, always rotate camshaft towards the
direction nearest to the timing marks (DO
NOT TURN CAMSHAFTS A FULL REVOLUTION OR DAMAGE to valves and/or pistons could
result).
TIMING GEAR ALIGNMENT
1. Align the crankshaft sprocket (10) with the TDC mark (9) on the oil pump cover. 2. Align the
camshaft sprockets (2, 7) timing reference marks (1, 8) with the marks on the rear cover. 3. Install
the timing belt (4) starting at the crankshaft sprocket (10) going in a counterclockwise direction.
Install the belt around the last sprocket and
maintain tension on the belt as it is positioned around the tensioner pulley (11).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
Timing Belt Cover
-M6 Bolts..............................................................................................................................................
.....................................................12 Nm (105 in.lbs.) -M8 Bolts..........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................28 Nm (250
in.lbs.) -M10 Bolts.................................................................................................................................
...................................................................54 Nm (40 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal
Timing Cover: Service and Repair Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
1. Perform fuel pressure release procedure See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Fuel Pressure
Release/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect negative battery cable. 3. Raise the vehicle. 4. Remove
the accessory drive belt See: Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Drive Belt/Service
and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Removal.
5. Remove accessory drive belt tensioner. 6. Remove bolts for power steering pump. Reposition
power steering pump aside. 7. Remove crankshaft damper See: Cylinder Block
Assembly/Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley/Service and Repair/Vibration Damper Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal > Page 2250
8. Remove the lower front timing belt cover fasteners. 9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Support the engine with a floor jack. 11. Remove the front engine mount See: Drive Belts,
Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Engine Mount/Service and Repair/Engine Mount Insulator Removal.
12. Disconnect the fuel supply line at the fuel rail. 13. Remove the upper timing belt cover bolts and
remove front timing belt cover See: Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks/Air Cleaner
Housing/Service and Repair/Air Cleaner Body - Removal.
Rear
REMOVAL
1. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Fuel Pressure
Release/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 3. Remove timing belt, See:
Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Removal. 4.
Remove camshaft sprockets, See: Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal > Page 2251
5. Remove rear timing belt cover bolts. 6. Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: The rear timing belt cover has O-rings to seal the water pump passages to cylinder block.
Do not reuse the O-rings.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal > Page 2252
Timing Cover: Service and Repair Engine Timing Cover(s) - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The timing cover bolts and both holes to the engine block must be thoroughly cleaned and
free of oil residue before assembly. IN
ADDITION, add thread sealant to the timing cover bolts that mount to the oil pump. See: Engine
Lubrication/Oil Pump/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement
1. Install front timing belt cover. 2. Install the upper engine mount See: Drive Belts, Mounts,
Brackets and Accessories/Engine Mount/Service and Repair/Engine Mount Insulator Installation.
3. Connect fuel supply line at fuel rail. 4. Raise the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal > Page 2253
5. Install power steering pump fasteners. Tighten bolts to 23 Nm (200 lbs. in.). 6. Install crankshaft
damper See: Cylinder Block Assembly/Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley/Service and
Repair/Vibration Damper Installation.
7. Install accessory drive belt tensioner. Torque fastener to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.). 8. Install
accessory drive belt See: Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Drive Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Installation.
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Connect negative battery cable.
Rear
INSTALLATION
1. Clean rear timing belt cover O-ring sealing surfaces and grooves. Lubricate new O-rings with
Mopar(R) Dielectric Grease or equivalent to
facilitate assembly.
2. Position NEW O-rings on cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Timing Cover(s) - Removal > Page 2254
3. Install rear timing belt cover. Tighten bolts to the following specified torque:
- M10-54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
- M8-28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
- M6-12 Nm (105 in. lbs.)
4. Install camshaft sprockets, See: Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Installation. 5. Install timing belt, See: Timing Belt/Service
and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
Fuel Flow
Leakdown
Less than 10 psi in 5 minutes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Checking the Fuel Delivery System
CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. FUEL PUMP OPERATION
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With a scan tool, actuate the Fuel System test.
NOTE: It may be necessary to use a mechanics stethoscope in the next step.
3. Listen for fuel pump operation at the fuel tank. The fuel pump should operate smoothly with no
excessive noise. If the pump has excessive noise
such as grinding, the pump should be replaced.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Does the Fuel Pump sound to be operate normally?
Yes
- Go to 2
No
- Go to 7
2. FUEL PRESSURE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Install a fuel pressure gauge. 3. Ignition on, engine not running. 4. With the scan tool, actuate the
Fuel Pump and observe the fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Choose a conclusion that best matches your fuel pressure reading.
Below Specification
- Go to 3
Within Specification
- Test Complete.
Above Specification
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2261
Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
3. RESTRICTED FUEL SUPPLY LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure even with the engine off. Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released.
2. Raise vehicle on hoist, and disconnect the fuel pressure line at the fuel pump module. 3. Install
special tool #6539 (5/16") or #6631(3/8") fuel line adapter and the fuel pressure gauge between the
fuel supply line and the fuel pump
module.
4. Ignition on, engine not running. 5. With the scan tool, actuate the Fuel Pump and observe the
fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Is the fuel pressure within specification now?
Yes
- Repair/replace fuel supply line as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. SADDLE FUEL TANK
Is the vehicle equipped with a saddle type fuel tank?
Yes
- Go to 5
No
- Go to 6
5. CHECKING FUEL TANK SIPHON HOSE AND FUEL LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Gain access to the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. 3. Inspect the following fuel
components: Fuel line and siphon hose between the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. Look for
disconnected and/or damaged lines or hoses.
- Fuel Pressure Regulator not properly seated in the module.
Were the above items in good working condition?
Yes
- Go to 6
No
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP INLET
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2262
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Remove the Fuel Pump Module and Fuel Tank Module (if equipped), inspect the Fuel Inlet and
the bottom of the fuel tank for debris that could
cause the fuel pump inlet to be plugged.
Is the Fuel Pump Inlet plugged?
Yes
- Repair/Replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. FUEL PUMP MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Disconnect the Fuel Pump Module harness connector. 3. Using a 12-volt
test light to battery voltage, probe the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit in the Fuel Pump Module
harness connector.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Does the test light illuminate brightly.
Yes
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Repair the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2263
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pressure Leak Down
FUEL PRESSURE LEAK DOWN
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious
or fatal injury when performing this test
procedure. Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
- Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eye wear
and clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair / replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM GAS AND DIESEL FUEL
PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2264
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Fuel Inlet Hose 8978A-1 (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the Fuel
Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect the Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to the
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir
Assembly 534960 (4) on the floor and out of
the way so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system: Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2265
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
2. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait 1 minute before
proceeding. 3. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4
fuel pressure specification is 552 KPa ± 34 KPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the Checking The Fuel Delivery System diagnostic procedure as directed. See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component
Tests and General Diagnostics/Checking the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAK DOWN
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Close the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1) and then wait five minutes before proceeding. 2. Read
the Fuel Inlet (2) and Fuel Outlet (3) Pressure Gauges. The pressure should not drop more than 10
psi on either gauge.
Does the fuel pressure drop more than 10 psi?
Yes - On Fuel Inlet Gauge (1)
- Replace the fuel pump module.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test.
Yes - On Fuel Outlet Gauge (2)
- Replace the leaking fuel injector(s).
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test.
No
- If directed here by another test, return to that test. Otherwise, test complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2266
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Delivery System Output - Flow Test
FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT - FLOW TEST
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal
injury when performing this test procedure.
- Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
- Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eyewear and
clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM THE GAS AND DIESEL
FUEL PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from the Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2267
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly 8978A-1 Fuel Inlet Hose (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect special tool Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the
Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir Assembly
534960 (4) on the floor and out of the way
so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system:
- Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2268
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
1. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait one minute before
proceeding. 2. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 kPa ± 34 kPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4 fuel
pressure specification is 552 kPa ± 34 kPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics/Checking the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump. 3. Open the Flow
Test Valve (1) for 20 seconds, then close the Valve.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
4. Turn the ignition off. 5. Measure the amount of fuel in the Reservoir Assembly (2). The fuel
output specification is ml/s X 20 seconds = fuel flow in ml.
Does the amount of fuel in the reservoir meet or exceed the specification?
Yes
- Test complete.
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics/Checking the Fuel Delivery System
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disengage the air filter housing clips (1). 2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) forward slightly to
disengage tabs from the bottom of the air filter housing.
3. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal > Page 2274
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install air filter element into the bottom half of the air filter housing.
2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) rearward to engage the tabs into the bottom half of the air
filter housing. 3. Reengage the air filter housing clips (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
1. Remove fuel fill cap. 2. Remove fuel pump fuse from Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
For location of fuse, refer to label on underside of TIPM cover. 3. Start and run engine until it stalls.
4. Attempt restarting engine until it will no longer run. 5. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 6. Place
a rag or towel below fuel line quick-connect fitting at fuel rail. 7. Disconnect quick-connect fitting at
fuel rail See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Line Coupler/Service
and Repair. 8. When the repair is complete, reconnect fuel fittings and return fuel pump fuse to
TIPM. 9. One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) may have been stored in PCM memory
due to fuel pump fuse removal. A diagnostic scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
FIRING ORDER
2.4L
The firing order is 1-3-4-2.
3.5L
The firing order is 1-2-3-4-5-6.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Spark Plug Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head cover(s). See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal 2. Using suitable locking pliers, remove the tube (1) from
the cylinder head and discard tube. 3. Clean area around spark plug with Mopar(R) Parts Cleaner
or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Spark Plug Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2287
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Stud and Bearing Mount to a new tube (1) approximately 1 mm (0.039 in.) from
the end of tube, in a 3 mm (0.118 in.) wide area. 2. Install sealer end of tube (1) into the cylinder
head. Then carefully install the tube (1) using a hardwood block and mallet. Install the tube (1) until
it is seated into the bottom of the bore.
3. For spark plug tube (1) seal replacement, See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service
and Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal. 4. Install cylinder head cover(s). See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Installation INSTALLATION)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
COMPRESSION CHECK
Compression Ratio ..............................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 10:1
Compression should not be less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from
cylinder to cylinder
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 2291
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE TEST
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions.
Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good operating
condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis purposes.
1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine reaches normal
operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators such as fouled, hot, oily,
etc. Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Remove the Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay from the TIPM. 5. Install a suitable compression test
gauge into the number 1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. 6. Crank engine until maximum pressure
is reached on gauge. Record this pressure as #1 cylinder pressure. 7. Repeat the previous step for
all remaining cylinders. 8. Compression should not be less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary
more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder. 9. If one or more cylinders have abnormally low
compression pressures, repeat the compression test.
10. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second compression
test, it could indicate the existence of a problem in
the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide
to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the cause of
low compression unless some malfunction is present.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
WATER PUMP
2.4L Engine
Bolts-Water Pump Mounting.................................................................................................................
.......................................................24 Nm (18 ft. lbs) Bolts-Water Pump Inlet Tube to Block..............
............................................................................................................................................12 Nm (9
ft. lbs) Bolts, Water Pump Inlet Tube to water pump
housing.................................................................................................................................24 Nm
(18 ft. lbs) Bolts, Water Pump to Water Pump Adapter........................................................................
.........................................................................22 Nm (16 ft. lbs) Bolts, Water Pump Pulley to Water
Pump....................................................................................................................................................
.9 Nm (80 in. lbs)
3.5L Engine
Bolts - Water Pump .............................................................................................................................
........................................ 12 Nm (9 ft.lb., 106 in. lb.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures
Water Pump: Procedures
Water Pump - Coolant Air Evacuation
COOLANT AIR EVACUATION
Evacuating or purging air from the cooling system involves the use of a pressurized air operated
vacuum generator. The vacuum created allows for a quick and complete coolant refilling while
removing any airlocks present in the system components.
NOTE: To avoid damage to the cooling system, ensure that no component would be susceptible to
damage when a vacuum is drawn on the
system.
WARNING: ANTIFREEZE IS AN ETHYLENE GLYCOL BASE COOLANT AND IS HARMFUL IF
SWALLOWED OR INHALED. IF
SWALLOWED, DRINK TWO GLASSES OF WATER AND INDUCE VOMITING. IF INHALED,
MOVE TO FRESH AIR AREA. SEEK MEDICAL ATTENTION IMMEDIATELY. DO NOT STORE IN
OPEN OR UNMARKED CONTAINERS. WASH SKIN AND CLOTHING THOROUGHLY AFTER
COMING IN CONTACT WITH ETHYLENE GLYCOL. KEEP OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN.
DISPOSE OF GLYCOL BASED COOLANT PROPERLY. CONTACT YOUR DEALER OR
GOVERNMENT AGENCY FOR LOCATION OF COLLECTION CENTER IN YOUR AREA. DO
NOT OPEN A COOLING SYSTEM WHEN THE ENGINE IS AT OPERATING TEMPERATURE OR
HOT UNDER PRESSURE; PERSONAL INJURY CAN RESULT. AVOID RADIATOR COOLING
FAN WHEN ENGINE COMPARTMENT RELATED SERVICE IS PERFORMED; PERSONAL
INJURY CAN RESULT.
WARNING: WEAR APPROPRIATE EYE AND HAND PROTECTION WHEN PERFORMING THIS
PROCEDURE.
NOTE: The service area where this procedure is performed should have a minimum shop air
requirement of 80 PSI (5.5 bar) and should be
equipped with an air dryer system.
NOTE: For best results, the radiator should be empty. The vehicle's heater control should be set to
the heat position (ignition may need to be
turned to the on position but do not start the motor).
1. Refer to the Chrysler Pentastar Service Equipment (Chrysler PSE) Coolant Refiller #85-15-0650
or equivalent tool's operating manual for specific
assembly steps.
2. Choose an appropriate adapter cone that will fit the vehicle's radiator filler neck or reservoir tank.
3. Attach the adapter cone (2) to the vacuum gauge (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 2297
4. Make sure the vacuum generator/venturi ball valve (3) is closed and attach an airline hose (2)
(minimum shop air requirement of 80 PSI/5.5 bar) to
the vacuum generator/venturi (1).
5. Position the adaptor cone/vacuum gauge assembly into the radiator filler neck or reservoir tank.
Ensure that the adapter cone is sealed properly.
6. Connect the vacuum generator/venturi (2) to the positioned adaptor cone/vacuum gauge
assembly (1). 7. Open the vacuum generator/venturi ball valve.
NOTE: Do not bump or move the assembly as it may result in loss of vacuum. Some radiator
overflow hoses may need to be clamped off to
obtain vacuum.
8. Let the system run until the vacuum gauge shows a good vacuum through the cooling system.
Refer to the tool's operating manual for appropriate
pressure readings.
NOTE: If a strong vacuum is being created in the system, it is normal to see the radiator hoses to
collapse.
9. Close the vacuum generator/venturi ball valve.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 2298
10. Disconnect the vacuum generator/venturi and airline from the adaptor cone/vacuum gauge
assembly. 11. Wait approximately 20 seconds, if the pressure readings do not move, the system
has no leaks. If the pressure readings move, a leak could be
present in the system and the cooling system should be checked for leaks and the procedure
should be repeated.
12. Place the tool's suction hose into the coolant's container.
NOTE: Ensure there is a sufficient amount of coolant, mixed to the required strength/protection
level available for use. For best results and to
assist the refilling procedure, place the coolant container at the same height as the radiator filler
neck. Always draw more coolant than required. If the coolant level is too low, it will pull air into the
cooling system which could result in airlocks in the system.
13. Connect the tool's suction hose (1) to the adaptor cone/vacuum gauge assembly (2).
14. Open the suction hose's ball valve to begin refilling the cooling system. 15. When the vacuum
gauge reads zero, the system is filled.
NOTE: On some remote pressurized tanks, it is recommended to stop filling when the proper level
is reached.
16. Close the suction hose's ball valve and remove the suction hose from the adaptor cone/vacuum
gauge assembly. 17. Remove the adaptor cone/vacuum gauge assembly from the radiator filler
neck or reservoir tank. 18. With heater control unit in the HEAT position, operate engine with
container cap in place. 19. After engine has reached normal operating temperature, shut engine off
and allow it to cool. When engine is cooling down, coolant will be drawn
into the radiator from the pressure container.
20. Add coolant to the recovery bottle/container as necessary. Only add coolant to the container
when the engine is cold. Coolant level in a warm
engine will be higher due to thermal expansion. Add necessary coolant to raise container level to
the COLD MINIMUM mark after each cool down period.
21. Once the appropriate coolant level is achieved, attach the radiator cap or reservoir tank cap.
Water Pump - Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean gasket mating surfaces as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 2299
Water Pump: Removal and Replacement
Water Pump - Removal
3.5L ENGINE
NOTE: It is normal for the water pump to weep a small amount of coolant from the weep hole
(black stain on water pump body). Do not
replace the water pump if this condition exists. Replace the water pump if a heavy deposit or a
steady flow of engine coolant is evident on water pump body from the weep hole (shaft seal
failure). Be sure to perform a thorough analysis before replacing water pump.
1. Drain cooling system See: Cooling System/Service and Repair. 2. Remove engine timing belt
See: Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt &
Sprockets Removal.
3. Remove water pump mounting bolts. Note position of longer bolt for proper re-installation. 4.
Remove water pump body from engine. 5. Clean water pump mounting surface.
Water Pump - Disassembly
WATER PUMP - GAS ENGINE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 2300
1. Remove the water pump assembly from the vehicle.See: Water Pump - Removal 2. Discard the
water pump outlet gasket (7). 3. Remove the three bolts (1) attaching the water pump pulley (2) to
the water pump (4). 4. Remove the water pump pulley (2). 5. Remove the five bolts (3) attaching
the water pump (4) to the water pump adapter (6). 6. Remove and discard the gasket (8). 7.
Remove the water pump (4) and inspect carefully for any damage.
Water Pump - Assembly
WATER PUMP - GAS ENGINE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 2301
1. Throughly clean all gasket mating surfaces before assembling. 2. Inspect water pump and
components for any damage. 3. Using bolts (3), install the water pump (4) and gasket (8) to the
water pump adapter (6). Tighten the bolts (3) to 22 N-m (16 lbs. ft.) 4. Using bolts (1), install the
water pump pulley (2) to the water pump (4). Tighten the bolts (1) to 9 N-m (80 lbs. in.) 5. Using
bolts (5), install the water pump assembly and gasket to the engine block. Tighten the bolts to 24
Nm (18 lbs. ft.).See: Water Pump Installation
6. Start the engine and check for leaks.See: Cooling System/Testing and Inspection
Water Pump - Installation
3.5L ENGINE
1. Clean all O-ring surfaces on pump and cover. 2. Install new O-ring on water pump.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 2302
3. Position water pump to engine. 4. Install mounting bolts and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 5.
Install timing belt See: Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets - Installation. 6. Evacuate air and refill cooling system. See:
Procedures/Water Pump - Coolant Air Evacuation 7. Check cooling system for leaks. See: Cooling
System/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2308
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Single or Dual Zone Climate Control System
................................................................................................................................................. 9.8 qts.
(9.3 L)
Three-Zone Climate Control System
.............................................................................................................................................................
12 qts. (11.4 L)
Includes heater and coolant recovery bottle filled to MAX level.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2311
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Coolant ...................................... Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula HOAT
(Hybrid Organic Additive Technology) or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description - Engine Coolant
Coolant: Description and Operation Description - Engine Coolant
ENGINE COOLANT
GAS ENGINES
WARNING: Antifreeze is an ethylene glycol based coolant and is harmful if swallowed or inhaled. If
swallowed, drink two glasses of water and
induce vomiting. If inhaled, move to fresh air area. Seek medical attention immediately. Do not
store in open or unmarked containers. Wash skin and clothing thoroughly after coming in contact
with ethylene glycol. Keep out of reach of children. Dispose of glycol based coolant properly,
contact your government agency for location of collection center in your area. Do not open a
cooling system when the engine is at operating temperature or hot under pressure, personal injury
can result. Avoid radiator cooling fan when engine compartment related service is performed,
personal injury can result.
CAUTION: Use of propylene glycol based coolants is not recommended, as they provide less
freeze protection and less boiling protection.
The cooling system is designed around the coolant. The coolant must accept heat from engine
metal, in the cylinder head area near the exhaust valves and engine block. Then coolant carries the
heat to the radiator where the tube/fin radiator can transfer the heat to the air.
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769), or the
equivalent ethylene glycol based coolant with hybrid organic corrosion inhibitors (called HOAT, for
Hybrid Organic Additive Technology) is recommended. This coolant offers the best engine cooling
without corrosion when mixed with 50% Ethylene Glycol and 50% distilled water to obtain a freeze
point of -37°C (-35°F). If it loses color or becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with
fresh properly mixed coolant solution.
The green coolant MUST NOT BE MIXED with the orange or magenta coolants. When replacing
coolant the complete system flush must be performed before using the replacement coolant.
CAUTION: Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769) may not be
mixed with any other type of antifreeze. Doing
so will reduce the corrosion protection and may result in premature water pump seal failure. If
non-HOAT coolant is introduced into the cooling system in an emergency, it should be replaced
with the specified coolant as soon as possible.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description - Engine Coolant > Page 2314
Coolant: Description and Operation Operation
COOLANT
Coolant flows through the engine block absorbing the heat from the engine, then flows to the
radiator where the cooling fins in the radiator transfers the heat from the coolant to the atmosphere.
During cold weather the ethylene-glycol or coolant prevents water present in the cooling system
from freezing within temperatures indicated by mixture ratio of coolant to water.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 2315
Coolant: Testing and Inspection
COOLANT CONCENTRATION TESTING
Check coolant concentration when any additional coolant is added to the system, or after a coolant
drain, flush and refill. Use of a hydrometer or Refractometer Tool 8286, refractometer can be used
to test coolant concentration.
A hydrometer tests the amount of glycol in a mixture by measuring the specific gravity of the
mixture. The higher the concentration of ethylene glycol, the larger the number of balls that will
float, and the higher the freeze protection (up to a maximum of 60% by volume glycol).
A Refractometer Tool 8286 tests the amount of glycol in a coolant mixture by measuring the
amount a beam of light bends as it passes through the fluid.
Some coolant manufacturers use other types of glycols into their coolant formulations. Propylene
glycol is the most common new coolant. However, propylene glycol based coolants do not provide
the same freezing protection and corrosion protection and are not recommended.
CAUTION: Do not mix types of coolant - corrosion protection will be severely reduced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Line/Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Water Pump Inlet Tube - Removal
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair Water Pump Inlet Tube - Removal
WATER INLET TUBE
The water pump inlet tube (2) connects the water pump to the coolant adapter. This tube is sealed
by an O-ring and held in place by fasteners to the water pump housing.
1. Drain cooling system See: Service and Repair. 2. Remove the coolant adapter and secondary
thermostat See: Thermostat/Service and Repair/Engine Coolant Thermostat - Removal. 3. Raise
and support vehicle. 4. Remove inlet tube mounting nuts (1). 5. Remove inlet tube (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Line/Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Water Pump Inlet Tube - Removal > Page 2320
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair Water Pump Inlet Tube - Installation
WATER INLET TUBE
1. Inspect the O-ring for damage before installing the tube. Replace O-ring as necessary. 2.
Lubricate O-rings with soapy water. 3. Install new water inlet gasket between tube and water pump
housing (2). 4. Position water pump inlet tube (3) on water pump housing (2). Hand tighten nuts to
aide in tube alignment. 5. Install secondary thermostat and coolant adapter See:
Thermostat/Service and Repair/Engine Coolant Thermostat - Installation. 6. Tighten coolant tube
nuts (1) to 24 Nm (212 in. lbs.). 7. Fill cooling system See: Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description - Pressure System
Coolant Reservoir: Description and Operation Description - Pressure System
PRESSURE SYSTEM
The coolant pressure container consists of a pressure chamber and a overflow chamber. The
coolant pressure container is mounted in the right side engine compartment.
NOTE: Coolant will normally be in the pressure chamber side of the coolant bottle. The overflow
chamber should normally be empty
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description - Pressure System > Page 2325
Coolant Reservoir: Description and Operation Description - Non-Pressure System
NON-PRESSURE
The coolant recovery system used on 2.4L engine consists of a coolant recovery container and an
overflow hose that is connected to the radiator. The coolant recovery container is mounted in the
right side engine compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description - Pressure System > Page 2326
Coolant Reservoir: Description and Operation Operation - Pressure System
PRESSURE SYSTEM
The pressure chamber keeps the coolant free of trapped air, provides a volume for expansion and
contraction, and provides a convenient and safe method for checking and adjusting coolant level at
atmospheric pressure. It also provides some reserve coolant to cover minor leaks, evaporation or
boiling losses. The overflow chamber allows coolant recovery in case of an overheat.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description - Pressure System > Page 2327
Coolant Reservoir: Description and Operation Operation - Non-Pressure System
NON-PRESSURE SYSTEM
This system works in conjunction with the pressure cap to utilize thermal expansion and contraction
of the coolant to keep the coolant free of trapped air. It provides a volume for expansion and
contraction, provides a convenient and safe method for checking coolant level, and adjusting level
at atmospheric pressure without removing the pressure cap. It also provides some reserve coolant
to cover minor leaks and evaporation or boiling losses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Coolant Recovery Bottle - Removal
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair Coolant Recovery Bottle - Removal
Non-Pressure System
NON-PRESSURE SYSTEM
1. Disconnect the over flow tube (2) from radiator nipple (3). 2. Remove coolant recovery container
mounting bolts (1). 3. Remove coolant recovery container (5).
Pressure System
PRESSURE SYSTEM
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Coolant Recovery Bottle - Removal > Page 2330
1. Drain coolant below the coolant recovery container level See: Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect
the return hose from coolant recover container (1). 3. Remove coolant recovery container mounting
bolts (3). 4. Disconnect supply hose (2) from the bottom of the coolant recovery container (1). 5.
Remove coolant recovery container (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Coolant Recovery Bottle - Removal > Page 2331
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair Coolant Recovery Bottle - Installation
Non-Pressure System
NON-PRESSURE SYSTEM
1. Connect the overflow tube (2) to the radiator nipple (3). 2. Position coolant recovery container on
mounting tab (4). Install mounting bolts (1). 3. Tighten mounting bolts to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.). 4. Fill
cooling system See: Service and Repair.
Pressure System
PRESSURIZED SYSTEM
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Coolant Recovery Bottle - Removal > Page 2332
1. Connect hose (3) to coolant recovery container (4). 2. Install coolant recovery container (4) in
mounting position and install mounting bolts (1) Tighten bolts to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.). 3. Connect
return hose (2) to the coolant recovery container (4). 4. Fill cooling system See: Service and
Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2337
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
FAN MODULE-RADIATOR COOLING - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2342
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2343
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2344
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2345
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2346
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2347
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2348
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2349
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2350
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2351
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2352
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2353
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2354
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2355
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Radiator Fan High Speed Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Radiator Fan High Speed Relay > Page 2360
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Radiator Fan Control Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagrams Radiator Fan Control Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RADIATOR FAN CONTROL - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Radiator Fan Control Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 2363
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagrams Radiator Fan High Speed Relay (Front End Module)
5 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 5 WAY
RELAY-RADIATOR FAN HIGH - (FRONT END MODULE) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Resistor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Resistor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2367
Radiator Cooling Fan Resistor: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
RESISTOR-RADIATOR FAN - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Engine
Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Engine
Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 2374
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Normal Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2375
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any ECT circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor(s) and the
PCM.
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Turn the ignition on. 5. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the
sensor(s) and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 6. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to
set during the wiggle test.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AND CONDITION
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Check the engine coolant level and the condition of the engine coolant. Refer to the appropriate
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. THERMOSTAT
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Using the appropriate service information, determine the proper opening temperature of the
thermostat. 2. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine
was allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
3. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool. 4. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2376
NOTE: The thermostat should not open until the engine reaches the temperature specified in the
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine was
allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
2. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool and the actual coolant temperature with a
thermometer. 3. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The sensor value transition should be smooth as the engine reaches operating
temperature. The thermometer reading and the coolant
temperature value on the scan tool should remain relatively close.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 5.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
5. (K2) ECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K2) ECT Signal circuit at the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor harness
connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the
voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2377
No
- Repair the (K2) ECT Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
harness connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure
the voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor and the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Heater Core - Description
Heater Core: Description and Operation Front Heater Core - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: LHD model shown.
The heater core (1) for the heating-A/C system is mounted within the HVAC air distribution
housing, which is located behind the instrument panel. The heater core is a heat exchanger made
of rows of tubes with fins and is positioned within the air distribution housing so that only the
selected amount of air entering the housing passes through the heater core before it is distributed
through the heating-A/C system ducts and outlets. One end of the heater core is fitted with a tank
(2) that includes the fittings for the heater core tubes (3).
The heater core can only be serviced by removing the HVAC housing from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Heater Core - Description > Page 2382
Heater Core: Description and Operation Front Heater Core - Operation
OPERATION
Engine coolant is circulated through the heater hoses to the heater core at all times. As the coolant
flows through the heater core, heat is removed from the engine and is transferred to the heater
core tubes and fins. Air directed through the heater core picks up the heat from the heater core
fins. The blend-air door allows control of the heater output air temperature by regulating the amount
of air flowing through the heater core. The blower motor speed controls the volume of air flowing
through the HVAC housing.
The heater core cannot be repaired and it must be replaced if inoperative, leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Heater Core - Description > Page 2383
Heater Core: Description and Operation Rear Heater Core - Description
DESCRIPTION
The rear heater core (1) is located in the rear heater-A/C housing behind the right interior quarter
trim panel. The rear heater core is a heat exchanger made of rows of tubes and fins (2). The heater
core tubes (3) are permanently soldered to the heater core tank and are retained to the outboard
side of the rear heater-A/C housing by use of an integral bracket (4) and screw.
The rear heater-A/C housing must be removed from the vehicle to service the rear heater core.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Heater Core - Description > Page 2384
Heater Core: Description and Operation Rear Heater Core - Operation
OPERATION
Engine coolant is circulated through heater hoses and tubes to the rear heater core at all times. As
the coolant flows through the heater core, heat removed from the engine is transferred to the
heater core fins and the air directed through the heater core picks up the heat from the fins. The
rear blend-air door allows control of the rear heater output air temperature by controlling the
amount of air flowing through or around the rear heater core. The rear blower motor speed controls
the volume of air flowing through the rear heater-A/C housing.
The rear heater core cannot be repaired and must be replaced if inoperative, leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Heater Core - Removal
Heater Core: Service and Repair Front Heater Core - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and cautions may result in possible serious or
fatal injury.
NOTE: The HVAC housing assembly must be removed from vehicle for service of the heater core.
NOTE: LHD model with A/C shown. Heater-only models similar.
1. Remove the HVAC housing assembly and place it on a workbench . 2. Remove the left side front
floor duct See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Air Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution Duct Removal.
NOTE: If the foam seal for the flange is deformed or damaged, it must be replaced.
3. Remove the foam seal (1) from the flange (2) located on the front of the HVAC housing (5). 4.
Remove the screw (6) that secures the flange to the front of the HVAC housing and remove the
flange. 5. On RHD models, remove the air distribution housing from the HVAC housing 6. Carefully
pull the heater core (4) out of the driver side of the air distribution housing (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 2387
Heater Core: Service and Repair Front Heater Core - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: LHD model with A/C shown.
1. Carefully install the heater core (4) into the side of the air distribution housing (3). 2. On RHD
models, install the air distribution housing onto the HVAC housing (5) . 3. Install the flange (2) that
secures the heater core tubes to the front of the HVAC housing. 4. Install the screw (6) that
secures the flange to the HVAC housing. Tighten the screw to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
NOTE: If the foam seal for the flange is deformed or damaged, it must be replaced.
5. Install the foam seal (1) onto the flange. 6. Install the left side front floor duct See: Heating and
Air Conditioning/Air Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution Duct - Installation.
NOTE: If the heater core is being replaced, flush the cooling system See: Service and Repair .
7. Install the HVAC housing assembly .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 2388
Heater Core: Service and Repair Rear Heater Core - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Service Precautions/Warning and See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the rear heater-A/C housing and
place it on a workbench See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing Removal.
3. Remove the foam seal (2) from the flange (1) located at the bottom of the rear heater-A/C
housing (3). If the foam seal is deformed or damaged, it
must be replaced.
4. Remove the three screws (2) that secure the flange (1) to the bottom of the rear heater-A/C
housing (3) and remove the flange.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 2389
5. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the rear blend door actuator (2) located on the
outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing (4). 6. Remove the two screws (1) that secure the
rear blend door actuator to the rear heater-A/C housing and remove the actuator.
7. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1) from the rear mode door actuator (3) located on the
outboard side of the rear heater-A/C distribution
housing (2).
8. Remove the three metal retaining clips (4) that secure the rear distribution housing to the rear
heater-A/C housing (5). 9. Release the five plastic retaining tabs (4) that secure the rear distribution
housing and rear heater-A/C housing together and separate the housings.
10. Remove the screw (1) that secures the rear heater core tubes (3) to the outboard side of the
rear heater-A/C housing (4).
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the plastic evaporator tube bracket, carefully guide the heater
core tubes past the bracket during removal
of the heater core.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 2390
11. Carefully pull the rear heater core (5) out of the top of the rear heater-A/C housing. Guide the
heater core tubes past the plastic evaporator tube
bracket (2). If the foam seals on the heater core are deformed or damaged, they must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 2391
Heater Core: Service and Repair Rear Heater Core - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the plastic evaporator tube bracket, carefully guide the heater
core tubes past the bracket during
installation of the heater core.
1. Carefully install the rear heater core (5) into the rear heater-A/C housing (4). Guide the heater
core tubes past the plastic evaporator tube bracket
(2). Make sure that the foam seals are properly installed.
2. Install the screw (1) that secures the rear heater core tubes (3) to the outboard side of the rear
heater-A/C housing. Tighten the screw to 1.2 Nm (10
in. lbs.).
3. Position the rear heater-A/C distribution housing (2) to the rear heater-A/C housing (5) and
engage the five plastic retaining tabs (4). Make sure
the retaining tabs are fully engaged.
4. Install the three metal retaining clips (6) that secure the rear distribution housing to the rear
heater-A/C housing. 5. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the rear mode door actuator (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 2392
6. Position the rear blend door actuator (1) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (3). If necessary,
rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines on the
actuator output shaft with those on the rear blend-air door pivot shaft (2).
7. Install the two screws (1) that secure the rear blend door actuator (2) to the rear heater-A/C
housing (4). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 8. Connect the wire harness connector (3)
to the rear blend door actuator.
9. Position the flange (1) to the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3) and install the three
retaining screws (2). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10
in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 2393
10. Install the foam seal (2) onto the flange (1) at the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3).
Make sure that the foam seal is properly installed. 11. Install the rear heater-A/C housing See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing Installation.
12. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 13. If the rear heater core is being replaced, flush the
cooling system See: Service and Repair. 14. Refill the engine cooling system See: Service and
Repair. 15. Evacuate and charge the refrigerant system See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service
and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Radiator Drain Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Radiator Drain Plug: Service and Repair Removal
DRAINCOCK
CAUTION: Use of pliers on draincock is not recommended. Damage may occur to radiator or
draincock.
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove draincock during a routine coolant drain.
1. Remove belly pan (if equipped). 2. Drain the cooling system See: Service and Repair. 3. Open
the draincock (2) by turning it counterclockwise until it stops. 4. Turn the draincock (2) back
(clockwise) 1/8 turn. 5. Pull the draincock (2) from the radiator tank (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Radiator Drain Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2399
Radiator Drain Plug: Service and Repair Installation
DRAINCOCK
1. Align draincock (2) stem to radiator tank (1) opening. 2. Push draincock (2) into the radiator tank
(1) opening. 3. Tighten the draincock (2) by turning clockwise until it stops. 4. Fill the cooling
system See: Service and Repair. 5. Install belly pan (if equipped).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Radiator Cap - Description
Radiator Cap: Description and Operation Radiator Cap - Description
DESCRIPTION
The cooling system is equipped with a pressure cap that releases built up pressure, maintaining a
range of 97-124 kPa (14-18 psi).
There is also a vent valve in the center of the cap. This valve also opens when coolant is cooling
and contracting, allowing coolant to return to radiator from coolant reserve/recovery system
container by vacuum through connecting hose. If valve is stuck shut, the radiator hoses will be
collapsed on cool down. Clean the vent valve to ensure proper sealing when boiling point is
reached.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Radiator Cap - Description > Page 2404
Radiator Cap: Description and Operation Radiator Cap - Operation
OPERATION
The pressure cap allows the cooling system to operate at higher than atmospheric pressure. The
higher pressure raises the coolant boiling point; this allows increased radiator cooling capacity.
The gasket in the cap seals the filler neck, so that vacuum can be maintained, allowing coolant to
be drawn back into the cooling system from the reserve container.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Radiator Pressure Cap
Radiator Cap: Testing and Inspection Radiator Pressure Cap
RADIATOR PRESSURE CAP TESTING
CAUTION: Vehicles equipped with 2.4L engines use a different pressure cap than vehicles
equipped with 2.7L engines. The pressure caps are
NOT interchangeable. Verify proper pressure cap part number.
Dip the pressure cap in water. Clean any deposits off the vent valve or its seat and apply cap to
end of the Pressure Cap Test Adaptor that is included with the Cooling System Tester 7700.
Working the plunger, bring the pressure to 104 kPa (15 psi) on the gauge. If the pressure cap fails
to hold pressure of at least 97 kPa (14 psi), replace the pressure cap.
CAUTION: The Cooling System Tester Tool is very sensitive to small air leaks that will not cause
cooling system problems. A pressure cap that
does not have a history of coolant loss should not be replaced just because it leaks slowly when
tested with this tool. Add water to the tool. Turn tool upside down and recheck pressure cap to
confirm that cap is bad.
If the pressure cap tests properly while positioned on Cooling System Tester but will not hold
pressure or vacuum when positioned on the filler neck. Inspect the filler neck and cap top gasket
for irregularities that may prevent the cap from sealing properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Radiator Pressure Cap > Page 2407
Radiator Cap: Testing and Inspection Pressure Relief Test
PRESSURE RELIEF TESTING
WARNING: The warning words "DO NOT OPEN HOT" on the pressure cap is a safety precaution.
When hot, the cooling system builds up
pressure. To prevent scalding or other injury, the pressure cap should not be removed while the
system is hot and/or under pressure.
CAUTION: Vehicles equipped with 2.4L engines use a different pressure cap than vehicles
equipped with 2.7L engines. The pressure caps are
NOT interchangeable. Verify proper pressure cap part number.
The pressure cap upper gasket to filler neck seal can be checked by removing the overflow hose at
the filler neck overflow nipple. Attach the radiator pressure tester to the filler neck overflow nipple,
and pump air into the system. The pressure cap upper gasket should relieve pressure at 69-124
kPa (10-18 psi), and hold pressure at 55 kPa (8 psi) minimum.
There is no need to remove the pressure cap at any time except for the following purposes:
- Check and adjust coolant freeze point
- Refill system with new coolant
- Conducting service procedures
- Checking for leaks
WARNING: If vehicle has been run recently, wait 15 minutes before removing cap. Place a shop
towel over the cap, and without pushing down,
rotate it counterclockwise to the first stop. Allow fluids to escape through the overflow tube. When
the system stops pushing coolant and steam into the coolant recovery tank and pressure drops,
push down on the cap and remove it completely. Squeezing the radiator inlet hose with a shop
towel (to check pressure) before and after turning to the first stop is recommended.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Radiator Cap - Cleaning
Radiator Cap: Service and Repair Radiator Cap - Cleaning
CLEANING
Use only a mild soap to clean the pressure cap.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Radiator Cap - Cleaning > Page 2410
Radiator Cap: Service and Repair Radiator Cap - Inspection
INSPECTION
Hold the cap in your hand, right side up. The vent valve at the bottom of the cap should fall open.
Turn the cap upside down. The vent valve should close.
Replace the cap for any of the following conditions:
- Rubber gasket has swollen, preventing the valve from opening.
- Any light can be seen between the vent valve and the rubber gasket (with cap upside down).
- Gasket on the bottom of the cap shows noticeable thinning.
- Cap has been through more than one engine overheat.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2415
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
FAN MODULE-RADIATOR COOLING - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Radiator Fan High Speed Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Radiator Fan High Speed Relay > Page 2420
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Radiator Fan Control Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagrams Radiator Fan Control Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RADIATOR FAN CONTROL - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Radiator Fan Control Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way >
Page 2423
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Diagrams Radiator Fan High Speed Relay (Front End Module)
5 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 5 WAY
RELAY-RADIATOR FAN HIGH - (FRONT END MODULE) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 2431
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Normal Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2432
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any ECT circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor(s) and the
PCM.
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Turn the ignition on. 5. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the
sensor(s) and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 6. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to
set during the wiggle test.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AND CONDITION
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Check the engine coolant level and the condition of the engine coolant. Refer to the appropriate
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. THERMOSTAT
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Using the appropriate service information, determine the proper opening temperature of the
thermostat. 2. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine
was allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
3. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool. 4. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2433
NOTE: The thermostat should not open until the engine reaches the temperature specified in the
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine was
allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
2. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool and the actual coolant temperature with a
thermometer. 3. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The sensor value transition should be smooth as the engine reaches operating
temperature. The thermometer reading and the coolant
temperature value on the scan tool should remain relatively close.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 5.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
5. (K2) ECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K2) ECT Signal circuit at the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor harness
connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the
voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2434
No
- Repair the (K2) ECT Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
harness connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure
the voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor and the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Engine Coolant Thermostat - Description
Thermostat: Description and Operation Engine Coolant Thermostat - Description
3.5L
The thermostat is located on the lower left side of engine, near the front. The thermostat is on the
inlet side of the water pump. It has an air bleed located in the thermostat flange. The air bleed
allows internal trapped air during cooling system filling to be released.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Engine Coolant Thermostat - Description > Page 2439
Thermostat: Description and Operation Engine Coolant Thermostat - Operation
OPERATION
The engine cooling thermostat is a wax pellet driven, reverse poppet choke type. The thermostat is
designed to provide the fastest warm up possible by preventing leakage through it and to
guarantee a minimum engine operating temperature of 88 to 93°C (192 to 199°F). The thermostat
also will automatically reach wide open so it will not restrict flow to the radiator as temperature of
the coolant rises in hot weather to around 104°C (220°F). Above this temperature the coolant
temperature is controlled by the radiator, fan, and ambient temperature, not the thermostat.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 2440
Thermostat: Testing and Inspection
ENGINE COOLANT THERMOSTAT TESTING
The thermostat is operated by a wax filled container (pellet) which is sealed. When heated coolant
reaches a predetermined temperature the wax pellet expands enough to overcome the closing
spring and water pump pressure, which forces the valve to open. Coolant leakage into the pellet
will cause a thermostat to fail open. Do not attempt to free up a thermostat with a screwdriver.
The thermostat that opens too soon type failure mode is included in the on-board diagnosis. The
check engine light will be lit by an open too soon condition. If it has failed open, a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) will be set. Do not change a thermostat for lack of heater performance or
temperature gauge position, unless a DTC is present. For other probable causes, See: Testing and
Inspection. Thermostat failing shut is the normal long term mode of failure, and normally, only on
high mileage vehicles. The temperature gauge will indicate this.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Coolant Thermostat - Removal
Thermostat: Service and Repair Engine Coolant Thermostat - Removal
3.5L ENGINE
WARNING: Do not remove pressure cap with the system hot and under pressure because serious
burns from coolant can occur.
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. 2. Drain cooling system See: Service and Repair. 3. Remove
engine cover. 4. Disconnect radiator upper hose from thermostat housing. 5. Remove thermostat
housing bolts. 6. Remove housing, thermostat, and gasket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Coolant Thermostat - Removal > Page 2443
Thermostat: Service and Repair Engine Coolant Thermostat - Installation
3.5L ENGINE
1. Clean gasket sealing surfaces. 2. Install thermostat and gasket into thermostat housing. For
ease of installation, install bolts in housing for thermostat and gasket retention. 3. Install thermostat
and housing to Intake manifold. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Connect radiator hoses
and install hose clamp. 5. Install engine cover. 6. Refill cooling system See: Service and Repair. 7.
Connect negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Coolant Outlet Housing - Removal
Thermostat Housing: Service and Repair Coolant Outlet Housing - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Do not remove pressure cap with the system hot and under pressure because serious
burns from coolant can occur.
1. Drain cooling system See: Service and Repair 2. Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor
connector. 3. Disconnect hoses at coolant outlet connector. 4. Remove bolts attaching coolant
outlet connector. 5. Remove coolant outlet connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Coolant Outlet Housing - Removal > Page 2448
Thermostat Housing: Service and Repair Coolant Outlet Housing - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean sealing surfaces. Inspect gaskets for tears and cuts. Replace as necessary. 2. Install
coolant outlet connector and tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 3. Connect hoses at coolant
outlet connector. 4. Connect engine coolant temperature sensor connector. 5. Fill cooling system
See: Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
WATER PUMP
2.4L Engine
Bolts-Water Pump Mounting.................................................................................................................
.......................................................24 Nm (18 ft. lbs) Bolts-Water Pump Inlet Tube to Block..............
............................................................................................................................................12 Nm (9
ft. lbs) Bolts, Water Pump Inlet Tube to water pump
housing.................................................................................................................................24 Nm
(18 ft. lbs) Bolts, Water Pump to Water Pump Adapter........................................................................
.........................................................................22 Nm (16 ft. lbs) Bolts, Water Pump Pulley to Water
Pump....................................................................................................................................................
.9 Nm (80 in. lbs)
3.5L Engine
Bolts - Water Pump .............................................................................................................................
........................................ 12 Nm (9 ft.lb., 106 in. lb.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Water Pump: Procedures
Water Pump - Coolant Air Evacuation
COOLANT AIR EVACUATION
Evacuating or purging air from the cooling system involves the use of a pressurized air operated
vacuum generator. The vacuum created allows for a quick and complete coolant refilling while
removing any airlocks present in the system components.
NOTE: To avoid damage to the cooling system, ensure that no component would be susceptible to
damage when a vacuum is drawn on the
system.
WARNING: ANTIFREEZE IS AN ETHYLENE GLYCOL BASE COOLANT AND IS HARMFUL IF
SWALLOWED OR INHALED. IF
SWALLOWED, DRINK TWO GLASSES OF WATER AND INDUCE VOMITING. IF INHALED,
MOVE TO FRESH AIR AREA. SEEK MEDICAL ATTENTION IMMEDIATELY. DO NOT STORE IN
OPEN OR UNMARKED CONTAINERS. WASH SKIN AND CLOTHING THOROUGHLY AFTER
COMING IN CONTACT WITH ETHYLENE GLYCOL. KEEP OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN.
DISPOSE OF GLYCOL BASED COOLANT PROPERLY. CONTACT YOUR DEALER OR
GOVERNMENT AGENCY FOR LOCATION OF COLLECTION CENTER IN YOUR AREA. DO
NOT OPEN A COOLING SYSTEM WHEN THE ENGINE IS AT OPERATING TEMPERATURE OR
HOT UNDER PRESSURE; PERSONAL INJURY CAN RESULT. AVOID RADIATOR COOLING
FAN WHEN ENGINE COMPARTMENT RELATED SERVICE IS PERFORMED; PERSONAL
INJURY CAN RESULT.
WARNING: WEAR APPROPRIATE EYE AND HAND PROTECTION WHEN PERFORMING THIS
PROCEDURE.
NOTE: The service area where this procedure is performed should have a minimum shop air
requirement of 80 PSI (5.5 bar) and should be
equipped with an air dryer system.
NOTE: For best results, the radiator should be empty. The vehicle's heater control should be set to
the heat position (ignition may need to be
turned to the on position but do not start the motor).
1. Refer to the Chrysler Pentastar Service Equipment (Chrysler PSE) Coolant Refiller #85-15-0650
or equivalent tool's operating manual for specific
assembly steps.
2. Choose an appropriate adapter cone that will fit the vehicle's radiator filler neck or reservoir tank.
3. Attach the adapter cone (2) to the vacuum gauge (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2454
4. Make sure the vacuum generator/venturi ball valve (3) is closed and attach an airline hose (2)
(minimum shop air requirement of 80 PSI/5.5 bar) to
the vacuum generator/venturi (1).
5. Position the adaptor cone/vacuum gauge assembly into the radiator filler neck or reservoir tank.
Ensure that the adapter cone is sealed properly.
6. Connect the vacuum generator/venturi (2) to the positioned adaptor cone/vacuum gauge
assembly (1). 7. Open the vacuum generator/venturi ball valve.
NOTE: Do not bump or move the assembly as it may result in loss of vacuum. Some radiator
overflow hoses may need to be clamped off to
obtain vacuum.
8. Let the system run until the vacuum gauge shows a good vacuum through the cooling system.
Refer to the tool's operating manual for appropriate
pressure readings.
NOTE: If a strong vacuum is being created in the system, it is normal to see the radiator hoses to
collapse.
9. Close the vacuum generator/venturi ball valve.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2455
10. Disconnect the vacuum generator/venturi and airline from the adaptor cone/vacuum gauge
assembly. 11. Wait approximately 20 seconds, if the pressure readings do not move, the system
has no leaks. If the pressure readings move, a leak could be
present in the system and the cooling system should be checked for leaks and the procedure
should be repeated.
12. Place the tool's suction hose into the coolant's container.
NOTE: Ensure there is a sufficient amount of coolant, mixed to the required strength/protection
level available for use. For best results and to
assist the refilling procedure, place the coolant container at the same height as the radiator filler
neck. Always draw more coolant than required. If the coolant level is too low, it will pull air into the
cooling system which could result in airlocks in the system.
13. Connect the tool's suction hose (1) to the adaptor cone/vacuum gauge assembly (2).
14. Open the suction hose's ball valve to begin refilling the cooling system. 15. When the vacuum
gauge reads zero, the system is filled.
NOTE: On some remote pressurized tanks, it is recommended to stop filling when the proper level
is reached.
16. Close the suction hose's ball valve and remove the suction hose from the adaptor cone/vacuum
gauge assembly. 17. Remove the adaptor cone/vacuum gauge assembly from the radiator filler
neck or reservoir tank. 18. With heater control unit in the HEAT position, operate engine with
container cap in place. 19. After engine has reached normal operating temperature, shut engine off
and allow it to cool. When engine is cooling down, coolant will be drawn
into the radiator from the pressure container.
20. Add coolant to the recovery bottle/container as necessary. Only add coolant to the container
when the engine is cold. Coolant level in a warm
engine will be higher due to thermal expansion. Add necessary coolant to raise container level to
the COLD MINIMUM mark after each cool down period.
21. Once the appropriate coolant level is achieved, attach the radiator cap or reservoir tank cap.
Water Pump - Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean gasket mating surfaces as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2456
Water Pump: Removal and Replacement
Water Pump - Removal
3.5L ENGINE
NOTE: It is normal for the water pump to weep a small amount of coolant from the weep hole
(black stain on water pump body). Do not
replace the water pump if this condition exists. Replace the water pump if a heavy deposit or a
steady flow of engine coolant is evident on water pump body from the weep hole (shaft seal
failure). Be sure to perform a thorough analysis before replacing water pump.
1. Drain cooling system See: Service and Repair. 2. Remove engine timing belt See: Engine/Timing
Components/Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets
- Removal.
3. Remove water pump mounting bolts. Note position of longer bolt for proper re-installation. 4.
Remove water pump body from engine. 5. Clean water pump mounting surface.
Water Pump - Disassembly
WATER PUMP - GAS ENGINE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2457
1. Remove the water pump assembly from the vehicle.See: Water Pump - Removal 2. Discard the
water pump outlet gasket (7). 3. Remove the three bolts (1) attaching the water pump pulley (2) to
the water pump (4). 4. Remove the water pump pulley (2). 5. Remove the five bolts (3) attaching
the water pump (4) to the water pump adapter (6). 6. Remove and discard the gasket (8). 7.
Remove the water pump (4) and inspect carefully for any damage.
Water Pump - Assembly
WATER PUMP - GAS ENGINE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2458
1. Throughly clean all gasket mating surfaces before assembling. 2. Inspect water pump and
components for any damage. 3. Using bolts (3), install the water pump (4) and gasket (8) to the
water pump adapter (6). Tighten the bolts (3) to 22 N-m (16 lbs. ft.) 4. Using bolts (1), install the
water pump pulley (2) to the water pump (4). Tighten the bolts (1) to 9 N-m (80 lbs. in.) 5. Using
bolts (5), install the water pump assembly and gasket to the engine block. Tighten the bolts to 24
Nm (18 lbs. ft.).See: Water Pump Installation
6. Start the engine and check for leaks.See: Testing and Inspection
Water Pump - Installation
3.5L ENGINE
1. Clean all O-ring surfaces on pump and cover. 2. Install new O-ring on water pump.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2459
3. Position water pump to engine. 4. Install mounting bolts and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 5.
Install timing belt See: Engine/Timing Components/Timing Belt/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Timing Belt & Sprockets Installation.
6. Evacuate air and refill cooling system. See: Procedures/Water Pump - Coolant Air Evacuation 7.
Check cooling system for leaks. See: Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation > Page 2466
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
EXHAUST MANIFOLD
Exhaust Manifold to Cylinder Head-Bolts.............................................................................................
....................................................23 Nm (200 in.lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures
Exhaust Manifold: Procedures
INSPECTION
1. Inspect exhaust maniverters for damage or cracks. 2. Check maniverter mounting surface
flatness. 3. Inspect the exhaust manifold gasket for obvious discoloration or distortion. 4. Check
distortion of the cylinder head mounting surface with a straightedge and thickness gauge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2472
Exhaust Manifold: Removal and Replacement
Front Exhaust Maniverter
REMOVAL - FRONT EXHAUST MANIVERTER
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the fasteners (1), and remove the upper heat shield (2).
3. Loosen the oil level indicator tube retaining bolt (3) and position the dipstick tube (2) aside.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2473
4. Remove the 12 belly pan fasteners (1) and remove the belly pan (2).
5. Remove the left maniverter-to-crossunder pipe fasteners (1).
6. Disconnect the harness connector (1) and remove the front lower maniverter oxygen sensor (2).
7. Disconnect the harness connector (3) and remove the front upper maniverter oxygen sensor (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2474
8. Remove the maniverter retaining bolts (1), the maniverter (2), and gasket (3).
Rear Exhaust Maniverter
REMOVAL - REAR EXHAUST MANIVERTER, AWD
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Raise and support the vehicle See:
Maintenance. 3. Remove twelve belly pan fasteners (1) and remove the belly pan (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2475
4. Remove the right front tire and wheel assembly See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service
and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and
Wheels - Removal
5. Remove the exhaust extension pipe (1) See: Exhaust Pipe/Service and Repair/Exhaust Pipe Removal. 6. Remove the exhaust crossunder pipe (3) See: Exhaust Pipe/Service and
Repair/Exhaust Crossunder Pipe - Removal
7. Disconnect harness connectors (1) and (3). Remove the right maniverter downstream (2) and
upstream (4) oxygen sensors See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Oxygen Sensor/Service and Repair/Removal
8. Remove heat shield retainers (1), (2), and (3) and remove the upper heat shield (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2476
9. Remove the right half shaft and intermediate shaft (4) See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Drive
Axles, Bearings and Joints/Axle Shaft
Assembly/Service and Repair/Intermediate Shaft/Removal
10. Remove the maniverter retaining bolts (5).
11. Reposition the maniverter to allow removal of the lower maniverter heatshield (2). 12. Remove
the lower maniverter heat shield retainers (1) and remove the lower maniverter heat shield (2). 13.
Remove the maniverter and gasket from the vehicle.
Front Exhaust Maniverter
INSTALLATION - FRONT EXHAUST MANIVERTER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2477
1. Position the maniverter (2) and gasket (3). Install the retaining bolts (1). Tighten bolts starting at
the center working outward to 23 N.m (200 in.
lbs.).
2. Install the upper heat shield (2), and torque nuts (1) to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs).
3. Install the oil level indicator tube (2) and the retaining bolt (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2478
4. Install the left upstream oxygen sensor (4) and connect the harness connector (3). 5. Install the
left downstream oxygen sensor (2) and connect the harness connector (1).
6. Install the left maniverter cross under pipe retaining bolts (1). Tighten bolts to 31 N.m (275 in.
lbs.).
7. Install the belly pan (2) and the 12 belly pan fasteners (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2479
8. Connect the negative battery cable See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service and
Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection.
Rear Exhaust Maniverter
INSTALLATION - REAR EXHAUST MANIVERTER, AWD
1. Clean the right maniverter gasket sealing surfaces with an appropriate tool See: Engine/Service
and Repair/Procedures. 2. Place the right maniverter in the engine compartment and position to
allow installation of the maniverter lower heatshield (2). 3. Install the right maniverter lower heat
shield (2) with heat shield retainers (1).
4. Install the right maniverter (6) and gasket (8) with retaining bolts (5). Tighten the bolts starting at
the center working outward to 23 Nm (200 in.
lbs.).
5. Install the right maniverter upper heat shield (4) with heat shield retainers (1), (2), and (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2480
6. Install the intermediate shaft (4) and right half shaft See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Drive
Axles, Bearings and Joints/Axle Shaft
Assembly/Service and Repair/Intermediate Shaft/Installation
7. Install the right maniverter upstream (4) and downstream (2) oxygen sensors and reconnect the
harness connectors (1) and (3) See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Oxygen Sensor/Service and Repair/Installation.
8. Install the exhaust crossunder pipe (3) See: Exhaust Pipe/Service and Repair/Exhaust
Crossunder Pipe - Installation 9. Install the exhaust extension pipe (1) See: Exhaust Pipe/Service
and Repair/Exhaust Pipe - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2481
10. Install the right front tire and wheel assembly See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and
Wheels - Installation
11. Install the belly pan (2) and the twelve belly pan fasteners (1). 12. Lower the vehicle. 13.
Connect the negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Pipe - Removal
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Exhaust Pipe - Removal
3.5L
WARNING: The normal operating temperature of the exhaust system is very high. Never attempt to
service any part of the exhaust system
until it is cooled. Special care should be taken when working near the catalytic converter. The
temperature of the converter rises to a high level after a short period of engine operation time.
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Apply penetrating oil to exhaust pipe band clamp, and fasteners (2). 3.
Loosen band clamp for resonator/pipe assembly. 4. Remove exhaust pipe mounting nuts (2) at
cross under pipe (3). 5. Remove exhaust pipe (1) and gasket from vehicle. 6. Discard band clamp.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Pipe - Removal > Page 2486
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Exhaust Pipe - Installation
3.5L
1. Position exhaust pipe (1) into muffler/resonator assembly. 2. Position exhaust pipe onto cross
over pipe. 3. Install exhaust pipe (1) to cross over pipe nuts. Tighten to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.). 4.
Align exhaust pipe (1) and resonator/muffler pipe assembly to maintain position and proper
clearance with underbody parts. All support isolators
should have equal load on them. Tighten fasteners attaching exhaust pipe (1) to cross-under pipe
(3) to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
5. Install new band clamp. Tighten band clamp to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.). 6. Lower vehicle. 7. Start the
engine and inspect for exhaust leaks. Repair exhaust leaks as necessary.See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics
8. Check the exhaust system for contact with the body panels. Make the necessary adjustments, if
needed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Pipe - Removal > Page 2487
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Exhaust Crossunder Pipe - Removal
3.5L ENGINE
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove the fasteners (1) and remove the belly pan (2).
3. Disconnect exhaust system pipe (1) from cross under pipe.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Pipe - Removal > Page 2488
4. Remove cross-under pipe bracket to cross under pipe bolt (1).
5. Remove cross under to front maniverter bolts and nuts (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Pipe - Removal > Page 2489
6. Remove cross under to rear maniverter bolts (5) and nuts (3). 7. Remove cross under pipe.
8. If necessary, remove cross under transmission bracket (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Pipe - Removal > Page 2490
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Exhaust Crossunder Pipe - Installation
3.5L ENGINE
1. If removed, install bracket (2). Tighten bolts (1) to 29 Nm (21 ft. lb.).
2. Position cross under pipe. 3. Install cross under to rear maniverter bolts (5) and nuts (3). Tighten
to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Pipe - Removal > Page 2491
4. Install cross under to front maniverter bolts and nuts. Tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
5. Install cross under pipe bracket to cross under pipe bolt (1). Tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
6. Install exhaust system pipe. Tighten flange nuts to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Pipe - Removal > Page 2492
7. Install belly pan (2) and fasteners (1). 8. Lower vehicle. 9. Start the engine and inspect for
exhaust leaks. Repair exhaust leaks as necessary.See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests
and General
Diagnostics
10. Check the exhaust system for contact with the body panels. Make the necessary adjustments,
if needed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove electrical connector at pressure
differential sensor (2). 3. Remove upstream exhaust pressure tube (4) from catalytic converter 4.
Remove downstream pressure tube (6) from catalytic converter. 5. Remove pressure differential
sensor mounting bolt. 6. Remove pressure differential sensor (2) and tubing (7) from vehicle. 7.
Remove tubing (7) from pressure differential sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2497
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Install tubing (7) on pressure differential sensor (2). 2. Position pressure differential sensor (2)
and tubing (7). 3. Install pressure differential sensor mounting bolt (3). Tighten to 10 Nm (89 in.
lbs.). 4. Install downstream pressure tube (6) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 5. Install upstream pressure tube (4) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10
Nm (89 in. lbs.) 6. Position electrical connector (1) into bracket. 7. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Heat Shield: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The exhaust system heat shields are attached to the under body of the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 2502
Heat Shield: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Heat shields are needed to protect both the vehicle and the environment from the high
temperatures developed near the catalytic converter.
Avoid application of rust prevention compounds or undercoating materials to exhaust system floor
pan heat shields on vehicles so equipped. Light over spray near the edges is permitted. Application
of coating will greatly reduce the efficiency of the heat shields resulting in excessive floor pan
temperatures and objectionable fumes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal
Muffler: Service and Repair Removal
MUFFLER
NOTE: Band clamps (3) are spot welded to exhaust system. If a band clamp must be replaced, the
spot weld must be ground off the exhaust
pipe.
NOTE: When replacement is required on any component of the exhaust system, it is most
important that original equipment parts (or their
equivalent) be used.
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Apply penetrating oil to band clamp (3). 3. Remove band clamp (3). 4.
Remove ground strap from muffler (2).
CAUTION: Do not use any tools to remove the rubber isolators-remove by hand only. Soapy water
or silicone based lubricant spray may be
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 2507
used to assist removal/installation of isolators. DO NOT use a petroleum based lubricant on the
isolators, as damage to the rubber material can occur.
5. Remove support isolators from muffler supports. 6. Remove the one muffler/resonator assembly.
.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 2508
Muffler: Service and Repair Installation
MUFFLER
NOTE: Always work from the front to rear of exhaust system when aligning and tightening exhaust
system components.
1. Position muffler/resonator assembly (2) onto exhaust pipe. 2. Install support isolators. 3. Align
muffler and resonator assembly to maintain position and proper clearance with underbody parts. All
support isolators should have equal load
on them.
4. Install new band clamp (3). Tighten to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.). 5. Connect ground strap to muffler (2).
6. Lower vehicle. 7. Start the engine and inspect for exhaust leaks. Repair exhaust leaks as
necessary.See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics
8. Check the exhaust system for contact with the body panels. Make the necessary adjustments, if
needed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove electrical connector at pressure
differential sensor (2). 3. Remove upstream exhaust pressure tube (4) from catalytic converter 4.
Remove downstream pressure tube (6) from catalytic converter. 5. Remove pressure differential
sensor mounting bolt. 6. Remove pressure differential sensor (2) and tubing (7) from vehicle. 7.
Remove tubing (7) from pressure differential sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2514
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Install tubing (7) on pressure differential sensor (2). 2. Position pressure differential sensor (2)
and tubing (7). 3. Install pressure differential sensor mounting bolt (3). Tighten to 10 Nm (89 in.
lbs.). 4. Install downstream pressure tube (6) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 5. Install upstream pressure tube (4) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10
Nm (89 in. lbs.) 6. Position electrical connector (1) into bracket. 7. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation > Page 2519
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2531
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2532
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2533
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2534
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2535
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2536
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2537
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2538
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2539
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2540
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 2541
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
Engine Control Module: Recalls Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control
Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function > Page
2551
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In
Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory >
Page 2556
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition > Page
2561
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 2566
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 2571
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM
Update For Cruise Control Function
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM
Update For Cruise Control Function > Page 2577
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 2582
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM
Update For Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM
Update For Over-Rev Condition > Page 2587
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 2592
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2597
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2598
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2599
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2600
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2601
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2602
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2603
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2604
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2605
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2606
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM
Replacement/Software Update > Page 2607
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000:
PCM Replacement
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering Power Steering Whine
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering Power Steering Whine > Page 2616
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update
For Cruise Control Function
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update
For Cruise Control Function > Page 2622
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 2627
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update
For Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update
For Over-Rev Condition > Page 2632
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 2637
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering Power Steering Whine
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering Power Steering Whine > Page 2642
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2648
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2649
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2650
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2651
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2652
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2653
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2654
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2655
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2656
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2657
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 2658
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000:
PCM Replacement
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Powertrain
Control Module (GPEC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Powertrain
Control Module (GPEC) > Page 2665
Engine Control Module: Locations Powertrain Control Module (NGC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Powertrain
Control Module (GPEC) > Page 2666
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain
Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38
Way
Connector C1 (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain
Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 2669
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain
Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 2670
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C2 (NGC) (Engine) 38 Way
Connector C2 (NGC) - (ENGINE) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (ENGINE) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain
Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 2671
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain
Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 2672
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C3 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38
Way
Connector C3 (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain
Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 2673
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain
Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 2674
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C4 (NGC) (Transmission) 38 Way
Connector C4 (NGC) - (TRANSMISSION) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (TRANSMISSION) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain
Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 2675
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Powertrain Control Module - Description
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module - Description
PCM
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is a digital computer containing a microprocessor. The PCM
receives input signals from various switches and sensors referred to as Powertrain Control Module
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine and vehicle operations through
devices referred to as Powertrain Control Module Outputs.
NOTE: PCM Inputs:
- Air Conditioning Pressure Transducer
- ASD/Main Relay
- Battery Voltage
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Distance Sensor (from transmission control module)
- EGR Position Feedback (if equipped)
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Heated Oxygen Sensors
- Ignition sense
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Park/Neutral (from trans range sensor)
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- Proportional Purge Sense
- CAN C Bus
- Speed Control
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+)
- Transmission Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Transmission Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Vehicle Speed
NOTE: PCM Outputs:
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Data Link Connector (CAN C Bus)
- Double Start Override
- EGR Solenoid (if equipped)
- Fuel Injectors
- Generator Field
- High Speed Fan Relay
- Ignition Coils
- Natural Vacuum Leak Detection
- Low Speed Fan Relay
- MTV Actuator
- Proportional Purge Solenoid
- SRV Valve
- Speed Control Relay
- Speed Control Vent Relay
- Speed Control Vacuum Relay
- Torque Reduction Request
- Transmission Control Relay
- Transmission Solenoids
- 5 Volt Output
Based on inputs it receives, the powertrain control module (PCM) adjusts fuel injector pulse width,
idle speed, ignition timing, and canister purge operation and EGR if equipped. The PCM regulates
the cooling fans, air conditioning and speed control systems. The PCM changes generator charge
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 2678
rate by adjusting the generator field.
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on the following inputs.
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Battery Voltage
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Gas Oxygen Content (heated oxygen sensors)
- Throttle Position
The PCM adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on the following inputs.
- Brake Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Park/Neutral
- Transaxle Gear Engagement
- Throttle Position
- Vehicle Speed (from Transmission Control Module)
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on the following inputs.
- Inlet Air Temperature
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Park/Neutral (from trans range sensor)
- Transaxle Gear Engagement
- Throttle Position
The camshaft and crankshaft signals are sent to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). If the PCM
does not receive both signals within approximately one second of engine cranking, it deactivates
the fuel pump. When deactivated, power is shut off to the fuel injectors, ignition coils, fuel pump
and the heating element in each oxygen sensor.
The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes battery voltage to a regulated 5.0 volts. The
5.0 volts power the camshaft position sensor, and crankshaft position sensor. The PCM also
provides a regulated 5.0 volts supply for the, manifold absolute pressure sensor, throttle position
sensor and EGR (if equipped).
The PCM engine control strategy prevents reduced idle speeds until after the engine operates for
320 km (200 miles). If the PCM is replaced after 320 km (200 miles) of usage, update the mileage
in new PCM. Use the scan tool to change the mileage in the PCM. Refer to the appropriate
Powertrain Diagnostic Manual and the scan tool. If equipped with SKREEM, must use SKREEM
function to program VIN number in new PCM.
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CVI CALCULATION
An important function of the PCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index (CVI). CVIs represent the
volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The PCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the PCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the PCM with output shaft speed information.
By comparing the two inputs, the PCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the PCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 2679
Gear ratios can be determined by using the scan tool and reading the Input/Output Speed Sensor
values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed Sensor
value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the PCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the PCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly, etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
SHIFT SCHEDULES
The PCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of shift schedules. Shift schedule
selection is dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
As driving conditions change, the PCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 2680
Sensor Return - PCM Input
SENSOR RETURN - PCM INPUT
The sensor return circuit provides a low electrical noise ground reference for all of the systems
sensors. The sensor return circuit connects to internal ground circuits within the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM).
PCM Replacement
PCM REPLACEMENT
DESCRIPTION
Use the scan tool to reprogram the new pcm with the vehicle's original identification number (vin)
and the vehicle's original mileage. If this step is not done a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) may be
set.
PCM Ground
PCM GROUND
Ground is provided through multiple pins of the PCM connector. Depending on the vehicle there
may be as many as two different ground pins. There are power grounds and sensor grounds.
The power grounds are used to control the ground side of relays, solenoids, ignition coil or
injectors. The signal ground is used for any input that uses sensor return for ground, and the
ground side of any internal processing component.
The PCM case is shielded to prevent RFI and EMI. The PCM case is grounded and must be firmly
attached to a good, clean body ground.
Internally all grounds are connected together, however there is noise suppression on the sensor
ground. For EMI and RFI protection the housing and cover are also grounded via the mounting
screws AND bracket to the chassis, separately from the ground pins.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 2681
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The PCM supplies two regulated 5 volts supplies - a 5V primary and a 5V secondary (auxiliary) to
the following sensors:
- Camshaft Position Sensor (5V secondary)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (5V primary)
- EGR Position feedback sensor (5V secondary) (if equipped)
- Engine coolant temperature sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Knock sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor (5V secondary)
- Oil Pressure Switch (connected to 5V internal via pullup resistor)
- Pedal Value Sensor #1 (5V Primary)
- Pedal Value Sensor #2 (5V Secondary)
- SRV Position Feedback Sensor (5V Secondary)
- Throttle Position Sensors (5V Primary)
- Variable Line Pressure Sensor (5V Secondary)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 2682
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE PCM POWER AND GROUND CIRCUITS
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. PCM WIRING OR CONNECTORS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 2683
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
each connector at the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 4.
Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. CHECKING THE PCM GROUND CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to 12 volts, check the PCM ground circuits. 3. Wiggle test
each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated and bright?
Yes
- Go to 3.
No
- Repair the PCM ground circuit(s) for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
3. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED B+ CIRCUITS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 2684
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
1. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM power supply circuits. 2. Wiggle
test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated and bright?
Yes
- Go to 4.
No
- Repair the PCM power supply circuit(s) for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
4. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition on.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM (F202) and (F1) Fused Ignition
circuits. 3. Wiggle test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open or short in the
circuit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 2685
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright with the ignition on and not illuminated with
the ignition off. Compare the brightness
to that of a direct connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated as described above?
Yes
- Go to 5.
No
- Repair the open or short in the Fused Ignition Switch circuits.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
5. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition on.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM Fused Ignition Switch circuits. 3.
Check each circuit with the ignition off, ignition on, engine not running position, and during
cranking. 4. Wiggle test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright with the ignition on and not illuminated with
the ignition off. Compare the brightness
to that of a direct connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated as described above?
Yes
- Test complete.
No
- Repair the PCM Fused Ignition Switch circuit(s) for as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Engine Control Module: Procedures
Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
PCM/TCM Programming
PCM / TCM PROGRAMMING
PCM / TCM FLASH PROGRAMING
This procedure will need to be done when one or more of the following situations are true:
1. A vehicle's Powertrain Control Module (PCM) has been replaced. 2. A diagnostic trouble code
(DTC) is set P1602 - PCM Not Programmed. 3. An updated calibration or software release is
available for either the PCM or TCM ECUs.
This procedure assumes that the wiTECH(TM) Vehicle Connection Interface (VCI) pod,
StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) devices are configured to your dealership's network with either
a wired or wireless connection. The wiTECH(TM) VCI pod, StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) must
also be running at the latest operating system and software release level. For more help on how to
network your StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) reference the StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) Quick
Start Networking Guide available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and
StarMOBILE(R) Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2688
> Online Documentation', under the Download Center. For the wiTECH(TM) VCI pod use the
"HELP" tab in the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application.
Table of contents
1. SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH PROCEDURE SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH
PROCEDURE 2. REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT: 3. TECH
TIPS and INFORMATION TECH TIPS and INFORMATION: 4. PARTS REQUIRED PARTS
REQUIRED
SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH PROCEDURE
If using StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client. Go To REPAIR PROCEDURE - Using
StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
If using wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application. Go To REPAIR PROCEDURE - wiTECH(TM)
Diagnostic Application
REPAIR PROCEDURE - Using StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood of the vehicle and install a battery charger. Verify that the charging rate provides
a continuous charge of 13.2 - 13.5 volts. 2. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) to the
vehicle data link connector located under the steering column and turn the ignition key to the
"RUN" position.
3. Power on the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R). If the StarMOBILE(R) is being used, launch the
StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client and connect to
the appropriate StarMOBILE(R) device.
4. Retrieve the old ECU part number. From the tool's Home screen,
a. Select "ECU View" b. Select "PCM/ECM" c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e.
Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM/ECM screen for later reference.
5. Program the ECU as follows:
a. Using the StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) at the Home screen, select "ECU View" b. Select
"PCM/ECM" c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Select "Browse for New File" and
follow the on screen instructions. f.
Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 4e, or by using
Year/Model/Engine and appropriate emissions selection for the vehicle being worked on. NOTE: If
you are not connected to the vehicle, you may also search for flash files by selecting the "Flash
Download" button from the Home screen.
g. Select "Download to Scantool" h. Once the download is complete, select "Close" and then
"Back" i.
Highlight the listed calibration, select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
j. When the PCM/ECM update is complete, select "OK"
k. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM/ECM screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
6. Continue to SECTION 2 - ADDITIONAL PCM / TCM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURES to
complete the process if the ECU has been
replaced.
7. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" (p/n 04275086AB) and
attach near the VECI label (See SECTION 3 AUTHORIZED MODIFCATION LABEL for details).
REPAIR PROCEDURE - wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood of the vehicle and install a battery charger. Verify that the charging rate provides
a continuous charge of 13.2 - 13.5 volts. 2. Connect the wiTECH(TM) Vehicle Connection Interface
(VCI) pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering column and turn
the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
3. Launch the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application and connect to the appropriate wiTECH(TM)
device. 4. From the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application Home screen,
a. Select "HELP" b. Select "HELP CONTENTS" c. Follow the correct "HELP TOPIC" for the ECU
being programmed
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2689
SECTION 2 - ADDITIONAL PCM / TCM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURES
NOTE: Find the PCM/TCM Type for the vehicle, read and write down the steps, and then go to the
step by step instructions for additional
information on how to perform these procedures. STEP-BY-STEP INSTRUCTIONS
If an EDC16-U31 PCM/ECM (2.0L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or
routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Program Variant Code
If an EDC16-C2 PCM/ECM (2.2L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or
routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3. IMA
Rapid Calibration Test - Only on 06 PT AND up 4. Injector Quantity Adjustment - Only on 06 PT
AND up
If an EDC16-CP31 (3.0L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning 4. NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization 5. Injector Quantity
Adjustment 6. IMA Rapid Calibration Test 7. Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization 8. Exhaust
Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position
If an EDC16-CP31-2 (2.8L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Injector Quantity Adjustment 4. Program Variant Code 5. ECU Replacement With Value Transfer if the ECU to be replaced is still responsive 6. ECU Replacement Without Value Transfer - if the
ECU to be replaced is NOT responsive 7. Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization 8. IMA Rapid
Calibration Test 9. Set Oil Dilution Mass Value
If a CM849 PCM/ECM (5.9L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped
If a CM2100 PCM/ECM (6.7l) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Enable / Disable Vehicle Features - need to enable features 4. Injector Quantity Adjustment 5.
Reset Regenerative Filter Timers 6. Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load
If an Aisin TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an EATX TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an NGC3 TCM ONLY was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an NGC4 TCM ONLY was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. Quick learn
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2690
If an EGS TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. Initialize EGS
STEP-BY-STEP INSTRUCTIONS
Check PCM/ECM VIN
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Check PCM/ECM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
ECU Replacement with Value Transfer
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "ECU Replacement with Value Transfer" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
ECU Replacement without Value Transfer
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "ECU Replacement without Value Transfer" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Enable / Disable Vehicle Features
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Enable / Disable Vehicle Features" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Exhaust Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Exhaust Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2691
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
IMA Rapid Calibration
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "IMA Rapid Calibration Test" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Initialize EGS
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Initialize EGS" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Injector Quantity Adjustment
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Injector Quantity Adjustment" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
PCM/ECM Replaced
The vehicle pin (Personal Identification Number) will be required to complete the routine. This
information may be obtained in three ways:
1. The original selling invoice 2. DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key Codes 3. Contacting the District
Manager.
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "WIN"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "PCM/ECM Replaced" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Program Variant Code
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2692
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Program Variant Code" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Quick learn
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Quick learn" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Reset Regenerative Filter Timers
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Reset Regenerative Filter Times" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Set Oil Dilution Mass Value
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Set Oil Dilution Mass Value" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
SECTION 3 - AUTHORIZED MODIFCATION LABEL
NOTE: The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM/ECM and/or TCM.
Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach near the VECI
label.
1. Powertrain Control / Transmission Control Module Part Numbers (Insert P/Ns) Used 2. Change
Authority: TSB XX--XX 3. Dealer Code: XXXXX 4. Date: XX-XX-XX
REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2693
TECH TIPS and INFORMATION:
CAUTION: Extreme care must be taken when programming a calibration into a generic PCM. Do
not randomly select a calibration. Once a
calibration is selected and programmed, the controller cannot be reprogrammed to a different
calibration. The module can only be reprogrammed to a more recent version of that calibration.
1. The wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application is the preferred method for flashing any Chrysler
vehicle ECU. For more information, training tutorials
are available under the "HELP" tab in the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application, under the 'Training
Aids' link.
2. To use the StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode requires that your StarMOBILE(R) is
connected to the dealerships network via a wired or
wireless connection. For more information on how to use the StarMOBILE in Pass-Through Mode
see the StarMOBILE(R) training tutorials available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R)
and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Training Aids', under the 'Training Aids' link.
3. If the flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted. 4. Due to the
PCM/ECM / TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other ECUs within the vehicle.
Some DTCs may cause the MIL to
illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All
Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
5. Do not allow the battery charger to time out or the charging rate to climb above 13.5 Volts during
the flash process. 6. The StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) diagnostic tools fully support Internet
connectivity and must be configured for your dealership's network.
For help on setting up your StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) for the dealership's network, refer to the
StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on 'DealerCONNECT >
Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Online Documentation', under the download
center.
7. The operating software in the StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) must be programmed with the
latest software release level. The software level is
visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
screens. For instructions on how to update your scan tool, refer to the StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R) Software Update guide available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R)
and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Online Documentation', under the download center.
PARTS REQUIRED
Module/Programming Order Replacement Guide
MODULE/PROGRAMMING ORDER REPLACEMENT GUIDE
Module Programming
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2694
MODULE PROGRAMMING
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) controls the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS), Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE). When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is in need of replacement, perform
the following steps in order:
NOTE: The PCM and the WIN should never be replaced at the same time. They should be
replaced independently of each other.
1. If applicable, first replace the PCM with the original WIN still connected to the vehicle. 2. Using a
scan tool program the new PCM. (This will ensure the transfer of the Secret Key data from the
original WIN into the new PCM). 3. Replace the WIN, using the scan tool program the new WIN
module. This will transfer the Secret Key data from the PCM into the new WIN. 4. With the scan
tool reprogram the key FOBIK to the new WIN. 5. Ensure all the customer's keys have been
programmed to the new module.
NOTE: If the original keys do not successfully program to the new WIN after the proper procedures
are followed correctly, programming
new keys will be necessary.
PROGRAMMING THE SECRET KEY TO THE WIN
The secret key is an ID code that is unique to each WIN. This code is programmed and stored in
the WIN, the PCM, and each ignition key transponder chip. When the PCM or WIN is replaced, it is
necessary to program the Secret Key Code into the new module using a diagnostic scan tool.
Follow the programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for PCM REPLACED, WIN
REPLACED, or TIPM REPLACED under MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS
CONTROL MODULE menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: Programming the PCM or WIN is done using a diagnostic scan tool and a PIN to enter
secure access mode. If three attempts are made
to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secure access mode will be locked out for
one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN position for one hour and then
enter the correct PIN. Be certain that all accessories are turned OFF. Also, monitor the battery
state and connect a battery charger if necessary.
PCM/WIN PROGRAMMING
When an PCM and the WIN are replaced at the same time, perform the following steps in order:
1. Program the new WIN. 2. Replace all ignition keys and program them to the new WIN.
PROGRAMMING THE WIN
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool.
NOTE: Have a unique vehicle PIN readily available before running the routine
CAUTION: If the PCM and WIN are replaced at the same time, the PCM MUST be programmed
before the WIN.
3. Select "ECU View." 4. Select "WIN". 5. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 6. Select "WIN
Replaced". 7. Enter the PIN when prompted. 8. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine
completion.
NOTE: If the PCM and the WIN are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new WIN.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE WIN
Each FOBIK has a unique ID code that is assigned at the time the key is manufactured. When a
key is programmed into the WIN, the module learns the transponder ID code and the transponder
acquires the unique Secret Key ID code from the WIN.
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool. 3. Have a unique vehicle PIN
readily available before running the routine.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2695
4. Ignition key should be in RUN position. 5. Select "ECU View". 6. Select "WIN Wireless Control".
7. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 8. Select "Program Ignition Keys or Key FOBs", Start 9. Enter
the PIN when prompted.
10. Verify the correct information. 11. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine completion.
NOTE: If the original keys do not successfully program to the new WIN after the proper procedures
are followed correctly, programming
new keys will be necessary.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned by the WIN. Once a key is learned by a WIN, that
key has acquired the Secret Key for that
WIN and cannot be transferred to any other WIN or vehicle.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool. 3. Have a unique vehicle PIN
readily available before running the routine. 4. Ignition key should be in RUN position.
CAUTION: If the PCM and WIN are replaced at the same time, the PCM MUST be programmed
before the WIN.
5. Select "ECU View". 6. Select "WIN Wireless Control". 7. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 8.
Select "PCM Replaced". 9. Enter the PIN when prompted.
10. Verify the correct information. 11. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine completion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2696
Engine Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Powertrain Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL - NGC CONTROLLER
NOTE: USE THE SCAN TOOL TO REPROGRAM THE NEW POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
(PCM) WITH THE VEHICLES
ORIGINAL IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) AND THE VEHICLES ORIGINAL MILEAGE. IF THIS
STEP IS NOT DONE, A DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (DTC) MAY BE SET.
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to PCM, ignition key must be off, and the negative battery
cable must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM connectors.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the 4 electrical
connectors at the PCM.
3. Remove the 3 fasteners (1) holding the PCM to the bracket.
Powertrain Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION - NGC CONTROLLER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2697
NOTE: USE THE SCAN TOOL TO REPROGRAM THE NEW POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
(PCM) WITH THE VEHICLES
ORIGINAL IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) AND THE VEHICLES ORIGINAL MILEAGE. IF THIS
STEP IS NOT DONE, A DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (DTC) MAY BE SET.
1. Install PCM to bracket with 3 fasteners (1).
2. Install and lock the 4 electrical connectors to the PCM. 3. Connect negative battery cable, tighten
nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.). 4. Use the scan tool to reprogram new PCM with vehicles original
Identification Number (VIN) and original vehicle mileage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Auto Shutdown Relay > Page 2702
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Auto Shutdown Relay > Page 2703
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-AUTO SHUT DOWN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 2706
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams PCM Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-PCM - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Auto Shutdown Relay > Page 2712
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Auto Shutdown Relay > Page 2713
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-AUTO SHUT DOWN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 2716
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams PCM Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-PCM - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2722
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 6 WAY
SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect air flow sensor electrical connector (4). 2. Remove constant tension clamps (1), (2)
securing the air flow sensor (3). 3. Remove air flow sensor (3) from hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 2727
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Note the arrow direction on the sensor and correctly position the air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 2.
Install constant tension clamps (1), (2) to secure air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 3. Connect air flow
sensor electrical connector (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L) > Page 2732
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2733
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CAMSHAFT 1/1 POSITION (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2734
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT AND CRANKSHAFT SIGNALS
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at battery. 2. Disconnect electrical connector
(3) from camshaft position (CMP) sensor (2). 3. Remove bolt (1) and CMP sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page 2737
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Install camshaft position (CMP) sensor utilizing twisting motion. Make sure CMP sensor
is fully seated. Do not drive CMP sensor
into the bore with mounting screw. This may cause CMP sensor to be incorrectly seated causing a
faulty signal or no signal at all.
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the CMP sensor (2) into the timing belt cover with a twisting motion until fully seated. 2.
While holding the sensor (2) in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt (1) to 12 Nm (106
in. lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector (3) to the CMP sensor (2). 4. Connect the
negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 2743
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Normal Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2744
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any ECT circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor(s) and the
PCM.
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Turn the ignition on. 5. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the
sensor(s) and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 6. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to
set during the wiggle test.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AND CONDITION
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Check the engine coolant level and the condition of the engine coolant. Refer to the appropriate
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. THERMOSTAT
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Using the appropriate service information, determine the proper opening temperature of the
thermostat. 2. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine
was allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
3. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool. 4. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2745
NOTE: The thermostat should not open until the engine reaches the temperature specified in the
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine was
allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
2. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool and the actual coolant temperature with a
thermometer. 3. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The sensor value transition should be smooth as the engine reaches operating
temperature. The thermometer reading and the coolant
temperature value on the scan tool should remain relatively close.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 5.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
5. (K2) ECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K2) ECT Signal circuit at the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor harness
connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the
voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2746
No
- Repair the (K2) ECT Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
harness connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure
the voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
7. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor and the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Replace the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2750
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2751
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor is located on the driver side of the vehicle, above the
differential housing. The bottom of the sensor sits
above the drive plate.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the electrical
connector from the crankshaft position sensor. 3. Remove the sensor mounting screw and the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page 2754
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor into the transmission case with a twisting motion until
fully seated.
CAUTION: Before tightening the sensor mounting bolt, be sure the sensor is completely flush to the
mounting surface. If the sensor is not
flush, damage to the sensor mounting tang may result.
2. While holding the sensor in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the CKP sensor. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Operation > Page 2759
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove electrical connector at pressure
differential sensor (2). 3. Remove upstream exhaust pressure tube (4) from catalytic converter 4.
Remove downstream pressure tube (6) from catalytic converter. 5. Remove pressure differential
sensor mounting bolt. 6. Remove pressure differential sensor (2) and tubing (7) from vehicle. 7.
Remove tubing (7) from pressure differential sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 2764
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Install tubing (7) on pressure differential sensor (2). 2. Position pressure differential sensor (2)
and tubing (7). 3. Install pressure differential sensor mounting bolt (3). Tighten to 10 Nm (89 in.
lbs.). 4. Install downstream pressure tube (6) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 5. Install upstream pressure tube (4) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10
Nm (89 in. lbs.) 6. Position electrical connector (1) into bracket. 7. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Module
Fuel Level Sensor: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Module > Page 2769
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Module > Page 2770
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Module > Page 2771
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump
Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Fuel Level Sensor: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 4 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump
Module C1 (Body) 4 Way > Page 2774
Fuel Level Sensor: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C2 (AWD) (Fuel Tank Jumper) 2 Way
Connector C2 (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Fuel Pump Module - Description
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module contains the electric fuel pump, fuel pump
reservoir, fuel level sending unit, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter.
The fuel level sending unit is serviceable See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel
Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal.
The fuel pump module, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter is serviced as an
assembly See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel pump modules.
The AWD fuel pump modules contains the main fuel pump module (1), auxiliary fuel pump module
(2), main fuel level sending unit, auxiliary fuel level sending unit, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure
regulator and fuel filter.
The main fuel level sending unit is located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal. The
auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module and is serviced
as an assembly See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 2777
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Operation
OPERATION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module is located inside the fuel tank with a fuel level
sending unit and pressure regulator. The fuel pump module is a positive displacement, gerotor,
driven by a 12 volt DC permanent magnet electric motor.
The fuel pump module draws fuel through a internal filter and pushes it through the motor to an
outlet pipe. The fuel pump module contains two check valves. One valve relieves internal fuel
pump pressure and regulates maximum pump output. The second valve, in the pump outlet,
maintains pump pressure during engine off conditions.
The fuel pump pressure regulator contains a calibrated spring which forces a diaphragm against
the fuel filter return port. When pressure exceeds the calibrated amount, the diaphragm retracts,
allowing excess fuel pressure in the fuel pump module to purge into the fuel tank.
The maximum deadhead pressure is approximately 880 kPa (130 psi). The fuel pump pressure
regulator adjusts fuel system pressure to approximately 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi).
AWD
Operation of the all wheel drive (AWD) main fuel pump module is similar to the FWD with the
addition of a auxiliary fuel pump module with a auxiliary fuel level sending unit and draws fuel from
the base of the auxiliary fuel pump module (2) through an internal tube.
The auxiliary fuel pump module flow rate is greater than the vehicle fuel consumption rate so that
the auxiliary side of the tank is emptied before fuel is depleted from the primary side.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 2778
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles have a serviceable fuel level sending unit located on the fuel
pump reservoir See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel level sending units.
The main fuel level sending unit located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal.
The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module. The
auxiliary fuel pump module and the fuel level sending unit is serviced as an assembly See: Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Removal
REMOVAL
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank Removal.
NOTE: Prior to removing the main fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel tank
opening.
2. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 3. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 4. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
5. Mark the main fuel pump module orientation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2781
WARNING: The fuel pump module reservoir does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir will spill out when the
module is removed.
NOTE: Do not spill fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
6. Raise the main fuel pump module out of the fuel tank using caution not spill fuel inside the
vehicle.
7. Tip the main fuel pump module and drain enough fuel from the main fuel pump module reservoir
to gain access to the internal fuel line without
spilling fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
8. If equipped with AWD, disconnect the internal fuel line from the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2782
9. Remove the main fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
10. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2783
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank -
Removal.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
2. Mark the auxiliary fuel pump module orientation (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing the auxiliary fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel
tank opening.
3. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 4. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 5. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
6. Raise the auxiliary fuel pump module and disconnect the internal fuel line. 7. Remove the
auxiliary fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2784
8. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2785
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. If equipped with AWD, Connect the internal fuel line to the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2786
3. Lower the main fuel pump module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the main fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be performed for
the fuel level gauge to work properly.
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the main fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Fuel Tank - Installation.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2787
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. Connect the internal fuel line to the auxiliary fuel pump module. 3. Lower the auxiliary fuel pump
module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the auxiliary fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be
performed for the fuel gauge to work properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2788
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the auxiliary fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Fuel Tank - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2789
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel. Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked and approved containers.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Remove the fuel pump module See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge
Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
2. Disconnect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector (1).
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not pull the fuel level sending unit by the wires or the float arm.
3. Using your finger, press the fuel level sending unit snap tab to the left while gently pushing up on
the bottom of the fuel level sending unit and
remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2790
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not handle the new fuel level sending unit by the float arm.
1. Position the new fuel level sending unit to the fuel pump module reservoir.
2. Gently push the fuel level sending unit down until the snap tab (2) engages.
CAUTION: Ensure the fuel level sending unit wires are routed so they do not get pinched between
the coils of the spring when the module is
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Pump Module - Removal > Page 2791
completely compressed.
3. Connect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector. 4. Install the fuel pump module See:
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump
Module Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2795
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2796
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable.
NOTE: Clean dirt from sensor area prior to removal from air box.
2. Disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Remove the inlet air
temperature sensor (2) from the air box (3) by turning the sensor 1/4 turn in the counter - clockwise
direction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 2799
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the inlet air temperature sensor (2) to the air box (3) by turning the sensor 1/4 turn in the
clockwise direction. 2. Connect the inlet air temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Connect
negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2803
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2804
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-KNOCK (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock
Sensor - Removal
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold, See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the knock sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock
Sensor - Removal > Page 2807
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Always use the specified torque when installing the knock sensor bolt. Over or under
tightening the sensor mounting bolt will
affect knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper spark control.
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 2. Route the knock sensor wire
in the proper location. 3. Install upper intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation.
4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2811
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2812
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2813
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE MAP SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. MAP SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2814
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any MAP Sensor circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any sensor supply or system voltage DTCs before proceeding with this
test.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
connectors between the MAP Sensor and the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or
partially broken wires. 4. Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 5. Turn the
ignition on. 6. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the sensor and wiggle test the wiring and
connectors. 7. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. If necessary,
check each sensor circuit for high resistance or a shorted
condition.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. MAP VACUUM/BAROMETRIC PRESSURE
1. With a scan tool, read the Barometric Pressure.
NOTE: The Barometric Pressure should be approximately equal to the actual barometric pressure.
If necessary, compare the Barometric
Pressure value of the tested vehicle to the value of a known good vehicle of a similar make and
model.
2. Connect a vacuum gauge to a manifold vacuum source. 3. Start the engine.
NOTE: If engine will not idle, maintain a constant RPM above idle.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
4. With the scan tool, read the MAP Sensor vacuum.
NOTE: The scan tool reading for MAP vacuum should be within 1" of the vacuum gauge reading.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. MAP SENSOR VOLTAGE
1. With the scan tool, monitor the MAP Sensor signal voltage. 2. With the engine idling in neutral or
park, snap the throttle.
NOTE: The MAP Sensor signal voltage should change from below 2.0 volts at idle to above 3.5
volts at wide open throttle.
Were any problems found?
Yes
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2815
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
4. (F856) 5 VOLT SUPPLY CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (F856) 5 Volt Supply circuit at
the MAP Sensor harness connector and by
probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are
connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 5
No
- Repair the (F856) 5 Volt Supply circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
5. (K1) MAP SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K1) MAP Signal circuit at the
MAP Sensor harness connector and by probing
the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are connected so
that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
No
- Repair the (K1) MAP Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2816
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the MAP Sensor harness connector and by
probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are
connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
7. MAP SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
MAP Sensor and the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Replace the MAP Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the
MAP sensor.
3. Rotate sensor.
4. Lift to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 2819
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
3.5L
1. Install sensor.
2. Rotate sensor into position.
3. Attach electrical connector (1) to sensor (2). 4. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5
Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 2824
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 2825
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 2826
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 2827
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
(Gas) > Page 2828
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1
(Gas) 4 Way
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1
(Gas) 4 Way > Page 2831
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 1/2 (Gas) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1
(Gas) 4 Way > Page 2832
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1
(Gas) 4 Way > Page 2833
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2834
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder.
See: Ignition System/Firing Order
Cylinder #1 on left side.
Cylinder #1 on right side.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
- A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2835
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE OXYGEN SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. OXYGEN SENSOR, WIRING, OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any O2 sensor or rationality DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: When performing this procedure as part of another diagnostic process, it may be necessary
to repeat this test for all of the oxygen
sensors on the vehicle.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
connectors between the Oxygen sensor and the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or
partially broken wires. 4. Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 5. Turn the
ignition on. 6. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the sensor and wiggle test the wiring and
connectors. 7. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. If necessary,
check each sensor circuit for high resistance or a shorted
condition.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. OXYGEN SENSOR VOLTAGE
1. Start the engine and allow it to reach normal operating temperature.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
2. With a scan tool, monitor all O2 Sensor voltage readings.
Is the voltage switching between 2.5 and 3.4 volts for all O2 sensors?
Yes
- Go to 3
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
3. O2 SENSOR HEATER OPERATION
1. Turn the ignition off.
NOTE: Wait a minimum of 10 minutes to allow the O2 Sensor to cool down before continuing the
test. Allow the O2 Sensor voltage to
stabilize at 5.0 volts.
2. Turn the ignition on. 3. With a scan tool, actuate the O2 Sensor heater. 4. With the scan tool,
monitor O2 Sensor voltage for at least 2 minutes.
Does the voltage stay above 4.5 volts?
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2836
Yes
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
4. O2 SENSOR
1. Turn the ignition off.
NOTE: Check for contaminants that may cause improper O2 Sensor operation, such as
contaminated fuel, unapproved silicone, or evidence
of oil or coolant.
2. Disconnect the O2 Sensor harness connector. 3. Turn the ignition on. 4. With a scan tool,
monitor the O2 Sensor voltage.
NOTE: The voltage should be approximately 5.0 volts with the connector disconnected.
5. Connect a jumper wire between the signal circuit and the return circuit in the O2 Sensor harness
connector.
NOTE: The voltage should drop from 5.0 volts to 2.5 volts with the jumper wire in place.
Is the O2 Sensor voltage displayed on the scan tool as described?
Yes
- Replace the O2 Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 5
5. O2 SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the O2 Sensor Signal circuit and
connectors between the O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Check the O2 Sensor signal circuit for a short
to ground, open circuit, short to voltage, or high resistance.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 6
6. O2 SENSOR RETURN CIRCUIT
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the O2 Sensor Return circuit and
connectors between the O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Check the O2 Sensor return circuit for a short
to ground, open circuit, short to voltage or high resistance.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2837
No
- Go to 7
7. POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3.
Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 4. Monitor the scan tool data relative to
the components tested in this procedure and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 5. Look for the
data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. 6. Search for any Technical Service
Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Replace and program the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
2.7, 3.5L
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/1)
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wires going into
oxygen sensor (O2S). Damage to the
oxygen sensor may occur.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect O2S wire harness mounting clips from engine or body,
if equipped. 3. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (1). 4. Remove O2S (2)
from catalytic converter (4). 5. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (5). 6.
Remove O2S (3) from catalytic converter (4).
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/1)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 2840
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wires going into
oxygen sensor (O2S). Damage to the
oxygen sensor may occur.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect O2S wire harness mounting clips from engine or body,
if equipped. 3. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (1). 4. Remove the O2S
(5) from catalytic converter (4). 5. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (2).
6. Remove O2S (3) from catalytic converter (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 2841
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
2.7, 3.5L
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/1)
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When Equipped: The oxygen sensor (O2S) pigtail harness must be clipped and/or
bolted back to their original positions on engine
or body to prevent mechanical damage to wiring.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
Threads of new oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal. DO
NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new O2S.
1. Install O2S (3) to catalytic converter (4). 2. Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring
harness (2). 3. Install the O2S (2) to catalytic converter (4). Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 4.
Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring harness (1). 5. Connect O2S wire harness mounting
clips to engine or body, if equipped.
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/1)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 2842
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When Equipped: The oxygen sensor (O2S) pigtail harness must be clipped and/or
bolted back to their original positions on engine
or body to prevent mechanical damage to wiring.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
Threads of new oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal. DO
NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new O2S.
1. Install O2S (3) to catalytic converter (4). 2. Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring
harness (5). 3. Install O2S (2) to catalytic converter (4). Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect
O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring harness (1). 5. Connect O2S wire harness mounting clips to
engine or body, if equipped.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2846
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal
2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 2849
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 2850
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 2851
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 2852
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 2853
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect air flow sensor electrical connector (4). 2. Remove constant tension clamps (1), (2)
securing the air flow sensor (3). 3. Remove air flow sensor (3) from hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 2859
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Note the arrow direction on the sensor and correctly position the air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 2.
Install constant tension clamps (1), (2) to secure air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 3. Connect air flow
sensor electrical connector (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Operation > Page 2864
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2869
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 6 WAY
SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Position an oil collecting container under switch location. 3. Disconnect
electrical connector (1). 4. Remove the oil pressure switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal > Page 2874
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Thread Sealant to the switch threads. 2. Install oil pressure switch (2). 3.
Connect electrical connector (1). 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Start engine and check for leaks. 6. Check
engine oil level and adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
1/1 (2.4L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
1/1 (2.4L/3.5L) > Page 2880
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2881
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CAMSHAFT 1/1 POSITION (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2882
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT AND CRANKSHAFT SIGNALS
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft
Position Sensor - Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at battery. 2. Disconnect electrical connector
(3) from camshaft position (CMP) sensor (2). 3. Remove bolt (1) and CMP sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft
Position Sensor - Removal > Page 2885
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Install camshaft position (CMP) sensor utilizing twisting motion. Make sure CMP sensor
is fully seated. Do not drive CMP sensor
into the bore with mounting screw. This may cause CMP sensor to be incorrectly seated causing a
faulty signal or no signal at all.
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the CMP sensor (2) into the timing belt cover with a twisting motion until fully seated. 2.
While holding the sensor (2) in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt (1) to 12 Nm (106
in. lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector (3) to the CMP sensor (2). 4. Connect the
negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2889
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2890
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft
Position Sensor - Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor is located on the driver side of the vehicle, above the
differential housing. The bottom of the sensor sits
above the drive plate.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the electrical
connector from the crankshaft position sensor. 3. Remove the sensor mounting screw and the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft
Position Sensor - Removal > Page 2893
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor into the transmission case with a twisting motion until
fully seated.
CAUTION: Before tightening the sensor mounting bolt, be sure the sensor is completely flush to the
mounting surface. If the sensor is not
flush, damage to the sensor mounting tang may result.
2. While holding the sensor in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the CKP sensor. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Locations
Ignition Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2897
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2900
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2901
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2902
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2903
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2904
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2905
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2906
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2907
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2908
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2909
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2910
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2911
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2912
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2913
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2914
Ignition Switch: Connector Views
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Description
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) (1). The WIN and the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch (5) located on the face of the instrument panel just to
the inboard side of the steering column.
The WIN housing is constructed of molded black plastic and it includes four integral mounting
bosses (4), which are secured to the instrument panel structure with screws. Two connector
receptacles are integral to the back of the switch housing. One (3) connects the WIN to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The other (2) is a dedicated connector for the coaxial cable input from the optional remote start
system external antenna module.
The WIN is an integrated electronic receiver that replaces the ignition switch. It communicates with
other electronic modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF)
communication. It also communicates with the TPM trigger transponders (if equipped) and steering
column lock module (if equipped) using a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus connection.
The WIN provides a switched 12-volt source through an isolated switch for the steering column lock
module required for certain export market vehicles. It also contains a key removal inhibit solenoid,
an electronic Brake Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI) solenoid, a key-in warning contact and it
serves as the real time vehicle clock by transmitting the clock information to other electronic
modules over the CAN data bus.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged, the
entire WIN must be replaced. When replacing the WIN, you must also replace the steering column
lock module (if equipped).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Description > Page 2917
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Operation
OPERATION
Following are brief descriptions of the systems that the WIN controls.
IGNITION SWITCH
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) incorporates an integral ignition switch that consists of four rotary
positions with three detent positions and one spring-loaded position. The one extreme clockwise
position is a spring-loaded momentary contact "START" position. When released from the "START"
position, the switch will automatically return to the detent "ON" position. The other position includes
a detent "ACCESSORY" position and a detent "LOCK" position.
The WIN reads the position of the ignition switch and transmits the data via the CAN data bus.
These positions include "LOCK" with ignition key-out, "LOCK" with ignition key-in,
"ACCESSORY,""RUN," and "START."
SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM (SKIS)
Upon failure of proper Sentry Key Immobilizer (SKIS) communication to the Powertrain Control
Module, (PCM), the PCM will not allow the vehicle to crank. The engine will not re-crank on the key
cycle that the failure occurred, a full key down sequence must be performed for the engine to crank
again. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Description and
Operation/Vehicle Theft Security System - Operation.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE)
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), transmitter uses Radio Frequency (RF) signals to communicate
with the WIN, and the WIN relays the RKE requests to other modules in the vehicle over the CAN
data bus. See: Body and Frame/Locks/Power Locks/Description and Operation/Power Locks Operation
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING (TPM)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system uses radio and sensor technology to monitor tire air
pressure levels. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Tire Monitoring
System/Description and Operation/Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) - Operation.
REMOTE START WITH/EXTENDED RANGE ANTENNA
Further information concerning the Remote Start System. See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Keyless Entry/Keyless Starting System/Description and
Operation/Starting System - Operation
BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFTER INTERLOCK (BTSI)
The Brake Transmission Shifter/Ignition Interlock (BTSI) is controlled by the WIN. The BTSI
prevents the transmission gear shifter from being moved out of PARK without a driver in place.
PARK SHIFT INTERLOCK
The key removal inhibit solenoid internal to the WIN prevents the FOB with Integrated KEY
(FOBIK) from being rotated in the ignition switch to the LOCK position for all vehicles with an
automatic transmission unless the transmission shift lever is in the PARK position. The WIN
module monitors a hard wired input from a switch integral to the automatic transmission shifter
module to control this feature. The key removal inhibit solenoid is electronically disabled internally
by the WIN on vehicles with a manual transmission.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Description > Page 2918
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Ignition Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN). The WIN, along with the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch located on the face of the instrument panel just to the
inboard side of the steering column. The remainder of the WIN including its mounting provisions
and electrical connections are concealed within the instrument panel.
In addition to replacing a conventional keyed ignition switch, the WIN is an integrated electronic
receiver that serves as the base station in the vehicle. It communicates with other electronic
modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF) RF
communication.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged the
entire WIN must be replaced See: Service and Repair/Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ignition Switch: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
FOBIK TRAPPED IN WIN
The Fob with Integrated Key (FOBIK) cannot be rotated to the LOCK position, allowing it to be
removed from the ignition switch also referred to as the Wireless Ignition Node/WIN. The automatic
transmission or transaxle is shifted mechanically through a cable from the gearshift lever
mechanism to the transmission or transaxle valve body. A gated park switch is physically located
on and integral to the gearshift lever mechanism and is hard wired directly to the WIN. The gated
park switch is a simple plunger-like actuated open or closed contact switch that could be
considered redundant to the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) except that it monitors the position
selected with the gearshift lever, while the TRS monitors the position or gear of the transmission or
transaxle that is actually engaged. A damaged or improperly adjusted gearshift cable could result in
a different gear being engaged than that which is selected. The WIN uses the gated park switch
input to control an internal key lock solenoid, which controls whether the FOBIK can be rotated to
the LOCK position. When the gearshift lever is not in the PARK position, the gated park switch is a
closed circuit, the key lock solenoid is energized and the FOBIK cannot be rotated to the LOCK
position for removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Removal
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the lower instrument panel knee
blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker - Removal. 3.
Remove upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument cluster bezel, reposition the instrument, and remove the upper WIN
bracket attaching screw (1). See: Instrument Panel,
Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster
- Removal.
5. Disconnect the WIN electrical connector (1) and the antenna connector (3) from the WIN. 6.
Utilize a trim stick or equivalent and gently pry WIN trim ring (2) away from the instrument panel. 7.
Remove the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 8. Remove the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Removal > Page 2923
9. Rotate the WIN (1) and (2) bracket to assist in removal from the instrument panel.
10. Remove the WIN from the instrument panel opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Removal > Page 2924
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The WIN initialization procedure is required whenever the WIN or shaft lock module is
replaced on vehicles equipped with the shaft
lock module.
1. Rotate and position the WIN (1) and bracket (2) into the to instrument panel opening.
2. Install the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4). 3. Install the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 4.
Connect the WIN electrical connector (1) and antenna connector (3) to the WIN. 5. Install the WIN
trim ring (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node
Receiver - Removal > Page 2925
6. Install the upper WIN bracket attaching screw (1) and reposition the instrument cluster into the
instrument panel and install the instrument cluster
bezel. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service
and Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
8. Install knee blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker Installation. 9. Connect negative battery cable.
10. If necessary, program the WIN, See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2929
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2930
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-KNOCK (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold, See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the knock sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal >
Page 2933
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Always use the specified torque when installing the knock sensor bolt. Over or under
tightening the sensor mounting bolt will
affect knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper spark control.
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 2. Route the knock sensor wire
in the proper location. 3. Install upper intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation.
4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
Fuel Flow
Leakdown
Less than 10 psi in 5 minutes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Checking the Fuel Delivery System
CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. FUEL PUMP OPERATION
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With a scan tool, actuate the Fuel System test.
NOTE: It may be necessary to use a mechanics stethoscope in the next step.
3. Listen for fuel pump operation at the fuel tank. The fuel pump should operate smoothly with no
excessive noise. If the pump has excessive noise
such as grinding, the pump should be replaced.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Does the Fuel Pump sound to be operate normally?
Yes
- Go to 2
No
- Go to 7
2. FUEL PRESSURE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Install a fuel pressure gauge. 3. Ignition on, engine not running. 4. With the scan tool, actuate the
Fuel Pump and observe the fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Choose a conclusion that best matches your fuel pressure reading.
Below Specification
- Go to 3
Within Specification
- Test Complete.
Above Specification
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2940
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
3. RESTRICTED FUEL SUPPLY LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure even with the engine off. Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released.
2. Raise vehicle on hoist, and disconnect the fuel pressure line at the fuel pump module. 3. Install
special tool #6539 (5/16") or #6631(3/8") fuel line adapter and the fuel pressure gauge between the
fuel supply line and the fuel pump
module.
4. Ignition on, engine not running. 5. With the scan tool, actuate the Fuel Pump and observe the
fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Is the fuel pressure within specification now?
Yes
- Repair/replace fuel supply line as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. SADDLE FUEL TANK
Is the vehicle equipped with a saddle type fuel tank?
Yes
- Go to 5
No
- Go to 6
5. CHECKING FUEL TANK SIPHON HOSE AND FUEL LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Gain access to the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. 3. Inspect the following fuel
components: Fuel line and siphon hose between the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. Look for
disconnected and/or damaged lines or hoses.
- Fuel Pressure Regulator not properly seated in the module.
Were the above items in good working condition?
Yes
- Go to 6
No
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
6. CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP INLET
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2941
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Remove the Fuel Pump Module and Fuel Tank Module (if equipped), inspect the Fuel Inlet and
the bottom of the fuel tank for debris that could
cause the fuel pump inlet to be plugged.
Is the Fuel Pump Inlet plugged?
Yes
- Repair/Replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
7. FUEL PUMP MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Disconnect the Fuel Pump Module harness connector. 3. Using a 12-volt
test light to battery voltage, probe the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit in the Fuel Pump Module
harness connector.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Does the test light illuminate brightly.
Yes
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Repair the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2942
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pressure Leak Down
FUEL PRESSURE LEAK DOWN
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious
or fatal injury when performing this test
procedure. Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
- Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eye wear
and clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair / replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM GAS AND DIESEL FUEL
PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2943
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Fuel Inlet Hose 8978A-1 (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the Fuel
Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect the Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to the
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir
Assembly 534960 (4) on the floor and out of
the way so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system: Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2944
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
2. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait 1 minute before
proceeding. 3. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4
fuel pressure specification is 552 KPa ± 34 KPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the Checking The Fuel Delivery System diagnostic procedure as directed. See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Checking the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAK DOWN
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Close the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1) and then wait five minutes before proceeding. 2. Read
the Fuel Inlet (2) and Fuel Outlet (3) Pressure Gauges. The pressure should not drop more than 10
psi on either gauge.
Does the fuel pressure drop more than 10 psi?
Yes - On Fuel Inlet Gauge (1)
- Replace the fuel pump module.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
Yes - On Fuel Outlet Gauge (2)
- Replace the leaking fuel injector(s).
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- If directed here by another test, return to that test. Otherwise, test complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2945
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Delivery System Output - Flow Test
FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT - FLOW TEST
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal
injury when performing this test procedure.
- Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
- Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eyewear and
clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM THE GAS AND DIESEL
FUEL PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from the Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2946
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly 8978A-1 Fuel Inlet Hose (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect special tool Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the
Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir Assembly
534960 (4) on the floor and out of the way
so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system:
- Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 2947
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
1. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait one minute before
proceeding. 2. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 kPa ± 34 kPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4 fuel
pressure specification is 552 kPa ± 34 kPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Checking
the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump. 3. Open the Flow
Test Valve (1) for 20 seconds, then close the Valve.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
4. Turn the ignition off. 5. Measure the amount of fuel in the Reservoir Assembly (2). The fuel
output specification is ml/s X 20 seconds = fuel flow in ml.
Does the amount of fuel in the reservoir meet or exceed the specification?
Yes
- Test complete.
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Checking
the Fuel Delivery System
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disengage the air filter housing clips (1). 2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) forward slightly to
disengage tabs from the bottom of the air filter housing.
3. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal > Page 2953
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install air filter element into the bottom half of the air filter housing.
2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) rearward to engage the tabs into the bottom half of the air
filter housing. 3. Reengage the air filter housing clips (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
1. Remove fuel fill cap. 2. Remove fuel pump fuse from Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
For location of fuse, refer to label on underside of TIPM cover. 3. Start and run engine until it stalls.
4. Attempt restarting engine until it will no longer run. 5. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 6. Place
a rag or towel below fuel line quick-connect fitting at fuel rail. 7. Disconnect quick-connect fitting at
fuel rail See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair. 8. When the
repair is complete, reconnect fuel fittings and return fuel pump fuse to TIPM. 9. One or more
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) may have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel pump fuse
removal. A diagnostic scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
FIRING ORDER
2.4L
The firing order is 1-3-4-2.
3.5L
The firing order is 1-2-3-4-5-6.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark
Plug Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head cover(s). See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Cylinder Head
Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder
Head Cover(s) - Removal
2. Using suitable locking pliers, remove the tube (1) from the cylinder head and discard tube. 3.
Clean area around spark plug with Mopar(R) Parts Cleaner or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark
Plug Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2966
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Stud and Bearing Mount to a new tube (1) approximately 1 mm (0.039 in.) from
the end of tube, in a 3 mm (0.118 in.) wide area. 2. Install sealer end of tube (1) into the cylinder
head. Then carefully install the tube (1) using a hardwood block and mallet. Install the tube (1) until
it is seated into the bottom of the bore.
3. For spark plug tube (1) seal replacement, See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal.
4. Install cylinder head cover(s). See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Cylinder Head
Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder Head
Cover(s) - Installation - INSTALLATION)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
COMPRESSION CHECK
Compression Ratio ..............................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 10:1
Compression should not be less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from
cylinder to cylinder
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2970
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE TEST
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions.
Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good operating
condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis purposes.
1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine reaches normal
operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators such as fouled, hot, oily,
etc. Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Remove the Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay from the TIPM. 5. Install a suitable compression test
gauge into the number 1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. 6. Crank engine until maximum pressure
is reached on gauge. Record this pressure as #1 cylinder pressure. 7. Repeat the previous step for
all remaining cylinders. 8. Compression should not be less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary
more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder. 9. If one or more cylinders have abnormally low
compression pressures, repeat the compression test.
10. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second compression
test, it could indicate the existence of a problem in
the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide
to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the cause of
low compression unless some malfunction is present.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2975
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 6 WAY
SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect air flow sensor electrical connector (4). 2. Remove constant tension clamps (1), (2)
securing the air flow sensor (3). 3. Remove air flow sensor (3) from hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2980
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Note the arrow direction on the sensor and correctly position the air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 2.
Install constant tension clamps (1), (2) to secure air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 3. Connect air flow
sensor electrical connector (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2984
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2985
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable.
NOTE: Clean dirt from sensor area prior to removal from air box.
2. Disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Remove the inlet air
temperature sensor (2) from the air box (3) by turning the sensor 1/4 turn in the counter - clockwise
direction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2988
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the inlet air temperature sensor (2) to the air box (3) by turning the sensor 1/4 turn in the
clockwise direction. 2. Connect the inlet air temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Connect
negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L) > Page 2993
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2994
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CAMSHAFT 1/1 POSITION (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2995
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT AND CRANKSHAFT SIGNALS
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at battery. 2. Disconnect electrical connector
(3) from camshaft position (CMP) sensor (2). 3. Remove bolt (1) and CMP sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page 2998
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Install camshaft position (CMP) sensor utilizing twisting motion. Make sure CMP sensor
is fully seated. Do not drive CMP sensor
into the bore with mounting screw. This may cause CMP sensor to be incorrectly seated causing a
faulty signal or no signal at all.
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the CMP sensor (2) into the timing belt cover with a twisting motion until fully seated. 2.
While holding the sensor (2) in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt (1) to 12 Nm (106
in. lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector (3) to the CMP sensor (2). 4. Connect the
negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation > Page 3003
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early
Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early
Build) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 3009
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Normal Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3010
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any ECT circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor(s) and the
PCM.
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Turn the ignition on. 5. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the
sensor(s) and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 6. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to
set during the wiggle test.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AND CONDITION
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Check the engine coolant level and the condition of the engine coolant. Refer to the appropriate
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. THERMOSTAT
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Using the appropriate service information, determine the proper opening temperature of the
thermostat. 2. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine
was allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
3. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool. 4. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3011
NOTE: The thermostat should not open until the engine reaches the temperature specified in the
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine was
allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
2. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool and the actual coolant temperature with a
thermometer. 3. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The sensor value transition should be smooth as the engine reaches operating
temperature. The thermometer reading and the coolant
temperature value on the scan tool should remain relatively close.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 5.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
5. (K2) ECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K2) ECT Signal circuit at the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor harness
connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the
voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3012
No
- Repair the (K2) ECT Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
harness connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure
the voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor and the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3016
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3017
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor is located on the driver side of the vehicle, above the
differential housing. The bottom of the sensor sits
above the drive plate.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the electrical
connector from the crankshaft position sensor. 3. Remove the sensor mounting screw and the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page 3020
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor into the transmission case with a twisting motion until
fully seated.
CAUTION: Before tightening the sensor mounting bolt, be sure the sensor is completely flush to the
mounting surface. If the sensor is not
flush, damage to the sensor mounting tang may result.
2. While holding the sensor in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the CKP sensor. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Data Link Connector: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3024
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3025
Data Link Connector: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
DATA LINK CONNECTOR - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Data Link Connector - Description
Data Link Connector: Description and Operation Data Link Connector - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Data Link Connector (DLC) (2) is a 16-way molded plastic connector insulator on a dedicated
take out of the instrument panel wire harness. This connector is located at the lower edge of the
instrument panel, outboard of the steering column. The connector insulator is retained by integral
snap features within a rectangular cutout in the lower instrument panel reinforcement, just forward
of the instrument panel steering column opening cover (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Data Link Connector - Description > Page 3028
Data Link Connector: Description and Operation Data Link Connector - Operation
OPERATION
The Data Link Connector (DLC) is an industry-standard 16-way connector that permits the
connection of a diagnostic scan tool to the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus for interfacing
with, configuring and retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) data from the electronic modules
that reside on the data bus network of the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3037
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3038
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3039
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3040
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3041
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3042
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3043
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3044
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3045
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3046
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software
Update > Page 3047
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000:
PCM Replacement
Engine Control Module: Recalls Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls PCM Update For Cruise Control Function
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control
Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls PCM Update For Cruise Control Function > Page 3057
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In
Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 3062
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition > Page 3067
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 3072
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine
Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine
Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 3077
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function > Page 3083
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 3088
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition > Page 3093
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 3098
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3103
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3104
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3105
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3106
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3107
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3108
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3109
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3110
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3111
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3112
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 >
Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3113
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 3122
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10
> Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10
> Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function > Page 3128
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C
> Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C
> Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 3133
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10
> Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10
> Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition > Page 3138
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09
> Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09
> Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 3143
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08
> Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08
> Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 3148
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3154
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3155
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3156
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3157
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3158
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3159
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3160
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3161
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3162
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3163
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov
> 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3164
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Powertrain Control Module (GPEC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Powertrain Control Module (GPEC) > Page 3171
Engine Control Module: Locations Powertrain Control Module (NGC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Powertrain Control Module (GPEC) > Page 3172
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38
Way
Connector C1 (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3175
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3176
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C2 (NGC) (Engine) 38 Way
Connector C2 (NGC) - (ENGINE) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (ENGINE) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3177
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3178
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C3 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38
Way
Connector C3 (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3179
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3180
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C4 (NGC) (Transmission) 38 Way
Connector C4 (NGC) - (TRANSMISSION) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (TRANSMISSION) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3181
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Powertrain Control Module - Description
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module - Description
PCM
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is a digital computer containing a microprocessor. The PCM
receives input signals from various switches and sensors referred to as Powertrain Control Module
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine and vehicle operations through
devices referred to as Powertrain Control Module Outputs.
NOTE: PCM Inputs:
- Air Conditioning Pressure Transducer
- ASD/Main Relay
- Battery Voltage
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Distance Sensor (from transmission control module)
- EGR Position Feedback (if equipped)
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Heated Oxygen Sensors
- Ignition sense
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Park/Neutral (from trans range sensor)
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- Proportional Purge Sense
- CAN C Bus
- Speed Control
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+)
- Transmission Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Transmission Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Vehicle Speed
NOTE: PCM Outputs:
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Data Link Connector (CAN C Bus)
- Double Start Override
- EGR Solenoid (if equipped)
- Fuel Injectors
- Generator Field
- High Speed Fan Relay
- Ignition Coils
- Natural Vacuum Leak Detection
- Low Speed Fan Relay
- MTV Actuator
- Proportional Purge Solenoid
- SRV Valve
- Speed Control Relay
- Speed Control Vent Relay
- Speed Control Vacuum Relay
- Torque Reduction Request
- Transmission Control Relay
- Transmission Solenoids
- 5 Volt Output
Based on inputs it receives, the powertrain control module (PCM) adjusts fuel injector pulse width,
idle speed, ignition timing, and canister purge operation and EGR if equipped. The PCM regulates
the cooling fans, air conditioning and speed control systems. The PCM changes generator charge
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 3184
rate by adjusting the generator field.
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on the following inputs.
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Battery Voltage
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Gas Oxygen Content (heated oxygen sensors)
- Throttle Position
The PCM adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on the following inputs.
- Brake Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Park/Neutral
- Transaxle Gear Engagement
- Throttle Position
- Vehicle Speed (from Transmission Control Module)
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on the following inputs.
- Inlet Air Temperature
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Park/Neutral (from trans range sensor)
- Transaxle Gear Engagement
- Throttle Position
The camshaft and crankshaft signals are sent to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). If the PCM
does not receive both signals within approximately one second of engine cranking, it deactivates
the fuel pump. When deactivated, power is shut off to the fuel injectors, ignition coils, fuel pump
and the heating element in each oxygen sensor.
The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes battery voltage to a regulated 5.0 volts. The
5.0 volts power the camshaft position sensor, and crankshaft position sensor. The PCM also
provides a regulated 5.0 volts supply for the, manifold absolute pressure sensor, throttle position
sensor and EGR (if equipped).
The PCM engine control strategy prevents reduced idle speeds until after the engine operates for
320 km (200 miles). If the PCM is replaced after 320 km (200 miles) of usage, update the mileage
in new PCM. Use the scan tool to change the mileage in the PCM. Refer to the appropriate
Powertrain Diagnostic Manual and the scan tool. If equipped with SKREEM, must use SKREEM
function to program VIN number in new PCM.
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CVI CALCULATION
An important function of the PCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index (CVI). CVIs represent the
volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The PCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the PCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the PCM with output shaft speed information.
By comparing the two inputs, the PCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the PCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 3185
Gear ratios can be determined by using the scan tool and reading the Input/Output Speed Sensor
values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed Sensor
value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the PCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the PCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly, etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
SHIFT SCHEDULES
The PCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of shift schedules. Shift schedule
selection is dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
As driving conditions change, the PCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 3186
Sensor Return - PCM Input
SENSOR RETURN - PCM INPUT
The sensor return circuit provides a low electrical noise ground reference for all of the systems
sensors. The sensor return circuit connects to internal ground circuits within the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM).
PCM Replacement
PCM REPLACEMENT
DESCRIPTION
Use the scan tool to reprogram the new pcm with the vehicle's original identification number (vin)
and the vehicle's original mileage. If this step is not done a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) may be
set.
PCM Ground
PCM GROUND
Ground is provided through multiple pins of the PCM connector. Depending on the vehicle there
may be as many as two different ground pins. There are power grounds and sensor grounds.
The power grounds are used to control the ground side of relays, solenoids, ignition coil or
injectors. The signal ground is used for any input that uses sensor return for ground, and the
ground side of any internal processing component.
The PCM case is shielded to prevent RFI and EMI. The PCM case is grounded and must be firmly
attached to a good, clean body ground.
Internally all grounds are connected together, however there is noise suppression on the sensor
ground. For EMI and RFI protection the housing and cover are also grounded via the mounting
screws AND bracket to the chassis, separately from the ground pins.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 3187
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The PCM supplies two regulated 5 volts supplies - a 5V primary and a 5V secondary (auxiliary) to
the following sensors:
- Camshaft Position Sensor (5V secondary)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (5V primary)
- EGR Position feedback sensor (5V secondary) (if equipped)
- Engine coolant temperature sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Knock sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor (5V secondary)
- Oil Pressure Switch (connected to 5V internal via pullup resistor)
- Pedal Value Sensor #1 (5V Primary)
- Pedal Value Sensor #2 (5V Secondary)
- SRV Position Feedback Sensor (5V Secondary)
- Throttle Position Sensors (5V Primary)
- Variable Line Pressure Sensor (5V Secondary)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3188
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE PCM POWER AND GROUND CIRCUITS
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. PCM WIRING OR CONNECTORS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3189
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
each connector at the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 4.
Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. CHECKING THE PCM GROUND CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to 12 volts, check the PCM ground circuits. 3. Wiggle test
each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated and bright?
Yes
- Go to 3.
No
- Repair the PCM ground circuit(s) for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
3. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED B+ CIRCUITS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3190
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
1. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM power supply circuits. 2. Wiggle
test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated and bright?
Yes
- Go to 4.
No
- Repair the PCM power supply circuit(s) for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
4. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition on.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM (F202) and (F1) Fused Ignition
circuits. 3. Wiggle test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open or short in the
circuit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3191
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright with the ignition on and not illuminated with
the ignition off. Compare the brightness
to that of a direct connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated as described above?
Yes
- Go to 5.
No
- Repair the open or short in the Fused Ignition Switch circuits.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
5. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition on.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM Fused Ignition Switch circuits. 3.
Check each circuit with the ignition off, ignition on, engine not running position, and during
cranking. 4. Wiggle test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright with the ignition on and not illuminated with
the ignition off. Compare the brightness
to that of a direct connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated as described above?
Yes
- Test complete.
No
- Repair the PCM Fused Ignition Switch circuit(s) for as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Engine Control Module: Procedures
Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
PCM/TCM Programming
PCM / TCM PROGRAMMING
PCM / TCM FLASH PROGRAMING
This procedure will need to be done when one or more of the following situations are true:
1. A vehicle's Powertrain Control Module (PCM) has been replaced. 2. A diagnostic trouble code
(DTC) is set P1602 - PCM Not Programmed. 3. An updated calibration or software release is
available for either the PCM or TCM ECUs.
This procedure assumes that the wiTECH(TM) Vehicle Connection Interface (VCI) pod,
StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) devices are configured to your dealership's network with either
a wired or wireless connection. The wiTECH(TM) VCI pod, StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) must
also be running at the latest operating system and software release level. For more help on how to
network your StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) reference the StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) Quick
Start Networking Guide available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and
StarMOBILE(R) Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3194
> Online Documentation', under the Download Center. For the wiTECH(TM) VCI pod use the
"HELP" tab in the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application.
Table of contents
1. SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH PROCEDURE SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH
PROCEDURE 2. REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT: 3. TECH
TIPS and INFORMATION TECH TIPS and INFORMATION: 4. PARTS REQUIRED PARTS
REQUIRED
SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH PROCEDURE
If using StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client. Go To REPAIR PROCEDURE - Using
StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
If using wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application. Go To REPAIR PROCEDURE - wiTECH(TM)
Diagnostic Application
REPAIR PROCEDURE - Using StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood of the vehicle and install a battery charger. Verify that the charging rate provides
a continuous charge of 13.2 - 13.5 volts. 2. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) to the
vehicle data link connector located under the steering column and turn the ignition key to the
"RUN" position.
3. Power on the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R). If the StarMOBILE(R) is being used, launch the
StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client and connect to
the appropriate StarMOBILE(R) device.
4. Retrieve the old ECU part number. From the tool's Home screen,
a. Select "ECU View" b. Select "PCM/ECM" c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e.
Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM/ECM screen for later reference.
5. Program the ECU as follows:
a. Using the StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) at the Home screen, select "ECU View" b. Select
"PCM/ECM" c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Select "Browse for New File" and
follow the on screen instructions. f.
Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 4e, or by using
Year/Model/Engine and appropriate emissions selection for the vehicle being worked on. NOTE: If
you are not connected to the vehicle, you may also search for flash files by selecting the "Flash
Download" button from the Home screen.
g. Select "Download to Scantool" h. Once the download is complete, select "Close" and then
"Back" i.
Highlight the listed calibration, select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
j. When the PCM/ECM update is complete, select "OK"
k. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM/ECM screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
6. Continue to SECTION 2 - ADDITIONAL PCM / TCM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURES to
complete the process if the ECU has been
replaced.
7. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" (p/n 04275086AB) and
attach near the VECI label (See SECTION 3 AUTHORIZED MODIFCATION LABEL for details).
REPAIR PROCEDURE - wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood of the vehicle and install a battery charger. Verify that the charging rate provides
a continuous charge of 13.2 - 13.5 volts. 2. Connect the wiTECH(TM) Vehicle Connection Interface
(VCI) pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering column and turn
the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
3. Launch the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application and connect to the appropriate wiTECH(TM)
device. 4. From the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application Home screen,
a. Select "HELP" b. Select "HELP CONTENTS" c. Follow the correct "HELP TOPIC" for the ECU
being programmed
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3195
SECTION 2 - ADDITIONAL PCM / TCM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURES
NOTE: Find the PCM/TCM Type for the vehicle, read and write down the steps, and then go to the
step by step instructions for additional
information on how to perform these procedures. STEP-BY-STEP INSTRUCTIONS
If an EDC16-U31 PCM/ECM (2.0L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or
routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Program Variant Code
If an EDC16-C2 PCM/ECM (2.2L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or
routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3. IMA
Rapid Calibration Test - Only on 06 PT AND up 4. Injector Quantity Adjustment - Only on 06 PT
AND up
If an EDC16-CP31 (3.0L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning 4. NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization 5. Injector Quantity
Adjustment 6. IMA Rapid Calibration Test 7. Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization 8. Exhaust
Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position
If an EDC16-CP31-2 (2.8L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Injector Quantity Adjustment 4. Program Variant Code 5. ECU Replacement With Value Transfer if the ECU to be replaced is still responsive 6. ECU Replacement Without Value Transfer - if the
ECU to be replaced is NOT responsive 7. Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization 8. IMA Rapid
Calibration Test 9. Set Oil Dilution Mass Value
If a CM849 PCM/ECM (5.9L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped
If a CM2100 PCM/ECM (6.7l) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Enable / Disable Vehicle Features - need to enable features 4. Injector Quantity Adjustment 5.
Reset Regenerative Filter Timers 6. Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load
If an Aisin TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an EATX TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an NGC3 TCM ONLY was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an NGC4 TCM ONLY was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. Quick learn
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3196
If an EGS TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. Initialize EGS
STEP-BY-STEP INSTRUCTIONS
Check PCM/ECM VIN
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Check PCM/ECM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
ECU Replacement with Value Transfer
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "ECU Replacement with Value Transfer" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
ECU Replacement without Value Transfer
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "ECU Replacement without Value Transfer" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Enable / Disable Vehicle Features
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Enable / Disable Vehicle Features" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Exhaust Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Exhaust Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3197
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
IMA Rapid Calibration
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "IMA Rapid Calibration Test" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Initialize EGS
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Initialize EGS" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Injector Quantity Adjustment
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Injector Quantity Adjustment" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
PCM/ECM Replaced
The vehicle pin (Personal Identification Number) will be required to complete the routine. This
information may be obtained in three ways:
1. The original selling invoice 2. DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key Codes 3. Contacting the District
Manager.
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "WIN"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "PCM/ECM Replaced" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Program Variant Code
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3198
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Program Variant Code" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Quick learn
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Quick learn" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Reset Regenerative Filter Timers
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Reset Regenerative Filter Times" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Set Oil Dilution Mass Value
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Set Oil Dilution Mass Value" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
SECTION 3 - AUTHORIZED MODIFCATION LABEL
NOTE: The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM/ECM and/or TCM.
Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach near the VECI
label.
1. Powertrain Control / Transmission Control Module Part Numbers (Insert P/Ns) Used 2. Change
Authority: TSB XX--XX 3. Dealer Code: XXXXX 4. Date: XX-XX-XX
REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3199
TECH TIPS and INFORMATION:
CAUTION: Extreme care must be taken when programming a calibration into a generic PCM. Do
not randomly select a calibration. Once a
calibration is selected and programmed, the controller cannot be reprogrammed to a different
calibration. The module can only be reprogrammed to a more recent version of that calibration.
1. The wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application is the preferred method for flashing any Chrysler
vehicle ECU. For more information, training tutorials
are available under the "HELP" tab in the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application, under the 'Training
Aids' link.
2. To use the StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode requires that your StarMOBILE(R) is
connected to the dealerships network via a wired or
wireless connection. For more information on how to use the StarMOBILE in Pass-Through Mode
see the StarMOBILE(R) training tutorials available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R)
and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Training Aids', under the 'Training Aids' link.
3. If the flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted. 4. Due to the
PCM/ECM / TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other ECUs within the vehicle.
Some DTCs may cause the MIL to
illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All
Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
5. Do not allow the battery charger to time out or the charging rate to climb above 13.5 Volts during
the flash process. 6. The StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) diagnostic tools fully support Internet
connectivity and must be configured for your dealership's network.
For help on setting up your StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) for the dealership's network, refer to the
StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on 'DealerCONNECT >
Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Online Documentation', under the download
center.
7. The operating software in the StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) must be programmed with the
latest software release level. The software level is
visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
screens. For instructions on how to update your scan tool, refer to the StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R) Software Update guide available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R)
and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Online Documentation', under the download center.
PARTS REQUIRED
Module/Programming Order Replacement Guide
MODULE/PROGRAMMING ORDER REPLACEMENT GUIDE
Module Programming
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3200
MODULE PROGRAMMING
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) controls the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS), Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE). When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is in need of replacement, perform
the following steps in order:
NOTE: The PCM and the WIN should never be replaced at the same time. They should be
replaced independently of each other.
1. If applicable, first replace the PCM with the original WIN still connected to the vehicle. 2. Using a
scan tool program the new PCM. (This will ensure the transfer of the Secret Key data from the
original WIN into the new PCM). 3. Replace the WIN, using the scan tool program the new WIN
module. This will transfer the Secret Key data from the PCM into the new WIN. 4. With the scan
tool reprogram the key FOBIK to the new WIN. 5. Ensure all the customer's keys have been
programmed to the new module.
NOTE: If the original keys do not successfully program to the new WIN after the proper procedures
are followed correctly, programming
new keys will be necessary.
PROGRAMMING THE SECRET KEY TO THE WIN
The secret key is an ID code that is unique to each WIN. This code is programmed and stored in
the WIN, the PCM, and each ignition key transponder chip. When the PCM or WIN is replaced, it is
necessary to program the Secret Key Code into the new module using a diagnostic scan tool.
Follow the programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for PCM REPLACED, WIN
REPLACED, or TIPM REPLACED under MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS
CONTROL MODULE menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: Programming the PCM or WIN is done using a diagnostic scan tool and a PIN to enter
secure access mode. If three attempts are made
to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secure access mode will be locked out for
one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN position for one hour and then
enter the correct PIN. Be certain that all accessories are turned OFF. Also, monitor the battery
state and connect a battery charger if necessary.
PCM/WIN PROGRAMMING
When an PCM and the WIN are replaced at the same time, perform the following steps in order:
1. Program the new WIN. 2. Replace all ignition keys and program them to the new WIN.
PROGRAMMING THE WIN
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool.
NOTE: Have a unique vehicle PIN readily available before running the routine
CAUTION: If the PCM and WIN are replaced at the same time, the PCM MUST be programmed
before the WIN.
3. Select "ECU View." 4. Select "WIN". 5. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 6. Select "WIN
Replaced". 7. Enter the PIN when prompted. 8. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine
completion.
NOTE: If the PCM and the WIN are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new WIN.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE WIN
Each FOBIK has a unique ID code that is assigned at the time the key is manufactured. When a
key is programmed into the WIN, the module learns the transponder ID code and the transponder
acquires the unique Secret Key ID code from the WIN.
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool. 3. Have a unique vehicle PIN
readily available before running the routine.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3201
4. Ignition key should be in RUN position. 5. Select "ECU View". 6. Select "WIN Wireless Control".
7. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 8. Select "Program Ignition Keys or Key FOBs", Start 9. Enter
the PIN when prompted.
10. Verify the correct information. 11. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine completion.
NOTE: If the original keys do not successfully program to the new WIN after the proper procedures
are followed correctly, programming
new keys will be necessary.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned by the WIN. Once a key is learned by a WIN, that
key has acquired the Secret Key for that
WIN and cannot be transferred to any other WIN or vehicle.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool. 3. Have a unique vehicle PIN
readily available before running the routine. 4. Ignition key should be in RUN position.
CAUTION: If the PCM and WIN are replaced at the same time, the PCM MUST be programmed
before the WIN.
5. Select "ECU View". 6. Select "WIN Wireless Control". 7. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 8.
Select "PCM Replaced". 9. Enter the PIN when prompted.
10. Verify the correct information. 11. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine completion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3202
Engine Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Powertrain Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL - NGC CONTROLLER
NOTE: USE THE SCAN TOOL TO REPROGRAM THE NEW POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
(PCM) WITH THE VEHICLES
ORIGINAL IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) AND THE VEHICLES ORIGINAL MILEAGE. IF THIS
STEP IS NOT DONE, A DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (DTC) MAY BE SET.
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to PCM, ignition key must be off, and the negative battery
cable must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM connectors.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the 4 electrical
connectors at the PCM.
3. Remove the 3 fasteners (1) holding the PCM to the bracket.
Powertrain Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION - NGC CONTROLLER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3203
NOTE: USE THE SCAN TOOL TO REPROGRAM THE NEW POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
(PCM) WITH THE VEHICLES
ORIGINAL IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) AND THE VEHICLES ORIGINAL MILEAGE. IF THIS
STEP IS NOT DONE, A DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (DTC) MAY BE SET.
1. Install PCM to bracket with 3 fasteners (1).
2. Install and lock the 4 electrical connectors to the PCM. 3. Connect negative battery cable, tighten
nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.). 4. Use the scan tool to reprogram new PCM with vehicles original
Identification Number (VIN) and original vehicle mileage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove electrical connector at pressure
differential sensor (2). 3. Remove upstream exhaust pressure tube (4) from catalytic converter 4.
Remove downstream pressure tube (6) from catalytic converter. 5. Remove pressure differential
sensor mounting bolt. 6. Remove pressure differential sensor (2) and tubing (7) from vehicle. 7.
Remove tubing (7) from pressure differential sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3208
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Install tubing (7) on pressure differential sensor (2). 2. Position pressure differential sensor (2)
and tubing (7). 3. Install pressure differential sensor mounting bolt (3). Tighten to 10 Nm (89 in.
lbs.). 4. Install downstream pressure tube (6) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 5. Install upstream pressure tube (4) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10
Nm (89 in. lbs.) 6. Position electrical connector (1) into bracket. 7. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Level Sensor: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3213
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3214
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3215
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Fuel Level Sensor: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 4 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way > Page 3218
Fuel Level Sensor: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C2 (AWD) (Fuel Tank Jumper) 2 Way
Connector C2 (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module contains the electric fuel pump, fuel pump
reservoir, fuel level sending unit, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter.
The fuel level sending unit is serviceable See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel
Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal.
The fuel pump module, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter is serviced as an
assembly See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel pump modules.
The AWD fuel pump modules contains the main fuel pump module (1), auxiliary fuel pump module
(2), main fuel level sending unit, auxiliary fuel level sending unit, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure
regulator and fuel filter.
The main fuel level sending unit is located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal. The
auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module and is serviced
as an assembly See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 3221
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Operation
OPERATION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module is located inside the fuel tank with a fuel level
sending unit and pressure regulator. The fuel pump module is a positive displacement, gerotor,
driven by a 12 volt DC permanent magnet electric motor.
The fuel pump module draws fuel through a internal filter and pushes it through the motor to an
outlet pipe. The fuel pump module contains two check valves. One valve relieves internal fuel
pump pressure and regulates maximum pump output. The second valve, in the pump outlet,
maintains pump pressure during engine off conditions.
The fuel pump pressure regulator contains a calibrated spring which forces a diaphragm against
the fuel filter return port. When pressure exceeds the calibrated amount, the diaphragm retracts,
allowing excess fuel pressure in the fuel pump module to purge into the fuel tank.
The maximum deadhead pressure is approximately 880 kPa (130 psi). The fuel pump pressure
regulator adjusts fuel system pressure to approximately 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi).
AWD
Operation of the all wheel drive (AWD) main fuel pump module is similar to the FWD with the
addition of a auxiliary fuel pump module with a auxiliary fuel level sending unit and draws fuel from
the base of the auxiliary fuel pump module (2) through an internal tube.
The auxiliary fuel pump module flow rate is greater than the vehicle fuel consumption rate so that
the auxiliary side of the tank is emptied before fuel is depleted from the primary side.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 3222
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles have a serviceable fuel level sending unit located on the fuel
pump reservoir See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel level sending units.
The main fuel level sending unit located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal.
The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module. The
auxiliary fuel pump module and the fuel level sending unit is serviced as an assembly See: Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Removal
REMOVAL
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank Removal.
NOTE: Prior to removing the main fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel tank
opening.
2. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 3. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 4. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
5. Mark the main fuel pump module orientation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3225
WARNING: The fuel pump module reservoir does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir will spill out when the
module is removed.
NOTE: Do not spill fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
6. Raise the main fuel pump module out of the fuel tank using caution not spill fuel inside the
vehicle.
7. Tip the main fuel pump module and drain enough fuel from the main fuel pump module reservoir
to gain access to the internal fuel line without
spilling fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
8. If equipped with AWD, disconnect the internal fuel line from the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3226
9. Remove the main fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
10. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3227
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank Removal.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
2. Mark the auxiliary fuel pump module orientation (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing the auxiliary fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel
tank opening.
3. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 4. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 5. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
6. Raise the auxiliary fuel pump module and disconnect the internal fuel line. 7. Remove the
auxiliary fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3228
8. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3229
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. If equipped with AWD, Connect the internal fuel line to the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3230
3. Lower the main fuel pump module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the main fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be performed for
the fuel level gauge to work properly.
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the main fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Fuel Tank - Installation.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3231
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. Connect the internal fuel line to the auxiliary fuel pump module. 3. Lower the auxiliary fuel pump
module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the auxiliary fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be
performed for the fuel gauge to work properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3232
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the auxiliary fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Fuel Tank - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3233
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel. Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked and approved containers.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Remove the fuel pump module See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge
Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
2. Disconnect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector (1).
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not pull the fuel level sending unit by the wires or the float arm.
3. Using your finger, press the fuel level sending unit snap tab to the left while gently pushing up on
the bottom of the fuel level sending unit and
remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3234
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not handle the new fuel level sending unit by the float arm.
1. Position the new fuel level sending unit to the fuel pump module reservoir.
2. Gently push the fuel level sending unit down until the snap tab (2) engages.
CAUTION: Ensure the fuel level sending unit wires are routed so they do not get pinched between
the coils of the spring when the module is
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3235
completely compressed.
3. Connect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector. 4. Install the fuel pump module See:
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump
Module Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3240
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3241
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3242
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3243
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3244
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3245
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3246
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3247
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3248
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3249
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3250
Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3251
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3252
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3253
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3254
Information Bus: Electrical Diagrams
BUS COMMUNICATIONS - Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3255
Bus Communications 8W-18-01
Bus Communications 8W-18-02
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3256
Bus Communications 8W-18-03
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3257
Bus Communications 8W-18-04
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3258
Bus Communications 8W-18-05
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3259
Bus Communications 8W-18-06
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3260
Bus Communications 8W-18-07
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3261
Bus Communications 8W-18-08
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams by Number See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Communication - Description
Information Bus: Description and Operation Communication - Description
DESCRIPTION
The primary on-board communication network between microprocessor-based electronic control
modules in this vehicle is the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus system. A data bus network
minimizes redundant wiring connections; and, at the same time, reduces wire harness complexity,
sensor current loads and controller hardware by allowing each sensing device to be connected to
only one module (also referred to as a node). Each node reads, then broadcasts its sensor data
over the bus for use by all other nodes requiring that data. Each node ignores the messages on the
bus that it cannot use.
The CAN bus is a two-wire multiplex system. Multiplexing is any system that enables the
transmission of multiple messages over a single channel or circuit. The CAN bus is used for
communication between most vehicle nodes. However, in addition to the CAN bus network, certain
nodes may also be equipped with a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus. The LIN data bus is a
single wire low-speed (9.6 Kbps) serial link bus used to provide direct communication between a
LIN master module and certain switch or sensor inputs.
There are actually three separate CAN bus systems used in the vehicle. They are designated: the
CAN-Interior (also known as CAN Interior High Speed/IHS), the CAN-C and the Diagnostic CAN-C.
The CAN-Interior and CAN-C systems provide on-board communication between all nodes in the
vehicle. The CAN-C is the faster of the two systems providing near real-time communication (500
Kbps). The CAN-C is used typically for communications between more critical nodes, while the
slower (125 Kbps) CAN-Interior system is used for communications between less critical nodes.
The added speed of the CAN data bus is many times faster than previous data bus systems. This
added speed facilitates the addition of more electronic control modules or nodes and the
incorporation of many new electrical and electronic features in the vehicle.
The Diagnostic CAN-C bus is also capable of 500 Kbps communication, and is sometimes
informally referred to as the CAN-D system to differentiate it from the other high speed CAN-C bus.
The Diagnostic CAN-C is used exclusively for the transmission of diagnostic information between
the Totally Integrated Power Module/Central GateWay (TIPM or TIPMCGW) and a diagnostic scan
tool connected to the industry-standard 16-way Data Link Connector (DLC) located beneath the
instrument panel on the driver side of the vehicle.
The TIPM is located in the engine compartment near the battery. The central CAN gateway or hub
module integral to the TIPM is connected to all three CAN buses. This gateway physically and
electrically isolates the CAN buses from each other and coordinates the bi-directional transfer of
messages between them.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Communication - Description > Page 3264
Information Bus: Description and Operation Communication - Operation
OPERATION
The Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus allows all electronic modules or nodes connected to
the bus to share information with each other. Regardless of whether a message originates from a
module on the lower speed CAN-Interior (also known as CAN Interior High Speed/IHS) bus or on
the higher speed CAN-C or CAN-D bus, the message structure and layout is similar, which allows
the Totally Integrated Power Module/Central GateWay (TIPM or TIPMCGW) to process and
transfer messages between the CAN buses. The TIPM also stores a Diagnostic Trouble Code
(DTC) for certain bus network faults.
All modules (also referred to as nodes) transmit and receive messages over one of these buses.
Data exchange between nodes is achieved by serial transmission of encoded data messages.
Each node can both send and receive serial data simultaneously. Each digital bit of a CAN bus
message is carried over the bus as a voltage differential between the two bus circuits which, when
strung together, form a message. Each node uses arbitration to sort the message priority if two
competing messages are attempting to be broadcast at the same time.
The Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment
Node/CCN) is the Local Interface Network (LIN) master module in this vehicle and it gathers
information from the compass module, the instrument panel switch bank, the Steering Control
Module (SCM), and the Heated Seat Module (HSM) through the LIN data bus. There is also LIN
bus communication between the individual Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) transponders and the
Wireless Ignition Node (WIN). Both the EMIC and the WIN either act directly upon the information
received through the LIN data bus, relay the information to other nodes in the vehicle using
electronic messages placed on the CAN bus, or both.
The voltage network used to transmit messages requires biasing and termination. Each module on
the CAN bus network provides its own biasing and termination. There are two types of nodes used
in the CAN bus network. On the CAN-C or the IHS bus, a dominant node has a 120 ohm
termination resistance while a non-dominant (or recessive) node has about a 2500 to 3000 ohm
(2.5 to 3.0 kilohm) termination resistance. The dominant nodes on the CAN-C bus are the WIN and
the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The dominant nodes on the IHS bus are the EMIC and the
TIPM.
The termination resistance of two dominant nodes is combined in parallel to provide a total of about
60 ohms. This resistance value may vary somewhat by application, depending upon the number of
non-dominant nodes on the bus. On the CAN-D bus (or Diagnostic CAN-C) all of the 60 ohm
termination resistance is present in the Central GateWay (TIPMCGW).
NOTE: All measurement of termination resistance is done with the vehicle battery disconnected.
The communication protocol being used for the CAN data bus is a non-proprietary, open standard
adopted from the Bosch CAN Specification 2.0b. The CAN-C is the faster of the two primary buses
in the CAN bus system, providing near real-time communication (500 Kbps).
The CAN bus nodes are connected in parallel to the two-wire bus using a twisted pair, where the
wires are wrapped around each other to provide shielding from unwanted electromagnetic
induction, thus preventing interference with the relatively low voltage signals being carried through
them. The twisted pairs have between 33 and 50 twists per meter (yard). While the CAN bus is
operating (active), one of the bus wires will carry a higher voltage and is referred to as the CAN
High or CAN bus (+) wire, while the other bus wire will carry a lower voltage and is referred to as
the CAN Low or CAN bus (-) wire. Refer to the CAN Bus Voltages table.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Communication - Description > Page 3265
In order to minimize the potential effects of Ignition-OFF Draw (IOD), the CAN-Interior network
employs a sleep strategy. However, a network sleep strategy should not be confused with the
sleep strategy of the individual nodes on that network, as they may differ. For example: The CAN-C
bus network is awake only when the ignition switch is in the ON or START positions; however, the
TIPM, which is on the CAN-C bus, may still be awake with the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY
or UNLOCK positions. The integrated circuitry of an individual node may be capable of processing
certain sensor inputs and outputs without the need to utilize network resources.
The CAN-Interior bus network remains active until all nodes on that network are ready for sleep.
This is determined by the network using tokens in a manner similar to polling. When the last node
that is active on the network is ready for sleep, and it has already received a token indicating that
all other nodes on the bus are ready for sleep, it broadcasts a bus sleep acknowledgment message
that causes the network to sleep. Once the CAN-Interior bus network is asleep, any node on the
bus can awaken it by transmitting a message on the network. The TIPM will keep either the
CAN-Interior or the CAN-C bus awake for a timed interval after it receives a diagnostic message for
that bus over the Diagnostic CAN-C bus.
In the CAN system, available options are configured into the TIPM at the assembly plant, but
additional options can be added in the field using the diagnostic scan tool. The configuration
settings are stored in non-volatile memory. The TIPM also has two 64-bit registers, which track
each of the as-built and currently responding nodes on the CAN-Interior and CAN-C buses. The
TIPM stores a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) in one of two caches for any detected active or
stored faults in the order in which they occur. One cache stores powertrain (P-Code), chassis
(C-Code) and body (B-Code) DTCs, while the second cache is dedicated to storing network
(U-Code) DTCs.
If there are intermittent or active faults in the CAN network, a diagnostic scan tool connected to the
Diagnostic CAN-C bus through the 16-way Data Link Connector (DLC) may only be able to
communicate with the TIPM. To aid in CAN network diagnosis, the TIPM will provide CAN-Interior
and CAN-C network status information to the scan tool using certain diagnostic signals. In addition,
the transceiver in each node on the CAN-C bus will identify a bus off hardware failure, while the
transceiver in each node on the CAN-Interior bus will identify a general bus hardware failure. The
transceivers for some CAN-Interior nodes will also identify certain failures for both CAN-Interior bus
signal wires.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3269
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3270
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-KNOCK (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold, See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the knock sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal > Page 3273
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Always use the specified torque when installing the knock sensor bolt. Over or under
tightening the sensor mounting bolt will
affect knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper spark control.
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 2. Route the knock sensor wire
in the proper location. 3. Install upper intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation.
4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto Shutdown Relay > Page 3278
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto Shutdown Relay > Page 3279
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-AUTO SHUT DOWN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 3282
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams PCM Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-PCM - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3286
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3287
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3288
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE MAP SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. MAP SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3289
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any MAP Sensor circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any sensor supply or system voltage DTCs before proceeding with this
test.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
connectors between the MAP Sensor and the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or
partially broken wires. 4. Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 5. Turn the
ignition on. 6. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the sensor and wiggle test the wiring and
connectors. 7. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. If necessary,
check each sensor circuit for high resistance or a shorted
condition.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. MAP VACUUM/BAROMETRIC PRESSURE
1. With a scan tool, read the Barometric Pressure.
NOTE: The Barometric Pressure should be approximately equal to the actual barometric pressure.
If necessary, compare the Barometric
Pressure value of the tested vehicle to the value of a known good vehicle of a similar make and
model.
2. Connect a vacuum gauge to a manifold vacuum source. 3. Start the engine.
NOTE: If engine will not idle, maintain a constant RPM above idle.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
4. With the scan tool, read the MAP Sensor vacuum.
NOTE: The scan tool reading for MAP vacuum should be within 1" of the vacuum gauge reading.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. MAP SENSOR VOLTAGE
1. With the scan tool, monitor the MAP Sensor signal voltage. 2. With the engine idling in neutral or
park, snap the throttle.
NOTE: The MAP Sensor signal voltage should change from below 2.0 volts at idle to above 3.5
volts at wide open throttle.
Were any problems found?
Yes
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3290
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
4. (F856) 5 VOLT SUPPLY CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (F856) 5 Volt Supply circuit at
the MAP Sensor harness connector and by
probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are
connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 5
No
- Repair the (F856) 5 Volt Supply circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
5. (K1) MAP SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K1) MAP Signal circuit at the
MAP Sensor harness connector and by probing
the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are connected so
that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
No
- Repair the (K1) MAP Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3291
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the MAP Sensor harness connector and by
probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are
connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. MAP SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
MAP Sensor and the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the MAP Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the
MAP sensor.
3. Rotate sensor.
4. Lift to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3294
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
3.5L
1. Install sensor.
2. Rotate sensor into position.
3. Attach electrical connector (1) to sensor (2). 4. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5
Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) > Page 3299
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) > Page 3300
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) > Page 3301
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) > Page 3302
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) > Page 3303
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4 Way
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4 Way > Page 3306
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 1/2 (Gas) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4 Way > Page 3307
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4 Way > Page 3308
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3309
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder.
See: Ignition System/Firing Order
Cylinder #1 on left side.
Cylinder #1 on right side.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
- A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3310
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE OXYGEN SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. OXYGEN SENSOR, WIRING, OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any O2 sensor or rationality DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: When performing this procedure as part of another diagnostic process, it may be necessary
to repeat this test for all of the oxygen
sensors on the vehicle.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
connectors between the Oxygen sensor and the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or
partially broken wires. 4. Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 5. Turn the
ignition on. 6. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the sensor and wiggle test the wiring and
connectors. 7. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. If necessary,
check each sensor circuit for high resistance or a shorted
condition.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. OXYGEN SENSOR VOLTAGE
1. Start the engine and allow it to reach normal operating temperature.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
2. With a scan tool, monitor all O2 Sensor voltage readings.
Is the voltage switching between 2.5 and 3.4 volts for all O2 sensors?
Yes
- Go to 3
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
3. O2 SENSOR HEATER OPERATION
1. Turn the ignition off.
NOTE: Wait a minimum of 10 minutes to allow the O2 Sensor to cool down before continuing the
test. Allow the O2 Sensor voltage to
stabilize at 5.0 volts.
2. Turn the ignition on. 3. With a scan tool, actuate the O2 Sensor heater. 4. With the scan tool,
monitor O2 Sensor voltage for at least 2 minutes.
Does the voltage stay above 4.5 volts?
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3311
Yes
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
4. O2 SENSOR
1. Turn the ignition off.
NOTE: Check for contaminants that may cause improper O2 Sensor operation, such as
contaminated fuel, unapproved silicone, or evidence
of oil or coolant.
2. Disconnect the O2 Sensor harness connector. 3. Turn the ignition on. 4. With a scan tool,
monitor the O2 Sensor voltage.
NOTE: The voltage should be approximately 5.0 volts with the connector disconnected.
5. Connect a jumper wire between the signal circuit and the return circuit in the O2 Sensor harness
connector.
NOTE: The voltage should drop from 5.0 volts to 2.5 volts with the jumper wire in place.
Is the O2 Sensor voltage displayed on the scan tool as described?
Yes
- Replace the O2 Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 5
5. O2 SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the O2 Sensor Signal circuit and
connectors between the O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Check the O2 Sensor signal circuit for a short
to ground, open circuit, short to voltage, or high resistance.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 6
6. O2 SENSOR RETURN CIRCUIT
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the O2 Sensor Return circuit and
connectors between the O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Check the O2 Sensor return circuit for a short
to ground, open circuit, short to voltage or high resistance.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3312
No
- Go to 7
7. POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3.
Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 4. Monitor the scan tool data relative to
the components tested in this procedure and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 5. Look for the
data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. 6. Search for any Technical Service
Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace and program the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
2.7, 3.5L
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/1)
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wires going into
oxygen sensor (O2S). Damage to the
oxygen sensor may occur.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect O2S wire harness mounting clips from engine or body,
if equipped. 3. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (1). 4. Remove O2S (2)
from catalytic converter (4). 5. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (5). 6.
Remove O2S (3) from catalytic converter (4).
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/1)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3315
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wires going into
oxygen sensor (O2S). Damage to the
oxygen sensor may occur.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect O2S wire harness mounting clips from engine or body,
if equipped. 3. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (1). 4. Remove the O2S
(5) from catalytic converter (4). 5. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (2).
6. Remove O2S (3) from catalytic converter (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3316
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
2.7, 3.5L
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/1)
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When Equipped: The oxygen sensor (O2S) pigtail harness must be clipped and/or
bolted back to their original positions on engine
or body to prevent mechanical damage to wiring.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
Threads of new oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal. DO
NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new O2S.
1. Install O2S (3) to catalytic converter (4). 2. Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring
harness (2). 3. Install the O2S (2) to catalytic converter (4). Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 4.
Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring harness (1). 5. Connect O2S wire harness mounting
clips to engine or body, if equipped.
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/1)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3317
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When Equipped: The oxygen sensor (O2S) pigtail harness must be clipped and/or
bolted back to their original positions on engine
or body to prevent mechanical damage to wiring.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
Threads of new oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal. DO
NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new O2S.
1. Install O2S (3) to catalytic converter (4). 2. Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring
harness (5). 3. Install O2S (2) to catalytic converter (4). Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect
O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring harness (1). 5. Connect O2S wire harness mounting clips to
engine or body, if equipped.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3327
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3328
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3329
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3330
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3331
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3332
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3333
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3334
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3335
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3336
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 3337
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
Engine Control Module: Recalls Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control
Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function > Page 3347
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In
Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 3352
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition > Page 3357
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 3362
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 3367
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function > Page 3373
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory > Page 3378
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition > Page 3383
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set > Page 3388
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3393
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3394
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3395
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3396
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3397
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3398
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3399
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3400
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3401
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3402
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 3403
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000: PCM
Replacement
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine > Page 3412
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise
Control Function > Page 3418
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is
Stored In Memory > Page 3423
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev
Condition
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev
Condition > Page 3428
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set > Page 3433
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine > Page 3438
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3444
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3445
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3446
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3447
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3448
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3449
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3450
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3451
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3452
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3453
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page
3454
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > NHTSA08V528000 > Oct > 08 > Recall 08V528000: PCM
Replacement
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V528000: PCM Replacement
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Chrysler/Sebring 2009 Dodge/Avenger 2009
Dodge/Caliber 2009 Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Compass 2009 Jeep/Patriot 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: October 07, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V528000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Power Train: Automatic Transmission: Control
module (TCM, PCM)
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 712
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 712 M/Y 2009 Sebring, Dodge Caliber, Avenger, Journey, Jeep
Patriot, and Compass vehicles. A new adhesive used in the Power Train Control Module (PCM)
manufacturing process can cause the printed circuit board to break.
CONSEQUENCE: This can cause the engine to stall and cause a crash without warning.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the PCM free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during
October 2008. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H33. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Powertrain Control
Module (GPEC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Powertrain Control
Module (GPEC) > Page 3461
Engine Control Module: Locations Powertrain Control Module (NGC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Powertrain Control
Module (GPEC) > Page 3462
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38
Way
Connector C1 (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3465
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3466
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C2 (NGC) (Engine) 38 Way
Connector C2 (NGC) - (ENGINE) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (ENGINE) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3467
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3468
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C3 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38
Way
Connector C3 (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3469
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3470
Engine Control Module: Diagrams Powertrain Control Module C4 (NGC) (Transmission) 38 Way
Connector C4 (NGC) - (TRANSMISSION) 38 WAY
MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL (NGC) - (TRANSMISSION) 38 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Powertrain Control
Module C1 (NGC) (Headlamp And Dash) 38 Way > Page 3471
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module - Description
PCM
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is a digital computer containing a microprocessor. The PCM
receives input signals from various switches and sensors referred to as Powertrain Control Module
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine and vehicle operations through
devices referred to as Powertrain Control Module Outputs.
NOTE: PCM Inputs:
- Air Conditioning Pressure Transducer
- ASD/Main Relay
- Battery Voltage
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Distance Sensor (from transmission control module)
- EGR Position Feedback (if equipped)
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Heated Oxygen Sensors
- Ignition sense
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Park/Neutral (from trans range sensor)
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- Proportional Purge Sense
- CAN C Bus
- Speed Control
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+)
- Transmission Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Transmission Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Vehicle Speed
NOTE: PCM Outputs:
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Data Link Connector (CAN C Bus)
- Double Start Override
- EGR Solenoid (if equipped)
- Fuel Injectors
- Generator Field
- High Speed Fan Relay
- Ignition Coils
- Natural Vacuum Leak Detection
- Low Speed Fan Relay
- MTV Actuator
- Proportional Purge Solenoid
- SRV Valve
- Speed Control Relay
- Speed Control Vent Relay
- Speed Control Vacuum Relay
- Torque Reduction Request
- Transmission Control Relay
- Transmission Solenoids
- 5 Volt Output
Based on inputs it receives, the powertrain control module (PCM) adjusts fuel injector pulse width,
idle speed, ignition timing, and canister purge operation and EGR if equipped. The PCM regulates
the cooling fans, air conditioning and speed control systems. The PCM changes generator charge
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 3474
rate by adjusting the generator field.
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on the following inputs.
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Battery Voltage
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Gas Oxygen Content (heated oxygen sensors)
- Throttle Position
The PCM adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on the following inputs.
- Brake Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Park/Neutral
- Transaxle Gear Engagement
- Throttle Position
- Vehicle Speed (from Transmission Control Module)
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on the following inputs.
- Inlet Air Temperature
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Park/Neutral (from trans range sensor)
- Transaxle Gear Engagement
- Throttle Position
The camshaft and crankshaft signals are sent to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). If the PCM
does not receive both signals within approximately one second of engine cranking, it deactivates
the fuel pump. When deactivated, power is shut off to the fuel injectors, ignition coils, fuel pump
and the heating element in each oxygen sensor.
The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes battery voltage to a regulated 5.0 volts. The
5.0 volts power the camshaft position sensor, and crankshaft position sensor. The PCM also
provides a regulated 5.0 volts supply for the, manifold absolute pressure sensor, throttle position
sensor and EGR (if equipped).
The PCM engine control strategy prevents reduced idle speeds until after the engine operates for
320 km (200 miles). If the PCM is replaced after 320 km (200 miles) of usage, update the mileage
in new PCM. Use the scan tool to change the mileage in the PCM. Refer to the appropriate
Powertrain Diagnostic Manual and the scan tool. If equipped with SKREEM, must use SKREEM
function to program VIN number in new PCM.
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CVI CALCULATION
An important function of the PCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index (CVI). CVIs represent the
volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The PCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the PCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the PCM with output shaft speed information.
By comparing the two inputs, the PCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the PCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 3475
Gear ratios can be determined by using the scan tool and reading the Input/Output Speed Sensor
values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed Sensor
value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the PCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the PCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly, etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
SHIFT SCHEDULES
The PCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of shift schedules. Shift schedule
selection is dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
As driving conditions change, the PCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 3476
Sensor Return - PCM Input
SENSOR RETURN - PCM INPUT
The sensor return circuit provides a low electrical noise ground reference for all of the systems
sensors. The sensor return circuit connects to internal ground circuits within the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM).
PCM Replacement
PCM REPLACEMENT
DESCRIPTION
Use the scan tool to reprogram the new pcm with the vehicle's original identification number (vin)
and the vehicle's original mileage. If this step is not done a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) may be
set.
PCM Ground
PCM GROUND
Ground is provided through multiple pins of the PCM connector. Depending on the vehicle there
may be as many as two different ground pins. There are power grounds and sensor grounds.
The power grounds are used to control the ground side of relays, solenoids, ignition coil or
injectors. The signal ground is used for any input that uses sensor return for ground, and the
ground side of any internal processing component.
The PCM case is shielded to prevent RFI and EMI. The PCM case is grounded and must be firmly
attached to a good, clean body ground.
Internally all grounds are connected together, however there is noise suppression on the sensor
ground. For EMI and RFI protection the housing and cover are also grounded via the mounting
screws AND bracket to the chassis, separately from the ground pins.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Powertrain Control Module - Description > Page 3477
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The PCM supplies two regulated 5 volts supplies - a 5V primary and a 5V secondary (auxiliary) to
the following sensors:
- Camshaft Position Sensor (5V secondary)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (5V primary)
- EGR Position feedback sensor (5V secondary) (if equipped)
- Engine coolant temperature sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Knock sensor (connected to 5V internal via a pullup resistor)
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor (5V secondary)
- Oil Pressure Switch (connected to 5V internal via pullup resistor)
- Pedal Value Sensor #1 (5V Primary)
- Pedal Value Sensor #2 (5V Secondary)
- SRV Position Feedback Sensor (5V Secondary)
- Throttle Position Sensors (5V Primary)
- Variable Line Pressure Sensor (5V Secondary)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3478
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE PCM POWER AND GROUND CIRCUITS
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. PCM WIRING OR CONNECTORS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3479
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
each connector at the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 4.
Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. CHECKING THE PCM GROUND CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to 12 volts, check the PCM ground circuits. 3. Wiggle test
each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated and bright?
Yes
- Go to 3.
No
- Repair the PCM ground circuit(s) for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
3. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED B+ CIRCUITS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3480
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
1. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM power supply circuits. 2. Wiggle
test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated and bright?
Yes
- Go to 4.
No
- Repair the PCM power supply circuit(s) for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
4. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition on.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM (F202) and (F1) Fused Ignition
circuits. 3. Wiggle test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open or short in the
circuit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3481
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright with the ignition on and not illuminated with
the ignition off. Compare the brightness
to that of a direct connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated as described above?
Yes
- Go to 5.
No
- Repair the open or short in the Fused Ignition Switch circuits.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
5. CHECKING THE PCM FUSED IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUITS
1. Turn the ignition on.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
2. Using a 12 volt test light connected to ground, check the PCM Fused Ignition Switch circuits. 3.
Check each circuit with the ignition off, ignition on, engine not running position, and during
cranking. 4. Wiggle test each circuit during the test to check for an intermittent open in the circuit.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright with the ignition on and not illuminated with
the ignition off. Compare the brightness
to that of a direct connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated as described above?
Yes
- Test complete.
No
- Repair the PCM Fused Ignition Switch circuit(s) for as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Engine Control Module: Procedures
Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
PCM/TCM Programming
PCM / TCM PROGRAMMING
PCM / TCM FLASH PROGRAMING
This procedure will need to be done when one or more of the following situations are true:
1. A vehicle's Powertrain Control Module (PCM) has been replaced. 2. A diagnostic trouble code
(DTC) is set P1602 - PCM Not Programmed. 3. An updated calibration or software release is
available for either the PCM or TCM ECUs.
This procedure assumes that the wiTECH(TM) Vehicle Connection Interface (VCI) pod,
StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) devices are configured to your dealership's network with either
a wired or wireless connection. The wiTECH(TM) VCI pod, StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) must
also be running at the latest operating system and software release level. For more help on how to
network your StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) reference the StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) Quick
Start Networking Guide available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and
StarMOBILE(R) Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3484
> Online Documentation', under the Download Center. For the wiTECH(TM) VCI pod use the
"HELP" tab in the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application.
Table of contents
1. SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH PROCEDURE SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH
PROCEDURE 2. REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT: 3. TECH
TIPS and INFORMATION TECH TIPS and INFORMATION: 4. PARTS REQUIRED PARTS
REQUIRED
SECTION 1 - PCM / TCM FLASH PROCEDURE
If using StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client. Go To REPAIR PROCEDURE - Using
StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
If using wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application. Go To REPAIR PROCEDURE - wiTECH(TM)
Diagnostic Application
REPAIR PROCEDURE - Using StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood of the vehicle and install a battery charger. Verify that the charging rate provides
a continuous charge of 13.2 - 13.5 volts. 2. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) to the
vehicle data link connector located under the steering column and turn the ignition key to the
"RUN" position.
3. Power on the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R). If the StarMOBILE(R) is being used, launch the
StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client and connect to
the appropriate StarMOBILE(R) device.
4. Retrieve the old ECU part number. From the tool's Home screen,
a. Select "ECU View" b. Select "PCM/ECM" c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e.
Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM/ECM screen for later reference.
5. Program the ECU as follows:
a. Using the StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) at the Home screen, select "ECU View" b. Select
"PCM/ECM" c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Select "Browse for New File" and
follow the on screen instructions. f.
Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 4e, or by using
Year/Model/Engine and appropriate emissions selection for the vehicle being worked on. NOTE: If
you are not connected to the vehicle, you may also search for flash files by selecting the "Flash
Download" button from the Home screen.
g. Select "Download to Scantool" h. Once the download is complete, select "Close" and then
"Back" i.
Highlight the listed calibration, select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
j. When the PCM/ECM update is complete, select "OK"
k. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM/ECM screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
6. Continue to SECTION 2 - ADDITIONAL PCM / TCM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURES to
complete the process if the ECU has been
replaced.
7. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" (p/n 04275086AB) and
attach near the VECI label (See SECTION 3 AUTHORIZED MODIFCATION LABEL for details).
REPAIR PROCEDURE - wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood of the vehicle and install a battery charger. Verify that the charging rate provides
a continuous charge of 13.2 - 13.5 volts. 2. Connect the wiTECH(TM) Vehicle Connection Interface
(VCI) pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering column and turn
the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
3. Launch the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application and connect to the appropriate wiTECH(TM)
device. 4. From the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application Home screen,
a. Select "HELP" b. Select "HELP CONTENTS" c. Follow the correct "HELP TOPIC" for the ECU
being programmed
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3485
SECTION 2 - ADDITIONAL PCM / TCM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURES
NOTE: Find the PCM/TCM Type for the vehicle, read and write down the steps, and then go to the
step by step instructions for additional
information on how to perform these procedures. STEP-BY-STEP INSTRUCTIONS
If an EDC16-U31 PCM/ECM (2.0L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or
routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Program Variant Code
If an EDC16-C2 PCM/ECM (2.2L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or
routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3. IMA
Rapid Calibration Test - Only on 06 PT AND up 4. Injector Quantity Adjustment - Only on 06 PT
AND up
If an EDC16-CP31 (3.0L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning 4. NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization 5. Injector Quantity
Adjustment 6. IMA Rapid Calibration Test 7. Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization 8. Exhaust
Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position
If an EDC16-CP31-2 (2.8L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Injector Quantity Adjustment 4. Program Variant Code 5. ECU Replacement With Value Transfer if the ECU to be replaced is still responsive 6. ECU Replacement Without Value Transfer - if the
ECU to be replaced is NOT responsive 7. Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization 8. IMA Rapid
Calibration Test 9. Set Oil Dilution Mass Value
If a CM849 PCM/ECM (5.9L) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped
If a CM2100 PCM/ECM (6.7l) was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. PCM/ECM Replaced - if WIN equipped 2. Check PCM/ECM VIN - if NOT WIN equipped 3.
Enable / Disable Vehicle Features - need to enable features 4. Injector Quantity Adjustment 5.
Reset Regenerative Filter Timers 6. Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load
If an Aisin TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an EATX TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an NGC3 TCM ONLY was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
If an NGC4 TCM ONLY was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. Quick learn
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3486
If an EGS TCM was replaced, perform the following additional steps and/or routines:
1. Initialize EGS
STEP-BY-STEP INSTRUCTIONS
Check PCM/ECM VIN
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Check PCM/ECM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Diesel Particulate Filter (Used) Learning" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
ECU Replacement with Value Transfer
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "ECU Replacement with Value Transfer" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
ECU Replacement without Value Transfer
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "ECU Replacement without Value Transfer" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Enable / Disable Vehicle Features
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Enable / Disable Vehicle Features" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Exhaust Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Exhaust Throttle Plate Adaptive Learn Position" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3487
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Fuel Mean Value Adaptation Initialization" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
IMA Rapid Calibration
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "IMA Rapid Calibration Test" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Initialize EGS
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Initialize EGS" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Injector Quantity Adjustment
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Injector Quantity Adjustment" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Mobile DeSoot - NO Minimum Required Soot Load" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "NOx Catalyst (New) Initialization" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
PCM/ECM Replaced
The vehicle pin (Personal Identification Number) will be required to complete the routine. This
information may be obtained in three ways:
1. The original selling invoice 2. DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key Codes 3. Contacting the District
Manager.
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "WIN"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "PCM/ECM Replaced" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Program Variant Code
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3488
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Program Variant Code" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Quick learn
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Quick learn" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Reset Regenerative Filter Timers
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Reset Regenerative Filter Times" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
Set Oil Dilution Mass Value
From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View"
- Select "PCM/ECM"
- Select "Misc. Functions"
- Select "Set Oil Dilution Mass Value" and follow the on screen instructions.
- When complete, select "Finish"
SECTION 3 - AUTHORIZED MODIFCATION LABEL
NOTE: The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM/ECM and/or TCM.
Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach near the VECI
label.
1. Powertrain Control / Transmission Control Module Part Numbers (Insert P/Ns) Used 2. Change
Authority: TSB XX--XX 3. Dealer Code: XXXXX 4. Date: XX-XX-XX
REQUIRED TOOLS/EQUIPMENT:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3489
TECH TIPS and INFORMATION:
CAUTION: Extreme care must be taken when programming a calibration into a generic PCM. Do
not randomly select a calibration. Once a
calibration is selected and programmed, the controller cannot be reprogrammed to a different
calibration. The module can only be reprogrammed to a more recent version of that calibration.
1. The wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application is the preferred method for flashing any Chrysler
vehicle ECU. For more information, training tutorials
are available under the "HELP" tab in the wiTECH(TM) Diagnostic Application, under the 'Training
Aids' link.
2. To use the StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode requires that your StarMOBILE(R) is
connected to the dealerships network via a wired or
wireless connection. For more information on how to use the StarMOBILE in Pass-Through Mode
see the StarMOBILE(R) training tutorials available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R)
and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Training Aids', under the 'Training Aids' link.
3. If the flash process is interrupted or aborted, the flash should be restarted. 4. Due to the
PCM/ECM / TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other ECUs within the vehicle.
Some DTCs may cause the MIL to
illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All
Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
5. Do not allow the battery charger to time out or the charging rate to climb above 13.5 Volts during
the flash process. 6. The StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) diagnostic tools fully support Internet
connectivity and must be configured for your dealership's network.
For help on setting up your StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) for the dealership's network, refer to the
StarSCAN(R) / StarMOBILE(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on 'DealerCONNECT >
Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Online Documentation', under the download
center.
7. The operating software in the StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) must be programmed with the
latest software release level. The software level is
visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client
screens. For instructions on how to update your scan tool, refer to the StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R) Software Update guide available on 'DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R)
and StarMOBILE(R) Tools > Online Documentation', under the download center.
PARTS REQUIRED
Module/Programming Order Replacement Guide
MODULE/PROGRAMMING ORDER REPLACEMENT GUIDE
Module Programming
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3490
MODULE PROGRAMMING
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) controls the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS), Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE). When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is in need of replacement, perform
the following steps in order:
NOTE: The PCM and the WIN should never be replaced at the same time. They should be
replaced independently of each other.
1. If applicable, first replace the PCM with the original WIN still connected to the vehicle. 2. Using a
scan tool program the new PCM. (This will ensure the transfer of the Secret Key data from the
original WIN into the new PCM). 3. Replace the WIN, using the scan tool program the new WIN
module. This will transfer the Secret Key data from the PCM into the new WIN. 4. With the scan
tool reprogram the key FOBIK to the new WIN. 5. Ensure all the customer's keys have been
programmed to the new module.
NOTE: If the original keys do not successfully program to the new WIN after the proper procedures
are followed correctly, programming
new keys will be necessary.
PROGRAMMING THE SECRET KEY TO THE WIN
The secret key is an ID code that is unique to each WIN. This code is programmed and stored in
the WIN, the PCM, and each ignition key transponder chip. When the PCM or WIN is replaced, it is
necessary to program the Secret Key Code into the new module using a diagnostic scan tool.
Follow the programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for PCM REPLACED, WIN
REPLACED, or TIPM REPLACED under MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS
CONTROL MODULE menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: Programming the PCM or WIN is done using a diagnostic scan tool and a PIN to enter
secure access mode. If three attempts are made
to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secure access mode will be locked out for
one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN position for one hour and then
enter the correct PIN. Be certain that all accessories are turned OFF. Also, monitor the battery
state and connect a battery charger if necessary.
PCM/WIN PROGRAMMING
When an PCM and the WIN are replaced at the same time, perform the following steps in order:
1. Program the new WIN. 2. Replace all ignition keys and program them to the new WIN.
PROGRAMMING THE WIN
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool.
NOTE: Have a unique vehicle PIN readily available before running the routine
CAUTION: If the PCM and WIN are replaced at the same time, the PCM MUST be programmed
before the WIN.
3. Select "ECU View." 4. Select "WIN". 5. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 6. Select "WIN
Replaced". 7. Enter the PIN when prompted. 8. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine
completion.
NOTE: If the PCM and the WIN are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new WIN.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE WIN
Each FOBIK has a unique ID code that is assigned at the time the key is manufactured. When a
key is programmed into the WIN, the module learns the transponder ID code and the transponder
acquires the unique Secret Key ID code from the WIN.
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool. 3. Have a unique vehicle PIN
readily available before running the routine.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3491
4. Ignition key should be in RUN position. 5. Select "ECU View". 6. Select "WIN Wireless Control".
7. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 8. Select "Program Ignition Keys or Key FOBs", Start 9. Enter
the PIN when prompted.
10. Verify the correct information. 11. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine completion.
NOTE: If the original keys do not successfully program to the new WIN after the proper procedures
are followed correctly, programming
new keys will be necessary.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned by the WIN. Once a key is learned by a WIN, that
key has acquired the Secret Key for that
WIN and cannot be transferred to any other WIN or vehicle.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle. 2. Connect the scan tool. 3. Have a unique vehicle PIN
readily available before running the routine. 4. Ignition key should be in RUN position.
CAUTION: If the PCM and WIN are replaced at the same time, the PCM MUST be programmed
before the WIN.
5. Select "ECU View". 6. Select "WIN Wireless Control". 7. Select "Miscellaneous Functions." 8.
Select "PCM Replaced". 9. Enter the PIN when prompted.
10. Verify the correct information. 11. Cycle ignition key after the successful routine completion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3492
Engine Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Powertrain Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL - NGC CONTROLLER
NOTE: USE THE SCAN TOOL TO REPROGRAM THE NEW POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
(PCM) WITH THE VEHICLES
ORIGINAL IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) AND THE VEHICLES ORIGINAL MILEAGE. IF THIS
STEP IS NOT DONE, A DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (DTC) MAY BE SET.
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to PCM, ignition key must be off, and the negative battery
cable must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM connectors.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the 4 electrical
connectors at the PCM.
3. Remove the 3 fasteners (1) holding the PCM to the bracket.
Powertrain Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION - NGC CONTROLLER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3493
NOTE: USE THE SCAN TOOL TO REPROGRAM THE NEW POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
(PCM) WITH THE VEHICLES
ORIGINAL IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) AND THE VEHICLES ORIGINAL MILEAGE. IF THIS
STEP IS NOT DONE, A DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (DTC) MAY BE SET.
1. Install PCM to bracket with 3 fasteners (1).
2. Install and lock the 4 electrical connectors to the PCM. 3. Connect negative battery cable, tighten
nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.). 4. Use the scan tool to reprogram new PCM with vehicles original
Identification Number (VIN) and original vehicle mileage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto
Shutdown Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto
Shutdown Relay > Page 3498
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto
Shutdown Relay > Page 3499
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto
Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-AUTO SHUT DOWN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto
Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 3502
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams PCM Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-PCM - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3507
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 6 WAY
SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect air flow sensor electrical connector (4). 2. Remove constant tension clamps (1), (2)
securing the air flow sensor (3). 3. Remove air flow sensor (3) from hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 3512
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Note the arrow direction on the sensor and correctly position the air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 2.
Install constant tension clamps (1), (2) to secure air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 3. Connect air flow
sensor electrical connector (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position
Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position
Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L) > Page 3517
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3518
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CAMSHAFT 1/1 POSITION (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3519
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT AND CRANKSHAFT SIGNALS
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft
Position Sensor - Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at battery. 2. Disconnect electrical connector
(3) from camshaft position (CMP) sensor (2). 3. Remove bolt (1) and CMP sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft
Position Sensor - Removal > Page 3522
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Install camshaft position (CMP) sensor utilizing twisting motion. Make sure CMP sensor
is fully seated. Do not drive CMP sensor
into the bore with mounting screw. This may cause CMP sensor to be incorrectly seated causing a
faulty signal or no signal at all.
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the CMP sensor (2) into the timing belt cover with a twisting motion until fully seated. 2.
While holding the sensor (2) in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt (1) to 12 Nm (106
in. lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector (3) to the CMP sensor (2). 4. Connect the
negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L EARLY BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 1 (3.5L Early Build) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 3528
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagrams Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor 1 (3.5L Normal Build) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE 1 (3.5L NORMAL BUILD) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3529
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any ECT circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor(s) and the
PCM.
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Turn the ignition on. 5. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the
sensor(s) and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 6. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to
set during the wiggle test.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AND CONDITION
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Check the engine coolant level and the condition of the engine coolant. Refer to the appropriate
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. THERMOSTAT
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Using the appropriate service information, determine the proper opening temperature of the
thermostat. 2. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine
was allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
3. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool. 4. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3530
NOTE: The thermostat should not open until the engine reaches the temperature specified in the
Service Information.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NOTE: Allow the engine to cool to ambient temperature before proceeding.
WARNING: Make sure the engine cooling system is cool before removing the pressure cap or any
hose. The cooling system is pressurized when
hot. Failure to follow these instructions can result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. With the scan tool, read the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor value. If the engine was
allowed to cool completely, the value should be
approximately equal to the ambient temperature.
2. Monitor the sensor value on the scan tool and the actual coolant temperature with a
thermometer. 3. Start the engine.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The sensor value transition should be smooth as the engine reaches operating
temperature. The thermometer reading and the coolant
temperature value on the scan tool should remain relatively close.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 5.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
5. (K2) ECT SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K2) ECT Signal circuit at the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor harness
connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the
voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3531
No
- Repair the (K2) ECT Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
harness connector and by probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure
the voltmeter leads are connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor and the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3535
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3536
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor is located on the driver side of the vehicle, above the
differential housing. The bottom of the sensor sits
above the drive plate.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the electrical
connector from the crankshaft position sensor. 3. Remove the sensor mounting screw and the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page 3539
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor into the transmission case with a twisting motion until
fully seated.
CAUTION: Before tightening the sensor mounting bolt, be sure the sensor is completely flush to the
mounting surface. If the sensor is not
flush, damage to the sensor mounting tang may result.
2. While holding the sensor in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the CKP sensor. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Operation > Page 3544
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove electrical connector at pressure
differential sensor (2). 3. Remove upstream exhaust pressure tube (4) from catalytic converter 4.
Remove downstream pressure tube (6) from catalytic converter. 5. Remove pressure differential
sensor mounting bolt. 6. Remove pressure differential sensor (2) and tubing (7) from vehicle. 7.
Remove tubing (7) from pressure differential sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 3549
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Install tubing (7) on pressure differential sensor (2). 2. Position pressure differential sensor (2)
and tubing (7). 3. Install pressure differential sensor mounting bolt (3). Tighten to 10 Nm (89 in.
lbs.). 4. Install downstream pressure tube (6) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 5. Install upstream pressure tube (4) into catalytic converter. Tighten the fitting to 10
Nm (89 in. lbs.) 6. Position electrical connector (1) into bracket. 7. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Level Sensor: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page
3554
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page
3555
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page
3556
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1
(Body) 4 Way
Fuel Level Sensor: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 4 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1
(Body) 4 Way > Page 3559
Fuel Level Sensor: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C2 (AWD) (Fuel Tank Jumper) 2 Way
Connector C2 (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump
Module - Description
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module contains the electric fuel pump, fuel pump
reservoir, fuel level sending unit, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter.
The fuel level sending unit is serviceable See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel
Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal.
The fuel pump module, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter is serviced as an
assembly See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel pump modules.
The AWD fuel pump modules contains the main fuel pump module (1), auxiliary fuel pump module
(2), main fuel level sending unit, auxiliary fuel level sending unit, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure
regulator and fuel filter.
The main fuel level sending unit is located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal. The
auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module and is serviced
as an assembly See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump
Module - Description > Page 3562
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Operation
OPERATION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module is located inside the fuel tank with a fuel level
sending unit and pressure regulator. The fuel pump module is a positive displacement, gerotor,
driven by a 12 volt DC permanent magnet electric motor.
The fuel pump module draws fuel through a internal filter and pushes it through the motor to an
outlet pipe. The fuel pump module contains two check valves. One valve relieves internal fuel
pump pressure and regulates maximum pump output. The second valve, in the pump outlet,
maintains pump pressure during engine off conditions.
The fuel pump pressure regulator contains a calibrated spring which forces a diaphragm against
the fuel filter return port. When pressure exceeds the calibrated amount, the diaphragm retracts,
allowing excess fuel pressure in the fuel pump module to purge into the fuel tank.
The maximum deadhead pressure is approximately 880 kPa (130 psi). The fuel pump pressure
regulator adjusts fuel system pressure to approximately 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi).
AWD
Operation of the all wheel drive (AWD) main fuel pump module is similar to the FWD with the
addition of a auxiliary fuel pump module with a auxiliary fuel level sending unit and draws fuel from
the base of the auxiliary fuel pump module (2) through an internal tube.
The auxiliary fuel pump module flow rate is greater than the vehicle fuel consumption rate so that
the auxiliary side of the tank is emptied before fuel is depleted from the primary side.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump
Module - Description > Page 3563
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles have a serviceable fuel level sending unit located on the fuel
pump reservoir See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and
Repair/Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel level sending units.
The main fuel level sending unit located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Removal.
The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module. The
auxiliary fuel pump module and the fuel level sending unit is serviced as an assembly See: Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Removal
REMOVAL
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank Removal.
NOTE: Prior to removing the main fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel tank
opening.
2. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 3. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 4. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
5. Mark the main fuel pump module orientation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3566
WARNING: The fuel pump module reservoir does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir will spill out when the
module is removed.
NOTE: Do not spill fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
6. Raise the main fuel pump module out of the fuel tank using caution not spill fuel inside the
vehicle.
7. Tip the main fuel pump module and drain enough fuel from the main fuel pump module reservoir
to gain access to the internal fuel line without
spilling fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
8. If equipped with AWD, disconnect the internal fuel line from the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3567
9. Remove the main fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
10. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3568
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank -
Removal.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
2. Mark the auxiliary fuel pump module orientation (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing the auxiliary fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel
tank opening.
3. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 4. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 5. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
6. Raise the auxiliary fuel pump module and disconnect the internal fuel line. 7. Remove the
auxiliary fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3569
8. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3570
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. If equipped with AWD, Connect the internal fuel line to the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3571
3. Lower the main fuel pump module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the main fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be performed for
the fuel level gauge to work properly.
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the main fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Fuel Tank - Installation.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3572
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. Connect the internal fuel line to the auxiliary fuel pump module. 3. Lower the auxiliary fuel pump
module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the auxiliary fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be
performed for the fuel gauge to work properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3573
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the auxiliary fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Fuel Tank - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3574
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel. Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked and approved containers.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Remove the fuel pump module See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge
Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
2. Disconnect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector (1).
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not pull the fuel level sending unit by the wires or the float arm.
3. Using your finger, press the fuel level sending unit snap tab to the left while gently pushing up on
the bottom of the fuel level sending unit and
remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3575
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not handle the new fuel level sending unit by the float arm.
1. Position the new fuel level sending unit to the fuel pump module reservoir.
2. Gently push the fuel level sending unit down until the snap tab (2) engages.
CAUTION: Ensure the fuel level sending unit wires are routed so they do not get pinched between
the coils of the spring when the module is
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
- Removal > Page 3576
completely compressed.
3. Connect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector. 4. Install the fuel pump module See:
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Tank/Fuel Gauge Sender/Service and Repair/Fuel Pump
Module Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3580
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3581
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable.
NOTE: Clean dirt from sensor area prior to removal from air box.
2. Disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Remove the inlet air
temperature sensor (2) from the air box (3) by turning the sensor 1/4 turn in the counter - clockwise
direction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 3584
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the inlet air temperature sensor (2) to the air box (3) by turning the sensor 1/4 turn in the
clockwise direction. 2. Connect the inlet air temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 3. Connect
negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3588
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3589
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-KNOCK (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor Removal
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold, See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the knock sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor Removal > Page 3592
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Always use the specified torque when installing the knock sensor bolt. Over or under
tightening the sensor mounting bolt will
affect knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper spark control.
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 2. Route the knock sensor wire
in the proper location. 3. Install upper intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation.
4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3596
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3597
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3598
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE MAP SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. MAP SENSOR WIRING OR CONNECTORS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3599
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any MAP Sensor circuit DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any sensor supply or system voltage DTCs before proceeding with this
test.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
connectors between the MAP Sensor and the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or
partially broken wires. 4. Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 5. Turn the
ignition on. 6. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the sensor and wiggle test the wiring and
connectors. 7. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. If necessary,
check each sensor circuit for high resistance or a shorted
condition.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. MAP VACUUM/BAROMETRIC PRESSURE
1. With a scan tool, read the Barometric Pressure.
NOTE: The Barometric Pressure should be approximately equal to the actual barometric pressure.
If necessary, compare the Barometric
Pressure value of the tested vehicle to the value of a known good vehicle of a similar make and
model.
2. Connect a vacuum gauge to a manifold vacuum source. 3. Start the engine.
NOTE: If engine will not idle, maintain a constant RPM above idle.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
4. With the scan tool, read the MAP Sensor vacuum.
NOTE: The scan tool reading for MAP vacuum should be within 1" of the vacuum gauge reading.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 3
3. MAP SENSOR VOLTAGE
1. With the scan tool, monitor the MAP Sensor signal voltage. 2. With the engine idling in neutral or
park, snap the throttle.
NOTE: The MAP Sensor signal voltage should change from below 2.0 volts at idle to above 3.5
volts at wide open throttle.
Were any problems found?
Yes
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3600
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
4. (F856) 5 VOLT SUPPLY CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (F856) 5 Volt Supply circuit at
the MAP Sensor harness connector and by
probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are
connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 5
No
- Repair the (F856) 5 Volt Supply circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
5. (K1) MAP SIGNAL CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K1) MAP Signal circuit at the
MAP Sensor harness connector and by probing
the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are connected so
that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 6
No
- Repair the (K1) MAP Signal circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
6. (K900) SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3601
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 along with the Adapter 8815-1 to
perform the diagnosis.
2. Using a voltmeter, perform a voltage drop test by backprobing the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit
at the MAP Sensor harness connector and by
probing the appropriate terminal of the special tool #8815. Make sure the voltmeter leads are
connected so that positive polarity is displayed on the voltmeter.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
3. Start the engine.
Is the voltage below 0.5 volts?
Yes
- Go to 7
No
- Repair the (K900) Sensor Ground circuit for excessive resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
7. MAP SENSOR
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
MAP Sensor and the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM).
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Search for any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace the MAP Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the
MAP sensor.
3. Rotate sensor.
4. Lift to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 3604
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
3.5L
1. Install sensor.
2. Rotate sensor into position.
3. Attach electrical connector (1) to sensor (2). 4. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5
Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) >
Page 3609
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) >
Page 3610
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) >
Page 3611
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) >
Page 3612
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen 1/1 (Gas) >
Page 3613
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4
Way
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4
Way > Page 3616
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 1/2 (Gas) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4
Way > Page 3617
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 2/1 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Oxygen Sensor 1/1 (Gas) 4
Way > Page 3618
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Oxygen Sensor 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 4 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
SENSOR-OXYGEN 2/2 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3619
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder.
See: Ignition System/Firing Order
Cylinder #1 on left side.
Cylinder #1 on right side.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
- A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3620
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE OXYGEN SENSOR OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. OXYGEN SENSOR, WIRING, OR CONNECTORS
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any O2 sensor or rationality DTCs before proceeding with this test.
NOTE: When performing this procedure as part of another diagnostic process, it may be necessary
to repeat this test for all of the oxygen
sensors on the vehicle.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
connectors between the Oxygen sensor and the PCM. 3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or
partially broken wires. 4. Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 5. Turn the
ignition on. 6. Monitor the scan tool data relative to the sensor and wiggle test the wiring and
connectors. 7. Look for the data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. If necessary,
check each sensor circuit for high resistance or a shorted
condition.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 2
2. OXYGEN SENSOR VOLTAGE
1. Start the engine and allow it to reach normal operating temperature.
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
2. With a scan tool, monitor all O2 Sensor voltage readings.
Is the voltage switching between 2.5 and 3.4 volts for all O2 sensors?
Yes
- Go to 3
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
3. O2 SENSOR HEATER OPERATION
1. Turn the ignition off.
NOTE: Wait a minimum of 10 minutes to allow the O2 Sensor to cool down before continuing the
test. Allow the O2 Sensor voltage to
stabilize at 5.0 volts.
2. Turn the ignition on. 3. With a scan tool, actuate the O2 Sensor heater. 4. With the scan tool,
monitor O2 Sensor voltage for at least 2 minutes.
Does the voltage stay above 4.5 volts?
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3621
Yes
- Go to 4
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Test complete.
4. O2 SENSOR
1. Turn the ignition off.
NOTE: Check for contaminants that may cause improper O2 Sensor operation, such as
contaminated fuel, unapproved silicone, or evidence
of oil or coolant.
2. Disconnect the O2 Sensor harness connector. 3. Turn the ignition on. 4. With a scan tool,
monitor the O2 Sensor voltage.
NOTE: The voltage should be approximately 5.0 volts with the connector disconnected.
5. Connect a jumper wire between the signal circuit and the return circuit in the O2 Sensor harness
connector.
NOTE: The voltage should drop from 5.0 volts to 2.5 volts with the jumper wire in place.
Is the O2 Sensor voltage displayed on the scan tool as described?
Yes
- Replace the O2 Sensor.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 5
5. O2 SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the O2 Sensor Signal circuit and
connectors between the O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Check the O2 Sensor signal circuit for a short
to ground, open circuit, short to voltage, or high resistance.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Go to 6
6. O2 SENSOR RETURN CIRCUIT
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the O2 Sensor Return circuit and
connectors between the O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Check the O2 Sensor return circuit for a short
to ground, open circuit, short to voltage or high resistance.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3622
No
- Go to 7
7. POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
O2 sensor and the PCM. 2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3.
Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals. 4. Monitor the scan tool data relative to
the components tested in this procedure and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. 5. Look for the
data to change or for a DTC to set during the wiggle test. 6. Search for any Technical Service
Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
No
- Replace and program the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests
and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
2.7, 3.5L
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/1)
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wires going into
oxygen sensor (O2S). Damage to the
oxygen sensor may occur.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect O2S wire harness mounting clips from engine or body,
if equipped. 3. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (1). 4. Remove O2S (2)
from catalytic converter (4). 5. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (5). 6.
Remove O2S (3) from catalytic converter (4).
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/1)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3625
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wires going into
oxygen sensor (O2S). Damage to the
oxygen sensor may occur.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect O2S wire harness mounting clips from engine or body,
if equipped. 3. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (1). 4. Remove the O2S
(5) from catalytic converter (4). 5. Disconnect O2S pigtail harness from engine wiring harness (2).
6. Remove O2S (3) from catalytic converter (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3626
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
2.7, 3.5L
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (2/1)
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When Equipped: The oxygen sensor (O2S) pigtail harness must be clipped and/or
bolted back to their original positions on engine
or body to prevent mechanical damage to wiring.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
Threads of new oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal. DO
NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new O2S.
1. Install O2S (3) to catalytic converter (4). 2. Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring
harness (2). 3. Install the O2S (2) to catalytic converter (4). Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 4.
Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring harness (1). 5. Connect O2S wire harness mounting
clips to engine or body, if equipped.
DOWNSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/2) AND UPSTREAM OXYGEN SENSOR (1/1)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3627
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, EXHAUST PIPES AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S)
BECOME VERY HOT DURING
ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING OXYGEN SENSOR.
FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL
INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
CAUTION: When Equipped: The oxygen sensor (O2S) pigtail harness must be clipped and/or
bolted back to their original positions on engine
or body to prevent mechanical damage to wiring.
NOTE: Use an O2S removal tool for this procedure.
Threads of new oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal. DO
NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new O2S.
1. Install O2S (3) to catalytic converter (4). 2. Connect O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring
harness (5). 3. Install O2S (2) to catalytic converter (4). Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect
O2S pigtail harness to engine wiring harness (1). 5. Connect O2S wire harness mounting clips to
engine or body, if equipped.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3631
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal
2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3634
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3635
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3636
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3637
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3638
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3642
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal
2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3645
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3646
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3647
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3648
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 3649
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Check
Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Air Injection Check Valve: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The air injection check valve (1) is a one-valve check valve that allows air to flow in one direction
only. The valve is located at exhaust side of the engine at the top of the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Check
Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3656
Air Injection Check Valve: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The air injection check valve (1) allows air pumped from the air injection pump to enter the exhaust
manifold during cold engine starts only. Air pressure from the air injection pump causes the spring
inside the air injection check valve to open allowing air to flow into the exhaust system.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Check
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Injection Check Valve: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE EXHAUST MANIFOLD, AIR INJECTION PIPES, EXHAUST PIPES AND
CATALYTIC CONVERTER(S) BECOME
VERY HOT DURING ENGINE OPERATION. ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVING
AIR INJECTION CHECK VALVE. FAILURE TO ALLOW ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE REMOVAL
MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL INJURY CAUSED BY BURNS.
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Remove air outlet tube (3) by pushing the ends (2) together, while
pulling the air pump outlet tube (3) away from air injection check valve (1). 3. Remove air injection
check valve mounting bolts (4). 4. Remove air injection check valve (1) and gasket (5) from pipe.
Clean old gasket material from air injection pipe.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Check
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3659
Air Injection Check Valve: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Make sure the old gasket material is completely removed from air injection pipe.
1. Install new gasket (5) and air injection check valve (1) to pipe. 2. Install air injection check valve
mounting bolts (4).
NOTE: The quick connect fitting on the air outlet tube is slotted to fit the air injection check valve
fitting. Line the slot up when making the
connection.
3. Install air pump outlet tube (3) to air injection check valve (1) connection. A click noise will
indicate a good connection. 4. Install engine cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Flow
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect air flow sensor electrical connector (4). 2. Remove constant tension clamps (1), (2)
securing the air flow sensor (3). 3. Remove air flow sensor (3) from hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Flow
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3664
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Note the arrow direction on the sensor and correctly position the air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 2.
Install constant tension clamps (1), (2) to secure air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 3. Connect air flow
sensor electrical connector (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Hose/Tube
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Injection Hose/Tube: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The air pump inlet tube is located on the left side of the engine compartment. The tube attaches to
the air injection pump using a quick connect style fitting. The other end of the tube connects to the
mass air flow sensor using a constant tension clamp.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Hose/Tube
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Injection Hose/Tube: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Cut the tie straps (3) being careful not to damage the air inlet tube (4). 2. Remove the constant
tension clamp (2) and remove the mass air flow (MAF) sensor (1) from the air inlet tube (4).
Position MAF sensor (1) and
wiring aside.
3. Remove air inlet tube (3) by pushing the ends (1) together, while pulling the air inlet tube (3)
away from air pump housing connection (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Hose/Tube
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3670
Air Injection Hose/Tube: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The quick connect fitting on the air inlet tube is slotted to fit the air pump housing fitting.
Line the slot up when making the
connection.
1. Install air inlet tube (3) to air pump housing connection (2). A click noise will indicate a good
connection.
2. Install mass air flow (MAF) sensor (1) and constant tension clamp (2) to air inlet tube (4). 3.
Position MAF sensor wiring to air inlet tube (4). Install new tie straps (3) securing the MAF sensor
wiring to air inlet tube (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Air Injection Pump: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The air injection pump is located on the left side of the engine compartment. The pump is operated
by an internal electrical motor and is mounted to a bracket by rubber isolators. An inlet and outlet
air hoses are attached to the air pump. A heat shield is attached at the air pump mounting bracket
to ensure that the air pump is not damaged by heat coming off the exhaust system.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3675
Air Injection Pump: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The electric air pump only functions during cold starts. The PCM will not command the electric air
pump to run if the engine coolant temperature is 10° Celsius (18° Fahrenheit) above ambient
temperature or if the engine coolant temperature is above 37° Celsius (98.6° Fahrenheit). The air
pump will not run more than 20 seconds during this cold start condition. The air inlet tube to the
electric air pump is equipped with a mass air flow (MAF) sensor. This MAF sensor monitors air flow
to the exhaust system and is used to diagnose the system by making sure the correct amount of
air, not too much or too little, reaches the exhaust system. Each component of the secondary air
system is diagnosed assuming the other part is functioning correctly. The diagnostic tool can
command the air pump ON with the key ON and engine OFF (KOEO).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Injection Pump: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery. 2. Remove engine cover. 3. Remove air inlet tube (3) by
pushing the ends (1) together while pulling the air inlet tube (3) away from air pump housing
connection (2).
4. Remove air outlet tube by pushing the coupling ends together while pulling the air outlet tube
away from the air pump.
5. Remove bolt (1) from heat shield (2) and air pump bracket (3).
6. Remove heat shield bolt (1) and heat shield (3) from air pump bracket (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3678
7. Disconnect electrical harness connector (1) from the air pump electrical connector (2). 8.
Remove air pump and bracket assembly from vehicle. 9. Remove air pump mounting nuts (5) from
bracket (4).
10. Remove air pump (3) from bracket (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3679
Air Injection Pump: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install air pump (3) to bracket (4). 2. Install air pump mounting nuts (5) to bracket (4). Tighten the
nuts to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.). 3. Position air pump and bracket assembly in vehicle. 4. Connect
electrical harness connector (1) to the air pump electrical connector (2).
5. Install heat shield (3) and bolt (1) to air pump bracket (2). Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
6. Install relay, heat shield (2) and bolt (1) to air pump bracket (3). Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (71 in.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3680
NOTE: The quick connect fitting on the air inlet tube is slotted to fit the air pump housing fitting.
Line the slot up when making the
connection.
7. Install air inlet tube (3) to air pump housing connection (2). A click noise will indicate a good
connection. 8. Install air outlet tube to air pump housing. A click noise will indicate a good
connection. 9. Connect the negative battery cable, tighten the nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
10. Install engine cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation > Page 3686
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3691
Canister Purge Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SOLENOID-EVAP PURGE (GAS) - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3692
Canister Purge Solenoid: Description and Operation
OPERATION
During the cold start warm-up period and the hot start time delay, the PCM does not energize the
solenoid. When de-energized, no vapors are purged.
The proportional purge solenoid operates at a frequency of 200 Hz and is controlled by an engine
controller circuit that senses the current being applied to the proportional purge solenoid and then
adjusts that current to achieve the desired purge flow. The proportional purge solenoid controls the
purge rate of fuel vapors from the vapor canister and fuel tank to the engine intake manifold.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Canister Purge Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable at battery. 2. If equipped with 3.5L engine, remove
the PCM See: Computers and Control Systems/Engine Control Module/Service and
Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Powertrain Control Module - Removal.
3. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from evaporator purge solenoid (1). 4. Remove purge hose
and quick connect fuel tank hose (3) from evaporator purge solenoid (1) See: Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Line
Coupler/Service and Repair.
5. Release tab to remove evaporator purge solenoid (1) from bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3695
Canister Purge Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install evaporator purge solenoid (1) to bracket. Make sure the tab secures the solenoid to the
bracket. 2. Install quick connect fuel tank hose and purge hose (3) to evaporator purge solenoid (1)
See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Line
Coupler/Service and Repair.
3. Connect electrical connector (2) to evaporator purge solenoid (1). 4. If equipped with 3.5L
engine, install the PCM See: Computers and Control Systems/Engine Control Module/Service and
Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Powertrain Control Module - Installation.
5. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Check Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporative
Check Valve: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
Evaporative Check Valve: Customer Interest Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
NUMBER: 14-001-09 REV. A
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: September 1, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-001-09, DATED APRIL 15,
2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Hard To Fill With Fuel Or Fuel Nozzle Shuts Off Repeatedly
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2009 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2007 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2009 (DR) Ram Truck (1500 / 2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2005 - 2009 (ND) Dakota
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2009 (J1) Sebring (China CKD)
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Sebring Convertible/Avenger
2006 - 2009 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)
2007 - 2009 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2009 (KK) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (LC) Challenger
2004 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2007 (R2) Caravan/Voyager(CKD)
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Check Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporative
Check Valve: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3704
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Check Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporative
Check Valve: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3705
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Check Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Evaporative Check Valve: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
Evaporative Check Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle
Shuts Off
NUMBER: 14-001-09 REV. A
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: September 1, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-001-09, DATED APRIL 15,
2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Hard To Fill With Fuel Or Fuel Nozzle Shuts Off Repeatedly
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2009 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2007 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2009 (DR) Ram Truck (1500 / 2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2005 - 2009 (ND) Dakota
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2009 (J1) Sebring (China CKD)
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Sebring Convertible/Avenger
2006 - 2009 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)
2007 - 2009 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2009 (KK) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (LC) Challenger
2004 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2007 (R2) Caravan/Voyager(CKD)
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Check Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Evaporative Check Valve: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3711
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Check Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Evaporative Check Valve: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3712
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Description and Operation
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Description and Operation
OPERATION
All gasoline fueled vehicles use a maintenance free, evaporative (EVAP) canister. Fuel tank vapors
vent into the canister. The canister temporarily holds the fuel vapors until intake manifold vacuum
draws them into the combustion chamber. The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) purges the
canister through the proportional purge solenoid. The PCM purges the canister at predetermined
intervals and engine conditions. The proportional purge solenoid controls the purge rate of fuel
vapors from the vapor canister and fuel tank to the engine intake manifold.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove the spare tire, refer to the owners
manual. 3. Raise and support vehicle. 4. Remove the 4 nuts (1) and the spare tire well (2).
5. Remove 2 nuts from EVAP canister mounting brackets and reposition EVAP canister assembly.
6. Disconnect purge line (4) from EVAP canister (1) See: Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Line
Coupler/Service and Repair. 7. Remove fresh air hose (2) and electrical connector (3) from the
ESIM. 8. Remove EVAP canister assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3718
9. A lock tab (see arrow) is used on the back of the switch. Push lock tab towards switch while
rotating switch counterclockwise 1/4 turn for removal.
10. Remove ESIM (1) from the EVAP canister (3). 11. Remove mounting brackets from EVAP
canister.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3719
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The picture displays a typical EVAP Canister and a typical ESIM switch. After installing any ESIM
switch, the electrical connector on the switch must be in the 3 O'clock position. This step must be
done for proper ESIM switch operation.
1. The fresh air hose that attaches to the ESIM must have a clear opening to the atmosphere.
Check the fresh air hose, including the fresh air filter,
for obstructions or restrictions at the ESIM. If a restriction is present, the system will not allow free
flow passage of clean air, and an early shut off of the fuel fill nozzle may occur during fuel fill.
2. Be sure O-ring (2) and EVAP canister opening are clean. 3. Install ESIM (1) to the EVAP
canister (3). 4. Instal mounting brackets to EVAP canister assembly.
5. Install EVAP canister assembly to vehicle. 6. Install purge line (4) to EVAP canister (1) See: Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair. 7. Install fresh air hose (2) and
electrical connector (3) to the ESIM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3720
8. Install the spare tire well (2) with 4 nuts (1). 9. Lower vehicle.
10. Install the spare tire, refer to the owners manual. 11. Connect negative battery cable, tighten
nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporative
Emissions Hose: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
Evaporative Emissions Hose: Customer Interest Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
NUMBER: 14-001-09 REV. A
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: September 1, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-001-09, DATED APRIL 15,
2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Hard To Fill With Fuel Or Fuel Nozzle Shuts Off Repeatedly
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2009 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2007 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2009 (DR) Ram Truck (1500 / 2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2005 - 2009 (ND) Dakota
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2009 (J1) Sebring (China CKD)
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Sebring Convertible/Avenger
2006 - 2009 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)
2007 - 2009 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2009 (KK) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (LC) Challenger
2004 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2007 (R2) Caravan/Voyager(CKD)
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporative
Emissions Hose: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3729
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporative
Emissions Hose: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3730
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Evaporative Emissions Hose: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
Evaporative Emissions Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle
Shuts Off
NUMBER: 14-001-09 REV. A
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: September 1, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-001-09, DATED APRIL 15,
2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Hard To Fill With Fuel Or Fuel Nozzle Shuts Off Repeatedly
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2009 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2007 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2009 (DR) Ram Truck (1500 / 2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2005 - 2009 (ND) Dakota
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2009 (J1) Sebring (China CKD)
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Sebring Convertible/Avenger
2006 - 2009 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)
2007 - 2009 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2009 (KK) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (LC) Challenger
2004 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2007 (R2) Caravan/Voyager(CKD)
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Evaporative Emissions Hose: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3736
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Evaporative Emissions Hose: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3737
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3741
Leak Detector: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (BODY) 2 WAY
SWITCH-EVAP SYSTEM MONITOR (GAS) - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3742
Leak Detector: Description and Operation
OPERATION
SYSTEM
The ESIM (Evaporative System Integrity Monitor) is very similar to the NVLD. However, the design
of the ESIM has been simplified and unlike the NVLD the ESIM does not require a solenoid. The
ESIM mounts directly to the canister, eliminating the need for a mounting bracket. It is critical that
the ESIM is mounted vertically. On vehicles where the canister is mounted on an angle, the ESIM
requires an adaptor to maintain a vertical position. When the ESIM is installed vertically, the
electrical connector is in the 3 o'clock position.
EXPLODED VIEW
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3743
The ESIM assembly consists of a housing, a small weight and a large weight that serve as check
valves, a diaphragm, a switch and a cover. There is one large weight and one small weight check
valve in the ESIM assembly. A seal is attached at the end of each weighted check valve. The large
weight check valve seals for pressure. The small weight check valve seals for vacuum. The
weighted check valves are contained within the ESIM housing.
CUT AWAY OF MODULE
The ESIM (Evaporative System Integrity Monitor), while physically different than the NVLD system,
performs the same basic function as the NVLD does - controlling evaporative emissions. The ESIM
has been simplified because the solenoid used on the NVLD is not used on the ESIM.
The ESIM consists of housing, two check valves (sometimes referred to as weights), a diaphragm,
a switch and a cover. The larger check valve seals for pressure and the smaller one seals for
vacuum.
During refueling, pressure is built up in the evaporative system. When pressure reaches
approximately.5 inches of water, the large check valve unseats and pressure vents to the fresh air
filter.
Conversely, when the system cools and the resulting vacuum lifts the small check valve from its
seat and allows fresh air to enter the system and relieve the vacuum condition. When a calibrated
amount of vacuum is achieved in the evaporative system, the diaphragm is pulled inward, pushing
on the spring and closing the contacts.
The ESIM conducts test on the evaporative system as follows: An engine off, non-intrusive test for
small leaks and an engine running, intrusive test for medium/large leaks.
The ESIM weights seal the EVAP system during engine off conditions. If the EVAP system is
sealed, it will be pulled into a vacuum, either due to the cool down from operating temperature or
diurnal ambient temperature cycling. When the vacuum in the system exceeds about 1" H20, the
vacuum switch closes. The switch closure sends a signal to the powertrain control module (PCM).
In order to pass the non-intrusive small leak test, the ESIM switch must close within a calculated
amount of time and within a specified amount of key-off events.
If the ESIM switch does not close as specified, the test is considered inconclusive and the intrusive
engine running test will be run during the next key-on cycle. This intrusive test will run on the next
cold engine running condition.
Conditions for running the intrusive test are:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3744
- After the vehicle is started, the engine coolant temperature must be within 10° C (50°F) of
ambient to indicate a cold start.
- The fuel level must be between 12% and 88%.
- The engine must be in closed loop.
- Manifold vacuum must be greater than a minimum specified value.
- Ambient temperature must be between 4° C and 37° C (39° F and 98° F) and the elevation level
must be below 8500 feet.
The test is accomplished by the PCM activating the purge solenoid to create a vacuum in the
evaporative system. The PCM then measures the amount of time it takes for the vacuum to
dissipate. This is known as the vacuum decay method. If the switch opens quickly a large leak is
recorded. If the switch opens after a predetermined amount of time, then the small leak matures. If
the switch does not close, then a general evaporative failure is recorded.
Even when all of the thresholds are met, a small leak won't be recorded until after the
medium/large leak monitor has been run. If the medium/large leak test runs and the ESIM switch
doesn't close, a general evaporative test is run. The purge solenoid is activated for approximately
10 seconds, increasing the amount of vacuum in the system. IF the ESIM switch closes after the
extended purge activation, a large leak fault is generated. If the switch doesn't close, a general
evaporative system fault is generated.
The purge monitor tests the integrity of the hose attached between the purge valve and throttle
body/intake. The purge monitor is a two stage test and it runs only after the evaporative system
passes the small leak test.
Stage one of the purge monitor is non-intrusive. The PCM monitors the purge vapor ratio. If the
ratio is above a calibrated specification, the monitor passes. Stage two is an intrusive test and it
runs only if stage one fails. During the stage two test, the PCM commands the purge solenoid to
flow at a specified rate to force the purge vapor ratio to update. The vapor ratio is compared to a
calibrated specification and if it is less than specified, a one-trip failure is recorded.
The ESIM switch stuck closed monitor checks to see if the switch is stuck closed. This is a power
down test that runs at key-off; when the PCM sees 0 rpm's, the purge solenoid is energized for a
maximum of 30 seconds, venting any vacuum trapped in the evaporative system. If the switch
opens or was open before the test began, the monitor passes. If the switch doesn't open, the
monitor fails. This is a two-trip MIL. The star scan tool can be used to force the ESIM switch stuck
closed monitor to run.
The PCM also uses the ESIM to detect a loose or missing gas cap. The PCM looks for a change in
the fuel level (25% minimum). If a medium/large leak is then detected, a loose gas cap light
illuminates and a pending one-trip fault code is set. This is a three-trip fault before the code
matures.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Leak Detector: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove the spare tire, refer to the owners
manual. 3. Raise and support vehicle. 4. Remove the 4 nuts (1) and the spare tire well (2).
5. Remove fresh air hose (2) and electrical connector (3) from the ESIM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3747
6. A lock tab (see arrow) is used on the back of the switch. Push lock tab towards switch while
rotating switch counterclockwise 1/4 turn for removal.
7. Remove ESIM (1) from the EVAP canister (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3748
Leak Detector: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The picture displays a typical EVAP Canister and a typical ESIM switch. After installing any ESIM
switch, the electrical connector on the switch must be in the 3 O'clock position. This step must be
done for proper ESIM switch operation.
1. The fresh air hose that attaches to the ESIM must have a clear opening to the atmosphere.
Check the fresh air hose, including the fresh air filter,
for obstructions or restrictions at the ESIM. If a restriction is present, the system will not allow free
flow passage of clean air, and an early shut off of the fuel fill nozzle may occur during fuel fill.
2. Be sure O-ring (2) and EVAP canister opening are clean. 3. Install ESIM (1) to the EVAP
canister (3).
4. Install fresh air hose (2) and electrical connector (3) to the ESIM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3749
5. Install the spare tire well (2) with 4 nuts (1). 6. Lower vehicle. 7. Install the spare tire, refer to the
owners manual. 8. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Cooler: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The EGR cooler (7) cools recirculated exhaust gasses to reduce combustion temperature and a
greater mass of exhaust gases can thus be circulated. There is less nitrogen oxides as a result.
The EGR cooler (7) allows the engine and catalytic converter to reach their operating temperature
quickly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Cooler - Removal
EGR Cooler: Service and Repair EGR Cooler - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove engine cover See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Engine - Removal. 2. Drain cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 3. Remove EGR cooler coolant hoses (8). 4. Remove
EGR cooler to exhaust manifold tube (11). 5. Remove EGR cooler to EGR valve tube (1). 6.
Remove EGR cooler mounting nuts (6). 7. Remove EGR cooler (7). 8. Remove the bypass valve
mounting screws (3). 9. Separate the bypass valve assembly from the EGR cooler body (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Cooler - Removal > Page 3756
EGR Cooler: Service and Repair EGR Cooler - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using a new gasket, position the bypass valve assembly to the EGR cooler body (5). Tighten
screws to 10 Nm (88 in. lbs.). 2. Position EGR cooler (7) and install mounting screws. Tighten to 10
Nm (88 in. lbs.). 3. Install EGR cooler to exhaust manifold tube (11). Tighten bolts to 20 Nm (14 ft.
lbs.) and nuts to 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.). 4. Install EGR cooler to EGR valve tube (1). Tighten bolts to 20
Nm (14 ft. lbs.). 5. Install coolant hoses. 6. Install vacuum line. 7. Fill cooling system See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 8. Install engine cover See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Tube - Removal
EGR Tube: Service and Repair Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Tube - Removal
3.5L
WARNING: The normal operating temperature of the exhaust gas recirculate (EGR) valve and tube
is very high. Therefore, never work
around or attempt to service any engine component until it is completely cooled.
1. Remove two upper tube mounting bolts. 2. When removing EGR tube assembly be careful not to
drop the silicone rubber seals into the intake manifold. Clean gasket surfaces on the EGR
valve. Note that any loose dirt can lodge between the pintle and the seat and cause valve leakage
that will give a rough idle and depressed manifold vacuum.
3. Remove two lower tube mounting bolts. 4. Remove tube assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Tube - Removal > Page 3761
EGR Tube: Service and Repair Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Tube - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Do Not use metal scrapers when cleaning the mounting surface of the EGR valve.
Damage from scratching the surface may cause
an improper seal.
CAUTION: Do not allow debris to enter the EGR valve when cleaning the mounting surface. Debris
can lodge between the pintle and the seat
causing valve leakage that results in rough idle and depressed manifold vacuum.
1. Clean and inspect gasket sealing surfaces.
NOTE: Install new rubber silicone seals on intake manifold end of EGR tube any time it is removed
from the intake manifold.
2. Install new silicone rubber seal (1) on the intake manifold end of the EGR tube. Position seal 17
mm (0.67 in.) from the tube flange.
3. Lubricate the EGR mounting tube hole in the intake manifold with Mopar(R) Rubber Bushing
Installation Lube. Do not lubricate the EGR tube or
seal.
4. Install the EGR tube (3) into the intake manifold (2) being careful not to damage the silicone
rubber seals, and verify that the seals are correctly
positioned in the intake manifold.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Tube - Removal > Page 3762
5. Install new gasket between the EGR valve and tube and install bolts (1). Tighten bolts to 15 Nm
(11 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: The EGR tube flange (1) does not need to be flush with the intake manifold (2) to be
sealed. The EGR tube flange can be up to 2 mm
(0.08 in.) from intake manifold and still be sealed. This design allows the EGR tube position to vary
with the tolerance stack up and remain properly sealed.
CAUTION: DO NOT use air tools to install bolts to intake manifold. Install bolts using hand tools
only. Torque all fasteners to specification.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Tube - Removal > Page 3763
The use of air tools can cause the threads of the intake manifold to become stripped.
6. Install the EGR tube flange mounting bolts to intake manifold. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (106 in.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3767
EGR Valve: Diagrams
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 6 WAY
ASSEMBLY-EGR VALVE (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Description
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Description
DESCRIPTION
The EGR valve consists of three major components. First there is the pintle, valve seat, and
housing which contains and regulates the gas flow. Second there is the armature, return spring,
and solenoid coil to provide the operating force to regulate the flow by changing the pintle position.
The solenoid coil assembly is in parallel with a diode and connects to the two connectors in the
connector assembly. The third major component which senses pintle position and is connected to
the three connectors in the electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Description >
Page 3770
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Operation
OPERATION
The exhaust gas recirculation flow is determined by the engine controller. For a given set of
conditions, the engine controller knows the ideal exhaust gas recirculation flow to optimize NOx
and fuel economy as a function of the pintle position. Pintle position is obtained from the position
sensor. The engine controller adjusts the duty cycle of 128 Hz power supplied to the solenoid coil
to obtain the correct position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Removal
EGR Valve: Service and Repair Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Removal
3.5L
WARNING: The normal operating temperature of the exhaust gas recirculate (EGR) valve and tube
is very high. Therefore, never work
around or attempt to service any engine component until it is completely cooled.
NOTE: It is very important to disconnect the battery due to the addresses (cells) within the engine
controller that store learned values related
to powertrain operation. A malfunctioning EGR system can cause bad values to be stored in these
cells that can cause an erroneous fault to occur after the system is repaired. Disconnecting the
battery for at least two minutes will remove all power from the controller and reset these cells to
normal default values.
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable at battery. 2. Remove EGR tube bolts (3) at
exhaust gas recirculate (EGR) valve (2). 3. Remove EGR tube (4) from EGR valve (2). 4. Remove
and discard gasket (5) located between EGR valve (2) and EGR tube (4). 5. Disconnect electrical
connector at EGR valve (2). 6. Remove EGR valve mounting bolts (6). 7. Remove EGR valve (2)
from cylinder head (1). 8. Remove and discard gasket located between EGR valve (2) and cylinder
head (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Removal > Page 3773
EGR Valve: Service and Repair Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve - Installation
3.5L
1. Install new exhaust gas recirculate (EGR) valve gasket to EGR valve.
2. Install EGR valve (2), gasket and bolts (6) to cylinder head (1). Tighten to 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.). 3.
Install new gasket (5), EGR tube (4) and bolts (3) to EGR valve (2). Tighten to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.).
4. Tighten the EGR tube to intake manifold bolts to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.). 5. Connect electrical
connector to EGR valve (2). 6. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Locations
The Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) valve is located on the end of the rear valve cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Positive Crankcase
Ventilation (PCV) Valve - Description
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Description and Operation Positive Crankcase Ventilation
(PCV) Valve - Description
DESCRIPTION
The PCV valve contains a spring loaded plunger. The plunger meters the amount of crankcase
vapors routed into the combustion chamber based on intake manifold vacuum.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Positive Crankcase
Ventilation (PCV) Valve - Description > Page 3780
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Description and Operation Positive Crankcase Ventilation
(PCV) Valve - Operation
OPERATION
When the engine is not operating or during an engine backfire, the spring forces the plunger back
against the seat. This prevents vapors from flowing through the valve.
When the engine is at idle or cruising, high manifold vacuum is present. At these times manifold
vacuum is able to completely compress the spring and pull the plunger to the top of the valve. In
this position there is minimal vapor flow through the valve.
During periods of moderate intake manifold vacuum the plunger is only pulled part way back from
the inlet. This results in maximum vapor flow through the valve.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3781
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Testing and Inspection
PCV SYSTEM
WARNING: apply parking brake and/or block wheels before performing any test or adjustment with
the engine operating.
1. With engine idling, remove the hose from the PCV valve. If the valve is not plugged, a hissing
noise will be heard as air passes through the valve.
A strong vacuum should also be felt when a finger is placed over the valve inlet.
2. Install hose on PCV valve. Remove the make-up air hose from the air plenum at the rear of the
engine. Hold a piece of stiff paper (parts tag)
loosely over the end of the make-up air hose.
3. After allowing approximately one minute for crankcase pressure to reduce, the paper should
draw up against the hose with noticeable force. If the
engine does not draw the paper against the grommet after installing a new valve, replace the PCV
valve hose.
4. Turn the engine off. Remove the PCV valve from intake manifold. The valve should rattle when
shaken. 5. Replace the PCV valve and retest the system if it does not operate as described in the
preceding tests. Do not attempt to clean the old PCV
valve.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Positive Crankcase Ventilation
(PCV) Valve - Removal
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Service and Repair Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV)
Valve - Removal
3.5L
The Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) valve is located on the end of the rear valve cover.
1. Remove positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) hose (2) from PCV valve (3). 2. Unscrew PCV
valve (3) from valve cover (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Positive Crankcase Ventilation
(PCV) Valve - Removal > Page 3784
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Service and Repair Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV)
Valve - Installation
3.5L
1. Install positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve (3) to valve cover (1) and tighten to 4 Nm (35
in. lbs.). 2. Install positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) hose (2) to PCV valve (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect air flow sensor electrical connector (4). 2. Remove constant tension clamps (1), (2)
securing the air flow sensor (3). 3. Remove air flow sensor (3) from hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Air Injection Flow Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3790
Air Injection Flow Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Note the arrow direction on the sensor and correctly position the air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 2.
Install constant tension clamps (1), (2) to secure air flow sensor (3) to hoses. 3. Connect air flow
sensor electrical connector (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Operation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect upstream
DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (1). 4. Remove upstream DPF temperature sensor
(2). 5. Disconnect downstream DPF temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 6. Remove
downstream DPF temperature sensor (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Operation > Page 3795
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Position DPF downstream temperature sensor (3) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 2.
Connect downstream temperature sensor electrical connector (4). 3. Position DPF upstream
temperature sensor (2) into DPF. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect upstream temperature
sensor electrical connector (1). 5. Install engine cover. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
Fuel Flow
Leakdown
Less than 10 psi in 5 minutes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Checking the Fuel Delivery System
CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. FUEL PUMP OPERATION
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With a scan tool, actuate the Fuel System test.
NOTE: It may be necessary to use a mechanics stethoscope in the next step.
3. Listen for fuel pump operation at the fuel tank. The fuel pump should operate smoothly with no
excessive noise. If the pump has excessive noise
such as grinding, the pump should be replaced.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Does the Fuel Pump sound to be operate normally?
Yes
- Go to 2
No
- Go to 7
2. FUEL PRESSURE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Install a fuel pressure gauge. 3. Ignition on, engine not running. 4. With the scan tool, actuate the
Fuel Pump and observe the fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Choose a conclusion that best matches your fuel pressure reading.
Below Specification
- Go to 3
Within Specification
- Test Complete.
Above Specification
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3802
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
3. RESTRICTED FUEL SUPPLY LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure even with the engine off. Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released.
2. Raise vehicle on hoist, and disconnect the fuel pressure line at the fuel pump module. 3. Install
special tool #6539 (5/16") or #6631(3/8") fuel line adapter and the fuel pressure gauge between the
fuel supply line and the fuel pump
module.
4. Ignition on, engine not running. 5. With the scan tool, actuate the Fuel Pump and observe the
fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Is the fuel pressure within specification now?
Yes
- Repair/replace fuel supply line as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. SADDLE FUEL TANK
Is the vehicle equipped with a saddle type fuel tank?
Yes
- Go to 5
No
- Go to 6
5. CHECKING FUEL TANK SIPHON HOSE AND FUEL LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Gain access to the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. 3. Inspect the following fuel
components: Fuel line and siphon hose between the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. Look for
disconnected and/or damaged lines or hoses.
- Fuel Pressure Regulator not properly seated in the module.
Were the above items in good working condition?
Yes
- Go to 6
No
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
6. CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP INLET
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3803
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Remove the Fuel Pump Module and Fuel Tank Module (if equipped), inspect the Fuel Inlet and
the bottom of the fuel tank for debris that could
cause the fuel pump inlet to be plugged.
Is the Fuel Pump Inlet plugged?
Yes
- Repair/Replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
7. FUEL PUMP MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Disconnect the Fuel Pump Module harness connector. 3. Using a 12-volt
test light to battery voltage, probe the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit in the Fuel Pump Module
harness connector.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Does the test light illuminate brightly.
Yes
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Repair the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3804
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pressure Leak Down
FUEL PRESSURE LEAK DOWN
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious
or fatal injury when performing this test
procedure. Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
- Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eye wear
and clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair / replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM GAS AND DIESEL FUEL
PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3805
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Fuel Inlet Hose 8978A-1 (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the Fuel
Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect the Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to the
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir
Assembly 534960 (4) on the floor and out of
the way so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system: Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3806
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
2. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait 1 minute before
proceeding. 3. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4
fuel pressure specification is 552 KPa ± 34 KPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the Checking The Fuel Delivery System diagnostic procedure as directed. See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Checking the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAK DOWN
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Close the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1) and then wait five minutes before proceeding. 2. Read
the Fuel Inlet (2) and Fuel Outlet (3) Pressure Gauges. The pressure should not drop more than 10
psi on either gauge.
Does the fuel pressure drop more than 10 psi?
Yes - On Fuel Inlet Gauge (1)
- Replace the fuel pump module.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
Yes - On Fuel Outlet Gauge (2)
- Replace the leaking fuel injector(s).
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- If directed here by another test, return to that test. Otherwise, test complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3807
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Delivery System Output - Flow Test
FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT - FLOW TEST
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal
injury when performing this test procedure.
- Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
- Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eyewear and
clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM THE GAS AND DIESEL
FUEL PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from the Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3808
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly 8978A-1 Fuel Inlet Hose (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect special tool Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the
Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir Assembly
534960 (4) on the floor and out of the way
so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system:
- Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3809
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
1. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait one minute before
proceeding. 2. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 kPa ± 34 kPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4 fuel
pressure specification is 552 kPa ± 34 kPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Checking
the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump. 3. Open the Flow
Test Valve (1) for 20 seconds, then close the Valve.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
4. Turn the ignition off. 5. Measure the amount of fuel in the Reservoir Assembly (2). The fuel
output specification is ml/s X 20 seconds = fuel flow in ml.
Does the amount of fuel in the reservoir meet or exceed the specification?
Yes
- Test complete.
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Checking
the Fuel Delivery System
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
1. Remove fuel fill cap. 2. Remove fuel pump fuse from Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
For location of fuse, refer to label on underside of TIPM cover. 3. Start and run engine until it stalls.
4. Attempt restarting engine until it will no longer run. 5. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 6. Place
a rag or towel below fuel line quick-connect fitting at fuel rail. 7. Disconnect quick-connect fitting at
fuel rail See: Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair. 8. When the repair is complete, reconnect fuel
fittings and return fuel pump fuse to TIPM. 9. One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) may
have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel pump fuse removal. A diagnostic scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable at battery. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector
from accelerator pedal. 3. Remove mounting nuts and remove accelerator pedal from the mounting
studs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3817
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The accelerator pedal and mounting nuts need to be torque in a mandatory torque
sequence or damage could result to the pedal
assembly.
1. Install the accelerator pedal and mounting nuts to the mounting studs. Tighten the nuts in a
mandatory torque sequence to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.). 2. Connect the electrical connector from
accelerator pedal. 3. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.). 4. Use a
scan tool and perform the APPS RELEARN function.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3821
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 6 WAY
SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disengage the air filter housing clips (1). 2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) forward slightly to
disengage tabs from the bottom of the air filter housing.
3. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Cleaner - Removal > Page 3827
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install air filter element into the bottom half of the air filter housing.
2. Slide the air filter housing cover (2) rearward to engage the tabs into the bottom half of the air
filter housing. 3. Reengage the air filter housing clips (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Fuel: Description and Operation
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
Your engine is designed to meet all emissions regulations and provide excellent fuel economy and
performance when using high quality unleaded gasoline having an octane rating of 87. The use of
premium gasoline is not recommended. The use of premium gasoline will provide no benefit over
high quality regular gasoline, and in some circumstances may result in poorer performance.
Light spark knock at low engine speeds is not harmful to your engine. However, continued heavy
spark knock at high speeds can cause damage and immediate service is required. Engine damage
resulting from operation with a heavy spark knock may not be covered by the new vehicle warranty.
Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hard starting, stalling and hesitations. If you
experience these symptoms, try another brand of gasoline before considering service for the
vehicle.
Over 40 auto manufacturers world-wide have issued and endorsed consistent gasoline
specifications (the Worldwide Fuel Charter, WWFC) to define fuel properties necessary to deliver
enhanced emissions, performance and durability for your vehicle. Chrysler recommends the use of
gasolines that meet the WWFC specifications if they are available.
REFORMULATED GASOLINE
Many areas of the country require the use of cleaner burning gasoline referred to as "reformulated"
gasoline. Reformulated gasoline contain oxygenates, and are specifically blended to reduce vehicle
emissions and improve air quality.
Chrysler strongly supports the use of reformulated gasoline. Properly blended reformulated
gasoline will provide excellent performance and durability for the engine and fuel system
components.
GASOLINE/OXYGENATE BLENDS
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxygenates such as 10% ethanol, MTBE, and
ETBE. Oxygenates are required in some areas of the country during the winter months to reduce
carbon monoxide emissions. Fuels blended with these oxygenates may be used in your vehicle.
CAUTION: DO NOT use gasoline containing METHANOL. Gasoline containing methanol may
damage critical fuel system components.
MMT IN GASOLINE
MMT is a manganese-containing metallic additive that is blended into some gasoline to increase
octane. Gasoline blended with MMT provide no performance advantage beyond gasoline of the
same octane number without MMT. Gasoline blended with MMT reduce spark plug life and reduce
emission system performance in some vehicles. Chrysler recommends that gasoline free of MMT
be used in your vehicle. The MMT content of gasoline may not be indicated on the gasoline pump;
therefore, you should ask your gasoline retailer whether or not his/her gasoline contains MMT.
It is even more important to look for gasoline without MMT in Canada because MMT can be used
at levels higher than allowed in the United States. MMT is prohibited in Federal and California
reformulated gasoline.
SULFUR IN GASOLINE
If you live in the northeast United States, your vehicle may have been designed to meet California
low emission standards with Cleaner-Burning California reformulated gasoline with low sulfur. If
such fuels are not available in states adopting California emission standards, your vehicles will
operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal specifications, but emission control system
performance may be adversely affected. Gasoline sold outside of California is permitted to have
higher sulfur levels which may affect the performance of the vehicle's catalytic converter. This may
cause the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL), Check Engine or Service Engine Soon light to
illuminate. Chrysler recommends that you try a different brand of unleaded gasoline having lower
sulfur to determine if the problem is fuel related prior to returning your vehicle to an authorized
dealer for service.
CAUTION: If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL), Check Engine or Service Engine Soon light is
flashing, immediate service is required;
see on-board diagnostics system section.
MATERIALS ADDED TO FUEL
All gasoline sold in the United States and Canada are required to contain effective detergent
additives. Use of additional detergents or other additives is not needed under normal conditions.
FUEL SYSTEM CAUTIONS
CAUTION: Follow these guidelines to maintain your vehicle's performance:
- The use of leaded gas is prohibited by Federal law. Using leaded gasoline can impair engine
performance, damage the emission control system,
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3831
and could result in loss of warranty coverage.
- An out-of-tune engine, or certain fuel or ignition malfunctions, can cause the catalytic converter to
overheat. If you notice a pungent burning odor or some light smoke, your engine may be out of
tune or malfunctioning and may require immediate service.
- When pulling a heavy load or driving a fully loaded vehicle when the humidity is low and the
temperature is high, use a premium unleaded fuel to help prevent spark knock. If spark knock
persists, lighten the load, or engine piston damage may result.
- The use of fuel additives which are now being sold as octane enhancers is not recommended.
Most of these products contain high concentrations of methanol. Fuel system damage or vehicle
performance problems resulting from the use of such fuels or additives is not the responsibility of
Chrysler Corporation and may not be covered under the new vehicle warranty.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control systems can result in civil penalties being
assessed against you.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fuel Filler Cap: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The plastic fuel fill cap is a threaded/quarter turn onto the end of the fuel filler tube. Its purpose is to
retain vapors and fuel in the fuel tank.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3836
Fuel Filler Cap: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The loss of any fuel vapor out of fuel filler tube is prevented by the use of pressure-vacuum fuel fill
cap. Relief valves inside the cap will release fuel tank pressure at predetermined pressures. Fuel
tank vacuum will also be released at predetermined values. This cap must be replaced by a similar
unit if replacement is necessary. This is in order for the system to remain effective.
CAUTION: Remove fill cap before servicing any fuel system component to relieve tank pressure. If
the cap is left loose, a Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTC) may be set.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
1. Remove fuel fill cap. 2. Remove fuel pump fuse from Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
For location of fuse, refer to label on underside of TIPM cover. 3. Start and run engine until it stalls.
4. Attempt restarting engine until it will no longer run. 5. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 6. Place
a rag or towel below fuel line quick-connect fitting at fuel rail. 7. Disconnect quick-connect fitting at
fuel rail See: Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair. 8. When the repair is complete, reconnect fuel
fittings and return fuel pump fuse to TIPM. 9. One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) may
have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel pump fuse removal. A diagnostic scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector: Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L) > Page 3847
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L) > Page 3848
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L) > Page 3849
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L) > Page 3850
Fuel Injector: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L) > Page 3851
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L) > Page 3852
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L) > Page 3853
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L) > Page 3854
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7/3.5L) > Page 3855
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Fuel Injector: Diagrams Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 1 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 3858
Fuel Injector: Diagrams Fuel Injector 2 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 2 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 3859
Fuel Injector: Diagrams Fuel Injector 3 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 3 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 3860
Fuel Injector: Diagrams Fuel Injector 4 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 4 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 3861
Fuel Injector: Diagrams
Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 1 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Fuel Injector 2 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 2 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 3862
Fuel Injector 3 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 3 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Fuel Injector 4 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 4 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 3863
Fuel Injector 5 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 5 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Fuel Injector 6 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
INJECTOR-FUEL 6 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 2 Way > Page 3864
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector - Removal
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair Fuel Injector - Removal
3.5L
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before
servicing any part on the fuel system, the fuel
system pressure must be released.
1. Release fuel pressure, See: Fuel Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair. 2.
Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable at battery. 3. Remove the upper intake manifold,
See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold Removal.
4. Disconnect the quick connect fuel line from the fuel rail.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector - Removal > Page 3867
NOTE: Mark fuel injector electrical harness connectors with correct corresponding cylinder
numbers.
5. Disconnect all fuel injector electrical connectors (1) from fuel injectors (2).
6. Remove fuel rail mounting bolts from fuel rail and lower intake manifold.
NOTE: Gently rock the fuel rail and injectors back and forth to loosen the seals on the fuel injectors
from the cylinder heads.
CAUTION: Do Not use excessive force or prying tools to remove fuel rail and injectors. Damage to
the fuel rail and injectors may result.
7. Lift fuel rail straight up off of the cylinder heads. 8. Drain any excess fuel from the fuel rail into an
approved fuel storage container.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector - Removal > Page 3868
NOTE: When replacing individual fuel injectors, each fuel injector must be installed to it's original
position. Mark or tag each fuel injector to
identify the correct cylinder.
9. Remove retaining clips (5) from fuel injectors (2) at fuel rail (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector - Removal > Page 3869
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair Fuel Injector - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: Inspect each O-ring seal on all the fuel injectors, replace O-ring seals if any damaged is
noted. Note the fuel injector O-rings are color
coded. The Blue colored O-ring is for the fuel rail side and the Green colored O-ring is cylinder
head side.
NOTE: If individual fuel injectors are being replaced, return the remaining fuel injectors to the
original positions noted during removal.
1. Install and lubricate each fuel injector O-rings (1), (3) with a light drop of clean engine oil. 2.
Install all of the fuel injectors (2) to the fuel rail (4), then install the retaining clip (5) to the fuel rail
(4).
3. Inspect each fuel injector for proper installation. Note how the retaining clip (3) secures the fuel
injector (1) to the fuel rail (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector - Removal > Page 3870
CAUTION: The fuel rail bolts are actually lower intake manifold bolts. These bolts must be torqued
in a mandatory torque sequence.
4. Insert fuel injector nozzles into openings in the cylinder heads. Seat the injectors in place. Install
the fuel rail bolts and tighten bolts in a mandatory
torque sequence to 28 Nm (20.5 ft. lbs.).
5. Correctly position and connect the fuel injector electrical harness connectors to the fuel injectors.
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel line quick connector is connected properly. Failure to connect the
fuel line correctly may result in a fuel leak at
the rail assembly. Fuel leaked onto a hot engine may ignite resulting in damage to the vehicle.
6. Connect quick connect fuel line to fuel rail.
7. Connect all fuel injector electrical connectors (1) to fuel injectors (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector - Removal > Page 3871
8. Install upper intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service
and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation. 9. Connect the negative battery cable, tighten the nut to 5
Nm (45 in. lbs.).
10. Use the scan tool ASD Fuel System Test to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair
QUICK-CONNECT FITTINGS
Different types of quick-connect fittings are used to attach the various fuel system components,
lines and tubes. These are: a single-button type, a two-button type, a pinch type, a single-tab type,
a two-tab type or a plastic retainer ring type. Some are equipped with safety latch clips. Some may
require the use of a special tool for disconnection and removal.
DISCONNECTING
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with engine off). Before servicing
any fuel system hose, fitting or line, fuel
system pressure must be released. See: Fuel Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair
CAUTION: Before separating a quick-connect fitting, pay attention to what type of fitting is being
used by referring to Quick-Connect Fitting
Removal. This will prevent unnecessary fitting or fitting latch breakage.
CAUTION: The interior components (O-rings, clips) of quick-connect fittings are not serviced
separately, but new plastic spacers and latches
are available for some types. If service parts are not available, do not attempt to repair the
damaged fitting or fuel line (tube). If repair is necessary, replace the complete fuel line (tube)
assembly.
1. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. See: Fuel Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and
Repair 2. Disconnect negative battery cable from battery. 3. Clean fitting of any foreign material
before disassembly.
4. Single-Button Type Fitting: This type of fitting is equipped with a single push-button (2) located
on the quick-connect fitting.
5. The push-button is attached to two internal latches (1). To disconnect, press on push-button with
your thumb and unlatch fitting from fuel line.
Special tools are not required for disconnection. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO PRY OR PULL UP ON
PUSH-BUTTON. LATCHES WILL BE BROKEN.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3875
6. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. See: Fuel Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and
Repair 7. Disconnect negative battery cable from battery. 8. Clean fitting of any foreign material
before disassembly. 9. 2-Button Type Fitting: This type of fitting (1) is equipped with a push-button
located on each side of quick-connect fitting (2). Press on both
buttons simultaneously for removal. Special tools are not required for disconnection.
10. Pinch-Type Fitting: This fitting (1) is equipped with two finger tabs (2). Pinch both tabs together
while removing fitting. Special tools are not
required for disconnection.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3876
11. Single-Tab Type Fitting: This type of fitting (3) is equipped with a single pull tab (1). The tab is
removable. After tab is removed, quick-connect
fitting can be separated from fuel system component. Special tools are not required for
disconnection.
12. Press release tab on side of fitting to release pull tab (1). If release tab is not pressed prior to
releasing pull tab, pull tab will be damaged. 13. While pressing release tab on side of fitting, use
screwdriver (2) to pry up pull tab. 14. Raise pull tab until it separates from quick-connect fitting.
15. Two-Tab Type Fitting: This type of fitting (2) is equipped with tabs located on both sides of
fitting (1). The tabs are supplied for disconnecting
quick-connect fitting from component being serviced. a. To disconnect quick-connect fitting,
squeeze plastic retainer tabs (1) against sides of quick-connect fitting with your fingers. Tool use is
not
required for removal and may damage plastic retainer.
b. Pull fitting from fuel system component being serviced. c. The plastic retainer will remain on
component being serviced after fitting is disconnected. The O-rings and spacer will remain in
quick-connect
fitting connector body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3877
16. Plastic Retainer Ring Type Fitting: This type of fitting can be identified by the use of a full-round
plastic retainer ring (4) usually black in color.
a. To release fuel system component from quick-connect fitting, firmly push fitting towards
component being serviced while firmly pushing
plastic retainer ring into fitting (6). With plastic ring depressed, pull fitting from component. The
plastic retainer ring must be pressed squarely into fitting body. If this retainer is cocked during
removal, it may be difficult to disconnect fitting. Use an open-end wrench on shoulder of plastic
retainer ring to aid in disconnection.
b. After disconnection, plastic retainer ring will remain with quick-connect fitting connector body. c.
Inspect fitting connector body, plastic retainer ring and fuel system component for damage.
Replace as necessary.
17. Latch Clips Type 1: Depending on vehicle model and engine, 2 different types of safety latch
clips are used. Type-1 (4) is tethered to fuel line
and type-2 is not. A special tool will be necessary to disconnect fuel line after latch clip is removed.
The latch clip may be used on certain fuel line/fuel rail connection, or to join fuel lines together.
18. Pry up on latch clip with a screwdriver (3). 19. Slide latch clip toward fuel rail while lifting with
screwdriver.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3878
20. Insert special fuel line removal tool (Snap-On number FIH 9055-1 or equivalent) into fuel line
(1). Use tool to release locking fingers in end of
line.
21. With special tool still inserted, pull fuel line from fuel rail. 22. After disconnection, locking fingers
will remain within quick-connect fitting at end of fuel line. 23. Disconnect quick-connect fitting from
fuel system component being serviced.
24. Latch Clips Type 2: Depending on vehicle model and engine, 2 different types of safety latch
clips are used. Type-1 is tethered to fuel line and
type-2 is not. A special tool will be necessary to disconnect fuel line after latch clip is removed. The
latch clip may be used on certain fuel line/fuel rail connection, or to join fuel lines together.
25. Type 2: Separate and unlatch small arms on end of clip and swing away from fuel line. 26.
Slide latch clip toward fuel rail while lifting with screwdriver.
27. Insert special fuel line removal tool (Snap-On number FIH 9055-1 or equivalent) into fuel line
(1). Use tool to release locking fingers in end of
line.
28. With special tool still inserted, pull fuel line from fuel rail. 29. After disconnection, locking fingers
will remain within quick-connect fitting at end of fuel line. 30. Disconnect quick-connect fitting from
fuel system component being serviced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3879
31. Wing Type: A special tool is not necessary to disconnect this type of fitting (2). This line is used
on different fuel and emission components. The
graphic shows the fitting used on an EVAP canister.
32. Use two fingers to push on fitting wings (2) 33. Pull and disconnect fitting while holding wings.
34. After disconnection, locking fingers will remain within quick-connect fitting.
CONNECTING
1. Inspect quick-connect fitting body and fuel system component for damage. Replace as
necessary. 2. Prior to connecting quick-connect fitting to component being serviced, check
condition of fitting and component. Clean parts with a lint-free cloth.
Lubricate with clean engine oil.
3. Insert quick-connect fitting into fuel tube or fuel system component until built-on stop on fuel tube
or component rests against back of fitting. 4. Continue pushing until a click is felt. 5. Single-tab type
fitting: Push new tab down until it locks into place in quick-connect fitting. 6. Verify a locked
condition by firmly pulling on fuel tube and fitting (15-30 lbs.). 7. Latch Clip Equipped: Install latch
clip (snaps into position). If latch clip will not fit, this indicates fuel line is not properly installed to
fuel rail
(or other fuel line). Recheck fuel line connection.
8. Connect negative cable to battery. 9. Start engine and check for leaks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
Fuel Flow
Leakdown
Less than 10 psi in 5 minutes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Checking the Fuel Delivery System
CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM
For a complete wiring diagram Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. FUEL PUMP OPERATION
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With a scan tool, actuate the Fuel System test.
NOTE: It may be necessary to use a mechanics stethoscope in the next step.
3. Listen for fuel pump operation at the fuel tank. The fuel pump should operate smoothly with no
excessive noise. If the pump has excessive noise
such as grinding, the pump should be replaced.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Does the Fuel Pump sound to be operate normally?
Yes
- Go to 2
No
- Go to 7
2. FUEL PRESSURE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Install a fuel pressure gauge. 3. Ignition on, engine not running. 4. With the scan tool, actuate the
Fuel Pump and observe the fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Choose a conclusion that best matches your fuel pressure reading.
Below Specification
- Go to 3
Within Specification
- Test Complete.
Above Specification
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3886
Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM Verification Test
3. RESTRICTED FUEL SUPPLY LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure even with the engine off. Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released.
2. Raise vehicle on hoist, and disconnect the fuel pressure line at the fuel pump module. 3. Install
special tool #6539 (5/16") or #6631(3/8") fuel line adapter and the fuel pressure gauge between the
fuel supply line and the fuel pump
module.
4. Ignition on, engine not running. 5. With the scan tool, actuate the Fuel Pump and observe the
fuel pressure gauge.
NOTE: Fuel pressure specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi).
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Is the fuel pressure within specification now?
Yes
- Repair/replace fuel supply line as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Go to 4
4. SADDLE FUEL TANK
Is the vehicle equipped with a saddle type fuel tank?
Yes
- Go to 5
No
- Go to 6
5. CHECKING FUEL TANK SIPHON HOSE AND FUEL LINE
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Gain access to the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. 3. Inspect the following fuel
components: Fuel line and siphon hose between the Fuel Pump Module and the Fuel Tank Module. Look for
disconnected and/or damaged lines or hoses.
- Fuel Pressure Regulator not properly seated in the module.
Were the above items in good working condition?
Yes
- Go to 6
No
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
6. CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP INLET
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3887
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Remove the Fuel Pump Module and Fuel Tank Module (if equipped), inspect the Fuel Inlet and
the bottom of the fuel tank for debris that could
cause the fuel pump inlet to be plugged.
Is the Fuel Pump Inlet plugged?
Yes
- Repair/Replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
7. FUEL PUMP MOTOR GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Disconnect the Fuel Pump Module harness connector. 3. Using a 12-volt
test light to battery voltage, probe the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit in the Fuel Pump Module
harness connector.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Does the test light illuminate brightly.
Yes
- Replace the Fuel Pump Module.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
No
- Repair the Fuel Pump Motor Ground circuit.
- Perform the PCM Verification TestSee: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3888
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pressure Leak Down
FUEL PRESSURE LEAK DOWN
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious
or fatal injury when performing this test
procedure. Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
- Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eye wear
and clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair / replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM GAS AND DIESEL FUEL
PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3889
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Fuel Inlet Hose 8978A-1 (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the Fuel
Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect the Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to the
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and serious possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir
Assembly 534960 (4) on the floor and out of
the way so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system: Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3890
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
2. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait 1 minute before
proceeding. 3. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 KPa ± 34 KPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4
fuel pressure specification is 552 KPa ± 34 KPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the Checking The Fuel Delivery System diagnostic procedure as directed. See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Checking the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAK DOWN
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Close the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1) and then wait five minutes before proceeding. 2. Read
the Fuel Inlet (2) and Fuel Outlet (3) Pressure Gauges. The pressure should not drop more than 10
psi on either gauge.
Does the fuel pressure drop more than 10 psi?
Yes - On Fuel Inlet Gauge (1)
- Replace the fuel pump module.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
Yes - On Fuel Outlet Gauge (2)
- Replace the leaking fuel injector(s).
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- If directed here by another test, return to that test. Otherwise, test complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3891
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Delivery System Output - Flow Test
FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT - FLOW TEST
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
WARNING: Follow these safety precautions to reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal
injury when performing this test procedure.
- Fuel or fuel vapors are highly flammable. A fire could occur if an ignition source is present. Do not
expose the fuel or the test equipment used in this procedure to open flames or sparks.
- Inhalation of fuel vapors could lead to disorientation and personal injury. Keep the service area
well ventilated, or perform this test procedure in an area where there is a building exhaust removal
system.
- Relieve fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components.
- Use extreme caution when connecting and disconnecting fuel lines.
Considerable fuel leakage may occur when servicing the fuel system. Wear protective eyewear and
clothing to protect from fuel splash, and take suitable fuel containment measures.
- Wrap a shop towel around the fuel pressure gauge connection to absorb fuel leakage that occurs
when connecting the test equipment. Place the towel in an approved container when complete.
- Never store fuel in an open container due to the possibility of fire or explosion. Have a dry
chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher nearby.
1. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM FOR LEAKS AND DAMAGE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Visually and physically inspect the fuel delivery system for external leaks and damage.
Is the system leaking or damaged?
Yes
- Repair or replace as necessary.
- Perform the PCM VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. INSTALL APPROPRIATE FUEL LINE ADAPTERS / FITTING FROM THE GAS AND DIESEL
FUEL PRESSURE/DECAY TESTER 8978A
1. Turn the ignition off.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
2. Disconnect the frame rail fuel supply line connector between the fuel supply line and the fuel rail.
3. Install the appropriate Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting from the Gas and Diesel Fuel Pressure/Decay
Tester 8978A.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3892
Proceed
- Go To 3
3. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE ASSEMBLY
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly 8978A-1 Fuel Inlet Hose (1) and Fuel Outlet Hose (2)
to the Fuel Line Adapters / Fitting. 2. Connect special tool Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3) to the
Fuel Pressure Gauge Assembly Drain Hose (5). 3. Connect Reservoir Assembly 534960 (4) to
Drain Extension Hose 535680 (3).
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and possible serious or fatal injury, place Reservoir Assembly
534960 (4) on the floor and out of the way
so that it is not a trip hazard.
Proceed
- Go To 4
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
Perform the following procedure to purge air from the system:
- Open the Fuel System Isolation Valve (1).
- Close the Flow Test Valve (2).
- Ignition on, engine not running.
- With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump.
- Open the Flow Test Valve (1) for 10 seconds, then close the Valve.
- CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Checking the Fuel Delivery System > Page 3893
- Turn the ignition off.
- Disconnect, empty and then reconnect the Reservoir Assembly.
1. Turn the ignition on, wait five seconds, turn the ignition off and then wait one minute before
proceeding. 2. Read the Fuel Pressure Gauge (3) and record the reading. Non SRT-4 fuel pressure
specification is 407 kPa ± 34 kPa (59 psi ± 5 psi). SRT-4 fuel
pressure specification is 552 kPa ± 34 kPa (80 psi ± 5 psi).
Is the fuel pressure within specifications?
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Checking
the Fuel Delivery System
5. CHECK FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM OUTPUT
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before testing
or servicing any fuel system hose, fitting, or
line, the fuel system pressure must be released. Failure to follow these instructions can result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Ignition on, engine not running. 2. With the scan tool, actuate the fuel pump. 3. Open the Flow
Test Valve (1) for 20 seconds, then close the Valve.
CAUTION: Stop All Actuations.
4. Turn the ignition off. 5. Measure the amount of fuel in the Reservoir Assembly (2). The fuel
output specification is ml/s X 20 seconds = fuel flow in ml.
Does the amount of fuel in the reservoir meet or exceed the specification?
Yes
- Test complete.
No
- Perform the CHECKING THE FUEL DELIVERY SYSTEM diagnostic procedure. See: Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Checking
the Fuel Delivery System
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Rail - Removal
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair Fuel Rail - Removal
3.5L
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before
servicing any part on the fuel system, the fuel
system pressure must be released.
1. Release fuel pressure See: Fuel Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect
and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Remove the upper intake manifold See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal.
4. Disconnect the quick connect fuel line from the fuel rail See: Fuel Line Coupler/Service and
Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Rail - Removal > Page 3898
NOTE: Mark fuel injector electrical harness connectors with correct corresponding cylinder
numbers.
5. Disconnect all fuel injector electrical connectors (1) from fuel injectors (2).
6. Remove fuel rail mounting bolts from fuel rail and lower intake manifold.
NOTE: Gently rock the fuel rail and injectors back and forth to loosen the seals on the fuel injectors
from the cylinder heads.
CAUTION: Do Not use excessive force or prying tools to remove fuel rail and injectors. Damage to
the fuel rail and injectors may result.
7. Lift fuel rail straight up off of the cylinder heads. 8. Drain any excess fuel from the fuel rail into an
approved fuel storage container.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Rail - Removal > Page 3899
NOTE: Mark or tag each fuel injector with correct corresponding cylinder numbers
9. Remove retaining clips (5) from fuel injectors (2) at fuel rail (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Rail - Removal > Page 3900
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair Fuel Rail - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: Inspect each O-ring seal on all the fuel injectors, replace O-ring seals if any damaged is
noted. Note the fuel injector O-rings are color
coded. The Blue colored O-ring is for the fuel rail side and the Green colored O-ring is cylinder
head side.
1. Install and lubricate each fuel injector O-rings (1), (3) with a light drop of clean engine oil. 2.
Install all of the fuel injectors (2) to the fuel rail (4), then install the retaining clips (5) to the fuel rail
(4).
3. Inspect each fuel injector for proper installation. Note how the retaining clip (3) secures the fuel
injector (1) to the fuel rail (2).
CAUTION: The fuel rail bolts are actually lower intake manifold bolts. These bolts must be torqued
in a mandatory torque sequence.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Rail - Removal > Page 3901
4. Insert fuel injector nozzles into openings in the cylinder heads. Seat the injectors in place. Install
the fuel rail bolts and tighten bolts in a mandatory
torque sequence to 28 Nm (20.5 ft. lbs.).
5. Correctly position and connect all fuel injector electrical connectors (1) to fuel injectors (2).
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel line quick connector is connected properly. Failure to connect the
fuel line correctly may result in a fuel leak at
the rail assembly. Fuel leaked onto a hot engine may ignite resulting in damage to the vehicle.
6. Connect quick connect fuel line to fuel rail See: Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair.
7. Install upper intake manifold See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service
and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation. 8. Connect the negative battery cable, tighten the nut to 5
Nm (45 in. lbs.). 9. Use the scan tool ASD Fuel System Test to pressurize the fuel system. Check
for leaks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tube(s) - Removal
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Fuel Tube(s) - Removal
3.5L
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly relieved from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system.
1. Release the fuel system pressure See: Fuel Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair. 2.
Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 3. Disconnect the fuel line quick connect fitting (2)
from the body mounted fuel line bundle See: Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair. 4. Disconnect
the fuel line quick connect fitting (3) from the fuel rail See: Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair.
5. Remove the fuel line (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tube(s) - Removal > Page 3906
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Fuel Tube(s) - Installation
3.5L
1. Install fuel line quick connect fitting (3) to fuel rail See: Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair. 2.
Install fuel line quick connect fitting (2) to body mounted fuel line bundle See: Fuel Line
Coupler/Service and Repair. 3. Connect the negative battery cable, tighten the nut to 5 Nm (45 in.
lbs.). 4. Use the scan tool ASD Fuel System Test to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Filler Neck: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 >
Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
Fuel Filler Neck: Customer Interest Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
NUMBER: 14-001-09 REV. A
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: September 1, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-001-09, DATED APRIL 15,
2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Hard To Fill With Fuel Or Fuel Nozzle Shuts Off Repeatedly
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2009 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2007 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2009 (DR) Ram Truck (1500 / 2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2005 - 2009 (ND) Dakota
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2009 (J1) Sebring (China CKD)
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Sebring Convertible/Avenger
2006 - 2009 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)
2007 - 2009 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2009 (KK) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (LC) Challenger
2004 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2007 (R2) Caravan/Voyager(CKD)
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Filler Neck: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 >
Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3916
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Filler Neck: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 >
Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3917
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Neck: > 14-001-09A >
Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
Fuel Filler Neck: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
NUMBER: 14-001-09 REV. A
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: September 1, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-001-09, DATED APRIL 15,
2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Hard To Fill With Fuel Or Fuel Nozzle Shuts Off Repeatedly
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2009 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2007 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2009 (DR) Ram Truck (1500 / 2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2005 - 2009 (ND) Dakota
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2009 (J1) Sebring (China CKD)
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Sebring Convertible/Avenger
2006 - 2009 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)
2007 - 2009 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2009 (KK) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (LC) Challenger
2004 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2007 (R2) Caravan/Voyager(CKD)
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Neck: > 14-001-09A >
Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3923
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Neck: > 14-001-09A >
Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3924
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Filler Neck: Service and Repair Removal
AWD
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable at battery. 2. Remove fuel cap. 3. Remove the
inner splash shield, See: Body and Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Removal. 4. Disconnect the quick connect fitting (1) and remove the
canister filter line See: Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair. 5. Disconnect the quick connect
fitting (2) and remove the recirculation line See: Fuel Line Coupler/Service and Repair. 6. Loosen
the hose clamp and remove the fuel filler tube (3) from the fuel tank.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3927
7. Remove filler tube mounting bracket bolt (1) from bracket (2) and body mount (3).
8. Remove fuel filler tube (2) from the fuel door housing assembly (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3928
Fuel Filler Neck: Service and Repair Installation
AWD
1. Install fuel filler tube (2) to the fuel door housing assembly (1).
2. Install fuel filler tube (3) to the fuel tank. Tighten hose clamp to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.). 3. Install the
recirculation line quick connect fitting (2) to the fuel tank. 4. Install the canister filter line quick
connect fitting (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3929
5. Install filler tube mounting bracket (2) and bolt (1) to the body mount (3). Tighten to 11.5 Nm
(101 in. lbs.). 6. Install the inner splash shield, See: Body and Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front
Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Installation. 7. Install fuel cap. 8. Connect
negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3935
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3936
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 4 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way > Page 3939
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C2 (AWD) (Fuel Tank Jumper) 2 Way
Connector C2 (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module contains the electric fuel pump, fuel pump
reservoir, fuel level sending unit, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter.
The fuel level sending unit is serviceable See: Service and Repair/Removal.
The fuel pump module, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter is serviced as an
assembly See: Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel pump modules.
The AWD fuel pump modules contains the main fuel pump module (1), auxiliary fuel pump module
(2), main fuel level sending unit, auxiliary fuel level sending unit, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure
regulator and fuel filter.
The main fuel level sending unit is located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Service and Repair/Removal. The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary
fuel pump module and is serviced as an assembly See: Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 3942
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Operation
OPERATION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module is located inside the fuel tank with a fuel level
sending unit and pressure regulator. The fuel pump module is a positive displacement, gerotor,
driven by a 12 volt DC permanent magnet electric motor.
The fuel pump module draws fuel through a internal filter and pushes it through the motor to an
outlet pipe. The fuel pump module contains two check valves. One valve relieves internal fuel
pump pressure and regulates maximum pump output. The second valve, in the pump outlet,
maintains pump pressure during engine off conditions.
The fuel pump pressure regulator contains a calibrated spring which forces a diaphragm against
the fuel filter return port. When pressure exceeds the calibrated amount, the diaphragm retracts,
allowing excess fuel pressure in the fuel pump module to purge into the fuel tank.
The maximum deadhead pressure is approximately 880 kPa (130 psi). The fuel pump pressure
regulator adjusts fuel system pressure to approximately 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi).
AWD
Operation of the all wheel drive (AWD) main fuel pump module is similar to the FWD with the
addition of a auxiliary fuel pump module with a auxiliary fuel level sending unit and draws fuel from
the base of the auxiliary fuel pump module (2) through an internal tube.
The auxiliary fuel pump module flow rate is greater than the vehicle fuel consumption rate so that
the auxiliary side of the tank is emptied before fuel is depleted from the primary side.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 3943
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles have a serviceable fuel level sending unit located on the fuel
pump reservoir See: Service and Repair/Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel level sending units.
The main fuel level sending unit located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Service and Repair/Removal.
The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module. The
auxiliary fuel pump module and the fuel level sending unit is serviced as an assembly See: Service
and Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Removal
REMOVAL
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank Removal.
NOTE: Prior to removing the main fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel tank
opening.
2. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 3. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 4. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
5. Mark the main fuel pump module orientation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3946
WARNING: The fuel pump module reservoir does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir will spill out when the
module is removed.
NOTE: Do not spill fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
6. Raise the main fuel pump module out of the fuel tank using caution not spill fuel inside the
vehicle.
7. Tip the main fuel pump module and drain enough fuel from the main fuel pump module reservoir
to gain access to the internal fuel line without
spilling fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
8. If equipped with AWD, disconnect the internal fuel line from the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3947
9. Remove the main fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
10. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3948
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank Removal.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
2. Mark the auxiliary fuel pump module orientation (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing the auxiliary fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel
tank opening.
3. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 4. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 5. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
6. Raise the auxiliary fuel pump module and disconnect the internal fuel line. 7. Remove the
auxiliary fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3949
8. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3950
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. If equipped with AWD, Connect the internal fuel line to the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3951
3. Lower the main fuel pump module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the main fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be performed for
the fuel level gauge to work properly.
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the main fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank - Installation.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3952
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. Connect the internal fuel line to the auxiliary fuel pump module. 3. Lower the auxiliary fuel pump
module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the auxiliary fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be
performed for the fuel gauge to work properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3953
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the auxiliary fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3954
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel. Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked and approved containers.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Remove the fuel pump module See: Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
2. Disconnect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector (1).
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not pull the fuel level sending unit by the wires or the float arm.
3. Using your finger, press the fuel level sending unit snap tab to the left while gently pushing up on
the bottom of the fuel level sending unit and
remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3955
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not handle the new fuel level sending unit by the float arm.
1. Position the new fuel level sending unit to the fuel pump module reservoir.
2. Gently push the fuel level sending unit down until the snap tab (2) engages.
CAUTION: Ensure the fuel level sending unit wires are routed so they do not get pinched between
the coils of the spring when the module is
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 3956
completely compressed.
3. Connect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector. 4. Install the fuel pump module See:
Fuel Pump Module - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Vent >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Tank Vent: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 >
Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
Fuel Tank Vent: Customer Interest Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
NUMBER: 14-001-09 REV. A
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: September 1, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-001-09, DATED APRIL 15,
2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Hard To Fill With Fuel Or Fuel Nozzle Shuts Off Repeatedly
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2009 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2007 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2009 (DR) Ram Truck (1500 / 2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2005 - 2009 (ND) Dakota
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2009 (J1) Sebring (China CKD)
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Sebring Convertible/Avenger
2006 - 2009 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)
2007 - 2009 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2009 (KK) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (LC) Challenger
2004 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2007 (R2) Caravan/Voyager(CKD)
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Vent >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Tank Vent: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 >
Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3965
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Vent >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Tank Vent: > 14-001-09A > Sep > 09 >
Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3966
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Vent >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Tank Vent: > 14-001-09A >
Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
Fuel Tank Vent: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off
NUMBER: 14-001-09 REV. A
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: September 1, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-001-09, DATED APRIL 15,
2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Hard To Fill With Fuel Or Fuel Nozzle Shuts Off Repeatedly
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2009 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2007 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2009 (DR) Ram Truck (1500 / 2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2005 - 2009 (ND) Dakota
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2009 (J1) Sebring (China CKD)
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Sebring Convertible/Avenger
2006 - 2009 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)
2007 - 2009 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2009 (KK) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (LC) Challenger
2004 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2007 (R2) Caravan/Voyager(CKD)
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Vent >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Tank Vent: > 14-001-09A >
Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3972
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2009 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2009 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to all vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.
DISCUSSION:
Customer may report that the vehicle is hard to fill with fuel or that the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
repeatedly while trying to fill vehicle.
This customer complaint can occur due to a number of different causes. The fuel tank is the least
likely cause of this condition. The following Diagnostic procedure can be used to diagnose the
issues.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Is the vehicle a LX/LE/LC/L2?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 2
b. No >> proceed to Step # 4
2. Idle the vehicle 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping.
3. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> proceed to Step # 4
b. Yes >> Inform the customer to idle the vehicle for 60 to 90 seconds upon stopping if vehicle was
driven aggressively. This is due to the fact that
on the LX/LE/LC/L2 the fuel tank is a unique saddle tank design and needs 30 to 60 seconds while
the engine is running to level the fuel in both half's of the fuel tank. Allowing the vehicle to idle for
this amount of time will let the fuel pump transfer fuel to the left side tank, opening the control valve
and allowing normal fuel filling.
4. Disconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
5. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
6. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 11.
7. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
8. Disconnect the other end of the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel filler tube.
9. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
10. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Replace fuel filler tube.
b. No >> Replace the vapor recirculation tube.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Vent >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Tank Vent: > 14-001-09A >
Sep > 09 > Fuel System - Difficult Fuel Fill/Nozzle Shuts Off > Page 3973
11. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
12. Reconnect the vapor recirculation tube at the fuel tank.
13. Does tank refill properly?
a. No >> Replace Fuel Tank.
b. Yes >> Proceed to
14. Reconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the fuel tank.
15. Disconnect the control valve to EVAP canister tube at the EVAP canister.
16. Attempt to refill fuel tank.
17. Does tank refill properly?
a. Yes >> Blockage is in the EVAP Canister, or ESIM, or Clean air hose (ESIM vent hose), or filter.
Diagnose appropriately.
b. No >> Replace the control valve to EVAP canister tube.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto Shutdown Relay > Page 3978
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto Shutdown Relay > Page 3979
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-AUTO SHUT DOWN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 3982
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams PCM Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-PCM - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Position an oil collecting container under switch location. 3. Disconnect
electrical connector (1). 4. Remove the oil pressure switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Pressure Switch - Removal > Page 3987
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Thread Sealant to the switch threads. 2. Install oil pressure switch (2). 3.
Connect electrical connector (1). 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Start engine and check for leaks. 6. Check
engine oil level and adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto Shutdown
Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto Shutdown
Relay > Page 3993
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Auto Shutdown
Relay > Page 3994
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto Shutdown
Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams Auto Shutdown Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-AUTO SHUT DOWN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Diagrams > Auto Shutdown
Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 3997
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams PCM Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-PCM - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4002
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 6 WAY
SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil
Pressure Switch - Removal
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Position an oil collecting container under switch location. 3. Disconnect
electrical connector (1). 4. Remove the oil pressure switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil
Pressure Switch - Removal > Page 4007
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair Oil Pressure Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Thread Sealant to the switch threads. 2. Install oil pressure switch (2). 3.
Connect electrical connector (1). 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Start engine and check for leaks. 6. Check
engine oil level and adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations
Throttle Body: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4011
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4012
Throttle Body: Diagrams
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 6 WAY
THROTTLE BODY (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body - Removal
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Throttle Body - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable at battery. 2. Remove engine cover. 3. Remove
clean air hose from throttle body. 4. Disconnect electrical connector (1) from throttle body.
5. Remove nut (1) form throttle body bracket (2). 6. Remove bolt (3) and throttle body bracket (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body - Removal > Page 4015
7. Remove bolts (2), stud (1) and remove throttle body from intake manifold.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body - Removal > Page 4016
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Throttle Body - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: Make sure the intake gasket is clean and free of debris. Inspect the intake gasket for
damage. Replace as necessary.
CAUTION: DO NOT OVER TORQUE. Over tightening can cause damage to the throttle body,
gaskets, bolts and/or the intake manifold.
1. Install throttle body, gasket and bolts to intake manifold. 2. Install throttle body and three throttle
body bolts (2), and stud (1). Hand tighten the three bolts and one stud.
CAUTION: The throttle body must be torqued in a mandatory torque sequence. Tighten in a criss cross pattern to specification.
3. Tighten the three bolts and one stud in a mandatory torque criss - cross pattern sequence to 5.5
Nm (50 in. lbs.).
4. Install throttle body bracket (2), nut (1) and bolt (3). Tighten nut (1) to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.).
Tighten bolt (3) to 28 Nm (20.5 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body - Removal > Page 4017
5. Connect electrical connector (1) to throttle body. 6. Install clean air hose to throttle body. 7.
Install engine cover. 8. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.). 9. Use a
scan tool and perform the ETC RELEARN function.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Variable Induction Control Solenoid: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4022
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4023
Variable Induction Control Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (3.5L) - (ENGINE) 6 WAY
SOLENOID-SHORT RUNNER VALVE (3.5L) - (ENGINE) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 4027
Variable Induction Control Valve: Diagrams
Connector (3.5L) - (ENGINE) 6 WAY
SOLENOID-MANIFOLD TUNING VALVE (3.5L) - (ENGINE) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Variable Induction Control Valve: Service and Repair Removal
Short Runner Valve
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. 2. Remove engine cover. 3. Unlock and disconnect electrical
connector. 4. Remove four mounting screws. 5. Remove Short Runner Valve.
6. Remove and inspect o-ring.
Manifold Tuning Valve
3.5L
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4030
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the electrical
connector. 4. Remove the 4 mounting bolts.
5. Pull manifold tune valve (MTV) straight out of manifold.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4031
6. Be sure the O-ring (1) is still in place on the MTV shaft. If not, refer to the following step.
7. If O-ring is not on MTV shaft (from previous step), gently pry it (1) from intake manifold.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4032
Variable Induction Control Valve: Service and Repair Installation
Short Runner Valve
INSTALLATION
1. Install o-ring.
2. Align tab on valve to slot in manifold and install. 3. Install mounting screws. 4. Tighten bolts to
2.8 Nm (25 in. lbs.). 5. Connect electrical connector and lock. 6. Install engine cover. 7. Connect
negative battery cable.
Manifold Tuning Valve
3.5L
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4033
NOTE: Inspect the O-ring and gasket for the manifold tune valve replace if damaged.
1. Install a new O-ring and gasket to the manifold tune valve, if necessary. 2. Install the manifold
tuning valve. 3. Make sure that the alignment pin and notch line up.
4. Install bolts and tighten. 5. Connect the electrical connector. 6. Install the engine cover. 7.
Connect negative battery cable and tighten to 16.5 Nm (145 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
FIRING ORDER
2.4L
The firing order is 1-3-4-2.
3.5L
The firing order is 1-2-3-4-5-6.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L) > Page 4042
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4043
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CAMSHAFT 1/1 POSITION (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4044
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT AND CRANKSHAFT SIGNALS
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at battery. 2. Disconnect electrical connector
(3) from camshaft position (CMP) sensor (2). 3. Remove bolt (1) and CMP sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page 4047
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Install camshaft position (CMP) sensor utilizing twisting motion. Make sure CMP sensor
is fully seated. Do not drive CMP sensor
into the bore with mounting screw. This may cause CMP sensor to be incorrectly seated causing a
faulty signal or no signal at all.
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the CMP sensor (2) into the timing belt cover with a twisting motion until fully seated. 2.
While holding the sensor (2) in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt (1) to 12 Nm (106
in. lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector (3) to the CMP sensor (2). 4. Connect the
negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Locations
Condenser: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4051
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4052
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4053
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4054
Condenser: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
CAPACITOR-IGNITION 1 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Ignition Capacitor - Removal
Condenser: Service and Repair Ignition Capacitor - Removal
3.5L
The ignition capacitor is located on the drivers side of the engine.
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable at battery. 2. Remove electrical connector (3). 3.
Remove mounting bolt (1) and ignition capacitor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Ignition Capacitor - Removal > Page 4057
Condenser: Service and Repair Ignition Capacitor - Installation
3.5L
1. Install ignition coil capacitor (2) and bolt (1). 2. Tighten bolt to 28 Nm (20.5 ft. lbs.). 3. Connect
electrical connector (3). 4. Connect negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4061
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4062
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor is located on the driver side of the vehicle, above the
differential housing. The bottom of the sensor sits
above the drive plate.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the electrical
connector from the crankshaft position sensor. 3. Remove the sensor mounting screw and the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page 4065
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor into the transmission case with a twisting motion until
fully seated.
CAUTION: Before tightening the sensor mounting bolt, be sure the sensor is completely flush to the
mounting surface. If the sensor is not
flush, damage to the sensor mounting tang may result.
2. While holding the sensor in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the CKP sensor. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications
Ignition Coil: Specifications
IGNITION RESISTANCE
IGNITION COIL RESISTANCE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) > Page 4071
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) > Page 4072
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) > Page 4073
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) > Page 4074
Ignition Coil: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) > Page 4075
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) > Page 4076
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) > Page 4077
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) > Page 4078
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) > Page 4079
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way
Ignition Coil: Diagrams Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
COIL-IGNITION 1 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way > Page 4082
Ignition Coil: Diagrams Ignition Coil 2 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
COIL-IGNITION 2 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way > Page 4083
Ignition Coil: Diagrams Ignition Coil 3 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
COIL-IGNITION 3 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way > Page 4084
Ignition Coil: Diagrams Ignition Coil 4 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
COIL-IGNITION 4 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way > Page 4085
Ignition Coil: Diagrams
Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
COIL-IGNITION 1 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Ignition Coil 2 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
COIL-IGNITION 2 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way > Page 4086
Ignition Coil 3 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
COIL-IGNITION 3 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Ignition Coil 4 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way > Page 4087
COIL-IGNITION 4 (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Ignition Coil 5 (2.7L/3.5L) 3 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
COIL-IGNITION 5 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Ignition Coil 6 (2.7L/3.5L) 3 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Coil 1 (Gas) (Engine) 3 Way > Page 4088
COIL-IGNITION 6 (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4089
Ignition Coil: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING THE IGNITION COIL OPERATION
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
1. IGNITION COIL WIRING OR CONNECTORS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4090
NOTE: Diagnose and repair any ignition coil, CMP sensor, or CKP sensor DTCs before proceeding
with this test.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and
connectors between the Ignition Coil for the cylinder being tested and the
PCM.
3. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 4. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals.
NOTE: If the vehicle is not equipped with the coil on plug ignition system, check the resistance of
the ignition wire(s) before checking the
cylinder with a spark tester. The resistance should be below 10k Ohms.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- Go To 2
2. IGNITION COIL OPERATION
NOTE: Inspect the ignition coil for damage, carbon tracking on the coil or a damaged spark plug
insulator boot. If a problem is found,
replace the ignition coil.
NOTE: 6.1L coils must have a spark tester installed on both sides of the coil during the following
test. During the test, each side of the coil
should output a crisp blue spark that is able to jump the gap of the spark tester.
NOTE: On the 2.7 and 3.5 engines, cylinders 1, 3 and 5, it is necessary to remove the upper intake
manifold to access the ignition coils. Once
the ignition coil has been removed, the intake must be installed in order to crank the engine. Move
the ignition coil harness connector through the slots in the upper intake and then connect the coil to
the harness connector. Secure the upper intake to the lower intake.
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with coil on plug ignition system, remove the
ignition coil for the cylinder being tested. 3. Disconnect the fuel injector harness connector for the
cylinder being tested. 4. For coil on plug ignition systems, install a spark tester(s) on the ignition
coil, otherwise install the spark tester to the ignition wire. 5. While cranking the engine observe the
spark coming from the spark tester.
NOTE: A crisp blue spark that jumps the gap of the spark tester should be generated.
Is good spark present?
Yes
- Go To 7
No
- Go To 3
3. MAIN/ASD RELAY OUTPUT CIRCUIT OPEN OR HIGH RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Disconnect the Ignition Coil harness connector. 3. Turn the ignition on. 4.
With the scan tool, actuate the Main/ASD Relay to on. 5. Using a 12-volt test light connected to
ground, check the Main/ASD Relay output circuit in the ignition coil harness connector.
NOTE: The test light should be illuminated and bright. Compare the brightness to that of a direct
connection to the battery.
Is the test light illuminated and bright during the actuation?
Yes
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4091
- Go To 4
No
- Repair the Main/ASD Relay output circuit for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
4. IGNITION COIL
WARNING: When the engine is operating, do not stand in direct line with the fan. Do not put your
hands near the pulleys, belts or fan. Do not
wear loose clothing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Using a 12-volt test light connected to 12 volts, check the Ignition Coil control circuit for the
cylinder being tested in the Ignition Coil harness
connector.
2. Crank the engine for 5 seconds.
NOTE: The test light should blink each time the circuit is activated by the PCM.
Does the test light blink each time the circuit is activated by the PCM?
Yes
- Replace the Ignition Coil.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- Go To 5
5. IGNITION COIL CONTROL CIRCUIT OPEN OR HIGH RESISTANCE
CAUTION: Do not probe the PCM harness connectors. Probing the PCM harness connectors will
damage the PCM terminals, resulting in
poor terminal to pin connection. Install PCM Pinout Box 8815 to perform diagnosis.
1. Measure the resistance of the Ignition Coil control circuit for the cylinder being tested between
the Ignition Coil harness connector and the
appropriate terminal of PCM Pinout Box 8815.
Is the resistance below 5.0 Ohms?
Yes
- Go To 6
No
- Repair the Ignition Coil control circuit for an open circuit or high resistance.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
6. POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
1. Using the wiring diagram/schematic as a guide, inspect the wiring and connectors between the
Ignition Coil for the cylinder being tested and the
PCM.
2. Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires. 3. Look for broken, bent, pushed
out or corroded terminals. 4. Perform any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Repair as necessary.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4092
No
- Replace and program the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
- Perform the PCM Verification Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
7. SPARK PLUG(S)
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Remove the spark plug.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with 5.7L or 6.1L engines must have both spark plugs (per cylinder)
removed and inspected to ensure proper
operation.
3. Inspect the spark plug for any of the following conditions: Cracks or damage
- Carbon tracking
- Foreign material
- Gap not within specification
- Loose or broken electrode
NOTE: Lightly tap the bottom of the spark plug on a solid surface. The electrode in the spark plug
should not move.
Were any problems found?
Yes
- Replace the spark plug.
- Perform the PCM Verification Test.See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/PCM
Verification Test.
No
- Test Complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Ignition Coil - Removal
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair Ignition Coil - Removal
3.5L
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 3. Remove the
upper intake manifold See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and
Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal.
4. Unlock and disconnect electrical connector (2) from ignition coils. 5. Remove mounting bolts and
engine cover studs (1).
CAUTION: Prior to removing the ignition coils, spray compressed air around the coils and spark
plugs. If dirt and debris enter the engine, this
may cause internal engine damage.
6. Twist, lift and remove ignition coil from engine.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Ignition Coil - Removal > Page 4095
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair Ignition Coil - Installation
3.5L
1. Install ignition coil (1).
2. Install engine cover studs (1) in the two outside ignition coils on the front of the engine. Install
bolts on the other ignition coils. 3. Tighten studs and bolts to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
4. Connect electrical connector and lock (2). 5. Install intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation. 6. Connect
negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.). 7. Install engine cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4099
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4100
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-KNOCK (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold, See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the knock sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal > Page 4103
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Always use the specified torque when installing the knock sensor bolt. Over or under
tightening the sensor mounting bolt will
affect knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper spark control.
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 2. Route the knock sensor wire
in the proper location. 3. Install upper intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation.
4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1/1 (2.4L/3.5L) > Page 4109
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4110
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CAMSHAFT 1/1 POSITION (2.4L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4111
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT AND CRANKSHAFT SIGNALS
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at battery. 2. Disconnect electrical connector
(3) from camshaft position (CMP) sensor (2). 3. Remove bolt (1) and CMP sensor (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Position Sensor - Removal > Page
4114
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Install camshaft position (CMP) sensor utilizing twisting motion. Make sure CMP sensor
is fully seated. Do not drive CMP sensor
into the bore with mounting screw. This may cause CMP sensor to be incorrectly seated causing a
faulty signal or no signal at all.
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the CMP sensor (2) into the timing belt cover with a twisting motion until fully seated. 2.
While holding the sensor (2) in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt (1) to 12 Nm (106
in. lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector (3) to the CMP sensor (2). 4. Connect the
negative battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4118
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION (GAS) - (ENGINE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4119
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
4 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
NOTE: The graphic represents the relationship between camshaft and crankshaft sensors edges
with camshafts in "lock pin" position (cam
shafts are not "phasing"). This is normally seen during idle.
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 4 cylinder engines.
6 CYLINDER CAM AND CRANK SIGNALS
Depiction of good camshaft and crankshaft square wave signals for 6 cylinder engines.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal
3.5L
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor is located on the driver side of the vehicle, above the
differential housing. The bottom of the sensor sits
above the drive plate.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Unlock and disconnect the electrical
connector from the crankshaft position sensor. 3. Remove the sensor mounting screw and the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor - Removal >
Page 4122
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor - Installation
3.5L
NOTE: If reinstalling the sensor, check the sensor O-ring for damage and replace if necessary.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil
before installing the sensor.
1. Push the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor into the transmission case with a twisting motion until
fully seated.
CAUTION: Before tightening the sensor mounting bolt, be sure the sensor is completely flush to the
mounting surface. If the sensor is not
flush, damage to the sensor mounting tang may result.
2. While holding the sensor in this position, install and tighten the retaining bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.). 3. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the CKP sensor. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable and tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Locations
Ignition Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4126
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4129
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4130
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4131
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4132
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4133
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4134
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4135
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4136
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4137
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4138
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4139
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4140
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4141
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4142
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4143
Ignition Switch: Connector Views
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) (1). The WIN and the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch (5) located on the face of the instrument panel just to
the inboard side of the steering column.
The WIN housing is constructed of molded black plastic and it includes four integral mounting
bosses (4), which are secured to the instrument panel structure with screws. Two connector
receptacles are integral to the back of the switch housing. One (3) connects the WIN to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The other (2) is a dedicated connector for the coaxial cable input from the optional remote start
system external antenna module.
The WIN is an integrated electronic receiver that replaces the ignition switch. It communicates with
other electronic modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF)
communication. It also communicates with the TPM trigger transponders (if equipped) and steering
column lock module (if equipped) using a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus connection.
The WIN provides a switched 12-volt source through an isolated switch for the steering column lock
module required for certain export market vehicles. It also contains a key removal inhibit solenoid,
an electronic Brake Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI) solenoid, a key-in warning contact and it
serves as the real time vehicle clock by transmitting the clock information to other electronic
modules over the CAN data bus.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged, the
entire WIN must be replaced. When replacing the WIN, you must also replace the steering column
lock module (if equipped).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description >
Page 4146
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Operation
OPERATION
Following are brief descriptions of the systems that the WIN controls.
IGNITION SWITCH
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) incorporates an integral ignition switch that consists of four rotary
positions with three detent positions and one spring-loaded position. The one extreme clockwise
position is a spring-loaded momentary contact "START" position. When released from the "START"
position, the switch will automatically return to the detent "ON" position. The other position includes
a detent "ACCESSORY" position and a detent "LOCK" position.
The WIN reads the position of the ignition switch and transmits the data via the CAN data bus.
These positions include "LOCK" with ignition key-out, "LOCK" with ignition key-in,
"ACCESSORY,""RUN," and "START."
SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM (SKIS)
Upon failure of proper Sentry Key Immobilizer (SKIS) communication to the Powertrain Control
Module, (PCM), the PCM will not allow the vehicle to crank. The engine will not re-crank on the key
cycle that the failure occurred, a full key down sequence must be performed for the engine to crank
again. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Description and
Operation/Vehicle Theft Security System - Operation.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE)
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), transmitter uses Radio Frequency (RF) signals to communicate
with the WIN, and the WIN relays the RKE requests to other modules in the vehicle over the CAN
data bus. See: Body and Frame/Locks/Power Locks/Description and Operation/Power Locks Operation
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING (TPM)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system uses radio and sensor technology to monitor tire air
pressure levels. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Tire Monitoring
System/Description and Operation/Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) - Operation.
REMOTE START WITH/EXTENDED RANGE ANTENNA
Further information concerning the Remote Start System. See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Keyless Entry/Keyless Starting System/Description and
Operation/Starting System - Operation
BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFTER INTERLOCK (BTSI)
The Brake Transmission Shifter/Ignition Interlock (BTSI) is controlled by the WIN. The BTSI
prevents the transmission gear shifter from being moved out of PARK without a driver in place.
PARK SHIFT INTERLOCK
The key removal inhibit solenoid internal to the WIN prevents the FOB with Integrated KEY
(FOBIK) from being rotated in the ignition switch to the LOCK position for all vehicles with an
automatic transmission unless the transmission shift lever is in the PARK position. The WIN
module monitors a hard wired input from a switch integral to the automatic transmission shifter
module to control this feature. The key removal inhibit solenoid is electronically disabled internally
by the WIN on vehicles with a manual transmission.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description >
Page 4147
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Ignition Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN). The WIN, along with the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch located on the face of the instrument panel just to the
inboard side of the steering column. The remainder of the WIN including its mounting provisions
and electrical connections are concealed within the instrument panel.
In addition to replacing a conventional keyed ignition switch, the WIN is an integrated electronic
receiver that serves as the base station in the vehicle. It communicates with other electronic
modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF) RF
communication.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged the
entire WIN must be replaced See: Service and Repair/Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ignition Switch: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
FOBIK TRAPPED IN WIN
The Fob with Integrated Key (FOBIK) cannot be rotated to the LOCK position, allowing it to be
removed from the ignition switch also referred to as the Wireless Ignition Node/WIN. The automatic
transmission or transaxle is shifted mechanically through a cable from the gearshift lever
mechanism to the transmission or transaxle valve body. A gated park switch is physically located
on and integral to the gearshift lever mechanism and is hard wired directly to the WIN. The gated
park switch is a simple plunger-like actuated open or closed contact switch that could be
considered redundant to the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) except that it monitors the position
selected with the gearshift lever, while the TRS monitors the position or gear of the transmission or
transaxle that is actually engaged. A damaged or improperly adjusted gearshift cable could result in
a different gear being engaged than that which is selected. The WIN uses the gated park switch
input to control an internal key lock solenoid, which controls whether the FOBIK can be rotated to
the LOCK position. When the gearshift lever is not in the PARK position, the gated park switch is a
closed circuit, the key lock solenoid is energized and the FOBIK cannot be rotated to the LOCK
position for removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the lower instrument panel knee
blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker - Removal. 3.
Remove upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument cluster bezel, reposition the instrument, and remove the upper WIN
bracket attaching screw (1). See: Instrument Panel,
Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster
- Removal.
5. Disconnect the WIN electrical connector (1) and the antenna connector (3) from the WIN. 6.
Utilize a trim stick or equivalent and gently pry WIN trim ring (2) away from the instrument panel. 7.
Remove the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 8. Remove the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 4152
9. Rotate the WIN (1) and (2) bracket to assist in removal from the instrument panel.
10. Remove the WIN from the instrument panel opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 4153
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The WIN initialization procedure is required whenever the WIN or shaft lock module is
replaced on vehicles equipped with the shaft
lock module.
1. Rotate and position the WIN (1) and bracket (2) into the to instrument panel opening.
2. Install the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4). 3. Install the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 4.
Connect the WIN electrical connector (1) and antenna connector (3) to the WIN. 5. Install the WIN
trim ring (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 4154
6. Install the upper WIN bracket attaching screw (1) and reposition the instrument cluster into the
instrument panel and install the instrument cluster
bezel. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service
and Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
8. Install knee blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker Installation. 9. Connect negative battery cable.
10. If necessary, program the WIN, See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4158
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4159
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-KNOCK (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold, See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Removal. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the knock sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knock Sensor - Removal > Page 4162
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair Knock Sensor - Installation
3.5L
CAUTION: Always use the specified torque when installing the knock sensor bolt. Over or under
tightening the sensor mounting bolt will
affect knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper spark control.
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 2. Route the knock sensor wire
in the proper location. 3. Install upper intake manifold, See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Intake Manifold/Service and Repair/Intake Manifold - Installation.
4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head cover(s). See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Cylinder Head
Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder
Head Cover(s) - Removal
2. Using suitable locking pliers, remove the tube (1) from the cylinder head and discard tube. 3.
Clean area around spark plug with Mopar(R) Parts Cleaner or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4168
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar(R) Stud and Bearing Mount to a new tube (1) approximately 1 mm (0.039 in.) from
the end of tube, in a 3 mm (0.118 in.) wide area. 2. Install sealer end of tube (1) into the cylinder
head. Then carefully install the tube (1) using a hardwood block and mallet. Install the tube (1) until
it is seated into the bottom of the bore.
3. For spark plug tube (1) seal replacement, See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Cylinder Head Cover(s) - Removal.
4. Install cylinder head cover(s). See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Cylinder Head
Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and Repair/Cylinder Head
Cover(s) - Installation - INSTALLATION)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4175
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4178
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
NOTE: Keep the Top Sound Dampener Cover if replacing the unit
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4179
10. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
11. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
12. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 13. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4180
14. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
15. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 16. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 17.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
18. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 19. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 20. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4181
21. Remove the bolts (1) at the line pressure sensor. 22. Remove the line pressure sensor from the
valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4182
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the line pressure
sensor and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle on a hoist.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4183
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise the vehicle on the hoist.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4184
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and install the fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4185
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4186
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter
Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4187
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4188
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove the shift cable (1) from the manual lever (2).
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
10. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4189
11. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
12. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
13. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 14. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4190
15. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
16. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 17. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 18.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
19. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 20. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 21. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4191
22. Remove the bolt (1) at the pressure control solenoid. 23. Remove the pressure control sensor
from the valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4192
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the pressure control solenoid on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the pressure
control solenoid and tighten to 6 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4193
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise and support the vehicle.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4194
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan.
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4195
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4196
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter
Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4200
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve
Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal > Page 4203
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center floor console to access the
gear selector unit. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center Console - Removal.
3. Firmly grasp the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing and rotate it
counterclockwise about 30 degrees to unlock it. 4. Pull the socket and bulb straight out from the
keyed opening in the shifter housing. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the socket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal > Page 4210
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing. 2. Push
the bulb straight into the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the
keyed opening in the side of the gear selector housing. 4. Insert the bulb and socket into the
housing until the socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it
into place. 6. Reinstall the center floor console. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center Console - Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4214
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 3 WAY
LAMP-PRNDL - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Quick Learn Procedure
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Quick Learn Procedure > Page 4221
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4226
Control Module: Diagrams
Connector (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
MODULE-ALL WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
The AWD ECM (electronic control module) mounts on the driver side cowl side panel, where it is
concealed by the instrument panel. It communicates with other systems over the high-speed
CAN-C bus.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description > Page 4229
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The all-wheel-drive system requires no driver input or control. Under most driving conditions, it is
passive and power is transmitted to the front wheels alone. The system functions to optimize
traction and handling under the following conditions:
Anticipates slip by responding to pedal position unlike all-wheel drive systems that rely on pumps
or viscous fluids to transfer torque, the system requires no front-to-rear slippage for activation. This
allows the system to transfer torque in response to accelerator pedal position. If the driver is asking
for a lot of power, the system immediately starts clamping the Electronically Controlled Coupling
(ECC), transferring a high percentage of power to the rear wheels. This avoids front wheel
slippage, as power to propel the car is transmitted through all four tires. This mode of operation is
called open-loop operation in that there is no feedback to affect the torque transfer.
Modulates torque to optimize traction on slippery surfaces a second, closed loop, operating mode
uses feedback from the wheel-speed sensors to determine the appropriate torque transfer. When
the front wheels slip, the all-wheel-drive electronic control module tells the ECC to start clamping,
sending power to the rear wheels. Attempting the same aggressive launch described above with
the front wheels on ice and the rear wheels on dry pavement, the ECC sends even more torque to
the rear wheels to minimize slippage and launch the vehicle. Both modes are always active and the
maximum of the two is chosen. Power to the rear wheels is modulated during lost of traction while
traveling at freeway speeds; for example, hydroplaning on a puddle of water, will send very little
power to the rear wheels because the controller knows at those speeds a lot of power is not
needed at the rear wheels.
Prevents binding during low-speed turns a third condition, which is independent of the others, uses
the ESP steering angle sensor to determine when the vehicle is turning in a tight circle. This
condition causes the electronic control module to reduce torque to the rear wheels to prevent
binding in the driveline. The electronic control module is always checking for this condition as well.
Influences handling at moderate speeds. The AWD system is used to influence vehicle dynamics.
Other manufacturers limit AWD to aiding traction or providing off-road capability. They concentrate
on launching the vehicle or going off road at speeds up to about 25 mph (40 km/hr). Above that
speed range, they use it to limit wheel slip for traction. Additional ECM calibration controls torque to
the rear wheels for improved handling in the 25-65 mph (40-105 km/hr) range. In this speed range,
the system utilizes torque to the rear wheels during cornering with the throttle open to make the car
turn more easily - make the handling more neutral. This is more readily accomplished with an
electronically controlled system, than with viscous-coupling or gerotor systems that require some
degree of front-to-rear slip to transfer torque to the rear wheels. Above 53 mph (113 km/hr), the
control strategy
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description > Page 4230
provides minimal torque to the rear wheels under normal driving conditions to aid fuel economy.
Works with ESP and Traction Control the electronic control module also interfaces with the ESP
and traction control systems. The interface allows the ESP system to use the ECC to help gain
control of the vehicle. For this purpose, torque transmitted to the rear wheels by the ECC can be
reduced. The AWD system is not traction control. It only works on situations where front-to-rear
traction varies, for instance, front wheels on ice, rear wheels on dry pavement or climbing steep
grades. AWD does not aid side-to-side traction. ESP does that through brake intervention.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive Control Module - Removal
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the left front trim panel. 2. Remove the electrical connector. 3. Remove the mounting
nuts. 4. Remove the ECC module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive Control Module - Removal > Page 4233
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install ECC module into mounting studs. 2. Install mounting nuts and tighten to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.)
torque. 3. Install the electrical connector. 4. Install the left front trim panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve
Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal > Page 4240
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4244
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal
2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4247
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4248
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4249
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4250
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4251
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Input Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4256
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4257
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way > Page 4260
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Output Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way > Page 4261
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Transfer Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-TRANSFER SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4264
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4265
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4266
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4267
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4268
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4269
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4270
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (3) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC
signals as rotation occurs.
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it
to the transaxle case.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4271
The transfer shaft speed sensor (3) is located at the rear of the case (backside). It reads rotation of
the front annulus/rear carrier assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4274
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4275
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4276
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4277
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4278
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4279
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4280
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4281
Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4282
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4283
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the transfer shaft sensor (3).
2. Remove the bolt at transfer shaft sensor (1). 3. Pull up on transfer shaft sensor to remove.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4284
1. Install a new O-ring (2). on the transfer shaft speed sensor (1).
2. Install transfer shaft speed sensor (3) into case.
3. Install bolt at transfer shaft speed sensor (1) and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect
the electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4293
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4294
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4295
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4296
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4297
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4298
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4299
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4300
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4301
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4302
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update >
Page 4303
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For
Cruise Control Function
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - PCM Update For
Cruise Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For
Cruise Control Function > Page 4309
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P2181 Is Stored In Memory
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P2181 Is Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 4314
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For
Over-Rev Condition > Page 4319
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0420/P0430 Set > Page 4324
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-003-09C > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0452 Set In Memory
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0452 Set In Memory
NUMBER: 18-003-09 REV. C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 11, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-003-09 REV. B, DATED MAY 29, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL VEHICLE.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Driveability Improvements Or MIL Illumination Diagnostic Trouble Code P0452 Evap Pressure Switch Stuck Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan (Includes International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to:
- **2008 CS vehicles equipped with a 4.0L Engine (Sales Code EGO)**.
- 2007, 2008 JS vehicles equipped with a 2.4L Engine and Automatic Transmission (Sales Code
EDG or ED3 with DFF) built before June 19, 2008
- 2007, 2008 and 2009 JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L and 3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF)
built Before October 15, 2008 (MDH 1015XX)
- 2008 RT vehicles equipped with a 3.3L or 3.8L or 4.0L engine (sales code EGV, EGL or EGQ)
- 2009 RT vehicles equipped with a 3.3L or 3.8L or 4.0L engine (sales code EGV, EGL or EGQ
built before May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX).
- 2009 JC vehicles equipped with a 2.4L engine (sales code ED3 or EDG) built before August 20,
2008 (MDH 0820XX)
- 2009 JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine (sales code EGF) built before September 6, 2008
(MDH 0906XX)
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain that the engine stumbles, runs rough,
has idle fluctuations and/or surges at idle or there is a MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find DTC:
- P0452 - Evap Pressure Switch Stuck Closed
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-003-09C > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0452 Set In Memory > Page 4329
further with this bulletin.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer to
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM
ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be completed
on all models.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power
Steering Whine
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls/Steering - Power
Steering Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power
Steering Whine > Page 4334
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM
Update For Cruise Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function > Page 4340
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 4345
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM
Update For Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition > Page 4350
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 4355
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-003-09C > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0452 Set In Memory
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0452 Set In Memory
NUMBER: 18-003-09 REV. C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 11, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-003-09 REV. B, DATED MAY 29, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL VEHICLE.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Driveability Improvements Or MIL Illumination Diagnostic Trouble Code P0452 Evap Pressure Switch Stuck Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan (Includes International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to:
- **2008 CS vehicles equipped with a 4.0L Engine (Sales Code EGO)**.
- 2007, 2008 JS vehicles equipped with a 2.4L Engine and Automatic Transmission (Sales Code
EDG or ED3 with DFF) built before June 19, 2008
- 2007, 2008 and 2009 JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L and 3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF)
built Before October 15, 2008 (MDH 1015XX)
- 2008 RT vehicles equipped with a 3.3L or 3.8L or 4.0L engine (sales code EGV, EGL or EGQ)
- 2009 RT vehicles equipped with a 3.3L or 3.8L or 4.0L engine (sales code EGV, EGL or EGQ
built before May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX).
- 2009 JC vehicles equipped with a 2.4L engine (sales code ED3 or EDG) built before August 20,
2008 (MDH 0820XX)
- 2009 JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine (sales code EGF) built before September 6, 2008
(MDH 0906XX)
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain that the engine stumbles, runs rough,
has idle fluctuations and/or surges at idle or there is a MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find DTC:
- P0452 - Evap Pressure Switch Stuck Closed
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-003-09C > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0452 Set In Memory > Page 4360
further with this bulletin.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer to
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM
ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be completed
on all models.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4365
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4366
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4367
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4368
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4369
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4370
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4371
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4372
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4373
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4374
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4375
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine
Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 4380
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - PCM
Update For Cruise Control Function
NUMBER: 18-028-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 16, 2010
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 11.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Speed Control Operation Improvements
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 15, 2010 (MDH 091 5XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 28, 2010 (MDH 0928XX).
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JS vehicles equipped with a 6-speed automatic transmission (sales code
DG2) built before September 23, 2010 (MDH 0923XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The speed control operation has changed to correct the following conditions:
i. Adjust the set speed control to react when the speed drops to 2-3 MPH below the target.
ii. A RPM increase while going downhill due to a transmission downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in
TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-028-10 > Oct > 10 > Engine Controls - PCM Update For Cruise Control Function > Page 4386
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the TCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory
NUMBER: 18-015-10 REV C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 12 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-015-10 REV B, DATED JULY *, 2010,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL VEHICLE MODELS
THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs HELP USING THE WiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE WiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW THE WiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT
RELEASE 1101 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE StarMOBILE DESKTOP
CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P2181 - Cooling System Performance
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with
new software
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 (JK) Wrangler
**2008 - 2010 (K1) Cherokee (CKD)**
2009 (LC) Challenger
2007 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/300 C/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2009 (L2) 300 (China)
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager
2008 - 2009 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2009 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2009 (XK) Commander
2008 - 2009 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT vehicles built with a 3.3L, 3.8L or 4.0L engine (Sales Codes EGV, EGL
or EGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to WK/WH/XK/HX vehicles equipped with a 4.7L or 5.7L engine (Sales code
EVE or EZB/EZH/EZD) and a automatic transmission (Sales code DGJ or DGQ)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC and JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code EER or
EGF) and a automatic transmission
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to LC/LE/LX/L2 vehicles equipped with a 2.7L or 3.5L engine (Sales code
EER or EGG) and a 4-speed automatic transmission (sales code DGV).**
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-015-10C > Aug > 10 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2181 Is Stored In Memory > Page 4391
This bulletin applies to JK vehicles equipped with a 3.8L engine (Sales code EGT)
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to K1 vehicles equipped with a 3.7L engine (Sales code EKG)**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain of a MIL illumination Upon further
investigation the Technician may find that P2181 Cooling System Performance has been set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (WiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT verify all engine systems are functioning as designed If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 Electrical > Electronic Control Modules Service Information > Module Powertrain Control >
Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming Gas After PCM reprogramming the following
must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming The WiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. On 62TE equipped vehicles clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters found in the Misc
Function menu for the PCM ECU.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label **
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - ECM
Update For Over-Rev Condition
NUMBER: 18-019-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 3, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-008-09 REV. A, DATED
MAY 29, 2009, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THIS UPDATE INCLUDES ADDITIONAL BODIES AND
ENHANCED SOFTWARE FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT THE RT BODIES.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.04 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Engine Over Rev Condition
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves flash reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or for vehicles
equipped with a 2.8L turbo diesel engine the Transmission Control Module (1CM) with new
software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2009 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Voyager**
**2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey**
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE: **This bulletin applies:
1. **2008 CS vehicles built with a 4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).**
2. 2008 and 2009 RT vehicles built with a 2.8L engines (Sales Codes ENS) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2) built before
March 24, 2009 (MDH 0324XX).
3. 2009 RT vehicles built with a 3.8L/4.0L engines (Sales Codes EGL or EGQ) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX),
4. 2009 JC vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engines (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE automatic
transmission (sales code DG2).
5.**201 0 JC International vehicles only built with a 2.7L engine (sales code EER) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2) built before
May 11, 2010 (MDH 0511XX).**
6.**2007 - 2009 JS vehicles built with a 2.7L/3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may notice that the engine can achieve higher RPM's
than normal after an unusual shift condition. This condition can happen if the driver of the vehicle
shifted the vehicle from drive to neutral then back to drive (D-N-D) with their foot on the accelerator
while driving at interstate highway speeds. The updated software corrects this condition.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarMOBILE) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-019-10 > Jun > 10 > Engine Controls - ECM Update For Over-Rev Condition > Page 4396
functioning as designed. If DIG's are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for
the PCM ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be
completed on all models.
b. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the wiTECH Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set
NUMBER: 18-026-09
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 23, 2009
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.01 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination For P0420 And/Or P0430
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine and (Sales code EGF) and a 62TE
automatic transmission (sales code DG2).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customers may experience a MIL illumination. Upon further investigation the Technician may
find that P0420 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank 1) and/or P0430 - Catalyst Efficiency (Bank2) has been
set.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH(TM) or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's are present other then the ones listed above record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the above condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-09 > Sep > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0420/P0430 Set > Page 4401
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-003-09C > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0452 Set In Memory
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0452 Set In Memory
NUMBER: 18-003-09 REV. C
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: June 11, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-003-09 REV. B, DATED MAY 29, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL VEHICLE.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT or StarSCAN MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Driveability Improvements Or MIL Illumination Diagnostic Trouble Code P0452 Evap Pressure Switch Stuck Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
**2008 (CS) Pacifica**
2009 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2008 - 2009 (RT) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan (Includes International Markets)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to:
- **2008 CS vehicles equipped with a 4.0L Engine (Sales Code EGO)**.
- 2007, 2008 JS vehicles equipped with a 2.4L Engine and Automatic Transmission (Sales Code
EDG or ED3 with DFF) built before June 19, 2008
- 2007, 2008 and 2009 JS vehicles equipped with a 2.7L and 3.5L engine (sales code EER or EGF)
built Before October 15, 2008 (MDH 1015XX)
- 2008 RT vehicles equipped with a 3.3L or 3.8L or 4.0L engine (sales code EGV, EGL or EGQ)
- 2009 RT vehicles equipped with a 3.3L or 3.8L or 4.0L engine (sales code EGV, EGL or EGQ
built before May 11, 2009 (MDH 0511XX).
- 2009 JC vehicles equipped with a 2.4L engine (sales code ED3 or EDG) built before August 20,
2008 (MDH 0820XX)
- 2009 JC vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine (sales code EGF) built before September 6, 2008
(MDH 0906XX)
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may complain that the engine stumbles, runs rough,
has idle fluctuations and/or surges at idle or there is a MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find DTC:
- P0452 - Evap Pressure Switch Stuck Closed
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (wiTECH or StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic
Procedures available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If
DTC's other then the one listed above are present record them on the repair order and repair as
necessary before proceeding
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-003-09C > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0452 Set In Memory > Page 4406
further with this bulletin.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer to
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas. After PCM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
b. Clear the Variable Line Pressure (VLP) Counters, found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM
ECU. VLP Clear Counters must be completed
on all models.
c. Perform the Quick Learn function, found in the Misc Function menu for the PCM ECU.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine
Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 4411
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # H33 Date: 081106
Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update
November 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H33 Powertrain Control Module
Models
2009 (PM) Dodge Caliber
(MK) Jeep(R) Compass and Patriot
(JS) Chrysler Sebring and Dodge Avenger
(JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from July 10, 2008 through August 26, 2008
(MDH 071011 through 082606).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 680 of the above vehicles may have been
manufactured with an adhesive that could cause the printed circuit board to break. This can cause
the engine to stall and result in a crash without warning.
Repair
The PCM must be replaced and the correct software programmed into the new module.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4417
These specials tool are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4418
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Caution Information
CAUTION:
To avoid a possible voltage spike that could damage the PCM, the ignition key must be in the
"OFF" position and the negative battery able must be disconnected before unplugging the PCM
connectors.
A. PCM Replacement For PM/MK Models (See Section "B" For JS/JC Models)
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4419
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors from the PCM.
6. Remove the air cleaner box.
7. Remove the three PCM mounting bolts (Figure 1).
8. Tip the PCM out and remove it from the mounting bracket.
9. Place the new PCM into the mounting bracket.
10. Install the three mounting bolts and tighten them to 80 in. lbs. (9 N.m) (Figure 1).
11. Connect the PCM electrical connectors and engage the electrical connector locks.
12. Install the air cleaner box.
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
B. PCM Replacement For JS/JC Models
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4420
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Determine the PCM software part number using the following procedure:
Using StarSCAN:
a. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
b. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
c. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
d. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "More Options".
f. Select "ECU Flash".
g. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
Using StarMOBILE:
a. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
b. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
c. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
d. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
f. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
g. Starting at the "Home" screen select "ECU View".
h. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
i. Select "More Options".
j. Select "ECU Flash".
k. Record the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen for later reference.
3. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position.
4. Disconnect and remove the battery charger.
5. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4421
6. Disconnect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
7. Remove the two PCM mounting bracket retaining nuts and remove the PCM and mounting
bracket as an assembly (Figure 2).
8. Remove the four mounting screws that hold the PCM to the mounting bracket.
9. Install the new PCM on to the mounting bracket.
10. Install the four PCM-to-mounting bracket retaining screws. Tighten the screws to 95 lbs. in. (11
N.m) (Figure 2).
11. Install the PCM and bracket into the vehicle. Tighten the two mounting nuts to 95 in. lbs. (11
N.m).
12. Connect both PCM electrical connectors (Figure 2).
13. Connect the negative battery cable.
14. Continue with Section C. Program PCM.
C. Program PCM
NOTE:
Either StarSCAN or StarMOBILE can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must be
performed with the latest software release level. If the reprogramming flash for the PCM is aborted
or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
PCM Programming Procedure using StarSCAN
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Home"
screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4422
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in the PCM replacement
procedure Step 2g for StarSCAN.
i. Select "Download to Scantool".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
6. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen," select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
7. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
f. Press the "Next" button on the StarSCAN screen.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT > Parts > Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
8. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4423
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
9. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN screen.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
11. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarSCAN.
12. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
13. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position and then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
14. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the StarSCAN.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
15. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4424
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.en instructions.
16. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
and battery charger from the vehicle.
PCM Module Programming Procedure using StarMOBILE
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if
so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger voltmeter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarMOBILE ethernet cable to the StarMOBILE and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarMOBILE vehicle cable to the StarMOBILE and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarMOBILE.
5. Record the StarMOBILE I.P. address displayed on the StarMOBILE screen.
6. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
7 Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.BILE scan tool.
8. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the
"Home" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Touch the screen to highlight "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Select "Browse for New File".
f. Enter Identification name and password.
g. Press "Finish".
h. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 2k. of the PCM
replacement procedure for StarMOBILE.
i. Select "Download to Client".
j. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
k. Highlight the listed calibration.
l. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
m. When the update is completed, select "OK".
n. Verify that the part number at the top of the Flash PCM screen has updated to the new part
number.
9. Vehicles equipped with a Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT), ensure that the Transmission
Control Module (TCM) has the latest software calibration available using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home Screen" select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM".
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4425
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for File".
f. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
10. Vehicles equipped with a Wireless Control Module (WCM), perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "WCM Wireless Control".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll down the list and select "PCM Replaced".
e. Press the blue "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
f. Press the "Next" button on the Desktop Client.
g. Enter the Personal Identification Number (PIN) for that vehicle
NOTE:
The PIN number can be obtained from the original selling invoice, DealerCONNECT>Parts>Key
Codes, or contacting the District Manager.
h. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process
11. Vehicles not equipped with a Wireless Control Module, perform the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM VIN" and follow the on screen instructions.
e. When complete, select "Finish".
12. Perform the learn Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Learn ETC" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the screen prompts to complete the process.
13. Check the PCM Odometer programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Check PCM Odometer" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4426
f. When complete, select "Finish".
14. Place the Ignition in the "OFF" position, then Power "Off" the StarMOBILE.
15. Disconnect the Data Link Connector (DLC), wait 15 seconds, and reconnect the DLC to the
vehicle.
16. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position, power "ON" the StarMOBILE and restart the Desktop
Client.
17. Vehicles equipped with a four-speed transaxle, perform Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Quicklearn programming using the following procedure:
a. From the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
b. Select "TCM Transmission Control Module".
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Select "Quicklearn" and press the "Start" button on the Desktop Client.
e. Follow the on screen instructions.
f. When complete, select "Finish".
18. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
d. Follow the on screen instructions.
19. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
H33 > Nov > 08 > Recall - PCM Replacement/Software Update > Page 4427
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4434
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4437
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
NOTE: Keep the Top Sound Dampener Cover if replacing the unit
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4438
10. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
11. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
12. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 13. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4439
14. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
15. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 16. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 17.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
18. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 19. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 20. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4440
21. Remove the bolts (1) at the line pressure sensor. 22. Remove the line pressure sensor from the
valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4441
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the line pressure
sensor and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle on a hoist.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4442
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise the vehicle on the hoist.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4443
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and install the fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4444
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4445
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4446
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4447
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove the shift cable (1) from the manual lever (2).
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
10. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4448
11. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
12. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
13. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 14. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4449
15. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
16. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 17. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 18.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
19. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 20. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 21. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4450
22. Remove the bolt (1) at the pressure control solenoid. 23. Remove the pressure control sensor
from the valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4451
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the pressure control solenoid on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the pressure
control solenoid and tighten to 6 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4452
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise and support the vehicle.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4453
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan.
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4454
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4455
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4459
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal > Page 4462
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4468
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4471
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
NOTE: Keep the Top Sound Dampener Cover if replacing the unit
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4472
10. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
11. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
12. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 13. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4473
14. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
15. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 16. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 17.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
18. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 19. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 20. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4474
21. Remove the bolts (1) at the line pressure sensor. 22. Remove the line pressure sensor from the
valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4475
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the line pressure
sensor and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle on a hoist.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4476
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise the vehicle on the hoist.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4477
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and install the fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4478
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4479
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Service and
Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4480
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4481
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove the shift cable (1) from the manual lever (2).
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
10. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4482
11. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
12. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
13. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 14. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4483
15. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
16. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 17. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 18.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
19. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 20. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 21. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4484
22. Remove the bolt (1) at the pressure control solenoid. 23. Remove the pressure control sensor
from the valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4485
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the pressure control solenoid on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the pressure
control solenoid and tighten to 6 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4486
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise and support the vehicle.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4487
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan.
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4488
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor Removal > Page 4489
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Service and
Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4493
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve
Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal > Page 4496
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Accumulator - Description
Accumulator: Description and Operation Accumulator - Description
DESCRIPTION
The 62TE has six accumulators and are all located in the case under the valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Accumulator - Description > Page 4501
Accumulator: Description and Operation Accumulator - Operation
OPERATION
The function of an accumulator is to cushion the application of a frictional clutch element. When
pressurized fluid is applied to a clutch circuit, the application force is dampened by fluid collecting
in the respective accumulator chamber against the piston and spring(s). The intended result is a
smooth, firm clutch application.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Accumulator - Description > Page 4502
Accumulator: Description and Operation Valve Body - Operation
OPERATION
REGULATOR VALVE
The regulator valve controls hydraulic pressure in the transaxle. It receives unregulated pressure
from the pump, which works against spring tension to maintain oil at specific pressures. A system
of sleeves and ports allows the regulator valve to work at one of three predetermined pressure
levels. Regulated oil pressure is also referred to as "line pressure."
SOLENOID SWITCH VALVE
The solenoid switch valve controls line pressure from the LR/CC solenoid. In one position, it allows
the low/reverse clutch to be pressurized. In the other, it directs line pressure to the converter
control and converter clutch valves.
MANUAL VALVE
The manual valve is operated by the mechanical shift linkage. Its primary responsibility is to send
line pressure to the appropriate hydraulic circuits and solenoids. The valve has three operating
ranges or positions.
CONVERTER CLUTCH SWITCH VALVE
The main responsibility of the converter clutch switch valve is to control hydraulic pressure applied
to the front (off) side of the converter clutch piston. Line pressure from the regulator valve is fed to
the torque converter regulator valve, where it passes through the valve, and is slightly regulated.
The pressure is then directed to the converter clutch switch valve and to the front side of the
converter clutch piston. This pressure pushes the piston back and disengages the converter clutch.
CONVERTER CLUTCH CONTROL VALVE
The converter clutch control valve controls the back (on) side of the torque converter clutch. When
the PCM/TCM energizes or modulates the LR/CC solenoid to apply the converter clutch piston,
both the converter clutch control valve and the converter control valve move, allowing pressure to
be applied to the back side of the clutch.
T/C REGULATOR VALVE
The torque converter regulator valve slightly regulates the flow of fluid to the torque converter.
LOW/REVERSE SWITCH VALVE
The low/reverse clutch is applied from different sources, depending on whether low (1st) gear or
reverse is selected. The low/reverse switch valve alternates positions depending on from which
direction fluid pressure is applied. By design, when the valve is shifted by fluid pressure from one
channel, the opposing channel is blocked. The switch valve alienates the possibility of a sticking
ball check, thus providing consistent application of the low/reverse clutch under all operating
conditions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Learn Procedure
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Learn Procedure > Page 4507
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information
Differential Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information > Page 4513
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 4518
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
41TE/41AE Estimated Service Fill .......................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.0 qts (3.8L)
41TE/41AE Overhaul Capacity with Torque Converter Empty
....................................................................................................................... 9.2 qts (8.7L)
62TE Estimated Service Fill ................................................................................................................
............................................................. 5.5 qts (5.2L)
62TE Overhaul Capacity with Torque Converter Empty
................................................................................................................................. 9.0 qts (8.5L)
Dry fill capacity depending on type and size of internal cooler, length and inside diameter of cooler
lines, or use of an auxiliary cooler, these figures may vary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4521
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
ATF Fluid
.....................................................................................................................................................
Mopar ATF +4 Automatic Transmission Fluid
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4522
Fluid - A/T: Description and Operation
AUTOMATIC/MANUAL TRANSAXLE FLUID
NOTE: All transaxles have a common transmission and differential sump. Filling the transaxle
accommodates the differential as well.
Mopar (R) ATF+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) is required in the automatic and T355/BG6
manual transaxles. Substitute fluids can induce torque converter clutch shudder, or premature
geartrain failure.
Mopar (R) ATF+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) when new is red in color. The ATF is dyed red so
it can be identified from other fluids used in the vehicle such as engine oil or antifreeze. The red
color is not permanent and is not an indicator of fluid condition. As the vehicle is driven, the ATF
will begin to look darker in color and may eventually become brown. This is normal. ATF+4 also
has a unique odor that may change with age. Consequently, odor and color cannot be used to
indicate the fluid condition or the need for a fluid change.
FLUID ADDITIVES
Chrysler strongly recommends against the addition of any fluids to the transmission, other than
those automatic transmission fluids listed above. Exceptions to this policy are the use of special
dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks.
Various "special" additives and supplements exist that claim to improve shift feel and/or quality.
These additives and others also claim to improve converter clutch operation and inhibit
overheating, oxidation, varnish, and sludge. These claims have not been supported to the
satisfaction of Chrysler and these additives must not be used. The use of transmission "sealers"
should also be avoided, since they may adversely affect the integrity of transmission seals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fluid Level and Condition Check
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid Level and Condition Check
FLUID LEVEL AND CONDITION CHECK
FLUID LEVEL CHECK USING THE SCAN TOOL
1. Verify that the vehicle is parked on a level surface. 2. Remove the dipstick tube cap.
WARNING: There is a risk of accident from vehicle starting off by itself when engine is running.
There is a risk of injury from contusions and
burns if you insert your hands into the engine when it is started or when it is running. Secure
vehicle to prevent it from moving off by itself. Wear properly fastened and close-fitting work clothes.
Do not touch hot or rotating parts.
3. Actuate the service brake. Start engine and let it run at idle speed in selector lever position "P".
4. Shift through the transmission modes several times with the vehicle stationary and the engine
idling.
NOTE: When inserting dipstick special tool 9336A, excess insertion force may cause the dipstick to
slip past the stop on the bracket in the
transmission oil pan. An approximate distance that the dipstick should be inserted into the fill tube
is 424 mm (16.69 in.).
5. Warm up the transmission, wait at least 2 minutes and check the oil level with the engine
running. Push the Oil Dipstick 9336A into transmission
fill tube until the dipstick tip contacts the oil pan and pull out again, read off oil level, repeat if
necessary.
NOTE: The dipstick will protrude from the fill tube when installed.
6. Check transmission oil temperature using the appropriate scan tool. 7. The transmission Oil
Dipstick 9336A has indicator marks every 10 mm. Determine the height of the oil level on the
dipstick and using the height,
the Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) as viewed with the scan too, and the Transmission Fluid
Graph, determine if the transmission oil level
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fluid Level and Condition Check > Page 4525
is correct.
8. Add or remove oil as necessary and recheck the oil level. 9. Once the oil level is correct, install
the dipstick tube cap.
FLUID CONDITION
Along with fluid level, it is important to check the condition of the fluid. When the fluid smells
burned, and is contaminated with metal or friction material particles, a complete transaxle
recondition is probably required. Be sure to examine the fluid on the dipstick closely. If there is any
doubt about its condition, drain out a sample for a double check.
MOPAR(R) ATF+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) when new is red in color. The ATF is dyed red
so it can be identified from other fluids used in the vehicle such as engine oil or antifreeze. The red
color is not permanent and is not an indicator of fluid condition. As the vehicle is driven, the ATF
will begin to look darker in color and may eventually become brown. This is normal. ATF+4 also
has a unique odor that may change with age. Consequently, odor and color cannot be used to
indicate the fluid condition or the need for a fluid change.
After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fluid Level and Condition Check > Page 4526
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid/Filter Service
FLUID AND FILTER SERVICE
FLUID/FILTER SERVICE (RECOMMENDED)
NOTE: Refer to the maintenance schedules in LUBRICATION and MAINTENANCE for the
recommended maintenance (fluid/filter change)
intervals for this transaxle.
NOTE: Only fluids of the type labeled MOPAR(R) ATF+4 should be used. A filter change should be
made at the time of the transmission oil
change. The magnet (on the inside of the oil pan) should also be cleaned with a clean, dry cloth.
NOTE: If the transaxle is disassembled for any reason, the fluid and filter should be changed.
1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Refer to LUBRICATION and MAINTENANCE for proper procedures.
Place a drain container with a large opening,
under transaxle oil pan.
2. Loosen pan bolts and tap the pan at one corner to break it loose allowing fluid to drain, then
remove the oil pan. 3. Remove nuts at the oil filter. 4. Install a new filter and nuts, tighten to 5 Nm
(40 in. lbs.). 5. Install the fluid filter oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 6.
Clean the oil pan and magnet. Reinstall pan using new MOPAR(R) Silicone Adhesive sealant.
Tighten oil pan bolts to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 7. Pour four Quarts of MOPAR(R) ATF+4 through the
dipstick opening. 8. Start engine and allow to idle for at least one minute. Then, with parking and
service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
9. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 in.) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick.
10. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature 82° C
(180°F). Refer to Fluid Level and Condition Check for
the proper fluid fill procedure See: Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid Level and Condition
Check.
11. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the
dipstick opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
FLUID AND FILTER SERVICE
FLUID/FILTER SERVICE (RECOMMENDED)
NOTE: Refer to the maintenance schedules in LUBRICATION and MAINTENANCE for the
recommended maintenance (fluid/filter change)
intervals for this transaxle.
NOTE: Only fluids of the type labeled MOPAR(R) ATF+4 should be used. A filter change should be
made at the time of the transmission oil
change. The magnet (on the inside of the oil pan) should also be cleaned with a clean, dry cloth.
NOTE: If the transaxle is disassembled for any reason, the fluid and filter should be changed.
1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Refer to LUBRICATION and MAINTENANCE for proper procedures.
Place a drain container with a large opening,
under transaxle oil pan.
2. Loosen pan bolts and tap the pan at one corner to break it loose allowing fluid to drain, then
remove the oil pan. 3. Remove nuts at the oil filter. 4. Install a new filter and nuts, tighten to 5 Nm
(40 in. lbs.). 5. Install the fluid filter oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 6.
Clean the oil pan and magnet. Reinstall pan using new MOPAR(R) Silicone Adhesive sealant.
Tighten oil pan bolts to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 7. Pour four Quarts of MOPAR(R) ATF+4 through the
dipstick opening. 8. Start engine and allow to idle for at least one minute. Then, with parking and
service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
9. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 in.) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick.
10. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature 82° C
(180°F). Refer to Fluid Level and Condition Check for
the proper fluid fill procedure See: Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid Level and Condition
Check.
11. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the
dipstick opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair
QUICK CONNECT FITTING DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY
DISCONNECT
1. Remove the dust cap by pulling it straight back off of the quick connect fitting (1). 2. Place the
properly sized release tool (4) onto the transmission cooler line with the fingers of the tool facing
the quick connect fitting. 3. Slide the release tool down the transmission line and engage the
fingers of the tool into the retaining clip. When properly engaged in the clip, the
tool will fit flush against the quick connect fitting.
4. Rotate the release tool 60° to expand the retaining clip. 5. While holding the release tool against
the quick connect fitting, pull back on the transmission cooler line to remove it. 6. If the quick
connect fitting is damaged or leaking at the transmission oil cooler or transmission, remove the
fitting.
CONNECT
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4533
1. If removed, install the quick connect fitting into the transmission oil cooler or the transmission.
Tighten the fitting to 15 Nm (132 in. lbs.). 2. Align the cooler line (3) with the quick connect fitting
while pushing straight into the fitting. 3. Push in on the transmission cooler line until a click is heard
or felt. 4. Slide the dust cap (4) down the transmission cooler line and snap it over the quick
connect fitting until it is fully seated and rotates freely. The dust
cap will only snap over the quick connect fitting when the transmission cooler line is properly
installed.
NOTE: If the dust cap will not snap into place, repeat step 2.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
OIL PAN
Oil Pan Bolts.........................................................................................................................................
....................................................19 Nm (165 in. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve
Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal > Page 4541
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center floor console to access the
gear selector unit. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center Console - Removal.
3. Firmly grasp the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing and rotate it
counterclockwise about 30 degrees to unlock it. 4. Pull the socket and bulb straight out from the
keyed opening in the shifter housing. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the socket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal >
Page 4547
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing. 2. Push
the bulb straight into the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the
keyed opening in the side of the gear selector housing. 4. Insert the bulb and socket into the
housing until the socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it
into place. 6. Reinstall the center floor console. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center Console - Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4551
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 3 WAY
LAMP-PRNDL - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4555
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4558
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
NOTE: Keep the Top Sound Dampener Cover if replacing the unit
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4559
10. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
11. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
12. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 13. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4560
14. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
15. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 16. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 17.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
18. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 19. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 20. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4561
21. Remove the bolts (1) at the line pressure sensor. 22. Remove the line pressure sensor from the
valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4562
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the line pressure
sensor and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle on a hoist.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4563
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise the vehicle on the hoist.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4564
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and install the fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4565
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4566
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Service and
Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4567
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4568
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove the shift cable (1) from the manual lever (2).
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
10. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4569
11. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
12. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
13. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 14. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4570
15. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
16. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 17. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 18.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
19. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 20. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 21. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4571
22. Remove the bolt (1) at the pressure control solenoid. 23. Remove the pressure control sensor
from the valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4572
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the pressure control solenoid on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the pressure
control solenoid and tighten to 6 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4573
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise and support the vehicle.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4574
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan.
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4575
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 4576
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Service and
Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Learn Procedure
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Learn Procedure > Page 4582
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and
Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve
Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and
Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal > Page 4588
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4592
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range
Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve
Body - Removal 2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range
Sensor - Removal > Page 4595
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range
Sensor - Removal > Page 4596
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range
Sensor - Removal > Page 4597
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range
Sensor - Removal > Page 4598
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range
Sensor - Removal > Page 4599
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4604
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4605
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission)
2 Way
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission)
2 Way > Page 4608
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Output Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission)
2 Way > Page 4609
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Transfer Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-TRANSFER SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor Description
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor Description > Page 4612
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor Description > Page 4613
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor Description > Page 4614
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor Description > Page 4615
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor Description > Page 4616
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor Description > Page 4617
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor Description > Page 4618
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (3) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC
signals as rotation occurs.
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it
to the transaxle case.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor Description > Page 4619
The transfer shaft speed sensor (3) is located at the rear of the case (backside). It reads rotation of
the front annulus/rear carrier assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4622
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4623
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4624
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4625
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4626
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4627
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4628
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4629
Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4630
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4631
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the transfer shaft sensor (3).
2. Remove the bolt at transfer shaft sensor (1). 3. Pull up on transfer shaft sensor to remove.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
> Page 4632
1. Install a new O-ring (2). on the transfer shaft speed sensor (1).
2. Install transfer shaft speed sensor (3) into case.
3. Install bolt at transfer shaft speed sensor (1) and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect
the electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Shift Interlock System - Description
Shift Interlock: Description and Operation Shift Interlock System - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Brake Transmission Shifter/Ignition Interlock (BTSI) is a solenoid operated system that
prevents the transmission gear shifter from being moved out of PARK without a driver in place.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Shift Interlock System - Description > Page 4637
Shift Interlock: Description and Operation Shift Interlock System - Operation
OPERATION
The Brake Transmission Shifter/Ignition Interlock (BTSI) is engaged whenever the ignition switch is
in the LOCK or ACC position. An additional electrically activated feature will prevent shifting out of
the PARK position unless the brake pedal is depressed at least one-half inch. When the key is in
the ON position and the brake pedal is depressed, the shifter is unlocked and will move into any
position.
When service brake pedal is not depressed the solenoid rotating arm (2) is free to rotate. The
shifter gate pin (1) hits the blocking arm (3) and is prevented from moving from park.
When service brake is applied the rotating arm (2) is prevented from rotating by magnetic force
within the solenoid. The shifter gate pin (1) pushes the rotating arm (2) and blocker arm (3)
allowing the shifter to move out of park.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4638
Shift Interlock: Testing and Inspection
SHIFT INTERLOCK SYSTEM
The following chart describes the normal operation of the Brake Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI)
system. If the "expected response" differs from the vehicle's response, then system repair is
necessary.
Refer to the following chart that expected shifter response, depending on ignition key/switch and
brake pedal positions.
If the shifter cannot be moved out of the PARK position, refer to Shifter Locked In Place below. If
the shift lever can be shifted out of PARK without the brake pedal depressed, refer to Circuit Test
below.
SHIFTER LOCKED IN PLACE
1. Gain access to the brake transmission shift interlock (BTSI) solenoid. The solenoid is part of the
shifter assembly. 2. Disconnect the wire connector from the rear of the BTSI solenoid. 3. Insert the
ignition key and turn it to the ON position. 4. With the brakes applied, try moving the shifter out of
the PARK position.
- If the lever now moves freely in and out of PARK, perform the Circuit Test.
If the shift lever now moves freely in and out of the park position, the BTSI solenoid is faulty and
the shifter must be replaced. If the shift lever still does not move from the park position, the
problem is in the shift lever assembly.
If the above test pass and the shifter can still be moved freely in and out of PARK without the brake
pedal depressed, replace shifter assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4642
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve
Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal > Page
4645
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Shifter A/T: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4649
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Shift Lever Assembly C1 (Body) 4 Way
Shifter A/T: Diagrams Shift Lever Assembly C1 (Body) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 4 WAY
ASSEMBLY-SHIFTER LEVER - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Shift Lever Assembly C1 (Body) 4 Way > Page 4652
Shifter A/T: Diagrams Shift Lever Assembly C2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
ASSEMBLY-SHIFTER LEVER - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Shift Lever Assembly C1 (Body) 4 Way > Page 4653
Shifter A/T: Diagrams Shift Lever Assembly C3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
ASSEMBLY-SHIFTER LEVER - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Shifter - Removal
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Shifter - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center console See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center Console - Removal.
3. Disconnect harness connector (1). 4. Remove the shift knob by pulling up on the knob.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Shifter - Removal > Page 4656
5. Remove the electrical connectors (1, 2) at the shifter.
6. Disconnect and remove gearshift cable (2, 3) from shift mechanism.
7. Remove four shift mechanism-to-lower console nuts (1). Remove shift mechanism (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Shifter - Removal > Page 4657
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Shifter - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install shifter to studs. 2. Install and tighten the shift mechanism-to-lower console nuts (1) to 8
Nm (71 in. lbs.)
.
3. Install gearshift cable (2, 3) to shift mechanism.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Shifter - Removal > Page 4658
4. Connect the harness connectors (1, 2).
5. Install the shifter knob (1).
6. Verify the shifter and transaxle are both in Park. 7. Loosen the cable adjust bolt, then tighten the
bolt to 6 Nm (40 in. lb.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Shifter - Removal > Page 4659
8. Install the center console See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center Console - Installation. 9. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Shift Cable - Removal
Shift Cable: Service and Repair Shift Cable - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center console See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center Console - Removal.
3. Disconnect and remove gearshift cable (2, 3) from shift mechanism. 4. Remove the air bag
module and the dynamics sensor. See: Relays and Modules/Relays and Modules - Restraint
Systems/Air Bag Control
Module/Service and Repair/Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal.
5. Remove the shift cable at the transmission and pull cable through.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Shift Cable - Removal > Page 4665
Shift Cable: Service and Repair Shift Cable - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the shift cable through the bulkhead and ensure that the grommet is seated. 2. Install the
cable at the transmission. 3. Install and connect gearshift cable (2, 3) at the shift mechanism. 4.
Install the air bag module and the dynamics sensor See: Relays and Modules/Relays and Modules
- Restraint Systems/Air Bag Control
Module/Service and Repair/Occupant Restraint Controller - Installation.
5. Install the center console See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center Console - Installation. 6. Connect the battery.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Torque Converter - Description
Torque Converter: Description and Operation Torque Converter - Description
DESCRIPTION
The torque converter is a hydraulic device that couples the engine crankshaft to the transmission.
The torque converter consists of an outer shell with an internal turbine (1), a stator (4), an
over-running clutch, an impeller (2) and an electronically applied converter clutch (5). The converter
clutch provides reduced engine speed and greater fuel economy when engaged. Clutch
engagement also provides reduced transmission fluid temperatures. The converter clutch engages
in third gear. The torque converter hub (3) drives the transmission oil (fluid) pump.
The torque converter is a sealed, welded unit that is not repairable and is serviced as an assembly.
IMPELLER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Torque Converter - Description > Page 4670
The impeller (3) is an integral part of the converter housing. The impeller consists of curved blades
placed radially along the inside of the housing on the transmission side of the converter. As the
converter housing is rotated by the engine (4,5), so is the impeller, because they are one and the
same and are the driving member of the system.
TURBINE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Torque Converter - Description > Page 4671
The turbine (1) is the output, or driven, member of the converter. The turbine is mounted within the
housing opposite the impeller, but is not attached to the housing. The input shaft (3) is inserted
through the center of the impeller and splined into the turbine. The design of the turbine is similar to
the impeller, except the blades of the turbine are curved in the opposite direction.
STATOR
The stator assembly (1) is mounted on a stationary shaft which is an integral part of the oil pump.
The stator is located between the impeller (2) and turbine (4) within the torque converter case. The
stator contains an over-running clutch, which allows the stator to rotate only in a clockwise
direction. When the stator is locked against the over-running clutch, the torque multiplication
feature of the torque converter is operational.
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Torque Converter - Description > Page 4672
The TCC was installed to improve the efficiency of the torque converter that is lost to the slippage
of the fluid coupling. Although the fluid coupling provides smooth, shock-free power transfer, it is
natural for all fluid couplings to slip. If the impeller (3) and turbine (5) were mechanically locked
together, a zero slippage condition could be obtained. A hydraulic piston (6) was added to the
turbine (5), and a friction material (7) was added to the inside of the front cover (1) to provide this
mechanical lock-up.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Torque Converter - Description > Page 4673
Torque Converter: Description and Operation Torque Converter - Operation
OPERATION
The converter impeller (driving member), which is integral to the converter housing and bolted to
the engine drive plate, rotates at engine speed. The converter turbine (driven member), which
reacts from fluid pressure generated by the impeller, rotates and turns the transmission input shaft.
TURBINE
As the fluid that was put into motion by the impeller blades strikes the blades of the turbine, some
of the energy and rotational force is transferred into the turbine and the input shaft. This causes
both of them (turbine and input shaft) to rotate in a clockwise direction following the impeller. As the
fluid is leaving the trailing edges of the turbine's blades, it continues in a "hindering" direction back
toward the impeller. If the fluid is not redirected before it strikes the impeller, it will strike the
impeller in such a direction that it would tend to slow it down.
STATOR
Torque multiplication is achieved by locking the stator's over-running clutch to its shaft. Under stall
conditions (the turbine is stationary), the oil leaving the turbine blades strikes the face of the stator
blades and tries to rotate them in a counterclockwise direction. When this happens the
over-running clutch of the stator locks and holds the stator from rotating. With the stator locked, the
oil strikes the stator blades and is redirected into a "helping" direction
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Torque Converter - Description > Page 4674
before it enters the impeller. This circulation of oil from impeller to turbine, turbine to stator, and
stator to impeller, can produce a maximum torque multiplication of about 2.4:1. As the turbine
begins to match the speed of the impeller, the fluid that was hitting the stator in such as way as to
cause it to lock-up is no longer doing so. In this condition of operation, the stator begins to free
wheel and the converter acts as a fluid coupling.
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC)
In a standard torque converter, the impeller and turbine are rotating at about the same speed and
the stator is freewheeling, providing no torque multiplication. By applying the turbine's piston to the
front cover's friction material, a total converter engagement can be obtained. The result of this
engagement is a direct 1:1 mechanical link between the engine and the transmission.
The engagement and disengagement of the TCC are automatic and controlled by the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM). The engagement cannot be activated in the lower gears because it
eliminates the torque multiplication effect of the torque converter necessary for acceleration. Inputs
that determine clutch engagement are: coolant temperature, vehicle speed and throttle position.
The torque converter clutch is engaged by the clutch solenoid on the valve body. The clutch will
engage at approximately 56 km/h (35 mph) with light throttle, after the shift to third gear.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter - Removal
Torque Converter: Service and Repair Torque Converter - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove transmission and torque converter from vehicle See: Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Removal. 2. Place a suitable drain pan under the converter housing end of the
transmission.
CAUTION: Verify that transmission is secure on the lifting device or work surface, the center of
gravity of the transmission will shift when the
torque converter is removed creating an unstable condition. The torque converter is a heavy unit.
Use caution when separating the torque converter from the transmission.
3. Pull the torque converter forward until the center hub clears the oil pump seal. 4. Separate the
torque converter from the transmission.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter - Removal > Page 4677
Torque Converter: Service and Repair Torque Converter - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Check converter hub and drive notches for sharp edges, burrs, scratches, or nicks. Polish
the hub and notches with 320/400 grit paper
or crocus cloth if necessary. The hub must be smooth to avoid damaging the pump seal at
installation.
1. Lubricate converter hub and oil pump seal lip with transmission fluid. 2. Place torque converter in
position on transmission.
CAUTION: Do not damage oil pump seal or bushing while inserting torque converter into the front
of the transmission.
3. Align torque converter to oil pump seal opening. 4. Insert torque converter hub into oil pump. 5.
While pushing torque converter inward, rotate converter until converter is fully seated in the oil
pump gears. 6. Check converter seating with a scale (1) and straightedge (2). Surface of converter
lugs should be 1/2 in. to rear of straightedge when converter is
fully seated.
7. If necessary, temporarily secure converter with C-clamp attached to the converter housing. 8.
Install the transmission in the vehicle See: Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Installation. 9. Fill the transmission with the recommended fluid, See: Service and
Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Transmission Cooler: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
An external oil-to-air type automatic transmission oil cooler is mounted to the front of the radiator
and is integral to the A/C condenser. The six upper tubes are used for transaxle oil cooling, and the
remaining tubes below are for the A/C system.
The cooler uses tubes and rubber hoses to feed oil to and from the automatic transaxle. The
replaceable inlet and outlet tubes use quick-connect type fittings. The trans oil cooler is replaced
with the A/C condenser.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4682
Transmission Cooler: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The oil flows from the transmission to the oil-to-air cooler. Heat is then transferred into the air.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Transmission Cooler: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Check the AC condenser for debris on the cooling fin surfaces. Clean as necessary.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect all hoses, tubes, clamps and connections for leaks, cracks, or damage. Replace as
necessary. Use only approved transmission oil cooler hoses that are molded to fit the space
available.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4685
Transmission Cooler: Removal and Replacement
Removal
TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER
1. The transmission oil cooler is integral to the A/C condenser. To remove the AC condenser
assembly, See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Condenser HVAC/Service and Repair/A/C Condenser - Removal.
Installation
TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER
1. The transmission oil cooler is integral to the A/C condenser. To install the AC condenser
assemblySee: Heating and Air Conditioning/Condenser
HVAC/Service and Repair/A/C Condenser - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4689
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 3 WAY
LAMP-PRNDL - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4693
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Removal
2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4696
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4697
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4698
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4699
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4700
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4705
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4706
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way > Page 4709
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Output Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way > Page 4710
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Transfer Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-TRANSFER SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4713
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4714
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4715
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4716
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4717
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4718
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4719
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (3) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC
signals as rotation occurs.
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it
to the transaxle case.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4720
The transfer shaft speed sensor (3) is located at the rear of the case (backside). It reads rotation of
the front annulus/rear carrier assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4723
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4724
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4725
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4726
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4727
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4728
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4729
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4730
Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4731
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4732
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the transfer shaft sensor (3).
2. Remove the bolt at transfer shaft sensor (1). 3. Pull up on transfer shaft sensor to remove.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 4733
1. Install a new O-ring (2). on the transfer shaft speed sensor (1).
2. Install transfer shaft speed sensor (3) into case.
3. Install bolt at transfer shaft speed sensor (1) and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect
the electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Valve Body: Description and Operation
OPERATION
REGULATOR VALVE
The regulator valve controls hydraulic pressure in the transaxle. It receives unregulated pressure
from the pump, which works against spring tension to maintain oil at specific pressures. A system
of sleeves and ports allows the regulator valve to work at one of three predetermined pressure
levels. Regulated oil pressure is also referred to as "line pressure."
SOLENOID SWITCH VALVE
The solenoid switch valve controls line pressure from the LR/CC solenoid. In one position, it allows
the low/reverse clutch to be pressurized. In the other, it directs line pressure to the converter
control and converter clutch valves.
MANUAL VALVE
The manual valve is operated by the mechanical shift linkage. Its primary responsibility is to send
line pressure to the appropriate hydraulic circuits and solenoids. The valve has three operating
ranges or positions.
CONVERTER CLUTCH SWITCH VALVE
The main responsibility of the converter clutch switch valve is to control hydraulic pressure applied
to the front (off) side of the converter clutch piston. Line pressure from the regulator valve is fed to
the torque converter regulator valve, where it passes through the valve, and is slightly regulated.
The pressure is then directed to the converter clutch switch valve and to the front side of the
converter clutch piston. This pressure pushes the piston back and disengages the converter clutch.
CONVERTER CLUTCH CONTROL VALVE
The converter clutch control valve controls the back (on) side of the torque converter clutch. When
the PCM/TCM energizes or modulates the LR/CC solenoid to apply the converter clutch piston,
both the converter clutch control valve and the converter control valve move, allowing pressure to
be applied to the back side of the clutch.
T/C REGULATOR VALVE
The torque converter regulator valve slightly regulates the flow of fluid to the torque converter.
LOW/REVERSE SWITCH VALVE
The low/reverse clutch is applied from different sources, depending on whether low (1st) gear or
reverse is selected. The low/reverse switch valve alternates positions depending on from which
direction fluid pressure is applied. By design, when the valve is shifted by fluid pressure from one
channel, the opposing channel is blocked. The switch valve alienates the possibility of a sticking
ball check, thus providing consistent application of the low/reverse clutch under all operating
conditions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Valve Body: Removal and Replacement
Valve Body - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the negative battery. 3. Drain the radiatorSee: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 4. Remove clamps at the lower radiator
hose. 5. Remove the lower radiator hose. 6. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
7. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4739
8. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
9. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
10. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 11. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening. 12. Turn the wheel fully to the left.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4740
13. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 14. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 15. Remove the valve body oil pan.
16. Remove the electrical connector (1) at the valve body (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4741
17. Remove screw at detente arm (2). 18. Remove detente arm (1).
19. Remove the twenty one valve body to case bolts (1).
20. Insure the manual lever is fully forward to keep the manual valve pin (3) from binding. 21. Pull
the valve body away from the underdrive compounder assembly oil transfer tubes (2) and lift up on
valve body to clear the manual valve pin
past the slot in the rooster comb.
Valve Body - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4742
1. Raise the vehicle on the hoist. 2. Install a NEW 2/4 clutch oil seal (1).
3. Install new O-rings (1) on the underdrive compounder assembly oil transfer tubes (2).
4. Insure the manual lever is fully forward to keep the manual valve pin (3) from binding.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4743
5. Set the manual valve pin (3) into the slot in the rooster comb. 6. Set the valve body into the
underdrive compounder assembly oil transfer tubes (2) and press the valve body into place.
7. Install the twenty one valve body to case bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
8. Install the detente arm (1) onto the pin at the valve body. 9. Install the screw (3) at the detente
arm and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4744
10. Install the electrical connector (1) at the valve body. 11. Lower the hoist.
12. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 13. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 14. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 15. Lower the vehicle on a hoist.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4745
16. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 17. Raise the vehicle on the hoist.
18. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 19. Install the left side
inner wheel splash shield screws (1).
20. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and the fasteners (1).
21. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4746
22. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2). 23. Install lower radiator hose and clamps. 24. Fill the
cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 25. Install
the battery cable. 26. Fill transmission and road test See: Service and
Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4747
Valve Body: Overhaul
Valve Body - Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
1. Unplug the electrical connectors (1, 2) at the valve body.
2. Remove the bolts (1) at the transfer plate (2) and remove the transfer plate.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4748
3. Turn valve body over and remove the solenoid module (1) from the valve body (2).
4. Remove the bolts (1) at the line pressure sensor (2). 5. Remove the line pressure sensor from
the valve body.
6. Remove the bolt (1) at the pressure control solenoid (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4749
7. Remove the bolts (1) at the clamping plate (2).
8. Remove the clamping plate (1).
9. Remove the valve body cover (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4750
10. Remove the valve body inner gasket and plate (1) from the valve body.
.
NOTE: The valve body contains some check balls that are pressed into a tapered bore (1). These
check balls are not removeable
11. Remove the check balls (2) if equipped.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4751
NOTE: Use exploded view for disassembly.
NOTE: Tag all valve/spring assemblies for reassembly identification.
12. Remove valves from valve body.
Valve Body - Assembly
ASSEMBLY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4752
NOTE: Use exploded view for assembly.
1. Install the valves into valve body.
NOTE: The valve body contains some check balls that are pressed into a tapered bore (1). These
check balls are not removeable
2. Install the check balls (2) if equipped.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4753
3. Install the inner separator plate (1).
4. Install the outer separator plate (1).
5. Install the transfer plate (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4754
6. Install the bolts (1) at the transfer plate (2) and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
7. Install the pressure control solenoid on to the valve body. 8. Install the bolt (1) at the pressure
control solenoid (2) and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4755
9. Install the pressure control sensor onto the valve body.
10. Install the bolts (1) to the pressure control sensor and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
11. Install the solenoid pack (1) onto the valve body (2).
12. Turn valve body over and install the clamp plate (2) onto the valve body. 13. Install the clamp
plate bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4756
14. Plug in the electrical connectors pressure control solenoid and pressure control sensors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Clutch Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 4763
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Differential, CVT > Differential Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid
Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - CVT: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Differential, CVT > Differential Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid
Flushing Information > Page 4770
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Fluid CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - CVT: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Fluid CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 4775
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - Differential: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 4781
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4782
Fluid - Differential: Specifications
Rear Drive Assembly (RDA)
.......................................................................................................................... Mopar Gear Lubricant
75W-90 or equivalent
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4783
Fluid - Differential: Service and Repair
STANDARD PROCEDURE - DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY FLUID CHANGE
The drain plug (2) for the differential assembly is located in the bottom of the differential assembly
case, toward the rear of the unit.
The fill plug (3) for the differential assembly is located on the left side of the assembly case.
The correct fill level is to the bottom of the fill plug hole. Be sure the vehicle is on a level surface, or
is hoisted in a level manner, in order to obtain the correct fill level.
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Position a drain pan under the differential drain plug. 3. Remove
the drain plug and allow the fluid to drain into the pan. 4. Install the drain plug and torque to 35 Nm
(26 ft. lbs.). 5. Re-position the drain pan under the differential fill plug. 6. Remove the differential fill
plug. 7. Using a suction gun or equivalent, fill the differential assembly with 0.7 L (0.74 Quarts) of
Mopar(R) Gear and Axle Lubricant (75W-90). 8. Install the fill plug and torque to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Seal - Removal
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Output Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove rear driveline module.See: Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Rear Driveline Module/Removal 3. Use suitable screwdriver (2) to remove output
seal (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Seal - Removal > Page 4788
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Output Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install output flange seal to differential housing using handle C- 4171A (1) and installer 8493 (2).
2. Install rear driveline module. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear Driveline
Module/Installation 3. Check differential assembly fluid level and adjust as required. See: Service
and Repair/Procedures
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Half Shaft, Outer Boot - Removal
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Front Half Shaft, Outer Boot - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove halfshaft assembly requiring boot replacement from vehicle. See: Service and
Repair/Half Shaft - Removal 2. Remove large boot clamp (4) retaining CV joint sealing boot to CV
joint housing (3) and discard. Remove small clamp (1) that retains outer CV
joint sealing boot to interconnecting shaft (5) and discard. Remove sealing boot (2) from outer CV
joint housing and slide it down interconnecting shaft.
3. Wipe away grease to expose outer CV joint and interconnecting shaft.
4. Remove outer CV joint from interconnecting shaft using the following procedure: Support
interconnecting shaft in a vise equipped with protective
caps on jaws of vise to prevent damage to interconnecting shaft. Then, using a soft-faced hammer
(1), sharply hit the end of the CV joint housing to dislodge housing from internal circlip (3) on
interconnecting shaft. Then slide outer CV joint off end of interconnecting shaft, joint may have to
be tapped off shaft using a soft-faced hammer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Half Shaft, Outer Boot - Removal >
Page 4795
NOTE: Always use a new circlip.
5. Remove large circlip (3) from the interconnecting shaft (2) before attempting to remove outer CV
joint sealing boot. 6. Slide sealing boot off interconnecting shaft. 7. Thoroughly clean and inspect
outer CV joint assembly and interconnecting joint for any signs of excessive wear. If any parts
show signs of
excessive wear, the halfshaft assembly will require replacement. Component parts of these
halfshaft assemblies are not serviceable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Half Shaft, Outer Boot - Removal >
Page 4796
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Front Half Shaft, Outer Boot - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Slide new sealing boot clamp (2) onto interconnecting shaft (4). Slide the outer CV joint
assembly sealing boot (1) onto the interconnecting shaft
(4). Seal boot MUST be positioned on interconnecting shaft so the raised bead on the inside of the
seal boot is in groove on interconnecting shaft.
NOTE: Always use a new circlip.
2. Align splines on interconnecting shaft with splines on cross of outer CV joint assembly and start
outer CV joint onto interconnecting shaft. 3. Install outer CV joint assembly onto interconnecting
shaft by using a soft-faced hammer (1) and tapping end of stub axle (2) (with hub nut (4)
installed) until outer CV joint (3) is fully seated on interconnecting shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Half Shaft, Outer Boot - Removal >
Page 4797
4. Outer CV joint assembly must be installed on interconnecting shaft until cross (2) of outer CV
joint assembly (3) is seated against circlip on
interconnecting shaft (1).
5. Distribute 1/2 the amount of grease provided in seal boot service package (DO NOT USE ANY
OTHER TYPE OF GREASE) into outer CV joint
assembly housing. Put the remaining amount into the sealing boot (4).
6. Install outer CV joint sealing boot to interconnecting shaft clamp evenly on sealing boot. 7.
Clamp sealing boot onto interconnecting shaft (2) using crimper, Crimping Tool C-4975A and the
following procedure. Place Crimping Tool
C-4975A (1) over bridge of clamp (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Half Shaft, Outer Boot - Removal >
Page 4798
8. Tighten nut on Crimping Tool C-4975A until jaws on tool (2) are closed completely together, face
to face.
CAUTION: Seal must not be dimpled, stretched, or out-of-shape in any way. If seal is NOT shaped
correctly, equalize pressure in seal and
shape it by hand.
9. Position outer CV joint sealing boot (4) into its retaining groove on outer CV joint housing. Install
sealing boot to outer CV joint retaining clamp
(1) evenly on sealing boot.
10. Clamp sealing boot onto outer CV joint housing using Crimping Tool C-4975A (3) and the
following procedure. Place Crimping Tool C-4975A
over bridge of clamp (1).
11. Tighten nut on Crimping Tool C-4975A until jaws on tool are closed completely together (4),
face to face. 12. Install the halfshaft requiring boot replacement back on the vehicle. See: Service
and Repair/Half Shaft - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Wheel bearing grease ...............................................................................................................
Mopar Multi-Purpose Lubricant NLGI Grade 2 EP, GC-LB
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Hub and Bearing - Description
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Front Hub and Bearing - Description
DESCRIPTION
The front wheel bearing and wheel hub of this vehicle are a one piece sealed unit or hub and
bearing unit type assembly.
The hub and bearing (1) is mounted to the knuckle using four mounting bolts (2) and to the axle
half shaft using a retaining nut. The center of the hub and bearing is splined to match the outer joint
of the axle half shaft.
Each front hub and bearing has five wheel mounting studs on the hub flange for mounting the
wheel to the vehicle. The wheel mounting studs are the only replaceable components of the hub
and bearing. Otherwise, the hub and bearing is serviced as a complete assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Hub and Bearing - Description > Page 4804
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Rear Hub and Bearing - Description
DESCRIPTION
The rear wheel bearing and wheel mounting hub used on this vehicle are a one-piece sealed unit
or hub and bearing assembly. It is permanently lubricated when assembled and is sealed for life.
There is no periodic lubrication or maintenance recommended for these units.
The hub and bearing (1) is mounted to the rear knuckle.
All vehicles have a magnetic encoder integrated into the rear hub and bearing for speed sense.
The encoder works with the rear wheel speed sensor (2) to provide wheel speed signal.
The only serviceable components of the hub and bearing are the wheel mounting studs pressed
into the hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Hub and Bearing
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Front Hub and Bearing
HUB AND BEARING
NOTE: The wheel bearing is designed to last for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of
periodic maintenance.
The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the hub and bearing.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly, disc brake caliper and brake rotor. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
2. Rotate the wheel hub checking for resistance or roughness.
Any roughness or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the
bearing exhibits any of these conditions, the hub bearing will require replacement. Do not attempt
to disassemble the bearing for repair. If the wheel bearing is disassembled for any reason, it must
be replaced.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require hub and bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weeping from the bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the hub and bearing.
To diagnose a bent hub, measure hub runout. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Hub and Bearing > Page 4807
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Rear Hub and Bearing
HUB AND BEARING
NOTE: The wheel bearing is designed to last for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of
periodic maintenance.
The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the wheel bearing and hub.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly, disc brake caliper and brake rotor. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
2. Rotate the wheel hub checking for resistance or roughness.
Any roughness or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the
bearing exhibits any of these conditions, the hub and bearing will require replacement. Do not
attempt to disassemble the bearing for repair. If the wheel bearing is disassembled for any reason,
it must be replaced.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weapage from the bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the wheel bearing.
To diagnose a bent hub, measure hub runout. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Hub and Bearing - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, review all Warnings and Cautions. See: Steering and
Suspension/Suspension/Service Precautions/Technician Safety
Information
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the hub from rotating, remove the hub nut (1) from the
axle half shaft (2). 4. Access and remove the front brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4810
5. Remove the four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing to the knuckle (3). 6. Slide the hub and
bearing (1) off the half shaft and out of the knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4811
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Hub and Bearing - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the hub and bearing (1) by sliding it over the half shaft and into the knuckle. 2. Install the
four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing (1) to the knuckle (3). Tighten the four bolts to 82 Nm
(60 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the brake rotor, disc brake caliper and adapter. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
4. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 5. Install the hub nut (1)
on the end of the half shaft (2) and lightly tighten it. 6. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the
hub from rotating, tighten the hub nut (1) to 132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4812
7. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4813
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Hub and Bearing - Removal
ALL-WHEEL-DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Steering and Suspension/Suspension/Service Precautions/Vehicle
Damage Warnings .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the cotter pin (2) from the hub nut (3) on the end of the axle half shaft. 4. While a helper
applies the brakes to keep the hub (1) from rotating, remove the hub nut (3) and washer (4) from
the axle half shaft. 5. Tap the end of the half shaft inward, loosening it from the hub and bearing.
This will also allow more room to access the hub and bearing
mounting bolts in a later step.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance
between the pads and the rotor to easily remove the caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be
accomplished before removal by grasping the inboard side of the caliper and pulling outward
working with the guide pins, thus retracting the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may
get damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4814
6. Remove two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) to the knuckle (3).
7. Remove the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) as an assembly from the knuckle (3) and
rotor. Hang the assembly out of the way using wire
or a bungee cord. Use care not to overextend the brake hose when doing this.
8. Remove any retaining clips, then slide the brake rotor (2) off the hub and bearing (1).
CAUTION: Prior to removal, clean area around sensor head to help prevent contaminants from
entering bearing when sensor head is
removed.
9. Remove the screw (3) fastening the speed sensor head (2) to the hub and bearing (1).
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor head (2) from the hub and bearing (1), then pass it through
the brake shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4815
11. Remove the four bolts (1) securing the hub and bearing to the knuckle. 12. Remove the hub
and bearing from the knuckle and half shaft (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4816
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Hub and Bearing - Installation
ALL-WHEEL-DRIVE
1. With the brake shield in place on the knuckle, slide the hub and bearing over the axle half shaft
and position it on the knuckle. 2. Install the four bolts (1) securing the hub and bearing to the
knuckle. Tighten the bolts to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Ensure that sensor mounting surface on bearing is clean before sensor installation.
3. Pass the wheel speed sensor head (2) through the hole in the brake shield, then push it into the
mounting hole in hub and bearing (1) and align the
mounting screw hole.
4. Install a NEW mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting screw to 6 Nm (55 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4817
5. Clean the rotor mounting face of the hub and bearing (1) to remove any dirt or corrosion. 6.
Install the brake rotor (2) over the hub and bearing (1).
CAUTION: If the brake rotor or brake pads are being replaced, the rear caliper piston must be
seated (bottomed) to compensate for the new
brake rotor or lining. Because the parking brake self-adjuster mechanism is attached to the piston,
a special seating method is required. The only acceptable method is by rotating the piston back
into the bore using Retractor, Special Tool 8807, as described below. Any other seating method will
damage the self-adjuster mechanism.
7. If necessary, seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5). e. Thread the screw drive on
8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the caliper piston. Do not over
tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4818
8. Install the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) over the knuckle and rotor as an assembly.
9. Install the two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) to the knuckle.
Tighten the mounting bolts to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
10. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 11. Install the washer
(4) and hub nut (3) on the end of the half shaft and snug it. 12. While a helper applies the brakes to
keep the hub (1) from rotating, tighten the hub nut (3) to 245 Nm (181 ft. lbs.). 13. Insert the cotter
pin (2) through the notches in the nut and the hole in half shaft. If the notches in the nut do not line
up with the hole in the half
shaft, continue to tighten the nut until they do. Do not loosen the nut.
14. Wrap the cotter pin (2) ends tightly around the lock nut.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 4819
15. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Pump the brake pedal several times to ensure the vehicle has a firm
brake pedal before moving it. Check the brake fluid level.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications > Front Suspension
Axle Nut: Specifications Front Suspension
Hub Nut................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications > Front Suspension > Page 4825
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear Suspension
Hub Nut................................................................................................................................................
...................................................245 Nm (181 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation > Propeller Shaft - Description
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Description and Operation Propeller Shaft - Description
DESCRIPTION
WARNING: Due to propeller shaft imbalance concerns, the propeller shaft can only be serviced as
an assembly.
AWD models utilize a "three-piece" propeller shaft to transmit torque to the rear driveline module
assembly. This three-piece design consists of:
- Front center and rear shaft segments
- Plunging front CV joint.
- Center support bearings
- Rubber coupler at driveline module flange
The front shaft segment utilizes a plunging CV joint at the power transfer unit connection. The
center and rear shaft segments utilize a support bearing/bracket assembly. The rear shaft segment
uses a rubber coupler at the driveline module flange.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation > Propeller Shaft - Description > Page 4831
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Description and Operation Propeller Shaft - Operation
OPERATION
The propeller shaft is used to transmit torque from the transaxle power transfer unit (PTU) to the
rear driveline module of AWD equipped models.
The propeller shaft front segment utilizes a plunging CV joint at the PTU flange. The joint is flexible,
allowing for torsional movement of the powertrain.
The propeller shaft center and rear segments utilize a support bearing/bracket, which support this
three-piece assembly and isolates driveline vibrations from the body. The rubber coupler at the
driveline module flange dampens out propeller shaft torsional vibrations, as the driveline module it
connects to is fastened to the rear suspension crossmember.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft - Removal
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Propeller Shaft - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on the hoist. 2. Mark propeller shaft and differential for proper installation. 3.
Remove rear propeller shaft to rear axle retaining nuts (1).
4. Remove the bolts (3) from the center support heat shield (2).
CAUTION: Propeller shaft removal. Never allow propeller shaft to hang while connected to Power
Transfer Unit (PTU), rear driveline module
flanges or center bearings. If propeller shaft section is hung unsupported, damage may occur to
joint, boot and/or center bearing from over-angulation. This may result in vibration/balance issues.
A helper may be needed.
5. Remove the heat shield (2). 6. Remove the center support mounting bolts (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft - Removal > Page 4834
7. Remove the bolts (2) at the PTU 8. Remove the propeller shaft (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft - Removal > Page 4835
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Propeller Shaft - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Propeller shaft installation. Never allow propeller shaft to hang while connected to
Power Transfer Unit (PTU), rear driveline
module flanges or center bearings. If propeller shaft section is hung unsupported, damage may
occur to joint, boot and/or center bearing from over-angulation. This may result in vibration/balance
issues. A helper may be needed.
1. Make sure transaxle is in Neutral (N) position. 2. Obtain a helper if needed and lift propeller shaft
assembly into position. Install propeller shaft to PTU with mounting bolts and tighten to 30 Nm
(22 ft. lbs.).
3. Align marks (2) on propeller shaft with marks on rear axle flange. Install propeller shaft and bolts,
tighten the bolts to 58 Nm (43 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft - Removal > Page 4836
4. Raise the center support into position and install mounting bolts (1), tighten bolts to 41 Nm (30
lbs.ft.). 5. Install heat shield (2) and retaining nuts tighten to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications
FLEX PLATE
Flex plate to Crankshaft........................................................................................................................
........................................................95 Nm (70 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Flexplate - Removal
Flex Plate: Service and Repair Flexplate - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the transaxle. See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Removal 2. Remove 8 flex plate attaching bolts (2). 3. Remove backing plate (3)
4. Remove the flex plate (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Flexplate - Removal > Page 4842
Flex Plate: Service and Repair Flexplate - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the flex plate (1) with backing plate (3) on the crankshaft. 2. Apply Mopar(R) Lock & Seal
Adhesive to the eight flex plate bolts (2). 3. Install the flex plate bolts (2). Tighten the bolts to 95 Nm
(70 ft. lbs.). 4. Install the transaxle See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Installation
NOTE: The Cam/Crank Variation Relearn procedure must be performed anytime there has been a
repair/replacement made to a powertrain
system, for example: flywheel, valvetrain, camshaft and/or crankshaft sensors or components See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Indicator Lamp
- Removal
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center floor console to access the
gear selector unit. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center Console - Removal.
3. Firmly grasp the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing and rotate it
counterclockwise about 30 degrees to unlock it. 4. Pull the socket and bulb straight out from the
keyed opening in the shifter housing. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the socket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Indicator Lamp
- Removal > Page 4849
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing. 2. Push
the bulb straight into the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the
keyed opening in the side of the gear selector housing. 4. Insert the bulb and socket into the
housing until the socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it
into place. 6. Reinstall the center floor console. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center Console - Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4853
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 3 WAY
LAMP-PRNDL - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information
Differential Fluid - M/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information > Page 4860
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - M/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 4865
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Learn Procedure
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Learn Procedure > Page
4872
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 4877
Control Module: Diagrams
Connector (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
MODULE-ALL WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Final Drive Control Module - Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
The AWD ECM (electronic control module) mounts on the driver side cowl side panel, where it is
concealed by the instrument panel. It communicates with other systems over the high-speed
CAN-C bus.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Final Drive Control Module - Description > Page 4880
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The all-wheel-drive system requires no driver input or control. Under most driving conditions, it is
passive and power is transmitted to the front wheels alone. The system functions to optimize
traction and handling under the following conditions:
Anticipates slip by responding to pedal position unlike all-wheel drive systems that rely on pumps
or viscous fluids to transfer torque, the system requires no front-to-rear slippage for activation. This
allows the system to transfer torque in response to accelerator pedal position. If the driver is asking
for a lot of power, the system immediately starts clamping the Electronically Controlled Coupling
(ECC), transferring a high percentage of power to the rear wheels. This avoids front wheel
slippage, as power to propel the car is transmitted through all four tires. This mode of operation is
called open-loop operation in that there is no feedback to affect the torque transfer.
Modulates torque to optimize traction on slippery surfaces a second, closed loop, operating mode
uses feedback from the wheel-speed sensors to determine the appropriate torque transfer. When
the front wheels slip, the all-wheel-drive electronic control module tells the ECC to start clamping,
sending power to the rear wheels. Attempting the same aggressive launch described above with
the front wheels on ice and the rear wheels on dry pavement, the ECC sends even more torque to
the rear wheels to minimize slippage and launch the vehicle. Both modes are always active and the
maximum of the two is chosen. Power to the rear wheels is modulated during lost of traction while
traveling at freeway speeds; for example, hydroplaning on a puddle of water, will send very little
power to the rear wheels because the controller knows at those speeds a lot of power is not
needed at the rear wheels.
Prevents binding during low-speed turns a third condition, which is independent of the others, uses
the ESP steering angle sensor to determine when the vehicle is turning in a tight circle. This
condition causes the electronic control module to reduce torque to the rear wheels to prevent
binding in the driveline. The electronic control module is always checking for this condition as well.
Influences handling at moderate speeds. The AWD system is used to influence vehicle dynamics.
Other manufacturers limit AWD to aiding traction or providing off-road capability. They concentrate
on launching the vehicle or going off road at speeds up to about 25 mph (40 km/hr). Above that
speed range, they use it to limit wheel slip for traction. Additional ECM calibration controls torque to
the rear wheels for improved handling in the 25-65 mph (40-105 km/hr) range. In this speed range,
the system utilizes torque to the rear wheels during cornering with the throttle open to make the car
turn more easily - make the handling more neutral. This is more readily accomplished with an
electronically controlled system, than with viscous-coupling or gerotor systems that require some
degree of front-to-rear slip to transfer torque to the rear wheels. Above 53 mph (113 km/hr), the
control strategy
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Final Drive Control Module - Description > Page 4881
provides minimal torque to the rear wheels under normal driving conditions to aid fuel economy.
Works with ESP and Traction Control the electronic control module also interfaces with the ESP
and traction control systems. The interface allows the ESP system to use the ECC to help gain
control of the vehicle. For this purpose, torque transmitted to the rear wheels by the ECC can be
reduced. The AWD system is not traction control. It only works on situations where front-to-rear
traction varies, for instance, front wheels on ice, rear wheels on dry pavement or climbing steep
grades. AWD does not aid side-to-side traction. ESP does that through brake intervention.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Final
Drive Control Module - Removal
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the left front trim panel. 2. Remove the electrical connector. 3. Remove the mounting
nuts. 4. Remove the ECC module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Final
Drive Control Module - Removal > Page 4884
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install ECC module into mounting studs. 2. Install mounting nuts and tighten to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.)
torque. 3. Install the electrical connector. 4. Install the left front trim panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal > Page 4891
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4895
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body Removal
2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4898
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4899
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4900
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4901
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 4902
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service
and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page
4907
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page
4908
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE)
(Transmission) 2 Way
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE)
(Transmission) 2 Way > Page 4911
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Output Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE)
(Transmission) 2 Way > Page 4912
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Transfer Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-TRANSFER SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Speed Sensor - Description
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4915
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4916
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4917
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4918
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4919
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4920
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4921
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (3) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC
signals as rotation occurs.
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it
to the transaxle case.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Speed Sensor - Description > Page 4922
The transfer shaft speed sensor (3) is located at the rear of the case (backside). It reads rotation of
the front annulus/rear carrier assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4925
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4926
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4927
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4928
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4929
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4930
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4931
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4932
Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4933
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4934
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the transfer shaft sensor (3).
2. Remove the bolt at transfer shaft sensor (1). 3. Pull up on transfer shaft sensor to remove.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Output Speed
Sensor - Removal > Page 4935
1. Install a new O-ring (2). on the transfer shaft speed sensor (1).
2. Install transfer shaft speed sensor (3) into case.
3. Install bolt at transfer shaft speed sensor (1) and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect
the electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4940
Control Module: Diagrams
Connector (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
MODULE-ALL WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
The AWD ECM (electronic control module) mounts on the driver side cowl side panel, where it is
concealed by the instrument panel. It communicates with other systems over the high-speed
CAN-C bus.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description > Page 4943
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The all-wheel-drive system requires no driver input or control. Under most driving conditions, it is
passive and power is transmitted to the front wheels alone. The system functions to optimize
traction and handling under the following conditions:
Anticipates slip by responding to pedal position unlike all-wheel drive systems that rely on pumps
or viscous fluids to transfer torque, the system requires no front-to-rear slippage for activation. This
allows the system to transfer torque in response to accelerator pedal position. If the driver is asking
for a lot of power, the system immediately starts clamping the Electronically Controlled Coupling
(ECC), transferring a high percentage of power to the rear wheels. This avoids front wheel
slippage, as power to propel the car is transmitted through all four tires. This mode of operation is
called open-loop operation in that there is no feedback to affect the torque transfer.
Modulates torque to optimize traction on slippery surfaces a second, closed loop, operating mode
uses feedback from the wheel-speed sensors to determine the appropriate torque transfer. When
the front wheels slip, the all-wheel-drive electronic control module tells the ECC to start clamping,
sending power to the rear wheels. Attempting the same aggressive launch described above with
the front wheels on ice and the rear wheels on dry pavement, the ECC sends even more torque to
the rear wheels to minimize slippage and launch the vehicle. Both modes are always active and the
maximum of the two is chosen. Power to the rear wheels is modulated during lost of traction while
traveling at freeway speeds; for example, hydroplaning on a puddle of water, will send very little
power to the rear wheels because the controller knows at those speeds a lot of power is not
needed at the rear wheels.
Prevents binding during low-speed turns a third condition, which is independent of the others, uses
the ESP steering angle sensor to determine when the vehicle is turning in a tight circle. This
condition causes the electronic control module to reduce torque to the rear wheels to prevent
binding in the driveline. The electronic control module is always checking for this condition as well.
Influences handling at moderate speeds. The AWD system is used to influence vehicle dynamics.
Other manufacturers limit AWD to aiding traction or providing off-road capability. They concentrate
on launching the vehicle or going off road at speeds up to about 25 mph (40 km/hr). Above that
speed range, they use it to limit wheel slip for traction. Additional ECM calibration controls torque to
the rear wheels for improved handling in the 25-65 mph (40-105 km/hr) range. In this speed range,
the system utilizes torque to the rear wheels during cornering with the throttle open to make the car
turn more easily - make the handling more neutral. This is more readily accomplished with an
electronically controlled system, than with viscous-coupling or gerotor systems that require some
degree of front-to-rear slip to transfer torque to the rear wheels. Above 53 mph (113 km/hr), the
control strategy
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description > Page 4944
provides minimal torque to the rear wheels under normal driving conditions to aid fuel economy.
Works with ESP and Traction Control the electronic control module also interfaces with the ESP
and traction control systems. The interface allows the ESP system to use the ECC to help gain
control of the vehicle. For this purpose, torque transmitted to the rear wheels by the ECC can be
reduced. The AWD system is not traction control. It only works on situations where front-to-rear
traction varies, for instance, front wheels on ice, rear wheels on dry pavement or climbing steep
grades. AWD does not aid side-to-side traction. ESP does that through brake intervention.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive Control Module - Removal
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the left front trim panel. 2. Remove the electrical connector. 3. Remove the mounting
nuts. 4. Remove the ECC module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive Control Module - Removal > Page 4947
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install ECC module into mounting studs. 2. Install mounting nuts and tighten to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.)
torque. 3. Install the electrical connector. 4. Install the left front trim panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Differential, Transfer Case > Differential Fluid Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - Transfer Case: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Differential, Transfer Case > Differential Fluid Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page
4953
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - Transfer Case: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 4958
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4959
Fluid - Transfer Case: Specifications
Power Transfer Unit (PTU)
............................................................................................................................ Mopar Gear
Lubricant 75W-90 or equivalent
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4960
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair
PTU FLUID DRAIN/FILL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. Remove bolt (1) from lower part of PTU heat shield (2).
3. Using a long prybar remove the retaining clip (1) from the side of the PTU heat shield (2).
NOTE: Position the PTU heat shield aside as necessary
4. Remove PTU drain plug (1). Drain fluid into suitable container. 5. Install drain plug (1) and torque
to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4961
6. A 10mm hex bit 7/8" long (1) and a ratcheting box angle wrench (2) will be required to remove
the PTU fill plug.
NOTE: Position the PTU heat shield aside as necessary
7. Using the ratcheting box angle wrench (1) and hex bit (3) remove the PTU fill plug (2).
8. Use a gear lube pump (1) to fill PTU with.8L (1.7 Pints.) of Mopar(R) 75W-90 Gear and Axle
Lubricant. 9. Install fill plug and torque to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4962
10. Reposition the PTU heat shield (2) to the side of the PTU, and install a new retaining clip (1).
11. Reposition the PTU heat shield (2) to the bottom of the PTU, and install bolt (1). Tighten to 12
Nm (105 in. lbs.). 12. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 4967
Control Module: Diagrams
Connector (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
MODULE-ALL WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
The AWD ECM (electronic control module) mounts on the driver side cowl side panel, where it is
concealed by the instrument panel. It communicates with other systems over the high-speed
CAN-C bus.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description >
Page 4970
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The all-wheel-drive system requires no driver input or control. Under most driving conditions, it is
passive and power is transmitted to the front wheels alone. The system functions to optimize
traction and handling under the following conditions:
Anticipates slip by responding to pedal position unlike all-wheel drive systems that rely on pumps
or viscous fluids to transfer torque, the system requires no front-to-rear slippage for activation. This
allows the system to transfer torque in response to accelerator pedal position. If the driver is asking
for a lot of power, the system immediately starts clamping the Electronically Controlled Coupling
(ECC), transferring a high percentage of power to the rear wheels. This avoids front wheel
slippage, as power to propel the car is transmitted through all four tires. This mode of operation is
called open-loop operation in that there is no feedback to affect the torque transfer.
Modulates torque to optimize traction on slippery surfaces a second, closed loop, operating mode
uses feedback from the wheel-speed sensors to determine the appropriate torque transfer. When
the front wheels slip, the all-wheel-drive electronic control module tells the ECC to start clamping,
sending power to the rear wheels. Attempting the same aggressive launch described above with
the front wheels on ice and the rear wheels on dry pavement, the ECC sends even more torque to
the rear wheels to minimize slippage and launch the vehicle. Both modes are always active and the
maximum of the two is chosen. Power to the rear wheels is modulated during lost of traction while
traveling at freeway speeds; for example, hydroplaning on a puddle of water, will send very little
power to the rear wheels because the controller knows at those speeds a lot of power is not
needed at the rear wheels.
Prevents binding during low-speed turns a third condition, which is independent of the others, uses
the ESP steering angle sensor to determine when the vehicle is turning in a tight circle. This
condition causes the electronic control module to reduce torque to the rear wheels to prevent
binding in the driveline. The electronic control module is always checking for this condition as well.
Influences handling at moderate speeds. The AWD system is used to influence vehicle dynamics.
Other manufacturers limit AWD to aiding traction or providing off-road capability. They concentrate
on launching the vehicle or going off road at speeds up to about 25 mph (40 km/hr). Above that
speed range, they use it to limit wheel slip for traction. Additional ECM calibration controls torque to
the rear wheels for improved handling in the 25-65 mph (40-105 km/hr) range. In this speed range,
the system utilizes torque to the rear wheels during cornering with the throttle open to make the car
turn more easily - make the handling more neutral. This is more readily accomplished with an
electronically controlled system, than with viscous-coupling or gerotor systems that require some
degree of front-to-rear slip to transfer torque to the rear wheels. Above 53 mph (113 km/hr), the
control strategy
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description >
Page 4971
provides minimal torque to the rear wheels under normal driving conditions to aid fuel economy.
Works with ESP and Traction Control the electronic control module also interfaces with the ESP
and traction control systems. The interface allows the ESP system to use the ECC to help gain
control of the vehicle. For this purpose, torque transmitted to the rear wheels by the ECC can be
reduced. The AWD system is not traction control. It only works on situations where front-to-rear
traction varies, for instance, front wheels on ice, rear wheels on dry pavement or climbing steep
grades. AWD does not aid side-to-side traction. ESP does that through brake intervention.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive Control Module - Removal
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the left front trim panel. 2. Remove the electrical connector. 3. Remove the mounting
nuts. 4. Remove the ECC module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive Control Module - Removal > Page
4974
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install ECC module into mounting studs. 2. Install mounting nuts and tighten to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.)
torque. 3. Install the electrical connector. 4. Install the left front trim panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove Power Transfer Unit. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Power
Transfer Unit - Removal 2. Remove outer halfshaft seal (2).
3. Remove power transfer unit end cover (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4979
4. Using suitable screwdriver or punch, remove inner halfshaft seal (1) and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4980
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using Driver Handle C-4171 (2) and Installer 9683 (1), install inner halfshaft seal until it bottoms
in bore. 2. Install roller bearing.
3. Install end cover (1) to PTU housing. Install and torque end cover-to-housing bolts (2) to 28 Nm
(20 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4981
4. Using driver Handle C-4171 (1) and seal Installer 6536-A (2), install outer halfshaft seal (3). 5.
Install PTU assembly. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Power Transfer Unit Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4982
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair
Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove Power Transfer Unit. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Power
Transfer Unit - Removal 2. Remove outer halfshaft seal (2).
3. Remove power transfer unit end cover (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4983
4. Using suitable screwdriver or punch, remove inner halfshaft seal (1) and discard.
Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using Driver Handle C-4171 (2) and Installer 9683 (1), install inner halfshaft seal until it bottoms
in bore. 2. Install roller bearing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4984
3. Install end cover (1) to PTU housing. Install and torque end cover-to-housing bolts (2) to 28 Nm
(20 ft. lbs.).
4. Using driver Handle C-4171 (1) and seal Installer 6536-A (2), install outer halfshaft seal (3). 5.
Install PTU assembly. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Power Transfer Unit Installation
Outer Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4985
1. Remove right halfshaft assembly. See: Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints/Axle Shaft
Assembly/Service and Repair/Half Shaft - Removal 2. Using suitable screwdriver (1), remove outer
halfshaft seal (2).
Outer Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install outer halfshaft seal using Handle C-4171 and Installer 6536-A. 2. Install right halfshaft
assembly. See: Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints/Axle Shaft Assembly/Service and Repair/Half
Shaft - Installation
Differential Carrier Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4986
NOTE: The Power Transfer Unit must be removed from the vehicle to replace this O-ring.
1. Remove PTU from transaxle. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Power
Transfer Unit - Removal 2. Remove the O-ring.
Differential Carrier Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (1). 2. Install the PTU to the transaxle. See: Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Power Transfer Unit - Installation. 3. Check PTU fluid level See: Fluid - Transfer
Case/Service and Repair.
Input Shaft Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4987
1. Remove power transfer unit. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Power
Transfer Unit - Removal 2. Using drill and suitable bit (2), drill hole in input shaft seal (1) to facilitate
removal with slide hammer. Use care not to damage the shaft sealing
surface.
3. Using slide hammer and suitable screw, remove input shaft seal.
Input Shaft Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using Handle C4171 (1) and Installer L-4429-3 (2), install input shaft seal. 2. Install Power
Transfer Unit. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Power Transfer Unit Installation
Output Flange Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4988
1. Remove propeller shaft See: Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints/Drive/Propeller
Shaft/Service and Repair/Propeller Shaft - Removal. 2. Using Spanner Wrench 6958 (1) and
suitable ratchet and socket, remove output flange nut
3. Install Puller 1026 (1) and remove PTU output flange (2). 4. Using suitable screwdriver, remove
seal and discard.
Output Flange Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4989
1. Using Installer 9684 (1) and Handle C-4171(2), install new PTU output flange seal.
2. Using Installer 9321 (2) and Handle C-4171 ,(1) install output flange (3). Lightly tap on flange
until sufficient threads are exposed to start flange
nut by hand.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair > Inner Axle Drive Shaft Seal - Removal > Page 4990
3. Using Spanner Wrench 6958 (1), install and torque output flange nut to 102 Nm (75 ft. lbs.)
torque. 4. Install propeller shaft See: Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints/Drive/Propeller
Shaft/Service and Repair/Propeller Shaft - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4997
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5000
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
NOTE: Keep the Top Sound Dampener Cover if replacing the unit
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5001
10. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
11. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
12. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 13. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5002
14. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
15. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 16. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 17.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
18. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 19. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 20. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5003
21. Remove the bolts (1) at the line pressure sensor. 22. Remove the line pressure sensor from the
valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5004
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the line pressure
sensor and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle on a hoist.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5005
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise the vehicle on the hoist.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5006
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and install the fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5007
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5008
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5009
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 3. Remove
the relay (1) at the core support.
4. Drain the radiator See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 5.
Remove clamps (1) at the upper radiator hose (2). 6. Remove the upper radiator hose See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5010
7. Remove the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2).
8. Remove the shift cable (1) from the manual lever (2).
9. Remove the fasteners (1) and the Front Sound Damper Cover (2).
10. Remove shift cable (1) from manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5011
11. Remove the top valve body oil pan (1) bolts.
12. Remove the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan (1).
13. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 14. Remove the front left side inner wheel splash screws from
front side of wheel opening (1) and fold shield (2) back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5012
15. Turn the wheel (3) fully to the left.
16. Remove the bolt (2) at the ground cable (3). 17. Remove the clip (1) at the valve body pan. 18.
Move cable away from the valve body pan.
19. Remove the pressure tap plug (2) at valve body oil pan. 20. Remove the lower valve body oil
pan bolts (1) and drain transmission fluid. 21. Remove the valve body oil pan.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5013
22. Remove the bolt (1) at the pressure control solenoid. 23. Remove the pressure control sensor
from the valve body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5014
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Pressure Control Solenoid - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the pressure control solenoid on to the valve body. 2. Install the bolts (1) to the pressure
control solenoid and tighten to 6 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
3. Install the valve body oil pan, use a bead of MOPAR(R) ATF RTV (MS-GF41). 4. Install the
upper valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 5. Install the pressure tap at valve
body oil pan and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 6. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5015
7. Install the solenoid pack connector (2) at valve body oil pan. 8. Raise and support the vehicle.
9. Install the lower valve body oil pan bolts and tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
10. Install the bolt at the ground cable and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5016
11. Install the clip to the valve body oil pan.
12. Install the Front Sound Damper Cover (2) and fasteners (1).
13. Move left side inner wheel splash shield (2) into place. 14. Install the left side inner wheel
splash shield screws (1). 15. Lower the vehicle.
16. Install the bolts (1) holding the power steering lines (2) and tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5017
17. Install shift cable (1) to manual lever (2).
18. Install upper radiator hose (2) and clamps (1). 19. Fill the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Pressure Control Sensor - Removal > Page 5018
20. Install the relay (1) at the core support. 21. Install the battery and battery tray See: Starting and
Charging/Battery/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 22. Install
the battery cables. 23. Fill transmission and road test See: Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Procedures/Fluid/Filter Service.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5022
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal > Page 5025
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center floor console to access the
gear selector unit. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center Console - Removal.
3. Firmly grasp the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing and rotate it
counterclockwise about 30 degrees to unlock it. 4. Pull the socket and bulb straight out from the
keyed opening in the shifter housing. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the socket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal > Page 5032
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing. 2. Push
the bulb straight into the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the
keyed opening in the side of the gear selector housing. 4. Insert the bulb and socket into the
housing until the socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it
into place. 6. Reinstall the center floor console. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center Console - Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5036
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 3 WAY
LAMP-PRNDL - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Quick Learn Procedure
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the scan tool. This program allows the electronic
transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the scan
tool indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 15.5° C (60° F) and below 93° C (200° F)
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the instrument
panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select Quick Learn
Procedure. Follow the instructions of the scan tool to perform the Quick Learn Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Quick Learn Procedure > Page 5043
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure
will result in an inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a scan tool.
1. Plug the scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the
Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the
instructions on the scan tool screen.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5048
Control Module: Diagrams
Connector (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
MODULE-ALL WHEEL DRIVE CONTROL (AWD) - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
The AWD ECM (electronic control module) mounts on the driver side cowl side panel, where it is
concealed by the instrument panel. It communicates with other systems over the high-speed
CAN-C bus.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description > Page 5051
Control Module: Description and Operation Final Drive Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The all-wheel-drive system requires no driver input or control. Under most driving conditions, it is
passive and power is transmitted to the front wheels alone. The system functions to optimize
traction and handling under the following conditions:
Anticipates slip by responding to pedal position unlike all-wheel drive systems that rely on pumps
or viscous fluids to transfer torque, the system requires no front-to-rear slippage for activation. This
allows the system to transfer torque in response to accelerator pedal position. If the driver is asking
for a lot of power, the system immediately starts clamping the Electronically Controlled Coupling
(ECC), transferring a high percentage of power to the rear wheels. This avoids front wheel
slippage, as power to propel the car is transmitted through all four tires. This mode of operation is
called open-loop operation in that there is no feedback to affect the torque transfer.
Modulates torque to optimize traction on slippery surfaces a second, closed loop, operating mode
uses feedback from the wheel-speed sensors to determine the appropriate torque transfer. When
the front wheels slip, the all-wheel-drive electronic control module tells the ECC to start clamping,
sending power to the rear wheels. Attempting the same aggressive launch described above with
the front wheels on ice and the rear wheels on dry pavement, the ECC sends even more torque to
the rear wheels to minimize slippage and launch the vehicle. Both modes are always active and the
maximum of the two is chosen. Power to the rear wheels is modulated during lost of traction while
traveling at freeway speeds; for example, hydroplaning on a puddle of water, will send very little
power to the rear wheels because the controller knows at those speeds a lot of power is not
needed at the rear wheels.
Prevents binding during low-speed turns a third condition, which is independent of the others, uses
the ESP steering angle sensor to determine when the vehicle is turning in a tight circle. This
condition causes the electronic control module to reduce torque to the rear wheels to prevent
binding in the driveline. The electronic control module is always checking for this condition as well.
Influences handling at moderate speeds. The AWD system is used to influence vehicle dynamics.
Other manufacturers limit AWD to aiding traction or providing off-road capability. They concentrate
on launching the vehicle or going off road at speeds up to about 25 mph (40 km/hr). Above that
speed range, they use it to limit wheel slip for traction. Additional ECM calibration controls torque to
the rear wheels for improved handling in the 25-65 mph (40-105 km/hr) range. In this speed range,
the system utilizes torque to the rear wheels during cornering with the throttle open to make the car
turn more easily - make the handling more neutral. This is more readily accomplished with an
electronically controlled system, than with viscous-coupling or gerotor systems that require some
degree of front-to-rear slip to transfer torque to the rear wheels. Above 53 mph (113 km/hr), the
control strategy
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Final Drive Control Module - Description > Page 5052
provides minimal torque to the rear wheels under normal driving conditions to aid fuel economy.
Works with ESP and Traction Control the electronic control module also interfaces with the ESP
and traction control systems. The interface allows the ESP system to use the ECC to help gain
control of the vehicle. For this purpose, torque transmitted to the rear wheels by the ECC can be
reduced. The AWD system is not traction control. It only works on situations where front-to-rear
traction varies, for instance, front wheels on ice, rear wheels on dry pavement or climbing steep
grades. AWD does not aid side-to-side traction. ESP does that through brake intervention.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive Control Module - Removal
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the left front trim panel. 2. Remove the electrical connector. 3. Remove the mounting
nuts. 4. Remove the ECC module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Final Drive Control Module - Removal > Page 5055
Control Module: Service and Repair Final Drive Control Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install ECC module into mounting studs. 2. Install mounting nuts and tighten to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.)
torque. 3. Install the electrical connector. 4. Install the left front trim panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body - Removal.
2. Remove the clamp plate bolts and clamp plate.
3. Remove the electrical connectors to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure sensors. 4.
Remove the solenoid/pressure switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly - Removal > Page 5062
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Solenoid and Pressure Switch
Assembly - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid/pressure switch assembly. 2. Install mounting bolts (1) at clamp plate (2) and
tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (1, 2) to the pressure control solenoid and line pressure
sensors. 4. Install valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5066
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 23 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body Removal
2. Remove the park rod assembly (2) from the TRS/rooster comb (1).
3. Remove the set screw (1) with a allen wrench (3) at manual lever (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 5069
4. Remove the roll pin (3) at the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Remove the manual lever (2) from case and inspect the bushing (3).
6. Remove the TRS/rooster (1, 2) comb from the case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 5070
7. Remove the manual lever seal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 5071
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair Transmission Range Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new manual lever oil seal (2) using socket (3).
2. Install the manual lever in the case up to the point of the TRS.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 5072
3. Install the TRS/rooser comb onto the manual lever and fully install the manual lever into the
case.
4. Install the roll pin (3) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) using a pin punch (2).
5. Install the set screw (1) at manual lever (2) and tighten to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Range Sensor - Removal > Page 5073
6. Install the park rod assembly (2) to the TRS/rooster comb (1) and place the park rod assembly
into the guide assembly. 7. Place the park pawl pin into the park pawl tube. 8. Install the electrical
connector. 9. Install the valve body See: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Valve Body/Service
and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Valve Body Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Input Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page 5078
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Input Speed Sensor > Page 5079
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-INPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way > Page 5082
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Output Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Input Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way > Page 5083
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Transfer Speed Sensor (62TE) (Transmission) 2 Way
Connector (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
SENSOR-TRANSFER SPEED (62TE) - (TRANSMISSION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5086
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5087
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5088
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5089
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Output Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor (2) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
The Output Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Output Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5090
The output speed sensor (2) is located at the rear of the case. It reads the rotation of the
underdrive compounder output carrier.
Input Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor (1) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5091
NOTE: Always use a new O-ring
The Input Speed Sensor is bolted (1) to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it to the
transaxle case.
Input Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The input speed sensor (1) is located at the top of the case, and read turbine speed from the input
clutch hub.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5092
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (3) is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC
signals as rotation occurs.
The Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor (1) is bolted to the transaxle case and uses a O-ring (2) to seal it
to the transaxle case.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Output Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5093
The transfer shaft speed sensor (3) is located at the rear of the case (backside). It reads rotation of
the front annulus/rear carrier assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5096
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5097
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5098
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5099
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5100
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5101
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Output Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the output speed sensor (2).
2. Remove the bolt at output speed sensor (1). 3. Pull up on output speed sensor to remove.
Output Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5102
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install output speed sensor (2) into case.
3. Install bolt at output speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5103
Input Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the input speed sensor (1).
2. Remove the bolt at input speed sensor. 3. Pull up on input speed sensor (1) to remove.
Input Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5104
1. Install a new O-ring (2).
2. Install input speed sensor (1) into case.
3. Install bolt at input speed sensor and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Engage electrical
connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5105
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Unplug the electrical connector at the transfer shaft sensor (3).
2. Remove the bolt at transfer shaft sensor (1). 3. Pull up on transfer shaft sensor to remove.
Transfer Shaft Speed Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Output Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5106
1. Install a new O-ring (2). on the transfer shaft speed sensor (1).
2. Install transfer shaft speed sensor (3) into case.
3. Install bolt at transfer shaft speed sensor (1) and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect
the electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5112
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 47 WAY
MODULE-ANTI-LOCK BRAKES - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 47 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5113
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Description
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Brake System Module Description
DESCRIPTION
The Antilock Brake Module (ABM) is a microprocessor-based device which monitors the antilock
brake system (ABS) during normal braking and controls it when the vehicle is in an ABS stop or
when in a traction control situation. The ABM utilizes a 47-way electrical connector on the vehicle
wiring harness. The power source for the ABM is through the ignition switch in the RUN or ON
position.
NOTE: The ABM is only separately serviceable for non-HSA (Hill Start Assist) equipped vehicles.
Do not remove the ABM for vehicles
equipped with HSA.
The ABM (1) is mounted to the HCU (2) as part of the Integrated Control Unit (ICU). The ICU is
located in the engine compartment below the master cylinder on the front suspension
cradle/crossmember. For information on the ICU, See: Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock
Brakes/Description and Operation/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Description - DESCRIPTION).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Description >
Page 5116
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Brake System Module Operation
OPERATION
The primary functions of the Antilock Brake Module (ABM) are to:
- Monitor the antilock brake system for proper operation.
- Detect wheel locking or wheel slipping tendencies by monitoring the speed of all four wheels of
the vehicle.
- Control fluid modulation to the wheel brakes while the system is in an ABS mode.
- Store diagnostic information.
- Provide communication to the scan tool while in diagnostic mode.
- Illuminate the amber ABS warning indicator lamp.
- Illuminate the ESP function lamp in the message center on the instrument panel when a traction
control event occurs.
- Illuminate the ESP function lamp when the amber ABS warning indicator lamp illuminates.
The ABM constantly monitors the antilock brake system for proper operation. If the ABM detects a
fault, it will turn on the amber ABS warning indicator lamp and disable the antilock braking system.
The normal base braking system will remain operational.
NOTE: If the vehicle is equipped with traction control, the ESP function lamp will illuminate anytime
the amber ABS warning indicator lamp
illuminates.
The ABM continuously monitors the speed of each wheel through the signals generated by the
wheel speed sensors to determine if any wheel is beginning to lock. When a wheel locking
tendency is detected, the ABM commands the ABM command coils to actuate. The coils then open
and close the valves in the HCU that modulate brake fluid pressure in some or all of the hydraulic
circuits. The ABM continues to control pressure in individual hydraulic circuits until a locking
tendency is no longer present.
The ABM contains a self-diagnostic program that monitors the antilock brake system for system
faults. When a fault is detected, the amber ABS warning indicator lamp is turned on and the fault
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is then stored in a diagnostic program memory. A latched fault will
disable certain system functionality for the current ignition cycle. An unlatched fault will disable
certain system functionality until the fault condition disappears. These DTC's will remain in the
ABM memory even after the ignition has been turned off. The DTC's can be read and cleared from
the ABM memory by a technician using a scan tool. If not cleared with a scan tool, the fault
occurrence and DTC will be automatically cleared from the ABM memory after the identical fault
has not been seen during the next 3,500 miles. Drive-off may be required for the amber ABS
warning indicator lamp to go out on the next ignition cycle.
ABM INPUTS
- Wheel speed sensors (four)
- Brake lamp switch
- Ignition switch
- System and pump voltage
- Ground
- ESP/BAS warning indicator lamp
- Diagnostic communication
ABM OUTPUTS
- Amber ABS warning indicator lamp actuation (via BUS)
- Red BRAKE warning indicator lamp actuation (via BUS)
- Instrument cluster (MIC) communication
- ESP/BAS warning indicator lamp
- Diagnostic communication
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal
LEFT-HAND DRIVE
NOTE: The ABM is only separately serviceable for non-HSA (Hill Start Assist) equipped vehicles.
Do not remove the ABM for vehicles
equipped with HSA.
1. Disconnect the negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate it. 2. Remove the engine
appearance cover.
3. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 4. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
5. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen. Remove the cowl screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 5119
6. Remove the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1) securing the wheel house brace to the strut
towers. 7. Remove the wheelhouse brace (2).
8. Remove two screws, then remove the fresh air plenum. 9. Raise and support the vehicle. See:
Maintenance
10. Loosen, but do not remove, the two mounting screws (2) attaching the ICU (1) mounting
bracket to the body. 11. Lift the ICU and mounting bracket (1) upward to near the top of the slots in
the bracket, then snug one or both of the mounting screws (2) to hold
the ICU in this position.
12. Lower the vehicle.
CAUTION: Before disassembling the ICU, the ICU must be thoroughly cleaned. This must be done
to prevent dirt particles and debris from
entering into vital areas of the ICU.
13. Thoroughly clean all surfaces of the ICU and brake tubes. Use only a solvent such as Mopar(R)
Brake Parts Cleaner or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 5120
NOTE: Use this figure in the following step to release the ABM harness connector cover. It shows
the location of the release tabs.
14. Disconnect the ABM harness connector from the Antilock Brake Module (ABM). To do so:
a. Depress the tabs on each side of the connector cover, then b. Pull outward and upward on the
lower half of the cover until it locks into position pointing straight outward (2). The connector can
then be
pulled straight outward off the ABM (1).
15. Remove the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU. A Torx T20 bit approximately 2
inches long works well.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 5121
CAUTION: When removing the ABM from the HCU, be sure to completely separate the two
components (approximately 38 mm (1.5 inches))
before removing the ABM. Otherwise, damage to the pressure sensor or pump motor connection
may result, requiring HCU replacement. Do not to touch the sensor terminals on the HCU side or
the contact pads on the ABM side as this may result in contamination and issues in the future.
16. Separate the ABM (1) from the HCU (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 5122
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Installation
LEFT-HAND DRIVE
1. Clean any debris off the mating surfaces of the HCU and ABM.
CAUTION: When installing new O-rings or solenoid valve stem seals, do not use any type of
lubricant.
2. If the seals (1) on the solenoid valve stems (2) are not new, replace them all. Each of the
solenoid valve stem seals must be new to keep out
moisture and debris; do not reuse solenoid valve stem seals.
3. Replace the pump/motor connector O-ring (1) if it is not new. Be sure the O-ring is properly
seated in the mounting groove (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 5123
4. Align components and install the ABM (1) on the HCU (2).
5. Install the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU. Tighten the mounting screws to 2
Nm (17 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 5124
CAUTION: Before installing the ABM harness connector on the ABM, be sure the seal is properly
installed in the connector.
6. Insert the ABM wiring harness connector (2) into the socket of the ABM (1) and close the cover,
locking the connector in place.
7. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
8. Loosen the two mounting screws (2) as necessary and allow the ICU (1) mounting bracket to
slide down over the mounting screws and hang the
assembly in place. Tighten the two mounting screws (2) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Position the fresh air plenum and install the two mounting screws.
11. Install the wheelhouse brace (2). Install and tighten the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1)
to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page 5125
12. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
13. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
14. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
15. Install the engine appearance cover. 16. Connect the negative cable on the battery negative
post. 17. Hook up the scan tool to initialize the ABM and perform the following:
a. Clear any faults. b. Perform the ABS Verification Test and road test the vehicle. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) Description
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Description and Operation Hydraulic Control unit
(HCU) - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) is mounted to the Antilock Brake Module (ABM) as part of the
Integrated Control Unit (ICU). The HCU controls the flow of brake fluid to the brakes using a series
of valves and accumulators. A pump/motor is mounted on the HCU to supply build pressure to the
brakes during TCS and ESP events and to empty the low pressure accumulators during ABS
events.
NOTE: The HCU is not serviceable from the ICU for vehicles equipped with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
For more information, See: Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Description - DESCRIPTION)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) Description > Page 5130
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Description and Operation Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) (2) and the Antilock Brake Module (ABM) (1) used with this
antilock brake system are combined (integrated) into one unit, which is called the Integrated
Control Unit (ICU).
The ICU (1) is located in the engine compartment, mounted to the right side body frame rail near
the strut tower.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) Description > Page 5131
On Right-Hand-Drive vehicles, the ICU (1) is located in the engine compartment, mounted to the
left side body frame rail and strut tower.
The ABS with ESP(R) and All-Speed Traction Control ICU consists of the following components:
the ABM, 8 (build/decay) solenoid valves, two traction control solenoid valves, two electronic
shuttle valves, valve block, fluid accumulators, a pump, and an electric pump/motor.
NOTE: The HCU and the ABM are not serviceable separately from the ICU for vehicles equipped
with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
The replaceable components of the ICU are the HCU and the ABM. No attempt should be made to
service any components of the HCU or ABM. The ABM can be serviced without removing the entire
assembly from the vehicle.
For additional information on the ABM, See: Electronic Brake Control Module/Description and
Operation/Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Description. For additional information on the HCU,
See: Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Description - DESCRIPTION).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Removal and Replacement
Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Installation
INSTALLATION
To install the HCU, assemble and install the ICU. See: Overhaul/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Assembly See: Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Removal
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
NOTE: If servicing the ABM only, See: Electronic Brake Control Module/Service and
Repair/Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable from battery post.
2. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first 25 mm (1 inch)
of travel and hold it in this position. This will
isolate the master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to
drain out of the master cylinder reservoir while the lines are disconnected.
3. Remove the engine appearance cover.
4. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 5. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5134
6. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen. Remove the cowl screen (3).
7. Remove the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1) securing the wheel house brace to the strut
towers. 8. Remove the wheelhouse brace (2).
9. Remove two screws, then remove the fresh air plenum.
10. Pull the brake tube bundle routing clips (with tubes) loose from studs on the dash panel.
11. Remove the primary (4) and secondary (1) brake tubes (from master cylinder) at the hydraulic
control unit (7). 12. Remove the remaining brake tubes (2, 3, 5, 6) at the hydraulic control unit (7).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5135
NOTE: Use this figure in the following step to release the ABM harness connector cover. It shows
the location of the release tabs.
13. Disconnect the ABM harness connector from the Antilock Brake Module (ABM). To do so:
a. Depress the tabs on each side of the connector cover, then b. Pull outward and upward on the
lower half of the cover until it locks into position pointing straight outward (2). The connector can
then be
pulled straight outward off the ABM (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5136
14. Loosen, but do not remove, the two mounting screws (2) attaching the ICU (1) mounting
bracket to the body. 15. Lift the ICU and mounting bracket (1) off the mounting screws (2). 16.
Move the brake tubes around as necessary without bending them and remove the ICU with
bracket.
NOTE: The HCU and the ABM are not serviceable separately from the ICU for vehicles equipped
with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
17. To separate the ABM from the HCU, See: Overhaul/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Disassembly.
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
1. Install the ICU with bracket (1) through the opening between the A/C lines and the exhaust
manifold using the opposite of how it was removed. 2. Place the mounting bracket for the ICU (1)
over the mounting screws (2) and hang the assembly in place. Tighten the two mounting screws (2)
to
23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5137
CAUTION: Before installing the ABM harness connector on the ABM, be sure the seal is properly
installed in the connector.
3. Insert the ABM wiring harness connector (2) into the socket of the ABM (1) and close the cover,
locking the connector in place.
CAUTION: The brake tubes must be routed to the correct ports. Improper routing can lead to
degraded or undesirable system performance
including external brake fluid leaks. (1) Master Cylinder Secondary
(2) Front Left
- (3) Front Right
- (4) Master Cylinder Primary
- (5) Rear Left
- (6) Rear Right
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5138
4. Install the four chassis brake tubes (2, 3, 5, 6) at the ICU hydraulic control unit (7). Tighten the
tube nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.). 5. Install the primary (4) and secondary (1) brake tubes at the ICU
hydraulic control unit (7). Tighten the tube nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
6. Push the brake tube bundle routing clips (with tubes) onto the studs on the dash panel. 7.
Position the fresh air plenum and install the two mounting screws.
8. Install the wheelhouse brace (2). Install and tighten the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1)
to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
10. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5139
11. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
12. Install the engine appearance cover.
13. Remove the brake pedal holding tool. 14. Connect the battery negative cable to the battery
post. It is important that this be performed properly. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service
and Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection
15. Hook up the scan tool to initialize the ABM and perform the following:
a. Clear any faults. b. Fill the master cylinder to the proper fill level and bleed the base and ABS
hydraulic systems. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair c. Check for leaks. d. Perform the ABS
Verification Test and road test the vehicle. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5140
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS
Verification Test
Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The HCU is not serviceable from the ICU for vehicles equipped with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
To remove the HCU, the ICU must be removed and disassembled. See: Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Removal See: Overhaul/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Disassembly
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5141
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Overhaul
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Assembly
ASSEMBLY
1. Clean any debris off the mating surfaces of the HCU and ABM.
CAUTION: When installing new O-rings or solenoid valve stem seals, do not use any type of
lubricant.
2. If the seals (1) on the solenoid valve stems (2) are not new, replace them all. Each of the
solenoid valve stem seals must be new to keep out
moisture and debris; do not reuse solenoid valve stem seals.
3. Replace the pump/motor connector O-ring (1) if it is not new. Be sure the O-ring is properly
seated in the mounting groove (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5142
4. Align components and install the ABM (1) on the HCU (2).
5. Install the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU. Tighten the mounting screws to 2
Nm (17 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5143
6. If necessary, install the mounting pins (1) in the ICU (2) and tighten to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.).
7. Install the ICU in the vehicle. See: Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Installation
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: The HCU and the ABM are not serviceable separately from the ICU for vehicles equipped
with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
1. If necessary, remove the mounting pins from the ICU.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5144
2. Remove the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU.
3. Separate the ABM (1) from the HCU (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 5148
Lateral Accelerometer: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 4 WAY
SENSOR-DYNAMICS - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 5149
Lateral Accelerometer: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensors are housed into one unit known as the Dynamics
Sensor (1). The sensor is used to measure side-to-side (Lateral) motion and vehicle rotational
sensing (how fast the vehicle is turning - Yaw).
The Dynamics Sensor (1) is located on the floor tunnel just forward of the center floor console (2),
below the instrument panel.
Yaw and Lateral Acceleration Sensors cannot be serviced separately. The entire Dynamics Sensor
must be replaced when necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from the battery post.
2. Remove the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below instrument panel.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness connector (3) at the dynamics sensor (1). 4. Working on each
side of the floor tunnel, remove the nuts (2) mounting the dynamics sensor to the floor pan tunnel
(4). 5. Remove the dynamics sensor (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal > Page 5152
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the dynamics sensor (1) over the studs mounted to the floor pan tunnel (4). 2. Working on
each side of the floor pan tunnel (4), install the two mounting nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 9 Nm (80
in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wiring harness connector (3) to the dynamics sensor (1).
4. Install the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below the instrument panel.
5. Connect the battery negative cable to the battery post. It is important that this be performed
properly. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service
and Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection
6. Perform the Verification Test and clear any faults. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Traction Control Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
MODULE-ASBM
The ESP Off Switch (2) is part of the accessory switch bank module located in the center bezel (2)
on the instrument panel above the radio. The ESP Off switch turns the Electronic Stability Program
off whenever the switch is depressed. Depressing the switch a second time turns the ESP(R) back
on. The switch resets itself each time the ignition is cycled.
When the ESP Off switch is depressed and released, turning ESP(R) off, it does not completely
turn the system off. The ESP(R) system reduces torque management to a lesser amount, but
ESP(R) function can still occur if the system perceives the need.
The ESP Off switch is serviced as part of the accessory switch bank. There are different accessory
switch banks available based on the option content of the vehicle. Ensure the accessory switch
bank being installed matches the vehicle options.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Removal
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The ESP Off switch is integral to the accessory switch bank and cannot be serviced
separately.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the center bezel from the
instrument panel and place it on a work bench See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Remove the screws that secure the accessory switch bank to the back of the center bezel and
remove the accessory switch bank.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Removal > Page 5158
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The ESP Off switch is serviced as part of the accessory switch bank.
NOTE: There are different instrument panel accessory switch banks available based on the option
content of the vehicle. Ensure the accessory
switch bank being installed matches the vehicle options.
1. Position the accessory switch bank onto the back of the instrument panel center bezel. 2. Install
the screws that secure the accessory switch bank to the center bezel. Tighten the screws to 2 Nm
(17 in. lbs.). 3. Install the center bezel onto the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Installation.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 5. Perform the ABS Verification Test See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble
Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS Verification Test and make sure the
ESP Off switch operates properly. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
6. Verify proper operation of all components controlled by the switch bank.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 5163
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 5164
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 5165
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-LEFT REAR - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way > Page 5168
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-RIGHT REAR - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way > Page 5169
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (Headlamp And Dash) 2 Way
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-LEFT FRONT - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way > Page 5170
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (Headlamp And Dash) 2 Way
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-RIGHT FRONT - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wheel Speed Sensor - Description
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensor - Description
Front
DESCRIPTION
The antilock brake system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed
sensors. The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto-resistive to help increase
performance and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A Wheel
Speed Sensor (WSS) is used at each wheel. A magnetic pole encoder serves as the trigger
mechanism for each sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one
encoder.
A front wheel speed sensor (2) is attached to a mounting boss on each front knuckle (3). The
encoder is an integral part of the hub and bearing.
WSS air gaps are not adjustable.
Rear
DESCRIPTION
The antilock brake system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed
sensors. The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto-resistive to help increase
performance and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A Wheel
Speed Sensor (WSS) is used at each wheel. A magnetic pole encoder serves as the trigger
mechanism for each sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one
encoder.
The rear wheel speed sensor (2) head is mounted to the rear hub and bearing (1). The encoder is
integral to the hub and bearing assembly. The encoder is serviced as part of the rear hub and
bearing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wheel Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5173
WSS air gaps are not adjustable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wheel Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5174
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensor - Operation
Front
OPERATION
The ABM sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the ABM. The relationship of the magnetic pole encoder to the
permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output
of the sensor, sent to the ABM, is a DC voltage signal with changing voltage and current levels.
The ground for the IC and the current sense circuit is provided by the ABM.
When a pole is properly aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8 volts and a
constant 7 mA current is sent to the ABM. As the magnetic pole encoder rotates, the encoder shifts
the magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The ABM senses a voltage
signal of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The ABM measures the amperage of the digital signal
for each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABM as the wheel speed.
Rear
OPERATION
The ABM sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the ABM. The relationship of the magnetic pole encoder to the
permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output
of the sensor, sent to the ABM, is a DC voltage signal with changing voltage and current levels.
The ground for the IC and the current sense circuit is provided by the ABM.
When a pole is properly aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8 volts and a
constant 7 mA current is sent to the ABM. As the magnetic pole encoder rotates, the encoder shifts
the magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The ABM senses a voltage
signal of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The ABM measures the amperage of the digital signal
for each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABM as the wheel speed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Open the hood. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable connector (2) from the wiring
harness connector (3) on top of the frame rail (1) to the inside of the strut
tower.
3. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
4. Remove the grommet (1) from the hole in the body (7) and pull the wheel speed sensor cable
out of the hole. 5. Remove the speed sensor cable routing clip (2) from the outside frame rail (6). 6.
Remove the screw fastening the cable routing clamp (3) to the outside frame rail (6).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5177
7. Remove the screw (2) securing the wheel speed sensor routing bracket (3) to the brake flex
hose bracket (4). 8. Remove the routing clip (1) securing wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle
(5).
9. Remove the mounting screw (1) fastening the wheel speed sensor head (2) to the knuckle (3).
Pull the sensor head out of the knuckle and remove
the sensor from the vehicle.
Rear
REMOVAL
1. Access and remove the rear brake rotor. See: Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5178
CAUTION: Prior to removal, clean area around sensor head to help prevent contaminants from
entering bearing when sensor head is
removed.
2. Remove the screw (3) fastening the speed sensor head (2) to the hub and bearing (1).
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor routing clip (4) from the brake tube routing bracket (1). 4.
Remove the wheel speed sensor cable from the routing clips (3) above the trailing arm.
5. Remove the wheel speed sensor head (2) from the hub and bearing (1), then pass it through the
brake shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5179
6. Remove the screw (1) fastening the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (2) to the rear
suspension crossmember (3).
7. Remove the screw (2) securing the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (1) to the trailing link.
8. Disconnect the vehicle wiring harness (3) from the wheel speed sensor connector (2) on the
body (1). 9. Disengage the wheel speed sensor connector from the routing clip fastened to the
body using a screwdriver. Pull the connector forward off the
routing clip. Or, if a NEW routing clip is available, remove the routing clip from the body with the
connector attached.
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5180
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Failure to install speed sensor cables properly may result in contact with moving parts
or an over extension of cables causing an
open circuit. Be sure that cables are installed, routed, and clipped properly.
1. Install the wheel speed sensor head (2) into the knuckle (3). Install the mounting screw (1) and
tighten it to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.).
2. Install the routing clip (1) securing the wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle (5). 3. Position
the wheel speed sensor routing bracket (3) on the brake flex hose bracket (4) and install the
mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting
screw to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5181
4. Position the wheel speed sensor cable routing clamp (4) on the outside frame rail (6) and install
the mounting screw (3). Tighten the mounting
screw to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the speed sensor cable routing clip (2) on the outside frame rail (6). 6. Insert the wheel
speed sensor cable through the hole in the body (7) and install the grommet (1) in the hole.
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Connect the wheel speed sensor cable connector (2) to the wiring harness
connector (3) on top of the frame rail (1). 9. Perform the Diagnostic Verification Test and clear any
faults. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
Rear
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5182
1. Slide the wheel speed sensor wiring connector (2) onto the routing clip mounted on the body
until it locks into place or if a NEW routing clip is
attached to the connector, push it into the mounting holes on the body.
2. Connect the vehicle wiring harness (3) to the wheel speed sensor connector (2).
3. Attach the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (2) to the rear suspension crossmember (3) using
the mounting screw (1). Tighten the mounting screw
to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
4. Attach the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (1) to the trailing link using the mounting screw (2).
Tighten the mounting screw to 20 Nm (15 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5183
5. Apply bearing grease (supplied with part) to sensor head shaft and O-ring.
CAUTION: Ensure that sensor mounting surface on bearing is clean before sensor installation.
6. Pass the wheel speed sensor head through the hole in the brake shield, then push it into the
mounting hole in hub and bearing (3) and align the
mounting screw hole.
7. Install a NEW mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting screw to 6 Nm (55 in. lbs.).
8. Install the wheel speed sensor routing clip (4) in the brake tube routing bracket (1). 9. Install the
wheel speed sensor cable into the routing clips (3) above the trailing arm.
10. Install brake rotor as well as all components necessary to access it. See: Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
11. Perform the ABS Verification Test and clear any faults. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 5187
Yaw Rate Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 4 WAY
SENSOR-DYNAMICS - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 5188
Yaw Rate Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensors are housed into one unit known as the Dynamics
Sensor (1). The sensor is used to measure side-to-side (Lateral) motion and vehicle rotational
sensing (how fast the vehicle is turning - Yaw).
The Dynamics Sensor (1) is located on the floor tunnel just forward of the center floor console (2),
below the instrument panel.
Yaw and Lateral Acceleration Sensors cannot be serviced separately. The entire Dynamics Sensor
must be replaced when necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from the battery post.
2. Remove the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below instrument panel.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness connector (3) at the dynamics sensor (1). 4. Working on each
side of the floor tunnel, remove the nuts (2) mounting the dynamics sensor to the floor pan tunnel
(4). 5. Remove the dynamics sensor (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal > Page 5191
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the dynamics sensor (1) over the studs mounted to the floor pan tunnel (4). 2. Working on
each side of the floor pan tunnel (4), install the two mounting nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 9 Nm (80
in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wiring harness connector (3) to the dynamics sensor (1).
4. Install the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below the instrument panel.
5. Connect the battery negative cable to the battery post. It is important that this be performed
properly. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service
and Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection
6. Perform the Verification Test and clear any faults. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Base Brake Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Base Brake Bleeding
BASE BRAKE BLEEDING
NOTE: This bleeding procedure is only for the vehicle's base brakes hydraulic system. For
bleeding the antilock brakes hydraulic system, See:
CAUTION: Before removing the master cylinder reservoir cap, thoroughly clean the cap and master
cylinder fluid reservoir to prevent dirt
and other foreign matter from dropping into the master cylinder fluid reservoir.
NOTE: The following wheel sequence should be used when bleeding the brake hydraulic system.
The use of this wheel sequence will ensure
adequate removal of all trapped air from the brake hydraulic system.
- Left Rear Wheel
- Right Front Wheel
- Right Rear Wheel
- Left Front Wheel
NOTE: When bleeding the brake system, some air may be trapped in the brake lines far upstream,
as much as ten feet from the bleeder screw.
Therefore, it is essential to have a fast flow of a large volume of brake fluid when bleeding the
brakes to ensure all the air gets out.
Pressure bleeding the brakes is recommended, although the brakes may be manually bled or
pressure bled. Refer to the appropriate following procedure.
PRESSURE BLEEDING PROCEDURE
Follow the pressure bleeder manufacturer's instructions for use of the pressure bleeding
equipment.
1. Install Master Cylinder Pressure Bleed Cap, Special Tool 6921, or equivalent on the master
cylinder fluid reservoir. Attach the fluid hose from the
pressure bleeder to the fitting on Special Tool 6921.
2. Attach a clear plastic hose (1) to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar (2)
containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of
the hose.
3. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain a steady stream of brake fluid. 4.
After approximately 120-240 ml (4-8 ounces) of fluid have been bled through the brake circuit and
an air-free flow is maintained in the clear
plastic hose and jar, close the bleeder screw.
5. Repeat this procedure at all the remaining bleeder screws. 6. Check and adjust brake fluid level
to the FULL mark on the reservoir. 7. Check brake pedal travel and feel. If pedal travel is excessive
or if the pedal feels excessively spongy, some air may still be trapped in the system.
Re-bleed the brakes as necessary including the IPB Caliper Brake Bleeding Procedure on the rear
calipers as listed below.
8. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
MANUAL BLEEDING PROCEDURE
NOTE: To bleed the brakes manually, the aid of a helper will be required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Base Brake Bleeding > Page 5196
1. Attach a clear plastic hose (1) to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar (2)
containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of
the hose.
2. Have a helper pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 3. With
the pedal in the down position, open the bleeder screw at least one full turn. 4. Once the brake
pedal has dropped, close the bleeder screw. After the bleeder screw is closed, release the brake
pedal. 5. Repeat the above steps until all trapped air is removed from that wheel circuit (usually
four or five times).
6. Bleed the remaining wheel circuits in the same manner until all air is removed from the brake
system. Monitor the fluid level in the master cylinder
reservoir to make sure it does not go dry.
7. Check and adjust brake fluid level to the FULL mark. 8. Check brake pedal travel and feel. If
pedal travel is excessive or if the pedal feels excessively spongy, some air may still be trapped in
the system.
Re-bleed the brakes as necessary including the IPB Caliper Brake Bleeding Procedure on the rear
calipers as listed below.
9. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
IPB CALIPER BRAKE BLEEDING PROCEDURE
NOTE: The following procedure is normally only necessary if a rear brake caliper has been
removed and installed, or replaced.
Perform the following procedure on each rear brake caliper as necessary.
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the
tire and wheel assembly (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Base Brake Bleeding > Page 5197
3. Remove the brake caliper lower guide pin bolt (1). 4. Swing the caliper assembly upward,
pivoting off the upper guide pin, until clear of the adapter bracket.
5. Remove the outboard pad (5) from the adapter bracket. 6. Return the caliper back down over the
adapter bracket into mounted position and install the lower guide pin bolt finger tight. 7. Slowly
pump the brake pedal until the caliper fingers touch the outboard surface of the brake rotor.
Release the pedal. 8. Remove the brake caliper lower guide pin bolt. 9. Swing the caliper assembly
upward, pivoting off the upper guide pin, until clear of the adapter bracket.
10. Reinstall the outboard pad in the adapter bracket. 11. Open the caliper bleeder screw at least
one full turn.
12. Seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Base Brake Bleeding > Page 5198
e. Thread the screw drive on 8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the
caliper piston. Do not over tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
13. Close the bleeder screw. 14. Return the caliper back down over the adapter bracket into
mounted position and install the lower guide pin bolt finger tight. 15. Have a helper pump the brake
pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 16. With the pedal in the down position,
open the bleeder screw at least one full turn and let out fluid and air, if any. 17. Once the brake
pedal has dropped, close the bleeder screw. Once the bleeder screw is closed, release the brake
pedal. 18. Repeat the previous three steps until all trapped air is removed. 19. Tighten the guide
pin bolt to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.). 20. Repeat the above procedure on the opposite rear brake caliper
as necessary. 21. Check brake pedal travel and feel. If pedal travel is still excessive or if the pedal
feels excessively spongy, repeat the entire procedure as
necessary.
22. Install the tire and wheel assembly See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
23. Lower the vehicle. 24. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and
pedal feel is correct.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Base Brake Bleeding > Page 5199
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System Bleeding
ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The base brake's hydraulic system must be bled anytime air enters the hydraulic system. The ABS
must always be bled anytime it is suspected that the HCU has ingested air.
Brake systems with ABS must be bled as two independent braking systems. The non-ABS portion
of the brake system with ABS is to be bled the same as any non-ABS system.
The ABS portion of the brake system must be bled separately. Use the following procedure to
properly bleed the brake hydraulic system including the ABS.
NOTE: During the brake bleeding procedure, be sure the brake fluid level remains close to the
FULL level in the master cylinder fluid
reservoir. Check the fluid level periodically during the bleeding procedure and add Mopar(R) DOT 3
brake fluid as required.
BLEEDING
When bleeding the ABS system, the following bleeding sequence must be followed to insure
complete and adequate bleeding.
1. Make sure all hydraulic fluid lines are installed and properly torqued. 2. Connect the scan tool to
the diagnostics connector. The diagnostic connector is located under the lower steering column
cover to the left of the
steering column.
3. Using the scan tool, check to make sure the ABM does not have any fault codes stored. If it
does, clear them.
WARNING: When bleeding the brake system wear safety glasses. A clear bleed tube (1) must be
attached to the bleeder screws and submerged
in a clear container filled part way with clean brake fluid (2). Direct the flow of brake fluid away from
yourself and the painted surfaces of the vehicle. Brake fluid at high pressure may come out of the
bleeder screws when opened.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding is recommended to bleed the base brake system to ensure all air is
removed from system. Manual bleeding may also
be used, but additional time is needed to remove all air from system.
4. Bleed the base brake system. See: 5. Using the scan tool, select ECU VIEW, followed by ABS
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS to access bleeding. Follow the instructions
displayed. When finished, disconnect the scan tool and proceed.
6. Bleed the base brake system a second time. Check brake fluid level in the reservoir periodically
to prevent emptying, causing air to enter the
hydraulic system.
7. Fill the master cylinder fluid reservoir to the FULL level. 8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure the
brakes are operating correctly and that the brake pedal does not feel spongy.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Brake and/or Accelerator Pedals - Removal
Brake Pedal Assy: Service and Repair Brake and/or Accelerator Pedals - Removal
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from its post on the battery. 2. If equipped,
remove the silencer pad below the steering column opening cover.
3. Disconnect the wiring connector (4) at the stop lamp switch (3). 4. Remove the stop lamp switch
wiring routing clip (1) from the brake pedal bracket (2).
5. Remove the stop lamp switch (2). Do not reuse the stop lamp switch on vehicles built prior to
July 21, 2008.See: Lighting and Horns/Brake
Light Switch/Service and Repair/Stop Lamp Switch - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Brake and/or Accelerator Pedals - Removal > Page 5204
6. Remove the retaining clip (2) securing the power brake booster push rod (1) to the brake pedal.
To do so, position a small screwdriver under the
center tang of the retaining clip, then rotate the screwdriver enough to allow the retaining clip tang
to pass over the end of the brake pedal pin (3). Remove and discard the clip. Do not reuse the clip.
7. Slide the booster push rod (1) off the brake pedal pin (3).
8. Remove the four nuts (4) attaching the brake pedal (1) (and power brake booster) to the dash
panel. 9. Remove the remaining nut (5) attaching the brake pedal (1) to the dash panel.
10. Remove the brake pedal (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Brake and/or Accelerator Pedals - Removal > Page 5205
Brake Pedal Assy: Service and Repair Brake and/or Accelerator Pedals - Installation
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
1. Carefully install the brake pedal and bracket assembly (1) in the vehicle lining up the bracket
with the power brake booster mounting studs and the
stud (2) on the dash panel.
2. Install the four nuts (4) attaching the brake pedal (1) (and power brake booster) to the dash
panel. Do not tighten the nuts at this time. 3. Install the remaining nut (5) attaching the brake pedal
(1) to the dash panel. To tighten this nut (and the other four from the preceding step), refer
to the following step.
CAUTION: Because of power brake booster design, it is very important to tighten the mounting
nuts in the proper sequence.
4. Tighten the brake pedal/booster mounting nuts in the proper sequence to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Brake and/or Accelerator Pedals - Removal > Page 5206
5. Using Mopar(R) Lubriplate, or an equivalent, coat the surface of the brake pedal pin (3) where it
contacts the brake booster push rod (1). 6. Install the power brake booster push rod (1) on the pin
(3) mounted on the side of the brake pedal. Install a NEW retaining clip (2) on the end of
the pin. Do not reuse the old clip.
CAUTION: Do not reuse the original stop lamp switch on vehicles built prior to July 21, 2008.
Anytime a switch has been removed or its
position compromised, a new switch must be installed and adjusted. Do not attempt to readjust the
switch. The original brake lamp switch can be reused and adjusted on vehicles built on or after July
21, 2008.
7. Install and adjust a NEW stop lamp switch (2) in the brake pedal bracket (1) on vehicle built prior
to July 21, 2008. The original brake lamp
switch can be reused on vehicles built on or after July 21, 2008. See: Lighting and Horns/Brake
Light Switch/Service and Repair/Stop Lamp Switch - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Brake and/or Accelerator Pedals - Removal > Page 5207
8. If not already performed, connect the wiring connector (4) at the stop lamp switch (3). 9. Attach
the stop lamp switch wiring routing clip (1) at the brake pedal bracket (2).
10. If equipped, install the silencer pad below the instrument panel. 11. Connect the battery
negative cable to its post on the battery. 12. Check the stop lamps to verify they are operating
properly and not staying on when the pedal is in the released position. 13. Road test the vehicle to
ensure proper operation of the brakes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Caliper: Procedures
Front
CLEANING
WARNING:
Chrysler LLC does not manufacture any vehicles or replacement parts that contain asbestos.
Aftermarket products may or may not contain asbestos. Refer to aftermarket product packaging for
product information.
Whether the product contains asbestos or not, dust and dirt can accumulate on brake parts during
normal use. Follow practices prescribed by appropriate regulations for the handling, processing
and disposing of dust and debris.
To clean or flush the internal passages of the brake caliper, use fresh brake fluid or Mopar(R)
Non-Chlorinated Brake Parts Cleaner. Never use gasoline, kerosene, alcohol, oil, transmission fluid
or any fluid containing mineral oil to clean the caliper. These fluids will damage rubber cups and
seals.
Rear
CLEANING
WARNING:
Chrysler LLC does not manufacture any vehicles or replacement parts that contain asbestos.
Aftermarket products may or may not contain asbestos. Refer to aftermarket product packaging for
product information.
Whether the product contains asbestos or not, dust and dirt can accumulate on brake parts during
normal use. Follow practices prescribed by appropriate regulations for the handling, processing
and disposing of dust and debris.
To clean or flush the internal passages of the brake caliper, use fresh brake fluid or Mopar(R)
Non-Chlorinated Brake Parts Cleaner. Never use gasoline, kerosene, alcohol, oil, transmission fluid
or any fluid containing mineral oil to clean the caliper. These fluids will damage rubber cups and
seals.
Front
INSPECTION
Inspect the disc brake caliper for the following:
- Brake fluid leaks in and around piston boot area
- Ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot
If caliper fails inspection, disassemble and recondition caliper, replacing the seals and dust boots.
Rear
INSPECTION
Inspect the disc brake caliper for the following:
- Brake fluid leaks in and around piston boot area
- Ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot
If caliper fails inspection, disassemble and recondition caliper, replacing the seals and dust boots.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5213
Brake Caliper: Removal and Replacement
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch (25
mm) of travel and hold it in this position. This will
isolate the master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to
drain out of the master cylinder reservoir when the lines are opened.
2. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
3. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5214
4. Remove the banjo bolt (3) connecting the brake flex hose (2) to the brake caliper (1). There are
two washers (4) that will come off with the banjo
bolt. Discard the washers. They should not be reused.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
5. Remove the two brake caliper guide pin bolts (2, 3). 6. Slide the disc brake caliper (4) from the
disc brake adapter bracket (1) and brake pads and remove.
Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable from battery post.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5215
2. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress brake pedal past its first inch of travel and
hold it in this position. Holding pedal in this
position will isolate master cylinder from hydraulic brake system and will not allow brake fluid to
drain out of brake fluid reservoir while brake lines are open.
3. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance
4. Remove wheel mounting nuts (3), then tire and wheel assembly (1).
5. Manually release the parking brake cable tension. See: Parking Brake System/Service and
Repair
6. Collapse the cable retainer fingers (2) at the end of the cable housing (3), then pull the cable
housing out of the mounting bracket (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5216
7. Slide the cable strand out of the mounting bracket, then pull the parking brake cable strand (1)
upward and unhook it from the caliper lever (2).
8. Remove the banjo bolt (4) connecting the brake flex hose (3) to the brake caliper (1). There are
two washers (2) that will come off with the banjo
bolt. Discard the washers. They should not be reused.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
9. Remove two caliper guide pin bolts (1).
10. Slide the disc brake caliper (2) from the disc brake adapter bracket (3) and brake pads.
Front
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5217
INSTALLATION
1. Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper. Use a C-clamp to retract
the piston. Place a wood block over the piston
before installing the C-clamp to avoid damaging the piston.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper (4) onto the adapter bracket (1) to avoid damaging
the guide pin boots.
2. Install the disc brake caliper over the brake pads on the brake caliper adapter bracket.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
3. Align the caliper guide pin bolt holes with the adapter bracket. Install the upper (2) and lower (3)
caliper guide pin bolts. Tighten the guide pin
bolts to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the banjo bolt (3) connecting the brake flex hose (2) to the brake caliper (1). Install NEW
brake hose washers (4) on each side of the hose
fitting as the banjo bolt is guided through the fitting. Thread the banjo bolt into the caliper and
tighten it to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5218
5. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Remove the brake pedal holding tool.
8. Bleed the caliper as necessary. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair 9. Road test the vehicle
and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the brake shoes.
Rear
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5219
CAUTION: When installing a NEW brake caliper it is necessary to bleed the brakes using a special
procedure which has been integrated to
this installation procedure.
1. Remove the outboard pad (5) from the adapter bracket.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper (2) onto the adapter bracket to avoid damaging the
guide pin boots.
2. Install the disc brake caliper (2) over the inboard brake pad on the brake caliper adapter bracket
and the brake rotor.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
3. Align the caliper guide pin bolt holes with the adapter bracket. Install the upper and lower caliper
guide pin bolts (1). Lightly tighten the guide pin
bolts at this time.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5220
4. Install the banjo bolt (4) connecting the brake flex hose (3) to the brake caliper (1). Be sure to
install a NEW brake hose washer (2) on each
side of the hose fitting as the banjo bolt is guided through the fitting. Thread the banjo bolt into the
caliper and tighten it to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs.).
5. Access the interior of the vehicle, remove the brake pedal holder, then slowly pump the brake
pedal until the rear caliper fingers touch the
outboard surface of the brake rotor where the brake pad was removed. Release the pedal.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
6. Remove two caliper guide pin bolts (1). 7. Slide the disc brake caliper (2) from the disc brake
adapter bracket (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5221
8. Reinstall the outboard pad (5) in the adapter bracket (3).
9. Open the caliper bleeder screw at least one full turn.
10. Seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5). e. Thread the screw drive on
8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the caliper piston. Do not over
tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
11. Close the bleeder screw.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5222
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper onto the adapter bracket to avoid damaging the
guide pin boots.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
12. Return the brake caliper back down over the adapter bracket into mounted position and install
the guide pin bolts (1). Tighten both guide pin bolts
to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: While bleeding air from the brake caliper in the following steps, be sure to monitor the fluid
level in the master cylinder reservoir
making sure it does not go dry.
13. Have a helper pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 14.
With the pedal in the down position, open the bleeder screw at least one full turn and let out fluid
and air, if any. 15. Once the brake pedal has dropped, close the bleeder screw. Once the bleeder
screw is closed, release the brake pedal. 16. Repeat the previous three steps as necessary until all
trapped air is removed. 17. If necessary, bleed remaining wheel circuits as necessary using normal
bleeding procedure. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
18. Pull the parking brake cable strand (1) outward from the cable housing and hook it onto the
caliper lever (2).
19. Push the excess cable strand back into the cable housing, then insert the cable housing (3) into
the mounting bracket (1) until the retainer fingers
(2) lock into place. Make sure both fingers are engaged preventing removal of the cable from the
bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5223
20. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
21. Reconnect the parking brake cable equalizer and reset the cable tension. See: Parking Brake
System/Service and Repair 22. Lower vehicle. 23. Connect battery negative (-) cable to battery
post. 24. Road test vehicle making several stops to wear off any foreign material on brakes and to
seat brake pads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5224
Brake Caliper: Overhaul
Disc Brake Caliper - Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: Before disassembling the brake caliper, remove it from the vehicle. See: Removal and
Replacement/Disc Brake Caliper - Removal
NOTE: Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it. See: Procedures/Disc Brake
Caliper - Cleaning See: Procedures/Disc Brake
Caliper - Inspection/Front
WARNING: Under no condition should high pressure air ever be used to remove a piston from a
caliper bore. Personal injury could result
from such a practice.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion.
1. Mount the caliper in a vise equipped with protective jaws.
WARNING: Do not place face or hands near caliper and piston if using compressed air pressure to
remove piston. Do not use high pressure.
2. Place a wooden block (1) in the caliper as shown. 3. If necessary, apply low pressure
compressed air to the caliper fluid inlet in short spurts to force the piston out. 4. Remove the piston
from the caliper. 5. Remove the dust boot from the piston and discard it.
CAUTION: Do not use a screw driver or other metal tool for seal removal. Using such tools can
scratch the bore or leave burrs on the seal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5225
groove edges.
6. Using a soft tool such as a plastic trim stick (1), work the piston seal (2) out of its groove in
caliper piston bore. Discard the used seal. 7. Clean the piston bore and drilled passage ways with
alcohol or a suitable solvent. Wipe it dry using only a lint-free cloth. 8. Inspect both the piston and
bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can usually be cleared of
the light scratches or
corrosion using crocus cloth.
Disc Brake Caliper - Assembly
ASSEMBLY
NOTE: Always have clean hands when assembling a brake caliper.
NOTE: Always use fresh, clean brake fluid when assembling a brake caliper.
NOTE: Never use an old piston seal.
1. Dip the NEW piston seal in clean brake fluid and install it in the groove (2) of the caliper bore.
The seal (1) should be started at one area of the
groove and gently worked around into the groove using only your clean fingers to seat it.
2. Coat the NEW piston with clean brake fluid. 3. Coat the NEW piston boot with clean brake fluid
leaving a generous amount inside the boot. 4. Position the dust boot over the lower section of the
piston. 5. Extend the dust boot below the bottom of the piston and guide the lip seal into the groove
in the caliper piston bore.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5226
CAUTION: Force applied to the piston (1) to seat it in the bore must be applied uniformly to avoid
cocking and binding of the piston.
6. Install the piston (1) into the bore, carefully pushing it past the piston seal using hand pressure.
Push the piston in until it bottoms in the caliper
bore and the dust boot lip seal falls into the groove near the top of the piston.
7. Install the caliper on the vehicle and bleed the brakes as necessary. See: Removal and
Replacement/Disc Brake Caliper - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Pad: > 05-003-11 > Feb > 11 > Brakes - Premature Front Brake
Pad Wear
Brake Pad: Customer Interest Brakes - Premature Front Brake Pad Wear
NUMBER: 05-003-11
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: February 18, 2011
SUBJECT:
Brake Front Pad Lining Life
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing new brake linings and replacing both brake rotors as
required.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built for the 2009 model year sold in U.S. and Canada (sales code
YAA and YAC) markets only.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Front brake pads may exhibit lining life complaints.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Remove both front tire and wheel assemblies. Refer to the service information outlined in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT > Service
Information > 22 - Tires and Wheels > Removal
2. Using a Brake Lining Thickness Gauge or Brake Pad/Shoe Gauge, measure brake pad
thickness.
3. Perform the repair procedure if the brake pad usable material measured at its thinnest point
measures 4mm (0.1575 inches) or less.
4. If the brake pad assemblies do not require replacement reassemble the vehicle. Refer to the
service information outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 22
- Tires and Wheels> Installation.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the front brake pads. Refer to the service information outlined in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 05 -
Brakes > 05 - Brakes, Base, Brake > Hydraulic/Mechanical > PADS, Brake, Front > Removal.
2. Remove any clips retaining the brake rotor to the wheel mounting studs.
3. Slide the brake rotor off the hub and bearing.
4. Clean the hub face to remove any dirt or corrosion where the rotor mounts.
5. Perform Step # 2 through Step # 4 on the opposite side of the vehicle.
6. Install brake rotors (p/n CNM2X252AB) over the studs on the hub and bearing on both sides of
the vehicle.
NOTE:
Rotor replacement is recommended when switching to this type brake pad. Standard brake service
procedures apply thereafter.
7. Install new pads. Refer to the service information outlined in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 05 - Brakes > O05 -
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Pad: > 05-003-11 > Feb > 11 > Brakes - Premature Front Brake
Pad Wear > Page 5235
Brakes, Base, Brake > Hydraulic/Mechanical > PADS, Brake, Front > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Vehicles included in this Service Bulletin have a Warranty Extension for this repair. See
Warranty Bulletins; U.S. D-11-07, Canada CA-2011-05 for details associated with the extended
warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Pad: > 05-003-11 > Feb > 11 > Brakes - Premature
Front Brake Pad Wear
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Premature Front Brake Pad Wear
NUMBER: 05-003-11
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: February 18, 2011
SUBJECT:
Brake Front Pad Lining Life
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing new brake linings and replacing both brake rotors as
required.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built for the 2009 model year sold in U.S. and Canada (sales code
YAA and YAC) markets only.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Front brake pads may exhibit lining life complaints.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Remove both front tire and wheel assemblies. Refer to the service information outlined in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT > Service
Information > 22 - Tires and Wheels > Removal
2. Using a Brake Lining Thickness Gauge or Brake Pad/Shoe Gauge, measure brake pad
thickness.
3. Perform the repair procedure if the brake pad usable material measured at its thinnest point
measures 4mm (0.1575 inches) or less.
4. If the brake pad assemblies do not require replacement reassemble the vehicle. Refer to the
service information outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 22
- Tires and Wheels> Installation.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the front brake pads. Refer to the service information outlined in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 05 -
Brakes > 05 - Brakes, Base, Brake > Hydraulic/Mechanical > PADS, Brake, Front > Removal.
2. Remove any clips retaining the brake rotor to the wheel mounting studs.
3. Slide the brake rotor off the hub and bearing.
4. Clean the hub face to remove any dirt or corrosion where the rotor mounts.
5. Perform Step # 2 through Step # 4 on the opposite side of the vehicle.
6. Install brake rotors (p/n CNM2X252AB) over the studs on the hub and bearing on both sides of
the vehicle.
NOTE:
Rotor replacement is recommended when switching to this type brake pad. Standard brake service
procedures apply thereafter.
7. Install new pads. Refer to the service information outlined in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 05 - Brakes > O05 -
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Pad: > 05-003-11 > Feb > 11 > Brakes - Premature
Front Brake Pad Wear > Page 5241
Brakes, Base, Brake > Hydraulic/Mechanical > PADS, Brake, Front > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Vehicles included in this Service Bulletin have a Warranty Extension for this repair. See
Warranty Bulletins; U.S. D-11-07, Canada CA-2011-05 for details associated with the extended
warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5242
Brake Pad: Specifications
Measure brake pad minimum thickness (1). Brake pads must be replaced when usable material on
a brake pad lining (2) measured at its thinnest point measures one millimeter (0.04 inches) or less.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Pad: Procedures
Front
CLEANING
WARNING:
Chrysler LLC does not manufacture any vehicles or replacement parts that contain asbestos.
Aftermarket products may or may not contain asbestos. Refer to aftermarket product packaging for
product information.
Whether the product contains asbestos or not, dust and dirt can accumulate on brake parts during
normal use. Follow practices prescribed by appropriate regulations for the handling, processing
and disposing of dust and debris.
Rear
CLEANING
WARNING:
Chrysler LLC does not manufacture any vehicles or replacement parts that contain asbestos.
Aftermarket products may or may not contain asbestos. Refer to aftermarket product packaging for
product information.
Whether the product contains asbestos or not, dust and dirt can accumulate on brake parts during
normal use. Follow practices prescribed by appropriate regulations for the handling, processing
and disposing of dust and debris.
Front
INSPECTION
Visually inspect brake pads for uneven lining wear. Also inspect for excessive lining deterioration.
Check the clearance between the tips of the wear indicators (if equipped) on the pads and the
brake rotors.
If a visual inspection does not adequately determine the condition of the lining, a physical check will
be necessary. To check the amount of lining wear, remove the disc brake pads from the vehicle.
Measure brake pad minimum thickness (1). Brake pads must be replaced when usable material on
a brake pad lining (2) measured at its thinnest point measures one millimeter (0.04 inches) or less.
If a brake pad fails inspection, replace both disc brake pads (inboard and outboard) at each caliper.
It is also necessary to replace the pads on the opposite side of the vehicle as well as the pads
failing inspection to maintain proper braking characteristics.
If the brake pad assemblies do not require replacement, be sure to reinstall the brake pads in the
original position they were removed from.
NOTE: It is important to inspect both front and rear brake pads during the same inspection.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5245
Rear
INSPECTION
Visually inspect brake pads for uneven lining wear. Also inspect for excessive lining deterioration.
Check the clearance between the tips of the wear indicators (if equipped) on the pads and the
brake rotors.
If a visual inspection does not adequately determine the condition of the lining, a physical check will
be necessary. To check the amount of lining wear, remove the disc brake pads from the vehicle.
Measure brake pad minimum thickness (1). Brake pads must be replaced when usable material on
a brake pad lining (2) measured at its thinnest point measures one millimeter (0.04 inches) or less.
If a brake pad fails inspection, replace both disc brake pads (inboard and outboard) at each caliper.
It is also necessary to replace the pads on the opposite side of the vehicle as well as the pads
failing inspection to maintain proper braking characteristics.
If the brake pad assemblies do not require replacement, be sure to reinstall the brake pads in the
original position they were removed from.
NOTE: It is important to inspect both front and rear brake pads during the same inspection.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5246
Brake Pad: Removal and Replacement
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
NOTE: Perform 2 through 5 on each side of the vehicle to complete pad set removal.
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
3. Remove the two brake caliper guide pin bolts (2, 3). 4. Remove the disc brake caliper (4) from
the disc brake adapter bracket (1) and hang it out of the way using wire or a bungee cord. Use care
not to
overextend the brake hose when doing this.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5247
5. Remove the brake pads (4, 5) from the caliper adapter bracket (2).
Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance
NOTE: Perform 2 through 5 on each side of vehicle to complete pad set removal.
2. Remove wheel mounting nuts (3), then tire and wheel assembly (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5248
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
3. Remove two caliper guide pin bolts (1). 4. Remove the disc brake caliper (2) from the disc brake
adapter bracket (3) and hang it out of the way using wire or a bungee cord. Use care not to
overextend the brake hose or parking brake cable when doing this.
5. Remove the brake pads (2, 5) from the caliper adapter bracket (3).
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Perform 1 through 5 on each side of the vehicle to complete pad set installation, then
proceed to 6.
NOTE: Make sure that the audible wear indicator (if equipped) is placed toward the top when the
inboard brake pad is installed on each side
of the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5249
NOTE: If the brake pads have a protective paper on the rear face of the brake pad plate, it must be
removed before pad installation.
1. Place the brake pads (4, 5) in the abutment shims (3) clipped into the disc brake caliper adapter
bracket (2) as shown. Place the pad with the wear
indicator (if equipped) attached on the inboard side (2).
2. Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper (4) onto the adapter bracket (1) to avoid damaging
the boots.
3. Install the disc brake caliper over the brake pads on the brake caliper adapter bracket.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
4. Align the caliper guide pin bolt holes with the adapter bracket. Install the upper (2) and lower (3)
caliper guide pin bolts. Tighten the guide pin
bolts to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5250
5. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Pump the brake pedal several times before moving the vehicle to set the pads to the brake rotor.
8. Check and adjust the brake fluid level in the reservoir as necessary. 9. Road test the vehicle and
make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the brake pads.
Rear
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Perform 1 through 6 on each side of vehicle to complete pad set installation, then proceed
to 7.
CAUTION: Anytime the brake rotor or brake pads are being replaced, the rear caliper piston must
be seated (bottomed) to compensate for the
new brake rotor or lining. Because the parking brake self-adjuster mechanism is attached to the
piston, a special seating method is required. The only acceptable method is by rotating the piston
back into the bore using Retractor, Special Tool 8807, as described below. Any other seating
method will damage the self-adjuster mechanism.
1. If necessary, seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5). e. Thread the screw drive on
8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the caliper piston. Do not over
tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5251
2. Make sure abutment shims (4) are in place on both upper and lower slide abutments of caliper
adapter (3).
NOTE: If the brake pads have a protective paper on the rear face of the brake pad plate, it must be
removed before pad installation.
3. Place the brake pads (2, 5) in the abutment shims (3) clipped into the disc brake caliper adapter
bracket (3) as shown.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper (2) onto the adapter bracket to avoid damaging the
guide pin boots.
4. Install the disc brake caliper (2) over the brake pads on the brake caliper adapter bracket (3).
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
5. Align the caliper guide pin bolt holes with the adapter bracket. Install the upper and lower caliper
guide pin bolts (1). Tighten the guide pin bolts
to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5252
6. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower vehicle. 8. Pump brake pedal several times to ensure vehicle has a firm brake pedal
before moving vehicle. 9. Check and adjust brake fluid level as necessary.
10. Road test vehicle and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on brakes and to
seat brake pads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Rotor/Disc: > 05-003-11 > Feb > 11 > Brakes Premature Front Brake Pad Wear
Brake Rotor/Disc: Customer Interest Brakes - Premature Front Brake Pad Wear
NUMBER: 05-003-11
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: February 18, 2011
SUBJECT:
Brake Front Pad Lining Life
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing new brake linings and replacing both brake rotors as
required.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built for the 2009 model year sold in U.S. and Canada (sales code
YAA and YAC) markets only.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Front brake pads may exhibit lining life complaints.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Remove both front tire and wheel assemblies. Refer to the service information outlined in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT > Service
Information > 22 - Tires and Wheels > Removal
2. Using a Brake Lining Thickness Gauge or Brake Pad/Shoe Gauge, measure brake pad
thickness.
3. Perform the repair procedure if the brake pad usable material measured at its thinnest point
measures 4mm (0.1575 inches) or less.
4. If the brake pad assemblies do not require replacement reassemble the vehicle. Refer to the
service information outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 22
- Tires and Wheels> Installation.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the front brake pads. Refer to the service information outlined in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 05 -
Brakes > 05 - Brakes, Base, Brake > Hydraulic/Mechanical > PADS, Brake, Front > Removal.
2. Remove any clips retaining the brake rotor to the wheel mounting studs.
3. Slide the brake rotor off the hub and bearing.
4. Clean the hub face to remove any dirt or corrosion where the rotor mounts.
5. Perform Step # 2 through Step # 4 on the opposite side of the vehicle.
6. Install brake rotors (p/n CNM2X252AB) over the studs on the hub and bearing on both sides of
the vehicle.
NOTE:
Rotor replacement is recommended when switching to this type brake pad. Standard brake service
procedures apply thereafter.
7. Install new pads. Refer to the service information outlined in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 05 - Brakes > O05 -
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Rotor/Disc: > 05-003-11 > Feb > 11 > Brakes Premature Front Brake Pad Wear > Page 5261
Brakes, Base, Brake > Hydraulic/Mechanical > PADS, Brake, Front > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Vehicles included in this Service Bulletin have a Warranty Extension for this repair. See
Warranty Bulletins; U.S. D-11-07, Canada CA-2011-05 for details associated with the extended
warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Rotor/Disc: > 05-003-11 > Feb > 11 >
Brakes - Premature Front Brake Pad Wear
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Premature Front Brake Pad Wear
NUMBER: 05-003-11
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: February 18, 2011
SUBJECT:
Brake Front Pad Lining Life
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing new brake linings and replacing both brake rotors as
required.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built for the 2009 model year sold in U.S. and Canada (sales code
YAA and YAC) markets only.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Front brake pads may exhibit lining life complaints.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Remove both front tire and wheel assemblies. Refer to the service information outlined in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT > Service
Information > 22 - Tires and Wheels > Removal
2. Using a Brake Lining Thickness Gauge or Brake Pad/Shoe Gauge, measure brake pad
thickness.
3. Perform the repair procedure if the brake pad usable material measured at its thinnest point
measures 4mm (0.1575 inches) or less.
4. If the brake pad assemblies do not require replacement reassemble the vehicle. Refer to the
service information outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 22
- Tires and Wheels> Installation.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the front brake pads. Refer to the service information outlined in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 05 -
Brakes > 05 - Brakes, Base, Brake > Hydraulic/Mechanical > PADS, Brake, Front > Removal.
2. Remove any clips retaining the brake rotor to the wheel mounting studs.
3. Slide the brake rotor off the hub and bearing.
4. Clean the hub face to remove any dirt or corrosion where the rotor mounts.
5. Perform Step # 2 through Step # 4 on the opposite side of the vehicle.
6. Install brake rotors (p/n CNM2X252AB) over the studs on the hub and bearing on both sides of
the vehicle.
NOTE:
Rotor replacement is recommended when switching to this type brake pad. Standard brake service
procedures apply thereafter.
7. Install new pads. Refer to the service information outlined in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Service Information tab > 05 - Brakes > O05 -
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Rotor/Disc: > 05-003-11 > Feb > 11 >
Brakes - Premature Front Brake Pad Wear > Page 5267
Brakes, Base, Brake > Hydraulic/Mechanical > PADS, Brake, Front > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Vehicles included in this Service Bulletin have a Warranty Extension for this repair. See
Warranty Bulletins; U.S. D-11-07, Canada CA-2011-05 for details associated with the extended
warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5268
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
NOTE: When refacing a rotor, the required TIR (Total Indicator Reading) and thickness variation
limits MUST BE MAINTAINED. Extreme
care in the operation of rotor turning (machining) equipment is required.
LIMITS/SPECIFICATIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5269
Brake Rotor/Disc: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE ROTOR
Any servicing of the rotor requires extreme care to maintain the rotor within service tolerances to
ensure proper brake action.
Excessive runout or wobble in a rotor can increase pedal travel due to piston knock-back. This
increases guide pin sleeve wear due to the tendency of the caliper to follow the rotor wobble.
When diagnosing a brake noise or pulsation, the machined disc braking surface should be
inspected.
BRAKING SURFACE INSPECTION
Light braking surface scoring and wear is acceptable. If heavy scoring or warping is evident, the
rotor must be refaced or replaced. See: Service and Repair/Procedures.
Excessive wear and scoring of the rotor can cause improper lining contact on the rotor's braking
surface. If the ridges on the rotor are not removed before new brake shoes are installed, improper
wear of the shoes will result.
If a vehicle has not been driven for a period of time, the rotor's braking surface will rust in the areas
not covered by the brake shoes at that time. Once the vehicle is driven, noise and chatter from the
disc brakes can result when the brakes are applied.
Some discoloration or wear of the rotor surface is normal and does not require resurfacing when
linings are replaced. If cracks or burned spots are evident, the rotor must be replaced.
ROTOR MINIMUM THICKNESS
Measure rotor thickness (1) at the center of the brake pad contact surface. Replace the rotor if it is
worn below minimum thickness or if machining the rotor will cause its thickness to fall below
specifications.
CAUTION: Do not machine the rotor if it will cause the rotor to fall below minimum thickness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5270
Minimum thickness specifications are cast on the rotor's un-machined surface (1). Limits can also
be found in this component's specification table. See: Specifications
ROTOR THICKNESS VARIATION
Thickness variation in a rotor's braking surface can result in pedal pulsation, chatter and surge.
This can also be caused by excessive runout in the rotor or the hub.
Rotor thickness variation measurements should be made in conjunction with measuring runout.
Measure thickness of the brake rotor (2) at 12 equal points around the rotor braking surface with a
micrometer (1) at a radius approximately 25 mm (1 inch) from edge of rotor. If thickness
measurements vary beyond the specification listed in the specification table See: Specifications ,
the rotor should be refaced or replaced. See: Service and Repair/Procedures.
ROTOR RUNOUT
On-vehicle rotor runout is the combination of the individual runout of the hub face and the runout of
the brake rotor (hub runout can be measured separately). To measure rotor runout on the vehicle:
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. Remove the tire and wheel assembly. See:
Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Removal
3. Install standard wheel mounting nuts, flat side to rotor, on all the wheel studs (2). Progressively
tighten the nuts in a crisscross (star) pattern to 135
Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Dial Indicator, Special Tool 9524, can be used in conjunction with C-3339A to measure in
millimeters instead of inches. Dial indicator
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5271
9524 includes a finer scale to measure lower, tighter tolerances.
4. Mount Dial Indicator (1), Special Tool C-3339A, with Wheel, Special Tool 25w, or equivalent, to
the knuckle. Position the dial indicator wheel to
contact the rotor braking surface approximately 10 millimeters from the outer edge of the rotor (3).
5. Slowly rotate the brake rotor checking lateral runout, marking the low and high spots. Record
these measurements. 6. Check and record the runout on the opposite side of the rotor in the same
fashion, marking the low and high spots. 7. Compare runout measurement to specifications.See:
Specifications
If runout is in excess of specifications, check the lateral runout of the hub face. Before removing the
rotor from the hub, place a chalk mark across both the rotor (1) and the one wheel stud (2) closest
to where the high runout measurement was taken. This way, the original mounting spot of the rotor
on the hub is indexed.
8. Remove the rotor from the hub. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake
Rotor - Removal
NOTE: Before measuring hub runout, clean the hub face surface with an appropriate cleaner. This
provides a clean surface to get an accurate
indicator reading.
NOTE: Dial Indicator, Special Tool 9524, can be used in conjunction with C-3339A to measure in
millimeters instead of inches. Dial indicator
9524 includes a finer scale to measure lower, tighter tolerances.
9. Mount Dial Indicator (2), Special Tool C-3339A, to the knuckle. Position the dial indicator stem
so it contacts the hub face (1) near the outer
diameter. Care must be taken to position the stem outside of the stud circle, but inside of the
chamfer on the hub rim.
10. Slowly rotate the hub measuring runout. Hub runout should not exceed 0.01 mm (0.0004 inch).
If runout exceeds this specification, the hub must
be replaced. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Front Steering Knuckle/Service and
Repair/Front Steering Knuckle - Removal See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Wheel
Bearing/Service and Repair/Rear Hub and Bearing - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5272
11. If hub runout does not exceed this specification, install the original rotor back on the hub,
aligning the chalk mark on the rotor (2) with a wheel
mounting stud, two studs apart from the original stud (1).
12. Install standard wheel mounting nuts, flat side to rotor, on all the wheel studs (2). Progressively
tighten the nuts in a crisscross (star) pattern to 135
Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
13. Mount the Dial Indicator (1), Special Tool C-3339A, and remeasure runout on both sides of the
brake rotor as explained in earlier steps to see if
runout is now within specifications. See: Specifications
14. If runout is still not within specifications, reface or replace brake rotor. See: Service and
Repair/Procedures
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Rotor/Disc: Procedures
BRAKE ROTOR MACHINING
NOTE: Refacing the rotor is not required each time the brake pads are replaced, only when the
need is foreseen.
Any servicing of the rotor requires extreme care to maintain the rotor within service tolerances to
ensure proper brake action.
If the rotor surface is deeply scored or warped, or there is a complaint of brake roughness or brake
pedal pulsation, the rotor should be refaced using a hub-mounted on-car brake lathe (1), or
replaced.
The use of a hub-mounted on-car brake lathe (1) is highly recommended to eliminate the possibility
of excessive runout. It trues the brake rotor to the vehicle's hub and bearing.
NOTE: All brake rotors (2) have markings for minimum allowable thickness cast on an
un-machined surface of the rotor (1) or stamped into
the hat section. Minimum thickness specifications can also be found in this component's
specification table. See: Specifications
Minimum allowable thickness is the minimum thickness which the brake rotor machined surface
may be cut to.
CAUTION: Do not machine the rotor if it will cause the rotor to fall below minimum thickness.
Before lathe installation, verify the brake rotor face and the hub adapters are free of any chips, rust,
or contamination.
When mounting and using the brake lathe, strict attention to the brake lathe manufacturer's
operating instructions is required.
Machine both sides of the brake rotor at the same time. Cutting both sides at the same time
minimizes the possibility of a tapered or uneven cut.
When refacing a rotor, the required TIR (Total Indicator Reading) and thickness variation limits
MUST BE MAINTAINED. Extreme care in the operation of rotor turning equipment is required.
Specifications for brake rotor machining can be founds specification table. See: Specifications
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5275
Brake Rotor/Disc: Removal and Replacement
Front
FRONT
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance
between the pads and the rotor to easily remove the caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be
accomplished before removal by grasping the inboard side of the caliper and pulling outward
working with the guide pins, thus retracting the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may
get damaged.
3. Remove the two bolts (3) securing disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (1) to the steering
knuckle (2). 4. Remove the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (1) from the knuckle (2) and
rotor (4) as an assembly. Hang the assembly out of the way using
wire or a bungee cord. Use care not to overextend the brake hose when doing this.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5276
5. Remove any clips retaining the brake rotor to the wheel mounting studs. 6. Slide the brake rotor
(2) off the hub and bearing (1).
Rear
REAR
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance
between the pads and the rotor to easily remove the caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be
accomplished before removal by grasping the inboard side of the caliper and pulling outward
working with the guide pins, thus retracting the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may
get damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5277
3. Remove two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket ( 2) to the knuckle (3).
4. Remove the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) as an assembly from the knuckle (3) and
rotor. Hang the assembly out of the way using wire
or a bungee cord. Use care not to overextend the brake hose when doing this.
5. Remove any retaining clips, then slide the brake rotor (2) off the hub and bearing (1).
Front
FRONT
NOTE: Inspect disc brake pads before installation, See: Brake Pad/Service and
Repair/Procedures/Brake Pads - Inspection/Front .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5278
1. Clean the hub face (1) to remove any dirt or corrosion where the rotor mounts. 2. Install the
brake rotor (2) over the studs on the hub and bearing.
3. Install the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket assembly (1) over the brake rotor (4) and
knuckle (2). 4. Install the mounting bolts (3) securing the caliper adapter bracket to the knuckle (2).
Tighten the bolts to 169 Nm (125 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Pump the brake pedal several times before moving the vehicle to set the
pads to the brake rotor. 8. Check and adjust the brake fluid level in the reservoir as necessary. 9.
Road test the vehicle and make several stops to seat the brake pads to the rotor.
Rear
REAR
NOTE: Inspect disc brake pads before installation. Replace as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5279
1. Clean the rotor mounting face of the hub and bearing (1) to remove any dirt or corrosion. 2.
Install the brake rotor (2) over the hub and bearing (1).
CAUTION: If the brake rotor or brake pads are being replaced, the rear caliper piston must be
seated (bottomed) to compensate for the new
brake rotor or lining. Because the parking brake self-adjuster mechanism is attached to the piston,
a special seating method is required. The only acceptable method is by rotating the piston back
into the bore using Retractor, Special Tool 8807, as described below. Any other seating method will
damage the self-adjuster mechanism.
3. If necessary, seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5). e. Thread the screw drive on
8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the caliper piston. Do not over
tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5280
4. Install the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) over the knuckle and rotor as an assembly.
5. Install the two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) to the knuckle.
Tighten the mounting bolts to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Pump the brake pedal several times to ensure the vehicle has a firm brake
pedal before moving vehicle. 9. Check and adjust the brake fluid level as necessary.
10. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes
and to seat the brake pads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Base Brake Bleeding
BASE BRAKE BLEEDING
NOTE: This bleeding procedure is only for the vehicle's base brakes hydraulic system. For
bleeding the antilock brakes hydraulic system, See:
CAUTION: Before removing the master cylinder reservoir cap, thoroughly clean the cap and master
cylinder fluid reservoir to prevent dirt
and other foreign matter from dropping into the master cylinder fluid reservoir.
NOTE: The following wheel sequence should be used when bleeding the brake hydraulic system.
The use of this wheel sequence will ensure
adequate removal of all trapped air from the brake hydraulic system.
- Left Rear Wheel
- Right Front Wheel
- Right Rear Wheel
- Left Front Wheel
NOTE: When bleeding the brake system, some air may be trapped in the brake lines far upstream,
as much as ten feet from the bleeder screw.
Therefore, it is essential to have a fast flow of a large volume of brake fluid when bleeding the
brakes to ensure all the air gets out.
Pressure bleeding the brakes is recommended, although the brakes may be manually bled or
pressure bled. Refer to the appropriate following procedure.
PRESSURE BLEEDING PROCEDURE
Follow the pressure bleeder manufacturer's instructions for use of the pressure bleeding
equipment.
1. Install Master Cylinder Pressure Bleed Cap, Special Tool 6921, or equivalent on the master
cylinder fluid reservoir. Attach the fluid hose from the
pressure bleeder to the fitting on Special Tool 6921.
2. Attach a clear plastic hose (1) to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar (2)
containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of
the hose.
3. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain a steady stream of brake fluid. 4.
After approximately 120-240 ml (4-8 ounces) of fluid have been bled through the brake circuit and
an air-free flow is maintained in the clear
plastic hose and jar, close the bleeder screw.
5. Repeat this procedure at all the remaining bleeder screws. 6. Check and adjust brake fluid level
to the FULL mark on the reservoir. 7. Check brake pedal travel and feel. If pedal travel is excessive
or if the pedal feels excessively spongy, some air may still be trapped in the system.
Re-bleed the brakes as necessary including the IPB Caliper Brake Bleeding Procedure on the rear
calipers as listed below.
8. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
MANUAL BLEEDING PROCEDURE
NOTE: To bleed the brakes manually, the aid of a helper will be required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake Bleeding > Page 5286
1. Attach a clear plastic hose (1) to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar (2)
containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of
the hose.
2. Have a helper pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 3. With
the pedal in the down position, open the bleeder screw at least one full turn. 4. Once the brake
pedal has dropped, close the bleeder screw. After the bleeder screw is closed, release the brake
pedal. 5. Repeat the above steps until all trapped air is removed from that wheel circuit (usually
four or five times).
6. Bleed the remaining wheel circuits in the same manner until all air is removed from the brake
system. Monitor the fluid level in the master cylinder
reservoir to make sure it does not go dry.
7. Check and adjust brake fluid level to the FULL mark. 8. Check brake pedal travel and feel. If
pedal travel is excessive or if the pedal feels excessively spongy, some air may still be trapped in
the system.
Re-bleed the brakes as necessary including the IPB Caliper Brake Bleeding Procedure on the rear
calipers as listed below.
9. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
IPB CALIPER BRAKE BLEEDING PROCEDURE
NOTE: The following procedure is normally only necessary if a rear brake caliper has been
removed and installed, or replaced.
Perform the following procedure on each rear brake caliper as necessary.
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the
tire and wheel assembly (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake Bleeding > Page 5287
3. Remove the brake caliper lower guide pin bolt (1). 4. Swing the caliper assembly upward,
pivoting off the upper guide pin, until clear of the adapter bracket.
5. Remove the outboard pad (5) from the adapter bracket. 6. Return the caliper back down over the
adapter bracket into mounted position and install the lower guide pin bolt finger tight. 7. Slowly
pump the brake pedal until the caliper fingers touch the outboard surface of the brake rotor.
Release the pedal. 8. Remove the brake caliper lower guide pin bolt. 9. Swing the caliper assembly
upward, pivoting off the upper guide pin, until clear of the adapter bracket.
10. Reinstall the outboard pad in the adapter bracket. 11. Open the caliper bleeder screw at least
one full turn.
12. Seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake Bleeding > Page 5288
e. Thread the screw drive on 8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the
caliper piston. Do not over tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
13. Close the bleeder screw. 14. Return the caliper back down over the adapter bracket into
mounted position and install the lower guide pin bolt finger tight. 15. Have a helper pump the brake
pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 16. With the pedal in the down position,
open the bleeder screw at least one full turn and let out fluid and air, if any. 17. Once the brake
pedal has dropped, close the bleeder screw. Once the bleeder screw is closed, release the brake
pedal. 18. Repeat the previous three steps until all trapped air is removed. 19. Tighten the guide
pin bolt to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.). 20. Repeat the above procedure on the opposite rear brake caliper
as necessary. 21. Check brake pedal travel and feel. If pedal travel is still excessive or if the pedal
feels excessively spongy, repeat the entire procedure as
necessary.
22. Install the tire and wheel assembly See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
23. Lower the vehicle. 24. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and
pedal feel is correct.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Base Brake Bleeding > Page 5289
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System Bleeding
ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The base brake's hydraulic system must be bled anytime air enters the hydraulic system. The ABS
must always be bled anytime it is suspected that the HCU has ingested air.
Brake systems with ABS must be bled as two independent braking systems. The non-ABS portion
of the brake system with ABS is to be bled the same as any non-ABS system.
The ABS portion of the brake system must be bled separately. Use the following procedure to
properly bleed the brake hydraulic system including the ABS.
NOTE: During the brake bleeding procedure, be sure the brake fluid level remains close to the
FULL level in the master cylinder fluid
reservoir. Check the fluid level periodically during the bleeding procedure and add Mopar(R) DOT 3
brake fluid as required.
BLEEDING
When bleeding the ABS system, the following bleeding sequence must be followed to insure
complete and adequate bleeding.
1. Make sure all hydraulic fluid lines are installed and properly torqued. 2. Connect the scan tool to
the diagnostics connector. The diagnostic connector is located under the lower steering column
cover to the left of the
steering column.
3. Using the scan tool, check to make sure the ABM does not have any fault codes stored. If it
does, clear them.
WARNING: When bleeding the brake system wear safety glasses. A clear bleed tube (1) must be
attached to the bleeder screws and submerged
in a clear container filled part way with clean brake fluid (2). Direct the flow of brake fluid away from
yourself and the painted surfaces of the vehicle. Brake fluid at high pressure may come out of the
bleeder screws when opened.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding is recommended to bleed the base brake system to ensure all air is
removed from system. Manual bleeding may also
be used, but additional time is needed to remove all air from system.
4. Bleed the base brake system. See: 5. Using the scan tool, select ECU VIEW, followed by ABS
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS to access bleeding. Follow the instructions
displayed. When finished, disconnect the scan tool and proceed.
6. Bleed the base brake system a second time. Check brake fluid level in the reservoir periodically
to prevent emptying, causing air to enter the
hydraulic system.
7. Fill the master cylinder fluid reservoir to the FULL level. 8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure the
brakes are operating correctly and that the brake pedal does not feel spongy.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Caliper: Procedures
Front
CLEANING
WARNING:
Chrysler LLC does not manufacture any vehicles or replacement parts that contain asbestos.
Aftermarket products may or may not contain asbestos. Refer to aftermarket product packaging for
product information.
Whether the product contains asbestos or not, dust and dirt can accumulate on brake parts during
normal use. Follow practices prescribed by appropriate regulations for the handling, processing
and disposing of dust and debris.
To clean or flush the internal passages of the brake caliper, use fresh brake fluid or Mopar(R)
Non-Chlorinated Brake Parts Cleaner. Never use gasoline, kerosene, alcohol, oil, transmission fluid
or any fluid containing mineral oil to clean the caliper. These fluids will damage rubber cups and
seals.
Rear
CLEANING
WARNING:
Chrysler LLC does not manufacture any vehicles or replacement parts that contain asbestos.
Aftermarket products may or may not contain asbestos. Refer to aftermarket product packaging for
product information.
Whether the product contains asbestos or not, dust and dirt can accumulate on brake parts during
normal use. Follow practices prescribed by appropriate regulations for the handling, processing
and disposing of dust and debris.
To clean or flush the internal passages of the brake caliper, use fresh brake fluid or Mopar(R)
Non-Chlorinated Brake Parts Cleaner. Never use gasoline, kerosene, alcohol, oil, transmission fluid
or any fluid containing mineral oil to clean the caliper. These fluids will damage rubber cups and
seals.
Front
INSPECTION
Inspect the disc brake caliper for the following:
- Brake fluid leaks in and around piston boot area
- Ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot
If caliper fails inspection, disassemble and recondition caliper, replacing the seals and dust boots.
Rear
INSPECTION
Inspect the disc brake caliper for the following:
- Brake fluid leaks in and around piston boot area
- Ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot
If caliper fails inspection, disassemble and recondition caliper, replacing the seals and dust boots.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5294
Brake Caliper: Removal and Replacement
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch (25
mm) of travel and hold it in this position. This will
isolate the master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to
drain out of the master cylinder reservoir when the lines are opened.
2. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
3. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5295
4. Remove the banjo bolt (3) connecting the brake flex hose (2) to the brake caliper (1). There are
two washers (4) that will come off with the banjo
bolt. Discard the washers. They should not be reused.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
5. Remove the two brake caliper guide pin bolts (2, 3). 6. Slide the disc brake caliper (4) from the
disc brake adapter bracket (1) and brake pads and remove.
Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable from battery post.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5296
2. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress brake pedal past its first inch of travel and
hold it in this position. Holding pedal in this
position will isolate master cylinder from hydraulic brake system and will not allow brake fluid to
drain out of brake fluid reservoir while brake lines are open.
3. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance
4. Remove wheel mounting nuts (3), then tire and wheel assembly (1).
5. Manually release the parking brake cable tension. See: Parking Brake System/Service and
Repair
6. Collapse the cable retainer fingers (2) at the end of the cable housing (3), then pull the cable
housing out of the mounting bracket (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5297
7. Slide the cable strand out of the mounting bracket, then pull the parking brake cable strand (1)
upward and unhook it from the caliper lever (2).
8. Remove the banjo bolt (4) connecting the brake flex hose (3) to the brake caliper (1). There are
two washers (2) that will come off with the banjo
bolt. Discard the washers. They should not be reused.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
9. Remove two caliper guide pin bolts (1).
10. Slide the disc brake caliper (2) from the disc brake adapter bracket (3) and brake pads.
Front
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5298
INSTALLATION
1. Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper. Use a C-clamp to retract
the piston. Place a wood block over the piston
before installing the C-clamp to avoid damaging the piston.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper (4) onto the adapter bracket (1) to avoid damaging
the guide pin boots.
2. Install the disc brake caliper over the brake pads on the brake caliper adapter bracket.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
3. Align the caliper guide pin bolt holes with the adapter bracket. Install the upper (2) and lower (3)
caliper guide pin bolts. Tighten the guide pin
bolts to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the banjo bolt (3) connecting the brake flex hose (2) to the brake caliper (1). Install NEW
brake hose washers (4) on each side of the hose
fitting as the banjo bolt is guided through the fitting. Thread the banjo bolt into the caliper and
tighten it to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5299
5. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Remove the brake pedal holding tool.
8. Bleed the caliper as necessary. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair 9. Road test the vehicle
and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the brake shoes.
Rear
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5300
CAUTION: When installing a NEW brake caliper it is necessary to bleed the brakes using a special
procedure which has been integrated to
this installation procedure.
1. Remove the outboard pad (5) from the adapter bracket.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper (2) onto the adapter bracket to avoid damaging the
guide pin boots.
2. Install the disc brake caliper (2) over the inboard brake pad on the brake caliper adapter bracket
and the brake rotor.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
3. Align the caliper guide pin bolt holes with the adapter bracket. Install the upper and lower caliper
guide pin bolts (1). Lightly tighten the guide pin
bolts at this time.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5301
4. Install the banjo bolt (4) connecting the brake flex hose (3) to the brake caliper (1). Be sure to
install a NEW brake hose washer (2) on each
side of the hose fitting as the banjo bolt is guided through the fitting. Thread the banjo bolt into the
caliper and tighten it to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs.).
5. Access the interior of the vehicle, remove the brake pedal holder, then slowly pump the brake
pedal until the rear caliper fingers touch the
outboard surface of the brake rotor where the brake pad was removed. Release the pedal.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
6. Remove two caliper guide pin bolts (1). 7. Slide the disc brake caliper (2) from the disc brake
adapter bracket (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5302
8. Reinstall the outboard pad (5) in the adapter bracket (3).
9. Open the caliper bleeder screw at least one full turn.
10. Seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5). e. Thread the screw drive on
8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the caliper piston. Do not over
tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
11. Close the bleeder screw.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5303
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper onto the adapter bracket to avoid damaging the
guide pin boots.
CAUTION: When removing or installing a caliper guide pin bolt, it is necessary to hold the guide pin
stationary while turning the bolt. Hold
the guide pin stationary using a wrench placed upon the pin's hex-shaped head.
12. Return the brake caliper back down over the adapter bracket into mounted position and install
the guide pin bolts (1). Tighten both guide pin bolts
to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: While bleeding air from the brake caliper in the following steps, be sure to monitor the fluid
level in the master cylinder reservoir
making sure it does not go dry.
13. Have a helper pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 14.
With the pedal in the down position, open the bleeder screw at least one full turn and let out fluid
and air, if any. 15. Once the brake pedal has dropped, close the bleeder screw. Once the bleeder
screw is closed, release the brake pedal. 16. Repeat the previous three steps as necessary until all
trapped air is removed. 17. If necessary, bleed remaining wheel circuits as necessary using normal
bleeding procedure. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
18. Pull the parking brake cable strand (1) outward from the cable housing and hook it onto the
caliper lever (2).
19. Push the excess cable strand back into the cable housing, then insert the cable housing (3) into
the mounting bracket (1) until the retainer fingers
(2) lock into place. Make sure both fingers are engaged preventing removal of the cable from the
bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5304
20. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
21. Reconnect the parking brake cable equalizer and reset the cable tension. See: Parking Brake
System/Service and Repair 22. Lower vehicle. 23. Connect battery negative (-) cable to battery
post. 24. Road test vehicle making several stops to wear off any foreign material on brakes and to
seat brake pads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5305
Brake Caliper: Overhaul
Disc Brake Caliper - Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: Before disassembling the brake caliper, remove it from the vehicle. See: Removal and
Replacement/Disc Brake Caliper - Removal
NOTE: Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it. See: Procedures/Disc Brake
Caliper - Cleaning See: Procedures/Disc Brake
Caliper - Inspection/Front
WARNING: Under no condition should high pressure air ever be used to remove a piston from a
caliper bore. Personal injury could result
from such a practice.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion.
1. Mount the caliper in a vise equipped with protective jaws.
WARNING: Do not place face or hands near caliper and piston if using compressed air pressure to
remove piston. Do not use high pressure.
2. Place a wooden block (1) in the caliper as shown. 3. If necessary, apply low pressure
compressed air to the caliper fluid inlet in short spurts to force the piston out. 4. Remove the piston
from the caliper. 5. Remove the dust boot from the piston and discard it.
CAUTION: Do not use a screw driver or other metal tool for seal removal. Using such tools can
scratch the bore or leave burrs on the seal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5306
groove edges.
6. Using a soft tool such as a plastic trim stick (1), work the piston seal (2) out of its groove in
caliper piston bore. Discard the used seal. 7. Clean the piston bore and drilled passage ways with
alcohol or a suitable solvent. Wipe it dry using only a lint-free cloth. 8. Inspect both the piston and
bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can usually be cleared of
the light scratches or
corrosion using crocus cloth.
Disc Brake Caliper - Assembly
ASSEMBLY
NOTE: Always have clean hands when assembling a brake caliper.
NOTE: Always use fresh, clean brake fluid when assembling a brake caliper.
NOTE: Never use an old piston seal.
1. Dip the NEW piston seal in clean brake fluid and install it in the groove (2) of the caliper bore.
The seal (1) should be started at one area of the
groove and gently worked around into the groove using only your clean fingers to seat it.
2. Coat the NEW piston with clean brake fluid. 3. Coat the NEW piston boot with clean brake fluid
leaving a generous amount inside the boot. 4. Position the dust boot over the lower section of the
piston. 5. Extend the dust boot below the bottom of the piston and guide the lip seal into the groove
in the caliper piston bore.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5307
CAUTION: Force applied to the piston (1) to seat it in the bore must be applied uniformly to avoid
cocking and binding of the piston.
6. Install the piston (1) into the bore, carefully pushing it past the piston seal using hand pressure.
Push the piston in until it bottoms in the caliper
bore and the dust boot lip seal falls into the groove near the top of the piston.
7. Install the caliper on the vehicle and bleed the brakes as necessary. See: Removal and
Replacement/Disc Brake Caliper - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Brake Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 5312
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5313
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Brake Master Cylinder
.......................................................................................................................................... Mopar DOT
3, SAE J1703 or equivalent
If DOT 3 brake fluid is not available, then DOT 4 is acceptable. Use only recommended brake
fluids.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5314
Brake Fluid: Description and Operation
BRAKE FLUID
The brake fluid used in this vehicle must conform to DOT 3 specifications and SAE J1703
standards. No other type of brake fluid is recommended or approved for usage in the vehicle brake
system. Use only Mopar(R) Brake Fluid or equivalent from a tightly sealed container.
CAUTION: Never use reclaimed brake fluid or fluid from a container which has been left open. An
open container of brake fluid will absorb
moisture from the air and contaminate the fluid.
CAUTION: Never use any type of a petroleum-based fluid in the brake hydraulic system. Use of
such type fluids will result in seal damage of
the vehicle brake hydraulic system causing a failure of the vehicle brake system. Petroleum based
fluids would be items such as engine oil, transmission fluid, power steering fluid, etc.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5315
Brake Fluid: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE FLUID CONTAMINATION
Indications of fluid contamination are swollen or deteriorated rubber parts. Swelling indicates the
presence of petroleum in the brake fluid.
To test for contamination, put a small amount of drained brake fluid in clear glass jar. If the fluid
separates into layers, there is mineral oil or other fluid contamination of the brake fluid.
If the brake fluid is contaminated, drain and thoroughly flush the brake system. Replace all the
rubber parts or components containing rubber coming into contact with the brake fluid including:
the master cylinder and reservoir; proportioning valves (non-ABS); caliper seals; wheel cylinder
seals; ABS hydraulic control unit; and all hydraulic fluid hoses.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5316
Brake Fluid: Service and Repair
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL CHECKING
NOTE: Brake fluid level should be checked a minimum of twice a year.
Master cylinder reservoirs are marked, FULL and ADD, indicating the allowable brake fluid level
range in the master cylinder fluid reservoir.
CAUTION: Use only Mopar(R) Brake Fluid DOT 3 Motor Vehicle or equivalent from a tightly sealed
container. Do not use petroleum-based
fluid because seal damage in the brake system will result. See: Specifications
NOTE: Although there is a range, the preferred level is FULL.
1. Remove the cap. 2. Adjust the brake fluid level to the FULL mark listed on the side of the master
cylinder fluid reservoir as necessary. Do not overfill the system. 3. Install the cap.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5320
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-BRAKE FLUID LEVEL - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5321
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The brake fluid level switch (2) is mounted through the center of the fluid reservoir. The switch can
be serviced separately from the master cylinder fluid reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Fluid Level Switch - Removal
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Brake Fluid Level Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Remove the wiring harness connector (1) from the brake fluid level switch (2) in the master
cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
2. Push together the retaining tabs (1) that hold the brake fluid level switch in place in the brake
fluid reservoir (2). 3. Pull the brake fluid level switch out the right side of the reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Fluid Level Switch - Removal > Page 5324
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Brake Fluid Level Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Align the brake fluid level switch with its mounting hole on the right side of the master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir. Push the switch into the fluid
reservoir until the switch retaining tabs (1) are expanded on the opposite side of the reservoir (2),
locking it in place.
2. Connect the wiring harness connector (1) to the switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Tubes and Hoses - Description
Brake Hose/Line: Description and Operation Brake Tubes and Hoses - Description
DESCRIPTION
The brake tubes are steel with a corrosion-resistant nylon coating applied to the external surfaces.
The flex hoses used at each wheel brake are made of reinforced rubber with fittings at each end.
The fitting at each brake caliper is the banjo-type and requires a special banjo bolt and copper
washers.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Tubes and Hoses - Description > Page 5329
Brake Hose/Line: Description and Operation Brake Tubes and Hoses - Operation
OPERATION
The purpose of the chassis brake tubes and flex hoses is to transfer the pressurized brake fluid
developed by the master cylinder to the wheel brakes of the vehicle. The flex hoses are made of
rubber to allow for the movement of the vehicle's suspension.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5330
Brake Hose/Line: Service and Repair
INSPECTION
Brake tubing should be inspected periodically for evidence of physical damage or contact with
moving or hot components.
Flexible rubber hose is used at both the front and rear wheel brakes. Inspection of the flexible
brake hoses should be performed whenever the brake system is serviced and every 12,000 km
(7,500 miles) or 12 months, whichever comes first. Inspect hydraulic brake hoses for surface
cracking, scuffing, or worn spots. If the fabric casing of the hose becomes exposed due to cracks
or abrasions in the hose cover, the hose should be replaced immediately. Eventual deterioration of
the hose can take place with possible burst failure. Faulty installation can cause twisting, resulting
in wheel, tire, or chassis interference.
NOTE: This vehicle is equipped with more than one size (diameter) brake tube depending on
location on the vehicle. If a brake tube must be
replaced, always use the same size brake tubing as that being replaced. Never use under-size
brake tubing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Description
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Description and Operation Hydraulic Control unit
(HCU) - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) is mounted to the Antilock Brake Module (ABM) as part of the
Integrated Control Unit (ICU). The HCU controls the flow of brake fluid to the brakes using a series
of valves and accumulators. A pump/motor is mounted on the HCU to supply build pressure to the
brakes during TCS and ESP events and to empty the low pressure accumulators during ABS
events.
NOTE: The HCU is not serviceable from the ICU for vehicles equipped with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
For more information, See: Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Description - DESCRIPTION)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Description > Page
5335
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Description and Operation Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) (2) and the Antilock Brake Module (ABM) (1) used with this
antilock brake system are combined (integrated) into one unit, which is called the Integrated
Control Unit (ICU).
The ICU (1) is located in the engine compartment, mounted to the right side body frame rail near
the strut tower.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Description > Page
5336
On Right-Hand-Drive vehicles, the ICU (1) is located in the engine compartment, mounted to the
left side body frame rail and strut tower.
The ABS with ESP(R) and All-Speed Traction Control ICU consists of the following components:
the ABM, 8 (build/decay) solenoid valves, two traction control solenoid valves, two electronic
shuttle valves, valve block, fluid accumulators, a pump, and an electric pump/motor.
NOTE: The HCU and the ABM are not serviceable separately from the ICU for vehicles equipped
with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
The replaceable components of the ICU are the HCU and the ABM. No attempt should be made to
service any components of the HCU or ABM. The ABM can be serviced without removing the entire
assembly from the vehicle.
For additional information on the ABM, See: Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Electronic
Brake Control Module/Description and Operation/Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Description.
For additional information on the HCU, See: Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Description DESCRIPTION).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Description > Page
5337
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Description and Operation Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Operation
OPERATION
For operation of the ICU, refer to the individual components of the ICU.
- ANTILOCK BRAKE MODULE (ABM) See: Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Electronic
Brake Control Module/Description and Operation/Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Description
- HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT (HCU)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Removal and Replacement
Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Installation
INSTALLATION
To install the HCU, assemble and install the ICU. See: Overhaul/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Assembly See: Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Removal
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
NOTE: If servicing the ABM only, See: Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Electronic Brake
Control Module/Service and
Repair/Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable from battery post.
2. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first 25 mm (1 inch)
of travel and hold it in this position. This will
isolate the master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to
drain out of the master cylinder reservoir while the lines are disconnected.
3. Remove the engine appearance cover.
4. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 5. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5340
6. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen. Remove the cowl screen (3).
7. Remove the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1) securing the wheel house brace to the strut
towers. 8. Remove the wheelhouse brace (2).
9. Remove two screws, then remove the fresh air plenum.
10. Pull the brake tube bundle routing clips (with tubes) loose from studs on the dash panel.
11. Remove the primary (4) and secondary (1) brake tubes (from master cylinder) at the hydraulic
control unit (7).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5341
12. Remove the remaining brake tubes (2, 3, 5, 6) at the hydraulic control unit (7).
NOTE: Use this figure in the following step to release the ABM harness connector cover. It shows
the location of the release tabs.
13. Disconnect the ABM harness connector from the Antilock Brake Module (ABM). To do so:
a. Depress the tabs on each side of the connector cover, then b. Pull outward and upward on the
lower half of the cover until it locks into position pointing straight outward (2). The connector can
then be
pulled straight outward off the ABM (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5342
14. Loosen, but do not remove, the two mounting screws (2) attaching the ICU (1) mounting
bracket to the body. 15. Lift the ICU and mounting bracket (1) off the mounting screws (2). 16.
Move the brake tubes around as necessary without bending them and remove the ICU with
bracket.
NOTE: The HCU and the ABM are not serviceable separately from the ICU for vehicles equipped
with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
17. To separate the ABM from the HCU, See: Overhaul/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Disassembly.
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
1. Install the ICU with bracket (1) through the opening between the A/C lines and the exhaust
manifold using the opposite of how it was removed. 2. Place the mounting bracket for the ICU (1)
over the mounting screws (2) and hang the assembly in place. Tighten the two mounting screws (2)
to
23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5343
CAUTION: Before installing the ABM harness connector on the ABM, be sure the seal is properly
installed in the connector.
3. Insert the ABM wiring harness connector (2) into the socket of the ABM (1) and close the cover,
locking the connector in place.
CAUTION: The brake tubes must be routed to the correct ports. Improper routing can lead to
degraded or undesirable system performance
including external brake fluid leaks. (1) Master Cylinder Secondary
(2) Front Left
- (3) Front Right
- (4) Master Cylinder Primary
- (5) Rear Left
- (6) Rear Right
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5344
4. Install the four chassis brake tubes (2, 3, 5, 6) at the ICU hydraulic control unit (7). Tighten the
tube nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.). 5. Install the primary (4) and secondary (1) brake tubes at the ICU
hydraulic control unit (7). Tighten the tube nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
6. Push the brake tube bundle routing clips (with tubes) onto the studs on the dash panel. 7.
Position the fresh air plenum and install the two mounting screws.
8. Install the wheelhouse brace (2). Install and tighten the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1)
to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
10. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5345
11. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
12. Install the engine appearance cover.
13. Remove the brake pedal holding tool. 14. Connect the battery negative cable to the battery
post. It is important that this be performed properly. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service
and Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection
15. Hook up the scan tool to initialize the ABM and perform the following:
a. Clear any faults. b. Fill the master cylinder to the proper fill level and bleed the base and ABS
hydraulic systems. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair c. Check for leaks. d. Perform the ABS
Verification Test and road test the vehicle. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5346
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS
Verification Test
Hydraulic Control unit (HCU) - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The HCU is not serviceable from the ICU for vehicles equipped with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
To remove the HCU, the ICU must be removed and disassembled. See: Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Removal See: Overhaul/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Disassembly
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5347
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Overhaul
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Assembly
ASSEMBLY
1. Clean any debris off the mating surfaces of the HCU and ABM.
CAUTION: When installing new O-rings or solenoid valve stem seals, do not use any type of
lubricant.
2. If the seals (1) on the solenoid valve stems (2) are not new, replace them all. Each of the
solenoid valve stem seals must be new to keep out
moisture and debris; do not reuse solenoid valve stem seals.
3. Replace the pump/motor connector O-ring (1) if it is not new. Be sure the O-ring is properly
seated in the mounting groove (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5348
4. Align components and install the ABM (1) on the HCU (2).
5. Install the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU. Tighten the mounting screws to 2
Nm (17 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5349
6. If necessary, install the mounting pins (1) in the ICU (2) and tighten to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.).
7. Install the ICU in the vehicle. See: Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Installation
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: The HCU and the ABM are not serviceable separately from the ICU for vehicles equipped
with Hill Start Assist (HSA).
1. If necessary, remove the mounting pins from the ICU.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5350
2. Remove the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU.
3. Separate the ABM (1) from the HCU (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Master Cylinder - Description
Brake Master Cylinder: Description and Operation Brake Master Cylinder - Description
DESCRIPTION
All master cylinders (2) are a two-outlet design and the brake tubes from these primary and
secondary outlet ports lead directly to the Integrated Control Unit (ICU) before going to each wheel
brake.
All master cylinders mount to the power brake booster in the same manner.
The master cylinder body is an anodized aluminum casting. It has a machined bore to accept the
master cylinder pistons and also has threaded ports with seats for hydraulic brake tube
connections.
The master cylinder has the brake fluid reservoir mounted on top of it which gravity feeds brake
fluid to the master cylinder when it is required. On manual transmission model vehicles the brake
fluid reservoir also feeds the clutch hydraulic circuit. The reservoir is made of see-through plastic
and it houses the brake fluid level switch. A removable brake fluid level switch is mounted in the
right side.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Master Cylinder - Description > Page 5355
Brake Master Cylinder: Description and Operation Brake Master Cylinder - Operation
OPERATION
When the brake pedal is pressed, the master cylinder primary and secondary pistons apply brake
pressure through the chassis brake tubes to each brake assembly. The brake fluid reservoir
supplies the brake hydraulic system with the necessary fluid to operate properly.
The master cylinder's outlet ports supply hydraulic pressure to the Integrated Control Unit (ICU)
where it is distributed to the individual wheel brakes.
The master cylinder reservoir cap diaphragm is slit to allow atmospheric pressure to equalize on
both sides of the diaphragm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Master Cylinder: Procedures
MASTER CYLINDER BLEEDING
1. Clamp the master cylinder in a vise with soft-jaw caps.
2. Thread a Bleeder Tube (2), Special Tool 8358-1, into the primary and secondary ports. Tighten
bleeder tube nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.). 3. Flex each Bleeder Tube and place the open ends into
the neck of the master cylinder reservoir. Position the open ends of the tubes into the
reservoir so their outlets are below the surface of the brake fluid in the reservoir when filled.
NOTE: Make sure the ends of the Bleeder Tubes stay below the surface of the brake fluid in the
reservoir at all times during the bleeding
procedure.
4. Fill the brake fluid reservoir with fresh Mopar(R) Brake Fluid DOT 3 Motor Vehicle, or equivalent.
See: Brake Fluid/Specifications
5. Using an appropriately sized wooden dowel as a pushrod (1), slowly press the pistons inward
discharging brake fluid through the Bleeder Tubes
(2), then release the pressure, allowing the pistons to return to the released position. Repeat this
several times until all air bubbles are expelled from the master cylinder bore and Bleeder Tubes.
6. Remove the Bleeder Tubes from the master cylinder and plug the master cylinder outlet ports. 7.
Install the fill cap on the reservoir. 8. Remove the master cylinder from the vise. 9. Install the
master cylinder on the vehicle. See: Removal and Replacement/Brake Master Cylinder Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5358
Brake Master Cylinder: Removal and Replacement
Brake Master Cylinder - Removal
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
CAUTION: The vacuum in the power brake booster must be depleted before removing the master
cylinder to avoid damaging the master
cylinder and to prevent inhalation of the o-ring or any other contamination into the booster. The
preferred method is to pump the brake pedal while the engine is not running until the brake pedal
becomes firm. An alternative method is to remove and immediately reinstall the check valve
located on the booster. If the check valve is removed, special care should be taken to ensure that
the grommet is not damaged and remains seated, the check valve is dry and free of debris, and
that contaminates cannot be ingested during removal.
1. With the engine not running, pump the brake pedal 4-5 strokes until the pedal feel is firm. 2.
Disconnect the negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness connector (1) from the brake fluid level switch (2) in the master
cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
4. Disconnect the primary (1) and secondary (3) brake tubes at the master cylinder (2) outlet ports.
Install plugs at all of the open brake tube outlets
on the master cylinder.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5359
5. If equipped with a manual transaxle, remove the clamp and slide the clutch actuator hose (2) off
the reservoir port (1).
6. Clean the area around where the master cylinder (2) attaches to the power brake booster (1)
using a suitable brake cleaner such as Mopar(R) Brake
Parts Cleaner or an equivalent.
7. Remove the two nuts (3) attaching the master cylinder (2) to the power brake booster (1). 8.
Slide the master cylinder straight out of the power brake booster.
Brake Master Cylinder - Installation
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
NOTE: The master cylinder must be bled before installing it on the vehicle.
1. Bench bleed the master cylinder. See: Procedures 2. Wipe the face of the power brake booster
clean where the vacuum seal on the rear of the master cylinder comes in contact when it's
installed. Do
not get any cleaner or debris inside the booster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5360
CAUTION: When installing a master cylinder on the vehicle, a NEW vacuum O-ring seal (2) MUST
be installed on the master cylinder
mounting flange (1).
3. If the master cylinder does not have a new vacuum O-ring seal (2) on the mounting flange (1),
remove it. Install a NEW vacuum O-ring seal on the
master cylinder mounting flange making sure the O-ring fits evenly against the mounting flange.
CAUTION: If resistance is met during master cylinder insertion into power brake booster, the
master cylinder push rod may not be lined up
with the booster push rod. Remove the master cylinder, realign and insert it again.
4. Line the master cylinder mounting holes up with the mounting studs on the power brake booster.
Ensure the master cylinder piston push rod lines
up with the booster push rod, then carefully slide the master cylinder into the power brake booster
until it contacts the face of the booster.
5. Install two NEW master cylinder mounting nuts (3). Tighten each nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5361
6. If equipped with a manual transaxle and a new reservoir is being installed, using an appropriate
cutting tool, cut the clutch actuator port at the
center of the "V" groove (2) opening the hydraulic clutch port (1). Discard the severed plug (3).
7. If equipped with a manual transaxle, slide the clutch actuator hose (2) onto the reservoir port (1).
Install the hose clamp just past the upset bead on
the port.
8. Connect the primary (1) and secondary (3) brake tubes to the master cylinder (2) outlet ports.
Tighten the tube nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
9. Connect the wiring harness connector (1) to the brake fluid level switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5362
10. Connect the negative (ground) cable on the battery. 11. Fill the master cylinder reservoir to the
proper level. See: Brake Fluid/Service and Repair
WARNING: Be certain a firm brake pedal is achieved prior to attempting to operate the vehicle. If a
firm brake pedal cannot be achieved,
bleed the brake hydraulic system and check for leaks. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
12. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper operation of the brakes.
Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir - Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: If at any time the master cylinder is loosened or removed, you must perform the master
cylinder installation procedure to ensure
that the seal (o-ring) is still on the hub of the master cylinder See: Brake Master Cylinder Installation .
NOTE: The brake fluid level switch is mounted through the center of the fluid reservoir. The switch
can be serviced separately from the
master cylinder fluid reservoir See: Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch/Service and Repair/Brake
Fluid Level Switch - Removal
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Remove the outer and inner cowl covers See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding /
Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Inner Cover Removal See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Outer
Cover - Removal
2. Remove the front wiper motor module See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Motor
Linkage/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm Linkage - Removal 3. Clean the master cylinder housing
and brake fluid reservoir. Use only Mopar(R) Brake Parts Cleaner or equivalent. 4. Remove the
wiring harness connector (1) from the brake fluid level switch (2) in the master cylinder brake fluid
reservoir. 5. Remove the brake fluid reservoir cap. Using a syringe or equivalent type tool, empty
as much brake fluid as possible from the reservoir.
6. Remove the four reservoir retaining tabs from the mounting posts on the master cylinder
housing. 7. Pull the reservoir straight up and remove it from the grommet seals in master cylinder
housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5363
Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The brake fluid level switch is mounted through the center of the fluid reservoir. The switch
can be serviced separately from the
master cylinder fluid reservoir See: Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch/Service and Repair/Brake
Fluid Level Switch - Installation
1. Lubricate the reservoir mounting area with fresh clean brake fluid. With the grommet seals (2) on
the fluid reservoir spigots, place the reservoir in
position over the master cylinder. Install the fluid reservoir by firmly pressing down on the fluid
reservoir. Once installed, make sure the fluid reservoir is touching the top of both grommet seals.
2. Push the reservoir retaining tabs over the mounting posts on the master cylinder housing. Make
sure the retaining tabs are securely engaged. 3. Fill the brake fluid reservoir with fresh Mopar(R)
Brake Fluid DOT 3 Motor Vehicle, or equivalent See: Brake Fluid/Specifications 4. Install the front
wiper motor module See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Motor Linkage/Service and
Repair/Wiper Arm Linkage - Installation 5. Install the inner and outer cowl covers See: Body and
Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Inner Cover Installation See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Outer
Cover - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5364
Brake Master Cylinder: Overhaul
Brake Master Cylinder - Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: If the reservoir is being replaced, the new reservoir will come with a brake fluid level switch
installed. The old fluid switch does not
need to be transferred from the old reservoir to the new reservoir.
1. Clean the master cylinder housing and brake fluid reservoir. Use only Mopar(R) Brake Parts
Cleaner or equivalent. 2. Remove the brake fluid reservoir cap. Using a syringe or equivalent type
tool, empty as much brake fluid as possible from the reservoir.
3. Remove the four reservoir retaining tabs from the mounting posts on the master cylinder
housing.
4. Pull the reservoir straight up and remove it from the grommet seals in master cylinder housing.
5. Remove the vacuum O-ring seal (2) from the master cylinder mounting flange (1).
Brake Master Cylinder - Assembly
ASSEMBLY
NOTE: If the reservoir is being replaced, the new reservoir will come with a brake fluid level switch
installed. The old fluid switch does not
need to be transferred from the old reservoir to the new reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5365
1. Install a NEW vacuum O-ring seal (2) on the master cylinder mounting flange (1) making sure
the O-ring fits evenly against the mounting flange.
2. Lubricate the reservoir mounting area with fresh clean brake fluid. With the grommet seals (2) on
the fluid reservoir spigots, place the reservoir in
position over the master cylinder. Install the fluid reservoir by firmly pressing down on the fluid
reservoir. Once installed, make sure the fluid reservoir is touching the top of both grommet seals.
3. Push the reservoir retaining tabs over the mounting posts on the master cylinder housing. Make
sure the retaining tabs are securely engaged. 4. Fill and thoroughly bleed the master cylinder
before installing it. See: Procedures 5. Install the master cylinder. See: Removal and
Replacement/Brake Master Cylinder - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking Brake Cable: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
Parking Brake Cable: Customer Interest Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking Brake Cable: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 5375
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking Brake Cable: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 5376
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Parking Brake Cable: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08
> Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
Parking Brake Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking
Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Parking Brake Cable: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08
> Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 5382
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Parking Brake Cable: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08
> Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 5383
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Removal
Front Cable - With Foot Lever
WITH FOOT LEVER
1. Release the parking brake. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance 3. Manually
release the parking brake cable tension. See: Service and Repair
4. Collapse the front cable retainer fingers at the end of the cable housing where it contacts the
intermediate bracket (1). Pull the cable (5) forward
and remove it from the intermediate bracket.
5. Push the front cable strand into the housing until it bottoms.
6. Remove the nuts (5) securing the front cable routing clamps (1) to the underbody of the vehicle.
7. Remove the cable routing clamps (1) from the cable (4).
8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Remove the left front door opening sill scuff plate.
10. Remove the lower cowl trim. 11. Remove the steering column opening cover See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Opening Cover - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5386
12. Remove the steering column cover reinforcement mounting screws (2). Remove the steering
column cover reinforcement (1).
13. Pull the parking brake lever pedal up and hold it in this position.
14. Rotate the cable strand around at the lever mechanism until the strand lines up with the slot,
then remove the cable end button (2) from the lever
mechanism (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing cable from lever, note cable routing through lever for ease in reassembly.
15. Collapse the front cable retainer fingers on the end of the cable housing (1) at the lever (2). 16.
Remove the cable from the parking brake lever (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5387
17. Lift back the carpet and pull the cable seal loose from the floor pan. 18. Remove the front
parking brake cable from the vehicle through the hole in the floor pan.
Front Cable - With Hand Lever
WITH HAND LEVER
1. Remove the floor center console. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service
and Repair/Center Console - Removal
2. Manually release the parking brake cable tension. See: Service and Repair 3. Raise and support
the vehicle. See: Maintenance
4. Remove the parking brake cable equalizer/bent nail tensioner (4) from the three parking brake
cables (2, 3, 5). 5. Collapse the front cable retainer fingers at the end of the cable housing where it
contacts the intermediate bracket (1). Pull the cable (5) forward
and remove it from the intermediate bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5388
6. Remove the screws (4) securing the front cable routing clamps (1, 5) to the underbody of the
vehicle. 7. Remove the cable routing clamps (1, 5) from the cable (6).
8. Lower the vehicle.
9. Remove the mounting screws (3) fastening the front cable (4) to the side of the parking brake
lever (1).
10. Remove the adjusting nut (2) from the end of the front parking brake cable. 11. Remove the
cable strand from the lever. 12. Pull the cable seal loose from the floor pan and remove the front
parking brake cable from the vehicle through the access hole in the floor pan.
Rear Cable
REMOVAL
1. Release the parking brake. 2. Manually release the parking brake cable tension. See: Service
and Repair 3. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5389
4. Remove wheel mounting nuts (3), then tire and wheel assembly (1).
5. If not removed, remove the cable equalizer (4) (with foot lever) or equalizer/tensioner (with hand
lever) from the front and rear cables. 6. Collapse the right rear cable (3) retainer fingers at the end
of the cable housing where it contacts the intermediate bracket (1). Pull the right rear
cable out of the intermediate bracket.
7. Pull the right rear cable (2) out of the cable routing loop (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5390
8. If servicing the left rear cable, collapse the left rear cable (2) retainer fingers at the end of the
cable housing where it contacts the intermediate
bracket (1). Pull the left rear cable out of the intermediate bracket.
9. If servicing the left rear cable, remove the nuts (1) fastening the cable routing loop (3) to the
vehicle underbody near the trailing link forward
mounting point.
10. If servicing the right rear cable, remove the four screws securing the right rear cable to the rear
crossmember
.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5391
11. If servicing the right rear cable, remove the upper bolt (1) securing the knuckle to the trailing
link. This bolt also fastens the cable routing clamp
(3) in place.
12. If servicing the left rear cable:
a. Remove the upper bolt (1) securing the knuckle to the trailing link as well as the rear cable
routing clamp (3). b. Remove the other bolt (2) fastening the rear cable (4) to the trailing arm.
13. Collapse the cable retainer fingers (2) at the end of the cable housing (3), then pull the cable
housing out of the mounting bracket (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5392
14. Slide the cable strand out of the mounting bracket, then pull the parking brake cable strand (1)
upward and unhook it from the caliper lever (2). 15. Remove the cable from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5393
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Installation
Front Cable - With Foot Lever
WITH FOOT LEVER
1. Pass most of the front parking brake cable down through the access hole in the floor pan from
inside the vehicle.
2. Insert the lever end of the front parking brake cable through the mounting hole in the parking
brake lever (2). Slide it through until the cable
retainer fingers on the end of the housing (1) lock in place. Make sure all fingers are engaged
preventing removal of the cable from the bracket.
3. Pull the button on the end of cable strand out of housing and route the strand around the cable
guide, then rotate the cable strand up and align the
cable with the slot in lever mechanism (1). Slide the cable button (2) into the slot and rotate the
cable down into mounted position with the cable inserted into the guide on the mechanism.
4. Slide any extra cable back into the cable housing. This can be easily done by pulling on the
trailing end of the front cable strand that is now under
the vehicle.
5. Install the front parking brake cable floor pan seal into the access hole in the floor pan. 6.
Reposition the carpeting back down on the floor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5394
7. Install the steering column cover reinforcement (1) using the four mounting screws (2). 8. Install
the steering column opening cover. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Opening Cover - Installation
9. Install the lower cowl trim.
10. Install the left front door opening sill scuff plate.
11. Raise and support the vehicle.
12. Pass the end of the front cable (5) through the hole in the end of the intermediate bracket (1).
Press the cable housing retainer through the hole
until the fingers on the retainer lock it into place.
13. Install the cable routing clamps (1) over the metal sleeves on the front cable (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5395
14. Position the front cable routing clamps over the studs on the underbody of the vehicle and
install the nuts (5). Tighten the nuts to 6 Nm (55 in.
lbs.).
15. Reconnect the parking brake cable equalizer (4) and reset the cable tension. See: Service and
Repair
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Apply and release the parking brake lever (pedal) one time. This will seat
the parking brake cables. 18. Check operation of parking brakes.
Front Cable - With Hand Lever
WITH HAND LEVER
1. Pass most of the front parking brake cable down through the access hole in the floor pan from
inside the vehicle. 2. Install the front parking brake cable floor pan seal into the access hole in the
floor pan.
3. Install the mounting screws (3) fastening the front cable (4) to the side of the parking brake lever
(1). Tighten the mounting screws to 28 Nm (21
ft. lbs.).
4. Route the cable strand around the lever cable guide and start the adjusting nut (2) on the end of
the cable stud. Do not install the nut any further
than having the threads flush with the top of the nut. Otherwise, cable equalizer/bent nail tensioner
installation later in this procedure could be difficult.
5. Slide any extra cable back into the cable housing.
6. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5396
7. Install the cable routing clamps (1, 5) over the metal sleeves on the front cable (6). Be sure to
place the correct length clamp at the appropriate
location.
8. Position the front cable routing clamps over the studs on the underbody of the vehicle and install
the screws (4). Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (55
in. lbs.).
9. Pass the end of the front cable (5) through the hole in the end of the intermediate bracket (1).
Press the cable housing retainer through the hole
until the fingers on the retainer lock it into place.
10. Connect the parking brake cable equalizer/bent nail tensioner (4) to the three parking brake
cables (2, 3, 5). 11. Remove any slack from the parking brake cables by pushing the front cable
strand forward into the housing until slack is removed.
12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Reset the hand lever cable tension and verify check operation of the
parking brake. See: Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5397
14. Install the cover on the side of the parking brake lever.
15. Install the floor center console. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service
and Repair/Center Console - Removal
Rear Cable
INSTALLATION
1. Guide the trailing end of the parking brake cable along the inboard side of the axle trailing arm
up to the rear brake caliper. Make sure the cable is
routed between the brake line and the trailing arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5398
2. Pull the parking brake cable strand (1) outward from the cable housing and hook it onto the
caliper lever (2).
3. Push the excess cable strand back into the cable housing, then insert the cable housing (3) into
the mounting bracket (1) until the retainer fingers
(2) lock into place. Make sure both fingers are engaged preventing removal of the cable from the
bracket.
CAUTION: Before installing bolt (1) in the following step, it is especially important to clean the
threads and apply Mopar(R) Lock & Seal
Adhesive or equivalent.
4. If servicing the left rear cable, position the cable routing clamps (3) against the axle trailing link
and:
a. Install the upper mounting bolt (1) securing the trailing link (and cable routing clamp) to the
knuckle. Tighten the mounting bolt to 60 Nm (44
ft. lbs.).
b. Install the bolt (2) attaching the other cable routing clamp to the axle trailing link. Tighten the bolt
to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Before installing bolt (1) in the following step, it is especially important to clean the
threads and apply Mopar(R) Lock & Seal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5399
Adhesive or equivalent.
5. If servicing the right rear cable, position the cable routing clamps (3) against the axle trailing link
and install the upper mounting bolt (1) securing
the trailing link (and cable routing clamp) to the knuckle. Tighten the mounting bolt to 60 Nm (44 ft.
lbs.).
6. If servicing the right rear cable, route the cable over the rear axle (if equipped with AWD) along
the front of the rear suspension crossmember.
Position the four routing clamps on the rear crossmember and install the screws. Tighten the
screws to 6 Nm (55 in. lbs.).
.
7. If servicing the left rear cable, place the routing loop (3) over the studs on the vehicle underbody
near the trailing link forward mounting point and
install the mounting nuts. Tighten the nuts to 6 Nm (55 in. lbs.).
8. Insert the right rear cable (2) through the lower loop of the cable routing loop (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5400
9. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
10. If servicing the left rear cable, pass the leading end of the left rear cable (2) through the upper
hole in the intermediate bracket (1). Press the cable
housing through the hole until the fingers on the retainer lock it into place.
11. If servicing a vehicle equipped with a foot lever:
a. Connect the parking brake cable equalizer (4) to the three parking brake cables (2, 3, 5) and
reset the cable tension. See: Service and Repair b. Lower the vehicle.
12. If servicing a vehicle equipped with a hand lever:
a. Connect the parking brake cable equalizer/bent nail tensioner (4) to the three parking brake
cables (2, 3, 5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5401
b. Remove any slack from the parking brake cables by pushing the front cable strand forward into
the housing until slack is removed. c. Lower the vehicle. d. Reset the hand lever cable tension and
verify check operation of the parking brake. See: Service and Repair
13. Check operation of parking brakes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Parking Brake Lever: Service and Repair Removal
Foot Operated Parking Brake Lever
FOOT OPERATED PARKING BRAKE LEVER
1. Release the parking brake. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance 3. Manually
release the parking brake cable tension. See: Service and Repair 4. Push the front cable strand
into the housing until it bottoms. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Remove the left front door opening sill
scuff plate. 7. Remove the lower cowl trim. 8. Remove the steering column opening cover See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Opening Cover - Removal.
9. Remove the steering column cover reinforcement mounting screws (2). Remove the steering
column cover reinforcement (1).
10. Pull the parking brake lever pedal up and hold it in this position.
11. Rotate the cable strand around at the lever mechanism until the strand lines up with the slot,
then remove the cable end button (2) from the lever
mechanism (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing cable from lever, note cable routing through lever for ease in reassembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5406
12. Collapse the front cable retainer fingers on the end of the cable housing (1) at the lever (2). 13.
Remove the cable from the parking brake lever (3).
14. Disconnect the wiring connector (2) at parking brake indicator lamp switch.
15. Remove the three mounting nuts (2), then remove the parking brake lever (1) from the cowl (3).
Hand Operated Parking Brake Lever
HAND OPERATED PARKING BRAKE LEVER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5407
1. Remove the floor center console. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service
and Repair/Center Console - Removal
2. Manually release the parking brake cable tension. See: Service and Repair
3. Remove the mounting screws (3) fastening the front cable (4) to the side of the parking brake
lever (1). 4. Remove the adjusting nut (2) from the end of the front parking brake cable. 5. Remove
the cable strand from the lever.
6. Disconnect the wiring connector (2) at parking brake indicator lamp switch (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5408
7. Remove the two horizontal (5) and one vertical (2) mounting bolts, then remove the parking
brake lever (1) from the shifter bracket (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5409
Parking Brake Lever: Service and Repair Installation
Foot Operated Parking Brake Lever
FOOT OPERATED PARKING BRAKE LEVER
1. Position the parking brake lever (1) over the mounting studs, against the left lower cowl (3). 2.
Install the three mounting nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the wiring connector (2) at the parking brake indicator lamp switch on the parking brake
lever (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5410
4. Insert the lever end of the front parking brake cable through the mounting hole in the parking
brake lever (2). Slide it through until the cable
retainer fingers on the end of the housing (1) lock in place. Make sure all fingers are engaged
preventing removal of the cable from the bracket.
5. Pull the button on the end of cable strand out of housing and route the strand around the cable
guide, then rotate the cable strand up and align the
cable with the slot in lever mechanism (1). Slide the cable button (2) into the slot and rotate the
cable down into mounted position with the cable inserted into the guide on the mechanism.
6. Slide any extra cable back into the cable housing. This can be easily done by pulling on the
trailing end of the front cable strand that is now under
the vehicle.
7. Install the front parking brake cable floor pan seal into the access hole in the floor pan. 8.
Reposition the carpeting back down on the floor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5411
9. Install the steering column cover reinforcement (1) using the four mounting screws (2).
10. Install the steering column opening cover. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Opening Cover - Installation
11. Install the lower cowl trim. 12. Install the left front door opening sill scuff plate.
13. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
14. If the original parking brake lever is being reinstalled, reconnect the parking brake cable
equalizer (4) and reset the cable tension. See: Service and
Repair
15. If a NEW parking brake lever is being installed, connect the parking brake cable equalizer to
the cables, then remove the pin locking the lever
mechanism spring tension at the lever.
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Apply and release the parking brake lever (pedal) one time. This will seat
the parking brake cables. 18. Check operation of parking brake lever and parking brakes.
Hand Operated Parking Brake Lever
HAND OPERATED PARKING BRAKE LEVER
1. Position the parking brake lever (1) on the shifter bracket (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5412
NOTE: When installing the vertical mounting bolt in the following step make sure to capture the
ground strap (2) with the mounting bolt (1)
before installation.
2. Install the two horizontal (5) and one vertical (2) mounting bolts. Tighten the nuts to 20 Nm (15 ft.
lbs.).
3. Connect the wiring connector (2) at the parking brake indicator lamp switch (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5413
4. Install the mounting screws (3) fastening the front cable (4) to the side of the parking brake lever
(1). Tighten the mounting screws to 28 Nm (21
ft. lbs.).
5. Route the cable strand around the lever cable guide and start the adjusting nut (2) on the end of
the cable stud. Do not install the nut any further
than having the threads flush with the top of the nut before the next step is performed.
6. Make sure the cables (2, 3, 5) are connected to the cable equalizer/bent nail tensioner (4) at the
intermediate bracket (1) under the vehicle.
7. Reset the hand lever cable tension and verify check operation of the parking brake. See: Service
and Repair
8. Install the cover on the side of the parking brake lever.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5414
9. Install the floor center console. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service
and Repair/Center Console - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5418
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5419
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 1 WAY
SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE - (BODY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
There are two unique park brake switches used on this vehicle, depending upon whether the
vehicle has a foot-operated or hand-operated park brake lever mechanism.
FOOT-OPERATED
Foot-Operated Park Brake Switch
The foot-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the cowl
side inner panel below the instrument panel, outboard of the steering column. This switch includes
a spade-type output terminal (3) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the
stationary contact within a molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive switch
location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact with an integral grounding lug (4) on
one end and an integral actuating lever and follower (2) on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The foot-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged,
it must be replaced.
HAND-OPERATED
Hand-Operated Park Brake Switch
The hand-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the floor
panel transmission tunnel below the center floor console. This switch includes a spade-type output
terminal (2) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out
and
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page 5422
connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the stationary contact within a
molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab (4) on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive
switch location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact (3) with an integral grounding lug
on one end and an integral actuating lever and follower on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The hand-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or
damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page 5423
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Operation
OPERATION
Both the foot-operated and hand-operated park brake switch are normally closed, mechanically
actuated leaf contact switches that are operated by the foot or hand park brake lever mechanism.
The switch is grounded through its mounting to the park brake lever mechanism and provides a
ground input to the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab
Compartment Node/CCN) on a park brake switch sense circuit whenever the park brake is applied,
and opens this circuit whenever the park brake is released. The park brake switch sense input to
the EMIC is used as a logic input by the EMIC for control of the brake indicator and may also be
used as a logic input for other electronic features in the vehicle.
The park brake switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that rely upon inputs
from the park brake switch. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the
electronic controls and communication related to park brake switch operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5424
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
PARK BRAKE SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: If the brake indicator stays ON with the ignition switch in the ON position and the park brake
released, or comes ON while driving,
the brake system must be diagnosed and repaired prior to performing the following tests. See:
Testing and Inspection . If no brake system problem is found, the following procedures will help to
locate a shorted or open park brake switch sense circuit, or an ineffective park brake switch.
INDICATOR ILLUMINATES DURING BULB TEST, BUT DOES NOT WHEN PARK BRAKE
APPLIED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Apply the parking brake. Check for continuity between the park brake switch terminal and a good
ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake
switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavities of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and the instrument panel wire harness connector for the instrument
cluster. There should be continuity. If not OK, repair the open park brake switch sense circuit
between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster as required.
INDICATOR REMAINS ILLUMINATED - BRAKE SYSTEM CHECKS OKAY
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Check for continuity between the terminal of the park brake switch and a good ground. There
should be no continuity with the park brake released, and continuity with the park brake applied. If
OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavity of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and a good ground. There should be no continuity. If not OK, repair the
shorted park brake switch sense circuit between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster
as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Apply the parking brake. 3. Reach under
the left end of the instrument panel to access and disconnect the wire harness connector from the
terminal of the park brake switch (2)
located on the park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side inner panel.
4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever mechanism. 5.
Remove the switch from the park brake lever mechanism.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the console from the floor panel
transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center
Console - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 5427
3. Pull the parking brake lever (1) upward to apply the parking brake. 4. Disconnect the wire
harness connector from the terminal of the park brake switch (2) located on the right side of the
park brake lever mechanism. 5. Remove the screw (3) that secures the switch to the park brake
lever bracket. 6. Remove the switch from the park brake lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 5428
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to position the park brake switch (2) onto the
park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side
inner panel. Be certain to engage the locating pin on the back of the switch insulator into the
locating slot in the lever mechanism bracket.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever
mechanism. Tighten the screw to 2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to
the terminal of the park brake switch. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the ON position and check for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake
applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Position park brake switch (2) onto the right side of the park brake lever (1) bracket. Be certain to
engage the locating pin on the back of the
switch insulator into the locating slot in the lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 5429
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the switch to the lever bracket. Tighten the screw to
2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the terminal of the switch. 4.
Reinstall the console onto the floor panel transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center
Console - Installation
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 6. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and check
for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The power brake booster (3) is mounted to the engine side of the dash panel. The master cylinder
is bolted to the front of the booster. A vacuum check valve is also mounted on the front of the
booster. A vacuum line connects the check valve to engine source vacuum. The booster input rod
extends through the dash panel and connects to the brake pedal.
This vehicle uses a tandem diaphragm, single rate vacuum power brake booster with 203 and 229
mm (8 and 9 in.) diaphragms. Power brake boosters are internally tuned differently depending on
whether the vehicle is equipped with ABS or without ABS. If the power brake booster requires
replacement, be sure it is replaced with the correct part.
The power brake booster can be identified by the tag attached to the body of the booster. This tag
contains the following information:
- The production part number
- The date it was built, and
- The booster manufacturer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5434
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection
POWER BRAKE BOOSTER
BASIC TEST
1. With engine off, depress and release the brake pedal several times to purge all vacuum from the
power brake booster. 2. Depress and hold the pedal with light effort (15 to 25 lbs. (6.8 to 11.3 kg)
pressure), then start the engine.
The pedal should fall slightly, then hold. Less effort should be needed to apply the pedal at this
time. If the pedal fell as indicated, perform the VACUUM LEAK TEST listed after the BASIC TEST.
If the pedal did not fall, continue on with this BASIC TEST.
3. Disconnect the vacuum hose at the vacuum check and tee-in a vacuum gauge. 4. Start the
engine. 5. When the engine is at warm operating temperature, allow it to idle and check the
vacuum at the gauge.
If the vacuum supply is 12 inches Hg (40.5 kPa) or more, the power brake booster is defective and
must be replaced. If the vacuum supply is below 12 inches Hg, continue on with this BASIC TEST.
6. Shut off the engine. 7. Connect the vacuum gauge to the vacuum reference port on the engine
intake manifold. 8. Start the engine and observe the vacuum gauge.
If the vacuum is still low, check the engine tune and repair as necessary. If the vacuum is above 12
inches, the hose or check to the booster has a restriction or leak.
Once an adequate vacuum supply is obtained, repeat the BASIC TEST.
VACUUM LEAK TEST
1. Disconnect the vacuum hose at the vacuum check and tee-in a vacuum gauge. 2. Start the
engine. 3. Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature and engine idle. 4. Using
vacuum line pliers, close off the vacuum supply hose near the booster and observe the vacuum
gauge.
If the vacuum drop exceeds 1.0 inch Hg (3.3 kPa) in one minute, repeat the above steps to confirm
the reading. The vacuum loss should be less than 1.0 inch Hg in one minute time span. If the loss
is more than 1.0 inch Hg, replace the power brake booster. If it is not, continue on with this test.
5. Remove the pliers from the hose temporarily. 6. Apply light effort (approximately 15 lbs. (6.8 kg)
of force) to the brake pedal and hold the pedal steady. Do not move the pedal once the pressure
is applied or the test results may vary.
7. Have an assistant reattach the pliers to the vacuum supply hose. 8. Allow 5 seconds for
stabilization, then observe the vacuum gauge.
If the vacuum drop exceeds 3.0 inches Hg (10 kPa) in 15 seconds, repeat the above steps to
confirm the reading. The vacuum loss should be less than 3.0 inches Hg in 15 seconds time span.
If the loss is more than 3.0 inches Hg, replace the power brake booster. If it is not, the booster is
not defective.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Brake Booster - Removal
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair Power Brake Booster - Removal
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
CAUTION: The vacuum in the power brake booster must be pumped down before removing the
master cylinder to prevent the booster from
sucking in any contamination. This can be done by pumping the brake pedal while the engine is not
running until a firm brake pedal is achieved.
1. With the engine not running, pump the brake pedal 4-5 strokes until the pedal feel is firm. 2.
Disconnect the negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable.
3. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 4. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
5. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen. Remove the cowl screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Brake Booster - Removal > Page 5437
6. Remove the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1) securing the wheel house brace to the strut
towers. 7. Remove the wheelhouse brace (2).
8. Remove the master cylinder. See: Hydraulic System/Brake Master Cylinder/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Master Cylinder
- Removal
9. Disconnect the rear brake tubes (1) at the junction block (2). Install plugs at all of the open brake
tubes.
10. Disconnect the vacuum hose (2) from the check valve (1) on the power brake booster. Do not
remove the check valve from power brake
booster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Brake Booster - Removal > Page 5438
11. If equipped, remove the silencer pad below the steering column opening cover.
12. Remove the stop lamp switch (2). Do not reuse the stop lamp switch on vehicles built prior to
July 21, 2008.See: Lighting and Horns/Brake
Light Switch/Service and Repair/Stop Lamp Switch - Removal
13. Remove the retaining clip (2) securing the power brake booster push rod (1) to the brake pedal.
To do so, position a small screwdriver under the
center tang of the retaining clip, then rotate the screwdriver enough to allow the retaining clip tang
to pass over the end of the brake pedal pin (3). Remove and discard the clip. Do not reuse the clip.
14. Slide the booster push rod (1) off the brake pedal pin (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Brake Booster - Removal > Page 5439
15. Remove the four nuts (4) attaching the power brake booster (3) to the dash panel. 16. Slide the
power brake booster (3) forward until its mounting studs clear the dash panel, then remove it
through the engine compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Brake Booster - Removal > Page 5440
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair Power Brake Booster - Installation
LEFT-HAND-DRIVE
NOTE: Before power brake booster (1) installation, be certain a NEW dash seal (2) is installed on
the booster mounting studs.
1. Install the power brake booster (3) by sliding the push rod and studs through the dash panel and
into mounting position. 2. Under the instrument panel, install the four power brake booster
mounting nuts (4). To tighten the nuts, refer to the following step.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Brake Booster - Removal > Page 5441
CAUTION: Because of power brake booster design, it is very important to tighten the mounting
nuts in the proper sequence.
3. Tighten the brake pedal/booster mounting nuts in the proper sequence to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
4. Using Mopar(R) Lubriplate, or an equivalent, coat the surface of the brake pedal pin (3) where it
contacts the brake booster input rod (1). 5. Install the power brake booster push rod (1) on the pin
(3) mounted on the side of the brake pedal. Install a NEW retaining clip (2) on the end of
the pin. Do not reuse the old clip.
CAUTION: Do not reuse the original stop lamp switch on vehicles built prior to July 21, 2008.
Anytime a switch has been removed or its
position compromised, a new switch must be installed and adjusted. Do not attempt to readjust the
switch. The original brake lamp switch can be reused and adjusted on vehicles built on or after July
21, 2008.
6. Install and adjust a NEW stop lamp switch (2) in the brake pedal bracket (1) on vehicle built prior
to July 21, 2008. The original brake lamp
switch can be reused on vehicles built on or after July 21, 2008. See: Lighting and Horns/Brake
Light Switch/Service and Repair/Stop Lamp Switch - Installation
7. If equipped, install the silencer pad below the instrument panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Brake Booster - Removal > Page 5442
CAUTION: When installing the vacuum hose on the check valve (1), make sure the hose is routed
properly to avoid possible contact with
unfriendly surfaces.
8. Connect the vacuum hose (2) to the vacuum check valve (1).
9. Connect the rear brake tubes (1) to the junction block (2). Tighten the tube nuts to 17 Nm (150
in. lbs.).
10. Install the master cylinder. See: Hydraulic System/Brake Master Cylinder/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Master Cylinder Installation
11. Install the wheelhouse brace (2). Install and tighten the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1)
to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Brake Booster - Removal > Page 5443
12. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
13. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
14. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
15. Connect the battery negative cable to its post on the battery. 16. Bleed the base brake system.
See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair 17. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper operation of
the brakes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5448
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 47 WAY
MODULE-ANTI-LOCK BRAKES - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 47 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5449
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Brake System Module Description
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Brake System Module Description
DESCRIPTION
The Antilock Brake Module (ABM) is a microprocessor-based device which monitors the antilock
brake system (ABS) during normal braking and controls it when the vehicle is in an ABS stop or
when in a traction control situation. The ABM utilizes a 47-way electrical connector on the vehicle
wiring harness. The power source for the ABM is through the ignition switch in the RUN or ON
position.
NOTE: The ABM is only separately serviceable for non-HSA (Hill Start Assist) equipped vehicles.
Do not remove the ABM for vehicles
equipped with HSA.
The ABM (1) is mounted to the HCU (2) as part of the Integrated Control Unit (ICU). The ICU is
located in the engine compartment below the master cylinder on the front suspension
cradle/crossmember. For information on the ICU, See: Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Description and Operation/Integrated
Control Unit (ICU) - Description - DESCRIPTION).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Brake System Module Description > Page 5452
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Brake System Module Operation
OPERATION
The primary functions of the Antilock Brake Module (ABM) are to:
- Monitor the antilock brake system for proper operation.
- Detect wheel locking or wheel slipping tendencies by monitoring the speed of all four wheels of
the vehicle.
- Control fluid modulation to the wheel brakes while the system is in an ABS mode.
- Store diagnostic information.
- Provide communication to the scan tool while in diagnostic mode.
- Illuminate the amber ABS warning indicator lamp.
- Illuminate the ESP function lamp in the message center on the instrument panel when a traction
control event occurs.
- Illuminate the ESP function lamp when the amber ABS warning indicator lamp illuminates.
The ABM constantly monitors the antilock brake system for proper operation. If the ABM detects a
fault, it will turn on the amber ABS warning indicator lamp and disable the antilock braking system.
The normal base braking system will remain operational.
NOTE: If the vehicle is equipped with traction control, the ESP function lamp will illuminate anytime
the amber ABS warning indicator lamp
illuminates.
The ABM continuously monitors the speed of each wheel through the signals generated by the
wheel speed sensors to determine if any wheel is beginning to lock. When a wheel locking
tendency is detected, the ABM commands the ABM command coils to actuate. The coils then open
and close the valves in the HCU that modulate brake fluid pressure in some or all of the hydraulic
circuits. The ABM continues to control pressure in individual hydraulic circuits until a locking
tendency is no longer present.
The ABM contains a self-diagnostic program that monitors the antilock brake system for system
faults. When a fault is detected, the amber ABS warning indicator lamp is turned on and the fault
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is then stored in a diagnostic program memory. A latched fault will
disable certain system functionality for the current ignition cycle. An unlatched fault will disable
certain system functionality until the fault condition disappears. These DTC's will remain in the
ABM memory even after the ignition has been turned off. The DTC's can be read and cleared from
the ABM memory by a technician using a scan tool. If not cleared with a scan tool, the fault
occurrence and DTC will be automatically cleared from the ABM memory after the identical fault
has not been seen during the next 3,500 miles. Drive-off may be required for the amber ABS
warning indicator lamp to go out on the next ignition cycle.
ABM INPUTS
- Wheel speed sensors (four)
- Brake lamp switch
- Ignition switch
- System and pump voltage
- Ground
- ESP/BAS warning indicator lamp
- Diagnostic communication
ABM OUTPUTS
- Amber ABS warning indicator lamp actuation (via BUS)
- Red BRAKE warning indicator lamp actuation (via BUS)
- Instrument cluster (MIC) communication
- ESP/BAS warning indicator lamp
- Diagnostic communication
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal
LEFT-HAND DRIVE
NOTE: The ABM is only separately serviceable for non-HSA (Hill Start Assist) equipped vehicles.
Do not remove the ABM for vehicles
equipped with HSA.
1. Disconnect the negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate it. 2. Remove the engine
appearance cover.
3. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 4. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
5. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen. Remove the cowl screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page
5455
6. Remove the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1) securing the wheel house brace to the strut
towers. 7. Remove the wheelhouse brace (2).
8. Remove two screws, then remove the fresh air plenum. 9. Raise and support the vehicle. See:
Maintenance
10. Loosen, but do not remove, the two mounting screws (2) attaching the ICU (1) mounting
bracket to the body. 11. Lift the ICU and mounting bracket (1) upward to near the top of the slots in
the bracket, then snug one or both of the mounting screws (2) to hold
the ICU in this position.
12. Lower the vehicle.
CAUTION: Before disassembling the ICU, the ICU must be thoroughly cleaned. This must be done
to prevent dirt particles and debris from
entering into vital areas of the ICU.
13. Thoroughly clean all surfaces of the ICU and brake tubes. Use only a solvent such as Mopar(R)
Brake Parts Cleaner or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page
5456
NOTE: Use this figure in the following step to release the ABM harness connector cover. It shows
the location of the release tabs.
14. Disconnect the ABM harness connector from the Antilock Brake Module (ABM). To do so:
a. Depress the tabs on each side of the connector cover, then b. Pull outward and upward on the
lower half of the cover until it locks into position pointing straight outward (2). The connector can
then be
pulled straight outward off the ABM (1).
15. Remove the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU. A Torx T20 bit approximately 2
inches long works well.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page
5457
CAUTION: When removing the ABM from the HCU, be sure to completely separate the two
components (approximately 38 mm (1.5 inches))
before removing the ABM. Otherwise, damage to the pressure sensor or pump motor connection
may result, requiring HCU replacement. Do not to touch the sensor terminals on the HCU side or
the contact pads on the ABM side as this may result in contamination and issues in the future.
16. Separate the ABM (1) from the HCU (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page
5458
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Installation
LEFT-HAND DRIVE
1. Clean any debris off the mating surfaces of the HCU and ABM.
CAUTION: When installing new O-rings or solenoid valve stem seals, do not use any type of
lubricant.
2. If the seals (1) on the solenoid valve stems (2) are not new, replace them all. Each of the
solenoid valve stem seals must be new to keep out
moisture and debris; do not reuse solenoid valve stem seals.
3. Replace the pump/motor connector O-ring (1) if it is not new. Be sure the O-ring is properly
seated in the mounting groove (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page
5459
4. Align components and install the ABM (1) on the HCU (2).
5. Install the four screws (1) attaching the ABM (2) to the HCU. Tighten the mounting screws to 2
Nm (17 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page
5460
CAUTION: Before installing the ABM harness connector on the ABM, be sure the seal is properly
installed in the connector.
6. Insert the ABM wiring harness connector (2) into the socket of the ABM (1) and close the cover,
locking the connector in place.
7. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
8. Loosen the two mounting screws (2) as necessary and allow the ICU (1) mounting bracket to
slide down over the mounting screws and hang the
assembly in place. Tighten the two mounting screws (2) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Position the fresh air plenum and install the two mounting screws.
11. Install the wheelhouse brace (2). Install and tighten the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1)
to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Brake System Module - Removal > Page
5461
12. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
13. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
14. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
15. Install the engine appearance cover. 16. Connect the negative cable on the battery negative
post. 17. Hook up the scan tool to initialize the ABM and perform the following:
a. Clear any faults. b. Perform the ABS Verification Test and road test the vehicle. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5466
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-BRAKE FLUID LEVEL - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5467
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The brake fluid level switch (2) is mounted through the center of the fluid reservoir. The switch can
be serviced separately from the master cylinder fluid reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Fluid Level Switch - Removal
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Brake Fluid Level Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Remove the wiring harness connector (1) from the brake fluid level switch (2) in the master
cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
2. Push together the retaining tabs (1) that hold the brake fluid level switch in place in the brake
fluid reservoir (2). 3. Pull the brake fluid level switch out the right side of the reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Fluid Level Switch - Removal > Page
5470
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Brake Fluid Level Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Align the brake fluid level switch with its mounting hole on the right side of the master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir. Push the switch into the fluid
reservoir until the switch retaining tabs (1) are expanded on the opposite side of the reservoir (2),
locking it in place.
2. Connect the wiring harness connector (1) to the switch (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 5474
Lateral Accelerometer: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 4 WAY
SENSOR-DYNAMICS - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 5475
Lateral Accelerometer: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensors are housed into one unit known as the Dynamics
Sensor (1). The sensor is used to measure side-to-side (Lateral) motion and vehicle rotational
sensing (how fast the vehicle is turning - Yaw).
The Dynamics Sensor (1) is located on the floor tunnel just forward of the center floor console (2),
below the instrument panel.
Yaw and Lateral Acceleration Sensors cannot be serviced separately. The entire Dynamics Sensor
must be replaced when necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from the battery post.
2. Remove the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below instrument panel.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness connector (3) at the dynamics sensor (1). 4. Working on each
side of the floor tunnel, remove the nuts (2) mounting the dynamics sensor to the floor pan tunnel
(4). 5. Remove the dynamics sensor (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal > Page 5478
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the dynamics sensor (1) over the studs mounted to the floor pan tunnel (4). 2. Working on
each side of the floor pan tunnel (4), install the two mounting nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 9 Nm (80
in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wiring harness connector (3) to the dynamics sensor (1).
4. Install the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below the instrument panel.
5. Connect the battery negative cable to the battery post. It is important that this be performed
properly. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service
and Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection
6. Perform the Verification Test and clear any faults. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5482
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5483
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 1 WAY
SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE - (BODY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
There are two unique park brake switches used on this vehicle, depending upon whether the
vehicle has a foot-operated or hand-operated park brake lever mechanism.
FOOT-OPERATED
Foot-Operated Park Brake Switch
The foot-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the cowl
side inner panel below the instrument panel, outboard of the steering column. This switch includes
a spade-type output terminal (3) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the
stationary contact within a molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive switch
location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact with an integral grounding lug (4) on
one end and an integral actuating lever and follower (2) on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The foot-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged,
it must be replaced.
HAND-OPERATED
Hand-Operated Park Brake Switch
The hand-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the floor
panel transmission tunnel below the center floor console. This switch includes a spade-type output
terminal (2) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out
and
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page
5486
connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the stationary contact within a
molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab (4) on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive
switch location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact (3) with an integral grounding lug
on one end and an integral actuating lever and follower on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The hand-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or
damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page
5487
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Operation
OPERATION
Both the foot-operated and hand-operated park brake switch are normally closed, mechanically
actuated leaf contact switches that are operated by the foot or hand park brake lever mechanism.
The switch is grounded through its mounting to the park brake lever mechanism and provides a
ground input to the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab
Compartment Node/CCN) on a park brake switch sense circuit whenever the park brake is applied,
and opens this circuit whenever the park brake is released. The park brake switch sense input to
the EMIC is used as a logic input by the EMIC for control of the brake indicator and may also be
used as a logic input for other electronic features in the vehicle.
The park brake switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that rely upon inputs
from the park brake switch. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the
electronic controls and communication related to park brake switch operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5488
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
PARK BRAKE SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: If the brake indicator stays ON with the ignition switch in the ON position and the park brake
released, or comes ON while driving,
the brake system must be diagnosed and repaired prior to performing the following tests. See:
Testing and Inspection . If no brake system problem is found, the following procedures will help to
locate a shorted or open park brake switch sense circuit, or an ineffective park brake switch.
INDICATOR ILLUMINATES DURING BULB TEST, BUT DOES NOT WHEN PARK BRAKE
APPLIED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Apply the parking brake. Check for continuity between the park brake switch terminal and a good
ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake
switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavities of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and the instrument panel wire harness connector for the instrument
cluster. There should be continuity. If not OK, repair the open park brake switch sense circuit
between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster as required.
INDICATOR REMAINS ILLUMINATED - BRAKE SYSTEM CHECKS OKAY
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Check for continuity between the terminal of the park brake switch and a good ground. There
should be no continuity with the park brake released, and continuity with the park brake applied. If
OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavity of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and a good ground. There should be no continuity. If not OK, repair the
shorted park brake switch sense circuit between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster
as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Apply the parking brake. 3. Reach under
the left end of the instrument panel to access and disconnect the wire harness connector from the
terminal of the park brake switch (2)
located on the park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side inner panel.
4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever mechanism. 5.
Remove the switch from the park brake lever mechanism.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the console from the floor panel
transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center
Console - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 5491
3. Pull the parking brake lever (1) upward to apply the parking brake. 4. Disconnect the wire
harness connector from the terminal of the park brake switch (2) located on the right side of the
park brake lever mechanism. 5. Remove the screw (3) that secures the switch to the park brake
lever bracket. 6. Remove the switch from the park brake lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 5492
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to position the park brake switch (2) onto the
park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side
inner panel. Be certain to engage the locating pin on the back of the switch insulator into the
locating slot in the lever mechanism bracket.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever
mechanism. Tighten the screw to 2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to
the terminal of the park brake switch. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the ON position and check for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake
applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Position park brake switch (2) onto the right side of the park brake lever (1) bracket. Be certain to
engage the locating pin on the back of the
switch insulator into the locating slot in the lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 5493
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the switch to the lever bracket. Tighten the screw to
2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the terminal of the switch. 4.
Reinstall the console onto the floor panel transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center
Console - Installation
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 6. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and check
for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Traction Control Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
MODULE-ASBM
The ESP Off Switch (2) is part of the accessory switch bank module located in the center bezel (2)
on the instrument panel above the radio. The ESP Off switch turns the Electronic Stability Program
off whenever the switch is depressed. Depressing the switch a second time turns the ESP(R) back
on. The switch resets itself each time the ignition is cycled.
When the ESP Off switch is depressed and released, turning ESP(R) off, it does not completely
turn the system off. The ESP(R) system reduces torque management to a lesser amount, but
ESP(R) function can still occur if the system perceives the need.
The ESP Off switch is serviced as part of the accessory switch bank. There are different accessory
switch banks available based on the option content of the vehicle. Ensure the accessory switch
bank being installed matches the vehicle options.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Removal
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The ESP Off switch is integral to the accessory switch bank and cannot be serviced
separately.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the center bezel from the
instrument panel and place it on a work bench See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Remove the screws that secure the accessory switch bank to the back of the center bezel and
remove the accessory switch bank.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Removal >
Page 5499
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The ESP Off switch is serviced as part of the accessory switch bank.
NOTE: There are different instrument panel accessory switch banks available based on the option
content of the vehicle. Ensure the accessory
switch bank being installed matches the vehicle options.
1. Position the accessory switch bank onto the back of the instrument panel center bezel. 2. Install
the screws that secure the accessory switch bank to the center bezel. Tighten the screws to 2 Nm
(17 in. lbs.). 3. Install the center bezel onto the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Installation.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 5. Perform the ABS Verification Test See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble
Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS Verification Test and make sure the
ESP Off switch operates properly. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
6. Verify proper operation of all components controlled by the switch bank.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 5504
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 5505
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 5506
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-LEFT REAR - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way > Page 5509
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-RIGHT REAR - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way > Page 5510
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (Headlamp And Dash) 2 Way
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-LEFT FRONT - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (Body) 2 Way > Page 5511
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (Headlamp And Dash) 2 Way
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-RIGHT FRONT - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wheel Speed Sensor - Description
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensor - Description
Front
DESCRIPTION
The antilock brake system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed
sensors. The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto-resistive to help increase
performance and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A Wheel
Speed Sensor (WSS) is used at each wheel. A magnetic pole encoder serves as the trigger
mechanism for each sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one
encoder.
A front wheel speed sensor (2) is attached to a mounting boss on each front knuckle (3). The
encoder is an integral part of the hub and bearing.
WSS air gaps are not adjustable.
Rear
DESCRIPTION
The antilock brake system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed
sensors. The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto-resistive to help increase
performance and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A Wheel
Speed Sensor (WSS) is used at each wheel. A magnetic pole encoder serves as the trigger
mechanism for each sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one
encoder.
The rear wheel speed sensor (2) head is mounted to the rear hub and bearing (1). The encoder is
integral to the hub and bearing assembly. The encoder is serviced as part of the rear hub and
bearing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wheel Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5514
WSS air gaps are not adjustable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Wheel Speed Sensor - Description > Page 5515
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensor - Operation
Front
OPERATION
The ABM sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the ABM. The relationship of the magnetic pole encoder to the
permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output
of the sensor, sent to the ABM, is a DC voltage signal with changing voltage and current levels.
The ground for the IC and the current sense circuit is provided by the ABM.
When a pole is properly aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8 volts and a
constant 7 mA current is sent to the ABM. As the magnetic pole encoder rotates, the encoder shifts
the magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The ABM senses a voltage
signal of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The ABM measures the amperage of the digital signal
for each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABM as the wheel speed.
Rear
OPERATION
The ABM sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the ABM. The relationship of the magnetic pole encoder to the
permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output
of the sensor, sent to the ABM, is a DC voltage signal with changing voltage and current levels.
The ground for the IC and the current sense circuit is provided by the ABM.
When a pole is properly aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8 volts and a
constant 7 mA current is sent to the ABM. As the magnetic pole encoder rotates, the encoder shifts
the magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The ABM senses a voltage
signal of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The ABM measures the amperage of the digital signal
for each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABM as the wheel speed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information See: Service
Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Open the hood. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable connector (2) from the wiring
harness connector (3) on top of the frame rail (1) to the inside of the strut
tower.
3. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
4. Remove the grommet (1) from the hole in the body (7) and pull the wheel speed sensor cable
out of the hole. 5. Remove the speed sensor cable routing clip (2) from the outside frame rail (6). 6.
Remove the screw fastening the cable routing clamp (3) to the outside frame rail (6).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5518
7. Remove the screw (2) securing the wheel speed sensor routing bracket (3) to the brake flex
hose bracket (4). 8. Remove the routing clip (1) securing wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle
(5).
9. Remove the mounting screw (1) fastening the wheel speed sensor head (2) to the knuckle (3).
Pull the sensor head out of the knuckle and remove
the sensor from the vehicle.
Rear
REMOVAL
1. Access and remove the rear brake rotor. See: Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5519
CAUTION: Prior to removal, clean area around sensor head to help prevent contaminants from
entering bearing when sensor head is
removed.
2. Remove the screw (3) fastening the speed sensor head (2) to the hub and bearing (1).
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor routing clip (4) from the brake tube routing bracket (1). 4.
Remove the wheel speed sensor cable from the routing clips (3) above the trailing arm.
5. Remove the wheel speed sensor head (2) from the hub and bearing (1), then pass it through the
brake shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5520
6. Remove the screw (1) fastening the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (2) to the rear
suspension crossmember (3).
7. Remove the screw (2) securing the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (1) to the trailing link.
8. Disconnect the vehicle wiring harness (3) from the wheel speed sensor connector (2) on the
body (1). 9. Disengage the wheel speed sensor connector from the routing clip fastened to the
body using a screwdriver. Pull the connector forward off the
routing clip. Or, if a NEW routing clip is available, remove the routing clip from the body with the
connector attached.
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5521
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Failure to install speed sensor cables properly may result in contact with moving parts
or an over extension of cables causing an
open circuit. Be sure that cables are installed, routed, and clipped properly.
1. Install the wheel speed sensor head (2) into the knuckle (3). Install the mounting screw (1) and
tighten it to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.).
2. Install the routing clip (1) securing the wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle (5). 3. Position
the wheel speed sensor routing bracket (3) on the brake flex hose bracket (4) and install the
mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting
screw to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5522
4. Position the wheel speed sensor cable routing clamp (4) on the outside frame rail (6) and install
the mounting screw (3). Tighten the mounting
screw to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the speed sensor cable routing clip (2) on the outside frame rail (6). 6. Insert the wheel
speed sensor cable through the hole in the body (7) and install the grommet (1) in the hole.
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Connect the wheel speed sensor cable connector (2) to the wiring harness
connector (3) on top of the frame rail (1). 9. Perform the Diagnostic Verification Test and clear any
faults. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
Rear
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5523
1. Slide the wheel speed sensor wiring connector (2) onto the routing clip mounted on the body
until it locks into place or if a NEW routing clip is
attached to the connector, push it into the mounting holes on the body.
2. Connect the vehicle wiring harness (3) to the wheel speed sensor connector (2).
3. Attach the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (2) to the rear suspension crossmember (3) using
the mounting screw (1). Tighten the mounting screw
to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
4. Attach the wheel speed sensor routing clamp (1) to the trailing link using the mounting screw (2).
Tighten the mounting screw to 20 Nm (15 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Removal > Page 5524
5. Apply bearing grease (supplied with part) to sensor head shaft and O-ring.
CAUTION: Ensure that sensor mounting surface on bearing is clean before sensor installation.
6. Pass the wheel speed sensor head through the hole in the brake shield, then push it into the
mounting hole in hub and bearing (3) and align the
mounting screw hole.
7. Install a NEW mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting screw to 6 Nm (55 in. lbs.).
8. Install the wheel speed sensor routing clip (4) in the brake tube routing bracket (1). 9. Install the
wheel speed sensor cable into the routing clips (3) above the trailing arm.
10. Install brake rotor as well as all components necessary to access it. See: Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
11. Perform the ABS Verification Test and clear any faults. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification Tests/ABS
Verification Test
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw
Rate Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw
Rate Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5528
Yaw Rate Sensor: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 4 WAY
SENSOR-DYNAMICS - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw
Rate Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5529
Yaw Rate Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensors are housed into one unit known as the Dynamics
Sensor (1). The sensor is used to measure side-to-side (Lateral) motion and vehicle rotational
sensing (how fast the vehicle is turning - Yaw).
The Dynamics Sensor (1) is located on the floor tunnel just forward of the center floor console (2),
below the instrument panel.
Yaw and Lateral Acceleration Sensors cannot be serviced separately. The entire Dynamics Sensor
must be replaced when necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw
Rate Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from the battery post.
2. Remove the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below instrument panel.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness connector (3) at the dynamics sensor (1). 4. Working on each
side of the floor tunnel, remove the nuts (2) mounting the dynamics sensor to the floor pan tunnel
(4). 5. Remove the dynamics sensor (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw
Rate Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Dynamics Sensor - Removal > Page 5532
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair Dynamics Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the dynamics sensor (1) over the studs mounted to the floor pan tunnel (4). 2. Working on
each side of the floor pan tunnel (4), install the two mounting nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 9 Nm (80
in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wiring harness connector (3) to the dynamics sensor (1).
4. Install the lower instrument panel trim on each side of console below the instrument panel.
5. Connect the battery negative cable to the battery post. It is important that this be performed
properly. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Service
and Repair/Procedures/Battery Reconnection
6. Perform the Verification Test and clear any faults. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ignition Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5538
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5541
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5542
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5543
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5544
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5545
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5546
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5547
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5548
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5549
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5550
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5551
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5552
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5553
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5554
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5555
Ignition Switch: Connector Views
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) (1). The WIN and the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch (5) located on the face of the instrument panel just to
the inboard side of the steering column.
The WIN housing is constructed of molded black plastic and it includes four integral mounting
bosses (4), which are secured to the instrument panel structure with screws. Two connector
receptacles are integral to the back of the switch housing. One (3) connects the WIN to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The other (2) is a dedicated connector for the coaxial cable input from the optional remote start
system external antenna module.
The WIN is an integrated electronic receiver that replaces the ignition switch. It communicates with
other electronic modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF)
communication. It also communicates with the TPM trigger transponders (if equipped) and steering
column lock module (if equipped) using a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus connection.
The WIN provides a switched 12-volt source through an isolated switch for the steering column lock
module required for certain export market vehicles. It also contains a key removal inhibit solenoid,
an electronic Brake Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI) solenoid, a key-in warning contact and it
serves as the real time vehicle clock by transmitting the clock information to other electronic
modules over the CAN data bus.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged, the
entire WIN must be replaced. When replacing the WIN, you must also replace the steering column
lock module (if equipped).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description > Page 5558
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Operation
OPERATION
Following are brief descriptions of the systems that the WIN controls.
IGNITION SWITCH
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) incorporates an integral ignition switch that consists of four rotary
positions with three detent positions and one spring-loaded position. The one extreme clockwise
position is a spring-loaded momentary contact "START" position. When released from the "START"
position, the switch will automatically return to the detent "ON" position. The other position includes
a detent "ACCESSORY" position and a detent "LOCK" position.
The WIN reads the position of the ignition switch and transmits the data via the CAN data bus.
These positions include "LOCK" with ignition key-out, "LOCK" with ignition key-in,
"ACCESSORY,""RUN," and "START."
SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM (SKIS)
Upon failure of proper Sentry Key Immobilizer (SKIS) communication to the Powertrain Control
Module, (PCM), the PCM will not allow the vehicle to crank. The engine will not re-crank on the key
cycle that the failure occurred, a full key down sequence must be performed for the engine to crank
again. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Description and
Operation/Vehicle Theft Security System - Operation.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE)
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), transmitter uses Radio Frequency (RF) signals to communicate
with the WIN, and the WIN relays the RKE requests to other modules in the vehicle over the CAN
data bus. See: Body and Frame/Locks/Power Locks/Description and Operation/Power Locks Operation
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING (TPM)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system uses radio and sensor technology to monitor tire air
pressure levels. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Tire Monitoring
System/Description and Operation/Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) - Operation.
REMOTE START WITH/EXTENDED RANGE ANTENNA
Further information concerning the Remote Start System. See: Starting System/Keyless Starting
System/Description and Operation/Starting System - Operation
BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFTER INTERLOCK (BTSI)
The Brake Transmission Shifter/Ignition Interlock (BTSI) is controlled by the WIN. The BTSI
prevents the transmission gear shifter from being moved out of PARK without a driver in place.
PARK SHIFT INTERLOCK
The key removal inhibit solenoid internal to the WIN prevents the FOB with Integrated KEY
(FOBIK) from being rotated in the ignition switch to the LOCK position for all vehicles with an
automatic transmission unless the transmission shift lever is in the PARK position. The WIN
module monitors a hard wired input from a switch integral to the automatic transmission shifter
module to control this feature. The key removal inhibit solenoid is electronically disabled internally
by the WIN on vehicles with a manual transmission.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description > Page 5559
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Ignition Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN). The WIN, along with the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch located on the face of the instrument panel just to the
inboard side of the steering column. The remainder of the WIN including its mounting provisions
and electrical connections are concealed within the instrument panel.
In addition to replacing a conventional keyed ignition switch, the WIN is an integrated electronic
receiver that serves as the base station in the vehicle. It communicates with other electronic
modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF) RF
communication.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged the
entire WIN must be replaced See: Service and Repair/Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ignition Switch: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
FOBIK TRAPPED IN WIN
The Fob with Integrated Key (FOBIK) cannot be rotated to the LOCK position, allowing it to be
removed from the ignition switch also referred to as the Wireless Ignition Node/WIN. The automatic
transmission or transaxle is shifted mechanically through a cable from the gearshift lever
mechanism to the transmission or transaxle valve body. A gated park switch is physically located
on and integral to the gearshift lever mechanism and is hard wired directly to the WIN. The gated
park switch is a simple plunger-like actuated open or closed contact switch that could be
considered redundant to the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) except that it monitors the position
selected with the gearshift lever, while the TRS monitors the position or gear of the transmission or
transaxle that is actually engaged. A damaged or improperly adjusted gearshift cable could result in
a different gear being engaged than that which is selected. The WIN uses the gated park switch
input to control an internal key lock solenoid, which controls whether the FOBIK can be rotated to
the LOCK position. When the gearshift lever is not in the PARK position, the gated park switch is a
closed circuit, the key lock solenoid is energized and the FOBIK cannot be rotated to the LOCK
position for removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the lower instrument panel knee
blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker - Removal. 3.
Remove upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument cluster bezel, reposition the instrument, and remove the upper WIN
bracket attaching screw (1). See: Instrument Panel,
Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster
- Removal.
5. Disconnect the WIN electrical connector (1) and the antenna connector (3) from the WIN. 6.
Utilize a trim stick or equivalent and gently pry WIN trim ring (2) away from the instrument panel. 7.
Remove the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 8. Remove the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 5564
9. Rotate the WIN (1) and (2) bracket to assist in removal from the instrument panel.
10. Remove the WIN from the instrument panel opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 5565
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The WIN initialization procedure is required whenever the WIN or shaft lock module is
replaced on vehicles equipped with the shaft
lock module.
1. Rotate and position the WIN (1) and bracket (2) into the to instrument panel opening.
2. Install the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4). 3. Install the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 4.
Connect the WIN electrical connector (1) and antenna connector (3) to the WIN. 5. Install the WIN
trim ring (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 5566
6. Install the upper WIN bracket attaching screw (1) and reposition the instrument cluster into the
instrument panel and install the instrument cluster
bezel. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service
and Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
8. Install knee blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker Installation. 9. Connect negative battery cable.
10. If necessary, program the WIN, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and
Relearning.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5570
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagrams
Connector (MTX) - (BODY) 3 WAY
SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK (MTX) - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5575
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-STARTER - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Jump Starting > System Information > Service and Repair
Jump Starting: Service and Repair
JUMP STARTING
WARNING: Do not jump start a frozen battery, personal injury can result. Do not jump start a
vehicle when the battery fluid is below the top
of lead plates. Do not allow jumper cable clamps to touch each other when connected to a booster
source. Do not use open flame near battery. Remove metallic jewelry worn on hands or wrists to
avoid injury by accidental arcing of battery current. When using a high output boosting device, do
not allow battery voltage to exceed 16 volts. Refer to instructions provided with device being used.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury or death.
CAUTION: When using another vehicle as a booster, do not allow vehicles to touch. Electrical
systems can be damaged on either vehicle.
NOTE: For information on accessing the battery for service or replacement See: Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery Removal
TO JUMP START A DISABLED VEHICLE:
WARNING:
- Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan whenever the hood is raised. It can start anytime the
ignition switch is ON. You can be hurt by the fan.
- Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it started. Vehicles equipped with an automatic
transaxle cannot be started this way. Unburned fuel could enter the catalytic converter and once
the engine has started, ignite and damage the converter and vehicle. If the vehicle has a
discharged battery, booster cables may be used to obtain a start from another vehicle. This type of
start can be dangerous if done improperly, so follow this procedure carefully.
- Do not use a booster battery or any other booster source with an output that exceeds 12 Volts.
WARNING:
- Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution; do not allow battery fluid to contact eyes, skin, or
clothing. Don't lean over battery when attaching clamps or allow the clamps to touch each other. If
acid splashes in eyes or on skin, flush contaminated area immediately with large quantities of
water.
- A battery generates hydrogen gas, which is flammable and explosive. Keep flame or spark away
from the vent holes.
NOTE: The battery is stored in a compartment that is located behind the left front fender and is
accessible through the wheel well. Remote
jump-start terminals are located in the engine compartment.
1. Wear eye protection and remove any metal jewelry such as watchbands or bracelets that might
make an inadvertent electrical contact. 2. When boosting from a battery in another vehicle, park
that vehicle within booster cable reach, but without allowing the vehicles to touch. Set
parking brake, place automatic transaxle in PARK, and turn ignition to LOCK for both vehicles.
WARNING: Do not permit vehicles to touch each other as this could establish a ground connection
and personal injury could result.
3. Turn off the heater, radio, and all unnecessary electrical loads.
4. Remove the protective cover (1) over the remote jump-start positive battery post (2) (+) in the
engine compartment. Connect one end of the jumper
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Jump Starting > System Information > Service and Repair >
Page 5580
cable to the positive battery post (2). Connect the other end of the same cable to the positive
terminal of the booster battery.
5. Connect the other cable, first to the negative terminal of the booster battery and then to the
engine ground (-) of the vehicle with the discharged
battery (5). Make sure you have a good contact on the engine ground.
6. If the vehicle is equipped with Sentry Key Immobilizer, turn the ignition switch to the ON position
for three seconds before moving the ignition
switch to the START position.
7. Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, and
then start the engine in the vehicle with the
discharged battery.
8. When removing the jumper cables, reverse the sequence exactly. Be careful of the moving belts
and fan. 9. Reinstall the protective cover over the remote jump-start positive battery post.
WARNING: During cold weather when temperatures are below freezing point, electrolyte in a
discharged battery may freeze. Do not attempt
jump-starting because the battery could rupture or explode. The battery temperature must be
brought up above freezing point before attempting jump-start.
WARNING: Any procedure other than above could result in:
- Personal injury caused by electrolyte squirting out the battery vent;
- Personal injury or property damage due to battery explosion;
Damage to charging system of booster vehicle or of immobilized vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Battery Cables - Description
Battery Cable: Description and Operation Battery Cables - Description
DESCRIPTION
The battery cables are large gauge, stranded copper wires sheathed within a heavy plastic or
synthetic rubber insulating jacket. The wire used in the battery cables combines excellent flexibility
and reliability with high electrical current carrying capacity. The battery cables feature a clamping
type female battery terminal made of stamped sheet metal that is die cast onto one end of the
battery cable wire. A pinch-bolt and nut are installed at the open end of the female battery terminal
clamp. Large eyelet type terminals are crimped onto the opposite end of the battery cable wire and
then soldered. The battery positive cable wires feature a larger female battery terminal clamp to
allow connection to the larger battery positive terminal post. The battery negative cable wires have
a smaller female battery terminal clamp.
There are two separate battery cable harnesses used on this vehicle. The battery harness includes
both the battery positive and negative cables to the remote battery connection and may include
portions of the wiring circuits for other components on some vehicles. The starter harness includes
both the battery positive and negative cables from the remote battery connection down to the
starter and engine ground location. These two harnesses are sold as separate assemblies.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Battery Cables - Description > Page 5585
Battery Cable: Description and Operation Battery Cables - Operation
OPERATION
The battery cables connect the battery terminal posts to the vehicle electrical system. These cables
also provide a path back to the battery for electrical current generated by the charging system for
restoring the voltage potential of the battery. The female battery terminal clamps on the ends of the
battery cable wires provide a strong and reliable connection of the battery cable to the battery
terminal posts. The terminal pinch bolts allow the female terminal clamps to be tightened around
the male terminal posts on the top of the battery. The eyelet terminals secured to the opposite ends
of the battery cable wires from the female battery terminal clamps provide secure and reliable
connection of the battery cables to the vehicle electrical system.
One wire has an eyelet terminal that connects the battery positive cable to the B(+) terminal stud of
the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM), and the other wire has an eyelet terminal that
connects the battery positive cable to the B(+) terminal stud of the engine starter motor solenoid.
The battery negative cable terminal clamp has one wire as an eyelet terminal that connects the
battery negative cable to the vehicle powertrain through a ground connection, typically on the
engine cylinder block.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5586
Battery Cable: Testing and Inspection
BATTERY CABLES
A voltage drop test will determine if there is excessive resistance in the battery cable terminal
connections or the battery cable. If excessive resistance is found in the battery cable connections,
the connection point should be disassembled, cleaned of all corrosion or foreign material, then
reassembled. Following reassembly, check the voltage drop for the battery cable connection and
the battery cable again to confirm repair.
When performing the voltage drop test, it is important to remember that the voltage drop is giving
an indication of the resistance between the two points at which the voltmeter probes are attached.
EXAMPLE: When testing the resistance of the battery positive cable, touch the voltmeter leads to
the battery positive cable terminal clamp and to the battery positive cable eyelet terminal at the
starter solenoid B(+) terminal stud. If you probe the battery positive terminal post and the battery
positive cable eyelet terminal at the starter solenoid B(+) terminal stud, you are reading the
combined voltage drop in the battery positive cable terminal clamp-to-terminal post connection and
the battery positive cable.
VOLTAGE DROP TEST
The following operation will require a voltmeter accurate to 1/10 (0.10) volt. Before performing this
test, be certain that the following procedures are accomplished:
- The battery is fully-charged and load tested. Refer to Standard Procedures for the proper battery
charging and load test procedures. See: Service and Repair/Procedures/Battery Charging
- Fully engage the parking brake.
- If the vehicle is equipped with an automatic transmission, place the gearshift selector lever in the
Park position. If the vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission, place the gearshift selector
lever in the Neutral position and block the clutch pedal in the fully depressed position.
- Verify that all lamps and accessories are turned off.
- To prevent the engine from starting, remove the Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay. The ASD
relay can be found in the Junction Block located in the left front engine compartment area. See the
layout label affixed to the underside of the Junction Block cover for ASD relay identification and
location.
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter (1) to the battery (2) negative terminal post. Connect
the negative lead of the voltmeter (1) to the battery
(2) negative cable terminal clamp. Rotate and hold the ignition switch in the Start position. Observe
the voltmeter. If voltage is detected, correct the poor connection between the battery negative
cable terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal post.
2. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter (1) to the battery (2) positive terminal post. Connect
the negative lead of the voltmeter (1) to the battery
(2) positive cable terminal clamp. Rotate and hold the ignition switch in the Start position. Observe
the voltmeter. If voltage is detected, correct the poor connection between the battery positive cable
terminal clamp and the battery positive terminal post.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5587
3. Connect the voltmeter (2) to measure between the battery positive cable terminal clamp (1) and
the starter solenoid B(+) terminal stud (3). Rotate
and hold the ignition switch in the Start position. Observe the voltmeter. If the reading is above 0.2
volt, clean and tighten the battery positive cable eyelet terminal connection at the starter solenoid
B(+) terminal stud. Repeat the test. If the reading is still above 0.2 volt, replace the faulty battery
positive cable.
4. Connect the voltmeter (1) to measure between the battery (2) negative cable terminal clamp and
a good clean ground on the engine block (3).
Rotate and hold the ignition switch in the Start position. Observe the voltmeter. If the reading is
above 0.2 volt, clean and tighten the battery negative cable eyelet terminal connection to the
engine block. Repeat the test. If the reading is still above 0.2 volt, replace the faulty battery
negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Battery Cables - Removal
Battery Cable: Service and Repair Battery Cables - Removal
REMOVAL
BATTERY HARNESS
WARNING:
To protect the hands from battery acid, a suitable pair of heavy duty rubber gloves should be worn
when removing or servicing a battery. Safety glasses also should be worn.
WARNING: Remove metallic jewelry to avoid injury by accidental arcing of battery current.
CAUTION: The negative battery cable remote terminal (2) must be disconnected and isolated from
the remote battery post (1) prior to service
of the vehicle electrical systems. The negative battery cable remote terminal can be isolated by
using the supplied isolation hole (3) in the terminal casing.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable (2) remote terminal from the remote battery
post (1).
2. Raise vehicle on hoist See: Maintenance. 3. Remove the battery and set aside See: Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal. 4. On diesel engine equipped vehicles,
disconnect the in-line connector to the instrument panel harness (2)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Battery Cables - Removal > Page 5590
NOTE: Diesel battery harness shown, gasoline battery harness similar.
5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Remove the negative battery cable remote terminal nut (8) from the remote
negative battery post. Remove the battery harness negative cable (7)
from the remote negative battery post.
7. Remove the cover (1) from the remote positive battery terminal (2). Remove the starter harness
positive cable retaining nut (4) and remove the
cable (3) from the remote positive battery post.
8. Remove the remote positive battery terminal (2) from mounting bracket on the left strut tower
(15) by lifting straight up. 9. On diesel engine equipped vehicles:
- Disconnect the glow plug module connector (14)
- Disconnect the cabin heater relay connectors (11 and 13)
- Disconnect the in-line connector to the instrument panel harness (12)
10. Remove the retaining nut (1) and remove the battery harness cable (2) from the TIPM stud.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Battery Cables - Removal > Page 5591
11. Depress the four mounting clips (2) to disengage and remove the TIPM housing (1) from its
mounting bracket, position aside to allow access to the
battery harness.
12. One at a time, trace any remaining battery harness retaining push pins, fasteners and routing
clips until the harness is free from the vehicle. 13. Remove the battery harness from the vehicle.
STARTER HARNESS
1. Remove the negative battery cable remote terminal nut (5) from the remote negative battery post
(1). Remove and isolate the battery harness
negative cable (4) on something other than the remote negative battery post (1).
2. Remove the starter harness negative cable retaining nut (3) and remove the cable (2) from the
remote negative battery post (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Battery Cables - Removal > Page 5592
3. Remove the cover (1) from the remote positive battery terminal. Remove the starter harness
positive cable retaining nut (4) and remove the cable
(3) from the remote positive battery post (2).
4. Raise vehicle on hoist, See: Maintenance. 5. Remove the starter harness negative cable
retaining bolt (4) and remove the cable (5) from the engine block. 6. Remove the starter harness
positive cable retaining nut (6) and remove the cable (2) from the starter positive battery post. 7.
One at a time, trace any remaining starter harness retaining pushpins, fasteners and routing clips
until the harness is free from the vehicle. 8. Remove the starter harness (3) from the engine
compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Battery Cables - Removal > Page 5593
Battery Cable: Service and Repair Battery Cables - Installation
INSTALLATION
BATTERY HARNESS
1. Position the battery harness into the vehicle. 2. One at a time, install the battery harness
retaining pushpins, fasteners and routing clips until the harness is installed exactly where it was in
the
vehicle.
3. Position the battery harness cable (2) onto the TIPM stud (3). Install the retaining nut (1) and
tighten to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.) 4. Install the TIPM on the bracket posts, push down until you hear a
click.
NOTE: Diesel battery harness shown, gasoline battery harness similar.
5. On diesel engine equipped vehicles:
- Connect the glow plug module connector (14)
- Connect the cabin heater relay connectors (11 and 13)
- Connect the in-line connector to the instrument panel harness (12)
6. Install the remote positive battery terminal (2) onto the mounting bracket on the left strut tower
(15) by pushing straight down until fully engaged. 7. Remove the cover (1) from the remote positive
battery terminal (2). Position the starter harness positive cable (3) onto the remote positive battery
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Battery Cables - Removal > Page 5594
post. Install the retaining nut (4) and tighten to 16.5 Nm (145 in. lbs.) Install the cover (1) onto the
remote positive battery terminal (2).
8. Raise vehicle on hoist, See: Maintenance. 9. Install the battery See: Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation.
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Install the negative battery cable remote terminal (2) onto the remote
battery post (1). Install the nut (3) and tighten to 16.5 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
STARTER HARNESS
WARNING:
To protect the hands from battery acid, a suitable pair of heavy duty rubber gloves should be worn
when removing or servicing a battery. Safety glasses also should be worn.
WARNING: Remove metallic jewelry to avoid injury by accidental arcing of battery current.
CAUTION: The negative battery cable remote terminal (2) must be disconnected and isolated from
the remote battery post (1) prior to service
of the vehicle electrical systems. The negative battery cable remote terminal can be isolated by
using the supplied isolation hole (3) in the terminal casing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Battery Cables - Removal > Page 5595
1. Remove and isolate the battery harness negative cable (4) on something other than the remote
negative battery post (1). 2. Position the starter harness into the vehicle. 3. One at a time, install
the starter harness retaining pushpins, fasteners and routing clips until the harness is installed
exactly where it was in the
vehicle.
4. Position the starter harness negative cable (2) onto the remote negative battery post (1). Install
the retaining nut (3) and tighten to 16.5 Nm (145 in.
lbs.)
Remove the cover (1) from the remote positive battery terminal (2). Position the starter harness
positive cable (3) onto the remote positive battery post. Install the retaining nut (4) and tighten to
16.5 Nm (145 in. lbs.) Install the cover (1) onto the remote positive battery terminal (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Battery Cables - Removal > Page 5596
5. Raise vehicle on hoist, See: Maintenance. 6. Position the starter harness positive cable (2) onto
the starter positive battery post. Install the retaining nut (6) and tighten to 13 Nm (115 in. lbs.) 7.
Position the starter harness negative cable (5) onto the engine block. Install the retaining bolt (4)
and tighten to 16.5 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Position the negative battery harness cable remote terminal (4) onto the
remote battery post (1). Install the nut (5) and tighten to 16.5 Nm (145 in.
lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Tray > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Battery Tray: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The battery is placed and secured in a stamped steel battery tray. The battery tray is located in the
left front side of the vehicle, just ahead of the left front wheel and tire assembly. The battery tray is
secured to the left front frame rail with four bolts.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Tray > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Battery Tray - Removal
Battery Tray: Service and Repair Battery Tray - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING:
To protect the hands from battery acid, a suitable pair of heavy duty rubber gloves should be worn
when removing or servicing a battery. Safety glasses also should be worn.
WARNING: Remove metallic jewelry to avoid injury by accidental arcing of battery current.
CAUTION: The negative battery cable remote terminal (2) must be disconnected and isolated from
the remote battery post (1) prior to service
of the vehicle electrical systems. The negative battery cable remote terminal can be isolated by
using the supplied isolation hole (3) in the terminal casing.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable remote terminal from the remote battery post.
2. Remove the battery See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Removal.
3. Remove the four bolts (2) securing the battery tray (3) to the left front frame rail (1). 4. Remove
the battery tray from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Tray > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Battery Tray - Removal > Page 5602
Battery Tray: Service and Repair Battery Tray - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING:
To protect the hands from battery acid, a suitable pair of heavy duty rubber gloves should be worn
when removing or servicing a battery. Safety glasses also should be worn.
WARNING: Remove metallic jewelry to avoid injury by accidental arcing of battery current.
CAUTION: The negative battery cable remote terminal (2) must be disconnected and isolated from
the remote battery post (1) prior to service
of the vehicle electrical systems. The negative battery cable remote terminal can be isolated by
using the supplied isolation hole (3) in the terminal casing.
1. Position the battery tray (3) onto the left front frame rail (1). 2. Install the bolts (2) securing the
battery tray (3) to the frame rail (1).Tighten the bolts to 16 Nm (142 in. lbs.)
3. Install the battery See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Battery - Installation. 4.
Install the negative battery cable remote terminal onto the remote battery post. Tighten the nut to
16.5 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Locations > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Ground Eyelet)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Locations > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Ground Eyelet) > Page 5607
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Locations > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Ground Eyelet) > Page 5608
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Locations > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Ground Eyelet) > Page 5609
Remote Battery Jumper Terminal: Locations Positive Remote Jump Post (3.5L Starter Eyelet)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Locations > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Ground Eyelet) > Page 5610
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Locations > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Ground Eyelet) > Page 5611
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Diagrams > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Early Build Ground Eyelet) (Engine) 1 Way
Remote Battery Jumper Terminal: Diagrams Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Early Build Ground
Eyelet) (Engine) 1 Way
Connector (3.5L EARLY BUILD GROUND EYELET) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
POST-REMOTE JUMP-NEGATIVE (3.5L EARLY BUILD GROUND EYELET) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Diagrams > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Early Build Ground Eyelet) (Engine) 1 Way > Page 5614
Remote Battery Jumper Terminal: Diagrams Negative Remote Jump Post (Battery Eyelet) (Battery)
1 Way
Connector (BATTERY EYELET) - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
POST-REMOTE JUMP-NEGATIVE (BATTERY EYELET) - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Diagrams > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Early Build Ground Eyelet) (Engine) 1 Way > Page 5615
Remote Battery Jumper Terminal: Diagrams Negative Remote Jump Post (Except 3.5L Early Build
Ground Eyelet) (Starter/Engine) 1 Way
Connector (EXCEPT 3.5L EARLY BUILD GROUND EYELET) - (STARTER/ENGINE) 1 WAY
POST-REMOTE JUMP-NEGATIVE (EXCEPT 3.5L EARLY BUILD GROUND EYELET) (STARTER/ENGINE) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Remote Battery Jumper Terminal > Component Information
> Diagrams > Negative Remote Jump Post (3.5L Early Build Ground Eyelet) (Engine) 1 Way > Page 5616
Remote Battery Jumper Terminal: Diagrams Positive Remote Jump Post (Gas Battery Eyelet)
(Battery) 1 Way
Connector (GAS BATTERY EYELET) - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
POST-REMOTE JUMP-POSITIVE (GAS BATTERY EYELET) - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications
Alternator: Specifications
GENERATOR
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Locations >
Generator (Gas)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Locations >
Generator (Gas) > Page 5623
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Generator (Gas Eyelet) (Engine) 1 Way
Alternator: Diagrams Generator (Gas Eyelet) (Engine) 1 Way
Connector (GAS EYELET) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
GENERATOR (GAS EYELET) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Generator (Gas Eyelet) (Engine) 1 Way > Page 5626
Alternator: Diagrams Generator (Gas) 2 Way
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
GENERATOR (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Generator - Description
Alternator: Description and Operation Generator - Description
DESCRIPTION
The generator is belt-driven by the engine. It is serviced only as a complete assembly. If the
generator fails for any reason, the entire assembly must be replaced. The generator produces DC
voltage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Generator - Description > Page 5629
Alternator: Description and Operation Generator - Operation
OPERATION
As the energized rotor begins to rotate within the generator, the spinning magnetic field induces a
current into the windings of the stator coil.
The Y type stator winding connections deliver the induced AC current to positive and negative
diodes for rectification. From the diodes, rectified DC current is delivered to the vehicles electrical
system through the generator, battery, and ground terminals.
Noise emitting from the generator may be caused by:
- Worn, loose or defective bearings
- Loose or defective drive pulley
- Incorrect, worn, damaged or misadjusted drive belt
- Loose mounting bolts
- Misaligned drive pulley
- Defective stator or diode
- Damaged internal fins
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Generator - Removal
Alternator: Service and Repair Generator - Removal
3.5L
CAUTION: Never force a belt over a pulley rim using a screwdriver. The synthetic fiber of the belt
can be damaged.
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove generator drive belt, See: Engine,
Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Drive Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Removal.
3. Unsnap plastic protective cover (4) from B+ mounting stud. 4. Remove B+ terminal mounting nut
(3) and B+ terminal (2) at top of generator. 5. Disconnect field wire electrical connector (1) by
pushing on connector tab.
6. Remove short mounting bolt (3) from generator (1). 7. Remove long mounting bolt (2) from
generator (1). 8. Remove generator (1) from engine mounting bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Generator - Removal > Page 5632
Alternator: Service and Repair Generator - Installation
3.5L
1. Install generator (1) to engine mounting bracket. 2. Install long mounting bolt (2) and short
mounting bolt (3) to generator (1). Tighten bolts to 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect field wire connector (1) into generator. 4. Install B+ terminal (2) and nut (3) to generator
mounting stud. Tighten nut to 10 Nm (88.5 in. lbs.) 5. Snap plastic protective cover (4) to B+
terminal. 6. Install drive belt Refer to Cooling System for belt routing, belt adjustment and bolt
tightening procedures. 7. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Ignition Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5637
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5640
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5641
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5642
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5643
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5644
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5645
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5646
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5647
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5648
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5649
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5650
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5651
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5652
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5653
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5654
Ignition Switch: Connector Views
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) (1). The WIN and the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch (5) located on the face of the instrument panel just to
the inboard side of the steering column.
The WIN housing is constructed of molded black plastic and it includes four integral mounting
bosses (4), which are secured to the instrument panel structure with screws. Two connector
receptacles are integral to the back of the switch housing. One (3) connects the WIN to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The other (2) is a dedicated connector for the coaxial cable input from the optional remote start
system external antenna module.
The WIN is an integrated electronic receiver that replaces the ignition switch. It communicates with
other electronic modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF)
communication. It also communicates with the TPM trigger transponders (if equipped) and steering
column lock module (if equipped) using a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus connection.
The WIN provides a switched 12-volt source through an isolated switch for the steering column lock
module required for certain export market vehicles. It also contains a key removal inhibit solenoid,
an electronic Brake Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI) solenoid, a key-in warning contact and it
serves as the real time vehicle clock by transmitting the clock information to other electronic
modules over the CAN data bus.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged, the
entire WIN must be replaced. When replacing the WIN, you must also replace the steering column
lock module (if equipped).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description > Page 5657
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Operation
OPERATION
Following are brief descriptions of the systems that the WIN controls.
IGNITION SWITCH
The Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) incorporates an integral ignition switch that consists of four rotary
positions with three detent positions and one spring-loaded position. The one extreme clockwise
position is a spring-loaded momentary contact "START" position. When released from the "START"
position, the switch will automatically return to the detent "ON" position. The other position includes
a detent "ACCESSORY" position and a detent "LOCK" position.
The WIN reads the position of the ignition switch and transmits the data via the CAN data bus.
These positions include "LOCK" with ignition key-out, "LOCK" with ignition key-in,
"ACCESSORY,""RUN," and "START."
SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM (SKIS)
Upon failure of proper Sentry Key Immobilizer (SKIS) communication to the Powertrain Control
Module, (PCM), the PCM will not allow the vehicle to crank. The engine will not re-crank on the key
cycle that the failure occurred, a full key down sequence must be performed for the engine to crank
again. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Description and
Operation/Vehicle Theft Security System - Operation.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE)
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), transmitter uses Radio Frequency (RF) signals to communicate
with the WIN, and the WIN relays the RKE requests to other modules in the vehicle over the CAN
data bus. See: Body and Frame/Locks/Power Locks/Description and Operation/Power Locks Operation
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING (TPM)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system uses radio and sensor technology to monitor tire air
pressure levels. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Tire Monitoring
System/Description and Operation/Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) - Operation.
REMOTE START WITH/EXTENDED RANGE ANTENNA
Further information concerning the Remote Start System. See: Keyless Starting
System/Description and Operation/Starting System - Operation
BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFTER INTERLOCK (BTSI)
The Brake Transmission Shifter/Ignition Interlock (BTSI) is controlled by the WIN. The BTSI
prevents the transmission gear shifter from being moved out of PARK without a driver in place.
PARK SHIFT INTERLOCK
The key removal inhibit solenoid internal to the WIN prevents the FOB with Integrated KEY
(FOBIK) from being rotated in the ignition switch to the LOCK position for all vehicles with an
automatic transmission unless the transmission shift lever is in the PARK position. The WIN
module monitors a hard wired input from a switch integral to the automatic transmission shifter
module to control this feature. The key removal inhibit solenoid is electronically disabled internally
by the WIN on vehicles with a manual transmission.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Description > Page 5658
Ignition Switch: Description and Operation Ignition Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Wireless Ignition Node (WIN). The WIN, along with the FOB with
Integrated Key (FOBIK) are the primary components of the keyless ignition system. The only visible
component of the WIN is the ignition switch located on the face of the instrument panel just to the
inboard side of the steering column. The remainder of the WIN including its mounting provisions
and electrical connections are concealed within the instrument panel.
In addition to replacing a conventional keyed ignition switch, the WIN is an integrated electronic
receiver that serves as the base station in the vehicle. It communicates with other electronic
modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The WIN interfaces with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) FOBIK and the Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) sensors (if equipped) using Radio Frequency (RF) communication, with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) transponder within the FOBIK using Low Frequency (LF) RF
communication.
The WIN cannot be adjusted or repaired, but is flash update capable. If ineffective or damaged the
entire WIN must be replaced See: Service and Repair/Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ignition Switch: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
FOBIK TRAPPED IN WIN
The Fob with Integrated Key (FOBIK) cannot be rotated to the LOCK position, allowing it to be
removed from the ignition switch also referred to as the Wireless Ignition Node/WIN. The automatic
transmission or transaxle is shifted mechanically through a cable from the gearshift lever
mechanism to the transmission or transaxle valve body. A gated park switch is physically located
on and integral to the gearshift lever mechanism and is hard wired directly to the WIN. The gated
park switch is a simple plunger-like actuated open or closed contact switch that could be
considered redundant to the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) except that it monitors the position
selected with the gearshift lever, while the TRS monitors the position or gear of the transmission or
transaxle that is actually engaged. A damaged or improperly adjusted gearshift cable could result in
a different gear being engaged than that which is selected. The WIN uses the gated park switch
input to control an internal key lock solenoid, which controls whether the FOBIK can be rotated to
the LOCK position. When the gearshift lever is not in the PARK position, the gated park switch is a
closed circuit, the key lock solenoid is energized and the FOBIK cannot be rotated to the LOCK
position for removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the lower instrument panel knee
blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker - Removal. 3.
Remove upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument cluster bezel, reposition the instrument, and remove the upper WIN
bracket attaching screw (1). See: Instrument Panel,
Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster
- Removal.
5. Disconnect the WIN electrical connector (1) and the antenna connector (3) from the WIN. 6.
Utilize a trim stick or equivalent and gently pry WIN trim ring (2) away from the instrument panel. 7.
Remove the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 8. Remove the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 5663
9. Rotate the WIN (1) and (2) bracket to assist in removal from the instrument panel.
10. Remove the WIN from the instrument panel opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 5664
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The WIN initialization procedure is required whenever the WIN or shaft lock module is
replaced on vehicles equipped with the shaft
lock module.
1. Rotate and position the WIN (1) and bracket (2) into the to instrument panel opening.
2. Install the lower WIN bracket attaching screw (4). 3. Install the lower WIN attaching screw (5). 4.
Connect the WIN electrical connector (1) and antenna connector (3) to the WIN. 5. Install the WIN
trim ring (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal > Page 5665
6. Install the upper WIN bracket attaching screw (1) and reposition the instrument cluster into the
instrument panel and install the instrument cluster
bezel. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service
and Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install upper steering column shroud. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
8. Install knee blocker. See: Restraint Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker Installation. 9. Connect negative battery cable.
10. If necessary, program the WIN, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and
Relearning.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Remote Start Antenna - Description
Keyless Start Antenna: Description and Operation Remote Start Antenna - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Remote Start Antenna Module Assembly consists of an electrical connection to the Wireless
Ignition Node (WIN) (1), a length of coaxial cable (2), two mounting clips (3 and 4) and a control
module/antenna (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Remote Start Antenna - Description > Page 5671
Keyless Start Antenna: Description and Operation Remote Start Antenna - Operation
OPERATION
The remote start antenna is an external hidden antenna located at the driver's side front of dash.
The antenna interfaces with the Wireless Integration Node (WIN) through a coaxial electrical cable
and electrical connector. The antenna helps to amplify the signal for the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) key fob.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Start Antenna - Removal
Keyless Start Antenna: Service and Repair Remote Start Antenna - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Wait two minutes for the system reserve capacitor to discharge before servicing any
airbag components. Failure to do this may
result in serious or fatal injury.
The remote start antenna is located driver's side front of dash.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove radio. Refer to See: Accessories
and Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and
Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Radio - Removal.
3. Remove instrument cluster. Refer to See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning
Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and
Repair/Instrument Cluster - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument panel top pad. Refer to See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Pad - Removal.
NOTE: During removal of the remote start antenna note the routing location of the coaxial cable.
5. Disconnect remote start antenna coaxial cable connector (1) from skreem module (3). 6.
Remove the mounting clip (2).
7. Remove the mounting clip at the steering column reinforcement bracket. 8. Remove screws (1)
and remove remote start antenna (2) from instrument panel assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Start Antenna - Removal > Page 5674
Keyless Start Antenna: Service and Repair Remote Start Antenna - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Make sure the remote start antenna is positioned the same way noted during the removal
procedure.
1. Install the remote start antenna (2) and screws (1) to instrument panel assembly. Tighten to 2.5
Nm (22 in. lbs.). 2. Route the remote start coaxial cable in the position noted during the removal
procedure. 3. Install the coaxial cable mounting clip at the steering column reinforcement bracket.
4. Install the mounting clip (2). 5. Connect remote start antenna coaxial cable connector (1) to
skreem module (3). 6. Install instrument cluster. Refer to See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and
Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and
Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install radio. Refer to See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact
Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Radio - Installation.
8. Install the instrument panel top pad. Refer to See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Pad - Installation.
9. Connect negative battery cable. Tighten to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5678
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagrams
Connector (MTX) - (BODY) 3 WAY
SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK (MTX) - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications
Starter Motor: Specifications
STARTER MOTOR
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5682
Starter Motor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5683
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5684
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Starter (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 1 Way
Starter Motor: Diagrams Starter (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 1 Way
Connector (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
STARTER (2.7L/3.5L) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Starter (2.7L/3.5L) (Engine) 1 Way > Page 5687
Starter Motor: Diagrams Starter (3.5L) (Engine) 1 Way
Connector (3.5L) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
STARTER (3.5L) - (ENGINE) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter - Removal
Starter Motor: Service and Repair Starter - Removal
3.5L
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove heat shield nuts (1), (3) and position
heat shield (2) aside.
3. Remove belly pan, if equipped. 4. Remove front mount through bolt (1) from transmission
bracket (2) and mount (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter - Removal > Page 5690
5. Remove rear bolts (1) from transmission crossmember.
6. Remove front bolts (1) from transmission crossmember. 7. Remove transmission crossmember.
8. Remove heat shield bolts (1) and remove heat shield (3). 9. Remove oxygen sensor (2) and
position aside.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter - Removal > Page 5691
10. Remove bolt (2) from transmission bracket (1).
11. Remove bolts (1), (3) and transmission bracket (2) from transmission housing.
12. Remove battery cable nut (1), ignition wire (2) and battery cable (3) from starter solenoid stud.
13. Disconnect electrical connector (4) from starter solenoid.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter - Removal > Page 5692
14. Remove starter mounting bolts (2) and ground wire (1) and remove the starter (4) from the
transmission housing (3).
15. Remove starter motor dust shield (2) from starter (1).
NOTE: If the flywheel is damaged refer to the transmission section for flywheel replacement.
16. Rotate and fully inspect flywheel gears (1) and wields (2) for damage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter - Removal > Page 5693
Starter Motor: Service and Repair Starter - Installation
3.5L
1. Install starter motor dust shield (2) to starter (1).
2. Position starter (4) into transmission housing (3), install ground wire (1) and starter mounting
bolts (2). Tighten bolts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
3. Install battery cable (3), ignition wire (2) and battery cable nut (1) to starter solenoid stud.
Tighten nut to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.). 4. Connect electrical connector (4) to starter solenoid.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter - Removal > Page 5694
5. Install transmission bracket (2) and bolts (1), (3) to transmission housing. Hand tighten bolts.
6. Install bolt (2) to transmission bracket (1). Hand tighten bolt.
CAUTION: The torque reaction bracket bolts need to be tightened using a mandatory torque
sequence. Failure to tighten bolts using the
mandatory torque sequence provided may result in damage to the fasteners, bracket, and threaded
bolts holes for the engine and transmission.
7. Tighten bolts in a mandatory torque sequence to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter - Removal > Page 5695
8. Install oxygen sensor (2) and tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs). 9. Install heat shield (3) and bolts (1).
Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs).
10. Install bolts (1) to transmission crossmember. Tighten bolts to 55 Nm (40.5 ft. lbs.).
11. Install bolts (1) to transmission crossmember. Tighten bolts to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter - Removal > Page 5696
12. Install front mount through bolt (1) to transmission bracket (2) and mount (3). Tighten bolt to 47
Nm (35 ft. lbs.). 13. If equipped, install belly pan.
NOTE: Make sure the lower heat shield is installed to the lower stud before the upper heat shield is
install. The upper heat shield stacks on
top of the lower heat shield, and both shields are held together by the lower nut.
14. Position heat shield (2) over the studs and install heat shield nuts (1), (3). Tighten nuts to 12
Nm (106 in. lbs). 15. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 5700
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-STARTER - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations > AC Power Outlet (Except Export)
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Locations AC Power Outlet (Except Export)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations > AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 5706
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations > AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 5707
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Locations Console Power Outlet
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations > AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 5708
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations > AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 5709
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Locations Instrument Panel Power Outlet
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations > AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 5710
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations > AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 5711
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations > AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 5712
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5715
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5716
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5717
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5718
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5719
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5720
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5721
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5722
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5723
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5724
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5725
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5726
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5727
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5728
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5729
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Connector Views
AC Power Outlet (Except Export) (Rear Console) 6 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (REAR CONSOLE) 6 WAY
POWER OUTLET-AC (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (REAR CONSOLE) 6 WAY
Console Power Outlet (Rear Console) 3 Way
Connector - (REAR CONSOLE) 3 WAY
POWER OUTLET-CONSOLE - (REAR CONSOLE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5730
Instrument Panel Power Outlet (Front Console) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT CONSOLE) 3 WAY
POWER OUTLET-INSTRUMENT PANEL - (FRONT CONSOLE) 3 WAY
Rear Power Outlet (Body) 3 Way
Connector - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5731
POWER OUTLET-REAR - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5732
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Electrical Diagrams
HORN/CIGAR LIGHTER/POWER OUTLET - Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5733
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-01
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-02 (EVIC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5734
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-03
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5735
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-04 (Except Export)
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams by Number See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 12 Volt Power Outlet - Removal
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair 12 Volt Power Outlet - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using Power Outlet Remover 9857 (4).
Insert the tool with tips against bosses (1). 3. Pull out the base (3) through mounting ring by gently
rocking power outlet remover. 4. Disconnect the base wires (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 12 Volt Power Outlet - Removal > Page 5738
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair 12 Volt Power Outlet - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect wire harness connectors. 2. Install power outlet to instrument panel. 3. Connect battery
negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > Circuit Breaker 1
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > Circuit Breaker 1 > Page 5743
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM)
Circuit Breaker: Diagrams Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM)
Connector - (IN TIPM)
CIRCUIT BREAKER 1 - (IN TIPM)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM) > Page 5746
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM) > Page 5747
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM) > Page 5748
Circuit Breaker: Diagrams Power Seat Circuit Breaker (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
CIRCUIT BREAKER-POWER SEAT - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module
Fuse: Locations Totally Integrated Power Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 5753
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 5754
The Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) is located in the engine compartment near the air
cleaner assembly. This center contains fuses and relays.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 5755
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 5756
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 5757
Fuse: Locations Fuse Locations/Types
FUSES/TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (TIPM)
TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (TIPM)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 5758
The Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) is located in the engine compartment near the air
cleaner assembly. This center contains fuses and relays.
CAUTION:
- When installing the power module cover, it is important to ensure the cover is properly positioned
and fully latched. Failure to do so may allow water to get into the TIPM, and possibly result in an
electrical system failure.
- When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to use only a fuse having the correct amperage
rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than indicated may result in a dangerous electrical
system overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem in the circuit that
must be corrected.
Relays
FUSE LOCATIONS AND TYPES
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 5759
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 5760
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Totally Integrated Power Module > Page 5761
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5762
Fuse: Application and ID
Connector - (IN TIPM)
CIRCUIT BREAKER 1 - (IN TIPM)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5763
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5764
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Description and Operation > IOD Fuse - Description
Fuse: Description and Operation IOD Fuse - Description
DESCRIPTION
All vehicles are equipped with an Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse that is disconnected within the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) when the vehicle is shipped from the factory. Dealer
personnel are to reconnect the IOD fuse in the TIPM as part of the preparation procedures
performed just prior to new vehicle delivery.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Description and Operation > IOD Fuse - Description > Page 5767
Fuse: Description and Operation IOD Fuse - Operation
OPERATION
The term ignition-off draw identifies a normal condition where power is being drained from the
battery with the ignition switch in the Off position. The IOD fuse feeds the memory and sleep mode
functions for some of the electronic modules in the vehicle as well as various other accessories that
require battery current when the ignition switch is in the OFF position, including the clock. The only
reason the IOD fuse is disconnected is to reduce the normal IOD of the vehicle electrical system
during new vehicle transportation and pre-delivery storage to reduce battery depletion, while still
allowing vehicle operation so that the vehicle can be loaded, unloaded and moved as needed by
both vehicle transportation company and dealer personnel.
Dealer personnel must reconnect the IOD fuse when the vehicle is being prepared for delivery in
order to restore full electrical system operation. Once the vehicle is prepared for delivery, the IOD
function of this fuse becomes transparent and the fuse that has been assigned the IOD designation
becomes only another Fused B(+) circuit fuse. The IOD fuse serves no useful purpose to the
dealer technician in the service or diagnosis of any vehicle system or condition, other than the
same purpose as that of any other standard circuit protection device.
The IOD fuse can be used by the vehicle owner as a convenient means of reducing battery
depletion when a vehicle is to be stored for periods not to exceed about thirty days. However, it
must be remembered that disconnecting the IOD fuse will not eliminate IOD, but only reduce this
normal condition. If a vehicle will be stored for more than about thirty days, the battery negative
cable should be disconnected to eliminate normal IOD; and, the battery should be tested and
recharged at regular intervals during the vehicle storage period to prevent the battery from
becoming discharged or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Service and Repair > IOD Fuse - Removal
Fuse: Service and Repair IOD Fuse - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: When removing or installing the Ignition Off Draw (IOD) fuse, it is important that the ignition
switch be in the OFF position. Failure
to place the ignition switch in the OFF position can cause the radio display to become scrambled
when the IOD fuse is installed. Removing and installing the IOD fuse again with the ignition switch
in the OFF position will usually correct the scrambled radio display condition.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Remove the cover from the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). 3. Pull on IOD fuse (J13) holder until it reaches the first detent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Service and Repair > IOD Fuse - Removal > Page 5770
Fuse: Service and Repair IOD Fuse - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Push on IOD fuse until completely seated. 2. Install the cover to the Totally Integrated Power
Module (TIPM).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5775
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5776
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5777
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5778
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5779
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5780
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5781
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5782
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5783
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5784
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5785
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5786
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5787
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5788
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5789
Fuse Block: Application and ID
Integrated Power Module 8W-13-01
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5790
Fuse Block: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
An electrical Junction Block (JB) is located next to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
The JB combines the functions previously provided by a separate relay center. It also serves to
simplify and centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to
many of the accessory systems in the vehicle. It eliminates the need for numerous splice
connections and serves in place of a bulkhead connector between many of the engine
compartment, instrument panel, and body wire harnesses. The junction block is replaced as part of
the engine harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fusible Link > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation
Technical Service Bulletin # J09 Date: 090325
Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation
March 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J09 Power Inverter Connector
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles NOT equipped with a 115 volt power inverter (sales
code JKV) built through February 6, 2009 (MDH 020614).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle
inventory. Federal law requires you to complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail
delivery. Dealers should also consider this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and
should perform this recall on vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using
the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector on about 16,800 of the above vehicles may
become contaminated, potentially causing the connector to melt and/or catch fire.
Repair
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector must be relocated and the 25 amp fuse for the
9-way white connector must be removed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
Parts Information
Special Tools
No special tools are required to perform this repair.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5802
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Move the driver's seat to the full forward position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5803
2. Working from the left rear door opening, locate the seat wiring harness where it comes through
the slit in the carpet under the driver's seat (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5804
3. Locate the taped back 9-way white connector under the carpet by accessing it through the
carpet slit (Figure 2).
4. Break the tape and pull the 9-way white connector through the carpet opening toward the seat
in-line connectors (Figure 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5805
5. Using a plastic tie strap, permanently tie back the white 9-way connector approximately 2 inches
(50 mm) from the back of the seat inline grey
connector.
CAUTION:
Assure that the 9-way white connector cannot lay on the carpet.
6. Move the seat back to its original position.
7. Open the hood.
8. Locate the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) in the engine compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5806
9. Open the cover on the TIPM and locate, remove and discard the 25 amp fuse shown in Figure 4.
10. Close the cover on the TIPM.
11. Close the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5807
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > NHTSA09V082000 > Mar
> 09 > Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
Multiple Junction Connector: Recalls Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler
LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: March 09, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V082000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Electrical System
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 16852
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 16,852 M/Y 2009 Dodge Journey equipped without optional 115
volt auxiliary power outlet. An unused electrical connector for the optional 115 volt auxiliary power
outlet option may become corroded and could short circuit.
CONSEQUENCE: If the fuse for this circuit does not blow, the connector could overheat and
potentially catch fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will re-route and stow the 115 volt auxiliary power outlet connector and pull the
25 amp fuse to remove power from this unused circuit free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin during March 2009. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. J09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: >
J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation
Technical Service Bulletin # J09 Date: 090325
Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation
March 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J09 Power Inverter Connector
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles NOT equipped with a 115 volt power inverter (sales
code JKV) built through February 6, 2009 (MDH 020614).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle
inventory. Federal law requires you to complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail
delivery. Dealers should also consider this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and
should perform this recall on vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using
the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector on about 16,800 of the above vehicles may
become contaminated, potentially causing the connector to melt and/or catch fire.
Repair
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector must be relocated and the 25 amp fuse for the
9-way white connector must be removed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
Parts Information
Special Tools
No special tools are required to perform this repair.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: >
J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5817
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Move the driver's seat to the full forward position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: >
J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5818
2. Working from the left rear door opening, locate the seat wiring harness where it comes through
the slit in the carpet under the driver's seat (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: >
J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5819
3. Locate the taped back 9-way white connector under the carpet by accessing it through the
carpet slit (Figure 2).
4. Break the tape and pull the 9-way white connector through the carpet opening toward the seat
in-line connectors (Figure 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: >
J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5820
5. Using a plastic tie strap, permanently tie back the white 9-way connector approximately 2 inches
(50 mm) from the back of the seat inline grey
connector.
CAUTION:
Assure that the 9-way white connector cannot lay on the carpet.
6. Move the seat back to its original position.
7. Open the hood.
8. Locate the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) in the engine compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: >
J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5821
9. Open the cover on the TIPM and locate, remove and discard the 25 amp fuse shown in Figure 4.
10. Close the cover on the TIPM.
11. Close the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: >
J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 5822
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: >
NHTSA09V082000 > Mar > 09 > Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
Multiple Junction Connector: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter
Connector
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler
LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: March 09, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V082000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Electrical System
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 16852
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 16,852 M/Y 2009 Dodge Journey equipped without optional 115
volt auxiliary power outlet. An unused electrical connector for the optional 115 volt auxiliary power
outlet option may become corroded and could short circuit.
CONSEQUENCE: If the fuse for this circuit does not blow, the connector could overheat and
potentially catch fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will re-route and stow the 115 volt auxiliary power outlet connector and pull the
25 amp fuse to remove power from this unused circuit free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin during March 2009. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. J09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 5831
Power Distribution Module: Locations Totally Integrated Power Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 5832
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 5833
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5836
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash)
50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5837
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5838
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5839
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26
Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5840
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16
Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5841
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams
Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5842
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5843
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5844
Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26 Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5845
Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16 Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5846
Module-Totally Integrated Power C1
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5847
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5848
Module-Totally Integrated Power C2
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5849
Module-Totally Integrated Power C3
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5850
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Module-Totally Integrated Power C4
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5851
Module-Totally Integrated Power C5
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5852
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5853
Module-Totally Integrated Power C6
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5854
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5855
Module-Totally Integrated Power C7
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5856
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5857
Totally Integrated Power Module C2 (Headlamp And Dash) 26 Way
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5858
Totally Integrated Power Module C8 (Battery) 1 Way
Connector C8 - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5859
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C5 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5860
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5861
Totally Integrated Power Module C6 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5862
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5863
Totally Integrated Power Module C7 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5864
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 5865
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) - Description
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Description
DESCRIPTION
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The molded plastic TIPM housing is located
on the right side of the engine compartment. The TIPM housing has a molded plastic cover. The
TIPM cover is easily removed for service access and has a convenient fuse layout label affixed to
the inside surface of the cover to ensure proper component identification.
The TIPM housing is secured to the TIPM mounting bracket by four clips integral to the TIPM
housing. All of the TIPM outputs are through the integral engine compartment wire harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) - Description > Page 5868
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Operation
OPERATION
All of the current to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) comes directly from the positive
battery cable to a stud located on the bottom of the TIPM. The cable is secured to the TIPM stud
with a nut. Internal connection of all the TIPM circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of
hard wiring and bus bars. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for complete circuit diagrams.
The fuses, relays and TIPM housing assembly are available for service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Power Distribution Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
INVERTER MODULE
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
110 VOLT POWER OUTLET DIAGNOSIS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics > Page 5871
Power Distribution Module: Programming and Relearning
PROGRAMMING
1. Install a battery charger. 2. Verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts.
NOTE: Do not allow the charger to time out during the reconfiguration process. Set the battery
charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous
charge.
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle. 5. Place the
Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN. 6. Select "ECU View". 7. Select
"TIPMCGW" or "FCMCGW". 8. Select "MISC". 9. Select "Restore Vehicle Configuration".
10. Follow prompts on StarSCAN to complete the reconfigure procedure. 11. Once complete, Wait
one minute and turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. 12. Remove the StarSCAN unit, cable
and charger from the vehicle. 13. Verify proper operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Position the front drivers seat to the full
rearward position. 3. Remove the power inverter (2) mounting retainers (1) located under the
carpet. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 5. Remove the power inverter module from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page 5874
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the inverter into the vehicle and install mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the electrical
connectors. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Position the front drivers seat back to the
original position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page 5875
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Release the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM) cover retaining clips and open the TIPM cover. 4. Remove the
TIPM positive cable retaining nut and remove the cable from the stud. 5. Depress the four
mounting clips to disengage and remove the TIPM housing from its mounting bracket. 6.
Disconnect each of the seven TIPM wire harness connectors. 7. Remove the TIPM from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page 5876
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The original Cabin Compartment Node (CCN) and Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
must be installed and functioning properly
prior to powering up the new Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM receives vehicle
configuration data from the CCN and Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) information from the
PCM. If configuration information becomes lost or corrupted, the data can be obtained from Dealer
CONNECT
1. Position the TIPM into the engine compartment. 2. Connect each of the seven TIPM wire
harness connectors. 3. Position the TIPM onto the mounting bracket and push down until the
mounting clips are fully seated. 4. Position the TIPM positive cable onto the mounting stud and
install the retaining nut. Tighten the nut to 9 - 11 Nm (80 - 100 in. lbs.). 5. Open the TIPM cover and
fully seat the airbag fuse holder (two fuses in one yellow carrier) and the Ignition Off Draw (IOD)
fuse. 6. Connect the battery negative cable. 7. Close the hood. 8. Insert the ignition key and turn it
to the RUN position and wait twelve seconds. The TIPM will collect the necessary vehicle
configuration and
VIN data from the CCN and PCM at this time. After twelve seconds turn the ignition key to the OFF
position and then back to the ON position and verify proper vehicle systems operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) >
Page 5882
Power Distribution Module: Locations Totally Integrated Power Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) >
Page 5883
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) >
Page 5884
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5887
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash)
50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5888
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5889
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5890
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26
Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5891
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16
Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5892
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams
Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5893
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5894
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5895
Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26 Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5896
Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16 Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5897
Module-Totally Integrated Power C1
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5898
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5899
Module-Totally Integrated Power C2
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5900
Module-Totally Integrated Power C3
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5901
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Module-Totally Integrated Power C4
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5902
Module-Totally Integrated Power C5
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5903
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5904
Module-Totally Integrated Power C6
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5905
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5906
Module-Totally Integrated Power C7
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5907
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5908
Totally Integrated Power Module C2 (Headlamp And Dash) 26 Way
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5909
Totally Integrated Power Module C8 (Battery) 1 Way
Connector C8 - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5910
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C5 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5911
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5912
Totally Integrated Power Module C6 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5913
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5914
Totally Integrated Power Module C7 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5915
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export)
(Body) 9 Way > Page 5916
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM) - Description
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Description
DESCRIPTION
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The molded plastic TIPM housing is located
on the right side of the engine compartment. The TIPM housing has a molded plastic cover. The
TIPM cover is easily removed for service access and has a convenient fuse layout label affixed to
the inside surface of the cover to ensure proper component identification.
The TIPM housing is secured to the TIPM mounting bracket by four clips integral to the TIPM
housing. All of the TIPM outputs are through the integral engine compartment wire harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM) - Description > Page 5919
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Operation
OPERATION
All of the current to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) comes directly from the positive
battery cable to a stud located on the bottom of the TIPM. The cable is secured to the TIPM stud
with a nut. Internal connection of all the TIPM circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of
hard wiring and bus bars. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for complete circuit diagrams.
The fuses, relays and TIPM housing assembly are available for service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests
and General Diagnostics
Power Distribution Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
INVERTER MODULE
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
110 VOLT POWER OUTLET DIAGNOSIS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests
and General Diagnostics > Page 5922
Power Distribution Module: Programming and Relearning
PROGRAMMING
1. Install a battery charger. 2. Verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts.
NOTE: Do not allow the charger to time out during the reconfiguration process. Set the battery
charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous
charge.
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle. 5. Place the
Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN. 6. Select "ECU View". 7. Select
"TIPMCGW" or "FCMCGW". 8. Select "MISC". 9. Select "Restore Vehicle Configuration".
10. Follow prompts on StarSCAN to complete the reconfigure procedure. 11. Once complete, Wait
one minute and turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. 12. Remove the StarSCAN unit, cable
and charger from the vehicle. 13. Verify proper operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module Removal
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Position the front drivers seat to the full
rearward position. 3. Remove the power inverter (2) mounting retainers (1) located under the
carpet. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 5. Remove the power inverter module from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module Removal > Page 5925
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the inverter into the vehicle and install mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the electrical
connectors. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Position the front drivers seat back to the
original position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module Removal > Page 5926
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Release the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM) cover retaining clips and open the TIPM cover. 4. Remove the
TIPM positive cable retaining nut and remove the cable from the stud. 5. Depress the four
mounting clips to disengage and remove the TIPM housing from its mounting bracket. 6.
Disconnect each of the seven TIPM wire harness connectors. 7. Remove the TIPM from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module Removal > Page 5927
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The original Cabin Compartment Node (CCN) and Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
must be installed and functioning properly
prior to powering up the new Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM receives vehicle
configuration data from the CCN and Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) information from the
PCM. If configuration information becomes lost or corrupted, the data can be obtained from Dealer
CONNECT
1. Position the TIPM into the engine compartment. 2. Connect each of the seven TIPM wire
harness connectors. 3. Position the TIPM onto the mounting bracket and push down until the
mounting clips are fully seated. 4. Position the TIPM positive cable onto the mounting stud and
install the retaining nut. Tighten the nut to 9 - 11 Nm (80 - 100 in. lbs.). 5. Open the TIPM cover and
fully seat the airbag fuse holder (two fuses in one yellow carrier) and the Ignition Off Draw (IOD)
fuse. 6. Connect the battery negative cable. 7. Close the hood. 8. Insert the ignition key and turn it
to the RUN position and wait twelve seconds. The TIPM will collect the necessary vehicle
configuration and
VIN data from the CCN and PCM at this time. After twelve seconds turn the ignition key to the OFF
position and then back to the ON position and verify proper vehicle systems operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Run Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Run Relay > Page 5932
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Run Relay > Page 5933
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Relay Box: Diagrams Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 5936
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Accessory Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/ACCESSORY - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 5937
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Start Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/START - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5938
Relay Box: Application and ID
Integrated Power Module 8W-13-01
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5939
Relay Box: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
An electrical Junction Block (JB) is located next to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
The JB combines the functions previously provided by a separate relay center. It also serves to
simplify and centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to
many of the accessory systems in the vehicle. It eliminates the need for numerous splice
connections and serves in place of a bulkhead connector between many of the engine
compartment, instrument panel, and body wire harnesses. The junction block is replaced as part of
the engine harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Run Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Run Relay > Page 5944
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Run Relay > Page 5945
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Relay Box: Diagrams Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 5948
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Accessory Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/ACCESSORY - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 5949
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Start Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/START - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 5950
Relay Box: Application and ID
Integrated Power Module 8W-13-01
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 5951
Relay Box: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
An electrical Junction Block (JB) is located next to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
The JB combines the functions previously provided by a separate relay center. It also serves to
simplify and centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to
many of the accessory systems in the vehicle. It eliminates the need for numerous splice
connections and serves in place of a bulkhead connector between many of the engine
compartment, instrument panel, and body wire harnesses. The junction block is replaced as part of
the engine harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # K07 Date: 110218
Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement
February 2011
Dealer Service Instructions for: Safety Recall K07 Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Safety Recall K07
Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from November 01, 2007 through November 07,
2008 (MDH 110122 through 110723).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer used vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The front door wiring harnesses on about 65,000 of the above vehicles may fatigue and break.
Broken wires could interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s) located inside the front doors.
This could resulting in the illumination of the airbag warning lamp and loss of side crash sensing
capability.
Repair
The right and left front door wiring harnesses must be replaced.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 5960
These special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 5961
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. Roll down both front door windows.
3. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at the left shock tower.
4. Remove the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel (Figure 1).
5. Remove the front door panel (Figure 1).
6. Remove the front door inner window seal (Figure 1).
7. Separate the oval wiring harness grommet from the lower "A" pillar (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 5962
8. Disconnect the body electrical connectors from the front door wiring harness (Figure 2).
9. Remove the two door grommet retaining screws (Figure 2).
10. Remove the door speaker from the door and disconnect the electrical connector (Figure 2).
11. Open the access door and disconnect the door latch electrical connector (Figure 3).
12. Disconnect the remaining electrical connectors and remove the front door wiring harness from
the vehicle (Figure 2).
CAUTION:
Note the wiring harness routing before removing the wiring harness from the door. The new wiring
harness must be routed in the same location as the original wiring harness.
13. Place the new front door wiring harness into position on the door.
14. Connect the front door wiring harness connectors to the body electrical connectors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 5963
15. Snap the oval wiring harness grommet into the oval hole on the "A" pillar (Figure 1).
16. Place the door grommet into position and install the two retaining screws (Figure 1).
17. Connect the remaining electrical connectors to their respective modules/connectors (Figure 2).
18. Connect the door latch electrical connector and close the access door (Figure 3).
19. Connect the door speaker electrical connector and install the door speaker (Figure 4).
20. Install the front door inner window seal.
21. Install the front door panel.
22. Install the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel.
23. Repeat steps 4 through 22 on the other front door.
24. Connect the negative battery cable.
25. Using Mopar Total Clean or equivalent, clean both front door panels
26. On vehicles equipped with Express Window Up/Down (sales code JSC), perform Steps 27
through 30.
27. Connect the wiTECH to the vehicle.
28. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
29. Clear/Denormalize the door modules using the following procedures:
a. Click on the "Miscellaneous Functions" tab.
b. Select "Denormalize Window/Reset ECU" and follow the directions to clear/denormalize the door
module memory.
30. Relearn/Normalize the door modules using the following procedure:
a. Place the vehicle on a battery charger or have the engine running.
b. Raise the front door glass to the full-up position by pulling up on the window switch to its second
detent and hold the switch until the front door
glass is fully closed. Continue to hold the window switch up for three seconds after the front door
glass is fully closed.
c. Lower the front door glass to the full-down position by pushing down (depress) the window
switch to its second detent and hold the switch until
the front door glass is fully open. Continue to hold the window switch down for three seconds after
the front door glass is fully open.
d. Check the operation of the express-up and express-down features. If the express-up feature
does not work, repeat the procedure starting with
Step 30b.
e. Check that the front door glass reverses when in the express-up mode by holding a pen in the
path of the glass.
f. Repeat steps 30b. through 30e. on the other front door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 5964
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > NHTSA10V658000 > Dec > 10 > Recall
10V658000: Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Wiring Harness: Recalls Recall 10V658000: Front Door Wiring Harnesses
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler Group LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: December 23, 2010
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 10V658000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A
COMPONENT: Electrical System: Wiring
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 65,180
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling certain model year 2009 Dodge Journey vehicles manufacturer
from November 1, 2007, through September 7, 2008. The wires within the front door wire
harnesses may fatigue and break, which can interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s),
resulting in an airbag warning lamp illumination and loss of side crash sensing capability.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a crash, the side airbag may not deploy, reducing the protection
intended for the occupant and increasing the risk of injuries.
REMEDY: Chrysler will notify owners and replace the left and right door wiring harnesses free of
charge. The safety recall is expected to begin during February 2011. Owners may contact Chrysler
at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler safety recall No. K07. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing
Technical Service Bulletin # H21 Date: 080701
Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing
July 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H21 Engine Wiring Harness Routing
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 08-040 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that have already
had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been excluded from this
recall.
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine ("V" in the 8th VIN
Position) built from February 5, 2008 through March 14, 2008 (MDH 020506 through 031423).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The engine wiring harness on about 5,900 of the above vehicles may chafe on the left transaxle
mount. This could cause a short circuit and result in an engine compartment fire.
Repair
The engine wiring harness must be inspected for damage, repaired if necessary and rerouted away
from the left transaxle mount.
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required plastic tie straps are already in your parts inventory, no
plastic tie straps will be distributed initially. The following plastic tie strap is available as required.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 5973
All dealers will receive one copy of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery connection on the left shock tower.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 5974
2. Inspect the engine wiring harness and, if equipped, the 120 volt engine block heater cord at the
left transaxle mount for chafed wires (Figure 1):
> If wire chafing is not found, continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If wire chafing is found, continue with Step 3 of this procedure.
3. Remove the wiring harness protective tape from around the damaged area.
4. Repair wire(s) as required.
5. Install electrical tape around repaired area of wiring harness.
6. Disconnect the 14-way connector using the following procedure:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 5975
a. Slide the red lock tab located on the top of the connector rearward (Figure 2).
b. Push down on the black connector release tab.
c. While pushing down on the black connector release tab pull the connector apart.
7. Wrap the harness side of the 14-way connector under and around the main wiring harness and
reconnect the 14-way connector (Figure 3). Route the 120 volt engine block heater cord in the
same manner, away from the left transaxle mount.
CAUTION:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 5976
Ensure that all wiring is routed away from all sharp edges.
8. Slide the red locking tab forward to lock the 14-way connector.
9. Connect the negative battery connection on the left shock tower.
10. Reposition the main wiring harness and, if equipped, the engine block heater cord. Secure
them using a tie strap as shown in Figure 4.
11. Verify that the main wiring harness and, if equipped, the engine block heater cord do not touch
the left transaxle mount or any other sharp edges.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 5977
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # K07 Date: 110218
Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement
February 2011
Dealer Service Instructions for: Safety Recall K07 Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Safety Recall K07
Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from November 01, 2007 through November 07,
2008 (MDH 110122 through 110723).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer used vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The front door wiring harnesses on about 65,000 of the above vehicles may fatigue and break.
Broken wires could interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s) located inside the front doors.
This could resulting in the illumination of the airbag warning lamp and loss of side crash sensing
capability.
Repair
The right and left front door wiring harnesses must be replaced.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement > Page 5983
These special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement > Page 5984
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. Roll down both front door windows.
3. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at the left shock tower.
4. Remove the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel (Figure 1).
5. Remove the front door panel (Figure 1).
6. Remove the front door inner window seal (Figure 1).
7. Separate the oval wiring harness grommet from the lower "A" pillar (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement > Page 5985
8. Disconnect the body electrical connectors from the front door wiring harness (Figure 2).
9. Remove the two door grommet retaining screws (Figure 2).
10. Remove the door speaker from the door and disconnect the electrical connector (Figure 2).
11. Open the access door and disconnect the door latch electrical connector (Figure 3).
12. Disconnect the remaining electrical connectors and remove the front door wiring harness from
the vehicle (Figure 2).
CAUTION:
Note the wiring harness routing before removing the wiring harness from the door. The new wiring
harness must be routed in the same location as the original wiring harness.
13. Place the new front door wiring harness into position on the door.
14. Connect the front door wiring harness connectors to the body electrical connectors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement > Page 5986
15. Snap the oval wiring harness grommet into the oval hole on the "A" pillar (Figure 1).
16. Place the door grommet into position and install the two retaining screws (Figure 1).
17. Connect the remaining electrical connectors to their respective modules/connectors (Figure 2).
18. Connect the door latch electrical connector and close the access door (Figure 3).
19. Connect the door speaker electrical connector and install the door speaker (Figure 4).
20. Install the front door inner window seal.
21. Install the front door panel.
22. Install the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel.
23. Repeat steps 4 through 22 on the other front door.
24. Connect the negative battery cable.
25. Using Mopar Total Clean or equivalent, clean both front door panels
26. On vehicles equipped with Express Window Up/Down (sales code JSC), perform Steps 27
through 30.
27. Connect the wiTECH to the vehicle.
28. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
29. Clear/Denormalize the door modules using the following procedures:
a. Click on the "Miscellaneous Functions" tab.
b. Select "Denormalize Window/Reset ECU" and follow the directions to clear/denormalize the door
module memory.
30. Relearn/Normalize the door modules using the following procedure:
a. Place the vehicle on a battery charger or have the engine running.
b. Raise the front door glass to the full-up position by pulling up on the window switch to its second
detent and hold the switch until the front door
glass is fully closed. Continue to hold the window switch up for three seconds after the front door
glass is fully closed.
c. Lower the front door glass to the full-down position by pushing down (depress) the window
switch to its second detent and hold the switch until
the front door glass is fully open. Continue to hold the window switch down for three seconds after
the front door glass is fully open.
d. Check the operation of the express-up and express-down features. If the express-up feature
does not work, repeat the procedure starting with
Step 30b.
e. Check that the front door glass reverses when in the express-up mode by holding a pen in the
path of the glass.
f. Repeat steps 30b. through 30e. on the other front door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement > Page 5987
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > NHTSA10V658000 > Dec >
10 > Recall 10V658000: Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 10V658000: Front Door Wiring Harnesses
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler Group LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: December 23, 2010
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 10V658000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A
COMPONENT: Electrical System: Wiring
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 65,180
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling certain model year 2009 Dodge Journey vehicles manufacturer
from November 1, 2007, through September 7, 2008. The wires within the front door wire
harnesses may fatigue and break, which can interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s),
resulting in an airbag warning lamp illumination and loss of side crash sensing capability.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a crash, the side airbag may not deploy, reducing the protection
intended for the occupant and increasing the risk of injuries.
REMEDY: Chrysler will notify owners and replace the left and right door wiring harnesses free of
charge. The safety recall is expected to begin during February 2011. Owners may contact Chrysler
at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler safety recall No. K07. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall Engine Wire Harness Routing
Technical Service Bulletin # H21 Date: 080701
Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing
July 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H21 Engine Wiring Harness Routing
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 08-040 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that have already
had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been excluded from this
recall.
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine ("V" in the 8th VIN
Position) built from February 5, 2008 through March 14, 2008 (MDH 020506 through 031423).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The engine wiring harness on about 5,900 of the above vehicles may chafe on the left transaxle
mount. This could cause a short circuit and result in an engine compartment fire.
Repair
The engine wiring harness must be inspected for damage, repaired if necessary and rerouted away
from the left transaxle mount.
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required plastic tie straps are already in your parts inventory, no
plastic tie straps will be distributed initially. The following plastic tie strap is available as required.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 5996
All dealers will receive one copy of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery connection on the left shock tower.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 5997
2. Inspect the engine wiring harness and, if equipped, the 120 volt engine block heater cord at the
left transaxle mount for chafed wires (Figure 1):
> If wire chafing is not found, continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If wire chafing is found, continue with Step 3 of this procedure.
3. Remove the wiring harness protective tape from around the damaged area.
4. Repair wire(s) as required.
5. Install electrical tape around repaired area of wiring harness.
6. Disconnect the 14-way connector using the following procedure:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 5998
a. Slide the red lock tab located on the top of the connector rearward (Figure 2).
b. Push down on the black connector release tab.
c. While pushing down on the black connector release tab pull the connector apart.
7. Wrap the harness side of the 14-way connector under and around the main wiring harness and
reconnect the 14-way connector (Figure 3). Route the 120 volt engine block heater cord in the
same manner, away from the left transaxle mount.
CAUTION:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 5999
Ensure that all wiring is routed away from all sharp edges.
8. Slide the red locking tab forward to lock the 14-way connector.
9. Connect the negative battery connection on the left shock tower.
10. Reposition the main wiring harness and, if equipped, the engine block heater cord. Secure
them using a tie strap as shown in Figure 4.
11. Verify that the main wiring harness and, if equipped, the engine block heater cord do not touch
the left transaxle mount or any other sharp edges.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 6000
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6001
Wiring Harness: Service and Repair
GROMMET - A PILLAR
1. Peel the A Pillar grommet (1) off of the connector/retainer and move it up the wire harness. 2.
Grasp the wire harness (2) by the convolute section of the grommet and gently pull the wire
harness down towards the floor to expose the
connector lock tabs.
CAUTION: Do not force the locking tab past the connector body, as damage to the connector may
occur.
3. While still pulling down on the harness, use a small slotted screw driver (3) to gently push one of
the top lock tabs until the lock feature is flush
with the connector/retainer body.
4. Repeat the step 3 for the remaining top lock tab. 5. The connector should now be able to rock
out of the sheet metal hole without causing any damage to the connector or sheet metal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
> AC Power Outlet (Except Export)
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Locations AC Power Outlet (Except Export)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
> AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 6007
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
> AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 6008
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Locations Console Power Outlet
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
> AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 6009
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
> AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 6010
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Locations Instrument Panel Power Outlet
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
> AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 6011
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
> AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 6012
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
> AC Power Outlet (Except Export) > Page 6013
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6016
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6017
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6018
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6019
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6020
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6021
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6022
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6023
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6024
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6025
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6026
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6027
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6028
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6029
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6030
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Connector Views
AC Power Outlet (Except Export) (Rear Console) 6 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (REAR CONSOLE) 6 WAY
POWER OUTLET-AC (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (REAR CONSOLE) 6 WAY
Console Power Outlet (Rear Console) 3 Way
Connector - (REAR CONSOLE) 3 WAY
POWER OUTLET-CONSOLE - (REAR CONSOLE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6031
Instrument Panel Power Outlet (Front Console) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT CONSOLE) 3 WAY
POWER OUTLET-INSTRUMENT PANEL - (FRONT CONSOLE) 3 WAY
Rear Power Outlet (Body) 3 Way
Connector - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6032
POWER OUTLET-REAR - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6033
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Electrical Diagrams
HORN/CIGAR LIGHTER/POWER OUTLET - Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6034
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-01
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-02 (EVIC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6035
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-03
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6036
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-04 (Except Export)
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams by Number See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > 12 Volt Power Outlet - Removal
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair 12 Volt Power Outlet - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using Power Outlet Remover 9857 (4).
Insert the tool with tips against bosses (1). 3. Pull out the base (3) through mounting ring by gently
rocking power outlet remover. 4. Disconnect the base wires (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > 12 Volt Power Outlet - Removal > Page 6039
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair 12 Volt Power Outlet - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect wire harness connectors. 2. Install power outlet to instrument panel. 3. Connect battery
negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations >
Circuit Breaker 1
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations >
Circuit Breaker 1 > Page 6044
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM)
Circuit Breaker: Diagrams Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM)
Connector - (IN TIPM)
CIRCUIT BREAKER 1 - (IN TIPM)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM) > Page 6047
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM) > Page 6048
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Circuit Breaker 1 (In TIPM) > Page 6049
Circuit Breaker: Diagrams Power Seat Circuit Breaker (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
CIRCUIT BREAKER-POWER SEAT - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module
Fuse: Locations Totally Integrated Power Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module > Page 6054
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module > Page 6055
The Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) is located in the engine compartment near the air
cleaner assembly. This center contains fuses and relays.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module > Page 6056
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module > Page 6057
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module > Page 6058
Fuse: Locations Fuse Locations/Types
FUSES/TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (TIPM)
TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (TIPM)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module > Page 6059
The Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) is located in the engine compartment near the air
cleaner assembly. This center contains fuses and relays.
CAUTION:
- When installing the power module cover, it is important to ensure the cover is properly positioned
and fully latched. Failure to do so may allow water to get into the TIPM, and possibly result in an
electrical system failure.
- When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to use only a fuse having the correct amperage
rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than indicated may result in a dangerous electrical
system overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem in the circuit that
must be corrected.
Relays
FUSE LOCATIONS AND TYPES
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module > Page 6060
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module > Page 6061
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Totally
Integrated Power Module > Page 6062
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Page 6063
Fuse: Application and ID
Connector - (IN TIPM)
CIRCUIT BREAKER 1 - (IN TIPM)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Page 6064
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Page 6065
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Description and Operation
> IOD Fuse - Description
Fuse: Description and Operation IOD Fuse - Description
DESCRIPTION
All vehicles are equipped with an Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse that is disconnected within the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) when the vehicle is shipped from the factory. Dealer
personnel are to reconnect the IOD fuse in the TIPM as part of the preparation procedures
performed just prior to new vehicle delivery.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Description and Operation
> IOD Fuse - Description > Page 6068
Fuse: Description and Operation IOD Fuse - Operation
OPERATION
The term ignition-off draw identifies a normal condition where power is being drained from the
battery with the ignition switch in the Off position. The IOD fuse feeds the memory and sleep mode
functions for some of the electronic modules in the vehicle as well as various other accessories that
require battery current when the ignition switch is in the OFF position, including the clock. The only
reason the IOD fuse is disconnected is to reduce the normal IOD of the vehicle electrical system
during new vehicle transportation and pre-delivery storage to reduce battery depletion, while still
allowing vehicle operation so that the vehicle can be loaded, unloaded and moved as needed by
both vehicle transportation company and dealer personnel.
Dealer personnel must reconnect the IOD fuse when the vehicle is being prepared for delivery in
order to restore full electrical system operation. Once the vehicle is prepared for delivery, the IOD
function of this fuse becomes transparent and the fuse that has been assigned the IOD designation
becomes only another Fused B(+) circuit fuse. The IOD fuse serves no useful purpose to the
dealer technician in the service or diagnosis of any vehicle system or condition, other than the
same purpose as that of any other standard circuit protection device.
The IOD fuse can be used by the vehicle owner as a convenient means of reducing battery
depletion when a vehicle is to be stored for periods not to exceed about thirty days. However, it
must be remembered that disconnecting the IOD fuse will not eliminate IOD, but only reduce this
normal condition. If a vehicle will be stored for more than about thirty days, the battery negative
cable should be disconnected to eliminate normal IOD; and, the battery should be tested and
recharged at regular intervals during the vehicle storage period to prevent the battery from
becoming discharged or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Service and Repair > IOD
Fuse - Removal
Fuse: Service and Repair IOD Fuse - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: When removing or installing the Ignition Off Draw (IOD) fuse, it is important that the ignition
switch be in the OFF position. Failure
to place the ignition switch in the OFF position can cause the radio display to become scrambled
when the IOD fuse is installed. Removing and installing the IOD fuse again with the ignition switch
in the OFF position will usually correct the scrambled radio display condition.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Remove the cover from the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). 3. Pull on IOD fuse (J13) holder until it reaches the first detent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Service and Repair > IOD
Fuse - Removal > Page 6071
Fuse: Service and Repair IOD Fuse - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Push on IOD fuse until completely seated. 2. Install the cover to the Totally Integrated Power
Module (TIPM).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6076
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6077
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6078
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6079
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6080
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6081
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6082
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6083
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6084
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6085
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6086
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6087
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6088
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6089
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
6090
Fuse Block: Application and ID
Integrated Power Module 8W-13-01
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
6091
Fuse Block: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
An electrical Junction Block (JB) is located next to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
The JB combines the functions previously provided by a separate relay center. It also serves to
simplify and centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to
many of the accessory systems in the vehicle. It eliminates the need for numerous splice
connections and serves in place of a bulkhead connector between many of the engine
compartment, instrument panel, and body wire harnesses. The junction block is replaced as part of
the engine harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fusible Link > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector
Relocation
Technical Service Bulletin # J09 Date: 090325
Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation
March 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J09 Power Inverter Connector
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles NOT equipped with a 115 volt power inverter (sales
code JKV) built through February 6, 2009 (MDH 020614).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle
inventory. Federal law requires you to complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail
delivery. Dealers should also consider this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and
should perform this recall on vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using
the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector on about 16,800 of the above vehicles may
become contaminated, potentially causing the connector to melt and/or catch fire.
Repair
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector must be relocated and the 25 amp fuse for the
9-way white connector must be removed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
Parts Information
Special Tools
No special tools are required to perform this repair.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector
Relocation > Page 6103
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Move the driver's seat to the full forward position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector
Relocation > Page 6104
2. Working from the left rear door opening, locate the seat wiring harness where it comes through
the slit in the carpet under the driver's seat (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector
Relocation > Page 6105
3. Locate the taped back 9-way white connector under the carpet by accessing it through the
carpet slit (Figure 2).
4. Break the tape and pull the 9-way white connector through the carpet opening toward the seat
in-line connectors (Figure 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector
Relocation > Page 6106
5. Using a plastic tie strap, permanently tie back the white 9-way connector approximately 2 inches
(50 mm) from the back of the seat inline grey
connector.
CAUTION:
Assure that the 9-way white connector cannot lay on the carpet.
6. Move the seat back to its original position.
7. Open the hood.
8. Locate the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) in the engine compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector
Relocation > Page 6107
9. Open the cover on the TIPM and locate, remove and discard the 25 amp fuse shown in Figure 4.
10. Close the cover on the TIPM.
11. Close the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector
Relocation > Page 6108
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Multiple Junction Connector: > NHTSA09V082000 > Mar > 09 > Recall
09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
Multiple Junction Connector: Recalls Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler
LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: March 09, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V082000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Electrical System
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 16852
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 16,852 M/Y 2009 Dodge Journey equipped without optional 115
volt auxiliary power outlet. An unused electrical connector for the optional 115 volt auxiliary power
outlet option may become corroded and could short circuit.
CONSEQUENCE: If the fuse for this circuit does not blow, the connector could overheat and
potentially catch fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will re-route and stow the 115 volt auxiliary power outlet connector and pull the
25 amp fuse to remove power from this unused circuit free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin during March 2009. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. J09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation
Technical Service Bulletin # J09 Date: 090325
Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation
March 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J09 Power Inverter Connector
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles NOT equipped with a 115 volt power inverter (sales
code JKV) built through February 6, 2009 (MDH 020614).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle
inventory. Federal law requires you to complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail
delivery. Dealers should also consider this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and
should perform this recall on vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using
the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector on about 16,800 of the above vehicles may
become contaminated, potentially causing the connector to melt and/or catch fire.
Repair
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector must be relocated and the 25 amp fuse for the
9-way white connector must be removed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
Parts Information
Special Tools
No special tools are required to perform this repair.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 6118
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Move the driver's seat to the full forward position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 6119
2. Working from the left rear door opening, locate the seat wiring harness where it comes through
the slit in the carpet under the driver's seat (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 6120
3. Locate the taped back 9-way white connector under the carpet by accessing it through the
carpet slit (Figure 2).
4. Break the tape and pull the 9-way white connector through the carpet opening toward the seat
in-line connectors (Figure 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 6121
5. Using a plastic tie strap, permanently tie back the white 9-way connector approximately 2 inches
(50 mm) from the back of the seat inline grey
connector.
CAUTION:
Assure that the 9-way white connector cannot lay on the carpet.
6. Move the seat back to its original position.
7. Open the hood.
8. Locate the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) in the engine compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 6122
9. Open the cover on the TIPM and locate, remove and discard the 25 amp fuse shown in Figure 4.
10. Close the cover on the TIPM.
11. Close the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 6123
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Multiple Junction Connector: > NHTSA09V082000 > Mar >
09 > Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
Multiple Junction Connector: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter
Connector
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler
LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: March 09, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V082000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Electrical System
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 16852
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 16,852 M/Y 2009 Dodge Journey equipped without optional 115
volt auxiliary power outlet. An unused electrical connector for the optional 115 volt auxiliary power
outlet option may become corroded and could short circuit.
CONSEQUENCE: If the fuse for this circuit does not blow, the connector could overheat and
potentially catch fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will re-route and stow the 115 volt auxiliary power outlet connector and pull the
25 amp fuse to remove power from this unused circuit free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin during March 2009. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. J09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 6132
Power Distribution Module: Locations Totally Integrated Power Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 6133
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 6134
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6137
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash)
50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6138
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6139
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6140
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26
Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6141
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16
Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6142
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams
Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6143
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6144
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6145
Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26 Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6146
Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16 Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6147
Module-Totally Integrated Power C1
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6148
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6149
Module-Totally Integrated Power C2
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6150
Module-Totally Integrated Power C3
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6151
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Module-Totally Integrated Power C4
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6152
Module-Totally Integrated Power C5
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6153
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6154
Module-Totally Integrated Power C6
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6155
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6156
Module-Totally Integrated Power C7
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6157
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6158
Totally Integrated Power Module C2 (Headlamp And Dash) 26 Way
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6159
Totally Integrated Power Module C8 (Battery) 1 Way
Connector C8 - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6160
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C5 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6161
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6162
Totally Integrated Power Module C6 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6163
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6164
Totally Integrated Power Module C7 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6165
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page 6166
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) - Description
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Description
DESCRIPTION
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The molded plastic TIPM housing is located
on the right side of the engine compartment. The TIPM housing has a molded plastic cover. The
TIPM cover is easily removed for service access and has a convenient fuse layout label affixed to
the inside surface of the cover to ensure proper component identification.
The TIPM housing is secured to the TIPM mounting bracket by four clips integral to the TIPM
housing. All of the TIPM outputs are through the integral engine compartment wire harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) - Description > Page 6169
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Operation
OPERATION
All of the current to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) comes directly from the positive
battery cable to a stud located on the bottom of the TIPM. The cable is secured to the TIPM stud
with a nut. Internal connection of all the TIPM circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of
hard wiring and bus bars. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for complete circuit diagrams.
The fuses, relays and TIPM housing assembly are available for service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Power Distribution Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
INVERTER MODULE
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
110 VOLT POWER OUTLET DIAGNOSIS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics > Page 6172
Power Distribution Module: Programming and Relearning
PROGRAMMING
1. Install a battery charger. 2. Verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts.
NOTE: Do not allow the charger to time out during the reconfiguration process. Set the battery
charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous
charge.
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle. 5. Place the
Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN. 6. Select "ECU View". 7. Select
"TIPMCGW" or "FCMCGW". 8. Select "MISC". 9. Select "Restore Vehicle Configuration".
10. Follow prompts on StarSCAN to complete the reconfigure procedure. 11. Once complete, Wait
one minute and turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. 12. Remove the StarSCAN unit, cable
and charger from the vehicle. 13. Verify proper operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Position the front drivers seat to the full
rearward position. 3. Remove the power inverter (2) mounting retainers (1) located under the
carpet. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 5. Remove the power inverter module from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page 6175
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the inverter into the vehicle and install mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the electrical
connectors. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Position the front drivers seat back to the
original position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page 6176
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Release the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM) cover retaining clips and open the TIPM cover. 4. Remove the
TIPM positive cable retaining nut and remove the cable from the stud. 5. Depress the four
mounting clips to disengage and remove the TIPM housing from its mounting bracket. 6.
Disconnect each of the seven TIPM wire harness connectors. 7. Remove the TIPM from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page 6177
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The original Cabin Compartment Node (CCN) and Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
must be installed and functioning properly
prior to powering up the new Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM receives vehicle
configuration data from the CCN and Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) information from the
PCM. If configuration information becomes lost or corrupted, the data can be obtained from Dealer
CONNECT
1. Position the TIPM into the engine compartment. 2. Connect each of the seven TIPM wire
harness connectors. 3. Position the TIPM onto the mounting bracket and push down until the
mounting clips are fully seated. 4. Position the TIPM positive cable onto the mounting stud and
install the retaining nut. Tighten the nut to 9 - 11 Nm (80 - 100 in. lbs.). 5. Open the TIPM cover and
fully seat the airbag fuse holder (two fuses in one yellow carrier) and the Ignition Off Draw (IOD)
fuse. 6. Connect the battery negative cable. 7. Close the hood. 8. Insert the ignition key and turn it
to the RUN position and wait twelve seconds. The TIPM will collect the necessary vehicle
configuration and
VIN data from the CCN and PCM at this time. After twelve seconds turn the ignition key to the OFF
position and then back to the ON position and verify proper vehicle systems operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 6183
Power Distribution Module: Locations Totally Integrated Power Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 6184
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Inverter Module (Except Export) > Page 6185
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6188
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash)
50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6189
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6190
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6191
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26
Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6192
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16
Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6193
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams
Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
MODULE-INVERTER (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (BODY) 9 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C1 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6194
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6195
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6196
Totally Integrated Power Module C3 (Front End Module) 26 Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6197
Totally Integrated Power Module C4 (Front End Module) 16 Way
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6198
Module-Totally Integrated Power C1
Connector C1 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6199
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6200
Module-Totally Integrated Power C2
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6201
Module-Totally Integrated Power C3
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6202
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 26 WAY
Module-Totally Integrated Power C4
Connector C4 - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (FRONT END MODULE) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6203
Module-Totally Integrated Power C5
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6204
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6205
Module-Totally Integrated Power C6
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6206
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6207
Module-Totally Integrated Power C7
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6208
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6209
Totally Integrated Power Module C2 (Headlamp And Dash) 26 Way
Connector C2 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 26 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6210
Totally Integrated Power Module C8 (Battery) 1 Way
Connector C8 - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6211
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (BATTERY) 1 WAY
Totally Integrated Power Module C5 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C5 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6212
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6213
Totally Integrated Power Module C6 (Headlamp And Dash) 40 Way
Connector C6 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 40 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6214
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6215
Totally Integrated Power Module C7 (Headlamp And Dash) 50 Way
Connector C7 - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 50 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6216
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Inverter Module (Except Export) (Body) 9 Way > Page
6217
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM)
- Description
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Description
DESCRIPTION
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The molded plastic TIPM housing is located
on the right side of the engine compartment. The TIPM housing has a molded plastic cover. The
TIPM cover is easily removed for service access and has a convenient fuse layout label affixed to
the inside surface of the cover to ensure proper component identification.
The TIPM housing is secured to the TIPM mounting bracket by four clips integral to the TIPM
housing. All of the TIPM outputs are through the integral engine compartment wire harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM)
- Description > Page 6220
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Operation
OPERATION
All of the current to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) comes directly from the positive
battery cable to a stud located on the bottom of the TIPM. The cable is secured to the TIPM stud
with a nut. Internal connection of all the TIPM circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of
hard wiring and bus bars. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for complete circuit diagrams.
The fuses, relays and TIPM housing assembly are available for service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Power Distribution Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
INVERTER MODULE
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
110 VOLT POWER OUTLET DIAGNOSIS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics
> Page 6223
Power Distribution Module: Programming and Relearning
PROGRAMMING
1. Install a battery charger. 2. Verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts.
NOTE: Do not allow the charger to time out during the reconfiguration process. Set the battery
charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous
charge.
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle. 5. Place the
Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN. 6. Select "ECU View". 7. Select
"TIPMCGW" or "FCMCGW". 8. Select "MISC". 9. Select "Restore Vehicle Configuration".
10. Follow prompts on StarSCAN to complete the reconfigure procedure. 11. Once complete, Wait
one minute and turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position. 12. Remove the StarSCAN unit, cable
and charger from the vehicle. 13. Verify proper operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Position the front drivers seat to the full
rearward position. 3. Remove the power inverter (2) mounting retainers (1) located under the
carpet. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 5. Remove the power inverter module from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page
6226
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Power Inverter Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the inverter into the vehicle and install mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the electrical
connectors. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Position the front drivers seat back to the
original position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page
6227
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Release the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM) cover retaining clips and open the TIPM cover. 4. Remove the
TIPM positive cable retaining nut and remove the cable from the stud. 5. Depress the four
mounting clips to disengage and remove the TIPM housing from its mounting bracket. 6.
Disconnect each of the seven TIPM wire harness connectors. 7. Remove the TIPM from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Inverter Module - Removal > Page
6228
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The original Cabin Compartment Node (CCN) and Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
must be installed and functioning properly
prior to powering up the new Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM receives vehicle
configuration data from the CCN and Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) information from the
PCM. If configuration information becomes lost or corrupted, the data can be obtained from Dealer
CONNECT
1. Position the TIPM into the engine compartment. 2. Connect each of the seven TIPM wire
harness connectors. 3. Position the TIPM onto the mounting bracket and push down until the
mounting clips are fully seated. 4. Position the TIPM positive cable onto the mounting stud and
install the retaining nut. Tighten the nut to 9 - 11 Nm (80 - 100 in. lbs.). 5. Open the TIPM cover and
fully seat the airbag fuse holder (two fuses in one yellow carrier) and the Ignition Off Draw (IOD)
fuse. 6. Connect the battery negative cable. 7. Close the hood. 8. Insert the ignition key and turn it
to the RUN position and wait twelve seconds. The TIPM will collect the necessary vehicle
configuration and
VIN data from the CCN and PCM at this time. After twelve seconds turn the ignition key to the OFF
position and then back to the ON position and verify proper vehicle systems operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Run Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Run Relay > Page 6233
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Run Relay > Page 6234
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Relay Box: Diagrams Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 6237
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Accessory Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/ACCESSORY - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 6238
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Start Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/START - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6239
Relay Box: Application and ID
Integrated Power Module 8W-13-01
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6240
Relay Box: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
An electrical Junction Block (JB) is located next to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
The JB combines the functions previously provided by a separate relay center. It also serves to
simplify and centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to
many of the accessory systems in the vehicle. It eliminates the need for numerous splice
connections and serves in place of a bulkhead connector between many of the engine
compartment, instrument panel, and body wire harnesses. The junction block is replaced as part of
the engine harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Run
Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Run
Relay > Page 6245
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Run
Relay > Page 6246
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Run
Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Relay Box: Diagrams Run Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Run
Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 6249
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Accessory Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/ACCESSORY - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Run
Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way > Page 6250
Relay Box: Diagrams Run/Start Relay (In TIPM) 5 Way
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-RUN/START - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
6251
Relay Box: Application and ID
Integrated Power Module 8W-13-01
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
6252
Relay Box: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
An electrical Junction Block (JB) is located next to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
The JB combines the functions previously provided by a separate relay center. It also serves to
simplify and centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to
many of the accessory systems in the vehicle. It eliminates the need for numerous splice
connections and serves in place of a bulkhead connector between many of the engine
compartment, instrument panel, and body wire harnesses. The junction block is replaced as part of
the engine harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # K07 Date: 110218
Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement
February 2011
Dealer Service Instructions for: Safety Recall K07 Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Safety Recall K07
Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from November 01, 2007 through November 07,
2008 (MDH 110122 through 110723).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer used vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The front door wiring harnesses on about 65,000 of the above vehicles may fatigue and break.
Broken wires could interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s) located inside the front doors.
This could resulting in the illumination of the airbag warning lamp and loss of side crash sensing
capability.
Repair
The right and left front door wiring harnesses must be replaced.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 6261
These special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 6262
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. Roll down both front door windows.
3. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at the left shock tower.
4. Remove the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel (Figure 1).
5. Remove the front door panel (Figure 1).
6. Remove the front door inner window seal (Figure 1).
7. Separate the oval wiring harness grommet from the lower "A" pillar (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 6263
8. Disconnect the body electrical connectors from the front door wiring harness (Figure 2).
9. Remove the two door grommet retaining screws (Figure 2).
10. Remove the door speaker from the door and disconnect the electrical connector (Figure 2).
11. Open the access door and disconnect the door latch electrical connector (Figure 3).
12. Disconnect the remaining electrical connectors and remove the front door wiring harness from
the vehicle (Figure 2).
CAUTION:
Note the wiring harness routing before removing the wiring harness from the door. The new wiring
harness must be routed in the same location as the original wiring harness.
13. Place the new front door wiring harness into position on the door.
14. Connect the front door wiring harness connectors to the body electrical connectors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 6264
15. Snap the oval wiring harness grommet into the oval hole on the "A" pillar (Figure 1).
16. Place the door grommet into position and install the two retaining screws (Figure 1).
17. Connect the remaining electrical connectors to their respective modules/connectors (Figure 2).
18. Connect the door latch electrical connector and close the access door (Figure 3).
19. Connect the door speaker electrical connector and install the door speaker (Figure 4).
20. Install the front door inner window seal.
21. Install the front door panel.
22. Install the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel.
23. Repeat steps 4 through 22 on the other front door.
24. Connect the negative battery cable.
25. Using Mopar Total Clean or equivalent, clean both front door panels
26. On vehicles equipped with Express Window Up/Down (sales code JSC), perform Steps 27
through 30.
27. Connect the wiTECH to the vehicle.
28. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
29. Clear/Denormalize the door modules using the following procedures:
a. Click on the "Miscellaneous Functions" tab.
b. Select "Denormalize Window/Reset ECU" and follow the directions to clear/denormalize the door
module memory.
30. Relearn/Normalize the door modules using the following procedure:
a. Place the vehicle on a battery charger or have the engine running.
b. Raise the front door glass to the full-up position by pulling up on the window switch to its second
detent and hold the switch until the front door
glass is fully closed. Continue to hold the window switch up for three seconds after the front door
glass is fully closed.
c. Lower the front door glass to the full-down position by pushing down (depress) the window
switch to its second detent and hold the switch until
the front door glass is fully open. Continue to hold the window switch down for three seconds after
the front door glass is fully open.
d. Check the operation of the express-up and express-down features. If the express-up feature
does not work, repeat the procedure starting with
Step 30b.
e. Check that the front door glass reverses when in the express-up mode by holding a pen in the
path of the glass.
f. Repeat steps 30b. through 30e. on the other front door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 6265
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > NHTSA10V658000 > Dec > 10 > Recall 10V658000: Front Door Wiring
Harnesses
Wiring Harness: Recalls Recall 10V658000: Front Door Wiring Harnesses
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler Group LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: December 23, 2010
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 10V658000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A
COMPONENT: Electrical System: Wiring
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 65,180
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling certain model year 2009 Dodge Journey vehicles manufacturer
from November 1, 2007, through September 7, 2008. The wires within the front door wire
harnesses may fatigue and break, which can interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s),
resulting in an airbag warning lamp illumination and loss of side crash sensing capability.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a crash, the side airbag may not deploy, reducing the protection
intended for the occupant and increasing the risk of injuries.
REMEDY: Chrysler will notify owners and replace the left and right door wiring harnesses free of
charge. The safety recall is expected to begin during February 2011. Owners may contact Chrysler
at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler safety recall No. K07. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing
Technical Service Bulletin # H21 Date: 080701
Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing
July 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H21 Engine Wiring Harness Routing
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 08-040 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that have already
had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been excluded from this
recall.
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine ("V" in the 8th VIN
Position) built from February 5, 2008 through March 14, 2008 (MDH 020506 through 031423).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The engine wiring harness on about 5,900 of the above vehicles may chafe on the left transaxle
mount. This could cause a short circuit and result in an engine compartment fire.
Repair
The engine wiring harness must be inspected for damage, repaired if necessary and rerouted away
from the left transaxle mount.
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required plastic tie straps are already in your parts inventory, no
plastic tie straps will be distributed initially. The following plastic tie strap is available as required.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 6274
All dealers will receive one copy of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery connection on the left shock tower.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 6275
2. Inspect the engine wiring harness and, if equipped, the 120 volt engine block heater cord at the
left transaxle mount for chafed wires (Figure 1):
> If wire chafing is not found, continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If wire chafing is found, continue with Step 3 of this procedure.
3. Remove the wiring harness protective tape from around the damaged area.
4. Repair wire(s) as required.
5. Install electrical tape around repaired area of wiring harness.
6. Disconnect the 14-way connector using the following procedure:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 6276
a. Slide the red lock tab located on the top of the connector rearward (Figure 2).
b. Push down on the black connector release tab.
c. While pushing down on the black connector release tab pull the connector apart.
7. Wrap the harness side of the 14-way connector under and around the main wiring harness and
reconnect the 14-way connector (Figure 3). Route the 120 volt engine block heater cord in the
same manner, away from the left transaxle mount.
CAUTION:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 6277
Ensure that all wiring is routed away from all sharp edges.
8. Slide the red locking tab forward to lock the 14-way connector.
9. Connect the negative battery connection on the left shock tower.
10. Reposition the main wiring harness and, if equipped, the engine block heater cord. Secure
them using a tie strap as shown in Figure 4.
11. Verify that the main wiring harness and, if equipped, the engine block heater cord do not touch
the left transaxle mount or any other sharp edges.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing > Page 6278
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # K07 Date: 110218
Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement
February 2011
Dealer Service Instructions for: Safety Recall K07 Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Safety Recall K07
Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from November 01, 2007 through November 07,
2008 (MDH 110122 through 110723).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer used vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The front door wiring harnesses on about 65,000 of the above vehicles may fatigue and break.
Broken wires could interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s) located inside the front doors.
This could resulting in the illumination of the airbag warning lamp and loss of side crash sensing
capability.
Repair
The right and left front door wiring harnesses must be replaced.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 6284
These special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 6285
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. Roll down both front door windows.
3. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at the left shock tower.
4. Remove the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel (Figure 1).
5. Remove the front door panel (Figure 1).
6. Remove the front door inner window seal (Figure 1).
7. Separate the oval wiring harness grommet from the lower "A" pillar (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 6286
8. Disconnect the body electrical connectors from the front door wiring harness (Figure 2).
9. Remove the two door grommet retaining screws (Figure 2).
10. Remove the door speaker from the door and disconnect the electrical connector (Figure 2).
11. Open the access door and disconnect the door latch electrical connector (Figure 3).
12. Disconnect the remaining electrical connectors and remove the front door wiring harness from
the vehicle (Figure 2).
CAUTION:
Note the wiring harness routing before removing the wiring harness from the door. The new wiring
harness must be routed in the same location as the original wiring harness.
13. Place the new front door wiring harness into position on the door.
14. Connect the front door wiring harness connectors to the body electrical connectors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 6287
15. Snap the oval wiring harness grommet into the oval hole on the "A" pillar (Figure 1).
16. Place the door grommet into position and install the two retaining screws (Figure 1).
17. Connect the remaining electrical connectors to their respective modules/connectors (Figure 2).
18. Connect the door latch electrical connector and close the access door (Figure 3).
19. Connect the door speaker electrical connector and install the door speaker (Figure 4).
20. Install the front door inner window seal.
21. Install the front door panel.
22. Install the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel.
23. Repeat steps 4 through 22 on the other front door.
24. Connect the negative battery cable.
25. Using Mopar Total Clean or equivalent, clean both front door panels
26. On vehicles equipped with Express Window Up/Down (sales code JSC), perform Steps 27
through 30.
27. Connect the wiTECH to the vehicle.
28. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
29. Clear/Denormalize the door modules using the following procedures:
a. Click on the "Miscellaneous Functions" tab.
b. Select "Denormalize Window/Reset ECU" and follow the directions to clear/denormalize the door
module memory.
30. Relearn/Normalize the door modules using the following procedure:
a. Place the vehicle on a battery charger or have the engine running.
b. Raise the front door glass to the full-up position by pulling up on the window switch to its second
detent and hold the switch until the front door
glass is fully closed. Continue to hold the window switch up for three seconds after the front door
glass is fully closed.
c. Lower the front door glass to the full-down position by pushing down (depress) the window
switch to its second detent and hold the switch until
the front door glass is fully open. Continue to hold the window switch down for three seconds after
the front door glass is fully open.
d. Check the operation of the express-up and express-down features. If the express-up feature
does not work, repeat the procedure starting with
Step 30b.
e. Check that the front door glass reverses when in the express-up mode by holding a pen in the
path of the glass.
f. Repeat steps 30b. through 30e. on the other front door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 6288
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > NHTSA10V658000 > Dec > 10 > Recall
10V658000: Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 10V658000: Front Door Wiring Harnesses
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009
MANUFACTURER: Chrysler Group LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: December 23, 2010
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 10V658000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A
COMPONENT: Electrical System: Wiring
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 65,180
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling certain model year 2009 Dodge Journey vehicles manufacturer
from November 1, 2007, through September 7, 2008. The wires within the front door wire
harnesses may fatigue and break, which can interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s),
resulting in an airbag warning lamp illumination and loss of side crash sensing capability.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a crash, the side airbag may not deploy, reducing the protection
intended for the occupant and increasing the risk of injuries.
REMEDY: Chrysler will notify owners and replace the left and right door wiring harnesses free of
charge. The safety recall is expected to begin during February 2011. Owners may contact Chrysler
at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler safety recall No. K07. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing
Technical Service Bulletin # H21 Date: 080701
Recall - Engine Wire Harness Routing
July 2008
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall H21 Engine Wiring Harness Routing
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 08-040 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that have already
had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been excluded from this
recall.
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 3.5L engine ("V" in the 8th VIN
Position) built from February 5, 2008 through March 14, 2008 (MDH 020506 through 031423).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The engine wiring harness on about 5,900 of the above vehicles may chafe on the left transaxle
mount. This could cause a short circuit and result in an engine compartment fire.
Repair
The engine wiring harness must be inspected for damage, repaired if necessary and rerouted away
from the left transaxle mount.
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required plastic tie straps are already in your parts inventory, no
plastic tie straps will be distributed initially. The following plastic tie strap is available as required.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 6297
All dealers will receive one copy of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Disconnect the negative battery connection on the left shock tower.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 6298
2. Inspect the engine wiring harness and, if equipped, the 120 volt engine block heater cord at the
left transaxle mount for chafed wires (Figure 1):
> If wire chafing is not found, continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If wire chafing is found, continue with Step 3 of this procedure.
3. Remove the wiring harness protective tape from around the damaged area.
4. Repair wire(s) as required.
5. Install electrical tape around repaired area of wiring harness.
6. Disconnect the 14-way connector using the following procedure:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 6299
a. Slide the red lock tab located on the top of the connector rearward (Figure 2).
b. Push down on the black connector release tab.
c. While pushing down on the black connector release tab pull the connector apart.
7. Wrap the harness side of the 14-way connector under and around the main wiring harness and
reconnect the 14-way connector (Figure 3). Route the 120 volt engine block heater cord in the
same manner, away from the left transaxle mount.
CAUTION:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 6300
Ensure that all wiring is routed away from all sharp edges.
8. Slide the red locking tab forward to lock the 14-way connector.
9. Connect the negative battery connection on the left shock tower.
10. Reposition the main wiring harness and, if equipped, the engine block heater cord. Secure
them using a tie strap as shown in Figure 4.
11. Verify that the main wiring harness and, if equipped, the engine block heater cord do not touch
the left transaxle mount or any other sharp edges.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > H21 > Jul > 08 > Recall - Engine Wire Harness
Routing > Page 6301
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6302
Wiring Harness: Service and Repair
GROMMET - A PILLAR
1. Peel the A Pillar grommet (1) off of the connector/retainer and move it up the wire harness. 2.
Grasp the wire harness (2) by the convolute section of the grommet and gently pull the wire
harness down towards the floor to expose the
connector lock tabs.
CAUTION: Do not force the locking tab past the connector body, as damage to the connector may
occur.
3. While still pulling down on the harness, use a small slotted screw driver (3) to gently push one of
the top lock tabs until the lock feature is flush
with the connector/retainer body.
4. Repeat the step 3 for the remaining top lock tab. 5. The connector should now be able to rock
out of the sheet metal hole without causing any damage to the connector or sheet metal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Curb Height
Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Curb Height Specifications
CURB HEIGHT SPECIFICATIONS
NOTE: On some vehicles it may be necessary to remove an engine belly pan in order to gain
access to the lower control arm pivot bolt.
Front - On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance (2) from the flat surface behind the PLP
hole (1) to the floor or alignment rack/lift runway surface. It may be necessary to measure to the
bottom of a straight edge (3), placed from lift runway to runway, to get an accurate measurement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Curb Height
Specifications > Page 6308
Rear - On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance (2) from the flat surface below the rear
toe adjustment cam bolt (1) to the floor or alignment rack/lift runway surface. It may be necessary
to measure to the bottom of a straight edge (3), placed from lift runway to runway, to get an
accurate measurement.
Compare the measurements to specifications listed in the CURB HEIGHT SPECIFICATIONS
chart. Maximum left-to-right differential is not to exceed 12.5 mm (0.5 in.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6309
Alignment: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Vehicle wheel alignment is the positioning of all interrelated front and rear suspension angles.
These angles affect the handling and steering of the vehicle when it is in motion. Proper wheel
alignment is essential for efficient steering, good directional stability, and proper tire wear.
The method of checking a vehicle's front and rear wheel alignment varies depending on the
manufacturer and type of equipment used. The manufacturer's instructions should always be
followed to ensure accuracy of the alignment, except when Chrysler Corporation's wheel alignment
specifications differ.
On this vehicle, the suspension angles that can be adjusted are as follows:
Front
- Camber (with cradle shift or service adjustment bolt package)
- Caster (limited adjustment with cradle shift)
- Toe
Rear
- Toe
Check the wheel alignment and make all wheel alignment adjustments with the vehicle standing at
its proper curb height specification. Curb height is the normal riding height of the vehicle. It is
measured from a certain point on the vehicle to the ground or a designated area while the vehicle
is sitting on a flat, level surface. Refer to Curb Height Measurement for additional information. See:
Service and Repair/Curb Height Measurement
Typical wheel alignment angles and measurements are described in the following paragraphs.
CAMBER
Camber is the inward or outward tilt of the top of the tire and wheel assembly. Inward tilt (2) is
known as negative camber. Outward tilt (1) is known as
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6310
positive camber. Camber is measured in degrees of angle relative to a true vertical line. Camber is
a tire wearing angle.
- Excessive negative camber will cause tread wear at the inside of the tire.
- Excessive positive camber will cause tread wear on the outside of the tire.
CROSS CAMBER
Cross camber is the difference between left and right camber. To achieve the cross camber
reading, subtract the right side camber reading from the left. For example, if the left camber is -0.7°
and the right camber is -0.5°, the cross camber would be -0.2° (-0.7 - (-0.5) = -0.7 + 0.5 = -0.2).
CASTER
Caster is the forward or rearward tilt of the steering knuckle in reference to the position of the upper
and lower ball joints. Caster is measured in degrees of angle relative to a true vertical center line.
This line is viewed from the side of the tire and wheel assembly.
- Forward tilt (upper ball joint ahead of lower) results in a negative caster angle.
- Rearward tilt (upper ball joint trailing lower) results in a positive caster angle.
Although caster does not affect tire wear, a caster imbalance between the two front wheels may
cause the vehicle to lead to the side with the least positive caster.
CROSS CASTER
Cross caster is the difference between left and right caster. To achieve the cross caster reading,
subtract the right side caster reading from the left. For example, if the left caster is 2.5° and the
right caster is 2.7°, the cross caster would be -0.2° (2.5 - 2.7 = -0.2).
TOE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6311
Toe is the inward or outward angle of the wheels as viewed from above the vehicle.
- Toe-in (1) is produced when the front edges of the wheels on the same axle are closer together
than the rear edges.
- Toe-out (2) is produced when the front edges of the wheels on the same axle are farther apart
than the rear edges.
Toe-in and toe-out can occur at the front wheels and the rear wheels.
Toe is measured in degrees or inches. The measurement identifies the amount that the front of the
wheels point inward (toe-in) or outward (toe-out). Toe is measured at the spindle height. Zero toe
means the front and rear edges of the wheels on the same axle are equal distant.
TOE-OUT ON TURNS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6312
Toe-out on turns (1), sometimes referred to as Ackerman Steering, is the relative positioning of the
front wheels while steering through a turn. This compensates for each front wheel's turning radius.
As the vehicle encounters a turn, the outboard wheel must travel in a larger radius circle than the
inboard wheel. The steering system is designed to make each wheel follow its particular radius
circle. To accomplish this, the front wheels must progressively toe outward as the steering is turned
from center. This eliminates tire scrubbing and undue tire wear when steering a vehicle through a
turn.
DYNAMIC TOE PATTERN
Dynamic toe pattern is the inward and outward toe movement of the front and rear tires through the
suspension's jounce and rebound travel. As the vehicle's suspension moves up and down, the toe
pattern varies. Toe pattern is critical in controlling the directional stability of the vehicle while in
motion. Front and rear dynamic toe pattern is preset by the factory at the time the vehicle is
assembled.
It is not necessary to check or adjust front or rear dynamic toe pattern when doing a normal wheel
alignment. The only time dynamic toe pattern needs to be checked or adjusted is if the frame of the
vehicle has been damaged.
STEERING AXIS INCLINATION (S.A.I.)
Steering axis inclination (1) is the angle between a true vertical line starting at the center of the tire
at the road contact point and a line drawn through the center of the upper ball joint (or strut) and
the lower ball joint. S.A.I. is built into the vehicle and is not an adjustable angle. If S.A.I. is not
within specifications, a bent or damaged suspension component may be the cause.
INCLUDED ANGLE (I.A.)
Included angle (3) is the sum of the S.A.I. angle (1) plus or minus the camber angle (2), depending
on whether or not the wheel has positive or negative camber. If camber is positive, add the camber
angle to the S.A.I angle. If camber is negative, subtract the camber angle from the S.A.I. angle.
Included angle is not adjustable, but can be used to diagnose a frame misalignment or bent
suspension component (spindle, strut).
THRUST ANGLE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6313
Thrust angle is the averaged direction the rear wheels are pointing in relation to the vehicle's center
line. The presence of negative or positive thrust angle causes the rear tires to track improperly to
the left or right of the front tires (dog tracking).
- Negative thrust angle means the rear tires are tracking to the left of the front tires.
- Positive thrust angle means the rear tires are tracking to the right of the front tires.
Improper tracking can cause undue tire wear, a lead or pull and a crooked steering wheel.
Excessive thrust angle can usually be corrected by adjusting the rear wheel toe so that each wheel
has one-half of the total toe measurement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment
Alignment: Service and Repair Wheel Alignment
WHEEL ALIGNMENT
PRE-WHEEL ALIGNMENT INSPECTION
Before any attempt is made to change or correct the wheel alignment, the following inspection and
necessary corrections must be made to the vehicle to ensure proper alignment.
1. Verify the fuel tank is full of fuel. If the fuel tank is not full, the reduction in weight will affect the
curb height of the vehicle and the alignment
specifications.
2. The passenger and luggage compartments of the vehicle should be free of any load that is not
factory equipment. 3. Check the tires on the vehicle. The tires are to be inflated to the
recommended air pressure. All tires must be the same size and in good condition
with approximately the same tread wear.
4. Check the front tire and wheel assemblies for excessive radial runout. 5. Inspect all suspension
component fasteners for looseness and proper torque. 6. Inspect the lower front ball joints and all
steering linkage for looseness and any sign of wear or damage. 7. Inspect the rubber bushings on
all the suspension components for signs of wear or deterioration. If any bushings show signs of
wear or
deterioration, they should be replaced prior to aligning the vehicle.
8. Check vehicle curb height to verify it is within specifications. See:
WHEEL ALIGNMENT SETUP
1. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack. 2. Install all required alignment equipment on the
vehicle, per the alignment equipment manufacturer's instructions. On this vehicle, a four-wheel
alignment is recommended.
NOTE: Prior to reading the vehicle's alignment readouts, the front and rear of vehicle should be
jounced. Induce jounce (rear first, then
front) by grasping the center of the bumper and jouncing each end of vehicle an equal number of
times. The bumper should always be released when vehicle is at the bottom of the jounce cycle.
3. Read the vehicle's current front and rear alignment settings. Compare the vehicle's current
alignment settings to the vehicle specifications for
camber, caster and toe-in. See: Specifications/Wheel Alignment Specifications
REAR CAMBER
Rear camber settings on this vehicle are determined at the time the vehicle is designed, by the
location of the vehicle's suspension components. This is referred to as Net Build. The result is no
required adjustment of camber after the vehicle is built or when servicing the suspension
components. Thus, when performing a wheel alignment, rear camber is not considered an
adjustable angle.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to adjust the vehicle's wheel alignment by heating or bending any of the
suspension components.
FRONT CAMBER AND CASTER
Front camber and caster settings on this vehicle are determined at the time the vehicle is designed,
by the location of the vehicle's suspension components. This is referred to as Net Build. The result
is no required adjustment of camber and caster after the vehicle is built or when servicing the
suspension components. Thus, when performing a wheel alignment, caster and camber are not
normally considered adjustable angles but some adjustment can be made. Camber and caster
should be checked to ensure they meet vehicle specifications. See: Specifications/Wheel
Alignment Specifications
If individual front camber or caster is found not to meet alignment specifications, each can be
adjusted by shifting the front crossmember or by using an available service adjustment bolt
package. If an adjustment bolt package installation is necessary, inspect the suspension
components for any signs of damage or bending first.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to adjust the vehicle's wheel alignment by heating or bending any of the
suspension components.
ADJUSTMENT BY SHIFTING CROSSMEMBER
CAUTION: Always use care when shifting crossmember to avoid damaging other components on
the vehicle.
1. Loosen the four bolts fastening the front crossmember to the frame just enough to allow
movement of the crossmember. See:
Suspension/Cross-Member/Service and Repair/Crossmember - Removal
2. Loosen the bolts fastening the fore/aft crossmember to the frame just enough to allow movement
of the crossmember. See:
Suspension/Cross-Member/Service and Repair/Crossmember - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 6316
CAUTION: When shifting the front crossmember, keep in mind that the front and rear engine
mounts are attached to the front crossmember
and fore/aft crossmember and should be inspected following the crossmember shift to make sure
they are properly aligned.
3. Shift front crossmember as necessary (See following tables) to bring camber or caster into
specifications. When shifting crossmember, use care not
to move other angles (camber or caster) that are within specifications, out of specifications.
4. Tighten all previously loosened fasteners (bolts) securing the crossmember to the vehicle to
specifications. See:
Suspension/Cross-Member/Service and Repair/Crossmember - Installation
5. Jounce the rear, then front of the vehicle an equal amount of times. 6. Measure camber and
caster. If camber and caster are within specifications, proceed to TOE. If camber cannot be brought
into specifications,
perform the CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT PACKAGE INSTALLATION below.
CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT PACKAGE INSTALLATION
1. Raise the vehicle until its tires are not supporting the weight of the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the front tire and wheel assembly (1).
CAUTION: The strut clevis-to-knuckle attaching bolt shanks are serrated and must not be turned
during removal. Remove the nuts while
holding the bolts stationary, then tap the bolts out using a punch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 6317
3. Remove the original nuts (3, 4) and upper (1) and lower (6) bolts attaching the strut clevis
bracket (2) to the knuckle (5). 4. Separate the knuckle (5) from the strut clevis bracket (2) and
position knuckle so it is out of the way of the strut. Use care not to overextend the
brake flex hose or axle half shaft.
CAUTION: When slotting the bottom mounting hole (3) on the strut clevis bracket (4), do not
enlarge the hole beyond the indentations (2) on
the sides of the strut clevis bracket.
5. Using an appropriate grinder and grinding wheel, slot the bottom hole (3) in both sides of the
strut clevis bracket (4).
CAUTION: After slotting the strut clevis bracket hole, do not install the original attaching bolts. Only
the service package bolts and dog bone
washers must be used to attach the knuckle to the strut once the mounting hole is slotted.
6. Position the strut clevis bracket in line with the upper end of the knuckle, aligning the mounting
holes. Install the two service package bolts. Be
sure to place the bolt with the eccentric cam in the bottom (slotted) hole on strut clevis bracket.
7. Install the dog bone washers provided in the service package and nuts on the replacement bolts.
Tighten each nut just enough to hold the knuckle
in position while adjusting camber, but still allows the knuckle to move in the clevis bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 6318
8. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
9. Perform the above procedure to opposite side strut as required.
10. Lower the vehicle and jounce the front and rear of the vehicle. 11. Adjust the front camber to
the preferred setting using the cam bolt in the lower mounting hole. Once camber is set to
specifications, tighten the
upper and lower strut service package bolt nuts to 140 Nm (103 ft. lbs.). Again jounce the front and
rear of the vehicle, then verify the camber settings.
12. Once camber is within specifications, adjust toe to meet the preferred specification setting.
Refer to FRONT TOE within this wheel alignment
service procedure.
TOE
1. Center the steering wheel and lock it in place using a steering wheel clamp.
NOTE: When setting toe, make sure to set rear toe to the preferred specifications before setting
front toe to the preferred specifications
REAR TOE
NOTE: Perform the following at each rear wheel as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 6319
1. While holding the cam bolt head (4) stationary, loosen the toe link mounting cam bolt nut (3). 2.
Rotate the cam bolt head (4) left or right until the rear wheel toe for that rear wheel is set to the
preferred specification. See: Specifications/Wheel
Alignment Specifications
3. While holding the cam bolt head (4) stationary, tighten the toe link mounting cam bolt nut (3) to
100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
FRONT TOE
NOTE: Perform the following at each front wheel as necessary.
CAUTION: Do not twist the inner tie rod-to-steering gear boot (bellows) while turning the inner tie
rod during front toe adjustment. It may be
necessary to remove the clamp where the boot meets the inner tie rod.
1. Loosen the tie rod adjusting jam nut (1). Grasp the inner tie rod (3) and rotate it one way or the
other until the front wheel toe is set to the preferred
specification. See: Specifications/Wheel Alignment Specifications
2. Tighten the tie rod adjusting jam nut to of 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.). 3. Make sure the inner tie
rod-to-steering gear boot is not twisted. If removed, reinstall the clamp where the boot meets the
inner tie rod.
4. Remove the steering wheel clamp. 5. Remove the alignment equipment. 6. Road test the vehicle
to verify the steering wheel is straight and the vehicle does not pull or wander.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 6320
Alignment: Service and Repair Curb Height Measurement
CURB HEIGHT MEASUREMENT
The wheel alignment is to be checked and all alignment adjustments made with the vehicle at its
required curb height specification.
Vehicle height is to be checked with the vehicle on a flat, level surface, preferably a vehicle
alignment rack. The tires are to be inflated to the recommended pressure. All tires are to be the
same size as standard equipment. Vehicle height is checked with the fuel tank full of fuel, and no
passenger or luggage compartment load.
Vehicle height is not adjustable. If the measurement is not within specifications, inspect the vehicle
for bent or weak suspension components. Compare the parts tag on the suspect coil spring(s) to
the parts book and the vehicle sales code, checking for a match. Once removed from the vehicle,
compare the coil spring height to a correct new or known good coil spring. The heights should vary
if the suspect spring is weak.
NOTE: Prior to reading the curb height measurement, the front and rear of the vehicle must be
jounced to settle the suspension. Induce jounce by pushing down on the center of the bumper
(fascia), using care not to damage the vehicle, moving the vehicle up and down, gradually
increasing the suspension travel with each stroke. Release the bumper at the bottom of each
stroke, repeating this action several times. Perform this to both front and rear suspensions an equal
amount of times.
Measure curb height as follows:
1. Jounce the vehicle. Refer to above note.
NOTE: On some vehicles it may be necessary to remove an engine belly pan in order to gain
access to the lower control arm pivot bolt.
2. Front - On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance 2 from the flat surface behind the PLP
hole 1 to the floor or alignment rack/lift
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 6321
runway surface. It may be necessary to measure to the bottom of a straight edge 3, placed from lift
runway to runway, to get an accurate measurement.
3. Rear - On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance 2 from the flat surface below the rear
toe adjustment cam bolt 1 to the floor or
alignment rack/lift runway surface. It may be necessary to measure to the bottom of a straight edge
3, placed from lift runway to runway, to get an accurate measurement.
4. Compare the measurements to specifications listed in the following CURB HEIGHT
SPECIFICATIONS chart. Maximum left-to-right
differential is not to exceed 12.5 mm (0.5 in.).
5. If curb height is found to be out of specification and there is no sign of excessive body damage,
curb height can be changed by replacing the
applicable spring with a spring offering a different check load.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for
Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
Technical Service Bulletin # J13 Date: 090609
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
May 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J13 Steering Column Control Module
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 09, 2009 through February 24,
2009 (MDH 020916 through 022417).
2009 (JK) Jeep(R) Wrangler
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 10, 2009 through February 26,
2009 (MDH 021008 through 022608).
2009 (WK) Jeep(R) Grand Cherokee
(XK) Jeep(R) Commander
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 19, 2009 through February 25,
2009 (MDH 021910 through 022509).
IMPORTANT:
Many of the vehicles within the above build period have already been inspected or repaired and,
therefore, have been excluded from this recall.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Steering Column Control Module (SCCM) on about 4,300 of the above vehicles may have the
squib connector wiring reversed for the driver airbag module. This could cause the driver side
airbag not to deploy as intended and increase the risk of injury during a crash.
Repair
The Steering Column Control Module build date code must be inspected on all vehicles. Those
vehicles that have Steering Column Control Modules with a Julian date code of 0409, 0419, or
0429 must receive an additional inspection on the driver airbag squib wires. Steering Column
Control Modules with suspect driver airbag squib wires must be replace.
Alternate Transportation
Dealers should attempt to minimize customer inconvenience by placing the owner in a loaner
vehicle if inspection determines that Steering Column Control Module replacement is required and
the vehicle must be held overnight.
Parts Information
There will be no initial parts distribution. Parts should only be ordered after inspection determines
the need for replacement.
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for
Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6332
The special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for
Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6333
approaches for this recall. This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special
equipment and is a Chrysler Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
A. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Data Label
1. Turn the steering wheel to the 6 o'clock position (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for
Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6334
2. Unsnap the knee bolster at the top of the bolster and allow it to hinge downward (Figure 2).
3. Remove the upper and lower plastic steering column shrouds.
4. Inspect the first four digits of the Julian data code (disregard the fifth digit) on the label located
on the bottom of the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 3) for the following:
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is 0409, 0419, or 0429 continue with Section B.
Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation.
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is not 0409, 0419, or 0429 the Steering Column
Control Module does not require further inspection or replacement. Continue with Step 5 of this
procedure.
5. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
6. Install the knee bolster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for
Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6335
7. Return the vehicle to the customer.
B. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation
WARNING:
To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) before attempting Steering Column Control Module replacement.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system
capacitor to discharge before proceeding. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable, then wait two minutes before proceeding.
2. Place the steering wheel in the straight ahead position.
NOTE:
The front wheels must also be in the straight ahead position.
3. Separate the driver airbag module from the steering wheel but do not disconnect the driver
airbag module squib wires.
CAUTION:
Do not allow the driver airbag module to hang by the squib wires.
NOTE:
Some models use three clips to hold the driver airbag module to the steering wheel (Figure 4).
4. Remove the black electrical tape that holds the two sets of squib wires together (Figure 5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for
Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6336
5. Inspect the driver airbag module squib wiring orientation going into the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 6):
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the left
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the right side, the Steering Column Control
Module does not require repair. Continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the right
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the left side, the Steering Column Control
Module is defective and must be replaced. Continue with Section C. Replace Steering Column
Control Module.
6. Install the driver airbag module onto the steering wheel.
7. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
8. Install the knee bolster.
9. Connect the negative battery cable.
10. Return the vehicle to the customer.
C. Replace Steering Column Control Module
CAUTION:
The clockspring in the Steering Column Control Module is shipped with the clockspring
pre-centered and with a molded plastic locking pin installed. This locking pin must not be removed
until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering column (Step 20).
1. Disconnect the driver airbag module wires and place the module aside.
2. Disconnect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
3. Remove the steering wheel retaining bolt.
4. Remove the steering wheel from the steering shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for
Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6337
5. Move the steering column to the fully lowered position.
6. Remove the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the steering
column bracket.
7. Pull the Steering Column Control Module away from the steering column far enough to access
and disconnect the three instrument panel wire
harness connectors from the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control Module case.
8. Remove the Steering Column Control Module from the steering column.
9. Transfer the right multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 7).
10. Transfer the left multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 8).
11. Transfer the multi-function switch jumper harness from the old Steering Column Control Module
onto the new Steering Column Control Module
(Figure 8).
CAUTION:
Make sure that the jumper wire connectors are locked in place by gently pulling on them.
12. Carefully slide the Steering Column Control Module down over the steering column upper shaft
far enough to reconnect the three instrument
panel wire harness connectors to the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control
Module case.
13. Position the Steering Column Control Module onto the steering column bracket.
14. Install and tighten the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the
steering column bracket to 27 in. lbs. (3 N.m) in the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for
Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6338
following sequence:
> Lower right screw
> Upper left screw
> Upper right screw
CAUTION:
Use of an improper sequence when tightening the Steering Column Control Module mounting
screws may result in an audible ticking noise as the steering wheel is rotated.
15. Install the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column.
16 Install the knee bolster.
17. Move the steering column back to the fully raised position and move the tilt release lever to the
locked position.
18. Install the steering wheel onto the steering column.
19. Install the steering wheel retaining bolt and tighten bolt to 45 ft. lbs. (61 N.m).
20. Remove the plastic locking pin that secures the clockspring rotor to the Steering Column
Control Module case.
21. Connect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
22. Connect the squib connectors to the driver airbag module.
23. Install the driver airbag module to the steering wheel.
24. Perform the Supplemental Restraints Verification Test below:
a. Connect the scan tool to the 16-way data link connector located on the driver's side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
b. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position and exit the vehicle with the scan tool.
c. Check and make certain that nobody is in the vehicle, then reconnect the negative battery cable.
d. Using the scan tool, read and record active and historical Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
e. Use the scan tool to erase the stored DTC's.
f. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position for about 15 seconds, and then back to the "ON" position.
Observe the airbag indicator lamp in the instrument cluster. It should light for six to eight seconds
and then go out. This indicates that the SRS is functioning normally and that the repairs are
complete.
g. Remove the scan tool from the vehicle.
h. Return the vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for
Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6339
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control
Module Defect
Technical Service Bulletin # J13 Date: 090609
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
May 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J13 Steering Column Control Module
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 09, 2009 through February 24,
2009 (MDH 020916 through 022417).
2009 (JK) Jeep(R) Wrangler
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 10, 2009 through February 26,
2009 (MDH 021008 through 022608).
2009 (WK) Jeep(R) Grand Cherokee
(XK) Jeep(R) Commander
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 19, 2009 through February 25,
2009 (MDH 021910 through 022509).
IMPORTANT:
Many of the vehicles within the above build period have already been inspected or repaired and,
therefore, have been excluded from this recall.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Steering Column Control Module (SCCM) on about 4,300 of the above vehicles may have the
squib connector wiring reversed for the driver airbag module. This could cause the driver side
airbag not to deploy as intended and increase the risk of injury during a crash.
Repair
The Steering Column Control Module build date code must be inspected on all vehicles. Those
vehicles that have Steering Column Control Modules with a Julian date code of 0409, 0419, or
0429 must receive an additional inspection on the driver airbag squib wires. Steering Column
Control Modules with suspect driver airbag squib wires must be replace.
Alternate Transportation
Dealers should attempt to minimize customer inconvenience by placing the owner in a loaner
vehicle if inspection determines that Steering Column Control Module replacement is required and
the vehicle must be held overnight.
Parts Information
There will be no initial parts distribution. Parts should only be ordered after inspection determines
the need for replacement.
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control
Module Defect > Page 6345
The special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control
Module Defect > Page 6346
approaches for this recall. This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special
equipment and is a Chrysler Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
A. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Data Label
1. Turn the steering wheel to the 6 o'clock position (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control
Module Defect > Page 6347
2. Unsnap the knee bolster at the top of the bolster and allow it to hinge downward (Figure 2).
3. Remove the upper and lower plastic steering column shrouds.
4. Inspect the first four digits of the Julian data code (disregard the fifth digit) on the label located
on the bottom of the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 3) for the following:
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is 0409, 0419, or 0429 continue with Section B.
Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation.
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is not 0409, 0419, or 0429 the Steering Column
Control Module does not require further inspection or replacement. Continue with Step 5 of this
procedure.
5. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
6. Install the knee bolster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control
Module Defect > Page 6348
7. Return the vehicle to the customer.
B. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation
WARNING:
To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) before attempting Steering Column Control Module replacement.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system
capacitor to discharge before proceeding. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable, then wait two minutes before proceeding.
2. Place the steering wheel in the straight ahead position.
NOTE:
The front wheels must also be in the straight ahead position.
3. Separate the driver airbag module from the steering wheel but do not disconnect the driver
airbag module squib wires.
CAUTION:
Do not allow the driver airbag module to hang by the squib wires.
NOTE:
Some models use three clips to hold the driver airbag module to the steering wheel (Figure 4).
4. Remove the black electrical tape that holds the two sets of squib wires together (Figure 5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control
Module Defect > Page 6349
5. Inspect the driver airbag module squib wiring orientation going into the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 6):
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the left
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the right side, the Steering Column Control
Module does not require repair. Continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the right
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the left side, the Steering Column Control
Module is defective and must be replaced. Continue with Section C. Replace Steering Column
Control Module.
6. Install the driver airbag module onto the steering wheel.
7. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
8. Install the knee bolster.
9. Connect the negative battery cable.
10. Return the vehicle to the customer.
C. Replace Steering Column Control Module
CAUTION:
The clockspring in the Steering Column Control Module is shipped with the clockspring
pre-centered and with a molded plastic locking pin installed. This locking pin must not be removed
until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering column (Step 20).
1. Disconnect the driver airbag module wires and place the module aside.
2. Disconnect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
3. Remove the steering wheel retaining bolt.
4. Remove the steering wheel from the steering shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control
Module Defect > Page 6350
5. Move the steering column to the fully lowered position.
6. Remove the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the steering
column bracket.
7. Pull the Steering Column Control Module away from the steering column far enough to access
and disconnect the three instrument panel wire
harness connectors from the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control Module case.
8. Remove the Steering Column Control Module from the steering column.
9. Transfer the right multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 7).
10. Transfer the left multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 8).
11. Transfer the multi-function switch jumper harness from the old Steering Column Control Module
onto the new Steering Column Control Module
(Figure 8).
CAUTION:
Make sure that the jumper wire connectors are locked in place by gently pulling on them.
12. Carefully slide the Steering Column Control Module down over the steering column upper shaft
far enough to reconnect the three instrument
panel wire harness connectors to the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control
Module case.
13. Position the Steering Column Control Module onto the steering column bracket.
14. Install and tighten the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the
steering column bracket to 27 in. lbs. (3 N.m) in the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control
Module Defect > Page 6351
following sequence:
> Lower right screw
> Upper left screw
> Upper right screw
CAUTION:
Use of an improper sequence when tightening the Steering Column Control Module mounting
screws may result in an audible ticking noise as the steering wheel is rotated.
15. Install the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column.
16 Install the knee bolster.
17. Move the steering column back to the fully raised position and move the tilt release lever to the
locked position.
18. Install the steering wheel onto the steering column.
19. Install the steering wheel retaining bolt and tighten bolt to 45 ft. lbs. (61 N.m).
20. Remove the plastic locking pin that secures the clockspring rotor to the Steering Column
Control Module case.
21. Connect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
22. Connect the squib connectors to the driver airbag module.
23. Install the driver airbag module to the steering wheel.
24. Perform the Supplemental Restraints Verification Test below:
a. Connect the scan tool to the 16-way data link connector located on the driver's side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
b. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position and exit the vehicle with the scan tool.
c. Check and make certain that nobody is in the vehicle, then reconnect the negative battery cable.
d. Using the scan tool, read and record active and historical Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
e. Use the scan tool to erase the stored DTC's.
f. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position for about 15 seconds, and then back to the "ON" position.
Observe the airbag indicator lamp in the instrument cluster. It should light for six to eight seconds
and then go out. This indicates that the SRS is functioning normally and that the repairs are
complete.
g. Remove the scan tool from the vehicle.
h. Return the vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Column Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control
Module Defect > Page 6352
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page
6356
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering
Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C2
(Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector C2 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering
Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6359
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C3
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C3 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering
Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6360
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C4
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C4 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering
Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6361
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C8
(Steering Wheel) 6 Way
Connector C8 - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Steering Column Module - Description
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Control Module (SCM) that is internal to the left
multi-function switch housing (2). The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side
of the steering column, just below the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the
interior and exterior lighting systems. The only visible components of the switch are the control
stalk (1), control knob and control sleeve that extend through the steering column shrouds on the
left side of the column. The remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions and electrical
connections are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing and controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A single screw (7)
through a mounting tab integral to the back of the switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the
bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the mounting bracket integral to the clockspring
(3). A connector receptacle containing seven terminal pins is integral to the inboard end of the
switch housing and connects the SCM through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the right
(wiper) multi-function switch (6). A second connector receptacle containing four terminal pins is
integral to the back of the switch housing and connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system
through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The SCM cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged the entire left multi-function
switch must be replaced. See: Lighting and Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and
Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left Multifunction Switch - Removal. The
clockspring (with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the
SCM), the right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate
service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Steering Column Module - Description > Page 6364
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Steering Column Module - Description > Page 6365
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Column Control Module (SCCM). The SCCM is secured
near the top of the steering column below the steering wheel and is completely concealed beneath
the steering column shrouds. It is installed as a modular unit that supports the left (lighting)
multi-function switch (1) and right (wiper) multi-function switch (6). The controls for each of these
switches extend through appropriate clearance holes provided in the steering column shrouds.
The microprocessor-based Steering Control Module (SCM) (2) utilizes integrated circuitry and
information carried on the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus along with several hard wired
analog and multiplexed inputs to monitor both the right and left multi-function switches. The SCCM
uses a Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data bus for exterior lighting and wiper functions. The LIN
data is sent to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN then sends it out on the CAN data
bus See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Description
and Operation/Communication - Description. The SCCM is available for service replacement as a
unit or each individual component:
- Clockspring (with integral Steering Angle Sensor if equipped)
- Left Multi-Function Switch (with integral Steering Control Module)
- Right Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Steering Column Module - Description > Page 6366
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6367
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Testing and Inspection
STEERING CONTROL MODULE
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
The hard wired circuits between components related to the Steering Control Module (SCM) may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair
procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector pin-out information and
location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the SCM or
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices that provide some
features of the SCM. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM or the
electronic controls and communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Steering Column Control Module - Removal
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Removal
REMOVAL
SCCM
1. Place the front road wheels in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. 2. Open hood. 3. Disconnect
and isolate the battery negative cable.
WARNING: Wait two minutes for the airbag system reserve capacitor to discharge before
beginning any airbag system or component service.
Failure to do so may result in accidental airbag deployment, personal injury or death.
4. Remove steering wheel See: Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and Repair/Removal. 5. Remove
upper and lower steering column shrouds to gain access to the Steering Column Control Module
(SCCM)See: Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal.
6. Lock the clockspring rotor in the center position as follows: Insert a grenade pin through the hole
in the rotor at the 10 o'clock position. 7. Remove the three screws (1) to the Steering Column
Control Module (SCCM) (3).
8. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) between the SCCM (1) and the instrument panel wiring
harness at the base of the SCCM and remove from
column.
NOTE: If only removing the SCCM from column, there is no need to continue to next step.
DISASSEMBLY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6370
1. Remove the left multi-function switch stalk retaining screw (2). 2. Pull the left stalk out of the
SCCM.
3. Disconnect the left stalk electrical connector. 4. Separate the left switch from the SCCM.
5. Remove the one right multi-function switch retaining screw. 6. Pull right switch out of SCCM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6371
7. Disconnect the right switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6372
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If SCCM is already assembled and needs to be installed, bypass ASSEMBLY and proceed
with SCCM 1.
ASSEMBLY
1. Connect the right stalk electrical connector.
2. Slide the right stalk into the groove and install the one retaining screw.
3. Connect the left stalk switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6373
4. Install the left stalk switch retaining screw.
SCCM
1. Position the SCCM (3) over the steering column shaft (2). 2. Install the three screws (1).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the instrument panel harness, ensure wiring is properly
routed. Then check that the connectors, locking
tabs are properly engaged.
4. Install steering column shrouds See: Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service
and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation.
Be sure all wires are inside of shrouds.
5. Install steering wheel ensuring the flats on hub align with the clockspring See: Steering/Steering
Wheel/Service and Repair/Installation. Pull the
airbag leads through the larger slot. Ensure leads do not get pinched under the steering wheel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6374
NOTE: There is a small wire harness in the steering wheel and it contains the horn circuits and
speed control circuits.
6. Connect the speed control and horn wire connector into the clockspring. 7. Pull the grenade pin
out of the clockspring. 8. Install the driver airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air
Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation
WARNING: Do not connect the negative battery cable at this time. Perform the Air Bag System
Test prior to connecting the negative battery
cable See: Restraint Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
Failure to follow this warning may result in accidental air bag deployment and possible serious or
fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION
CAUTION: The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPM system
pressures have been established for the tire size equipped on the vehicle. Undesirable system
operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same
size, type, or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause sensor damage. Do not use aftermarket tire
sealants or balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with TPM, as damage to the sensors may
result.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. Use tire
pressure sensors in original style factory wheels
only. If aftermarket wheels are installed, and therefore do not contain tire pressure sensors, the
system will not function properly and the driver will be continuously notified of a system
malfunction.
CAUTION: After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure always reinstall the valve stem cap. This
will prevent moisture and dirt from
entering the valve stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Sensor.
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensor valve stem caps and cores are specially designed for the sensors.
Due to risk of corrosion, do not use a
standard valve stem cap or core in a tire pressure sensor in place of the original equipment style
sensor cap and core.
CAUTION: Any time a sensor is to be installed in a wheel, it is necessary to install a new
sensor-to-wheel seal, metal washer and valve stem
nut, to ensure air tight sealing.
CAUTION: When installing the valve core, be sure to tighten the core to specifications See: Wheels
and Tires/Wheels/Specifications .
Overtightening by a little as three or four inch pounds can damage the sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM), one tire pressure sensor (6) is
mounted to each wheel (5) in place of the traditional tire valve stem. Each sensor has an internal
battery that lasts up to 10 years. The battery is not serviceable. At the time of battery failure, the
sensor must be replaced.
The TPM system operates on a 433 MHz radio frequency. The 433 MHz sensors (1) can be easily
identified by the part number.
CAUTION: Although additional sensors operating at 433 MHz sensors are available and are used
in other applications, they are not
interchangeable. Always make sure the correct sensor is being used and be sure to replace the
sensor with the correct part number.
NOTE: Once mounted inside a tire and wheel assembly you are not able to visually see the
difference between this sensor and other 315 MHz
and 433 MHz sensors. At that point, the TPM/RKE Analyzer 9936, with the Scan Tool may be used
to identify the sensor frequency or the tire can be dismounted allowing visual inspection of the
sensor body and part number.
The TPM sensors are designed for original style factory wheels. It is not recommended to install a
tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel (This could cause sealing and system performance
issues). Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. If aftermarket
wheels are installed and do not contain tire pressure sensors, the system will not function properly
and the driver will be continuously notified of a system malfunction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description > Page 6382
The serviceable components of the tire pressure sensor are:
- Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2) and Metal Washer (1)
- Valve Stem Cap (4)
- Valve Stem Core
- Valve Stem Nut (with pressed-in washer) (3)
NOTE: Any time a sensor is installed on a wheel, a new Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2), Metal Washer
(1) and Valve Stem Nut (3) must be installed
to ensure air tight sealing. A service kit is available.
The valve stem caps and cores are specifically designed for the tire pressure monitoring sensors.
Although similar to standard valve stem caps and cores, they are different. The valve stem cap has
a special seal inside to keep moisture and corrosion out. The valve stem core has a special nickel
coating to protect from corrosion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description > Page 6383
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The battery operated tire pressure sensor is both a transmitter and a receiver. The TPM sensor can
be forced to transmit by using a special tool such as a TPM-RKE Analyzer. Using a TPM-RKE
Analyzer can take up to a minute to force a transmission from a sensor.
NOTE: The TPM-RKE Analyzer will not define the mode.
The TPM sensor can be in one of the following operating modes:
- OFF MODE - A new TPM sensor will be in this mode. In this mode the sensor does not transmit
periodically on its own. By forcing a transmission from the sensor with the TPM-RKE Analyzer, it
will change to the STATIONARY MODE. The sensor will also automatically change from OFF
mode to the STATIONARY MODE once it experiences a great increase in pressure (i.e. installation
into a wheel/tire assembly and then inflated).
- WAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes when the vehicle is driven over
15mph (24km/h), but only after the vehicle was previously parked for a duration of 18 minutes or
greater. In WAL MODE the sensors transmit every 33 seconds and these transmissions contain
left/right information that allows the TPM Module to determine sensor location on the vehicle. WAL
MODE lasts for the first 10 minutes of consecutive driving, then NORMAL DRIVE mode ensues.
- FACTORY MODE- This is a special case of WAL MODE. If a TPM sensor has just been taken out
of OFF MODE, then for the first 3 minutes of the WAL period (10 minutes) the sensors transmit at
an accelerated rate of every 10 seconds. After the first 20 drives, then the sensors never again
transmit out of FACTORY MODE.
- NORMAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes after the first 10 minutes of a
drive. In NORMAL MODE the sensors transmit every 66 seconds and cease transmitting left/right
information.
- SERVICE MODE- Once a vehicle stops, the sensors go into SERVICE MODE. After 18 minutes
of no driving then the sensors go into the STATIONARY MODE. If the vehicle was stopped for less
than 18 minutes and driving resumes, then the sensors go back to the NORMAL MODE.
- STATIONARY MODE - When a vehicle has been stopped for more then 18 minutes, then the
sensor is forced into STATIONARY MODE. In STATIONARY MODE the sensor never transmits
any pressure information. The sensor leaves STATIONARY MODE and enters WAL MODE when
the vehicle is driven above 15mph (24km/h).
Each sensor's (transmitter) broadcast is uniquely coded so that the TPM module can monitor the
state of each of the sensors on the four rotating road wheels. The TPM module can automatically
learn and store the sensor's ID while driving "within 20 minutes continuously above 15 mph (24
km/h)" after a sensor has been replaced. The vehicle must be stationary for more then 20 minutes
in order to initiate the learning sequence. The TPM module can also learn the sensor's ID using the
TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool following the procedure listed in the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly.
CAUTION: The cap used on this valve stem contains an O-ring seal to prevent contamination and
moisture from entering the valve stem.
Retain this valve stem cap for reuse. Do not substitute a regular valve stem cap in its place.
CAUTION: The valve stem used on this vehicle is made of aluminum and the core is nickel plated
brass. The original valve stem core must be
reinstalled and not substituted with a valve stem core made of a different material. This is required
to prevent corrosion in the valve stem caused by the different metals.
3. Dismount tire from wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions while paying special
attention to the following to avoid damaging the
pressure sensor: a. When breaking the tire bead loose from the wheel rim, avoid using the Bead
Breaker in the area of the sensor (1). That includes both outer and
inner beads of the tire.
b. When preparing to dismount the tire from the wheel, carefully insert the mounting/dismounting
tool 280° from the valve stem ± 10°, then
proceed to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use this process on both outer and inner tire beads.
4. Remove sensor nut (3) retaining sensor to wheel. While removing nut, hold pressure against
rear of metal valve stem to keep valve stem from
pushing rearward, damaging antenna strap.
5. Remove sensor (1) from wheel (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 6386
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before reinstalling an existing tire pressure sensor, replace seal (2) and metal washer (1) at
base of sensor valve stem (6) to ensure
proper sealing.
1. Wipe area clean around sensor/valve stem mounting hole in wheel (5). Make sure surface of
wheel is not damaged.
CAUTION: To avoid damaging sensor antenna strap (1), if equipped, hold pressure against rear of
metal valve stem (2) while sensor is
inserted through wheel mounting hole and nut is installed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 6387
2. Insert sensor (1) through wheel (2) as shown keeping pressure against rear of metal valve stem
(See Arrow). Potted side of sensor is to be
positioned toward wheel. Do not attempt to mount sensor otherwise, damage may occur.
3. Install sensor nut (with pressed-in washer) (3) by hand.
NOTE: Before tightening sensor nut, push downward on sensor housing (2) in an attempt to make
it flush with interior contour of wheel (1).
4. While holding sensor in position, tighten sensor nut to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Over-torquing the sensor nut by as little as 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.) may result in sensor
separation from the valve stem. Under this
condition, the sensor may still function. However, the condition should be corrected immediately.
5. Mount tire on wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions, paying special attention to
the following to avoid damaging tire pressure
sensor: a.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 6388
Rotating Wheel Tire Changers - Once the wheel is mounted to the changer, position the sensor
valve stem (2) approximately 280° from the head of the changer (located at 1) in a clockwise
direction before rotating the wheel (also in a clockwise direction) to mount the tire. Use this
procedure on both the outer and inner tire beads.
b.
Rotating Tool Tire Changers - Position the wheel on the changer so that the sensor valve stem (1)
is located approximately 210° clockwise from the installation end of the mounting/dismounting tool
(2) once the tool is mounted for tire installation. Make sure the sensor is clear of the lower bead
breaker area (3) to avoid damaging the sensor when the breaker rises. Rotate the tool (2) in a
counterclockwise direction to mount the tire. Use this procedure on both the upper and lower tire
beads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 6389
6. Adjust air pressure to that listed on Tire Inflation Pressure Label (Placard) provided with vehicle
(applied to driver's side B-pillar). Make sure
original style and color valve stem cap is securely installed to keep moisture out of sensor.
7. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) on vehicle See: Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Installation. Tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower vehicle. 9. Perform one of the following to make the system learn the new sensor ID.
a. Use the TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool to program the WIN with the
tire pressure sensor ID. This is part of the
TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
b. Once the vehicle has remained stationary for more than 20 minutes, drive vehicle for a minimum
of 10 minutes while maintaining a continuous
speed above 15 mph (24 km/h). During this time, the system will learn the new sensor ID. This is
part of the TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
NOTE: If a sensor cannot be trained, refer to appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Front Steering Knuckle: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The knuckle (3) is a single casting with legs machined for attachment to the front strut assembly on
the top and steering linkage on the trailing end. A ball joint is located on the bottom of the knuckle
which attaches to the lower control arm. The knuckle also has two machined, drilled legs on the
leading end casting to support and align the front disc brake caliper adapter.
The knuckle supports the hub and bearing (1). A shield (not shown in figure) is fastened to the
knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6394
Front Steering Knuckle: Testing and Inspection
KNUCKLE
The front suspension knuckle is not a repairable component of the front suspension. It must be
replaced if found to be damaged in any way. If it is determined that the knuckle is bent when
servicing the vehicle, no attempt is to be made to straighten the knuckle.
Inspect the lower ball joint per the inspection procedure. The lower ball joint can be replaced
separately from the knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Front Steering Knuckle - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, review all Warnings and Cautions. See: Suspension/Service
Precautions/Technician Safety Information
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the hub from rotating, remove the hub nut (1) from the
axle half shaft (2). 4. Access and remove the front brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6397
5. Remove the routing clip (1) securing wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle (5).
6. Remove the screw (1) fastening the wheel speed sensor head (2) to the knuckle (3). Pull the
sensor head out of the knuckle.
7. Remove the nut (3) attaching the outer tie rod (6) to the knuckle (2). To do this it might be
necessary to hold the tie rod end stud with a wrench
while loosening and removing the nut with a standard wrench or crowfoot wrench.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6398
8. Release the outer tie rod end (1) from the knuckle (3) using Remover (2), Special Tool 9360. 9.
Remove the outer tie rod from the knuckle.
10. Remove the nut (4) attaching the lower ball joint to the lower control arm (5).
11. Release the lower ball joint (3) from the lower control arm (1) using Remover (2), Special Tool
9360. Do not lift the knuckle out of the lower
control arm at this time.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6399
CAUTION: The strut assembly-to-knuckle attaching bolts (5) are serrated and must not be turned
during removal. Proper removal is
required. Refer to the following steps for the correct method.
12. While holding the bolt heads stationary, remove the two nuts (2) from the bolts (5) attaching the
strut (3) to the knuckle (6). 13. Remove the two bolts (5) attaching the strut (3) to the knuckle (6)
using a pin punch.
NOTE: Do not allow the half shaft (1) to hang by the inner C/V joint; it must be supported to keep
the joint from separating during this
operation.
14. Pull the knuckle (2) off the half shaft (1) outer C/V joint splines and remove the knuckle from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6400
15. If required, remove the three screws (2) fastening the shield (3) to the knuckle (1). Remove the
shield.
16. If required, remove the four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing (1) to the knuckle (3). 17. If
required, slide the hub and bearing (1) out of the knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6401
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Front Steering Knuckle - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If required, install the hub and bearing (1) by sliding it into the knuckle. 2. If installing hub and
bearing, install the four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing (1) to the knuckle (3). Tighten the
four bolts to 82 Nm (60 ft.
lbs.).
3. If required, install the shield on the knuckle. Install and tighten the three mounting screws (2) to
10 Nm (89 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6402
4. Slide the hub and bearing in the knuckle (2) onto the splines of the half shaft outer C/V joint (1).
5. Insert the lower ball joint stud into the mounting hole in the lower control arm. 6. Install a NEW
ball joint stud nut (4). Tighten the nut to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: The strut clevis-to-knuckle bolts (5) are serrated and must not be turned during
installation. Install the nuts while holding the
bolts stationary in the steering knuckle. Refer to the following step.
7. Position the lower end of the strut assembly (3) in line with the upper end of the knuckle (6),
aligning the mounting holes. Install the two mounting
bolts (5).
8. Install the nuts (2) on the two bolts (5). While holding the bolts in place, tighten the nuts to 140
Nm (103 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6403
9. Install the outer tie rod (6) ball stud into the hole in the knuckle (2) arm. Start the tie rod
end-to-knuckle nut (4) onto the stud. While holding the
tie rod end stud with a wrench, tighten the nut with a wrench or crowfoot wrench to 85 Nm (63 ft.
lbs.).
10. Install the wheel speed sensor head (2) into the knuckle (3). Install the mounting screw (1) and
tighten it to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.).
11. Install the routing clip (1) securing the wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle (5). 12. Install
the brake rotor, disc brake caliper and adapter. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6404
13. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 14. Install the hub nut
(1) on the end of the half shaft (2) and snug it. 15. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the
hub from rotating, tighten the hub nut (3) to 132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.).
16. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
17. Lower the vehicle. 18. Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service and
Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Bleeding: > 19-001-09 > Jan > 09 >
Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns
Power Steering Bleeding: Customer Interest Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns
NUMBER: 19-001-09
GROUP: Steering
DATE: January 22, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-08, DATED
OCTOBER 11, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL YEARS AND
MODELS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Honk, Moan Or Grinding Sound On Left Turns
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the power steering reservoir with a revised (taller)
reservoir and bleeding the power steering system.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE:
**This bulletin does not apply to vehicles built for Europe or Japan
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to **JC** vehicles built prior to September 3, 2008 (MDH 0903XX) **or JS
vehicles built prior to January 29, 2009 (MDH 0129xx)**.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customers may hear a honk moan or grinding sound when
performing hard left turns while accelerating or decelerating.
DIAGNOSIS: If the above condition is present and determined to be coming from the power
steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING RESERVOIR REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering reservoir with the revised (taller) reservoir pn 05151028AA.
2. Refer to the detailed power steering system fill and bleed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 19 - Steering > Standard Procedure.
NOTE:
If vehicle still exhibits a honk sound on turns, there may still be air ingested into the steering system
and the power steering bleeding procedure may have to be repeated several times.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Bleeding: > 19-001-09 > Jan > 09 >
Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns > Page 6414
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Bleeding: > 19-001-09 > Jan >
09 > Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns
Power Steering Bleeding: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand
Turns
NUMBER: 19-001-09
GROUP: Steering
DATE: January 22, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-08, DATED
OCTOBER 11, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL YEARS AND
MODELS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Honk, Moan Or Grinding Sound On Left Turns
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the power steering reservoir with a revised (taller)
reservoir and bleeding the power steering system.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE:
**This bulletin does not apply to vehicles built for Europe or Japan
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to **JC** vehicles built prior to September 3, 2008 (MDH 0903XX) **or JS
vehicles built prior to January 29, 2009 (MDH 0129xx)**.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customers may hear a honk moan or grinding sound when
performing hard left turns while accelerating or decelerating.
DIAGNOSIS: If the above condition is present and determined to be coming from the power
steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING RESERVOIR REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering reservoir with the revised (taller) reservoir pn 05151028AA.
2. Refer to the detailed power steering system fill and bleed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 19 - Steering > Standard Procedure.
NOTE:
If vehicle still exhibits a honk sound on turns, there may still be air ingested into the steering system
and the power steering bleeding procedure may have to be repeated several times.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Bleeding: > 19-001-09 > Jan >
09 > Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns > Page 6420
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Bleeding: > Page 6421
Power Steering Bleeding: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 19-001-09 Date: 090122
Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns
NUMBER: 19-001-09
GROUP: Steering
DATE: January 22, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-08, DATED
OCTOBER 11, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL YEARS AND
MODELS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Honk, Moan Or Grinding Sound On Left Turns
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the power steering reservoir with a revised (taller)
reservoir and bleeding the power steering system.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE:
**This bulletin does not apply to vehicles built for Europe or Japan
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to **JC** vehicles built prior to September 3, 2008 (MDH 0903XX) **or JS
vehicles built prior to January 29, 2009 (MDH 0129xx)**.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customers may hear a honk moan or grinding sound when
performing hard left turns while accelerating or decelerating.
DIAGNOSIS: If the above condition is present and determined to be coming from the power
steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING RESERVOIR REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering reservoir with the revised (taller) reservoir pn 05151028AA.
2. Refer to the detailed power steering system fill and bleed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 19 - Steering > Standard Procedure.
NOTE:
If vehicle still exhibits a honk sound on turns, there may still be air ingested into the steering system
and the power steering bleeding procedure may
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Bleeding: > Page 6422
have to be repeated several times.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 19-001-09 Date:
090122
Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns
NUMBER: 19-001-09
GROUP: Steering
DATE: January 22, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-08, DATED
OCTOBER 11, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL YEARS AND
MODELS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Honk, Moan Or Grinding Sound On Left Turns
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the power steering reservoir with a revised (taller)
reservoir and bleeding the power steering system.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE:
**This bulletin does not apply to vehicles built for Europe or Japan
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to **JC** vehicles built prior to September 3, 2008 (MDH 0903XX) **or JS
vehicles built prior to January 29, 2009 (MDH 0129xx)**.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customers may hear a honk moan or grinding sound when
performing hard left turns while accelerating or decelerating.
DIAGNOSIS: If the above condition is present and determined to be coming from the power
steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Bleeding: > Page 6423
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING RESERVOIR REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering reservoir with the revised (taller) reservoir pn 05151028AA.
2. Refer to the detailed power steering system fill and bleed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 19 - Steering > Standard Procedure.
NOTE:
If vehicle still exhibits a honk sound on turns, there may still be air ingested into the steering system
and the power steering bleeding procedure may have to be repeated several times.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6424
Power Steering Bleeding: Service and Repair
POWER STEERING SYSTEM BLEEDING
WARNING: The fluid level should be checked with engine off to prevent injury from moving
components.
CAUTION: Mopar(R) Power Steering Fluid + 4 or Mopar(R) ATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid is
to be used in the power steering system.
Both Fluids have the same material standard specifications (MS-9602). No other power steering or
automatic transmission fluid is to be used in the system. Damage may result to the power steering
pump and system if another fluid is used. Do not overfill the system.
CAUTION: If the air is not purged from the power steering system correctly, pump failure could
result.
NOTE: Be sure the vacuum tool used in the following procedure is clean and free of any fluids.
1. Check the fluid level. As measured on the side of the reservoir, the level should indicate between
MAX and MIN when the fluid is at normal
ambient temperature. Adjust the fluid level as necessary.See: Service and Repair/Power Steering
Fluid Level Checking
2. Tightly insert Power Steering Cap Adapter (4), Special Tool 9688, into the mouth of the reservoir
(3).
CAUTION: Failure to use a vacuum pump reservoir (1) may allow power steering fluid to be sucked
into the hand vacuum pump.
3. Attach Hand Vacuum Pump (2), Special Tool C-4207 or equivalent, with reservoir (1) attached,
to the Power Steering Cap Adapter (4).
CAUTION: Do not run the engine while vacuum is applied to the power steering system. Damage
to the power steering pump can occur.
NOTE: When performing the following step make sure the vacuum level is maintained during the
entire time period.
4. Using Hand Vacuum Pump (2), apply 68-85 kPa (20-25 in. Hg) of vacuum to the system for a
minimum of three minutes. 5. Slowly release the vacuum and remove the special tools. 6. Adjust
the fluid level as necessary. Refer to 1.
7. Repeat 1 through 6 until the fluid no longer drops when vacuum is applied. 8. Start the engine
and cycle the steering wheel lock-to-lock three times.
NOTE: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops.
9. Stop the engine and check for leaks at all connections.
10. Check for any signs of air in the reservoir and check the fluid level. If air is present, repeat the
procedure as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Power Steering Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 6429
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6430
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
Power Steering Fluid ............................................................................... Mopar Power Steering
Fluid +4, Mopar ATF +4 Automatic Transmission Fluid.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6431
Power Steering Fluid: Description and Operation
POWER STEERING FLUID
The recommended fluid for the power steering system is Mopar(R) Power Steering fluid + 4 or
Mopar(R) ATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid. Both Fluids have the same material standard
specifications (MS-9602).
Mopar(R) ATF+4 (and Mopar(R) Power Steering fluid + 4), when new, is red in color. ATF+4 is
dyed red so it can be identified from other fluids used in the vehicle such as engine oil or
antifreeze. The red color is not permanent and is not an indicator of fluid condition. As the vehicle is
driven, ATF+4 will begin to look darker in color and may eventually become brown. THIS IS
NORMAL. ATF+4 also has a unique odor that may change with age. Consequently, odor and color
cannot be used to indicate the fluid condition or the need for a fluid change.
The power steering system is filled-for-life at the factory and requires no regular maintenance.
Although not required at specific intervals, the fluid level may be checked periodically. Check the
fluid level anytime there is a system noise or fluid leak suspected. See: Service and Repair/Power
Steering Fluid Level Checking
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6432
Power Steering Fluid: Service and Repair
POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL CHECKING
WARNING: Fluid level should be checked with the engine OFF to prevent personal injury from
moving parts and to assure an accurate fluid
level reading.
CAUTION: Mopar(R) Power Steering Fluid + 4 or Mopar(R) ATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid is
to be used in the power steering system.
Both fluids have the same material standard specifications (MS-9602). No other power steering or
automatic transmission fluid is to be used in the system. Damage may result to the power steering
pump and system if another fluid is used. Do not overfill the system.
NOTE: Although not required at specific intervals, the fluid level may be checked periodically.
Check the fluid level anytime there is a system
noise or fluid leak suspected.
The power steering fluid level can be viewed through the side of the power steering fluid reservoir.
Compare the fluid level to the markings on the side of the reservoir. When the fluid is at normal
ambient temperature, approximately 21°C to 27°C (70°F to 80°F), the fluid level should read
between the MAX. and MIN. markings. When the fluid is hot, fluid level is allowed to read up to the
MAX. line.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The cooler (3) is placed in series with the power steering fluid return hose, between the steering
gear fluid outlet port and the fluid return hose leading to the power steering fluid reservoir. It is
attached to the front bumper reinforcement (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Cooler - Removal
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Service and Repair Power Steering Cooler - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions .
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Raise and support
the vehicle. See: Maintenance. 3. If equipped, remove the belly pan below the engine. 4. Remove
the lower fascia valance.
5. Remove the hose clamps (5) attaching the fluid return hoses (1) to the power steering fluid
cooler line (3). Separate the return hoses from the
cooler line.
6. Remove the two cooler mounting push pins (4) at the bumper reinforcement (2). 7. Remove the
cooler line (3) from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Cooler - Removal > Page 6438
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Service and Repair Power Steering Cooler - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the power steering fluid cooler line (3) to the bumper reinforcement (2) by installing the
two cooler mounting push pins (4). 2. Install the fluid return hoses (1) on the cooler line (3). Install
the hose clamps (5) on the hoses past the bead formed into the end of the cooler tube
and secure in place.
3. Install the lower fascia valance. 4. If equipped, install the belly pan below the engine. 5. Lower
the vehicle. 6. Fill and bleed the power steering system. See: Service and Repair/Steering - Power
Steering System Bleeding 7. Check for leaks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: > 19-001-09
> Jan > 09 > Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Customer Interest Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns
NUMBER: 19-001-09
GROUP: Steering
DATE: January 22, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-08, DATED
OCTOBER 11, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL YEARS AND
MODELS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Honk, Moan Or Grinding Sound On Left Turns
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the power steering reservoir with a revised (taller)
reservoir and bleeding the power steering system.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE:
**This bulletin does not apply to vehicles built for Europe or Japan
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to **JC** vehicles built prior to September 3, 2008 (MDH 0903XX) **or JS
vehicles built prior to January 29, 2009 (MDH 0129xx)**.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customers may hear a honk moan or grinding sound when
performing hard left turns while accelerating or decelerating.
DIAGNOSIS: If the above condition is present and determined to be coming from the power
steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING RESERVOIR REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering reservoir with the revised (taller) reservoir pn 05151028AA.
2. Refer to the detailed power steering system fill and bleed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 19 - Steering > Standard Procedure.
NOTE:
If vehicle still exhibits a honk sound on turns, there may still be air ingested into the steering system
and the power steering bleeding procedure may have to be repeated several times.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: > 19-001-09
> Jan > 09 > Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns > Page 6447
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: >
19-001-09 > Jan > 09 > Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left
Hand Turns
NUMBER: 19-001-09
GROUP: Steering
DATE: January 22, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-08, DATED
OCTOBER 11, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL YEARS AND
MODELS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Honk, Moan Or Grinding Sound On Left Turns
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the power steering reservoir with a revised (taller)
reservoir and bleeding the power steering system.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
**2007 - 2009 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible**
NOTE:
**This bulletin does not apply to vehicles built for Europe or Japan
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to **JC** vehicles built prior to September 3, 2008 (MDH 0903XX) **or JS
vehicles built prior to January 29, 2009 (MDH 0129xx)**.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customers may hear a honk moan or grinding sound when
performing hard left turns while accelerating or decelerating.
DIAGNOSIS: If the above condition is present and determined to be coming from the power
steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING RESERVOIR REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering reservoir with the revised (taller) reservoir pn 05151028AA.
2. Refer to the detailed power steering system fill and bleed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 19 - Steering > Standard Procedure.
NOTE:
If vehicle still exhibits a honk sound on turns, there may still be air ingested into the steering system
and the power steering bleeding procedure may have to be repeated several times.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: >
19-001-09 > Jan > 09 > Steering - Honk/Moan On Hard Left Hand Turns > Page 6453
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6454
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The power steering fluid reservoir (5) is mounted above the right front inner fender well to a bracket
(2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Service and Repair Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions .
1. Remove engine appearance cover. 2. Remove the fasteners securing the coolant recovery bottle
to its mounts and move it away from the power steering fluid reservoir. It is not
necessary to disconnect the coolant recovery bottle fluid lines. See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery Bottle - Removal
3. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir (5). 4. Remove hose
clamp securing cooler return hose (3) to fluid reservoir fitting. Slide the hose off the end of the
reservoir fitting. 5. Remove hose clamp securing pump supply hose (4) to the fluid reservoir fitting.
Slide the hose off the end of the reservoir fitting. 6. Remove the reservoir mounting screw (1) used
to secure the reservoir in place. 7. Remove the reservoir (5). 8. Remove the plastic shield from the
reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal > Page 6457
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Service and Repair Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the plastic shield over the reservoir neck.
2. Attach the reservoir (5) to the strut tower bracket (2) using the mounting screw (1). Tighten
mounting screw (1) to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.). 3. Slide the pump supply hose (4) onto reservoir fitting.
Expand hose clamp and slide it over hose on reservoir fitting. Secure clamp once it is past
bead formed into fluid reservoir fitting.
4. Slide cooler return hose (3) onto reservoir fitting. Expand hose clamp and slide it over hose on
reservoir fitting. Secure clamp once it is past bead
formed into fluid reservoir fitting.
5. Install the coolant recovery bottle. See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Installation
6. Fill and bleed the power steering system. See: Service and Repair/Steering - Power Steering
System Bleeding 7. Check for leaks. 8. Install the engine appearance cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Power Steering Line/Hose: Testing and Inspection
POWER STEERING PUMP AND HOSES
NOTE: This information is designed to be used in conjunction with the diagnostic charts at the
beginning of the Steering section. See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CHECKING FOR WEAR OF POWER STEERING PUMP INTERNAL COMPONENTS
1. Place gear selector in PARK (or NEUTRAL) with wheels chalked. 2. With the engine idling, have
a helper turn the steering wheel. 3. Using an electronic listening tool, determine if noise is coming
from the pump. 4. Increase the engine speed and have a helper turn the steering wheel. Does the
noise change with load? 5. Replace the power steering pump if excessive noise is present. See:
Power Steering Pump/Service and Repair/Power Steering Pump - Removal
CHECKING FOR POWER STEERING HOSES TOUCHING BODY OR FRAME OF VEHICLE
Check hoses and hose tubes as following:
- Inspect hoses and hose tubes for witness marks. If witness marks are present, adjust hose(s) to
the proper position by loosening, repositioning and tightening attachments to the specified torque
See: Specifications. Do not bend tubing to adjust. Replace the hose assembly if damaged.
- Check fastener torque of hose mounting brackets and tube nuts. See: Specifications
- Have a helper bump the steering gear off of the stops to induce pressure fluctuations which may
move the hose. If hose contact is made, adjust hose(s) to the proper position by loosening,
repositioning and tightening attachments to the specified torque See: Specifications. Do not bend
tubing to adjust. Replace the hose assembly if damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Hose - Removal
Pressure Hose
3.5L ENGINE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions .
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Remove the engine
appearance cover. 3. Raise and support the vehicle See: Maintenance. 4. Unscrew the tube nut
(3), then remove the pressure hose (4) at the steering gear. 5. Lower the vehicle.
6. Unscrew the tube nut (3), then remove the pressure hose (1) at the pump (4). 7. Remove the
pressure hose routing clamp bolt (2) at the engine cylinder head.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 6463
8. Accessing it through the area behind the powertrain control module (3), remove the routing
clamp screw (2) securing the pressure hose (1) to the
left side of the front suspension crossmember.
9. Remove the power steering pressure hose from the vehicle.
Return Hose
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions .
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Remove the power
steering fluid reservoir.See: Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and Repair/Reservoir, Power
Steering Pump - Removal 3. Remove the coolant recovery bottle. See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Removal
4. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance 5. If equipped, remove the belly pan below the
engine. 6. Remove the lower fascia valance.
7. Remove the return hose (1) at the return tube (2). If equipped with a screw-clamp, be sure to
save the original clamp for reinstallation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 6464
8. Remove the hose clamps (5) attaching the fluid return hoses (7) to the power steering fluid
cooler line (4). Separate the return hoses from the
cooler line.
9. Remove the return hose routing clamp screws (3) securing the return hose (7) to the frame rail.
10. Remove the return hose routing clamp screw (6) securing the return hose (7) to the frame rail.
11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Remove the return hose routing clamp screw (1) securing the return
hose (7) to the body. 13. Remove the return hose from the vehicle.
Supply Hose
3.5L ENGINE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions .
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir.
2. Remove the clamp (3) securing the supply hose (2) to the power steering pump supply fitting (4),
then remove the hose from the supply fitting.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 6465
3. Remove the mounting screws (1) securing the coolant recovery container (4) in place.
4. Lift the coolant recovery container as high as its connected hoses will allow, then remove the clip
(6) securing the supply hose to the coolant
recovery container's lower mounting point.
5. Remove the hose clamp (1) securing the supply hose (2) to the power steering fluid reservoir (7).
Slide the hose off the end of the reservoir fitting
and remove from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 6466
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Hose - Installation
Pressure Hose
3.5L ENGINE
CAUTION: Power steering fluid hoses must remain away from the exhaust system, driveshafts,
vehicle components and any unfriendly surface
that can possibly damage the hoses.
1. Install the pressure hose into the engine compartment from above between the engine and the
upper radiator hose. Then route the hose down the
left side of the engine above the transmission, down to the steering gear.
2. Raise and support the vehicle See: Maintenance. 3. Install the pressure hose tube (4) at the
gear. Tighten the tube nut (3) to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.). 4. Lower the vehicle.
5. Accessing it through the area behind the powertrain control module (3), position the power
steering hose (1) routing clamp at the left side of the
front suspension crossmember. Install and tighten the routing clamp screw (2) to 14 Nm (10 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 6467
6. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the open power steering pressure hose end and the power
steering pump port. Replace any used O-rings with
new. Lubricate the O-ring with clean power steering fluid.
7. Install the pressure hose (1) at the power steering pump (4). Tighten the tube nut (3) to 32 Nm
(24 ft. lbs.). 8. Position the pressure hose (1) routing clamp at the engine cylinder head. Install and
tighten the routing clamp bolt (2) to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.). 9. Fill and bleed the power steering system
See: Service and Repair/Steering - Power Steering System Bleeding.
10. Check for leaks.
Return Hose
INSTALLATION
1. Install the power steering return hose (7) into the engine compartment. 2. Install the return hose
routing clamp screw (1) securing the return hose (7) to the body. 3. Raise and support the vehicle.
See: Maintenance 4. Install the return hose routing clamp screw (6) securing the return hose (7) to
the frame rail. Tighten the screw to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.). 5. Install the screws (3) securing the return
hose to the frame rail (2). Tighten the screws to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.). 6. Install the return hose onto
the cooler line (4) and install the hose clamps (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 6468
7. Install the return hose (1) at the return tube (2) and install the clamp. If a screw-clamp is used,
tighten it to 2.5 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
8. Install the lower fascia valance. 9. If equipped, install the belly pan below the engine.
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Install the coolant recovery bottle. See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Installation
12. Install the power steering fluid reservoir. See: Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation 13. Fill and bleed the power steering system.
See: Service and Repair/Steering - Power Steering System Bleeding 14. Check for leaks.
Supply Hose
3.5L ENGINE
1. Slide hose clamps (1, 3) onto the ends of the power steering fluid supply hose (2) far enough to
clear the fittings on the reservoir and pump once
the hose is installed.
2. Place the pump end of the supply hose onto the pump supply fitting (4). Expand the hose clamp
(3) and slide it over the hose and pump supply
fitting. Secure the clamp once it is past the bead formed into the fluid supply fitting.
3. Lift the coolant recovery container as high as its connected hoses will allow, then install the clip
(6) in the mounting hole (5) securing the supply
hose to the coolant recovery container's lower mounting point.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Hose - Removal > Page 6469
4. Lower the coolant recovery container (4) to its mounted position and install the mounting screws
(1).
5. Place the fluid reservoir end of the supply hose (2) onto the reservoir (7) supply fitting. Expand
the hose clamp and slide it over the hose and
fitting. Secure the clamp once it is past the bead formed into the fluid reservoir fitting.
6. Fill and bleed the power steering system. See: Service and Repair/Steering - Power Steering
System Bleeding 7. Check for leaks.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Pump: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine
Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
Power Steering Pump: Customer Interest Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Pump: > 19-001-08 > Apr > 08 > Engine
Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 6478
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-001-08 > Apr >
08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine
Power Steering Pump: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering
Whine
NUMBER: 19-001-08
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 3, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 8.04 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: Flash: Power Steering Whine Sound / Coordinated Hardware Change
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves replacing the Power Steering Pump with a revised part and selectively
erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a 3.5L engine (Sales Codes EGF) built prior to
February 29, 2008 (MDH0229XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some customers may hear a high pitched whine sound between 1200 and 2000 engine RPM. The
whine may be most noticeable when accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
Start the engine and raise the engine speed to between 1200 and 2000 RPM. With the RPM
raised, listen for a high pitched whine sound. If a high pitched whine is heard and determined to be
coming from the power steering system, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
Do not move the steering wheel during the test. The whine sound is heard with no load on the
power steering pump.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-001-08 > Apr >
08 > Engine Controls/Steering - Power Steering Whine > Page 6484
NOTE:
If a power steering pump is replaced for other reasons on any vehicle built prior to February 29,
2008. The PCM will require update to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate Idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers. Failure to update
the software may result in inappropriate low speed power steering assist feel.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP REPLACEMENT:
1. Using the procedures outlined in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT, replace the power
steering pump with pn 05151835AB..
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
The software update must be made to take full advantage of the power steering pump change and
provide the appropriate idle RPM assist during low speed parking lot maneuvers.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the PCM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical > Electronic Control Modules - Service Information > Module - Powertrain
Control > Standard Procedures > PCM/ECM Programming - Gas.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pump - Description
Power Steering Pump: Description and Operation Power Steering Pump - Description
DESCRIPTION
Hydraulic pressure for operation of the power steering gear is provided by a droop-flow type power
steering pump.
The power steering pump is belt driven. The pulley (1) cannot be serviced separately on
four-cylinder engine mounted pumps.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pump - Description > Page 6487
Power Steering Pump: Description and Operation Power Steering Pump Pulley - Description
DESCRIPTION
The pulley mounted on power steering pumps used on six cylinder engines can serviced separately
from the pump. It has a center hub incorporating a flange used for pump removal. The pulley used
on pumps mounted on four cylinder engines is not serviced separately.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6488
Power Steering Pump: Testing and Inspection
POWER STEERING PUMP AND HOSES
NOTE: This information is designed to be used in conjunction with the diagnostic charts at the
beginning of the Steering section. See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CHECKING FOR WEAR OF POWER STEERING PUMP INTERNAL COMPONENTS
1. Place gear selector in PARK (or NEUTRAL) with wheels chalked. 2. With the engine idling, have
a helper turn the steering wheel. 3. Using an electronic listening tool, determine if noise is coming
from the pump. 4. Increase the engine speed and have a helper turn the steering wheel. Does the
noise change with load? 5. Replace the power steering pump if excessive noise is present. See:
Service and Repair/Power Steering Pump - Removal
CHECKING FOR POWER STEERING HOSES TOUCHING BODY OR FRAME OF VEHICLE
Check hoses and hose tubes as following:
- Inspect hoses and hose tubes for witness marks. If witness marks are present, adjust hose(s) to
the proper position by loosening, repositioning and tightening attachments to the specified torque
See: Specifications. Do not bend tubing to adjust. Replace the hose assembly if damaged.
- Check fastener torque of hose mounting brackets and tube nuts. See: Specifications
- Have a helper bump the steering gear off of the stops to induce pressure fluctuations which may
move the hose. If hose contact is made, adjust hose(s) to the proper position by loosening,
repositioning and tightening attachments to the specified torque See: Specifications. Do not bend
tubing to adjust. Replace the hose assembly if damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump - Removal
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump - Removal
3.5L ENGINE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions .
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Remove the engine
appearance cover.
3. Unscrew the tube nut (3), then remove the pressure hose (1) at the pump (4). 4. Remove the
pressure hose routing clamp bolt (2) at the engine cylinder head.
5. Remove the clamp (3) securing the supply hose (2) to the power steering pump supply fitting (4),
then remove the hose from the supply fitting.
6. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump - Removal > Page 6491
7. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the right front tire and wheel assembly (1).
8. Remove the drive belt splash shield. 9. Remove the drive belt. See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Drive Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Removal
10. Lower the vehicle.
11. Remove the two nuts securing the right engine mount bracket to the mount.
12. Position a floor jack (3) with an appropriate size block of wood (2) below the engine oil pan (1).
raise the jack until the block of wood just comes
into contact with the bottom of the oil pan, but no further.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump - Removal > Page 6492
13. Slowly raise the right side of the engine using the floor jack while viewing the pump drive pulley.
Raise the engine until all three power steering
pump mounting bolts can be accessed through the openings in the drive pulley.
14. Remove the three pump mounting bolts through the pulley openings. 15. Remove the power
steering pump.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump - Removal > Page 6493
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump - Installation
3.5L ENGINE
1. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the open power steering pressure hose end and the power
steering pump port. Replace any used O-rings with
new. Lubricate the O-ring with clean power steering fluid.
2. Place the pump in mounted position. Install the three bolts through the pulley openings. Tighten
the mounting bolts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.). 3. Slowly lower the right side of the engine using the floor
jack, guiding the right engine mount bracket mounting holes over the mounting studs of
the right engine mount.
4. Remove the floor jack and block of wood from below engine.
5. Install the two nuts securing the right engine mount bracket to the mount.See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Engine/Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets
and Accessories/Engine Mount/Service and Repair/Engine Mount Insulator - Installation
6. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance 7. Install the drive belt. See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Engine/Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Drive Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Installation
8. Install the drive belt splash shield.
9. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump - Removal > Page 6494
11. Place the pump end of the supply hose (2) onto the pump supply fitting (4). Expand the hose
clamp (3) and slide it over the hose and pump supply
fitting. Secure the clamp once it is past the bead formed into the fluid supply fitting.
12. Install the pressure hose (1) at the power steering pump (4). Tighten the tube nut (3) to 32 Nm
(24 ft. lbs.). 13. Position the pressure hose (1) routing clamp at the engine cylinder head. Install
and tighten the routing clamp bolt (2) to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.).
14. Fill and bleed the power steering system. See: Service and Repair/Steering - Power Steering
System Bleeding 15. Check for leaks. 16. Install the engine appearance cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump - Removal > Page 6495
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Pulley - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove power steering pump from engine. See: Power Steering Pump - Removal
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove power steering pump
pulley. Damage to pulley and power
steering pump will occur.
CAUTION: It is very important to use Puller 9962, to remove pulley from power steering pump
shaft. Use of other pullers can damage or
break pulley and pump shaft.
2. Coat Screw-Drive (1) with lubricant and thread into Puller Body (2).
NOTE: Two Buttons come with Puller kit (9962-3 and 9962-4). Be sure to use Button that best fits
end of pump shaft to avoid damage to
Button or pump shaft.
3. Insert Button 9962-4 (4), into end of Screw-Drive. Be sure not to misplace ball bearing that
resides behind Button.
4. Assemble Puller 9962, over end of pump shaft and pulley hub.
a. Place Button on end of Screw-Drive against pump shaft. b. Assemble Collets 9962-2 (3),
surrounding Puller Body (1) and pulley hub flange, then slide the Collet Sleeve over the Collets. c.
Hand tighten Screw-Drive (2) taking up any slack in Puller.
5. Hold Puller Body stationary while turning Screw-Drive until pulley is removed from power
steering pump shaft.
NOTE: Inspect pulley. Replace if pulley is bent, cracked, or loose.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump - Removal > Page 6496
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Pulley - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley (2) or pump shaft to install pulley. This
action will damage pulley and power
steering pump.
1. Place power steering pump pulley (2) squarely on end of power steering pump shaft. 2. Place
Installation Spacer 6936 (1), on top of pump pulley (2).
NOTE: Later build pumps feature a shaft with internal threads that are not as deep as earlier
production, thus requiring a stack of washers,
approximately 13 mm (0.5 in.) thickness (3), placed over Spacer 6936 (2), before mounting Installer
C-4063C (1) on the pump. To know if a replacement pump requires the stack of washers, measure
the depth of the shaft hole. A later build pump will have a depth of 20 mm (0.78 in.) while an earlier
build pump will have a depth of 32 mm (1.25 in.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump - Removal > Page 6497
3. As necessary (see above note), place a stack of washers approximately 13 mm (0.5 in.)
thickness (3) over Spacer 6936 (2).
NOTE: It is important to use Forcing Screw C-4063-2 when performing this procedure.
4. Thread Installer C-4063C (1), completely into internal threads of power steering pump shaft, then
rotate Installer Nut down against washers (as
necessary) and Spacer (2) on pump pulley.
5. Ensuring that the tools and pulley remain aligned with pump shaft, tighten Installer Nut, forcing
pulley onto power steering pump shaft until
Spacer (2) comes in contact with end of pump shaft. When Spacer (2) is against shaft of power
steering pump, Installer (1) Nut will no longer rotate.
6. Install power steering pump on engine.See: Power Steering Pump - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: >
J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
Technical Service Bulletin # J13 Date: 090609
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
May 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J13 Steering Column Control Module
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 09, 2009 through February 24,
2009 (MDH 020916 through 022417).
2009 (JK) Jeep(R) Wrangler
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 10, 2009 through February 26,
2009 (MDH 021008 through 022608).
2009 (WK) Jeep(R) Grand Cherokee
(XK) Jeep(R) Commander
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 19, 2009 through February 25,
2009 (MDH 021910 through 022509).
IMPORTANT:
Many of the vehicles within the above build period have already been inspected or repaired and,
therefore, have been excluded from this recall.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Steering Column Control Module (SCCM) on about 4,300 of the above vehicles may have the
squib connector wiring reversed for the driver airbag module. This could cause the driver side
airbag not to deploy as intended and increase the risk of injury during a crash.
Repair
The Steering Column Control Module build date code must be inspected on all vehicles. Those
vehicles that have Steering Column Control Modules with a Julian date code of 0409, 0419, or
0429 must receive an additional inspection on the driver airbag squib wires. Steering Column
Control Modules with suspect driver airbag squib wires must be replace.
Alternate Transportation
Dealers should attempt to minimize customer inconvenience by placing the owner in a loaner
vehicle if inspection determines that Steering Column Control Module replacement is required and
the vehicle must be held overnight.
Parts Information
There will be no initial parts distribution. Parts should only be ordered after inspection determines
the need for replacement.
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: >
J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6507
The special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: >
J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6508
approaches for this recall. This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special
equipment and is a Chrysler Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
A. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Data Label
1. Turn the steering wheel to the 6 o'clock position (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: >
J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6509
2. Unsnap the knee bolster at the top of the bolster and allow it to hinge downward (Figure 2).
3. Remove the upper and lower plastic steering column shrouds.
4. Inspect the first four digits of the Julian data code (disregard the fifth digit) on the label located
on the bottom of the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 3) for the following:
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is 0409, 0419, or 0429 continue with Section B.
Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation.
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is not 0409, 0419, or 0429 the Steering Column
Control Module does not require further inspection or replacement. Continue with Step 5 of this
procedure.
5. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
6. Install the knee bolster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: >
J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6510
7. Return the vehicle to the customer.
B. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation
WARNING:
To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) before attempting Steering Column Control Module replacement.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system
capacitor to discharge before proceeding. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable, then wait two minutes before proceeding.
2. Place the steering wheel in the straight ahead position.
NOTE:
The front wheels must also be in the straight ahead position.
3. Separate the driver airbag module from the steering wheel but do not disconnect the driver
airbag module squib wires.
CAUTION:
Do not allow the driver airbag module to hang by the squib wires.
NOTE:
Some models use three clips to hold the driver airbag module to the steering wheel (Figure 4).
4. Remove the black electrical tape that holds the two sets of squib wires together (Figure 5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: >
J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6511
5. Inspect the driver airbag module squib wiring orientation going into the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 6):
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the left
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the right side, the Steering Column Control
Module does not require repair. Continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the right
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the left side, the Steering Column Control
Module is defective and must be replaced. Continue with Section C. Replace Steering Column
Control Module.
6. Install the driver airbag module onto the steering wheel.
7. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
8. Install the knee bolster.
9. Connect the negative battery cable.
10. Return the vehicle to the customer.
C. Replace Steering Column Control Module
CAUTION:
The clockspring in the Steering Column Control Module is shipped with the clockspring
pre-centered and with a molded plastic locking pin installed. This locking pin must not be removed
until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering column (Step 20).
1. Disconnect the driver airbag module wires and place the module aside.
2. Disconnect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
3. Remove the steering wheel retaining bolt.
4. Remove the steering wheel from the steering shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: >
J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6512
5. Move the steering column to the fully lowered position.
6. Remove the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the steering
column bracket.
7. Pull the Steering Column Control Module away from the steering column far enough to access
and disconnect the three instrument panel wire
harness connectors from the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control Module case.
8. Remove the Steering Column Control Module from the steering column.
9. Transfer the right multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 7).
10. Transfer the left multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 8).
11. Transfer the multi-function switch jumper harness from the old Steering Column Control Module
onto the new Steering Column Control Module
(Figure 8).
CAUTION:
Make sure that the jumper wire connectors are locked in place by gently pulling on them.
12. Carefully slide the Steering Column Control Module down over the steering column upper shaft
far enough to reconnect the three instrument
panel wire harness connectors to the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control
Module case.
13. Position the Steering Column Control Module onto the steering column bracket.
14. Install and tighten the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the
steering column bracket to 27 in. lbs. (3 N.m) in the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: >
J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6513
following sequence:
> Lower right screw
> Upper left screw
> Upper right screw
CAUTION:
Use of an improper sequence when tightening the Steering Column Control Module mounting
screws may result in an audible ticking noise as the steering wheel is rotated.
15. Install the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column.
16 Install the knee bolster.
17. Move the steering column back to the fully raised position and move the tilt release lever to the
locked position.
18. Install the steering wheel onto the steering column.
19. Install the steering wheel retaining bolt and tighten bolt to 45 ft. lbs. (61 N.m).
20. Remove the plastic locking pin that secures the clockspring rotor to the Steering Column
Control Module case.
21. Connect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
22. Connect the squib connectors to the driver airbag module.
23. Install the driver airbag module to the steering wheel.
24. Perform the Supplemental Restraints Verification Test below:
a. Connect the scan tool to the 16-way data link connector located on the driver's side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
b. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position and exit the vehicle with the scan tool.
c. Check and make certain that nobody is in the vehicle, then reconnect the negative battery cable.
d. Using the scan tool, read and record active and historical Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
e. Use the scan tool to erase the stored DTC's.
f. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position for about 15 seconds, and then back to the "ON" position.
Observe the airbag indicator lamp in the instrument cluster. It should light for six to eight seconds
and then go out. This indicates that the SRS is functioning normally and that the repairs are
complete.
g. Remove the scan tool from the vehicle.
h. Return the vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: >
J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6514
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
Technical Service Bulletin # J13 Date: 090609
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
May 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J13 Steering Column Control Module
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 09, 2009 through February 24,
2009 (MDH 020916 through 022417).
2009 (JK) Jeep(R) Wrangler
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 10, 2009 through February 26,
2009 (MDH 021008 through 022608).
2009 (WK) Jeep(R) Grand Cherokee
(XK) Jeep(R) Commander
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 19, 2009 through February 25,
2009 (MDH 021910 through 022509).
IMPORTANT:
Many of the vehicles within the above build period have already been inspected or repaired and,
therefore, have been excluded from this recall.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Steering Column Control Module (SCCM) on about 4,300 of the above vehicles may have the
squib connector wiring reversed for the driver airbag module. This could cause the driver side
airbag not to deploy as intended and increase the risk of injury during a crash.
Repair
The Steering Column Control Module build date code must be inspected on all vehicles. Those
vehicles that have Steering Column Control Modules with a Julian date code of 0409, 0419, or
0429 must receive an additional inspection on the driver airbag squib wires. Steering Column
Control Modules with suspect driver airbag squib wires must be replace.
Alternate Transportation
Dealers should attempt to minimize customer inconvenience by placing the owner in a loaner
vehicle if inspection determines that Steering Column Control Module replacement is required and
the vehicle must be held overnight.
Parts Information
There will be no initial parts distribution. Parts should only be ordered after inspection determines
the need for replacement.
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6520
The special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6521
approaches for this recall. This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special
equipment and is a Chrysler Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
A. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Data Label
1. Turn the steering wheel to the 6 o'clock position (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6522
2. Unsnap the knee bolster at the top of the bolster and allow it to hinge downward (Figure 2).
3. Remove the upper and lower plastic steering column shrouds.
4. Inspect the first four digits of the Julian data code (disregard the fifth digit) on the label located
on the bottom of the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 3) for the following:
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is 0409, 0419, or 0429 continue with Section B.
Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation.
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is not 0409, 0419, or 0429 the Steering Column
Control Module does not require further inspection or replacement. Continue with Step 5 of this
procedure.
5. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
6. Install the knee bolster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6523
7. Return the vehicle to the customer.
B. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation
WARNING:
To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) before attempting Steering Column Control Module replacement.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system
capacitor to discharge before proceeding. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable, then wait two minutes before proceeding.
2. Place the steering wheel in the straight ahead position.
NOTE:
The front wheels must also be in the straight ahead position.
3. Separate the driver airbag module from the steering wheel but do not disconnect the driver
airbag module squib wires.
CAUTION:
Do not allow the driver airbag module to hang by the squib wires.
NOTE:
Some models use three clips to hold the driver airbag module to the steering wheel (Figure 4).
4. Remove the black electrical tape that holds the two sets of squib wires together (Figure 5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6524
5. Inspect the driver airbag module squib wiring orientation going into the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 6):
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the left
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the right side, the Steering Column Control
Module does not require repair. Continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the right
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the left side, the Steering Column Control
Module is defective and must be replaced. Continue with Section C. Replace Steering Column
Control Module.
6. Install the driver airbag module onto the steering wheel.
7. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
8. Install the knee bolster.
9. Connect the negative battery cable.
10. Return the vehicle to the customer.
C. Replace Steering Column Control Module
CAUTION:
The clockspring in the Steering Column Control Module is shipped with the clockspring
pre-centered and with a molded plastic locking pin installed. This locking pin must not be removed
until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering column (Step 20).
1. Disconnect the driver airbag module wires and place the module aside.
2. Disconnect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
3. Remove the steering wheel retaining bolt.
4. Remove the steering wheel from the steering shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6525
5. Move the steering column to the fully lowered position.
6. Remove the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the steering
column bracket.
7. Pull the Steering Column Control Module away from the steering column far enough to access
and disconnect the three instrument panel wire
harness connectors from the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control Module case.
8. Remove the Steering Column Control Module from the steering column.
9. Transfer the right multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 7).
10. Transfer the left multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 8).
11. Transfer the multi-function switch jumper harness from the old Steering Column Control Module
onto the new Steering Column Control Module
(Figure 8).
CAUTION:
Make sure that the jumper wire connectors are locked in place by gently pulling on them.
12. Carefully slide the Steering Column Control Module down over the steering column upper shaft
far enough to reconnect the three instrument
panel wire harness connectors to the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control
Module case.
13. Position the Steering Column Control Module onto the steering column bracket.
14. Install and tighten the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the
steering column bracket to 27 in. lbs. (3 N.m) in the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6526
following sequence:
> Lower right screw
> Upper left screw
> Upper right screw
CAUTION:
Use of an improper sequence when tightening the Steering Column Control Module mounting
screws may result in an audible ticking noise as the steering wheel is rotated.
15. Install the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column.
16 Install the knee bolster.
17. Move the steering column back to the fully raised position and move the tilt release lever to the
locked position.
18. Install the steering wheel onto the steering column.
19. Install the steering wheel retaining bolt and tighten bolt to 45 ft. lbs. (61 N.m).
20. Remove the plastic locking pin that secures the clockspring rotor to the Steering Column
Control Module case.
21. Connect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
22. Connect the squib connectors to the driver airbag module.
23. Install the driver airbag module to the steering wheel.
24. Perform the Supplemental Restraints Verification Test below:
a. Connect the scan tool to the 16-way data link connector located on the driver's side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
b. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position and exit the vehicle with the scan tool.
c. Check and make certain that nobody is in the vehicle, then reconnect the negative battery cable.
d. Using the scan tool, read and record active and historical Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
e. Use the scan tool to erase the stored DTC's.
f. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position for about 15 seconds, and then back to the "ON" position.
Observe the airbag indicator lamp in the instrument cluster. It should light for six to eight seconds
and then go out. This indicates that the SRS is functioning normally and that the repairs are
complete.
g. Remove the scan tool from the vehicle.
h. Return the vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Column
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering
Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6527
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6531
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6
Way
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C2
(Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector C2 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6
Way > Page 6534
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C3
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C3 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6
Way > Page 6535
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C4
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C4 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6
Way > Page 6536
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C8
(Steering Wheel) 6 Way
Connector C8 - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module Description
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Control Module (SCM) that is internal to the left
multi-function switch housing (2). The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side
of the steering column, just below the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the
interior and exterior lighting systems. The only visible components of the switch are the control
stalk (1), control knob and control sleeve that extend through the steering column shrouds on the
left side of the column. The remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions and electrical
connections are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing and controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A single screw (7)
through a mounting tab integral to the back of the switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the
bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the mounting bracket integral to the clockspring
(3). A connector receptacle containing seven terminal pins is integral to the inboard end of the
switch housing and connects the SCM through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the right
(wiper) multi-function switch (6). A second connector receptacle containing four terminal pins is
integral to the back of the switch housing and connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system
through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The SCM cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged the entire left multi-function
switch must be replaced. See: Lighting and Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and
Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left Multifunction Switch - Removal. The
clockspring (with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the
SCM), the right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate
service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module Description > Page 6539
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module Description > Page 6540
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Column Control Module (SCCM). The SCCM is secured
near the top of the steering column below the steering wheel and is completely concealed beneath
the steering column shrouds. It is installed as a modular unit that supports the left (lighting)
multi-function switch (1) and right (wiper) multi-function switch (6). The controls for each of these
switches extend through appropriate clearance holes provided in the steering column shrouds.
The microprocessor-based Steering Control Module (SCM) (2) utilizes integrated circuitry and
information carried on the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus along with several hard wired
analog and multiplexed inputs to monitor both the right and left multi-function switches. The SCCM
uses a Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data bus for exterior lighting and wiper functions. The LIN
data is sent to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN then sends it out on the CAN data
bus See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Description
and Operation/Communication - Description. The SCCM is available for service replacement as a
unit or each individual component:
- Clockspring (with integral Steering Angle Sensor if equipped)
- Left Multi-Function Switch (with integral Steering Control Module)
- Right Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module Description > Page 6541
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6542
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Testing and Inspection
STEERING CONTROL MODULE
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
The hard wired circuits between components related to the Steering Control Module (SCM) may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair
procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector pin-out information and
location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the SCM or
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices that provide some
features of the SCM. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM or the
electronic controls and communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module Removal
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Removal
REMOVAL
SCCM
1. Place the front road wheels in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. 2. Open hood. 3. Disconnect
and isolate the battery negative cable.
WARNING: Wait two minutes for the airbag system reserve capacitor to discharge before
beginning any airbag system or component service.
Failure to do so may result in accidental airbag deployment, personal injury or death.
4. Remove steering wheel See: Steering Wheel/Service and Repair/Removal. 5. Remove upper
and lower steering column shrouds to gain access to the Steering Column Control Module
(SCCM)See: Steering Column/Steering
Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal.
6. Lock the clockspring rotor in the center position as follows: Insert a grenade pin through the hole
in the rotor at the 10 o'clock position. 7. Remove the three screws (1) to the Steering Column
Control Module (SCCM) (3).
8. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) between the SCCM (1) and the instrument panel wiring
harness at the base of the SCCM and remove from
column.
NOTE: If only removing the SCCM from column, there is no need to continue to next step.
DISASSEMBLY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module Removal > Page 6545
1. Remove the left multi-function switch stalk retaining screw (2). 2. Pull the left stalk out of the
SCCM.
3. Disconnect the left stalk electrical connector. 4. Separate the left switch from the SCCM.
5. Remove the one right multi-function switch retaining screw. 6. Pull right switch out of SCCM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module Removal > Page 6546
7. Disconnect the right switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module Removal > Page 6547
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If SCCM is already assembled and needs to be installed, bypass ASSEMBLY and proceed
with SCCM 1.
ASSEMBLY
1. Connect the right stalk electrical connector.
2. Slide the right stalk into the groove and install the one retaining screw.
3. Connect the left stalk switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module Removal > Page 6548
4. Install the left stalk switch retaining screw.
SCCM
1. Position the SCCM (3) over the steering column shaft (2). 2. Install the three screws (1).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the instrument panel harness, ensure wiring is properly
routed. Then check that the connectors, locking
tabs are properly engaged.
4. Install steering column shrouds See: Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation. Be sure
all wires are inside of shrouds.
5. Install steering wheel ensuring the flats on hub align with the clockspring See: Steering
Wheel/Service and Repair/Installation. Pull the airbag
leads through the larger slot. Ensure leads do not get pinched under the steering wheel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Relays and Modules - Steering > Steering Mounted
Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module Removal > Page 6549
NOTE: There is a small wire harness in the steering wheel and it contains the horn circuits and
speed control circuits.
6. Connect the speed control and horn wire connector into the clockspring. 7. Pull the grenade pin
out of the clockspring. 8. Install the driver airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air
Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation
WARNING: Do not connect the negative battery cable at this time. Perform the Air Bag System
Test prior to connecting the negative battery
cable See: Restraint Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
Failure to follow this warning may result in accidental air bag deployment and possible serious or
fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 >
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
Technical Service Bulletin # J13 Date: 090609
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
May 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J13 Steering Column Control Module
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 09, 2009 through February 24,
2009 (MDH 020916 through 022417).
2009 (JK) Jeep(R) Wrangler
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 10, 2009 through February 26,
2009 (MDH 021008 through 022608).
2009 (WK) Jeep(R) Grand Cherokee
(XK) Jeep(R) Commander
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 19, 2009 through February 25,
2009 (MDH 021910 through 022509).
IMPORTANT:
Many of the vehicles within the above build period have already been inspected or repaired and,
therefore, have been excluded from this recall.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Steering Column Control Module (SCCM) on about 4,300 of the above vehicles may have the
squib connector wiring reversed for the driver airbag module. This could cause the driver side
airbag not to deploy as intended and increase the risk of injury during a crash.
Repair
The Steering Column Control Module build date code must be inspected on all vehicles. Those
vehicles that have Steering Column Control Modules with a Julian date code of 0409, 0419, or
0429 must receive an additional inspection on the driver airbag squib wires. Steering Column
Control Modules with suspect driver airbag squib wires must be replace.
Alternate Transportation
Dealers should attempt to minimize customer inconvenience by placing the owner in a loaner
vehicle if inspection determines that Steering Column Control Module replacement is required and
the vehicle must be held overnight.
Parts Information
There will be no initial parts distribution. Parts should only be ordered after inspection determines
the need for replacement.
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 >
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6559
The special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 >
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6560
approaches for this recall. This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special
equipment and is a Chrysler Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
A. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Data Label
1. Turn the steering wheel to the 6 o'clock position (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 >
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6561
2. Unsnap the knee bolster at the top of the bolster and allow it to hinge downward (Figure 2).
3. Remove the upper and lower plastic steering column shrouds.
4. Inspect the first four digits of the Julian data code (disregard the fifth digit) on the label located
on the bottom of the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 3) for the following:
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is 0409, 0419, or 0429 continue with Section B.
Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation.
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is not 0409, 0419, or 0429 the Steering Column
Control Module does not require further inspection or replacement. Continue with Step 5 of this
procedure.
5. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
6. Install the knee bolster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 >
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6562
7. Return the vehicle to the customer.
B. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation
WARNING:
To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) before attempting Steering Column Control Module replacement.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system
capacitor to discharge before proceeding. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable, then wait two minutes before proceeding.
2. Place the steering wheel in the straight ahead position.
NOTE:
The front wheels must also be in the straight ahead position.
3. Separate the driver airbag module from the steering wheel but do not disconnect the driver
airbag module squib wires.
CAUTION:
Do not allow the driver airbag module to hang by the squib wires.
NOTE:
Some models use three clips to hold the driver airbag module to the steering wheel (Figure 4).
4. Remove the black electrical tape that holds the two sets of squib wires together (Figure 5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 >
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6563
5. Inspect the driver airbag module squib wiring orientation going into the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 6):
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the left
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the right side, the Steering Column Control
Module does not require repair. Continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the right
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the left side, the Steering Column Control
Module is defective and must be replaced. Continue with Section C. Replace Steering Column
Control Module.
6. Install the driver airbag module onto the steering wheel.
7. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
8. Install the knee bolster.
9. Connect the negative battery cable.
10. Return the vehicle to the customer.
C. Replace Steering Column Control Module
CAUTION:
The clockspring in the Steering Column Control Module is shipped with the clockspring
pre-centered and with a molded plastic locking pin installed. This locking pin must not be removed
until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering column (Step 20).
1. Disconnect the driver airbag module wires and place the module aside.
2. Disconnect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
3. Remove the steering wheel retaining bolt.
4. Remove the steering wheel from the steering shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 >
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6564
5. Move the steering column to the fully lowered position.
6. Remove the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the steering
column bracket.
7. Pull the Steering Column Control Module away from the steering column far enough to access
and disconnect the three instrument panel wire
harness connectors from the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control Module case.
8. Remove the Steering Column Control Module from the steering column.
9. Transfer the right multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 7).
10. Transfer the left multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 8).
11. Transfer the multi-function switch jumper harness from the old Steering Column Control Module
onto the new Steering Column Control Module
(Figure 8).
CAUTION:
Make sure that the jumper wire connectors are locked in place by gently pulling on them.
12. Carefully slide the Steering Column Control Module down over the steering column upper shaft
far enough to reconnect the three instrument
panel wire harness connectors to the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control
Module case.
13. Position the Steering Column Control Module onto the steering column bracket.
14. Install and tighten the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the
steering column bracket to 27 in. lbs. (3 N.m) in the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 >
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6565
following sequence:
> Lower right screw
> Upper left screw
> Upper right screw
CAUTION:
Use of an improper sequence when tightening the Steering Column Control Module mounting
screws may result in an audible ticking noise as the steering wheel is rotated.
15. Install the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column.
16 Install the knee bolster.
17. Move the steering column back to the fully raised position and move the tilt release lever to the
locked position.
18. Install the steering wheel onto the steering column.
19. Install the steering wheel retaining bolt and tighten bolt to 45 ft. lbs. (61 N.m).
20. Remove the plastic locking pin that secures the clockspring rotor to the Steering Column
Control Module case.
21. Connect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
22. Connect the squib connectors to the driver airbag module.
23. Install the driver airbag module to the steering wheel.
24. Perform the Supplemental Restraints Verification Test below:
a. Connect the scan tool to the 16-way data link connector located on the driver's side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
b. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position and exit the vehicle with the scan tool.
c. Check and make certain that nobody is in the vehicle, then reconnect the negative battery cable.
d. Using the scan tool, read and record active and historical Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
e. Use the scan tool to erase the stored DTC's.
f. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position for about 15 seconds, and then back to the "ON" position.
Observe the airbag indicator lamp in the instrument cluster. It should light for six to eight seconds
and then go out. This indicates that the SRS is functioning normally and that the repairs are
complete.
g. Remove the scan tool from the vehicle.
h. Return the vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Steering Column Control Module: > J13 > Jun > 09 >
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6566
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module:
> J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
Technical Service Bulletin # J13 Date: 090609
Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect
May 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J13 Steering Column Control Module
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 09, 2009 through February 24,
2009 (MDH 020916 through 022417).
2009 (JK) Jeep(R) Wrangler
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 10, 2009 through February 26,
2009 (MDH 021008 through 022608).
2009 (WK) Jeep(R) Grand Cherokee
(XK) Jeep(R) Commander
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from February 19, 2009 through February 25,
2009 (MDH 021910 through 022509).
IMPORTANT:
Many of the vehicles within the above build period have already been inspected or repaired and,
therefore, have been excluded from this recall.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Steering Column Control Module (SCCM) on about 4,300 of the above vehicles may have the
squib connector wiring reversed for the driver airbag module. This could cause the driver side
airbag not to deploy as intended and increase the risk of injury during a crash.
Repair
The Steering Column Control Module build date code must be inspected on all vehicles. Those
vehicles that have Steering Column Control Modules with a Julian date code of 0409, 0419, or
0429 must receive an additional inspection on the driver airbag squib wires. Steering Column
Control Modules with suspect driver airbag squib wires must be replace.
Alternate Transportation
Dealers should attempt to minimize customer inconvenience by placing the owner in a loaner
vehicle if inspection determines that Steering Column Control Module replacement is required and
the vehicle must be held overnight.
Parts Information
There will be no initial parts distribution. Parts should only be ordered after inspection determines
the need for replacement.
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module:
> J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6572
The special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module:
> J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6573
approaches for this recall. This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special
equipment and is a Chrysler Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
A. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Data Label
1. Turn the steering wheel to the 6 o'clock position (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module:
> J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6574
2. Unsnap the knee bolster at the top of the bolster and allow it to hinge downward (Figure 2).
3. Remove the upper and lower plastic steering column shrouds.
4. Inspect the first four digits of the Julian data code (disregard the fifth digit) on the label located
on the bottom of the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 3) for the following:
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is 0409, 0419, or 0429 continue with Section B.
Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation.
> If the Julian date code on the bar code data label is not 0409, 0419, or 0429 the Steering Column
Control Module does not require further inspection or replacement. Continue with Step 5 of this
procedure.
5. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
6. Install the knee bolster.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module:
> J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6575
7. Return the vehicle to the customer.
B. Inspect Steering Column Control Module Wiring Orientation
WARNING:
To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) before attempting Steering Column Control Module replacement.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system
capacitor to discharge before proceeding. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable, then wait two minutes before proceeding.
2. Place the steering wheel in the straight ahead position.
NOTE:
The front wheels must also be in the straight ahead position.
3. Separate the driver airbag module from the steering wheel but do not disconnect the driver
airbag module squib wires.
CAUTION:
Do not allow the driver airbag module to hang by the squib wires.
NOTE:
Some models use three clips to hold the driver airbag module to the steering wheel (Figure 4).
4. Remove the black electrical tape that holds the two sets of squib wires together (Figure 5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module:
> J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6576
5. Inspect the driver airbag module squib wiring orientation going into the Steering Column Control
Module (Figure 6):
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the left
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the right side, the Steering Column Control
Module does not require repair. Continue with Step 6 of this procedure.
> If the pair of red and blue wires going into the Steering Column Control Module enter on the right
side and the pair of yellow and brown wires enter on the left side, the Steering Column Control
Module is defective and must be replaced. Continue with Section C. Replace Steering Column
Control Module.
6. Install the driver airbag module onto the steering wheel.
7. Install the steering column cover shrouds.
8. Install the knee bolster.
9. Connect the negative battery cable.
10. Return the vehicle to the customer.
C. Replace Steering Column Control Module
CAUTION:
The clockspring in the Steering Column Control Module is shipped with the clockspring
pre-centered and with a molded plastic locking pin installed. This locking pin must not be removed
until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering column (Step 20).
1. Disconnect the driver airbag module wires and place the module aside.
2. Disconnect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
3. Remove the steering wheel retaining bolt.
4. Remove the steering wheel from the steering shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module:
> J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6577
5. Move the steering column to the fully lowered position.
6. Remove the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the steering
column bracket.
7. Pull the Steering Column Control Module away from the steering column far enough to access
and disconnect the three instrument panel wire
harness connectors from the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control Module case.
8. Remove the Steering Column Control Module from the steering column.
9. Transfer the right multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 7).
10. Transfer the left multi-function switch from the old Steering Column Control Module to the new
Steering Column Control Module (Figure 8).
11. Transfer the multi-function switch jumper harness from the old Steering Column Control Module
onto the new Steering Column Control Module
(Figure 8).
CAUTION:
Make sure that the jumper wire connectors are locked in place by gently pulling on them.
12. Carefully slide the Steering Column Control Module down over the steering column upper shaft
far enough to reconnect the three instrument
panel wire harness connectors to the receptacles on the back of the Steering Column Control
Module case.
13. Position the Steering Column Control Module onto the steering column bracket.
14. Install and tighten the three screws that secure the Steering Column Control Module to the
steering column bracket to 27 in. lbs. (3 N.m) in the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module:
> J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6578
following sequence:
> Lower right screw
> Upper left screw
> Upper right screw
CAUTION:
Use of an improper sequence when tightening the Steering Column Control Module mounting
screws may result in an audible ticking noise as the steering wheel is rotated.
15. Install the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column.
16 Install the knee bolster.
17. Move the steering column back to the fully raised position and move the tilt release lever to the
locked position.
18. Install the steering wheel onto the steering column.
19. Install the steering wheel retaining bolt and tighten bolt to 45 ft. lbs. (61 N.m).
20. Remove the plastic locking pin that secures the clockspring rotor to the Steering Column
Control Module case.
21. Connect the white steering wheel wiring connector.
22. Connect the squib connectors to the driver airbag module.
23. Install the driver airbag module to the steering wheel.
24. Perform the Supplemental Restraints Verification Test below:
a. Connect the scan tool to the 16-way data link connector located on the driver's side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
b. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position and exit the vehicle with the scan tool.
c. Check and make certain that nobody is in the vehicle, then reconnect the negative battery cable.
d. Using the scan tool, read and record active and historical Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
e. Use the scan tool to erase the stored DTC's.
f. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position for about 15 seconds, and then back to the "ON" position.
Observe the airbag indicator lamp in the instrument cluster. It should light for six to eight seconds
and then go out. This indicates that the SRS is functioning normally and that the repairs are
complete.
g. Remove the scan tool from the vehicle.
h. Return the vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Control Module:
> J13 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Steering Column Control Module Defect > Page 6579
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Shroud - Removal
Steering Column Cover: Service and Repair Steering Column Shroud - Removal
Upper
REMOVAL
1. Position the column tilt at the full-upward position. 2. Remove the steering column opening
cover, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Opening Cover - Removal.
3. Remove the steering column cover reinforcement mounting screws (2). Remove the steering
column cover reinforcement (1).
4. Position the column tilt at the full-downward position. Leave the tilt lever (2) in the released
position. 5. Remove the screws (1) attaching the lower shroud. After removing the screws, un-clip
the shrouds from one another by applying hand pressure
along the seams where the shrouds connect on the sides.
6. Remove the lower shroud.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Shroud - Removal > Page 6584
NOTE: The gap hider on the upper shroud is attached to the instrument cluster (1) by four retaining
tabs (2) along the top and two along the
sides (one each side). These tabs can be easily released by hand in the following step. Do not use
a tool that could damage the gap hider.
7. Pull the column outward to the full-extended position. 8. Reach up behind the shroud gap hider
(1) and release the two side and four upper tabs retaining the shroud gap hider to the instrument
cluster (2). 9. Remove the upper shroud from the column.
Lower
REMOVAL
1. Position the column tilt at the full-upward position. 2. Remove the steering column opening
cover, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Opening Cover - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Shroud - Removal > Page 6585
3. Remove the steering column cover reinforcement mounting screws (2). Remove the steering
column cover reinforcement (1).
4. Position the column tilt at the full-downward position. Leave the tilt lever (2) in the released
position. 5. Remove the screws (1) attaching the lower shroud. After removing the screws, un-clip
the shrouds from one another by applying hand pressure
along the seams where the shrouds connect on the sides.
6. Remove the lower shroud.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Shroud - Removal > Page 6586
Steering Column Cover: Service and Repair Steering Column Shroud - Installation
Upper
INSTALLATION
1. Position the upper shroud over the steering column. 2. Align the four upper shroud gap hider
retaining tabs (2) with the mounting holes in the instrument cluster (1), then push the tabs upward,
securing
the shroud.
3. Align the two shroud gap hider side retaining tabs (one each side) with the mounting holes, then
push the tabs into place, securing the shroud.
4. Push the column tilt lever (2) downward (released position). 5. Install the lower shroud (2) over
the tilt lever and onto the column. 6. Install the upper shroud onto the lower shroud, clipping the
shrouds to one another. 7. Install the three screws (1) attaching the lower shroud to the steering
column. 8. Position the column tilt (5) at the full-upward position. 9. Push the tilt lever upward,
locking the column in place.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Shroud - Removal > Page 6587
10. Install the steering column cover reinforcement (1) using the four mounting screws (2). 11.
Install the steering column opening cover, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Opening Cover - Installation.
Lower
INSTALLATION
1. Push the tilt lever (2) downward (released position). 2. Install the lower shroud (2) over the tilt
lever and onto the column. 3. Install the upper shroud onto the lower shroud, clipping the shrouds
to one another. 4. Install the three screws (1) attaching the lower shroud to the steering column. 5.
Position the column tilt (5) at the full-upward position. 6. Push the tilt lever upward, locking the
column in place.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Shroud - Removal > Page 6588
7. Install the steering column cover reinforcement (1) using the four mounting screws (2). 8. Install
the steering column opening cover, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Opening Cover - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6592
Steering Column Lock: Diagrams
Connector (VTSA) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING COLUMN-LOCK (VTSA) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Shaft Lock Module - Description
Steering Column Lock: Description and Operation Shaft Lock Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
A shaft lock module (1) is part of the premium version of the Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS)
in the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS). The premium version of the SKIS is only available in
vehicles built for certain markets, where the additional features offered by this system are required.
The shaft lock module is located in a bracket integral to the lower end of the steering column
housing casting below the instrument panel in the passenger compartment. This unit is designed to
work in conjunction with the Wireless Ignition Node (WIN), sometimes referred to as the Sentry Key
REmote Entry Module (SKREEM) to control a locking bolt (2) that engages a machined slot in the
steering shaft to prevent shaft rotation whenever there is not a valid key present in the ignition lock
cylinder on the instrument panel.
Concealed within the module is the electronic circuitry of the module, and a bi-directional electric
motor that actuates the locking bolt. The module is connected to the vehicle electrical system
through the instrument panel wire harness.
The mounting provisions for the shaft lock module are designed to resist unauthorized tampering.
The module cannot be removed from the steering column while the locking bolt is in the locked
position, or while the steering column is installed in the vehicle. The shaft lock module unit cannot
be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire steering column must be
replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Shaft Lock Module - Description > Page 6595
Steering Column Lock: Description and Operation Shaft Lock Module - Operation
OPERATION
The electronic circuitry within the shaft lock module contains all of the logic circuits and
components to monitor and control the operation of the shaft locking bolt. The module uses a serial
data bus for bi-directional communication with the Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) , sometimes
referred to as the Sentry Key REmote Entry Module (SKREEM). If the module detects a problem
with the positioning or operation of the locking bolt, it sends an error message to the WIN. The WIN
then stores a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and sends an electronic error message to the
Instrument Cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN), over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The shaft lock module continuously monitors inputs from the WIN and energizes the electric motor
to move the locking bolt to the locked or unlocked position based upon that input. If the WIN
indicates that the key present in the ignition lock cylinder is invalid, the locking bolt remains in the
locked position. When the WIN indicates that a valid key is present in the ignition lock cylinder, the
shaft lock module operates a motor to move the locking bolt to the unlocked position. However, to
prevent inadvertent column locking due to a failure while the vehicle is being operated, the module
cannot move the locking bolt from the unlocked position to the locked position as long as a key
remains in the ignition lock cylinder.
The shaft lock module receives ground at all times through a hard wired remote ground point. The
module receives battery voltage to operate and to move the locking bolt in the unlocked direction
on a B(+) circuit, and receives battery voltage to operate the locking bolt in the locked direction only
when the key is removed from the ignition switch. These connections allow the module to remain
operational, regardless of the ignition switch position.
For added system security, the shaft lock module learns a unique Secret Key code from the WIN
over the serial data bus upon initialization. This code is stored in the memory of the module and
cannot be changed. Therefore, if the WIN requires service replacement, a new shaft lock module
will also be required. Another security code, called a PIN, is used to gain access to the WIN
Secured Access Mode. The Secured Access Mode is required during service to initialize a new
shaft lock module. The shaft lock module is not available for separate service replacement. It is
integral to the steering column so a complete column must be installed if the module is damaged or
inoperative See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Steering Column - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Shaft Lock Module - Removal
Steering Column Lock: Service and Repair Shaft Lock Module - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: The shaft lock module cannot be removed from the steering column while the locking bolt is
in the locked position without irreversibly
damaging the column. Before attempting service, insert a valid FOB with Integrated Key (FOBIK)
into the ignition switch, then rotate the steering wheel from side to side. If the steering wheel can be
rotated, the locking bolt is in the unlocked position. Leave the FOBIK in the ignition switch until
service has been completed. If the steering wheel cannot be rotated, test and repair the wiring
circuits between the module and the ignition switch as required. If no problem is found in these
circuits, the module has failed with the locking bolt in the locked position and both the module and
the steering column must be replaced with new units.
1. Insert a FOB with Integrated Key (FOBIK) into the ignition switch to move the shaft lock module
locking bolt to the unlocked position. Leave the
FOBIK in the ignition switch while the shaft lock module service is being completed.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire
harness connector (3) from the shaft lock module (2) connector receptacle. 4. Remove the steering
column from the vehicle. See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Steering Column Removal. 5. Depress the two spring clips that secure the shaft lock module to the mounting bracket
on the steering column by inserting a suitable drift or punch
into the release holes (1) on the upper surface of the bracket opposite the module.
6. While holding both of the spring clips depressed, slide the module toward the base of the column
far enough to disengage the engagement tabs and
slide tabs on the module from the slots and channels in the bracket.
7. Remove the module from the steering column bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Shaft Lock Module - Removal > Page 6598
Steering Column Lock: Service and Repair Shaft Lock Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Be certain that a valid FOB with Integrated Key (FOBIK) is still present in the ignition switch.
Leave the FOBIK in the ignition switch while the
shaft lock module service is being completed.
2. Align the engagement and slide tabs integral to the housing of the shaft lock module (1) with the
slots and channels in the mounting bracket (3) on
the steering column.
3. Slide the module toward the top of the column far enough for the spring clips (2) on the module
to engage the bracket. 4. Reinstall the steering column into the vehicle. See: Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Steering Column - Installation. 5. Reconnect the instrument
panel wire harness connector to the shaft lock module connector receptacle. 6. Reconnect the
battery negative cable.
NOTE: If the shaft lock module has been replaced with a new unit, the Wireless Ignition Node
(WIN) MUST also be replaced. See: Powertrain
Management/Ignition System/Sensors and Switches - Ignition System/Ignition Switch/Service and
Repair/Wireless Ignition Node Receiver - Removal . Also, a diagnostic scan tool MUST be used to
initialize the new module before the vehicle can be operated. .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Steering Gear: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The steering gear (2) used is the rack-and-pinion type with power assist. It is mounted on the front
suspension crossmember. The outer ends of the outer tie rods attach to the front (steering)
knuckles.
NOTE: The power steering gear should not be serviced or adjusted. If a malfunction or oil leak
occurs with the steering gear, the complete
steering gear needs to be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 6602
Steering Gear: Testing and Inspection
POWER STEERING GEAR
NOTE: This information is designed to be used in conjunction with the diagnostic charts at the
beginning of the Steering section. See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
OBJECTIONABLE HISS OR WHISTLE POSSIBLY CAUSED BY A NOISY STEERING GEAR
1. Check and adjust power steering fluid level in the reservoir as necessary. See: Service and
Repair/Power Steering Fluid Level Checking 2. Start the vehicle and heat system by steering
lock-to-lock 5 times with the engine running at 3000 rpm. Do not hold the gear against the stops for
more than 5 seconds at a time.
3. Return the engine to idle speed. 4. Listen for the noise when turning the wheel slowly off center
during a dry park maneuver. 5. Replace power steering gear if the hiss or whistle is present. See:
Service and Repair/Steering Gear - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Steering Gear - Removal
LEFT-HAND DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions .
1. Siphon out as much power steering fluid as possible from the reservoir.
2. Place the front wheels of vehicle (and steering wheel) in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. Using
a steering wheel holder, lock the steering wheel
in place to keep it from rotating. This keeps the clockspring in the proper orientation while the
intermediate shaft is disconnected.
3. Reposition the floor carpeting and sound deadening insulation to access the intermediate shaft
coupling (1) at the base of the column. 4. Remove the intermediate shaft coupling bolt (2). 5.
Separate the intermediate shaft coupling (1) from the steering gear pinion shaft (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6605
6. Release the clips securing the dash seal to the dash panel and push the seal away from the
dash panel.
7. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance 8. On each side of the vehicle, remove the
wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
9. On each side of the gear, remove the nut (3) from the out tie rod end (6) at the knuckle (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6606
10. On each side of the gear, separate the outer tie rod end (1) from the knuckle (3) using Remover
(2), Special Tool 9360.
11. If equipped, remove the engine belly pan.
12. Remove the rear engine mount through-bolt (1).
13. Remove the front engine mount through-bolt (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6607
14. Remove the screws (1) securing the power steering hose routing clamps (2) to the rear of the
crossmember.
15. Unscrew the tube nut (2), then remove the return hose (1) at the steering gear. 16. Unscrew the
tube nut (3), then remove the pressure hose (4) at the steering gear.
NOTE: Before lowering the front suspension crossmember, the location of the crossmember must
be marked on the body of the vehicle. Do
this so the crossmember can be relocated, upon reinstallation, against the body of vehicle in the
same location as before removal. If the front suspension crossmember is not reinstalled in exactly
the same location as before removal, the preset front wheel alignment settings (caster and camber)
may be lost.
17. Using a crayon or marker (2) that will not break the paint surface, mark the location of the front
crossmember (1) on the body near each mounting
bolt. Do not use any type of sharp instrument that will damage the underbody of the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6608
18. Support the crossmember (9) with a transmission jack. 19. Remove the four mounting bolts (6)
securing the front crossmember (9) to the body. 20. Remove the mounting screws (8) securing the
front crossmember reinforcement brackets (7) (one each side of vehicle) to the body (1). Remove
the brackets.
21. Using the jack, slowly lower the crossmember approximately 3 inches (76 mm) (as measured at
the rear crossmember mounts). Do not lower the
crossmember more than necessary as the fore/aft crossmember is still attached to the radiator
support and damage may occur.
22. Remove the screws and push-pins securing the heat shield (1) over the right side of the
steering gear (2). Remove the shield.
23. Remove the two bolts (1) securing the steering gear (2) to the crossmember.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6609
24. Tip the steering gear pinion shaft (3) straight up and remove the dash seal (2) from the steering
gear.
25. Slide the steering gear across the crossmember and out through left wheel opening. 26. If
necessary, remove outer tie rods from inner tie rod threads. Count how many rotations it takes to
remove each outer tie rod for installation
reference.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6610
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Steering Gear - Installation
LEFT-HAND DRIVE
1. If necessary, install the outer tie rods onto the inner tie rod threads. As the outer tie rods are
installed, count out same number rotations as were
counted on tie rod removal. This will get the toe setting somewhat close to specification before the
vehicle is aligned at end of this procedure. Snug the tie rod jam nuts on both ends of gear. Tighten
the tie rod jam nuts to specification while performing the wheel alignment at end of this procedure.
2. Carefully install the steering gear (1) through the left wheel opening using the reverse of how it
was removed. Move it across the crossmember
until centered.
3. Tip the steering gear pinion shaft (3) straight up and install the dash seal (2) matching it to the
contour of the steering gear housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6611
4. Position the steering gear in mounted position on the crossmember. 5. Install the two bolts (1)
securing the steering gear (2) to the crossmember. Tighten the gear mounting bolts to 100 Nm (74
ft. lbs.).
6. Install the heat shield (1) over the steering gear (2). Install the mounting screws and push-pins.
Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (53 in. lbs.).
7. Center the power steering gear rack in its travel as necessary.
NOTE: When installing the front suspension crossmember (1) it is very important that the
crossmember be attached to the body in exactly the
same spot as when it was removed. Otherwise, the vehicle's wheel alignment settings (caster and
camber) will be lost making wheel alignment more difficult.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6612
8. Slowly raise the crossmember (9) into mounted position using the transmission jack matching
the crossmember to the marked locations on the
body made during removal.
9. Position the front crossmember reinforcement brackets (7) (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bushings and install the
mounting screws (8), but do not tighten at this time.
10. Install the four mounting bolts (6) securing the front crossmember (1) to the body. Tighten the
crossmember mounting bolts to 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.).
11. Tighten the crossmember reinforcement bracket mounting screws (8) to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.). 12.
Remove the transmission jack.
13. Install the pressure hose tube (4) at the gear. Tighten the tube nut (3) to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.). 14.
Install the return hose tube (1) at the gear. Tighten the tube nut (2) to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6613
15. Position the power steering hose routing clamps (2) on the crossmember. Install and tighten the
screws to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
16. Install the rear engine mount through-bolt (1).
17. Install the front engine mount through-bolt (1). See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Drive
Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Engine
Mount/Service and Repair/Engine Mount Insulator - Installation
18. If equipped, install the engine belly pan.
NOTE: Prior to attaching the outer tie rod end to the knuckle, inspect the tie rod seal boot. If the
seal boot is damaged, replace the outer tie
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6614
rod end.
19. On each side of the gear, install the outer tie rod end (6) into the hole in the knuckle (2) arm.
Start a NEW tie rod mounting nut (3) onto the stud.
While holding the tie rod end stud with a wrench, tighten the nut with a wrench or crowfoot wrench.
Tighten the nut to 85 Nm (63 ft. lbs.).
20. On each side of the vehicle, install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and
Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and
Wheels - Installation. Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
21. Lower the vehicle.
22. Lift the dash seal into position and engage the retaining clips securing the dash seal to the
dash panel.
23. Remove the steering wheel holder using care not to rotate the steering wheel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear - Removal > Page 6615
24. Verify the front wheels of vehicle are in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. 25. Center the
intermediate shaft coupling (1) over the steering gear pinion shaft (3), then slide the intermediate
shaft onto the steering gear pinion
shaft.
26. Install the intermediate shaft coupling bolt (2). Tighten the bolt to 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.). 27.
Position the sound deadening insulation and floor carpet back into place.
28. Fill and bleed the power steering system. See: Service and Repair/Steering - Power Steering
System Bleeding 29. Check for fluid leaks. 30. Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See:
Alignment/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Locations
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6619
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C2
(Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector C2 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6622
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C3
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C3 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6623
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C4
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C4 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6624
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C8
(Steering Wheel) 6 Way
Connector C8 - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module - Description
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Control Module (SCM) that is internal to the left
multi-function switch housing (2). The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side
of the steering column, just below the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the
interior and exterior lighting systems. The only visible components of the switch are the control
stalk (1), control knob and control sleeve that extend through the steering column shrouds on the
left side of the column. The remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions and electrical
connections are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing and controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A single screw (7)
through a mounting tab integral to the back of the switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the
bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the mounting bracket integral to the clockspring
(3). A connector receptacle containing seven terminal pins is integral to the inboard end of the
switch housing and connects the SCM through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the right
(wiper) multi-function switch (6). A second connector receptacle containing four terminal pins is
integral to the back of the switch housing and connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system
through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The SCM cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged the entire left multi-function
switch must be replaced. See: Lighting and Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and
Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left Multifunction Switch - Removal. The
clockspring (with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the
SCM), the right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate
service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module - Description > Page 6627
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module - Description > Page 6628
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Column Control Module (SCCM). The SCCM is secured
near the top of the steering column below the steering wheel and is completely concealed beneath
the steering column shrouds. It is installed as a modular unit that supports the left (lighting)
multi-function switch (1) and right (wiper) multi-function switch (6). The controls for each of these
switches extend through appropriate clearance holes provided in the steering column shrouds.
The microprocessor-based Steering Control Module (SCM) (2) utilizes integrated circuitry and
information carried on the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus along with several hard wired
analog and multiplexed inputs to monitor both the right and left multi-function switches. The SCCM
uses a Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data bus for exterior lighting and wiper functions. The LIN
data is sent to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN then sends it out on the CAN data
bus See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Description
and Operation/Communication - Description. The SCCM is available for service replacement as a
unit or each individual component:
- Clockspring (with integral Steering Angle Sensor if equipped)
- Left Multi-Function Switch (with integral Steering Control Module)
- Right Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module - Description > Page 6629
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6630
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Testing and Inspection
STEERING CONTROL MODULE
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
The hard wired circuits between components related to the Steering Control Module (SCM) may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair
procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector pin-out information and
location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the SCM or
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices that provide some
features of the SCM. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM or the
electronic controls and communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Removal
REMOVAL
SCCM
1. Place the front road wheels in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. 2. Open hood. 3. Disconnect
and isolate the battery negative cable.
WARNING: Wait two minutes for the airbag system reserve capacitor to discharge before
beginning any airbag system or component service.
Failure to do so may result in accidental airbag deployment, personal injury or death.
4. Remove steering wheel See: Steering Wheel/Service and Repair/Removal. 5. Remove upper
and lower steering column shrouds to gain access to the Steering Column Control Module
(SCCM)See: Steering Column/Steering
Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal.
6. Lock the clockspring rotor in the center position as follows: Insert a grenade pin through the hole
in the rotor at the 10 o'clock position. 7. Remove the three screws (1) to the Steering Column
Control Module (SCCM) (3).
8. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) between the SCCM (1) and the instrument panel wiring
harness at the base of the SCCM and remove from
column.
NOTE: If only removing the SCCM from column, there is no need to continue to next step.
DISASSEMBLY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6633
1. Remove the left multi-function switch stalk retaining screw (2). 2. Pull the left stalk out of the
SCCM.
3. Disconnect the left stalk electrical connector. 4. Separate the left switch from the SCCM.
5. Remove the one right multi-function switch retaining screw. 6. Pull right switch out of SCCM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6634
7. Disconnect the right switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6635
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If SCCM is already assembled and needs to be installed, bypass ASSEMBLY and proceed
with SCCM 1.
ASSEMBLY
1. Connect the right stalk electrical connector.
2. Slide the right stalk into the groove and install the one retaining screw.
3. Connect the left stalk switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6636
4. Install the left stalk switch retaining screw.
SCCM
1. Position the SCCM (3) over the steering column shaft (2). 2. Install the three screws (1).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the instrument panel harness, ensure wiring is properly
routed. Then check that the connectors, locking
tabs are properly engaged.
4. Install steering column shrouds See: Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and
Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation. Be sure
all wires are inside of shrouds.
5. Install steering wheel ensuring the flats on hub align with the clockspring See: Steering
Wheel/Service and Repair/Installation. Pull the airbag
leads through the larger slot. Ensure leads do not get pinched under the steering wheel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 6637
NOTE: There is a small wire harness in the steering wheel and it contains the horn circuits and
speed control circuits.
6. Connect the speed control and horn wire connector into the clockspring. 7. Pull the grenade pin
out of the clockspring. 8. Install the driver airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air
Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation
WARNING: Do not connect the negative battery cable at this time. Perform the Air Bag System
Test prior to connecting the negative battery
cable See: Restraint Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
Failure to follow this warning may result in accidental air bag deployment and possible serious or
fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal
Steering Wheel: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING:
Do not place a non-deployed airbag face down on a hard surface. The airbag will propel into the air
if accidentally deployed. Failure to follow this instruction may result in possible serious or fatal
injury.
- Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning steering wheel
removal or installation. This will disable the airbag system. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
- Allow the airbag system capacitor to discharge for two minutes before removing the steering
wheel or any airbag system component. Failure to follow this instruction may result in accidental
airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Adjust the steering wheel so that the tires are in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. 2. Disconnect
and isolate the negative battery cable. 3. Remove the driver airbag (3) See: Restraint Systems/Air
Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Removal.
4. Disconnect the wiring connector (2) at the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 6642
5. While holding the steering wheel (2) firmly in place, remove the bolt (4) that secures the steering
wheel to the steering column shaft (1).
CAUTION: Do not bump or hammer on the steering wheel or steering column shaft when removing
the steering wheel.
6. Install an appropriate wheel puller with hooked legs (1) on the steering wheel over the steering
shaft.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to rotate the clockspring rotor once the steering wheel is removed. The
clockspring must remain centered in its
travel to avoid overextending the clockspring inner parts, causing the clockspring to become
inoperative. If removed and handled properly using the correct procedures, it should remain in the
"centered" position. If there is any question as to whether the clockspring is in the "centered"
position of travel, perform the clockspring centering procedure before installing the steering wheel
See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable/Service and
Repair/Procedures .
7. While holding the steering wheel firmly in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position, remove the steering
wheel from the steering column shaft splines
using the wheel puller.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 6643
Steering Wheel: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Confirm that:
a. The front wheels are in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. b. The turn signal stalk is in the
NEUTRAL position.
CAUTION: Do not install the steering wheel onto the shaft of the steering column by driving it onto
the shaft.
2. Align the wide mounting spline of the steering wheel (2) with the missing spline area of the
steering column shaft (1) and push the wheel onto the
shaft. Make sure the clockspring lines up with the back of the wheel and does not bind.
3. Install the steering wheel retaining bolt (4). Tighten the steering wheel retaining bolt to 50 Nm
(37 ft. lbs.).
4. Connect the wiring connector (2) at the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 6644
5. Install the driver airbag (3) See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and
Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation.
WARNING: Do not reconnect the battery without first performing the Airbag System Test procedure
See: Restraint Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics . Failure to perform the Airbag System Test
may result in accidental airbag deployment and serious or fatal injury.
6. Reconnect the battery using the Airbag System Test procedure See: Restraint Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics.
7. Verify vehicle and system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Tie Rod End: Testing and Inspection
TIE ROD
Tie rod free-play can be measured using the following hand methods:
OUTER TIE ROD
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance. 2. Remove the front wheels. See: Wheels and
Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Removal. 3. Install two
standard wheel mounting nuts, flat side to rotor, diagonally opposite to each on the rotor.
4. Attach a magnetic dial indicator (2) to the inside or outside of the brake rotor, then align the dial
indicator's contact pointer (1) with the direction
of the stud axis and touch the outer tie rod.
5. Zero the dial indicator. (3)
NOTE: When checking free-play, DO NOT rotate the tie rod. Just because a tie rod rotates easily
does not mean that it is necessarily faulty.
Using more than light hand pressure will result in a false reading.
6. Grasp the outer tie rod near the ball stud and attempt to move the tie rod straight up and down
using light hand pressure. (Less than 10 lbs. of
force.)
7. Measure and record any tie rod free-play movement.
8. Remove the magnetic dial indicator. 9. Remove the standard wheel mounting nuts from the two
studs.
If the free-play in the tie rod exceeds 0.05 mm (.002 in.), replace the outer tie rod. See: Service and
Repair/Tie Rod End - Removal. If the free-play is less than 0.05 mm (.002 in.) at the outer tie rod
check the inner tie rod for free-play. Refer to the following procedure.
INNER TIE ROD
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 6649
NOTE: Always check and repair (if necessary) outer tie rod free-play before checking inner tie rod
free-play. False results can otherwise be
obtained.
1. Grasp the inner tie rod near the steering gear bellows and attempt to move the tie rod straight up
and down. If any free-play is felt, replace the
inner tie rod See: Service and Repair/Tie Rod End - Removal.
2. If no free-play is felt, install the front wheels. See: Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation
3. Remove support and lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Tie Rod End - Removal
Tie Rod End: Service and Repair Tie Rod End - Removal
Inner Tie Rod
INNER TIE ROD
1. Remove the outer tie rod. See: 2. Remove the tie rod jam nut from the inner tie rod.
3. If servicing the right inner tie rod, remove the screws and push-pins securing the heat shield (1)
over the right side of the steering gear (2). Remove
the heat shield from over the bellows.
4. Remove the clamp (3) securing the bellows (1) to the inner tie rod. 5. Remove the clamp (2)
securing the bellows (1) to the steering gear body. 6. Remove the bellows.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Tie Rod End - Removal > Page 6652
7. Remove the travel restrictor (3) from the inner tie rod (1). 8. Install an appropriate inner tie rod
removal tool on the inner tie rod (1) hex.
CAUTION: If the inner tie rod cannot be removed using the specified tools, do not use a hammer or
heat to loosen. Damage to the steering
gear will occur. Replace the entire steering gear.
9. Unthread and remove the inner tie rod (1) from the steering gear (2).
Outer Tie Rod End
OUTER TIE ROD END
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3) , then
the tire and wheel assembly (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Tie Rod End - Removal > Page 6653
3. Loosen the tie rod jam nut. 4. Remove the nut (3) attaching the outer tie rod end (6) to the
knuckle (2). To do this, hold the tie rod end stud with a wrench while loosening and
removing the nut with a standard wrench or crowfoot wrench.
5. Separate the outer tie rod end (1) from the knuckle (3) using Remover (2), Special Tool 9360.
Remove the outer tie rod from the knuckle.
NOTE: When unscrewing the outer tie rod from inner, count the number of revolutions to take it off.
This action will aid in installation,
getting the toe close to where it needs to be when setting the wheel alignment.
6. Remove the outer tie rod from the inner tie rod.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Tie Rod End - Removal > Page 6654
Tie Rod End: Service and Repair Tie Rod End - Installation
Inner Tie Rod
INNER TIE ROD
CAUTION: When installing the travel restrictor, be sure to use the same color and thickness travel
restrictor as was removed. This action is
necessary to properly set gear travel for the steering gear being serviced. Travel restrictor
thickness can vary side-to-side on the steering gear.
1. Install the travel restrictor (1), flat side of teeth (2) facing out, on the inboard end of the inner tie
rod ball joint. 2. Apply Mopar(R) Lock & Seal Adhesive or equivalent medium thread locker
adhesive to the inboard end threads of the inner tie rod.
3. Install the inner tie rod (1) onto the gear (2) using an appropriate inner tie rod installation tool or
crows foot wrench on the hex. Tighten the inner
tie rod to 78 Nm, (58 ft. lbs.).
4. Loosely place a NEW clamp over the large end of the NEW bellows. 5. Slide the NEW bellows
with clamp over the end of the inner tie rod and onto the gear body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Tie Rod End - Removal > Page 6655
6. Push the small end of the bellows (2) past the groove (1) machined into the inner tie rod. 7.
Apply a small amount of Mopar(R) Lubriplate or equivalent uniformly to the groove (1) in the inner
tie rod shaft. This allows for toe adjustment
without twisting the bellows.
8. Pull the small end of the bellows outward until the ridge inside the bellows engages the groove.
9. Install a NEW clamp (3) over the small end of the bellows (1).
10. Using crimping pliers (1), crimp the large clamp (2) securing the bellows to the gear body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Tie Rod End - Removal > Page 6656
11. If servicing the right inner tie rod, position the heat shield (1) over the steering gear (2). Install
mounting screws and push-pins. Tighten the screws
to 6 Nm (53 in. lbs.).
12. Thread the tie rod jam nut onto the inner tie rod far enough to install the outer tie rod. 13. Install
the outer tie rod. See:
Outer Tie Rod End
OUTER TIE ROD END
1. If it is not already installed, install the jam nut on the inner tie rod threads. Thread the jam nut
down the inner tie rod far enough to allow for outer
tie rod installation.
2. Thread the outer tie rod onto the inner tie rod approximately the same amount of revolutions as
the original was installed. Do not tighten the jam
nut at this time.
3. Install the outer tie rod end (6) into the hole in the knuckle (2) arm. Start a NEW tie rod mounting
nut (3) onto the stud. While holding the tie rod
end stud with a wrench, tighten the nut with a wrench or crowfoot wrench. Tighten the nut to 85 Nm
(63 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Tie Rod End - Removal > Page 6657
4. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1)See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Install
and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Adjust the front wheel toe setting. See: Alignment/Service and Repair. 7.
Tighten the tie rod jam nut to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.) once wheel toe is set.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
Ball Joint: Specifications
The end play is acceptable if no more than 1.0 mm (0.039 in.) of end play is achieved
back-to-back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 6662
Ball Joint: Testing and Inspection
LOWER BALL JOINT
1. Raise the vehicle allowing the front suspension to hang. 2. Remove the tire and wheel assembly.
3. Using Dial Indicator C-3339A, or equivalent, attach the dial indicator mount to the knuckle and
align the dial indicator's plunger with the direction
of the stud axis, touching the end of the ball joint stud in the lower control arm.
4. Push up on the lower control arm and zero the dial indicator.
NOTE: Use care when applying load to the knuckle as to avoid damaging the ball joint seal boot.
5. From the front of the vehicle, insert a pry bar between the knuckle and lower control arm, resting
it on the lower control arm. Use lever principle to
push the knuckle up from the lower control arm. Apply the load until the needle of the dial indicator
no longer moves.
6. Record the ball joint movement. The end play is acceptable if no more than 1.0 mm (0.039 in.) of
end play is achieved back-to-back. 7. Perform this procedure on each side of the vehicle as
necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension Lower Ball Joint - Installation
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Front Suspension Lower Ball Joint - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install Installer (2), Special Tool 9964-1, and Installer (4), Special Tool 9964-2 on
Remover/Installer (5), Special Tool 8441-1. Place a new ball
joint (stem down) into Installer 9964-2.
2. Position the assembly onto the knuckle as shown, then hand tighten the screw-drive. 3. Using
hand-tools, tighten the screw-drive forcing the ball joint (3) into the knuckle (1). Continue to install
the ball joint until the flange on the ball
joint comes to a stop against the bottom of the knuckle.
4. Loosen the screw-drive and remove the tools. 5. Install a NEW snap-ring into the groove in the
ball joint using a drift punch.
6. Slide the hub and bearing in the knuckle (2) onto the splines of the half shaft outer C/V joint (1).
7. Insert the lower ball joint stud into the mounting hole in the lower control arm. 8. Install a NEW
ball joint stud nut (4). Tighten the nut to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension Lower Ball Joint - Installation > Page 6665
9. Install the wheel speed sensor head (2) into the knuckle (3). Install the mounting screw (1) and
tighten it to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.).
10. Install the routing clip (1) securing the wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle (5). 11. Install
the brake rotor, disc brake caliper and adapter. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
12. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 13. Install the hub nut
(1) on the end of the half shaft (2) and snug it. 14. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the
hub from rotating, tighten the hub nut (3) to 132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension Lower Ball Joint - Installation > Page 6666
15. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service and
Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension Lower Ball Joint - Installation > Page 6667
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Front Suspension Lower Ball Joint - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, review all Warnings and Cautions. See: Service Precautions/Technician
Safety Information
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the hub from rotating, remove the hub nut (1) from the
axle half shaft (2). 4. Access and remove the front brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension Lower Ball Joint - Installation > Page 6668
5. Remove the routing clip (1) securing wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle (5).
6. Remove the screw (1) fastening the wheel speed sensor head (2) to the knuckle (3). Pull the
sensor head out of the knuckle.
7. Remove the nut (4) attaching the lower ball joint to the lower control arm (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension Lower Ball Joint - Installation > Page 6669
8. Release the lower ball joint (5) from the lower control arm (1) using Remover (2) 9360. Do not lift
the knuckle out of the lower control arm at this
time.
9. Lift the knuckle (2) out of the lower control arm (5).
NOTE: Do not allow the half shaft (1) to hang by the inner C/V joint; it must be supported to keep
the joint from separating during this
operation.
10. Pull the knuckle (2) off the axle half shaft (1) outer C/V joint splines and support the half shaft.
11. Through the access hole (1) in the knuckle, tap the ends of the snap-ring (2) with a drift punch
and remove it from the ball joint.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension Lower Ball Joint - Installation > Page 6670
12. Install Remover (2) 9964-3, and Remover (4), Special Tool 9964-4 on Remover/Installer (5),
Special Tool 8441-1. Place the tools over the ball
joint (3) as shown, then hand tighten the screw-drive.
13. Using hand-tools, tighten the screw-drive forcing the ball joint (3) out of the knuckle (1). 14.
Loosen the screw-drive and remove the tools and ball joint.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Control Arm: Testing and Inspection
LOWER CONTROL ARM
Inspect the lower control arm for signs of damage from contact with the ground or road debris. If
the lower control arm shows any sign of damage, look for distortion. Do not attempt to repair or
straighten a broken or bent lower control arm. If damaged, the lower control arm is serviced only as
a complete component.
Inspect both lower control arm isolator bushings for severe deterioration and replace the lower
control arm as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal
Control Arm: Service and Repair Front Lower Control Arm - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the nut (4) attaching the lower ball joint to the lower control arm (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6676
4. Release the lower ball joint (3) from the lower control arm (1) using Remover (2) 9360. Do not lift
the knuckle out of the lower control arm at this
time.
CAUTION: Upon removing the knuckle from the ball joint stud, do not pull outward on the knuckle.
Pulling the knuckle outward at this point
can separate the inner C/V joint on the half shaft thus damaging it.
5. At each end of the stabilizer bar, while holding the stabilizer bar link (1) lower stud stationary,
remove the nut (3) securing the link to the stabilizer
bar (2).
6. Rotate the ends of the stabilizer bar (2) upward away from the lower control arm.
7. Remove the front bolt (1) attaching the lower control arm (3) to the front suspension
crossmember.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6677
8. Remove the nut on the rear bolt (2) attaching the lower control arm (3) to the front suspension
crossmember. Remove the bolt. 9. Remove the lower control arm (3) from the crossmember.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6678
Control Arm: Service and Repair Front Lower Control Arm - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place the lower control arm (3) into the front suspension crossmember. 2. Insert the rear bolt (2)
up through the crossmember and lower control arm (3). Install the nut on the top-end of the bolt,
but do not tighten it at this
time.
3. Install, but do not fully tighten, the front bolt (1) attaching the lower control arm (3) to the
crossmember. 4. With no weight or obstruction on the lower control arm, tighten the lower control
arm front mounting bolt (1) to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.). 5. With no weight or obstruction on the lower
control arm, tighten the lower control arm rear mounting bolt nut to 145 Nm (107 ft. lbs.).
6. Attach the stabilizer bar link (1) at each end of the stabilizer bar (2). At each link, install and
tighten the nut (3) while holding the stabilizer bar
link lower stud stationary. Tighten the nuts to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: If a new or cleaned lower control arm is being installed, it is important to have a film of
general purpose grease around the ball joint
mounting hole on the lower control arm to avoid any future corrosion issues. Make sure the grease
does not get inside the ball joint mounting hole or on the ball joint stud during installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6679
7. Insert the lower ball joint stud into the mounting hole in the lower control arm (5). 8. Install a
NEW ball joint stud nut (4). Tighten the nut to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service and
Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6680
Control Arm: Service and Repair Rear Upper Control Arm - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the nut (3) and bolt (4) securing the upper control arm (5) to the knuckle. 4. Remove the
nut (2) and bolt (1) securing the upper control arm (5) to the crossmember. 5. Remove the upper
control arm (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6681
Control Arm: Service and Repair Rear Upper Control Arm - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the upper control arm (5) and install the bolt (1) and nut (2) securing the arm to the
crossmember. Do not tighten at this time. 2. Install the bolt (4) and nut (3) securing the upper
control arm (5) to the knuckle. Do not tighten at this time.
3. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack/drive-on lift. Raise the vehicle as
necessary to access mounting bolts and nuts. 6. Tighten the upper control arm mounting bolt nut at
the crossmember to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.). 7. Tighten the upper control arm mounting bolt nut at the
knuckle to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.). 8. Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service
and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6682
Control Arm: Service and Repair
Front Lower Control Arm - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the nut (4) attaching the lower ball joint to the lower control arm (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6683
4. Release the lower ball joint (3) from the lower control arm (1) using Remover (2) 9360. Do not lift
the knuckle out of the lower control arm at this
time.
CAUTION: Upon removing the knuckle from the ball joint stud, do not pull outward on the knuckle.
Pulling the knuckle outward at this point
can separate the inner C/V joint on the half shaft thus damaging it.
5. At each end of the stabilizer bar, while holding the stabilizer bar link (1) lower stud stationary,
remove the nut (3) securing the link to the stabilizer
bar (2).
6. Rotate the ends of the stabilizer bar (2) upward away from the lower control arm.
7. Remove the front bolt (1) attaching the lower control arm (3) to the front suspension
crossmember.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6684
8. Remove the nut on the rear bolt (2) attaching the lower control arm (3) to the front suspension
crossmember. Remove the bolt. 9. Remove the lower control arm (3) from the crossmember.
Front Lower Control Arm - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place the lower control arm (3) into the front suspension crossmember. 2. Insert the rear bolt (2)
up through the crossmember and lower control arm (3). Install the nut on the top-end of the bolt,
but do not tighten it at this
time.
3. Install, but do not fully tighten, the front bolt (1) attaching the lower control arm (3) to the
crossmember. 4. With no weight or obstruction on the lower control arm, tighten the lower control
arm front mounting bolt (1) to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.). 5. With no weight or obstruction on the lower
control arm, tighten the lower control arm rear mounting bolt nut to 145 Nm (107 ft. lbs.).
6. Attach the stabilizer bar link (1) at each end of the stabilizer bar (2). At each link, install and
tighten the nut (3) while holding the stabilizer bar
link lower stud stationary. Tighten the nuts to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: If a new or cleaned lower control arm is being installed, it is important to have a film of
general purpose grease around the ball joint
mounting hole on the lower control arm to avoid any future corrosion issues. Make sure the grease
does not get inside the ball joint mounting hole or on the ball joint stud during installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6685
7. Insert the lower ball joint stud into the mounting hole in the lower control arm (5). 8. Install a
NEW ball joint stud nut (4). Tighten the nut to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service and
Repair
Rear Upper Control Arm - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6686
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the nut (3) and bolt (4) securing the upper control arm (5) to the knuckle. 4. Remove the
nut (2) and bolt (1) securing the upper control arm (5) to the crossmember. 5. Remove the upper
control arm (5).
Rear Upper Control Arm - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the upper control arm (5) and install the bolt (1) and nut (2) securing the arm to the
crossmember. Do not tighten at this time.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6687
2. Install the bolt (4) and nut (3) securing the upper control arm (5) to the knuckle. Do not tighten at
this time.
3. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack/drive-on lift. Raise the vehicle as
necessary to access mounting bolts and nuts. 6. Tighten the upper control arm mounting bolt nut at
the crossmember to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.). 7. Tighten the upper control arm mounting bolt nut at the
knuckle to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.). 8. Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service
and Repair
Rear Lower Control Arm - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6688
3. If equipped, while holding the stabilizer bar link lower stud stationary, remove the nut (3)
securing the link (2) to the lower control arm (4).
4. If equipped with load-leveling shocks, support the lower shock (1) with a jack (2) using just
enough force to allow easy removal of the lower
shock mounting bolt in the following step. Lower the jack following bolt removal.
5. Remove the lower shock mounting nut (1) and bolt (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6689
6. Remove the nut (2) and bolt (7) securing the lower control arm (3) to the knuckle (1). 7. Remove
the nut (4) and bolt (6) securing the lower control arm (3) to the rear crossmember (5). 8. Remove
the lower control arm (3).
Rear Lower Control Arm - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the lower control arm (3) and install the bolt (6) and nut (4) securing the lower control
arm to the crossmember (5). Do not tighten at this
time.
2. Install the bolt (7) and nut (2) securing the lower control arm (3) to the knuckle (1). Do not tighten
at this time.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6690
3. If equipped with load-leveling shocks, place a jack (2) against the lower shock eye and support
the lower end of the shock assembly (1). Lift the
shock assembly using the jack until the hole in the lower shock eye lines up with that in the lower
control arm.
4. Install the mounting bolt (4) and nut (1) fastening the shock assembly (2) to the lower control arm
(3). Do not tighten at this time.
NOTE: When attaching a stabilizer bar link to the lower control arm it is important that the lower
mounting stud be positioned properly. The
lower mounting stud on the right side link needs to point toward the front of the vehicle when
inserted through the lower control arm mounting flange. The left side link lower stud needs to point
toward the rear of the vehicle. Otherwise the suspension geometry will not function properly.
CAUTION: Before installing the nut in the following step, it is especially important to clean the
threads and apply Mopar(R) Lock & Seal
Adhesive or equivalent.
5. If equipped, attach the stabilizer bar link (2) to the lower control arm (4). Install the nut (3) and
while holding the stabilizer bar link lower stud
stationary, tighten the nut (2) to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Lower Control Arm - Removal > Page 6691
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack/drive-on lift. Raise the vehicle as
necessary to access mounting bolts and nuts. 9. Tighten the lower control arm mounting bolt nut at
the crossmember to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.).
10. Tighten the lower control arm mounting bolt nut at the knuckle to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.). 11.
Tighten the shock assembly lower mounting bolt nut to 99 Nm (73 ft. lbs.). 12. Perform wheel
alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
Rear Cross-Member: Customer Interest Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 6701
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 6702
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
Rear Cross-Member: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking
Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 6708
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 6709
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 6710
Rear Cross-Member: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 02-004-08 Date: 080731
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 6711
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 6712
3. Remove the brackets.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 02-004-08 Date:
080731
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 6713
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 6714
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 6715
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Front Steering Knuckle: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The knuckle (3) is a single casting with legs machined for attachment to the front strut assembly on
the top and steering linkage on the trailing end. A ball joint is located on the bottom of the knuckle
which attaches to the lower control arm. The knuckle also has two machined, drilled legs on the
leading end casting to support and align the front disc brake caliper adapter.
The knuckle supports the hub and bearing (1). A shield (not shown in figure) is fastened to the
knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6719
Front Steering Knuckle: Testing and Inspection
KNUCKLE
The front suspension knuckle is not a repairable component of the front suspension. It must be
replaced if found to be damaged in any way. If it is determined that the knuckle is bent when
servicing the vehicle, no attempt is to be made to straighten the knuckle.
Inspect the lower ball joint per the inspection procedure. The lower ball joint can be replaced
separately from the knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Front Steering Knuckle - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, review all Warnings and Cautions. See: Service Precautions/Technician
Safety Information
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the hub from rotating, remove the hub nut (1) from the
axle half shaft (2). 4. Access and remove the front brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6722
5. Remove the routing clip (1) securing wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle (5).
6. Remove the screw (1) fastening the wheel speed sensor head (2) to the knuckle (3). Pull the
sensor head out of the knuckle.
7. Remove the nut (3) attaching the outer tie rod (6) to the knuckle (2). To do this it might be
necessary to hold the tie rod end stud with a wrench
while loosening and removing the nut with a standard wrench or crowfoot wrench.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6723
8. Release the outer tie rod end (1) from the knuckle (3) using Remover (2), Special Tool 9360. 9.
Remove the outer tie rod from the knuckle.
10. Remove the nut (4) attaching the lower ball joint to the lower control arm (5).
11. Release the lower ball joint (3) from the lower control arm (1) using Remover (2), Special Tool
9360. Do not lift the knuckle out of the lower
control arm at this time.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6724
CAUTION: The strut assembly-to-knuckle attaching bolts (5) are serrated and must not be turned
during removal. Proper removal is
required. Refer to the following steps for the correct method.
12. While holding the bolt heads stationary, remove the two nuts (2) from the bolts (5) attaching the
strut (3) to the knuckle (6). 13. Remove the two bolts (5) attaching the strut (3) to the knuckle (6)
using a pin punch.
NOTE: Do not allow the half shaft (1) to hang by the inner C/V joint; it must be supported to keep
the joint from separating during this
operation.
14. Pull the knuckle (2) off the half shaft (1) outer C/V joint splines and remove the knuckle from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6725
15. If required, remove the three screws (2) fastening the shield (3) to the knuckle (1). Remove the
shield.
16. If required, remove the four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing (1) to the knuckle (3). 17. If
required, slide the hub and bearing (1) out of the knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6726
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Front Steering Knuckle - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If required, install the hub and bearing (1) by sliding it into the knuckle. 2. If installing hub and
bearing, install the four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing (1) to the knuckle (3). Tighten the
four bolts to 82 Nm (60 ft.
lbs.).
3. If required, install the shield on the knuckle. Install and tighten the three mounting screws (2) to
10 Nm (89 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6727
4. Slide the hub and bearing in the knuckle (2) onto the splines of the half shaft outer C/V joint (1).
5. Insert the lower ball joint stud into the mounting hole in the lower control arm. 6. Install a NEW
ball joint stud nut (4). Tighten the nut to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: The strut clevis-to-knuckle bolts (5) are serrated and must not be turned during
installation. Install the nuts while holding the
bolts stationary in the steering knuckle. Refer to the following step.
7. Position the lower end of the strut assembly (3) in line with the upper end of the knuckle (6),
aligning the mounting holes. Install the two mounting
bolts (5).
8. Install the nuts (2) on the two bolts (5). While holding the bolts in place, tighten the nuts to 140
Nm (103 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6728
9. Install the outer tie rod (6) ball stud into the hole in the knuckle (2) arm. Start the tie rod
end-to-knuckle nut (4) onto the stud. While holding the
tie rod end stud with a wrench, tighten the nut with a wrench or crowfoot wrench to 85 Nm (63 ft.
lbs.).
10. Install the wheel speed sensor head (2) into the knuckle (3). Install the mounting screw (1) and
tighten it to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.).
11. Install the routing clip (1) securing the wheel speed sensor cable to the knuckle (5). 12. Install
the brake rotor, disc brake caliper and adapter. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Steering Knuckle - Removal > Page 6729
13. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 14. Install the hub nut
(1) on the end of the half shaft (2) and snug it. 15. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the
hub from rotating, tighten the hub nut (3) to 132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.).
16. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
17. Lower the vehicle. 18. Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service and
Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle Alignment Link > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Toe Link - Removal
Rear Knuckle Alignment Link: Service and Repair Rear Toe Link - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the mounting bolt (2) and nut securing the toe link (3) to the knuckle.
3. Mark the position of the cam bolt cam on the crossmember using a paint marker or crayon. Do
not use any type marker that will scratch or damage
the surface of the crossmember.
4. While holding the cam bolt (4) head stationary, loosen and remove the toe link mounting cam
bolt nut (3) and washer (1). Remove the cam bolt. 5. Remove the toe link (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle Alignment Link > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Toe Link - Removal > Page 6734
Rear Knuckle Alignment Link: Service and Repair Rear Toe Link - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: When installing the cam bolt (4) and washer make sure the cams stay inside the
abutments built into the crossmember. Failure to
do so can damage the abutments and make toe adjustment difficult.
1. Position the toe link (2) and install the cam bolt (4) from the front through the crossmember and
link. Match the cam on the bolt to the marks made
during removal or position the top of the cam to the 12 O'clock position.
2. Install the cam washer (1) and nut (3) securing the toe link (2) to the crossmember. Do not
tighten at this time.
3. Install the mounting bolt (2) and nut securing the link to the knuckle. To install the bolt it may be
necessary to flex the trailing link at the body
mount bushing inward or outward using an appropriate prying tool. Do not tighten at this time.
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack/drive-on lift. Raise the vehicle as
necessary to access mounting bolts and nuts. 6. Tighten the toe link mounting bolt nut at the
knuckle to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.). 7. Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service
and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle Alignment Link > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Toe Link - Removal > Page 6735
8. Once rear toe is set, while holding the cam bolt (4) head stationary, tighten the toe link mounting
cam bolt nut (3) to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension Knuckle - Removal
Spindle: Service and Repair Rear Suspension Knuckle - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the bolt (2) securing the brake tube routing bracket (1) to the knuckle.
4. Remove the brake rotor or brake drum, then the hub and bearing. See: Wheel Bearing/Service
and Repair/Rear Hub and Bearing - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension Knuckle - Removal > Page 6740
5. Remove the three bolts (3) securing the knuckle (1) to the trailing link (2).
6. Remove the nut (3) and bolt securing the toe link to the knuckle (1). 7. Remove the nut (4) and
bolt securing the lower control arm to the knuckle (1). 8. Remove the nut (2) and bolt securing the
upper control arm to the knuckle (1). 9. Remove the knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension Knuckle - Removal > Page 6741
Spindle: Service and Repair Rear Suspension Knuckle - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the knuckle (1) on the upper and lower control arm, and the toe link. 2. Install the bolt
and nut (2) securing the upper control arm to the knuckle. Do not tighten the mounting bolt nut at
this time. 3. Install the bolt and nut (4) securing the lower control arm to the knuckle. Do not tighten
the mounting bolt nut at this time. 4. Install the bolt and nut (3) securing the toe link to the knuckle.
Do not tighten the mounting bolt nut at this time.
CAUTION: Before installing the bolts in the following step, it is especially important to clean the
threads and apply Mopar(R) Lock & Seal
Adhesive or equivalent.
5. Install the three bolts (3) securing the trailing link (2) to the knuckle (1). Be sure to include the
parking brake cable routing clamp when installing
the top mounting bolt. Tighten the mounting bolts to 60 Nm (44 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the hub and bearing, then the brake rotor and caliper. See: Wheel Bearing/Service and
Repair/Rear Hub and Bearing - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension Knuckle - Removal > Page 6742
7. Position the brake tube routing bracket (1) at the knuckle and install the mounting screw. Tighten
the screw to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack/drive-on lift. Raise the vehicle as necessary to access
yet to be tightened mounting bolts and nuts. 11. Tighten the upper control arm bolt nut at the
knuckle to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.). 12. Tighten the lower control arm bolt nut at the knuckle to 105 Nm
(77 ft. lbs.). 13. Tighten the toe link mounting bolt nut at the knuckle to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.). 14.
Perform wheel alignment as necessary. See: Alignment/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Stabilizer Bar Link - Removal
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Front Stabilizer Bar Link - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. While holding the stabilizer bar link (1) stud stationary, remove the nut (4) securing the link to the
strut (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Stabilizer Bar Link - Removal > Page 6748
4. While holding the stabilizer bar link (1) lower stud stationary, remove the nut (3) securing the link
to the stabilizer bar (2). 5. Remove the stabilizer bar link (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Stabilizer Bar Link - Removal > Page 6749
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Front Stabilizer Bar Link - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the stabilizer bar link (1) to the stabilizer bar (2). Install and tighten the nut (3) while
holding the stabilizer bar link lower stud stationary.
Tighten the nut to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
2. Attach the stabilizer bar link (1) to the strut (3). Install and tighten the nut (4) while holding the
stabilizer bar link stud stationary. Tighten the nut
to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Stabilizer Bar Link - Removal > Page 6750
3. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Install
and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
4. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Stabilizer Bar Link - Removal > Page 6751
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Rear Suspension Stabilizer Bar Link - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. While holding the stabilizer bar link lower
stud stationary, remove the nut (3) securing the link (2) to the lower control arm (4). 3. While
holding the stabilizer bar link upper stud stationary, remove the nut (5) securing the link (2) to the
stabilizer bar (1). 4. Remove the stabilizer bar link (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Stabilizer Bar Link - Removal > Page 6752
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Rear Suspension Stabilizer Bar Link - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Before installing the nuts in the following steps, it is especially important to clean the
threads and apply Mopar(R) Lock & Seal
Adhesive or equivalent.
1. Install the stabilizer link (2) upper stud in the end of the stabilizer bar (1) from the inboard side.
Install the nut (5) on the upper stud and while
holding the stabilizer link stud stationary, tighten the nut to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: When attaching a stabilizer bar link to the lower control arm it is important that the lower
mounting stud be positioned properly. The
lower mounting stud on the right side link needs to point toward the front of the vehicle when
inserted through the lower control arm mounting flange. The left side link lower stud needs to point
toward the rear of the vehicle. Otherwise the suspension geometry will not function properly.
2. Attach the stabilizer bar link (2) to the lower control arm (4). Install the nut (3) and while holding
the stabilizer bar link lower stud stationary,
tighten the nut (2) to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
3. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Suspension Strut Assembly - Description
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Description and Operation Front Suspension Strut Assembly Description
DESCRIPTION
A Macpherson type design strut assembly is used in place of the traditional front suspension upper
control arm and upper ball joint. The bottom of the strut mounts directly to the steering knuckle
using two attaching bolts and nuts going through the strut clevis bracket and knuckle. The top of
the strut mounts directly to the strut tower of the vehicle using the three threaded studs on the strut
assembly's upper mount.
The strut assembly includes the following components:
- Upper mount (2)
- Bearing and upper spring seat (3)
- Upper spring isolator (4)
- Dust shield (5)
- Jounce bumper (6)
- Coil spring (7)
- Lower spring isolator (8)
- Strut (damper) (9)
Each component is serviced by removing the strut assembly from the vehicle and disassembling it.
Coil springs are rated separately for each corner or side of the vehicle depending on optional
equipment and type of vehicle service. If a coil spring requires replacement, be sure that it is
replaced with a spring meeting the correct load rating for the vehicle and its specific options.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Suspension Strut Assembly - Description > Page 6757
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Description and Operation Front Suspension Strut Assembly Operation
OPERATION
The strut assembly cushions the ride of the vehicle, controlling vibration, jounce and rebound of the
suspension.
The coil spring controls ride quality and maintains proper ride height.
The spring isolators isolate the coil spring at the top and bottom from coming into metal-to-metal
contact with the upper mounting seat and the strut.
The jounce bumper limits suspension travel and metal-to-metal contact under full jounce condition.
The strut dampens jounce and rebound motions of the coil spring and suspension.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Suspension Strut Assembly - Description > Page 6758
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Description and Operation Rear Shock Absorber - Description
DESCRIPTION
A coil-over shock absorber assembly supports each side of the vehicle. The bottom of the shock
assembly mounts to the lower control arm. The top of the shock assembly mounts to the body.
The shock assembly includes the following major components:
- Upper bushing (3)
- Upper mounting bracket (4)
- Sleeve (5)
- Lower bushing (6)
- Jounce bumper (8)
- Dust shield (9)
- Upper spring isolator (10)
- Coil spring (11)
- Lower spring isolator (12)
- Shock absorber (damper) (13)
Each component is serviced by removing the shock assembly from the vehicle and disassembling
it.
Coil springs are rated separately for each corner or side of the vehicle depending on optional
equipment and type of vehicle service. If a coil spring requires replacement, be sure that it is
replaced with a spring meeting the correct load rating for the vehicle and its specific options.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Suspension Strut Assembly
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Testing and Inspection Front Suspension Strut Assembly
STRUT ASSEMBLY
Inspect the strut assembly for the following conditions:
- Inspect for a damaged or broken coil spring (7).
- Inspect for a torn or damaged dust shield (5).
- Inspect for torn or deteriorated spring isolators (4, 8).
- Lift the dust shield and inspect the strut assembly for evidence of fluid running from the upper end
of the strut fluid reservoir. (Actual leakage will be a stream of fluid running down the side and
dripping off lower end of unit). A slight amount of seepage between the strut shaft and strut shaft
seal is not unusual and does not affect performance of the strut assembly.
- Inspect the jounce bumper (6) for signs of damage or deterioration.
- Inspect the clearance between the shock tower and the coil spring. Make sure no fasteners are
protruding through the shock tower possibly contacting the coil spring and strut. Because of the
minimum clearance in this area, installation of metal fasteners could damage the coil spring coating
and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring.
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle can a sheet metal screw, bolt or other metal
fastener be installed into the strut tower (1) to
take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, do not drill holes into the front strut tower for the
installation of any metal fasteners into the shock tower area indicated (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Suspension Strut Assembly > Page 6761
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Testing and Inspection Rear Shock Absorber, Coil-Over
SHOCK ABSORBER
Inspect the shock absorber for damage and evidence of fluid running from the upper end of the
fluid reservoir. (Actual leakage will be a stream of fluid running down the side of the reservoir tube
and dripping off lower end of unit). A slight amount of seepage between the shaft and shaft seal is
not unusual and does not affect performance of the shock absorber.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Technician Safety Information .
1. Remove the engine appearance cover.
2. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 3. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
4. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen. Remove the cowl screen (3).
5. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6764
6. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
NOTE: If both strut assemblies are to be removed, mark the strut assemblies right or left and keep
the parts separated to avoid mix-up. Not
all parts of the strut assembly are interchangeable side-to-side.
7. Remove the screw (1) securing the flex hose (2) routing bracket to the strut (6).
8. While holding the stabilizer bar link (1) stud stationary, remove the nut (4) securing the link to the
strut (3).
CAUTION: The strut assembly-to-knuckle attaching bolts (5) are serrated and must not be turned
during removal. Hold the bolts stationary in
the knuckle while removing the nuts, then tap the bolts out using a pin punch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6765
9. While holding the bolt heads stationary, remove the two nuts (2) from the bolts (5) attaching the
strut (3) to the knuckle (6).
10. Remove the two bolts (5) attaching the strut (3) to the knuckle (6) using a pin punch.
11. Lower the vehicle just enough to open the hood without allowing the tires to touch the floor.
12. Remove the three nuts (1) attaching the strut assembly (2) upper mount to the strut tower. 13.
Remove the strut assembly (2) from the vehicle. 14. For disassembly, See: Overhaul/Front
Suspension Strut Assembly - Disassembly.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Raise the strut assembly (2) into the strut tower, aligning the three studs on the strut assembly
upper mount with the holes in strut tower. Install the
three mounting nuts (1) on the studs. Tighten the three nuts to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6766
CAUTION: The strut clevis-to-knuckle bolts (5) are serrated and must not be turned during
installation. Install the nuts while holding the
bolts stationary in the knuckle.
2. Position the lower end of the strut assembly (3) in line with the upper end of the knuckle (6),
aligning the mounting holes. Install the two attaching
bolts (5). Install the nuts (2). While holding the bolts in place, tighten the nuts to 140 Nm (103 ft.
lbs.).
3. Attach the stabilizer bar link (1) to the strut (3). Install and tighten the nut (4) while holding the
stabilizer bar link stud stationary. Tighten the nut
to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
4. Secure the flex hose (2) routing bracket to the strut (6) with the mounting screw (1). Tighten the
mounting screw to 13 Nm (120 in. lbs.).
5. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Install
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6767
and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
8. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
9. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
10. Install the engine appearance cover.
With Third Row Seating
WITH THIRD ROW SEATING
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Access and remove the rear quarter trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal
2. Move insulation out of the way to access the shock assembly upper mounting nuts.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6768
3. Remove the two nuts (1) securing the shock assembly to the body bracket (2).
4. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
5. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the rear tire and wheel assembly.
6. If equipped with load-leveling shocks, support the lower shock (1) with a jack (2) using just
enough force to allow easy removal of the lower
shock mounting bolt in the following step. Lower the jack following bolt removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6769
7. Remove the lower shock mounting nut (1) and bolt (4). 8. Lower the shock assembly (2) out of
the body bracket and lift out over rear suspension.
Without Third Row Seating
WITHOUT THIRD ROW SEATING
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Remove four nuts, remove load floor. 2. Open access panel by breaking perforations along
panel, then folding panel upward. 3. Move insulation out of the way to access shock assembly
upper mounting nuts.
4. Remove the two nuts (1) securing the shock assembly to the body bracket (2).
5. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6770
6. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the rear tire and wheel assembly.
7. If equipped with load-leveling shocks, support the lower shock (1) with a jack (2) using just
enough force to allow easy removal of the lower
shock mounting bolt in the following step. Lower the jack following bolt removal.
8. Remove the lower shock mounting nut (1) and bolt (4). 9. Lower the shock assembly (2) out of
the body bracket and lift out over rear suspension.
With Third Row Seating
WITH THIRD ROW SEATING
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6771
NOTE: When installing the shock assembly into the body bracket in the following step, be sure to
position the upper mounting bracket so that
the angular formed side (as viewed from above) of the mounting bracket flange (1) is facing
outboard of vehicle (opposite side of bracket is rounded).
1. Insert the lower end of the shock assembly down though the lower control arm from above just
enough to clear the body with the upper mount,
then lift it up, inserting the upper mounting studs (3) through the body bracket (2).
2. If equipped with load-leveling shocks, place a jack (2) against the lower shock eye and support
the lower end of the shock assembly (1). Lift the
shock assembly using the jack until the hole in the lower shock eye lines up with that in the lower
control arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6772
3. Install the mounting bolt (4) and nut (1) fastening the shock assembly (2) to the lower control arm
(3). Do not tighten at this time.
4. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
5. Lower the vehicle.
6. Install the two nuts (1) on the studs (3) securing the shock assembly to the body bracket (2).
Tighten the mounting nuts to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
7. Install the rear quarter trim panel and components removed to access it. See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6773
8. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack/drive-on lift. Raise the lift as necessary to access the
shock mounting bolt and nut. 9. Tighten the shock assembly lower mounting bolt nut (1) to 99 Nm
(73 ft. lbs.).
Without Third Row Seating
WITHOUT THIRD ROW SEATING
NOTE: When installing the shock assembly into the body bracket in the following step, be sure to
position the upper mounting bracket so that
the angular formed side (as viewed from above) of the mounting bracket flange (1) is facing
outboard of vehicle (opposite side of bracket is rounded).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6774
1. Insert the lower end of the shock assembly down though the lower control arm from above just
enough to clear the body with the upper mount,
then lift it up, inserting the upper mounting studs (3) through the body bracket (2).
2. If equipped with load-leveling shocks, place a jack (2) against the lower shock eye and support
the lower end of the shock assembly (1). Lift the
shock assembly using the jack until the hole in the lower shock eye lines up with that in the lower
control arm.
3. Install the mounting bolt (4) and nut (1) fastening the shock assembly (2) to the lower control arm
(3). Do not tighten at this time.
4. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
5. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6775
6. Install the two nuts (1) on the studs (3) securing the shock assembly to the body bracket (2).
Tighten the mounting nuts to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
7. Remove four nuts, remove load floor. 8. Fold the access panel back into place. 9. Install the load
floor.
10. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack/drive-on lift. Raise the lift as necessary to access the
shock mounting bolt and nut. 11. Tighten the shock assembly lower mounting bolt nut (1) to 99 Nm
(73 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6776
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Overhaul
Front Suspension Strut Assembly - Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: The strut assembly must be removed from the vehicle for it to be disassembled and
assembled. See: Removal and Replacement/Front
Strut / Shock/Removal
For the disassembly and assembly of the strut assembly, use strut spring compressor, teamPSE
tool 223-7400, or the equivalent, to compress the coil spring. Follow the manufacturer's instructions
closely.
WARNING: Do not remove the strut rod nut before the coil spring is properly compressed. The coil
spring is held under pressure. The coil
spring must be compressed, removing spring tension from the upper mount and bearing, before the
strut rod nut is removed.
1. If both struts are being serviced at the same time, mark both the coil spring and strut assembly
according to which side of the vehicle the strut is
being removed from.
2. Position the strut assembly (2) in the strut coil spring compressor (1) following the
manufacturer's instructions and set the lower and upper hooks
of the compressor on the coil spring. Position the strut clevis bracket (2) straight outward, away
from the compressor.
3. Compress the coil spring until all coil spring tension is removed from the upper mount and
bearing.
CAUTION: Never use impact or high speed tools to remove the strut rod nut. Damage to the strut
internal bearings can occur.
4. Once the spring is sufficiently compressed, install Strut Nut Wrench (2) 9362, on the strut rod
nut. Next, install a deep socket (1) on the end of the
strut rod. While holding the strut rod from turning, remove the nut using the strut nut wrench.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6777
5. Remove the clamp (if installed) from the bottom of the coil spring and remove the strut (damper)
(9) out through the bottom of the coil spring. 6. Remove the lower spring isolator (8) from the strut
seat. 7. remove the dust shield (5) and jounce bumper (6). 8. Remove the upper strut mount (2)
from the top of the bearing and upper spring seat (3). 9. Remove the upper spring seat (3) and
isolator (4) from the top of the coil spring (5).
NOTE: If the coil spring needs to be serviced, proceed with the next step, otherwise, proceed with
11.
10. Release the tension from the coil spring by backing off the compressor drive completely. Push
back the compressor hooks and remove the coil
spring.
11. Inspect the strut assembly components for the following and replace as necessary:
- Inspect the strut (damper) (9) for shaft binding over the full stroke of the shaft.
- Inspect the jounce bumper (6) for cracks and signs of deterioration.
- Inspect the dust shield (5) for cracks and tears.
- Check the upper mount (2) for cracks and distortion and its retaining studs for any sign of
damage.
- Check the bearing and upper spring seat (3) for any binding.
- Inspect the upper and lower spring isolators (4, 8) for material deterioration and distortion.
- Inspect the coil spring (7) for any sign of damage to the coating.
NOTE: For reassembly, See: Front Suspension Strut Assembly - Assembly .
Front Suspension Strut Assembly - Assembly
ASSEMBLY
NOTE: If the coil spring has been removed from the spring compressor, proceed with the next step,
otherwise, proceed with 3.
NOTE: To determine the flat coil end of the coil spring for the following step, attempt to stand the
coil spring on-end on a flat, level surface. If
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6778
the coil spring stands on end, the end on the flat surface is the flat coil end. If the coil spring falls
over, the end on the flat surface is not the flat coil end. Stand the coil spring on the opposite end to
verify.
1. Place the coil spring flat coil end upward (see above note) in the spring compressor following the
manufacturer's instructions. Before compressing
the spring, rotate the spring so the end of the bottom coil is at approximately the 9 o'clock position
as viewed above (or to where the spring was when removed from the compressor). This action will
allow the strut (damper) clevis bracket to be positioned outward, away from the compressor once
installed.
2. Slowly compress the coil spring until enough room is available for strut assembly reassembly.
3. Install the bearing and upper spring seat (3), and isolator (4) on top of the coil spring (7). 4.
Install the upper mount (2) on top of the bearing and upper spring seat (3). 5. Install the lower
spring isolator (8) on the spring seat on the strut (damper) (9). 6. Slide the jounce bumper (6) and
dust shield (5) onto the strut rod.
7. Install the strut up through the bottom of the coil spring and upper spring seat, mount, and
bearing until the lower spring seat contacts the lower
end of the coil spring. Rotate the strut as necessary until the end of the bottom coil (2) comes in
contact with the stop (1) built into the lower spring isolator.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6779
8. While holding the strut in position, install the nut (1) on the end of the strut rod.
CAUTION: Never use impact or high speed tools to remove the strut rod nut. Damage to the strut
internal bearings can occur.
9. Install Strut Nut Wrench (2) 9362, on the strut rod nut. Next, install a deep socket (1) on the end
of the strut rod. While holding the strut rod from
turning, tighten the strut rod nut to 60 Nm (44 ft. lbs.) using a torque wrench on the end of Strut Nut
Wrench (2) 9362.
10. Slowly release the tension from the coil spring by backing off the compressor (1) drive
completely. As the tension is relieved, make sure the upper
mount and bearing align properly. Verify the upper mount does not bind when rotated.
11. Remove the strut assembly from the spring compressor. 12. Install the strut assembly on the
vehicle. See: Removal and Replacement/Front Strut / Shock/Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6780
Assembly
ASSEMBLY
NOTE: If the coil spring has been removed from the spring compressor, proceed with the next step,
otherwise, proceed with 3.
NOTE: To determine the flat coil end of the coil spring for the following step, attempt to stand the
coil spring on end on a flat, level surface. If
the coil spring stands on end, the end on the flat surface is the flat coil end. If the coil spring falls
over, the end on the flat surface is not the flat coil end. Stand the coil spring on the opposite end to
verify.
1. Place the coil spring flat coil end downward (see above note) in the spring compressor following
the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Slowly compress the coil spring until enough room is available
for shock assembly reassembly.
3. Assemble the bushings (3, 6) and sleeve (5) through the upper mounting bracket (4).
NOTE: When installing the upper spring isolator on the upper mounting bracket in the following
step, make sure the tab on the isolator is
positioned toward the forward mounting stud on the mounting bracket. To determine the forward
mounting stud on the mounting bracket, position the angular formed side (as viewed from above;
opposite side of bracket is rounded) of the mounting bracket flange (1) toward you with the
mounting studs pointing upwards. The stud to the left would be the forward mounting stud for a left
rear shock assembly. The stud to the right would be the forward mounting stud for a right rear
shock assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6781
4. If not already together, install the upper spring isolator (10) on the upper mounting bracket (4).
Make sure the tab on the isolator is positioned
toward the forward mounting stud on the mounting bracket (See above note).
5. Install the upper mounting bracket (4) on top of the coil spring (11) matching the step in the
isolator to the end of the coil. 6. Install the lower spring isolator (12) on the spring seat of the shock
absorber (13).
7. Slide the dust shield (9), jounce bumper (8) and washer (7) onto the shock rod. 8. Install the
shock absorber (13) up through the bottom of the coil spring (11) and upper mounting bracket until
the lower spring seat contacts the
lower end of the coil spring.
9. While holding the shock absorber in position, install the washer (2) and nut (1) on the end of the
shock rod.
CAUTION: Never use impact or high speed tools to remove the shock rod nut. Damage to the
shock internal bearings can occur.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6782
10. Install Snap-On(R) Shock Absorber Socket A139, or equivalent, on the end of the shock rod
(1). While holding the shock rod from turning, tighten
the nut (2) using a crows foot wrench and a torque wrench. Tighten the shock rod nut to 41 Nm (30
ft. lbs.).
11. Turn the upper mounting bracket or shock absorber as necessary until the mounting studs on
the mounting bracket line up with the lower mounting
bolt eyelet at the bottom of the shock absorber.
12. Slowly release the tension from the coil spring by backing off the compressor (1) drive
completely. 13. Remove the shock assembly from the spring compressor. 14. Install the shock
assembly on the vehicle. See: Removal and Replacement/Rear Shock Absorber/Rear Shock
Absorber, Coil-Over - Installation
Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: The shock assembly must be removed from the vehicle for it to be disassembled and
assembled. See: Removal and Replacement/Rear
Shock Absorber/Rear Shock Absorber, Coil-Over - Removal
For the disassembly and assembly of the shock assembly, use Strut Spring Compressor, teamPSE
tool 223-7400, or the equivalent, to compress the coil spring. Follow the manufacturer's instructions
closely.
WARNING: Do not remove the shock rod nut before the coil spring is properly compressed. The
coil spring is held under pressure. The coil
spring must be compressed, removing spring tension from the upper mounting bracket, before the
shock rod nut is removed.
1. If both shocks are being serviced at the same time, mark both the coil spring and shock
assembly according to which side of the vehicle the shock
is being removed from.
2. Position the shock assembly (2) in the strut spring compressor (1) following the manufacturer's
instructions and set the lower and upper hooks of
the compressor on the coil spring.
3. Compress the coil spring until all spring tension is removed from the upper mounting bracket and
bushings.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6783
CAUTION: Never use impact or high speed tools to remove the shock rod nut. Damage to the
shock internal bearings can occur.
4. Once the spring is sufficiently compressed, install Snap-On(R) Shock Absorber Socket A139, or
equivalent, on the end of the shock rod (1). While
holding the shock rod from turning, remove the nut (2) using a wrench. Remove the washer below
the nut.
5. Remove the shock absorber (13) out through the bottom of the coil spring (11). The washer (7),
jounce bumper (8), dust shield (9) and lower
spring isolator (12) will come out with the shock.
6. Slide the washer (7), jounce bumper (8), and dust shield (9) from the shock rod. 7. Remove the
lower spring isolator (12) from the shock spring seat. 8. Remove the upper mounting bracket (4),
bushings (3, 6), sleeve (5) and upper spring isolator (10) from the top of the spring. 9. Remove the
bushings (3, 6), sleeve (5) and upper spring isolator (10) from the upper mounting bracket (4).
NOTE: If the coil spring needs to be serviced, proceed with the next step, otherwise, proceed with
11.
10. Release the tension from the coil spring by backing off the compressor drive completely. Push
back the compressor hooks and remove the coil
spring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6784
11. Inspect the shock assembly components for the following and replace as necessary:
- Inspect the shock absorber (damper) (13) for shaft binding over the full stroke of the shaft.
- Inspect the jounce bumper (8) for cracks and signs of deterioration.
- Inspect the dust shield (9) for cracks and tears.
- Check the upper mounting bracket (4) for cracks and distortion and its retaining studs for any sign
of damage.
- Inspect the upper (3) and lower (6) bushings for material deterioration and signs of deterioration.
Inspect the sleeve (5) for wear and distortion.
- Inspect the upper (10) and lower (12) spring isolators for material deterioration and distortion.
- Inspect the coil spring (11) for any sign of damage to the coating.
NOTE: For reassembly, See: Rear Suspension
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Rear Suspension Trailing Link - Removal
Trailing Arm: Service and Repair Rear Suspension Trailing Link - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the screw (3) securing the brake flex hose and tube bracket (4) to the trailing link. 4.
Remove the screw (2) securing the wheel speed sensor routing clip (1) to the trailing link.
5. Remove the three bolts (3) securing the knuckle (1) to the trailing link (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Rear Suspension Trailing Link - Removal > Page 6789
6. Remove the two bolts (2) fastening the leading end of the trailing link (3) to the body (1). 7.
Remove the trailing link.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Rear Suspension Trailing Link - Removal > Page 6790
Trailing Arm: Service and Repair Rear Suspension Trailing Link - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Before installing the bolts in the following step, it is especially important to clean the
threads and apply Mopar(R) Lock & Seal
Adhesive or equivalent.
1. Position the trailing link (2) and install the three bolts (3) securing the trailing link to the knuckle
(1). Be sure to include the parking brake cable
routing clamp when installing the top mounting bolt. Tighten the mounting bolts to 60 Nm (44 ft.
lbs.).
2. Position the forward end of the trailing link (3) on the body (1) and install the two mounting bolts
(2). Do not tighten the bolts at this time.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Rear Suspension Trailing Link - Removal > Page 6791
3. Position the brake flex hose and tube bracket (4) on the trailing link and install the mounting
screw (3). Tighten the screw to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 4. Attach the wheel speed sensor routing clip (1)
to the trailing link using the mounting screw (2).
5. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Install
and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack/drive-on lift. Raise the vehicle as necessary to access
yet to be tightened mounting bolts. 8. Tighten the two mounting bolts fastening the leading end of
the trailing link (3) to the body (1) to 110 Nm (81 ft. lbs.). 9. Perform wheel alignment as necessary.
See: Alignment/Service and Repair
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Wheel bearing grease ...............................................................................................................
Mopar Multi-Purpose Lubricant NLGI Grade 2 EP, GC-LB
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Hub and Bearing - Description
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Front Hub and Bearing - Description
DESCRIPTION
The front wheel bearing and wheel hub of this vehicle are a one piece sealed unit or hub and
bearing unit type assembly.
The hub and bearing (1) is mounted to the knuckle using four mounting bolts (2) and to the axle
half shaft using a retaining nut. The center of the hub and bearing is splined to match the outer joint
of the axle half shaft.
Each front hub and bearing has five wheel mounting studs on the hub flange for mounting the
wheel to the vehicle. The wheel mounting studs are the only replaceable components of the hub
and bearing. Otherwise, the hub and bearing is serviced as a complete assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Hub and Bearing - Description > Page 6797
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Rear Hub and Bearing - Description
DESCRIPTION
The rear wheel bearing and wheel mounting hub used on this vehicle are a one-piece sealed unit
or hub and bearing assembly. It is permanently lubricated when assembled and is sealed for life.
There is no periodic lubrication or maintenance recommended for these units.
The hub and bearing (1) is mounted to the rear knuckle.
All vehicles have a magnetic encoder integrated into the rear hub and bearing for speed sense.
The encoder works with the rear wheel speed sensor (2) to provide wheel speed signal.
The only serviceable components of the hub and bearing are the wheel mounting studs pressed
into the hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Front Hub and Bearing
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Front Hub and Bearing
HUB AND BEARING
NOTE: The wheel bearing is designed to last for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of
periodic maintenance.
The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the hub and bearing.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly, disc brake caliper and brake rotor. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
2. Rotate the wheel hub checking for resistance or roughness.
Any roughness or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the
bearing exhibits any of these conditions, the hub bearing will require replacement. Do not attempt
to disassemble the bearing for repair. If the wheel bearing is disassembled for any reason, it must
be replaced.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require hub and bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weeping from the bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the hub and bearing.
To diagnose a bent hub, measure hub runout. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Front Hub and Bearing > Page 6800
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Rear Hub and Bearing
HUB AND BEARING
NOTE: The wheel bearing is designed to last for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of
periodic maintenance.
The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the wheel bearing and hub.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly, disc brake caliper and brake rotor. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
2. Rotate the wheel hub checking for resistance or roughness.
Any roughness or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the
bearing exhibits any of these conditions, the hub and bearing will require replacement. Do not
attempt to disassemble the bearing for repair. If the wheel bearing is disassembled for any reason,
it must be replaced.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weapage from the bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the wheel bearing.
To diagnose a bent hub, measure hub runout. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Hub and Bearing - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, review all Warnings and Cautions. See: Service Precautions/Technician
Safety Information
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the hub from rotating, remove the hub nut (1) from the
axle half shaft (2). 4. Access and remove the front brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6803
5. Remove the four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing to the knuckle (3). 6. Slide the hub and
bearing (1) off the half shaft and out of the knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6804
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Hub and Bearing - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the hub and bearing (1) by sliding it over the half shaft and into the knuckle. 2. Install the
four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing (1) to the knuckle (3). Tighten the four bolts to 82 Nm
(60 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the brake rotor, disc brake caliper and adapter. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
4. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 5. Install the hub nut (1)
on the end of the half shaft (2) and lightly tighten it. 6. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the
hub from rotating, tighten the hub nut (1) to 132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6805
7. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Install and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6806
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Hub and Bearing - Removal
ALL-WHEEL-DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Service Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the cotter pin (2) from the hub nut (3) on the end of the axle half shaft. 4. While a helper
applies the brakes to keep the hub (1) from rotating, remove the hub nut (3) and washer (4) from
the axle half shaft. 5. Tap the end of the half shaft inward, loosening it from the hub and bearing.
This will also allow more room to access the hub and bearing
mounting bolts in a later step.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance
between the pads and the rotor to easily remove the caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be
accomplished before removal by grasping the inboard side of the caliper and pulling outward
working with the guide pins, thus retracting the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may
get damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6807
6. Remove two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) to the knuckle (3).
7. Remove the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) as an assembly from the knuckle (3) and
rotor. Hang the assembly out of the way using wire
or a bungee cord. Use care not to overextend the brake hose when doing this.
8. Remove any retaining clips, then slide the brake rotor (2) off the hub and bearing (1).
CAUTION: Prior to removal, clean area around sensor head to help prevent contaminants from
entering bearing when sensor head is
removed.
9. Remove the screw (3) fastening the speed sensor head (2) to the hub and bearing (1).
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor head (2) from the hub and bearing (1), then pass it through
the brake shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6808
11. Remove the four bolts (1) securing the hub and bearing to the knuckle. 12. Remove the hub
and bearing from the knuckle and half shaft (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6809
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Hub and Bearing - Installation
ALL-WHEEL-DRIVE
1. With the brake shield in place on the knuckle, slide the hub and bearing over the axle half shaft
and position it on the knuckle. 2. Install the four bolts (1) securing the hub and bearing to the
knuckle. Tighten the bolts to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Ensure that sensor mounting surface on bearing is clean before sensor installation.
3. Pass the wheel speed sensor head (2) through the hole in the brake shield, then push it into the
mounting hole in hub and bearing (1) and align the
mounting screw hole.
4. Install a NEW mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting screw to 6 Nm (55 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6810
5. Clean the rotor mounting face of the hub and bearing (1) to remove any dirt or corrosion. 6.
Install the brake rotor (2) over the hub and bearing (1).
CAUTION: If the brake rotor or brake pads are being replaced, the rear caliper piston must be
seated (bottomed) to compensate for the new
brake rotor or lining. Because the parking brake self-adjuster mechanism is attached to the piston,
a special seating method is required. The only acceptable method is by rotating the piston back
into the bore using Retractor, Special Tool 8807, as described below. Any other seating method will
damage the self-adjuster mechanism.
7. If necessary, seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5). e. Thread the screw drive on
8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the caliper piston. Do not over
tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6811
8. Install the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) over the knuckle and rotor as an assembly.
9. Install the two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) to the knuckle.
Tighten the mounting bolts to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
10. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 11. Install the washer
(4) and hub nut (3) on the end of the half shaft and snug it. 12. While a helper applies the brakes to
keep the hub (1) from rotating, tighten the hub nut (3) to 245 Nm (181 ft. lbs.). 13. Insert the cotter
pin (2) through the notches in the nut and the hole in half shaft. If the notches in the nut do not line
up with the hole in the half
shaft, continue to tighten the nut until they do. Do not loosen the nut.
14. Wrap the cotter pin (2) ends tightly around the lock nut.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6812
15. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Install
and tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Pump the brake pedal several times to ensure the vehicle has a firm
brake pedal before moving it. Check the brake fluid level.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications > Front Suspension
Axle Nut: Specifications Front Suspension
Hub Nut................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications > Front Suspension > Page 6818
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear Suspension
Hub Nut................................................................................................................................................
...................................................245 Nm (181 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Vehicle Lifting: Service and Repair
HOISTING
Refer to Owner's Manual provided with vehicle for proper emergency jacking procedures.
WARNING: The hoisting and jack lifting points provided are for a complete vehicle. When the
engine or rear suspension is removed from a
vehicle, the center of gravity is altered making some hoisting conditions unstable. Properly support
or secure vehicle to hoisting device when these conditions exist. Failure to follow these instructions
may result in personal injury or death.
CAUTION: Do not position hoisting device on suspension components, damage to vehicle can
result.Do not attempt to raise one entire side of
the vehicle by placing a floor jack midway between the front and rear wheels. This practice may
result in permanent damage to the body.
When properly positioned, a floor jack can be used to lift the vehicle and support the raised vehicle
with jack stands.
A floor jack or any lifting device, must never be used on any part of the underbody other then the
described areas.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION
CAUTION: The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPM system
pressures have been established for the tire size equipped on the vehicle. Undesirable system
operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same
size, type, or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause sensor damage. Do not use aftermarket tire
sealants or balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with TPM, as damage to the sensors may
result.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. Use tire
pressure sensors in original style factory wheels
only. If aftermarket wheels are installed, and therefore do not contain tire pressure sensors, the
system will not function properly and the driver will be continuously notified of a system
malfunction.
CAUTION: After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure always reinstall the valve stem cap. This
will prevent moisture and dirt from
entering the valve stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Sensor.
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensor valve stem caps and cores are specially designed for the sensors.
Due to risk of corrosion, do not use a
standard valve stem cap or core in a tire pressure sensor in place of the original equipment style
sensor cap and core.
CAUTION: Any time a sensor is to be installed in a wheel, it is necessary to install a new
sensor-to-wheel seal, metal washer and valve stem
nut, to ensure air tight sealing.
CAUTION: When installing the valve core, be sure to tighten the core to specifications See:
Wheels/Specifications . Overtightening by a little as
three or four inch pounds can damage the sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM), one tire pressure sensor (6) is
mounted to each wheel (5) in place of the traditional tire valve stem. Each sensor has an internal
battery that lasts up to 10 years. The battery is not serviceable. At the time of battery failure, the
sensor must be replaced.
The TPM system operates on a 433 MHz radio frequency. The 433 MHz sensors (1) can be easily
identified by the part number.
CAUTION: Although additional sensors operating at 433 MHz sensors are available and are used
in other applications, they are not
interchangeable. Always make sure the correct sensor is being used and be sure to replace the
sensor with the correct part number.
NOTE: Once mounted inside a tire and wheel assembly you are not able to visually see the
difference between this sensor and other 315 MHz
and 433 MHz sensors. At that point, the TPM/RKE Analyzer 9936, with the Scan Tool may be used
to identify the sensor frequency or the tire can be dismounted allowing visual inspection of the
sensor body and part number.
The TPM sensors are designed for original style factory wheels. It is not recommended to install a
tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel (This could cause sealing and system performance
issues). Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. If aftermarket
wheels are installed and do not contain tire pressure sensors, the system will not function properly
and the driver will be continuously notified of a system malfunction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description > Page 6829
The serviceable components of the tire pressure sensor are:
- Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2) and Metal Washer (1)
- Valve Stem Cap (4)
- Valve Stem Core
- Valve Stem Nut (with pressed-in washer) (3)
NOTE: Any time a sensor is installed on a wheel, a new Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2), Metal Washer
(1) and Valve Stem Nut (3) must be installed
to ensure air tight sealing. A service kit is available.
The valve stem caps and cores are specifically designed for the tire pressure monitoring sensors.
Although similar to standard valve stem caps and cores, they are different. The valve stem cap has
a special seal inside to keep moisture and corrosion out. The valve stem core has a special nickel
coating to protect from corrosion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description > Page 6830
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The battery operated tire pressure sensor is both a transmitter and a receiver. The TPM sensor can
be forced to transmit by using a special tool such as a TPM-RKE Analyzer. Using a TPM-RKE
Analyzer can take up to a minute to force a transmission from a sensor.
NOTE: The TPM-RKE Analyzer will not define the mode.
The TPM sensor can be in one of the following operating modes:
- OFF MODE - A new TPM sensor will be in this mode. In this mode the sensor does not transmit
periodically on its own. By forcing a transmission from the sensor with the TPM-RKE Analyzer, it
will change to the STATIONARY MODE. The sensor will also automatically change from OFF
mode to the STATIONARY MODE once it experiences a great increase in pressure (i.e. installation
into a wheel/tire assembly and then inflated).
- WAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes when the vehicle is driven over
15mph (24km/h), but only after the vehicle was previously parked for a duration of 18 minutes or
greater. In WAL MODE the sensors transmit every 33 seconds and these transmissions contain
left/right information that allows the TPM Module to determine sensor location on the vehicle. WAL
MODE lasts for the first 10 minutes of consecutive driving, then NORMAL DRIVE mode ensues.
- FACTORY MODE- This is a special case of WAL MODE. If a TPM sensor has just been taken out
of OFF MODE, then for the first 3 minutes of the WAL period (10 minutes) the sensors transmit at
an accelerated rate of every 10 seconds. After the first 20 drives, then the sensors never again
transmit out of FACTORY MODE.
- NORMAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes after the first 10 minutes of a
drive. In NORMAL MODE the sensors transmit every 66 seconds and cease transmitting left/right
information.
- SERVICE MODE- Once a vehicle stops, the sensors go into SERVICE MODE. After 18 minutes
of no driving then the sensors go into the STATIONARY MODE. If the vehicle was stopped for less
than 18 minutes and driving resumes, then the sensors go back to the NORMAL MODE.
- STATIONARY MODE - When a vehicle has been stopped for more then 18 minutes, then the
sensor is forced into STATIONARY MODE. In STATIONARY MODE the sensor never transmits
any pressure information. The sensor leaves STATIONARY MODE and enters WAL MODE when
the vehicle is driven above 15mph (24km/h).
Each sensor's (transmitter) broadcast is uniquely coded so that the TPM module can monitor the
state of each of the sensors on the four rotating road wheels. The TPM module can automatically
learn and store the sensor's ID while driving "within 20 minutes continuously above 15 mph (24
km/h)" after a sensor has been replaced. The vehicle must be stationary for more then 20 minutes
in order to initiate the learning sequence. The TPM module can also learn the sensor's ID using the
TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool following the procedure listed in the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly.
CAUTION: The cap used on this valve stem contains an O-ring seal to prevent contamination and
moisture from entering the valve stem.
Retain this valve stem cap for reuse. Do not substitute a regular valve stem cap in its place.
CAUTION: The valve stem used on this vehicle is made of aluminum and the core is nickel plated
brass. The original valve stem core must be
reinstalled and not substituted with a valve stem core made of a different material. This is required
to prevent corrosion in the valve stem caused by the different metals.
3. Dismount tire from wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions while paying special
attention to the following to avoid damaging the
pressure sensor: a. When breaking the tire bead loose from the wheel rim, avoid using the Bead
Breaker in the area of the sensor (1). That includes both outer and
inner beads of the tire.
b. When preparing to dismount the tire from the wheel, carefully insert the mounting/dismounting
tool 280° from the valve stem ± 10°, then
proceed to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use this process on both outer and inner tire beads.
4. Remove sensor nut (3) retaining sensor to wheel. While removing nut, hold pressure against
rear of metal valve stem to keep valve stem from
pushing rearward, damaging antenna strap.
5. Remove sensor (1) from wheel (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
> Page 6833
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before reinstalling an existing tire pressure sensor, replace seal (2) and metal washer (1) at
base of sensor valve stem (6) to ensure
proper sealing.
1. Wipe area clean around sensor/valve stem mounting hole in wheel (5). Make sure surface of
wheel is not damaged.
CAUTION: To avoid damaging sensor antenna strap (1), if equipped, hold pressure against rear of
metal valve stem (2) while sensor is
inserted through wheel mounting hole and nut is installed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
> Page 6834
2. Insert sensor (1) through wheel (2) as shown keeping pressure against rear of metal valve stem
(See Arrow). Potted side of sensor is to be
positioned toward wheel. Do not attempt to mount sensor otherwise, damage may occur.
3. Install sensor nut (with pressed-in washer) (3) by hand.
NOTE: Before tightening sensor nut, push downward on sensor housing (2) in an attempt to make
it flush with interior contour of wheel (1).
4. While holding sensor in position, tighten sensor nut to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Over-torquing the sensor nut by as little as 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.) may result in sensor
separation from the valve stem. Under this
condition, the sensor may still function. However, the condition should be corrected immediately.
5. Mount tire on wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions, paying special attention to
the following to avoid damaging tire pressure
sensor: a.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
> Page 6835
Rotating Wheel Tire Changers - Once the wheel is mounted to the changer, position the sensor
valve stem (2) approximately 280° from the head of the changer (located at 1) in a clockwise
direction before rotating the wheel (also in a clockwise direction) to mount the tire. Use this
procedure on both the outer and inner tire beads.
b.
Rotating Tool Tire Changers - Position the wheel on the changer so that the sensor valve stem (1)
is located approximately 210° clockwise from the installation end of the mounting/dismounting tool
(2) once the tool is mounted for tire installation. Make sure the sensor is clear of the lower bead
breaker area (3) to avoid damaging the sensor when the breaker rises. Rotate the tool (2) in a
counterclockwise direction to mount the tire. Use this procedure on both the upper and lower tire
beads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
> Page 6836
6. Adjust air pressure to that listed on Tire Inflation Pressure Label (Placard) provided with vehicle
(applied to driver's side B-pillar). Make sure
original style and color valve stem cap is securely installed to keep moisture out of sensor.
7. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) on vehicle See: Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Tighten wheel
mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower vehicle. 9. Perform one of the following to make the system learn the new sensor ID.
a. Use the TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool to program the WIN with the
tire pressure sensor ID. This is part of the
TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
b. Once the vehicle has remained stationary for more than 20 minutes, drive vehicle for a minimum
of 10 minutes while maintaining a continuous
speed above 15 mph (24 km/h). During this time, the system will learn the new sensor ID. This is
part of the TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
NOTE: If a sensor cannot be trained, refer to appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION
CAUTION: The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPM system
pressures have been established for the tire size equipped on the vehicle. Undesirable system
operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same
size, type, or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause sensor damage. Do not use aftermarket tire
sealants or balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with TPM, as damage to the sensors may
result.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. Use tire
pressure sensors in original style factory wheels
only. If aftermarket wheels are installed, and therefore do not contain tire pressure sensors, the
system will not function properly and the driver will be continuously notified of a system
malfunction.
CAUTION: After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure always reinstall the valve stem cap. This
will prevent moisture and dirt from
entering the valve stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Sensor.
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensor valve stem caps and cores are specially designed for the sensors.
Due to risk of corrosion, do not use a
standard valve stem cap or core in a tire pressure sensor in place of the original equipment style
sensor cap and core.
CAUTION: Any time a sensor is to be installed in a wheel, it is necessary to install a new
sensor-to-wheel seal, metal washer and valve stem
nut, to ensure air tight sealing.
CAUTION: When installing the valve core, be sure to tighten the core to specifications See:
Wheels/Specifications . Overtightening by a little as
three or four inch pounds can damage the sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM), one tire pressure sensor (6) is
mounted to each wheel (5) in place of the traditional tire valve stem. Each sensor has an internal
battery that lasts up to 10 years. The battery is not serviceable. At the time of battery failure, the
sensor must be replaced.
The TPM system operates on a 433 MHz radio frequency. The 433 MHz sensors (1) can be easily
identified by the part number.
CAUTION: Although additional sensors operating at 433 MHz sensors are available and are used
in other applications, they are not
interchangeable. Always make sure the correct sensor is being used and be sure to replace the
sensor with the correct part number.
NOTE: Once mounted inside a tire and wheel assembly you are not able to visually see the
difference between this sensor and other 315 MHz
and 433 MHz sensors. At that point, the TPM/RKE Analyzer 9936, with the Scan Tool may be used
to identify the sensor frequency or the tire can be dismounted allowing visual inspection of the
sensor body and part number.
The TPM sensors are designed for original style factory wheels. It is not recommended to install a
tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel (This could cause sealing and system performance
issues). Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. If aftermarket
wheels are installed and do not contain tire pressure sensors, the system will not function properly
and the driver will be continuously notified of a system malfunction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description >
Page 6843
The serviceable components of the tire pressure sensor are:
- Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2) and Metal Washer (1)
- Valve Stem Cap (4)
- Valve Stem Core
- Valve Stem Nut (with pressed-in washer) (3)
NOTE: Any time a sensor is installed on a wheel, a new Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2), Metal Washer
(1) and Valve Stem Nut (3) must be installed
to ensure air tight sealing. A service kit is available.
The valve stem caps and cores are specifically designed for the tire pressure monitoring sensors.
Although similar to standard valve stem caps and cores, they are different. The valve stem cap has
a special seal inside to keep moisture and corrosion out. The valve stem core has a special nickel
coating to protect from corrosion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description >
Page 6844
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The battery operated tire pressure sensor is both a transmitter and a receiver. The TPM sensor can
be forced to transmit by using a special tool such as a TPM-RKE Analyzer. Using a TPM-RKE
Analyzer can take up to a minute to force a transmission from a sensor.
NOTE: The TPM-RKE Analyzer will not define the mode.
The TPM sensor can be in one of the following operating modes:
- OFF MODE - A new TPM sensor will be in this mode. In this mode the sensor does not transmit
periodically on its own. By forcing a transmission from the sensor with the TPM-RKE Analyzer, it
will change to the STATIONARY MODE. The sensor will also automatically change from OFF
mode to the STATIONARY MODE once it experiences a great increase in pressure (i.e. installation
into a wheel/tire assembly and then inflated).
- WAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes when the vehicle is driven over
15mph (24km/h), but only after the vehicle was previously parked for a duration of 18 minutes or
greater. In WAL MODE the sensors transmit every 33 seconds and these transmissions contain
left/right information that allows the TPM Module to determine sensor location on the vehicle. WAL
MODE lasts for the first 10 minutes of consecutive driving, then NORMAL DRIVE mode ensues.
- FACTORY MODE- This is a special case of WAL MODE. If a TPM sensor has just been taken out
of OFF MODE, then for the first 3 minutes of the WAL period (10 minutes) the sensors transmit at
an accelerated rate of every 10 seconds. After the first 20 drives, then the sensors never again
transmit out of FACTORY MODE.
- NORMAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes after the first 10 minutes of a
drive. In NORMAL MODE the sensors transmit every 66 seconds and cease transmitting left/right
information.
- SERVICE MODE- Once a vehicle stops, the sensors go into SERVICE MODE. After 18 minutes
of no driving then the sensors go into the STATIONARY MODE. If the vehicle was stopped for less
than 18 minutes and driving resumes, then the sensors go back to the NORMAL MODE.
- STATIONARY MODE - When a vehicle has been stopped for more then 18 minutes, then the
sensor is forced into STATIONARY MODE. In STATIONARY MODE the sensor never transmits
any pressure information. The sensor leaves STATIONARY MODE and enters WAL MODE when
the vehicle is driven above 15mph (24km/h).
Each sensor's (transmitter) broadcast is uniquely coded so that the TPM module can monitor the
state of each of the sensors on the four rotating road wheels. The TPM module can automatically
learn and store the sensor's ID while driving "within 20 minutes continuously above 15 mph (24
km/h)" after a sensor has been replaced. The vehicle must be stationary for more then 20 minutes
in order to initiate the learning sequence. The TPM module can also learn the sensor's ID using the
TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool following the procedure listed in the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly.
CAUTION: The cap used on this valve stem contains an O-ring seal to prevent contamination and
moisture from entering the valve stem.
Retain this valve stem cap for reuse. Do not substitute a regular valve stem cap in its place.
CAUTION: The valve stem used on this vehicle is made of aluminum and the core is nickel plated
brass. The original valve stem core must be
reinstalled and not substituted with a valve stem core made of a different material. This is required
to prevent corrosion in the valve stem caused by the different metals.
3. Dismount tire from wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions while paying special
attention to the following to avoid damaging the
pressure sensor: a. When breaking the tire bead loose from the wheel rim, avoid using the Bead
Breaker in the area of the sensor (1). That includes both outer and
inner beads of the tire.
b. When preparing to dismount the tire from the wheel, carefully insert the mounting/dismounting
tool 280° from the valve stem ± 10°, then
proceed to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use this process on both outer and inner tire beads.
4. Remove sensor nut (3) retaining sensor to wheel. While removing nut, hold pressure against
rear of metal valve stem to keep valve stem from
pushing rearward, damaging antenna strap.
5. Remove sensor (1) from wheel (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 6847
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before reinstalling an existing tire pressure sensor, replace seal (2) and metal washer (1) at
base of sensor valve stem (6) to ensure
proper sealing.
1. Wipe area clean around sensor/valve stem mounting hole in wheel (5). Make sure surface of
wheel is not damaged.
CAUTION: To avoid damaging sensor antenna strap (1), if equipped, hold pressure against rear of
metal valve stem (2) while sensor is
inserted through wheel mounting hole and nut is installed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 6848
2. Insert sensor (1) through wheel (2) as shown keeping pressure against rear of metal valve stem
(See Arrow). Potted side of sensor is to be
positioned toward wheel. Do not attempt to mount sensor otherwise, damage may occur.
3. Install sensor nut (with pressed-in washer) (3) by hand.
NOTE: Before tightening sensor nut, push downward on sensor housing (2) in an attempt to make
it flush with interior contour of wheel (1).
4. While holding sensor in position, tighten sensor nut to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Over-torquing the sensor nut by as little as 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.) may result in sensor
separation from the valve stem. Under this
condition, the sensor may still function. However, the condition should be corrected immediately.
5. Mount tire on wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions, paying special attention to
the following to avoid damaging tire pressure
sensor: a.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 6849
Rotating Wheel Tire Changers - Once the wheel is mounted to the changer, position the sensor
valve stem (2) approximately 280° from the head of the changer (located at 1) in a clockwise
direction before rotating the wheel (also in a clockwise direction) to mount the tire. Use this
procedure on both the outer and inner tire beads.
b.
Rotating Tool Tire Changers - Position the wheel on the changer so that the sensor valve stem (1)
is located approximately 210° clockwise from the installation end of the mounting/dismounting tool
(2) once the tool is mounted for tire installation. Make sure the sensor is clear of the lower bead
breaker area (3) to avoid damaging the sensor when the breaker rises. Rotate the tool (2) in a
counterclockwise direction to mount the tire. Use this procedure on both the upper and lower tire
beads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 6850
6. Adjust air pressure to that listed on Tire Inflation Pressure Label (Placard) provided with vehicle
(applied to driver's side B-pillar). Make sure
original style and color valve stem cap is securely installed to keep moisture out of sensor.
7. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) on vehicle See: Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation. Tighten wheel
mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower vehicle. 9. Perform one of the following to make the system learn the new sensor ID.
a. Use the TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool to program the WIN with the
tire pressure sensor ID. This is part of the
TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
b. Once the vehicle has remained stationary for more than 20 minutes, drive vehicle for a minimum
of 10 minutes while maintaining a continuous
speed above 15 mph (24 km/h). During this time, the system will learn the new sensor ID. This is
part of the TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
NOTE: If a sensor cannot be trained, refer to appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 22-002-10 > May > 10 > Wheels/Tire - Highway Speed Vibration/Shake
Tires: Customer Interest Wheels/Tire - Highway Speed Vibration/Shake
NUMBER: 22-002-10
GROUP: Wheels/Tires
DATE: May O7, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 22-001-08, DATED APRIL 19, 2008,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE THE ADDITION OF VEHICLE MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Vehicle Vibration / Shake At Highway Speed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin provides information to diagnose vehicle vibration concerns.
MODELS:
2009-**2010** (JC) Journey
DISCUSSION: Tires used on the Journey models include nylon cap material as part of their
construction.
Tires that include Nylon can temporarily "flat spot" when vehicles are shipped by car hauler or rail
and if vehicles are stored for an extended period.
Immediately following delivery, some vehicles may exhibit a vibration / shake due to temporary tire
flat-spotting. The vibration may be felt in the steering wheel and / or seat, and may be most
noticeable at highway speeds, 60mph (96 kph). This may be misinterpreted as an out of balance
tire.
NOTE:
Do not attempt to rebalance the wheel/tire assembly until the vehicle has been driven for an
extended period (20 minutes or more) at highway speeds.
If the tires are flat-spotted, the vehicle vibration will go away after the tires are warmed up,
(normally 10 to 20 minutes of highway driving depending on outside temperatures). If highway
driving doesn't resolve the vehicle vibration, follow the procedures found in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Group 22 - Tires and Wheels > Tire and Wheel Vibration.
Replacing tires should only be done as a last resort after all appropriate wheel and tire diagnostics
have been completed. U.S. dealers can contact the MOPAR tire program if assistance is needed
with obtaining any tire.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
**TIME ALLOWANCE**:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 22-002-11 > Apr > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Alternative 19 Inch
Tires
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Alternative 19 Inch Tires
NUMBER: 22-002-11
GROUP: Tires and wheels
DATE: April 02, 2011
SUBJECT: Alternative 19 Inch Tires
OVERVIEW: This bulletin specifies alternative 19 tires that should be used if the Khumo Solus
KH16 P225/55R19 991 All Season (U.S. and Canada Markets Only) is not available.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles sold in U.S. and Canada (sales code YAA and YAC) markets only.
DISCUSSION:
The following 19 tires can be used as aftermarket replacement tires for the 2009 and 2010 model
year Dodge Journey in the event that the Khumo Solus KH16 P225/55R19 991 All Season (U.S.
and Canada Markets Only) are not available.
Approved Alternative Tires:
NOTE:
It is recommended to use these tires only as sets of four.
POLICY: Information Only.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 22-002-10 > May > 10 > Wheels/Tire - Highway Speed
Vibration/Shake
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tire - Highway Speed Vibration/Shake
NUMBER: 22-002-10
GROUP: Wheels/Tires
DATE: May O7, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 22-001-08, DATED APRIL 19, 2008,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE THE ADDITION OF VEHICLE MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Vehicle Vibration / Shake At Highway Speed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin provides information to diagnose vehicle vibration concerns.
MODELS:
2009-**2010** (JC) Journey
DISCUSSION: Tires used on the Journey models include nylon cap material as part of their
construction.
Tires that include Nylon can temporarily "flat spot" when vehicles are shipped by car hauler or rail
and if vehicles are stored for an extended period.
Immediately following delivery, some vehicles may exhibit a vibration / shake due to temporary tire
flat-spotting. The vibration may be felt in the steering wheel and / or seat, and may be most
noticeable at highway speeds, 60mph (96 kph). This may be misinterpreted as an out of balance
tire.
NOTE:
Do not attempt to rebalance the wheel/tire assembly until the vehicle has been driven for an
extended period (20 minutes or more) at highway speeds.
If the tires are flat-spotted, the vehicle vibration will go away after the tires are warmed up,
(normally 10 to 20 minutes of highway driving depending on outside temperatures). If highway
driving doesn't resolve the vehicle vibration, follow the procedures found in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT > Group 22 - Tires and Wheels > Tire and Wheel Vibration.
Replacing tires should only be done as a last resort after all appropriate wheel and tire diagnostics
have been completed. U.S. dealers can contact the MOPAR tire program if assistance is needed
with obtaining any tire.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
**TIME ALLOWANCE**:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 22-002-11 > Apr > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Alternative 19 Inch Tires
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Alternative 19 Inch Tires
NUMBER: 22-002-11
GROUP: Tires and wheels
DATE: April 02, 2011
SUBJECT: Alternative 19 Inch Tires
OVERVIEW: This bulletin specifies alternative 19 tires that should be used if the Khumo Solus
KH16 P225/55R19 991 All Season (U.S. and Canada Markets Only) is not available.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles sold in U.S. and Canada (sales code YAA and YAC) markets only.
DISCUSSION:
The following 19 tires can be used as aftermarket replacement tires for the 2009 and 2010 model
year Dodge Journey in the event that the Khumo Solus KH16 P225/55R19 991 All Season (U.S.
and Canada Markets Only) are not available.
Approved Alternative Tires:
NOTE:
It is recommended to use these tires only as sets of four.
POLICY: Information Only.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6873
Tires: Specifications
FASTENER TORQUE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Tires
Tires: Description and Operation Tires
TIRE
Tires are designed and engineered for each specific vehicle. They provide the best overall
performance for normal operation. The ride and handling characteristics match the vehicle's
requirements. With proper care they will give excellent reliability, traction, skid resistance, and tread
life.
Driving habits have more effect on tire life than any other factor. Careful drivers will obtain, in most
cases, much greater mileage than severe use or careless drivers. A few of the driving habits which
will shorten the life of any tire are:
- Rapid acceleration
- Severe application of brakes
- High-speed driving
- Taking turns at excessive speeds
- Striking curbs and other obstacles
- Operating vehicle with over or under inflated tire pressures
Radial ply tires are more prone to irregular tread wear. It is important to follow the tire rotation
interval on Tire Rotation. This will help to achieve a greater tread-life potential.
TIRE IDENTIFICATION
Tire type, size, load index and speed rating are encoded in the letters and numbers imprinted on
the side wall of the tire. Refer to the Tire Identification chart to decipher the code. For example
purposes, the tire size P225/60 R 16 97 T is used in the chart. An All Season type tire will also
have either M + S, M AND S, or M - S (indicating mud and snow traction) imprinted on the side
wall. An Extra or Light Load marking "XL" or "LL" may also be listed on the sidewall. The absence
of an "XL" or "LL" marking infers a standard load tire.
TIRE IDENTIFICATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Tires > Page 6876
NOTE: * Height (2) ÷ Width (1) = Aspect Ratio.
NOTE: ** Consult the tire manufacturer regarding any questions on tire specifications or
capabilities.
TIRE CHAINS
Refer to the owners manual supplied with the vehicle to determine whether the use of tire chains is
permitted on this vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Tires > Page 6877
Tires: Description and Operation Spare Tire
SPARE TIRE
A compact (temporary) spare tire and wheel assembly is standard equipment on this vehicle. A
full-size spare is available on some models.
Export vehicles are equipped with the TIREFIT tire repair kit as standard equipment in place of a
spare tire. It is to be used to repair small punctures in the tire as necessary. A compact spare tire is
optional.
The compact spare tire is designed for emergency use only. The original tire should be repaired or
replaced at the first opportunity, then reinstalled. Do not exceed speeds of 80 km/h (50 mph) when
using the compact spare tire.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Tires > Page 6878
Tires: Description and Operation Replacement Tires
REPLACEMENT TIRES
WARNING: Failure to equip the vehicle with tires having adequate speed capability can result in
sudden tire failure.
WARNING: In order to maintain the speed capability of the vehicle, replacement tires must have
speed ratings equal to or higher than those
fitted to the vehicle as original equipment. If tires with lower speed ratings are fitted, the vehicle's
handling may be affected and the speed capability of the vehicle may be lowered to the maximum
speed capability of the replacement tires. To avoid an accident resulting in severe or fatal injury,
consult the tire manufacturer in regards to maximum speed ratings.
It is recommended that tires equivalent to the original equipment tires be used when replacement is
needed.
Failure to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the safety and handling of the
vehicle.
The original equipment tires provide a proper combination of many characteristics such as:
- Ride
- Noise
- Handling
- Durability
- Tread life
- Traction
- Rolling resistance
- Speed capability
The use of tires smaller than the minimum tire size approved for the vehicle can result in tire
overloading and failure.
Use tires that have the approved load rating for the vehicle and never overload them. Failure to
equip the vehicle with tires having adequate speed capability can result in sudden tire failure and
loss of vehicle control.
The use of oversize tires may cause interference with vehicle components. Under extremes of
suspension and steering travel, interference with vehicle components may cause tire damage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Tire Wear Patterns
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tire Wear Patterns
TIRE WEAR PATTERNS
Under inflation will cause wear on the shoulders of tire. Over inflation will cause wear at the center
of tire.
Excessive camber causes the tire to run at an angle to the road. One side of tread is then worn
more than the other.
Excessive toe-in or toe-out causes wear on the tread edges and a feathered effect across the
tread.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Tire Wear Patterns > Page 6881
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tread Wear Indicators
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
Tread wear indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread grooves. When tread depth is 1.6
mm (1/16 in.), the tread wear indicators will appear as a 13 mm (1/2 in.) band (3).
Tire replacement is necessary when indicators appear in two or more grooves or if localized
balding occurs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures
Tires: Procedures
Cleaning
TIRE CLEANING
Before delivery of a vehicle, remove the protective coating on the tires with white sidewalls or
raised white letters. To remove the protective coating, apply warm water and let it soak for a few
minutes. Afterwards, scrub the coating away with a soft bristle brush. Steam cleaning may also be
used to remove the coating.
CAUTION: DO NOT use gasoline, mineral oil, oil-based solvent or a wire brush for cleaning.
Tire Inflation Pressures
TIRE INFLATION PRESSURES
The specified tire pressures have been chosen to provide safe operation, vehicle stability, and a
smooth ride. The proper tire pressure specification can be found on the Tire And Loading
Information Label provided with the vehicle (usually on the driver's door opening (B-pillar) or rear
shutface of driver's door).
A quality air pressure gauge is recommended to check tire air pressure. Tire pressure should be
checked cold once per month. Check tire pressure more frequently when the weather temperature
varies widely. Tire pressure will decrease when the outdoor temperature drops. After checking the
air pressure, replace valve cap finger tight.
Inflation pressures specified on the Tire Inflation Pressure Label are always the cold inflation
pressure of the tire. Cold inflation pressure is obtained after the vehicle has not been operated for
at least 3 hours, or the vehicle is driven less than one mile after being inoperative for 3 hours. Tire
inflation pressures may increase from 2 to 6 pounds per square inch (psi) during operation. Do not
reduce this normal pressure buildup.
Improper inflation can cause:
- Uneven wear patterns
- Reduced tread life
- Reduced fuel economy
- Unsatisfactory ride
- The vehicle to drift.
WARNING: Over or Under inflated tires can affect vehicle handling. The tire can fail suddenly,
resulting in loss of vehicle control.
Under inflation causes rapid shoulder wear, tire flexing, and can result in tire failure (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 6884
Over inflation causes rapid center wear and loss of the tire's ability to cushion shocks (1).
Tire Pressure For High Speed Operation
TIRE PRESSURE FOR HIGH SPEED OPERATION
Refer to the vehicle's Owners Manual Package.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 6885
Tires: Removal and Replacement
TIRE LEAK REPAIRING
For proper repairing, a radial tire must be removed from the wheel. Repairs should only be made if
the defect, or puncture, is in the tread area (1). The tire should be replaced if the puncture is
located in the sidewall.
Deflate tire completely before attempting to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use a lubricant such
as a mild soap solution when dismounting or mounting tire. Use tools free of burrs or sharp edges
which could damage the tire or wheel rim.
Before mounting tire on wheel, make sure all rust is removed from the rim bead and repaint if
necessary.
Install wheel on vehicle, and progressively tighten the five wheel nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Chrome Clad Wheel Balancing Information
Wheels: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Chrome Clad Wheel Balancing Information
NUMBER: 22-002-09
GROUP: Wheels/Tires
DATE: July 29, 2009
SUBJECT: Chrome Clad Wheel Adapters For Proper Balancing
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper wheel adapters when mounting Chrome
Clad wheels to wheel balancing equipment.
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2007 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2004 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2008 - 2010 (JS27) Sebring Convertible
2007 - 2010 (JS41) Sebring/Avenger
2007-2010 (KA) Nitro
2002-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005-2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2001 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Chrome Clad Wheel Balancing Information > Page 6890
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This information applies to any model equipped with Chrome Clad Wheels.
DISCUSSION:
Models equipped with Chrome Clad wheels require specific piloting on balance equipment to
properly center the wheel and prevent damage to the chrome clad surface. The chrome cladding is
not removable or replaceable and has cladding tabs that extend into the wheel bore. Traditional
high-taper cones will come into contact with the cladding tabs rather than properly seat on the hub
bore chamfer. Many modern aluminum wheel designs cannot be mounted with traditional cones.
Direct-Fit Collets should be used to properly mount clad wheels on balance equipment (Fig 1).
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
This kit includes the adapters for all Dodge, Chrysler & Jeep models with clad wheels. Individual
adapters for specific wheel sizes can be ordered separately. To order a kit or individual adapters,
contact Pentastar Service Equipment @ 1-800-223-5623.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6891
Wheels: Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
BASE WHEEL
TORQUE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6892
Wheels: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
All vehicles use either steel or cast aluminum drop center wheels. The original equipment wheels
are designed for proper operation at all loads up to the specified maximum vehicle capacity.
Every wheel has raised sections between the rim flanges (1) and drop well (3) called safety humps
(2). In case of air loss, these raised sections help hold the tire in position on the wheel until the
vehicle can be brought to a safe stop. When being installed on the wheel, initial inflation of the tire
forces the tire bead over these raised sections into place.
The wheel studs and nuts are designed for specific wheel applications and must be replaced with
equivalent parts. Do not use replacement parts of lesser quality or of a substitute design. All
aluminum and steel wheels have wheel stud nuts with an enlarged nose. This enlarged nose is
necessary to ensure proper retention of the wheels.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6893
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
WHEEL INSPECTION
Inspect wheels for:
- Excessive runout
- Dents, cracks or irregular bends
- Damaged wheel stud (lug) holes
- Air Leaks
NOTE: Do not attempt to repair a wheel by hammering, heating or welding.
If a wheel is damaged, an original equipment replacement wheel should be used. When obtaining
replacement wheels, they should be equivalent in load carrying capacity. The diameter, width,
offset, pilot hole and bolt circle of the wheel should be the same as the original wheel.
WARNING: Failure to use equivalent replacement wheels may adversely affect the safety and
handling of the vehicle.
WARNING: Replacement with used wheels is not recommended. The service history of the wheel
may have included severe treatment or very
high mileage. The rim could fail without warning.
WARNING: Chrysler LLC does not recommend that customers use "reconditioned" wheels (wheels
that have been damaged and repaired)
because they can result in a sudden catastrophic wheel failure which could cause loss of control
and result in injury or death. For clarification: Cosmetic refinishing for the purpose of repairing a superficial flaw is an acceptable procedure
providing it is limited to paint or clear coat only, the wheel is not modified in any way, and there is
no exposure to paint curing heat over 200 degrees Fahrenheit (93 degrees Celsius).
- Damaged wheels are those which have been bent, broken, cracked or sustained some other
physical damage which may have compromised the wheel structure.
- Repaired indicates that the wheel has been modified through bending, welding, heating,
straightening, or material removal to rectify damage.
- Re-plating of chrome plated wheels is not an acceptable procedure nor is chrome plating of
original equipment painted or polished wheels, as this may alter mechanical properties and affect
fatigue life.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6894
Wheels: Service and Repair
WHEEL AND WHEEL TRIM CARE
All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and chrome plated, should be cleaned regularly
using mild soap and water to maintain their luster and to prevent corrosion. Wash them with the
same soap solution recommended for the body of the vehicle.
When cleaning extremely dirty wheels, care must be taken in the selection of tire and wheel
cleaning chemicals and equipment to prevent damage to the wheels. Mopar(R) Tire AND Wheel
Cleaner, Mopar(R) Wheel Treatment or Mopar(R) Chrome Cleaner is recommended. Any of the
"DO NOT USE" items listed below can damage wheels and wheel trim.
DO NOT USE:
- Any abrasive cleaner
- Any abrasive cleaning pad (such as steel wool) or abrasive brush
- Any cleaner that contains an acid which can react with and discolor the chrome surface. Many
wheel cleaners contain acids that can harm the wheel surface.
- Oven cleaner
- A car wash that uses carbide-tipped wheel cleaning brushes or acidic solutions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Wheel bearing grease ...............................................................................................................
Mopar Multi-Purpose Lubricant NLGI Grade 2 EP, GC-LB
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Hub and Bearing - Description
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Front Hub and Bearing - Description
DESCRIPTION
The front wheel bearing and wheel hub of this vehicle are a one piece sealed unit or hub and
bearing unit type assembly.
The hub and bearing (1) is mounted to the knuckle using four mounting bolts (2) and to the axle
half shaft using a retaining nut. The center of the hub and bearing is splined to match the outer joint
of the axle half shaft.
Each front hub and bearing has five wheel mounting studs on the hub flange for mounting the
wheel to the vehicle. The wheel mounting studs are the only replaceable components of the hub
and bearing. Otherwise, the hub and bearing is serviced as a complete assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Hub and Bearing - Description > Page 6900
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Rear Hub and Bearing - Description
DESCRIPTION
The rear wheel bearing and wheel mounting hub used on this vehicle are a one-piece sealed unit
or hub and bearing assembly. It is permanently lubricated when assembled and is sealed for life.
There is no periodic lubrication or maintenance recommended for these units.
The hub and bearing (1) is mounted to the rear knuckle.
All vehicles have a magnetic encoder integrated into the rear hub and bearing for speed sense.
The encoder works with the rear wheel speed sensor (2) to provide wheel speed signal.
The only serviceable components of the hub and bearing are the wheel mounting studs pressed
into the hub.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front Hub and Bearing
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Front Hub and Bearing
HUB AND BEARING
NOTE: The wheel bearing is designed to last for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of
periodic maintenance.
The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the hub and bearing.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly, disc brake caliper and brake rotor. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
2. Rotate the wheel hub checking for resistance or roughness.
Any roughness or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the
bearing exhibits any of these conditions, the hub bearing will require replacement. Do not attempt
to disassemble the bearing for repair. If the wheel bearing is disassembled for any reason, it must
be replaced.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require hub and bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weeping from the bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the hub and bearing.
To diagnose a bent hub, measure hub runout. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front Hub and Bearing > Page 6903
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Rear Hub and Bearing
HUB AND BEARING
NOTE: The wheel bearing is designed to last for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of
periodic maintenance.
The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the wheel bearing and hub.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly, disc brake caliper and brake rotor. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
2. Rotate the wheel hub checking for resistance or roughness.
Any roughness or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the
bearing exhibits any of these conditions, the hub and bearing will require replacement. Do not
attempt to disassemble the bearing for repair. If the wheel bearing is disassembled for any reason,
it must be replaced.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weapage from the bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the wheel bearing.
To diagnose a bent hub, measure hub runout. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Hub and Bearing - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, review all Warnings and Cautions. See: Suspension/Service
Precautions/Technician Safety Information
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the hub from rotating, remove the hub nut (1) from the
axle half shaft (2). 4. Access and remove the front brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6906
5. Remove the four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing to the knuckle (3). 6. Slide the hub and
bearing (1) off the half shaft and out of the knuckle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6907
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Hub and Bearing - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the hub and bearing (1) by sliding it over the half shaft and into the knuckle. 2. Install the
four bolts (2) fastening the hub and bearing (1) to the knuckle (3). Tighten the four bolts to 82 Nm
(60 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the brake rotor, disc brake caliper and adapter. See: Brakes and Traction
Control/Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
4. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 5. Install the hub nut (1)
on the end of the half shaft (2) and lightly tighten it. 6. While a helper applies the brakes to keep the
hub from rotating, tighten the hub nut (1) to 132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6908
7. Install the tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires
and Wheels - Installation. Install and tighten
wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6909
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Hub and Bearing - Removal
ALL-WHEEL-DRIVE
NOTE: Before proceeding, See: Suspension/Service Precautions/Vehicle Damage Warnings .
1. Raise and support the vehicle. See: Maintenance
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts (3), then the tire and wheel assembly (1).
3. Remove the cotter pin (2) from the hub nut (3) on the end of the axle half shaft. 4. While a helper
applies the brakes to keep the hub (1) from rotating, remove the hub nut (3) and washer (4) from
the axle half shaft. 5. Tap the end of the half shaft inward, loosening it from the hub and bearing.
This will also allow more room to access the hub and bearing
mounting bolts in a later step.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance
between the pads and the rotor to easily remove the caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be
accomplished before removal by grasping the inboard side of the caliper and pulling outward
working with the guide pins, thus retracting the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may
get damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6910
6. Remove two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) to the knuckle (3).
7. Remove the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) as an assembly from the knuckle (3) and
rotor. Hang the assembly out of the way using wire
or a bungee cord. Use care not to overextend the brake hose when doing this.
8. Remove any retaining clips, then slide the brake rotor (2) off the hub and bearing (1).
CAUTION: Prior to removal, clean area around sensor head to help prevent contaminants from
entering bearing when sensor head is
removed.
9. Remove the screw (3) fastening the speed sensor head (2) to the hub and bearing (1).
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor head (2) from the hub and bearing (1), then pass it through
the brake shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6911
11. Remove the four bolts (1) securing the hub and bearing to the knuckle. 12. Remove the hub
and bearing from the knuckle and half shaft (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6912
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Hub and Bearing - Installation
ALL-WHEEL-DRIVE
1. With the brake shield in place on the knuckle, slide the hub and bearing over the axle half shaft
and position it on the knuckle. 2. Install the four bolts (1) securing the hub and bearing to the
knuckle. Tighten the bolts to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Ensure that sensor mounting surface on bearing is clean before sensor installation.
3. Pass the wheel speed sensor head (2) through the hole in the brake shield, then push it into the
mounting hole in hub and bearing (1) and align the
mounting screw hole.
4. Install a NEW mounting screw (2). Tighten the mounting screw to 6 Nm (55 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6913
5. Clean the rotor mounting face of the hub and bearing (1) to remove any dirt or corrosion. 6.
Install the brake rotor (2) over the hub and bearing (1).
CAUTION: If the brake rotor or brake pads are being replaced, the rear caliper piston must be
seated (bottomed) to compensate for the new
brake rotor or lining. Because the parking brake self-adjuster mechanism is attached to the piston,
a special seating method is required. The only acceptable method is by rotating the piston back
into the bore using Retractor, Special Tool 8807, as described below. Any other seating method will
damage the self-adjuster mechanism.
7. If necessary, seat (bottom) the caliper piston in the bore as follows:
a. Assemble a 3/8 in. drive ratchet handle and an extension (3). b. Insert the extension through
Special Tool 8807-1 (2). c. Place Special Tool 8807-2 (1) on the end of the extension. d. Insert lugs
on Special Tool 8807-2 into notches in face of caliper piston (5). e. Thread the screw drive on
8807-1 down until it contacts the top of 8807-2 which is against the caliper piston. Do not over
tighten the
screw-drive. Damage to the piston can occur.
f. Turn 8807-2 with the ratchet, rotating the piston in a clockwise direction until fully seated
(bottomed) in the bore. It may be necessary to turn 8807-1 with 8807-2 to start the process of
piston retraction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6914
8. Install the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) over the knuckle and rotor as an assembly.
9. Install the two bolts (1) securing the disc brake caliper and adapter bracket (2) to the knuckle.
Tighten the mounting bolts to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Always install a new hub nut. The original hub nut is one-time use only and should be
discarded when removed.
10. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the half shaft outer C/V joint. 11. Install the washer
(4) and hub nut (3) on the end of the half shaft and snug it. 12. While a helper applies the brakes to
keep the hub (1) from rotating, tighten the hub nut (3) to 245 Nm (181 ft. lbs.). 13. Insert the cotter
pin (2) through the notches in the nut and the hole in half shaft. If the notches in the nut do not line
up with the hole in the half
shaft, continue to tighten the nut until they do. Do not loosen the nut.
14. Wrap the cotter pin (2) ends tightly around the lock nut.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Hub and Bearing - Removal > Page 6915
15. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires
and Wheels - Installation. Install and tighten wheel
mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Pump the brake pedal several times to ensure the vehicle has a firm
brake pedal before moving it. Check the brake fluid level.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Wheel Cover - Removal
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Wheel Cover - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle so that tire and wheel assembly clears ground level. See:
Maintenance
CAUTION: When removing the bolt-on wheel cover, do not attempt to pry the wheel cover off the
wheel. It is held on by the wheel mounting
nuts.
2. Remove the five wheel mounting (lug) nuts (3) from the wheel studs. While removing the nuts,
hold the wheel cover (2) in place so it doesn't fall
off when the last nut is removed.
3. Remove the wheel cover (2) using care not to let the tire and wheel assembly (1) fall off the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Wheel Cover - Removal > Page 6920
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Wheel Cover - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Installing wheels without good metal-to-metal contact with the mounting surface could
cause loosening of the wheel mounting (lug)
nuts. This could adversely affect the safety and handling of the vehicle.
NOTE: Never use oil or grease on studs or wheel mounting (lug) nuts.
1. With the tire and wheel assembly (1) positioned on the wheel studs without the wheel mounting
(lug) nuts installed, align the valve notch in the
wheel cover with the valve stem on the wheel and install the wheel cover over the studs.
NOTE: Always use the original (OEM) style wheel mounting (lug) nuts. Do not use replacement
parts of lesser quality or substitute design.
2. Install and lightly snug all five wheel mounting (lug) nuts (3) Do not tighten at this time. 3. Lower
the vehicle.
4. Progressively tighten all wheel mounting (lug) nuts in the proper sequence shown. Tighten the
nuts to a final torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Specifications > Front Suspension
Axle Nut: Specifications Front Suspension
Hub Nut................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................132 Nm (97 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Specifications > Front Suspension > Page 6926
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear Suspension
Hub Nut................................................................................................................................................
...................................................245 Nm (181 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel Mounting (Lug) Nut....................................................................................................................
...................................................135 Nm (100 ft.lbs)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Wheel Stud - Removal
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Wheel Stud - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Use the following procedure to remove one of five studs on one wheel hub.
1. Access and remove front brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
CAUTION: Do not hammer wheel mounting studs out of the hub. Damage to the wheel bearing will
occur, leading to premature bearing
failure.
2. Install Remover 8677 (3) on the hub flange (1) and wheel stud (2). 3. Tighten the Remover,
pushing the wheel mounting stud out the rear of the hub flange. When the shoulder of the stud is
past the flange, remove the
Remover from the hub.
4. Remove the stud from the hub flange.
Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Use the following procedure to remove one of five studs on one wheel hub.
1. Access and remove rear brake rotor. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Disc Brake
System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Brake Rotor - Removal
CAUTION: Do not hammer wheel mounting studs out of the hub. Damage to the wheel bearing will
occur, leading to premature bearing
failure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Wheel Stud - Removal > Page 6932
2. Install Remover (3), Special Tool 8677, on the hub flange (1) and wheel stud (2). 3. Tighten the
Remover, pushing the wheel mounting stud out the rear of the hub flange. When the shoulder of
the stud is past the flange, remove the
Remover from the hub.
4. Remove the stud from the hub flange.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Wheel Stud - Removal > Page 6933
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Wheel Stud - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Use the following procedure to install one of five studs on one wheel hub.
1. Install the NEW wheel mounting stud in the flange of the hub (2) from the rear. 2. Install several
washers (1) and a standard wheel mounting (lug) nut (3) on the stud (4). Install the mounting nut so
that the flat side of the nut is
against the washers to eliminate any binding.
3. Tighten the wheel mounting nut. This will pull the wheel mounting stud into the hub flange. When
the head of the stud is fully seated against the
rear of the hub flange, remove the wheel mounting nut and washers.
4. Install the brake rotor and all components previously removed to access it. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
Rear
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Use the following procedure to install one of five studs on one wheel hub.
1. Install the NEW wheel mounting stud in the flange of the hub (2) from the rear. 2. Install several
washers (1) and a standard wheel mounting (lug) nut (3) on the stud (4). Install the mounting nut so
that the flat side of the nut is
against the washers to eliminate any binding.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Wheel Stud - Removal > Page 6934
3. Tighten the wheel mounting nut. This will pull the wheel mounting stud into the hub flange. When
the head of the stud is fully seated against the
rear of the hub flange, remove the wheel mounting nut and washers.
4. Install the brake rotor and all components previously removed to access it. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Disc Brake System/Brake
Rotor/Disc/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Brake Rotor - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Left Blend Door Actuator
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6941
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6942
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6943
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6944
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Mode Door Actuator
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6945
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6946
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Right Blend Door Actuator
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6947
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6948
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6949
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6950
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6951
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6952
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6953
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6954
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6955
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6956
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Left Blend Door Actuator > Page 6957
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
ACTUATOR-BLEND DOOR-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6960
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams Rear Blend Door Actuator (3 Zone HVAC) (Rear HVAC
Jumper) 6 Way
Connector (3 ZONE HVAC) - (REAR HVAC JUMPER) 6 WAY
ACTUATOR-BLEND DOOR-REAR (3 ZONE HVAC) - (REAR HVAC JUMPER) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6961
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams Right Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
ACTUATOR-BLEND DOOR-RIGHT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6962
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams Rear Mode Door Actuator (3 Zone HVAC) (Rear HVAC
Jumper) 6 Way
Connector (3 ZONE HVAC) - (REAR HVAC JUMPER) 6 WAY
ACTUATOR-MODE DOOR-REAR (3 ZONE HVAC) - (REAR HVAC JUMPER) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6963
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams
Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
ACTUATOR-BLEND DOOR-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Rear Blend Door Actuator (3 Zone HVAC) (Rear HVAC Jumper) 6 Way
Connector (3 ZONE HVAC) - (REAR HVAC JUMPER) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6964
ACTUATOR-BLEND DOOR-REAR (3 ZONE HVAC) - (REAR HVAC JUMPER) 6 WAY
Right Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
ACTUATOR-BLEND DOOR-RIGHT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Rear Mode Door Actuator (3 Zone HVAC) (Rear HVAC Jumper) 6 Way
Connector (3 ZONE HVAC) - (REAR HVAC JUMPER) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6965
ACTUATOR-MODE DOOR-REAR (3 ZONE HVAC) - (REAR HVAC JUMPER) 6 WAY
Recirculation Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
ACTUATOR-RECIRCULATION DOOR - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Blend Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 6966
Mode Door Actuator (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
ACTUATOR-MODE DOOR - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Description and Operation Blend Door Actuator - Description
Front
DESCRIPTION
The blend door actuators (1) for the front heating-A/C system are reversible, 12-volt direct current
(DC) servo motors. Models with the front single zone heating-A/C system have a single blend-air
door, which is controlled by a single blend door actuator. Models with the front dual zone
heating-A/C system have dual blend-air doors, which are controlled by two blend door actuators.
The blend door actuator for the single zone heating-A/C system is located on the driver side front
HVAC air distribution housing. For the dual zone heating-A/C system, the same blend door
actuator used for the single zone system becomes the driver side blend door actuator, which is
mechanically connected to only the driver side blend-air door. A second separate blend door
actuator is also located on the passenger side of the front air distribution housing which is
mechanically connected to only the passenger side blend-air door.
The blend door actuators are contained within a black molded plastic housing with an integral wire
connector receptacle (2). An output shaft with splines (3) connect the blend door actuators to the
blend door linkage. Three integral mounting tabs (4) allow the actuators to be secured to the air
distribution housing. The blend door actuators do not require mechanical indexing to the blend door
linkage, as they are electronically calibrated by the A/C-heater control.
The A/C-heater control must be recalibrated each time an actuator motor is replaced See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The blend door actuators are interchangeable with the actuators for the recirculation and mode-air
doors.
Rear
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6969
The blend door actuator (1) for the rear heating-A/C system is a reversible, 12 volt direct current
(DC), servo motor. The rear blend door actuator is located on the outboard side of the rear
heater-A/C housing.
The rear blend door actuator is contained within a black molded plastic housing with an integral
wire connector receptacle (2), an output shaft with splines (3) connect it to the rear blend-air door
and three integral mounting tabs (4) allow the actuator to be secured to the rear heater-A/C
housing. The blend door actuator does not require mechanical indexing to the blend door linkage,
as it is electronically calibrated by the A/C-heater control.
The A/C-heater control must be recalibrated each time an actuator motor is replaced See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic
Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear blend door actuator is interchangeable with the actuator for the rear mode-air door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6970
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Description and Operation Blend Door Actuator - Operation
Front
OPERATION
The blend door actuators are connected to the A/C-heater control through the vehicle electrical
system by a dedicated two-wire lead and connector. The blend door actuator(s) can move the
blend-air door(s) in two directions. When the A/C-heater control pulls the voltage on one side of the
motor connection high and the other connection low, the blend-air door will move in one direction.
When the A/C-heater control reverses the polarity of the voltage to the motor, the blend-air door
moves in the opposite direction. When the A/C-heater control makes the voltage to both
connections high or both connections low, the blend-air door stops and will not move.
The A/C-heater control uses a pulse-count positioning system to monitor the operation and relative
position of the blend door actuator(s) and the blend-air door(s). The A/C-heater control learns the
blend-air door stop positions during the calibration procedure and will store a diagnostic trouble
code(DTC) for any problems it detects in the blend door actuator circuits.
The blend door actuators are diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The blend door actuators cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Rear
OPERATION
The rear blend door actuator is connected to the A/C-heater control through the vehicle electrical
system by a dedicated two-wire lead and connector of the rear heater-A/C wire harness. The rear
blend door actuator can move the rear blend-air door in two directions. When the A/C-heater
control pulls the voltage on one side of the motor connection high and the other connection low, the
rear blend-air door will move in one direction. When the A/C-heater control reverses the polarity of
the voltage to the motor, the rear blend-air door moves in the opposite direction. When the front
A/C-heater control makes the voltage to both connections high or both connections low, the rear
blend-air door stops and will not move.
The front A/C-heater control uses a pulse-count positioning system to monitor the operation and
relative position of the rear blend door actuator and the rear blend-air door. The front A/C-heater
control learns the rear blend-air door stop positions during the calibration procedure and will store a
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) for any problems it detects in the rear blend door actuator circuits.
The rear blend door actuator is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear blend door actuator cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6971
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Description and Operation Mode Door Actuator - Description
Front
DESCRIPTION
The mode door actuator (1) for the heating-A/C system is a reversible, 12-volt Direct Current (DC)
servo motor, which is mechanically connected to the mode-air doors. The mode door actuator is
located on the right side of the HVAC air distribution housing.
The mode door actuator is contained within a black molded plastic housing with an integral wire
connector receptacle (2). An output shaft with splines (3) connect it to mode door linkage and
integral mounting tabs (4) allow the actuator to be secured to the air distribution housing. The mode
door actuator does not require mechanical indexing to the mode-air doors, as it is electronically
calibrated by the A/C-heater control.
The A/C-heater control must be recalibrated each time an actuator motor is replaced See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The mode door actuator is interchangeable with the actuators for the recirculation and blend-air
doors.
Rear
DESCRIPTION
The mode door actuator (1) for the rear heater-A/C system is a reversible, 12 volt direct current
(DC), servo motor. The rear mode door actuator is located on the outboard side of the rear
heater-A/C housing.
The rear mode door actuator is contained within a black molded plastic housing with an integral
wire connector receptacle (2), an output shaft with
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6972
splines (3) connect it to the rear mode-air door and three integral mounting tabs (4) allow the
actuator to be secured to the rear heater-A/C housing. The mode door actuator does not require
mechanical indexing to the mode door linkage, as it is electronically calibrated by the A/C-heater
control.
The A/C-heater control must be recalibrated each time an actuator motor is replaced See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The rear mode door actuator is interchangeable with the actuator for the rear blend-air door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6973
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Description and Operation Mode Door Actuator - Operation
Front
OPERATION
The mode door actuator is connected to the A/C-heater control through the vehicle electrical
system by a dedicated two-wire lead and connector of the instrument panel wire harness. The
mode door actuator can move the mode-air door in two directions. When the A/C-heater control
pulls the voltage on one side of the motor connection high and the other connection low, the
mode-air door will move in one direction. When the A/C-heater control reverses the polarity of the
voltage to the motor, the mode-air door moves in the opposite direction. Once the A/C-heater
control makes the voltage to both connections high or both connections low, the mode-air door
stops and will not move.
The A/C-heater control uses a pulse-count positioning system to monitor the operation and relative
position of the mode door actuator and the mode-air door. The A/C-heater control learns the
mode-air door stop positions during the calibration procedure and will store a diagnostic trouble
code (DTC) for any problems it detects in the mode door actuator circuits See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The mode door actuator cannot be adjusted or repaired and it must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Rear
OPERATION
The rear mode door actuator is connected to the A/C-heater control through the vehicle electrical
system by a dedicated two-wire lead and connector of the rear heater-A/C wire harness. The rear
mode door actuator can move the rear mode-air door in two directions. When the A/C-heater
control pulls the voltage on one side of the motor connection high and the other connection low, the
rear mode-air door will move in one direction. When the A/C-heater control reverses the polarity of
the voltage to the motor, the rear mode-air door moves in the opposite direction. When the front
A/C-heater control makes the voltage to both connections high or both connections low, the rear
mode-air door stops and will not move.
The front A/C-heater control uses a pulse-count positioning system to monitor the operation and
relative position of the rear mode door actuator and the rear mode-air door. The front A/C-heater
control learns the rear mode-air door stop positions during the calibration procedure and will store a
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) for any problems it detects in the rear mode door actuator circuits.
The rear mode door actuator is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear mode door actuator cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6974
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Description and Operation
Front
DESCRIPTION
The blend door actuators (1) for the front heating-A/C system are reversible, 12-volt direct current
(DC) servo motors. Models with the front single zone heating-A/C system have a single blend-air
door, which is controlled by a single blend door actuator. Models with the front dual zone
heating-A/C system have dual blend-air doors, which are controlled by two blend door actuators.
The blend door actuator for the single zone heating-A/C system is located on the driver side front
HVAC air distribution housing. For the dual zone heating-A/C system, the same blend door
actuator used for the single zone system becomes the driver side blend door actuator, which is
mechanically connected to only the driver side blend-air door. A second separate blend door
actuator is also located on the passenger side of the front air distribution housing which is
mechanically connected to only the passenger side blend-air door.
The blend door actuators are contained within a black molded plastic housing with an integral wire
connector receptacle (2). An output shaft with splines (3) connect the blend door actuators to the
blend door linkage. Three integral mounting tabs (4) allow the actuators to be secured to the air
distribution housing. The blend door actuators do not require mechanical indexing to the blend door
linkage, as they are electronically calibrated by the A/C-heater control.
The A/C-heater control must be recalibrated each time an actuator motor is replaced See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The blend door actuators are interchangeable with the actuators for the recirculation and mode-air
doors.
Rear
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6975
The blend door actuator (1) for the rear heating-A/C system is a reversible, 12 volt direct current
(DC), servo motor. The rear blend door actuator is located on the outboard side of the rear
heater-A/C housing.
The rear blend door actuator is contained within a black molded plastic housing with an integral
wire connector receptacle (2), an output shaft with splines (3) connect it to the rear blend-air door
and three integral mounting tabs (4) allow the actuator to be secured to the rear heater-A/C
housing. The blend door actuator does not require mechanical indexing to the blend door linkage,
as it is electronically calibrated by the A/C-heater control.
The A/C-heater control must be recalibrated each time an actuator motor is replaced See:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic
Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear blend door actuator is interchangeable with the actuator for the rear mode-air door.
Front
OPERATION
The blend door actuators are connected to the A/C-heater control through the vehicle electrical
system by a dedicated two-wire lead and connector. The blend door actuator(s) can move the
blend-air door(s) in two directions. When the A/C-heater control pulls the voltage on one side of the
motor connection high and the other connection low, the blend-air door will move in one direction.
When the A/C-heater control reverses the polarity of the voltage to the motor, the blend-air door
moves in the opposite direction. When the A/C-heater control makes the voltage to both
connections high or both connections low, the blend-air door stops and will not move.
The A/C-heater control uses a pulse-count positioning system to monitor the operation and relative
position of the blend door actuator(s) and the blend-air door(s). The A/C-heater control learns the
blend-air door stop positions during the calibration procedure and will store a diagnostic trouble
code(DTC) for any problems it detects in the blend door actuator circuits.
The blend door actuators are diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The blend door actuators cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Rear
OPERATION
The rear blend door actuator is connected to the A/C-heater control through the vehicle electrical
system by a dedicated two-wire lead and connector of the rear heater-A/C wire harness. The rear
blend door actuator can move the rear blend-air door in two directions. When the A/C-heater
control pulls the voltage on one side of the motor connection high and the other connection low, the
rear blend-air door will move in one direction. When the A/C-heater control reverses the polarity of
the voltage to the motor, the rear blend-air door moves in the opposite direction. When the front
A/C-heater control makes the voltage to both connections high or both connections low, the rear
blend-air door stops and will not move.
The front A/C-heater control uses a pulse-count positioning system to monitor the operation and
relative position of the rear blend door actuator and the rear blend-air door. The front A/C-heater
control learns the rear blend-air door stop positions during the calibration procedure and will store a
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) for any problems it detects in the rear blend door actuator circuits.
The rear blend door actuator is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6976
The rear blend door actuator cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Front
DESCRIPTION
The mode door actuator (1) for the heating-A/C system is a reversible, 12-volt Direct Current (DC)
servo motor, which is mechanically connected to the mode-air doors. The mode door actuator is
located on the right side of the HVAC air distribution housing.
The mode door actuator is contained within a black molded plastic housing with an integral wire
connector receptacle (2). An output shaft with splines (3) connect it to mode door linkage and
integral mounting tabs (4) allow the actuator to be secured to the air distribution housing. The mode
door actuator does not require mechanical indexing to the mode-air doors, as it is electronically
calibrated by the A/C-heater control.
The A/C-heater control must be recalibrated each time an actuator motor is replaced See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The mode door actuator is interchangeable with the actuators for the recirculation and blend-air
doors.
Rear
DESCRIPTION
The mode door actuator (1) for the rear heater-A/C system is a reversible, 12 volt direct current
(DC), servo motor. The rear mode door actuator is located on the outboard side of the rear
heater-A/C housing.
The rear mode door actuator is contained within a black molded plastic housing with an integral
wire connector receptacle (2), an output shaft with splines (3) connect it to the rear mode-air door
and three integral mounting tabs (4) allow the actuator to be secured to the rear heater-A/C
housing. The
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6977
mode door actuator does not require mechanical indexing to the mode door linkage, as it is
electronically calibrated by the A/C-heater control.
The A/C-heater control must be recalibrated each time an actuator motor is replaced See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The rear mode door actuator is interchangeable with the actuator for the rear blend-air door.
Front
OPERATION
The mode door actuator is connected to the A/C-heater control through the vehicle electrical
system by a dedicated two-wire lead and connector of the instrument panel wire harness. The
mode door actuator can move the mode-air door in two directions. When the A/C-heater control
pulls the voltage on one side of the motor connection high and the other connection low, the
mode-air door will move in one direction. When the A/C-heater control reverses the polarity of the
voltage to the motor, the mode-air door moves in the opposite direction. Once the A/C-heater
control makes the voltage to both connections high or both connections low, the mode-air door
stops and will not move.
The A/C-heater control uses a pulse-count positioning system to monitor the operation and relative
position of the mode door actuator and the mode-air door. The A/C-heater control learns the
mode-air door stop positions during the calibration procedure and will store a diagnostic trouble
code (DTC) for any problems it detects in the mode door actuator circuits See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The mode door actuator cannot be adjusted or repaired and it must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Rear
OPERATION
The rear mode door actuator is connected to the A/C-heater control through the vehicle electrical
system by a dedicated two-wire lead and connector of the rear heater-A/C wire harness. The rear
mode door actuator can move the rear mode-air door in two directions. When the A/C-heater
control pulls the voltage on one side of the motor connection high and the other connection low, the
rear mode-air door will move in one direction. When the A/C-heater control reverses the polarity of
the voltage to the motor, the rear mode-air door moves in the opposite direction. When the front
A/C-heater control makes the voltage to both connections high or both connections low, the rear
mode-air door stops and will not move.
The front A/C-heater control uses a pulse-count positioning system to monitor the operation and
relative position of the rear mode door actuator and the rear mode-air door. The front A/C-heater
control learns the rear mode-air door stop positions during the calibration procedure and will store a
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) for any problems it detects in the rear mode door actuator circuits.
The rear mode door actuator is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear mode door actuator cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Recirculation Door Actuator - Description
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Blend Door Actuator - Description > Page 6978
The recirculation door actuator (1) is a reversible, 12 volt direct current (DC) servo motor, which is
connected directly to the pivot shaft lever of the recirculation-air door. The recirculation door
actuator is located on the right side of the HVAC air inlet housing.
The recirculation door actuator is contained within a black molded plastic housing with an integral
wire connector receptacle (2), an output shaft with splines (3) connect it to the recirculation door
and three integral mounting tabs (4) allow the actuator to be secured to the air inlet housing. The
recirculation door actuator does not require mechanical indexing to the recirculation-air door, as it
is electronically calibrated by the A/C-heater control.
The A/C-heater control must be recalibrated each time an actuator motor is replaced See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The recirculation door actuator is interchangeable with the actuators for the blend and mode-air
doors.
Recirculation Door Actuator - Operation
OPERATION
The recirculation door actuator is connected to the A/C-heater control through the vehicle electrical
system by a dedicated two-wire lead and connector of the instrument panel wire harness. The
recirculation door actuator can move the recirculation-air door in two directions. When the
A/C-heater control pulls the voltage on one side of the motor connection high and the other
connection low, the recirculation-air door will move in one direction. When the A/C-heater control
reverses the polarity of the voltage to the motor, the recirculation-air door moves in the opposite
direction. Once the A/C-heater control makes the voltage to both connections high or both
connections low, the recirculation-air door stops and will not move.
The A/C-heater control uses a pulse-count positioning system to monitor the operation and relative
position of the recirculation door actuator and the recirculation-air door. The A/C-heater control
learns the recirculation-air door stop positions during the calibration procedure and will store a
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) for any problems it detects in the recirculation door actuator circuits
See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic
Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures.
The recirculation door actuator cannot be adjusted or repaired and it must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Blend Door Actuator - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The single zone heating-A/C system is equipped with a single blend door actuator. The dual
zone system has two blend door actuators,
one for the driver side blend-air door and one for the passenger side blend-air door.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
SINGLE ZONE/DUAL ZONE LEFT SIDE
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. On RHD models, if equipped, remove the
silencer from underneath the passenger side of the instrument panel. 3. On RHD models, remove
the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and
Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Removal.
4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1) from the blend door actuator (2) located on the left
side of the HVAC air distribution housing (3). 5. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the blend
door actuator to the air distribution housing and remove the actuator.
DUAL ZONE RIGHT SIDE
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. On LHD models, if equipped, remove the
silencer from underneath the passenger side of the instrument panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6981
3. On LHD models, remove the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Removal.
4. Remove the front floor distribution duct from the right side of the air distribution housing See: Air
Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution
Duct - Installation.
5. Remove the screws (2) that secure the blend door actuator (1) to the right side of the air
distribution housing (4) and remove the actuator from the
housing.
6. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the blend door actuator and remove the actuator
from the vehicle.
Rear
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove rear heater-A/C housing (4) and
place it on a workbench . 3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the rear blend door
actuator (2) located on the outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing. 4. Remove the two
screws (1) that secure the rear blend door actuator to the rear heater-A/C housing and remove the
actuator.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6982
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Blend Door Actuator - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The single zone heating-A/C system is equipped with a single blend door actuator. The dual
zone system has two blend door actuators,
one for the driver side blend-air door and one for the passenger side blend-air door.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
SINGLE ZONE/DUAL ZONE LEFT SIDE
1. Position the blend door actuator (2) onto the left side of the HVAC air distribution housing (3). If
necessary, rotate the actuator slightly to align the
splines on the actuator output shaft with those in the blend air door linkage.
2. Install the two screws (4) that secure the blend door actuator to the air distribution housing.
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the blend
door actuator. 4. On RHD models, install the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Installation.
5. On RHD models, if equipped, install the silencer underneath the instrument panel. 6. Reconnect
the negative battery cable. 7. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
DUAL ZONE RIGHT SIDE
1. Position the blend door actuator (1) to the right side of the HVAC air distribution housing (4) and
connect the wire harness connector (3) to the
actuator.
2. Install the blend door actuator onto the air distribution housing. If necessary, rotate the actuator
slightly to align the splines on the actuator with the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6983
blend door linkage.
3. Install the two screws (2) that secure the blend door actuator to the air distribution housing.
Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 4. Install the right front floor distribution duct onto the air
distribution housing See: Air Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution Duct Installation.
5. On LHD models, install the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Installation.
6. On LHD models, if equipped, install the silencer underneath the instrument panel. 7. Reconnect
the negative battery cable. 8. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Rear
INSTALLATION
1. Position the rear blend door actuator (1) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (3). If necessary,
rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines on the
actuator output shaft with those on the rear blend-air door pivot shaft (2).
2. Install the two screws (1) that secure the rear blend door actuator (2) to the rear heater-A/C
housing (4). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (3)
to the rear blend door actuator. 4. Install the rear heater-A/C housing See: Housing Assembly
HVAC/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing
Installation.
5. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6984
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Door Actuator - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the glove box binSee: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove
Box Removal.
3. Remove the screws (1) that secure the mode door actuator (4) to the bracket (5) located on the
right side of the HVAC air distribution housing (2). 4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3)
from the mode door actuator and remove the actuator.
Rear
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove rear heater-A/C housing (3) and
place it on a workbench . 3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the rear mode door
actuator (2) located on the outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing. 4. Remove the two
screws (1) that secure the rear mode door actuator to rear heater-A/C housing and remove the
actuator.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6985
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Door Actuator - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
1. Position the mode door actuator (4) onto the bracket (5) located on the right side of the HVAC air
distribution housing (2). If necessary, rotate the
actuator slightly to align the splines on the actuator output shaft with those in the mode air door
linkage.
2. Install the screws (1) that secure the mode door actuator to the air distribution housing. Tighten
the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (3) to the mode door
actuator. 4. Install the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Installation.
5. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 6. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan
tool See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Rear
INSTALLATION
1. Position the rear mode door actuator (1) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (3). If necessary,
rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines on the
actuator output shaft with those on the rear mode-air door pivot shaft (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6986
2. Install the two screws (1) that secure the rear mode door actuator (2) to the rear heater-A/C
housing (3). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (4)
to the rear mode door actuator. 4. Install the rear heater-A/C housing See: Housing Assembly
HVAC/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing
Installation.
5. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6987
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair
Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The single zone heating-A/C system is equipped with a single blend door actuator. The dual
zone system has two blend door actuators,
one for the driver side blend-air door and one for the passenger side blend-air door.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
SINGLE ZONE/DUAL ZONE LEFT SIDE
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. On RHD models, if equipped, remove the
silencer from underneath the passenger side of the instrument panel. 3. On RHD models, remove
the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and
Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Removal.
4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1) from the blend door actuator (2) located on the left
side of the HVAC air distribution housing (3). 5. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the blend
door actuator to the air distribution housing and remove the actuator.
DUAL ZONE RIGHT SIDE
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. On LHD models, if equipped, remove the
silencer from underneath the passenger side of the instrument panel. 3. On LHD models, remove
the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and
Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6988
4. Remove the front floor distribution duct from the right side of the air distribution housing See: Air
Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution
Duct - Installation.
5. Remove the screws (2) that secure the blend door actuator (1) to the right side of the air
distribution housing (4) and remove the actuator from the
housing.
6. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the blend door actuator and remove the actuator
from the vehicle.
Rear
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove rear heater-A/C housing (4) and
place it on a workbench . 3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the rear blend door
actuator (2) located on the outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing. 4. Remove the two
screws (1) that secure the rear blend door actuator to the rear heater-A/C housing and remove the
actuator.
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The single zone heating-A/C system is equipped with a single blend door actuator. The dual
zone system has two blend door actuators,
one for the driver side blend-air door and one for the passenger side blend-air door.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
SINGLE ZONE/DUAL ZONE LEFT SIDE
1. Position the blend door actuator (2) onto the left side of the HVAC air distribution housing (3). If
necessary, rotate the actuator slightly to align the
splines on the actuator output shaft with those in the blend air door linkage.
2. Install the two screws (4) that secure the blend door actuator to the air distribution housing.
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the blend
door actuator. 4. On RHD models, install the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6989
Panel Glove Box - Installation.
5. On RHD models, if equipped, install the silencer underneath the instrument panel. 6. Reconnect
the negative battery cable. 7. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
DUAL ZONE RIGHT SIDE
1. Position the blend door actuator (1) to the right side of the HVAC air distribution housing (4) and
connect the wire harness connector (3) to the
actuator.
2. Install the blend door actuator onto the air distribution housing. If necessary, rotate the actuator
slightly to align the splines on the actuator with the
blend door linkage.
3. Install the two screws (2) that secure the blend door actuator to the air distribution housing.
Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 4. Install the right front floor distribution duct onto the air
distribution housing See: Air Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution Duct Installation.
5. On LHD models, install the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Installation.
6. On LHD models, if equipped, install the silencer underneath the instrument panel. 7. Reconnect
the negative battery cable. 8. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Rear
INSTALLATION
1. Position the rear blend door actuator (1) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (3). If necessary,
rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines on the
actuator output shaft with those on the rear blend-air door pivot shaft (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6990
2. Install the two screws (1) that secure the rear blend door actuator (2) to the rear heater-A/C
housing (4). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (3)
to the rear blend door actuator. 4. Install the rear heater-A/C housing See: Housing Assembly
HVAC/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing
Installation.
5. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the glove box binSee: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove
Box Removal.
3. Remove the screws (1) that secure the mode door actuator (4) to the bracket (5) located on the
right side of the HVAC air distribution housing (2). 4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3)
from the mode door actuator and remove the actuator.
Rear
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6991
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove rear heater-A/C housing (3) and
place it on a workbench . 3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the rear mode door
actuator (2) located on the outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing. 4. Remove the two
screws (1) that secure the rear mode door actuator to rear heater-A/C housing and remove the
actuator.
Front
INSTALLATION
1. Position the mode door actuator (4) onto the bracket (5) located on the right side of the HVAC air
distribution housing (2). If necessary, rotate the
actuator slightly to align the splines on the actuator output shaft with those in the mode air door
linkage.
2. Install the screws (1) that secure the mode door actuator to the air distribution housing. Tighten
the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (3) to the mode door
actuator. 4. Install the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Installation.
5. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 6. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan
tool See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Rear
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6992
1. Position the rear mode door actuator (1) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (3). If necessary,
rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines on the
actuator output shaft with those on the rear mode-air door pivot shaft (2).
2. Install the two screws (1) that secure the rear mode door actuator (2) to the rear heater-A/C
housing (3). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (4)
to the rear mode door actuator. 4. Install the rear heater-A/C housing See: Housing Assembly
HVAC/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing
Installation.
5. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Recirculation Door Actuator - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6993
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the glove box bin See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove
Box Removal.
3. Reach through the glove box opening in the instrument panel and remove the screws (1) that
secure the recirculation door actuator (2) to the right
side of the HVAC air inlet housing (3).
4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the recirculation door actuator and remove the
actuator.
Recirculation Door Actuator - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Illustrations shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Position the recirculation door actuator (1) to the right side of the HVAC air inlet housing (2). 2.
Install the recirculation door actuator onto the air inlet housing. If necessary, rotate the actuator
slightly to align the splines on the actuator output
shaft (3) with those on the recirculation door pivot shaft adapter (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blend Door Actuator - Removal > Page 6994
3. Install the screws (1) that secure the recirculation door actuator (2) to the air inlet housing (3).
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 4. Connect the instrument panel wire harness connector
(4) to the recirculation door actuator. 5. Install the glove box binSee: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Installation.
6. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 7. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan
tool See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal
Air Duct: Service and Repair Defroster Duct - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the instrument panel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Remove the instrument panel and place it on a workbench See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service
and Repair/Instrument Panel - Removal.
2. Remove the outboard instrument panel air outlets See: Air Register/Service and Repair/Air
Outlet - Removal. 3. Remove the cover from the instrument panel. 4. Remove the driver side
outboard instrument panel and demister duct assembly See: Instrument Panel Duct - Removal. 5.
Disengage the two retaining clips (2) that secure the wire harness lead (3) to the top of the
defroster duct (1). 6. Disconnect the defroster duct from the passenger side demister duct (4) and
remove the defroster duct from the instrument panel support (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 6999
Air Duct: Service and Repair Defroster Duct - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the instrument panel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Position the defroster duct (1) to the top of the instrument panel support (5) and connect it to the
passenger side demister duct (4). 2. Engage the two retaining clips (2) that secure the wire harness
lead (3) to the top of the defroster duct. 3. Install the driver side instrument panel and demister duct
assemblySee: Instrument Panel Duct - Installation. 4. Install the cover onto the instrument panel
support. 5. Install the outboard instrument panel air outlets See: Air Register/Service and Repair/Air
Outlet - Installation. 6. Install the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7000
Air Duct: Service and Repair Floor Distribution Duct - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in an
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
RIGHT FRONT FLOOR DUCT
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. On LHD models, remove the glove box bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Removal.
2. Disconnect the right floor duct (1) from the right side of the HVAC housing (2) and remove the
duct.
LEFT FRONT FLOOR DUCT
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. On RHD models, remove the glove box bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Removal.
2. On LHD models, disconnect the shift interlock cable (3) from the left floor duct (1) and position
the cable out of the way. 3. Remove the screw (4) that secures the left floor duct to the left side of
the HVAC housing (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7001
4. Disconnect the left floor duct from the HVAC housing and remove the duct.
REAR FLOOR DISTRIBUTION DUCTS
1. Remove the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Removal.
2. Remove the rear seat floor ducts (refer to REAR SEAT FLOOR DUCTS). 3. Disconnect the left
rear floor distribution duct (1) and the right rear floor distribution duct (2) as required from the
HVAC housing (3) and remove
the duct(s).
REAR SEAT FLOOR DUCTS
NOTE: Right side rear floor duct shown. Left side duct similar.
1. Remove the center floor console See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service
and Repair/Center Console - Removal. 2. Remove the front seat from the side of the vehicle being
serviced See: Body and Frame/Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 3. Pull the
carpet back to gain access to the rear seat floor duct (2) See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Carpet/Service and Repair/Carpet
- Removal.
4. Remove the screw (1) and disengage the retainer that secures the rear seat floor duct to the
floor support (4). 5. Disconnect the rear seat floor duct from the rear floor distribution duct (3) and
remove the rear seat duct(s).
Rear
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7002
1. Remove right quarter trim panel, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
2. Remove the push-pin retainer (2) that secures the rear floor distribution duct (1) to the right inner
quarter panel (3). 3. Disengage the rear floor distribution duct from the stud (5) located on the right
inner quarter panel. 4. Disengage the rear floor distribution duct from the rear heater-A/C housing
(4) and remove the duct.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7003
Air Duct: Service and Repair Floor Distribution Duct - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
RIGHT FRONT FLOOR DUCT
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Connect the right floor duct (1) to the right side of the HVAC housing (2). Make sure the duct is
fully engaged to the housing. 2. On LHD models, install the glove box bin See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Installation.
LEFT FRONT FLOOR DUCT
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Connect the left floor duct (1) to the left side of the HVAC housing (2). Make sure the duct is fully
engaged to the housing. 2. Install the screw (4) that secures the left floor duct to the HVAC
housing. Tighten the screw to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 3. On LHD models, connect the shift interlock
cable (3) to the left floor duct. 4. On RHD models, install the glove box bin See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Installation.
REAR FLOOR DISTRIBUTION DUCTS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7004
1. Connect the left rear floor distribution duct (1) and the right rear floor distribution duct (2) as
required to the HVAC housing (3). Make sure the
ducts are fully engaged to the housing.
2. Install the rear seat floor ducts (refer to REAR SEAT FLOOR DUCTS). 3. Install the instrument
panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Installation.
REAR SEAT FLOOR DUCTS
NOTE: Right side rear floor duct shown. Left side duct similar.
1. Connect the rear seat floor duct (2) to the rear floor distribution duct (3). Make sure the ducts are
fully engaged to each other. 2. Engage the retainer that secures the rear seat floor duct to the floor
support (4) and install the retaining screw (1). Tighten the screw to 2.2 Nm (20
in. lbs.).
3. Reinstall the carpet See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Carpet/Service and
Repair/Carpet - Installation. 4. Install the front seat to the side of the vehicle being serviced See:
Body and Frame/Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation. 5. Install the center
floor console See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center
Console - Installation.
Rear
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7005
1. Install the rear floor distribution duct (1) onto rear heater-A/C housing (4). Make sure the duct is
fully engaged to the housing. 2. Engage the rear floor distribution duct to the stud (5) located on the
right inner quarter panel (3). 3. Install the push-pin retainer (2) that secures the rear floor
distribution duct to the right inner quarter panel. 4. Install the right quarter panel trim, See: Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7006
Air Duct: Service and Repair
Defroster Duct - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the instrument panel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Remove the instrument panel and place it on a workbench See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service
and Repair/Instrument Panel - Removal.
2. Remove the outboard instrument panel air outlets See: Air Register/Service and Repair/Air
Outlet - Removal. 3. Remove the cover from the instrument panel. 4. Remove the driver side
outboard instrument panel and demister duct assembly See: Instrument Panel Duct - Removal. 5.
Disengage the two retaining clips (2) that secure the wire harness lead (3) to the top of the
defroster duct (1). 6. Disconnect the defroster duct from the passenger side demister duct (4) and
remove the defroster duct from the instrument panel support (5).
Defroster Duct - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the instrument panel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7007
1. Position the defroster duct (1) to the top of the instrument panel support (5) and connect it to the
passenger side demister duct (4). 2. Engage the two retaining clips (2) that secure the wire harness
lead (3) to the top of the defroster duct. 3. Install the driver side instrument panel and demister duct
assemblySee: Instrument Panel Duct - Installation. 4. Install the cover onto the instrument panel
support. 5. Install the outboard instrument panel air outlets See: Air Register/Service and Repair/Air
Outlet - Installation. 6. Install the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Installation.
Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in an
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
RIGHT FRONT FLOOR DUCT
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. On LHD models, remove the glove box bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Removal.
2. Disconnect the right floor duct (1) from the right side of the HVAC housing (2) and remove the
duct.
LEFT FRONT FLOOR DUCT
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7008
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. On RHD models, remove the glove box bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Removal.
2. On LHD models, disconnect the shift interlock cable (3) from the left floor duct (1) and position
the cable out of the way. 3. Remove the screw (4) that secures the left floor duct to the left side of
the HVAC housing (2). 4. Disconnect the left floor duct from the HVAC housing and remove the
duct.
REAR FLOOR DISTRIBUTION DUCTS
1. Remove the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Removal.
2. Remove the rear seat floor ducts (refer to REAR SEAT FLOOR DUCTS). 3. Disconnect the left
rear floor distribution duct (1) and the right rear floor distribution duct (2) as required from the
HVAC housing (3) and remove
the duct(s).
REAR SEAT FLOOR DUCTS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7009
NOTE: Right side rear floor duct shown. Left side duct similar.
1. Remove the center floor console See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service
and Repair/Center Console - Removal. 2. Remove the front seat from the side of the vehicle being
serviced See: Body and Frame/Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 3. Pull the
carpet back to gain access to the rear seat floor duct (2) See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Carpet/Service and Repair/Carpet
- Removal.
4. Remove the screw (1) and disengage the retainer that secures the rear seat floor duct to the
floor support (4). 5. Disconnect the rear seat floor duct from the rear floor distribution duct (3) and
remove the rear seat duct(s).
Rear
REMOVAL
1. Remove right quarter trim panel, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
2. Remove the push-pin retainer (2) that secures the rear floor distribution duct (1) to the right inner
quarter panel (3). 3. Disengage the rear floor distribution duct from the stud (5) located on the right
inner quarter panel. 4. Disengage the rear floor distribution duct from the rear heater-A/C housing
(4) and remove the duct.
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
RIGHT FRONT FLOOR DUCT
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7010
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Connect the right floor duct (1) to the right side of the HVAC housing (2). Make sure the duct is
fully engaged to the housing. 2. On LHD models, install the glove box bin See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Installation.
LEFT FRONT FLOOR DUCT
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Connect the left floor duct (1) to the left side of the HVAC housing (2). Make sure the duct is fully
engaged to the housing. 2. Install the screw (4) that secures the left floor duct to the HVAC
housing. Tighten the screw to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 3. On LHD models, connect the shift interlock
cable (3) to the left floor duct. 4. On RHD models, install the glove box bin See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Glove Box - Installation.
REAR FLOOR DISTRIBUTION DUCTS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7011
1. Connect the left rear floor distribution duct (1) and the right rear floor distribution duct (2) as
required to the HVAC housing (3). Make sure the
ducts are fully engaged to the housing.
2. Install the rear seat floor ducts (refer to REAR SEAT FLOOR DUCTS). 3. Install the instrument
panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Installation.
REAR SEAT FLOOR DUCTS
NOTE: Right side rear floor duct shown. Left side duct similar.
1. Connect the rear seat floor duct (2) to the rear floor distribution duct (3). Make sure the ducts are
fully engaged to each other. 2. Engage the retainer that secures the rear seat floor duct to the floor
support (4) and install the retaining screw (1). Tighten the screw to 2.2 Nm (20
in. lbs.).
3. Reinstall the carpet See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Carpet/Service and
Repair/Carpet - Installation. 4. Install the front seat to the side of the vehicle being serviced See:
Body and Frame/Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation. 5. Install the center
floor console See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center
Console - Installation.
Rear
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7012
1. Install the rear floor distribution duct (1) onto rear heater-A/C housing (4). Make sure the duct is
fully engaged to the housing. 2. Engage the rear floor distribution duct to the stud (5) located on the
right inner quarter panel (3). 3. Install the push-pin retainer (2) that secures the rear floor
distribution duct to the right inner quarter panel. 4. Install the right quarter panel trim, See: Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
Instrument Panel Duct - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The left and right instrument panel ducts are serviced with the left and right demister ducts
as an assembly.
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the instrument panel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the instrument panel and place it on a workbench See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service
and Repair/Instrument Panel - Removal.
2. Remove the outboard instrument panel air outlets See: Air Register/Service and Repair/Air
Outlet - Removal. 3. Remove the cover from the instrument panel. 4. Remove the two push-pin
retainers (4) that secure the driver side instrument panel and demister duct assembly (1) to the top
of the instrument
panel support (5).
5. Disconnect the driver side instrument panel and demister duct assembly from the instrument
panel center duct (2) and the defroster duct (3) and
remove the driver side instrument panel and demister duct assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7013
6. Remove the two push-pin retainers (4) that secure the passenger side instrument panel and
demister duct assembly (1) to the top of the instrument
panel support (5).
7. Disconnect the passenger side instrument panel and demister duct assembly from the
instrument panel center duct (2) and the defroster duct (3)
and remove the passenger side instrument panel and demister duct assembly.
8. Remove the two screws (2 and 4) that secure the instrument panel center duct (1) to the
instrument panel support (3) and remove the center duct.
Instrument Panel Duct - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The left and right instrument panel ducts are serviced with the left and right demister ducts
as an assembly.
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the instrument panel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7014
1. Position the instrument panel center duct (3) to the instrument panel support (4) and install the
two retaining screws (2 and 4). Tighten the screws
to 2.2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
2. Position the passenger side instrument panel and demister duct assembly (1) to the instrument
panel support (5) and connect the instrument panel
and demister duct assembly to the center duct (2) and to the defroster duct (3). Make sure the
ducts are fully engaged.
3. Install the two push-pin retainers (4) that secure the passenger side instrument panel and
demister duct assembly to the instrument panel support.
4. Position the driver side instrument panel and demister duct assembly (1) to the instrument panel
support (5) and connect the instrument panel and
demister duct assembly to the center duct (2) and to the defroster duct (3). Make sure the ducts are
fully engaged.
5. Install the two push-pin retainers (4) that secure the driver side instrument panel and demister
duct assembly to the instrument panel support. 6. Install the cover onto the instrument panel. 7.
Install the outboard instrument panel air outlets See: Air Register/Service and Repair/Air Outlet Installation. 8. Install the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7015
Instrument Panel Demister Duct - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The left and right demister ducts are serviced with the left and right instrument panel ducts
as an assembly.
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the instrument panel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the instrument panel and place it on a workbench See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service
and Repair/Instrument Panel - Removal.
2. Remove the outboard instrument panel air outlets See: Air Register/Service and Repair/Air
Outlet - Removal. 3. Remove the cover from the instrument panel. 4. Remove the two push-pin
retainers (4) that secure the driver side instrument panel and demister duct assembly (1) to the top
of the instrument
panel support (5).
5. Disconnect the driver side instrument panel and demister duct assembly from the instrument
panel center duct (2) and the defroster duct (3) and
remove the driver side instrument panel and demister duct assembly.
6. Remove the two push-pin retainers (4) that secure the passenger side instrument panel and
demister duct assembly (1) to the top of the instrument
panel support (5).
7. Disconnect the passenger side instrument panel and demister duct assembly from the
instrument panel center duct (2) and the defroster duct (3)
and remove the passenger side instrument panel and demister duct assembly.
Instrument Panel Demister Duct - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7016
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The left and right demister ducts are serviced with the left and right instrument panel ducts
as an assembly.
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the instrument panel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Position the passenger side instrument panel and demister duct assembly (1) to the instrument
panel support (5) and connect the instrument panel
and demister duct assembly to the center duct (2) and to the defroster duct (3). Make sure the
ducts are fully engaged.
2. Install the two push-pin retainers (4) that secure the passenger side instrument panel and
demister duct assembly to the instrument panel support.
3. Position the driver side instrument panel and demister duct assembly (1) to the instrument panel
support (5) and connect the instrument panel and
demister duct assembly to the center duct (2) and to the defroster duct (3). Make sure the ducts are
fully engaged.
4. Install the two push-pin retainers (4) that secure the driver side instrument panel and demister
duct assembly to the instrument panel support. 5. Install the cover onto the instrument panel. 6.
Install the outboard instrument panel air outlets See: Air Register/Service and Repair/Air Outlet Installation. 7. Install the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Installation.
Ceiling Distribution Duct - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7017
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the right D-pillar trim panel See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/D-Pillar
Trim/Removal.
3. Remove right quarter trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
4. Remove the two bolts (2) that secure the upper seat belt bracket (1) to the right D-pillar (3) and
remove the bracket. 5. Remove the two bolts (4) that secure the right seat belt retractor (5) to the
right D-pillar and remove the retractor.
6. Remove the two retainers (4 and 5) that secure the rear ceiling distribution duct (3) to the right
D-pillar (2). 7. Lift the rear ceiling distribution duct upward and disengage it from the rear
heater-A/C housing (1).
CAUTION: Use care when removing the rear ceiling distribution duct from the heater-A/C housing
to prevent damage to the molded plastic
support brace located on the top of the housing outlet. Failure to follow this caution could result in
part of, or all of the support brace falling into the rear housing, which may interfere with rear mode
door operation.
8. Pull the bottom end of the rear ceiling distribution duct away from the rear heater-A/C housing
and remove the duct.
Ceiling Distribution Duct - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Duct - Removal > Page 7018
1. Position the rear ceiling distribution duct (3) to the right D-pillar (2).
CAUTION: Use care when installing the rear ceiling distribution duct onto the heater-A/C housing to
prevent damage to the molded plastic
support brace located on the top of the housing outlet. Failure to follow this caution could result in
part of, or all of the support brace falling into the rear housing, which may interfere with rear mode
door operation.
2. Install the rear ceiling distribution duct onto the top of the rear heater-A/C housing (1). Make sure
the duct is fully engaged to the housing. 3. Install the two retainers (4 and 5) that secure the rear
ceiling distribution duct to the right D-pillar.
4. Position the upper seat belt bracket (2) onto the D-pillar (3) and install the two retaining bolts (1).
Tighten the bolts to 52 Nm (38.5 ft. lbs.). 5. Install the right seat belt retractor (5) and retaining bolts
(4) onto the D-pillar. Tighten the bolts to 52 Nm (38.5 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the right quarter trim panel
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
7. Install the right D-pillar trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/D-Pillar
Trim/Installation
8. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Air Register: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
There are two defroster air outlets (1) in the defroster grille (2) located at the top of the instrument
panel. The airflow from the defroster outlets are directed by fixed vanes in the grille and cannot be
adjusted. The defroster air outlets are not serviceable from the defroster grille.
There are two side window demister air outlets (3 and 5). One located on each end of the
instrument panel. The airflow from the side window demister air outlets is directed by fixed vanes
and cannot be adjusted. The side window demister air outlets can be serviced separately from the
instrument panel.
There are four instrument panel air outlets (4). One air outlet is located near each outboard end of
the instrument panel facing the rear of the vehicle and two air outlets are located at the top of the
instrument panel center bezel. Each of the instrument panel air outlets contain movable vanes that
can direct or shut off the flow of the conditioned air leaving the outlets. The instrument panel air
outlets can be serviced separately from the instrument panel.
Some models with A/C are equipped with a cooled beverage storage bin located in the instrument
panel. Vehicles so equipped have an outlet, which, when opened with the A/C on, allows cooled air
to flow into the bin.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal
Air Register: Service and Repair Defroster Grille - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the left and right A-pillar trim panels. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/A-Pillar
Trim Panel-Removal.
2. Using trim stick C4755 or equivalent, pry up on defroster grille disengaging clips. 3. Remove
defroster grille from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal > Page 7024
Air Register: Service and Repair Defroster Grille - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the defroster grille in place and align the spring retainers with the instrument panel. 2.
Hand tap defroster grille in place ensuring proper seat. 3. Install the left and right A-pillar trim
panels. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Trim/A-Pillar
Trim Panel-Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal > Page 7025
Air Register: Service and Repair Air Outlet - Removal
Demister Outlets
DEMISTER OUTLETS
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Right side air outlet shown. Left side outlet similar.
1. Using Trim Stick C-4755 or equivalent (2), carefully disengage the three retaining tabs that
secure each demister air outlet (1) to the instrument
panel cover (3) and remove the outlet.
Air Outlets
AIR OUTLETS
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
OUTBOARD OUTLETS
NOTE: Right side air outlet shown. Left side outlet similar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal > Page 7026
1. Using trim stick C-4755 or equivalent (2), carefully disengage the four retaining tabs (two tabs on
each side) that secure each air outlet (1) to the
instrument panel cover (3) and remove the outlet.
CENTER OUTLETS
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the center bezel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
1. Remove the center bezel (3) from the instrument panel and place it on a workbench See: Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
2. Remove the four screws (2 and 4) that secure the center instrument panel air outlets (1) to the
center bezel and remove the outlets.
Rear
REMOVAL
1. Rotate the air outlet (1) being serviced clockwise until the retaining tabs on the back of the outlet
disengage from the headliner (2). 2. Remove the air outlet from the headliner.
Beverage Cooler
BEVERAGE COOLER
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
OUTLET
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal > Page 7027
1. Using Trim Stick C-4755 or equivalent (1), disengage the three retaining tabs that secure the
beverage cooler outlet (2) to side of the glove box bin
(3).
NOTE: If the beverage cooler cold air supply hose becomes disconnected from the air beverage
cooler outlet and falls back into the
instrument panel during outlet removal, the beverage cooler bin may need to be removed from the
instrument panel for outlet installation See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Beverage Cooler Bin - Removal.
2. Carefully pull the beverage cooler outlet (1) away from side of the beverage cooler bin (3) and
disconnect the cold air supply hose (2) from the
outlet. Make sure the end of the cold air supply hose remains in the bin and does not fall back into
the instrument panel.
COLD AIR SUPPLY HOSE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal > Page 7028
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel center bezel
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Remove the outer passenger side instrument panel air outlet See: . 4. Remove the beverage
cooler outlet (refer to OUTLET - REMOVAL). 5. Remove the beverage cooler bin See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Beverage Cooler Bin - Removal.
6. If equipped, remove the silencer trim panel out from underneath the passenger side of the
instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel Removal.
7. Remove the glove box bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Removal.
8. Reach up underneath the instrument panel and disconnect the cold air supply hose (1) from the
passenger side of the air distribution housing (3). 9. Working through the beverage cooler bin
opening in the instrument panel, disengage the cold air supply hose from the bracket (4) located on
the
air inlet housing (2) and remove the hose. Note the routing of the hose and the instrument panel
wiring for aid in reinstallation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal > Page 7029
Air Register: Service and Repair Air Outlet - Installation
Air Outlets
AIR OUTLETS
OUTBOARD OUTLETS
NOTE: Right side air outlet shown. Left side outlet similar.
1. Position the air outlet (1) to the opening in the instrument panel cover (2) and align the outlet to
the instrument panel duct.
NOTE: Make sure that the air outlet(s) are properly aligned to the instrument panel duct(s).
2. Engage the four retaining tabs that secure each instrument panel outlet to the instrument panel
cover. Make sure the retaining tabs are fully
engaged.
CENTER OUTLETS
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the center bezel from cosmetic
damage while performing this procedure.
1. Position the air outlets (1) to the back of the center bezel (3) and install the four retaining screws
(2 and 4). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in.
lbs.).
NOTE: Make sure that the air outlets are properly aligned to the instrument panel center duct.
2. Install the center bezel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal > Page 7030
Demister Outlets
DEMISTER OUTLETS
NOTE: Right side demister outlet shown. Left side outlet similar.
1. Position the demister air outlet (1) to the opening in the instrument panel cover (2) and engage
the three retaining tabs. Make sure the retaining
tabs are fully engaged.
Rear
INSTALLATION
1. Position the air outlet (1) being serviced to the opening in the headliner (2). 2. Rotate the air
outlet counterclockwise until the retaining tabs on the back of the outlet are fully engaged to the
headliner.
Beverage Cooler
BEVERAGE COOLER
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
OUTLET
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal > Page 7031
NOTE: If the beverage cooler cold air supply hose falls back into the instrument panel during outlet
installation, the beverage cooler bin may
need to be removed from the instrument panel and the hose rerouted through the opening in the
bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Lower Bin - Removal.
1. Position the beverage cooler outlet (1) to the beverage cooler bin (3) and connect the cold air
supply hose (2) to the outlet.
2. Feed the cold air supply hose through the opening in the side of the beverage cooler bin (1) and
align and install the beverage cooler outlet (2)
onto the bin. Make sure the three retaining tabs on the outlet are fully engaged to the bin.
COLD AIR SUPPLY HOSE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Defroster Grille - Removal > Page 7032
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Working through the beverage cooler bin opening in the instrument panel, feed the cold air
supply hose (1) into the instrument panel. Note the
routing of the hose and the instrument panel wiring.
2. Reach up underneath the instrument panel and connect the cold air supply hose to the
passenger side of the air distribution housing (3). 3. Working through the beverage cooler bin
opening in the instrument panel, engage the cold air supply hose to the bracket (4) located on the
air inlet
housing (2).
4. Position the beverage cooler bin to the instrument panel and route the cold air supply hose
through the beverage cooler outlet opening. 5. Install the beverage cooler bin See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Beverage Cooler Bin - Installation.
6. Install the beverage cooler outlet (refer to OUTLET - INSTALLATION). 7. Install the instrument
panel center bezel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Installation.
8. Install the outer passenger side instrument panel air outlet See: . 9. Install the glove box bin See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel
Glove Box Installation.
10. If equipped, install the silencer trim panel underneath the passenger side of the instrument
panel \See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
11. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7036
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Ambient Temperature Sensor - Description
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation Front Ambient
Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The ambient air temperature sensor is a variable resistor that monitors the air temperature outside
of the vehicle. The ATC system uses the sensor data to maintain optimum cabin temperature
levels. The ambient air temperature sensor is mounted inside the front fascia.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Ambient Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 7039
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation Front Ambient
Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The ambient air temperature sensor is a variable resistor that operates on a 5-volt reference signal
sent by the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The ambient air temperature sensor is
connected to the TIPM through a two-wire lead and connector of the vehicle wire harness. The
ambient air temperature sensor changes its internal resistance in response to changes in the
outside air temperature, which either increases or decreases the reference signal voltage read by
the TIPM. The TIPM converts and broadcasts the sensor data over the Controller Area Network
(CAN) IHS bus, where it is read by the ATC A/C-heater control, Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
and other vehicle control modules.
The ambient air temperature sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The ambient air temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Auxiliary Cabin Heater > Auxiliary Heater Element Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Cabin Heater Relay 1
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Auxiliary Cabin Heater > Auxiliary Heater Element Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Cabin Heater Relay 1 > Page 7045
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Auxiliary Cabin Heater > Auxiliary Heater Element Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Cabin Heater Relay 1 > Page 7046
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Blower Motor
Blower Motor: Locations Front Blower Motor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Blower Motor > Page 7051
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Blower Motor > Page 7052
Blower Motor: Locations Rear Blower Motor (3 Zone HVAC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Blower Motor > Page 7053
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Blower Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7056
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7057
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7058
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7059
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7060
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7061
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7062
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7063
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7064
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7065
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7066
Blower Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7067
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7068
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7069
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7070
Blower Motor: Connector Views
Front Blower Motor (Instrument Panel) 2 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
MOTOR-BLOWER-FRONT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
Rear Blower Motor (3 Zone HVAC) (Body) 2 Way
Connector (3 ZONE HVAC) - (BODY) 2 WAY
MOTOR-BLOWER-REAR (3 ZONE HVAC) - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7071
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description - Front
Blower Motor: Description and Operation Description - Front
DESCRIPTION
The blower motor (1) is used to control the velocity of air moving through the HVAC housing by
spinning the blower wheel (2) within the HVAC air inlet housing at the selected speed.
The blower motor is a 12-volt, direct current (DC) motor mounted within a plastic housing with an
integral wire harness connector (3) and three mounting tabs (4). The squirrel cage-type blower
wheel is secured to the blower motor shaft and is positioned within the air inlet housing on the
passenger side of the HVAC housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description - Front > Page 7074
Blower Motor: Description and Operation Description - Rear
DESCRIPTION
The rear blower motor (1) is a 12-volt, direct current (DC) motor mounted within a plastic housing
with an integral wire connector (4) and a squirrel cage-type blower wheel (3) that is secured to the
blower motor shaft. Three integral mounting tabs (2) and a lock tab (5) secure the blower motor to
the inboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing.
The rear blower motor can be accessed for service without removing the rear heater-A/C housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description - Front > Page 7075
Blower Motor: Description and Operation Operation - Front
OPERATION
The blower motor controls the velocity of air moving through the HVAC housing by spinning the
blower wheel within the HVAC air inlet housing at the selected speed.
On the Manual Temperature Control (MTC) heating-A/C system, blower motor speed is controlled
by regulating the path to ground through the blower control switch and the blower motor resistor.
With the Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) heating-A/C system, blower motor speed is
controlled by an electronic blower motor power module, that uses a Pulse Width Modulated (PWM)
input from the A/C-heater control and a feedback signal from the blower motor to regulate the
blower motor ground path. On both systems, the blower motor receives battery current through the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) whenever the ignition switch is in the Run position, and
the blower motor control is in any position except Off.
The blower motor can be accessed for service from underneath the instrument panel.
NOTE: The blower motor is supplied with a 12 volt feed from the TIPM whenever the ignition switch
is in the Run position. Due to an open
circuit condition within the blower motor control switch, the TIPM is unable to detect an open circuit
for the blower motor.
The blower motor control system is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The blower motor and blower motor wheel are factory balanced as an assembly and cannot be
adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description - Front > Page 7076
Blower Motor: Description and Operation Operation - Rear
OPERATION
The rear blower motor is used to control the velocity of air moving through the rear heater-A/C
housing by spinning the blower wheel within the heater-A/C housing at the selected speed.
The rear blower motor will only operate when the ignition switch is in ON and the rear blower motor
switch located in the front accessory switch panel is ON. The rear blower motor receives a battery
feed through the totally integrated power module (TIPM), whenever the ignition switch is in ON
See: Testing and Inspection.
The rear blower motor and blower wheel are factory balanced and cannot be adjusted or repaired
and must be replaced as an assembly if inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7077
Blower Motor: Testing and Inspection
BLOWER MOTOR
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. Failure to take
the proper precautions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal
injury.
NOTE: The blower motor is supplied with a 12V feed from the TIPM whenever the ignition switch is
in RUN. Due to an open circuit
condition within the blower motor control switch the TIPM is UNABLE to detect an OPEN circuit for
the blower motor.
To determine if an open condition exists within the blower motor circuit wiring, it is necessary to
disconnect the negative battery cable and check for continuity within the blower motor circuits using
an ohmmeter. See Wiring Information for circuit descriptions and diagrams.
OPERATION
Possible causes of an inoperative blower motor include:
- Open fuse
- Inoperative blower motor resistor
- Inoperative blower motor switch
- Inoperative blower motor
- Inoperative blower motor circuit wiring or wire harness connectors
NOISE
To determine if the blower motor is the source of the noise, simply switch the blower motor from Off
to On. To verify that the blower motor is the source of the noise, unplug the blower motor wire
harness connector and operate the heater-A/C system. If the noise goes away, possible causes
include:
- Foreign material on fresh air inlet screen
- Foreign material in blower wheel
- Foreign material in HVAC housing
- Improper blower motor mounting
- Deformed or damaged blower wheel
- Worn blower motor bearings or brushes
VIBRATION
Possible causes of a blower motor vibration include:
- Improper blower motor mounting
- Foreign material in blower wheel
- Deformed or damaged blower wheel
- Worn blower motor bearings
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal - Front
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Removal - Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The blower motor is located on the bottom of the passenger side of the HVAC housing. The
blower motor can be removed from the
vehicle without having to remove the HVAC housing.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer from
below the passenger side of the instrument panel. 3. From underneath the instrument panel,
disengage the connector lock and disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (1) from
the
blower motor (2).
4. Remove the three screws (3) that secure the blower motor and the wire lead bracket (4) (if
equipped) to the bottom of the HVAC housing (5) and
remove the blower motor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal - Front > Page 7080
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Removal - Rear
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove right rear quarter trim panel See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the rear blower motor (1). 4. Disengage the
locking tab (4) and remove the rear blower motor from the rear heater-A/C housing (2) by turning
the blower motor
counterclockwise.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal - Front > Page 7081
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Installation - Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Position the blower motor (2) into the bottom of the HVAC housing (5). 2. Install the three screws
(3) that secure the blower motor and the wire lead bracket (4) (if equipped) to the HVAC housing.
Tighten the screws to
1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
3. Connect the instrument panel wire harness connector (1) to the blower motor and engage the
connector lock. 4. If equipped, install the silencer below the passenger side of the instrument panel.
5. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal - Front > Page 7082
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Installation - Rear
INSTALLATION
1. Position the rear blower motor (1) into the rear heater-A/C housing (2) and rotate the blower
motor clockwise until the blower motor is fully
engaged to the housing and the retaining tab (4) is in the locked position.
2. Connect the wire harness connector (3) to the rear blower motor. 3. Install the right rear quarter
trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7086
Blower Motor Relay: Diagrams
Connector (3 ZONE HVAC) - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-REAR BLOWER MOTOR (3 ZONE HVAC) - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Resistor (MTC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Resistor (MTC) > Page 7091
Blower Motor Resistor: Locations Rear Blower Motor Resistor (3 Zone MTC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Resistor (MTC) > Page 7092
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Blower Motor Resistor (MTC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Blower Motor Resistor: Diagrams Front Blower Motor Resistor (MTC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
RESISTOR-BLOWER MOTOR-FRONT (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Blower Motor Resistor (MTC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 7095
Blower Motor Resistor: Diagrams Rear Blower Motor Resistor (3 Zone MTC) (Body) 4 Way
Connector (3 ZONE MTC) - (BODY) 4 WAY
RESISTOR-BLOWER MOTOR-REAR (3 ZONE MTC) - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description - Front
Blower Motor Resistor: Description and Operation Description - Front
DESCRIPTION
A blower motor resistor is used on vehicles equipped with the manual temperature control (MTC)
heating-A/C system. Vehicles equipped with the automatic temperature control (ATC) heating-A/C
system use a blower motor power module, instead of the blower motor resistor See: Control
Module HVAC/Description and Operation/Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description.
The blower motor resistor is mounted to the bottom of the HVAC housing, on the passenger side of
the vehicle. The blower motor resistor consists of a molded plastic mounting plate (1) with an
integral wire connector receptacle (2). Concealed behind the mounting plate are resistors (3)
located between a two-piece stamped steel base (4). The blower motor resistor is accessed for
service from under the instrument panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description - Front > Page 7098
Blower Motor Resistor: Description and Operation Description - Rear
DESCRIPTION
A blower motor resistor is used on this model when equipped with the manual temperature control
(MTC) rear heating-A/C system. Models equipped with the automatic temperature control (ATC)
rear heating-A/C system use a blower motor power module, instead of the blower motor resistor
See: Control Module HVAC/Description and Operation/Rear Blower Motor Power Module Description.
The rear blower motor resistor is mounted to the inboard side of the rear heating-A/C housing,
located on the right side of the vehicle. The rear blower motor resistor consists of a molded plastic
mounting plate (1) with an integral wire connector receptacle (2). Concealed behind the mounting
plate are resistors (3) located between a two-piece stamped steel heat sink (4).
The rear blower motor resistor can be accessed for service without removing the rear heater-A/C
housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description - Front > Page 7099
Blower Motor Resistor: Description and Operation Operation - Front
OPERATION
The blower motor resistor is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take
out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness. The blower motor resistor has three
resistors, each of which will reduce the current flow through the blower motor to change the blower
motor speed.
The blower motor control for the heating-A/C system directs the ground path for the blower motor
through the correct resistor to obtain the selected speed. With the blower motor control in the
lowest speed position, the ground path for the blower motor is applied through all of the resistors.
Each higher speed selected with the blower motor control applies the blower motor ground path
through fewer of the resistors, increasing the blower motor speed. When the blower motor control
is in the highest speed position, the blower motor resistor is bypassed and the blower motor
receives a direct path to ground.
The blower motor resistor cannot be adjusted or repaired and it must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description - Front > Page 7100
Blower Motor Resistor: Description and Operation Operation - Rear
OPERATION
The blower motor resistor for the rear heating-A/C system is connected to the vehicle electrical
system through a dedicated wire lead and connector of the rear heater-A/C wire harness. The rear
blower motor resistor has an electrical circuit board with three resistors, each of which will reduce
the current flow through the rear blower motor to change the blower motor speed.
The blower motor switch for the MTC rear heater-A/C system directs the ground path for the rear
blower motor through the correct resistor to obtain the selected speed. With the rear blower motor
control in the lowest speed position, the ground path for the rear blower motor is applied through all
of the resistors. Each higher speed selected with the rear blower motor control applies the blower
motor ground path through fewer of the resistors, increasing the rear blower motor speed. When
the blower motor switch is in the highest speed position, the blower motor resistors are bypassed
and the blower motor receives a direct path to ground through the rear blower motor switch.
The rear blower motor resistor cannot be adjusted or repaired and it must be replaced if inoperative
or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Resistor
Blower Motor Resistor: Testing and Inspection Front Blower Motor Resistor
BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: See Wiring Information for circuit descriptions and diagrams. Wiring Information includes
wiring diagrams, proper wire and
connector repair procedures, further details on wire harness routing and retention, as well as
pin-out and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector
from the blower motor resistor . 3. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between all of the
blower motor resistor terminals. In each case there should be continuity. If OK, repair
the wire harness circuits between the blower motor speed control and the blower motor resistor or
blower motor as required. If not OK, replace the inoperative blower motor resistor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Resistor > Page 7103
Blower Motor Resistor: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Resistor
REAR BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
NOTE: See Wiring Information for circuit descriptions and diagrams. Wiring Information includes
wiring diagrams, proper wire and
connector repair procedures, further details on wire harness routing and retention, as well as
pin-out and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector
from the blower motor resistor . 3. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between all of the
blower motor resistor terminals. In each case there should be continuity. If OK, repair
the wire harness circuits between the blower motor switch and the blower motor resistor or the
blower motor as required. If not OK, replace the inoperative blower motor resistor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal - Front
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Removal - Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The blower motor resistor may get very hot during normal operation. If the blower
motor was turned on prior to servicing the
blower motor resistor, wait five minutes to allow the blower motor resistors to cool before
performing diagnosis or service. Failure to take this precaution may result in possible injury.
CAUTION: Do not operate the blower motor with the blower motor resistor removed from the
circuit. Failure to take this precaution can
result in vehicle damage.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1)
from the blower motor resistor (2) located at the bottom of the HVAC housing (3) on the passenger
side
of the vehicle.
3. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the blower motor resistor to the HVAC housing and
remove the resistor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal - Front > Page 7106
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Removal - Rear
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove right rear quarter trim panel See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the rear blower motor resistor (3). 4. Remove
the two screws (1) that secure the rear blower motor resistor to the rear heater-A/C housing (2) and
remove the resistor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal - Front > Page 7107
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Installation - Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Position the blower motor resistor (2) onto the bottom of the HVAC housing (3). 2. Install the two
screws (4) that secure the blower motor resistor to the HVAC housing. Tighten the screws to 1.2
Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the blower motor resistor. 4.
Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal - Front > Page 7108
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Installation - Rear
INSTALLATION
1. Position the rear blower motor resistor (3) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (2). 2. Install the two
screws (1) that secure the rear blower motor resistor to the rear heater-A/C housing. Tighten the
screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (4) to the rear blower motor
resistor. 4. Install the right rear quarter trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
5. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Cabin Air Filter: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Some models are equipped with a particulate air filter (1) that helps purify the outside air entering
the HVAC housing. The filter is mounted in the passenger compartment, behind the glove box bin.
The filter should be replaced at least once a year or every 24,000 km (15,000 miles) and checked if
heating-A/C system performance seems lower than expected. The particulate air filter is labeled
with an arrow (2) to indicate the direction of air flow through the filter.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Procedures
Cabin Air Filter: Procedures
WARNING: Do not remove the A/C air filter while the blower is operating or personal injury may
result.
The A/C air filter is located in the fresh air inlet behind the glove box. Perform the following steps to
replace the filter:
1. Open the glove box and remove all contents.
2. Push the retaining tab on each side of the glove box inward while gently pulling the glove box
door outward until both tabs clear the door opening
in the instrument panel.
3. Pivot the glove box downward.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Procedures > Page 7114
4. Disengage the two retaining tabs that secure the filter cover to the HVAC housing and remove
the cover. 5. Remove the A/C air filter by pulling it straight out of the housing. 6. Install the A/C air
filter with the arrow on the filter pointing toward the floor. When installing the filter cover, make sure
the retaining tabs fully
engage the cover.
CAUTION: The A/C air filter is labeled with an arrow to indicate airflow direction through the filter.
Failure to install the filter properly will result in the need to replace it more often.
7. Reinstall the glove box door. Make sure that the hinges are seated fully as you raise the door.
Otherwise, the door latch will not align properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Procedures > Page 7115
Cabin Air Filter: Removal and Replacement
Particulate Air Filter - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: Always make sure the A/C-heater system is turned off and that the ignition switch is in
the OFF position prior to servicing the
particulate air filter. Never place fingers or other objects into the filter opening of the HVAC
housing. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Remove the glove box bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Removal.
2. Disengage the two retaining tabs (1) that secure the particulate air filter cover (2) to the
passenger side of the HVAC housing (3) and remove the
cover.
3. Remove the particulate air filter (1) from the HVAC housing (2) by pulling the filter element
straight out of the housing.
Particulate Air Filter - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Procedures > Page 7116
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The particulate air filter is labeled with an arrow to indicate air flow direction through the
filter. Make sure to properly install the
particulate air filter. Failure to properly install the filter will result in the need to replace the filter
sooner than required by design.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Install the particulate air filter (1) into the filter opening in the HVAC housing (2). Insert the
particulate air filter directly into the housing with the
arrow on the filter pointing to the floor.
2. Position the particulate air filter cover (2) to the HVAC housing (3) and engage the two retaining
tabs (1) that secure the cover to the housing.
Make sure the retaining tabs are fully engaged.
3. Install the glove box bin See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications
Compressor Clutch: Specifications
CLUTCH GAP
Air Gap.................................................................................................................................................
..............................0.35 - 0.60 mm (0.014 - 0.024 in.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 7121
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 7122
Compressor Clutch: Diagrams
Connector (PAC) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
CLUTCH-A/C COMPRESSOR (PAC) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Compressor Clutch - Description
Compressor Clutch: Description and Operation A/C Compressor Clutch - Description
CLUTCH - FIXED DISPLACEMENT A/C COMPRESSOR
NOTE: Typical A/C clutch assembly shown.
The clutch assembly for the Denso 10SR15 and 10SR17 fixed displacement A/C compressors
consists of a stationary electromagnetic A/C clutch field coil (4), pulley bearing and pulley assembly
(3), clutch plate (2) and shims (7). These components provide the means to engage and disengage
the A/C compressor from the engine accessory drive belt.
The A/C clutch field coil and the pulley bearing and pulley assembly are both retained on the nose
of the A/C compressor with snap rings (5 and 6). The clutch plate is splined to the compressor
shaft and secured with a bolt (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Compressor Clutch - Description > Page 7125
Compressor Clutch: Description and Operation A/C Compressor Clutch - Operation
CLUTCH - FIXED DISPLACEMENT A/C COMPRESSOR
The clutch components for the Denso 10SR15 and 10SR17 fixed displacement A/C compressor
provide the means to engage and disengage the compressor from the engine accessory drive belt.
When the electromagnetic A/C clutch field coil is energized, it magnetically draws the clutch plate
into contact with the clutch pulley and drives the compressor shaft. When the coil is not energized,
the pulley freewheels on the clutch hub bearing, which is part of the pulley assembly.
A/C compressor clutch engagement is controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) or the
engine control module (ECM), depending on engine application. When the A/C-heater control is set
to any A/C position, it sends a request signal on the CAN-IHS bus to the totally integrated power
module (TIPM), which then transfers the request on the CAN-C Bus to the PCM/ECM, which
determines if operating conditions are correct for A/C clutch engagement. When all operating
conditions have been met, the PCM/ECM sends a signal on a dedicated hard-wired circuit back to
the totally integrated power module (TIPM) to energize the internal A/C clutch high side driver.
When energized, the A/C clutch high side driver provides battery current to the A/C clutch field coil.
The A/C clutch control system is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The A/C compressor clutch components cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fixed Displacement A/C Compressor Clutch Inspection
Compressor Clutch: Testing and Inspection Fixed Displacement A/C Compressor Clutch Inspection
CLUTCH INSPECTION - FIXED DISPLACEMENT A/C COMPRESSOR
Examine the friction surfaces of the pulley and the clutch plate (2) for wear. The pulley and clutch
plate should be replaced if there is excessive wear or scoring.
If the friction surfaces are oily, inspect the shaft and nose area of the A/C compressor (1) for
refrigerant oil. If refrigerant oil is found, the compressor shaft seal is leaking and the A/C
compressor must be replaced.
Check the pulley bearing for roughness or excessive leakage of grease. Replace the pulley and
clutch plate if required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fixed Displacement A/C Compressor Clutch Inspection > Page 7128
Compressor Clutch: Testing and Inspection Fixed Displacement A/C Compressor Clutch
CLUTCH - FIXED DISPLACEMENT A/C COMPRESSOR
The compressor clutch coil electrical circuit for the Denso 10SR15 and 10SR17 fixed displacement
A/C compressors is controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) or the engine control
module (ECM) (depending on engine application) through the totally integrated power module
(TIPM) (refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete HVAC wiring diagrams). Begin
testing of a suspected compressor clutch coil problem by performing the preliminary checks.
PRELIMINARY CHECKS
1. Using a scan tool, check for diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) in the A/C-heater control, TIPM
and PCM/ECM. If no diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) are found, go to 2. If any DTCs are found, repair as required.
2. If the A/C compressor clutch still will not engage, verify the refrigerant charge level See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics. If the refrigerant charge level is OK, go to COIL RESISTANCE TEST and/or COIL
CURRENT DRAW TEST. If the refrigerant charge level is not OK, adjust the refrigerant charge as
required.
COIL RESISTANCE TEST
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector
from the A/C clutch field coil connector. 3. Use an ohm meter and Back Probe Tool 6801 and
measure the resistance of the clutch field coil at the field coil connector terminals. 4. Refer to the
A/C Clutch Field Coil Specifications chart for the acceptable A/C clutch coil resistance.
Specifications apply for a work area
temperature of 21° C (70° F). a. If the A/C clutch coil reading is below specifications, the coil is
shorted and must be replaced. b. If the A/C clutch coil reading is above specifications, the coil is
open and must be replaced.
COIL CURRENT DRAW TEST
1. Verify the battery state of charge See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Battery. 2. Connect an ammeter (0 to 10
ampere scale selected) in series with the clutch coil feed terminal using Back Probe Tool 6801.
Connect a voltmeter
(0 to 20 volt scale selected) to measure voltage across the battery and the clutch coil.
3. With the heater-A/C control in the A/C mode and the blower at low speed, start the engine and
allow it to run at a normal idle speed. 4. The compressor clutch should engage immediately, and
the clutch coil supply voltage should be within two volts of the battery voltage. If the coil
supply voltage is OK, go to 5. If the coil supply voltage is not within two volts of battery voltage, test
the clutch coil feed circuit for excessive voltage drop and repair as necessary.
5. Refer to the A/C Clutch Field Coil Specifications chart for the acceptable A/C clutch field coil
current draw. Specifications apply for a work area
temperature of 21° C (70° F). If voltage is more than 12.5 volts, add electrical loads by turning on
electrical accessories until voltage reads below 12.5 volts. a. If the compressor clutch coil current
reading is zero, the coil is open and must be replaced. b. If the compressor clutch coil current
reading is above specifications, the coil is shorted and must be replaced.
A/C CLUTCH FIELD COIL SPECIFICATIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor Clutch - Removal
Compressor Clutch: Service and Repair A/C Compressor Clutch - Removal
CLUTCH - FIXED DISPLACEMENT A/C COMPRESSOR
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The compressor clutch assembly can be serviced with the refrigerant system fully-charged
and with the A/C compressor installed on
the engine.
NOTE: Typical A/C compressor and clutch assembly shown in illustrations.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. 3. Remove
the splash shield from the right side frame rail See: Body and Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front
Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash
Shield - Removal.
4. Remove the accessory drive belt See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Drive Belts, Mounts,
Brackets and Accessories/Drive Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Removal.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the compressor clutch field coil connector (1) located
on the top of the A/C compressor (5).
NOTE: Some models (depending on engine application) may require the A/C compressor to be
removed from its installed location and
repositioned to gain access to the compressor shaft bolt and/or pulley and field coil snap rings.
However, the refrigerant system can still remain fully charged.
6. If necessary, remove the bolts that secure the A/C compressor to the engine and reposition the
compressor to gain access to the shaft bolt and/or
pulley and field coil snap rings See: Service and Repair/A/C Compressor - Removal.
7. Carefully remove the compressor clutch field coil connector and wire lead from the connector
bracket (2). 8. Remove the compressor shaft bolt (3). A band-type oil filter wrench or a strap
wrench may be used to hold the clutch plate (4) from rotating during
bolt removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor Clutch - Removal > Page 7131
CAUTION: Do not pry between the clutch plate and the pulley and bearing assembly to remove the
clutch plate from the compressor shaft as
this may damage the clutch plate.
NOTE: Use care not to lose any clutch shim(s) during removal of the clutch plate, as they may be
reused during the clutch plate installation
process.
9. Tap the clutch plate (2) lightly with a plastic mallet to release it from the splines on the
compressor shaft (1) and remove the clutch plate and
shim(s) (3).
10. Using A/C Snap Ring Pliers 9764 or equivalent (1), remove the snap ring (2) that secures the
pulley and bearing assembly (3) to the front of the
A/C compressor and remove the pulley and bearing assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor Clutch - Removal > Page 7132
11. Using A/C Snap Ring Pliers 9764 or equivalent (1), remove the snap ring (4) that secures the
compressor clutch field coil (2) to the front of the
A/C compressor (3) and remove the field coil.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor Clutch - Removal > Page 7133
Compressor Clutch: Service and Repair A/C Compressor Clutch - Installation
CLUTCH - FIXED DISPLACEMENT A/C COMPRESSOR
NOTE: Typical A/C compressor and clutch assembly shown in illustrations.
1. Align the dowel pin on the back of the compressor clutch field coil (2) with the hole in the front of
the A/C compressor (3) and position the field
coil onto the compressor. Be certain that the compressor clutch field coil wire lead is properly
routed so that it is not pinched between the A/C compressor and the field coil.
CAUTION: The snap ring must be fully and properly seated in the groove or it will vibrate out,
resulting in a clutch failure and severe damage
to the A/C compressor.
NOTE: A new snap ring must be used to secure the compressor clutch field coil to the A/C
compressor. The bevel side of the snap ring must
face outward and both snap ring eyelets must be oriented to the right or to the left of the field coil
dowel pin location on the A/C compressor.
2. Using A/C Snap Ring Pliers 9764 or equivalent (1), install the snap ring (4) that secures the
compressor clutch field coil to the front of the A/C
compressor. Be certain that the snap ring is fully and properly seated in the groove and oriented
correctly.
CAUTION: Be certain to position the A/C clutch coil wire lead so that it is not damaged during A/C
compressor pulley and bearing
installation.
CAUTION: When installing the pulley and bearing assembly, DO NOT mar the friction surfaces of
the pulley or premature failure of the A/C
clutch will result.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor Clutch - Removal > Page 7134
3. Install the pulley and bearing assembly (1) onto the front of the A/C compressor. If necessary,
tap the pulley gently with a block of wood (2)
placed on the pulley friction surface.
CAUTION: The snap ring must be fully and properly seated in the groove or it will vibrate out,
resulting in a clutch failure and severe damage
to the A/C compressor.
NOTE: A new snap ring must be used to secure the pulley and bearing assembly to the A/C
compressor. The bevel side of the snap ring must
face outward.
4. Using A/C Snap Ring Pliers 9764 or equivalent (1), install the snap ring (2) that secures the
pulley and bearing assembly (3) to the front of the A/C
compressor. Be certain that the snap ring is fully and properly seated in the groove.
5. If the original clutch plate (2) and pulley and bearing assembly are to be reused, reinstall the
original shim(s) (3) onto the compressor shaft (1). If a
new clutch plate and pulley and bearing assembly are being used, install a trial stack of shims 2.54
mm (0.010 in.) thick onto the compressor shaft.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor Clutch - Removal > Page 7135
6. Install the clutch plate (4) onto the front of the A/C compressor (5). 7. Install the compressor
shaft bolt (3). Tighten the bolt to 19 Nm (168 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The shims may compress after tightening the shaft bolt. Check the air gap in four or more
places to verify the air gap is correct. Spin
the pulley before performing a final check of the air gap.
NOTE: On models with the clutch plate recessed into the pulley, use a 90° wire gap gauge to
measure the clutch air gap. On other models, use
a blade type feeler gauge to measure the air gap.
8. With the clutch plate assembled tight against the shim(s), measure the air gap between the
clutch plate and the pulley and bearing assembly. The
air gap should be between 0.35 - 0.60 mm (0.014 - 0.024 in.). If the air gap is not between
specifications, add or subtract shims as needed until the correct air gap is obtained.
CAUTION: Be certain that the compressor clutch coil wire lead is routed so that it is not pinched
between the A/C compressor and the coil
connector bracket.
9. Carefully route the compressor clutch field coil wire lead behind the connector bracket (2).
10. Install the compressor clutch field coil connector (1) onto the connector bracket. 11. Reinstall
the A/C compressor onto the engine if removed for A/C clutch service See: Service and Repair/A/C
Compressor - Installation. 12. Connect the engine wire harness to the compressor clutch field coil
connector. 13. Install the accessory drive belt See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Drive
Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Drive Belt/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Serpentine Accessory Drive Belt - Installation.
14. Install the splash shield onto the right side frame rail See: Body and Frame/Fender/Front
Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash
Shield - Installation.
15. Lower the vehicle. 16. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Control Valve Assembly >
Component Information > Diagrams
Compressor Control Valve Assembly: Diagrams
Connector (VDAC) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SOLENOID-A/C COMPRESSOR (VDAC) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Condenser - Description
Condenser HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Condenser - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: A/C condenser with automatic transmission cooler shown. A/C Condenser without cooler
similar.
The A/C condenser (1) is located in the front of the engine compartment behind the grille. The A/C
condenser is a heat exchanger that allows the high-pressure refrigerant gas being discharged by
the A/C compressor to give up its heat to the air passing over the condenser fins, which causes the
refrigerant to cool and change to a liquid state.
The A/C condenser is equipped with mounting tabs (3), a tapping block for the A/C discharge and
liquid lines (4) and a tapping block for the integral automatic transmission cooler (2), when
equipped with an automatic transaxle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Condenser - Description > Page 7143
Condenser HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Condenser - Operation
OPERATION
When air passes through the fins of the A/C condenser, the high-pressure refrigerant gas within the
A/C condenser gives up its heat. The refrigerant then condenses as it leaves the A/C condenser
and becomes a high-pressure liquid. The volume of air flowing over the condenser fins is critical to
the proper cooling performance of the A/C system. Therefore, it is important that there are no
objects placed in front of the radiator grille openings at the front of the vehicle or foreign material on
the condenser fins that might obstruct proper air flow. Also, any factory-installed air seals or
shrouds must be properly reinstalled following radiator or A/C condenser service.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C condenser has no serviceable parts. The O-ring seals used on the connections are made
from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals and gaskets
must be replaced whenever a refrigerant line is disconnected from the A/C condenser.
The A/C condenser cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Condenser - Removal
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Condenser - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
CAUTION: Before removing the A/C condenser, note the location of each of the radiator/condenser
air seals. These air seals are used to direct
air through the A/C condenser and radiator. The air seals must be reinstalled in their proper
locations in order for the A/C and engine cooling systems to perform as designed.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Remove the nuts (5) that secure
the A/C discharge line (1) and the A/C liquid line (4) to the tapping block (2) located on the right
side of the A/C
condenser.
4. Disconnect the A/C discharge and liquid lines from the tapping block and remove and discard
the O-ring seals and gaskets. 5. Remove the bolt (3) that secures the tapping block to the right side
of the radiator support. 6. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened refrigerant line fittings and
condenser ports.
NOTE: A/C condenser with automatic transmission cooler shown. A/C Condenser without cooler
similar.
7. Remove the front fascia See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Front Bumper/Front Bumper Cover /
Fascia/Service and Repair/Front Bumper Fascia Removal.
8. Remove the front bumper reinforcement See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Front Bumper/Front
Bumper Reinforcement/Service and Repair/Front
Bumper Reinforcement - Removal.
9. If equipped, disconnect the automatic transmission cooler lines (3) from the left side of the A/C
condenser (2) See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
10. If equipped with the 2.0L diesel engine, remove the charge air cooler.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Condenser - Removal > Page 7146
11. Disengage the two plastic retaining tabs (1 and 4) that secure the top mounting brackets of the
A/C condenser to the radiator. 12. Lift the A/C condenser slightly upward to disengage the two
lower mounting brackets (5 and 6) from the condenser and remove the condenser
from the engine compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Condenser - Removal > Page 7147
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Condenser - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: If only the A/C condenser is being replaced, add 10 milliliters (0.3 fluid ounce) of refrigerant
oil to the refrigerant system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: A/C condenser with automatic transmission cooler shown. A/C Condenser without cooler
similar.
1. Position the A/C condenser (1) to the front of the engine compartment and engage the
condenser to the two lower mounting brackets. 2. Engage the two plastic retaining tabs (1 and 4)
that secure the top mounting brackets of the A/C condenser to the radiator. Make sure the retaining
tabs are fully engaged.
3. If equipped, connect the automatic transmission cooler lines (2) to the left side of the A/C
condenser See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling
System/Service and Repair.
4. If equipped with the 2.0L diesel engine, install the charge air cooler. 5. Install the front bumper
reinforcement See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Front Bumper/Front Bumper Reinforcement/Service
and Repair/Front
Bumper Reinforcement - Installation.
6. Install the front fascia See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Front Bumper/Front Bumper Cover /
Fascia/Service and Repair/Front Bumper Fascia Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Condenser - Removal > Page 7148
7. Install the bolt (3) that secures the condenser tapping block (2) to the right side of the radiator
support. Tighten the bolt securely. 8. Remove the tape or plug from the opened refrigerant line
fittings and condenser ports. 9. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and
install them and new gaskets onto the refrigerant line fittings. Use only the
specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
10. Connect the A/C liquid line (4) and the A/C discharge line (1) to the tapping block and install the
retaining nuts (5). Tighten the nuts to 20 Nm (15
ft. lbs.).
11. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
12. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate 13. If
the A/C condenser is being replaced, add 10 milliliters (0.3 fluid ounce) of refrigerant oil to the
refrigerant system. When replacing multiple A/C
system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart to determine how much oil should
be added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
14. Charge the A/C system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > A/C-Heater Control (3 Zone MTC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > A/C-Heater Control (3 Zone MTC) > Page 7153
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > A/C-Heater Control (3 Zone MTC) > Page 7154
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way
Control Assembly: Diagrams A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way
Connector (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 32 WAY
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 32 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7157
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7158
Control Assembly: Diagrams A/C-Heater Control C1 (3 Zone MTC) (Instrument Panel) 16 Way
Connector C1 (3 ZONE MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (3 ZONE MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7159
Control Assembly: Diagrams A/C-Heater Control C1 (MTC) (Instrument Panel) 16 Way
Connector C1 (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7160
Control Assembly: Diagrams A/C-Heater Control C2 (MTC) (Instrument Panel) 5 Way
Connector C2 (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 5 WAY
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7161
Control Assembly: Diagrams
A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way
Connector (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 32 WAY
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 32 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7162
A/C-Heater Control C1 (3 Zone MTC) (Instrument Panel) 16 Way
Connector C1 (3 ZONE MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7163
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (3 ZONE MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
A/C-Heater Control C1 (MTC) (Instrument Panel) 16 Way
Connector C1 (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7164
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
A/C-Heater Control C2 (MTC) (Instrument Panel) 5 Way
Connector C2 (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7165
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 5 WAY
A/C-Heater Control C3 (3 Zone MTC) (Instrument Panel) 16 Way
Connector C3 (3 ZONE MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (3 ZONE MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7166
A/C-Heater Control C4 (3 Zone MTC) (Instrument Panel) 8 Way
Connector C4 (3 ZONE MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 8 WAY
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER (3 ZONE MTC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 8 WAY
Rear A/C-Heater Control (3 Zone HVAC) (Headliner) 8 Way
Connector (3 ZONE HVAC) - (HEADLINER) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > A/C-Heater Control (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 32 Way > Page 7167
CONTROL-A/C-HEATER-REAR (3 ZONE HVAC) - (HEADLINER) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single
Zone
MANUAL TEMPERATURE CONTROL (MTC) SINGLE ZONE
The A/C-heater control for the front Manual Temperature Control (MTC) single zone system allows
one temperature setting for the entire vehicle. All controls are identified by ISO graphic symbols.
The heating-A/C system uses a dedicated microprocessor to drive the electrically operated door
actuators. This control provides the vehicle operator with a number of setting options to help control
the climate and comfort within the vehicle.
The A/C-heater control (1) is located in the instrument panel and contains:
- a rotary control for blower motor speed selection, and to turn the blower motor off (2).
- a rotary control for temperature control of the discharged air (3).
- a rotary control for mode control of the discharged air (4).
- a push-button control with an indicator lamp to turn the rear window defogger system on and off
(5).
- a push-button control with an indicator lamp to turn the A/C system on and off (6).
- a push-button control with an indicator lamp for recirculation control of the discharged air (7).
The A/C-heater control for the MTC heating and A/C system and is diagnosed using a scan tool
See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic
Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures.
Prior to replacing an A/C-heater control, check for any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) related to
the heating-A/C system, and run the calibration procedure to verify that the concern is not an
air-door calibration issue . See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/HVAC System Test
The A/C-heater control cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone > Page 7170
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Front - Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) Dual
Zone
AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL (ATC) DUAL ZONE
The A/C-heater control for the Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) dual zone front heating-A/C
system allows both the driver and the front seat passenger the ability to individually regulate air
temperature for their side of the vehicle. An infrared sensor located in the overhead console
detects thermal radiation emitted by the front seat occupants and their surroundings. Based on the
sensor input, the system automatically adjusts the air temperature, airflow volume, airflow
distribution and amount of inside air recirculation to maintain front seat occupant comfort, even
under changing outside weather conditions. All controls are identified by ISO graphic symbols.
The ATC dual zone heating-A/C system uses a dedicated microprocessor to automatically drive the
electrically operated door actuators. The ATC A/C-heater control obtains vehicle speed, engine
speed, engine coolant temperature, ambient temperature and refrigerant system pressure. The
ATC A/C-heater control communicates with other electrical modules in the vehicle over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) IHC bus.
This ATC system provides the vehicle operator with a number of setting options to help control the
climate and comfort within the vehicle and offers several manual override features such as fan
speed, airflow distribution, defrost mode and when the outside air contains smoke, odors or high
humidity, the interior air can be manually recirculated.
The ATC dual zone A/C-heater control (1) is located in the instrument panel and contains:
- a push button on/off control which allows the heating-A/C system to be completely turned off (2).
The Vacuum-Fluorescent (VF) digital display (4) is blank when the heater-A/C system is off.
- two rotary temperature controls to select both driver and front seat passenger comfort
temperatures from 15° to 29° C (60° to 85° F) (3 and 5). Comfort temperatures for each zone are
shown in the VF digital display. If the set temperatures are 15° C (60° F) and is adjusted lower, the
A/C-heater control will attempt to achieve the lowest temperature possible, but the display will show
LO. If the set temperatures are 29° C (85° F) and is adjusted up, the A/C-heater control will attempt
to achieve the highest temperature possible, but the display will show HIGH. Temperatures can be
displayed in either Metric or Fahrenheit.
- a push button A/C on/off control (6). An ISO Snowflake symbol appears in the VF digital display
when the A/C system is in operation, whether under manual or Auto mode.
- a push button air recirculation control to set the heating-A/C system to Recirculation mode (7). An
ISO Recirculation symbol appears in the VF digital display when Recirculation mode is selected
and when the system exceeds 80 percent circulated air under Auto mode (due to high A/C
demand).
- a rocker switch mode control that can override the Auto mode (8). An ISO mode symbol appears
in the VF digital display to indicate the current mode setting when selected manually or by Auto
mode.
- a push button rear window defogger on/off control (9). An indicator lamp illuminates in the control
when selected. The indicator lamp illuminates in the control even with the heating-A/C system
turned off.
- a push button front window defogger control (10). An indicator lamp illuminates in the control
when selected manually and an ISO symbol appears in the VF digital display when selected by
auto mode.
- a rocker switch fan speed control that can override the auto mode (11). A bar graph is shown in
the VF digital display to indicate the selected or determined front fan speed (depending on manual
or auto mode).
- a push button automatic mode control to set the heating-A/C system to auto mode (12). AUTO
appears in the VF digital display when the system is in auto mode.
- illumination lamps for backlighting of the control.
- computer logic that remembers the settings of the controls when the ignition is turned off and
retains those settings after a restart. If the heating-A/C system is off when the ignition is turned off,
the system will be off when the engine is restarted.
- computer logic that provides variable air recirculation under high temperature and humidity
conditions. Because recirculation is generally
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone > Page 7171
accompanied by increased fan noise, the proportion of recirculated to outside air, gradually
approaches full recirculation over a broad temperature range.
The front A/C-heater control utilizes integrated circuitry and information carried on the CAN IHS
bus to monitor many sensors and switch inputs throughout the vehicle. In response to those inputs,
the internal circuitry and programming of the A/C-heater control allows it to control the electronic
functions and features of the ATC heating-A/C system.
The inputs received by the A/C-heater control of the ATC heating-A/C system are as follows:
- Refrigerant Pressure
- Evaporator Temperature
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient Air Temperature
- Infrared Temperature Sensor
- Vehicle Speed
The messages broadcasted by the A/C-heater control of the ATC heating-A/C system are as
follows:
- A/C Request
- A/C Select
- Rear Window Defogger (EBL) Request
The A/C-heater control for the ATC heating and A/C system is diagnosed using a scan toolSee:
Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic
Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures.
Prior to replacing an A/C-heater control, check for any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) related to
the heating-A/C system, and run the calibration procedure to verify that the concern is not an
air-door calibration issue See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The A/C-heater control cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged. The illumination lamps for the A/C-heater control can be serviced separately.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone > Page 7172
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Tri Zone
MANUAL TEMPERATURE CONTROL (MTC) TRI ZONE
The A/C-heater controls for the Manual Temperature Control (MTC) tri-zone heating-A/C system
allows the driver, front seat passenger and the intermediate seat passengers, the ability to
individually regulate air temperature as well as fan speed for their portion of the vehicle. Primary
controls for the rear heating-A/C system are located on the front A/C-heater control panel. All
controls are identified by ISO graphic symbols.
FRONT CONTROL PANEL
The front MTC dual zone A/C-heater control and integral computer (1) is located in the instrument
panel and contains:
- three rotary temperature controls (2, 7 and 9) to select the separate temperatures for both of the
front comfort zones and the rear comfort zone
- five push button mode controls (3 and 5) to select the position of the discharged air for the driver
and front passenger comfort zones. An indicator lamp illuminates in each of the controls when
selected.
- a rotary control knob for front fan speed selection and turning the heater-A/C system off (4).
- a push button air recirculation control (6). An indicator lamp illuminates in the control when
selected.
- a push button rear window defogger on/off control (8). An indicator lamp illuminates in the control
when selected. The rear window defogger system operates and the indicator lamp illuminates in
the control even when the heating-A/C system is turned off.
- a rotary control knob for rear fan speed selection and turning the rear heater-A/C system off (10).
This control has a position for locking out the rear heater-A/C controls, allowing only the driver and
front seat passenger control of the rear heating-A/C system.
- a push button A/C on/off control (11). An indicator lamp illuminates in the control when the A/C
system is in operation.
- computer logic that remembers the settings of the A/C-heater control when the ignition is turned
off, and retains those settings after a restart. If the heating-A/C system is off when the ignition is
turned off, the system will be off when the engine is restarted.
The front A/C-heater control utilizes integrated circuitry and information carried on the Controller
Area Network (CAN) IHS bus to monitor many sensors and switch inputs throughout the vehicle. In
response to those inputs, the internal circuitry and programming of the A/C-heater control allows it
to control the electronic functions and features of the MTC heating-A/C system.
The front A/C-heater control is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
Prior to replacing an A/C-heater control, check for any Diagnostic Trouble Codes(DTCs) related to
the heating-A/C system, and run the calibration procedure to verify that the concern is not an
air-door calibration issue See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The front A/C-heater control cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
REAR CONTROL PANEL
The rear MTC A/C-heater control is located in the headliner and allows intermediate seat
passengers to adjust rear air distribution, temperature and blower motor speed when the rear
heating-A/C system primary on/off control in the front A/C-heater control in the instrument panel is
set to the on position and the rear heater-A/C controls are NOT locked out by the driver or front
seat passenger.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone > Page 7173
The rear A/C-heater control (1) contains:
- a rotary control knob for fan speed selection and turning the rear heating-A/C system on and off
(2).
- a rotary control knob for temperature control of the rear discharged air (3). An indicator lamp
illuminates in the control when the rear heater-A/C controls are locked out by the driver or front
seat passenger.
- a rotary control knob for mode control of the rear discharged air (4).
The rear A/C-heater control is a slave potentiometer to the front A/C-heater control and cannot be
adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone > Page 7174
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Front - Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) Tri
Zone
AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL (ATC) TRI ZONE
The A/C-heater controls for the Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) tri-zone heating-A/C system
allows the driver, font seat passenger and the intermediate seat passengers the ability to
individually regulate the air temperature for their portion of the vehicle automatically. Primary
controls for the rear are located on the front A/C-heater control panel. All controls are identified by
ISO graphic symbols.
FRONT CONTROL PANEL
The front A/C-heater control (1) and integral computer is located in the instrument panel and
contains:
- three rotary temperature controls (2) to select both of the front and the rear comfort temperatures
from 15° to 29° C (60° to 85° F). Comfort temperatures for each zone are shown in the
Vacuum-Fluorescent (VF) digital display (5). If the set temperatures are 15° C (60° F) and is
adjusted lower, the A/C-heater control will attempt to achieve the lowest temperature possible, but
the display will show LO. If the set temperatures are 29° C (85° F) and is adjusted up, the
A/C-heater control will attempt to achieve the highest temperature possible, but the display will
show HIGH. Temperatures can be displayed in either Metric or Fahrenheit, which is selected from
the overhead console.
- a rocker switch front fan speed control (3) that can override the Auto mode. A bar graph is shown
in the VF digital display to indicate the selected or determined front fan speed (depending on
manual or Auto mode).
- a push button front window defogger control (4). An indicator lamp illuminates in the control when
selected manually and an ISO symbol appears in the VF digital display when selected by Auto
mode.
- a push button air recirculation control (6). An indicator lamp illuminates in the control when
selected manually and an ISO Recirculation symbol appears in the VF digital display when the
system exceeds 80 percent circulated air under Auto mode due to high A/C demand.
- a rocker switch front mode control (7) that can override the Auto mode. An ISO mode symbol
appears in the VF digital display to indicate the current mode setting when selected manually or by
Auto mode.
- a push button A/C on/off control (8). An ISO Snowflake symbol appears in the VF digital display
when the A/C system is in operation, whether under manual or Auto mode.
- a push button automatic mode control (9) to set the heating-A/C system to Auto mode. FRONT
AUTO appears in the VF digital display when the system is in Auto mode.
- a rocker switch rear mode control (10) that can override the rear A/C-heater control and the Auto
mode. An ISO mode symbol appears in the center portion of the VF display to show the current
mode setting when selected manually or by Auto mode.
- a push button control that locks out the rear heater-A/C controls (11), allowing only the driver and
front seat passenger control of the rear heating-A/C system. An indicator lamp illuminates in the
control when selected.
- a push button on/off control (12) that turns the rear heating-A/C system completely off. The center
portion of the VF display is blank when the rear heating-A/C system is off.
- a push button rear window defogger on/off control (13). An indicator lamp illuminates in the
control when selected. The indicator lamp illuminates in the control even with the heating-A/C
system turned off.
- a rocker switch rear fan speed control (14) that can override the rear A/C-heater control and the
Auto mode. A bar graph is shown in the center portion of the VF digital display to indicate the
selected or determined rear fan speed (depending on manual or Auto mode).
- a push button synchronize control (15) that synchronizes the temperature of all three of the
comfort zones to the drivers selected temperature. SYNC appears in the VF digital display when
the system is synchronized, whether under manual or Auto mode.
- a push button on/off control (16) which allows the heating-A/C system to be completely turned off.
The display is blank when the heater-A/C system is off.
- illumination lamps for backlighting of the control.
- computer logic that remembers the settings of the controls when the ignition is turned off and
retains those settings after a restart. If the system is off when the ignition is turned off it will be off
when the engine is restarted, etc.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone > Page 7175
- computer logic that provides variable air recirculation under high temperature and humidity
conditions. Because recirculation is generally accompanied by increased fan noise, the proportion
of recirculated to outside air gradually approaches full recirculation over a broad temperature
range.
The front A/C-heater control utilizes integrated circuitry and information carried on the Controller
Area Network (CAN) IHS bus to monitor many sensors and switch inputs throughout the vehicle. In
response to those inputs, the internal circuitry and programming of the A/C-heater control allows it
to control the electronic functions and features of the ATC heating-A/C system.
The inputs received by the A/C-heater control of the ATC heating-A/C system are as follows:
- Refrigerant Pressure
- Evaporator Temperature
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient Air Temperature
- Infrared Temperature Sensor
- Vehicle Speed
The messages broadcast by the A/C-heater control of the ATC heating-A/C system are as follows:
- A/C Request
- A/C Select
- Rear Window Defogger (EBL) Request
- Heated Front Seat Requests
The front A/C-heater control is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
Prior to replacing an A/C-heater control, check for any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) related to
the heating-A/C systems and run the calibration procedure to verify that the concern is not an
system calibration issue See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
The front A/C-heater control cannot be repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or damaged.
REAR CONTROL PANEL
The rear A/C-heater control is located in the rear overhead console and allows intermediate seat
passengers to adjust rear air distribution, temperature and blower motor speed when the rear
heating-A/C system primary on/off control in the front A/C-heater control in the instrument panel is
set to the on position and the rear heater-A/C controls are NOT locked out by the driver and front
seat passenger.
The rear A/C-heater control (1) contains:
- a rotary control knob for fan speed selection and turning the rear heating-A/C system off or to
Auto mode (2).
- a rotary control knob for temperature control of the rear discharged air (3). An indicator lamp
illuminates in the control when the rear heater-A/C controls are locked out by the driver or front
seat passenger.
- a rotary control knob for mode control of the rear discharged air (4).
The rear A/C-heater control is a slave potentiometer to the front A/C-heater control and cannot be
repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone > Page 7176
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone > Page 7177
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Rear
DESCRIPTION
The A/C-heater controls allows the driver and front seat passenger and the intermediate seat
passengers the ability to regulate air temperature as well as fan speed for the rear heating-A/C
system and provides a floor outlet near the right rear door and upper air outlets at the ceiling. All
controls are identified by ISO graphic symbols.
The primary controls for the rear heating-A/C system are located in the instrument panel See: .
The rear A/C-heater control is located in the headliner and allows intermediate seat passengers to
adjust rear air distribution, temperature and blower motor speed when the rear heating-A/C system
primary on/off control in the instrument panel is set to the on position and the rear heater-A/C
controls are NOT locked out by the driver and front seat passenger.
The rear automatic temperature control (ATC) A/C-heater control (1) contains:
- a rotary control knob for fan speed selection and turning the rear heating-A/C system off or to
Auto mode (2).
- a rotary control knob for temperature control of the rear discharged air (3). An indicator lamp
illuminates in the control when the rear heater-A/C controls are locked out by the driver or front
seat passenger.
- a rotary control knob for mode control of the rear discharged air (4).
The rear manual temperature control (MTC) A/C-heater control (1) contains:
- a rotary control knob for fan speed selection and turning the rear heating-A/C system on and off
(2).
- a rotary control knob for temperature control of the rear discharged air (3). An indicator lamp
illuminates in the control when the rear heater-A/C controls are locked out by the driver or front
seat passenger.
- a rotary control knob for mode control of the rear discharged air (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front - Manual Temperature Control (MTC) Single Zone > Page 7178
The rear A/C-heater control is a slave potentiometer to the front A/C-heater control and is
diagnosed using a scan tool.
Prior to replacing an A/C-heater control, check for any diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) related to
the heating-A/C systems and run the calibration procedure to verify that the concern is not a
system issue, See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC
System Test.
The rear A/C-heater control cannot be repaired must be replaced if inoperative or damaged. The
illumination lamps are available for service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > A/C and Heater Control - Removal
Control Assembly: Service and Repair A/C and Heater Control - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the front face of the instrument panel center bezel
from cosmetic damage during this service
procedure.
NOTE: MTC single zone A/C-heater control shown. Other A/C-heater controls similar.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the center bezel (3) and place it
on a workbench See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service
and Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Remove the screws (2 and 4) that secure the A/C-heater control (1) to the back of the center
bezel and remove the control.
Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Take the proper precautions to protect the face of the rear A/C-heater control bezel from
cosmetic damage during this service
procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > A/C and Heater Control - Removal > Page 7181
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the rear A/C-heater control (3) and
bezel (1) as an assembly from the headliner by releasing the four metal retaining tabs (2) using
Trim
Stick C-4755 or equivalent.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the back of the rear A/C-heater control and place
the control and bezel assembly on a workbench. 4. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the rear
A/C-heater control to the rear control bezel and remove the control from the bezel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > A/C and Heater Control - Removal > Page 7182
Control Assembly: Service and Repair A/C and Heater Control - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: MTC single zone A/C-heater control shown. Other A/C-heater controls similar.
1. Position the A/C-heater control (1) onto the back of the center bezel (3). 2. Install the screws (2
and 4) that secure the A/C-heater control to the center bezel. Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in.
lbs.). 3. Install the center bezel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel Installation.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE: The A/C-heater control will automatically perform the Actuator Calibration function when the
ignition is initially turned on when
installing a new control or when reinstalling the original control. However, the Actuator Calibration
function must be manually initiated using a scan tool if the A/C-heater control has been previously
installed in another vehicle.
5. If required, initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
Rear
INSTALLATION
1. Position the rear A/C-heater control (3) to the rear control bezel (1) and align the control to the
two plastic guide posts on the back of the bezel. 2. Install the two screws (4) that secure the rear
A/C-heater control to the rear control bezel. Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect
the wire harness connector to the back of the rear A/C-heater control and install the bezel and
control as an assembly to the headliner.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > A/C and Heater Control - Removal > Page 7183
Make sure the four metal retaining tabs (2) are fully engaged.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 5. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan
tool See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/HVAC System
Test.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module HVAC: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With
A/C OFF
Control Module HVAC: Customer Interest A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF
NUMBER: 24-008-08
GROUP: Air Conditioning
DATE: September 4, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.01 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: FLASH: Airflow Through HVAC Ducts with System Off
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin involves reprogramming the Three Zone Manual Temperature Control
module with new software.
MODELS:
2008 (RT) Grand Caravan/Town & Country
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built prior to April
16, 2008 (MDH0416XX) at Windsor Assembly plant (R in 11th VIN position) -OR- April 22, 2008
(MDH0422XX) at the St. Louis Assembly plant (B in 11th VIN position)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built before June
15, 2008 (MDH0615XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience an intermittent condition where air flow
from the HVAC vents is noticeable while driving with the HVAC system off. This may be more
noticeable with the temperature settings at medium or higher heat settings due to the temperature
differential coming out of the ducts.
Turning the blower on, and then off will force the fresh air/recirculation door closed eliminating the
airflow.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) using the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all A/C Systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are
present record them on a repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this
bulletin. If the Symptom/Condition is experienced or described by the customer, perform the Repair
Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
When performing this Repair Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN®; must be
programmed with 9.01 level software or higher. The
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module HVAC: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With
A/C OFF > Page 7192
software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, to take
advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's network.
Make sure the StarSCAN® is configured to the dealership's network before proceeding. For
instruction on setting up your StarSCAN® for the dealer's network refer to either:
"DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) tools > Online Documentation",
or refer to the StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide. The StarSCAN(R) Quick Start
Networking Guide is also available on the website under the "Download Center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts. Set
the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash
process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process is complete.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Turn the ignition switch on.
6. Retrieve the old HVAC part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a.Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the HVAC in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK".
l. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE:
Due to the HVAC programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored
DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module HVAC: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With
A/C OFF > Page 7193
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From
Vents With A/C OFF
Control Module HVAC: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF
NUMBER: 24-008-08
GROUP: Air Conditioning
DATE: September 4, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.01 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: FLASH: Airflow Through HVAC Ducts with System Off
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin involves reprogramming the Three Zone Manual Temperature Control
module with new software.
MODELS:
2008 (RT) Grand Caravan/Town & Country
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built prior to April
16, 2008 (MDH0416XX) at Windsor Assembly plant (R in 11th VIN position) -OR- April 22, 2008
(MDH0422XX) at the St. Louis Assembly plant (B in 11th VIN position)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built before June
15, 2008 (MDH0615XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience an intermittent condition where air flow
from the HVAC vents is noticeable while driving with the HVAC system off. This may be more
noticeable with the temperature settings at medium or higher heat settings due to the temperature
differential coming out of the ducts.
Turning the blower on, and then off will force the fresh air/recirculation door closed eliminating the
airflow.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) using the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all A/C Systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are
present record them on a repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this
bulletin. If the Symptom/Condition is experienced or described by the customer, perform the Repair
Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
When performing this Repair Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN®; must be
programmed with 9.01 level software or higher. The
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From
Vents With A/C OFF > Page 7199
software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, to take
advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's network.
Make sure the StarSCAN® is configured to the dealership's network before proceeding. For
instruction on setting up your StarSCAN® for the dealer's network refer to either:
"DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) tools > Online Documentation",
or refer to the StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide. The StarSCAN(R) Quick Start
Networking Guide is also available on the website under the "Download Center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts. Set
the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash
process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process is complete.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Turn the ignition switch on.
6. Retrieve the old HVAC part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a.Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the HVAC in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK".
l. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE:
Due to the HVAC programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored
DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: > 24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From
Vents With A/C OFF > Page 7200
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7201
Control Module HVAC: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7202
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-BLOWER-FRONT (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 7205
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Rear Blower Module C1 (3 Zone ATC) (Body) 6 Way
Connector C1 (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 6 WAY
MODULE-BLOWER-REAR (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 7206
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Rear Blower Module C2 (3 Zone ATC) (Body) 2 Way
Connector C2 (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-BLOWER-REAR (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
A blower motor power module is used on this model when equipped with the automatic
temperature control (ATC) heating-A/C system. Models equipped with the manual temperature
control (MTC) heating-A/C system use a blower motor resistor, instead of the blower motor power
module .
The blower motor power module is mounted to the bottom of the HVAC housing, on the passenger
side of the vehicle. The blower motor power module consists of a molded plastic mounting plate (1)
with an integral connector receptacle (2). Concealed behind the mounting plate is the power
module electronic circuitry (3) and a finned aluminum heat sink (4). The blower motor power
module is accessed for service from under the instrument panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description > Page 7209
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Front Blower Motor Power Module - Operation
OPERATION
The blower motor power module is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
lead and connector of the instrument panel wire harness. A second lead and connector of the
instrument panel wire harness is connected to the blower motor. The blower motor power module
allows the microprocessor-based automatic temperature control(ATC) A/C-heater control to
calculate and provide infinitely variable blower motor speeds based upon either manual blower
switch input or the ATC programming using a pulse width modulated (PWM) circuit strategy.
The PWM voltage is applied to a comparator circuit which compares the PWM signal voltage to the
blower motor feedback voltage. The resulting output drives the power module circuitry, which
provides a linear output voltage to change or maintain the desired blower speed.
The blower motor power module is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The blower motor power module cannot be adjusted or repaired must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description > Page 7210
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
A blower motor power module is used on this model when equipped with the automatic
temperature control (ATC) rear heating-A/C system. Models equipped with the manual temperature
control (MTC) rear heating-A/C system use a blower motor resistor, instead of the blower motor
power module .
The rear blower motor power module (1) is mounted to the inboard side of the rear heating-A/C
housing, located on the right side of the vehicle. The rear blower motor power module consists of a
molded plastic housing with two integral wire connector receptacles (2) for the power module
electronic circuitry, a mounting plate (3) with a gasket and a finned aluminum heat sink (4).
The rear blower motor power module can be accessed for service without removing the rear
heater-A/C housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description > Page 7211
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Operation
OPERATION
The rear blower motor power module is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated lead and connector of the rear body wire harness. A second lead and connector of the
wire harness is connected to the rear blower motor. The rear blower motor power module allows
the microprocessor-based automatic temperature control (ATC) A/C-heater control to calculate and
provide infinitely variable blower motor speeds based upon either manual blower switch input or the
ATC programming using a pulse width modulated (PWM) circuit strategy.
The PWM voltage is applied to a comparator circuit which compares the PWM signal voltage to the
rear blower motor feedback voltage. The resulting output drives the power module circuitry, which
provides a linear output voltage to change or maintain the desired blower speed.
The rear blower motor power module is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear blower motor power module cannot be adjusted or repaired must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The heat sink for the blower motor power module may get very hot during normal
operation. If the blower motor was turned on
prior to servicing the blower motor power module, wait five minutes to allow the heat sink to cool
before performing diagnosis or service. Failure to take this precaution may result in possible
serious injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1)
from the blower motor power module (2) located at the bottom of the HVAC housing (3) on the
passenger side of the vehicle.
3. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the blower motor power module to the HVAC housing
and remove the power module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal > Page 7214
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Front Blower Motor Power Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Position the blower motor power module (2) into the bottom of the HVAC housing (3). 2. Install
the two screws (4) that secure the blower motor power module to the HVAC housing. Tighten the
screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the blower motor
power module. 4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal > Page 7215
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the rear blower motor power module (3) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (2). 2. Install
the two screws (1) that secure the rear blower motor power module to the rear heater-A/C housing.
Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in.
lbs.).
3. Connect the two wire harness connectors (4) to the rear blower motor power module. 4. Install
the right rear quarter trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service
and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
5. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal > Page 7216
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove right rear quarter trim panel See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the two wire harness connectors (4) from the rear blower motor power module (3). 4.
Remove the two screws (1) that secure the rear blower motor power module to the rear heater-A/C
housing (2) and remove the module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front A/C Evaporator - Description
Evaporator Core: Description and Operation Front A/C Evaporator - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: LHD model shown.
The A/C evaporator (1) for the heating-A/C system is mounted in the HVAC housing, which is
located behind the instrument panel. The A/C evaporator and its insulator (2) are positioned within
the HVAC housing so that all air entering the housing must pass over the evaporator fins before it
is distributed through the heating-A/C system ducts and outlets.
A tapping block (3) and O-ring seals (4) are used to connect and seal the A/C evaporator tubes (5)
to the A/C expansion valve.
The A/C evaporator can only be serviced by removing and disassembling the HVAC housing
assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front A/C Evaporator - Description > Page 7221
Evaporator Core: Description and Operation Front A/C Evaporator - Operation
OPERATION
Refrigerant enters the A/C evaporator from the A/C expansion valve as a low-temperature,
low-pressure mixture of liquid and gas. As air flows over the fins of the A/C evaporator, the
humidity in the air condenses on the fins, and the heat from the air is absorbed by the refrigerant.
Heat absorption causes the refrigerant to boil and vaporize. The refrigerant becomes a
low-pressure gas when it leaves the A/C evaporator.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line or expansion valve is disconnected.
Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system
leak.
The A/C evaporator has no serviceable parts except for the O-ring seals. The O-ring seals used on
the connections are made from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The
O-ring seals must be replaced whenever the A/C expansion valve is removed from the A/C
evaporator.
The A/C evaporator cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front A/C Evaporator - Description > Page 7222
Evaporator Core: Description and Operation Rear A/C Evaporator - Description
DESCRIPTION
The rear A/C evaporator (4) is located within the rear heater-A/C housing, behind the right interior
quarter panel trim. The rear A/C evaporator is positioned in the rear heater-A/C housing so that all
air entering the housing must pass over the evaporator fins (3) before it is distributed through the
rear heating-A/C system ducts and outlets. However, air passing over the rear evaporator fins will
only be conditioned when the A/C compressor is engaged and circulating refrigerant through the
A/C evaporator.
The A/C expansion valve is connected and sealed to the A/C evaporator tubes (2) by use of rubber
O-ring seals and a tapping plate (1).
The rear A/C evaporator can only be serviced by removing and disassembling the rear heater-A/C
housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front A/C Evaporator - Description > Page 7223
Evaporator Core: Description and Operation Rear A/C Evaporator - Operation
OPERATION
Refrigerant enters the rear A/C evaporator from the rear A/C expansion valve as a
low-temperature, low-pressure mixture of liquid and gas. As air flows over the fins of the rear A/C
evaporator, the humidity in the air condenses on the fins, and the heat from the air is absorbed by
the refrigerant. Heat absorption causes the refrigerant to boil and vaporize. The refrigerant
becomes a low-pressure gas when it leaves the rear A/C evaporator.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime a refrigerant line or
expansion valve is disconnected. Failure to
replace the rubber O-ring seals could result in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C evaporator has no serviceable parts except for the O-ring seals. The O-ring seals used on
the connections are made from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The
O-ring seals must be replaced whenever the rear A/C expansion valve is removed from the rear
A/C evaporator.
The rear A/C evaporator cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front A/C Evaporator - Removal
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Front A/C Evaporator - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The HVAC housing assembly must be removed from vehicle and disassembled for service
of the A/C evaporator.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Remove the HVAC housing and place it on a workbench . 2. Disassemble the HVAC housing to
gain access to the A/C evaporator See: Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and
Repair/Overhaul/Disassembly.
NOTE: If the foam insulator around the A/C evaporator is deformed or damaged, the insulator must
be replaced.
3. Carefully lift the A/C evaporator (1) and the foam insulator (2) out of the lower half of the HVAC
housing (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front A/C Evaporator - Removal > Page 7226
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Front A/C Evaporator - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: If only the A/C evaporator is being replaced, add 10 milliliters (0.3 fluid ounce) of refrigerant
oil to the refrigerant system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
NOTE: Make sure that the foam insulator is properly positioned around the A/C evaporator and in
the HVAC housing.
1. Carefully install the A/C evaporator (1) and foam insulator (2) into the lower half of the HVAC
housing (3). 2. Assemble the HVAC housing See: Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and
Repair/Overhaul/Assembly. 3. Install the HVAC housing . 4. If the A/C evaporator is being
replaced, add 10 milliliters (0.3 fluid ounce) of refrigerant oil to the refrigerant system. When
replacing multiple
A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart to determine how much oil
should be added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front A/C Evaporator - Removal > Page 7227
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Rear A/C Evaporator - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the rear heater-A/C housing and
place it on a workbench See: Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing Removal.
3. Remove the foam seal (2) from the flange (1) located at the bottom of the rear heater-A/C
housing (3). If the foam seal is deformed or damaged, it
must be replaced.
4. Remove the three screws (2) that secure the flange (1) to the bottom of the rear heater-A/C
housing (3) and remove the flange.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front A/C Evaporator - Removal > Page 7228
5. Remove the two screws (1) that secure the rear expansion valve (3) to the tapping plate located
on the end of the rear evaporator tubes (2) and
remove the valve.
6. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and install plugs in, or tape over the opened evaporator
tubes and expansion valve ports.
7. Remove the wire harness connector (7) from the lower rear heater-A/C housing (6). 8. Open the
evaporator tube retaining bracket (3) located on the outboard side of the lower housing. 9. Remove
the metal retaining clip (2) that secures the lower housing to the rear heater-A/C housing (4).
10. Remove the five screws (1 and 5) that secure the lower housing the rear heater-A/C housing
and carefully remove the lower housing. Rotate and
tilt the lower housing as necessary for removal.
11. Remove the screw (1) that secures the rear evaporator cover (3) to the outboard side of the
rear heater-A/C housing (2) and remove the cover of
the housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front A/C Evaporator - Removal > Page 7229
12. Carefully pull the rear A/C evaporator (4) out the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3).
Guide the evaporator tubes (2) past the heater core
tubes (1). If the foam seals on the A/C evaporator are deformed or damaged, they must be
replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front A/C Evaporator - Removal > Page 7230
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Rear A/C Evaporator - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: If only the rear A/C evaporator is being replaced, add 30 milliliters (1 fluid ounce) of
refrigerant oil to the refrigerant system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime a refrigerant line or
expansion valve is disconnected. Failure to
replace the rubber O-ring seals could result in a refrigerant system leak.
1. Install the rear A/C evaporator (4) into the rear heater-A/C housing (3). Guide the evaporator
tubes (2) past the rear heater core tubes (1). Make
sure that the foam seals are properly installed on the evaporator.
2. Install the evaporator cover (3) onto the outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing (2) and
install the retaining screw (1). Tighten the screw to
1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front A/C Evaporator - Removal > Page 7231
3. Install the lower rear heater-A/C housing (6) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (4). Rotate and tilt
the lower housing as necessary for installation. 4. Install the five screws (1 and 5) that secure the
lower housing to the rear heater-A/C housing. Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 5. Install
the metal retaining clip (2) that secures the lower housing to the rear heater-A/C housing. 6. Close
the evaporator tube retaining bracket (3). Make sure the bracket retainers are fully engaged. 7.
Install the wire harness connector (7) onto the lower rear heater-A/C housing.
8. Remove the tape or plugs from the rear evaporator tubes and expansion valve ports. 9.
Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the rear
evaporator tube fittings. Use only the specified O-rings
as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type
recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
10. Install the rear A/C expansion valve (3) onto the tapping plate located on the end of the rear
evaporator tubes (2) 11. Install two bolts (1) that secure the rear A/C expansion valve to the taping
plate. Tighten the bolts to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.).
12. Position the flange (1) to the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3) and install the three
retaining screws (2). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front A/C Evaporator - Removal > Page 7232
in. lbs.).
13. Install the foam seal (2) onto the flange (1) at the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3).
Make sure that the foam seal is properly installed. 14. Install the rear heater-A/C housing See:
Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing
Installation.
15. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 16. If the rear A/C evaporator is being replaced, add 30
milliliters (1 fluid ounce) of refrigerant oil to the refrigerant system. When replacing multiple
A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart to determine how much oil
should be added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7236
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7237
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7238
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
SENSOR-EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Description
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front Evaporator
Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The evaporator temperature sensor measures the temperature of the conditioned air downstream
of the A/C evaporator. The evaporator temperature sensor is an electrical thermistor (1) mounted
on the end of a molded plastic housing (2) that is inserted into the driver side of the HVAC housing
near the coldest point of the A/C evaporator. The evaporator temperature sensor is retained in the
HVAC housing by two integral retaining tabs (3) and is connected to the vehicle electrical system
by use of a wire lead and connector (4) with two terminals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 7241
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front Evaporator
Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The evaporator temperature sensor monitors the surface temperature of A/C evaporator and
supplies an input signal to the A/C-heater control. The A/C-heater control uses the evaporator
temperature sensor input signal to optimize A/C system performance and to protect the A/C system
from evaporator freezing. The evaporator temperature sensor will change its internal resistance in
response to the temperatures it monitors and is connected to the A/C-heater control through sensor
ground circuit and a 5-volt reference signal circuit. As the temperature of the A/C evaporator
decreases, the internal resistance of the evaporator temperature sensor decreases.
The A/C-heater control uses the monitored voltage reading as an indication of evaporator
temperature. The A/C-heater control is programmed to respond to this input by requesting the
powertrain control module (PCM) or the engine control module (ECM) (depending on engine
application) to adjust the compressor swash plate angle as necessary to optimize A/C system
performance and to protect the A/C system from evaporator freezing See: Compressor
HVAC/Description and Operation/A/C Compressor - Operation.
The evaporator temperature sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool.
The evaporator temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and it must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Removal
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front Evaporator Temperature
Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Illustration shown with air distribution housing removed for clarity.
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove and disassemble the HVAC housing to service the evaporator
temperature sensor. The evaporator
temperature sensor can be removed for service from underneath the instrument panel.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Reach up under the driver side of the
instrument panel and disconnect the electrical connector for the evaporator temperature sensor (1)
from the
instrument panel wire harness.
3. Using needle nose pliers, disengage the two retaining tabs (3) that secure the evaporator
temperature sensor to the HVAC housing (2) by carefully
pulling the sensor straight out of the side of the HVAC housing.
4. Route the electrical connector and wire lead of the evaporator temperature sensor out from
under the heater core tubes and remove the sensor from
the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 7244
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front Evaporator Temperature
Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Illustration shown with air distribution housing removed for clarity.
1. Route the electrical connector and wire lead of the evaporator temperature sensor (1) under the
heater core tubes located on the driver side of the
HVAC housing (2).
2. Install the evaporator temperature sensor into the driver side of the HVAC housing. Make sure
the retaining tabs (3) are fully engaged to the
housing.
3. Connect the electrical connector for the evaporator temperature sensor to the instrument panel
wire harness. 4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Expansion Valve - Description
Expansion Valve: Description and Operation A/C Expansion Valve - Description
Front
DESCRIPTION
The A/C expansion valve controls the amount of refrigerant entering the A/C evaporator. The A/C
expansion valve is of a thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) design and consists of an aluminum
H-valve type body (1) with an inlet port (2), outlet port (3) and an integral thermal sensor (4).
The A/C expansion valve is located in the engine compartment at the dash panel, between the A/C
refrigerant lines and the A/C evaporator.
Rear
DESCRIPTION
The rear A/C expansion valve controls the amount of refrigerant entering the rear A/C evaporator.
The rear A/C expansion valve is of a thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) design and consists of an
aluminum H-valve type body (1) with an inlet port (2), outlet port (3) and an integral thermal sensor
(4).
The rear A/C expansion valve is located on the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing, which
extends through the rear floor panel behind the right rear wheel housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Expansion Valve - Description > Page 7249
Expansion Valve: Description and Operation A/C Expansion Valve - Operation
Front
OPERATION
The A/C expansion valve controls the high-pressure, low temperature liquid refrigerant from the
A/C liquid line and converts it into a low-pressure, low-temperature mixture of liquid and gas before
it enters the A/C evaporator. A mechanical sensor in the A/C expansion valve monitors the
temperature and pressure of the refrigerant leaving the A/C evaporator through the A/C suction
line, and adjusts the orifice size at the liquid line port to let the proper amount of refrigerant into the
evaporator to meet the vehicle A/C cooling requirements. Controlling the refrigerant flow through
the A/C evaporator ensures that none of the refrigerant leaving the A/C evaporator is still in a liquid
state, which could damage the A/C compressor.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime a refrigerant line is
disconnected from the expansion valve, or if
the expansion valve is removed. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals may result in a
refrigerant system leak.
The A/C expansion valve is factory calibrated and cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be
replaced if inoperative or damaged.
Rear
OPERATION
The rear A/C expansion valve controls the flow of high-pressure, low temperature liquid refrigerant
entering the expansion valve and converts it into a low-pressure, low-temperature mixture of liquid
and gas before it enters the rear A/C evaporator. To meet the vehicles A/C cooling requirements, a
mechanical sensor is used in the rear A/C expansion valve to monitor the temperature and
pressure of the refrigerant leaving the rear A/C evaporator and then adjust the inlet port orifice size
to allow only the proper amount of refrigerant to enter the evaporator. Controlling the refrigerant
flow through the rear A/C evaporator ensures that none of the refrigerant leaving the evaporator is
still in a liquid state, which could damage the A/C compressor.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime a refrigerant line is
disconnected from the expansion valve, or if
the expansion valve is removed. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals may result in a
refrigerant system leak.
The rear A/C expansion valve is factory calibrated and cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be
replaced if inoperative or damaged See: Testing and Inspection.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7250
Expansion Valve: Testing and Inspection
A/C EXPANSION VALVE
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The A/C expansion valve should only be tested following testing of the A/C compressor.
NOTE: Liquid CO2 is required to test the A/C expansion valve. This material is available from most
welding supply facilities. Liquid CO2 is
also available from companies which service and sell fire extinguishers.
When testing the A/C expansion valve, the work area and the vehicle temperature must be 21° to
27° C (70° to 85° F). To test the expansion valve:
1. Connect a charging station or manifold gauge set to the refrigerant system service ports. Verify
the refrigerant charge level. 2. Close all doors, windows and vents to the passenger compartment.
3. Set the A/C-heater controls so that the A/C compressor is operating, the temperature control is
in the highest temperature position, the mode-air
doors is directing air output to the floor and the blower motor operating is operating at the highest
speed.
4. Start the engine and allow it to idle. After the engine has reached normal operating temperature,
allow the passenger compartment to heat up. This
will create the need for maximum refrigerant flow into the A/C evaporator.
5. If the refrigerant charge is sufficient, the discharge (high pressure) gauge should read 827 kPa to
1655 kPa (120 psi to 240 psi). The suction (low
pressure) gauge should read 207 kPa to 345 kPa (30 psi to 50 psi). If OK, go to 6. If not OK,
replace the inoperative A/C expansion valve.
WARNING:
Protect the skin and eyes from exposure to liquid CO2 or personal injury can result.
6. If the suction (low pressure) gauge reads within the specified range, freeze the A/C expansion
valve for 30 seconds using liquid CO2 or another
suitable super-cold material. Do not spray R-134a or R-12 refrigerant on the A/C expansion valve
for this test. The suction (low pressure) gauge reading should drop by 69 kPa (10 psi). If OK, go to
7. If not OK, replace the inoperative A/C expansion valve.
7. Allow the expansion valve control head to thaw. The suction (low pressure) gauge reading
should stabilize at 207 kPa to 345 kPa (30 psi to 50
psi). If not OK, replace the inoperative A/C expansion valve.
8. When expansion valve testing is complete, test the overall A/C system performance See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Expansion Valve - Removal
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair A/C Expansion Valve - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. If equipped with heat shield (3),
remove the top nut (2) that secures the heat shield to the stud (1) located on the dash panel.
NOTE: Two slots are provided at the bottom of the heat shield to aid in heat shield removal, if
equipped. Complete removal of the two bottom
heat shield retaining nuts is not required.
4. If equipped, reach behind the engine and remove the two bottom nuts the that secure the heat
shield to the studs located on the dash panel and
remove the heat shield. Rotate and tilt the heat shield as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Expansion Valve - Removal > Page 7253
5. Remove the nut (6) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (1) to the stud (2)
located on the right front shock tower. 6. Remove the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and
suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve (4). 7. Disconnect the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly from the A/C expansion valve, remove and discard the O-ring seals and position the
refrigerant lines out of the way.
8. Remove the two bolts (1) that secure the A/C expansion valve (2) to the evaporator tube tapping
block (3). 9. Remove the A/C expansion valve from the tapping block and remove and discard the
O-ring seals
10. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened refrigerant fittings and all expansion valve and
evaporator tube ports.
Rear
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Expansion Valve - Removal > Page 7254
1. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System
Recovery. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. 3. Loosen the nuts (1) that secure the underbody
refrigerant lines to the underbody refrigerant extension lines (2 and 6) located behind the right rear
wheel housing.
4. Disconnect the underbody refrigerant lines from underbody refrigerant extension lines and
remove and discard the O-ring seals. 5. Remove the nut (5) that secures the underbody refrigerant
extension line sealing plate (4) to the rear A/C expansion valve (3). 6. Disconnect the underbody
refrigerant extension lines and sealing plate from the rear A/C expansion valve and remove and
discard the O-ring seals.
NOTE: Illustration shown with rear heater-A/C housing removed from vehicle.
7. Remove the two bolts (1) that secure the rear A/C expansion valve (3) to the rear evaporator
tubes (2), which extend through the rear floor panel
behind the right rear wheel housing.
8. Remove the rear A/C expansion valve from the rear evaporator tubes and remove and discard
the O-ring seals. 9. Install plugs in, or tape over all the opened underbody refrigerant line fittings
and the rear evaporator and expansion valve ports.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Expansion Valve - Removal > Page 7255
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair A/C Expansion Valve - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime a refrigerant line is
disconnected from the expansion valve, or if
the expansion valve is removed. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals may result in a
refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened refrigerant fittings and all expansion valve and
evaporator ports. 2. Lubricate new O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the
refrigerant line and evaporator tube fittings. Use only the specified
O-ring seals as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil
of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Install the A/C expansion valve (2) onto the evaporator tube tapping block (3) 4. Install the two
bolts (1) that secure the A/C expansion valve to the evaporator tube tapping block. Tighten the
bolts to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Expansion Valve - Removal > Page 7256
5. Connect the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (1) to the A/C expansion valve (4).
CAUTION: Use care when installing the A/C lines to the A/C expansion valve. Carefully align the
tube ends with the valve prior to tightening
the A/C line retaining nut or damage to the sealing rings and tube ends may occur.
6. Install the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion
valve. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 7. Install the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line
retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on the right front strut tower. Tighten the nut securely.
8. If equipped, position the heat shield (3) onto the three studs (1) located on the dash panel in the
engine compartment and install the three retaining
nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
9. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
10. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Expansion Valve - Removal > Page 7257
11. Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 12. Charge the
A/C system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Rear
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime a refrigerant line is
disconnected from the expansion valve, or if
the expansion valve is removed. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals may result in a
refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: Illustration shown with rear heater-A/C housing removed from vehicle.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened underbody refrigerant line fittings and the rear
evaporator and expansion valve ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant
oil and install them onto the rear evaporator tube fittings. Use only the specified O-rings
as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type
recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Install the rear A/C expansion valve (3) onto the rear evaporator tubes (2) extending through the
rear floor panel behind the right rear wheel
housing.
4. Install two bolts (1) that secure the rear A/C expansion valve to the rear evaporator tubes.
Tighten the bolts to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.).
5. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the underbody
refrigerant extension line fittings. Use only the
specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Expansion Valve - Removal > Page 7258
CAUTION: Use care when installing the underbody refrigerant extension lines to the rear A/C
expansion valve. Carefully align the tube ends
with the valve prior to tightening the sealing plate retaining nut or damage to the sealing rings and
tube ends may occur.
6. Connect the underbody refrigerant extension lines (2 and 6) and the sealing plate (4) to the rear
A/C expansion valve (2). 7. Loosely install the nut (5) that secures the extension lines and sealing
plate to the rear A/C expansion valve. 8. Connect the underbody refrigerant lines to the underbody
refrigerant extension lines and tighten the fitting nuts (1) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 9. Tighten the nut
that secures the extension lines and sealing plate to the rear A/C expansion valve to 11 Nm (97 in.
lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant
System Evacuate. 12. Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level.
13. Charge the A/C system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front Heater Core - Description
Heater Core: Description and Operation Front Heater Core - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: LHD model shown.
The heater core (1) for the heating-A/C system is mounted within the HVAC air distribution
housing, which is located behind the instrument panel. The heater core is a heat exchanger made
of rows of tubes with fins and is positioned within the air distribution housing so that only the
selected amount of air entering the housing passes through the heater core before it is distributed
through the heating-A/C system ducts and outlets. One end of the heater core is fitted with a tank
(2) that includes the fittings for the heater core tubes (3).
The heater core can only be serviced by removing the HVAC housing from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front Heater Core - Description > Page 7263
Heater Core: Description and Operation Front Heater Core - Operation
OPERATION
Engine coolant is circulated through the heater hoses to the heater core at all times. As the coolant
flows through the heater core, heat is removed from the engine and is transferred to the heater
core tubes and fins. Air directed through the heater core picks up the heat from the heater core
fins. The blend-air door allows control of the heater output air temperature by regulating the amount
of air flowing through the heater core. The blower motor speed controls the volume of air flowing
through the HVAC housing.
The heater core cannot be repaired and it must be replaced if inoperative, leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front Heater Core - Description > Page 7264
Heater Core: Description and Operation Rear Heater Core - Description
DESCRIPTION
The rear heater core (1) is located in the rear heater-A/C housing behind the right interior quarter
trim panel. The rear heater core is a heat exchanger made of rows of tubes and fins (2). The heater
core tubes (3) are permanently soldered to the heater core tank and are retained to the outboard
side of the rear heater-A/C housing by use of an integral bracket (4) and screw.
The rear heater-A/C housing must be removed from the vehicle to service the rear heater core.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front Heater Core - Description > Page 7265
Heater Core: Description and Operation Rear Heater Core - Operation
OPERATION
Engine coolant is circulated through heater hoses and tubes to the rear heater core at all times. As
the coolant flows through the heater core, heat removed from the engine is transferred to the
heater core fins and the air directed through the heater core picks up the heat from the fins. The
rear blend-air door allows control of the rear heater output air temperature by controlling the
amount of air flowing through or around the rear heater core. The rear blower motor speed controls
the volume of air flowing through the rear heater-A/C housing.
The rear heater core cannot be repaired and must be replaced if inoperative, leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Heater Core - Removal
Heater Core: Service and Repair Front Heater Core - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The HVAC housing assembly must be removed from vehicle for service of the heater core.
NOTE: LHD model with A/C shown. Heater-only models similar.
1. Remove the HVAC housing assembly and place it on a workbench . 2. Remove the left side front
floor duct See: Air Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution Duct - Removal.
NOTE: If the foam seal for the flange is deformed or damaged, it must be replaced.
3. Remove the foam seal (1) from the flange (2) located on the front of the HVAC housing (5). 4.
Remove the screw (6) that secures the flange to the front of the HVAC housing and remove the
flange. 5. On RHD models, remove the air distribution housing from the HVAC housing 6. Carefully
pull the heater core (4) out of the driver side of the air distribution housing (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 7268
Heater Core: Service and Repair Front Heater Core - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: LHD model with A/C shown.
1. Carefully install the heater core (4) into the side of the air distribution housing (3). 2. On RHD
models, install the air distribution housing onto the HVAC housing (5) . 3. Install the flange (2) that
secures the heater core tubes to the front of the HVAC housing. 4. Install the screw (6) that
secures the flange to the HVAC housing. Tighten the screw to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
NOTE: If the foam seal for the flange is deformed or damaged, it must be replaced.
5. Install the foam seal (1) onto the flange. 6. Install the left side front floor duct See: Air
Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution Duct - Installation.
NOTE: If the heater core is being replaced, flush the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair .
7. Install the HVAC housing assembly .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 7269
Heater Core: Service and Repair Rear Heater Core - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the rear heater-A/C housing and
place it on a workbench See: Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing Removal.
3. Remove the foam seal (2) from the flange (1) located at the bottom of the rear heater-A/C
housing (3). If the foam seal is deformed or damaged, it
must be replaced.
4. Remove the three screws (2) that secure the flange (1) to the bottom of the rear heater-A/C
housing (3) and remove the flange.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 7270
5. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the rear blend door actuator (2) located on the
outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing (4). 6. Remove the two screws (1) that secure the
rear blend door actuator to the rear heater-A/C housing and remove the actuator.
7. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1) from the rear mode door actuator (3) located on the
outboard side of the rear heater-A/C distribution
housing (2).
8. Remove the three metal retaining clips (4) that secure the rear distribution housing to the rear
heater-A/C housing (5). 9. Release the five plastic retaining tabs (4) that secure the rear distribution
housing and rear heater-A/C housing together and separate the housings.
10. Remove the screw (1) that secures the rear heater core tubes (3) to the outboard side of the
rear heater-A/C housing (4).
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the plastic evaporator tube bracket, carefully guide the heater
core tubes past the bracket during removal
of the heater core.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 7271
11. Carefully pull the rear heater core (5) out of the top of the rear heater-A/C housing. Guide the
heater core tubes past the plastic evaporator tube
bracket (2). If the foam seals on the heater core are deformed or damaged, they must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 7272
Heater Core: Service and Repair Rear Heater Core - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the plastic evaporator tube bracket, carefully guide the heater
core tubes past the bracket during
installation of the heater core.
1. Carefully install the rear heater core (5) into the rear heater-A/C housing (4). Guide the heater
core tubes past the plastic evaporator tube bracket
(2). Make sure that the foam seals are properly installed.
2. Install the screw (1) that secures the rear heater core tubes (3) to the outboard side of the rear
heater-A/C housing. Tighten the screw to 1.2 Nm (10
in. lbs.).
3. Position the rear heater-A/C distribution housing (2) to the rear heater-A/C housing (5) and
engage the five plastic retaining tabs (4). Make sure
the retaining tabs are fully engaged.
4. Install the three metal retaining clips (6) that secure the rear distribution housing to the rear
heater-A/C housing. 5. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the rear mode door actuator (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 7273
6. Position the rear blend door actuator (1) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (3). If necessary,
rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines on the
actuator output shaft with those on the rear blend-air door pivot shaft (2).
7. Install the two screws (1) that secure the rear blend door actuator (2) to the rear heater-A/C
housing (4). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 8. Connect the wire harness connector (3)
to the rear blend door actuator.
9. Position the flange (1) to the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3) and install the three
retaining screws (2). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10
in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Heater Core - Removal > Page 7274
10. Install the foam seal (2) onto the flange (1) at the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3).
Make sure that the foam seal is properly installed. 11. Install the rear heater-A/C housing See:
Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing
Installation.
12. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 13. If the rear heater core is being replaced, flush the
cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 14. Refill
the engine cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
15. Evacuate and charge the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System
Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > High Pressure Relief Valve - Operation
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Description and Operation High Pressure Relief Valve Operation
HIGH PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
The high pressure relief valve vents refrigerant from the A/C system when a discharge pressure of
3445 to 4135 kPa (500 to 600 psi) or above is reached. The high pressure relief valve closes with a
minimum discharge pressure of 2756 kPa (400 psi) is reached.
The high pressure relief valve should not open when the A/C system is operating correctly. If the
high pressure relief valve vents refrigerant, there is most likely a problem within the A/C refrigerant
system. The high pressure relief valve vents only enough refrigerant to reduce the A/C system
pressure, and then re-seats itself. If the high pressure relief valve vents refrigerant, see the A/C
System Diagnosis chart See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
The high pressure relief valve is factory-calibrated and cannot be adjusted or repaired, and must
not be removed or otherwise disturbed. The valve is only serviced as a part of the A/C compressor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Discharge Line - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
The A/C discharge line (2) is the refrigerant line that carries refrigerant from the A/C compressor to
the A/C condenser.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C discharge line has no serviceable parts except for the metal gaskets (1) and rubber O-ring
seals (3) used on the fittings. The O-ring seals are made from a special type of rubber not affected
by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals and gaskets must be replaced whenever the A/C discharge
line is disconnected.
The A/C discharge line cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description > Page 7283
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Liquid Line - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: A/C liquid and suction line assembly with rear A/C shown. Front A/C only line assembly
similar.
The A/C liquid line is serviced in two sections. The front section of the A/C liquid line is the
refrigerant line that carries liquid refrigerant from the A/C condenser to the A/C receiver/drier and is
only serviced as an assembly with receiver/drier See: Receiver Dryer/Description and
Operation/Front A/C Receiver Drier - Description.
The rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) carries liquid refrigerant from the A/C receiver/drier to the
A/C expansion valve and includes the high side service port (2) and a fitting for the A/C pressure
transducer (4). The rear section of the A/C liquid line is only serviced as an assembly with the A/C
suction line (5). When equipped with rear A/C, the A/C liquid and suction line assembly includes
connections for the underbody refrigerant lines (3).
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C liquid and suction line assembly has no serviceable parts except for the metal gaskets,
rubber O-ring seals and the service port valve cores. The O-ring seals used on the connections are
made from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals and
gaskets must be replaced whenever the A/C liquid/suction line assembly is disconnected.
The A/C liquid and suction line assembly cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description > Page 7284
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Suction Line - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: A/C Suction line for 2.7L engine shown. Other engines similar.
The A/C suction line carries refrigerant from the A/C expansion valve to the A/C compressor and is
serviced in two sections. The upper section of the A/C suction line (1) includes the low side service
port (2) and is only serviced as an assembly with the rear A/C liquid line (6). When equipped with
rear A/C, the A/C liquid and suction line assembly includes connections for the underbody
refrigerant lines (3). The lower section of the A/C suction line (7) connects to the upper section of
the suction line and the connections are sealed by use of metal gaskets (5) and rubber O-ring seals
(4)
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
The lower A/C suction line and the A/C liquid and suction line assembly has no serviceable parts
except for the metal gaskets, rubber O-ring seals and the service port valve cores. The O-ring
seals used on the connections are made from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a
refrigerant. The O-ring seals and gaskets must be replaced whenever the lower A/C suction line
and/or the A/C liquid and suction line assembly is disconnected.
The lower A/C suction line and the A/C liquid and suction line assembly cannot be repaired and
must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description > Page 7285
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Underbody Lines - Description
DESCRIPTION
Models equipped with the rear heating-A/C system use metal lines attached to the vehicle
underbody to carry refrigerant and engine coolant to and from the rear A/C evaporator and heater
core. The underbody A/C lines (1) are connected to the front A/C suction and liquid lines and to the
rear A/C expansion valve extension tubes using nut type fittings (4) and O-ring seals. The
underbody heater lines (2) are connected to the front heater hoses and the rear heater core using
spring type clamps (3). The underbody lines are retained to the vehicle by seven plastic mounting
brackets (5).
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime an underbody
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals may result in a refrigerant system leak.
The underbody lines have no serviceable parts except for the refrigerant line rubber O-ring seals
and metal spring clamps. The O-ring seals used on the refrigerant line connections are made from
a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals must be replaced
whenever the underbody refrigerant lines are disconnected.
The underbody lines cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line - Description > Page 7286
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Underbody Extension Lines - Description
DESCRIPTION
Models equipped with the rear heating-A/C system use metal lines attached to the vehicle
underbody to carry refrigerant and engine coolant to and from the rear A/C evaporator and heater
core. The underbody A/C lines are connected to the front A/C suction and liquid lines by use of
underbody A/C extension lines (2). The underbody A/C extension lines are connected to the front
and underbody refrigerant lines with nut type fittings (1 and 3) and O-ring seals.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime an underbody
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals may result in a refrigerant system leak.
The underbody A/C extension lines have no serviceable parts except for the rubber O-ring seals.
The O-ring seals used on the refrigerant line connections are made from a special type of rubber
not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals must be replaced whenever the underbody
refrigerant lines are disconnected.
The underbody A/C extension lines cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Discharge Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Remove the nut (5) that secures
the A/C discharge line (1) to the condenser tapping block (2) located on the right side of the
condenser. 4. Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the tapping block.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
5. Remove the nut (3) that secures the A/C discharge line (1) to the A/C compressor (2). 6.
Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the A/C compressor and remove the discharge line from
the engine compartment. 7. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and gaskets and install plugs in,
or tape over the opened discharge line fittings and the compressor and
condenser ports.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7289
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Discharge Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened discharge line fittings and the compressor and
condenser ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the discharge line fittings. Use only the
specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C discharge line (1) into the engine compartment and connect it to the A/C
compressor (2). 4. Install the nut (3) that secures the A/C discharge line to the A/C compressor.
Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect the A/C discharge line (1) to the condenser tapping block (2). 6. Install the nut (5) that
secures the A/C discharge line to the tapping block. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 7.
Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7290
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
8. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 9.
Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level.
10. Charge the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7291
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Liquid Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Review safety precautions and warnings before performing this procedure See:
Service Precautions/Warning and See: Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible serious or
fatal injury.
NOTE: The rear A/C liquid line is only serviced as an assembly with the upper A/C suction line.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Raise and support the vehicle. 4.
Position the front portion of the right front wheelhouse splash shield out of the way to gain access
to the A/C receiver/drier See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
5. Remove the nut (5) that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C
receiver/drier (4). 6. Disconnect the rear section of the A/C liquid line from the A/C receiver/drier
and remove and discard the O-ring seal and gasket. 7. Disconnect the lower portion of the A/C
suction line from the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C Suction Line - Removal. 8.
Remove the bolt (3) that secures the rear section of the A/C suction line (2) to the right front frame
rail.
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. If equipped with heat shield (3), remove the top nut (2) that secures the heat shield to the stud
(1) located on the dash panel.
NOTE: Two slots are provided at the bottom of the heat shield to aid in heat shield removal, if
equipped. Complete removal of the two bottom
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7292
heat shield retaining nuts is not required.
11. If equipped, reach behind the engine and remove the two bottom nuts the that secure the heat
shield to the studs located on the dash panel and
remove the heat shield. Rotate and tilt the heat shield as required.
NOTE: It is only necessary to position the engine coolant reservoir and the power steering fluid
reservoir out of the way. Draining of the
coolant and power steering fluid is not required.
12. Remove the engine coolant reservoir from the right side of the engine compartment and
position it out of the way See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery Bottle Removal.
13. Remove the power steering fluid reservoir from the right front strut tower and position it out of
the way See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal.
14. If equipped with ABS, remove the ABS control module and pump assembly and position the
brake lines out of the way as necessary See: Brakes
and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Installation.
15. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on the
A/C liquid line and remove the transducer if required
See: Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch/Service and Repair/Front A/C Pressure Transducer Removal.
16. If equipped with rear A/C, disconnect the rear A/C extension lines from the fittings (3) located
on the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See:
A/C Underbody Lines - Removal.
17. Remove the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on
the right front strut tower. 18. Remove the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly (1) to the A/C expansion valve (4). 19. Disconnect the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly from the A/C expansion valve and remove and discard the O-ring seals. 20. Remove the
A/C liquid and suction line assembly from the engine compartment. 21. Install plugs in, or tape over
all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve and receiver/drier ports.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7293
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Liquid Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve
and receiver/drier ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-rings with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the liquid and suction line fittings. Use only the
specified O-ring seals as they are made of special materials compatible to the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (1) into the engine compartment. 4. Connect
the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve (4).
CAUTION: Use care when installing the A/C lines to the A/C expansion valve. Carefully align the
tube ends with the valve prior to tightening
the A/C line retaining nut or damage to the sealing rings and tube ends may occur.
5. Install the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion
valve. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line
retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on the right front strut tower. Tighten the nut securely. 7. If
equipped with rear A/C, connect the rear A/C extension lines to the fittings (3) located on the A/C
liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C
Underbody Lines - Installation.
8. If removed, lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the
fitting for the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on
the A/C liquid line and install the pressure transducer. Tighten the A/C pressure transducer to 5.6
Nm (50 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7294
9. Connect the wire harness connector to the A/C pressure transducer.
10. If equipped with ABS, install the ABS control module and pump assembly See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation.
11. Install the power steering fluid reservoir See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power
Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation.
12. Install the engine coolant reservoir See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Installation.
13. If equipped, position the heat shield (3) onto the three studs (1) located on the dash panel in
the engine compartment and install the three retaining
nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
14. Raise and support the vehicle. 15. Install the bolt (3) that secures the upper portion of the A/C
suction line (2) to the right front frame rail. Tighten the bolt securely 16. Install the lower portion of
the A/C suction line to the upper suction line See: A/C Suction Line - Installation. 17. Connect the
rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). 18. Install the nut (5) that secures
the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15
ft. lbs.). 19. Reposition the right front wheel house splash shield to the body See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Installation.
20. Lower the vehicle. 21. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 22. If equipped with ABS, bleed
the brake system See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Installation.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7295
23. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 24.
Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 25. Charge the A/C
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7296
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair
A/C Discharge Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Remove the nut (5) that secures
the A/C discharge line (1) to the condenser tapping block (2) located on the right side of the
condenser. 4. Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the tapping block.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
5. Remove the nut (3) that secures the A/C discharge line (1) to the A/C compressor (2). 6.
Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the A/C compressor and remove the discharge line from
the engine compartment. 7. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and gaskets and install plugs in,
or tape over the opened discharge line fittings and the compressor and
condenser ports.
A/C Discharge Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7297
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened discharge line fittings and the compressor and
condenser ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the discharge line fittings. Use only the
specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C discharge line (1) into the engine compartment and connect it to the A/C
compressor (2). 4. Install the nut (3) that secures the A/C discharge line to the A/C compressor.
Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect the A/C discharge line (1) to the condenser tapping block (2). 6. Install the nut (5) that
secures the A/C discharge line to the tapping block. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 7.
Reconnect the negative battery cable.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
8. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 9.
Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level.
10. Charge the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7298
A/C Liquid Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Review safety precautions and warnings before performing this procedure See:
Service Precautions/Warning and See: Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible serious or
fatal injury.
NOTE: The rear A/C liquid line is only serviced as an assembly with the upper A/C suction line.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Raise and support the vehicle. 4.
Position the front portion of the right front wheelhouse splash shield out of the way to gain access
to the A/C receiver/drier See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
5. Remove the nut (5) that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C
receiver/drier (4). 6. Disconnect the rear section of the A/C liquid line from the A/C receiver/drier
and remove and discard the O-ring seal and gasket. 7. Disconnect the lower portion of the A/C
suction line from the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C Suction Line - Removal. 8.
Remove the bolt (3) that secures the rear section of the A/C suction line (2) to the right front frame
rail.
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. If equipped with heat shield (3), remove the top nut (2) that secures the heat shield to the stud
(1) located on the dash panel.
NOTE: Two slots are provided at the bottom of the heat shield to aid in heat shield removal, if
equipped. Complete removal of the two bottom
heat shield retaining nuts is not required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7299
11. If equipped, reach behind the engine and remove the two bottom nuts the that secure the heat
shield to the studs located on the dash panel and
remove the heat shield. Rotate and tilt the heat shield as required.
NOTE: It is only necessary to position the engine coolant reservoir and the power steering fluid
reservoir out of the way. Draining of the
coolant and power steering fluid is not required.
12. Remove the engine coolant reservoir from the right side of the engine compartment and
position it out of the way See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery Bottle Removal.
13. Remove the power steering fluid reservoir from the right front strut tower and position it out of
the way See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal.
14. If equipped with ABS, remove the ABS control module and pump assembly and position the
brake lines out of the way as necessary See: Brakes
and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Installation.
15. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on the
A/C liquid line and remove the transducer if required
See: Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch/Service and Repair/Front A/C Pressure Transducer Removal.
16. If equipped with rear A/C, disconnect the rear A/C extension lines from the fittings (3) located
on the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See:
A/C Underbody Lines - Removal.
17. Remove the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on
the right front strut tower. 18. Remove the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly (1) to the A/C expansion valve (4). 19. Disconnect the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly from the A/C expansion valve and remove and discard the O-ring seals. 20. Remove the
A/C liquid and suction line assembly from the engine compartment. 21. Install plugs in, or tape over
all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve and receiver/drier ports.
A/C Liquid Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7300
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the tape or plugs from all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve
and receiver/drier ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-rings with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the liquid and suction line fittings. Use only the
specified O-ring seals as they are made of special materials compatible to the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (1) into the engine compartment. 4. Connect
the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve (4).
CAUTION: Use care when installing the A/C lines to the A/C expansion valve. Carefully align the
tube ends with the valve prior to tightening
the A/C line retaining nut or damage to the sealing rings and tube ends may occur.
5. Install the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion
valve. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line
retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on the right front strut tower. Tighten the nut securely. 7. If
equipped with rear A/C, connect the rear A/C extension lines to the fittings (3) located on the A/C
liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C
Underbody Lines - Installation.
8. If removed, lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the
fitting for the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on
the A/C liquid line and install the pressure transducer. Tighten the A/C pressure transducer to 5.6
Nm (50 in. lbs.).
9. Connect the wire harness connector to the A/C pressure transducer.
10. If equipped with ABS, install the ABS control module and pump assembly See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation.
11. Install the power steering fluid reservoir See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power
Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation.
12. Install the engine coolant reservoir See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7301
13. If equipped, position the heat shield (3) onto the three studs (1) located on the dash panel in
the engine compartment and install the three retaining
nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
14. Raise and support the vehicle. 15. Install the bolt (3) that secures the upper portion of the A/C
suction line (2) to the right front frame rail. Tighten the bolt securely 16. Install the lower portion of
the A/C suction line to the upper suction line See: A/C Suction Line - Installation. 17. Connect the
rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). 18. Install the nut (5) that secures
the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15
ft. lbs.). 19. Reposition the right front wheel house splash shield to the body See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Installation.
20. Lower the vehicle. 21. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 22. If equipped with ABS, bleed
the brake system See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Installation.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
23. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 24.
Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 25. Charge the A/C
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
A/C Suction Line - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Review safety precautions and warnings before performing this procedure See:
Service Precautions/Warning and See: Service
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7302
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible serious or
fatal injury.
NOTE: The A/C suction line is serviced in two sections.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
Upper A/C Suction Line
NOTE: The upper portion of the A/C suction line is only serviced as an assembly with the rear A/C
liquid line.
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Raise and support the vehicle. 4.
Position the front portion of the right front wheelhouse splash shield out of the way to gain access
to the A/C receiver/drier See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
5. Remove the nut (5) that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C
receiver/drier (4). 6. Disconnect the rear section of the A/C liquid line from the A/C receiver/drier
and remove and discard the O-ring seal and gasket. 7. Disconnect the lower portion of the A/C
suction line from the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C Suction Line - Removal. 8.
Remove the bolt (3) that secures the rear section of the A/C suction line (2) to the right front frame
rail.
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. If equipped with heat shield (3), remove the top nut (2) that secures the heat shield to the stud
(1) located on the dash panel.
NOTE: Two slots are provided at the bottom of the heat shield to aid in heat shield removal, if
equipped. Complete removal of the two bottom
heat shield retaining nuts is not required.
11. If equipped, reach behind the engine and remove the two bottom nuts the that secure the heat
shield to the studs located on the dash panel and
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7303
remove the heat shield. Rotate and tilt the heat shield as required.
NOTE: It is only necessary to position the engine coolant reservoir and the power steering fluid
reservoir out of the way. Draining of the
coolant and power steering fluid is not required.
12. Remove the engine coolant reservoir from the right side of the engine compartment and
position it out of the way See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery Bottle Removal.
13. Remove the power steering fluid reservoir from the right front strut tower and position it out of
the way See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Removal.
14. If equipped with ABS, remove the ABS control module and pump assembly and position the
brake lines out of the way as necessary See: Brakes
and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) Installation.
15. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on the
A/C liquid line and remove the transducer if required
See: Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch/Service and Repair/Front A/C Pressure Transducer Removal.
16. If equipped with rear A/C, disconnect the rear A/C extension lines from the fittings (3) located
on the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See:
A/C Underbody Lines - Removal.
17. Remove the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on
the right front strut tower. 18. Remove the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly (1) to the A/C expansion valve (4). 19. Disconnect the A/C liquid and suction line
assembly from the A/C expansion valve and remove and discard the O-ring seals. 20. Remove the
A/C liquid and suction line assembly from the engine compartment. 21. Install plugs in, or tape over
all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve and receiver/drier ports.
Lower A/C Suction Line
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7304
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Raise and support the vehicle. 4.
Position the front portion of the right front wheelhouse splash shield out of the way to gain access
to the A/C receiver/drier See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
5. Remove the nut (2) that secures the lower A/C suction line (3) to the upper A/C suction line (1).
6. Disconnect the lower A/C suction line to the upper A/C suction line and remove and discard the
O-ring seal and gasket.
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
7. Remove the nut (2) that secures the lower A/C suction line (1) to the A/C compressor (3). 8.
Disconnect the lower A/C suction line from the A/C compressor and remove the lower line from the
engine compartment. 9. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and gaskets and install plugs in, or
tape over all the opened suction line fittings and the compressor port.
A/C Suction Line - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7305
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
Upper A/C Suction Line
1. Remove the tape or plugs from all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve
and receiver/drier ports. 2. Lubricate new rubber O-rings with clean refrigerant oil and install them
and new gaskets onto the liquid and suction line fittings. Use only the
specified O-ring seals as they are made of special materials compatible to the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (1) into the engine compartment. 4. Connect
the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve (4).
CAUTION: Use care when installing the A/C lines to the A/C expansion valve. Carefully align the
tube ends with the valve prior to tightening
the A/C line retaining nut or damage to the sealing rings and tube ends may occur.
5. Install the nut (5) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion
valve. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the nut (6) that secures the refrigerant line
retaining bracket to the stud (2) located on the right front strut tower. Tighten the nut securely. 7. If
equipped with rear A/C, connect the rear A/C extension lines to the fittings (3) located on the A/C
liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C
Underbody Lines - Installation.
8. If removed, lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the
fitting for the A/C pressure transducer (7) located on
the A/C liquid line and install the pressure transducer. Tighten the A/C pressure transducer to 5.6
Nm (50 in. lbs.).
9. Connect the wire harness connector to the A/C pressure transducer.
10. If equipped with ABS, install the ABS control module and pump assembly See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Integrated Control Unit (ICU) - Installation.
11. Install the power steering fluid reservoir See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Power
Steering/Power Steering Fluid Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Reservoir, Power Steering Pump - Installation.
12. Install the engine coolant reservoir See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Coolant
Reservoir/Service and Repair/Coolant Recovery
Bottle - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7306
13. If equipped, position the heat shield (3) onto the three studs (1) located on the dash panel in
the engine compartment and install the three retaining
nuts (2). Tighten the nuts to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
14. Raise and support the vehicle. 15. Install the bolt (3) that secures the upper portion of the A/C
suction line (2) to the right front frame rail. Tighten the bolt securely 16. Connect the lower portion
of the A/C suction line to the A/C liquid and suction line assembly See: A/C Suction Line Installation. 17. Connect the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4). 18.
Install the nut (5) that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C receiver/drier (4).
Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 19. Reposition the right front wheel house splash shield to the
body See: Body and Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
20. Lower the vehicle. 21. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 22. If equipped with ABS, bleed
the brake system See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Integrated Control Unit
(ICU) - Installation.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
23. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 24.
Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 25. Charge the A/C
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Lower A/C Suction Line
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7307
NOTE: 2.7L shown. Other engines similar.
1. Position the lower A/C suction line (1) into the engine compartment. 2. Remove the tape or plugs
from the suction line fittings and the compressor port. 3. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with
clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the suction line fittings. Use only the
specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
4. Connect the lower A/C suction line to the A/C compressor (3). 5. Install the nut (2) that secures
the lower A/C suction line to the A/C compressor. Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
6. Connect the lower portion of the A/C suction line (3) to the upper suction line (1) 7. Install the nut
(2) that secures the lower portion of the A/C suction line to the upper suction line. Tighten the nut to
20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 8. Reposition the right front wheel house splash shield to the body See: Body
and Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Installation.
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
11. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 12.
Adjust the refrigerant oil level See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 13. Charge the A/C
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
A/C Underbody Lines - Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7308
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: To prevent any contaminates from entering the rear heating-A/C system, make sure that
the area around the underbody line
connections is clean of any dirt or foreign residue prior to disconnecting the lines.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Drain the engine cooling system
See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 4. Raise and support the
vehicle. 5. Remove the rear section of the exhaust system See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Exhaust System/Exhaust Pipe/Service and Repair/Exhaust Pipe Removal.
6. Remove the exhaust heat shields as necessary to gain access to the underbody lines See:
Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Exhaust System/Heat
Shield/Description and Operation/Description.
NOTE: Replacement of the front heater hoses will be required if the hose ends are cut for removal.
7. Release the spring type hose clamps (2) and disconnect the front heater hoses (1) from the
underbody heater lines (4). 8. Loosen the fitting nuts (6) that secure the underbody refrigerant lines
(5) to the front A/C liquid and suction lines (7). 9. Disconnect the front A/C liquid and suction lines
from the underbody refrigerant lines and remove and discard the O-ring seals.
10. Disengage the front A/C liquid and suction lines from the front underbody refrigerant line
bracket (3).
11. Remove the two nuts (3) and one screw (1) that secure the underbody line shield (2) to the
vehicle underbody and remove the shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7309
CAUTION: DO NOT apply excessive force on underbody heater lines or rear heater tubes when
disconnecting the connections. Excessive force
may damage or deform the tubes and or lines, causing an engine coolant leak.
NOTE: Replacement of the rubber heater hose ends will be required if the rubber hoses are cut for
removal.
12. Release the spring type hose clamps (4) and disconnect the underbody heater lines (5) from
the rear heater core tubes located behind the right rear
wheel housing.
13. Lower the underbody heater lines and drain any residual coolant from the lines into a suitable
container. 14. Loosen the fitting nuts (1) that secure the underbody refrigerant lines (7) to the
underbody refrigerant extension lines and sealing plate (2 and 6). 15. Disconnect the underbody
refrigerant lines from underbody refrigerant extension lines and remove and discard the O-ring
seals. 16. Remove the nut (3) that secures the underbody refrigerant extension lines and sealing
plate to the rear A/C expansion valve. 17. Disconnect the extension lines and sealing plate from the
rear A/C expansion valve and remove and discard the O-ring seals.
18. Disconnect the rear ABS wire harness lead and bracket (4) from the right side of the body (3) to
gain clearance to partially lower the right side of
the rear cradle.
NOTE: It is not necessary to disconnect the brake line to remove it from the brackets.
19. Remove the two bolts (6) that secure the right rear brake line (1) to the two brackets (2 and 5)
and remove the brake line from the brackets to gain
clearance to partially lower the right side of the rear cradle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7310
NOTE: Illustration shown with rear body cradle removed for clarity.
20. Remove the lower right rear shock retaining bolt See: Steering and
Suspension/Suspension/Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear Shock Absorber/Rear Shock Absorber, Coil-Over Removal.
WARNING: Be sure to properly support the rear cradle before removing the right side retaining
bolts. Failure to follow this warning may
result in serious or fatal injury.
21. Support the right side of the rear cradle with a suitable jack stand and remove the bolts that
secure the right side of the cradle to the body See:
Body and Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service and Repair/Crossmember - Removal.
CAUTION: Use care not to damage the ABS wire lead or the brake line when lowering the rear
cradle for clearance.
22. Carefully lower the jack stand until the right side of the rear cradle (supported by the stand) is
approximately 76-101 mm (3-4 in.) below the body.
This will allow access to remove the underbody line assembly.
23. Remove the nut (5) that secures the underbody line bracket (4) to the stud located near the
center of the underbody (6). 24. Disengage the remainder of the underbody line brackets (1, 2, and
7) from the studs located underneath the vehicle. 25. Rotate and tilt the underbody lines (3) as
necessary and remove the lines from the vehicle. 26. Install plugs in, or tape over all the opened
refrigerant line fittings and the rear expansion valve ports.
27. If required, place the extension lines and sealing plate (1) on a workbench, remove the nylon
retaining clip (4) that secures the suction extension
line (3) to the sealing plate and remove the suction line from the sealing plate.
A/C Underbody Lines - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7311
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime an underbody
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals may result in a refrigerant system leak.
1. If removed, install the suction extension line (3) into the sealing plate (1) and install the nylon
retaining clip (4).
NOTE: Illustration shown with rear body cradle removed for clarity.
2. Position the underbody lines (3) and engage the underbody line brackets (1, 2, and 7) to the
mounting studs located on the underbody (6). Rotate
and tilt the underbody lines as necessary. Make sure the brackets are fully engaged to the studs.
3. Position the underbody line bracket (4) onto the mounting stud located near the center of the
underbody and install the retaining nut (5). Tighten
the nut securely.
CAUTION: Use care not to damage the ABS wire lead or the brake line when repositioning the rear
cradle.
4. Carefully raise the jack stand until the right side of the rear cradle is positioned to the body.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7312
WARNING: Be sure to properly support the rear cradle when installing the right side retaining bolts.
Failure to follow this warning may result
in serious or fatal injury.
5. Install the bolts that secure the right side of the cradle to the body and remove the jack stand
See: Body and Frame/Frame/Cross-Member/Service
and Repair/Crossmember - Installation.
6. Install the lower right rear shock retaining bolt See: Steering and
Suspension/Suspension/Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Rear Shock Absorber/Rear Shock Absorber, Coil-Over Installation.
7. Connect the rear ABS wire harness lead and bracket (4) to the right side of the body (3). 8.
Position the right rear brake line (1) onto the two brackets (2 and 5) and install the two retaining
bolts (6). Tighten the bolts securely.
CAUTION: DO NOT apply excessive force on underbody heater lines or rear heater tubes fittings
when connecting the connections. Excessive
force may damage or deform the tubes and or lines, causing an engine coolant leak.
NOTE: Replacement of the rubber heater hose ends will be required if the rubber hoses were cut
for removal.
9. Remove the tape or plugs from all the opened refrigerant line fittings and the rear expansion
valve ports.
10. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the underbody
refrigerant extension line fittings. Use only the
specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
11. Connect the underbody refrigerant extension lines and sealing plate (2 and 6) to the rear A/C
expansion valve. 12. Loosely install the nut (3) that secures the extension lines and sealing plate to
the rear A/C expansion valve. 13. Connect the underbody refrigerant lines (7) to the underbody
refrigerant extension lines and tighten the fitting nuts (1) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 14. Tighten the nut
that secures the extension lines and sealing plate to the rear A/C expansion valve to 11 Nm (97 in.
lbs.). 15. Connect the underbody heater lines (5) to the rear heater core tubes located behind the
right rear wheel housing and engage the spring type hose
clamps (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7313
16. Position the underbody line shield (2) to the vehicle underbody and install the two nuts (3) and
one screw (1). Tighten the fasteners securely.
17. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the underbody
refrigerant line fittings. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
18. Connect the front A/C liquid and suction lines (7) to the underbody refrigerant lines (5). Tighten
the fitting nuts (6) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 19. Position the front A/C liquid and suction lines into the
front underbody refrigerant line bracket (3) and engage the bracket retainer.
NOTE: Replacement of the front heater hoses will be required if the hose ends were cut for
removal.
20. Connect the front heater hoses (1) to the underbody heater lines (4) and engage the spring
type hose clamps (2). 21. Install the exhaust heat shields as necessary. 22. Install the rear section
of the exhaust system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Exhaust System/Exhaust Pipe/Service
and Repair/Exhaust Pipe Installation.
23. Lower the vehicle. 24. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 25. Fill the engine cooling system
See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 26. Evacuate the
refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 27. Adjust the refrigerant
oil level See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 28. Charge the refrigerant system See:
Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
A/C Underbody Extension Lines - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: To prevent any contaminates from entering the rear heating-A/C system, make sure that
the area around the underbody line
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7314
connections is clean of any dirt or foreign residue prior to disconnecting the lines.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Raise and support the vehicle. 4.
Disengage the underbody A/C extension lines (4) from the front underbody refrigerant line bracket
(1). 5. Loosen the fitting nuts (3) that secure the underbody A/C extension lines to the underbody
A/C liquid and suction lines (2). 6. Disconnect the underbody A/C extension lines from the
underbody A/C liquid and suction lines and remove and discard the O-ring seals. 7. Install plugs in,
or tape over the opened refrigerant line fittings.
8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Loosen the fitting nuts (3) that secure the underbody A/C extension lines
(2) to the front A/C liquid and suction lines (1).
10. Disconnect the underbody A/C extension lines from the front A/C liquid and suction lines and
remove and discard the O-ring seals. 11. Rotate and tilt the underbody A/C extension lines as
necessary and remove the lines from the vehicle. 12. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened
refrigerant line fittings.
A/C Underbody Extension Lines - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime an underbody
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals may result in a refrigerant system leak.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Line - Removal > Page 7315
1. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened refrigerant extension line fittings. 2. Lubricate new
rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the refrigerant line fittings. Use
only the specified O-rings as
they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
3. Position the underbody A/C extension lines (2) into the engine compartment. Rotate and tilt the
underbody A/C extension lines as necessary. 4. Connect the underbody A/C extension lines to the
front A/C liquid and suction lines (1). Tighten the fitting nuts (3) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
5. Raise and support the vehicle. 6. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened underbody
refrigerant line fittings. 7. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install
them onto the refrigerant line fittings. Use only the specified O-rings as
they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
8. Connect the underbody A/C extension lines (4) to the underbody A/C liquid and suction lines (2).
Tighten the fitting nuts (3) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 9. Position the underbody A/C extension lines into
the front underbody refrigerant line bracket (1) and engage the bracket retainer.
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 12. Evacuate the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 13. Adjust the refrigerant oil level
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. 14. Charge the refrigerant system See: Service and
Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front
Housing Assembly HVAC: Description and Operation Front
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: LHD model shown.
All models are equipped with a common HVAC housing assembly that combines A/C and heating
capabilities into a single unit mounted within the passenger compartment. The HVAC housing
assembly consists of three separate housings:
- HVAC housing - The HVAC housing (1) is mounted to the dash panel behind the instrument panel
and contains the A/C evaporator. The HVAC housing consists of an upper and a lower housing that
are attached together and has mounting provisions for the air inlet housing, blower motor and the
air distribution housing.
- Air distribution housing - The air distribution housing (2) is mounted to the rear of the HVAC
housing and contains the heater core, blend-air and mode-air doors and door linkage.
- Air inlet housing - The air inlet housing (3) is mounted to the passenger side end of the HVAC
housing and contains the recirculation-air door and actuator.
The heating-A/C system is a blend-air type system. The blend-air door controls the amount of
conditioned air that is allowed to flow through, or around the heater core.
The A/C system is designed for the use of a non-CFC, R-134a refrigerant and uses an A/C
evaporator to cool and dehumidify the incoming air prior to blending it with the heated air. A
temperature control determines the discharge air temperature by operating the electric blend door
actuator, which moves the blend-air door. This allows an almost immediate control of the output air
temperature of the system. The electric mode door actuator operates the mode-air door. The
electric recirculation door actuator operates the recirculation-air door which closes off the fresh air
intake into the HVAC housing and recirculates the air already inside the vehicle. The blower motor
controls the velocity of air flowing through the HVAC housing assembly by spinning the blower
wheel within the HVAC housing at the selected speed by use of the blower motor resistor or power
module (depending on application), which is located on the bottom of the HVAC housing. The
actuators, resistor or power module and the blower motor are connected to the vehicle electrical
system by the instrument panel wire harness.
The air distribution housing must be removed from the HVAC housing and disassembled for
service of the blend-air and mode-air doors. The air inlet housing must be removed from HVAC
housing and disassembled for service of the recirculation-air door. The HVAC housing must be
removed from the vehicle and disassembled for service of the A/C evaporator.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front > Page 7320
Housing Assembly HVAC: Description and Operation Rear
DESCRIPTION
Models with the rear heating-A/C system use a rear heater-A/C housing (1) that combines A/C and
heating capabilities into a single unit mounted within the rear passenger compartment. The rear
heating-A/C system is a blend-air type system. A blend-air door controls the amount of conditioned
air that is allowed to flow through, or around, the heater core (9). The rear A/C system is designed
for the use of a non-CFC, R-134a refrigerant and uses an A/C expansion valve (7) and A/C
evaporator (6) to cool and dehumidify the incoming air prior to blending it with the heated air. A
temperature control determines the discharge air temperature by operating the blend door actuator
(3), which moves the blend-air door. This allows an almost immediate control of the output air
temperature of the rear system. The mode control operates the mode door actuator (2) that
positions the mode-air door to direct the flow of the conditioned air out the upper or lower air
outlets, depending on the position selected. Both electric door actuators are connected to the
vehicle electrical system by the rear heater-A/C wire harness (8). The rear blower motor (4)
controls the velocity of air flowing through the rear heater-A/C housing by spinning the blower
wheel within the rear housing at the selected speed by use of the rear blower motor resistor or
power module (5) (depending on manual or automatic control).
The rear heater-A/C housing must be removed from the vehicle for service of the mode door
actuator and blend door actuator and it must be disassembled for service of the A/C evaporator
and the heater core.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Housing Assembly HVAC: Removal and Replacement
Front Air Distribution Housing Removal
HOUSING-AIR DISTRIBUTION
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The air distribution housing must be removed from the HVAC housing and disassembled for
service of the blend-air and mode-air
doors.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the HVAC housing assembly and place it on a workbench . 2. Remove the floor
distribution ducts from the HVAC housing assembly See: Air Duct/Service and Repair/Floor
Distribution Duct - Removal.
NOTE: If the foam seal for the flange is deformed or damaged, it must be replaced.
3. Remove the foam seal (1) from the flange (2) located on the front of the HVAC housing (5). 4.
Remove the screw (6) that secures the flange to the HVAC housing and remove the flange. 5. On
RHD models, remove the air distribution housing (3) from the HVAC housing 6. Carefully pull the
heater core (4) out of the air distribution housing.
7. Remove the two metal retaining clips (3) that secure the bottom of air distribution housing (2) to
the HVAC housing (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7323
8. Remove the seven screws (1) that secure the air distribution housing to the rear of the HVAC
housing. 9. Remove the air distribution housing from the rear of the HVAC housing.
10. If required, disassemble the air distribution housing See: Overhaul/Disassembly.
Front Air Distribution Housing Installation
HOUSING-AIR DISTRIBUTION
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Position the air distribution housing (2) onto the rear of the HVAC housing (4). 2. Install the two
metal retaining clips (3) that secure the bottom of the air distribution housing to the HVAC housing.
3. Install the seven screws (1) that secure the air distribution housing to the HVAC housing. Tighten
the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Carefully install the heater core (4) into the side of the air distribution housing (3). 5. On RHD
models, install the air distribution housing onto the HVAC housing (5) . 6. Install the flange (2) that
secures the heater core tubes to the front of the HVAC housing. 7. Install the screw (6) that
secures the flange to the HVAC housing. Tighten the screw to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
NOTE: If the foam seal for the flange is deformed or damaged, it must be replaced.
8. Install the foam seal (1) onto the flange. 9. Install all of the floor distribution ducts onto the air
distribution housing See: Air Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution Duct - Installation.
NOTE: If the heater core is being replaced, flush the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair .
10. Install the HVAC housing assembly .
Front Air Inlet Housing Removal
HOUSING-AIR INLET
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7324
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The air inlet housing must be removed from HVAC housing and disassembled for service of
the recirculation-air door.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Remove the HVAC housing assembly and place it on a workbench . 2. If equipped, remove the
particulate air filter See: Cabin Air Filter/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Particulate
Air Filter - Removal. 3. Remove the four screws (1) that secure the air inlet housing (2) to the top of
the HVAC housing (3). 4. Disengage the two plastic retaining tabs (4) that secure the air inlet
housing to the HVAC housing and remove the inlet housing from the HVAC
housing.
5. If required, disassemble the air inlet housing See: Overhaul/Disassembly.
Front Air Inlet Housing Installation
HOUSING-AIR INLET
NOTE: LHD model shown. RHD model similar.
1. Install the air inlet housing (2) onto the top of the HVAC housing (3) and engage the two plastic
retaining tabs (4). Make sure the retaining tabs are
fully engaged.
2. Install the four screws (1) that secure the air inlet housing to the HVAC housing. Tighten the
screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. If equipped, install the particulate air filter See: Cabin Air
Filter/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Particulate Air Filter - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7325
4. Install the HVAC housing assembly .
Front Air Inlet Screen Removal
SCREEN-AIR INLET
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Remove the cowl grille screen See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and
Repair. 2. Disengage the three push-in retainers (1) that secure the HVAC housing air inlet screen
(2) to the cowl panel (3) and remove the screen.
Front Air Inlet Screen Installation
SCREEN-AIR INLET
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Position the HVAC housing air inlet screen (2) to the cowl panel (3) and fully engage the three
push-in retainers (1) that secure the screen to the
panel.
2. Install the cowl grille screen See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and
Repair.
Front HVAC Housing Removal
HOUSING-HVAC
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7326
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The HVAC housing must be removed from the vehicle and disassembled for service of the
heater core, A/C evaporator, air intake
housing and the mode-air and blend-air doors.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Partially drain the engine cooling
system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 4. If equipped with
heat shield (3), remove the top nut (2) that secures the heat shield to the stud (1) located on the
dash panel.
NOTE: Two slots are provided at the bottom of the heat shield to aid in heat shield removal, if
equipped. Complete removal of the two bottom
heat shield retaining nuts is not required.
5. If equipped, reach behind the engine and remove the two bottom nuts the that secure the heat
shield to the studs located on the dash panel and
remove the heat shield. Rotate and tilt the heat shield as required.
6. Remove the nut (1) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (2) to the A/C
expansion valve (3). 7. Disconnect the A/C liquid and suction line assembly from the A/C
evaporator and remove and discard the dual-plane seals. 8. Install plugs in, or tape over the
opened refrigerant line fittings and the evaporator ports. 9. Disconnect the heater hoses (4) from
the heater core tubes. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened heater core tubes to prevent coolant
spillage
during housing removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7327
NOTE: Make sure to remove the five bolts that secure the HVAC housing to the instrument panel
support prior to removing the instrument
panel from the vehicle.
10. Remove the instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Removal.
11. Remove the rear floor ducts See: Air Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution Duct Removal. 12. Remove the condensation drain tube. 13. Remove the nut (1) that secures the
passenger side of the HVAC housing (2) to the dash panel (3).
NOTE: Use care to ensure that the interior is covered in case of loss of residual fluids from the
heater and evaporator cores.
14. Pull the HVAC housing rearward and remove the HVAC housing assembly from the passenger
compartment.
15. If required, remove the HVAC housing air inlet duct (2) from the passenger compartment side
of the dash panel (1).
Front HVAC Housing Installation
HOUSING-HVAC
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7328
1. If removed, install the HVAC housing air inlet duct (2) onto the passenger compartment side of
the dash panel (1). Make sure the foam seal is not
missing or damaged and that the retaining tabs are fully engage to the dash panel.
2. Position the HVAC housing assembly (2) to the dash panel (3). Be certain that the passenger
side of the HVAC housing is correctly located over
the dash panel mounting stud.
3. Install the nut (1) that secures the HVAC housing to the passenger compartment side of dash
panel. Tighten the nut to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.). 4. Install the condensation drain tube. 5. Install the
rear floor ducts See: Air Duct/Service and Repair/Floor Distribution Duct - Installation. 6. Install the
instrument panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Installation.
7. Remove the previously installed plugs or caps and connect the heater hoses (4) to the heater
core tubes. 8. Remove the tape or plugs from the refrigerant line fittings and the expansion valve
ports. 9. Lubricate the rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the liquid
and suction line fittings. Use only the specified O-ring
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7329
seals as they are made of special materials compatible to the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant
oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
10. Connect the A/C liquid and suction line assembly (2) to the A/C expansion valve (3). 11. Install
the nut (1) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve.
Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
12. If equipped, position the heat shield (3) onto the studs (1) located on the dash panel in the
engine compartment and install the retaining nuts (2).
Tighten the nuts to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
13. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 14. If the heater core is being replaced, flush the cooling
system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair. 15. Refill the
engine cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
16. Evacuate and charge the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System
Charge. 17. Initiate the Actuator Calibration function using a scan tool See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Rear HVAC Housing Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The rear heater-A/C housing must be removed from the vehicle for service of the mode
door actuator and blend door actuator and it
must be disassembled for service of the A/C evaporator and the heater core.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7330
3. Drain the engine cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and
Repair. 4. Raise and support the vehicle.
CAUTION: DO NOT apply excessive force on underbody heater lines or rear heater tubes when
disconnecting the connections. Excessive force
may damage or deform the tubes and or lines, causing an engine coolant leak.
NOTE: Replacement of the rubber heater hose ends will be required if the rubber hoses are cut for
removal.
5. Release the spring type hose clamps (4) and disconnect the underbody heater lines (5) from the
rear heater core tubes located behind the right rear
wheel housing.
6. Lower the underbody heater lines and drain any residual coolant from the lines into a suitable
container. 7. Loosen the fitting nuts (1) that secure the underbody refrigerant lines (7) to the
underbody refrigerant extension lines and sealing plate (2 and 6). 8. Disconnect the underbody
refrigerant lines from underbody refrigerant extension lines and remove and discard the O-ring
seals. 9. Remove the nut (3) that secures the underbody refrigerant extension lines and sealing
plate to the rear A/C expansion valve.
10. Disconnect the extension lines and sealing plate from the rear A/C expansion valve and
remove and discard the O-ring seals. 11. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened underbody
refrigerant line fittings and rear expansion valve ports.
12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Remove the right D-pillar trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/D-Pillar
Trim/Removal.
14. Remove right quarter trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
15. Remove the two bolts (2) that secure the upper seat belt bracket (1) to the right D-pillar (3) and
remove the bracket. 16. Remove the two bolts (4) that secure the right seat belt retractor (5) to the
right D-pillar and remove the retractor.
17. Remove the two retainers (4 and 5) that secure the rear ceiling distribution duct (3) to the right
D-pillar (2). 18. Lift the rear ceiling distribution duct upward and disengage it from the rear
heater-A/C housing (1).
CAUTION: Use care when removing the rear ceiling distribution duct from the heater-A/C housing
to prevent damage to the molded plastic
support brace located on the top of the housing outlet. Failure to follow this caution could result in
part of, or all of the support
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7331
brace falling into the rear housing, which may interfere with rear mode door operation.
19. Pull the bottom end of the rear ceiling distribution duct away from the rear heater-A/C housing
and remove the duct.
20. Remove the push-pin retainer (2) that secures the rear floor distribution duct (1) to the right
inner quarter panel (3). 21. Disengage the rear floor distribution duct from the stud (5) located on
the right inner quarter panel. 22. Disengage the rear floor distribution duct from the rear heater-A/C
housing (4) and remove the duct.
NOTE: MTC rear heater-A/C system shown. ATC system similar.
23. Disconnect the body wire harness connectors (8 and 9) from the rear blower motor (2) and the
rear blower motor resistor or power module (3)
(depending on control system).
24. Disconnect the body wire harness connector (6) from the rear heater-A/C wire harness
connector (5). 25. Remove the two bolts (4 and 10) that secure the rear heater-A/C housing (1) to
the right inner quarter panel (7) and remove the housing.
Rear HVAC Housing Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7332
NOTE: MTC rear heater-A/C system shown. ATC system similar.
1. Position the rear heater-A/C housing (1) into the vehicle and align the guide pins on the housing
to the holes in the right inner quarter panel (7). 2. Install the two bolts (4 and 10) that secure the
rear heater-A/C housing to the right inner quarter panel. Tighten the bolts to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.). 3.
Connect the body wire harness connector (6) to the rear heater-A/C wire harness connector (5). 4.
Connect the body wire harness connectors (8 and 9) to the rear blower motor (2) and the rear
blower motor resistor or power module (3)
(depending on control system).
5. Install the rear floor distribution duct (1) onto rear heater-A/C housing (4). Make sure the duct is
fully engaged to the housing. 6. Engage the rear floor distribution duct to the stud (5) located on the
right inner quarter panel (3). 7. Install the push-pin retainer (2) that secures the rear floor
distribution duct to the right inner quarter panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7333
8. Position the rear ceiling distribution duct (3) to the right D-pillar (2).
CAUTION: Use care when installing the rear ceiling distribution duct onto the heater-A/C housing to
prevent damage to the molded plastic
support brace located on the top of the housing outlet. Failure to follow this caution could result in
part of, or all of the support brace falling into the rear housing, which may interfere with rear mode
door operation.
9. Install the rear ceiling distribution duct onto the top of the rear heater-A/C housing (1). Make sure
the duct is fully engaged to the housing.
10. Install the two retainers (4 and 5) that secure the rear ceiling distribution duct to the right
D-pillar.
11. Position the upper seat belt bracket (2) onto the D-pillar (3) and install the two retaining bolts
(1). Tighten the bolts to 52 Nm (38.5 ft. lbs.). 12. Install the right seat belt retractor (5) and retaining
bolts (4) onto the D-pillar. Tighten the bolts to 52 Nm (38.5 ft. lbs.). 13. Install the right quarter trim
panel, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
14. Install the right D-pillar trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/D-Pillar
Trim/Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7334
15. Raise and support the vehicle.
CAUTION: DO NOT apply excessive force on underbody heater lines or rear heater tubes fittings
when connecting the connections. Excessive
force may damage or deform the tubes and or lines, causing an engine coolant leak.
NOTE: Replacement of the rubber heater hose ends will be required if the rubber hoses were cut
for removal.
16. Remove the tape or plugs from all the opened refrigerant line fittings and the rear expansion
valve ports. 17. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto
the underbody refrigerant extension line fittings. Use only the
specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a refrigerant system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
18. Connect the underbody refrigerant extension lines and sealing plate (2 and 6) to the rear A/C
expansion valve. 19. Loosely install the nut (3) that secures the extension lines and sealing plate to
the rear A/C expansion valve. 20. Connect the underbody refrigerant lines (7) to the underbody
refrigerant extension lines and tighten the fitting nuts (1) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 21. Tighten the nut
that secures the extension lines and sealing plate to the rear A/C expansion valve to 11 Nm (97 in.
lbs.). 22. Connect the underbody heater lines (5) to the rear heater core tubes located behind the
right rear wheel housing and engage the spring type hose
clamps (4).
23. Lower the vehicle. 24. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 25. If the heater core is being
replaced, flush the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and
Repair. 26. Fill the engine cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling
System/Service and Repair.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
27. Evacuate and charge the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System
Charge. 28. Calibrate the A/C-heater control See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics/HVAC System Test.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7335
Housing Assembly HVAC: Overhaul
Front Air Distribution Housing
HOUSING-AIR DISTRIBUTION
NOTE: The air distribution housing must be removed from the HVAC housing and disassembled for
service of the blend-air and mode-air
doors.
NOTE: LHD model with A/C shown in illustrations. Heater-only models similar.
1. Remove the HVAC housing assembly and place it on a workbench . 2. Remove the air
distribution housing (2) from the HVAC housing (1) . 3. If equipped with the 2.0L diesel engine,
remove the electric positive temperature coefficient (PTC) heater unit from the air distribution
housing . 4. Remove the heater core from the air distribution housing See: Heater Core/Service
and Repair/Front Heater Core - Removal.
5. Remove the screws (1) that secure the blend door actuator (2) to the left side of the air
distribution housing (3) and remove the actuator. 6. If equipped with dual zone system, remove the
screws that secure the other blend door actuator to the right side of the air distribution housing and
remove the actuator See: Air Door/Air Door Actuator / Motor/Service and Repair/Blend Door
Actuator - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7336
7. Remove the blend door lever (1) from the left side of the air distribution housing (2).
NOTE: To remove the blend door pivot lever, disengage the retaining tab on the lever and pull the
lever straight off the pivot shaft.
8. Remove the blend door pivot lever (3) from the end of the blend door pivot shaft (4).
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the mode door actuator from the bracket when servicing the
air distribution housing.
9. Remove the three screws (1) that secure the mode door actuator (2) and bracket (3) to the right
side of the air distribution housing (4) and remove
the actuator and bracket as an assembly.
10. Remove the mode door cam (1) from the right side of the air distribution housing (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7337
NOTE: If any foam seal on the air distribution housing outlets is deformed or damaged, the seal
must be replaced.
11. Carefully cut the two foam seals (1) along the parting line (2) of the two halves of the air
distribution housing (3). If either seal is deformed or
damaged, it must be replaced.
12. Remove the five screws (4) and one metal clip (5) that secure the two halves of the air
distribution housing together. 13. Disengage the three plastic retaining tabs (6) that secure the two
halves of the air distribution housing together and carefully separate the housing.
NOTE: If a seal on an air door is deformed or damaged, the air door must be replaced.
NOTE: If equipped with dual zone heating/A/C system, there are two blend-air doors that mate
together at the centerline of the housing.
14. Disengage the air doors (1, 2, 3 and 4) from the door levers and remove the air doors from the
air distribution housing (5).
NOTE: To remove the door levers, disengage the retaining tabs on the inside of the air distribution
housing and pull the levers straight out of
the housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7338
15. If required, remove the door levers (1, 2, 3 and 4) from the right side of the air distribution
housing (5).
Front Air Inlet Housing
HOUSING-AIR INLET
NOTE: The air inlet housing must be removed from HVAC housing and disassembled for service of
the recirculation-air door.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the HVAC housing assembly and place it on a workbench . 2. Remove the air inlet
housing (3) from the HVAC housing (1).
3. Remove the two screws (1) that secure the recirculation door actuator (2) to the right side of the
air inlet housing (3) and remove the actuator.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7339
4. To remove the recirculation door pivot shaft adapter from the right end of the recirculation-air
door, first carefully push down on the tab of the
door lever pivot shaft adapter located inside of the air inlet housing, then pull the pivot shaft adapter
straight out of the end of the recirculation-air door pivot shaft.
NOTE: If the foam seal on the air inlet housing is deformed or damaged, the seal must be replaced.
NOTE: If a rubber seal on the recirculation air-door is deformed or damaged, the air-door must be
replaced.
5. Carefully pinch the two ends of the recirculation air-door together and remove the air-door from
the air inlet housing. If the seal on the
recirculation air-door is deformed or damaged, the air-door must be replaced.
Front HVAC Housing
HOUSING-HVAC
NOTE: The HVAC housing must be removed from the vehicle and disassembled for service of the
A/C evaporator.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Remove the HVAC housing assembly and place it on a workbench . 2. Remove the air
distribution housing (2) from the HVAC housing (1) . 3. Remove the air inlet housing (3) from the
HVAC housing .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7340
NOTE: Manual temperature system shown. Automatic system similar.
4. Remove the three screws (1) that secure the wire lead bracket (2) and the blower motor (3) to
the bottom of the HVAC housing (4) and remove the
blower motor and wire lead bracket.
5. Remove the two screws (5) that secure the blower motor resistor or power module (6) to the
bottom of the HVAC housing and remove the resistor
or power module.
6. Using needle nose pliers (1), disengage the two retaining tabs (2) that secure the evaporator
temperature sensor (3) to the driver side of the HVAC
housing (4) and remove the sensor.
NOTE: If the foam seal or plastic flange is deformed or damaged, it must be replaced.
7. Remove the two bolts that secure the A/C expansion valve (6 to the A/C evaporator and remove
the valve See: Expansion Valve/Service and
Repair/A/C Expansion Valve - Removal.
8. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and install plugs in, or tape over the opened expansion
valve and evaporator tube ports.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7341
9. Remove the foam seal and plastic flange (2) from the front of the two halves of the HVAC
housing (4). Carefully release the four retaining tabs
located at the back of the flange and pull the flange off of the evaporator tubes. If the seal or flange
is deformed or damaged, it must be replaced.
10. Remove the nine screws (3) and three metal clips (5) that secure the two halves of the HVAC
housing together. 11. Disengage the nine plastic retaining tabs (1) that secure the two halves of the
HVAC housing together and separate the housing.
12. Carefully lift the A/C evaporator (1) and the foam insulator (2) out of the lower half of the HVAC
housing (3).
Rear HVAC Housing
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: The rear heater-A/C housing must be removed from the vehicle for service of the mode
door actuator and blend door actuator and it
must be disassembled for service of the A/C evaporator and the heater core. The blend-air door
and mode-air door are only serviced with the respective housing.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the rear heater-A/C housing and
place it on a workbench See: Removal and Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing Removal. 3.
Remove the rear blower motor resistor or power module (depending on application) or See: Control
Module HVAC/Service and Repair/Rear
Blower Motor Power Module - Removal.
4. Remove the rear blower motor . 5. Remove the foam seal (2) from the flange (1) located at the
bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3). If the foam seal is deformed or damaged, it
must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7342
6. Remove the three screws (2) that secure the flange (1) to the bottom of the rear heater-A/C
housing (3) and remove the flange.
7. Remove the two screws (1) that secure the rear expansion valve (3) to the tapping plate located
on the end of the rear evaporator tubes (2) and
remove the valve.
8. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and install plugs in, or tape over the opened evaporator
tubes and expansion valve ports.
9. Remove the wire harness connector (7) from the lower rear heater-A/C housing (6).
10. Open the evaporator tube retaining bracket (3) located on the outboard side of the lower
housing. 11. Remove the metal retaining clip (2) that secures the lower housing to the rear
heater-A/C housing (4). 12. Remove the five screws (1 and 5) that secure the lower housing the
rear heater-A/C housing and carefully remove the lower housing. Rotate and
tilt the lower housing as necessary for removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7343
13. Remove the screw (1) that secures the rear evaporator cover (3) to the outboard side of the
rear heater-A/C housing (2) and remove the cover of
the housing.
14. Carefully pull the rear A/C evaporator (4) out the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3).
Guide the evaporator tubes (2) past the heater core
tubes (1). If the foam seals on the A/C evaporator are deformed or damaged, they must be
replaced.
15. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the rear blend door actuator (2) located on the
outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing (4). 16. Remove the two screws (1) that secure the
rear blend door actuator to the rear heater-A/C housing and remove the actuator.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7344
17. Disconnect the rear heater-A/C wire harness connector (1) from the rear mode door actuator
(3) located on the outboard side of the rear
heater-A/C distribution housing (2) and remove the wire harness from the rear heater-A/C housing
(5).
18. Remove the three metal retaining clips (4) that secure the rear distribution housing to the rear
heater-A/C housing. 19. Release the five plastic retaining tabs (4) that secure the rear distribution
housing and rear heater-A/C housing together and separate the housings. 20. If required, remove
the rear mode door actuator from the rear distribution housing See: Air Door/Air Door Actuator /
Motor/Service and
Repair/Mode Door Actuator - Removal.
21. Remove the screw (1) that secures the rear heater core tubes (3) to the outboard side of the
rear heater-A/C housing (4). 22. Pull the rear heater core (5) out of the top of the rear heater-A/C
housing. If the foam seals on the heater core are deformed or damaged, they must
be replaced.
Front Air Distribution Housing
HOUSING-AIR DISTRIBUTION
NOTE: LHD model with A/C shown in illustrations. Heater-only models similar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7345
1. If removed, install the four door levers (1, 2, 3 and 4) onto the right side of the air distribution
housing (5) Make sure the lever retaining tabs are
fully engaged to the housing.
NOTE: If a seal on an air door is deformed or damaged, the air door must be replaced.
NOTE: Properly position the air doors within the air distribution housing by first aligning the four
door levers to the scribe lines located on
the right outer side of the air distribution housing. Then, install the air doors onto the door levers
with the UP mark on each air door facing toward the top of the housing.
NOTE: If equipped with dual zone heating/A/C system, there are two blend-air doors that mate
together at the centerline of the housing.
2. Align the four door levers to the scribe lines on the right outer side of the air distribution housing
(5) and install the air door(s) (1, 2, 3 and 4) onto
the door levers with the UP mark on each air door facing toward the top of the housing.
3. Align the air door(s) with the pivot shaft hole(s) in the air distribution housing (3) and install the
two halves of the housing together. Make sure the
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7346
three plastic retaining tabs (6) are fully engaged.
4. Install the five screws (4) and one metal clip (5) that secure the two halves of the air distribution
housing together. Tighten the screws to 2.2 Nm
(20 in lbs.). Make sure the metal clip is fully engaged to the housing halves.
NOTE: If any foam seal on the air distribution housing outlets is deformed or damaged, the seal
must be replaced.
5. Inspect the foam seals (1), especially at the parting line (2). If a foam seal is deformed or
damaged, it must be replaced.
NOTE: Align the pins on the mode door levers with the grooves in the back of the mode door cam
prior to installation of the cam.
6. Align the mode door levers on the right side of the air distribution housing (2) to the mode door
cam (1) and install the cam onto the housing.
Make sure the levers are correctly engaged to the cam.
7. Position the mode door actuator (2) and bracket (3) onto the right side of the HVAC air
distribution housing (4). If necessary, rotate the actuator
slightly to align the splines on the actuator output shaft with those in the mode door cam.
8. Install the screws (1) that secure the mode door actuator bracket to the air distribution housing.
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7347
9. Install the blend door pivot lever (3) onto the end of the blend door pivot shaft (4) located on the
left side of the air distribution housing (2). Make
sure the lever retaining tab is fully engaged to the pivot shaft.
NOTE: Align the pin on the blend door lever with the groove in the pivot lever prior to installation of
the blend door lever.
10. Install the blend door lever (1) onto the air distribution housing. Make sure the levers are
correctly aligned to each other.
11. Position the blend door actuator (2) onto the left side of the air distribution housing (3). If
necessary, rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines
on the actuator output shaft with those in the blend door lever.
12. Install the screws (1) that secure the blend door actuator to the air distribution housing. Tighten
the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 13. If equipped with dual zone system, position the blend door
actuator onto the right side of the air distribution housing and install the retaining
screws. If necessary, rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines on the actuator output shaft
with those in the blend door. Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.).
14. If equipped with the 2.0L diesel engine, install the electric positive temperature coefficient
(PTC) heater unit into the air distribution housing (2) .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7348
15. Install the heater core into the air distribution housing See: Heater Core/Service and
Repair/Front Heater Core - Installation. 16. Install the air distribution housing onto the HVAC
housing (1) . 17. Install the HVAC housing assembly .
Front Air Inlet Housing
HOUSING-AIR INLET
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Carefully install the recirculation-air door (1) into the air inlet housing (2) by pinching the two
ends of the air-door together and aligning the pivot
shafts of the air-door to the pivot shaft holes in the air inlet housing.
NOTE: Install the recirculation door pivot shaft adapter by carefully pushing it straight into the end
of the recirculation door pivot shaft.
2. Install the recirculation door pivot shaft adapter (3) into the right side pivot shaft of the
recirculation air-door. Make sure the adapter is fully
engaged to the pivot shaft.
3. Install the recirculation door actuator (1) onto the right side of the air inlet housing (2). If
necessary, rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines
of the actuator output shaft (3) with those on the recirculation door pivot shaft adapter (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7349
4. Install the air inlet housing (3) onto the HVAC housing (1) . 5. Install the HVAC housing
assembly .
Front HVAC Housing
HOUSING-HVAC
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
NOTE: Make sure that the foam insulator is properly positioned around the A/C evaporator and in
the HVAC housing.
1. Carefully install the A/C evaporator (1) and foam insulator (2) into the lower half of the HVAC
housing (3).
2. Install the two halves of the HVAC housing (4) together and engage the nine plastic retaining
tabs (1). Make sure the retaining tabs are fully
engaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7350
3. Install the nine screws (3) and three metal clips (5) that secure the two halves of the HVAC
housing together. Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in
lbs.). Make sure the metal clips are fully engaged to the housing halves.
NOTE: If the foam seal or plastic flange is deformed or damaged, it must be replaced.
4. Install the plastic flange and foam seal (2) over the evaporator tubes and onto the front of the
HVAC housing. Make sure the four flange retaining
tabs are fully engaged to the housing.
5. Remove the tape or plugs from the expansion valve and evaporator ports. 6. Lubricate new
O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the evaporator tube fittings. Use only
the specified O-ring seals as they
are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type
recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
7. Install the A/C expansion valve (6) and the two retaining bolts. Tighten the bolts to 11 Nm (97 in.
lbs.) See: Expansion Valve/Service and
Repair/A/C Expansion Valve - Installation.
8. Install the evaporator temperature sensor (1) into the driver side of the HVAC housing (2). Make
sure the retaining tabs (3) are fully engaged to
the housing.
NOTE: Manual temperature system shown. Automatic system similar.
9. Position the blower motor (3) into the bottom of the HVAC housing (4).
10. Install the wire lead bracket (2) and the three screws (1) that secure the blower motor to the
HVAC housing. Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in.
lbs.).
11. Position the blower motor resistor or power module (6) into the HVAC housing. 12. Install the
two screws (5) that secure the resistor or power module to the HVAC housing. Tighten the screws
to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7351
13. Install the air inlet housing (3) onto the HVAC housing (1) . 14. Install the air distribution
housing (2) onto the HVAC housing .
NOTE: If the heater core is being replaced, flush the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair .
15. Install the HVAC housing assembly .
Rear HVAC Housing
ASSEMBLY
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: If only the rear A/C evaporator is being replaced, add 30 milliliters (1 fluid ounce) of
refrigerant oil to the refrigerant system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals is required anytime a refrigerant line or
expansion valve is disconnected. Failure to
replace the rubber O-ring seals could result in a refrigerant system leak.
1. Install the rear heater core (5) into the rear heater-A/C housing (4). Make sure that the foam
seals are properly installed. 2. Install the screw (1) that secures the rear heater core tubes (3) to
the outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing. Tighten the screw to 1.2 Nm (10
in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7352
3. If removed, install the rear mode door actuator (3) to the rear heater-A/C distribution housing (2)
See: Air Door/Air Door Actuator /
Motor/Service and Repair/Mode Door Actuator - Installation.
4. Position the rear heater-A/C distribution housing to the rear heater-A/C housing (5) and engage
the five plastic retaining tabs (4). Make sure the
retaining tabs are fully engaged.
5. Install the three metal retaining clips (6) that secure the rear distribution housing to the rear
heater-A/C housing. 6. Position the rear heater-A/C wire harness (1) to the rear heater-A/C
distribution housing and connect it to the rear mode door actuator (3).
7. Position the rear blend door actuator (1) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (3). If necessary,
rotate the actuator slightly to align the splines on the
actuator output shaft with those on the rear blend-air door pivot shaft (2).
8. Install the two screws (1) that secure the rear blend door actuator (2) to the rear heater-A/C
housing (4). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the wire harness connector (3)
to the rear blend door actuator.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7353
10. Install the rear A/C evaporator (4) into the rear heater-A/C housing (3). Guide the evaporator
tubes (2) past the rear heater core tubes (1). Make
sure that the foam seals are properly installed on the evaporator.
11. Install the evaporator cover (3) onto the outboard side of the rear heater-A/C housing (2) and
install the retaining screw (1). Tighten the screw to
1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
12. Install the lower rear heater-A/C housing (6) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (4). Rotate and
tilt the lower housing as necessary for installation. 13. Install the five screws (1 and 5) that secure
the lower housing to the rear heater-A/C housing. Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 14.
Install the metal retaining clip (2) that secures the lower housing to the rear heater-A/C housing. 15.
Close the evaporator tube retaining bracket (3). Make sure the bracket retainers are fully engaged.
16. Install the wire harness connector (7) onto the lower rear heater-A/C housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7354
17. Remove the tape or plugs from the rear evaporator tubes and expansion valve ports. 18.
Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the rear
evaporator tube fittings. Use only the specified O-rings
as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type
recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
19. Install the rear A/C expansion valve (3) onto the tapping plate located on the end of the rear
evaporator tubes (2) 20. Install two bolts (1) that secure the rear A/C expansion valve to the taping
plate. Tighten the bolts to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.).
21. Position the flange (1) to the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3) and install the three
retaining screws (2). Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10
in. lbs.).
22. Install the foam seal (2) onto the flange (1) at the bottom of the rear heater-A/C housing (3).
Make sure that the foam seal is properly installed. 23. Install the rear blower motor .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7355
24. Install the rear blower motor resistor or power module (depending on application) or See:
Control Module HVAC/Service and Repair/Rear
Blower Motor Power Module - Installation.
25. Install the rear heater-A/C housing See: Removal and Replacement/Rear HVAC Housing
Installation. 26. Reconnect the negative battery cable. 27. If the rear heater core is being replaced,
flush the cooling system See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair.
28. If the rear A/C evaporator is being replaced, add 30 milliliters (1 fluid ounce) of refrigerant oil to
the refrigerant system. When replacing multiple
A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart to determine how much oil
should be added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front A/C Receiver Drier - Description
Receiver Dryer: Description and Operation Front A/C Receiver Drier - Description
DESCRIPTION
The A/C receiver/drier (1) stores unused refrigerant, filters the refrigerant, helps remove moisture
from the refrigerant and retains any refrigerant vapor that may leave the A/C condenser until it
becomes a liquid.
The A/C receiver/drier is installed on the high-side of the A/C system, below the engine
compartment behind the right side of the front fascia and is connected to the right side of the A/C
condenser by an integral refrigerant line (2). An integral mounting bracket (5) secures the A/C
receiver/drier to the right front frame rail and the connections are sealed by use of rubber O-ring
seals (3) and metal gaskets (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Front A/C Receiver Drier - Description > Page 7360
Receiver Dryer: Description and Operation Front A/C Receiver Drier - Operation
OPERATION
The A/C receiver/drier performs a filtering action to prevent foreign material in the refrigerant from
contaminating the A/C expansion valve. Refrigerant enters the A/C receiver/drier as a
high-pressure, low temperature liquid. Desiccant inside the A/C receiver/drier absorbs any moisture
which may have entered and become trapped within the refrigerant system. In addition, during
periods of high demand operation of the A/C system, the A/C receiver/drier acts as a reservoir to
store surplus refrigerant.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C receiver/drier has no serviceable parts except for the O-ring seals and gaskets. The O-ring
seals used on the connections are made from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a
refrigerant. The O-ring seals and gaskets must be replaced whenever the A/C receiver/drier is
disconnected.
The A/C receiver/drier cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged, or if an
internal failure of the A/C compressor has occurred.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Front A/C Receiver Drier - Removal
Receiver Dryer: Service and Repair Front A/C Receiver Drier - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Review safety precautions and warnings before performing this procedure See:
Service Precautions/Warning and See: Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible serious or
fatal injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant
system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Remove the nut (5) that secures
the A/C liquid line (4) to the tapping block (2) located on the right side of the A/C condenser. 4.
Disconnect the A/C liquid line from the tapping block and remove and discard the O-ring seal and
gasket. 5. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened refrigerant line fitting and condenser port.
6. Raise and support the vehicle. 7. Position the front portion of the right front wheelhouse splash
shield out of the way to gain access to the A/C receiver/drier See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
8. Remove the nut (2) that secures the lower A/C suction line (3) to the upper A/C suction line (1).
9. Disconnect the lower A/C suction line to the upper A/C suction line and remove and discard the
O-ring seal and gasket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Front A/C Receiver Drier - Removal > Page 7363
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
10. Remove the bolt (3) that secures the rear section of the A/C suction line (1) to the right front
frame rail (2) and position the suction line out of the
way.
11. Remove the nut (6) that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line (7) to the A/C
receiver/drier (4). 12. Disconnect the rear section of the A/C liquid line from the A/C receiver/drier,
remove and discard the O-ring seal and gasket and position the
liquid line out of the way.
13. Remove the bolt (5) that secure the A/C receiver/drier to the right front frame rail and remove
the receiver/drier. 14. Install plugs in, or tape over all of the opened refrigerant line fittings and the
receiver/drier port.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Front A/C Receiver Drier - Removal > Page 7364
Receiver Dryer: Service and Repair Front A/C Receiver Drier - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
CAUTION: The A/C receiver/drier must be replaced if an internal failure of the A/C compressor has
occurred See: Front A/C Receiver Drier Removal . Failure to replace the A/C Receiver Drier can cause serious damage to the replacement
A/C compressor.
NOTE: If only the A/C receiver/drier is being replaced, add 30 milliliters (1 fluid ounce) of refrigerant
oil to the refrigerant system. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be
added to the refrigerant systemSee: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level .
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is disconnected. Failure to replace
the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: LHD model shown in illustrations.
NOTE: Illustration shown with front fascia and headlamp removed for clarity.
1. Position the A/C receiver/drier (4) to the right front frame rail (2) and loosely install the lower
retaining bolt (5). 2. Install the bolt (3) that secures the upper portion of the A/C suction line (1) to
the right front frame rail. Tighten both bolts securely. 3. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened
refrigerant line fittings and the receiver/drier port. 4. Lubricate new O-ring seals with clean
refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the refrigerant line fittings. Use only the
specified
O-ring seals as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil
of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
5. Connect the rear section of the A/C liquid line (7) to the A/C receiver/drier. 6. Install the nut (6)
that secures the rear section of the A/C liquid line to the A/C receiver/drier. Tighten the nut to 20
Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Front A/C Receiver Drier - Removal > Page 7365
7. Connect the lower portion of the A/C suction line (3) to the upper suction line (1) 8. Install the nut
(2) that secures the lower portion of the A/C suction line to the upper suction line. Tighten the nut to
20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 9. Reposition the right front wheel house splash shield to the body See: Body
and Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Installation.
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Remove the tape or plug from the opened refrigerant line fitting and
condenser ports. 12. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it and
a new gaskets onto the refrigerant line fitting. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
13. Connect the A/C liquid line (4) to the tapping block (2) and install the retaining nut (5). Tighten
the nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.). 14. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
15. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate 16. If
the A/C condenser is being replaced, add 10 milliliters (0.3 fluid ounce) of refrigerant oil to the
refrigerant system. When replacing multiple A/C
system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart to determine how much oil should
be added to the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
17. Charge the A/C system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
REFRIGERANT CHARGE CAPACITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 7370
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Type......................................................................................................................................................
.........................................................................R-134a
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Refrigerant - Description
Refrigerant: Description and Operation Refrigerant - Description
A/C REFRIGERANT
The refrigerant used in this air conditioning system is a HydroFluoroCarbon (HFC), type R-134a.
Unlike R-12, which is a ChloroFluoroCarbon (CFC), R-134a refrigerant does not contain
ozone-depleting chlorine. R-134a refrigerant is a nontoxic, nonflammable, clear and colorless
liquefied gas.
CAUTION: R-134a refrigerant is not compatible with R-12 refrigerant in an A/C system. Even a
small amount of R-12 refrigerant added to an
R-134a refrigerant system will cause A/C compressor failure.
The A/C refrigerant system is filled-for-life at the factory and requires no regular maintenance.
Although not required at specific intervals, the charge level should be checked if system
performance deteriorates or if a noise or leak is suspected See: Testing and Inspection/Component
Tests and General Diagnostics.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Refrigerant - Description > Page 7373
Refrigerant: Description and Operation Refrigerant - Operation
OPERATION
R-134a refrigerant is not compatible with R-12 refrigerant in an A/C system. Even a small amount
of R-12 refrigerant added to an R-134a refrigerant system will cause A/C compressor failure,
refrigerant oil sludge or poor A/C system performance. In addition, the poly alkylene glycol (PAG)
synthetic refrigerant oils used in an R-134a refrigerant system are not compatible with the
mineral-based refrigerant oils used in an R-12 refrigerant system.
R-134a refrigerant system service ports, service tool couplers and refrigerant dispensing bottles
have all been designed with unique fittings to ensure that an R-134a refrigerant system is not
accidentally contaminated with the wrong refrigerant (R-12). There are also labels posted in the
engine compartment of the vehicle and on the A/C compressor to identify that the A/C system is
equipped with R-134a refrigerant.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant System - Recovery
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System - Recovery
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM RECOVERY
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: If equipped with the rear heating-A/C system, use a heat gun to heat the underbody lines to
help remove any trapped refrigerant from
the rear A/C system.
When servicing the A/C system, a R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that
meets SAE standard J2788 must be used (1). Per SAE standard J2788, refrigerant recovery
stations must recover 95% of the refrigerant system within 30 minutes at 21.1° C (70° F) and be
able to measure the amount of refrigerant removed from the system to an accuracy of 28 grams (1
oz.). Refer to the operating instructions supplied by the equipment manufacturer for proper care
and use of this equipment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant System - Recovery > Page 7376
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System - Evacuate
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM EVACUATE
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system. Failure to follow this
caution will result in serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: Special effort must be used to prevent moisture from entering the A/C system oil. Moisture
in the oil is very difficult to remove and
will cause a reliability problem with the A/C compressor.
If an A/C compressor designed to use R-134a refrigerant is left open to the atmosphere for an
extended period of time. It is recommended that the refrigerant oil be drained and replaced with
new oil or a new A/C compressor be used. This will eliminate the possibility of contaminating the
refrigerant system.
If the refrigerant system has been open to the atmosphere, it must be evacuated before the system
can be filled. Moisture and air mixed with the refrigerant will raise the compressor head pressure
above acceptable operating levels. This will reduce the performance of the A/C system and
damage the A/C compressor. Moisture will boil at near room temperature when exposed to
vacuum. To evacuate the refrigerant system:
NOTE: When connecting the service equipment coupling to the line fitting, verify that the valve of
the coupling is fully closed. This will reduce
the amount of effort required to make the connection.
1. Recover the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 2. With
the engine OFF, connect a suitable charging station, refrigerant recovery machine or a manifold
gauge set with vacuum pump and refrigerant
recovery equipment See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. Do not operate the
engine with a vacuum on the A/C system.
3. Open the suction and discharge valves and start the vacuum pump. The vacuum pump should
run a minimum of 45 minutes prior to charge to
eliminate all moisture in system. When the suction gauge reads to the lowest degree of vacuum
possible (approximately -88 kPa (- 26 in. Hg) or greater) for 30 minutes, close all valves and turn
off vacuum pump. If the system fails to reach specified vacuum, the refrigerant system likely has a
leak that must be corrected. If the refrigerant system maintains specified vacuum for at least 30
minutes, start the vacuum pump, open the suction and discharge valves. Then allow the system to
evacuate an additional 10 minutes.
4. Close all valves. Turn off and disconnect the vacuum pump. 5. Charge the refrigerant system
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant System - Recovery > Page 7377
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System - Charge
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM CHARGE
WARNING: Review safety precautions and warnings before performing this procedure See:
Service Precautions/Warning and See: Service
Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The Underhood HVAC Specification Label contains the refrigerant fill specification of the
vehicle being serviced.
After all refrigerant system leaks have been repaired and the refrigerant system has been
evacuated, a refrigerant charge can be injected into the system See: Specifications/Capacity
Specifications.
When charging the A/C system, a R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that meets
SAE standard J2788 must be used (1). Per SAE standard J2788, refrigerant recovery stations must
charge the system to an accuracy of 14 grams (0.5 oz.). Refer to the operating instructions
supplied by the equipment manufacturer for proper care and use of this equipment.
CHARGING PROCEDURE
CAUTION: A small amount of refrigerant oil is removed from the A/C system each time the
refrigerant system is recovered and evacuated.
Before charging the A/C system, you MUST replenish any oil lost during the recovery process. See
the equipment manufacturer instructions for more information.
1. Evacuate the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate. 2.
Connect a manifold gauge set or R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that meets
SAE standard J2788 to the refrigerant system. 3. Measure the proper amount of refrigerant and
heat it to 52° C (125° F) with the charging station. See the operating instructions supplied by the
equipment manufacturer for proper use of this equipment.
4. Open both the suction and discharge valves, then open the charge valve to allow the heated
refrigerant to flow into the system. 5. When the transfer of refrigerant has stopped, close both the
suction and discharge valves. 6. If all of the refrigerant charge did not transfer from the dispensing
device, open all of the windows in the vehicle and set the heating-A/C system
controls so that the A/C compressor is engaged and the blower motor is operating at its lowest
speed setting. Run the engine at a steady high idle (about 1400 rpm). If the A/C compressor does
not engage, test the compressor clutch control circuit and repair as required.
7. Open the low-side valve to allow the remaining refrigerant to transfer to the refrigerant system.
WARNING: Take care not to open the discharge (high pressure) valve at this time. Failure to follow
this warning could result in possible
serious or fatal injury.
8. Disconnect the charging station and manifold gauge set from the refrigerant system service
ports. 9. Reinstall the caps onto the refrigerant system service ports.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL CAPACITIES
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 7382
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Type......................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................ND-8 PAG
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Refrigerant Oil - Description
Refrigerant Oil: Description and Operation Refrigerant Oil - Description
DESCRIPTION
The refrigerant oil used in R-134a refrigerant systems is a synthetic-based, poly alkylene glycol
(PAG), wax-free lubricant. Mineral-based R-12 refrigerant oils are not compatible with PAG oils and
should never be introduced to an R-134a refrigerant system.
There are different PAG oils available and each contain a different additive package. Always use
only the type of refrigerant oil recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant system oil level when replacing an A/C compressor
See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Level
. Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level can prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
The A/C compressors used in this vehicle is designed to use ND-8 PAG refrigerant oil. Use only
this type of refrigerant oil in the refrigerant system.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Refrigerant Oil - Description > Page 7385
Refrigerant Oil: Description and Operation Refrigerant Oil - Operation
OPERATION
After performing any refrigerant recovery or recycling operation, always replenish the refrigerant
system with the same amount of the recommended refrigerant oil as was removed. Too little
refrigerant oil can cause A/C compressor damage, and too much can reduce A/C system
performance.
PAG refrigerant oil is more hygroscopic than mineral oil, and will absorb any moisture it comes into
contact with, even moisture in the air. The PAG oil container should always be kept tightly capped
until it is ready to be used. After use, recap the oil container immediately to prevent moisture
contamination.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7386
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
REFRIGERANT OIL LEVEL
When an A/C system is assembled at the factory, all components except the A/C compressor are
refrigerant oil free. After the refrigerant system has been charged and operated, the refrigerant oil
in the A/C compressor is dispersed throughout the refrigerant system. The A/C receiver/drier, A/C
evaporator, A/C condenser and the A/C compressor will each retain a significant amount of the
needed refrigerant oil.
It is important to have the correct amount of refrigerant oil in the A/C system. This ensures proper
lubrication of the A/C compressor. Too little oil will result in damage to the A/C compressor, while
too much oil will reduce the cooling capacity of the A/C system and consequently result in higher
discharge air temperatures.
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant system oil level when replacing an A/C compressor.
Drain the refrigerant oil from the A/C
compressor using the procedures described below. Failure to properly drain the refrigerant oil from
the A/C compressor can prevent the A/C system from operating as designed and cause serious
compressor damage.
CAUTION: ND-8 PAG refrigerant oil is used in the A/C system. Only refrigerant oil of the same type
should be used to service this R-134a
A/C system. Do not use any other refrigerant oil. The refrigerant oil container should be kept tightly
capped until it is ready for use and then tightly capped after use to prevent contamination from
moisture and dirt. Refrigerant oil will quickly absorb any moisture it comes in contact with,
therefore, special effort must be used to keep all R-134a system components moisture-free.
Moisture in the refrigerant oil is very difficult to remove and will cause a reliability problem with the
A/C compressor.
NOTE: Most reclaim/recycling equipment will measure the amount of refrigerant oil being removed
during the recovery process. This
amount of refrigerant oil should always be added back into the refrigerant system. Refer to the
reclaim/recycling equipment manufacturers instructions.
It will not be necessary to check the oil level within the A/C refrigerant system or to add oil, unless
there has been an oil loss. A refrigerant oil loss may occur due to component replacement or a
rupture or leak from a refrigerant line, connector fitting, component or component seal. If a leak
does occurs, add 30 milliliters (1 fluid ounce) of the recommended refrigerant oil to the refrigerant
system after the repair has been made. Refrigerant oil loss will be evident at the leak point by the
presence of a wet, shiny surface around the leak.
Refrigerant oil must be added when an A/C receiver/drier, A/C evaporator or A/C condenser is
replaced. Refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities charts.
The refrigerant oil level in a new A/C compressor must first be adjusted prior to compressor
installation. Refer to the following COMPRESSOR OIL DRAIN PROCEDURE.
REFRIGERANT OIL CAPACITIES
COMPRESSOR OIL DRAIN PROCEDURE - DENSO 6SEU16 VARIABLE DISPLACEMENT
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant system oil level when replacing an A/C compressor.
The refrigerant oil in the Denso 6SEU16
A/C compressor can only be drained using the procedure described below. Failure to properly drain
the refrigerant oil from the A/C compressor can prevent the A/C system from operating as designed
and cause serious compressor damage.
If the Denso 6SEU16 A/C compressor is being replaced, some refrigerant oil must first be drained
from the replacement A/C compressor. The 6SEU16 A/C compressor is filled with 100 milliliters
(3.4 oz.) from the factory. Drain 50 milliliters (1.7 oz.) of refrigerant oil from the replacement
6SEU16 compressor. Use the following procedure to drain and measure refrigerant oil from the
Denso 6SEU16 A/C compressor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7387
1. Place the replacement A/C compressor (2) on a workbench and remove the drain plug (1).
CAUTION: The 6SEU16 A/C compressor is filled with 100 milliliters (3.4 oz.) from the factory. Drain
50 milliliters (1.7 oz.) of refrigerant oil
from the new 6SEU16 compressor when replacing only the compressor.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, see the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart
to determine how much oil should be
removed from the replacement A/C compressor (example: new 6SEU16 compressor and
receiver/drier requires 80 ml. (2.7 oz.) of oil to be added to the system. 100 ml. (3.4 oz.) of oil is in
replacement compressor. 100 ml. (3.4 oz.) minus 80 ml. (2.7 oz.) equals 20 ml. (0.7 oz.) oil to be
drained from replacement compressor).
2. Position the replacement A/C compressor so that the refrigerant oil can drain out of the drain
port into a suitable clean measured container. Hold
the replacement A/C compressor in this position until the required amount of refrigerant oil is
drained from the compressor.
CAUTION: Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level prior to installation of a replacement
compressor can prevent the A/C system
from operating as designed and cause serious compressor damage.
3. Reinstall the drain plug. Tighten the drain plug securely. 4. Install the replacement A/C
compressor onto the engine See: Compressor HVAC/Service and Repair/A/C Compressor Installation.
COMPRESSOR OIL DRAIN PROCEDURE - DENSO 10SR15 AND 10SR17 FIXED
DISPLACEMENT
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant system oil level when replacing an A/C compressor.
Failure to properly drain and measure the
refrigerant oil from the A/C compressor can prevent the A/C system from operating as designed
and cause serious compressor damage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7388
The Denso 10SR15 and 10SR17 A/C compressors are filled with refrigerant oil from the factory.
Use the following procedure to drain and measure refrigerant oil from the Denso 10SR15 and
10SR17 A/C compressors.
1. Position the original A/C compressor so that the refrigerant oil can drain out of the suction and
discharge ports into a suitable clean measured
container. Hold the original A/C compressor in this position until all of the refrigerant oil is drained
from the compressor.
2. Drain all of the refrigerant oil from the replacement A/C compressor into a clean measured
container. 3. Refill the replacement A/C compressor with the same amount of refrigerant oil that
was drained out of the original compressor. Use only clean
refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
CAUTION: Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level prior to installation of a replacement
compressor can prevent the A/C system
from operating as designed and cause serious compressor damage.
See: Compressor HVAC/Service and Repair/A/C Compressor - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7392
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 4 WAY
TRANSDUCER-A/C PRESSURE - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Description
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front A/C Pressure Transducer Description
DESCRIPTION
The A/C pressure transducer (1) is a switch that is installed on a fitting located on the A/C liquid
line at the right front corner of the engine compartment. An internally threaded fitting on the A/C
pressure transducer connects it to the externally threaded Schrader-type fitting. A rubber O-ring
seals the connection between the A/C pressure transducer and the A/C liquid line fitting. The A/C
pressure transducer is connected to the vehicle electrical system by a molded plastic connector
with three terminals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Description > Page 7395
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front A/C Pressure Transducer Operation
OPERATION
The A/C pressure transducer monitors the pressures in the high side of the refrigerant system
through its connection to a fitting on the A/C discharge line. The internal resistance of the A/C
pressure transducer changes in response to the pressures it monitors.
The Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) provides a five volt reference signal and a sensor
ground to the A/C pressure transducer. The TIPM then monitors the output voltage of the
transducer on a sensor return circuit to determine refrigerant pressure and sends a message to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or the Engine Control Module (ECM) (depending on engine
application) over the CAN C BUS.
With 3.5L 5-Passenger and all 7-Passenger models, the PCM is programmed to respond to this
and other sensor inputs by controlling the operation of the swash plate within the A/C compressor
and the radiator cooling fan to help optimize A/C system performance and to protect the system
components from damage. The PCM adjusts the swash plate to nearly a zero degree angle (low
compressor displacement) when high side pressure rises above 3130 kPa (454 psi) and readjusts
the swash plate to a greater angle (higher compressor displacement) when high side pressure
drops below 1999 kPa (290 psi). The A/C pressure transducer also reduces the swash plate angle
if the high side pressure drops below 200 kPa (29 psi) and will increase the swash plate angle
when the high side pressure rises above 234 - 262 kPa (34 - 38 psi). When the refrigerant pressure
rises above 1655 kPa (240 psi), the PCM will actuate the cooling fan.
With 2.4L 5-Passenger models, A/C compressor clutch engagement is controlled by the PCM or
ECM, depending on engine application. When the A/C-heater control is set to any A/C position, it
sends a request signal on the CAN-IHS bus to the TIPM, which then transfers the request on the
CAN-C Bus to the PCM/ECM, which determines if operating conditions are correct for A/C clutch
engagement. When all operating conditions have been met, the PCM/ECM sends a signal on a
dedicated hard-wired circuit back to the TIPM to energize the internal A/C clutch high side driver.
When energized, the A/C clutch high side driver provides battery current to the A/C clutch field coil.
A Schrader-type valve in the A/C discharge line fitting permits the A/C pressure transducer to be
removed or installed without disturbing the refrigerant in the A/C system.
The A/C pressure transducer is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The A/C pressure transducer cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Removal
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front A/C Pressure Transducer Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: It is not necessary to discharge the refrigerant system to replace the A/C pressure
transducer.
NOTE: Typical A/C pressure transducer shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1)
from the A/C pressure transducer (2) located on the A/C liquid line (3) at the right front corner of the
engine compartment.
3. Remove the A/C pressure transducer from the A/C liquid line and remove and discard the O-ring
seal (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Removal > Page 7398
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front A/C Pressure Transducer Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Use only the specified O-ring as it is made of special material for R-134a. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type required for the A/C
compressor.
NOTE: Typical A/C pressure transducer shown.
1. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal (4) with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the A/C liquid
line (3). 2. Install the A/C pressure transducer (2) onto the A/C liquid line. Tighten the A/C pressure
transducer to 5.6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the A/C pressure
transducer. 4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Auxiliary Heater Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Cabin Heater Relay 1
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Auxiliary Heater Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Cabin Heater Relay 1 > Page 7404
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Auxiliary Heater Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Cabin Heater Relay 1 > Page 7405
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7409
Blower Motor Relay: Diagrams
Connector (3 ZONE HVAC) - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-REAR BLOWER MOTOR (3 ZONE HVAC) - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module HVAC: > 24-008-08 > Sep >
08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF
Control Module HVAC: Customer Interest A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF
NUMBER: 24-008-08
GROUP: Air Conditioning
DATE: September 4, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.01 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: FLASH: Airflow Through HVAC Ducts with System Off
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin involves reprogramming the Three Zone Manual Temperature Control
module with new software.
MODELS:
2008 (RT) Grand Caravan/Town & Country
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built prior to April
16, 2008 (MDH0416XX) at Windsor Assembly plant (R in 11th VIN position) -OR- April 22, 2008
(MDH0422XX) at the St. Louis Assembly plant (B in 11th VIN position)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built before June
15, 2008 (MDH0615XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience an intermittent condition where air flow
from the HVAC vents is noticeable while driving with the HVAC system off. This may be more
noticeable with the temperature settings at medium or higher heat settings due to the temperature
differential coming out of the ducts.
Turning the blower on, and then off will force the fresh air/recirculation door closed eliminating the
airflow.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) using the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all A/C Systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are
present record them on a repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this
bulletin. If the Symptom/Condition is experienced or described by the customer, perform the Repair
Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
When performing this Repair Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN®; must be
programmed with 9.01 level software or higher. The
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module HVAC: > 24-008-08 > Sep >
08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF > Page 7418
software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, to take
advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's network.
Make sure the StarSCAN® is configured to the dealership's network before proceeding. For
instruction on setting up your StarSCAN® for the dealer's network refer to either:
"DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) tools > Online Documentation",
or refer to the StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide. The StarSCAN(R) Quick Start
Networking Guide is also available on the website under the "Download Center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts. Set
the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash
process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process is complete.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Turn the ignition switch on.
6. Retrieve the old HVAC part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a.Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the HVAC in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK".
l. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE:
Due to the HVAC programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored
DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module HVAC: > 24-008-08 > Sep >
08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF > Page 7419
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: >
24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF
Control Module HVAC: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF
NUMBER: 24-008-08
GROUP: Air Conditioning
DATE: September 4, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.01 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: FLASH: Airflow Through HVAC Ducts with System Off
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin involves reprogramming the Three Zone Manual Temperature Control
module with new software.
MODELS:
2008 (RT) Grand Caravan/Town & Country
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to RT equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built prior to April
16, 2008 (MDH0416XX) at Windsor Assembly plant (R in 11th VIN position) -OR- April 22, 2008
(MDH0422XX) at the St. Louis Assembly plant (B in 11th VIN position)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to JC equipped with 3 zone manual A/C (Sales Code HAG) built before June
15, 2008 (MDH0615XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience an intermittent condition where air flow
from the HVAC vents is noticeable while driving with the HVAC system off. This may be more
noticeable with the temperature settings at medium or higher heat settings due to the temperature
differential coming out of the ducts.
Turning the blower on, and then off will force the fresh air/recirculation door closed eliminating the
airflow.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) using the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all A/C Systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are
present record them on a repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this
bulletin. If the Symptom/Condition is experienced or described by the customer, perform the Repair
Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
When performing this Repair Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN®; must be
programmed with 9.01 level software or higher. The
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: >
24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF > Page 7425
software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, to take
advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's network.
Make sure the StarSCAN® is configured to the dealership's network before proceeding. For
instruction on setting up your StarSCAN® for the dealer's network refer to either:
"DealerCONNECT > Service > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) tools > Online Documentation",
or refer to the StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide. The StarSCAN(R) Quick Start
Networking Guide is also available on the website under the "Download Center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately 13.5 volts. Set
the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger to time out during the flash
process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process is complete.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Turn the ignition switch on.
6. Retrieve the old HVAC part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a.Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the HVAC in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK".
l. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash HVAC" screen has updated to the new part
number.
NOTE:
Due to the HVAC programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
From the "Home" screen select "System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored
DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module HVAC: >
24-008-08 > Sep > 08 > A/C - Airflow From Vents With A/C OFF > Page 7426
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7427
Control Module HVAC: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7428
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-BLOWER-FRONT (ATC) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 7431
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Rear Blower Module C1 (3 Zone ATC) (Body) 6 Way
Connector C1 (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 6 WAY
MODULE-BLOWER-REAR (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Module (ATC) (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 7432
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Rear Blower Module C2 (3 Zone ATC) (Body) 2 Way
Connector C2 (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-BLOWER-REAR (3 ZONE ATC) - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
A blower motor power module is used on this model when equipped with the automatic
temperature control (ATC) heating-A/C system. Models equipped with the manual temperature
control (MTC) heating-A/C system use a blower motor resistor, instead of the blower motor power
module .
The blower motor power module is mounted to the bottom of the HVAC housing, on the passenger
side of the vehicle. The blower motor power module consists of a molded plastic mounting plate (1)
with an integral connector receptacle (2). Concealed behind the mounting plate is the power
module electronic circuitry (3) and a finned aluminum heat sink (4). The blower motor power
module is accessed for service from under the instrument panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description > Page 7435
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Front Blower Motor Power Module - Operation
OPERATION
The blower motor power module is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
lead and connector of the instrument panel wire harness. A second lead and connector of the
instrument panel wire harness is connected to the blower motor. The blower motor power module
allows the microprocessor-based automatic temperature control(ATC) A/C-heater control to
calculate and provide infinitely variable blower motor speeds based upon either manual blower
switch input or the ATC programming using a pulse width modulated (PWM) circuit strategy.
The PWM voltage is applied to a comparator circuit which compares the PWM signal voltage to the
blower motor feedback voltage. The resulting output drives the power module circuitry, which
provides a linear output voltage to change or maintain the desired blower speed.
The blower motor power module is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The blower motor power module cannot be adjusted or repaired must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description > Page 7436
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
A blower motor power module is used on this model when equipped with the automatic
temperature control (ATC) rear heating-A/C system. Models equipped with the manual temperature
control (MTC) rear heating-A/C system use a blower motor resistor, instead of the blower motor
power module .
The rear blower motor power module (1) is mounted to the inboard side of the rear heating-A/C
housing, located on the right side of the vehicle. The rear blower motor power module consists of a
molded plastic housing with two integral wire connector receptacles (2) for the power module
electronic circuitry, a mounting plate (3) with a gasket and a finned aluminum heat sink (4).
The rear blower motor power module can be accessed for service without removing the rear
heater-A/C housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Description > Page 7437
Control Module HVAC: Description and Operation Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Operation
OPERATION
The rear blower motor power module is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated lead and connector of the rear body wire harness. A second lead and connector of the
wire harness is connected to the rear blower motor. The rear blower motor power module allows
the microprocessor-based automatic temperature control (ATC) A/C-heater control to calculate and
provide infinitely variable blower motor speeds based upon either manual blower switch input or the
ATC programming using a pulse width modulated (PWM) circuit strategy.
The PWM voltage is applied to a comparator circuit which compares the PWM signal voltage to the
rear blower motor feedback voltage. The resulting output drives the power module circuitry, which
provides a linear output voltage to change or maintain the desired blower speed.
The rear blower motor power module is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear blower motor power module cannot be adjusted or repaired must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The heat sink for the blower motor power module may get very hot during normal
operation. If the blower motor was turned on
prior to servicing the blower motor power module, wait five minutes to allow the heat sink to cool
before performing diagnosis or service. Failure to take this precaution may result in possible
serious injury.
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1)
from the blower motor power module (2) located at the bottom of the HVAC housing (3) on the
passenger side of the vehicle.
3. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the blower motor power module to the HVAC housing
and remove the power module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal > Page 7440
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Front Blower Motor Power Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: LHD model shown.
1. Position the blower motor power module (2) into the bottom of the HVAC housing (3). 2. Install
the two screws (4) that secure the blower motor power module to the HVAC housing. Tighten the
screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the blower motor
power module. 4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal > Page 7441
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the rear blower motor power module (3) onto the rear heater-A/C housing (2). 2. Install
the two screws (1) that secure the rear blower motor power module to the rear heater-A/C housing.
Tighten the screws to 1.2 Nm (10 in.
lbs.).
3. Connect the two wire harness connectors (4) to the rear blower motor power module. 4. Install
the right rear quarter trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service
and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
5. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Blower Motor Power Module - Removal > Page 7442
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair Rear Blower Motor Power Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove right rear quarter trim panel See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the two wire harness connectors (4) from the rear blower motor power module (3). 4.
Remove the two screws (1) that secure the rear blower motor power module to the rear heater-A/C
housing (2) and remove the module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 7447
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Ambient Temperature Sensor - Description
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation Front Ambient
Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The ambient air temperature sensor is a variable resistor that monitors the air temperature outside
of the vehicle. The ATC system uses the sensor data to maintain optimum cabin temperature
levels. The ambient air temperature sensor is mounted inside the front fascia.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Ambient Temperature Sensor - Description >
Page 7450
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation Front Ambient
Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The ambient air temperature sensor is a variable resistor that operates on a 5-volt reference signal
sent by the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The ambient air temperature sensor is
connected to the TIPM through a two-wire lead and connector of the vehicle wire harness. The
ambient air temperature sensor changes its internal resistance in response to changes in the
outside air temperature, which either increases or decreases the reference signal voltage read by
the TIPM. The TIPM converts and broadcasts the sensor data over the Controller Area Network
(CAN) IHS bus, where it is read by the ATC A/C-heater control, Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
and other vehicle control modules.
The ambient air temperature sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The ambient air temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7454
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7455
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7456
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
SENSOR-EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor Description
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front Evaporator
Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The evaporator temperature sensor measures the temperature of the conditioned air downstream
of the A/C evaporator. The evaporator temperature sensor is an electrical thermistor (1) mounted
on the end of a molded plastic housing (2) that is inserted into the driver side of the HVAC housing
near the coldest point of the A/C evaporator. The evaporator temperature sensor is retained in the
HVAC housing by two integral retaining tabs (3) and is connected to the vehicle electrical system
by use of a wire lead and connector (4) with two terminals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor Description > Page 7459
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front Evaporator
Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The evaporator temperature sensor monitors the surface temperature of A/C evaporator and
supplies an input signal to the A/C-heater control. The A/C-heater control uses the evaporator
temperature sensor input signal to optimize A/C system performance and to protect the A/C system
from evaporator freezing. The evaporator temperature sensor will change its internal resistance in
response to the temperatures it monitors and is connected to the A/C-heater control through sensor
ground circuit and a 5-volt reference signal circuit. As the temperature of the A/C evaporator
decreases, the internal resistance of the evaporator temperature sensor decreases.
The A/C-heater control uses the monitored voltage reading as an indication of evaporator
temperature. The A/C-heater control is programmed to respond to this input by requesting the
powertrain control module (PCM) or the engine control module (ECM) (depending on engine
application) to adjust the compressor swash plate angle as necessary to optimize A/C system
performance and to protect the A/C system from evaporator freezing See: Compressor
HVAC/Description and Operation/A/C Compressor - Operation.
The evaporator temperature sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool.
The evaporator temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and it must be replaced if
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Removal
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front Evaporator Temperature
Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Illustration shown with air distribution housing removed for clarity.
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove and disassemble the HVAC housing to service the evaporator
temperature sensor. The evaporator
temperature sensor can be removed for service from underneath the instrument panel.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Reach up under the driver side of the
instrument panel and disconnect the electrical connector for the evaporator temperature sensor (1)
from the
instrument panel wire harness.
3. Using needle nose pliers, disengage the two retaining tabs (3) that secure the evaporator
temperature sensor to the HVAC housing (2) by carefully
pulling the sensor straight out of the side of the HVAC housing.
4. Route the electrical connector and wire lead of the evaporator temperature sensor out from
under the heater core tubes and remove the sensor from
the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Evaporator Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page
7462
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front Evaporator Temperature
Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Illustration shown with air distribution housing removed for clarity.
1. Route the electrical connector and wire lead of the evaporator temperature sensor (1) under the
heater core tubes located on the driver side of the
HVAC housing (2).
2. Install the evaporator temperature sensor into the driver side of the HVAC housing. Make sure
the retaining tabs (3) are fully engaged to the
housing.
3. Connect the electrical connector for the evaporator temperature sensor to the instrument panel
wire harness. 4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 7466
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 4 WAY
TRANSDUCER-A/C PRESSURE - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Description
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front A/C Pressure Transducer Description
DESCRIPTION
The A/C pressure transducer (1) is a switch that is installed on a fitting located on the A/C liquid
line at the right front corner of the engine compartment. An internally threaded fitting on the A/C
pressure transducer connects it to the externally threaded Schrader-type fitting. A rubber O-ring
seals the connection between the A/C pressure transducer and the A/C liquid line fitting. The A/C
pressure transducer is connected to the vehicle electrical system by a molded plastic connector
with three terminals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Description >
Page 7469
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Front A/C Pressure Transducer Operation
OPERATION
The A/C pressure transducer monitors the pressures in the high side of the refrigerant system
through its connection to a fitting on the A/C discharge line. The internal resistance of the A/C
pressure transducer changes in response to the pressures it monitors.
The Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) provides a five volt reference signal and a sensor
ground to the A/C pressure transducer. The TIPM then monitors the output voltage of the
transducer on a sensor return circuit to determine refrigerant pressure and sends a message to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or the Engine Control Module (ECM) (depending on engine
application) over the CAN C BUS.
With 3.5L 5-Passenger and all 7-Passenger models, the PCM is programmed to respond to this
and other sensor inputs by controlling the operation of the swash plate within the A/C compressor
and the radiator cooling fan to help optimize A/C system performance and to protect the system
components from damage. The PCM adjusts the swash plate to nearly a zero degree angle (low
compressor displacement) when high side pressure rises above 3130 kPa (454 psi) and readjusts
the swash plate to a greater angle (higher compressor displacement) when high side pressure
drops below 1999 kPa (290 psi). The A/C pressure transducer also reduces the swash plate angle
if the high side pressure drops below 200 kPa (29 psi) and will increase the swash plate angle
when the high side pressure rises above 234 - 262 kPa (34 - 38 psi). When the refrigerant pressure
rises above 1655 kPa (240 psi), the PCM will actuate the cooling fan.
With 2.4L 5-Passenger models, A/C compressor clutch engagement is controlled by the PCM or
ECM, depending on engine application. When the A/C-heater control is set to any A/C position, it
sends a request signal on the CAN-IHS bus to the TIPM, which then transfers the request on the
CAN-C Bus to the PCM/ECM, which determines if operating conditions are correct for A/C clutch
engagement. When all operating conditions have been met, the PCM/ECM sends a signal on a
dedicated hard-wired circuit back to the TIPM to energize the internal A/C clutch high side driver.
When energized, the A/C clutch high side driver provides battery current to the A/C clutch field coil.
A Schrader-type valve in the A/C discharge line fitting permits the A/C pressure transducer to be
removed or installed without disturbing the refrigerant in the A/C system.
The A/C pressure transducer is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The A/C pressure transducer cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Removal
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front A/C Pressure Transducer Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: It is not necessary to discharge the refrigerant system to replace the A/C pressure
transducer.
NOTE: Typical A/C pressure transducer shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1)
from the A/C pressure transducer (2) located on the A/C liquid line (3) at the right front corner of the
engine compartment.
3. Remove the A/C pressure transducer from the A/C liquid line and remove and discard the O-ring
seal (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front A/C Pressure Transducer - Removal > Page 7472
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Front A/C Pressure Transducer Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Use only the specified O-ring as it is made of special material for R-134a. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type required for the A/C
compressor.
NOTE: Typical A/C pressure transducer shown.
1. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal (4) with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the A/C liquid
line (3). 2. Install the A/C pressure transducer (2) onto the A/C liquid line. Tighten the A/C pressure
transducer to 5.6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the A/C pressure
transducer. 4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Infrared Sensor (ATC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Infrared Sensor (ATC) > Page 7477
Solar Sensor: Locations Sun Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Infrared Sensor (ATC) > Page 7478
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Infrared Sensor (ATC) (Headliner) 4 Way
Solar Sensor: Diagrams Infrared Sensor (ATC) (Headliner) 4 Way
Connector (ATC) - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
SENSOR-INFRARED (ATC) - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Infrared Sensor (ATC) (Headliner) 4 Way > Page 7481
Solar Sensor: Diagrams Sun Sensor (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SENSOR-SUN - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The infrared temperature sensor is located in the overhead console and consists of an infrared
transducer concealed behind a clear lens (2) in a molded plastic housing with an integral wire
connector receptacle (1) and mounting tab (3).
The infrared sensor is used only on models equipped with the automatic temperature control (ATC)
heating-A/C system.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 7484
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Infrared Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The infrared sensor detects thermal radiation emitted by the driver and front passenger seat
occupants and surroundings and converts its data into a linear Pulse Width Modulated (PWM)
output signal which is read by the Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) A/C-heater control. The
ATC A/C-heater control uses the infrared sensor data as one of the inputs necessary to
automatically control the interior cabin temperature levels. By using thermal radiation (surface
temperature) measurement, rather than an air temperature measurement, the ATC heating-A/C
system is able to adjust itself to the comfort level as perceived by the occupants. This allows the
ATC system to compensate for other ambient conditions affecting comfort levels, such as solar
heat gain or evaporative heat loss. The ATC system logic responds to the infrared sensor message
by calculating and adjusting the air flow temperature and air flow rate needed to properly obtain
and maintain the selected comfort level temperature of the occupants. The A/C-heater control
continually monitors the infrared sensor circuits, and will store Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
for any problem it detects.
The infrared sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures.
The infrared sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 7485
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Sun Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: Typical sun sensor assembly shown.
The automatic temperature control (ATC) heating-A/C system uses a sun sensor assembly (1) to
measure sun light intensity. The sun sensor assembly incorporates two sun sensors (2) within a
molded plastic case which is mounted to the instrument panel and a clear lens (3) that protrudes
through the defroster grille. The wire harness receptacle (4) connects the sun sensors to the
vehicle electrical system through a wire lead and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 7486
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Sun Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The ATC dual-zone heating-A/C system uses two sun sensors to balance the system in response
to side-to-side variations in sun light intensity. Passengers in sun and shadow require different
functional settings because they experience very different temperatures. The sun sensor assembly
provides data to the A/C heater control to help determine proper mode and blend-air door positions
and blower motor speeds. The sun sensors are not thermistor type sensors, but rather photo
diodes. For this reason the sun sensors responds to sun light intensity rather than temperature.
The sun sensor assembly is also used to sense day and night conditions for automatic headlight
control, if equipped.
The sun sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures.
The sun sensor assembly cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7487
Solar Sensor: Testing and Inspection
SUN SENSOR
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in an
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
The sun sensor assembly is located so that the sun rays will hit the sensors in the same way that it
will hit the driver and the passenger. It is important that the area in front of the sun sensor
assembly be unobstructed. Check for the following:
- Windshield wipers are properly adjusted.
- Defroster grille or sun sensor is properly installed. The sun sensor lens should protrude above the
defroster grille.
- Any stickers on the windshield are not directly in front of the sun sensor.
- Any items laying on top of the instrument panel are not covering the sun sensor.
If the vehicle exhibits a lack of passenger comfort in sunny weather such as in the early afternoon,
inspect the position of the sun sensor assembly. The sun sensor lens should protrude above the
defroster grille to insure proper operation. If the sun sensor is not properly positioned, perform the
following procedure:
1. Confirm that the defroster grille is properly installed. If not, repair as required. 2. Remove the
defroster grille and verify that the sun sensor is properly installed to the instrument panel See:
Service and Repair/Sun Sensor Installation.
3. Reinstall the defroster grille.
The A/C-heater control continually monitors the sun sensor circuits and will store diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) for any problem it detects. The sun sensor can be tested in the vehicle with a scan
tool See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Using Trim Stick C-4755 or equivalent,
carefully disengage the four retaining tabs (1) that secure the infrared sensor and overhead
map/courtesy
lamp bezel (2) to the overhead console (3).
3. Disconnect the wire harness connectors (4) from the two overhead map/courtesy lamps (5) and
the infrared sensor (6) and remove the sensor, lamp
and bezel assembly from the vehicle
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 7490
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Infrared Temperature Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the infrared sensor and overhead map/courtesy lamp bezel (2) to the overhead console
(3). 2. Connect the wire harness connectors (4) to the two overhead map/courtesy lamps (5) and
the infrared sensor (6). 3. Engage the four retaining tabs (1) that secure the infrared sensor and
overhead map/courtesy lamp bezel to the overhead console. Make sure the
retaining tabs are fully engaged.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 7491
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Sun Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the defroster grille See: Air
Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille - Removal. 3. Using Trim Stick C-4755 or equivalent
(2), gently pry between both sides of the sun sensor assembly (1) and the instrument panel (3) to
release
the snap retainers that secure the sun sensor.
4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (2) from the sun sensor assembly (1) and remove the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 7492
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Sun Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the sun sensor assembly (1) to the top of the instrument panel (4) and connect the wire
harness connector (3). 2. Align the tab (2) on the sun sensor assembly with the opening in the
instrument panel. 3. Gently push the sun sensor assembly into the instrument panel until the
sensor snap retainers are securely engaged. 4. Install the defroster grille See: Air Register/Service
and Repair/Defroster Grille - Installation. 5. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Service Port HVAC: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Refrigerant system service ports are used to recover, recycle, evacuate, charge and test the A/C
refrigerant system. Unique sizes are used on the two service ports for the R-134a refrigerant
system to ensure the system is not accidentally contaminated with R-12 refrigerant or by service
equipment used for R-12 refrigerant.
The high side service port is located on the A/C liquid line near the right front strut tower. The low
side service port is located on the A/C suction line near the dash panel.
Both the high side and low side A/C service port valve cores are serviceable.
NOTE: The protective cap aids in service port sealing and helps protect the refrigerant system from
contamination. Remember to always
reinstall the protective caps onto the service ports when refrigerant system service is complete.
Each of the service ports has a threaded plastic protective cap installed over it from the factory.
The service port caps are serviceable items.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Service Port Valve Core - Removal
Service Port HVAC: Service and Repair Front Service Port Valve Core - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation See: Service
Precautions/Warning and See: Service Precautions/Caution . Failure to follow the warnings and
cautions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Typical A/C service port shown.
1. Remove the protective cap (1) from the service port (2). 2. Recover the refrigerant from the
refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Recovery. 3. Using a
Schrader-type valve core tool, remove the valve core (3) from the service port. 4. Install a plug in,
or tape over the opened service port(s).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Service Port Valve Core - Removal > Page 7498
Service Port HVAC: Service and Repair Front Service Port Valve Core - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Typical A/C service port shown.
1. Lubricate the valve core (3) with clean refrigerant oil prior to installation. Use only refrigerant oil
of the type recommended for the A/C
compressor in the vehicle.
2. Remove the tape or plug from the service port (2).
CAUTION: A valve core that is not fully seated in the A/C service port can result in damage to the
valve during refrigerant system evacuation
and charge. Such damage may result in a loss of system refrigerant while uncoupling the charge
adapters.
3. Using a Schrader-type valve core tool, install and tighten the valve core into the service port(s).
CAUTION: Do NOT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present
within the A/C system when equipped with
the Denso 6SEU16 variable displacement compressor. Failure to follow this caution will result in
serious A/C compressor damage.
4. Evacuate and charge the refrigerant system See: Service and Repair/Refrigerant System
Charge.
NOTE: The protective cap helps aid in service port sealing and helps protect the refrigerant system
from contamination. Remember to always
reinstall the protective cap onto the service port when refrigerant system service is complete.
5. Install the protective cap (1) onto the service port.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Infrared Sensor (ATC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Infrared Sensor (ATC) > Page 7503
Solar Sensor: Locations Sun Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Infrared Sensor (ATC) > Page 7504
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Infrared Sensor (ATC) (Headliner) 4 Way
Solar Sensor: Diagrams Infrared Sensor (ATC) (Headliner) 4 Way
Connector (ATC) - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
SENSOR-INFRARED (ATC) - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Infrared Sensor (ATC) (Headliner) 4 Way > Page 7507
Solar Sensor: Diagrams Sun Sensor (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SENSOR-SUN - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The infrared temperature sensor is located in the overhead console and consists of an infrared
transducer concealed behind a clear lens (2) in a molded plastic housing with an integral wire
connector receptacle (1) and mounting tab (3).
The infrared sensor is used only on models equipped with the automatic temperature control (ATC)
heating-A/C system.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 7510
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Infrared Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The infrared sensor detects thermal radiation emitted by the driver and front passenger seat
occupants and surroundings and converts its data into a linear Pulse Width Modulated (PWM)
output signal which is read by the Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) A/C-heater control. The
ATC A/C-heater control uses the infrared sensor data as one of the inputs necessary to
automatically control the interior cabin temperature levels. By using thermal radiation (surface
temperature) measurement, rather than an air temperature measurement, the ATC heating-A/C
system is able to adjust itself to the comfort level as perceived by the occupants. This allows the
ATC system to compensate for other ambient conditions affecting comfort levels, such as solar
heat gain or evaporative heat loss. The ATC system logic responds to the infrared sensor message
by calculating and adjusting the air flow temperature and air flow rate needed to properly obtain
and maintain the selected comfort level temperature of the occupants. The A/C-heater control
continually monitors the infrared sensor circuits, and will store Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
for any problem it detects.
The infrared sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures.
The infrared sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 7511
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Sun Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: Typical sun sensor assembly shown.
The automatic temperature control (ATC) heating-A/C system uses a sun sensor assembly (1) to
measure sun light intensity. The sun sensor assembly incorporates two sun sensors (2) within a
molded plastic case which is mounted to the instrument panel and a clear lens (3) that protrudes
through the defroster grille. The wire harness receptacle (4) connects the sun sensors to the
vehicle electrical system through a wire lead and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 7512
Solar Sensor: Description and Operation Sun Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The ATC dual-zone heating-A/C system uses two sun sensors to balance the system in response
to side-to-side variations in sun light intensity. Passengers in sun and shadow require different
functional settings because they experience very different temperatures. The sun sensor assembly
provides data to the A/C heater control to help determine proper mode and blend-air door positions
and blower motor speeds. The sun sensors are not thermistor type sensors, but rather photo
diodes. For this reason the sun sensors responds to sun light intensity rather than temperature.
The sun sensor assembly is also used to sense day and night conditions for automatic headlight
control, if equipped.
The sun sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures.
The sun sensor assembly cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if inoperative or
damaged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 7513
Solar Sensor: Testing and Inspection
SUN SENSOR
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in an
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
The sun sensor assembly is located so that the sun rays will hit the sensors in the same way that it
will hit the driver and the passenger. It is important that the area in front of the sun sensor
assembly be unobstructed. Check for the following:
- Windshield wipers are properly adjusted.
- Defroster grille or sun sensor is properly installed. The sun sensor lens should protrude above the
defroster grille.
- Any stickers on the windshield are not directly in front of the sun sensor.
- Any items laying on top of the instrument panel are not covering the sun sensor.
If the vehicle exhibits a lack of passenger comfort in sunny weather such as in the early afternoon,
inspect the position of the sun sensor assembly. The sun sensor lens should protrude above the
defroster grille to insure proper operation. If the sun sensor is not properly positioned, perform the
following procedure:
1. Confirm that the defroster grille is properly installed. If not, repair as required. 2. Remove the
defroster grille and verify that the sun sensor is properly installed to the instrument panel See:
Service and Repair/Sun Sensor Installation.
3. Reinstall the defroster grille.
The A/C-heater control continually monitors the sun sensor circuits and will store diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) for any problem it detects. The sun sensor can be tested in the vehicle with a scan
tool See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Using Trim Stick C-4755 or equivalent,
carefully disengage the four retaining tabs (1) that secure the infrared sensor and overhead
map/courtesy
lamp bezel (2) to the overhead console (3).
3. Disconnect the wire harness connectors (4) from the two overhead map/courtesy lamps (5) and
the infrared sensor (6) and remove the sensor, lamp
and bezel assembly from the vehicle
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 7516
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Infrared Temperature Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the infrared sensor and overhead map/courtesy lamp bezel (2) to the overhead console
(3). 2. Connect the wire harness connectors (4) to the two overhead map/courtesy lamps (5) and
the infrared sensor (6). 3. Engage the four retaining tabs (1) that secure the infrared sensor and
overhead map/courtesy lamp bezel to the overhead console. Make sure the
retaining tabs are fully engaged.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 7517
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Sun Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the defroster grille See: Air
Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille - Removal. 3. Using Trim Stick C-4755 or equivalent
(2), gently pry between both sides of the sun sensor assembly (1) and the instrument panel (3) to
release
the snap retainers that secure the sun sensor.
4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (2) from the sun sensor assembly (1) and remove the
sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Infrared Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 7518
Solar Sensor: Service and Repair Sun Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the sun sensor assembly (1) to the top of the instrument panel (4) and connect the wire
harness connector (3). 2. Align the tab (2) on the sun sensor assembly with the opening in the
instrument panel. 3. Gently push the sun sensor assembly into the instrument panel until the
sensor snap retainers are securely engaged. 4. Install the defroster grille See: Air Register/Service
and Repair/Defroster Grille - Installation. 5. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information
> Service and Repair
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair
SERVICE AFTER A SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT DEPLOYMENT
Any vehicle which is to be returned to use following a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
component deployment must have the deployed restraints replaced. In addition, if the driver airbag
has been deployed, the clockspring must be replaced and the steering column must be inspected.
See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Testing and Inspection. If the passenger
airbag is deployed, the instrument panel top pad must be replaced.
The seat belt tensioners are deployed in conjunction with front airbags, but can also be deployed
with seat (thorax) or side airbags. The seat belt tensioners must be replaced if either front airbag
has been deployed, and must be inspected if either seat or side airbag has been deployed. If a
seat airbag is deployed, the seat back frame, the seat back foam and the seat back trim cover on
the same side of the vehicle as the deployed airbag must also be replaced.
If a side curtain airbag has been deployed, the headliner as well as the upper A, B, C and, on
vehicles with the optional seven-passenger seating, the D-pillar trim on the same side of the
vehicle as the deployed airbag must be replaced. These components are not intended for reuse
and will be damaged or weakened as a result of a SRS component deployment, which may or may
not be obvious during a visual inspection. On vehicles with an optional sunroof, the sunroof drain
tubes and hoses must be closely inspected following a side curtain airbag deployment.
It is also critical that the mounting surfaces and mounting brackets for the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC), side impact sensors and front impact sensors be closely inspected and restored
to their original conditions following any vehicle impact damage. Because the ORC and each
impact sensor are used by the SRS to monitor or confirm the direction and severity of a vehicle
impact, improper orientation or insecure fastening of these components may cause airbags not to
deploy when required, or to deploy when not required.
There are two methods by which an airbag or seat belt tensioner may be connected to the vehicle
electrical system. The first method involves a short pigtail harness and connector insulator that are
integral to the airbag or tensioner unit and are replaced as a unit with the service replacement
airbag or seat belt tensioner unit. The second method involves a wire harness takeout and
connector insulator (squib circuits) that are connected directly to the air bag or tensioner initiator.
The heat created by the initiator during an airbag or tensioner deployment will cause collateral
damage to a directly connected wire harness take out and connector insulator. Therefore, these
direct-connect type take outs and connector insulators must be repaired following an airbag or seat
belt tensioner deployment. See: Service and Repair.
All other vehicle components should be closely inspected following any SRS component
deployment, but are to be replaced only as required by the extent of the visible damage incurred.
AIRBAG SQUIB STATUS
Multistage airbags with multiple initiators (squibs) must be checked to determine that all squibs
were used during the deployment event. The driver and passenger airbags in this vehicle are
deployed by electrical signals generated by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) through the
driver or passenger squib 1 and squib 2 circuits to the two initiators in the airbag inflators. Typically,
both initiators are used and all potentially hazardous chemicals are burned during an airbag
deployment event. However, it is possible for only one initiator to be used; therefore, it is always
necessary to confirm that both initiators have been used in order to avoid the improper handling or
disposal of potentially live pyrotechnic or hazardous materials. The following procedure should be
performed using a diagnostic scan tool to verify the status of both airbag squibs before either
deployed airbag is removed from the vehicle for disposal.
CAUTION: Deployed front airbags having two initiators (squibs) in the airbag inflator may or may
not have live pyrotechnic material within
the inflator. Do not dispose of these airbags unless you are certain of complete deployment. Refer
to the Hazardous Substance Control System for information regarding the potentially hazardous
properties of the subject component and the proper safe handling procedures. Then dispose of all
non-deployed and deployed airbags and seat belt tensioners in a manner consistent with state,
provincial, local and federal regulations.
1. Be certain that the diagnostic scan tool contains the latest version of the proper diagnostic
software. Connect the scan tool to the 16-way Data Link
Connector (DLC). The DLC is located on the driver side lower edge of the instrument panel,
outboard of the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. 3. Using the scan tool, read and record the active
(current) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) data.
Using the active DTC information, refer to the Airbag Squib Status table to determine the status of
both driver and passenger airbag squibs.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 7523
NOTE: If none of the Driver or Passenger Squib 1 or 2 open are active codes, the status of the
airbag squibs is unknown. In this case the
airbag should be handled and disposed of as if the squibs were both live.
CLEANUP PROCEDURE
Following a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) component deployment, the vehicle interior will
contain a powdery residue. This residue consists primarily of harmless particulate by-products of
the small pyrotechnic charge that initiates the propellant used to deploy a SRS component.
However, this residue may also contain traces of sodium hydroxide powder, a chemical by-product
of the propellant material that is used to generate the inert gas that inflates the airbag. Since
sodium hydroxide powder can irritate the skin, eyes, nose, or throat, be certain to wear safety
glasses, rubber gloves, and a long-sleeved shirt during cleanup.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, if you experience skin irritation during cleanup, run cool
water over the affected area. Also, if you
experience irritation of the nose or throat, exit the vehicle for fresh air until the irritation ceases. If
irritation continues, see a physician.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 7524
1. Begin the cleanup by using a vacuum cleaner to remove any residual powder from the vehicle
interior. Clean from outside the vehicle and work
your way inside, so that you avoid kneeling or sitting on a non-cleaned area.
2. Be certain to vacuum the heater and air conditioning outlets as well. Run the heater and air
conditioner blower on the lowest speed setting and
vacuum any powder expelled from the outlets.
CAUTION: Deployed front airbags having two initiators (squibs) in the airbag inflator may or may
not have live pyrotechnic material within
the inflator. Do not dispose of these airbags unless you are certain of complete deployment. Refer
to AIRBAG SQUIB STATUS. All damaged, ineffective, or non-deployed Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components which are replaced on vehicles are to be handled and disposed of
properly. If an airbag or seat belt tensioner unit is ineffective or damaged and non-deployed, refer
to the Hazardous Substance Control System for information regarding the potentially hazardous
properties of the subject component and the proper safe handling procedures. Then dispose of all
non-deployed and deployed airbags and seat belt tensioners in a manner consistent with state,
provincial, local and federal regulations.
3. Next, remove the deployed SRS components from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
removal procedures. 4. You may need to vacuum the interior of the vehicle a second time to
recover all of the powder.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Air Bag Harness > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Harness: > NHTSA09V118000 > Apr > 09 > Recall 09V118000: Air Bag
Wiring Defect
Air Bag Harness: Recalls Recall 09V118000: Air Bag Wiring Defect
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Commander 2009
Jeep/Grand Cherokee 2009 Jeep/Wrangler 4-DR 4X4 2009 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: April 07, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V118000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Electrical System: Wiring
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 4336
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 4,336 M/Y 2009 Dodge Journey, Jeep Grand Cherokee,
Commander and Wrangler Vehicles. Wiring may be reversed on the steering column control
module driver airbag squib connector. The driver's airbag may not deploy as intended.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a crash, the driver's airbag may not properly inflate and may not
be able to properly protect an occupant, increasing the risk of injuries.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect the driver's airbag squib wires and replace the steering column
control module free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during May 2009. Owners may
contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. J13. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Air Bag Harness > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Harness: > NHTSA09V118000 > Apr > 09 > Recall
09V118000: Air Bag Wiring Defect
Air Bag Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 09V118000: Air Bag Wiring Defect
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009 Jeep/Commander 2009
Jeep/Grand Cherokee 2009 Jeep/Wrangler 4-DR 4X4 2009 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC
MFR'S REPORT DATE: April 07, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V118000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Electrical System: Wiring
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 4336
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 4,336 M/Y 2009 Dodge Journey, Jeep Grand Cherokee,
Commander and Wrangler Vehicles. Wiring may be reversed on the steering column control
module driver airbag squib connector. The driver's airbag may not deploy as intended.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a crash, the driver's airbag may not properly inflate and may not
be able to properly protect an occupant, increasing the risk of injuries.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect the driver's airbag squib wires and replace the steering column
control module free of charge. The recall is expected to begin during May 2009. Owners may
contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. J13. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7543
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way
C2-A
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
C2-B
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7546
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7547
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller (Body) 36 Way
C1-A
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7548
C1-B
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7549
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7550
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7551
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller Module (Instrument Panel) 12
Way
C2-A
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
C2-B
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7552
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7553
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller Module (Body) 36 Way
C1-A
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7554
C1-B
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7555
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7556
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Occupant Restraint Controller - Description
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation Occupant Restraint Controller - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (1) is secured with three screws to a stamped steel
mounting bracket welded onto the top of the floor panel transmission tunnel near the base of the
dash panel and just forward on the center instrument panel support in the passenger compartment
of the vehicle. Concealed within a hollow in the center of the die cast aluminum ORC housing is the
electronic circuitry of the ORC which includes a microprocessor, electronic impact sensors and an
energy storage capacitor. A stamped metal cover plate is secured to the bottom of the ORC
housing with five screws to enclose and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components.
An arrow printed on the label (2) on the top of the ORC housing provides a visual verification of the
proper orientation of the unit, and should always be pointed toward the front of the vehicle. The
ORC housing has three integral mounting tabs and two integral locating pins. The molded plastic
electrical connector (3), with two receptacles containing numerous terminal pins, exits the rearward
facing side of the ORC housing. These terminal pins connect the ORC to the vehicle electrical
system through two dedicated take outs and connectors, one from the body wire harness and one
from the instrument panel wire harness.
The impact sensors internal to the ORC are calibrated for the specific vehicle, and are only
serviced as a unit with the ORC. In addition, there are unique versions of the ORC for vehicles with
or without side curtain airbags or seat (thorax) airbags, with or without third row seating as well as
for those vehicles with domestic or export applications. These variations are necessary for both
equipment needs and for compliance with certain regulatory requirements. The ORC cannot be
repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or ineffective, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Occupant Restraint Controller - Description > Page 7559
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation Occupant Restraint Controller - Operation
OPERATION
The microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) contains the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) logic circuits and controls all of the SRS components. The ORC uses
On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) and can communicate with other electronic modules in the vehicle as
well as with the diagnostic scan tool using the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus. This
method of communication is used for control of the airbag indicator in the Electro Mechanical
Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) and for SRS
diagnosis and testing through the 16-way data link connector located on the driver side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the SRS electrical circuits to determine the
system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets an active and stored
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and sends electronic messages to the EMIC over the CAN data
bus to turn ON the airbag indicator. An active fault only remains for the duration of the fault, or in
some cases for the duration of the current ignition cycle, while a stored fault causes a DTC to be
stored in memory by the ORC. For some DTCs, if a fault does not recur for a number of ignition
cycles, the ORC will automatically erase the stored DTC. For other internal faults, the stored DTC
is latched forever.
The ORC receives battery current through two circuits; a fused ignition switch output (run) circuit
through a fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM), and a fused output (run-start) circuit
through a second fuse in the TIPM. The ORC receives ground through a ground circuit and take
out of the instrument panel wire harness that is secured by a ground screw to the body sheet
metal. These connections allow the ORC to be operational whenever the ignition switch is in the
START or ON positions.
The ORC also contains an energy-storage capacitor. When the ignition switch is in the START or
ON positions, this capacitor is continually being charged with enough electrical energy to deploy
the SRS components for up to one second following a battery disconnect or failure. The purpose of
the capacitor is to provide backup SRS protection in case there is a loss of battery current supply to
the ORC during an impact.
Various impact sensors within the ORC are continuously monitored by the ORC logic. These
internal sensors, along with several external impact sensor inputs allow the ORC to determine both
the severity of an impact and to verify the necessity for deployment of any airbags. Two remote
front impact sensors are located on the back of the front end module carrier to the right and left of
the cooling module near the front of the vehicle. The electronic impact sensors are accelerometers
that sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity
of an impact.
The ORC also monitors inputs from an internal rollover sensor and up to six additional remote side
impact sensors located on the left and right front door module carriers, on the right and left lower
C-pillars and, on vehicles equipped with optional third row seating, on the right and left quarter
inner panels to control deployment of the side curtain airbag units and seat (thorax) airbags.
The impact sensors within the ORC are electronic accelerometer sensors that provide an additional
logic input to the ORC microprocessor. These sensors are used to verify the need for a SRS
component deployment by also detecting impact energy of a lesser magnitude than that of the
primary electronic impact sensors, and must exceed a safing threshold in order for the airbags to
deploy. On vehicles equipped with side curtain airbags or seat airbags, a separate impact sensor
within the ORC provides confirmation to the ORC microprocessor of side impact forces. This
separate sensor is a bi-directional unit that detects impact forces from either side of the vehicle.
Pre-programmed decision algorithms in the ORC microprocessor determine when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the impact sensors indicate an impact that is severe enough to require SRS
protection and, based upon the severity of the monitored impact, determines the level of front
airbag deployment force required for each front seating position. When the programmed conditions
are met, the ORC sends the proper electrical signals to deploy the dual multistage front airbags at
the programmed force levels, the front seat belt tensioners, the seat airbags and either side curtain
airbag unit.
The hard wired inputs and outputs for the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic
tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information. However, conventional
diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the ORC or the electronic controls
or communication between other modules and devices that provide features of the SRS. The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the ORC or the electronic controls and
communication related to ORC operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with side curtain airbags, disable
the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
before attempting any Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) diagnosis or service. The ORC
contains a rollover sensor, which enables the system to deploy the side SRS components in the
event of a vehicle rollover event. If an ORC is accidentally rolled during service while still
connected to battery power, the side SRS components will deploy. Disconnect and isolate the
battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before
performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the Occupant Restraint Controller
(ORC), as it can damage the impact
sensor or affect its calibration. The ORC contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) components. If an ORC is accidentally dropped
during service, the module must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this
warning could result in accidental, incomplete, or improper SRS component deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Remove the mini console from the top of the floor panel
transmission tunnel (3). See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Lower Bin - Removal.
3. First disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (4), followed by the body wire
harness connector (5) from the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC) (2) connector receptacles located on the rearward facing side of the module. To
disconnect the wire harness connectors from the ORC, depress the release tab and lift the lever
arm to the fully open position on each connector.
4. Remove the three screws (1) that secure the ORC to the ORC bracket that is welded onto the
top of the floor panel transmission tunnel. 5. Lift the ORC far enough to disengage the locating pins
and remove the ORC from the bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal > Page 7562
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Occupant Restraint Controller - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with side curtain airbags, disable
the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
before attempting any Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) diagnosis or service. The ORC
contains a rollover sensor, which enables the system to deploy the side SRS components in the
event of a vehicle rollover event. If an ORC is accidentally rolled during service while still
connected to battery power, the side SRS components will deploy. Disconnect and isolate the
battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before
performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the Occupant Restraint Controller
(ORC), as it can damage the impact
sensor or affect its calibration. The ORC contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) components. If an ORC is accidentally dropped
during service, the module must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this
warning could result in accidental, incomplete, or improper SRS component deployment.
1. Carefully position the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (2) to the ORC bracket that is welded
onto the top of the floor panel transmission
tunnel. When the ORC is correctly positioned, the arrow on the ORC label will be pointed forward in
the vehicle and the locating pins on the bottom of the ORC will be engaged into the locating holes
in the ORC bracket.
2. Install and tighten the three screws (1) that secure the ORC to the ORC bracket. Tighten the
screws to 12.5 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: The lever arms of the wire harness connectors for the ORC MUST be in the unlatched
position before they are inserted into their
connector receptacles on the ORC or they may become damaged.
3. First reconnect the body wire harness connector (5), followed by the instrument panel wire
harness connector (4) to the ORC connector receptacles
located on the rearward facing side of the module. Be certain that the latches on both connectors
are each fully engaged.
4. Reinstall the mini console onto the top of the floor panel transmission tunnel. See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Lower Bin - Installation.
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
NOTE: Service replacement ORC modules are shipped in a LOCKED OUT state and after installed
will set a ORC UNLOCKED - ALL
DEPLOYMENT DISABLED fault. Use a diagnostic scan tool to access the ORC module and go to
the MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS menu item to perform the MODULE INITIALIZATION
procedure to erase the fault and initialize the new replacement ORC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Clockspring - Description
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Description and Operation Clockspring - Description
DESCRIPTION
The clockspring (3) for this vehicle is secured near the top of the steering column below the
steering wheel. The clockspring also includes an integral, internal turn signal cancel cam and a
Steering Angle Sensor (SAS) that are both serviced as a unit with the clockspring. The clockspring
also supports the left (lighting) multi-function switch (1), the Steering Control Module (SCM) internal
to the left multi-function switch housing (2), and the right (wiper) multi-function switch (6). Each of
these switches and the jumper wire harness (5) between the two multi-function switches can be
separated from and are serviced individually from the clockspring.
The clockspring case includes integral tabs for mounting the unit with three screws to the steering
column lock housing as well as integral provisions for mounting and supporting both multi-function
switches. The multi-function switches are each secured to the clockspring with a single screw (7).
The SAS within the clockspring includes an electronic circuit board and a microprocessor, which
allows it to communicate with other electronic modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area
Network (CAN) data bus. The SAS circuitry, the clockspring, and the turn signal cancel cam are all
contained within a flat, molded plastic case.
The clockspring case includes three connector receptacles that face toward the instrument panel.
Within the plastic case is a spool-like molded plastic rotor with a large exposed hub. The upper
surface of the rotor hub has a large center hole, two short pigtail wires with connectors, and a
connector receptacle that faces toward the steering wheel. The lower surface of the rotor has an
integral dowel or drive pin that also faces toward the steering wheel. Wound around the rotor spool
within the case is a long ribbon-like tape that consists of several thin copper wire leads sandwiched
between two thin plastic membranes. The outer end of the tape terminates at two of the connector
receptacles that face the instrument panel, while the inner end of the tape terminates at the pigtail
wires and connector receptacle on the hub of the clockspring rotor that face the steering wheel.
The outer surface of the rotor hub rim within the clockspring case also has the integral lobes of the
turn signal cancel cam.
The service replacement clockspring is shipped pre-centered and with a molded plastic locking pin
(4) installed. The locking pin secures the centered clockspring rotor to the clockspring case during
shipment and handling, but must be removed after the clockspring is installed on the steering
column and the steering wheel is installed. See: Service and Repair/Procedures.
The clockspring cannot be repaired. If the clockspring is ineffective, damaged, or if the driver airbag
has been deployed, the clockspring/turn signal cancel cam/SAS unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Clockspring - Description > Page 7567
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Description and Operation Clockspring - Operation
OPERATION
The clockspring is a mechanical electrical circuit component that is used to provide continuous
electrical continuity between the fixed instrument panel wire harness and certain electrical
components mounted on or in the rotating steering wheel. On this vehicle the rotating electrical
components include the driver airbag, the horn switch, the speed control switch, the remote radio
switches and the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) control switches, if the vehicle is so
equipped. The clockspring is positioned and secured near the top of the steering column. The fixed
connector receptacles on the back of the fixed clockspring case connect the clockspring to the
vehicle electrical system through three take outs with connectors from the instrument panel wire
harness.
The turn signal cancel cam is integral to the rim of the clockspring rotor hub within the clockspring
case so it also moves with the rotation of the steering wheel. Two short, black-sleeved pigtail wires
on the upper surface of the clockspring rotor connect the clockspring to the driver airbag, while a
steering wheel wire harness connected to the connector receptacle on the upper surface of the
clockspring rotor complete circuits to the horn switch, the speed control switch and, if the vehicle is
so equipped, to the optional remote radio switches and EVIC control switches on the steering
wheel. The third connector receptacle is dedicated to the inputs and outputs of the Steering Angle
Sensor (SAS) internal to the clockspring case.
Like the clockspring in a timepiece, the clockspring tape has travel limits and can be damaged by
being wound too tightly during full stop-to-stop steering wheel rotation. To prevent this from
occurring, the clockspring is centered when it is installed on the steering column. Centering the
clockspring indexes the clockspring tape to the movable steering components so that the tape can
operate within its designed travel limits. However, if the steering wheel is removed from the
steering column, if the clockspring is removed from the steering column, or if the steering shaft is
disconnected from the steering gear, the clockspring spool can change position relative to the other
steering components. The clockspring must be re-centered following completion of this service or
the tape may be damaged.
Service replacement clocksprings are shipped pre-centered and with a plastic locking pin installed.
This locking pin should not be removed until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering
column. If the locking pin is removed before the steering wheel is installed on a steering column,
the clockspring centering procedure must be performed. See: Service and Repair/Procedures.
Proper clockspring installation may be confirmed by viewing the SAS data using a diagnostic scan
tool.
The hard wired clockspring circuits as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the SAS may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the SAS or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and devices that
provide features of the Electronic Stability Program (ESP) or Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS). The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SAS or the electronic
controls and communication related to ESP or SRS operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan
tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Procedures
CLOCKSPRING CENTERING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: A service replacement clockspring is shipped with the clockspring pre-centered and with a
molded plastic locking pin installed. This
locking pin should not be removed until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering
column. If the locking pin is removed before the steering wheel is installed, the clockspring
centering procedure must be performed.
NOTE: When a clockspring is installed into a vehicle without properly centering and locking the
entire steering system, the Steering Angle
Sensor (SAS) data does not agree with the true position of the steering system and causes the
Electronic Stability Program (ESP) system to shut down. This may also damage the clockspring
without any immediate malfunction. Unlike some other Chrysler vehicles, this SAS never requires
calibration. However, upon each new ignition ON cycle, the steering wheel must be rotated slightly
to initialize the SAS.
NOTE: Determining if the clockspring/SAS is centered is also possible electrically using the
diagnostic scan tool. Steering wheel position is
displayed as ANGLE with a range of up to 900 degrees. Refer to the appropriate menu item on the
diagnostic scan tool.
NOTE: Before starting this procedure, be certain to turn the steering wheel until the front wheels
are in the straight-ahead position and that
the entire steering system is locked or inhibited from rotation.
NOTE: The clockspring may be centered and the rotor may be rotated freely once the steering
wheel has been removed.
1. Place the front wheels in the straight-ahead position and inhibit the steering column shaft from
rotation. 2. Remove the steering wheel from the steering shaft. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and Repair/Removal. 3. Rotate the clockspring rotor
(1) clockwise to the end of its travel. Do not apply excessive torque. 4. From the end of the
clockwise travel, rotate the rotor about two and one-half turns counterclockwise. Turn the rotor
slightly clockwise or
counterclockwise as necessary so that the clockspring airbag pigtail wires (3) and connector
receptacle are at the top and the dowel or drive pin (5) is at the bottom.
5. The clockspring is now centered. Secure the clockspring rotor to the clockspring case using a
locking pin (2) or some similar device to maintain
clockspring centering until the steering wheel is reinstalled on the steering column.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7570
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Removal and Replacement
Clockspring - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: A service replacement clockspring is shipped with the clockspring pre-centered and with a
molded plastic locking pin installed. This
locking pin should not be removed until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering
column. If the locking pin is removed before the steering wheel is installed, the clockspring
centering procedure must be performed.
NOTE: When a clockspring is installed into a vehicle without properly centering and locking the
entire steering system, the Steering Angle
Sensor (SAS) data does not agree with the true position of the steering system and causes the
Electronic Stability Program (ESP) system to shut down. This may also damage the clockspring
without any immediate malfunction. Unlike some other Chrysler vehicles, this SAS never requires
calibration. See: Procedures .
NOTE: Determining if the clockspring/SAS is centered is also possible electrically using the
diagnostic scan tool. Steering wheel position is
displayed as ANGLE with a range of up to 900 degrees. Refer to the appropriate menu item on the
diagnostic scan tool.
NOTE: Before starting this procedure, be certain to turn the steering wheel until the front wheels
are in the straight-ahead position and that
the entire steering system is locked or inhibited from rotation.
1. Place the front wheels in the straight ahead position and inhibit the steering column shaft from
rotation. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Remove the steering wheel from
the steering shaft. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and
Repair/Removal. 4. If the removed clockspring is to be reused, be certain to secure the clockspring
rotor to the clockspring case to maintain clockspring centering until
the steering wheel is reinstalled on the steering column. If clockspring centering is not maintained,
the clockspring must be centered again before the steering wheel is reinstalled. See: Procedures.
5. Move the steering column to the fully lowered position and leave the tilt release lever in the
released (down) position. 6. Remove the upper and lower shrouds from the steering column. See:
Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
7. Remove the right multi-function switch (3) from the clockspring (4). See: Sensors and
Switches/Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Switch/Service and Repair/Right Multifunction Switch - Removal.
8. Remove the left multi-function switch (5) from the clockspring. See: Lighting and Horns/Sensors
and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination
Switch/Service and Repair/Left Multifunction Switch - Removal.
9. Remove the three screws (1) that secure the clockspring to the steering column bracket (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7571
10. Pull the clockspring (1) away from the steering column far enough to access and disconnect the
three instrument panel wire harness connectors (2)
from the receptacles on the back of the clockspring case.
11. Remove the clockspring from the steering column.
Clockspring - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: A service replacement clockspring is shipped with the clockspring pre-centered and with a
molded plastic locking pin installed. This
locking pin should not be removed until the steering wheel has been installed on the steering
column. If the locking pin is removed before the steering wheel is installed, the clockspring
centering procedure must be performed.
NOTE: When a clockspring is installed into a vehicle without properly centering and locking the
entire steering system, the Steering Angle
Sensor (SAS) data does not agree with the true position of the steering system and causes the
Electronic Stability Program (ESP) system to shut down. This may also damage the clockspring
without any immediate malfunction. Unlike some other Chrysler vehicles, this SAS never requires
calibration. See: Procedures .
NOTE: Determining if the clockspring/SAS is centered is also possible electrically using the
diagnostic scan tool. Steering wheel position is
displayed as ANGLE with a range of up to 900 degrees. Refer to the appropriate menu item on the
diagnostic scan tool.
NOTE: Before starting this procedure, be certain to turn the steering wheel until the front wheels
are in the straight-ahead position and that
the entire steering system is locked or inhibited from rotation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7572
1. If a new clockspring (1) is being installed, transfer the multifunction switch jumper harness from
the old clockspring or position a new jumper
harness onto the new clockspring.
2. Carefully slide the clockspring down over the steering column upper shaft far enough to
reconnect the three instrument panel wire harness
connectors (2) to the receptacles on the back of the clockspring case.
3. Position the clockspring (4) onto the steering column bracket (2). 4. Install and tighten the three
screws (1) that secure the clockspring to the bracket in the following sequence: lower right, upper
left, upper right.
Tighten the screws to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Use of an improper sequence when tightening the clockspring mounting screws may result
in an audible ticking noise as the steering
wheel is rotated.
5. Reinstall the left multi-function switch (5) onto the clockspring. See: Lighting and Horns/Sensors
and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination
Switch/Service and Repair/Left Multifunction Switch - Installation.
6. Reinstall the right multi-function switch (3) onto the clockspring. See: Sensors and
Switches/Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Switch/Service and Repair/Right Multifunction Switch - Installation.
7. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
8. Move the steering column back to the fully raised position and move the tilt release lever back to
the locked (up) position. 9. Reinstall the steering wheel onto the steering column. See: Steering
and Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and Repair/Installation.
10. Remove the plastic locking pin that secures the clockspring rotor to the clockspring case to
maintain clockspring centering. 11. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7577
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7578
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7579
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7580
Impact Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7581
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7582
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7583
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7584
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7585
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7586
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
> Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7587
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7590
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Right Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-RIGHT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7591
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Left Side Impact Sensor 1 (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1 - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7592
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Left Side Impact Sensor 3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7593
Impact Sensor: Diagrams
Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Right Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-RIGHT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7594
Left Side Impact Sensor 1 (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1 - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Left Side Impact Sensor 3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7595
Right Side Impact Sensor 1 (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 1 - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Right Side Impact Sensor 3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7596
Left Side Impact Sensor 2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Right Side Impact Sensor 2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
> Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7597
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Impact Sensor - Description
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
Two acceleration-type front impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle, one each for the left and
right sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is
internal to the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each front sensor is secured with a screw to
the back of the front end module carrier on either outboard side of the cooling module, just inboard
of each front lamp unit housing within the engine compartment. The sensor housing has an integral
connector receptacle (3), an integral locating and anti-rotation pin, and an integral mounting hole
(2).
The right and left front impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration. A cavity in the
center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the sensor
which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. The cavity is
filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components.
The front impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the front end module wire harness.
These acceleration-type front impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or
ineffective, they must be replaced.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
Two pressure-type front door side impact sensors (2) are used on this vehicle when it is equipped
with the side curtain airbags or the optional seat (also known as thorax) airbags, one each for the
left and right sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that
is internal to the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each side sensor is secured with two
screws and is sealed by a resilient gasket (1) to the front door module carrier on the inside of the
front door. The sensors are concealed behind the front door trim panel within the passenger
compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 7600
The right and left front door side impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration. The
impact sensor housing has an integral connector receptacle (3), two integral mounting tabs, and an
integral hood-like water shield (4) that extends through a hole in the front door module carrier into
the interior of the door cavity and protects the sensor orifice from contamination. A cavity in the
center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the sensor,
which includes an electronic communication chip and the pressure sensor. The housing cavity is
filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components. A
label on the sensor has a directional arrow and the word down imprinted upon it to provide
verification of the correct sensor orientation in the vehicle. The side impact sensors are each
connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the front
door wire harness.
These pressure-type front door side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if
damaged or ineffective, they must be replaced.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
Two acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle when it
is equipped with the side curtain airbags, one each for the left and right sides of the vehicle. These
sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is internal to the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC). Each side sensor is secured with a screw to the lower C-pillar just above the rear
door opening sill within the passenger compartment. The sensor housing has an integral connector
receptacle (3), an integral locating anti-rotation pin, and an integral mounting hole (2).
The right and left second row seating side impact sensors are identical in construction and
calibration. However, the connector orientation in the vehicle is reversed. The connector receptacle
faces forward on the right side of the vehicle, and faces rearward on the left side of the vehicle. A
cavity in the center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of
the sensor which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. The
cavity is filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and
components. The second row seating side impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness.
These acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted
and, if damaged or ineffective, they must be replaced.
Side - Third Row Seating
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 7601
Two acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle when it is
equipped with the side curtain airbags and seven-passenger seating, one each for the left and right
sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is internal to
the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each side sensor is secured with a screw to the right or
left quarter inner panel just above the right or left rear wheel housing within the passenger
compartment. The sensor housing has an integral connector receptacle (3), an integral locating
anti-rotation pin, and an integral mounting hole (2).
The right and left third row seating side impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration.
However, the connector orientation in the vehicle is reversed. The connector receptacle faces
forward on the right side of the vehicle, and faces rearward on the left side of the vehicle. A cavity
in the center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the
sensor which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. The
cavity is filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and
components. The third row seating side impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle electrical
system through a dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness.
These acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and,
if damaged or ineffective, they must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 7602
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Impact Sensor - Operation
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
The acceleration-type front impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that sense the rate of
vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity of an impact. Each
sensor also contains an electronic communication chip that allows the unit to communicate the
sensor status as well as sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the front passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and commands the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The
impact sensors each receive battery current and ground through dedicated left and right sensor
plus and minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by
modulating the current in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the acceleration-type front impact sensors and the ORC may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and
devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most reliable,
efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls and
communication related to acceleration-type front impact sensor operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
The pressure-type front door side impact sensors recognize a side impact in the front door area by
monitoring changes in pressure within the front door cavity, which manifests itself as a sudden
pressure wave as the door collapses during an impact. Each sensor also contains an electronic
communication chip that allows the unit to communicate the sensor status as well as sensor fault
information to the microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through dedicated left and right sensor plus and
minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating the
current in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the pressure-type front door side impact sensors and the ORC
may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate
wiring information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the
diagnosis of the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the pressure-type front door side impact
sensors or the electronic controls and communication related to side impact sensor operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
The acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that
sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity of an
impact. Each sensor also contains an electronic communication chip that allows the unit to
communicate the sensor status as well as sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through the dedicated left and right sensor plus
and minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating
the voltage in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors and
the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive
in the diagnosis of the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls
and communication related to acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensor operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Side - Third Row Seating
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 7603
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
The acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that
sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity of an
impact. Each sensor also contains an electronic communication chip that allows the unit to
communicate the sensor status as well as sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through the dedicated left and right sensor plus
and minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating
the voltage in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors and
the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive
in the diagnosis of the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls
and communication related to acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensor operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Impact Sensor - Removal
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the front impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The front impact sensor enables the system to deploy the front Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper front SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Service access for the front impact sensors is accomplished by
reaching behind the front end module carrier (2) from the top of the engine
compartment and between the inboard end of either front lamp unit housing (3) and either outboard
end of the cooling module.
3. For the left front impact sensor only, remove the fresh air intake snorkel and the air filter housing
from behind the front end module carrier for
service access.
4. Disconnect the front end module wire harness connector (5) from the connector receptacle of the
right or left front impact sensor (1). 5. Remove the screw (4) that secures the front impact sensor to
the back (engine compartment side) of the front end module carrier. 6. Pull the front impact sensor
straight back from the mounting location to disengage the anti-rotation pin on the base of the
sensor from the clearance
hole in the front end module carrier.
7. Remove the right or left front impact sensor from the engine compartment.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7606
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Remove the trim panel from the inside of the right or left front
door. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the front door wire harness connector (3) from the side impact sensor (1) connector
receptacle. 4. Remove the two screws (2) that secure the side impact sensor to the front door
module carrier panel (4). 5. Remove the side impact sensor from the door.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Open the sliding door. 3. Remove the quarter trim panel from
the lower C-pillar (1).See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
4. Disconnect the body wire harness connector (4) from the side impact sensor (3) connector
receptacle. 5. Remove the screw (2) that secures the side impact sensor to the lower C-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7607
6. Pull the side impact sensor straight out from the mounting location to unsnap the anti-rotation pin
on the base of the sensor from the clearance hole
in the lower C-pillar.
7. Remove the side impact sensor from the vehicle.
Side - Third Row Seating
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Remove the quarter trim panel from the quarter inner panel
over the rear wheel housing (1). See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the body wire harness connector (2) from the side impact sensor (4) above the rear
wheel housing on the quarter inner panel. 4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the side impact
sensor to the quarter inner panel. 5. Pull the side impact sensor straight out from the mounting
location to disengage the anti-rotation pin on the base of the sensor from the clearance
hole in the quarter inner panel.
6. Remove the side impact sensor from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7608
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Impact Sensor - Installation
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the front impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The front impact sensor enables the system to deploy the front Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper front SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Service access for the front impact sensors is accomplished by reaching behind the front end
module carrier (2) from the top of the engine
compartment and between the inboard end of either front lamp unit housing (3) and either outboard
end of the cooling module.
2. Position the right or left front impact sensor (1) into the engine compartment. 3. Align and insert
the anti-rotation pin on the base of the sensor into the clearance hole on the back (engine
compartment side) of the front end
module carrier.
4. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the front impact sensor to the front end module
carrier. Tighten the screw to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 5. Reconnect the front end module wire harness
connector (5) to the connector receptacle of the front impact sensor. 6. For the left front impact
sensor only, reinstall the fresh air intake snorkel and the air filter housing behind the front end
module carrier. 7. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7609
NOTE: Be certain that the gasket between the pressure-type side impact sensor and the front door
module carrier panel is in good condition
and positioned on the back of the sensor. There MUST be a good seal between the sensor and the
module carrier panel for the sensor to operate properly. If the gasket is in poor condition, replace
the sensor.
1. Position the side impact sensor (1) to the right or left front door module carrier panel (4). When
the sensor is correctly positioned, the arrow on the
sensor label will be pointed toward the bottom of the door.
2. Install and tighten the two screws (2) that secure the side impact sensor to the door. Tighten the
screws to 2.4 Nm (21 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the front door wire harness connector (3) to the sensor
connector receptacle. 4. Reinstall the trim panel onto the inside of the right or left front door. See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Installation.
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7610
1. Position the side impact sensor (3) to the lower C-pillar (1). 2. Align the anti-rotation pin on the
base of the sensor with the clearance hole in the lower C-pillar, then press on the sensor firmly and
evenly to snap
the pin into place.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the side impact sensor to the lower C-pillar. Tighten
the screw to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (4) to the side
impact sensor on the lower C-pillar. 5. Reinstall the quarter trim panel onto the lower C-pillar. See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
6. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Side - Third Row Seating
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Position the side impact sensor (4) to the quarter inner panel above the rear wheel housing (1).
2. Align the anti-rotation pin on the base of the sensor with the clearance hole in the quarter inner
panel, then press on the sensor firmly and evenly to
snap the pin into place.
3. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the side impact sensor to the quarter inner panel.
Tighten the screw to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (2) to the
side impact sensor on the quarter inner panel. 5. Reinstall the quarter trim panel onto the quarter
inner panel over the rear wheel housing. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
6. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Position Sensor > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Seat Track Position Sensor - Description
Seat Position Sensor: Description and Operation Seat Track Position Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The seat track position sensor (2) is a Hall Effect-type sensor used on some vehicles. This sensor
consists of a Hall Effect Integrated Circuit (IC) chip encased in potting material within a cavity of the
molded plastic sensor housing.
The sensor housing has a mounting slot containing an integral latch feature (1) and slides and
latches onto a stamped metal blade-type bracket located on the inboard side of the upper inboard
seat adjuster track near the rear of the driver side front seat. A molded connector receptacle (3)
integral to the sensor housing is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a connector
and take out of the driver side front seat wire harness beneath the front seat cushion frame.
The seat track position sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
entire sensor must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Position Sensor > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Seat Track Position Sensor - Description > Page 7615
Seat Position Sensor: Description and Operation Seat Track Position Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The seat track position sensor is designed to provide a seat position data input to the Occupant
Restraint Controller (ORC) indicating whether the driver side front seat is in a full forward or a not
full forward position. The ORC uses this data as an additional logic input for use in determining the
appropriate deployment force to be used when deploying the multistage driver airbag.
The seat track position sensor receives a nominal five volt supply from the ORC. The sensor
communicates the seat position by modulating the voltage returned to the ORC on a sensor data
circuit. The ORC also monitors the condition of the sensor circuits and will store a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that is detected. The ORC sends messages over the CAN data
bus to control the illumination of the airbag indicator in the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN).
The hard wired circuits between the seat track position sensor and the ORC may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the seat
track position sensor or the electronic controls and communication between other modules and
devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most reliable,
efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the seat track position sensor or the electronic controls
and communication related to seat track position sensor operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Position Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Track Position Sensor - Removal
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair Seat Track Position Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting
any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel
component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or
service. This is the only sure way to disable the supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the
proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Reach under the rear edge of the front seat cushion to access
the seat track position sensor (2) on a bracket (1) located on the inboard side near the
rear of the upper inboard seat track (4).
3. Using a small screwdriver, hold the latch feature (3) depressed while sliding the connector end of
the sensor off of the bracket. 4. Disconnect the seat wire harness connector (5) from the sensor
connector receptacle. 5. Remove the sensor from under the front seat.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Position Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Track Position Sensor - Removal > Page 7618
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair Seat Track Position Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting
any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel
component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or
service. This is the only sure way to disable the supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the
proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Reach under the rear edge of the front seat cushion to reconnect the seat wire harness
connector (5) to the seat track position sensor (2) connector
receptacle. Be certain that the latch on the connector is fully engaged.
2. Align the open end of the sensor to the blade of the sensor bracket (1) located on the inboard
side near the rear of the upper inboard seat track (4). 3. Push the sensor firmly onto the bracket
until the latch feature (3) snaps into place with an audible click. 4. Do not reconnect the battery
negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) verification test procedure
should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Service and Repair > Child Seat Removal
Child Seat: Service and Repair Child Seat - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the appropriate seat cushion and place on a bench. See: Body and Frame/Seats/Seat
Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Cover Removal.
2. Unzip the seat cover. 3. Partially remove the seat cushion cover to gain access to the booster
seat fasteners. 4. Remove the booster seat mounting fasteners. 5. Unlatch the booster seat and
carefully place in the upright position. 6. Disengage the booster seat cover trim clips. 7. Remove
the booster seat from the seat cushion. 8. If required, disengage the seat cover clips and carefully
pull the booster seat cover off the foam.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Service and Repair > Child Seat Removal > Page 7623
Child Seat: Service and Repair Child Seat - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If required, carefully pull the booster seat cover over the foam and engage the booster seat
cover clips. 2. Install the booster seat to the seat cushion. 3. Engage the booster seat cover trim
clips. 4. Latch the booster seat. 5. Install the booster seat mounting fasteners. Tighten to 13 N-m
(10 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the seat cushion cover. 7. Zip the seat cover. 8. Install the seat cushion. See:
Body and Frame/Seats/Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Cover - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Kneeblocker - Removal
Knee Diverter: Service and Repair Kneeblocker - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the steering column cover.See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Opening Cover - Removal.
2. Remove mounting fasteners. 3. Remove knee bolster from instrument panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Kneeblocker - Removal > Page 7628
Knee Diverter: Service and Repair Kneeblocker - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place knee bolster into position. 2. Install the mounting fasteners. 3. Install the steering column
cover. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Steering
Column Opening Cover - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7633
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way
C2-A
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
C2-B
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7636
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7637
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller (Body) 36 Way
C1-A
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7638
C1-B
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7639
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7640
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7641
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller Module (Instrument Panel) 12
Way
C2-A
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
C2-B
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7642
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7643
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams Occupant Restraint Controller Module (Body) 36 Way
C1-A
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7644
C1-B
Connector - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7645
MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER - (BODY) 36 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Restraint Controller (Instrument Panel) 12 Way > Page 7646
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Occupant Restraint Controller - Description
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation Occupant Restraint Controller - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (1) is secured with three screws to a stamped steel
mounting bracket welded onto the top of the floor panel transmission tunnel near the base of the
dash panel and just forward on the center instrument panel support in the passenger compartment
of the vehicle. Concealed within a hollow in the center of the die cast aluminum ORC housing is the
electronic circuitry of the ORC which includes a microprocessor, electronic impact sensors and an
energy storage capacitor. A stamped metal cover plate is secured to the bottom of the ORC
housing with five screws to enclose and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components.
An arrow printed on the label (2) on the top of the ORC housing provides a visual verification of the
proper orientation of the unit, and should always be pointed toward the front of the vehicle. The
ORC housing has three integral mounting tabs and two integral locating pins. The molded plastic
electrical connector (3), with two receptacles containing numerous terminal pins, exits the rearward
facing side of the ORC housing. These terminal pins connect the ORC to the vehicle electrical
system through two dedicated take outs and connectors, one from the body wire harness and one
from the instrument panel wire harness.
The impact sensors internal to the ORC are calibrated for the specific vehicle, and are only
serviced as a unit with the ORC. In addition, there are unique versions of the ORC for vehicles with
or without side curtain airbags or seat (thorax) airbags, with or without third row seating as well as
for those vehicles with domestic or export applications. These variations are necessary for both
equipment needs and for compliance with certain regulatory requirements. The ORC cannot be
repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or ineffective, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Occupant Restraint Controller - Description > Page 7649
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation Occupant Restraint Controller - Operation
OPERATION
The microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) contains the Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) logic circuits and controls all of the SRS components. The ORC uses
On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) and can communicate with other electronic modules in the vehicle as
well as with the diagnostic scan tool using the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus. This
method of communication is used for control of the airbag indicator in the Electro Mechanical
Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) and for SRS
diagnosis and testing through the 16-way data link connector located on the driver side lower edge
of the instrument panel.
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the SRS electrical circuits to determine the
system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets an active and stored
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and sends electronic messages to the EMIC over the CAN data
bus to turn ON the airbag indicator. An active fault only remains for the duration of the fault, or in
some cases for the duration of the current ignition cycle, while a stored fault causes a DTC to be
stored in memory by the ORC. For some DTCs, if a fault does not recur for a number of ignition
cycles, the ORC will automatically erase the stored DTC. For other internal faults, the stored DTC
is latched forever.
The ORC receives battery current through two circuits; a fused ignition switch output (run) circuit
through a fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM), and a fused output (run-start) circuit
through a second fuse in the TIPM. The ORC receives ground through a ground circuit and take
out of the instrument panel wire harness that is secured by a ground screw to the body sheet
metal. These connections allow the ORC to be operational whenever the ignition switch is in the
START or ON positions.
The ORC also contains an energy-storage capacitor. When the ignition switch is in the START or
ON positions, this capacitor is continually being charged with enough electrical energy to deploy
the SRS components for up to one second following a battery disconnect or failure. The purpose of
the capacitor is to provide backup SRS protection in case there is a loss of battery current supply to
the ORC during an impact.
Various impact sensors within the ORC are continuously monitored by the ORC logic. These
internal sensors, along with several external impact sensor inputs allow the ORC to determine both
the severity of an impact and to verify the necessity for deployment of any airbags. Two remote
front impact sensors are located on the back of the front end module carrier to the right and left of
the cooling module near the front of the vehicle. The electronic impact sensors are accelerometers
that sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity
of an impact.
The ORC also monitors inputs from an internal rollover sensor and up to six additional remote side
impact sensors located on the left and right front door module carriers, on the right and left lower
C-pillars and, on vehicles equipped with optional third row seating, on the right and left quarter
inner panels to control deployment of the side curtain airbag units and seat (thorax) airbags.
The impact sensors within the ORC are electronic accelerometer sensors that provide an additional
logic input to the ORC microprocessor. These sensors are used to verify the need for a SRS
component deployment by also detecting impact energy of a lesser magnitude than that of the
primary electronic impact sensors, and must exceed a safing threshold in order for the airbags to
deploy. On vehicles equipped with side curtain airbags or seat airbags, a separate impact sensor
within the ORC provides confirmation to the ORC microprocessor of side impact forces. This
separate sensor is a bi-directional unit that detects impact forces from either side of the vehicle.
Pre-programmed decision algorithms in the ORC microprocessor determine when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the impact sensors indicate an impact that is severe enough to require SRS
protection and, based upon the severity of the monitored impact, determines the level of front
airbag deployment force required for each front seating position. When the programmed conditions
are met, the ORC sends the proper electrical signals to deploy the dual multistage front airbags at
the programmed force levels, the front seat belt tensioners, the seat airbags and either side curtain
airbag unit.
The hard wired inputs and outputs for the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic
tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information. However, conventional
diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the ORC or the electronic controls
or communication between other modules and devices that provide features of the SRS. The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the ORC or the electronic controls and
communication related to ORC operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with side curtain airbags, disable
the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
before attempting any Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) diagnosis or service. The ORC
contains a rollover sensor, which enables the system to deploy the side SRS components in the
event of a vehicle rollover event. If an ORC is accidentally rolled during service while still
connected to battery power, the side SRS components will deploy. Disconnect and isolate the
battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before
performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the Occupant Restraint Controller
(ORC), as it can damage the impact
sensor or affect its calibration. The ORC contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) components. If an ORC is accidentally dropped
during service, the module must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this
warning could result in accidental, incomplete, or improper SRS component deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Remove the mini console from the top of the floor panel
transmission tunnel (3). See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Lower Bin - Removal.
3. First disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (4), followed by the body wire
harness connector (5) from the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC) (2) connector receptacles located on the rearward facing side of the module. To
disconnect the wire harness connectors from the ORC, depress the release tab and lift the lever
arm to the fully open position on each connector.
4. Remove the three screws (1) that secure the ORC to the ORC bracket that is welded onto the
top of the floor panel transmission tunnel. 5. Lift the ORC far enough to disengage the locating pins
and remove the ORC from the bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Restraint Controller - Removal > Page 7652
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Occupant Restraint Controller - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with side curtain airbags, disable
the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
before attempting any Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) diagnosis or service. The ORC
contains a rollover sensor, which enables the system to deploy the side SRS components in the
event of a vehicle rollover event. If an ORC is accidentally rolled during service while still
connected to battery power, the side SRS components will deploy. Disconnect and isolate the
battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before
performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to
take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the Occupant Restraint Controller
(ORC), as it can damage the impact
sensor or affect its calibration. The ORC contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) components. If an ORC is accidentally dropped
during service, the module must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this
warning could result in accidental, incomplete, or improper SRS component deployment.
1. Carefully position the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (2) to the ORC bracket that is welded
onto the top of the floor panel transmission
tunnel. When the ORC is correctly positioned, the arrow on the ORC label will be pointed forward in
the vehicle and the locating pins on the bottom of the ORC will be engaged into the locating holes
in the ORC bracket.
2. Install and tighten the three screws (1) that secure the ORC to the ORC bracket. Tighten the
screws to 12.5 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: The lever arms of the wire harness connectors for the ORC MUST be in the unlatched
position before they are inserted into their
connector receptacles on the ORC or they may become damaged.
3. First reconnect the body wire harness connector (5), followed by the instrument panel wire
harness connector (4) to the ORC connector receptacles
located on the rearward facing side of the module. Be certain that the latches on both connectors
are each fully engaged.
4. Reinstall the mini console onto the top of the floor panel transmission tunnel. See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Lower Bin - Installation.
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
NOTE: Service replacement ORC modules are shipped in a LOCKED OUT state and after installed
will set a ORC UNLOCKED - ALL
DEPLOYMENT DISABLED fault. Use a diagnostic scan tool to access the ORC module and go to
the MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS menu item to perform the MODULE INITIALIZATION
procedure to erase the fault and initialize the new replacement ORC.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Child Seat Anchor - Description
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Description and Operation Child Seat Anchor - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Lower Anchors and Tether for Children, or LATCH child restraint
anchorage system. The LATCH system provides for the installation of suitable child restraints in
certain seating positions without using the standard equipment seat belt provided for that seating
position. The second row seats in this vehicle are equipped with three fixed-position child restraint
upper tether anchors and five child restraint lower anchors. These anchorages allow for the
installation of suitable child restraints to be installed in either both second row outboard seating
positions or in just the second row center seating position.
The second row upper tether anchors (1) are integral to the seat cushion frames (2). These
anchors are each constructed from a heavy-gauge steel wire loop that is securely welded to the
seat cushion frame. The second row child restraint upper tether anchors cannot be adjusted or
repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, they must be replaced as a unit with their respective
second row seat cushion frame unit.
The lower anchors (4) for this vehicle are also integral to their respective second row seat cushion
frame. Sewn tags (2) with an embroidered child seat icon on the second row seat back trim cover
(1) help identify the anchor locations because they may be otherwise difficult to see with the seat
back in the upright position. These anchors are also constructed from a heavy-gauge steel wire
loop that is securely welded to the seat cushion frame. They are each accessed from the front of
the second row seat, where the seat back meets the seat cushion (3). These lower anchors cannot
be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, they must be replaced as a unit with the
second row seat cushion frame unit.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Child Seat Anchor - Description > Page 7659
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Description and Operation Child Seat Anchor - Operation
OPERATION
All vehicles manufactured for sale in the United States and Canada are required to be equipped
with a Lower Anchors and Tether for Children, or LATCH child restraint anchorage system. The
second row seats in this vehicle has two pairs of anchor provisions for installing a
LATCH-compatible child seat in each outboard seating position. Also, a single center anchor
provision may be used in combination with the inboard anchor for either outboard seating position
allowing a single seat to be mounted in the second row center seating position.
With LATCH, child seats are secured by direct attachment to the vehicle seat structure, rather than
by the seat belts. With LATCH-compatible child seats, lower anchors attach to the seat structure
through heavy-gauge wire loops located at the intersection between the seat cushion and the seat
back surfaces.
Upper tether anchors are integral to the second row seat cushion frames to secure the top tether
strap of child seats equipped with this feature. These upper tether anchors work with both
LATCH-compatible and other child seats equipped with a top tether strap.
The owner's information packet in the vehicle glove box contains details and suggestions on the
proper use of all of the factory-installed child restraint anchors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Seat Belt: Service and Repair
WEB STOP BUTTON REPLACEMENT
The webbing of the second row center seat belt tip half for this vehicle is equipped with a molded
plastic web stop button, which holds the latch plate of the seat belt tip half in a readily accessible
stored position and prevents it from falling to the lower belt anchor while the belt is not in use. If this
button becomes damaged or separated from the belt webbing, it may be successfully replaced
using the following procedure without the need for removing or replacing the entire seat belt
assembly.
The web stop button replacement kit includes two molded plastic replacement button halves: a
male button half with a pointed spike in its center, and a female button half with a hole in its center.
The button halves are not available separately. In addition to the button replacement kit, a pair of
wheel weight pliers (such as KD Tools(R) #3358, Snap-on(R) #WWPR13A or equivalent) and a
gel-type super adhesive glue (such as Mopar(R) Bond-All Gel #04467709 or equivalent) are
required.
NOTE: Avoid using heavy-duty, truck-style wheel weight pliers as the jaws may not close far
enough to successfully complete web stop button
replacement.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Carefully inspect the seat belt webbing to identify the hole or a witness mark where the original
web stop button halves (2 and 5) were installed. If
no distinct evidence of the prior button location is found, go to Step 2. If the original button location
is clearly evident, go to Step 3.
2. Find the appropriate dimension in the Web Stop Button Location table. Measure and mark that
distance (4) in the center of the belt webbing from
the point where the webbing is secured to the seat belt lower anchor plate (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 7663
CAUTION: Be certain that the seat belt latch plate (1) is located and secured above the web stop
button location mark before installing the
replacement button.
3. Working from the side of the seat belt webbing that faces the interior of the vehicle, pierce the
webbing with the spike in the center of the male
button half. The male button head should face the interior of the vehicle.
4. Apply a small dot of gel-type super adhesive glue (2) around the center hole on the back side of
the female button half (1). 5. Press the female button half over the spike of the male button half that
protrudes through the side of the belt webbing that faces away from the
interior of the vehicle.
6. Use the flat anvil-like jaw (3) of the wheel weight pliers to flatten the sharp spike (2) of the male
button half that protrudes through the female
button half (1) on the back side of the belt webbing (4).
7. Carefully use the curved jaw (3) of the wheel weight pliers to compress and form the flattened
spike of the male button half (2) on the back side of
the seat belt webbing (1) until it is concave and entirely below the outer convex surface of the
female button half.
8. Check to be certain that the web stop button is secure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Seat Belt Buckle - Removal
Front
FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the front seat from the vehicle.
See: Body and Frame/Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 3. Remove the
screw (3) that secures the front seat belt buckle (1) lower anchor to the bracket at the back of the
inboard seat track. 4. Remove the buckle from the front seat.
Second Row - Center
SECOND ROW - CENTER
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal > Page 7668
1. Move the second row right seat to the fully rearward position. 2. Move the second row left seat to
the fully forward position. 3. Remove the plastic push-in fastener (3) that secures the outboard
center seat back hinge bracket outboard trim (2) over the buckle (1) anchor to the
left rear corner of the right seat frame.
4. Carefully pry the edges of the outboard center seat back hinge bracket outboard and inboard
trim halves away from each other at their front and
rear parting lines far enough to disengage the four integral latch features that secure the two halves
of the trim to each other.
5. Carefully pry the outboard center seat back hinge bracket outboard trim away from the hinge
bracket far enough to disengage the snap clip that
secures the center of the trim to the bracket.
6. Remove the outboard trim from over the buckle anchor on the left rear corner of the right seat
frame.
7. Remove the screw (2) that secures the buckle (1) lower anchor to the right seat frame. 8.
Disengage the buckle from the elastic loop (3) of the right seat cushion trim cover and remove the
buckle unit from the seat.
Second Row - Left
SECOND ROW - LEFT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal > Page 7669
1. Move the second row left seat to the fully rearward position. 2. Move the second row right seat to
the fully forward position. 3. Remove the screw (1) that secures the trim (2) over the buckle (3)
anchor to the right rear corner of the left seat frame. 4. Remove the trim over the buckle anchor
from the right rear corner of the left seat frame.
5. Remove the screw (1) that secures the buckle lower anchor (3) to the left seat frame. 6.
Disengage the buckle from the elastic loop (2) of the left seat cushion trim cover and remove the
buckle unit from the seat.
Second Row - Right
SECOND ROW - RIGHT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal > Page 7670
1. Move the second row right seat to the fully forward position. 2. Reach under the rear edge of the
second row right seat cushion frame just to the right of the lower end of the inboard center seat
back hinge
bracket (1) to access the right buckle lower anchor (3) and the center seat belt lower anchor (2).
3. Remove the screw (4) that secures the right buckle lower anchor and the center seat belt lower
anchor to the right seat cushion frame.
4. From the front of the second row right seat, disengage the buckle (2) from the elastic loop (3) of
the right seat cushion trim cover and pull the
buckle lower anchor out from between the right seat cushion and back trim covers.
Third Row
THIRD ROW
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal > Page 7671
1. Remove the third row seat cushion and cover from the rear floor panel (3) See: Body and
Frame/Seats/Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat
Cushion Cover - Removal.
2. Reach between the two third row seat back hinge brackets on the rear floor panel to access and
remove the screw (2) that secures the third row seat
belt buckle (1) anchor plate to the rear floor.
3. Remove the two buckles from the rear floor panel as a unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal > Page 7672
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Seat Belt Buckle - Installation
Front
FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Position the front seat belt buckle (1) lower anchor to the bracket at the back of the inboard seat
track. 2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the lower anchor to the seat track bracket.
Tighten the screw to 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.). 3. Reinstall the front seat into the vehicle. See: Body and
Frame/Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation. 4. Reconnect the battery negative
cable.
Second Row - Center
SECOND ROW - CENTER
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal > Page 7673
1. Engage the second row center seat belt buckle (1) through the elastic loop (3) of the right seat
cushion trim cover. 2. Position the buckle lower anchor to the left rear corner of the right seat
frame. 3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the buckle unit to the right seat frame.
Tighten the screw to 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.).
4. Position the outboard center seat back hinge bracket outboard trim (2) over the buckle (1)
anchor on the left rear corner of the right seat frame. 5. Using hand pressure, align and press the
outboard center seat back hinge bracket outboard trim toward the hinge bracket until the snap clip
that
secures the center of the trim snaps into the bracket.
6. Using hand pressure, squeeze the edges of the outboard center seat back hinge bracket
outboard and inboard trim halves together until the four
integral latch features that secure the two halves of the trim to each other are fully engaged.
7. Install the plastic push-in fastener (3) that secures the outboard center seat back hinge bracket
outboard trim over the buckle anchor. 8. Restore the second row left seat to the fully rearward
position.
Second Row - Left
SECOND ROW - LEFT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal > Page 7674
1. Engage the second row left seat belt buckle through the elastic loop (2) of the left seat cushion
trim cover. 2. Position the buckle lower anchor (3) to the right rear corner of the left seat frame. 3.
Install and tighten the screw (1) that secures the buckle unit to the left seat frame. Tighten the
screw to 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.).
4. Position the trim (2) over the buckle (3) anchor on the right rear corner of the left seat frame. 5.
Install and tighten the screw (1) that secures the trim over the buckle anchor. Tighten the screw
securely. 6. Restore the second row right seat to the fully rearward position.
Second Row - Right
SECOND ROW - RIGHT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal > Page 7675
1. From the front of the second row right seat, engage the second row right buckle (2) through the
elastic loop (3) of the right seat cushion trim cover
and insert the buckle lower anchor between the right seat cushion and back trim covers.
2. Reach under the rear edge of the second row right seat cushion frame just to the right of the
lower end of the inboard center seat back hinge
bracket (1) to position the buckle lower anchor (3) and the center seat belt lower anchor (2) to the
right seat frame.
3. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the buckle unit and the center seat belt lower
anchor to the right seat frame. Tighten the screw to 39
Nm (29 ft. lbs.).
4. Restore the second row right seat to the fully rearward position.
Third Row
THIRD ROW
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Removal > Page 7676
1. Reach between the two third row seat back hinge brackets on the rear floor panel (3) to position
the third row seat belt buckle (1) anchor plate to
the rear floor.
2. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the anchor plate to the rear floor panel. Tighten the
screw to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.). 3. Reinstall the third row seat cushion and cover onto the rear floor
panel (3) See: Body and Frame/Seats/Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat
Cushion Cover - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7680
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7681
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SWITCH-SEAT BELT-DRIVER - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Seat Belt Switch - Description
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation Seat Belt Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The seat belt switch (4) is a small, normally open, single pole, single throw, plunger (3) actuated,
momentary switch. One seat belt switch is installed on the seat belt retractor frame (2) over the
retractor spool (1) for the driver side front seat. The seat belt switch includes an integral connector
that is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the body wire
harness.
The seat belt switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire front
seat belt and retractor unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Seat Belt Switch - Description > Page 7684
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation Seat Belt Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The driver side front seat belt switch is designed to control a path to ground for the seat belt switch
sense input of the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM provides electronic driver
side seat belt switch status messages to the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also
known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The EMIC controls the seat belt indicator based upon the electronic driver side seat belt switch
status message inputs.
The seat belt switch plunger is actuated by the seat belt webbing wound onto the seat belt retractor
spool. When the seat belt tip-half webbing is pulled out of the retractor far enough to engage the
seat belt buckle-half, the switch plunger is extended and closes the seat belt switch sense circuit to
ground. Conversely, when the seat belt tip-half webbing is wound onto the retractor spool the
switch plunger is depressed, opening the ground path.
The seat belt switch is connected in series between ground and the seat belt switch sense input of
the TIPM. The seat belt switch receives ground through its connection to the body wire harness
from another take out of the body wire harness. An eyelet terminal connector on that ground take
out is secured under a ground screw. The TIPM monitors the condition of the driver seat belt switch
circuits and will send an electronic message to illuminate the airbag indicator in the EMIC then
store a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that is detected.
The hard wired circuits between the driver side seat belt switch and the TIPM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the switch
or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and devices that provide
features of the supplemental restraint system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to
diagnose the driver side seat belt switch or the electronic controls and communication related to
seat belt switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Seat Belt Turning Loop Adjuster - Removal
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair Seat Belt Turning Loop Adjuster - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Adjust the front seat to its most forward position for easiest access to the B-pillar trim. 2.
Remove the upper trim (4) from the B-pillar (1). See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Trim/B-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal.
3. Remove the screw that secures the seat belt turning loop (5) to the height adjuster (3) on the
upper B-pillar. 4. Remove the seat belt turning loop from the height adjuster. 5. Remove the screw
(2) that secures the top of the height adjuster to the B-pillar. 6. Disengage the tabs at the bottom of
the height adjuster from the slots in the B-pillar. 7. Remove the adjuster from the B-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Seat Belt Turning Loop Adjuster - Removal > Page 7689
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair Seat Belt Turning Loop Adjuster - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Position the seat belt turning loop height adjuster (3) to the upper inner B-pillar (1). 2. Engage
the tabs at the bottom of the height adjuster into the slots in the B-pillar. 3. Install and tighten the
screw (2) that secures the height adjuster to the B-pillar. Tighten the screw to 58 Nm (43 ft. lbs.). 4.
Position the seat belt turning loop onto the height adjuster on the upper B-pillar. Be certain the seat
belt webbing is not twisted between the turning
loop and the web guide or between the turning loop and the lower anchor.
5. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the turning loop to the height adjuster. Tighten the
screw to 37 Nm (27 ft. lbs.). 6. Reinstall the upper trim (4) onto the inside of the B-pillar. See: Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Trim/B-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Seat Belt Turning Loop Adjuster - Removal > Page 7690
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair Seat Belt Retractor - Removal
THIRD ROW TURNING LOOP BRACKET
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Unsnap and remove the trim cover (1) from the third row seat belt turning loop on the inside of
the upper D-pillar trim (3) to access the turning
loop screw (2).
2. Remove the screw (2) that secures the seat belt turning loop to the bracket on the inside of the
upper D-pillar. 3. Remove the turning loop from the D-pillar. 4. Remove the trim from the inside of
the upper D-pillar. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Pillar
Trim/D-Pillar Trim/Removal.
5. Remove the two screws (2) that secure the seat belt turning loop bracket (1) to the inside of the
upper D-pillar (3). 6. Remove the turning loop bracket from the D-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Seat Belt Turning Loop Adjuster - Removal > Page 7691
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair Seat Belt Retractor - Installation
THIRD ROW TURNING LOOP BRACKET
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Position the third row turning loop bracket (1) to the inside of the upper D-pillar (3). 2. Install and
tighten the two screws (2) that secure the turning loop bracket to the D-pillar. Tighten the screws to
22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.).
3. Reinstall the trim (3) onto the inside of the upper D-pillar. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding
/ Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Trim/D-Pillar Trim/Installation.
4. Position the seat belt turning loop to the inside of the upper D-pillar. Be certain the seat belt
webbing (5) is not twisted between the retractor and
the turning loop as well as between the turning loop and the lower anchor.
5. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the turning loop to the bracket on the inside of the
upper D-pillar. Tighten the screw to 43 Nm (32 ft.
lbs.).
6. Snap the trim cover (1) over the seat belt turning loop on the inside of the upper D-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Seat Belt Retractor - Description
Seat Belt Retractor: Description and Operation Seat Belt Retractor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The seat belt retractors used in all seating positions include an inertia-type, emergency locking
mechanism as standard equipment. However, the retractor locking mechanism for all seating
positions except the driver side front and the second row center are mechanically switchable from
an emergency locking retractor to an automatic locking retractor. The primary function of this
feature is to securely accommodate a child seat in these seating positions of the vehicle without the
need for a self-cinching seat belt tip half latch plate unit or another supplemental device that would
be required to prevent the seat belt webbing from unwinding freely from the retractor spool of an
inertia-type emergency locking retractor mechanism.
The automatic locking mechanism is integral to the seat belt retractor unit and is concealed
beneath a molded plastic cover located on the side of the retractor spool. The automatic locking
mechanism cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire seat belt and
retractor unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Seat Belt Retractor - Description > Page 7696
Seat Belt Retractor: Description and Operation Seat Belt Retractor - Operation
OPERATION
The locked mode of the retractor is engaged and the automatic locking retractor is switched from
operating as a standard inertia-type emergency locking retractor by first buckling the combination
lap and shoulder belt buckle. Then grasp the shoulder belt and pull all of the webbing out of the
retractor. Once all of the belt webbing is extracted from the spool, the retractor will automatically
become engaged in the pre-locked automatic locking mode and will make an audible clicking or
ratcheting sound as the shoulder belt is allowed to retract to confirm that the automatic locking
mode is now engaged. Once the automatic locking mode is engaged, the retractor will remain
locked and the belt will remain tight around whatever it is restraining.
The retractor is returned to standard emergency locking (inertia) mode by unbuckling the
combination lap and shoulder belt buckle and allowing the belt webbing to be almost fully retracted
onto the retractor spool. The emergency locking mode is confirmed by the absence of the audible
clicking or ratcheting sound as the belt webbing retracts. This mode will allow the belt to unwind
from and wind onto the retractor spool freely unless and until a predetermined inertia load is
sensed, or until the retractor is again switched to the automatic locking mode.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Seat Belt Retractor - Removal
Front
FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The following procedure is for replacement of an ineffective or damaged seat belt and
retractor unit. The front retractor also includes
a seat belt tensioner. If the front seat belt or retractor is ineffective or damaged, but the seat belt
tensioner is not deployed, review the recommended procedures for handling non-deployed
supplemental restraints. See: Service and Repair . If the seat belt tensioner has been deployed,
review the recommended procedures for service after a supplemental restraint deployment before
removing the unit from the vehicle. See: Service and Repair .
1. Adjust the front seat to its most forward position for easiest access to the front seat belt lower
anchor and the B-pillar trim. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes
for the system capacitor to discharge before further service. 3. Using a trim stick or another suitable
wide flat-bladed tool, gently pry the seat belt anchor cover (3) to remove it from the rear of the
outboard
front seat (2) side shield.
4. Remove the screw (4) that secures the front seat belt (1) lower anchor to the bracket on the
outboard side of the front seat cushion frame.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7699
5. Remove the lower and upper trim (4) from the B-pillar (1). See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Trim/B-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal.
6. Remove the screw (3) that secures the seat belt (5) turning loop to the height adjuster (2) on the
upper B-pillar. 7. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed tool, gently pry the seat belt
web guide (6) to unsnap it from the B-pillar.
8. Disconnect the body wire harness connector (1) from the seat belt tensioner initiator on the
retractor (3). 9. On the driver side only, disconnect the second body wire harness connector from
the seat belt switch connector receptacle on the retractor.
10. Remove the screw (4) that secures the lower retractor bracket to the inner B-pillar (2). 11.
Remove the front seat belt and retractor from the B-pillar as a unit.
Second Row - Center
SECOND ROW - CENTER
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7700
1. Remove the second row right seat from the vehicle. See: Body and Frame/Seats/Service and
Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 2. Reach under the rear edge of the second row right seat
cushion frame just to the right of the lower end of the inboard center seat back hinge
bracket (1) to access the right buckle lower anchor (3) and the center seat belt lower anchor (2).
3. Remove the screw (4) that secures the right buckle lower anchor and the center seat belt lower
anchor to the right seat cushion frame. 4. From the front of the second row right seat, pull the
center seat belt lower anchor out from between the right seat cushion and back trim covers.
5. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed tool, carefully pry the belt web guide bezel
(3) upward from the top of the right seat back
(2) far enough to disengage the three barrel clips that secure the bezel to the seat back frame.
6. Slide the center seat belt webbing (1) through the slot in the guide bezel to disengage the belt
from the bezel.
7. Remove the head rest, back panel and trim cover from the right seat back frame (1). It is not
necessary to remove the seat back frame from the seat
cushion frame. See: Body and Frame/Seats/Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back - Removal.
8. Remove the screws (4) that secure the molded plastic shield (5) to the top of the seat back
frame. Pull the top of the seat back foam away from the
seat back frame to access the lower screws securing the shield.
9. Remove the molded plastic shield from the top of the seat back frame.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7701
10. From the back side of the seat back frame, remove the screw (2) that secures the retractor (3)
to the frame. 11. Lift the retractor upward far enough to disengage the T-tab of the retractor bracket
from the keyed slot in the seat back frame. 12. Guide the seat belt webbing through the slot in the
top of the seat back frame while removing the seat belt and retractor from the seat as a unit.
Second Row - Outboard
SECOND ROW - OUTBOARD
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Loosen the front of the quarter trim panel from the lower C-pillar (1) enough to access the
second row outboard seat belt and retractor. See: Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
2. Remove the screw (4) that secures the second row outboard seat belt (2) lower anchor to the
rear floor panel (3) near the base of the C-pillar.
3. Remove the upper trim (6) from the inside of the C-pillar See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding
/ Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Trim/B-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal.
4. Remove the screw (1) that secures the seat belt turning loop to the inside of the upper C-pillar
(3). 5. Remove the seat belt turning loop from the C-pillar. 6. Using a trim stick or another suitable
wide flat-bladed tool, gently pry the seat belt web guide (2) to unsnap it from the quarter inner panel
near the
base of the C-pillar.
7. Remove the screw (4) that secures the retractor (5) bracket to the quarter inner panel. 8. Lift the
retractor upward far enough to disengage the retractor tab from the keyed hole in the quarter inner
panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7702
9. Remove the second row outboard seat belt and retractor from the vehicle as a unit.
Third Row Seat Belt and Retractor
THIRD ROW SEAT BELT AND RETRACTOR
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Remove the third row seat cushion and cover from the rear floor panel See: Body and
Frame/Seats/Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion
Cover - Removal.
2. Remove the screw (2) that secures the third row seat belt lower anchor (1) and the third row seat
back (3) outboard bracket to the rear floor panel. 3. Remove the lower anchor from the third row
seat back outboard bracket.
4. Unsnap and remove the trim cover (1) from the third row seat belt turning loop on the inside of
the upper D-pillar trim (3) to access the turning
loop screw (2).
5. Remove the screw (2) that secures the seat belt turning loop to the bracket on the inside of the
upper D-pillar. 6. Remove the turning loop from the D-pillar. 7. Remove the trim from the inside of
the upper D-pillar See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Pillar
Trim/D-Pillar Trim/Removal.
8. Loosen the rear of the quarter trim panel from the lower D-pillar enough to access the third row
outboard seat belt and retractor (7) See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter
Trim Panel - Removal.
9. Remove the screw (4) that secures the upper retractor bracket to the inside of the D-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7703
10. Remove the screw (6) that secures the lower retractor bracket to the inside of the D-pillar. 11.
Lift the retractor upward far enough to disengage the tab of the upper retractor bracket from the
keyed hole in the D-pillar. 12. Remove the third row seat belt and retractor from the vehicle as a
unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7704
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Seat Belt Retractor - Installation
Front
FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The following procedure is for replacement of an ineffective or damaged seat belt and
retractor unit. The front retractor also includes
a seat belt tensioner. If the front seat belt or retractor is ineffective or damaged, but the seat belt
tensioner is not deployed, review the recommended procedures for handling non-deployed
supplemental restraints. See: Service and Repair . If the seat belt tensioner has been deployed,
review the recommended procedures for service after a supplemental restraint deployment before
removing the unit from the vehicle. See: Service and Repair .
1. Position the front seat belt and retractor (3) to the inner B-pillar (2) as a unit. 2. On the driver side
only, reconnect the body wire harness connector to the seat belt switch connector receptacle on
the retractor. 3. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (1) to the seat belt tensioner initiator
on the retractor. 4. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the lower retractor bracket to the
inner B-pillar. Tighten the screw to 58 Nm (43 ft. lbs.). 5. Be certain to route the wiring for the seat
belt tensioner behind the B-pillar flange to ensure it does not interfere with the seat belt webbing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7705
6. Position the web guide (6) to the B-pillar (1). Be certain the seat belt webbing (5) is not twisted
between the retractor and the web guide. 7. Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly on the
web guide to snap it into place. 8. Position the seat belt turning loop onto the height adjuster (2) on
the upper B-pillar. Be certain the seat belt webbing is not twisted between the
web guide and the turning loop.
9. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the turning loop to the height adjuster. Tighten the
screw to 37 Nm (27 ft. lbs.).
10. Reinstall the upper (4) and lower trim onto the B-pillar. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Trim/B-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation.
11. Position the front seat belt (1) lower anchor to the bracket on the outboard side of the front seat
(2) cushion frame. Be certain the seat belt webbing
is not twisted between the turning loop and the lower anchor.
12. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the lower anchor to the bracket on the outboard
side of the front seat cushion frame. Tighten the screw
to 51 Nm (38 ft. lbs.).
13. Align the seat belt anchor cover (3) to the opening near the rear of the outboard seat side
shield. Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly on
the cover until it snaps into place.
14. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Second Row - Center
SECOND ROW - CENTER
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7706
1. Guide the seat belt webbing through the slot in the top of the right seat back frame (1) while
positioning the center seat belt and retractor (3) to the
frame as a unit. Be certain the seat belt webbing is not twisted between the retractor and the top of
the seat.
2. Engage the T-tab of the retractor bracket with the keyed slot in the seat back frame. 3. From the
back side of the seat back frame, install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the retractor to the
frame. Tighten the screw to 39 Nm (29
ft. lbs.).
4. Position the molded plastic shield (5) onto the top of the seat back frame. 5. Install and tighten
the screws (4) that secure the molded plastic shield to the top of the seat back frame. Pull the top
of the seat back foam away
from the seat back frame to access the lower screws securing the shield.
6. Reinstall the trim cover, back panel and head rest to the right seat back frame. See: Body and
Frame/Seats/Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat
Back - Installation.
7. Grasp the center seat belt webbing (1) between where it exits the top of the seat and the seat
belt latch plate and slide it through the slot in the belt
web guide bezel (3) to engage the belt through the bezel.
8. Position the guide bezel to the top of the right seat back (2) with the slot facing forward. 9. Using
hand pressure, press the guide bezel down onto the top of the right seat back far enough to
engage the three barrel clips that secure the bezel
to the seat back frame.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7707
10. From the front of the second row right seat, insert the center seat belt lower anchor between
the right seat cushion and back trim covers. Be certain
the seat belt webbing is not twisted between the top of the seat and the belt lower anchor.
11. Reach under the rear edge of the second row right seat cushion frame just to the right of the
lower end of the inboard center seat back hinge
bracket (1) to position the buckle lower anchor (3) and the center seat belt lower anchor (2) to the
right seat frame.
12. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the buckle unit and the center seat belt lower
anchor to the right seat frame. Tighten the screw to 39
Nm (29 ft. lbs.).
13. Reinstall the second row right seat into the vehicle. See: Body and Frame/Seats/Service and
Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation.
Second Row - Outboard
SECOND ROW - OUTBOARD
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Position the second row outboard seat belt and retractor (5) to the quarter inner panel just below
the base of the upper C-pillar (3) as a unit. 2. Engage the tab on the retractor bracket into the
keyed hole in the quarter inner panel. 3. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the retractor
to the quarter inner panel. Tighten the screw to 58 Nm (43 ft. lbs.). 4. Position the web guide (2) to
the quarter inner panel near the base of the C-pillar. Be certain the seat belt webbing is not twisted
between the
retractor and the web guide.
5. Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly on the web guide to snap it into place. 6. Position
the seat belt turning loop to the inside of the upper C-pillar. Be certain the seat belt webbing is not
twisted between the web guide and the
turning loop.
7. Install and tighten the screw (1) that secures the turning loop to the C-pillar. Tighten the screw to
43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7708
8. Reinstall the upper trim (2) onto the inside of the C-pillar (5). See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Trim/C-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation.
9. Position the lower seat belt (2) anchor to the rear floor panel (3) near the base of the lower
C-pillar (1). Be certain the seat belt webbing is not
twisted between the turning loop and the lower anchor.
10. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the lower seat belt anchor to the floor. Tighten the
screw to 58 Nm (43 ft. lbs.). 11. Reinstall the front of the quarter trim panel onto the lower C-pillar.
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
Third Row Seat Belt and Retractor
THIRD ROW SEAT BELT AND RETRACTOR
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury during and following any seat belt or child restraint
anchor service, carefully inspect all seat belts,
buckles, mounting hardware, retractors, tether straps, and anchors for proper installation,
operation, or damage. Replace any belt that is cut, frayed, or torn. Straighten any belt that is
twisted. Tighten any loose fasteners. Replace any belt that has a damaged or ineffective buckle or
retractor. Replace any belt that has a bent or damaged latch plate or anchor plate. Replace any
child restraint anchor or the unit to which the anchor is integral that has been bent or damaged.
Never attempt to repair a seat belt or child restraint component. Always replace damaged or
ineffective seat belt and child restraint components with the correct, new and unused replacement
parts listed in the Chrysler Mopar (R) Parts Catalog. Failure to follow these instructions may result
in possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Position the third row seat belt and retractor (7) to the inside of the D-pillar (5) as a unit. 2.
Engage the tab of the upper retractor bracket into the keyed hole in the D-pillar. 3. Install and
tighten the screw (6) that secures the lower retractor bracket to the inside of the D-pillar. Tighten
the screw to 58 Nm (43 ft. lbs.). 4. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the upper retractor
bracket to the inside of the D-pillar. Tighten the screw to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.). 5. Reinstall the rear of
the quarter trim panel to the lower D-pillar See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and
Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
6. Reinstall the trim (3) onto the inside of the upper D-pillar See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding
/ Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat Belt Retractor - Removal > Page 7709
Trim/D-Pillar Trim/Installation.
7. Position the seat belt turning loop to the inside of the upper D-pillar. Be certain the seat belt
webbing (5) is not twisted between the retractor and
the turning loop.
8. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the turning loop to the bracket on the inside of the
upper D-pillar. Tighten the screw to 43 Nm (32 ft.
lbs.).
9. Snap the trim cover (1) over the seat belt turning loop on the inside of the upper D-pillar.
10. Position the seat belt lower anchor (1) to the third row seat back (3) outboard bracket on the
rear floor panel. Be certain the seat belt webbing is
not twisted between the turning loop and the lower anchor.
11. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the lower anchor and the third row seat back
outboard bracket to the rear floor panel. Tighten the
screw to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
12. Reinstall the third row seat cushion and cover to the rear floor panel See: Body and
Frame/Seats/Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion
Cover - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Seat Belt Tensioner
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Seat Belt Tensioner > Page 7714
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Seat Belt Tensioner (Body) 2 Way
Seat Belt Tensioner: Diagrams Driver Seat Belt Tensioner (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SEAT BELT-TENSIONER-DRIVER - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Seat Belt Tensioner (Body) 2 Way > Page 7717
Seat Belt Tensioner: Diagrams Passenger Seat Belt Tensioner (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SEAT BELT-TENSIONER-PASSENGER - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Seat Belt Tensioner - Description
Seat Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation Seat Belt Tensioner - Description
DESCRIPTION
The seat belt tensioners are integral to the front seat belt retractor units (4), which are secured to
the inner B-pillar on the right and left sides of the vehicle.
The seat belt tensioner consists primarily of a sprocket/pinion, a steel tube (3), a cast metal
housing, numerous steel balls, a stamped metal ball trap (2), a torsion bar and a small
pyrotechnically activated gas generator with a connector receptacle (1). All of these components
are located on one side of the retractor spool on the outside of the retractor housing except for the
torsion bar, which serves as the spindle upon which the retractor spool rides. The seat belt
tensioners are controlled by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) and are connected to the
vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out of the body wire harness by a keyed and
latching yellow molded plastic connector insulator to ensure a secure connection.
The seat belt tensioners cannot be repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire front seat belt
and retractor unit must be replaced. If the front airbags have been deployed, the seat belt
tensioners have also been deployed. The seat belt tensioners are not intended for reuse and must
be replaced following any front airbag deployment. A growling or grinding sound while attempting to
operate the seat belt retractor is a sure indication that the seat belt tensioner has been deployed
and requires replacement. See: Seat Belt Retractor/Service and Repair/Seat Belt Retractor Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Seat Belt Tensioner - Description > Page 7720
Seat Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation Seat Belt Tensioner - Operation
OPERATION
The seat belt tensioners are deployed in conjunction with the dual front airbags by a signal
generated by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) through the driver or passenger seat belt
tensioner line 1 and line 2 (or squib) circuits. They may also be deployed in certain vehicle rollover
events in conjunction with the side curtain airbags and the seat (thorax) airbags. When the ORC
sends the proper electrical signal to the tensioners, the electrical energy generates enough heat to
initiate a small pyrotechnic gas generator.
The gas generator is installed in one end of a steel tube that contains numerous steel balls. As the
gas expands, it pushes the steel balls through the tube into a cast metal housing, where a ball
guide directs the balls into engagement with the teeth of a sprocket that is geared to one end of the
retractor spool. As the balls drive past the sprocket, the sprocket turns and drives the seat belt
retractor spool causing the slack to be removed from the front seat belts. The ball trap captures the
balls as they leave the sprocket and are expelled from the housing.
Removing excess slack from the front seat belts not only keeps the occupants properly positioned
for an airbag deployment following a frontal impact of the vehicle, but also helps to reduce injuries
that the occupant might experience in these situations as a result of harmful contact with the
steering wheel, steering column, instrument panel or windshield. Also, the seat belt tensioner
torsion bar that the retractor spool rides upon is designed to deform in order to control the loading
being applied to the occupants by the seat belts during a frontal impact, further reducing the
potential for occupant injuries.
The ORC monitors the condition of the seat belt tensioners through circuit resistance, and will
illuminate the airbag indicator in the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as
the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) and store a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that is
detected. Proper diagnosis of the seat belt tensioner gas generator and the seat belt tensioner
squib circuits requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic
information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor > Page 7725
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way
Seat Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Driver Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-DRIVER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way > Page 7728
Seat Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Passenger Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-PASSENGER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7734
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7735
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7736
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7737
Impact Sensor: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7738
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7739
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7740
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7741
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7742
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7743
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Impact Sensor > Page 7744
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7747
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Right Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-RIGHT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7748
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Left Side Impact Sensor 1 (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1 - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7749
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Left Side Impact Sensor 3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7750
Impact Sensor: Diagrams
Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Right Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-RIGHT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7751
Left Side Impact Sensor 1 (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1 - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Left Side Impact Sensor 3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7752
Right Side Impact Sensor 1 (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 1 - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Right Side Impact Sensor 3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7753
Left Side Impact Sensor 2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Right Side Impact Sensor 2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Impact Sensor (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 7754
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Impact Sensor - Description
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
Two acceleration-type front impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle, one each for the left and
right sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is
internal to the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each front sensor is secured with a screw to
the back of the front end module carrier on either outboard side of the cooling module, just inboard
of each front lamp unit housing within the engine compartment. The sensor housing has an integral
connector receptacle (3), an integral locating and anti-rotation pin, and an integral mounting hole
(2).
The right and left front impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration. A cavity in the
center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the sensor
which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. The cavity is
filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components.
The front impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the front end module wire harness.
These acceleration-type front impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or
ineffective, they must be replaced.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
Two pressure-type front door side impact sensors (2) are used on this vehicle when it is equipped
with the side curtain airbags or the optional seat (also known as thorax) airbags, one each for the
left and right sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that
is internal to the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each side sensor is secured with two
screws and is sealed by a resilient gasket (1) to the front door module carrier on the inside of the
front door. The sensors are concealed behind the front door trim panel within the passenger
compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 7757
The right and left front door side impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration. The
impact sensor housing has an integral connector receptacle (3), two integral mounting tabs, and an
integral hood-like water shield (4) that extends through a hole in the front door module carrier into
the interior of the door cavity and protects the sensor orifice from contamination. A cavity in the
center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the sensor,
which includes an electronic communication chip and the pressure sensor. The housing cavity is
filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components. A
label on the sensor has a directional arrow and the word down imprinted upon it to provide
verification of the correct sensor orientation in the vehicle. The side impact sensors are each
connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the front
door wire harness.
These pressure-type front door side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if
damaged or ineffective, they must be replaced.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
Two acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle when it
is equipped with the side curtain airbags, one each for the left and right sides of the vehicle. These
sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is internal to the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC). Each side sensor is secured with a screw to the lower C-pillar just above the rear
door opening sill within the passenger compartment. The sensor housing has an integral connector
receptacle (3), an integral locating anti-rotation pin, and an integral mounting hole (2).
The right and left second row seating side impact sensors are identical in construction and
calibration. However, the connector orientation in the vehicle is reversed. The connector receptacle
faces forward on the right side of the vehicle, and faces rearward on the left side of the vehicle. A
cavity in the center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of
the sensor which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. The
cavity is filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and
components. The second row seating side impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness.
These acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted
and, if damaged or ineffective, they must be replaced.
Side - Third Row Seating
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 7758
Two acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle when it is
equipped with the side curtain airbags and seven-passenger seating, one each for the left and right
sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is internal to
the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each side sensor is secured with a screw to the right or
left quarter inner panel just above the right or left rear wheel housing within the passenger
compartment. The sensor housing has an integral connector receptacle (3), an integral locating
anti-rotation pin, and an integral mounting hole (2).
The right and left third row seating side impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration.
However, the connector orientation in the vehicle is reversed. The connector receptacle faces
forward on the right side of the vehicle, and faces rearward on the left side of the vehicle. A cavity
in the center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the
sensor which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. The
cavity is filled with a potting material to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and
components. The third row seating side impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle electrical
system through a dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness.
These acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and,
if damaged or ineffective, they must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 7759
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Impact Sensor - Operation
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
The acceleration-type front impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that sense the rate of
vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity of an impact. Each
sensor also contains an electronic communication chip that allows the unit to communicate the
sensor status as well as sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the front passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and commands the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The
impact sensors each receive battery current and ground through dedicated left and right sensor
plus and minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by
modulating the current in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the acceleration-type front impact sensors and the ORC may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and
devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most reliable,
efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls and
communication related to acceleration-type front impact sensor operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
The pressure-type front door side impact sensors recognize a side impact in the front door area by
monitoring changes in pressure within the front door cavity, which manifests itself as a sudden
pressure wave as the door collapses during an impact. Each sensor also contains an electronic
communication chip that allows the unit to communicate the sensor status as well as sensor fault
information to the microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through dedicated left and right sensor plus and
minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating the
current in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the pressure-type front door side impact sensors and the ORC
may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate
wiring information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the
diagnosis of the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the pressure-type front door side impact
sensors or the electronic controls and communication related to side impact sensor operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
The acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that
sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity of an
impact. Each sensor also contains an electronic communication chip that allows the unit to
communicate the sensor status as well as sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through the dedicated left and right sensor plus
and minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating
the voltage in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensors and
the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive
in the diagnosis of the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls
and communication related to acceleration-type second row seating side impact sensor operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Side - Third Row Seating
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Impact Sensor - Description > Page 7760
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
The acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that
sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity of an
impact. Each sensor also contains an electronic communication chip that allows the unit to
communicate the sensor status as well as sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through the dedicated left and right sensor plus
and minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating
the voltage in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensors and
the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive
in the diagnosis of the impact sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls
and communication related to acceleration-type third row seating side impact sensor operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Impact Sensor - Removal
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the front impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The front impact sensor enables the system to deploy the front Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper front SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Service access for the front impact sensors is accomplished by
reaching behind the front end module carrier (2) from the top of the engine
compartment and between the inboard end of either front lamp unit housing (3) and either outboard
end of the cooling module.
3. For the left front impact sensor only, remove the fresh air intake snorkel and the air filter housing
from behind the front end module carrier for
service access.
4. Disconnect the front end module wire harness connector (5) from the connector receptacle of the
right or left front impact sensor (1). 5. Remove the screw (4) that secures the front impact sensor to
the back (engine compartment side) of the front end module carrier. 6. Pull the front impact sensor
straight back from the mounting location to disengage the anti-rotation pin on the base of the
sensor from the clearance
hole in the front end module carrier.
7. Remove the right or left front impact sensor from the engine compartment.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7763
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Remove the trim panel from the inside of the right or left front
door. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the front door wire harness connector (3) from the side impact sensor (1) connector
receptacle. 4. Remove the two screws (2) that secure the side impact sensor to the front door
module carrier panel (4). 5. Remove the side impact sensor from the door.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Open the sliding door. 3. Remove the quarter trim panel from
the lower C-pillar (1).See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
4. Disconnect the body wire harness connector (4) from the side impact sensor (3) connector
receptacle. 5. Remove the screw (2) that secures the side impact sensor to the lower C-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7764
6. Pull the side impact sensor straight out from the mounting location to unsnap the anti-rotation pin
on the base of the sensor from the clearance hole
in the lower C-pillar.
7. Remove the side impact sensor from the vehicle.
Side - Third Row Seating
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Remove the quarter trim panel from the quarter inner panel
over the rear wheel housing (1). See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the body wire harness connector (2) from the side impact sensor (4) above the rear
wheel housing on the quarter inner panel. 4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the side impact
sensor to the quarter inner panel. 5. Pull the side impact sensor straight out from the mounting
location to disengage the anti-rotation pin on the base of the sensor from the clearance
hole in the quarter inner panel.
6. Remove the side impact sensor from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7765
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Impact Sensor - Installation
Vehicle Front
VEHICLE FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the front impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The front impact sensor enables the system to deploy the front Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper front SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Service access for the front impact sensors is accomplished by reaching behind the front end
module carrier (2) from the top of the engine
compartment and between the inboard end of either front lamp unit housing (3) and either outboard
end of the cooling module.
2. Position the right or left front impact sensor (1) into the engine compartment. 3. Align and insert
the anti-rotation pin on the base of the sensor into the clearance hole on the back (engine
compartment side) of the front end
module carrier.
4. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the front impact sensor to the front end module
carrier. Tighten the screw to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 5. Reconnect the front end module wire harness
connector (5) to the connector receptacle of the front impact sensor. 6. For the left front impact
sensor only, reinstall the fresh air intake snorkel and the air filter housing behind the front end
module carrier. 7. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental
Restraint System (SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Side - Front Door
SIDE - FRONT DOOR
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7766
NOTE: Be certain that the gasket between the pressure-type side impact sensor and the front door
module carrier panel is in good condition
and positioned on the back of the sensor. There MUST be a good seal between the sensor and the
module carrier panel for the sensor to operate properly. If the gasket is in poor condition, replace
the sensor.
1. Position the side impact sensor (1) to the right or left front door module carrier panel (4). When
the sensor is correctly positioned, the arrow on the
sensor label will be pointed toward the bottom of the door.
2. Install and tighten the two screws (2) that secure the side impact sensor to the door. Tighten the
screws to 2.4 Nm (21 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the front door wire harness connector (3) to the sensor
connector receptacle. 4. Reinstall the trim panel onto the inside of the right or left front door. See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Installation.
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Side - Second Row Seating
SIDE - SECOND ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Impact Sensor - Removal > Page 7767
1. Position the side impact sensor (3) to the lower C-pillar (1). 2. Align the anti-rotation pin on the
base of the sensor with the clearance hole in the lower C-pillar, then press on the sensor firmly and
evenly to snap
the pin into place.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the side impact sensor to the lower C-pillar. Tighten
the screw to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (4) to the side
impact sensor on the lower C-pillar. 5. Reinstall the quarter trim panel onto the lower C-pillar. See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
6. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Side - Third Row Seating
SIDE - THIRD ROW SEATING
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its
calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to deploy the side Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) components. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the sensor
must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in
accidental, incomplete, or improper side SRS component deployment.
NOTE: The front and the second or third row seating side impact sensors are interchangeable.
1. Position the side impact sensor (4) to the quarter inner panel above the rear wheel housing (1).
2. Align the anti-rotation pin on the base of the sensor with the clearance hole in the quarter inner
panel, then press on the sensor firmly and evenly to
snap the pin into place.
3. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the side impact sensor to the quarter inner panel.
Tighten the screw to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (2) to the
side impact sensor on the quarter inner panel. 5. Reinstall the quarter trim panel onto the quarter
inner panel over the rear wheel housing. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
6. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7771
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7772
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
SWITCH-SEAT BELT-DRIVER - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Seat Belt Switch - Description
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation Seat Belt Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The seat belt switch (4) is a small, normally open, single pole, single throw, plunger (3) actuated,
momentary switch. One seat belt switch is installed on the seat belt retractor frame (2) over the
retractor spool (1) for the driver side front seat. The seat belt switch includes an integral connector
that is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the body wire
harness.
The seat belt switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire front
seat belt and retractor unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Seat Belt Switch - Description > Page 7775
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation Seat Belt Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The driver side front seat belt switch is designed to control a path to ground for the seat belt switch
sense input of the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM provides electronic driver
side seat belt switch status messages to the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also
known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The EMIC controls the seat belt indicator based upon the electronic driver side seat belt switch
status message inputs.
The seat belt switch plunger is actuated by the seat belt webbing wound onto the seat belt retractor
spool. When the seat belt tip-half webbing is pulled out of the retractor far enough to engage the
seat belt buckle-half, the switch plunger is extended and closes the seat belt switch sense circuit to
ground. Conversely, when the seat belt tip-half webbing is wound onto the retractor spool the
switch plunger is depressed, opening the ground path.
The seat belt switch is connected in series between ground and the seat belt switch sense input of
the TIPM. The seat belt switch receives ground through its connection to the body wire harness
from another take out of the body wire harness. An eyelet terminal connector on that ground take
out is secured under a ground screw. The TIPM monitors the condition of the driver seat belt switch
circuits and will send an electronic message to illuminate the airbag indicator in the EMIC then
store a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that is detected.
The hard wired circuits between the driver side seat belt switch and the TIPM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the switch
or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and devices that provide
features of the supplemental restraint system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to
diagnose the driver side seat belt switch or the electronic controls and communication related to
seat belt switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Seat Track Position Sensor - Description
Seat Position Sensor: Description and Operation Seat Track Position Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The seat track position sensor (2) is a Hall Effect-type sensor used on some vehicles. This sensor
consists of a Hall Effect Integrated Circuit (IC) chip encased in potting material within a cavity of the
molded plastic sensor housing.
The sensor housing has a mounting slot containing an integral latch feature (1) and slides and
latches onto a stamped metal blade-type bracket located on the inboard side of the upper inboard
seat adjuster track near the rear of the driver side front seat. A molded connector receptacle (3)
integral to the sensor housing is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a connector
and take out of the driver side front seat wire harness beneath the front seat cushion frame.
The seat track position sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
entire sensor must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Seat Track Position Sensor - Description > Page 7780
Seat Position Sensor: Description and Operation Seat Track Position Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The seat track position sensor is designed to provide a seat position data input to the Occupant
Restraint Controller (ORC) indicating whether the driver side front seat is in a full forward or a not
full forward position. The ORC uses this data as an additional logic input for use in determining the
appropriate deployment force to be used when deploying the multistage driver airbag.
The seat track position sensor receives a nominal five volt supply from the ORC. The sensor
communicates the seat position by modulating the voltage returned to the ORC on a sensor data
circuit. The ORC also monitors the condition of the sensor circuits and will store a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that is detected. The ORC sends messages over the CAN data
bus to control the illumination of the airbag indicator in the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN).
The hard wired circuits between the seat track position sensor and the ORC may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the seat
track position sensor or the electronic controls and communication between other modules and
devices that provide features of the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). The most reliable,
efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the seat track position sensor or the electronic controls
and communication related to seat track position sensor operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Track Position Sensor - Removal
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair Seat Track Position Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting
any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel
component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or
service. This is the only sure way to disable the supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the
proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service. 2. Reach under the rear edge of the front seat cushion to access
the seat track position sensor (2) on a bracket (1) located on the inboard side near the
rear of the upper inboard seat track (4).
3. Using a small screwdriver, hold the latch feature (3) depressed while sliding the connector end of
the sensor off of the bracket. 4. Disconnect the seat wire harness connector (5) from the sensor
connector receptacle. 5. Remove the sensor from under the front seat.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Track Position Sensor - Removal > Page 7783
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair Seat Track Position Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting
any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel
component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or
service. This is the only sure way to disable the supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the
proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Reach under the rear edge of the front seat cushion to reconnect the seat wire harness
connector (5) to the seat track position sensor (2) connector
receptacle. Be certain that the latch on the connector is fully engaged.
2. Align the open end of the sensor to the blade of the sensor bracket (1) located on the inboard
side near the rear of the upper inboard seat track (4). 3. Push the sensor firmly onto the bracket
until the latch feature (3) snaps into place with an audible click. 4. Do not reconnect the battery
negative cable at this time. The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) verification test procedure
should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Service and Repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor > Page 7788
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way
Seat Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Driver Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-DRIVER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way > Page 7791
Seat Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Passenger Seat Track Position Sensor (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-PASSENGER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7797
Antenna, Navigation: Diagrams
Connector (COMPONENT SIDE) - (GPS ANTENNA) 2 WAY
ANTENNA-NAVIGATION (COMPONENT SIDE) - (GPS ANTENNA) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Phone > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Navigation Antenna - Removal
Antenna, Phone: Service and Repair Navigation Antenna - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel center bezel.
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Remove the radio. See: Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Radio - Removal. 4. Remove the defroster grille. See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Air Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille - Removal. 5. Remove the
GPS antenna mounting fasteners and remove the antenna.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Phone > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Navigation Antenna - Removal > Page 7802
Antenna, Phone: Service and Repair Navigation Antenna - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the GPS antenna and mounting fasteners. 2. Install the defroster grille. See: Heating and
Air Conditioning/Air Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille - Installation. 3. Install the radio.
See: Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Radio - Installation. 4. Install the instrument panel center bezel. See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Installation.
5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, TV > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, TV > Component Information >
Diagrams > Satellite Video Antenna 1 (Body) 2 Way
Antenna, TV: Diagrams Satellite Video Antenna 1 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
ANTENNA-SATELLITE VIDEO 1 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, TV > Component Information >
Diagrams > Satellite Video Antenna 1 (Body) 2 Way > Page 7808
Antenna, TV: Diagrams Satellite Video Antenna 2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
ANTENNA-SATELLITE VIDEO 2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, TV > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Satellite Video Antenna - Description
Antenna, TV: Description and Operation Satellite Video Antenna - Description
DESCRIPTION
The satellite video antenna cable connects the roof mounted antenna to the satellite receiver. It has
two connectors at each end and is routed above the headliner, then down the right side A-pillar to
the cowl area.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, TV > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Satellite Video Antenna - Description > Page 7811
Antenna, TV: Description and Operation Satellite Video Antenna - Operation
OPERATION
The satellite video antenna receives signals from orbiting satellites and sends these signals to the
satellite receiver module. The satellite video antenna must have open space in which to operate.
Items carried on the roof, parking inside etc. can have an effect on the antenna's ability to receive
signals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, TV > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Satellite Video Antenna - Removal
Antenna, TV: Service and Repair Satellite Video Antenna - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Lower the appropriate portion of the
headliner as necessary, to access the underside of the antenna. 3. Disconnect the electrical
connectors from the antenna. 4. Remove the fastener and retainer. 5. From inside the vehicle,
using a flat bladed tool, depress one of the retaining tabs on the antenna. Push up one side of the
antenna connector
through the roof panel. Depress the other side of the connector and remove the antenna.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, TV > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Satellite Video Antenna - Removal > Page 7814
Antenna, TV: Service and Repair Satellite Video Antenna - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. From inside the vehicle, using a flat bladed tool, depress one of the retaining tabs on the
antenna. Push up one side of the antenna connector
through the roof panel. Depress the other side of the connector and remove the antenna.
2. Connect the electrical connector to the antenna. 3. Install the headliner See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner - Installation. 4. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Keyless Start Antenna > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Remote Start Antenna - Description
Keyless Start Antenna: Description and Operation Remote Start Antenna - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Remote Start Antenna Module Assembly consists of an electrical connection to the Wireless
Ignition Node (WIN) (1), a length of coaxial cable (2), two mounting clips (3 and 4) and a control
module/antenna (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Keyless Start Antenna > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Remote Start Antenna - Description > Page 7819
Keyless Start Antenna: Description and Operation Remote Start Antenna - Operation
OPERATION
The remote start antenna is an external hidden antenna located at the driver's side front of dash.
The antenna interfaces with the Wireless Integration Node (WIN) through a coaxial electrical cable
and electrical connector. The antenna helps to amplify the signal for the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) key fob.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Keyless Start Antenna > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Remote Start Antenna - Removal
Keyless Start Antenna: Service and Repair Remote Start Antenna - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Wait two minutes for the system reserve capacitor to discharge before servicing any
airbag components. Failure to do this may
result in serious or fatal injury.
The remote start antenna is located driver's side front of dash.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove radio. Refer to See: Radio, Stereo,
and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Radio - Removal.
3. Remove instrument cluster. Refer to See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning
Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and
Repair/Instrument Cluster - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument panel top pad. Refer to See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Pad - Removal.
NOTE: During removal of the remote start antenna note the routing location of the coaxial cable.
5. Disconnect remote start antenna coaxial cable connector (1) from skreem module (3). 6.
Remove the mounting clip (2).
7. Remove the mounting clip at the steering column reinforcement bracket. 8. Remove screws (1)
and remove remote start antenna (2) from instrument panel assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Keyless Start Antenna > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Remote Start Antenna - Removal > Page 7822
Keyless Start Antenna: Service and Repair Remote Start Antenna - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Make sure the remote start antenna is positioned the same way noted during the removal
procedure.
1. Install the remote start antenna (2) and screws (1) to instrument panel assembly. Tighten to 2.5
Nm (22 in. lbs.). 2. Route the remote start coaxial cable in the position noted during the removal
procedure. 3. Install the coaxial cable mounting clip at the steering column reinforcement bracket.
4. Install the mounting clip (2). 5. Connect remote start antenna coaxial cable connector (1) to
skreem module (3). 6. Install instrument cluster. Refer to See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and
Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and
Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install radio. Refer to See: Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Radio - Installation. 8. Install the instrument panel top pad.
Refer to See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Pad - Installation.
9. Connect negative battery cable. Tighten to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Locations > Radio Antenna
Antenna, Radio: Locations Radio Antenna
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Locations > Radio Antenna > Page 7827
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Locations > Radio Antenna > Page 7828
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Locations > Radio Antenna > Page 7829
Antenna, Radio: Locations Radio Antenna (Satellite Radio)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Locations > Radio Antenna > Page 7830
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Locations > Radio Antenna > Page 7831
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Diagrams > Radio Antenna C1 (Headliner) 2 Way
Antenna, Radio: Diagrams Radio Antenna C1 (Headliner) 2 Way
Connector C1 - (HEADLINER) 2 WAY
ANTENNA-RADIO - (HEADLINER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Diagrams > Radio Antenna C1 (Headliner) 2 Way > Page 7834
Antenna, Radio: Diagrams Radio Antenna C2 (Headliner) 1 Way
Connector C2 - (HEADLINER) 1 WAY
ANTENNA-RADIO - (HEADLINER) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Diagrams > Radio Antenna C1 (Headliner) 2 Way > Page 7835
Antenna, Radio: Diagrams Radio Antenna C3 (Satellite Radio) (Body) 2 Way
Connector C3 (SATELLITE RADIO) - (BODY) 2 WAY
ANTENNA-RADIO (SATELLITE RADIO) - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Satellite Radio Antenna - Removal
Antenna, Radio: Service and Repair Satellite Radio Antenna - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Lower the appropriate portion of the
headliner as necessary to access the underside of the antenna See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding /
Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner - Removal.
3. Disconnect the antenna electrical connectors. 4. Remove the fastener and retainer. 5. From
inside the vehicle, using a flat bladed tool, depress one of the retaining tabs on the antenna. Push
one side of the antenna connector through
the roof panel. Depress the other side of the connector and remove the antenna.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Satellite Radio Antenna - Removal > Page 7838
Antenna, Radio: Service and Repair Satellite Radio Antenna - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the antenna electrical connector through the hole in the roof panel. 2. Press the antenna
into position until both retainers snap into place. Tighten to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the
antenna electrical connector to the antenna. 4. Install headliner See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner - Installation. 5. Connect negative battery
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Satellite Radio Antenna - Removal > Page 7839
Antenna, Radio: Service and Repair Antenna - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
SATELLITE AUDIO ONLY
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable 2. Lower the rear portion of the headliner as
necessary to gain access to the audio antenna See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner - Removal.
3. Disconnect the antenna cable(s). 4. Remove antenna mast by unscrewing mast from antenna
body. 5. Remove the fastener from the mounting bracket. 6. Remove the antenna bracket. 7.
Remove the antenna base from the roof of the vehicle. 8. Remove the passenger side quarter trim
panel. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
9. Remove the passenger side C-pillar See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/C-Pillar Trim
Panel-Removal.
10. Remove the passenger side scuff plates See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Scuff
Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Removal. 11. Remove the passenger side cowl panel See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel Removal
.
12. Remove the glove box See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Removal.
13. Remove the radio See: Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Radio - Removal.
CAUTION: Pulling the antenna cable straight out of the radio without pulling on the locking antenna
connector could damage the cable or
radio.
14. Disconnect the antenna.
SATELLITE AUDIO AND VIDEO
AUDIO CABLE TO MODULE
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Lower the rear portion of the headliner as
necessary to gain access to the audio antenna See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner - Removal.
3. Disconnect the antenna cable(s). 4. Remove antenna mast by unscrewing mast from antenna
body. 5. Remove the fastener from the mounting bracket. 6. Remove the antenna bracket. 7.
Remove the antenna base from the roof of the vehicle. 8. Remove the passenger side quarter trim
panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
9. Remove the passenger side C-pillar See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/C-Pillar Trim
Panel-Removal
10. Remove the passenger side scuff plates See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Scuff
Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Removal. 11. Position the passenger seat forward.
CAUTION: Pulling the antenna cable straight out of the radio without pulling on the locking antenna
connector could damage the cable or
radio.
12. Disconnect the audio antenna from the module.
VIDEO CABLE TO MODULE
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Lower the front portion of the headliner as
necessary to gain access to the video antenna See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Satellite Radio Antenna - Removal > Page 7840
Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner - Removal.
3. Disconnect the antenna cable(s). 4. Remove antenna mast by unscrewing mast from antenna
body. 5. Remove the fastener from the mounting bracket. 6. Remove the antenna bracket. 7.
Remove the antenna base from the roof of the vehicle. 8. Remove the passenger side front scuff
plate See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate Removal. 9. Remove the passenger side cowl panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel - Removal
.
10. Position the passenger seat forward.
CAUTION: Pulling the antenna cable straight out of the radio without pulling on the locking antenna
connector could damage the cable or
radio.
11. Disconnect the video antenna from the module.
SIGNAL (RADIO FEED) ANTENNA CABLE FROM MODULE TO COWL
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the passenger side front scuff
plate See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate Removal. 3. Remove the passenger side cowl panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel - Removal
.
4. Position the passenger seat forward.
CAUTION: Pulling the antenna cable straight out of the radio without pulling on the locking antenna
connector could damage the cable or
radio.
5. Disconnect the signal (radio feed) antenna from the module. 6. Disconnect the antenna cable
from the instrument panel antenna cable in the cowl area.
SIGNAL (RADIO FEED) ANTENNA FROM COWL TO RADIO
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the passenger side cowl panel
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel Removal
.
3. Remove the glove box See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove
Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Removal.
4. Remove the radio See: Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Radio - Removal.
CAUTION: Pulling the antenna cable straight out of the radio without pulling on the locking antenna
connector could damage the cable or
radio.
5. Disconnect the antenna from the radio.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Satellite Radio Antenna - Removal > Page 7841
Antenna, Radio: Service and Repair Antenna - Installation
INSTALLATION
SATELLITE AUDIO ONLY
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
1. Route the cable behind the glove box, up to the radio and secure. 2. Connect the antenna to the
radio. 3. Install the radio See: Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Radio - Installation. 4. Install the glove box See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove
Box Installation.
5. Route the antenna cable along the path of the old antenna wiring harness, securing where
necessary. 6. Install the passenger side cowl panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel Installation.
7. Install the passenger side quarter trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
8. Install the passenger side scuff plates See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Scuff
Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation. 9. Install the passenger side C-pillar See: Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/C-Pillar Trim
Panel-Installation.
10. Install the antenna base to the roof of the vehicle. 11. Install the antenna bracket and mounting
fastener. 12. Install the antenna cable(s). 13. Install the headliner See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner - Installation. 14. Connect the battery
negative cable.
SATELLITE AUDIO AND VIDEO
AUDIO CABLE TO MODULE
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
1. Connect the antenna cable to the module located under the front passenger seat. 2. Route the
antenna cable along the path of the old audio antenna wiring harness, securing where necessary.
3. Install the passenger side cowl panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel Installation.
4. Install the passenger side quarter trim panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
5. Install the passenger side scuff plates See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Scuff
Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation. 6. Install the passenger side C-pillar See: Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/C-Pillar Trim
Panel-Installation.
7. Install the antenna base to the roof of the vehicle. 8. Install the antenna bracket and mounting
fastener. 9. Install the antenna cable(s).
10. Install the headliner See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Headliner/Service and
Repair/Headliner - Installation. 11. Position the passenger seat to its original position. 12. Connect
the battery negative cable.
VIDEO CABLE TO MODULE
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
1. Connect the antenna cable to the module located under the passenger seat. 2. Route the
antenna cable along the path of the old audio antenna wiring harness, securing where necessary.
3. Install the passenger side cowl panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel Installation.
4. Install the front passenger side scuff plate See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Scuff
Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation. 5. Install the antenna base to the roof of the
vehicle. 6. Install the antenna bracket and mounting fastener. 7. Install the antenna cable(s). 8.
Install the headliner See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Headliner/Service and
Repair/Headliner - Installation. 9. Position the passenger seat to its original position.
10. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Satellite Radio Antenna - Removal > Page 7842
SIGNAL (RADIO FEED) ANTENNA CABLE FROM MODULE TO COWL
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
1. Connect the antenna cable to the instrument panel antenna cable in the cowl area. 2. Route the
antenna cable along the path of the old audio antenna wiring harness, securing where necessary.
3. Connect the antenna cable to the module. 4. Install the passenger side cowl panel See: Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel Installation.
5. Install the front passenger side scuff plate See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Scuff
Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation. 6. Position the passenger seat to its original
position. 7. Connect the battery negative cable.
SIGNAL (RADIO FEED) ANTENNA FROM COWL TO RADIO
NOTE: The antenna cables are integrated into the body wiring harnesses. New antenna cables is
overlaid on the body wiring harness.
1. Connect the antenna to the radio. 2. Route the antenna cable along the path of the old audio
antenna wiring harness, securing where necessary. 3. Install the radio See: Radio, Stereo, and
Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Radio - Installation. 4.
Install the glove box See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Glove Compartment/Service
and Repair/Instrument Panel Glove Box Installation.
5. Install the passenger side cowl panel See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel Installation.
6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transponder > Component Information > Description and Operation > Transponder Key - Description
Alarm System Transponder: Description and Operation Transponder Key - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS) has a transponder chip included on the circuit board
beneath the cover of each FOB with Integrated Key (FOBIK) (1) included with the vehicle. The
FOBIK includes an integral mechanical valet key which is stored within the bottom of the FOBIK
housing until it is released using the latch button (2). The valet key is cut to match the mechanical
coding of the door and glove box lock cylinders. Each new replacement FOBIK must be
programmed for operation of the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system and has a unique
transponder identification code that is permanently programmed into it by the manufacturer. This
identification code must be programmed into the Wireless Ignition Node (WIN) to be recognized by
the SKIS as a valid key.
The FOBIK transponder cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged, the entire
FOBIK and RKE transmitter unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transponder > Component Information > Description and Operation > Transponder Key - Description > Page 7848
Alarm System Transponder: Description and Operation Transponder Key - Operation
OPERATION
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the Wireless Ignition Node (WIN)
communicates through its antenna with the Sentry Key transponder within the FOB with Integrated
Key (FOBIK) using a Low Frequency (LF) signal. The Sentry Key transponder chip is within the
range of the WIN transceiver antenna ring when it is inserted into the ignition switch.
The WIN determines whether a valid FOBIK is present in the ignition switch based upon the signal
from the transponder. If a valid FOBIK is detected, that fact is communicated by the WIN to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus, and the PCM
allows the engine to start. If the PCM receives an invalid key message, or receives no message
from the WIN over the CAN data bus, the engine will be disabled. The Electro Mechanical
Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) will also respond to
the invalid key message on the CAN data bus by flashing the security indicator ON and OFF.
Each Sentry Key FOBIK has a unique transponder identification code permanently programmed
into it by the manufacturer. Likewise, the WIN has a unique Secret Key code programmed into it by
the manufacturer. When a Sentry Key FOBIK is programmed into the memory of the WIN, the WIN
stores the transponder identification code from the Sentry Key FOBIK and the Sentry Key FOBIK
learns the Secret Key code from the WIN. Once the Sentry Key FOBIK learns the Secret Key code
of the WIN, it is permanently stored in the memory of the transponder. Therefore, once a FOBIK
has been programmed to a particular vehicle, it cannot be used on any other vehicle.
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS) performs a self-test each time the ignition switch is
turned to the ON position, and will store key-related fault information in the form of a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) in WIN memory if a Sentry Key FOBIK transponder problem is detected. The
Sentry Key FOBIK transponder chip can be diagnosed, and any stored DTC can be retrieved using
a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch
(For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch
(For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 7852
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-HOOD AJAR - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch
(For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch - Description
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The hood ajar switch is a normally closed, single pole, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch. This
switch has two unique versions that are used in two different applications. One switch is used only
on vehicles equipped with the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) for sale in certain export
markets where protection of the underhood area is required equipment. The second switch is used
only on domestic vehicles equipped with an optional remote starter system.
The molded plastic switch body (5) has an integral molded connector receptacle (1) on the lower
end containing two terminal pins. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out of the headlamp and dash wire harness. Two integral latches (2) lock the switch
into a keyed mounting hole in the stamped steel switch mounting bracket. The mounting bracket is
secured with screws to the right inner fender shield near the fender ledge in the engine
compartment. The underside of the hood panel inner reinforcement actuates the switch plunger as
the hood panel is closed.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) and a sleeve-like retainer ring on the
upper end of the switch body. The retainer ring has a one time, self-adjustment feature that is
activated after the switch is installed by closing the hood. The retainer ring is also color-coded to
aid in identifying the switch application. A dark brown retainer ring identifies the underhood security
switch application, while a white retainer ring identifies the remote starter system application.
An installed hood ajar switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, or requires readjustment, it must be replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch
(For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch - Description
> Page 7855
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The hood ajar switches are interchangeable physically, but not functionally. In each case, the hood
ajar switch is a normally closed switch that is held open as the spring-loaded switch plunger is
depressed by the inner hood panel reinforcement when the hood panel is closed and latched.
When the hood is opened, the spring-loaded switch plunger extends from the switch body and the
switch contacts are closed.
In the underhood security application (export vehicles only - dark brown retainer ring), the switch is
connected in series between ground and the hood ajar switch sense input of the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM uses an internal resistor pull up to monitor the state of the hood
ajar switch contacts.
In the remote starter system application (domestic vehicles only - white retainer ring) the switch has
a 1 kilohm diagnostic resistor connected in parallel to the switch contacts between the two switch
terminals. The switch is connected in series between an output of the TIPM and the hood ajar
switch sense input of the TIPM. The TIPM continually monitors this circuit and it will store a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that it detects.
The components of the switch self-adjustment feature include an integral stop on the shaft of the
plunger and a ribbed, ratcheting sleeve-like retainer ring at the top of the switch body from which
the plunger extends. With the switch mounting collar secured in its mounting bracket, the plunger is
depressed by the hood inner reinforcement as the hood is closed. As the plunger is depressed, the
plunger stop contacts the top of the retainer ring and it is driven downward, ratcheting through the
switch mounting collar until the hood is fully closed and latched. The ribs on the retainer ring are
engaged within the mounting collar to maintain this adjusted position.
The hood ajar switch as well as the hard-wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices related to hood ajar
switch operation that provide some features of the export vehicle theft or domestic remote starter
systems. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to hood ajar switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch
(For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch - Removal
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal
SWITCH
1. Unlatch and open the hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect
the wire harness connector (3) from the switch connector receptacle. 4. From the top of the hood
ajar switch mounting bracket (2), squeeze the two switch latch tabs together and pull the switch (1)
upward through the
hole in the mounting bracket.
5. Remove the hood ajar switch from the mounting bracket and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch
(For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch - Removal > Page
7858
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Installation
SWITCH
NOTE: Self-adjustment of the hood ajar switch is a one-time feature. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, removed or requires readjustment,
it must be replaced with a new unit.
1. Position the hood ajar switch (1) above the hole in the mounting bracket (2). 2. Press the switch
into the mounting hole until the integral switch latch tabs lock it into place. 3. Connect the harness
connector (3) to the switch connector receptacle. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Close
and latch the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7863
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7864
Keyless Entry Module: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna > Component Information > Description and Operation > Remote Start
Antenna - Description
Keyless Start Antenna: Description and Operation Remote Start Antenna - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Remote Start Antenna Module Assembly consists of an electrical connection to the Wireless
Ignition Node (WIN) (1), a length of coaxial cable (2), two mounting clips (3 and 4) and a control
module/antenna (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna > Component Information > Description and Operation > Remote Start
Antenna - Description > Page 7870
Keyless Start Antenna: Description and Operation Remote Start Antenna - Operation
OPERATION
The remote start antenna is an external hidden antenna located at the driver's side front of dash.
The antenna interfaces with the Wireless Integration Node (WIN) through a coaxial electrical cable
and electrical connector. The antenna helps to amplify the signal for the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) key fob.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Start Antenna Removal
Keyless Start Antenna: Service and Repair Remote Start Antenna - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Wait two minutes for the system reserve capacitor to discharge before servicing any
airbag components. Failure to do this may
result in serious or fatal injury.
The remote start antenna is located driver's side front of dash.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove radio. Refer to See: Radio, Stereo,
and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Radio - Removal.
3. Remove instrument cluster. Refer to See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning
Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and
Repair/Instrument Cluster - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument panel top pad. Refer to See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Pad - Removal.
NOTE: During removal of the remote start antenna note the routing location of the coaxial cable.
5. Disconnect remote start antenna coaxial cable connector (1) from skreem module (3). 6.
Remove the mounting clip (2).
7. Remove the mounting clip at the steering column reinforcement bracket. 8. Remove screws (1)
and remove remote start antenna (2) from instrument panel assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Start Antenna Removal > Page 7873
Keyless Start Antenna: Service and Repair Remote Start Antenna - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Make sure the remote start antenna is positioned the same way noted during the removal
procedure.
1. Install the remote start antenna (2) and screws (1) to instrument panel assembly. Tighten to 2.5
Nm (22 in. lbs.). 2. Route the remote start coaxial cable in the position noted during the removal
procedure. 3. Install the coaxial cable mounting clip at the steering column reinforcement bracket.
4. Install the mounting clip (2). 5. Connect remote start antenna coaxial cable connector (1) to
skreem module (3). 6. Install instrument cluster. Refer to See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and
Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and
Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install radio. Refer to See: Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Radio - Installation. 8. Install the instrument panel top pad.
Refer to See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Pad - Installation.
9. Connect negative battery cable. Tighten to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Service and Repair
Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: Service and Repair
FOBIK TRANSMITTER BATTERY REPLACEMENT
FOBIK WITH BATTERY COVER
NOTE: Do not disturb the metal terminal near the battery. Avoid touching the new battery. Skin oils
may cause battery deterioration. If
battery are touched, clean with rubbing alcohol.
To replace the FOBIK transmitter battery:
1. Using a small flat bladed tool, carefully remove the battery cover on the back of the FOBIK.
2. Remove the battery one at a time by slightly lifting up and sliding out from the FOBIK. 3. Replace
the battery with the same type of battery cell. 4. Install the battery with the positive terminal up. 5.
Install battery cover and snap into place. 6. Test FOBIK operation.
FOBIK WITHOUT BATTERY COVER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7878
NOTE: Do not disturb the metal terminal near the battery. Avoid touching the new battery. Skin oils
may cause battery deterioration. If
battery are touched, clean with rubbing alcohol.
This design is a clam shell design whereby both halves are split apart.
1. Remove the valet/spare key from the FOBIK if present. 2. Using a trim stick C-4755 or
equivalent, carefully separate the top half from the bottom half.
3. Lift up on the battery to remove. 4. Replace battery with the same type of cell. 5. Install new
battery negative side up. 6. Snap the top and bottom halves together. 7. Test FOBIK operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Navigation/Telecommunication - Description
Cellular Phone: Description and Operation Navigation/Telecommunication - Description
DESCRIPTION
TELECOMMUNICATIONS
The hands-free cellular system on this vehicle uses Bluetooth(TM) technology to provide wireless
communication between the operator's compatible cellular telephone and the vehicle's on-board
receiver.
The system uses voice recognition technology to control operation. The incoming voice is
broadcast through the vehicle's radio speakers, automatically overriding any other audio signals on
the front speakers when the hands-free system is in use. A microphone in the rearview mirror picks
up vehicle occupant's voices. If a call is in progress when the ignition is switched off, the call will be
transferred to the hand-held telephone.
The system will communicate with a telephone that is anywhere within the vehicle. However,
covering the hand held phone or the hands-free phone module with a metal object may block the
signal. The system will recognize up to seven telephones, each of which is given a spoken
identification by the user during the setup process. The system includes Spanish and French voice
recognition in addition to English.
The hands free module is contained within the radio for premium systems. With the low line radio,
the hands free module is located on the left side of the instrument panel to the left of the steering
column.
NAVIGATION
The navigation system offers several new customer features for expanded usability and
convenience with hands-free voice-activated operation in addition to the touch screen buttons. The
navigation system uses the Bluetooth microphone in the rear view mirror. Navigation routes can be
based on a variety of formats including some of the following:
- Destination entry by street intersection, city, zip code, street name, street address and number,
state/province/country and phone number
- Stop/change route
- Save current position
- Personal menu, including Guide Me Home (Go Home), Trip Itinerary, List of Saved Locations,
Favorite Points of Interest (from a data base), Manage Personal User and Choose User
- Personal Interests including recent routes, address book, Where Am I Now, Emergency (police
stations, Dodge dealerships, fire stations, hospitals and emergency care centers), Trail and geocoordinates
- Route options include shortest, quickest, maximize freeways, minimize freeways, avoid toll roads
and avoid ferries
- Navigation can be put into DEMO mode to enhance trip planning
This navigation system will support Traffic Messaging. Traffic Messaging displays voice and pop up
warning messages for medium and high priority situations on the route such as road closures due
to accidents/hazardous situations and it can even generate a traffic detour for a traffic event
located on the route.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Navigation/Telecommunication - Description > Page 7883
Cellular Phone: Description and Operation Navigation/Telecommunication - Operation
OPERATION
TELECOMMUNICATION
Two buttons on the rearview mirror, identified with ISO icons, control the system: A "phone" button
turns the system on and off; a "voice recognition" (or voice command) button prompts the
hands-free system to listen for a voice command. The system includes the following features:
- Phone book - Stores telephone numbers for later recall by name or other verbal identification,
called a voice tag, and memory location.
- Four memory locations - Home, Work, Mobile, and Pager. A maximum of 32 unique names or
voice tags may be stored at the same time, with a different number in each of the four memory
locations.
- Voice tag dialing - Dials the number associated with a voice tag and memory location.
- Digit dialing - Dials the telephone number by recognizing the names of the digits as they are
spoken.
- Receiving calls - A voice prompt notifies the user of an incoming call. Pressing the U Connect
button accepts or rejects the call.
- Privacy Mode - Switches the call to the handheld telephone and the hands-free system and back
again using the "voice recognition" (or "voice command") button and a voice command, if desired.
NAVIGATION
The navigation system collects data from GPS satellites in orbit around the Earth. This information
is sent to the radio to be processed and provides the user with present location and is used to
provide the route planing and guidance as the vehicle is driven.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Hands Free Module (HFM) - Removal
Cellular Phone: Service and Repair Hands Free Module (HFM) - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the knee bolster. See: Restraint
Systems/Knee Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker - Removal. 3. Remove the hands free
module mounting fasteners. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Hands Free Module (HFM) - Removal > Page 7886
Cellular Phone: Service and Repair Hands Free Module (HFM) - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the electrical connectors and install the hands free module. 2. Install the hands free
module mounting fasteners. 3. Install the knee bolster. See: Restraint Systems/Knee
Diverter/Service and Repair/Kneeblocker - Installation. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Locations > Rear Video Camera
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Locations > Rear Video Camera > Page 7892
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Locations > Page 7893
Rear Vision Camera: Diagrams
Connector (PARKVIEW) - (LIFTGATE) 6 WAY
CAMERA-REAR VIDEO (PARKVIEW) - (LIFTGATE) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rear Camera - Description
Rear Vision Camera: Description and Operation Rear Camera - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Rear View Camera (RVC) (4) (also known as Park View(TM)), is a camera on chip device
utilizing Complementary Metal Oxide Semiconductor (CMOS) technology. CMOS technology is
used for a wide variety of digital or analog circuits. In this application, it supports the analog image
sensor of the RVC. The RVC function is to provide a wide angle video image of the area behind the
vehicle, including areas that might not be normally visible from the seated position of the vehicle
operator, only while the transaxle gear selector is in the Reverse position. This video image then
displays to the vehicle operator within the display screen of the audio system receiver unit near the
center of the instrument panel.
The RVC is intended to be an auxiliary viewing aid and is not promoted as an obstacle detection or
safety device. It does not remove vehicle operator responsibility to recognize and obey official
traffic laws or regulations or to take sensible precautions and care to avoid pedestrians, other
vehicle traffic or both fixed and moving obstacles through the habitual use of safe and defensive
driving techniques.
The RVC is located on the underside of the light bar (1) mounted above the license plate tub on the
vehicle liftgate. The camera lens is visible just to the left of the vehicle center line, while the body of
the camera and the camera connections are concealed within the light bar above a camera
mounting bracket (3), to which the camera is secured with three screws. The camera mounting
bracket secures to the light bar assembly to the left of the left license plate lamp (2) with two
additional screws. A light bar wire harness routes through a rubber grommet into the interior of the
liftgate where it connects the RVC and both license plate lamps to the vehicle electrical system
through a dedicated take out and connector of the liftgate wire harness.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rear Camera - Description > Page 7896
The camera image sensor and electronics are sealed and protected within a two-piece die cast
zinc housing (1), held together by four screws (2). The camera lens (5) extends from the lower
surface of the housing and an integral connector receptacle (3) containing five terminal pins that
extends from the right side of the housing. Additionally, there are three mounting bosses (4)
integral to the camera housing, two on the left side and one on the right. The mounting bosses
receive the three self-tapping screws securing the unit to the camera bracket.
Hardwired circuitry connects the RVC to the electrical system of the vehicle. These hardwired
circuits are integral to several wire harnesses, which routes throughout the vehicle and retained by
many different methods. These circuits may be connected to each other and to the vehicle
electrical system through the use of a combination of soldered splices, splice block connectors, and
many different types of wire harness terminal connectors and insulators. Refer to the appropriate
wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector
repair procedures, further details on wire harness routing and retention, as well as pin-out and
location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
The RVC cannot be adjusted or repaired. If the RVC is damaged or ineffective, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rear Camera - Description > Page 7897
Rear Vision Camera: Description and Operation Rear Camera - Operation
OPERATION
The Rear View Camera (RVC) is powered by a battery feed received through the backup lamp
switch output circuit from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) so that is only active when
the transaxle is shifted into the REVERSE position. In addition, the radio receiver monitors
messages on the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to determine the selected transaxle gear
and overrides any other display to show the RVC video output, whenever it detects that the
transaxle is in REVERSE. A momentary blank video display screen immediately following the
gearshift transition into the REVERSE position is considered normal operation. The camera
electronics receive a path to ground at all times through a takeout and eyelet terminal of the liftgate
wire harness that is secured by a ground screw to the right side of the liftgate inner panel.
The output of the camera is a video signal compatible to the National Television System Committee
(NTSC) standard composite video M format, or NTSC-M. The video signal is delivered to the radio
video display unit through the entire length of the vehicle by camera signal and the camera return
circuits that are arranged as a twisted pair, with an additional grounded foil jacket to protect the
video signal from corruption due to stray radiated signals within the vehicle environment. The
ground shield is terminated only at the video display (radio) end, not at the camera. Portions of
these video signal wires are contained within the liftgate lightbar wire harness, the liftgate wire
harness, the body wire harness and a jumper harness located between the radio and the body
harness connector below the instrument panel at the right cowl side inner panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Rear Vision Camera: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
REAR CAMERA INOPERATIVE
For a complete wiring diagram, Refer to the Wiring Information See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
- When Monitored:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page
7900
Ignition on, vehicle in reverse.
- Set Condition: No rear picture is displayed on radio with the vehicle in reverse.
1. VERIFY OPERATION OF THE RADIO AND BACKUP LAMPS
1. Verify the operation of the Radio and Backup Lamps.
Do the Radio and Backup Lamps operate correctly?
Yes
- Go To 2
No
- Diagnose any problems with the Radio and Backup Lamps.
- Perform the BODY VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Body Verification Test.
2. (L1) BACKUP LAMP FEED CIRCUIT
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Apply the parking brake. 3. Disconnect the Rear Video Camera harness
connector. 4. Turn the ignition on. 5. Shift the vehicle into reverse. 6. Measure the voltage of the
(L1) Backup Lamp Feed circuit.
Is battery voltage present?
Yes
- Go To 3
No
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page
7901
- Using the wiring diagrams as a guide, repair the (L1) Backup Lamp Feed circuit for an open.
- Perform the BODY VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Body Verification Test.
3. (Z913) GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn the ignition off. 2. Measure the resistance between ground and the (Z913) Ground Circuit.
Is the resistance below 10.0 Ohms?
Yes
- Go To 4
No
- Using the wiring diagrams as a guide, repair the (Z913) Ground circuit for an open.
- Perform the BODY VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Body Verification Test.
4. CAMERA SIGNAL, RETURN, AND SHIELD CIRCUITS OPEN
1. Disconnect the Radio C3 harness connector. 2. Measure the resistance of the (X970) (X971)
and (X972) circuits.
Is the resistance below 10.0 Ohms on the (X970) (X971) or (X972) circuits?
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page
7902
Yes
- Go To 5
No
- Using the wiring diagrams as a guide, repair the appropriate circuit for an open.
- Perform the BODY VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Body Verification Test.
5. CAMERA SIGNAL, RETURN, AND SHIELD CIRCUITS SHORTED TO GROUND
1. Measure the resistance between ground and the (X970) (X971) and (X972) circuits.
Is the resistance below 10.0 Ohms on the (X970) (X971) or (X972) circuits?
Yes
- Using the wiring diagrams as a guide, repair the appropriate circuit for a short to ground.
- Perform the BODY VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Body Verification Test.
No
- Replace the Rear Video Camera.
- Perform the BODY VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Body Verification Test.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page
7903
Rear Vision Camera: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Rear Camera
The hardwired circuits of the Rear View Camera (RVC) and those between the RVC and the radio
receiver may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and
connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector pin-out
information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the RVC or
the radio receiver. The most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose the electronic
controls and communication related to radio receiver operation, as well as the retrieval or erasure
of a DTC requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: Be certain to confirm both of the following prior to attempting any further diagnosis or
testing of the RVC. Use a diagnostic scan tool
to confirm the rear view camera is setup in the vehicle configuration. From the initial start up screen
of the diagnostic scan tool, navigate to ECU VIEW, select TIPMCGW CENTRAL GATEWAY,
MORE OPTIONS, ECU DETAILS and then CONFIG INFO. Verify that REAR CAMERA PRESET - - - SET is present. If not, the Sales Code XAC (Park View Rear Back-Up Camera) will have to be
added to the vehicle configuration to enable the RVC, in vehicles equipped with a MyGIG
multimedia entertainment system (Sales Codes RE1, REN, REP, RER, REU, REW, REX or REZ),
be certain that the RVC is set to ENABLED using the CAMERA SETUP option in the MyGIG
system settings.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page
7904
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Camera - Removal
Rear Vision Camera: Service and Repair Rear Camera - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the four retainers (1) holding the lightbar (5) to
the liftgate (6). 3. Using a trim stick or equivalent, release the lightbar (5) from the clips. 4.
Disconnect the electrical connectors from the backup camera (2) and the lights (3). 5. Disconnect
the liftgate release cable (4) from the lightbar (5). 6. Remove the retainer from the back of the
camera. 7. Unclip the camera cover from the lightbar. 8. Remove the camera mounting retainers. 9.
Remove the camera from the lightbar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Rear Vision Camera > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Camera - Removal > Page 7907
Rear Vision Camera: Service and Repair Rear Camera - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the camera to the lightbar. 2. Install the camera mounting retainers. 3. Clip the camera
cover to the lightbar. 4. Install the retainer to the back of the camera. 5. Connect the liftgate release
cable (4) to the lightbar (5). 6. Connect the electrical connectors to the backup camera (2) and the
lights (3). 7. Install the lightbar to the tailgate. 8. Install the four retainers (1) holding the lightbar (5)
to the liftgate (6). 9. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Vehicle Information Center Setup
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Vehicle Information
Center Setup
NUMBER: 08-002-09
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: February 4, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-014-07, DATED JULY 11,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITIONAL YEARS AND MODELS.
SUBJECT: Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Oil Change Indicator System - Dealer
Preferences During Prep
MODELS:
2008 (DR) Ram Truck
**2009 (HB) Durango**
**2009 (HG) Aspen**
**2009 (JC) Journey**
**2008 - 2009 (KA) Nitro**
**2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty**
**2009 (LC) Challenger**
**2008 - 2009 (LX) 300 / Magnum / Charger**
**2008 - 2009 (RI) Caravan / Town & Country**
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a programmable EVIC.
DISCUSSION:
**Many models now include an oil change indicator system**. This system displays an "Oil Change
Required" or "Oil Change" message at appropriate intervals on the instrument cluster.
The vehicles listed above may be equipped with a programmable display on the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center, (EVIC). The "Oil Change Required message may also include the dealerships
name and phone number which can be programmed into the vehicle with the StarSCAN(R) or
StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
NOTE:
**Other vehicles may be added at any time. Dealers can determine if the feature is available by
following the procedures below. If Enable/Disable Dealer Contact Information is active, the feature
can be used to enter the servicing dealer's information.**
The following procedure describes the steps to add, delete or change a dealership name and
phone number on the display.
NOTE:
If NOT programmed during vehicle prep, customer approval MUST be obtained before adding or
changing this information.
NOTE:
When performing this Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN(R) or
StarMOBILE(R); must be programmed with the latest level software. The software release level is
visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) screen.
1. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R). (in Pass-Through Mode)
NOTE:
To use the StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode requires that StarMOBILE(R) be connected to
the dealership network via a wired or wireless connection. For more information on how to use the
StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode, see the StarMOBILE(R) training tutorials available on
DealerCONNECT > Service > Repair > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Tools link or at the
website.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Vehicle Information Center Setup > Page 7912
2. From the Home Screen, enter "ECU VIEW or "VEHICLE PREP".
3. Select "CCN".
4. Select "Misc. Functions".
5. Select "Enable/Disable Dealer Contact Information".
6. Select "Enable" or "Disable" as desired.
7. If enabled, select "Program Dealer Contact Information" and follow on screen prompts.
8. "Reset will cause display to read: "Contact Dealer" as default.
9. Select finish to exit.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7915
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7916
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7917
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7918
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7919
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7920
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7921
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7922
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7923
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7924
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7925
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7926
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7927
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7928
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7929
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Electrical Diagrams
OVERHEAD CONSOLE - Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7930
Overhead Console 8W-49-01 (Except Navigation)
Overhead Console 8W-49-02 (Navigation)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7931
Overhead Console 8W-49-03
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams by Number See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Vehicle Information Center - Description
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation Electronic Vehicle Information
Center - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display (29). The
display is located in the lower left part of the instrument cluster below the fuel (2) and engine
temperature (1) gauges.
The display in the lower right part of the instrument cluster (15) below the tachometer (13) shows
the vehicle odometer related functions. These functions include Trip Odometer (ODO), Trip A and
Trip B readouts. The instrument cluster pushbutton (21) can be used to scroll through the different
odometer functions. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster /
Carrier/Description and Operation/Instrument Cluster - Description for additional information on the
instrument cluster and related functions.
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display. It is located
in the instrument cluster below the fuel and temperature gauges. Vehicles equipped with steering
wheel-mounted buttons (described) are also equipped with the EVIC. The EVIC consists of the
following:
- System Status
- Vehicle information warning message displays
- Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPM) - If Equipped
- Personal Settings (customer programmable features)
- Compass display
- Outside temperature display
- Trip computer functions
The EVIC system is comprised of several different components. Those components are:
- Instrument Cluster (sometimes referred to as Cab Compartment Node [CCN])
- ASBM EVIC Function Buttons
- Ambient Temperature Sensor
- Remote Compass Module (RCM)
- Controller Area Network (CAN) Data Bus
- Local Interface Network (LIN) Data Bus
The EVIC display is part of the Instrument Cluster assembly and is not serviced as a separate
component. If the display is inoperative the complete Instrument Cluster assembly must be
replaced, See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster /
Carrier/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Vehicle Information Center - Description > Page 7934
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation Electronic Vehicle Information
Center - Operation
OPERATION
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) uses both non-switched and ignition switched
sources of battery current so that some of its features remain operational at any time, while others
may only operate with the ignition switch in the "ON" position. When the ignition switch is turned to
the "ON" position, the EVIC display will return to the last function being displayed before the
ignition was turned to the "OFF" position.
The EVIC system is comprised of several different components that communicate over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) and Local Interface Network (LIN) Data Buses. If the system is
inoperative a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic information must be used to diagnose the
system.
The EVIC function buttons are used to operate the different functions of the EVIC system. Pressing
and releasing the MENU button allows the driver to select the Compass/Temperature, Trip
Computer, Personal Settings or System Status functions. The STEP button is used to toggle
through options or features of the Trip Computer, Personal Settings or System Status functions.
Pressing and releasing the RESET button allows the selection of setting or resetting of the function
currently displayed at that time. Pressing and releasing the C/T (compass/temperature) button will
cause the EVIC to return to the compass/temperature display mode from any other mode.
EVIC DISPLAY MODES
SYSTEM STATUS MODE
System display mode displays warnings and user interaction messages on the EVIC display. The
driver can scroll to view multiple messages by using the STEP button.
When the appropriate conditions exist, the EVIC displays the following messages:
- Turn Signal On (with a continuous warning chime if the vehicle is driven more than 1 mile [1.6 km]
with either turn signal on)
- Left Front Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
- Left Rear Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
- Right Front Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
- Right Rear Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
- RKE (Remote Keyless Entry ) Battery Low (with a single chime)
- Channel # Transmit.
- Channel # Training.
- Channel # Trained.
- Clearing Channels.
- Channels Cleared.
- Did Not Train.
- Left Front Low Pressure (with a single chime).
- Left Rear Low Pressure (with a single chime).
- Right Front Low Pressure (with a single chime).
- Right Rear Low Pressure (with a single chime).
- Check TPM System (with a single chime).
- Low Fuel
- Cal
- Oil Change Required (with a single chime)
- Low Washer Fluid
- Coolant Low
- Key in Ignition
- Lights On
PERSONAL SETTINGS MODE (CUSTOMER PROGRAMMABLE FEATURES)
Allows the driver to set and recall features when the transmission is in Park by pressing and
releasing the MENU button until Personal Settings is displayed in the EVIC. Pressing and releasing
the STEP button will scroll through the following personal settings choices:
- Language When in this display you may select one of three languages for all display
nomenclature, including the trip functions and the navigation system (if equipped). Press the
RESET button while in this display to select English, Espanol, or Francais. Then, as you continue,
the information will display in the selected language. NOTE: The EVIC will not change the
UConnect(TM) language selection.
- Unlock Doors Automatically on Exit When ON is selected, all doors will unlock when the vehicle is
stopped and the transmission is in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) position and the driver's door is
opened. To make your selection, press and release the RESET button until "ON" or "OFF"
appears.
- Remote Key Unlock When DRIVER DOOR 1ST PRESS is selected, only the driver's door will
unlock on the first press of the remote keyless
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Vehicle Information Center - Description > Page 7935
entry unlock button. When Driver Door 1st Press is selected, you must press of the remote keyless
entry unlock button twice to unlock the passenger's doors. When ALL DOORS 1ST PRESS is
selected, all of the doors will unlock on the first press of the remote keyless entry unlock button. To
make your selection, press and release the RESET button until "Driver Door 1st Press" or "All
Doors 1st Press" appears.
- Sound Horn with Remote Key Lock When ON is selected, a short horn sound will occur when the
remote keyless entry "Lock" button is pressed. This feature may be selected with or without the
flash lights on lock/unlock feature. To make your selection, press and release the RESET button
until "ON" or "OFF" appears.
- Flash Lights with Remote Key Lock When ON is selected, the front and rear turn signals will flash
when the doors are locked or unlocked with the remote keyless entry transmitter. This feature may
be selected with or without the sound horn on lock feature selected. To make your selection, press
and release the RESET button until "ON" or "OFF" appears.
- Delay Turning Headlights Off When this feature is selected, the driver can choose to have the
headlights remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds when exiting the vehicle. To make your selection,
press and release the RESET button until "0," "30," "60," or "90" appears.
- Headlights On with Wipers (Available with Auto Headlights Only) When this feature is selected
and the headlight switch is in the AUTO position, the headlights will activate approximately 10
seconds after the wipers are turned on. To make your selection, press and release the RESET
button until "ON" or "OFF" appears.
- Delay Power Off to Accessories Until Exit When this feature is selected, the power window
switches, radio, hands-free system (if equipped), DVD video system (if equipped), power sunroof (if
equipped), and power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes after the ignition switch is
turned off. Opening a vehicle door will cancel this feature. To make your selection, press and
release the RESET button until "Off," "45 sec.," "5 min.," or "10 min." appears.
Confirmation of Voice Commands - If Equipped When ON is selected, all voice commands from the
UConnect(TM) system are confirmed. To make your selection, press and release the RESET
button until "ON" or "OFF" appears.
- Display Units of Measure in The EVIC, odometer, and navigation system (if equipped) can be
changed between English and Metric units of measure. To make your selection, press and release
the RESET button until "US" or "METRIC" appears.
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE
Compass heading and outside temperature are displayed on the EVIC display screen. One of eight
compass headings to indicate the direction the vehicle is facing (N, S, E, W, NE, NW, SE, SW) and
one of 15 compass variance settings can be programmed. Outside temperature is displayed in °C
(degrees Celsius) or °F (degrees Fahrenheit).
For additional information regarding the compass, refer to Personal Settings (Customer
Programmable Features).
TRIP COMPUTER
Press and release the MENU button until one of the following Trip Functions displays in the EVIC:
- Average Fuel Economy
- Distance To Empty
- Elapsed Time
- Display Units of Measure in
Press the STEP button to cycle through all the Trip Computer functions.
The Trip Functions mode displays the following information:
- Average Fuel Economy Shows the average fuel economy since the last reset. When the fuel
economy is reset, the display will read "RESET" or show dashes for two seconds. Then, the history
information will be erased, and the averaging will continue from the last fuel average reading before
the reset.
- Distance To Empty (DTE) Shows the estimated distance that can be traveled with the fuel
remaining in the tank. This estimated distance is determined by a weighted average of the
instantaneous and average fuel economy, according to the current fuel tank level. DTE cannot be
reset through the RESET button. When the DTE value is less than 30 miles (48 km) estimated
driving distance, the DTE display will change to a text display of "LOW FUEL." This display will
continue until the vehicle runs out of fuel. Adding a significant amount of fuel to the vehicle will turn
off the "LOW FUEL" text and a new DTE value will display.
- Elapsed Time Shows the total elapsed time of travel since the last reset when the ignition switch
is in the ACC position. Elapsed time will increment when the ignition switch is in the ON or START
position.
- Display Units of Measure in: To make your selection, press and release the RESET button until
"US" or "METRIC" appears.
To Reset The Display Reset will only occur while a resettable function is being displayed. Press
and release the RESET button once to clear the resettable function being displayed. To reset all
resettable functions, press and release the RESET button a second time within 3 seconds of
resetting the currently displayed function (>Reset ALL will display during this 3 second window).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7936
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Testing and Inspection
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
CAUTION: Do not place any external magnets, such as magnetic roof mount antennas, in the
vicinity of the compass. Do not place any
electronic devices (cell phones, laptop computers, PDAs, portable DVD players, etc), on or near
the instrument panel as the Remote Compass Module (RCM) performance may be effected. Do not
use magnetic tools when servicing the RCM.
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) data is obtained from several components on the
Controller Area Network (CAN) and Local Interface Network (LIN) Data Bus circuits. The EVIC will
not function properly if the bus messages from any of these components is not receive. If no EVIC
data is displayed or the display indicates dashes "- -", check the CAN and LIN Data Bus circuit
communications, the Instrument Cluster functions, the Remote Compass Module (RCM) and the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). Should the RCM become disconnected, the instrument
cluster display will go blank.
The use of a scan tool and the proper diagnostic procedures information are recommended for
further testing of the Instrument Cluster, the RCM, the CAN Data Bus and the LIN Data Bus
circuits. Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector
pin-out information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Adjustments > Manual Compass Calibration
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Adjustments Manual Compass Calibration
MANUAL COMPASS CALIBRATION
CAUTION: Do not place any external magnets, such as magnetic roof mount antennas, in the
vicinity of the compass. Do not place any
electronic devices (cell phones, laptop computers, PDAs, portable DVD players, etc), on or near
the instrument panel as the Remote Compass Module (RCM) performance may be effected. Do not
use magnetic tools when servicing the RCM.
NOTE: Calibration is required anytime a new RCM is installed. Upon installation of the new RCM
the "CAL" message will appear in the
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) display. The RCM will automatically calibrate if the
vehicle is driven in two or more circles, slowly, and away from large metal objects. The RCM can
also be calibrated by performing the following procedure.
NOTE: Confirmation that the proper variance zone is programmed, is recommended whenever
manual compass calibration is performed.
See: for the appropriate procedure.
The electronic compass unit features a self-calibrating design, which simplifies the calibration
procedure. This feature automatically updates the compass calibration while the vehicle is being
driven. This allows the compass unit to compensate for small changes in the residual magnetism
that the vehicle may acquire during normal use. If the compass readings appear to be erratic or the
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) displays "CAL", perform the following manual
calibration procedure. Also, any time EVIC service replacement components are installed, they
must be calibrated using this procedure. Do not attempt to calibrate the compass near large metal
objects such as other vehicles, large buildings, or bridges; or, near overhead or underground power
lines.
Calibrate the compass manually as follows:
NOTE: Do not attempt to calibrate the compass near large metal objects such as other vehicles,
large buildings, or bridges; or, near overhead
or underground power lines.
1. Start the engine but leave the vehicle in "PARK". 2. Press and release the MENU push button
(1) until "Personal Settings" is displayed. 3. Once in the "Personal Settings" menu depress and
release the STEP button (4) several times until "Calibrate Compass (Yes)" is displayed. 4.
Momentarily depress and release the RESET push button (3) to initiate the calibration procedure.
The "CAL" symbol will come on solid in the
EVIC display.
5. Slowly drive the vehicle on a level surface, away from large metal objects and power lines,
through one or two complete circles not exceeding 8
km/h (5 mph). The "CAL" symbol will disappear from the display to indicate successful compass
calibration.
NOTE: A blank compass display indicates that vehicle degaussing (demagnetizing) may be
necessary.
NOTE: If the "CAL" message remains in the display, either there is excessive magnetism near the
compass, or the EVIC is inoperative.
Attempt the calibration procedure at least one more time before performing EVIC diagnosis.
NOTE: If the wrong direction is still indicated in the compass display, the area selected for
calibration may be too close to a strong magnetic
field. Repeat the manual calibration procedure in another location.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Adjustments > Manual Compass Calibration > Page 7939
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Adjustments Compass Variance Adjustment
COMPASS VARIANCE ADJUSTMENT
Compass variance, also known as magnetic declination, is the difference in angle between
magnetic north and true geographic north. In some geographic locations, the difference between
magnetic and geographic north is great enough to cause the compass to give false readings. If this
problem occurs, the compass variance must be set.
NOTE: If the vehicle is taken on long trips into a new variance zone the compass function may be
effected. Compass variance will need to be
updated to the new zone number to function properly.
NOTE: The default for the compass variance from the factory is 8.
To set the compass variance:
1. Using the Variance Settings Map, find your geographic location and note the zone number.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Adjustments > Manual Compass Calibration > Page 7940
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position. Press and release the MENU push button (1)
until "Personal Settings" is displayed. 3. Press the STEP push button (4) until "Compass Variance"
is displayed. The "Compass Variance" message and the current variance zone number
will be displayed.
4. Press and release the RESET push button (3) to toggle through the zone numbers (1-15), until
the zone number for your geographic location
appears in the display.
NOTE: The default for the compass variance from the factory is 8. During programming, the Zone
value will wrap around from Zone 15 to
Zone 1.
5. Press and release the Compass Temperature (C/T) push button (2) to enter the displayed zone
number into the compass unit memory. 6. Confirm that the correct directions are now indicated by
the compass.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Procedures
COMPASS DEMAGNETIZING
DEGAUSSING TOOL #6029
A degaussing tool (Special Tool 6029) is used to demagnetize, or degauss, the roof panel of the
vehicle. Equivalent units must be rated as continuous duty for 110/115 volts and 60 Hz. They must
also have a field strength of over 350 gauss at 7 millimeters (0.25 inch) beyond the tip of the probe.
To demagnetize the roof panel proceed as follows:
1. Be certain that the ignition switch is in the Off position, before you begin the demagnetizing
procedure.
2. Place a piece of paper approximately 22 by 28 centimeters (8.5 by 11 inches), oriented on the
vehicle lengthwise from front to rear, on the center
line of the roof at the windshield header. The purpose of the paper is to protect the roof panel from
scratches, and to define the area to be demagnetized.
3. Connect the degaussing tool to an electrical outlet, while keeping the tool at least 61 centimeters
(2 feet) away from the vehicle. 4. Slowly approach the center line of the roof panel at the windshield
header, with the degaussing tool connected. 5. Contact the roof panel with the plastic coated tip of
the degaussing tool. Be sure that the template is in place to avoid scratching the roof panel.
Using a slow, back-and-forth sweeping motion, and allowing 13 millimeters (0.50 inch) between
passes, move the tool at least 11 centimeters (4 inches) to each side of the roof center line, and 28
centimeters (11 inches) back from the windshield header.
6. With the degaussing tool still energized, slowly back it away from the roof panel. When the tip of
the tool is at least 61 centimeters (2 feet) from
the roof panel, disconnect the tool.
7. Calibrate the compass, See: Adjustments and adjust the compass variance, See: Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7943
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Removal and Replacement
Electronic Vehicle Information Center Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the driver airbag. See: Restraint
Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Removal. 3. Using a trim
stick (special tool # C-4755) or equivalent, gently pry the switch and bezel assembly (3) away from
the steering wheel at the inner
retaining tab (1) and the outer bezel edge (2).
4. With the switch and bezel assembly free from the steering wheel, lift the assembly up and
disconnect the switch electrical connector.
5. Using trim stick (special tool # C-4755) or equivalent, gently pry the switch bezel retainers (2)
away from the switch tabs (1), while applying
pressure to the back side of the switch. Remove the switch from the bezel.
Electronic Vehicle Information Center Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7944
1. Position the steering wheel switch onto the switch bezel aligning the switch tabs (1) with the
bezel retainers (2). 2. Press the switch into the bezel, until the switch is held in place by all four
retainers.
3. Position the switch and bezel assembly (3) over the steering wheel and connect the switch
electrical connector. 4. Align the switch bezel tab (1) with the slot in the steering wheel and press
the switch and bezel assembly (3) into the steering wheel until it is
secured in place.
5. Install the driver airbag. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and
Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation. 6. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Restraints System Verification Test.
7. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7945
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Tools and Equipment
SPECIAL TOOLS
DE GAUSER - 6029
RF Detector - 9001
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Antenna, TV > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Antenna, TV > Component
Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Antenna 1 (Body) 2 Way
Antenna, TV: Diagrams Satellite Video Antenna 1 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
ANTENNA-SATELLITE VIDEO 1 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Antenna, TV > Component
Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Antenna 1 (Body) 2 Way > Page 7952
Antenna, TV: Diagrams Satellite Video Antenna 2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector - (BODY) 2 WAY
ANTENNA-SATELLITE VIDEO 2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Antenna, TV > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Satellite Video Antenna - Description
Antenna, TV: Description and Operation Satellite Video Antenna - Description
DESCRIPTION
The satellite video antenna cable connects the roof mounted antenna to the satellite receiver. It has
two connectors at each end and is routed above the headliner, then down the right side A-pillar to
the cowl area.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Antenna, TV > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Satellite Video Antenna - Description > Page 7955
Antenna, TV: Description and Operation Satellite Video Antenna - Operation
OPERATION
The satellite video antenna receives signals from orbiting satellites and sends these signals to the
satellite receiver module. The satellite video antenna must have open space in which to operate.
Items carried on the roof, parking inside etc. can have an effect on the antenna's ability to receive
signals.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Antenna, TV > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Satellite Video Antenna - Removal
Antenna, TV: Service and Repair Satellite Video Antenna - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Lower the appropriate portion of the
headliner as necessary, to access the underside of the antenna. 3. Disconnect the electrical
connectors from the antenna. 4. Remove the fastener and retainer. 5. From inside the vehicle,
using a flat bladed tool, depress one of the retaining tabs on the antenna. Push up one side of the
antenna connector
through the roof panel. Depress the other side of the connector and remove the antenna.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Antenna, TV > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Satellite Video Antenna - Removal > Page 7958
Antenna, TV: Service and Repair Satellite Video Antenna - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. From inside the vehicle, using a flat bladed tool, depress one of the retaining tabs on the
antenna. Push up one side of the antenna connector
through the roof panel. Depress the other side of the connector and remove the antenna.
2. Connect the electrical connector to the antenna. 3. Install the headliner See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner - Installation. 4. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Audio/Video Port
Auxiliary Input / Output Jack: Locations Auxiliary Audio/Video Port
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Audio/Video Port > Page 7963
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Audio/Video Port > Page 7964
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Diagrams > Auxiliary Audio/Video Port (Rear Console) 8 Way
Auxiliary Input / Output Jack: Diagrams Auxiliary Audio/Video Port (Rear Console) 8 Way
Connector - (REAR CONSOLE) 8 WAY
PORT-AUXILIARY AUDIO VIDEO - (REAR CONSOLE) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Diagrams > Auxiliary Audio/Video Port (Rear Console) 8 Way > Page
7967
Auxiliary Input / Output Jack: Diagrams Media Port (UCI) (Instrument Panel) 16 Way
Connector (UCI) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
PORT-MEDIA (UCI) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Television / Monitor >
Component Information > Locations > Video Screen Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Television / Monitor >
Component Information > Locations > Video Screen Module > Page 7972
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Television / Monitor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Video Screen Module C1 (DVD) (Headliner) 22 Way
Television / Monitor: Diagrams Video Screen Module C1 (DVD) (Headliner) 22 Way
Connector C1 (DVD) - (HEADLINER) 22 WAY
MODULE-VIDEO SCREEN (DVD) - (HEADLINER) 22 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Television / Monitor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Video Screen Module C1 (DVD) (Headliner) 22 Way > Page 7975
Television / Monitor: Diagrams Video Screen Module C3 (Satellite Video) (Headliner) 22 Way
Connector C3 (SATELLITE VIDEO) - (HEADLINER) 22 WAY
MODULE-VIDEO SCREEN (SATELLITE VIDEO) - (HEADLINER) 22 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Television / Monitor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Video Screen Module C1 (DVD) (Headliner) 22 Way > Page 7976
Television / Monitor: Diagrams Video Screen Module C4 (DVD) (Headliner) 10 Way
Connector C4 (DVD) - (HEADLINER) 10 WAY
MODULE-VIDEO SCREEN (DVD) - (HEADLINER) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Television / Monitor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Media System Monitor - Removal
Television / Monitor: Service and Repair Media System Monitor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Open the video screen to access the
mounting fasteners. 3. Remove the mounting fasteners.
4. If equipped, disconnect the rear heat control connector (1). 5. Disconnect the video monitor
connectors (2) and remove the assembly from the vehicle.
6. Remove the fasteners (1) and remove the rear A/C and heater control.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Television / Monitor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Media System Monitor - Removal > Page 7979
Television / Monitor: Service and Repair Media System Monitor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear A/C and heater control and the fasteners (1).
2. If equipped, connect the rear A/C and heater control connector (1). 3. Connect the video monitor
connectors (2).
4. Install the mounting fasteners. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Entertainment System - Disabling Front Seat Video Source
DVD Player: Technical Service Bulletins Entertainment System - Disabling Front Seat Video
Source
NUMBER: 08-004-10
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: March 2, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 08-002-2007 DATED FEBRUARY 6, 2007.
THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT
REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Radio Video Disable Update
MODELS:
2010 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2008 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2008-2009 (HG) Aspen
2008-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2010 (JS) Sebring/Avenger/Sebring Convertible
2007-2010 (KA) Nitro
2008-2010 (KK) Liberty
2008 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2008 - 2010 (LX) 300/ 300C, Charger
2009-2010 (MK) Patriot
2008-2010 (ND) Dakota
2008-2010 (PM) Caliber
2008 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2008 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2008 - 2010 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Hard Drive Radio (sales code REN, RER, REU,
RBZ, RHR).
NOTE:
Refer to Warranty Bulletin D-07-04 for additional information and a listing of affected states.
DISCUSSION: Due to certain state regulations, a function for disabling the front seat video option
has been incorporated into the vehicle. This function will enable or disable the radio's ability to play
video in the front seat. If enabled, the radio will play video when the vehicle is in Park (Automatic
Transmission) or when the parking brake is set and vehicle speed is zero (Manual Transmission). If
disabled the radio will NOT play video in the front seat in any operating mode. If it becomes
necessary to disable the front seat video option, use the following procedure.
NOTE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Entertainment System - Disabling Front Seat Video Source > Page 7984
Using the wiTECH Diagnostic Application for flashing an ECU is made available through the
wiTECH Diagnostic Application. For instructions select the "HELP" tab on upper portion of the
wiTECH window, then "HELP CONTENTS." This will open the Welcome to wiTECH Help screen
were help topics can now selected.
1. Connect the wiTech
2. From the Home Screen select Radio
3. Select "Misc. Functions"
4. Select "Enable/Disable Front Seat Video"
5. Select "Enable" or "Disable" as required by your state laws.
6. Select finish to exit.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way > Page 7990
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way > Page 7991
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C1 (Body) 16 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 16 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way > Page 7992
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C4 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C4 - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Satellite Video Module - Removal
Entertainment System Control Module: Service and Repair Satellite Video Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Move the front passenger seat to the most
forward position.
3. Disconnect the three antenna connectors (1) and the electrical connector (2).
4. Remove the three retainers (1) securing the video module housing (2) to the floor, remove video
housing and module from vehicle.
5. Remove the video module retainers (1) to the video module housing (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Satellite Video Module - Removal > Page 7995
Entertainment System Control Module: Service and Repair Satellite Video Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the video module to the housing.
2. Install the video module into the vehicle and Install the three retainers (1) securing the video
module housing (2) to the floor.Tighten to 6 Nm (53
in. lbs.).
3. Connect the three antenna connectors (1) and the electrical connector (2). 4. Move the front
passenger seat back to the original position. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Universal Transmitter - Description
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Description and Operation Universal Transmitter - Description
DESCRIPTION
Some vehicles are equipped with the HomeLink(R) transceiver (1). The transceiver is located in the
driver side sun visor assembly (2). The only visible component of the HomeLink(R) transceiver are
the three push buttons. The buttons are marked with one, two or three dots, respectively, for
identification of each channel.
Each of the three HomeLink(R) transceiver push buttons controls an independent radio transmitter
channel. Each of these three channels can be trained to transmit a different radio frequency signal
for the remote operation of garage door openers, motorized gate openers, home or office lighting,
security systems or just about any other device that can be equipped with a radio receiver in the
280 to 418 MegaHertz (MHz) frequency range for remote operation. The transceiver is capable of
operating systems using either rolling code or non-rolling code technology. The system will not
transmit operating signals if the Vehicle Theft Security System is armed.
The HomeLink(R) transceiver cannot be repaired, and is available for service only with the visor
assembly. If any part of the component is inoperative or damaged, the complete visor assembly
must be replaced, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Sun Visor/Service and
Repair/Visor - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Universal Transmitter - Description > Page 8000
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Description and Operation Universal Transmitter - Operation
OPERATION
The HomeLink(R) transceiver operates on a direct battery feed so the unit will remain functional,
regardless of the ignition switch position. The transceiver has a security ground and will become
disabled any time the vehicle security alarm is armed. For more information on the features,
programming procedures and operation of the HomeLink(R) transceiver, see the owner's manual in
the vehicle glove box.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
HOMELINK TRANSCEIVER
RADIO FREQUENCY DETECTOR
If the HomeLink(R) transceiver is inoperative, retrain the transceiver with a known good transmitter,
insuring the transmitter battery is OK, See: Programming and Relearning. Test the universal
transmitter operation again. If the unit is still inoperative, test the universal transmitter with Radio
Frequency Detector special tool as described below:
1. Turn the Radio Frequency (RF) Detector ON (3). A "chirp" will sound and the green power Light
Emitting Diode (LED) will light (2). If the green
LED does not light, replace the battery (4).
2. Hold the RF detector within one inch of the TRAINED universal transmitter and press any of the
transmitters buttons. 3. The red signal detection LEDs (1) will light and the tool will beep if a radio
signal is detected. Repeat this test for all three transmitter buttons. If
the tool does not detect a radio signal for any of the three buttons, replace the inoperative
HomeLink(R) transceiver assembly, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Sun
Visor/Service and Repair/Visor - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics > Page 8003
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Programming and Relearning
Programming Homelink(R) Transceiver Codes
PROGRAMMING HOMELINK(R) TRANSCEIVER CODES
WARNING: Vehicle exhaust contains carbon monoxide, a dangerous gas. Do not run the vehicle's
exhaust while training the transceiver.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: Your motorized door or gate may open and close while you are training the
HomeLink(R) transceiver if the vehicle is in range of
the motorized device. Do not train the HomeLink(R) transceiver if people or pets are in the path of
the door or gate. A moving door or gate can cause serious injury or death to people and pets or
damage to objects.
NOTE: When programming a garage door opener, it is advised to park outside the garage. It is also
recommended that a new battery be
placed in the hand-held transmitter of the device being programmed to the HomeLink(R)
transceiver for quicker training and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency signal.
NOTE: If programing the HomeLink(R) transceiver is unsuccessful using the following procedure,
refer to the Owner's Manual for the
current customer assistance phone number.
- Press and hold the two outer HomeLink(R) transceiver buttons, and release only when the
indicator light begins to flash (after 20 seconds). Do not hold the buttons for longer than 30
seconds and do not repeat step one to program a second and/or third hand-held transmitter to the
remaining two HomeLink(R) transceiver buttons.
- Position the end of your hand-held transmitter 3-8 cm (1-3 inches) away from the HomeLink(R)
transceiver buttons while keeping the indicator light in view.
- Simultaneously press and hold both the HomeLink(R) transceiver button that you want to train
and the hand-held transmitter button. Do not release the buttons until step 4 has been
completed.NOTE: Some gate operators and garage door openers may require you to replace this
Programming Step 3 with procedures noted in the "Gate Operator/Canadian Programming"
section.
- The HomeLink(R) transceiver indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly after HomeLink(R)
successfully receives the frequency signal from the hand-held transmitter. Release both buttons
after the indicator light changes from the slow to rapid flash.
- Press and hold the just trained HomeLink(R) transceiver button and observe the indicator light. If
the indicator light stays on constantly, programming is complete and your device should activate
when the button is pressed and released. NOTE: To program the remaining two buttons, begin with
"Programming" step 2. Do not repeat step 1. If the indicator light blinks rapidly for two seconds and
then turns to a constant light, continue with "Programming" steps 6-8 to complete the programming
of a rolling code equipped device (most commonly a garage door opener).
- At the garage door opener receiver (motor-head unit) in the garage, locate the "learn" or "smart"
button. This can usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is attached to the motor-head
unit.
- Firmly press and release the "learn" or "smart" button. (The name and color of the button may
vary by manufacturer.)NOTE: There are 30 seconds in which to initiate step 8.
- Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold for two seconds and release the programmed
HomeLink(R) transceiver button. Repeat the "press/hold/release" sequence a second time, and,
depending on the brand of the garage door opener (or other rolling code equipped device), repeat
this sequence a third time to complete the programming. The HomeLink(R) transceiver should now
activate your rolling code equipped device.
NOTE: To program the remaining two HomeLink(R) transceiver buttons, begin with "Programming"
step 2. Do not repeat step 1.
Canadian Programming/Gate Programming
Canadian radio-frequency laws require transmitter signals to "time-out" (or quit) after several
seconds of transmission which may not be long enough for the HomeLink(R) transceiver to pick up
the signal during programming. Similar to this Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are
designed to "time-out" in the same manner.
If you live in Canada or you are having difficulties programming a gate operator by using the
"Programming" procedures (regardless of where you live), replace "Programming HomeLink(R)
Transceiver Codes" step 3 with the following:
NOTE: When programming a garage door opener or gate operator, it is advised to unplug the
device or move the vehicle out of range during
the "cycling" process to prevent possible overheating.
- 3. Continue to press and hold the HomeLink(R) transceiver button while you press and release
every two seconds ("cycle") your hand-held transmitter until the frequency signal has successfully
been accepted. The indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly. Proceed with "Programming"
step 4 to complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics > Page 8004
Erasing Homelink(R) Transceiver Codes
ERASING HOMELINK(R) TRANSCEIVER CODES
NOTE: Individual channels cannot be erased. Erasing the HomeLink(R) transceiver codes will
erase ALL programmed codes.
To erase programming from all three buttons (individual buttons cannot be erased but can be
"reprogrammed"), follow the step noted:
- Press and hold the two outer HomeLink(R) transceiver buttons until the indicator light begins to
flash-after 20 seconds. Release both buttons. Do not hold for longer that 30 seconds. HomeLink(R)
is now in the train (or learning) mode and can be programmed at any time beginning with
"Programming" See: .
Reprogramming Homelink(R) Transmitter Codes
REPROGRAMMING HOMELINK(R) TRANSCEIVER CODES
WARNING: Vehicle exhaust contains carbon monoxide, a dangerous gas. Do not run the vehicle's
exhaust while training the HomeLink(R)
transceiver. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: Your motorized door or gate may open and close while you are training the
HomeLink(R) transceiver if the vehicle is in range of
the motorized device. Do not train the HomeLink(R) transceiver if people or pets are in the path of
the door or gate. A moving door or gate can cause serious injury or death to people and pets or
damage to objects.
NOTE: If programing the HomeLink(R) transceiver is unsuccessful using the following procedure,
refer to the Owner's Manual for the
current customer assistance phone number.
To program a device to the HomeLink(R) transceiver using a button previously trained, follow these
steps:
- Press and hold the desired HomeLink(R) transceiver button. DO NOT release the button. The
indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds. Without releasing the HomeLink(R) transceiver
button, proceed to step 2.
- Position the end of your hand-held transmitter 3-8 cm (1-3 inches) away from the HomeLink(R)
transceiver button while keeping the indicator light in view.
- Simultaneously press and hold both the HomeLink(R) transceiver button that you want to train
and the hand-held transmitter buttons. Do not release the buttons until step 4 has been
completed.NOTE: Some gate operators and garage door openers may require you to replace this
Reprogramming Step 3 with procedures noted in the "Gate Operator/Canadian Programming"
section.
- The HomeLink(R) transceiver indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly after it successfully
receives the frequency signal from the hand-held transmitter. Release both buttons after the
indicator light changes from the slow to the rapid flash.
- Press and hold the just trained HomeLink(R) transceiver button and observe the indicator light. If
the indicator light stays on constantly, reprogramming is complete and your device should activate
when the button is pressed and released. NOTE: If the indicator light blinks rapidly for two seconds
and then turns to a constant light, continue with "Reprogramming" steps 6-8 to complete the
programming of a rolling code equipped device (most commonly a garage door opener).
- At the garage door opener receiver (motor-head unit) in the garage, locate the "learn" or "smart"
button. This can usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is attached to the motor-head
unit.
- Firmly press and release the "learn" or "smart" button. (The name and color of the button may
vary by manufacturer.)NOTE: There are 30 seconds in which to initiate step 8.
- Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold for two seconds and release the reprogrammed
HomeLink(R) transceiver button. Repeat the "press/hold/release" sequence a second time, and,
depending on the brand of the garage door opener (or other rolling code equipped device), repeat
this sequence a third time to complete the reprogramming. The HomeLink(R) transceiver should
now activate your rolling code equipped device.
Canadian Programming/Gate Programming
Canadian radio-frequency laws require transmitter signals to "time-out" (or quit) after several
seconds of transmission which may not be long enough for the HomeLink(R) transceiver to pick up
the signal during programming. Similar to this Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are
designed to "time-out" in the same manner.
If you live in Canada or you are having difficulties programming a gate operator by using the
"Programming" procedures (regardless of where you live), replace "Reprogramming HomeLink(R)
Transceiver Codes" step 3 with the following:
NOTE: When programming a garage door opener or gate operator, it is advised to unplug the
device or move the vehicle out of range during
the "cycling" process to prevent possible overheating.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Tests and General Diagnostics > Page 8005
- 3. Continue to press and hold the HomeLink(R) transceiver button while you press and release
every two seconds ("cycle") your hand-held transmitter until the frequency signal has successfully
been accepted. The indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly. Proceed with "Programming"
step 4 to complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8009
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 8 WAY
SWITCH-BANK - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Instrument Cluster Switch Pod - Description
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Description and Operation Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM) is located in the center stack area of the instrument
panel just below the heater and air conditioner duct and above the radio. This switch is available in
multiple configurations, which vary from a single momentary push button switch to as many as six
momentary push button switches, depending upon the optional equipment in the vehicle. The pod
may include the following switches:
- Heated Seats (if equipped) (1)
- Electronic Stability Program Off (2)
- Hazard Warning (3)
- Headlamp Leveling (export only) (4)
- Electrical Inverter On/Off (domestic only) (5)
The switch housing and the push buttons are constructed of molded plastic. Each push button has
a smooth finish and is clearly identified with the appropriate text and International Control and
Display Symbol icons. Several of the push buttons feature Light Emitting Diode (LED) units to give
the vehicle operator an indication when the function of that switch is currently active.
Four screws secure the switch to the back of the instrument panel center bezel through integral
mounting tabs that are molded into each corner of the switch housing. The back of the switch
housing has an integral connector receptacle containing terminal pins that connect the switch to the
vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness.
Panel lamps dimmer controlled illumination lamps integral to the circuit board within the switch
provide back lighting for visibility at night, but these lamps are not serviceable. The individual
switches in the ASBM cannot be repaired and are not serviced individually. If any component within
the switch pod is ineffective or damaged, the entire switch pod must be replaced.
The Domestic version of the ASBM is as follows:
- Heated Seat Switches (if equipped) - See: Body and Frame/Seats/Seat Heater Switch/Description
and Operation/Heated Seat Switch - Description.
- ESP Off - See: Brakes and Traction Control/Description and Operation.
- Hazard Switch (all models) - See: Lighting and Horns/Hazard Warning Lamps/Hazard Warning
Switch/Description and Operation/Hazard Warning Switch - Description.
- Electrical Inverter (domestic models).
The Export version of the ASBM will vary from the domestic:
- Heated Seat Switches (if equipped) - See: Body and Frame/Seats/Seat Heater Switch/Description
and Operation/Heated Seat Switch - Description.
- Hazard Switch (all models) - See: Lighting and Horns/Hazard Warning Lamps/Hazard Warning
Switch/Description and Operation/Hazard Warning Switch - Description.
- Headlamp Leveling Switch (if equipped) - .
Each individual switch is not available for service replacement. If one or more switches are
inoperative, the entire ASBM must be replaced. See: Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster Switch
Pod - Removal. To diagnose the ASBM switches, use a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic
information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Instrument Cluster Switch Pod - Description > Page 8012
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Description and Operation Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Operation
OPERATION
For information covering details of operation for the individual switches or indicator contained within
the instrument panel switch pod, refer to the specific service information covering the system to
which that switch or indicator belongs.
- Heated Seat Switches (if equipped) - See: Body and Frame/Seats/Seat Heater Switch/Description
and Operation/Heated Seat Switch - Description.
- ESP On/Off (domestic models) - See: Brakes and Traction Control/Description and Operation.
- Hazard Switch (all models) - See: Lighting and Horns/Hazard Warning Lamps/Hazard Warning
Switch/Description and Operation/Hazard Warning Switch - Description.
- Electrical Inverter (domestic models)
- Headlamp Leveling Switch (if equipped) - .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Cluster Switch Pod - Removal
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Service and Repair Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel center bezel.
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the switch by depressing the lock tab and pulling
connector from the ASBM. 4. Remove the four screws (1) to the Accessory Switch Bank Module
(ASBM). 5. Remove the ASBM from the instrument panel center bezel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Cluster Switch Pod - Removal > Page 8015
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Service and Repair Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the accessory switch bank module (ASBM) in the center bezel and install the four
screws (1). 2. Connect the electrical connector to the ASBM. Be sure the lock tab engages
securely into the ASBM. 3. Install the instrument panel center bezel. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Radio Amplifier C1 (Body) 22 Way
Amplifier: Diagrams Radio Amplifier C1 (Body) 22 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 22 WAY
AMPLIFIER-RADIO - (BODY) 22 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Radio Amplifier C1 (Body) 22 Way > Page 8022
Amplifier: Diagrams Radio Amplifier C2 (Body) 16 Way
Connector C2 - (BODY) 16 WAY
AMPLIFIER-RADIO - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Description and Operation > Amplifier - Description
Amplifier: Description and Operation Amplifier - Description
DESCRIPTION
The optional premium speaker system includes a separate audio power amplifier. The amplifier is
an eight channel unit. The amplifier is located behind the right cowl trim panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Description and Operation > Amplifier - Description > Page 8025
Amplifier: Description and Operation Amplifier - Operation
OPERATION
The power amplifier electronically increases the frequency response of the normal audio signal
output from the radio amplifier in order to improve the acoustic performance of the speakers. On
vehicles equipped with an amplifier, the amplifier section of the radio becomes a pre-amplifier.
The amplifier receives audio signal inputs for speaker channels from the radio, then sends
amplified audio outputs through eight separate channels with dedicated feed and return circuits to
the individual speakers.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Amplifier - Removal
Amplifier: Service and Repair Amplifier - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Lower the glove box as necessary to gain
access to the amplifier. 3. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Loosen the mounting fasteners
and remove the amplifier and bracket. 5. Remove the amplifier from the bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Amplifier - Removal > Page 8028
Amplifier: Service and Repair Amplifier - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the amplifier to the mounting bracket. 2. Install amplifier. Tighten the forward screw to 3
Nm (26.5 in. lbs.) and the rear nut to 2 Nm (18 in. lbs.). 3. Connect the electrical connectors. 4.
Raise the glove box. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch > Page 8034
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch > Page 8035
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch > Page 8036
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
Remote Switch: Diagrams Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
SWITCH-REMOTE RADIO-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
> Page 8039
Remote Switch: Diagrams Right Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
SWITCH-REMOTE RADIO-RIGHT - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
> Page 8040
Remote Switch: Diagrams Left Steering Wheel Switch (EVIC) (Steering Wheel) 4 Way
Connector (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-STEERING WHEEL-LEFT (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
> Page 8041
Remote Switch: Diagrams Right Steering Wheel Switch (EVIC) (Steering Wheel) 10 Way
Connector (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 10 WAY
SWITCH-STEERING WHEEL-RIGHT (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8042
Remote Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Remote radio control switches are rocker-type switch units are mounted in the upper spoke covers
of the rear (instrument panel side) steering wheel trim cover. The switch unit on the left side is the
seek switch and has seek up, seek down, and preset station advance switch functions. The switch
unit on the right side is the volume control switch and has volume up, volume down, and mode
advance switch functions.
The two remote radio switch units are each retained in a mounting hole located on opposite sides
of the rear steering wheel trim cover by four integral snap features. A plastic bracket on the back of
each switch unit provides additional support for the unit by extending towards the center of the
steering wheel where it is clamped between the steering wheel armature and the steering wheel
rear trim cover mounting boss by the trim cover mounting screw.
The two remote radio switch units share a common steering wheel wire harness with the vehicle
speed control switches. The steering wheel wire harness is connected to the instrument panel wire
harness through the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8043
Remote Switch: Testing and Inspection
REMOTE SWITCHES
Any diagnosis of the Audio system should begin with the use of the scan tool. For information on
the use of the scan tool, refer to the appropriate Diagnostic Service information.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the remote radio switch(es) from the
steering wheel. 2. Use an ohmmeter to check the switch resistances as shown in the Remote
Radio Switch Test table. If the remote radio switch resistances check
OK, go to 3. If not OK, replace the faulty switch.
REMOTE RADIO SWITCH TEST
3. Reconnect the battery negative cable. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. Check for 5
volts at the radio control circuit cavities of the
steering wheel wire harness connectors for both remote radio switches. If OK, refer to the proper
Body Diagnostic Procedures. If not OK, repair the circuit as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches - Removal
Remote Switch: Service and Repair Remote Radio Switches - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the driver side airbag module from
the steering wheel. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air
Bag - Removal.
3. Disconnect the horn connector (3). 4. Remove retainers (1) and remove the horn button
assembly (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches - Removal >
Page 8046
5. Remove the speed control switch (3) See: Cruise Control/Cruise Control Switch/Service and
Repair/Speed Control Switch - Removal.
6. Disconnect the radio switches (1). 7. From the inside of the steering wheel rear trim cover, press
firmly and evenly outward on the back of the switch to disengage the four snap features
that secure the switch to the inside of the mounting hole.
8. From the outside of the steering wheel rear trim cover, remove the remote radio switch from the
trim cover mounting hole.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches - Removal >
Page 8047
Remote Switch: Service and Repair Remote Radio Switches - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Position the remote radio switch to the mounting hole on the outside of the steering wheel rear
trim cover. Be certain that the connector receptacle
is oriented toward the bottom of the switch and pointed toward the center of the steering wheel.
2. Press firmly and evenly on the remote radio switch until each of the switch snap features is fully
engaged in the mounting hole of the steering
wheel rear trim cover.
3. Reconnect the steering wheel wire harness connector to the connector receptacle of the remote
radio switch (1).
4. Install the speed control switch (3) See: Cruise Control/Cruise Control Switch/Service and
Repair/Speed Control Switch - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches - Removal >
Page 8048
5. Install the horn button assembly (2) and install the three retainers (1). 6. Connect the horn
connector (3).
7. Install the driver side airbag module to the steering wheel See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag Installation.
8. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8053
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8054
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8055
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8056
Speaker: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8057
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8058
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8059
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8060
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8061
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Left Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 8062
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way
Speaker: Diagrams Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
SPEAKER-INSTRUMENT PANEL-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way > Page 8065
Speaker: Diagrams Right Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
SPEAKER-INSTRUMENT PANEL-RIGHT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way > Page 8066
Speaker: Diagrams Left Front Door Speaker (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SPEAKER-LEFT FRONT DOOR - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way > Page 8067
Speaker: Diagrams Left Rear Door Speaker (Rear Door) 3 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 3 WAY
SPEAKER-LEFT REAR DOOR - (REAR DOOR) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way > Page 8068
Speaker: Diagrams
Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
SPEAKER-INSTRUMENT PANEL-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
Right Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
SPEAKER-INSTRUMENT PANEL-RIGHT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way > Page 8069
Left Front Door Speaker (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SPEAKER-LEFT FRONT DOOR - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Left Rear Door Speaker (Rear Door) 3 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way > Page 8070
SPEAKER-LEFT REAR DOOR - (REAR DOOR) 3 WAY
Right Front Door Speaker (Front Door) 3 Way
Connector - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
SPEAKER-RIGHT FRONT DOOR - (FRONT DOOR) 3 WAY
Right Rear Door Speaker (Rear Door) 3 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Instrument Panel Speaker (Instrument Panel) 2 Way > Page 8071
SPEAKER-RIGHT REAR DOOR - (REAR DOOR) 3 WAY
Subwoofer Speaker (Premium) (Body) 6 Way
Connector (PREMIUM) - (BODY) 6 WAY
SPEAKER-SUBWOOFER (PREMIUM) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8072
Speaker: Description and Operation
OPERATION
Two wires connected to each speaker, one feed circuit (+) and one return circuit (-), allow the audio
output signal electrical current to flow through the voice coil. For complete circuit diagrams, refer to
the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper wire
and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector pin-out
information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8073
Speaker: Testing and Inspection
SPEAKER
Any diagnosis of the Audio system should begin with the use of the scan tool. For information on
the use of the scan tool, refer to the appropriate Diagnostic Service information.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
CAUTION: The speaker output of the radio is a "floating ground" system. Do not allow any speaker
lead to short to ground, as damage to the
radio may result.
1. If all speakers are inoperative, check the radio fuses in the Totally Integrated Power Module
(TIPM). If OK, go to Step 2. If not OK, repair the
shorted circuit or component as required and replace the faulty fuse.
2. Check the amplifier fuse (if equipped) in the TIPM. If OK, go to Step 3. If not OK, repair the
shorted circuit or component as required and replace
the faulty fuse.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. Turn the radio receiver ON. Adjust the balance and
fader control controls to check the performance of
each individual speaker. Note the speaker locations that are not performing correctly. Go to Step 4.
4. Turn the radio receiver OFF. Turn the ignition OFF. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
cable. If vehicle is not equipped with a amplifier,
remove the radio receiver. If vehicle is equipped with an amplifier. disconnect wire harness
connector at output side of amplifier. Go to Step 5.
5. Check both the speaker feed (+) circuit and return (-) circuit cavities for the inoperative speaker
at the radio receiver wire harness connector for
continuity to ground. There should be no continuity. If OK, go to Step 6. If not OK, repair the
shorted speaker feed (+) and/or return (-) circuit(s) to the speaker as required.
6. Disconnect wire harness connector at the inoperative speaker. Check for continuity between the
speaker feed (+) circuit cavities of the radio
receiver wire harness connector or if equipped, the amplifier wire harness connector and the
speaker wire harness connector. Repeat the check between the speaker return (-) circuit cavities of
the radio receiver wire harness connector and the speaker wire harness connector. In each case,
there should be continuity. If OK, replace the faulty speaker. If not OK, repair the open speaker
feed (+) and/or return (-) circuit(s) as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker - Removal
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker - Removal
REMOVAL
DOOR SPEAKER
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the door trim panel. See: Body
and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front
Door
Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Remove the mounting fasteners. 4. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the speaker
from the vehicle.
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the defroster grille. See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Air Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille - Removal. 3. Remove the
mounting fasteners. 4. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the speaker from the
vehicle.
SUBWOOFER
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the left rear quarter trim panel.
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Remove the subwoofer mounting fasteners. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove
the subwoofer from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker - Removal > Page 8076
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker - Installation
INSTALLATION
DOOR SPEAKER
1. Install the speaker and connect the electrical connector. 2. Install the mounting fasteners. 3.
Install the door trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door
Trim Panel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
1. Install the speaker and connect the electrical connector. 2. Install the mounting fasteners. 3.
Install the defroster grille. See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Air Register/Service and
Repair/Defroster Grille - Installation. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
SUBWOOFER
1. Install the subwoofer and connect the electrical connector. 2. Install the mounting fasteners. 3.
Install the left rear quarter trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2
(Body) 2 Way
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C2 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C2 - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2
(Body) 2 Way > Page 8083
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C3 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C3 - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2
(Body) 2 Way > Page 8084
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C1 (Body) 16 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 16 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 16 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Satellite Video Module C2
(Body) 2 Way > Page 8085
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Satellite Video Module C4 (Body) 2 Way
Connector C4 - (BODY) 2 WAY
MODULE-SATELLITE VIDEO - (BODY) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Satellite Video
Module - Removal
Entertainment System Control Module: Service and Repair Satellite Video Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Move the front passenger seat to the most
forward position.
3. Disconnect the three antenna connectors (1) and the electrical connector (2).
4. Remove the three retainers (1) securing the video module housing (2) to the floor, remove video
housing and module from vehicle.
5. Remove the video module retainers (1) to the video module housing (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Satellite Video
Module - Removal > Page 8088
Entertainment System Control Module: Service and Repair Satellite Video Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the video module to the housing.
2. Install the video module into the vehicle and Install the three retainers (1) securing the video
module housing (2) to the floor.Tighten to 6 Nm (53
in. lbs.).
3. Connect the three antenna connectors (1) and the electrical connector (2). 4. Move the front
passenger seat back to the original position. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8092
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8093
Keyless Entry Module: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Voice Activation Module > Component Information > Locations > Hands Free Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Voice Activation Module > Component Information > Locations > Hands Free Module > Page 8098
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Voice Activation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Hands Free Module C1 (Instrument Panel)
22 Way
Voice Activation Module: Diagrams Hands Free Module C1 (Instrument Panel) 22 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 22 WAY
MODULE-HANDS FREE - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 22 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Voice Activation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Hands Free Module C1 (Instrument Panel)
22 Way > Page 8101
Voice Activation Module: Diagrams Hands Free Module C2 (UCI) (Instrument Panel) 10 Way
Connector C2 (UCI) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 10 WAY
MODULE-HANDS FREE (UCI) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 8106
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-HOOD AJAR - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft
Security Hood Ajar Switch - Description
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The hood ajar switch is a normally closed, single pole, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch. This
switch has two unique versions that are used in two different applications. One switch is used only
on vehicles equipped with the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) for sale in certain export
markets where protection of the underhood area is required equipment. The second switch is used
only on domestic vehicles equipped with an optional remote starter system.
The molded plastic switch body (5) has an integral molded connector receptacle (1) on the lower
end containing two terminal pins. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out of the headlamp and dash wire harness. Two integral latches (2) lock the switch
into a keyed mounting hole in the stamped steel switch mounting bracket. The mounting bracket is
secured with screws to the right inner fender shield near the fender ledge in the engine
compartment. The underside of the hood panel inner reinforcement actuates the switch plunger as
the hood panel is closed.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) and a sleeve-like retainer ring on the
upper end of the switch body. The retainer ring has a one time, self-adjustment feature that is
activated after the switch is installed by closing the hood. The retainer ring is also color-coded to
aid in identifying the switch application. A dark brown retainer ring identifies the underhood security
switch application, while a white retainer ring identifies the remote starter system application.
An installed hood ajar switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, or requires readjustment, it must be replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft
Security Hood Ajar Switch - Description > Page 8109
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The hood ajar switches are interchangeable physically, but not functionally. In each case, the hood
ajar switch is a normally closed switch that is held open as the spring-loaded switch plunger is
depressed by the inner hood panel reinforcement when the hood panel is closed and latched.
When the hood is opened, the spring-loaded switch plunger extends from the switch body and the
switch contacts are closed.
In the underhood security application (export vehicles only - dark brown retainer ring), the switch is
connected in series between ground and the hood ajar switch sense input of the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM uses an internal resistor pull up to monitor the state of the hood
ajar switch contacts.
In the remote starter system application (domestic vehicles only - white retainer ring) the switch has
a 1 kilohm diagnostic resistor connected in parallel to the switch contacts between the two switch
terminals. The switch is connected in series between an output of the TIPM and the hood ajar
switch sense input of the TIPM. The TIPM continually monitors this circuit and it will store a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that it detects.
The components of the switch self-adjustment feature include an integral stop on the shaft of the
plunger and a ribbed, ratcheting sleeve-like retainer ring at the top of the switch body from which
the plunger extends. With the switch mounting collar secured in its mounting bracket, the plunger is
depressed by the hood inner reinforcement as the hood is closed. As the plunger is depressed, the
plunger stop contacts the top of the retainer ring and it is driven downward, ratcheting through the
switch mounting collar until the hood is fully closed and latched. The ribs on the retainer ring are
engaged within the mounting collar to maintain this adjusted position.
The hood ajar switch as well as the hard-wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices related to hood ajar
switch operation that provide some features of the export vehicle theft or domestic remote starter
systems. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to hood ajar switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security
Hood Ajar Switch - Removal
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal
SWITCH
1. Unlatch and open the hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect
the wire harness connector (3) from the switch connector receptacle. 4. From the top of the hood
ajar switch mounting bracket (2), squeeze the two switch latch tabs together and pull the switch (1)
upward through the
hole in the mounting bracket.
5. Remove the hood ajar switch from the mounting bracket and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security
Hood Ajar Switch - Removal > Page 8112
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Installation
SWITCH
NOTE: Self-adjustment of the hood ajar switch is a one-time feature. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, removed or requires readjustment,
it must be replaced with a new unit.
1. Position the hood ajar switch (1) above the hole in the mounting bracket (2). 2. Press the switch
into the mounting hole until the integral switch latch tabs lock it into place. 3. Connect the harness
connector (3) to the switch connector receptacle. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Close
and latch the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Locations > Page 8116
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 8 WAY
SWITCH-BANK - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Description and Operation > Instrument
Cluster Switch Pod - Description
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Description and Operation Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM) is located in the center stack area of the instrument
panel just below the heater and air conditioner duct and above the radio. This switch is available in
multiple configurations, which vary from a single momentary push button switch to as many as six
momentary push button switches, depending upon the optional equipment in the vehicle. The pod
may include the following switches:
- Heated Seats (if equipped) (1)
- Electronic Stability Program Off (2)
- Hazard Warning (3)
- Headlamp Leveling (export only) (4)
- Electrical Inverter On/Off (domestic only) (5)
The switch housing and the push buttons are constructed of molded plastic. Each push button has
a smooth finish and is clearly identified with the appropriate text and International Control and
Display Symbol icons. Several of the push buttons feature Light Emitting Diode (LED) units to give
the vehicle operator an indication when the function of that switch is currently active.
Four screws secure the switch to the back of the instrument panel center bezel through integral
mounting tabs that are molded into each corner of the switch housing. The back of the switch
housing has an integral connector receptacle containing terminal pins that connect the switch to the
vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness.
Panel lamps dimmer controlled illumination lamps integral to the circuit board within the switch
provide back lighting for visibility at night, but these lamps are not serviceable. The individual
switches in the ASBM cannot be repaired and are not serviced individually. If any component within
the switch pod is ineffective or damaged, the entire switch pod must be replaced.
The Domestic version of the ASBM is as follows:
- Heated Seat Switches (if equipped) - See: Body and Frame/Seats/Seat Heater Switch/Description
and Operation/Heated Seat Switch - Description.
- ESP Off - See: Brakes and Traction Control/Description and Operation.
- Hazard Switch (all models) - See: Lighting and Horns/Hazard Warning Lamps/Hazard Warning
Switch/Description and Operation/Hazard Warning Switch - Description.
- Electrical Inverter (domestic models).
The Export version of the ASBM will vary from the domestic:
- Heated Seat Switches (if equipped) - See: Body and Frame/Seats/Seat Heater Switch/Description
and Operation/Heated Seat Switch - Description.
- Hazard Switch (all models) - See: Lighting and Horns/Hazard Warning Lamps/Hazard Warning
Switch/Description and Operation/Hazard Warning Switch - Description.
- Headlamp Leveling Switch (if equipped) - .
Each individual switch is not available for service replacement. If one or more switches are
inoperative, the entire ASBM must be replaced. See: Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster Switch
Pod - Removal. To diagnose the ASBM switches, use a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic
information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Description and Operation > Instrument
Cluster Switch Pod - Description > Page 8119
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Description and Operation Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Operation
OPERATION
For information covering details of operation for the individual switches or indicator contained within
the instrument panel switch pod, refer to the specific service information covering the system to
which that switch or indicator belongs.
- Heated Seat Switches (if equipped) - See: Body and Frame/Seats/Seat Heater Switch/Description
and Operation/Heated Seat Switch - Description.
- ESP On/Off (domestic models) - See: Brakes and Traction Control/Description and Operation.
- Hazard Switch (all models) - See: Lighting and Horns/Hazard Warning Lamps/Hazard Warning
Switch/Description and Operation/Hazard Warning Switch - Description.
- Electrical Inverter (domestic models)
- Headlamp Leveling Switch (if equipped) - .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Cluster
Switch Pod - Removal
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Service and Repair Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel center bezel.
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the switch by depressing the lock tab and pulling
connector from the ASBM. 4. Remove the four screws (1) to the Accessory Switch Bank Module
(ASBM). 5. Remove the ASBM from the instrument panel center bezel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Cluster
Switch Pod - Removal > Page 8122
Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly: Service and Repair Instrument Cluster Switch Pod Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the accessory switch bank module (ASBM) in the center bezel and install the four
screws (1). 2. Connect the electrical connector to the ASBM. Be sure the lock tab engages
securely into the ASBM. 3. Install the instrument panel center bezel. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Bezel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch > Page
8127
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch > Page
8128
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Left Remote Radio Switch > Page
8129
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering
Wheel) 2 Way
Remote Switch: Diagrams Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
SWITCH-REMOTE RADIO-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering
Wheel) 2 Way > Page 8132
Remote Switch: Diagrams Right Remote Radio Switch (Steering Wheel) 2 Way
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
SWITCH-REMOTE RADIO-RIGHT - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering
Wheel) 2 Way > Page 8133
Remote Switch: Diagrams Left Steering Wheel Switch (EVIC) (Steering Wheel) 4 Way
Connector (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-STEERING WHEEL-LEFT (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Remote Radio Switch (Steering
Wheel) 2 Way > Page 8134
Remote Switch: Diagrams Right Steering Wheel Switch (EVIC) (Steering Wheel) 10 Way
Connector (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 10 WAY
SWITCH-STEERING WHEEL-RIGHT (EVIC) - (STEERING WHEEL) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8135
Remote Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Remote radio control switches are rocker-type switch units are mounted in the upper spoke covers
of the rear (instrument panel side) steering wheel trim cover. The switch unit on the left side is the
seek switch and has seek up, seek down, and preset station advance switch functions. The switch
unit on the right side is the volume control switch and has volume up, volume down, and mode
advance switch functions.
The two remote radio switch units are each retained in a mounting hole located on opposite sides
of the rear steering wheel trim cover by four integral snap features. A plastic bracket on the back of
each switch unit provides additional support for the unit by extending towards the center of the
steering wheel where it is clamped between the steering wheel armature and the steering wheel
rear trim cover mounting boss by the trim cover mounting screw.
The two remote radio switch units share a common steering wheel wire harness with the vehicle
speed control switches. The steering wheel wire harness is connected to the instrument panel wire
harness through the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8136
Remote Switch: Testing and Inspection
REMOTE SWITCHES
Any diagnosis of the Audio system should begin with the use of the scan tool. For information on
the use of the scan tool, refer to the appropriate Diagnostic Service information.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the remote radio switch(es) from the
steering wheel. 2. Use an ohmmeter to check the switch resistances as shown in the Remote
Radio Switch Test table. If the remote radio switch resistances check
OK, go to 3. If not OK, replace the faulty switch.
REMOTE RADIO SWITCH TEST
3. Reconnect the battery negative cable. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. Check for 5
volts at the radio control circuit cavities of the
steering wheel wire harness connectors for both remote radio switches. If OK, refer to the proper
Body Diagnostic Procedures. If not OK, repair the circuit as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches Removal
Remote Switch: Service and Repair Remote Radio Switches - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the driver side airbag module from
the steering wheel. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air
Bag - Removal.
3. Disconnect the horn connector (3). 4. Remove retainers (1) and remove the horn button
assembly (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches Removal > Page 8139
5. Remove the speed control switch (3) See: Cruise Control/Cruise Control Switch/Service and
Repair/Speed Control Switch - Removal.
6. Disconnect the radio switches (1). 7. From the inside of the steering wheel rear trim cover, press
firmly and evenly outward on the back of the switch to disengage the four snap features
that secure the switch to the inside of the mounting hole.
8. From the outside of the steering wheel rear trim cover, remove the remote radio switch from the
trim cover mounting hole.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches Removal > Page 8140
Remote Switch: Service and Repair Remote Radio Switches - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag or instrument
panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable.
Wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis
or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Position the remote radio switch to the mounting hole on the outside of the steering wheel rear
trim cover. Be certain that the connector receptacle
is oriented toward the bottom of the switch and pointed toward the center of the steering wheel.
2. Press firmly and evenly on the remote radio switch until each of the switch snap features is fully
engaged in the mounting hole of the steering
wheel rear trim cover.
3. Reconnect the steering wheel wire harness connector to the connector receptacle of the remote
radio switch (1).
4. Install the speed control switch (3) See: Cruise Control/Cruise Control Switch/Service and
Repair/Speed Control Switch - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Radio Switches Removal > Page 8141
5. Install the horn button assembly (2) and install the three retainers (1). 6. Connect the horn
connector (3).
7. Install the driver side airbag module to the steering wheel See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag Installation.
8. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Locations
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8145
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C2
(Instrument Panel) 6 Way
Connector C2 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 8148
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C3
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C3 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 8149
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C4
(Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C4 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Steering Control Module C2 (Instrument Panel) 6 Way > Page 8150
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams Steering Control Module C8
(Steering Wheel) 6 Way
Connector C8 - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
MODULE-STEERING CONTROL - (STEERING WHEEL) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module - Description
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Control Module (SCM) that is internal to the left
multi-function switch housing (2). The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side
of the steering column, just below the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the
interior and exterior lighting systems. The only visible components of the switch are the control
stalk (1), control knob and control sleeve that extend through the steering column shrouds on the
left side of the column. The remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions and electrical
connections are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing and controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A single screw (7)
through a mounting tab integral to the back of the switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the
bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the mounting bracket integral to the clockspring
(3). A connector receptacle containing seven terminal pins is integral to the inboard end of the
switch housing and connects the SCM through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the right
(wiper) multi-function switch (6). A second connector receptacle containing four terminal pins is
integral to the back of the switch housing and connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system
through a dedicated takeout and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The SCM cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged the entire left multi-function
switch must be replaced. See: Lighting and Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and
Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left Multifunction Switch - Removal. The
clockspring (with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the
SCM), the right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate
service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module - Description > Page 8153
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module - Description > Page 8154
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle is equipped with a Steering Column Control Module (SCCM). The SCCM is secured
near the top of the steering column below the steering wheel and is completely concealed beneath
the steering column shrouds. It is installed as a modular unit that supports the left (lighting)
multi-function switch (1) and right (wiper) multi-function switch (6). The controls for each of these
switches extend through appropriate clearance holes provided in the steering column shrouds.
The microprocessor-based Steering Control Module (SCM) (2) utilizes integrated circuitry and
information carried on the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus along with several hard wired
analog and multiplexed inputs to monitor both the right and left multi-function switches. The SCCM
uses a Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data bus for exterior lighting and wiper functions. The LIN
data is sent to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN then sends it out on the CAN data
bus See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Description
and Operation/Communication - Description. The SCCM is available for service replacement as a
unit or each individual component:
- Clockspring (with integral Steering Angle Sensor if equipped)
- Left Multi-Function Switch (with integral Steering Control Module)
- Right Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Steering Column Module - Description > Page 8155
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Description and Operation Steering Column
Control Module - Operation
OPERATION
The Steering Control Module (SCM) communicates over the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) data
bus with other electronic modules in the vehicle and/or a diagnostic scan tool. The horn switch
circuits pass through the clockspring to the Cab Compartment Node (CCN) and the CCN sends a
CAN message to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control the horn. The CCN stores
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) for the SCM. The right (wiper) multi-function switch has several
inputs to the CCN.
The SCM is connected to a fused B(+) circuit and receives a path to ground at all times. These
connections allow it to remain functional regardless of the ignition switch position. The driver airbag
squib circuits of the clockspring, the horn, and the speed control switch circuits pass through the
SCM, but the SCM does not monitor, and has no control outputs related to these circuits. Any other
input to the SCM that would cause a vehicle system to function but does not require that the
ignition switch be in the On position, such as turning on the lights or sounding the horn, prompts
the SCM to wake up and transmit on the CAN data bus.
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM, the CAN data bus, the hard
wired inputs or the electronic communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
The integral SCM is not available for separate service replacement. If found inoperative or
defective, the entire left (lighting) multi-function switch must be replaced See: Lighting and
Horns/Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns/Combination Switch/Service and Repair/Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8156
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Testing and Inspection
STEERING CONTROL MODULE
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
The hard wired circuits between components related to the Steering Control Module (SCM) may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair
procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector pin-out information and
location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the SCM or
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices that provide some
features of the SCM. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the SCM or the
electronic controls and communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Removal
REMOVAL
SCCM
1. Place the front road wheels in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. 2. Open hood. 3. Disconnect
and isolate the battery negative cable.
WARNING: Wait two minutes for the airbag system reserve capacitor to discharge before
beginning any airbag system or component service.
Failure to do so may result in accidental airbag deployment, personal injury or death.
4. Remove steering wheel See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and
Repair/Removal. 5. Remove upper and lower steering column shrouds to gain access to the
Steering Column Control Module (SCCM)See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
6. Lock the clockspring rotor in the center position as follows: Insert a grenade pin through the hole
in the rotor at the 10 o'clock position. 7. Remove the three screws (1) to the Steering Column
Control Module (SCCM) (3).
8. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) between the SCCM (1) and the instrument panel wiring
harness at the base of the SCCM and remove from
column.
NOTE: If only removing the SCCM from column, there is no need to continue to next step.
DISASSEMBLY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 8159
1. Remove the left multi-function switch stalk retaining screw (2). 2. Pull the left stalk out of the
SCCM.
3. Disconnect the left stalk electrical connector. 4. Separate the left switch from the SCCM.
5. Remove the one right multi-function switch retaining screw. 6. Pull right switch out of SCCM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 8160
7. Disconnect the right switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 8161
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Service and Repair Steering Column Control
Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If SCCM is already assembled and needs to be installed, bypass ASSEMBLY and proceed
with SCCM 1.
ASSEMBLY
1. Connect the right stalk electrical connector.
2. Slide the right stalk into the groove and install the one retaining screw.
3. Connect the left stalk switch electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 8162
4. Install the left stalk switch retaining screw.
SCCM
1. Position the SCCM (3) over the steering column shaft (2). 2. Install the three screws (1).
3. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the instrument panel harness, ensure wiring is properly
routed. Then check that the connectors, locking
tabs are properly engaged.
4. Install steering column shrouds See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation. Be sure all wires are inside of shrouds.
5. Install steering wheel ensuring the flats on hub align with the clockspring See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and
Repair/Installation. Pull the airbag leads through the larger slot. Ensure leads do not get pinched
under the steering wheel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Column Control Module - Removal > Page 8163
NOTE: There is a small wire harness in the steering wheel and it contains the horn circuits and
speed control circuits.
6. Connect the speed control and horn wire connector into the clockspring. 7. Pull the grenade pin
out of the clockspring. 8. Install the driver airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air
Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation
WARNING: Do not connect the negative battery cable at this time. Perform the Air Bag System
Test prior to connecting the negative battery
cable See: Restraint Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
Failure to follow this warning may result in accidental air bag deployment and possible serious or
fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico
Towing Information: Service and Repair Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico
SPECIFICATION - TOWING, Trailer - NAFTA, Puerto Rico
you will find safety tips and information on limits to the type of towing you can reasonably do with
your vehicle. Before towing a trailer, carefully review this information to tow your load as efficiently
and safely as possible.
To maintain warranty coverage, follow the requirements and recommendations concerning vehicles
used for trailer towing.
Common Towing Definitions
The following trailer towing related definitions will assist you in understanding the following
information:
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
The Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) is the total allowable weight of your vehicle. This
includes driver, passengers, cargo, and tongue weight. The total load must be limited so that you
do not exceed the GVWR.
Gross Trailer Weight (GTW)
The Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) is the weight of the trailer plus the weight of all cargo,
consumables, and equipment (permanent or temporary) loaded in or on the trailer in its "loaded
and ready for operation" condition. The recommended way to measure GTW is to put your fully
loaded trailer on a vehicle scale. The entire weight of the trailer must be supported by the scale.
Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR)
The Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR) is the total permissible weight of your vehicle and
trailer when weighed in combination. (Note that GCWR ratings include a 150 lbs (68 kg) allowance
for the presence of a driver.)
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
The Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) is the maximum capacity of the front and rear axles.
Distribute the load over the front and rear axles evenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either
front or rear GAWR.
WARNING: It is important that you do not exceed the maximum front or rear GAWR. A dangerous
driving condition can result if either
rating is exceeded. You could lose control of the vehicle and have an accident. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Tongue Weight (TW)
Tongue weight (TW) is the downward force exerted on the hitch ball by the trailer. In most cases, it
should not be less than 10% or more than 15% of the trailer load. You must consider this as part of
the load on your vehicle.
Frontal Area
Frontal area is the maximum height and maximum width of the front of a trailer.
Trailer Sway Control - Electronic
For information on this system, See: Brakes and Traction Control/Description and Operation.
Trailer Sway Control - Mechanical
The trailer sway control is a telescoping link that can be installed between the hitch receiver and
the trailer tongue that typically provides adjustable friction associated with the telescoping motion to
dampen any unwanted trailer swaying motions while traveling.
Weight-Carrying Hitch
A weight-carrying hitch supports the trailer tongue weight, just as if it were luggage located at a
hitch ball or some other connecting point of the vehicle. These kinds of hitches are the most
popular on the market today and they are commonly used to tow small- and medium-sized trailers.
Weight-Distributing Hitch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 8169
Weight Distributing Hitch System
A weight-distributing system works by applying leverage through spring (load) bars. They are
typically used for heavier loads to distribute trailer tongue weight to the tow vehicle's front axle and
the trailer axle(s). When used in accordance with the manufacturers directions, it provides for a
more level ride, offering more consistent steering and brake control thereby enhancing towing
safety. The addition of a friction / hydraulic sway control also dampens sway caused by traffic and
crosswinds and contributes positively to tow vehicle and trailer stability. Trailer sway control and a
weight distributing (load equalizing) hitch are recommended for heavier Tongue Weights (TW) and
may be required depending on vehicle and trailer configuration / loading to comply with Gross Axle
Weight Rating (GAWR) requirements.
Improper Adjustment of Weight Distributing System
WARNING:
- An improperly adjusted weight distributing hitch system may reduce handling, stability, braking
performance, and could result in an accident.
- Weight distributing systems may not be compatible with surge brake couplers. Consult with your
hitch and trailer manufacturer or a reputable recreational vehicle dealer for additional information.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
Trailer Hitch Classification
Your vehicle may be factory equipped for safe towing of trailers weighing over 2,000 lbs (907 kg)
with the optional Trailer Tow Prep Package. See your authorized dealer for package content.
The following chart provides the industry standard for the maximum trailer weight a given trailer
hitch class can tow and should be used to assist you in selecting the correct trailer hitch for your
intended towing condition.
All trailer hitches should be professionally installed on your vehicle.
Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer Weight Ratings)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 8170
The following chart provides the maximum trailer weight ratings towable for your given drivetrain.
Trailer and Tongue Weight
Always load a trailer with 60% to 65% of the weight in the front of the trailer. This places 10% to
15% of the Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) on the tow hitch of your vehicle. Loads balanced over the
wheels or heavier in the rear can cause the trailer to sway severely side to side which will cause
loss of control of the vehicle and trailer. Failure to load trailers heavier in front is the cause of many
trailer accidents.
Never exceed the maximum tongue weight stamped on your bumper or trailer hitch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 8171
Consider the following items when computing the weight on the rear axle of the vehicle:
- The tongue weight of the trailer.
- The weight of any other type of cargo or equipment put in or on your vehicle.
- The weight of the driver and all passengers.
NOTE: Remember that everything put into or on the trailer adds to the load on your vehicle. Also,
additional factory-installed options or
authorized dealer-installed options must be considered as part of the total load on your vehicle.
Refer to the "Tire and Loading Information" placard for the maximum combined weight of
occupants and cargo for your vehicle.
Towing Requirements
To promote proper break-in of your new vehicle drivetrain components the following guidelines are
recommended:
CAUTION:
- Avoid towing a trailer for the first 500 mi (805 km) of vehicle operation. Doing so may damage the
vehicle.
- During the first 500 mi (805 km) of trailer towing, limit the speed to 50 mph (80 km/h).
WARNING: Improper towing can lead to an injury accident. Follow these guidelines to make your
trailer towing as safe as possible:
Make certain that the load is secured in the trailer and that it will not shift during travel. When
trailering cargo that is not fully secured, dynamic load shifts can occur that may be difficult for the
driver to control. You could lose control of your vehicle and have an accident. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
- When hauling cargo or towing a trailer, do not overload your vehicle or trailer. Overloading can
cause a loss of control, poor performance, or damage to brakes, axle, engine, transaxle, steering,
suspension, chassis structure, or tires.
- Safety chains must always be used between your vehicle and trailer. Always connect the chains
to the frame or hook retainers of the vehicle hitch. Cross the chains under the trailer tongue and
allow enough slack for turning corners.
- Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a grade. When parking, apply the parking brake on
the tow vehicle. Put the tow vehicle automatic transaxle in PARK. Always, block or "chock" the
trailer wheels.
- GCWR must not be exceeded.
- Total weight must be distributed between the tow vehicle and the trailer such that the following
four ratings are not exceeded:
- GVWR
- GTW
- GAWR
- Tongue weight rating for the trailer hitch utilized. (This requirement may limit the ability to always
achieve the 10% to 15% range of tongue weight as a percentage of total trailer weight.)
Towing Requirements - Tires
- Do not attempt to tow a trailer while using a compact spare tire.
- Proper tire inflation pressures are essential to the safe and satisfactory operation of your vehicle.
Refer to "Tires-General Information" for information on tire pressures and for proper tire inflation
procedures.
- Also, check the trailer tires for proper tire inflation pressures before trailer usage.
- Check for signs of tire wear or visible tire damage before towing a trailer. Refer to "Tires-General
Information" for information on tread wear indicators and for the proper inspection procedure.
- When replacing tires, See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Tires/Description and Operation for
information on replacement tires and for the proper tire replacement procedures. Replacing tires
with a higher load carrying capacity will not increase the vehicle's GVWR and GAWR limits.
Towing Requirements - Trailer Brakes
- Do not interconnect the hydraulic brake system or vacuum system of your vehicle with that of the
trailer. This could cause inadequate braking and possible personal injury.
- An electronically actuated trailer brake controller is required when towing a trailer with
electronically actuated brakes. When towing a trailer equipped with a hydraulic surge actuated
brake system, an electronic brake controller is not required.
- Trailer brakes are recommended for trailers over 1,000 lbs (454 kg) and required for trailers in
excess of 2,000 lbs (907 kg).
CAUTION: If the trailer weighs more than 1,000 lbs (454 kg) loaded, it should have its own brakes,
and they should be of adequate capacity.
Failure to do this could lead to accelerated brake lining wear, higher brake pedal effort, and longer
stopping distances.
WARNING: Do not connect trailer brakes to your vehicle's hydraulic brake lines. It can overload
your brake system and cause it to fail. You
might not have brakes when you need them and could have an accident. Towing any trailer will
increase your stopping distance. When towing, you should allow for additional space between your
vehicle and the vehicle in front of you. Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible
serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 8172
Towing Requirements - Trailer Lights AND Wiring
4 - Pin Connector
Whenever you pull a trailer, regardless of the trailer size, stoplights and turn signals on the trailer
are required for motoring safety.
The Trailer Tow Package may include a 4- and 7-pin wiring harness. Use a factory approved trailer
harness and connector.
NOTE: Do not cut or splice wiring into the vehicles wiring harness.
The electrical connections are all complete to the vehicle but you must mate the harness to a trailer
connector. Refer to the following illustrations.
7- Pin Connector
Towing Tips
Before setting out on a trip, practice turning, stopping, and backing up the trailer in an area located
away from heavy traffic.
Towing Tips - Automatic Transaxle
The DRIVE range can be selected when towing. However, if frequent shifting occurs while in this
range, select the "3" range for 4-speed automatic or the "5" range for 6-speed automatic.
NOTE: Using the "3" or "5" range while operating the vehicle under heavy operating conditions will
improve performance and extend
transaxle life by reducing excessive shifting and heat build up. This action will also provide better
engine braking.
If you REGULARLY tow a trailer for more than 45 minutes of continuous operation, then change
the automatic transaxle fluid and filter according to the interval specified for "police, taxi, fleet, or
frequent trailer towing" in the Maintenance Schedule.
NOTE: Check the 4-speed automatic transaxle fluid level before towing. The 6-speed transaxle is
sealed and the fluid level cannot be checked.
See your authorized dealer for assistance.
Towing Tips - Electronic Speed Control (If Equipped)
- Don't use in hilly terrain or with heavy loads.
- When using the speed control, if you experience speed drops greater than 10 mph (16 km/h),
disengage until you can get back to cruising speed.
- Use speed control in flat terrain and with light loads to maximize fuel efficiency.
Towing Tips - Autostick (R) (If Equipped)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 8173
- By using the Autostick(R) modes and selecting a specific gear range, frequent shifting can be
avoided. The highest gear range should be selected that allows for adequate performance. For
example, choose "4" if the desired speed can be maintained. Choose "3" or "2" if needed to
maintain the desired speed.
- Extended driving at high RPM should be avoided to prevent excess heat generation. A reduction
in vehicle speed may be required to avoid extended driving at high RPM. Return to a higher gear
range or vehicle speed when road conditions and RPM level allows.
Cooling System
To reduce potential for engine and transmission overheating, take the following actions:
- City Driving
- When stopped for short periods of time, put transmission in neutral and increase engine idle
speed.
- Highway Driving
- Reduce speed.
- Air Conditioning
- Turn off temporarily.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 8174
Towing Information: Service and Repair Vehicle Towing
TOWING, Vehicle
WARNINGS AND PRECAUTIONS
WARNING: Do not allow towing attachment devices to contact the fuel tank or lines, fuel leakage
can result. Do not lift or tow vehicle by front
or rear bumper, or bumper energy absorber units. Do not venture under a lifted vehicle if not
supported properly on safety stands. Do not allow passengers to ride in a towed vehicle. Use a
safety chain that is independent from the towing attachment device. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury or death.
CAUTION: Do not damage brake lines, exhaust system, shock absorbers, sway bars, or any other
under vehicle components when attaching
towing device to vehicle. Do not attach towing device to front or rear suspension components. Do
not secure vehicle to towing device by the use of front or rear suspension or steering components.
Remove or secure loose or protruding objects from a damaged vehicle before towing. Refer to
state and local rules and regulations before towing a vehicle. Do not allow weight of towed vehicle
to bear on lower fascia, air dams, or spoilers.
RECOMMENDED TOWING EQUIPMENT
To avoid damage to bumper fascia and air dams use of a flat bed towing device or wheel lift is
recommended. When using a wheel lift towing device, be sure the unlifted end of disabled vehicle
has at least 100 mm (4 in.) ground clearance. If minimum ground clearance cannot be reached,
use a towing dolly. If a flat bed device is used, the approach angle should not exceed 15 degrees.
TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE
NUMBER: Without The Ignition Key
Front Wheel Drive (FWD)
Special care must be taken when the vehicle is towed with the ignition in the LOCK position. Flat
bed towing is the preferred towing method. However, if a flat bed towing vehicle is not available, a
wheel lift towing vehicle may be used. Furthermore, rear towing is not recommended with the front
wheels on the ground, as transaxle damage can result. If rear towing is the only alternative, a front
end dolly must be used. Proper towing equipment is necessary to prevent damage to the vehicle.
All Wheel Drive (AWD)
The vehicle must be transported on a flat bed truck.
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle (Flat Towing With The Key In The Ignition And All
Four Wheels On The Ground)
CAUTION:
- If the vehicle being towed requires steering, the ignition switch must be in the ON position, not in
the LOCK or ACC position.
- Do not attempt to tow this vehicle from the front with sling type towing equipment. Damage to the
front fascia will result.
- Do not push or tow this vehicle with another vehicle as damage to the bumper fascia and
transaxle may result.
If you must use the accessories (wipers, defrosters, etc.) while being towed, the key must be in the
ON position, not the ACC position. Make certain the transaxle remains in NEUTRAL.
Front Wheel Drive (FWD)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 8175
The vehicle may be towed under the following conditions: The shift lever must be in NEUTRAL, the
distance to be traveled must not exceed 15 mi (25 km), and the towing speed must not exceed 25
mph (40 km/h). Exceeding these towing limits may cause a transaxle failure. If the transaxle is not
operative, or if the vehicle is to be towed more than 15 mi (25 km), the vehicle must be transported
either with a flat bed truck or with the front wheels off the ground.
All Wheel Drive (AWD)
The vehicle may be towed under the following conditions: The shift lever must be in NEUTRAL, the
distance to be traveled must not exceed 15 mi (25 km), the towing speed must not exceed 25 mph
(40 km/h), and both front and rear wheels must be on the ground. Exceeding these towing limits
may cause a transaxle failure. If the transaxle is not operative, or if the vehicle is to be towed more
than 15 mi (25 km), the vehicle must be transported on a flat bed truck.
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle With A Tow Dolly
Front Wheel Drive (FWD)
Rear towing is not recommended with the front wheels on the ground, as transaxle damage can
result. If rear towing is the only alternative, a front end dolly must be used. Proper towing
equipment is necessary to prevent damage to the vehicle.
All Wheel Drive (AWD)
CAUTION: The manufacturer does not recommend towing an All-Wheel Drive (AWD) on a tow
dolly. Vehicle damage may occur.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Towing - NAFTA, Puerto Rico > Page 8176
Towing Information: Service and Repair Recreational Towing (Behind Motorhome, etc.)
RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND MOTORHOME, ETC.)
Recreational Towing Chart
CAUTION: ONLY vehicles equipped with a MANUAL TRANSAXLE may be recreationally towed
(flat towed) at any legal highway speed, for any
distance, if the MANUAL TRANSAXLE is in NEUTRAL and the ignition key is in the ACC position.
CAUTION:
- DO NOT FLAT TOW any vehicle equipped with an AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE. Damage to the
drivetrain will result. If these vehicles require towing, make sure all four wheels are off the ground.
- Front or rear wheel lifts should not be used. Internal damage to the transaxle will occur if a front or
rear wheel lift is used when recreational towing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Adapter Kit >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Adapter Kit: Service and Repair
TRAILER TOW HARNESS INSTALLATION
1. Remove the push pin fasteners (2) and separate the rear tail lamp assemblies (1).
2. Disconnect the tail lamp electrical connectors (2 and 3).
3. Connect the harness (2) to the left side tail lamp electrical connectors (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Adapter Kit >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8180
4. Position the harness (1) through the tail lamp opening and down the side of the fender. 5.
Secure the support clips (2) to the body seem.
6. Position the harness (1) over the exhaust and fasten the push pin fasteners (2) to the under side
of the rear bumper in the existing holes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Adapter Kit >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8181
7. Position the harness (1) up the right side of the vehicle to the right tail lamp opening and secure
the clips (2) to the body seem.
8. Connect the harness (1) to the right side tail lamp electrical connectors (2).
9. Connect the tail lamp electrical connectors (2 and 3) to the tail lamp assemblies (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Adapter Kit >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8182
10. Install tail lamps assemblies (1) and install the push pin fasteners (2) fully.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8188
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8189
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8190
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8191
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8192
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8193
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8194
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8195
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8196
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8197
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8198
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8199
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8200
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8201
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8202
Trailer Connector: Connector Views
Connector - (TRAILER TOW) 4 WAY
WIRING-TRAILER TOW 4-WAY - (TRAILER TOW) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8203
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
TRAILER TOW - Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8204
Trailer Tow 8W-54-01
Trailer Tow 8W-54-02
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams by Number See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Wiring - Description
Trailer Connector: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Wiring - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with an optional Trailer Tow Preparation package have a trailer tow wiring
harness and an instruction sheet (1) that are placed in the glove box (2) of the vehicle when it is
shipped from the factory. This package also includes four relays to isolate the trailer lighting from
the vehicle lighting and a four-way trailer tow wiring connector that are all concealed behind the
rear bumper fascia after installation is complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Wiring - Description > Page 8207
Trailer Connector: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Wiring - Operation
OPERATION
The trailer tow preparation wiring harness is connected to the body wire harness at the right and
left outer rear lamp unit connections. After installation is complete, a trailer tow stop/turn relay is
secured to the harness behind the rear bumper fascia just below each outer rear lamp unit, while a
trailer tow stop lamp relay is located on the underside of each outboard end of the rear bumper
reinforcement behind the rear fascia. The four-way trailer tow connector is located near the center
of the rear fascia.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, further details on wire harness routing and retention, as well
as pin-out and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds. Also
refer to the Instruction Sheet packaged with the harness for additional details.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 8212
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 8213
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 8214
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP-LEFT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 8217
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Right Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP-RIGHT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 8218
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Left Trailer Tow Stop/Turn Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN-LEFT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 8219
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Right Trailer Tow Stop/Turn Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN-RIGHT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Relay - Description
Trailer Towing Relay: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Relay - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with an optional trailer tow preparation package have four trailer tow relays, one
each for the trailer tow stop/turn right and left and one each for the trailer stop lamp right and left.
The trailer tow relays are conventional International Standards Organization (ISO) micro relays.
Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions, current capacities,
terminal patterns, and terminal functions. Each relay is contained within a small, rectangular,
molded plastic housing and is connected to all of the required inputs and outputs through five
integral male spade-type terminals that extend from the relay base plate.
The trailer tow relays are included with the trailer tow preparation wire harness that is shipped
loose in the glove box for customer or dealer installation at the rear of the vehicle. A trailer tow
stop/turn relay is located behind the rear fascia below each outer tail lamp, while a trailer stop lamp
relay is located behind the rear fascia below each outboard end of the rear bumper reinforcement.
Each relay and connector is wrapped within an isolator envelope for sound deadening and
anti-rattle protection. Refer to the appropriate wiring information for specific relay cavity assignment
information.
Any of the trailer tow relays cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
affected unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Relay - Description > Page 8222
Trailer Towing Relay: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Relay - Operation
OPERATION
The trailer tow relays are electromechanical switches that use a low current input from the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to the tail lamps to control a high current output to the trailer
brake and turn signal lamps. Within each relay are an electromagnetic coil, a movable contact and
two fixed contact points. A resistor is connected in parallel with the coil, and helps to dissipate
voltage spikes and electromagnetic interference that can be generated as the field of the relay coil
collapses.
The movable common supply contact point is held against the fixed normally closed contact point
by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field is produced by the
coil windings. This field draws the movable contact away from the normally closed contact, and
holds it against the normally open contact. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure
returns the movable contact back against the normally closed contact.
The inputs and outputs of the trailer tow relays include:
- Common Supply Terminal (30) - The common feed terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected to their respective left or right trailer tow stop/turn signal pins of the
4-way trailer tow connector at all times. The common feed terminals of both the left and right trailer
tow stop relays is connected to the normally closed (87A) terminal of their respective left or right
trailer tow stop/turn relay at all times.
- Coil Ground Terminal (85) - The coil ground terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop/turn
relays is connected to their respective left or right rear turn signal control circuits from the TIPM at
all times. The coil ground terminals of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays are connected to
the stop lamp control circuit from the TIPM at all times.
- Coil Battery Terminal (86) - The coil battery terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop/turn
relays is connected to a path to ground at all times. The coil battery terminal of both the left and
right trailer tow stop relays is connected to their respective left or right rear turn signal control
circuits from the TIPM at all times.
- Normally Open Terminal (87) - The normally open terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected to the stop lamp control circuit from the TIPM whenever that relay is
energized. The normally open terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays is connected
to a path to ground whenever that relay is energized.
- Normally Closed Terminal (87A) - The normally closed terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected are connected to the common supply (30) terminal of their respective
left or right trailer tow stop relay whenever the relay is de-energized. The normally closed terminal
of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays is not connected to any circuit in this application.
The trailer tow relays and the hard wired circuits for the relays may be diagnosed using
conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that provide some
features of the trailer tow turn and stop lamp lighting system. The most reliable, efficient, and
accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and communication related to trailer tow turn
and stop lamp lighting operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Tow Relay - Removal
Trailer Towing Relay: Service and Repair Trailer Tow Relay - Removal
REMOVAL
TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN RELAYS
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear fascia from the vehicle.
See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear
Bumper Fascia - Removal
3. Disengage the left or right trailer tow stop/turn relay and connector from the isolator envelope (3)
secured to the trailer tow wire harness (6) along
the left or right body side aperture (2) just below the outer tail lamp.
4. Pull the relay straight out from the wire harness connector.
TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP RELAYS
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear fascia from the vehicle.
See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear
Bumper Fascia - Removal
3. Disengage the left or right trailer tow stop lamp relay and connector from the isolator envelope
(4) secured to the trailer tow wire harness (6) on
the underside of the rear bumper reinforcement (1) on the left or right side of the 4-way trailer tow
connector (5).
4. Pull the relay straight out from the wire harness connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Tow Relay - Removal > Page 8225
Trailer Towing Relay: Service and Repair Trailer Tow Relay - Installation
INSTALLATION
TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN RELAYS
1. Align the terminals of the left or right trailer tow stop/turn relay with the terminal receptacles of
the trailer tow wire harness connector. 2. Firmly and evenly push the relay into the connector until it
is fully seated. 3. Insert the relay and connector into the isolator envelope (3) secured to the wire
harness (6) along the left or right body side aperture (2) just below
the outer tail lamp.
4. Reinstall the rear fascia onto the vehicle. See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear
Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear
Bumper Fascia - Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP RELAYS
1. Align the terminals of the left or right trailer tow stop lamp relay with the terminal receptacles of
the trailer tow wire harness connector. 2. Firmly and evenly push the relay into the connector until it
is fully seated. 3. Insert the relay and connector into the isolator envelope (4) secured to the trailer
tow wire harness (6) on the underside of the rear bumper
reinforcement (1) on the left or right side of the 4-way trailer tow connector (5).
4. Reinstall the rear fascia onto the vehicle. See: Body and Frame/Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear
Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear
Bumper Fascia - Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8231
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8232
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8233
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8234
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8235
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8236
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8237
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8238
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8239
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8240
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8241
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8242
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8243
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8244
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8245
Trailer Connector: Connector Views
Connector - (TRAILER TOW) 4 WAY
WIRING-TRAILER TOW 4-WAY - (TRAILER TOW) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8246
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
TRAILER TOW - Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8247
Trailer Tow 8W-54-01
Trailer Tow 8W-54-02
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams by Number See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Wiring - Description
Trailer Connector: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Wiring - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with an optional Trailer Tow Preparation package have a trailer tow wiring
harness and an instruction sheet (1) that are placed in the glove box (2) of the vehicle when it is
shipped from the factory. This package also includes four relays to isolate the trailer lighting from
the vehicle lighting and a four-way trailer tow wiring connector that are all concealed behind the
rear bumper fascia after installation is complete.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Wiring - Description > Page 8250
Trailer Connector: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Wiring - Operation
OPERATION
The trailer tow preparation wiring harness is connected to the body wire harness at the right and
left outer rear lamp unit connections. After installation is complete, a trailer tow stop/turn relay is
secured to the harness behind the rear bumper fascia just below each outer rear lamp unit, while a
trailer tow stop lamp relay is located on the underside of each outboard end of the rear bumper
reinforcement behind the rear fascia. The four-way trailer tow connector is located near the center
of the rear fascia.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, further details on wire harness routing and retention, as well
as pin-out and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds. Also
refer to the Instruction Sheet packaged with the harness for additional details.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice Activation System > Voice Activation Module >
Component Information > Locations > Hands Free Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice Activation System > Voice Activation Module >
Component Information > Locations > Hands Free Module > Page 8256
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice Activation System > Voice Activation Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Hands Free Module C1 (Instrument Panel) 22 Way
Voice Activation Module: Diagrams Hands Free Module C1 (Instrument Panel) 22 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 22 WAY
MODULE-HANDS FREE - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 22 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice Activation System > Voice Activation Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Hands Free Module C1 (Instrument Panel) 22 Way > Page 8259
Voice Activation Module: Diagrams Hands Free Module C2 (UCI) (Instrument Panel) 10 Way
Connector C2 (UCI) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 10 WAY
MODULE-HANDS FREE (UCI) - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Body Control Systems: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8265
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8266
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8267
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8268
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8269
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8270
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8271
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8272
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8273
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8274
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8275
Body Control Systems: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8276
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8277
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8278
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8279
Body Control Systems: Electrical Diagrams
CONVENIENCE SYSTEMS - Diagrams (PARKVIEW)
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8280
Convenience Systems 8W-56-01 (Parkview/Navigation)
Convenience Systems 8W-56-02 (Parkview/Navigation)
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams by Number See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Bumper Fascia - Removal
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair Front Bumper Fascia - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Remove the pushpins for the fascia (2) at the radiator
support.
3. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. See: Maintenance , for proper hoisting and jacking
procedures. 4. Remove the pop rivets (2) at the wheel well opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Bumper Fascia - Removal > Page 8287
5. Remove the torx(R) screw (3) at the wheel well housing. 6. Separate the fascia tabs (2) at the
bracket (1).
7. Remove the pushpins (1) for the fascia (2) at the lower closeout panel.
8. Slide the fascia (2) out from the mounting tab (1) under the headlamp. 9. Disengage fog lamp
wire connector and side marker connector from body harness, if equipped.
10. Disengage the ambient temp sensor wire connector, if equipped. 11. Remove fascia from
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Bumper Fascia - Removal > Page 8288
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair Front Bumper Fascia - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the fascia to the vehicle. 2. Reconnect the ambient temp sensor wire connector, if
equipped. 3. Reconnect the fog lamp wire connector and side marker connector from body
harness, if equipped. 4. Slide the fascia (2) into the mounting tab (1) under the headlamp.
5. Install the pushpins (1) for the fascia (2) at the lower closeout panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Bumper Fascia - Removal > Page 8289
6. Insert and snap into place the fascia tabs (2) at the bracket (1). 7. Install the torx(R) screw (3) at
the wheel well housing.
8. Install the pop rivets (2) at the wheel well opening. 9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Install the pushpins for the fascia (2) at the radiator support.
11. close the hood and check for proper fit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Bumper Fascia - Removal > Page 8290
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair Front Lower Fascia Closeout - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove fasteners (5) to lower closeout.
2. Remove push pins (1) to lower closeout. 3. Remove the front lower fascia.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Bumper Fascia - Removal > Page 8291
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair Front Lower Fascia Closeout - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the front lower fascia. 2. Install the push pins (1) to lower closeout.
3. Install the fasteners (5) to lower closeout.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Bumper Reinforcement - Removal
Front Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair Front Bumper Reinforcement - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front fascia See: Front Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Front Bumper
Fascia - Removal. 2. Support bumper reinforcement (3) on a suitable lifting device. 3. Mark the
position of the bolts (1) on frame rail to aid in installation. 4. Remove the smaller bolts (2) attaching
bumper reinforcement (3) to frame rail. 5. Remove the larger bolts (1) attaching bumper
reinforcement (3) to frame rail. 6. Remove bumper reinforcement (3) from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Bumper Reinforcement - Removal > Page 8296
Front Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair Front Bumper Reinforcement - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the bumper reinforcement (3) on vehicle.
NOTE: Use marks made previously to properly position bumper reinforcement
2. Install the larger bolts (1) attaching bumper reinforcement (3) to frame rail. Tighten bolts (1) to 28
Nm (250 in.lbs.). 3. Install the smaller bolts (2) attaching bumper reinforcement (3) to frame rail. 4.
Install front fascia See: Front Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Front Bumper Fascia Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Bumper Fascia - Removal
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair Rear Bumper Fascia - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the hatch. 2. Remove the 6 pushpins (1) securing the fascia (2).
3. Remove the rivets (2) and the torx(R) screw (3) around the wheel well for the fascia (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Bumper Fascia - Removal > Page 8302
4. Separate the tabs (2) securing the fascia (3) to the bracket (1).
5. Remove the push pin (2) under the taillight (1) to the fascia (3). 6. Remove fascia (3) from
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Bumper Fascia - Removal > Page 8303
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair Rear Bumper Fascia - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the fascia (3) to the vehicle and install the pushpin (2) at the taillight (1) to the body.
2. Clip the fascia (3) into the tabs (2) to the bracket (1).
3. Install the torx(R) screw (3) for the fascia top the wheel opening and then install the pop rivets
(2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Bumper Fascia - Removal > Page 8304
4. Install the 6 push pins (1) to secure the fascia (2) to the body. 5. Close the hatch and check for
fit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Bumper Reinforcement - Removal
Rear Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair Rear Bumper Reinforcement - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear fascia See: Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia Removal. 2. Support bumper reinforcement (1) on a suitable lifting device. 3. Mark position of bolts
(2) on frame rail to aid in installation. 4. Remove bolts (2) attaching rear bumper reinforcement (1)
to frame rail. 5. Remove bumper reinforcement (1) from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Bumper Reinforcement - Removal > Page 8309
Rear Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair Rear Bumper Reinforcement - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position rear bumper reinforcement (1) on vehicle. 2. Install bolts (2) attaching bumper
reinforcement to frame rail. Use marks made previously to properly position bumper reinforcement.
3. Tighten bolts (2) to 28 Nm (250 in.lbs.). 4. Install rear fascia See: Rear Bumper Cover /
Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap At
Windshield/Wind Noise
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Customer Interest Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap At
Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 8319
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap At
Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 8320
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap At
Windshield/Wind Noise
Cowl Moulding / Trim: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind
Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap At
Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 8326
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap At
Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 8327
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8328
Cowl Moulding / Trim: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-027-08 Date: 080906
Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8329
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8330
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-027-08 Date:
080906
Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8331
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8332
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8333
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair >
Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 3. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
4. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen.
5. Remove the cowl screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair >
Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal > Page 8336
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
2. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
3. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair >
Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal > Page 8337
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). 3. Remove the cowl top screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair >
Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal > Page 8338
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the cowl top screen (3). 2. Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at
the ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # K07 Date: 110218
Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement
February 2011
Dealer Service Instructions for: Safety Recall K07 Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Safety Recall K07
Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from November 01, 2007 through November 07,
2008 (MDH 110122 through 110723).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer used vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The front door wiring harnesses on about 65,000 of the above vehicles may fatigue and break.
Broken wires could interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s) located inside the front doors.
This could resulting in the illumination of the airbag warning lamp and loss of side crash sensing
capability.
Repair
The right and left front door wiring harnesses must be replaced.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 8349
These special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 8350
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. Roll down both front door windows.
3. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at the left shock tower.
4. Remove the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel (Figure 1).
5. Remove the front door panel (Figure 1).
6. Remove the front door inner window seal (Figure 1).
7. Separate the oval wiring harness grommet from the lower "A" pillar (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 8351
8. Disconnect the body electrical connectors from the front door wiring harness (Figure 2).
9. Remove the two door grommet retaining screws (Figure 2).
10. Remove the door speaker from the door and disconnect the electrical connector (Figure 2).
11. Open the access door and disconnect the door latch electrical connector (Figure 3).
12. Disconnect the remaining electrical connectors and remove the front door wiring harness from
the vehicle (Figure 2).
CAUTION:
Note the wiring harness routing before removing the wiring harness from the door. The new wiring
harness must be routed in the same location as the original wiring harness.
13. Place the new front door wiring harness into position on the door.
14. Connect the front door wiring harness connectors to the body electrical connectors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 8352
15. Snap the oval wiring harness grommet into the oval hole on the "A" pillar (Figure 1).
16. Place the door grommet into position and install the two retaining screws (Figure 1).
17. Connect the remaining electrical connectors to their respective modules/connectors (Figure 2).
18. Connect the door latch electrical connector and close the access door (Figure 3).
19. Connect the door speaker electrical connector and install the door speaker (Figure 4).
20. Install the front door inner window seal.
21. Install the front door panel.
22. Install the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel.
23. Repeat steps 4 through 22 on the other front door.
24. Connect the negative battery cable.
25. Using Mopar Total Clean or equivalent, clean both front door panels
26. On vehicles equipped with Express Window Up/Down (sales code JSC), perform Steps 27
through 30.
27. Connect the wiTECH to the vehicle.
28. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
29. Clear/Denormalize the door modules using the following procedures:
a. Click on the "Miscellaneous Functions" tab.
b. Select "Denormalize Window/Reset ECU" and follow the directions to clear/denormalize the door
module memory.
30. Relearn/Normalize the door modules using the following procedure:
a. Place the vehicle on a battery charger or have the engine running.
b. Raise the front door glass to the full-up position by pulling up on the window switch to its second
detent and hold the switch until the front door
glass is fully closed. Continue to hold the window switch up for three seconds after the front door
glass is fully closed.
c. Lower the front door glass to the full-down position by pushing down (depress) the window
switch to its second detent and hold the switch until
the front door glass is fully open. Continue to hold the window switch down for three seconds after
the front door glass is fully open.
d. Check the operation of the express-up and express-down features. If the express-up feature
does not work, repeat the procedure starting with
Step 30b.
e. Check that the front door glass reverses when in the express-up mode by holding a pen in the
path of the glass.
f. Repeat steps 30b. through 30e. on the other front door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement >
Page 8353
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # K07 Date: 110218
Recall - Front Door Wiring Harness Replacement
February 2011
Dealer Service Instructions for: Safety Recall K07 Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Safety Recall K07
Front Door Wiring Harnesses
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles built from November 01, 2007 through November 07,
2008 (MDH 110122 through 110723).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer used vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The front door wiring harnesses on about 65,000 of the above vehicles may fatigue and break.
Broken wires could interrupt the circuits for the side impact sensor(s) located inside the front doors.
This could resulting in the illumination of the airbag warning lamp and loss of side crash sensing
capability.
Repair
The right and left front door wiring harnesses must be replaced.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 8359
These special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 8360
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. Roll down both front door windows.
3. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable at the left shock tower.
4. Remove the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel (Figure 1).
5. Remove the front door panel (Figure 1).
6. Remove the front door inner window seal (Figure 1).
7. Separate the oval wiring harness grommet from the lower "A" pillar (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 8361
8. Disconnect the body electrical connectors from the front door wiring harness (Figure 2).
9. Remove the two door grommet retaining screws (Figure 2).
10. Remove the door speaker from the door and disconnect the electrical connector (Figure 2).
11. Open the access door and disconnect the door latch electrical connector (Figure 3).
12. Disconnect the remaining electrical connectors and remove the front door wiring harness from
the vehicle (Figure 2).
CAUTION:
Note the wiring harness routing before removing the wiring harness from the door. The new wiring
harness must be routed in the same location as the original wiring harness.
13. Place the new front door wiring harness into position on the door.
14. Connect the front door wiring harness connectors to the body electrical connectors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 8362
15. Snap the oval wiring harness grommet into the oval hole on the "A" pillar (Figure 1).
16. Place the door grommet into position and install the two retaining screws (Figure 1).
17. Connect the remaining electrical connectors to their respective modules/connectors (Figure 2).
18. Connect the door latch electrical connector and close the access door (Figure 3).
19. Connect the door speaker electrical connector and install the door speaker (Figure 4).
20. Install the front door inner window seal.
21. Install the front door panel.
22. Install the front door window switch, grab handle cup, and release handle bezel.
23. Repeat steps 4 through 22 on the other front door.
24. Connect the negative battery cable.
25. Using Mopar Total Clean or equivalent, clean both front door panels
26. On vehicles equipped with Express Window Up/Down (sales code JSC), perform Steps 27
through 30.
27. Connect the wiTECH to the vehicle.
28. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
29. Clear/Denormalize the door modules using the following procedures:
a. Click on the "Miscellaneous Functions" tab.
b. Select "Denormalize Window/Reset ECU" and follow the directions to clear/denormalize the door
module memory.
30. Relearn/Normalize the door modules using the following procedure:
a. Place the vehicle on a battery charger or have the engine running.
b. Raise the front door glass to the full-up position by pulling up on the window switch to its second
detent and hold the switch until the front door
glass is fully closed. Continue to hold the window switch up for three seconds after the front door
glass is fully closed.
c. Lower the front door glass to the full-down position by pushing down (depress) the window
switch to its second detent and hold the switch until
the front door glass is fully open. Continue to hold the window switch down for three seconds after
the front door glass is fully open.
d. Check the operation of the express-up and express-down features. If the express-up feature
does not work, repeat the procedure starting with
Step 30b.
e. Check that the front door glass reverses when in the express-up mode by holding a pen in the
path of the glass.
f. Repeat steps 30b. through 30e. on the other front door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Door Stop > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Stop: > K07 > Feb > 11 > Recall - Front Door Wiring
Harness Replacement > Page 8363
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Exterior Handle - Removal
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Front Exterior Handle - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Place the door glass in the full up position. 2. Remove door trim panel.See: Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Removal. 3. Disconnect latch rods. 4. Remove
fasteners (2) attaching door handle (1) to outer door panel. 5. Remove outside door handle from
door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Exterior Handle - Removal > Page 8370
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Front Exterior Handle - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert tip of handle (1) towards front of door through handle opening in door outer. 2. Pull handle
at rear as if to open to swing handle into opening. 3. Install fasteners (2) into sheet metal and into
rear side of door handle. 4. Tighten to 7 Nm (62 in. lbs.) 5. Install door trim panelSee: Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Installation. 6. Verify door handle operation.
Adjust door latch as necessary. See: Front Door Latch/Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Interior Door Handle - Removal
Front Door Interior Handle: Service and Repair Front Interior Door Handle - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove trim panel from door.See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Removal 2. Remove mounting fastener (1). 3. Remove the interior door handle from door module.
4. Disconnect the door handle cable (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Interior Door Handle - Removal > Page 8375
Front Door Interior Handle: Service and Repair Front Interior Door Handle - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the interior handle cable (2) to the handle. 2. Position the handle to the door module
ensuring that the handle is aligned correctly. 3. Install the mounting fastener (1). 4. Install the door
trim panel. See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 > Body - Lower
Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
Front Door Hinge: Customer Interest Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
NUMBER: 23-018-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: October 21, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-016-06, DATED MARCH
18, 2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Lower Door Hinges Make Popping or Groan When Opened Or Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves spraying white lithium grease between the roller and roller pin
while avoiding getting grease on the. This needs to be done to all lower door hinges.
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
MODELS:
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2010 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2010 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2010 (HG) Aspen
2007 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2006 - 2010 (LE) Chrysler 300C (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (WH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The lower door hinges make a moderate to loud popping/groan sound
when the door is opened or closed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 > Body - Lower
Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises > Page 8384
This is due to the roller axle not being properly maintained with grease.
DIAGNOSIS: Open the doors and listen for the popping or groan sound from the lower hinge, if the
sound is present perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open door.
2. With straw installed on the lithium grease spray can (p/n 04318066AB), spray a very small
amount of grease between the roller pin and inside roller
surface (axle). (Fig. 1).
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
3. Open and close the door 10 times to work the grease onto the roller axle.
4. Wipe away any excess grease in the sprayed area.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for every door.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 > Body - Lower
Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises > Page 8385
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 >
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
Front Door Hinge: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning
Noises
NUMBER: 23-018-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: October 21, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-016-06, DATED MARCH
18, 2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Lower Door Hinges Make Popping or Groan When Opened Or Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves spraying white lithium grease between the roller and roller pin
while avoiding getting grease on the. This needs to be done to all lower door hinges.
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
MODELS:
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2010 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2010 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2010 (HG) Aspen
2007 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2006 - 2010 (LE) Chrysler 300C (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (WH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The lower door hinges make a moderate to loud popping/groan sound
when the door is opened or closed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 >
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises > Page 8391
This is due to the roller axle not being properly maintained with grease.
DIAGNOSIS: Open the doors and listen for the popping or groan sound from the lower hinge, if the
sound is present perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open door.
2. With straw installed on the lithium grease spray can (p/n 04318066AB), spray a very small
amount of grease between the roller pin and inside roller
surface (axle). (Fig. 1).
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
3. Open and close the door 10 times to work the grease onto the roller axle.
4. Wipe away any excess grease in the sprayed area.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for every door.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 >
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises > Page 8392
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Hinge: > Page 8393
Front Door Hinge: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-018-10 Date: 101021
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
NUMBER: 23-018-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: October 21, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-016-06, DATED MARCH
18, 2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Lower Door Hinges Make Popping or Groan When Opened Or Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves spraying white lithium grease between the roller and roller pin
while avoiding getting grease on the. This needs to be done to all lower door hinges.
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
MODELS:
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2010 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2010 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2010 (HG) Aspen
2007 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2006 - 2010 (LE) Chrysler 300C (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (WH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Hinge: > Page 8394
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The lower door hinges make a moderate to loud popping/groan sound
when the door is opened or closed.
This is due to the roller axle not being properly maintained with grease.
DIAGNOSIS: Open the doors and listen for the popping or groan sound from the lower hinge, if the
sound is present perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open door.
2. With straw installed on the lithium grease spray can (p/n 04318066AB), spray a very small
amount of grease between the roller pin and inside roller
surface (axle). (Fig. 1).
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
3. Open and close the door 10 times to work the grease onto the roller axle.
4. Wipe away any excess grease in the sprayed area.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for every door.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Hinge: > Page 8395
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-018-10 Date:
101021
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
NUMBER: 23-018-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: October 21, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-016-06, DATED MARCH
18, 2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Lower Door Hinges Make Popping or Groan When Opened Or Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves spraying white lithium grease between the roller and roller pin
while avoiding getting grease on the. This needs to be done to all lower door hinges.
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
MODELS:
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2010 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2010 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2010 (HG) Aspen
2007 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2006 - 2010 (LE) Chrysler 300C (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Hinge: > Page 8396
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (WH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The lower door hinges make a moderate to loud popping/groan sound
when the door is opened or closed.
This is due to the roller axle not being properly maintained with grease.
DIAGNOSIS: Open the doors and listen for the popping or groan sound from the lower hinge, if the
sound is present perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open door.
2. With straw installed on the lithium grease spray can (p/n 04318066AB), spray a very small
amount of grease between the roller pin and inside roller
surface (axle). (Fig. 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Hinge: > Page 8397
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
3. Open and close the door 10 times to work the grease onto the roller axle.
4. Wipe away any excess grease in the sprayed area.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for every door.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Hinge - Removal
Front Door Hinge: Service and Repair Front Door Hinge - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove front door from vehicle.See: Service and Repair/Front Door - Removal 2. Transfer door
to bench. 3. Mark position of upper hinge (3) and lower hinge (4) on the upper A-pillar and lower
A-pillar with a grease pencil or other suitable device to ease
installation.
4. Remove bolts attaching hinge to door the upper A-pillar and lower A-pillar frame and remove the
hinge.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Hinge - Removal > Page 8400
Front Door Hinge: Service and Repair Front Door Hinge - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If necessary, paint new door hinge prior to installation. 2. Loosely install bolts attaching hinge to
lower A-pillar. 3. Align hinges to marks made previously and tighten all bolts. Tighten bolts to 28
Nm (21 ft. lbs.) torque. 4. Install the front door. See: Service and Repair/Front Door - Installation. 5.
Verify door fit and operation. Adjust door hinge for proper door alignment, if necessary. See:
Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Adjustments
Front Door Latch: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENTS
1. Insert a suitable allen wrench through the elongated slot in door end frame and loosen bolt 1/2 to
one full turn. 2. Cycle outside door handle twice. 3. Tighten adjusting screw. 4. Verify latch
operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Latch - Removal
Front Door Latch: Service and Repair Front Door Latch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the door trim panel. See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Removal. 2. Remove the door module. See: Service and Repair/Front Door Carrier Plate Removal. 3. Remove the latch assembly from the rear of the door module by disengaging the clips.
4. Disconnect the latch cable (1) and rods (2) from the latch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Latch - Removal > Page 8406
Front Door Latch: Service and Repair Front Door Latch - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not close door before adjusting the door latch. Door may fail to reopen.
1. Position the latch assembly to the door module. 2. Connect the latch cable (1) and rods (2) to the
latch assembly. 3. Snap the latch assembly into place onto the door module. 4. Install the door
module. See: Service and Repair/Front Door Carrier Plate - Installation. 5. Install the door trim
panel. See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 > Body - Doors
Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
Front Door Panel: Customer Interest Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
NUMBER: 23-004-09
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 4, 2009
SUBJECT: Doors Do Not Lock Or Unlock Properly When Using Power Door Lock System Or
Remote Keyless Entry
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves modifying the door trim panel to assure the lock knob will not
interfere with it.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built before August 6, 2008 (MDH 0806XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience difficulty locking or unlocking the doors
when using the power door lock system or remote keyless entry transmitter. Mechanical
interference between the lock knob & door trim panel may be preventing the keyless entry system
form operating properly.
DIAGNOSIS: If the customer experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open Door.
2. Ensure doors are unlocked.
3. Using your hand wiggle the lock knobs.
4. Does the interior lock knob have wiggle room in the door panel?
a. Yes >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 5
5. From inside the vehicle lock and unlock the door with the power door lock switch/FOB 1K. Watch
the lock knob and door panel as switch is being
activated.
6. Was there any interference detected between the lock knob and door panel?
a. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
7. Remove door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service info
> Body > Door - Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Removal.
8. Use the FOBIK to lock and unlock the doors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 > Body - Doors
Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8415
9. If the locking assembly work's properly then the lock knob has been rubbing the Door Trim Panel
(Fig 1).
10. Inspect the three ribs inside the lock knob hole and verify how they look compared to (Fig 2)
number two and three in.
11. Do the ribs match number two (Fig 2).
a. Yes >> Continue the repair.
b. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 > Body - Doors
Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8416
12. Adjust the ribs angle accordingly with a square body file as shown in (Fig 3) to the desired
angle shown in (Fig 2) number one.
NOTE:
Only modify the bottom portion of the rib(s) keeping top portion square to avoid rattle sounds.
NOTE:
Adjust lock knob ribs by filling from the inside to remove the lower rib edge. The tapered profile
must be maintained to keep the lock knob from rattling in the door panel.
13. Install door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect> TechCONNECT under: Service info >
Body > Door-Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 > Body - Doors
Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8417
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 >
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
Front Door Panel: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
NUMBER: 23-004-09
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 4, 2009
SUBJECT: Doors Do Not Lock Or Unlock Properly When Using Power Door Lock System Or
Remote Keyless Entry
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves modifying the door trim panel to assure the lock knob will not
interfere with it.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built before August 6, 2008 (MDH 0806XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience difficulty locking or unlocking the doors
when using the power door lock system or remote keyless entry transmitter. Mechanical
interference between the lock knob & door trim panel may be preventing the keyless entry system
form operating properly.
DIAGNOSIS: If the customer experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open Door.
2. Ensure doors are unlocked.
3. Using your hand wiggle the lock knobs.
4. Does the interior lock knob have wiggle room in the door panel?
a. Yes >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 5
5. From inside the vehicle lock and unlock the door with the power door lock switch/FOB 1K. Watch
the lock knob and door panel as switch is being
activated.
6. Was there any interference detected between the lock knob and door panel?
a. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
7. Remove door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service info
> Body > Door - Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Removal.
8. Use the FOBIK to lock and unlock the doors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 >
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8423
9. If the locking assembly work's properly then the lock knob has been rubbing the Door Trim Panel
(Fig 1).
10. Inspect the three ribs inside the lock knob hole and verify how they look compared to (Fig 2)
number two and three in.
11. Do the ribs match number two (Fig 2).
a. Yes >> Continue the repair.
b. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 >
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8424
12. Adjust the ribs angle accordingly with a square body file as shown in (Fig 3) to the desired
angle shown in (Fig 2) number one.
NOTE:
Only modify the bottom portion of the rib(s) keeping top portion square to avoid rattle sounds.
NOTE:
Adjust lock knob ribs by filling from the inside to remove the lower rib edge. The tapered profile
must be maintained to keep the lock knob from rattling in the door panel.
13. Install door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect> TechCONNECT under: Service info >
Body > Door-Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 >
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8425
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > Page 8426
Front Door Panel: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-004-09 Date: 090304
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
NUMBER: 23-004-09
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 4, 2009
SUBJECT: Doors Do Not Lock Or Unlock Properly When Using Power Door Lock System Or
Remote Keyless Entry
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves modifying the door trim panel to assure the lock knob will not
interfere with it.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built before August 6, 2008 (MDH 0806XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience difficulty locking or unlocking the doors
when using the power door lock system or remote keyless entry transmitter. Mechanical
interference between the lock knob & door trim panel may be preventing the keyless entry system
form operating properly.
DIAGNOSIS: If the customer experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open Door.
2. Ensure doors are unlocked.
3. Using your hand wiggle the lock knobs.
4. Does the interior lock knob have wiggle room in the door panel?
a. Yes >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 5
5. From inside the vehicle lock and unlock the door with the power door lock switch/FOB 1K. Watch
the lock knob and door panel as switch is being
activated.
6. Was there any interference detected between the lock knob and door panel?
a. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
7. Remove door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service info
> Body > Door - Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Removal.
8. Use the FOBIK to lock and unlock the doors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > Page 8427
9. If the locking assembly work's properly then the lock knob has been rubbing the Door Trim Panel
(Fig 1).
10. Inspect the three ribs inside the lock knob hole and verify how they look compared to (Fig 2)
number two and three in.
11. Do the ribs match number two (Fig 2).
a. Yes >> Continue the repair.
b. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > Page 8428
12. Adjust the ribs angle accordingly with a square body file as shown in (Fig 3) to the desired
angle shown in (Fig 2) number one.
NOTE:
Only modify the bottom portion of the rib(s) keeping top portion square to avoid rattle sounds.
NOTE:
Adjust lock knob ribs by filling from the inside to remove the lower rib edge. The tapered profile
must be maintained to keep the lock knob from rattling in the door panel.
13. Install door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect> TechCONNECT under: Service info >
Body > Door-Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > Page 8429
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-004-09 Date:
090304
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
NUMBER: 23-004-09
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 4, 2009
SUBJECT: Doors Do Not Lock Or Unlock Properly When Using Power Door Lock System Or
Remote Keyless Entry
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves modifying the door trim panel to assure the lock knob will not
interfere with it.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built before August 6, 2008 (MDH 0806XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience difficulty locking or unlocking the doors
when using the power door lock system or remote keyless entry transmitter. Mechanical
interference between the lock knob & door trim panel may be preventing the keyless entry system
form operating properly.
DIAGNOSIS: If the customer experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > Page 8430
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open Door.
2. Ensure doors are unlocked.
3. Using your hand wiggle the lock knobs.
4. Does the interior lock knob have wiggle room in the door panel?
a. Yes >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 5
5. From inside the vehicle lock and unlock the door with the power door lock switch/FOB 1K. Watch
the lock knob and door panel as switch is being
activated.
6. Was there any interference detected between the lock knob and door panel?
a. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
7. Remove door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service info
> Body > Door - Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Removal.
8. Use the FOBIK to lock and unlock the doors.
9. If the locking assembly work's properly then the lock knob has been rubbing the Door Trim Panel
(Fig 1).
10. Inspect the three ribs inside the lock knob hole and verify how they look compared to (Fig 2)
number two and three in.
11. Do the ribs match number two (Fig 2).
a. Yes >> Continue the repair.
b. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > Page 8431
12. Adjust the ribs angle accordingly with a square body file as shown in (Fig 3) to the desired
angle shown in (Fig 2) number one.
NOTE:
Only modify the bottom portion of the rib(s) keeping top portion square to avoid rattle sounds.
NOTE:
Adjust lock knob ribs by filling from the inside to remove the lower rib edge. The tapered profile
must be maintained to keep the lock knob from rattling in the door panel.
13. Install door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect> TechCONNECT under: Service info >
Body > Door-Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Panel: > Page 8432
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Trim Panel - Removal
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair Front Door Trim Panel - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove pull handle screw. 2. Remove screw from inside door handle. 3. Remove the power
window controls. See: Sensors and Switches/Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass/Power
Window Switch/Service and
Repair/Power Window Switch - Removal.
4. Using trim stick C-4755, pry trim panel from door (1). 5. Transfer trim panel (2) to bench
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8435
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair Front Door Trim Panel - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position door trim panel near to door. 2. Raise trim panel such that the backside of trim edge can
be engaged with inner belt molding. 3. Press downward on top edge of trim panel while rotating
bottom edge of panel towards door. 4. Position the locators at the top of the backside of the trim
panel into the corresponding sheet metal holes ensuring fit. 5. Install the screw to the interior
handle cover. 6. Install the screw to the pull handle. 7. Snap screw covers closed. 8. Install the
power window controls. See: Sensors and Switches/Sensors and Switches - Windows and
Glass/Power Window Switch/Service and
Repair/Power Window Switch - Installation.
9. Close door window.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Striker >
System Information > Service and Repair > Door Latch Striker - Removal
Front Door Striker: Service and Repair Door Latch Striker - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be sure to check for any shims between door latch striker and B-pillar. If any shims are
found, they must be reinstalled with the new
door latch striker to maintain proper door operation.
1. Mark outline of door latch striker on B-pillar to aid in installation. 2. Remove mounting fasteners
attaching door latch striker to B-pillar. 3. Remove latch striker from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Striker >
System Information > Service and Repair > Door Latch Striker - Removal > Page 8440
Front Door Striker: Service and Repair Door Latch Striker - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position door latch striker and any shims on vehicle. 2. Loosely install mounting fasteners
attaching latch striker to B-pillar. 3. Align latch striker to marks on B-pillar made previously. 4.
Tighten all fasteners. 5. Verify door fit and operation. Adjust door latch striker as necessary. See:
Front Door Latch/Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Glass - Removal
Front Door Window Glass: Service and Repair Front Door Glass - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and re-install the window switches, if equipped. See: Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Removal
2. Remove the interior window trim molding. 3. Remove the door speaker. See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Speaker/Service and Repair/Speaker Removal
4. Drill a hole large enough to get a small puch through into the carrier plate (3). 5. Lower glass to
approximately mid position and line up the glass lift plates (1) with the holes (2 and 3). 6. Using a
punch or equivalent, press tabs releasing glass from window regulator (2 and 3).
7. Remove glass from channel. 8. Raise glass (1) upward and out of the opening at top of door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Glass - Removal > Page 8445
Front Door Window Glass: Service and Repair Front Door Glass - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Lower glass (1) down and in the opening at top of door. 2. Slide glass downward making sure
the glass holes properly lock into snaps (1). 3. Install the interior window trim molding. 4. Install the
door speaker. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact
Disc/Speaker/Service and Repair/Speaker Installation
5. Install door trim panel. See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Front Door Window Motor: Testing and Inspection
WINDOW MOTOR
1. Remove door trim panel. See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Removal. 2. Connect positive (+) lead from a test battery to either of the two motor terminals. 3.
Connect negative (-) lead from test battery to remaining motor terminal. 4. The motor should now
rotate in one direction to either move window up or down.
a. If window happens to already be in full UP position and motor is connected so as to move it in
UP direction no movement will be observed. b. Likewise, motor connected to move window in
DOWN direction no movement will be observed if window is already in full DOWN position. c.
Reverse battery leads in 1 and 2 and window should now move. If window does not move, replace
motor.
5. If window moved completely up or down, the test leads should be reversed one more time to
complete a full window travel inspection. 6. If window does not move, check to make sure that it is
free. 7. It is necessary that the window be free to slide up and down in the glass channels. If the
window is not free to move up and down, the window lift
motor will not be able to move the glass.
8. To determine if the glass is free, disconnect the regulator from the glass lift plate. Remove the
two attaching screws, and slide the window up and
down by hand.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Window Regulator Motor - Removal
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Window Regulator Motor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the door trim panel. See: Front
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Removal. 3. Disconnect the electrical
connector. 4. Remove the mounting fasteners and remove the motor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Window Regulator Motor - Removal > Page 8451
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Window Regulator Motor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the window motor and install the mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the electrical connector.
3. Install the door trim panel. See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Installation. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Window Regulator - Removal
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Front Door Window Regulator - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Removal. 2. Remove the door module assembly. See: Service and Repair/Front Door Carrier Plate
- Removal. 3. Remove the power window lift motor See: Front Door Window Motor/Service and
Repair/Window Regulator Motor - Removal. 4. Remove the regulator mounting fasteners. 5.
Remove regulator from door module assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Window Regulator - Removal > Page 8456
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Front Door Window Regulator - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position regulator on door module assembly and install mounting fasteners. 2. Install the power
window motor. See: Front Door Window Motor/Service and Repair/Window Regulator Motor Installation. 3. Install the door module assembly. See: Service and Repair/Front Door Carrier Plate
- Installation. 4. Install door trim panel. See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim
Panel - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Exterior Door Handle - Removal
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Rear Exterior Door Handle - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Move the glass to the full up position. 2. Remove the door trim panel. See: Rear Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel - Removal. 3. Disconnect the link rod from the
door handle. 4. Remove the mounting fasteners. 5. Remove the handle from the door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Exterior Door Handle - Removal > Page 8463
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Rear Exterior Door Handle - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place the door handle into position in the door. 2. Install the mounting fasteners. 3. Connect the
link rod to the door handle. 4. Install the door trim panel. See: Rear Door Panel/Service and
Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel - Installation. 5. Verify proper operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Interior Door Handle - Removal
Rear Door Interior Handle: Service and Repair Rear Interior Door Handle - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the door trim panel. See: Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel Removal. 2. Remove the mounting fastener. 3. Disconnect the door handle cable from the interior
handle. 4. Remove the handle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Interior Door Handle - Removal > Page 8468
Rear Door Interior Handle: Service and Repair Rear Interior Door Handle - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the interior door handle cable. 2. Align the handle to the door module assembly. 3.
Install the mounting fastener. 4. Install the door trim panel. See: Rear Door Panel/Service and
Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel - Installation. 5. Verify proper operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 > Body - Lower
Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
Rear Door Hinge: Customer Interest Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
NUMBER: 23-018-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: October 21, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-016-06, DATED MARCH
18, 2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Lower Door Hinges Make Popping or Groan When Opened Or Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves spraying white lithium grease between the roller and roller pin
while avoiding getting grease on the. This needs to be done to all lower door hinges.
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
MODELS:
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2010 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2010 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2010 (HG) Aspen
2007 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2006 - 2010 (LE) Chrysler 300C (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (WH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The lower door hinges make a moderate to loud popping/groan sound
when the door is opened or closed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 > Body - Lower
Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises > Page 8477
This is due to the roller axle not being properly maintained with grease.
DIAGNOSIS: Open the doors and listen for the popping or groan sound from the lower hinge, if the
sound is present perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open door.
2. With straw installed on the lithium grease spray can (p/n 04318066AB), spray a very small
amount of grease between the roller pin and inside roller
surface (axle). (Fig. 1).
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
3. Open and close the door 10 times to work the grease onto the roller axle.
4. Wipe away any excess grease in the sprayed area.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for every door.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 > Body - Lower
Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises > Page 8478
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 >
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
Rear Door Hinge: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning
Noises
NUMBER: 23-018-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: October 21, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-016-06, DATED MARCH
18, 2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Lower Door Hinges Make Popping or Groan When Opened Or Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves spraying white lithium grease between the roller and roller pin
while avoiding getting grease on the. This needs to be done to all lower door hinges.
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
MODELS:
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2010 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2010 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2010 (HG) Aspen
2007 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2006 - 2010 (LE) Chrysler 300C (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (WH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The lower door hinges make a moderate to loud popping/groan sound
when the door is opened or closed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 >
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises > Page 8484
This is due to the roller axle not being properly maintained with grease.
DIAGNOSIS: Open the doors and listen for the popping or groan sound from the lower hinge, if the
sound is present perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open door.
2. With straw installed on the lithium grease spray can (p/n 04318066AB), spray a very small
amount of grease between the roller pin and inside roller
surface (axle). (Fig. 1).
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
3. Open and close the door 10 times to work the grease onto the roller axle.
4. Wipe away any excess grease in the sprayed area.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for every door.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Hinge: > 23-018-10 > Oct > 10 >
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises > Page 8485
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Hinge: > Page 8486
Rear Door Hinge: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-018-10 Date: 101021
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
NUMBER: 23-018-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: October 21, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-016-06, DATED MARCH
18, 2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Lower Door Hinges Make Popping or Groan When Opened Or Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves spraying white lithium grease between the roller and roller pin
while avoiding getting grease on the. This needs to be done to all lower door hinges.
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
MODELS:
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2010 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2010 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2010 (HG) Aspen
2007 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2006 - 2010 (LE) Chrysler 300C (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (WH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Hinge: > Page 8487
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The lower door hinges make a moderate to loud popping/groan sound
when the door is opened or closed.
This is due to the roller axle not being properly maintained with grease.
DIAGNOSIS: Open the doors and listen for the popping or groan sound from the lower hinge, if the
sound is present perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open door.
2. With straw installed on the lithium grease spray can (p/n 04318066AB), spray a very small
amount of grease between the roller pin and inside roller
surface (axle). (Fig. 1).
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
3. Open and close the door 10 times to work the grease onto the roller axle.
4. Wipe away any excess grease in the sprayed area.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for every door.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Hinge: > Page 8488
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-018-10 Date:
101021
Body - Lower Door Hinge Popping Groaning Noises
NUMBER: 23-018-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: October 21, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-016-06, DATED MARCH
18, 2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Lower Door Hinges Make Popping or Groan When Opened Or Closed
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves spraying white lithium grease between the roller and roller pin
while avoiding getting grease on the. This needs to be done to all lower door hinges.
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
MODELS:
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2010 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2004 - 2010 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2010 (HG) Aspen
2007 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2008 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2006 - 2010 (LE) Chrysler 300C (International Markets)
2007 - 2010 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Hinge: > Page 8489
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (WH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The lower door hinges make a moderate to loud popping/groan sound
when the door is opened or closed.
This is due to the roller axle not being properly maintained with grease.
DIAGNOSIS: Open the doors and listen for the popping or groan sound from the lower hinge, if the
sound is present perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open door.
2. With straw installed on the lithium grease spray can (p/n 04318066AB), spray a very small
amount of grease between the roller pin and inside roller
surface (axle). (Fig. 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Hinge: > Page 8490
CAUTION:
Be careful not to spray grease on the outside of the roller or roller cam. If grease is allowed to get
on the outside of the roller or roller cam it must be cleaned off using a clean shop towel. Grease left
on the outside of the roller and roller cam may also cause a noise.
3. Open and close the door 10 times to work the grease onto the roller axle.
4. Wipe away any excess grease in the sprayed area.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for every door.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Hinge - Removal
Rear Door Hinge: Service and Repair Rear Door Hinge - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the door See: Service and Repair/Rear Door - Removal. 2. Mark hinge attachment
locations with a grease pencil or other suitable device on the B-pillar. 3. Remove the nuts and
remove the hinges.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Hinge - Removal > Page 8493
Rear Door Hinge: Service and Repair Rear Door Hinge - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If necessary, paint new door hinge prior to installation.
1. Loosely install bolts attaching hinge to lower B-pillar. 2. Align hinge to marks made previously
and tighten bolts and nuts to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the rear door See: Service and
Repair/Rear Door - Installation. 4. Verify door fit and operation. Adjust door hinge for proper door
alignment, as necessary. See: Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Adjustments
Rear Door Latch: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENTS
1. Insert a suitable allen wrench through the elongated slot in door end frame and loosen bolt 1/2 to
one full turn. 2. Cycle outside door handle twice. 3. Tighten adjusting screw. 4. Verify latch
operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Latch - Removal
Rear Door Latch: Service and Repair Rear Door Latch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the door trim panel. See: Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel Removal. 2. Remove the door module assembly. 3. Remove the latch assembly from the rear of
the door module by disengaging the clips. 4. Disconnect the latch cable and rods from the latch
assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Latch - Removal > Page 8499
Rear Door Latch: Service and Repair Rear Door Latch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the latch assembly to the door module. 2. Connect the latch cable and rods to the latch
assembly. 3. Snap the latch assembly into place onto the door module. 4. Install the door module.
5. Install the door trim panel. See: Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel Installation. 6. Verify proper operation and adjust as necessary. See: Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 > Body - Doors
Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
Rear Door Panel: Customer Interest Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
NUMBER: 23-004-09
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 4, 2009
SUBJECT: Doors Do Not Lock Or Unlock Properly When Using Power Door Lock System Or
Remote Keyless Entry
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves modifying the door trim panel to assure the lock knob will not
interfere with it.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built before August 6, 2008 (MDH 0806XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience difficulty locking or unlocking the doors
when using the power door lock system or remote keyless entry transmitter. Mechanical
interference between the lock knob & door trim panel may be preventing the keyless entry system
form operating properly.
DIAGNOSIS: If the customer experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open Door.
2. Ensure doors are unlocked.
3. Using your hand wiggle the lock knobs.
4. Does the interior lock knob have wiggle room in the door panel?
a. Yes >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 5
5. From inside the vehicle lock and unlock the door with the power door lock switch/FOB 1K. Watch
the lock knob and door panel as switch is being
activated.
6. Was there any interference detected between the lock knob and door panel?
a. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
7. Remove door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service info
> Body > Door - Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Removal.
8. Use the FOBIK to lock and unlock the doors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 > Body - Doors
Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8508
9. If the locking assembly work's properly then the lock knob has been rubbing the Door Trim Panel
(Fig 1).
10. Inspect the three ribs inside the lock knob hole and verify how they look compared to (Fig 2)
number two and three in.
11. Do the ribs match number two (Fig 2).
a. Yes >> Continue the repair.
b. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 > Body - Doors
Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8509
12. Adjust the ribs angle accordingly with a square body file as shown in (Fig 3) to the desired
angle shown in (Fig 2) number one.
NOTE:
Only modify the bottom portion of the rib(s) keeping top portion square to avoid rattle sounds.
NOTE:
Adjust lock knob ribs by filling from the inside to remove the lower rib edge. The tapered profile
must be maintained to keep the lock knob from rattling in the door panel.
13. Install door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect> TechCONNECT under: Service info >
Body > Door-Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 > Body - Doors
Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8510
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 >
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
Rear Door Panel: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
NUMBER: 23-004-09
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 4, 2009
SUBJECT: Doors Do Not Lock Or Unlock Properly When Using Power Door Lock System Or
Remote Keyless Entry
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves modifying the door trim panel to assure the lock knob will not
interfere with it.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built before August 6, 2008 (MDH 0806XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience difficulty locking or unlocking the doors
when using the power door lock system or remote keyless entry transmitter. Mechanical
interference between the lock knob & door trim panel may be preventing the keyless entry system
form operating properly.
DIAGNOSIS: If the customer experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open Door.
2. Ensure doors are unlocked.
3. Using your hand wiggle the lock knobs.
4. Does the interior lock knob have wiggle room in the door panel?
a. Yes >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 5
5. From inside the vehicle lock and unlock the door with the power door lock switch/FOB 1K. Watch
the lock knob and door panel as switch is being
activated.
6. Was there any interference detected between the lock knob and door panel?
a. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
7. Remove door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service info
> Body > Door - Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Removal.
8. Use the FOBIK to lock and unlock the doors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 >
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8516
9. If the locking assembly work's properly then the lock knob has been rubbing the Door Trim Panel
(Fig 1).
10. Inspect the three ribs inside the lock knob hole and verify how they look compared to (Fig 2)
number two and three in.
11. Do the ribs match number two (Fig 2).
a. Yes >> Continue the repair.
b. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 >
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8517
12. Adjust the ribs angle accordingly with a square body file as shown in (Fig 3) to the desired
angle shown in (Fig 2) number one.
NOTE:
Only modify the bottom portion of the rib(s) keeping top portion square to avoid rattle sounds.
NOTE:
Adjust lock knob ribs by filling from the inside to remove the lower rib edge. The tapered profile
must be maintained to keep the lock knob from rattling in the door panel.
13. Install door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect> TechCONNECT under: Service info >
Body > Door-Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > 23-004-09 > Mar > 09 >
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly > Page 8518
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > Page 8519
Rear Door Panel: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-004-09 Date: 090304
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
NUMBER: 23-004-09
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 4, 2009
SUBJECT: Doors Do Not Lock Or Unlock Properly When Using Power Door Lock System Or
Remote Keyless Entry
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves modifying the door trim panel to assure the lock knob will not
interfere with it.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built before August 6, 2008 (MDH 0806XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience difficulty locking or unlocking the doors
when using the power door lock system or remote keyless entry transmitter. Mechanical
interference between the lock knob & door trim panel may be preventing the keyless entry system
form operating properly.
DIAGNOSIS: If the customer experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open Door.
2. Ensure doors are unlocked.
3. Using your hand wiggle the lock knobs.
4. Does the interior lock knob have wiggle room in the door panel?
a. Yes >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 5
5. From inside the vehicle lock and unlock the door with the power door lock switch/FOB 1K. Watch
the lock knob and door panel as switch is being
activated.
6. Was there any interference detected between the lock knob and door panel?
a. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
7. Remove door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service info
> Body > Door - Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Removal.
8. Use the FOBIK to lock and unlock the doors.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > Page 8520
9. If the locking assembly work's properly then the lock knob has been rubbing the Door Trim Panel
(Fig 1).
10. Inspect the three ribs inside the lock knob hole and verify how they look compared to (Fig 2)
number two and three in.
11. Do the ribs match number two (Fig 2).
a. Yes >> Continue the repair.
b. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > Page 8521
12. Adjust the ribs angle accordingly with a square body file as shown in (Fig 3) to the desired
angle shown in (Fig 2) number one.
NOTE:
Only modify the bottom portion of the rib(s) keeping top portion square to avoid rattle sounds.
NOTE:
Adjust lock knob ribs by filling from the inside to remove the lower rib edge. The tapered profile
must be maintained to keep the lock knob from rattling in the door panel.
13. Install door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect> TechCONNECT under: Service info >
Body > Door-Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > Page 8522
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-004-09 Date:
090304
Body - Doors Won't Lock/Unlock Properly
NUMBER: 23-004-09
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 4, 2009
SUBJECT: Doors Do Not Lock Or Unlock Properly When Using Power Door Lock System Or
Remote Keyless Entry
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves modifying the door trim panel to assure the lock knob will not
interfere with it.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles built before August 6, 2008 (MDH 0806XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some customers may experience difficulty locking or unlocking the doors
when using the power door lock system or remote keyless entry transmitter. Mechanical
interference between the lock knob & door trim panel may be preventing the keyless entry system
form operating properly.
DIAGNOSIS: If the customer experiences the Symptom/Condition perform the Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > Page 8523
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Open Door.
2. Ensure doors are unlocked.
3. Using your hand wiggle the lock knobs.
4. Does the interior lock knob have wiggle room in the door panel?
a. Yes >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. No >> Proceed to Step # 5
5. From inside the vehicle lock and unlock the door with the power door lock switch/FOB 1K. Watch
the lock knob and door panel as switch is being
activated.
6. Was there any interference detected between the lock knob and door panel?
a. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply, Further diagnosis is required.
b. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 7
7. Remove door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service info
> Body > Door - Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Removal.
8. Use the FOBIK to lock and unlock the doors.
9. If the locking assembly work's properly then the lock knob has been rubbing the Door Trim Panel
(Fig 1).
10. Inspect the three ribs inside the lock knob hole and verify how they look compared to (Fig 2)
number two and three in.
11. Do the ribs match number two (Fig 2).
a. Yes >> Continue the repair.
b. No >> This Service Bulletin does not apply.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > Page 8524
12. Adjust the ribs angle accordingly with a square body file as shown in (Fig 3) to the desired
angle shown in (Fig 2) number one.
NOTE:
Only modify the bottom portion of the rib(s) keeping top portion square to avoid rattle sounds.
NOTE:
Adjust lock knob ribs by filling from the inside to remove the lower rib edge. The tapered profile
must be maintained to keep the lock knob from rattling in the door panel.
13. Install door trim panel. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerConnect> TechCONNECT under: Service info >
Body > Door-Front/Rear > Panel, Door Trim > Installation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door Panel: > Page 8525
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Interior Window Trim Molding - Removal
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair Interior Window Trim Molding - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the door trim panel. See: Rear Door Trim Panel - Removal. 2. Remove the pushpin
style retainers (3) from the front and rear of the interior window trim molding (2). 3. Remove the
window trim molding from the rear door (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Interior Window Trim Molding - Removal > Page 8528
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair Interior Window Trim Molding - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the interior window trim molding (2) to the door (1). 2. Install the pushpin style fasteners
(3) to the front and rear of the molding. 3. Install the door trim panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Interior Window Trim Molding - Removal > Page 8529
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair Rear Door Trim Panel - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove fastener located in pull handle. 2. Remove fastener near inside door handle. 3. Using
trim stick C-4755 or equivalent, gently pry upward on door trim panel (1) disengaging trim panel
from door run. 4. Disconnect the power window switch if equipped. 5. Remove trim panel from door
assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Interior Window Trim Molding - Removal > Page 8530
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair Rear Door Trim Panel - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install trim panel (1) to door assembly. 2. Connect the power window switch if equipped. 3.
Install fastener located in pull handle. 4. Install fastener near inside door handle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Striker > System
Information > Service and Repair > Door Latch Striker - Removal
Rear Door Striker: Service and Repair Door Latch Striker - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be sure to check for any shims between door latch striker and C-pillar. If any shims are
found, they must be reinstalled with the new
door latch striker to maintain proper door operation.
1. Mark outline of door latch striker on C-pillar. 2. Remove bolts attaching door latch striker to
C-pillar. 3. Remove door latch striker from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Striker > System
Information > Service and Repair > Door Latch Striker - Removal > Page 8535
Rear Door Striker: Service and Repair Door Latch Striker - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position door latch striker and any shims on vehicle. 2. Loosely install screws attaching latch
striker to C-pillar. 3. Align latch striker to marks on C-pillar and tighten bolts to 20 Nm (14.8 ft. lbs.).
4. Verify door fit and operation. Adjust door latch striker as necessary. See: Rear Door
Latch/Adjustments
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Outer Belt Molding - Removal
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Outer Belt Molding - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Lower the window to the full down position. 2. Remove the rear door trim panel. See: Rear Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel - Removal. 3. Remove the front and rear mounting
fasteners. 4. Remove the rear door belt molding (2) by carefully pulling up on the molding and
remove from the rear door (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Outer Belt Molding - Removal >
Page 8541
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Outer Belt Molding - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear door belt molding (2) to the rear door (3). 2. Install the front and rear mounting
fasteners. 3. Install the rear door trim panel. See: Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door
Trim Panel - Installation. 4. Verify proper window operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Regulator - Removal
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Rear Door Window Regulator - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. See: Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel Removal. 2. Remove the door module assembly. See: Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear
Door Trim Panel - Removal. 3. Remove the power window lift motor. See: Front Door/Front Door
Window Motor/Service and Repair/Window Regulator Motor - Removal 4. Remove the regulator
mounting fasteners. 5. Remove regulator from door module assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Regulator - Removal > Page 8546
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Rear Door Window Regulator - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install regulator to door module assembly. 2. Install the regulator mounting fasteners. 3. Install
the power window lift motor. See: Front Door/Front Door Window Motor/Service and
Repair/Window Regulator Motor - Removal. 4. Install the door module assembly. See: Front
Door/Front Door Window Motor/Service and Repair/Window Regulator Motor - Removal. 5. Install
door trim panel. See: Front Door/Front Door Window Motor/Service and Repair/Window Regulator
Motor - Removal. 6. Verify Proper operation of the window.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Fuel Fill Door - Removal
Fuel Door: Service and Repair Fuel Fill Door - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open fuel filler door (2). 2. Remove the two torx screws (1). 3. Remove fuel filler door (2) from
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Fuel Fill Door - Removal > Page 8551
Fuel Door: Service and Repair Fuel Fill Door - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place fuel filler door (2) into position. 2. Install the two torx screws (1). 3. Ensure that door
operates properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Hinge > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Hood Hinge - Removal
Hood Hinge: Service and Repair Hood Hinge - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Support hood on the side that requires hinge replacement. 2. Mark hinge attachment locations
with a grease pencil or other suitable device to aid installation. 3. Remove cowl cover See:
Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal See: Cowl/Cowl
Moulding /
Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Removal.
4. Remove bolts attaching hood to hinge. 5. Remove bolts attaching hood hinge to load beam inner
and remove hinge from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Hinge > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Hood Hinge - Removal > Page 8557
Hood Hinge: Service and Repair Hood Hinge - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If necessary, paint new hinge before installation. 2. Place hinge in position on vehicle. 3. Install
bolts to attach hood hinge to load beam inner. 4. Install bolts to attach hood to hinge. 5. Align all
marks and secure bolts. 6. Tighten bolts to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) torque.
7. The hood should be aligned to 4 mm (0.160 in.) gap to the front fenders and flush across the top
surfaces along fenders. Shims can be added or
removed under hood hinge to achieve proper hood height.
8. Install cowl cover See: Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Inner Cover Installation See: Cowl/Cowl Moulding /
Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Installation.
9. Verify hood latch operation. Adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Hood Latch - Removal
Hood Latch: Service and Repair Hood Latch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Support hood on prop rod. 3. Mark outline of hood latch
on radiator support crossmember with a grease pencil or other suitable device to aid installation. 4.
Remove nuts (1) attaching hood latch to upper radiator support crossmember. 5. Remove hood
latch from vehicle. 6. Disengage remote release cable (2) from hood latch.See: Hood Latch
Release Cable/Service and Repair/Hood Release Cable - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Hood Latch - Removal > Page 8562
Hood Latch: Service and Repair Hood Latch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Engage remote release cable into hood latch. 2. Position hood latch on vehicle. 3. Install nuts
attaching hood latch onto upper radiator support crossmember. 4. Tighten nut to 28 Nm (20 ft.lbs.)
torque. 5. Verify operation. Adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hood Release Cable - Removal
Hood Latch Release Cable: Service and Repair Hood Release Cable - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove left front cowl trim panel. 2. Remove screws (2) attaching hood release handle (1) to
inner cowl panel. 3. Disconnect the hood release cable from the latch handle. 4. Disengage rubber
grommet at lower dash panel. 5. Disengage push-in fastener (3) attaching hood release cable (4)
to dash panel.
6. Remove hood latchSee: Hood Latch/Service and Repair/Hood Latch - Removal. 7. Release clips
(2) attaching hood release cable to left inner frame rail. 8. Remove hood release cable (1) from
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hood Release Cable - Removal > Page 8567
Hood Latch Release Cable: Service and Repair Hood Release Cable - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Route hood release cable (4) through hole in lower dash panel and along inner frame rail. 2.
Engage rubber grommet to lower dash panel. 3. Engage push-in fastener (3) attaching hood
release cable to lower dash panel. 4. Install screws attaching hood release cable handle (1) to
inner cowl panel. 5. Tighten screws (2) to 1.8 Nm (16 in. lbs.) torque. 6. Install left front cowl trim
panel.
7. Engage hood release cable into clips (2) along inner frame rail. 8. Install hood latch. See: Hood
Latch/Service and Repair/Hood Latch - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 8572
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-HOOD AJAR - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch
- Description
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The hood ajar switch is a normally closed, single pole, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch. This
switch has two unique versions that are used in two different applications. One switch is used only
on vehicles equipped with the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) for sale in certain export
markets where protection of the underhood area is required equipment. The second switch is used
only on domestic vehicles equipped with an optional remote starter system.
The molded plastic switch body (5) has an integral molded connector receptacle (1) on the lower
end containing two terminal pins. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out of the headlamp and dash wire harness. Two integral latches (2) lock the switch
into a keyed mounting hole in the stamped steel switch mounting bracket. The mounting bracket is
secured with screws to the right inner fender shield near the fender ledge in the engine
compartment. The underside of the hood panel inner reinforcement actuates the switch plunger as
the hood panel is closed.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) and a sleeve-like retainer ring on the
upper end of the switch body. The retainer ring has a one time, self-adjustment feature that is
activated after the switch is installed by closing the hood. The retainer ring is also color-coded to
aid in identifying the switch application. A dark brown retainer ring identifies the underhood security
switch application, while a white retainer ring identifies the remote starter system application.
An installed hood ajar switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, or requires readjustment, it must be replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch
- Description > Page 8575
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The hood ajar switches are interchangeable physically, but not functionally. In each case, the hood
ajar switch is a normally closed switch that is held open as the spring-loaded switch plunger is
depressed by the inner hood panel reinforcement when the hood panel is closed and latched.
When the hood is opened, the spring-loaded switch plunger extends from the switch body and the
switch contacts are closed.
In the underhood security application (export vehicles only - dark brown retainer ring), the switch is
connected in series between ground and the hood ajar switch sense input of the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM uses an internal resistor pull up to monitor the state of the hood
ajar switch contacts.
In the remote starter system application (domestic vehicles only - white retainer ring) the switch has
a 1 kilohm diagnostic resistor connected in parallel to the switch contacts between the two switch
terminals. The switch is connected in series between an output of the TIPM and the hood ajar
switch sense input of the TIPM. The TIPM continually monitors this circuit and it will store a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that it detects.
The components of the switch self-adjustment feature include an integral stop on the shaft of the
plunger and a ribbed, ratcheting sleeve-like retainer ring at the top of the switch body from which
the plunger extends. With the switch mounting collar secured in its mounting bracket, the plunger is
depressed by the hood inner reinforcement as the hood is closed. As the plunger is depressed, the
plunger stop contacts the top of the retainer ring and it is driven downward, ratcheting through the
switch mounting collar until the hood is fully closed and latched. The ribs on the retainer ring are
engaged within the mounting collar to maintain this adjusted position.
The hood ajar switch as well as the hard-wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices related to hood ajar
switch operation that provide some features of the export vehicle theft or domestic remote starter
systems. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to hood ajar switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal
SWITCH
1. Unlatch and open the hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect
the wire harness connector (3) from the switch connector receptacle. 4. From the top of the hood
ajar switch mounting bracket (2), squeeze the two switch latch tabs together and pull the switch (1)
upward through the
hole in the mounting bracket.
5. Remove the hood ajar switch from the mounting bracket and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal > Page 8578
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Installation
SWITCH
NOTE: Self-adjustment of the hood ajar switch is a one-time feature. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, removed or requires readjustment,
it must be replaced with a new unit.
1. Position the hood ajar switch (1) above the hole in the mounting bracket (2). 2. Press the switch
into the mounting hole until the integral switch latch tabs lock it into place. 3. Connect the harness
connector (3) to the switch connector receptacle. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Close
and latch the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair Liftgate Glass - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Windshield removal shown, backlite similar.
1. Before proceeding with the following repair procedure, review all warnings and cautions. See:
Windows and Glass/Windshield/Service
Precautions
2. Remove liftgate trim panels. See: Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Liftgate
Trim Panel - Removal 3. Remove rear window wiper arm, if equipped. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal 4. Disconnect the heated backlite
electrical connectors, if equipped. 5. Using a windshield cut-out wire or other suitable tool, separate
the adhesive. 6. Carefully remove backlite.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 8584
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair Liftgate Glass - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Allow the urethane at least 24 hours to cure before returning the vehicle to use.
CAUTION: Roll down the left and right front door glass and open the rear glass slider (if available)
before installing backlite to avoid
pressurizing the passenger compartment if a door is slammed before urethane is cured. Water
leaks can result.
NOTE: The backlite fence should be cleaned of most of its old urethane bonding material. A small
amount of old urethane, approximately 1-2
mm in height, should remain on the fence. Do not grind off or completely remove all old urethane
from the fence, the paint finish and bonding strength will be adversely affected. Support spacers
should be replaced with new parts. Replace any missing or damaged spacers around the perimeter
of the liftgate opening.
Glass Preparation - Installing A Previously Installed Backlite
1. Before proceeding with the following repair procedure, review all warnings and cautions. See:
Windows and Glass/Windshield/Service
Precautions
2. Level old bead of backlite adhesive (3) to a thickness of approximately 1 mm (0.04 in.) and
remove loose adhesive.
3. Apply four new spacers (1) to the liftgate frame and place them 55 mm in from the window
opening; 70 mm from the upper edge and 150 mm
from the lower edge.
4. Install the lower spacers (2) to the backlite approximately 25 mm (1.0 in) from each side of the
glass.
NOTE: Remove the lower spacers 2 hours after installation of the glass.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 8585
5. Position backlite in center of liftgate opening and resting on the side and lower spacers.
6. Apply adhesive tape strips (1) around the perimeter of the liftgate opening to aid in installation.
NOTE: Windshield installation shown, backlite similar.
7. Verify the backlite gap is parallel to with the liftgate opening. 8. Cut tape with a sharp knife and
remove backlite.
NOTE: Typical primer installation shown.
9. Clean and dry area of glass (2) to be re-glued with a suitable glass preparation solvent and rag.
10. Using a flash light, verify that glass primer is without damage. 11. Re-prime any damaged area.
If old adhesive has been exposed for more than 12 hours, entire adhesive area needs to be
re-primed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 8586
12. Apply primer (1) around the perimeter of the glass to a width of 15 mm (0.5 in.) (2). 13. Allow
primer to air dry for at least 10 minutes. 14. Using a flash light, verify that glass primer is without
damage.
Glass Preparation - Installing A New Backlite
1. Apply four new spacers (1) to the liftgate frame and place them 55 mm in from the window
opening; 70 mm from the upper edge and 150 mm
from the lower edge.
2. Install the lower spacers (2) to the backlite approximately 36 cm (1.0 in) from each side of the
glass.
NOTE: Remove the lower spacers 2 hours after installation of the glass.
3. Position backlite in center of liftgate opening and resting on the side and lower spacers.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 8587
4. Apply adhesive tape strips (1) around the perimeter of the liftgate opening to aid in installation.
NOTE: Windshield installation shown, backlite similar.
5. Verify the backlite gap is parallel to with the liftgate opening. 6. Cut tape with a sharp knife and
remove backlite.
NOTE: Typical primer installation shown.
7. Clean and dry area of glass (2) to be re-glued with a suitable glass preparation solvent and rag.
8. Apply primer to gluing surface at backlite seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 8588
9. Apply primer (1) around the perimeter of the glass to a width of 15 mm (0.5 in.) (2).
10. Allow primer to air dry for at least 10 minutes. 11. Using a flash light, verify that glass primer is
without damage.
Liftgate Opening Preparation
NOTE: Windshield opening shown, liftgate opening similar.
1. Clean and vacuum liftgate opening. 2. Level old bead of liftgate opening adhesive (1) to a
thickness of approximately 1 mm (0.04 in.) and remove loose adhesive.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 8589
NOTE: Windshield opening shown, liftgate opening similar.
3. Clean and dry area of liftgate opening to be re-glued with a suitable glass preparation solvent
and rag. 4. Re-prime any damaged area. If old adhesive has been exposed for more than 12 hours,
entire adhesive area needs to be re-primed. 5. Allow primer to air dry for at least 10 minutes.
Backlite Installation
1. Apply bead of adhesive (1) with a triangular nozzle directly to the backlite seal starting at bottom
in center of the backlite.
CAUTION: Always apply bead of adhesive to the backlite. Always install the backlite within 5
minutes after applying adhesive.
2. Bead dimensions should be approximately 9.5 mm wide (1) by 12.7 mm in height (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 8590
3. Allow end of adhesive bead (1) to run out parallel to the start of the bead and smooth ends flush.
4. Lift backlite into place in the center of the liftgate opening and use the tape as a guide to aid
installation of the backlite into the center of the
cutout.
5. Carefully lay down the backlite and press on.
CAUTION: It is no longer possible to move the backlite after installation. The backlite should never
be pressed into place by more than one
person, because the backlite can break if pressed simultaneously on both sides.
CAUTION: Roll down the left and right front door glass and open the rear glass slider (if available)
before installing backlite to avoid
pressurizing the passenger compartment if a door is slammed before urethane is cured. Water
leaks can result.
6. Install the rear wiper arm, if equipped. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and
Repair/Wiper Arm - Installation 7. Install the liftgate trim panels.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Door Latch C1 (Liftgate) 2 Way
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Actuator: Diagrams Liftgate Door Latch C1 (Liftgate) 2 Way
Connector C1 - (LIFTGATE) 2 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-LIFTGATE - (LIFTGATE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Door Latch C1 (Liftgate) 2 Way > Page 8596
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Actuator: Diagrams Liftgate Door Latch C2 (Liftgate) 3 Way
Connector C2 - (LIFTGATE) 3 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-LIFTGATE - (LIFTGATE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Release Solenoid - Removal
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Actuator: Service and Repair Liftgate Release Solenoid - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the liftgate latch assembly. See:
Trunk / Liftgate Latch/Service and Repair/Liftgate Latch - Removal. 3. Remove the liftgate release
solenoid.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Release Solenoid - Removal > Page 8599
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Actuator: Service and Repair Liftgate Release Solenoid - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the liftgate latch. See: Trunk / Liftgate Latch/Service and Repair/Liftgate Latch Installation. 2. Install the liftgate trim panel. See: Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Liftgate Trim Panel - Installation. 3. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hinge >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hinge - Removal
Trunk / Liftgate Hinge: Service and Repair Hinge - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the liftgate to replace one or both hinges. The hinges can be
replaced one at a time.
NOTE: A suitable body sealant should be used when removing or moving the hinges.
1. Place the liftgate in the full up position. 2. Support liftgate on a suitable lifting device. 3. Using a
trim stick C-4755 or equivalent, remove the upper rear headliner trim. 4. Mark outline of hinge on
the inside of liftgate to aid in installation. 5. Remove the upper hinge bolts (1).
6. Remove the lower hinge bolts (1). 7. Remove hinge from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hinge >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hinge - Removal > Page 8604
Trunk / Liftgate Hinge: Service and Repair Hinge - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position hinge to the vehicle. 2. Install the lower hinge bolts (1). Tighten the hinge bolts to 28 Nm
(21 ft. lbs.).
3. Align the hinge to the previously made markings. 4. Install the upper hinge bolts (1). Tighten the
hinge bolts to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.). 5. Install the upper rear headliner trim. 6. Close the liftgate and
verify proper operation. See: Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Handle >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Exterior Handle - Removal
Trunk / Liftgate Handle: Service and Repair Liftgate Exterior Handle - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. See: Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Liftgate Trim Panel - Removal. 2. Remove the liftgate handle rear mounting nut. 3. Place
the liftgate in the closed position. 4. Remove the mounting fasteners on the front of the liftgate
handle. 5. Disconnect the liftgate handle latch cable. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors and
remove the liftgate handle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Handle >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Exterior Handle - Removal > Page 8609
Trunk / Liftgate Handle: Service and Repair Liftgate Exterior Handle - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the liftgate handle latch cable. 2. Connect electrical connectors and seat the liftgate
handle into position. 3. Install the front liftgate handle fasteners. 4. Place the liftgate in the up
position. 5. Install the rear liftgate handle fastener. 6. Install the liftgate trim panel. See: Trunk /
Liftgate Interior Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Liftgate Trim Panel - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Trim Panel - Removal
Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair Liftgate Trim Panel - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the left and right side trim panels. 2. Using a trim stick C-4829A or equivalent, separate
the pushpin fasteners and remove the upper trim panel. 3. Remove the two lower screws. 4.
Remove the lower trim panel and disconnect the electrical connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8614
Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair Liftgate Trim Panel - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the electrical connector and install the lower trim panel. 2. Install the two lower screws.
3. Install the left and right side trim panels. 4. Position the upper trim into place and seat the push
pin fasteners fully.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch - Removal
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. See: Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Liftgate Trim Panel - Removal. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the latch (3).
3. Disconnect the liftgate latch cable (1). 4. Lower the liftgate to mid position and remove the latch
mounting bolts. 5. Remove the liftgate latch from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch - Removal > Page 8619
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the liftgate latch to the liftgate. 2. Install the mounting fasteners. Tighten the bolts to 28
Nm (21 ft. lbs.). 3. Connect the liftgate latch cable. 4. Connect the electrical connector to the latch.
5. Install the liftgate trim panel. See: Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Liftgate
Trim Panel - Installation. 6. Close the liftgate and verify proper operation. See: Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Gas Prop - Removal
Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support: Service and Repair Gas Prop - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open liftgate. 2. Using a small flat bladed tool or equivalent, release the retaining clips while
pulling the ball socket away from the ball stud.
3. Remove the gas prop-rod lock caps. 4. Remove the support cylinder.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Gas Prop - Removal > Page 8624
Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support: Service and Repair Gas Prop - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Make sure the retaining clips are seated into the ball socket (2) fully. 2. Install the support
cylinder over the ball studs with the thin end connected to the liftgate and the retaining clips
snapping into place.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Striker >
Component Information > Adjustments
Trunk / Liftgate Striker: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT
1. Using a grease pencil or equivalent, mark the position of the striker to aid in adjustment. 2.
Loosen the striker bolts. 3. Change the striker position to adjust the lower liftgate gap and flush
measurement. 4. Tighten the bolts to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Striker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch Striker - Removal
Trunk / Liftgate Striker: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch Striker - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the liftgate. 2. Remove screws attaching liftgate striker to floor pan (1) and remove the
striker.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Body Emblem > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Nameplate - Removal
Body Emblem: Service and Repair Nameplate - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Exterior nameplates are attached to body panels with adhesive tape.
1. Apply a length of masking tape on the body, parallel to the top edge of the nameplate to use as a
guide, if necessary. 2. If temperature is below 21°C (70°F) warm emblem with a heat lamp or gun.
Do not exceed 52°C (120°F) when heating emblem. 3. Insert a plastic trim stick or a hard wood
wedge behind the emblem to separate the adhesive backing from the body. 4. Clean adhesive
residue from body with MOPAR(R) Super Kleen solvent or equivalent.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Body Emblem > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Nameplate - Removal > Page 8635
Body Emblem: Service and Repair Nameplate - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove carrier from adhesive tape on back of emblem. 2. Position emblem properly on body. 3.
Press emblem firmly to body with palm of hand. 4. If temperature is below 21°C (70°F) warm
emblem with a heat lamp or gun to assure adhesion. Do not exceed 52°C (120°F) when heating
emblem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap
At Windshield/Wind Noise
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Customer Interest Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap
At Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 8644
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap
At Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 8645
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
Cowl Moulding / Trim: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind
Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 8651
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 8652
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8653
Cowl Moulding / Trim: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-027-08 Date: 080906
Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8654
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8655
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-027-08 Date:
080906
Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8656
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8657
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 8658
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair > Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 3. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
4. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen.
5. Remove the cowl screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair > Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal > Page 8661
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
2. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
3. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair > Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal > Page 8662
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). 3. Remove the cowl top screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair > Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal > Page 8663
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the cowl top screen (3). 2. Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at
the ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Lower Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Body Cladding - Removal
Lower Side Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Body Cladding - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Warm the effected adhesive type molding and body metal to approximately 38°C (100°F) using a
suitable heat lamp or heat gun. 2. Pull stick-on molding from painted surface.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Lower Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Body Cladding - Removal > Page 8668
Lower Side Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Body Cladding - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean body surface with MOPAR(R) Super Kleen solvent or equivalent. Wipe surface dry with
lint free cloth. 2. Remove protective cover from tape on back of molding. Apply molding to body
below the masking tape guide. 3. Remove masking tape guide and firmly press molding to body
surface to assure adhesion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Service and Repair > Splash Shield - Removal
Front Fender Liner: Service and Repair Splash Shield - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The front splash shields are a two piece assembly.
1. Remove the appropriate front wheel. See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Removal
2. Remove push pins. 3. Remove fasteners. 4. Remove splash shield from wheel well.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Service and Repair > Splash Shield - Removal > Page 8675
Front Fender Liner: Service and Repair Splash Shield - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place splash shield up to wheelhouse opening. 2. Install push pins. 3. Install fasteners. 4. Install
the front wheel. See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Rear Fender > Rear Fender Liner > System Information > Service
and Repair > Splash Shield - Removal
Rear Fender Liner: Service and Repair Splash Shield - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the appropriate rear wheel. See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and Wheels Removal.
2. Remove push pins. 3. Remove fasteners. 4. Remove splash shield from wheel well.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Rear Fender > Rear Fender Liner > System Information > Service
and Repair > Splash Shield - Removal > Page 8681
Rear Fender Liner: Service and Repair Splash Shield - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place splash shield up to wheelhouse opening. 2. Install push pins. 3. Install fasteners. 4. Install
the rear wheel. See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Tires and Wheels - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 > Suspension - Rear
Suspension Squeaking Noise
Rear Cross-Member: Customer Interest Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 > Suspension - Rear
Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 8692
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 > Suspension - Rear
Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 8693
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 > Suspension Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
Rear Cross-Member: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking
Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 > Suspension Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 8699
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > 02-004-08 > Jul > 08 > Suspension Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise > Page 8700
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 8701
Rear Cross-Member: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 02-004-08 Date: 080731
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 8702
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 8703
3. Remove the brackets.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 02-004-08 Date:
080731
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 8704
Suspension - Rear Suspension Squeaking Noise
NUMBER: 02-004-08
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 31, 2008
SUBJECT: Rear Suspension Squeak
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and adjustment of the rear suspension to correct park
brake cable clamp screw head interference with the rear crossmember right front mounting bolt
washer.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 and April 15, 2008 (MDH0102XX >
MDH0415XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Vehicle operator may complain of a squeak or creak sound heard from
the rear of the vehicle while driving over bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Locate the park brake cable clamp screw and rear crossmember mounting bolt washer on both
the right and left front side of the crossmember (Fig. 1).
3. Check for a minimum of 3 mm (0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw
head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer (Fig. 1).
4. Is the gap 3 mm (0.118 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform rear crossmember mounting bolt torque verification Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Perform rear crossmember centering and adjustment Repair Procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 8705
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
TORQUE VERIFICATION REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
4. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
7. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
8. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
9. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle.
REAR CROSSMEMBER CENTERING AND ADJUSTMENT REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the two mounting screws securing each crossmember reinforcement bracket (one each
side of vehicle) to the body (Fig. 2).
2. Remove the mounting nuts securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the
crossmember rear mounting bolts (Fig. 2).
3. Remove the brackets.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the four mounting bolts in the next step. Just Loosen them.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Cross-Member: > Page 8706
4. Loosen the four mounting bolts securing the crossmember to the body to allow enough
movement for repositioning of the crossmember (Fig. 2).
5. With the mounting bolts loose, reposition the crossmember to allow for a minimum of 3 mm
(0.118 in.) clearance between the park brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember
mounting bolt washer. If available, place a 3 mm (0.118 in.) mechanical spacer between the park
brake cable clamp screw head and the rear crossmember mounting bolt washer.
NOTE:
The next step is critical in securing the crossmember to the body and must be done prior to
securing the rear fasteners.
6. Once the crossmember position has been adjusted to allow for 3mm (0.118 in.) or more
clearance on both sides, tighten the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts first.
NOTE:
If a mechanical spacer is used, be sure the mechanical spacer is in place to maintain proper
clearance while securing the front fasteners.
7. Torque the forward (front) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Torque the aft (rear) rear crossmember mounting bolts to 95 N.m (70 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the 3 mm (0.118 in.) spacer if used.
10. Position the crossmember reinforcement brackets (one each side of vehicle) over the
crossmember rear mounting bolt head-studs and install the mounting nuts, but do not tighten at this
time.
11. Install the mounting screws securing the crossmember reinforcement brackets to the body.
12. Torque the screws to 55 N.m (41 ft. lbs.).
13. Torque the mounting nuts securing the reinforcement brackets to the rear crossmember
mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle.
15. Perform rear wheel alignment as necessary. Refer to the detailed procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 02 - Front Suspension > Wheel
Alignment > Standard Procedure > WHEEL ALIGNMENT.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Structural Brace > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wheelhouse Brace - Removal
Structural Brace: Service and Repair Wheelhouse Brace - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 3. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
4. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen. Remove the cowl screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Structural Brace > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wheelhouse Brace - Removal > Page 8711
5. Remove the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1) securing the wheel house brace to the strut
towers. 6. Remove the wheelhouse brace (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Structural Brace > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wheelhouse Brace - Removal > Page 8712
Structural Brace: Service and Repair Wheelhouse Brace - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the wheelhouse brace (2). Install and tighten the eight mounting bolts (four each side) (1)
to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
2. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
3. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Structural Brace > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wheelhouse Brace - Removal > Page 8713
4. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Adapter Kit > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Adapter Kit: Service and Repair
TRAILER TOW HARNESS INSTALLATION
1. Remove the push pin fasteners (2) and separate the rear tail lamp assemblies (1).
2. Disconnect the tail lamp electrical connectors (2 and 3).
3. Connect the harness (2) to the left side tail lamp electrical connectors (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Adapter Kit > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Page 8717
4. Position the harness (1) through the tail lamp opening and down the side of the fender. 5.
Secure the support clips (2) to the body seem.
6. Position the harness (1) over the exhaust and fasten the push pin fasteners (2) to the under side
of the rear bumper in the existing holes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Adapter Kit > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Page 8718
7. Position the harness (1) up the right side of the vehicle to the right tail lamp opening and secure
the clips (2) to the body seem.
8. Connect the harness (1) to the right side tail lamp electrical connectors (2).
9. Connect the tail lamp electrical connectors (2 and 3) to the tail lamp assemblies (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Adapter Kit > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Page 8719
10. Install tail lamps assemblies (1) and install the push pin fasteners (2) fully.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Left
Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Left
Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 8724
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Left
Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 8725
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Left
Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 8726
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP-LEFT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 8729
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Right Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP-RIGHT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 8730
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Left Trailer Tow Stop/Turn Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN-LEFT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 8731
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Right Trailer Tow Stop/Turn Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN-RIGHT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Trailer Tow Relay - Description
Trailer Towing Relay: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Relay - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with an optional trailer tow preparation package have four trailer tow relays, one
each for the trailer tow stop/turn right and left and one each for the trailer stop lamp right and left.
The trailer tow relays are conventional International Standards Organization (ISO) micro relays.
Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions, current capacities,
terminal patterns, and terminal functions. Each relay is contained within a small, rectangular,
molded plastic housing and is connected to all of the required inputs and outputs through five
integral male spade-type terminals that extend from the relay base plate.
The trailer tow relays are included with the trailer tow preparation wire harness that is shipped
loose in the glove box for customer or dealer installation at the rear of the vehicle. A trailer tow
stop/turn relay is located behind the rear fascia below each outer tail lamp, while a trailer stop lamp
relay is located behind the rear fascia below each outboard end of the rear bumper reinforcement.
Each relay and connector is wrapped within an isolator envelope for sound deadening and
anti-rattle protection. Refer to the appropriate wiring information for specific relay cavity assignment
information.
Any of the trailer tow relays cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
affected unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Trailer Tow Relay - Description > Page 8734
Trailer Towing Relay: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Relay - Operation
OPERATION
The trailer tow relays are electromechanical switches that use a low current input from the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to the tail lamps to control a high current output to the trailer
brake and turn signal lamps. Within each relay are an electromagnetic coil, a movable contact and
two fixed contact points. A resistor is connected in parallel with the coil, and helps to dissipate
voltage spikes and electromagnetic interference that can be generated as the field of the relay coil
collapses.
The movable common supply contact point is held against the fixed normally closed contact point
by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field is produced by the
coil windings. This field draws the movable contact away from the normally closed contact, and
holds it against the normally open contact. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure
returns the movable contact back against the normally closed contact.
The inputs and outputs of the trailer tow relays include:
- Common Supply Terminal (30) - The common feed terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected to their respective left or right trailer tow stop/turn signal pins of the
4-way trailer tow connector at all times. The common feed terminals of both the left and right trailer
tow stop relays is connected to the normally closed (87A) terminal of their respective left or right
trailer tow stop/turn relay at all times.
- Coil Ground Terminal (85) - The coil ground terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop/turn
relays is connected to their respective left or right rear turn signal control circuits from the TIPM at
all times. The coil ground terminals of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays are connected to
the stop lamp control circuit from the TIPM at all times.
- Coil Battery Terminal (86) - The coil battery terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop/turn
relays is connected to a path to ground at all times. The coil battery terminal of both the left and
right trailer tow stop relays is connected to their respective left or right rear turn signal control
circuits from the TIPM at all times.
- Normally Open Terminal (87) - The normally open terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected to the stop lamp control circuit from the TIPM whenever that relay is
energized. The normally open terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays is connected
to a path to ground whenever that relay is energized.
- Normally Closed Terminal (87A) - The normally closed terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected are connected to the common supply (30) terminal of their respective
left or right trailer tow stop relay whenever the relay is de-energized. The normally closed terminal
of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays is not connected to any circuit in this application.
The trailer tow relays and the hard wired circuits for the relays may be diagnosed using
conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that provide some
features of the trailer tow turn and stop lamp lighting system. The most reliable, efficient, and
accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and communication related to trailer tow turn
and stop lamp lighting operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Trailer Tow Relay - Removal
Trailer Towing Relay: Service and Repair Trailer Tow Relay - Removal
REMOVAL
TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN RELAYS
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear fascia from the vehicle.
See: Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia Removal
3. Disengage the left or right trailer tow stop/turn relay and connector from the isolator envelope (3)
secured to the trailer tow wire harness (6) along
the left or right body side aperture (2) just below the outer tail lamp.
4. Pull the relay straight out from the wire harness connector.
TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP RELAYS
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear fascia from the vehicle.
See: Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia Removal
3. Disengage the left or right trailer tow stop lamp relay and connector from the isolator envelope
(4) secured to the trailer tow wire harness (6) on
the underside of the rear bumper reinforcement (1) on the left or right side of the 4-way trailer tow
connector (5).
4. Pull the relay straight out from the wire harness connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Trailer Tow Relay - Removal > Page 8737
Trailer Towing Relay: Service and Repair Trailer Tow Relay - Installation
INSTALLATION
TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN RELAYS
1. Align the terminals of the left or right trailer tow stop/turn relay with the terminal receptacles of
the trailer tow wire harness connector. 2. Firmly and evenly push the relay into the connector until it
is fully seated. 3. Insert the relay and connector into the isolator envelope (3) secured to the wire
harness (6) along the left or right body side aperture (2) just below
the outer tail lamp.
4. Reinstall the rear fascia onto the vehicle. See: Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover /
Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP RELAYS
1. Align the terminals of the left or right trailer tow stop lamp relay with the terminal receptacles of
the trailer tow wire harness connector. 2. Firmly and evenly push the relay into the connector until it
is fully seated. 3. Insert the relay and connector into the isolator envelope (4) secured to the trailer
tow wire harness (6) on the underside of the rear bumper
reinforcement (1) on the left or right side of the 4-way trailer tow connector (5).
4. Reinstall the rear fascia onto the vehicle. See: Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover /
Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia -
Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Arm Rest > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Armrest - Removal
Arm Rest: Service and Repair Armrest - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Position the 40 split seat with back folded flat, to the full forward position. 2. Partially remove the
armrest side shield and remove the mounting fastener. 3. With the armrest folded down, remove
the two mounting fasteners located on the inside of the armrest bracket. 4. Remove the armrest
from the vehicle.
NOTE: Only perform the following steps if the cover or foam replacement is required.
5. Remove the armrest plastic cover, by carefully prying up until the retainers disengage. 6. If
equipped, remove the headrest. 7. Remove the headrest sleeves, if equipped. 8. Carefully pull the
seat cover off of the armrest and remove the cover. 9. Remove the foam as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Arm Rest > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Armrest - Removal > Page 8743
Arm Rest: Service and Repair Armrest - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the foam, if required. 2. Carefully install the seat cover to the armrest. 3. If equipped,
install the headrest sleeves to the armrest. 4. Install the headrest, if equipped. 5. Install the armrest
plastic cover, ensuring the retainers engage. 6. Position the armrest to the vehicle. 7. With the
armrest folded down, install the two mounting fasteners located on the inside of the armrest
bracket. Tighten to 40 N-m (29 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the outboard armrest mounting fastener. Tighten
to 30 N-m (22 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Carpet - Removal
Carpet: Service and Repair Carpet - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove door sill trim. See: Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Removal 2. Remove
front seats. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 3. Remove the second
row seats. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal 4. Remove the third row
seats, if equipped. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 5. Remove B-pillar
trim panels as necessary to clear carpet. 6. Remove cowl trim panels. See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Cowl Trim Panel - Removal 7. Remove center console.See: Console/Service and
Repair/Center Console - Removal 8. Remove the rear storage bin. See: Utility Storage
Compartment/Service and Repair/Rear Storage Bin - Removal. 9. Remove the rear storage box.
See: Utility Storage Compartment/Service and Repair/Rear Storage Box - Removal.
10. Pull carpet from behind brake pedal, accelerator pedal and remove the front left carpet (5). 11.
Pull carpet from behind the HVAC and remove the front right carpet (2). 12. Remove the rear
carpet from the vehicle (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Carpet - Removal > Page 8748
Carpet: Service and Repair Carpet - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear carpet to the vehicle (3). 2. Install the front right carpet (2) and push the carpet
behind the HVAC. 3. Install the front left carpet (5) and push the carpet behind brake pedal and
accelerator pedal. 4. Install the rear storage box. See: Utility Storage Compartment/Service and
Repair/Rear Storage Box - Installation. 5. Install the rear storage bin. See: Utility Storage
Compartment/Service and Repair/Rear Storage Bin - Installation. 6. Install center console. See:
Console/Service and Repair/Center Console - Installation. 7. Install cowl trim panels. See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Cowl Trim Panel - Installation. 8. Install B-pillar trim panels as necessary
to clear carpet. 9. Install the third row seats, if equipped. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats,
Front/Seat - Installation.
10. Install the second row seats. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation. 11.
Install front seats. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation 12. Install door sill
trim. See: Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not Stay
Latched
Console: Customer Interest Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not Stay Latched
NUMBER: 23-004-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: February 27, 2010
SUBJECT: Sunglass Holder Will Not Stay Latched
OVERVIEW: If the overhead console endures excessive heat the bezel may warp and the sunglass
holder door will not stay latched in the closed position. Dealers are required to replace the bezel
and follower arm which guides the sunglass holder door.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built before March 27, 2009 (MDH0327XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience the sunglass holder door unlatching and not return returning to the
closed position in high heat conditions.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the sunglass holder door, if it does not return to the closed position, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
Each kit will include two follower arms but only one is needed to perform the repair procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the overhead console assembly. Refer to the detailed removal procedures available in:
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service
Info > Electrical > Message Systems > Overhead Console> Removal > Console Assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not Stay
Latched > Page 8757
2. Remove the sunroof switch (If equipped) by flexing the 4 retaining tabs. Transfer the sunroof
switch to the new console bezel by snapping it into the
retaining tabs (Fig 1).
3. Remove the 4 fasteners that secure the sunglass holder bin assembly to the console bezel and
remove the bin assembly (Fig. 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not Stay
Latched > Page 8758
4. Open the sunglass holder and remove the follower arm from the sunglass bin assembly by
squeezing the 2 locking tabs on the outer side of the bin
(Fig. 3). Discard the old follower arm and replace with the new one provided in the kit.
5. With the sunglass holder open, align the center pin and snap the arm into the bin housing.
Check that the follower arm is properly engaged into the
housing by rotating it (Fig. 4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not Stay
Latched > Page 8759
6. Place the sunglass bin housing onto the locators on the new console bezel and fasten with 4
screws (Fig. 5).
7. Hold the console as it would be positioned in the vehicle and test the function of the latch
mechanism ensuring that all positions can be achieved.
8. Remove the lamp assembly from the console bezel by unsnapping the 2 locking tabs at the
forward edge of the console (Fig. 6).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not Stay
Latched > Page 8760
9. Transfer the lamp assembly to the new bezel by aligning the locator pins and snapping into
place (Fig. 7).
10. Install the overhead console assembly. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in: DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service
Info > Electrical > Message Systems > Overhead Console > Installation > Console Assembly.
11. Return the vehicle to the customer.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not
Stay Latched
Console: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not Stay Latched
NUMBER: 23-004-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: February 27, 2010
SUBJECT: Sunglass Holder Will Not Stay Latched
OVERVIEW: If the overhead console endures excessive heat the bezel may warp and the sunglass
holder door will not stay latched in the closed position. Dealers are required to replace the bezel
and follower arm which guides the sunglass holder door.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built before March 27, 2009 (MDH0327XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience the sunglass holder door unlatching and not return returning to the
closed position in high heat conditions.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the sunglass holder door, if it does not return to the closed position, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
Each kit will include two follower arms but only one is needed to perform the repair procedure.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the overhead console assembly. Refer to the detailed removal procedures available in:
DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service
Info > Electrical > Message Systems > Overhead Console> Removal > Console Assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not
Stay Latched > Page 8766
2. Remove the sunroof switch (If equipped) by flexing the 4 retaining tabs. Transfer the sunroof
switch to the new console bezel by snapping it into the
retaining tabs (Fig 1).
3. Remove the 4 fasteners that secure the sunglass holder bin assembly to the console bezel and
remove the bin assembly (Fig. 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not
Stay Latched > Page 8767
4. Open the sunglass holder and remove the follower arm from the sunglass bin assembly by
squeezing the 2 locking tabs on the outer side of the bin
(Fig. 3). Discard the old follower arm and replace with the new one provided in the kit.
5. With the sunglass holder open, align the center pin and snap the arm into the bin housing.
Check that the follower arm is properly engaged into the
housing by rotating it (Fig. 4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not
Stay Latched > Page 8768
6. Place the sunglass bin housing onto the locators on the new console bezel and fasten with 4
screws (Fig. 5).
7. Hold the console as it would be positioned in the vehicle and test the function of the latch
mechanism ensuring that all positions can be achieved.
8. Remove the lamp assembly from the console bezel by unsnapping the 2 locking tabs at the
forward edge of the console (Fig. 6).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Console: > 23-004-10 > Feb > 10 > Interior - Sunglass Holder Will Not
Stay Latched > Page 8769
9. Transfer the lamp assembly to the new bezel by aligning the locator pins and snapping into
place (Fig. 7).
10. Install the overhead console assembly. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in: DealerConnect > TechCONNECT under: Service
Info > Electrical > Message Systems > Overhead Console > Installation > Console Assembly.
11. Return the vehicle to the customer.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 8770
Console: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
There are two different style's of overhead console (1) available on this vehicle, High line and Mid
or Low line. All overhead consoles are equipped with a sunglasses storage bin (2) and two reading
and courtesy lamps (4). On High line models, the reading lamps are a Light Emitting Diode (LED)
multi directional design, and on the Mid or Low line design the lamps are fixed with a replaceable
incandescent bulb. The sunglasses storage bin also has a conversation mirror that is visible when
the bin is locked in the partial open position. On vehicles equipped with a power sunroof, the
sunroof switch (5) is located behind the sunglasses bin. On vehicles equipped with automatic
climate control an infrared temperature sensor (3) is located between the reading and courtesy
lamps. Both overhead console designs are mounted with six snap clips into a molded plastic
retainer bracket located above the headliner to provide secure overhead console attachment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center Console - Removal
Console: Service and Repair Center Console - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the shifter bezel and shifter knob. 2. Place the parking brake handle (6) in the up
position. 3. Remove the side mounting fasteners (1). 4. Open the console lid (3) and remove the
four mounting fasteners (2). 5. Carefully pry up on the front of the center console until the retainers
disengage from the instrument panel center console (5). 6. Disconnect the electrical connector (4)
at the back of the center floor console. 7. Remove the center floor console from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center Console - Removal > Page 8773
Console: Service and Repair Center Console - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the center floor console into position to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connector (4)
at the back of the center floor console. 3. Carefully depress the front of the center console until the
retainers engage to the instrument panel center console (5). 4. Install the four mounting fasteners
(2) located in the storage bin area. 5. Install the side mounting fasteners (1). 6. Install the shifter
bezel and shifter knob. 7. Lower the parking brake handle (6).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center Console - Removal > Page 8774
Console: Service and Repair Overhead Console - Removal
Console Assembly
CONSOLE ASSEMBLY
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using your fingertips, grasp the sides of the
overhead console (1) and pull straight down evenly to disengage the snap clips from the mounting
bracket.
3. Lower the overhead console (5) far enough to access the wire harness connectors. 4. If
equipped, disconnect the courtesy lamps (1), infrared temperature sensor (2) and power sunroof
switch (4) electrical connectors. 5. Remove the overhead console assembly from the vehicle.
Sunglasses Bin
SUNGLASSES BIN
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center Console - Removal > Page 8775
1. Remove the overhead console (5), See: . 2. Remove the four fasteners (3) that secure the
sunglasses bin (6) to the console. 3. Remove the bin from the console.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center Console - Removal > Page 8776
Console: Service and Repair Overhead Console - Installation
Console Assembly
CONSOLE ASSEMBLY
1. Position the overhead console (5) in the vehicle near the headliner assembly. 2. If equipped,
connect the courtesy lamps (1), infrared temperature sensor (2) and power sunroof switch (4)
electrical connectors. 3. Position the overhead console so that the six retaining clips are lined up
properly with the bracket.
4. Applying pressure to the overhead console (1), push straight up evenly to engage the snap clips
into the mounting bracket. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Sunglasses Bin
SUNGLASSES BIN
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center Console - Removal > Page 8777
1. Install the sunglasses bin (6) into the overhead console (5). 2. Install the four fasteners (3) that
secure the bin to the console. 3. Install the overhead console, See: .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Glove Box Door Latch - Removal
Glove Compartment: Service and Repair Glove Box Door Latch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the glove box. 2. Remove the three glove box latch screws. 3. Separate the latch from the
glove box assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Glove Box Door Latch - Removal > Page 8782
Glove Compartment: Service and Repair Glove Box Door Latch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the latch onto the glove box assembly. 2. Install the glove box latch screws. 3. Close glove
box door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Glove Box Door Latch - Removal > Page 8783
Glove Compartment: Service and Repair Instrument Panel Glove Box - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open glove box. 2. Push in on sides of glove box bin and lower door. 3. Pivot glove box
downward and disengage hinge hooks from instrument panel. 4. Remove glove box.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Glove Box Door Latch - Removal > Page 8784
Glove Compartment: Service and Repair Instrument Panel Glove Box - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place glove box in position. 2. Engage hinge hooks into instrument panel and pivot glove box
upward. 3. Push in sides of glove box bin and snap glove box assembly into instrument panel. 4.
Close glove box door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Headliner - Removal
Headliner: Service and Repair Headliner - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Do not remove the headliner from the vehicle, unless replacing with a new headliner or it is
absolutely necessary.
1. Remove the sun visors by removing the mounting fasteners and disconnect the electrical
connector, if equipped. 2. Remove the sun visor support mounting fasteners and remove the
support from the headliner. 3. Remove the A-pillar trim panel. See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Pillar Trim/A-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal. 4. Remove the B-pillar trim panel. See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/B-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal. 5. Remove the C-pillar trim
panel. See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/B-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal 6. Remove the
D-pillar trim panel. See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/D-Pillar Trim/Removal. 7.
Remove the overhead console. See: Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Removal. 8.
Remove the header trim panel by carefully pulling down on the trim disengaging the retainers. 9.
Remove the mounting fasteners and remove the grab handles and coat hooks.
10. Remove the left quarter trim panel. See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal. 11. Remove the seat belt mounting bracket from the right
D-pillar. 12. Lower the first and second row seats as far as possible removing the headrests as
necessary. 13. Disconnect electrical connectors. 14. Remove the pushpin retainers at the rear of
the headliner. 15. Carefully disengage retaining clips and lower headliner. 16. With the help of an
assistant(s), remove the headliner from the vehicle through the lift gate opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Headliner - Removal > Page 8789
Headliner: Service and Repair Headliner - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. With the help of an assistant(s), carefully install the headliner into the vehicle through the rear
liftgate opening. Do not over flex the headliner and
be carefully not to crack or mar the headliner.
2. Raise the headliner into position and engage the retainers. 3. Connect the electrical connectors.
4. Install the grab handles and coat hooks. Install the mounting fasteners. 5. Install the overhead
console. See: Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Installation. 6. Install the D-pillar
trim panel. See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/D-Pillar Trim/Installation. 7. Install the
C-pillar trim panel. See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/C-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation.
8. Install the B-pillar trim panel. See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar Trim/B-Pillar Trim
Panel-Installation. 9. Install the A-pillar trim panel. See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Pillar
Trim/A-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation.
10. Install the quarter trim panel to the vehicle. See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage
Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation. 11. Install the sun visor support and mounting
fasteners. 12. Install the sun visors and mounting fasteners.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Scuff Plate > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Scuff Plate - Removal
Scuff Plate: Service and Repair Scuff Plate - Removal
Door Sill
REMOVAL
1. Using trim stick C-4755 disengage clips holding door sill scuff panel and to door sill. 2. Starting
at forward end of door sill scuff panel, pull upward on sill scuff panel in order to disengage clips
attaching sill scuff panel to door opening
flange.
3. Remove door sill scuff panel from vehicle.
Liftgate Sill
REMOVAL
1. Open the liftgate. 2. Using trim stick C-4755, carefully pry the liftgate sill plate out disengaging
the retaining clips. 3. Remove the liftgate sill plate from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Scuff Plate > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Scuff Plate - Removal > Page 8794
Scuff Plate: Service and Repair Scuff Plate - Installation
Door Sill
INSTALLATION
1. Place door sill trim panel into position. 2. Ensure plastic retaining nut is installed. 3. Pushing
downward on sill trim panel to engage tabs and attaching clips to the door sill.
Liftgate Sill
INSTALLATION
1. Position the liftgate sill plate into the vehicle. 2. Firmly press the sill plate downward securing the
retaining clips. 3. Close the liftgate.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Sun Visor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Visor Support - Removal
Sun Visor: Service and Repair Visor Support - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disengage sun visor from center support. 2. Remove mounting fasteners attaching support to
roof header, 3. Remove support from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Sun Visor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Visor Support - Removal > Page 8799
Sun Visor: Service and Repair Visor Support - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place support into position. 2. Install mounting fasteners attaching support to roof header, 3.
Engage sun visor to center support.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Sun Visor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Visor Support - Removal > Page 8800
Sun Visor: Service and Repair Visor - Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: When removing or installing the screws (1), be certain to avoid any wiring or drain tube
interference.
1. Remove the three screws (1) that secure each sun visor (2) to the roof panel and remove the
visor from the headliner (3). 2. If equipped, disconnect the wire harness connector for the
illuminated vanity mirror (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Sun Visor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Visor Support - Removal > Page 8801
Sun Visor: Service and Repair Visor - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: When removing or installing the screws (1), be certain to avoid any wiring or drain tube
interference.
1. If equipped, connect the wire harness connector for the illuminated vanity mirror (4). 2. Position
the sun visor (2) onto the headliner (3). 3. Install the three screws (1) that secure each sun visor to
the roof panel. Tighten the screws to 2.2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Cowl Trim Panel - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove door sill trim panel.See: Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Removal. 2. Using
trim stick C-4755, disengage cowl trim panel clips from the corresponding locations in the sheet
metal. 3. Remove cowl trim panel from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8806
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Cowl Trim Panel - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Ensure plastic retaining nut (3) is installed. 2. Position cowl trim panel (1) to vehicle. 3. Hand
press cowl trim panel to corresponding holes in sheet metal. 4. Install door sill trim panel.See: Scuff
Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8807
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Luggage Compartment Trim
Quarter Trim Panel - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the second row seats. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 2.
Remove the third row seats, if equipped. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat Removal 3. Remove the storage box, if equipped. See: Utility Storage Compartment/Service and
Repair/Rear Storage Box - Removal. 4. Remove the door sill plate. See: Scuff Plate/Service and
Repair/Scuff Plate - Removal. 5. Remove the D-pillar trim panel. See: Pillar Trim/D-Pillar
Trim/Removal. 6. Remove the mounting fasteners. 7. Using trim stick C-4755, carefully pry the
quarter trim panel out disengaging the retaining clips.
Quarter Trim Panel - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the quarter trim panel. 2. Install the mounting fasteners. 3. Install the door sill plate. See:
Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation. 4. Install the D-pillar trim panel. See: Pillar
Trim/D-Pillar Trim/Installation. 5. Install the storage box, if equipped. See: Utility Storage
Compartment/Service and Repair/Rear Storage Box - Installation. 6. Install the third row seats, if
equipped. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation. 7. Install the second row
seats. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8808
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Pillar Trim
A-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: If the high-retention snap clip (3) is removed from the sheet metal, it will be damaged
and must be replaced with a new tether and
snap clip unit. Also, if the rosebud on the plastic tether is damaged due to misalignment and does
not engage, it must be replaced with a new plastic tether.
1. Carefully pull the upper end of the trim away from the A-pillar far enough to disengage the
rosebud retainer (6) and unfold the tether (2). 2. Using a screwdriver or equivalent, carefully
disengage the tether clip (1) and slide from housing on the A-pillar trim panel.
3. Carefully pull the bottom end of the trim away from the A-pillar to disengage the spring clip
retainer. 4. Remove A-pillar trim from vehicle.
A-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: If the high-retention snap clip (3) is removed from the sheet metal, it will be damaged
and must be replaced with a new tether and
snap clip unit. Also, if the rosebud on the plastic tether is damaged due to misalignment and does
not engage, it must be replaced with a new plastic tether.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8809
1. Place A-pillar trim (1) into position. 2. Carefully push the bottom end of the trim onto the A-pillar
to engage the spring clip retainer.
3. Carefully slide the tether (2) into the housing on the A-pillar trim panel and engage the tether clip
(1). 4. Carefully engage the rosebud retainer (6) and push the upper end of the trim to the A-pillar
and engage the spring clip retainer.
B-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert top of B-pillar trim locator into position. 2. Before hinging B-pillar upward into place, route
seat belt anchor through seat belt adjuster opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8810
3. Fasten seat belt anchor to seat.See: Restraint Systems/Seat Belt Systems/Seat Belt Height
Adjuster/Service and Repair/Seat Belt Turning Loop
Adjuster - Installation
4. Hinge B-pillar trim downward, engaging clips ensuring proper seat. 5. Install B-pillar screw into
B-pillar.
6. Snap SRS airbag anchor cover into place ensuring proper seat. 7. Install the lower B-pillar trim
panel. 8. Install the sill trim panel. See: Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation.
B-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove sill trim panel.See: Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Removal 2. Remove
seat belt anchor.See: Restraint Systems/Seat Belt Systems/Seat Belt Retractor/Service and
Repair/Seat Belt Retractor - Removal 3. Remove the lower B-pillar trim panel. 4. Using trim stick
C-4755, remove SRS airbag cover located at top of B-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8811
5. Move seat belt adjuster all the way down exposing the B-pillar screw. Remove B-pillar screw. 6.
Using trim stick C-4755, pry up B-pillar and route seat belt through B-pillar trim. Remove B-pillar
bottom first and remove trim from B-pillar.
C-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the quarter trim panel. See: Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
2. Remove seat belt anchor bolt, See: Restraint Systems/Seat Belt Systems/Seat Belt
Retractor/Service and Repair/Seat Belt Retractor - Removal. 3. Remove the access hole cover and
remove the mounting fastener. 4. Using trim stick C-4755, carefully pry the C-pillar out disengaging
the retaining clips. 5. Route seat belt through opening and remove C-pillar trim panel from vehicle.
C-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8812
1. Place upper C-pillar trim into position. 2. Route seat belt through opening in C-Pillar Trim 3.
Firmly seat the retaining clips to the C-pillar. 4. Install the mounting fastener and access hole cover.
5. Install bolt attaching seat belt lower anchor to floor, See: Restraint Systems/Seat Belt
Systems/Seat Belt Retractor/Service and Repair/Seat Belt
Retractor - Installation.
6. Install quarter panel trim. See: Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the rear header trim panel. 2. Remove the access hole covers and remove the
mounting fasteners. 3. Using trim stick C-4755, carefully pry the D-pillar out disengaging the
retaining clips. 4. Remove the D-pillar from the vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8813
1. Position the D-pillar into position. 2. Firmly seat the retaining clips securing the D-pillar. 3. Install
mounting fasteners and access hole covers. 4. Install the rear header trim panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8814
Trim Panel: Service and Repair
Cowl Trim Panel - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove door sill trim panel.See: Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Removal. 2. Using
trim stick C-4755, disengage cowl trim panel clips from the corresponding locations in the sheet
metal. 3. Remove cowl trim panel from vehicle.
Cowl Trim Panel - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Ensure plastic retaining nut (3) is installed. 2. Position cowl trim panel (1) to vehicle. 3. Hand
press cowl trim panel to corresponding holes in sheet metal. 4. Install door sill trim panel.See: Scuff
Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation.
Quarter Trim Panel - Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8815
1. Remove the second row seats. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 2.
Remove the third row seats, if equipped. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat Removal 3. Remove the storage box, if equipped. See: Utility Storage Compartment/Service and
Repair/Rear Storage Box - Removal. 4. Remove the door sill plate. See: Scuff Plate/Service and
Repair/Scuff Plate - Removal. 5. Remove the D-pillar trim panel. See: Pillar Trim/D-Pillar
Trim/Removal. 6. Remove the mounting fasteners. 7. Using trim stick C-4755, carefully pry the
quarter trim panel out disengaging the retaining clips.
Quarter Trim Panel - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the quarter trim panel. 2. Install the mounting fasteners. 3. Install the door sill plate. See:
Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation. 4. Install the D-pillar trim panel. See: Pillar
Trim/D-Pillar Trim/Installation. 5. Install the storage box, if equipped. See: Utility Storage
Compartment/Service and Repair/Rear Storage Box - Installation. 6. Install the third row seats, if
equipped. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation. 7. Install the second row
seats. See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation.
A-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: If the high-retention snap clip (3) is removed from the sheet metal, it will be damaged
and must be replaced with a new tether and
snap clip unit. Also, if the rosebud on the plastic tether is damaged due to misalignment and does
not engage, it must be replaced with a new plastic tether.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8816
1. Carefully pull the upper end of the trim away from the A-pillar far enough to disengage the
rosebud retainer (6) and unfold the tether (2). 2. Using a screwdriver or equivalent, carefully
disengage the tether clip (1) and slide from housing on the A-pillar trim panel.
3. Carefully pull the bottom end of the trim away from the A-pillar to disengage the spring clip
retainer. 4. Remove A-pillar trim from vehicle.
A-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: If the high-retention snap clip (3) is removed from the sheet metal, it will be damaged
and must be replaced with a new tether and
snap clip unit. Also, if the rosebud on the plastic tether is damaged due to misalignment and does
not engage, it must be replaced with a new plastic tether.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8817
1. Place A-pillar trim (1) into position. 2. Carefully push the bottom end of the trim onto the A-pillar
to engage the spring clip retainer.
3. Carefully slide the tether (2) into the housing on the A-pillar trim panel and engage the tether clip
(1). 4. Carefully engage the rosebud retainer (6) and push the upper end of the trim to the A-pillar
and engage the spring clip retainer.
B-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert top of B-pillar trim locator into position. 2. Before hinging B-pillar upward into place, route
seat belt anchor through seat belt adjuster opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8818
3. Fasten seat belt anchor to seat.See: Restraint Systems/Seat Belt Systems/Seat Belt Height
Adjuster/Service and Repair/Seat Belt Turning Loop
Adjuster - Installation
4. Hinge B-pillar trim downward, engaging clips ensuring proper seat. 5. Install B-pillar screw into
B-pillar.
6. Snap SRS airbag anchor cover into place ensuring proper seat. 7. Install the lower B-pillar trim
panel. 8. Install the sill trim panel. See: Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Installation.
B-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove sill trim panel.See: Scuff Plate/Service and Repair/Scuff Plate - Removal 2. Remove
seat belt anchor.See: Restraint Systems/Seat Belt Systems/Seat Belt Retractor/Service and
Repair/Seat Belt Retractor - Removal 3. Remove the lower B-pillar trim panel. 4. Using trim stick
C-4755, remove SRS airbag cover located at top of B-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8819
5. Move seat belt adjuster all the way down exposing the B-pillar screw. Remove B-pillar screw. 6.
Using trim stick C-4755, pry up B-pillar and route seat belt through B-pillar trim. Remove B-pillar
bottom first and remove trim from B-pillar.
C-Pillar Trim Panel-Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the quarter trim panel. See: Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Removal.
2. Remove seat belt anchor bolt, See: Restraint Systems/Seat Belt Systems/Seat Belt
Retractor/Service and Repair/Seat Belt Retractor - Removal. 3. Remove the access hole cover and
remove the mounting fastener. 4. Using trim stick C-4755, carefully pry the C-pillar out disengaging
the retaining clips. 5. Route seat belt through opening and remove C-pillar trim panel from vehicle.
C-Pillar Trim Panel-Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8820
1. Place upper C-pillar trim into position. 2. Route seat belt through opening in C-Pillar Trim 3.
Firmly seat the retaining clips to the C-pillar. 4. Install the mounting fastener and access hole cover.
5. Install bolt attaching seat belt lower anchor to floor, See: Restraint Systems/Seat Belt
Systems/Seat Belt Retractor/Service and Repair/Seat Belt
Retractor - Installation.
6. Install quarter panel trim. See: Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the rear header trim panel. 2. Remove the access hole covers and remove the
mounting fasteners. 3. Using trim stick C-4755, carefully pry the D-pillar out disengaging the
retaining clips. 4. Remove the D-pillar from the vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8821
1. Position the D-pillar into position. 2. Firmly seat the retaining clips securing the D-pillar. 3. Install
mounting fasteners and access hole covers. 4. Install the rear header trim panel.
Shifter Housing - Removal
REMOVAL
AUTOMATIC
1. Disengage the lower cover of the shift knob (1) to access set screw. 2. Remove set screw and
remove shift knob. 3. Carefully pry up the shift bezel (2) and remove.
MANUAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8822
1. Disengage the lower cover of the shift knob (4) to access set screw. 2. Remove set screw and
remove shift knob. 3. Carefully pry up the shift bezel (3) and remove. 4. Carefully pry up on the shift
boot (1) and remove from shift shaft (2).
Shifter Housing - Installation
INSTALLATION
AUTOMATIC
1. Install the shift bezel (2). 2. Remove set screw and remove shift knob (1). 3. Install the lower
cover.
MANUAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Trim Panel - Removal > Page 8823
1. Install the shift boot (1). 2. Install the shift bezel (3). 3. Install the shift knob (4) and install the set
screw. 4. Install the lower cover.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Second Row Storage Bin - Removal
Utility Storage Compartment: Service and Repair Second Row Storage Bin - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the lid to the second row storage bin and remove the inner liner. 2. Remove the mounting
fasteners securing the storage bin to the floor. 3. Remove the storage bin from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Second Row Storage Bin - Removal > Page 8828
Utility Storage Compartment: Service and Repair Second Row Storage Bin - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place the storage bin into position in the vehicle. 2. Install the mounting fasteners that secure the
storage bin to the floor. 3. Install the liner and close the lid.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Second Row Storage Bin - Removal > Page 8829
Utility Storage Compartment: Service and Repair Rear Storage Bin - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the carpet (1) covering the storage bin. 2. Remove the storage bin liner (3). 3. Remove
the mounting fasteners (4). 4. Remove the storage bin (5) from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Second Row Storage Bin - Removal > Page 8830
Utility Storage Compartment: Service and Repair Rear Storage Bin - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the storage bin (5) to the vehicle. 2. Install the mounting fasteners (4). 3. Install the
storage bin liner (3). 4. Install the carpet (1) covering the storage bin.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Second Row Storage Bin - Removal > Page 8831
Utility Storage Compartment: Service and Repair
Second Row Storage Bin - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the lid to the second row storage bin and remove the inner liner. 2. Remove the mounting
fasteners securing the storage bin to the floor. 3. Remove the storage bin from the vehicle.
Second Row Storage Bin - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place the storage bin into position in the vehicle. 2. Install the mounting fasteners that secure the
storage bin to the floor. 3. Install the liner and close the lid.
Rear Storage Bin - Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Second Row Storage Bin - Removal > Page 8832
1. Remove the carpet (1) covering the storage bin. 2. Remove the storage bin liner (3). 3. Remove
the mounting fasteners (4). 4. Remove the storage bin (5) from the vehicle.
Rear Storage Bin - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the storage bin (5) to the vehicle. 2. Install the mounting fasteners (4). 3. Install the
storage bin liner (3). 4. Install the carpet (1) covering the storage bin.
Rear Storage Box - Removal
REMOVAL
STORAGE BOX - 5 PASSENGER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Second Row Storage Bin - Removal > Page 8833
1. Remove the mat covering the storage box. 2. Remove the load floor assembly (3). 3. Remove
the storage box mounting fasteners (2). 4. Remove the storage box (1) from the vehicle.
STORAGE BOX - 7 PASSENGER
1. Remove the retainers on the seat back gap hider to the rear storage box. 2. Open the storage
bin lid. 3. Remove the storage box liner (2), if equipped. 4. Remove the storage box mounting
fasteners (4). 5. Remove the storage box (1) from the vehicle.
Rear Storage Box - Installation
INSTALLATION
STORAGE BOX - 5 PASSENGER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Second Row Storage Bin - Removal > Page 8834
1. Install the storage box (1) to the vehicle. 2. Install the storage box mounting fasteners (2). 3.
Install the load floor assembly (3). 4. Install the mat covering the storage box.
STORAGE BOX - 7 PASSENGER
1. Install the storage box (1) to the vehicle. 2. Install the storage box mounting fasteners (4). 3.
Install the storage box liner (2). 4. Install the seat back gap hider retainers to the rear storage box.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal
Door Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove door trim panel See: Doors, Hood
and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Removal. 3. Disconnect the wiring clip and pigtail wire connector. 4. Remove the Door Cylinder
Lock Switch from door lock cylinder.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal > Page 8841
Door Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the Door Cylinder Lock Switch onto the door lock cylinder. 2. Connect the wiring clip and
pigtail wire connector. 3. Install door trim panel See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Installation. 4. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Locations
> Driver Door Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Locations
> Driver Door Module > Page 8846
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8849
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C3 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C3 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8850
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C4 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C4 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8851
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C5 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C5 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8852
Door Module: Diagrams
Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Driver Door Module C3 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C3 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8853
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Driver Door Module C4 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C4 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8854
Driver Door Module C5 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C5 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8855
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Door Module C3 (Except Base) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C3 (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8856
Passenger Door Module C4 (Except Base) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C4 (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Passenger Door Module C5 (Except Base) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C5 (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Diagrams
> Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8857
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Door Module - Removal
Door Module: Service and Repair Door Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the door trim panel as necessary
to gain access to the door control module. See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front
Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the door control module mounting fasteners
and remove the module from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Door Module - Removal > Page 8860
Door Module: Service and Repair Door Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place the door control module into position and install the mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the
electrical connectors. 3. Install the door trim panel. See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Installation.
4. Install the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations
Keyless Entry Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8865
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8866
Keyless Entry Module: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Remote Start Antenna - Description
Keyless Start Antenna: Description and Operation Remote Start Antenna - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Remote Start Antenna Module Assembly consists of an electrical connection to the Wireless
Ignition Node (WIN) (1), a length of coaxial cable (2), two mounting clips (3 and 4) and a control
module/antenna (5).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Remote Start Antenna - Description > Page 8872
Keyless Start Antenna: Description and Operation Remote Start Antenna - Operation
OPERATION
The remote start antenna is an external hidden antenna located at the driver's side front of dash.
The antenna interfaces with the Wireless Integration Node (WIN) through a coaxial electrical cable
and electrical connector. The antenna helps to amplify the signal for the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) key fob.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Start Antenna - Removal
Keyless Start Antenna: Service and Repair Remote Start Antenna - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Wait two minutes for the system reserve capacitor to discharge before servicing any
airbag components. Failure to do this may
result in serious or fatal injury.
The remote start antenna is located driver's side front of dash.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove radio. Refer to See: Accessories
and Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and
Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Radio - Removal.
3. Remove instrument cluster. Refer to See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning
Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and
Repair/Instrument Cluster - Removal.
4. Remove the instrument panel top pad. Refer to See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel
Pad - Removal.
NOTE: During removal of the remote start antenna note the routing location of the coaxial cable.
5. Disconnect remote start antenna coaxial cable connector (1) from skreem module (3). 6.
Remove the mounting clip (2).
7. Remove the mounting clip at the steering column reinforcement bracket. 8. Remove screws (1)
and remove remote start antenna (2) from instrument panel assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Starting System > Keyless Start Antenna
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Start Antenna - Removal > Page 8875
Keyless Start Antenna: Service and Repair Remote Start Antenna - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Make sure the remote start antenna is positioned the same way noted during the removal
procedure.
1. Install the remote start antenna (2) and screws (1) to instrument panel assembly. Tighten to 2.5
Nm (22 in. lbs.). 2. Route the remote start coaxial cable in the position noted during the removal
procedure. 3. Install the coaxial cable mounting clip at the steering column reinforcement bracket.
4. Install the mounting clip (2). 5. Connect remote start antenna coaxial cable connector (1) to
skreem module (3). 6. Install instrument cluster. Refer to See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and
Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and
Repair/Instrument Cluster - Installation.
7. Install radio. Refer to See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact
Disc/Radio/Stereo/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Radio - Installation.
8. Install the instrument panel top pad. Refer to See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel
Pad - Installation.
9. Connect negative battery cable. Tighten to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry
Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Service and Repair
Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: Service and Repair
FOBIK TRANSMITTER BATTERY REPLACEMENT
FOBIK WITH BATTERY COVER
NOTE: Do not disturb the metal terminal near the battery. Avoid touching the new battery. Skin oils
may cause battery deterioration. If
battery are touched, clean with rubbing alcohol.
To replace the FOBIK transmitter battery:
1. Using a small flat bladed tool, carefully remove the battery cover on the back of the FOBIK.
2. Remove the battery one at a time by slightly lifting up and sliding out from the FOBIK. 3. Replace
the battery with the same type of battery cell. 4. Install the battery with the positive terminal up. 5.
Install battery cover and snap into place. 6. Test FOBIK operation.
FOBIK WITHOUT BATTERY COVER
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry
Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8880
NOTE: Do not disturb the metal terminal near the battery. Avoid touching the new battery. Skin oils
may cause battery deterioration. If
battery are touched, clean with rubbing alcohol.
This design is a clam shell design whereby both halves are split apart.
1. Remove the valet/spare key from the FOBIK if present. 2. Using a trim stick C-4755 or
equivalent, carefully separate the top half from the bottom half.
3. Lift up on the battery to remove. 4. Replace battery with the same type of cell. 5. Install new
battery negative side up. 6. Snap the top and bottom halves together. 7. Test FOBIK operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Door Lock Cylinder Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal
Door Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove door trim panel See: Doors, Hood
and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Removal. 3. Disconnect the wiring clip and pigtail wire connector. 4. Remove the Door Cylinder
Lock Switch from door lock cylinder.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Door Lock Cylinder Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal > Page 8886
Door Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the Door Cylinder Lock Switch onto the door lock cylinder. 2. Connect the wiring clip and
pigtail wire connector. 3. Install door trim panel See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Installation. 4. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Driver Door Latch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Driver Door Latch > Page 8891
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Driver Door Latch > Page 8892
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Driver Door Latch > Page 8893
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way
Power Door Lock Actuator: Diagrams Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way
Connector (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 4 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-DRIVER (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way > Page 8896
Power Door Lock Actuator: Diagrams Driver Door Latch (Thatcham) (Front Door) 8 Way
Connector (THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-DRIVER (THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way > Page 8897
Power Door Lock Actuator: Diagrams Left Rear Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Rear Door) 4 Way
Connector (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 4 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-LEFT REAR (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way > Page 8898
Power Door Lock Actuator: Diagrams Left Rear Door Latch (Thatcham) (Rear Door) 8 Way
Connector (THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 8 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-LEFT REAR (THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way > Page 8899
Power Door Lock Actuator: Diagrams
Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way
Connector (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 4 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-DRIVER (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 4 WAY
Driver Door Latch (Thatcham) (Front Door) 8 Way
Connector (THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-DRIVER (THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way > Page 8900
Left Rear Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Rear Door) 4 Way
Connector (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 4 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-LEFT REAR (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 4 WAY
Left Rear Door Latch (Thatcham) (Rear Door) 8 Way
Connector (THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way > Page 8901
LATCH-DOOR-LEFT REAR (THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 8 WAY
Passenger Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way
Connector (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 4 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way > Page 8902
Passenger Door Latch (Thatcham) (Front Door) 8 Way
Connector (THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-PASSENGER (THATCHAM) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
Right Rear Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Rear Door) 4 Way
Connector (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way > Page 8903
LATCH-DOOR-RIGHT REAR (EXCEPT THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 4 WAY
Right Rear Door Latch (Thatcham) (Rear Door) 8 Way
Connector (THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 8 WAY
LATCH-DOOR-RIGHT REAR (THATCHAM) - (REAR DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Latch (Except Thatcham) (Front Door) 4 Way > Page 8904
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8905
Power Door Lock Actuator: Testing and Inspection
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
Make certain battery is in normal condition before circuits are tested.
To determine which motor is faulty, check each individual door for electrical lock and unlock or
disconnect the motor connectors one at a time, while operating the door lock switch. In the event
that none of the motors work, the problem maybe caused by a shorted motor, a bad switch, or a
bad relay. Disconnecting a defective motor will allow the others to work.
To test an individual door lock motor, disconnect the electrical connector from the motor. To lock
the door, connect a 12 volt power source to the positive pin of the lock motor and a ground wire to
the other pin. To unlock the door reverse the wire connections at the motor pin terminals. If these
results are NOT obtained, replace the motor.
The door lock motor is integral to the door latch. If faulty, the entire door latch must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch > Page 8910
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Connector C1 - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way > Page 8913
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C2 (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way > Page 8914
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Except Base) (Front
Door) 10 Way
Connector (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way > Page 8915
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Base) (Front Door) 8
Way
Connector (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 8916
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
VOLTAGE
The following wiring test sequence determines whether or not voltage is continuous through the
body harness to switch.
1. Remove switch from door trim panel. 2. Carefully separate multiple terminal block on wiring
harness from switch body. 3. Connect one lead of test light to a ground terminal:
- Touch other test light lead to battery feed B+ terminal.
- If test light comes on, the wiring circuit between the battery and switch is functional.
- If test light does not come on, check for a blown fuse. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for circuit
information.
DOOR LOCK SWITCH
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the auto-express feature for power windows, the local interface
network (LIN) controls the lock, mirror and
window features.
Remove the non-express switch from its mounting location. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the DOOR
LOCK SWITCH CONTINUITY table to determine if the continuity is correct in the LOCK and
UNLOCK switch positions. If these results are not obtained, replace the switch.
DOOR LOCK SWITCH CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Power Lock Switch - Removal
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Power Lock Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative remote cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent,
carefully pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
switch wire connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Power Lock Switch - Removal > Page 8919
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Power Lock Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect switch wire connector. 2. Install the switch by snapping into place. 3. Connect the
battery negative remote cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Mirror Switch - Removal
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair Power Mirror Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent, carefully
pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect switch wire
connector. 4. Remove switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Mirror Switch - Removal > Page 8925
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair Power Mirror Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect switch wire connector. 2. Install the switch to the door trim panel. 3. Connect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and
ID
Paint: Application and ID
PAINT CODES
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Description and
Operation > Basecoat/Clearcoat Finish - Description
Paint: Description and Operation Basecoat/Clearcoat Finish - Description
DESCRIPTION
On most vehicles a two-part paint application (basecoat/clearcoat) is used. Color paint that is
applied to primer is called basecoat. The clearcoat protects the basecoat from ultraviolet light and
provides a durable high-gloss finish.
CAUTION: Do not use abrasive chemicals or compounds on painted surfaces. Damage to finish
can result.
Do not use harsh alkaline based cleaning solvents on painted surfaces. Damage to finish or color
can result.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Description and
Operation > Basecoat/Clearcoat Finish - Description > Page 8932
Paint: Description and Operation Paint Code - Description
DESCRIPTION
The paint code is identified on the Vehicle Safety Certification Label which is located on the drivers
door shut face. The first digit of the paint code listed on the vehicle indicates the sequence of
application, i.e.: P = primary coat, Q = secondary coat. The codes listed in the Color Code Chart
are used for manufacturing purposes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > Paint Touch-Up
Paint: Service and Repair Paint Touch-Up
DESCRIPTION
When a painted metal surface has been scratched or chipped, it should be touched up as soon as
possible to avoid corrosion. For best results, use Mopar(R) Scratch Filler/Primer, Touch Up Paints
and Clear Top Coat. For a description of the paint codes, See: Application and ID.
WARNING: Use an OSHA approved respirator and safety glasses when spraying paint or solvents
in a confined area. Personal injury can
result.
TOUCH UP PROCEDURE
1. Scrape loose paint and corrosion from inside scratch or chip. 2. Clean affected area with
Mopar(R) Tar/Road Oil Remover, and allow to dry. 3. Fill the inside of the scratch or chip with a
coat of filler/primer. Do not overlap primer onto good surface finish. The applicator brush should be
wet enough to puddle-fill the scratch or chip without running. Do not stroke brush applicator on
body surface. Allow the filler/primer to dry hard.
4. Cover the filler/primer with color touch up paint. Do not overlap touch up color onto the original
color coat around the scratch or chip. Butt the
new color to the original color, if possible. Do not stroke applicator brush on body surface. Allow
touch up paint to dry hard.
5. On vehicles without clearcoat, the touch up color can be lightly finesse sanded (1500 grit) and
polished with rubbing compound. 6. On vehicles with clearcoat, apply clear top coat to touch up
paint with the same technique as described in 4. Allow clear top coat to dry hard. If
desired, 5 can be performed on clear top coat.
WARNING: Avoid prolonged skin contact with petroleum or alcohol - based cleaning solvents.
Personal injury can result.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > Paint Touch-Up > Page 8935
Paint: Service and Repair Finesse Sanding, Buffing, And Polishing - Description
DESCRIPTION
Minor acid etching, orange peel, or smudging in clearcoat or single-stage finishes can be reduced
with light finesse sanding, hand buffing, and polishing. If the finish has been finesse sanded in the
past, it cannot be repeated. Finesse sanding operation should be performed by a trained
automotive paint technician.
CAUTION: Do not remove clearcoat finish, if equipped. Basecoat paint must retain clearcoat for
durability.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Locations > Driver Door Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Locations > Driver Door Module > Page 8941
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8944
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C3 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C3 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8945
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C4 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C4 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8946
Door Module: Diagrams Driver Door Module C5 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C5 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8947
Door Module: Diagrams
Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Driver Door Module C3 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C3 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8948
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Driver Door Module C4 (Express) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C4 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8949
Driver Door Module C5 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C5 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-DRIVER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8950
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXPRESS) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Door Module C3 (Except Base) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C3 (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8951
Passenger Door Module C4 (Except Base) (Front Door) 5 Way
Connector C4 (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 5 WAY
Passenger Door Module C5 (Except Base) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C5 (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Driver Door Module C2 (Express) (Front Door) 10 Way > Page 8952
MODULE-DOOR-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Door Module - Removal
Door Module: Service and Repair Door Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the door trim panel as necessary
to gain access to the door control module. See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front
Door
Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the door control module mounting fasteners
and remove the module from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Door Module - Removal > Page 8955
Door Module: Service and Repair Door Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place the door control module into position and install the mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the
electrical connectors. 3. Install the door trim panel. See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Installation.
4. Install the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Module: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8959
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8960
Keyless Entry Module: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
NODE-WIRELESS IGNITION - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 12 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8964
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams
Connector - (SEAT) 10 WAY
MODULE-HEATED SEATS - (SEAT) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Module - Description
Seat Heater Control Module: Description and Operation Heated Seat Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
The heated seat module (2) is located under the driver front seat. It has a single electrical
connector (1) and a push pin style retainer that secures it to the seat pan (4). The module can be
accessed from under the Driver seat with the seat in the full back and up position.
The heated seat module is a microprocessor designed to use the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus messages from the instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment
Node (CCN). The CCN receives inputs from the heated seat switches and in turn signals the
heated seat module to operate the heated seat elements for both front seats.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Module - Description > Page 8967
Seat Heater Control Module: Description and Operation Heated Seat Module - Operation
OPERATION
The heated seat module operates on fused battery current received from the ignition switch. The
module is grounded to the body at all times through the electrical connector. Inputs to the module
include Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus messages and standard hardwired 12 volt power
and ground. In response to the LIN inputs the heated seat module will control the battery current to
the appropriate heated seat elements.
When a heated seat switch LIN data bus signal is received by the heated seat module, the module
energizes the selected heated seat element. The Low heat set point is about 38° C (100.4° F), and
the High heat set point is about 42° C (107.6° F).
In addition to operating the heated seat elements, the heated seat module sends LED illumination
messages to the instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN)
via the LIN data bus. The CCN then sends the LED illumination message to the accessory switch
bank so that the appropriate LEDs are illuminated for any given heating level. Pressing the switch
once will select high-level heating. Pressing the switch a second time will select low-level heating.
Pressing the switch a third time will shut the heating elements off.
If the heated seat module detects a heated seat element OPEN or SHORT circuit, it will record and
store the appropriate Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8968
Seat Heater Control Module: Testing and Inspection
HEATED SEAT MODULE
In order to obtain conclusive testing, the heated seat system and the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus circuit must be checked. Any diagnosis of the heated seat system should begin with, the
use of a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic service information.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector pin-out
information.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the heated seat option utilize a low voltage cut-off feature. This
feature turns off power to the heated seat
system anytime vehicle voltage is below 11.7v or above 15.5v. Be certain to check the vehicle
electrical system for proper voltage anytime the power seat system appears inoperative.
Before any testing of the heated seat system is attempted, the battery should be fully-charged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Seat Module - Removal
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module - Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: The Heated Seat Module mounting tab can be damaged during module removal and
installation. Use care to properly align tab to
prevent binding that could result in tab breakage.
1. Position the driver front seat to the full rearward position. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. 3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the heated seat module (3). 4.
Unsnap the heated seat module retaining tab (2) from the seat pan (1). 5. Remove the heated seat
module (3) from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Seat Module - Removal > Page 8971
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The Heated Seat Module mounting tab can be damaged during module removal and
installation. Use care to properly align tab to
prevent binding that could result in tab breakage.
1. Install the heated seat module (3) into the vehicle. 2. Position the retaining tab (2) with the
mounting hole in the seat pan (1). Firmly apply even pressure to the module (3) until the mounting
tab is
fully seated.
3. Connect the wire harness connector (4) to the heated seat module (3). 4. Connect the battery
negative cable. 5. Check for proper heated seat system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 8976
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 8977
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay > Page 8978
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP-LEFT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 8981
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Right Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP-RIGHT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 8982
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Left Trailer Tow Stop/Turn Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN-LEFT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Trailer Tow Stop Lamp Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5 Way > Page 8983
Trailer Towing Relay: Diagrams Right Trailer Tow Stop/Turn Relay (Except Export) (Trailer Tow) 5
Way
Connector (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
RELAY-TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN-RIGHT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (TRAILER TOW) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Relay - Description
Trailer Towing Relay: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Relay - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with an optional trailer tow preparation package have four trailer tow relays, one
each for the trailer tow stop/turn right and left and one each for the trailer stop lamp right and left.
The trailer tow relays are conventional International Standards Organization (ISO) micro relays.
Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions, current capacities,
terminal patterns, and terminal functions. Each relay is contained within a small, rectangular,
molded plastic housing and is connected to all of the required inputs and outputs through five
integral male spade-type terminals that extend from the relay base plate.
The trailer tow relays are included with the trailer tow preparation wire harness that is shipped
loose in the glove box for customer or dealer installation at the rear of the vehicle. A trailer tow
stop/turn relay is located behind the rear fascia below each outer tail lamp, while a trailer stop lamp
relay is located behind the rear fascia below each outboard end of the rear bumper reinforcement.
Each relay and connector is wrapped within an isolator envelope for sound deadening and
anti-rattle protection. Refer to the appropriate wiring information for specific relay cavity assignment
information.
Any of the trailer tow relays cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
affected unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Trailer Tow Relay - Description > Page 8986
Trailer Towing Relay: Description and Operation Trailer Tow Relay - Operation
OPERATION
The trailer tow relays are electromechanical switches that use a low current input from the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to the tail lamps to control a high current output to the trailer
brake and turn signal lamps. Within each relay are an electromagnetic coil, a movable contact and
two fixed contact points. A resistor is connected in parallel with the coil, and helps to dissipate
voltage spikes and electromagnetic interference that can be generated as the field of the relay coil
collapses.
The movable common supply contact point is held against the fixed normally closed contact point
by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field is produced by the
coil windings. This field draws the movable contact away from the normally closed contact, and
holds it against the normally open contact. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure
returns the movable contact back against the normally closed contact.
The inputs and outputs of the trailer tow relays include:
- Common Supply Terminal (30) - The common feed terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected to their respective left or right trailer tow stop/turn signal pins of the
4-way trailer tow connector at all times. The common feed terminals of both the left and right trailer
tow stop relays is connected to the normally closed (87A) terminal of their respective left or right
trailer tow stop/turn relay at all times.
- Coil Ground Terminal (85) - The coil ground terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop/turn
relays is connected to their respective left or right rear turn signal control circuits from the TIPM at
all times. The coil ground terminals of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays are connected to
the stop lamp control circuit from the TIPM at all times.
- Coil Battery Terminal (86) - The coil battery terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop/turn
relays is connected to a path to ground at all times. The coil battery terminal of both the left and
right trailer tow stop relays is connected to their respective left or right rear turn signal control
circuits from the TIPM at all times.
- Normally Open Terminal (87) - The normally open terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected to the stop lamp control circuit from the TIPM whenever that relay is
energized. The normally open terminal of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays is connected
to a path to ground whenever that relay is energized.
- Normally Closed Terminal (87A) - The normally closed terminal of both the left and right trailer tow
stop/turn relays is connected are connected to the common supply (30) terminal of their respective
left or right trailer tow stop relay whenever the relay is de-energized. The normally closed terminal
of both the left and right trailer tow stop relays is not connected to any circuit in this application.
The trailer tow relays and the hard wired circuits for the relays may be diagnosed using
conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that provide some
features of the trailer tow turn and stop lamp lighting system. The most reliable, efficient, and
accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and communication related to trailer tow turn
and stop lamp lighting operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Tow Relay - Removal
Trailer Towing Relay: Service and Repair Trailer Tow Relay - Removal
REMOVAL
TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN RELAYS
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear fascia from the vehicle.
See: Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia Removal
3. Disengage the left or right trailer tow stop/turn relay and connector from the isolator envelope (3)
secured to the trailer tow wire harness (6) along
the left or right body side aperture (2) just below the outer tail lamp.
4. Pull the relay straight out from the wire harness connector.
TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP RELAYS
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear fascia from the vehicle.
See: Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia Removal
3. Disengage the left or right trailer tow stop lamp relay and connector from the isolator envelope
(4) secured to the trailer tow wire harness (6) on
the underside of the rear bumper reinforcement (1) on the left or right side of the 4-way trailer tow
connector (5).
4. Pull the relay straight out from the wire harness connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Trailer Tow Relay - Removal > Page 8989
Trailer Towing Relay: Service and Repair Trailer Tow Relay - Installation
INSTALLATION
TRAILER TOW STOP/TURN RELAYS
1. Align the terminals of the left or right trailer tow stop/turn relay with the terminal receptacles of
the trailer tow wire harness connector. 2. Firmly and evenly push the relay into the connector until it
is fully seated. 3. Insert the relay and connector into the isolator envelope (3) secured to the wire
harness (6) along the left or right body side aperture (2) just below
the outer tail lamp.
4. Reinstall the rear fascia onto the vehicle. See: Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover /
Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
TRAILER TOW STOP LAMP RELAYS
1. Align the terminals of the left or right trailer tow stop lamp relay with the terminal receptacles of
the trailer tow wire harness connector. 2. Firmly and evenly push the relay into the connector until it
is fully seated. 3. Insert the relay and connector into the isolator envelope (4) secured to the trailer
tow wire harness (6) on the underside of the rear bumper
reinforcement (1) on the left or right side of the 4-way trailer tow connector (5).
4. Reinstall the rear fascia onto the vehicle. See: Bumper/Rear Bumper/Rear Bumper Cover /
Fascia/Service and Repair/Rear Bumper Fascia -
Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Luggage Rack - Removal
Luggage Rack: Service and Repair Luggage Rack - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the luggage rack crossbars. 2. Remove the front and rear covers of the luggage rack
rails. 3. Remove the mounting fasteners. 4. Carefully remove the luggage rack rails from the top of
the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Luggage Rack - Removal > Page 8995
Luggage Rack: Service and Repair Luggage Rack - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Carefully install the luggage rack rails to the top of the vehicle. 2. Install the mounting fasteners.
3. Install the front and rear covers of the luggage rack rails. 4. Install the luggage rack crossbars.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Sunshade - Removal
Sun Shade: Service and Repair Sunroof Sunshade - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the drain trough, See: Sunroof / Moonroof Track/Service and Repair/Sunroof Trough Removal 2. Push up the front center of the sunshade (1) to pop out the front two feet.
3. Rotate the sunshade (2) so that the other feet (1) are removed from the guide track.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Sunshade - Removal > Page 9001
Sun Shade: Service and Repair Sunroof Sunshade - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify the sunshade track is free of obstructions like the trim lace/ring. 2. Start with sunshade (2)
at an angle with one foot (1) in the track. 3. Rotate the sunshade so the other rear foot is in the
track as well as the 2 other feet (3) on the same side as the first foot.
4. To insert the remaining two feet (2) apply force to the middle front of sunshade (3) and guide
them into the track. 5. Check that all the feet are in the right track and verify sunshade operation. 6.
Install the drain trough, See: Sunroof / Moonroof Track/Service and Repair/Sunroof Trough Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Locations > Page 9005
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLINER) 10 WAY
MOTOR-SUNROOF - (HEADLINER) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Motor Teach Procedure
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Testing and Inspection Drive Motor Teach Procedure
DRIVE MOTOR TEACH PROCEDURE
REPLACEMENT DRIVE MOTOR
1. Upon first powering up the sunroof, continuously press the close button on the power sunroof
switch. The sunroof will begin moving in the tilt up
direction.
2. The glass panel will move to the hard stop (just past the full tilt position) and then reverse to the
soft stop (the full tilt position). 3. Once the sunroof has reversed immediately (within 5 seconds of
stopping travel), release the switch and continuously press the close button
again.
4. The sunroof glass will continue to move to the fully closed position. Once fully closed the close
button can be released.
ORIGINAL DRIVE MOTOR
1. Cycle the sunroof to full close position and release close button on the power sunroof switch. 2.
Once the sunroof is in the fully closed position, press and continuously hold the close button again.
3. After a ten second delay the sunroof will begin to move past the normal vent position to the hard
stop position. It will then reverse to the normal
full vent position (also called the soft stop).
4. Once the sunroof has reversed to the vent soft stop, immediately (within 5 seconds of stopping
travel) release the close button and continuously
press it again.
5. After a three second delay the sunroof glass will continue to move to the fully closed position.
Once fully closed the close button can be released.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Motor Teach Procedure > Page 9008
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Testing and Inspection Sunroof Motor With Control Unit
DRIVE MOTOR TEACH PROCEDURE
REPLACEMENT DRIVE MOTOR
1. Press and hold the sunroof switch open until the sunroof glass fully opens, automatically
reverses direction, and stops at a position just forward of
the full open position.
2. Release sunroof switch. 3. Within five seconds of releasing sunroof switch, press and hold the
sunroof switch open again until the sunroof glass closes, goes into vent
position, and then finally stops in the closed position.
4. Release sunroof switch. Sunroof will now operate normally.
ORIGINAL DRIVE MOTOR
1. Press and hold sunroof switch open until the sunroof glass opens and stops. 2. Release sunroof
switch. 3. Press and hold sunroof switch open once again for at least 10 seconds. After 10 seconds
of pressing the switch open, the sunroof glass will
automatically move and stop at a new location.
4. Release sunroof switch. 5. Within five seconds of releasing the sunroof switch, press and hold
the switch open again until the sunroof glass closes, goes into vent position,
and then finally stops in the closed position.
6. Release sunroof switch. The sunroof will now operate normally.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Motor - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Sunroof Motor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove headliner. See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner Removal 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (1). 3. Remove three motor assembly attaching
screws (4) from bottom side of motor assembly (3) and remove motor assembly from the motor
bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Motor - Removal > Page 9011
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Sunroof Motor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If sunroof was open when drive motor was removed, carefully move glass panel into closed
position and remove glass panel. See: Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel/Service and Repair/Sunroof Glass - Removal
2. Set lifter arm timing by manually sliding the mechanisms (1) in the track until timing holes in the
trollies are aligned with the timing holes in the
lifter arm cams (2) and insert pins (3) into the mechanisms to hold mechanisms in closed position.
3. Place motor (3) into position and install screws (4) attaching motor to bracket (2). 4. Tighten the
screws (4) to 3 Nm (26 in. lbs.). 5. If sunroof glass panel was removed previously, remove the
timing pins and install the sunroof glass panel. See: Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service
and Repair/Sunroof Glass - Installation
6. Partially install the headliner and connect the sunroof wiring electrical connectors. See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Headliner/Service and
Repair/Headliner - Installation
7. Temporarily install sunroof switch and perform the sunroof motor teach procedure. See: Testing
and Inspection/Drive Motor Teach Procedure. 8. Test sunroof operation, adjust glass as necessary.
See: Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Adjustments 9. Complete the headliner installation. See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9015
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
SWITCH-SUNROOF - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Sunroof Switch - Description
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Description and Operation Sunroof Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The power sunroof switch (3) is a combination push-button and rocker switch module mounted in
the overhead console assembly (1). The sunroof switch is a direct contact unit that is directly wired
to the sunroof motor/module assembly. The sunroof switch performs the following functions:
- Power sunroof open (back of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof express open (back of switch pushed and released)
- Power sunroof closed (front of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof express closed (front of switch pushed and released)
- Power sunroof vent (switch center button pushed)
The power sunroof switch cannot be repaired. If the individual components are damaged or
inoperative the switch assembly must be replaced, See: Service and Repair/Sunroof Switch Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Sunroof Switch - Description > Page 9018
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Description and Operation Sunroof Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The sunroof is electrically operated from two switches located in the headliner on the
courtesy/reading lamp assembly. The power sunroof switch is hard wired to the sunroof
motor/module assembly. The "VENT" switch is a push button type switch and opens the sunroof to
the vent position only. The other switch "OPEN/CLOSED" is a rocker type switch for opening and
closing the sunroof. Pressing and releasing the open button once, the sunroof will express open
and the wind deflector will raise. If the button is pressed a second time the sunroof will stop in that
position. Pressing and releasing the close button once will express close the sunroof. If the close
button is pressed a second time during the express close operation the sunroof will stop in that
position.
The switch is grounded at one terminal and receives a 5 volt signal from the sunroof motor/module
on the remaining three terminals. The switch pulls down the 5 volt reference voltage from the
module signaling it to perform the desired function.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9019
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
SUNROOF SWITCH
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
1. Remove the overhead console, See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Overhead Console - Removal. 2. Disconnect the power sunroof switch wire harness
connector. 3. With the ignition key in the "RUN" position check for 5 volts on the "OPEN", "CLOSE"
and "VENT" circuits of the sunroof switch harness
connector. If OK, go to 4. If not OK, inspect the wiring harness and connectors between the
motor/module and switch for damage and repair as necessary.
4. With the ignition key in the "OFF" position check for continuity between the ground circuit of the
sunroof switch harness connector and a known
good ground. Continuity should be present. If OK, go to 5. If not OK, inspect the wiring harness and
connector and repair the ground circuit as necessary.
5. Using an ohmmeter, test the continuity of the power sunroof switch in each switch position. Refer
to the POWER SUNROOF SWITCH
CONTINUITY TABLE. If OK, inspect the wiring harness and connectors for damage and repair as
necessary. If not OK, replace the overhead console assembly, See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Removal.
POWER SUNROOF SWITCH CONTINUITY TABLE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Switch - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair Sunroof Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove overhead console, See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Removal. 3. Using a suitable flat
bladed tool, release the mounting tabs from the sides of the sunroof control switch and pull the
switch out of the overhead
console assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Switch - Removal > Page 9022
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair Sunroof Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the sunroof control switch into the overhead console assembly. Push the switch until it is
securely held in place by the mounting tabs. 2. Install the overhead console, See: Interior Moulding
/ Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Installation. 3. Connect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Trough - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair Sunroof Trough - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the glass See: Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and Repair/Sunroof Glass - Removal.
2. Separate the trough pins (3) from the glass lift mechanisms (1).
3. Slide trough (1) to one side and push down on the center of the trough until the guide shoe tab
(3) releases from the track (2). 4. Slide the trough in the opposite direction to release the other
shoe and lift the trough out of the sunroof opening.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Trough - Removal > Page 9027
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair Sunroof Trough - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert one of the trough guides (3) and guide shoe (2) into the track. 2. Push down on the center
of the trough (1) to flatten it out and install the remaining trough guide (3) and guide shoe (2) into
the track.
3. Install the trough guide pins into the glass lift mechanism (3) and seat fully. 4. Install the glass
See: Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and Repair/Sunroof Glass - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wind Deflector - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Service and Repair Wind Deflector - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the sunroof glass to the full open position. 2. Press the spring lock (1) with a small flat
bladed tool and push the wind deflector (2) reward to release from the car top opening. 3. Repeat
the previous step on the opposite side.
4. Rotate the wind deflector (1) up and release from the mounting hole (2) in the sunroof frame.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wind Deflector - Removal > Page 9032
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Service and Repair Wind Deflector - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the wind deflector springs (1) into the mounting holes (2) in the sunroof frame. 2. Rotate
forward and down into position.
3. Slide the wind deflector and spring (1) forward under the car top lip and make sure the spring
lock snaps into place (2) fully.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Drain > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Drain Tube - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Drain: Service and Repair Sunroof Drain Tube - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Drop down the headliner as necessary to gain access to the drain hoses See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Headliner/Service and Repair/Headliner Removal.
2. Disconnect the front hoses (2) from the sunroof assembly (1). 3. Release the support clips (3)
and disconnect the lower grommet and remove the hose.
4. Disconnect the rear hoses (2) from the sunroof assembly (1) and release the support clips (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Drain > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Drain Tube - Removal > Page 9037
5. Separate the remaining support clips (1). 6. Disconnect the grommet (2) from the body (3) and
remove the rear hoses as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Drain > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Drain Tube - Removal > Page 9038
Sunroof / Moonroof Drain: Service and Repair Sunroof Drain Tube - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear hoses (4) and connect the grommets (2) to the body (3). 2. Connect the support
clips (1).
3. Route the hose as required and connect the remaining support clips (3). 4. Connect the hoses
(2) to the sunroof assembly (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Drain > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Drain Tube - Removal > Page 9039
5. Connect the front hose lower grommet to the body. 6. Connect the front hose (2) to the sunroof
assembly (1) and connect the support clips (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Adjustments
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Adjustments
GLASS PANEL
1. Move the sunshade rearward to the open position. 2. Move the sunroof glass panel to the fully
closed position. 3. Adjust the glass one corner at a time.
a. Loosen four glass screws (1). b. Lift glass assembly and align the top of the glass panel to the
top of the roof panel. c. Tighten screw to 3 Nm (26 in. lbs.). d. Repeat steps a. and b. for each
corner of the glass panel. e. When properly adjusted, the front of the glass panel is 1.0 mm (0.04
in.) to 2.0 mm (0.08 in.) lower than the roof surface and the rear edge of
the glass panel is 1.0 mm (0.04 in.) to 2.0 mm (0.08 in.) higher than the roof surface.
NOTE: When properly adjusted, the front of the glass panel (3) is 1.0 mm (0.04 in.) to 2.0 mm (0.08
in.) lower than the roof surface (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 9043
NOTE: When properly adjusted, the rear edge of the glass panel (3) is 1.0 mm (0.04 in.) to 2.0 mm
(0.08 in.) higher than the roof surface (2).
4. Verify sunroof operation and alignment. Check fit and re-adjust as necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Glass - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Sunroof Glass - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Slide sunshade rearward to the open position. 2. Move the glass panel to the closed position. 3.
Remove the four glass panel screws (1). 4. Lift off glass panel and remove from vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Glass - Removal > Page 9046
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Sunroof Glass - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position glass panel (2) on to mechanism lift arm. 2. Start the four attaching screws (1). 3.
Center glass in opening by running a business card around the glass. 4. Adjust glass panel See:
Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Glass Seal - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Sunroof Glass Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove sunroof glass panel See: Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and Repair/Sunroof Glass Removal. 2. Place glass panel on clean work area with the top side up. Support the glass assembly
from underside to avoid bending or otherwise damaging the
mounting tabs.
3. Grasp the seal (1) and pull seal away from the glass panel (2). The seal is a one piece seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Glass Seal - Removal > Page 9051
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Sunroof Glass Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Always position seal seam on center of the passenger side of glass panel.
1. Place seal (1) into position. 2. Seat the seal into the glass channel fully. Using care working the
seal around the glass (2), being careful not to over stretch the seal while
installing.
3. Install the glass panel See: Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and Repair/Sunroof Glass Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Service and Repair > Child
Seat - Removal
Child Seat: Service and Repair Child Seat - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the appropriate seat cushion and place on a bench. See: Seat Cover/Service and
Repair/Seat Cushion Cover - Removal. 2. Unzip the seat cover. 3. Partially remove the seat
cushion cover to gain access to the booster seat fasteners. 4. Remove the booster seat mounting
fasteners. 5. Unlatch the booster seat and carefully place in the upright position. 6. Disengage the
booster seat cover trim clips. 7. Remove the booster seat from the seat cushion. 8. If required,
disengage the seat cover clips and carefully pull the booster seat cover off the foam.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Service and Repair > Child
Seat - Removal > Page 9057
Child Seat: Service and Repair Child Seat - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If required, carefully pull the booster seat cover over the foam and engage the booster seat
cover clips. 2. Install the booster seat to the seat cushion. 3. Engage the booster seat cover trim
clips. 4. Latch the booster seat. 5. Install the booster seat mounting fasteners. Tighten to 13 N-m
(10 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the seat cushion cover. 7. Zip the seat cover. 8. Install the seat cushion. See:
Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Cover - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Head Rest > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Headrest Sleeve - Removal
Head Rest: Service and Repair Headrest Sleeve - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for a detailed exploded view of the seats.
1. Remove the headrest. 2. If equipped, remove the back panel (14) or unzip the seat back cover.
3. Remove the J-clip from the bottom rear of the seat back. 4. Squeeze the detents at the bottom of
the headrest guides then lightly tap the headrest guides (12) until the retaining clips disengage
from the seat
frame.
5. Remove the headrest guides from the seat back.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Head Rest > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Headrest Sleeve - Removal > Page 9062
Head Rest: Service and Repair Headrest Sleeve - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for a detailed exploded view of the seats.
1. Install the headrest guides to the seat back. 2. Lightly tap the headrest guides (12) until the
retaining clips engage the seat frame. 3. Zip the seat back cover. 4. Install the J-clip to the bottom
rear of the seat back. 5. Install the back panel (14), if equipped. 6. Install the headrest.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Seat Horizontal Adjuster Motor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Seat Horizontal Adjuster Motor > Page 9067
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Seat Horizontal Adjuster Motor > Page 9068
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Seat Horizontal Adjuster Motor (Seat) 4 Way
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams Driver Seat Horizontal Adjuster Motor (Seat) 4 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 4 WAY
MOTOR-SEAT ADJUSTER-DRIVER HORIZONTAL - (SEAT) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Seat Horizontal Adjuster Motor (Seat) 4 Way > Page 9071
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams Driver Seat Front Vertical Adjuster Motor (Seat) 4 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 4 WAY
MOTOR-SEAT ADJUSTER-FRONT DRIVER VERTICAL - (SEAT) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Seat Horizontal Adjuster Motor (Seat) 4 Way > Page 9072
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams Driver Seat Rear Vertical Adjuster Motor (Seat) 4 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 4 WAY
MOTOR-SEAT ADJUSTER-REAR DRIVER VERTICAL - (SEAT) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Power Seat Motor - Removal
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Power Seat Motor - Removal
Fore Aft Motor
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any component diagnosis or service of
the front seats, when equipped with front seat
air bags. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the inoperative front seat
assembly, See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 3. Remove the flex drive cable
cover (2).
a. Using a small flat bladed tool, release the mounting strap (1) that secures the flex drive cable
cover (2) to the fore/aft motor (5). b. Pivot the cover away from the cable and pull it away from the
seat frame (4) to disengage the cover slot from the mounting tab (3).
4. Remove the flex drive cable.
a. Carefully bend the flex drive cable at the center and pull the motor end (3) away from the fore/aft
motor (1) to disengage. b. Pull the cable out of the screw drive assembly (2) and remove from seat
track.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Power Seat Motor - Removal > Page 9075
5. Disconnect the fore aft motor electrical connector. 6. Remove the fore/aft motor to mounting
bracket retaining screws (1). 7. Remove the fore/aft motor (3). 8. Remove the short flex drive cable
(2) from the seat frame assembly (4).
Height Adjust Motor
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any component diagnosis or service of
the front seats, when equipped with front seat
air bags. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. WARNING: Use caution when removing the height adjust motor and gearbox assembly (2) if the
motor is inoperative, and the power seat
is not in the full up position. The seat adjuster assembly is under load from the height adjust assist
spring and may cause the motor to rotate under pressure when the fasteners are removed. The
seat adjuster assembly also may spring upward when the motor is removed. If the height adjust
motor is operative, move the power seat to the full up position prior to disconnecting the battery.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the inoperative front seat assembly, See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat Removal. 3. Disconnect the height adjust motor electrical connector. 4. Remove the height adjust
motor gearbox spindle (1) retaining screw (4). 5. Remove the motor retaining screws (3). 6.
Remove the height adjust motor and gearbox assembly (2) from the seat track.
Tilt Motor
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Power Seat Motor - Removal > Page 9076
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any component diagnosis or service of
the front seats, when equipped with front seat
air bags. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the inoperative front seat
assembly, See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 3. Disconnect the front tilt motor
electrical connector. 4. Remove the front tilt motor gearbox spindle (3) retaining screw (2). 5.
Remove the motor retaining screws (4). 6. Remove the front tilt motor and gearbox assembly (1)
from the seat track.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Power Seat Motor - Removal > Page 9077
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Power Seat Motor - Installation
Fore Aft Motor
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any component diagnosis or service of
the front seats, when equipped with front seat
air bags. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
CAUTION: Seat track side to side timing may be off if the fore aft motor was completely inoperative
prior to removal. In the event the track
timing is in question, proceed to 1 for track timing procedure. If track timing is not in question
proceed to 2.
1. Using the square drive end of the old flex drive cable and a variable speed drill motor, drive the
seat track screw drive assemblies reward until they
reach the rear stops. a. Clamp one end of the old cable into the drill motor chuck. b. Put the other
cable end into the seat track screw drive cable slot and slowly drive the seat track assembly reward
until it reaches the rear stops.
Take care not to bind the cable when the drive reaches the stop.
c. Repeat this procedure for the other seat track.
2. Install the short flex drive cable (2) into the seat frame assembly (4). Ensure the square cable
end is properly aligned and fully inserted into the
square drive slot of the screw drive assembly.
3. Install the fore/aft motor (3) ensuring the square cable end is properly aligned and fully inserted
into the square drive slot of the motor. 4. Install the motor retaining screws (1). Tighten the screws
to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
5. Install the flex drive cable.
a. Install the flex drive cable into the seat frame assembly (2). Ensure the square cable end is
properly aligned and fully inserted into the square
drive slot of the screw drive assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Power Seat Motor - Removal > Page 9078
b. Install the flex drive cable into the fore/aft motor (1). Ensure the square cable end is properly
aligned and fully inserted into the square drive
slot of the motor assembly (3).
6. Position the flex drive cable cover (2) onto the seat track assembly (4). Ensure the cover slots
are properly aligned and fully inserted onto the
mounting tabs (3).
7. Pivot the cable cover towards the cable and onto the fore/aft motor (5). 8. Secure the cover to
the motor with the retaining strap (1). 9. Connect the fore/aft motor electrical connector.
10. Install the power seat, See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation. 11. Verify
proper power seat operation.
Height Adjust Motor
INSTALLATION
1. Screw the height adjust motor gearbox spindle (1) in or out as necessary until the motor
retaining screws (3) and spindle screw (4) holes are
aligned and all fasteners can be installed.
2. Position the height adjust motor and gearbox assembly (2) onto the seat track. 3. Install the
motor retaining screws (3). Tighten the screws to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.). 4. Install the height adjust
motor gearbox spindle (1) retaining screw (4). Tighten the screw to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.). 5. Connect
the motor electrical connector. 6. Install the power seat, See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat
- Installation. 7. Verify proper power seat operation.
Tilt Motor
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Power Seat Motor - Removal > Page 9079
1. Screw the front tilt motor gearbox spindle (3) in or out as necessary until the motor retaining
screws (4) and spindle screw (2) holes are aligned
and all fasteners can be installed.
2. Position the front tilt motor and gearbox assembly (1) onto the seat track. 3. Install the motor
retaining screws (4). Tighten the screws to 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.). 4. Install the front tilt motor
gearbox spindle (3) retaining screw (2). Tighten the screw to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.). 5. Connect the
motor electrical connector. 6. Install the power seat, See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat Installation. 7. Verify proper power seat operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9083
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (SEAT) 11 WAY
SWITCH-SEAT-DRIVER - (SEAT) 11 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Seat Switch - Description
Power Seat Switch: Description and Operation Power Seat Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The driver power seat can be adjusted in six different ways using the power seat switch. The power
seat switch (2) is located on the lower outboard side of the seat cushion (1) on the seat cushion
side shield (3). The power seat system incorporates a seat switch with a seat cushion control
paddle.
The individual components in the power seat switch assembly cannot be repaired. If the switch is
damaged or inoperative, the entire power seat switch must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Seat Switch - Description > Page 9086
Power Seat Switch: Description and Operation Power Seat Switch - Operation
OPERATION
When a power seat switch is actuated, a battery feed and a ground path are applied through the
switch contacts to the power seat track adjuster motor. The selected adjuster motor operates to
move the seat through its drive unit in the selected direction until the switch is released, or until the
travel limit of the adjuster is reached. When the switch is moved in the opposite direction, the
battery feed and ground path to the motor are reversed through the switch contacts. This causes
the adjuster motor to run in the opposite direction.
No power seat switch should be held applied in any direction after the adjuster has reached its
travel limit. The power seat adjuster motors each contain a self-resetting circuit breaker to protect
them from overload. However, consecutive or frequent resetting of the circuit breaker may result in
motor damage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 9087
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
POWER SEAT SWITCH
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the power seat switch from the
power seat See: Service and Repair/Power Seat Switch - Removal. 3. Use an ohmmeter to test the
continuity of the power seat switch. Refer to POWER SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY table. If not
OK, replace the
faulty power seat switch. If switch tests OK See: Testing and Inspection.
POWER SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Power Seat Switch - Removal
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Power Seat Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the outboard seat cushion side
shield (3). 3. Disconnect the power seat switch electrical harness connector (4). 4. Using a small
flat bladed tool, gently release the four mounting tabs (1) that secure the power seat switch (2) and
separate switch from side shield
(3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Power Seat Switch - Removal > Page 9090
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Power Seat Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the power seat switch (2) onto the seat cushion side shield (3). Gently apply pressure to
the switch until the four mounting tabs (1) are
fully seated into place.
2. Connect the power seat switch electrical connector (4). 3. Install the seat cushion outboard side
shield. 4. Connect the battery negative cable. 5. Verify normal operation of the power seat
assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal
Seat Back: Service and Repair Seat Back - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for detailed exploded views.
NOTE: All call outs are in reference to the Driver Power exploded view unless otherwise noted.
1. Remove the seat from the vehicle. See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 2.
Remove the lift handle cover (24 - Driver Manual) and mounting fasteners (26 - Driver Manual), if
equipped. 3. Remove the lift handle (23 - Driver Manual), if equipped. 4. Carefully pry the side
shield away from the recliner handle (26) and remove the retaining clip. 5. Remove the recliner
handle. 6. Remove the rear fastener (31) from the outboard shield (25). 7. Starting at the rear of the
outboard shield, carefully pry the side shield until the retainers disengage and slide the shield
forward to remove. 8. Remove the seat buckle bolt and buckle (40). 9. Remove the rear fastener
(31) from the inboard shield (42).
10. Starting at the rear of the inboard shield, carefully pry the side shield until the retainers
disengage and slide the shield forward to remove. 11. Remove the airbag wiring harness (24) from
the seat bottom, ensure the harness is completely removed from the bracket (26) and through
recliner
mechanism.
12. Remove the outboard and inboard seat back bolts (30). 13. Remove the seat back from the
seat cushion assembly.
Second Row
REMOVAL
1. Remove the recliner handle cover and mounting fasteners. 2. Remove the recliner handle 3.
Remove the folding seat handle cover, mounting fasteners and handle, if equipped. 4. Remove the
outboard shield. 5. Remove the headrest and headrest guides. 6. Fold the seat flat and remove the
seat back panel by carefully prying up on the panel until the retainers disengage. 7. For the 60 split
seat only, remove the seat belt anchor mounting fastener. 8. Remove the seat cover clips and pull
back to expose the inboard seat back mounting fasteners.
NOTE: On the 40 split seat, the inboard mounting fasteners are located on the outside of the seat
back frame. On the 60 split seat, they are
located on the inside of the seat back frame which will require the seat back cushion/cover to be
removed. See: .
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal > Page 9095
9. Remove the inboard seat back mounting fasteners.
10. Remove the outboard seat back mounting fasteners. 11. Remove the cable attachment from
the back steel panel. 12. Remove the seat back from the vehicle.
Third Row
REMOVAL
1. Remove the seat cover and cushion See: Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Cover Removal. 2. Remove the retainers on the seat back gap hider from the rear storage box. 3.
Remove the front seat back mounting fasteners (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal > Page 9096
4. Remove the rear seat back mounting fasteners (1 and 2). 5. Remove the seat back from the
vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal > Page 9097
Seat Back: Service and Repair Seat Back - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for detailed exploded views.
NOTE: All call outs are in reference to the Driver Power exploded view unless otherwise noted.
1. Install the seat back to the seat cushion assembly. 2. Install the outboard and inboard seat back
bolts (30) and torque to 40 N-m (29 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the airbag wiring harness (24) to the seat
bottom. 4. Install the inboard shield. 5. Install the rear fastener (31) to the inboard shield (42). 6.
Install the seat buckle bolt and buckle (40). Tighten to 45 N-m (33 ft. lbs.). 7. Install the outboard
shield. 8. Install the rear fastener (31) to the outboard shield (25). 9. Install the recliner handle (26)
retaining clip.
10. Install the recliner handle. 11. Install the lift handle (23 - Driver Manual), if equipped. 12. Install
the mounting fasteners (26 - Driver Manual) and lift handle cover (24 - Driver Manual), if equipped.
13. Install the seat to the vehicle. See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal.
Second Row
INSTALLATION
1. Position the seat back frame to the seat adjuster assembly. 2. For the 40% seat back, install the
inboard mounting fasteners. Tighten to 55 N-m (40 ft. lbs.). 3. For the 40% seat back, install the
outboard mounting fasteners. Tighten to 30 N-m (22 ft. lbs.). 4. For the 60% seat back, install the
inboard mounting fasteners. Tighten to 60 N-m (44 ft. lbs.). 5. For the 60% seat back, install the
outboard mounting fasteners. Tighten to 30 N-m (22 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the seat back cushion/cover,
if required. See: . 7. For the 60% seat back, place the seat belt and seat buckle into position.
Tighten the mounting fastener to 49 N-m (36 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the cable attachment to the back
steel panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal > Page 9098
9. Install the outboard shield.
10. Install the recliner handle 11. Install the recliner handle mounting fasteners and cover. 12.
Install the folding seat handle, mounting fasteners and cover, if equipped. 13. Install the headrest
guides and headrest.
Third Row
INSTALLATION
1. Place the seat back into position in the vehicle. Make sure that the seat belts are position
correctly. 2. Install the rear mounting fasteners (1 and 2). Tighten to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal > Page 9099
3. Install the front mounting fasteners (1). Tighten to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.). 4. Install the retainers on
the seat back gap hider to the rear storage box. 5. Install the seat cushion and cover See: Seat
Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Cover - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal > Page 9100
Seat Back: Service and Repair Seat Back Panel - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
FOLD FLAT SEAT
1. Carefully disengage the clip retainers (2) by pulling up on the bottom and sides of the back
panel. 2. Slide the back panel up to disengage the side retainers (3). 3. While lifting the bottom of
the panel, slide the panel down and remove from the seat back disengaging the upper retainers
(1).
NON-FOLD FLAT SEAT
1. Carefully pull the bottom and sides of the panel upwards to disenge the lower clip retainers (2).
2. While lifting the bottom of the back panel, disengage the upper retainers (1) and remove the
panel from the seat back.
Second Row
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal > Page 9101
1. Note the locations (1) of the retainers on the seat back panels (3) and armrest (2).
CAUTION: Use care when removing the pushpins on the back panel from the seat back. Failure to
do so will result in damage to the back
panel.
2. Using a clip removal tool or equivalent, carefully disengage the retainers (2) that secure the seat
back panel (1). 3. Remove the back panel from the seat.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal > Page 9102
Seat Back: Service and Repair Seat Back Panel - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
FOLD FLAT SEAT
1. While lifting the bottom of the panel up, engage the upper retainers (1) to the seat back. 2.
Engage the side retainers (3) to the seat and slide the back panel down into position. 3. Firmly seat
the clip retainers (2) securing the back panel to the seat back.
NON-FOLD FLAT SEAT
1. While lifting the bottom of the back panel, engage the upper retainers (1) to the seat back. 2.
Firmly seat the lower clip retainers (2) securing the back panel to the seat back.
Second Row
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back - Removal > Page 9103
1. Place the back panel (1) into position on the seat. 2. Engage the retainers (2) that secure the
back panel to the seat.
3. Press firmly on the retainer locations (1), as shown above, to ensure proper engagement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Bottom > Seat Bottom Frame > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Bottom Frame: > 23-008-10 > Jun > 10 > Interior - Corrosion On
2nd Row Seat Frames
Seat Bottom Frame: Customer Interest Interior - Corrosion On 2nd Row Seat Frames
NUMBER: 23-008-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: June 15, 2010
SUBJECT: Second Row Seat Revised Bracket Covers
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves the installation of 5 revised lower seat bracket covers and
surface corrosion removal.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built before February 02, 2010 (MDH0202XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may notice light surface corrosion of the seat frame.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator experiences the symptom/condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
One 32oz bottle of IES Rust Raider will service 50 vehicles.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Bottom > Seat Bottom Frame > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Bottom Frame: > 23-008-10 > Jun > 10 > Interior - Corrosion On
2nd Row Seat Frames > Page 9113
1. Fold the second row seat backs to the closed position and inspect the exposed seat frame
locations (Fig. 1).
2. Inspect for light seat frame corrosion around the lower bracket. Was corrosion found (Fig. 2)?
a. Yes>>> Neutralize all corrosion with IES Rust Raider 1840 or equivalent using an acid brush
apply the material following manufacturers
specifications and proceed to Step # 3.
b. No>>> Proceed to Step # 3.
NOTE:
In (Fig. 2) the seat frame plastic trim has been removed for demonstration Purposes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Bottom > Seat Bottom Frame > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Bottom Frame: > 23-008-10 > Jun > 10 > Interior - Corrosion On
2nd Row Seat Frames > Page 9114
3. Install lower bracket cover (Fig. 3).
4. Fold seat back to the upright position.
5. Return the vehicle to the customer.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Bottom > Seat Bottom Frame > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Bottom Frame: > 23-008-10 > Jun > 10 > Interior Corrosion On 2nd Row Seat Frames
Seat Bottom Frame: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Corrosion On 2nd Row Seat Frames
NUMBER: 23-008-10
GROUP: Body
DATE: June 15, 2010
SUBJECT: Second Row Seat Revised Bracket Covers
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves the installation of 5 revised lower seat bracket covers and
surface corrosion removal.
MODELS:
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built before February 02, 2010 (MDH0202XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may notice light surface corrosion of the seat frame.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator experiences the symptom/condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
One 32oz bottle of IES Rust Raider will service 50 vehicles.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Bottom > Seat Bottom Frame > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Bottom Frame: > 23-008-10 > Jun > 10 > Interior Corrosion On 2nd Row Seat Frames > Page 9120
1. Fold the second row seat backs to the closed position and inspect the exposed seat frame
locations (Fig. 1).
2. Inspect for light seat frame corrosion around the lower bracket. Was corrosion found (Fig. 2)?
a. Yes>>> Neutralize all corrosion with IES Rust Raider 1840 or equivalent using an acid brush
apply the material following manufacturers
specifications and proceed to Step # 3.
b. No>>> Proceed to Step # 3.
NOTE:
In (Fig. 2) the seat frame plastic trim has been removed for demonstration Purposes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Bottom > Seat Bottom Frame > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Bottom Frame: > 23-008-10 > Jun > 10 > Interior Corrosion On 2nd Row Seat Frames > Page 9121
3. Install lower bracket cover (Fig. 3).
4. Fold seat back to the upright position.
5. Return the vehicle to the customer.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back Cover - Removal
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Back Cover - Removal
Second Row
REMOVAL
1. Remove the folding seat handle cover, mounting fasteners and handle from the seat back. 2.
Remove the seat belt trim, if required. 3. Remove the headrest and headrest guides. 4. Fold the
seat back down flat. 5. For the 60 split seat only, remove the seat belt anchor bolt. 6. Remove the
back panel from the seat back. See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Panel - Removal. 7.
Release the seat cover clips from the seat back. 8. Carefully pull the seat cover and foam away
from the seat back frame. 9. If required, feed the seat belt through the seat cover.
10. Carefully pull the cover off of the foam, cutting any hog rings and discarding.
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for a detailed exploded view of the seats.
NOTE: All call outs are in reference to the Driver Power exploded view unless otherwise noted.
1. Remove the seat from the vehicle. See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 2.
Remove the seat back. See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back - Removal/Front. 3. Remove
the lumbar handle cover (23). 4. Remove the retaining fastener (22) and remove the handle (21). 5.
Remove the back panel from the seat back. See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Panel Removal. 6. Remove the J-clips and pushpins on the seat back cover from the frame. 7. Remove
the side airbag (SAB) mounting nuts. 8. Disconnect the SAB wiring connector. 9. Remove the SAB
from the seat cover.
10. Remove the inner inboard shield (41). 11. Remove the inner outboard shield (28). 12. Remove
the headrest guides (12). See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Headrest Sleeve - Removal. 13.
Starting from the bottom rear of the seat back, carefully pull seat cover off seat cushion to expose
hog rings. 14. Cut hog rings and discard. 15. Remove the cover from the seat back assembly. 16.
Remove the seat cushion foam, if required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back Cover - Removal > Page 9126
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Back Cover - Installation
Second Row
INSTALLATION
1. Carefully install the cover to the foam, installing any hog rings. 2. If required, feed the seat belt
through the seat cover. 3. Position the seat cover and foam to the seat back frame. 4. Install the
seat cover clips to the seat back. 5. Install the seat back panel. See: Seat Back/Service and
Repair/Seat Back Panel - Installation. 6. For the 60 split seat only, install the seat belt anchor bolt.
Tighten to 49 N-m (36 ft. lbs.). 7. Fold the seat back up. 8. Install the headrest guides and
headrest. 9. Install the seat belt trim, if required.
10. Install the folding seat handle, mounting fasteners and cover to the seat back.
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for a detailed exploded view of the seats.
NOTE: Do not reuse the recliner assembly attaching bolts.
1. Position cover on the top of seat back. 2. Carefully roll cover down to the area that hog rings are
to be installed. 3. Install the side airbag (SAB) to the seat back cover. 4. Connect the SAB wiring
connector. 5. Install the SAB mounting fasteners. 6. Engage the J-clip retainers to the back frame
assembly. 7. Install hog rings. 8. Roll cover downward. 9. Engage the J-clip retainer to the seat
frame.
10. Install lumbar handle, if equipped. 11. Install the seat back panel. See: Seat Back/Service and
Repair/Seat Back Panel - Installation 12. Install headrest guides. See: Head Rest/Service and
Repair/Headrest Sleeve - Installation. 13. Install seat back to seat cushion. See: Seat Back/Service
and Repair/Seat Back - Installation/Front. 14. Install the seat to the vehicle. See: Service and
Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation. 15. Check seat back and headrest operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back Cover - Removal > Page 9127
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Cover - Removal
Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for a detailed exploded view of the seats.
1. Remove seat from vehicle.See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal 2. Remove the
wiring harness from the seat pan.
3. Remove four seat pan fasteners (1). 4. Remove the seat pan from the adjuster assembly. 5.
Remove the J-clips securing the seat cover to the seat pan, if required.
6. Starting at the rear of the seat cushion, carefully pull seat cover (3) down towards the front. 7.
Cut and discard hog rings. 8. Remove the seat cover from the foam.
Third Row
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back Cover - Removal > Page 9128
1. Remove the rear storage box. See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Utility Storage Compartment/Service
and Repair/Rear Storage Box - Removal. 2. Lift front edge of the third row seat until retainers (5)
disengage. 3. With the help of an assistant, carefully pry up on the hooks (4) while the seat cushion
is being pressed towards the seat back. 4. While lifting up on the hooks, pull the seat cushion out
towards the front of the vehicle and remove the seat cushion. 5. Disengage J-clips from seat
cushion. 6. Carefully remove the seat cover from the cushion, removing any hog rings and
discarding.
Second Row
REMOVAL
NOTE: Only the 40 split seat must be removed to replace the seat cushion.
1. For the 40 split seat only, remove the seat from the vehicle. See: Service and Repair/Seats,
Front/Seat - Removal. 2. Remove the seat recliner handle cover and fastener. 3. Remove the seat
recliner handle. 4. Remove the seat adjuster handle cover and fastener. 5. Remove the seat
adjuster handle. 6. Remove the seat side shields. 7. Remove the outboard seat bolt securing the
seat cushion to the seat frame. 8. For the 40 split seat only, remove the inboard seat cushion
mounting fastener. 9. Pull the release latch and push up on seat cushion to separate from the seat
frame.
10. Remove the cable assembly from the seat cushion. 11. Remove the gas strut from the seat
cushion, if equipped. 12. Remove the cushion from the seat frame. 13. Unzip the cover from the
cushion. 14. Carefully pull the seat cover off of the seat cushion, cutting any hog rings and
discarding them, if required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back Cover - Removal > Page 9129
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Cover - Installation
Front
INSTALLATION
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for a detailed exploded view of the seats.
1. Install the heated seat element (2) to the seat cushion, if required. 2. Slide the seat cover (3)
over the front of the cushion. 3. Install hog rings as the cover is slid over the cushion.
4. Place the seat cushion into position on the seat pan. 5. Install the J-clips securing the seat
cushion to the seat pan. 6. Install the seat pan and cushion to the adjuster assembly. 7. Install the
mounting fasteners and torque to 12.5 N-m (9 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the seat to the vehicle. See:
Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation.
Third Row
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Back Cover - Removal > Page 9130
1. Carefully install the seat cover to the cushion, installing any hog rings required. 2. Engage J-clips
to seat cushion. 3. Place the third row seat cushion (1) into position. 4. Press the seat cushion back
(2) and under the seat back. 5. Ensure the seat retaining hooks (4) slide under the body side
hooks. 6. Firmly depress the front of the seat cushion down, ensuring that the seat retainers (5)
engage. 7. Install the rear storage box. See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Utility Storage
Compartment/Service and Repair/Rear Storage Box - Installation
Second Row
INSTALLATION
1. Carefully pull the seat cover over the seat foam, installing any hog rings, if required. 2. Zip the
cover on to the foam. 3. Install the cushion to the seat frame. 4. Install the gas strut to the seat
cushion, if equipped. 5. Install the cable assembly to the seat cushion. 6. Ensure the seat cushion
is latched into the seat frame. 7. Install the outboard seat bolt securing the seat cushion to the seat
frame. Tighten to 30 N-m (22 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the inboard seat bolt, if required. 9. Install the seat
side shields.
10. Install the seat recliner handle. 11. Install the seat recliner handle fastener and cover. 12. Install
the seat adjuster handle. 13. Install the seat adjuster handle fastener and cover. 14. Install the seat
to the vehicle, if required. See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Side Shields - Removal
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Side Shields - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for detailed exploded views.
NOTE: All call outs are in reference to the Driver Power exploded view unless otherwise noted.
1. Remove the seat from the vehicle. See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 2.
Remove the lift handle cover (24 - Driver Manual) and mounting fasteners (26 - Driver Manual), if
equipped. 3. Remove the lift handle (23 - Driver Manual), if equipped. 4. Remove the recliner
handle retainer and handle (26). 5. Remove the seat belt buckle bolt and buckle (40). 6. Remove
the rear fastener on the outboard shield (25). 7. Remove the rear fastener on the inboard shield
(42). 8. Remove the appropriate side shield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Side Shields - Removal > Page 9135
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Side Shields - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: See: Description and Operation/Seats, Front for detailed exploded views.
NOTE: All call outs are in reference to the Driver Power exploded view unless otherwise noted.
1. Install the side shield. 2. Install the rear fastener on the inboard shield (42). 3. Install the rear
fastener on the outboard shield (25). 4. Install the seat belt buckle bolt and buckle (40). 5. Install
the recliner handle retainer and handle (26). 6. Install the lift handle (23 - Driver Manual), if
equipped. 7. Install the lift handle cover (24 - Driver Manual) and mounting fasteners (26 - Driver
Manual), if equipped. 8. Install the seat to the vehicle. See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Locations > Driver Seat
Back Heater
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Locations > Driver Seat
Back Heater > Page 9140
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Locations > Driver Seat
Back Heater > Page 9141
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Locations > Driver Seat
Back Heater > Page 9142
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat
Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way
Seat Heater: Diagrams Driver Seat Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way
Connector (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT BACK) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT BACK-DRIVER (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT BACK) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat
Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way > Page 9145
Seat Heater: Diagrams Driver Seat Back Heater (Seat Cushion) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT CUSHION) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT BACK-DRIVER - (SEAT CUSHION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat
Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way > Page 9146
Seat Heater: Diagrams Passenger Seat Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way
Connector (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT BACK) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT BACK-PASSENGER (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT BACK) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat
Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way > Page 9147
Seat Heater: Diagrams Passenger Seat Back Heater (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT BACK-PASSENGER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat
Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way > Page 9148
Seat Heater: Diagrams
Driver Seat Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way
Connector (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT BACK) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT BACK-DRIVER (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT BACK) 2 WAY
Driver Seat Back Heater (Seat Cushion) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT CUSHION) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT BACK-DRIVER - (SEAT CUSHION) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat
Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way > Page 9149
Passenger Seat Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way
Connector (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT BACK) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT BACK-PASSENGER (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT BACK) 2 WAY
Passenger Seat Back Heater (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT BACK-PASSENGER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat
Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way > Page 9150
Driver Seat Cushion Heater (Component Side) (Seat Cushion) 2 Way
Connector (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT CUSHION) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT CUSHION-DRIVER (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT CUSHION) 2 WAY
Driver Seat Cushion Heater (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat
Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way > Page 9151
HEATER-SEAT CUSHION-DRIVER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Passenger Seat Cushion Heater (Component Side) (Seat Cushion) 2 Way
Connector (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT CUSHION) 2 WAY
HEATER-SEAT CUSHION-PASSENGER (COMPONENT SIDE) - (SEAT CUSHION) 2 WAY
Passenger Seat Cushion Heater (Seat) 2 Way
Connector - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Seat
Back Heater (Component Side) (Seat Back) 2 Way > Page 9152
HEATER-SEAT CUSHION-PASSENGER - (SEAT) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Heated Seats - Description
Seat Heater: Description and Operation Heated Seats - Description
DESCRIPTION
MODULE-ASBM
Vehicles with the heated seat option can be visually identified by the two heated seat switches (1)
located in the center stack of the instrument panel. The switches are located on the outer edges of
the Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM). The ASBM is located just below the vents and just
above the heater and air conditioner controls in the center stack area of the instrument panel.
The heated seat system allows the driver and front seat passenger to select from two different
levels of electrical seat heating (HI/LO). The heated seat system includes the following major
components:
- Heated Seat Elements - Four heated seat elements are used per vehicle. Two heated seat
elements are integral to each seat, one in the seat back and the other in the seat cushion.
- Heated Seat Module - One heated seat module is used per vehicle. The Heated Seat Module is
mounted under the Driver front seat. This module contains the control logic and software for the
front heated seat system. The module communicates on the Local Interface Network (LIN) data
bus.
- Heated Seat Switches - Two heated seat switches are used per vehicle, one for each heated
seat. Both switches are integral to the ASBM mounted in the instrument panel center stack.
- Instrument Cluster (CCN) - The instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) utilizes integrated software and information carried on the LIN data bus.
The CCN serves as the link between the heated seat switches and the heated seat module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Heated Seats - Description > Page 9155
Seat Heater: Description and Operation Heated Seats - Operation
OPERATION
The heated seat system operates on battery current received through a fuse in the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM). Fused ignition switch output (Run) circuits are used, so that the
heated seat system will only operate when the ignition switch is in the ON position. The heated
seat system will turn Off automatically whenever the ignition switch is turned to any position except
ON.
A Heated Seat Module (2) is used to control the heated seat system. The module is located under
the driver front seat mounted to the seat pan (4). The heated seat module responds to heated seat
switch messages and ignition switch status inputs by controlling the 12v output to the front seat
heating elements through integral solid-state relays.
When either of the heated seat switches (1) are depressed a switch status message is sent to the
instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN), via the Local
Interface Network (LIN) data bus. The CCN then sends a message via the LIN data bus to the
heated seat module, signaling the module to energize the heating element for the selected seat.
Amber Light Emitting Diodes (LEDs) in the top portion of each switch indicate the level of heat in
use: Two LEDs are illuminated for high, one for low, and none for off. The heated seat module
sends the LED illumination message to the CNN via the LIN data bus. The CNN then sends the
LED illumination message to the accessory switch bank so that the appropriate LEDs are
illuminated for any given heating level. Pressing the switch once will select high-level heating.
Pressing the switch a second time will select low-level heating. Pressing the switch a third time will
shut the heating elements off.
The heated seat module energizes an integral solid-state relay, which supplies battery current to
the heating elements. When high-temperature heating is selected, the heaters provide a boosted
heat level during the first four minutes of operation after heating is activated. The heat output then
drops to the normal high-temperature level. If high-level heating is selected, the control system will
automatically switch to the low level after 26 minutes of continuous operation. At that time, the
number of illuminated LEDs changes from two to one, indicating the change. Operation on the low
setting also turns off automatically after 30 minutes.
The module will automatically turn off the heating elements if it detects an OPEN or LOW short in
the heating element circuit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Heated Seats - Description > Page 9156
Seat Heater: Description and Operation Heater Pad - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with the optional heated seat system have two carbon fiber heated seat
elements located in each front seat. One heating element is used for each seat cushion and
another for each seat back.
Each of the heated seat elements consist of multiple heating circuits operating in parallel
throughout the carbon fiber element. The heated seat elements are captured between the leather
trim cover and the seat cushion assembly. If a malfunction occurs in one or more of the individual
carbon fiber circuits, the others will continue to provide heat.
The heated seat elements cannot be repaired. If found to be damaged or inoperative, a new
heating element assembly must be installed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Heated Seats - Description > Page 9157
Seat Heater: Description and Operation Heater Pad - Operation
OPERATION
One end of the heated seat element is connected to ground at all times through a splice under the
seat. Battery current is directed to the other end of the heated seat element by the heated seat
module. The heated seat module will energize the heated seat element when the heated seat
switch is depressed in the LOW or HIGH position.
As electrical current passes through the heated seat element, the resistance of the wire used in the
element disperses some of the electrical current in the form of heat. The heat produced by the
heated seat element then radiates through the underside of the seat cushion and seat back trim
covers, warming the seat cover and its occupant.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Heated Seat System
Seat Heater: Testing and Inspection Heated Seat System
HEATED SEAT SYSTEM
In order to obtain conclusive testing, the heated seat system and the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus circuit must be checked. Any diagnosis of the heated seat system should begin with, the
use of a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic service information.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector pin-out
information.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the heated seat option utilize a low voltage cut-off feature. This
feature turns off power to the heated seat
system anytime vehicle voltage is below 11.7v or above 15.5v. Be certain to check the vehicle
electrical system for proper voltage anytime the power seat system appears inoperative.
Before any testing of the heated seat system is attempted, the battery should be fully-charged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Heated Seat System > Page 9160
Seat Heater: Testing and Inspection Heater Pad
HEATED SEAT ELEMENT
Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector pin-out
information.
The wire harness connectors for the heating elements are located under the seat.
NOTE: When checking heated seat elements for continuity, be certain to move the heating element
being checked. Moving the element, such
as sitting in the seat will eliminate the possibility of an intermittent open in the element which would
only be evident if the element was in a certain position. Failure to check the element in various
positions could result in an incomplete test.
1. Locate and disconnect the seat element electrical connector. 2. Check the resistance between
the circuit leading in and out of the suspect heated seat element. The resistance should be
between 3.0 - 5.5 ohms for
a seat cushion element and 4.0 - 6.0 ohms for a seat back element. If OK, See: Heated Seat
System. If not OK, replace the inoperative heated seat element.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Pad - Removal
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Heater Pad - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The factory installed heating element can be removed from foam cushion by carefully
peeling the element off along the adhesive lines.
NOTE: Heated seat cushion shown, heated seat back similar.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the appropriate seat cushion trim
cover, See: Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Cover - Removal or seat back trim cover,
See:
Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Back Cover - Removal.
3. Disconnect the inoperative heated seat cushion or seat back element electrical connectors (2).
4. Peel the heater element off the foam pad, being careful not to remove excessive foam in the
process.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Pad - Removal > Page 9163
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Heater Pad - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: During the installation of the replacement heating element, be careful not to fold or
crease the element assembly. Folds or creases
will cause premature failure.
NOTE: Heated seat cushion shown, heated seat back similar.
1. Peel off the adhesive backing on the back of the replacement heating element (2) and stick on
foam pad directly where the original element was
placed (there will be adhesive marks on the foam outlining factory installed element)(1).
2. Connect the new heating element electrical connectors (3 AND 4). 3. Connect the battery
negative cable. 4. Verify heated seat system operation. 5. Install the appropriate seat cushion trim
cover, See: Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Cover - Installation or seat back trim
cover, See:
Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Back Cover - Installation.
NOTE: Make certain the seat wire harness is correctly routed through the seat and seat back. The
excess wire between the cushion and back
elements should be securely tucked between the rear of the cushion foam and the rear carpet flap
of the trim cover. The factory installed heater element should be completely removed from the
system and discarded.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9167
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams
Connector - (SEAT) 10 WAY
MODULE-HEATED SEATS - (SEAT) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Heated Seat Module - Description
Seat Heater Control Module: Description and Operation Heated Seat Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
The heated seat module (2) is located under the driver front seat. It has a single electrical
connector (1) and a push pin style retainer that secures it to the seat pan (4). The module can be
accessed from under the Driver seat with the seat in the full back and up position.
The heated seat module is a microprocessor designed to use the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus messages from the instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment
Node (CCN). The CCN receives inputs from the heated seat switches and in turn signals the
heated seat module to operate the heated seat elements for both front seats.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Heated Seat Module - Description > Page 9170
Seat Heater Control Module: Description and Operation Heated Seat Module - Operation
OPERATION
The heated seat module operates on fused battery current received from the ignition switch. The
module is grounded to the body at all times through the electrical connector. Inputs to the module
include Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus messages and standard hardwired 12 volt power
and ground. In response to the LIN inputs the heated seat module will control the battery current to
the appropriate heated seat elements.
When a heated seat switch LIN data bus signal is received by the heated seat module, the module
energizes the selected heated seat element. The Low heat set point is about 38° C (100.4° F), and
the High heat set point is about 42° C (107.6° F).
In addition to operating the heated seat elements, the heated seat module sends LED illumination
messages to the instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN)
via the LIN data bus. The CCN then sends the LED illumination message to the accessory switch
bank so that the appropriate LEDs are illuminated for any given heating level. Pressing the switch
once will select high-level heating. Pressing the switch a second time will select low-level heating.
Pressing the switch a third time will shut the heating elements off.
If the heated seat module detects a heated seat element OPEN or SHORT circuit, it will record and
store the appropriate Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 9171
Seat Heater Control Module: Testing and Inspection
HEATED SEAT MODULE
In order to obtain conclusive testing, the heated seat system and the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus circuit must be checked. Any diagnosis of the heated seat system should begin with, the
use of a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic service information.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector pin-out
information.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the heated seat option utilize a low voltage cut-off feature. This
feature turns off power to the heated seat
system anytime vehicle voltage is below 11.7v or above 15.5v. Be certain to check the vehicle
electrical system for proper voltage anytime the power seat system appears inoperative.
Before any testing of the heated seat system is attempted, the battery should be fully-charged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heated Seat Module - Removal
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module - Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: The Heated Seat Module mounting tab can be damaged during module removal and
installation. Use care to properly align tab to
prevent binding that could result in tab breakage.
1. Position the driver front seat to the full rearward position. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. 3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the heated seat module (3). 4.
Unsnap the heated seat module retaining tab (2) from the seat pan (1). 5. Remove the heated seat
module (3) from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heated Seat Module - Removal > Page 9174
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The Heated Seat Module mounting tab can be damaged during module removal and
installation. Use care to properly align tab to
prevent binding that could result in tab breakage.
1. Install the heated seat module (3) into the vehicle. 2. Position the retaining tab (2) with the
mounting hole in the seat pan (1). Firmly apply even pressure to the module (3) until the mounting
tab is
fully seated.
3. Connect the wire harness connector (4) to the heated seat module (3). 4. Connect the battery
negative cable. 5. Check for proper heated seat system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Heated Seat Switch - Description
Seat Heater Switch: Description and Operation Heated Seat Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
Two heated seat switches are located in the center stack of the instrument panel. The switches are
located on the outer edges of the Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM). The ASBM (3) is
located just below the radio (1) and just above the heater and air conditioner controls (2) in the
center stack area of the instrument panel. If either of the switches is damaged or inoperative the
complete ASBM assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Heated Seat Switch - Description > Page 9179
Each heated seat switch (4) provides a resistor-multiplexed signal to the instrument cluster,
sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN). Amber Light Emitting Diodes (LEDs)
on the outside edge of each switch indicate the level of heat in use: Two LEDs are illuminated for
high, one for low, and none for off. Pressing the switch once will select high-level heating. Pressing
the switch a second time will select low-level heating. Pressing the switch a third time will shut the
heating elements off.
The LED indicator lamps in each heated seat switch cannot be repaired. If the LED lamps are
inoperative or damaged, or the switch is inoperative or damaged the complete ASBM assembly
must be replaced, See: Service and Repair/Heated Seat Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Heated Seat Switch - Description > Page 9180
Seat Heater Switch: Description and Operation Heated Seat Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The heated seat switches (4) are active any time the Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus is
active. Depressing the heated seat switch provides a switch status message to the instrument
cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN), via the LIN data bus. The
CCN is responsible for supplying the LIN data bus message to the heated seat module, signaling
the module to power the heated seat element of the selected seat and maintain the temperature
setting. If the heated seat switch is depressed to a different position (Low or High) than the
currently selected state, the CCN will go through the process again to change the temperature
setting.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 9181
Seat Heater Switch: Testing and Inspection
HEATED SEAT SWITCH
In order to obtain conclusive testing, the heated seat system and the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus circuit must be checked. Any diagnosis of the heated seat system should begin with, the
use of a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic service information.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector pin-out
information.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the heated seat option utilize a low voltage cut-off feature. This
feature turns off power to the heated seat
system anytime vehicle voltage is below 11.7v or above 15.5v. Be certain to check the vehicle
electrical system for proper voltage anytime the power seat system appears inoperative.
Before any testing of the heated seat system is attempted, the battery should be fully-charged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Heated Seat Switch - Removal
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The heated seat switches are integral to the Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM) and
cannot be serviced separately. The complete
ASBM assembly must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center bezel from the
instrument panel, See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument
Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Remove the four screws (1) that secure the ASBM (2) to the back of the instrument panel center
bezel (3) and remove the ASBM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Heated Seat Switch - Removal > Page 9184
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There are different Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM) configurations available based
on the option content of the vehicle.
Ensure the ASBM being installed matches the vehicle options.
1. Position the ASBM (2) onto the back of the instrument panel center bezel (3). 2. Install the four
screws (1) that secure the ASBM to the center bezel. Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 3.
Install the center bezel onto the instrument panel, See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Bezel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable. 5. Verify heated seat system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Power Seat Track - Removal
Seat Track: Service and Repair Power Seat Track - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any component diagnosis or service of
the front seats, when equipped with front seat
air bags. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: Driver seat shown in illustrations. Passenger seat similar.
1. Position the seat so that the heads of the bolts which secure the rear of the seat riser to the track
can be accessed. 2. Remove the seat from the vehicle and place it on a workbench See: Service
and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Removal. 3. Remove the inboard seat cushion side shield See:
Seat Cushion/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Side Shields - Removal. 4. Remove the push-pin
retainers (1) that secure the two elastic straps (4) of the seat bottom closeout (3) to the bottom of
the seat cushion frame (2)
and remove the closeout.
NOTE: Heated seat shown. Non-heated seat similar.
5. If equipped, remove the heated seat module (4) from the bottom of the seat cushion frame (3). 6.
Disconnect the wire harness connectors from the power seat motors (1) and the seat track position
sensor (8) and remove the wire harness (7) from
the bottom of the seat cushion frame and the seat riser (9).
7. If required, remove the seat track position sensor from the seat track. 8. Remove the bolt (2) that
secures the four seat track mounting brackets (3) to the bottom of the seat cushion frame. 9.
Disengage the seat track mounting brackets from the bottom of the seat cushion frame and remove
the seat track assembly (6) from the frame.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Power Seat Track - Removal > Page 9189
10. If required, remove the wire harness retaining bracket (4) from the bottom of the seat riser (2).
11. Remove the two nuts (1) and the two bolts (3) that secure the seat riser to the seat track and
remove the riser.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Power Seat Track - Removal > Page 9190
Seat Track: Service and Repair Power Seat Track - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Driver seat shown in illustrations. Passenger seat similar.
1. Position the seat riser (2) to the seat track and install the retaining two nuts (1) and bolts (3).
Tighten the nuts and bolts to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.). 2. Install the wire harness retaining bracket (4)
onto the seat riser.
NOTE: Heated seat shown. Non-heated seat similar.
3. If removed, install the seat track position sensor (8). 4. Position the seat track assembly (6) to
the bottom of the seat cushion frame (5). Make sure the seat track is properly located and that the
plastic
isolators are correctly installed.
5. Engage the four seat track mounting brackets (3) to the bottom of the seat cushion frame and
install the retaining bolts (2). Tighten the bolts to 28
Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the wire harness (7) to the bottom of the seat cushion frame and to the seat riser (9) and
connect the wire harness connectors to the power
seat motors (1) and the seat track position sensor.
7. If equipped, install the heated seat module (4) onto the bottom of the seat cushion frame.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Power Seat Track - Removal > Page 9191
8. Position the seat bottom closeout (3) to the rear of the seat and install the push-pin retainers (1)
that secure the two elastic straps (4) to the bottom
of the seat cushion frame (2).
9. Install the inboard seat cushion side shield See: Seat Cushion/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion
Side Shields - Installation.
10. Install the seat into the vehicle See: Service and Repair/Seats, Front/Seat - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Power Seat Track - Removal > Page 9192
Seat Track: Service and Repair Seats, Second Row
Seat Track Adjuster - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the seat cushion. See: Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Cover - Removal.
2. Remove the rear plastic shield fasteners and shields. 3. Remove the bottom plastic shield by
carefully prying up on the shield until the retainers disengage. 4. Remove the cables and cable
assemblies. 5. Remove the frame to adjuster fasteners and separate. 6. Remove the adjuster latch
mounting nuts and remove the latch.
Seat Track Adjuster - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the adjuster latch mounting nuts and install the latch. 2. Position the frame to the adjuster
assembly. 3. Install the frame to adjuster fasteners. Tighten to 30 N-m (22 ft. lbs.). 4. Install the
cables and cable assemblies. 5. Install the bottom plastic shield ensuring the retainers engage. 6.
Install the rear plastic shield shields and fasteners. 7. Install the seat cushion and cover See: Seat
Cover/Service and Repair/Seat Cushion Cover - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Door Lock Cylinder Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal
Door Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove door trim panel See: Doors, Hood
and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel Removal. 3. Disconnect the wiring clip and pigtail wire connector. 4. Remove the Door Cylinder
Lock Switch from door lock cylinder.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Door Lock Cylinder Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Removal > Page 9198
Door Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair Door Lock Cylinder Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the Door Cylinder Lock Switch onto the door lock cylinder. 2. Connect the wiring clip and
pigtail wire connector. 3. Install door trim panel See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Installation. 4. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 9203
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-HOOD AJAR - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch
- Description
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The hood ajar switch is a normally closed, single pole, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch. This
switch has two unique versions that are used in two different applications. One switch is used only
on vehicles equipped with the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) for sale in certain export
markets where protection of the underhood area is required equipment. The second switch is used
only on domestic vehicles equipped with an optional remote starter system.
The molded plastic switch body (5) has an integral molded connector receptacle (1) on the lower
end containing two terminal pins. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out of the headlamp and dash wire harness. Two integral latches (2) lock the switch
into a keyed mounting hole in the stamped steel switch mounting bracket. The mounting bracket is
secured with screws to the right inner fender shield near the fender ledge in the engine
compartment. The underside of the hood panel inner reinforcement actuates the switch plunger as
the hood panel is closed.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) and a sleeve-like retainer ring on the
upper end of the switch body. The retainer ring has a one time, self-adjustment feature that is
activated after the switch is installed by closing the hood. The retainer ring is also color-coded to
aid in identifying the switch application. A dark brown retainer ring identifies the underhood security
switch application, while a white retainer ring identifies the remote starter system application.
An installed hood ajar switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, or requires readjustment, it must be replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch
- Description > Page 9206
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar
Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The hood ajar switches are interchangeable physically, but not functionally. In each case, the hood
ajar switch is a normally closed switch that is held open as the spring-loaded switch plunger is
depressed by the inner hood panel reinforcement when the hood panel is closed and latched.
When the hood is opened, the spring-loaded switch plunger extends from the switch body and the
switch contacts are closed.
In the underhood security application (export vehicles only - dark brown retainer ring), the switch is
connected in series between ground and the hood ajar switch sense input of the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM uses an internal resistor pull up to monitor the state of the hood
ajar switch contacts.
In the remote starter system application (domestic vehicles only - white retainer ring) the switch has
a 1 kilohm diagnostic resistor connected in parallel to the switch contacts between the two switch
terminals. The switch is connected in series between an output of the TIPM and the hood ajar
switch sense input of the TIPM. The TIPM continually monitors this circuit and it will store a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that it detects.
The components of the switch self-adjustment feature include an integral stop on the shaft of the
plunger and a ribbed, ratcheting sleeve-like retainer ring at the top of the switch body from which
the plunger extends. With the switch mounting collar secured in its mounting bracket, the plunger is
depressed by the hood inner reinforcement as the hood is closed. As the plunger is depressed, the
plunger stop contacts the top of the retainer ring and it is driven downward, ratcheting through the
switch mounting collar until the hood is fully closed and latched. The ribs on the retainer ring are
engaged within the mounting collar to maintain this adjusted position.
The hood ajar switch as well as the hard-wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices related to hood ajar
switch operation that provide some features of the export vehicle theft or domestic remote starter
systems. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to hood ajar switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal
SWITCH
1. Unlatch and open the hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect
the wire harness connector (3) from the switch connector receptacle. 4. From the top of the hood
ajar switch mounting bracket (2), squeeze the two switch latch tabs together and pull the switch (1)
upward through the
hole in the mounting bracket.
5. Remove the hood ajar switch from the mounting bracket and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Removal > Page 9209
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Vehicle Theft Security Hood Ajar Switch Installation
SWITCH
NOTE: Self-adjustment of the hood ajar switch is a one-time feature. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, removed or requires readjustment,
it must be replaced with a new unit.
1. Position the hood ajar switch (1) above the hole in the mounting bracket (2). 2. Press the switch
into the mounting hole until the integral switch latch tabs lock it into place. 3. Connect the harness
connector (3) to the switch connector receptacle. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Close
and latch the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch > Page 9214
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Connector C1 - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way > Page 9217
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C2 (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way > Page 9218
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Except Base) (Front
Door) 10 Way
Connector (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way > Page 9219
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Base) (Front Door) 8
Way
Connector (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9220
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
VOLTAGE
The following wiring test sequence determines whether or not voltage is continuous through the
body harness to switch.
1. Remove switch from door trim panel. 2. Carefully separate multiple terminal block on wiring
harness from switch body. 3. Connect one lead of test light to a ground terminal:
- Touch other test light lead to battery feed B+ terminal.
- If test light comes on, the wiring circuit between the battery and switch is functional.
- If test light does not come on, check for a blown fuse. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for circuit
information.
DOOR LOCK SWITCH
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the auto-express feature for power windows, the local interface
network (LIN) controls the lock, mirror and
window features.
Remove the non-express switch from its mounting location. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the DOOR
LOCK SWITCH CONTINUITY table to determine if the continuity is correct in the LOCK and
UNLOCK switch positions. If these results are not obtained, replace the switch.
DOOR LOCK SWITCH CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Lock Switch - Removal
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Power Lock Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative remote cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent,
carefully pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
switch wire connector.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Lock Switch - Removal > Page 9223
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Power Lock Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect switch wire connector. 2. Install the switch by snapping into place. 3. Connect the
battery negative remote cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Mirror Switch - Removal
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair Power Mirror Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent, carefully
pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect switch wire
connector. 4. Remove switch assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Mirror Switch - Removal > Page 9228
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair Power Mirror Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect switch wire connector. 2. Install the switch to the door trim panel. 3. Connect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9232
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (SEAT) 11 WAY
SWITCH-SEAT-DRIVER - (SEAT) 11 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Seat Switch - Description
Power Seat Switch: Description and Operation Power Seat Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The driver power seat can be adjusted in six different ways using the power seat switch. The power
seat switch (2) is located on the lower outboard side of the seat cushion (1) on the seat cushion
side shield (3). The power seat system incorporates a seat switch with a seat cushion control
paddle.
The individual components in the power seat switch assembly cannot be repaired. If the switch is
damaged or inoperative, the entire power seat switch must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Seat Switch - Description > Page 9235
Power Seat Switch: Description and Operation Power Seat Switch - Operation
OPERATION
When a power seat switch is actuated, a battery feed and a ground path are applied through the
switch contacts to the power seat track adjuster motor. The selected adjuster motor operates to
move the seat through its drive unit in the selected direction until the switch is released, or until the
travel limit of the adjuster is reached. When the switch is moved in the opposite direction, the
battery feed and ground path to the motor are reversed through the switch contacts. This causes
the adjuster motor to run in the opposite direction.
No power seat switch should be held applied in any direction after the adjuster has reached its
travel limit. The power seat adjuster motors each contain a self-resetting circuit breaker to protect
them from overload. However, consecutive or frequent resetting of the circuit breaker may result in
motor damage.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9236
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
POWER SEAT SWITCH
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the power seat switch from the
power seat See: Service and Repair/Power Seat Switch - Removal. 3. Use an ohmmeter to test the
continuity of the power seat switch. Refer to POWER SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY table. If not
OK, replace the
faulty power seat switch. If switch tests OK See: Seats/Testing and Inspection.
POWER SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Seat Switch - Removal
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Power Seat Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the outboard seat cushion side
shield (3). 3. Disconnect the power seat switch electrical harness connector (4). 4. Using a small
flat bladed tool, gently release the four mounting tabs (1) that secure the power seat switch (2) and
separate switch from side shield
(3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Seat Switch - Removal > Page 9239
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Power Seat Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the power seat switch (2) onto the seat cushion side shield (3). Gently apply pressure to
the switch until the four mounting tabs (1) are
fully seated into place.
2. Connect the power seat switch electrical connector (4). 3. Install the seat cushion outboard side
shield. 4. Connect the battery negative cable. 5. Verify normal operation of the power seat
assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Switch - Description
Seat Heater Switch: Description and Operation Heated Seat Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
Two heated seat switches are located in the center stack of the instrument panel. The switches are
located on the outer edges of the Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM). The ASBM (3) is
located just below the radio (1) and just above the heater and air conditioner controls (2) in the
center stack area of the instrument panel. If either of the switches is damaged or inoperative the
complete ASBM assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Switch - Description > Page 9244
Each heated seat switch (4) provides a resistor-multiplexed signal to the instrument cluster,
sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN). Amber Light Emitting Diodes (LEDs)
on the outside edge of each switch indicate the level of heat in use: Two LEDs are illuminated for
high, one for low, and none for off. Pressing the switch once will select high-level heating. Pressing
the switch a second time will select low-level heating. Pressing the switch a third time will shut the
heating elements off.
The LED indicator lamps in each heated seat switch cannot be repaired. If the LED lamps are
inoperative or damaged, or the switch is inoperative or damaged the complete ASBM assembly
must be replaced, See: Service and Repair/Heated Seat Switch - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Seat Switch - Description > Page 9245
Seat Heater Switch: Description and Operation Heated Seat Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The heated seat switches (4) are active any time the Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus is
active. Depressing the heated seat switch provides a switch status message to the instrument
cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN), via the LIN data bus. The
CCN is responsible for supplying the LIN data bus message to the heated seat module, signaling
the module to power the heated seat element of the selected seat and maintain the temperature
setting. If the heated seat switch is depressed to a different position (Low or High) than the
currently selected state, the CCN will go through the process again to change the temperature
setting.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9246
Seat Heater Switch: Testing and Inspection
HEATED SEAT SWITCH
In order to obtain conclusive testing, the heated seat system and the Local Interface Network (LIN)
data bus circuit must be checked. Any diagnosis of the heated seat system should begin with, the
use of a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic service information.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector pin-out
information.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with the heated seat option utilize a low voltage cut-off feature. This
feature turns off power to the heated seat
system anytime vehicle voltage is below 11.7v or above 15.5v. Be certain to check the vehicle
electrical system for proper voltage anytime the power seat system appears inoperative.
Before any testing of the heated seat system is attempted, the battery should be fully-charged.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Seat Switch - Removal
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or
service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the
airbag system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the
only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions may result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The heated seat switches are integral to the Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM) and
cannot be serviced separately. The complete
ASBM assembly must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center bezel from the
instrument panel, See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument
Panel Bezel - Removal.
3. Remove the four screws (1) that secure the ASBM (2) to the back of the instrument panel center
bezel (3) and remove the ASBM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Seat Switch - Removal > Page 9249
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There are different Accessory Switch Bank Module (ASBM) configurations available based
on the option content of the vehicle.
Ensure the ASBM being installed matches the vehicle options.
1. Position the ASBM (2) onto the back of the instrument panel center bezel (3). 2. Install the four
screws (1) that secure the ASBM to the center bezel. Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.). 3.
Install the center bezel onto the instrument panel, See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Bezel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable. 5. Verify heated seat system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9253
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
SWITCH-SUNROOF - (HEADLINER) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Sunroof Switch - Description
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Description and Operation Sunroof Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The power sunroof switch (3) is a combination push-button and rocker switch module mounted in
the overhead console assembly (1). The sunroof switch is a direct contact unit that is directly wired
to the sunroof motor/module assembly. The sunroof switch performs the following functions:
- Power sunroof open (back of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof express open (back of switch pushed and released)
- Power sunroof closed (front of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof express closed (front of switch pushed and released)
- Power sunroof vent (switch center button pushed)
The power sunroof switch cannot be repaired. If the individual components are damaged or
inoperative the switch assembly must be replaced, See: Service and Repair/Sunroof Switch Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Sunroof Switch - Description > Page 9256
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Description and Operation Sunroof Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The sunroof is electrically operated from two switches located in the headliner on the
courtesy/reading lamp assembly. The power sunroof switch is hard wired to the sunroof
motor/module assembly. The "VENT" switch is a push button type switch and opens the sunroof to
the vent position only. The other switch "OPEN/CLOSED" is a rocker type switch for opening and
closing the sunroof. Pressing and releasing the open button once, the sunroof will express open
and the wind deflector will raise. If the button is pressed a second time the sunroof will stop in that
position. Pressing and releasing the close button once will express close the sunroof. If the close
button is pressed a second time during the express close operation the sunroof will stop in that
position.
The switch is grounded at one terminal and receives a 5 volt signal from the sunroof motor/module
on the remaining three terminals. The switch pulls down the 5 volt reference voltage from the
module signaling it to perform the desired function.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9257
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
SUNROOF SWITCH
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
1. Remove the overhead console, See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Overhead Console - Removal. 2. Disconnect the power sunroof switch wire harness
connector. 3. With the ignition key in the "RUN" position check for 5 volts on the "OPEN", "CLOSE"
and "VENT" circuits of the sunroof switch harness
connector. If OK, go to 4. If not OK, inspect the wiring harness and connectors between the
motor/module and switch for damage and repair as necessary.
4. With the ignition key in the "OFF" position check for continuity between the ground circuit of the
sunroof switch harness connector and a known
good ground. Continuity should be present. If OK, go to 5. If not OK, inspect the wiring harness and
connector and repair the ground circuit as necessary.
5. Using an ohmmeter, test the continuity of the power sunroof switch in each switch position. Refer
to the POWER SUNROOF SWITCH
CONTINUITY TABLE. If OK, inspect the wiring harness and connectors for damage and repair as
necessary. If not OK, replace the overhead console assembly, See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Removal.
POWER SUNROOF SWITCH CONTINUITY TABLE
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Switch - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair Sunroof Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove overhead console, See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Removal. 3. Using a suitable flat
bladed tool, release the mounting tabs from the sides of the sunroof control switch and pull the
switch out of the overhead
console assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Switch - Removal > Page 9260
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair Sunroof Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the sunroof control switch into the overhead console assembly. Push the switch until it is
securely held in place by the mounting tabs. 2. Install the overhead console, See: Interior Moulding
/ Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead Console - Installation. 3. Connect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Locations
Sound Proofing / Insulation: Locations
SOUND DEADENER LOCATIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Locations > Page
9264
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Locations > Page
9265
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Locations > Page
9266
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Locations > Page
9267
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spare Tire Carrier > Component Information > Service and Repair > Spare
Tire Carrier Winch - Removal
Spare Tire Carrier: Service and Repair Spare Tire Carrier Winch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Access and remove the spare tire. 2. Remove the screw and two nuts securing the winch to the
body floor pan. 3. Remove the winch from the jack storage compartment carefully extracting the
cable and retainer through the access hole.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spare Tire Carrier > Component Information > Service and Repair > Spare
Tire Carrier Winch - Removal > Page 9272
Spare Tire Carrier: Service and Repair Spare Tire Carrier Winch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Route the winch cable and retainer down through the access hole in the jack storage
compartment. 2. Position the spare tire winch on the floor pan, over the mounting studs. 3. Install
the screw and two nuts securing the winch to the body floor pan. First, tighten the screw to 7 Nm
(62 in. lbs.), then tighten the nuts to 7 Nm
(62 in. lbs.).
4. Install the spare tire.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap At
Windshield/Wind Noise
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Customer Interest Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap At
Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 9283
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel Gap At
Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 9284
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel
Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
Cowl Moulding / Trim: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind
Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel
Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 9290
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > 23-027-08 > Sep > 08 > Body - Cowl Panel
Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise > Page 9291
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 9292
Cowl Moulding / Trim: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-027-08 Date: 080906
Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 9293
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 9294
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-027-08 Date:
080906
Body - Cowl Panel Gap At Windshield/Wind Noise
NUMBER: 23-027-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: September 6, 2008
SUBJECT: Cowl Panel Screen Gapping From Windshield
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspection and installation of an additional cowl screen push-pin.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 9295
MODELS:
2009 (JC) Journey
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles between January 2, 2008 (MDH0102XX) and April 30, 2008
(MDH0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience one or more of the following conditions:
^ Wind noise from lower windshield and cowl screen panel center area at highway speed.
^ Cowl screen panel gapping or warping from windshield at center area.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Inspect the cowl screen panel center section, for gapping from the windshield.
2. Is the gap 2 mm (0.078 in.) or greater?
a. Yes >>> Perform the Repair Procedure.
b. No >>> Repair procedure does not apply. Further diagnosis required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the inner cowl screen from the vehicle. Refer to the detailed removal procedures
available in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR >
COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner > REMOVAL.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 9296
2. Drill a 13 mm (0.511 in.) hole in the inner cowl panel lower screen at the location shown (Fig 1).
3. Cut and remove a 14 mm (0.551 in.) section of foam from the airbox at the location shown (Fig.
2).
4. Install the inner cowl panel lower screen but do not install the wiper arms or outer cowl panel top
screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER, Cowl Panel, Inner >
INSTALLATION.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cowl Moulding / Trim: > Page 9297
5. Drill a 6.5 mm (0.256 in.) hole in the airbox flange at center of cowl screen hole (Fig. 3).
6. Install push pin p/n 06501590 through the cowl screen into the airbox hole.
7. Install the wiper arms and cowl top screen. Refer to the detailed installation procedures available
in DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info > 23 - BODY > EXTERIOR > COVER,
Cowl Panel, Inner > INSTALLATION.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). Remove the cowl top screen (3). 3. Remove the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer
Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal
4. Remove the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse brace and cowl. Rotate
the screw (2) in the center of the cowl screen 90°
clockwise to release the screen.
5. Remove the cowl screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal > Page 9300
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the cowl screen. Install the push-pins (1) securing the cowl screen to the wheelhouse
brace and cowl. Rotate the screw (2) in the center of
the cowl screen 90° counterclockwise to lock the screen in place.
2. Install the wiper arms. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation
3. Install the cowl top screen (3). Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the
ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal > Page 9301
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at the ends. Remove the remaining
push-pins (2). 3. Remove the cowl top screen (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service
and Repair > Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal > Page 9302
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the cowl top screen (3). 2. Install the two push-pins (1) securing the cowl top screen at
the ends. Install the remaining push-pins (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Outer Belt Molding - Removal
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Outer Belt Molding - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Lower the window to the full down position. 2. Remove the rear door trim panel. See: Doors,
Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel Removal.
3. Remove the front and rear mounting fasteners. 4. Remove the rear door belt molding (2) by
carefully pulling up on the molding and remove from the rear door (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Outer Belt Molding - Removal > Page 9308
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Outer Belt Molding - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear door belt molding (2) to the rear door (3). 2. Install the front and rear mounting
fasteners. 3. Install the rear door trim panel. See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door Trim Panel Installation.
4. Verify proper window operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Sunroof Glass Seal - Removal
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Sunroof Glass Seal - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove sunroof glass panel See: Roof and Associated Components/Sunroof /
Moonroof/Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and Repair/Sunroof
Glass - Removal.
2. Place glass panel on clean work area with the top side up. Support the glass assembly from
underside to avoid bending or otherwise damaging the
mounting tabs.
3. Grasp the seal (1) and pull seal away from the glass panel (2). The seal is a one piece seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Sunroof Glass Seal - Removal > Page 9313
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Sunroof Glass Seal - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Always position seal seam on center of the passenger side of glass panel.
1. Place seal (1) into position. 2. Seat the seal into the glass channel fully. Using care working the
seal around the glass (2), being careful not to over stretch the seal while
installing.
3. Install the glass panel See: Roof and Associated Components/Sunroof / Moonroof/Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel/Service and Repair/Sunroof Glass Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9318
Cruise Control Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 3 WAY
SWITCH-SPEED CONTROL - (STEERING WHEEL) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Speed Control Switch - Removal
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Speed Control Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning steering
wheel removal or installation. Allow the front
airbag system capacitor to discharge for two minutes before removing the steering wheel or any
front airbag system component. This will disable the front airbag system. Failure to disconnect the
battery could result in accidental front airbag module deployment and possible personal injury.Do
not place a non-deployed airbag face down on a hard surface as the airbag will propel into the air if
accidentally deployed, and could result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable before beginning steering wheel removal.
Allow the front airbag system capacitor to discharge
for two minutes before removing the steering wheel or any front airbag system component.
2. Turn off ignition. 3. Remove the driver's side airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air
Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Removal. 4. Disconnect electrical connector (1) from horn
switch (2). 5. Remove mounting screws (3) and horn switch (2) from steering wheel.
6. Disconnect electrical connector (1) from speed control switch (3). 7. Remove screws (4) from
speed control switch (3). 8. Remove speed control switch (3) from steering wheel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Speed Control Switch - Removal > Page 9321
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Speed Control Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install speed control switch (3) onto the locating pin (2) in the steering wheel. 2. Install speed
control switch mounting screws (4) and tighten screws to 1.6 Nm (15 ins. lbs.). 3. Connect electrical
connector (1) to speed control switch (3).
4. Install horn switch (2) to steering wheel. 5. Install horn switch mounting screws (3) and tighten
screws to 8 Nm (71 ins. lbs.). 6. Connect electrical connector to horn switch. 7. Install driver's side
airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag Installation. 8. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.). 9. Verify vehicle
and system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9326
Cruise Control Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 3 WAY
SWITCH-SPEED CONTROL - (STEERING WHEEL) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Speed Control Switch - Removal
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Speed Control Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning steering
wheel removal or installation. Allow the front
airbag system capacitor to discharge for two minutes before removing the steering wheel or any
front airbag system component. This will disable the front airbag system. Failure to disconnect the
battery could result in accidental front airbag module deployment and possible personal injury.Do
not place a non-deployed airbag face down on a hard surface as the airbag will propel into the air if
accidentally deployed, and could result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable before beginning steering wheel removal.
Allow the front airbag system capacitor to discharge
for two minutes before removing the steering wheel or any front airbag system component.
2. Turn off ignition. 3. Remove the driver's side airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air
Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Removal. 4. Disconnect electrical connector (1) from horn
switch (2). 5. Remove mounting screws (3) and horn switch (2) from steering wheel.
6. Disconnect electrical connector (1) from speed control switch (3). 7. Remove screws (4) from
speed control switch (3). 8. Remove speed control switch (3) from steering wheel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Speed Control Switch - Removal > Page 9329
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Speed Control Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install speed control switch (3) onto the locating pin (2) in the steering wheel. 2. Install speed
control switch mounting screws (4) and tighten screws to 1.6 Nm (15 ins. lbs.). 3. Connect electrical
connector (1) to speed control switch (3).
4. Install horn switch (2) to steering wheel. 5. Install horn switch mounting screws (3) and tighten
screws to 8 Nm (71 ins. lbs.). 6. Connect electrical connector to horn switch. 7. Install driver's side
airbag, See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag Installation. 8. Connect negative battery cable, tighten nut to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.). 9. Verify vehicle
and system operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Chime/Buzzer - Description
Audible Warning Device: Description and Operation Chime/Buzzer - Description
DESCRIPTION
The chime warning system uses an electromechanical transducer and an electromechanical relay
that are soldered onto the circuit board of the instrument cluster also known as the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) to provide audible indications of various vehicle conditions that may
require the attention of the vehicle operator or occupants. The CCN also includes the necessary
hardware and software to serve as the vehicle's electronic body control module.
The electromechanical transducer generates chime tones, while the electromechanical relay
generates click tones to emulate the sounds associated with conventional turn signal and hazard
warning flasher operation. The microprocessor-based CCN utilizes electronic chime request
messages received from other modules in the vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data
bus along with hard-wired inputs to monitor many sensors and switches throughout the vehicle. In
response to those inputs, the circuitry and programming of the CCN allow it to control the audible
outputs that are produced through its on-board transducer and relay.
The CCN is capable of producing the following audible outputs:
- Slow Rate Repetitive Click - Repeated click tones that are issued at a slow rate of about 90 clicks
per minute.
- Fast Rate Repetitive Click - Repeated click tones that are issued at a fast rate of more than about
180 clicks per minute.
Single Chime Tone - A single chime tone.
- Continuous Repetitive Chime Tone - Repeated chime tones that are issued continuously.
Hard-wired circuitry connects the CCN and the various chime warning system switch and sensor
inputs to their modules and to each other through the electrical system of the vehicle. These
hard-wired circuits are integral to several wire harnesses that are routed throughout the vehicle and
they are retained by many different methods. These circuits may be connected to each other, to the
vehicle electrical system, and to the CCN through a combination of soldered splices, splice block
connectors, and many different types of wire harness terminal connectors and insulators. Refer to
the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, procedures for
proper wire and connector repair, further details on wire harness routing and retention, and pin-out
and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices, and grounds.
The chime warning system circuits and components cannot be adjusted or repaired. If the CCN
circuitry, the on-board transducer, or the relay is damaged or ineffective, the instrument cluster
assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Chime/Buzzer - Description > Page 9335
Audible Warning Device: Description and Operation Chime/Buzzer - Operation
OPERATION
DOOR AJAR CHIME
The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) will sound an audible chime when the key is in the ignition and
the driver's door is open. This is to prevent partial closing of vehicle doors.
An audible chime will sound when the vehicle begins to move and the transmission range indicator
display will indicate DOOR.
ENHANCED SEAT BELT REMINDER
If all the following are met after sixty seconds with the engine ON, then the enhanced seat belt
reminder feature will be activated.
- Driver seat belt is unbuckled for ten seconds or more.
- Vehicle speed is greater than five mph (8 km/h).
- The gear positioning is not in REVERSE (except in MTX vehicles where the reverse position
cannot be detected).
The seat belt indicator will periodically blink, accompanied with a continuous chime for
approximately ninety-six seconds or until the driver seat belt is buckled. When the enhanced seat
belt feature is not initiated or if the feature is disabled, the seat belt indicator will be turned ON
continuously until the driver seat belt is buckled.
In the same ignition cycle, if the seat belt is again unbuckled for more than ten seconds with the
vehicle speed greater than five mph (8 km/h), the enhanced seat belt reminder feature will again be
initiated.
The enhanced seat belt reminder feature is customer programmable and can be enabled/disabled
with the use of a Scan Tool, or by the customer completing a sequence of steps.
CUSTOMER PROGRAMMING OF ENHANCED SEAT BELT REMINDER FEATURE
1. With the ignition not in RUN or START, buckle the driver seat belt. 2. Turn the ignition switch to
the RUN or START position and wait for the seat belt reminder check to be completed. 3. Unbuckle
and then re-buckle the driver seat belt causing the indicator to go ON and OFF three or more times
ending with the seat belt buckled. 4. Return the ignition switch back to a non-RUN or no-START
position (the feature will toggle from the current status) and a confirmation chime
will sound indicating to the customer the proper sequence to enable/disable the feature was
performed.
EXTERIOR LAMPS LEFT ON
An audible chime tone that indicates the exterior lamps were left on.
FASTEN SEAT BELTS
At power up, the instrument cluster will conduct a seat belt lamp bulb check. If the driver side seat
belt buckle is unbuckled during the bulb check, an accompanying chime will sound within the
duration of the bulb check.
KEY LEFT IN IGNITION
An audible chime tone that indicates the key was left in ignition.
SINGLE WARNING CHIME
After a bulb check at power-up, if any of the following indicators are still activated, the CCN will
sound a single chime tone. ABS, Air Bag, Check Engine, Charging System, Engine Temperature,
Low Fuel (after 10 seconds for accurate fuel information), and BRAKE (if speed is greater than 2
mph).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 9336
Audible Warning Device: Testing and Inspection
CHIME WARNING SYSTEM
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
The hard-wired circuits between components related to the chime warning system may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, procedures for proper wire and
connector repair, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector pin-out information, and
location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices, and grounds.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the chime
warning system or the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices
that provide some features of the chime warning system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate
means to diagnose the chime warning system or the electronic controls and communication related
to chime warning system operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Locations
Cigarette Lighter: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9340
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9341
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cigarette Lighter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9344
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9345
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9346
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9347
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9348
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9349
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9350
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9351
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9352
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9353
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9354
Cigarette Lighter: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9355
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9356
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9357
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9358
Cigarette Lighter: Connector Views
Connector - (FRONT CONSOLE) 3 WAY
LIGHTER-CIGAR - (FRONT CONSOLE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9359
Cigarette Lighter: Electrical Diagrams
HORN/CIGAR LIGHTER/POWER OUTLET - Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9360
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-01
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-02 (EVIC)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9361
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-03
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9362
Horn/Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet 8W-41-04 (Except Export)
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams by Number See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9366
Compass: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
MODULE-COMPASS - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9367
Compass: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Remote Compass Module (RCM) (2) is a separate stand alone module mounted to the top of
the instrument panel (1). The RCM can be accessed by removing the defroster grille, See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Air Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille - Removal.
If the compass position sensor (Remote Compass Module) is inoperative and requires
replacement, See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Compass Module - Removal for
the appropriate procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9368
Compass: Testing and Inspection
REMOTE COMPASS MODULE
The Remote Compass Module (RCM) data is transferred on the Controller Area Network (CAN)
Data Bus circuit. The RCM and Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will not function
properly if the bus messages are not properly received. If no EVIC data is displayed, check the
CAN Data Bus circuit communications, the RCM, the Instrument Cluster functions and the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM). Any diagnosis of the RCM and EVIC display should begin with
the use of a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic service information.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Adjustments > Manual Compass Calibration
Compass: Adjustments Manual Compass Calibration
MANUAL COMPASS CALIBRATION
CAUTION: Do not place any external magnets, such as magnetic roof mount antennas, in the
vicinity of the compass. Do not place any
electronic devices (cell phones, laptop computers, PDAs, portable DVD players, etc), on or near
the instrument panel as the Remote Compass Module (RCM) performance may be effected. Do not
use magnetic tools when servicing the RCM.
NOTE: Calibration is required anytime a new RCM is installed. Upon installation of the new RCM
the "CAL" message will appear in the
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) display. The RCM will automatically calibrate if the
vehicle is driven in two or more circles, slowly, and away from large metal objects. The RCM can
also be calibrated by performing the following procedure.
NOTE: Confirmation that the proper variance zone is programmed, is recommended whenever
manual compass calibration is performed.
See: Driver/Vehicle Information Display/Adjustments for the appropriate procedure.
The electronic compass unit features a self-calibrating design, which simplifies the calibration
procedure. This feature automatically updates the compass calibration while the vehicle is being
driven. This allows the compass unit to compensate for small changes in the residual magnetism
that the vehicle may acquire during normal use. If the compass readings appear to be erratic or the
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) displays "CAL", perform the following manual
calibration procedure. Also, any time EVIC service replacement components are installed, they
must be calibrated using this procedure. Do not attempt to calibrate the compass near large metal
objects such as other vehicles, large buildings, or bridges; or, near overhead or underground power
lines.
Calibrate the compass manually as follows:
NOTE: Do not attempt to calibrate the compass near large metal objects such as other vehicles,
large buildings, or bridges; or, near overhead
or underground power lines.
1. Start the engine but leave the vehicle in "PARK". 2. Press and release the MENU push button
(1) until "Personal Settings" is displayed. 3. Once in the "Personal Settings" menu depress and
release the STEP button (4) several times until "Calibrate Compass (Yes)" is displayed. 4.
Momentarily depress and release the RESET push button (3) to initiate the calibration procedure.
The "CAL" symbol will come on solid in the
EVIC display.
5. Slowly drive the vehicle on a level surface, away from large metal objects and power lines,
through one or two complete circles not exceeding 8
km/h (5 mph). The "CAL" symbol will disappear from the display to indicate successful compass
calibration.
NOTE: A blank compass display indicates that vehicle degaussing (demagnetizing) may be
necessary.
NOTE: If the "CAL" message remains in the display, either there is excessive magnetism near the
compass, or the EVIC is inoperative.
Attempt the calibration procedure at least one more time before performing EVIC diagnosis.
NOTE: If the wrong direction is still indicated in the compass display, the area selected for
calibration may be too close to a strong magnetic
field. Repeat the manual calibration procedure in another location.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Adjustments > Manual Compass Calibration > Page 9371
Compass: Adjustments Compass Variance Adjustment
COMPASS VARIANCE ADJUSTMENT
Compass variance, also known as magnetic declination, is the difference in angle between
magnetic north and true geographic north. In some geographic locations, the difference between
magnetic and geographic north is great enough to cause the compass to give false readings. If this
problem occurs, the compass variance must be set.
NOTE: If the vehicle is taken on long trips into a new variance zone the compass function may be
effected. Compass variance will need to be
updated to the new zone number to function properly.
NOTE: The default for the compass variance from the factory is 8.
To set the compass variance:
1. Using the Variance Settings Map, find your geographic location and note the zone number.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Adjustments > Manual Compass Calibration > Page 9372
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position. Press and release the MENU push button (1)
until "Personal Settings" is displayed. 3. Press the STEP push button (4) until "Compass Variance"
is displayed. The "Compass Variance" message and the current variance zone number
will be displayed.
4. Press and release the RESET push button (3) to toggle through the zone numbers (1-15), until
the zone number for your geographic location
appears in the display.
NOTE: The default for the compass variance from the factory is 8. During programming, the Zone
value will wrap around from Zone 15 to
Zone 1.
5. Press and release the Compass Temperature (C/T) push button (2) to enter the displayed zone
number into the compass unit memory. 6. Confirm that the correct directions are now indicated by
the compass.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Compass: Procedures
COMPASS DEMAGNETIZING
DEGAUSSING TOOL #6029
A degaussing tool (Special Tool 6029) is used to demagnetize, or degauss, the roof panel of the
vehicle. Equivalent units must be rated as continuous duty for 110/115 volts and 60 Hz. They must
also have a field strength of over 350 gauss at 7 millimeters (0.25 inch) beyond the tip of the probe.
To demagnetize the roof panel proceed as follows:
1. Be certain that the ignition switch is in the Off position, before you begin the demagnetizing
procedure.
2. Place a piece of paper approximately 22 by 28 centimeters (8.5 by 11 inches), oriented on the
vehicle lengthwise from front to rear, on the center
line of the roof at the windshield header. The purpose of the paper is to protect the roof panel from
scratches, and to define the area to be demagnetized.
3. Connect the degaussing tool to an electrical outlet, while keeping the tool at least 61 centimeters
(2 feet) away from the vehicle. 4. Slowly approach the center line of the roof panel at the windshield
header, with the degaussing tool connected. 5. Contact the roof panel with the plastic coated tip of
the degaussing tool. Be sure that the template is in place to avoid scratching the roof panel.
Using a slow, back-and-forth sweeping motion, and allowing 13 millimeters (0.50 inch) between
passes, move the tool at least 11 centimeters (4 inches) to each side of the roof center line, and 28
centimeters (11 inches) back from the windshield header.
6. With the degaussing tool still energized, slowly back it away from the roof panel. When the tip of
the tool is at least 61 centimeters (2 feet) from
the roof panel, disconnect the tool.
7. Calibrate the compass, See: Driver/Vehicle Information Display/Adjustments and adjust the
compass variance, See: Driver/Vehicle Information
Display/Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9375
Compass: Removal and Replacement
Compass Module - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the defroster grille See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Air Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille - Removal 3. Remove the
retaining screw (3) securing the Remote Compass Module (RCM) (2) to the instrument panel (1). 4.
Disconnect the RCM electrical connector (4). 5. Remove the RCM from the vehicle.
Compass Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the Remote Compass Module (RCM) (2) onto the top of the Instrument Panel (IP) (1). 2.
Connect the electrical connector (4). 3. Install the RCM retaining screws (3). 4. Install the defroster
grille See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Air Register/Service and Repair/Defroster Grille Installation 5. Connect the battery negative cable. 6. Perform the Compass Variance Adjustment,
See: Driver/Vehicle Information Display/Adjustments. 7. Perform the Manual Compass Calibration,
See: Driver/Vehicle Information Display/Adjustments. 8. Verify proper compass operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9380
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9381
Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9382
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9385
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Vehicle Information Center Setup
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Vehicle Information
Center Setup
NUMBER: 08-002-09
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: February 4, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-014-07, DATED JULY 11,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITIONAL YEARS AND MODELS.
SUBJECT: Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Oil Change Indicator System - Dealer
Preferences During Prep
MODELS:
2008 (DR) Ram Truck
**2009 (HB) Durango**
**2009 (HG) Aspen**
**2009 (JC) Journey**
**2008 - 2009 (KA) Nitro**
**2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty**
**2009 (LC) Challenger**
**2008 - 2009 (LX) 300 / Magnum / Charger**
**2008 - 2009 (RI) Caravan / Town & Country**
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a programmable EVIC.
DISCUSSION:
**Many models now include an oil change indicator system**. This system displays an "Oil Change
Required" or "Oil Change" message at appropriate intervals on the instrument cluster.
The vehicles listed above may be equipped with a programmable display on the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center, (EVIC). The "Oil Change Required message may also include the dealerships
name and phone number which can be programmed into the vehicle with the StarSCAN(R) or
StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
NOTE:
**Other vehicles may be added at any time. Dealers can determine if the feature is available by
following the procedures below. If Enable/Disable Dealer Contact Information is active, the feature
can be used to enter the servicing dealer's information.**
The following procedure describes the steps to add, delete or change a dealership name and
phone number on the display.
NOTE:
If NOT programmed during vehicle prep, customer approval MUST be obtained before adding or
changing this information.
NOTE:
When performing this Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN(R) or
StarMOBILE(R); must be programmed with the latest level software. The software release level is
visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) screen.
1. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R). (in Pass-Through Mode)
NOTE:
To use the StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode requires that StarMOBILE(R) be connected to
the dealership network via a wired or wireless connection. For more information on how to use the
StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode, see the StarMOBILE(R) training tutorials available on
DealerCONNECT > Service > Repair > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Tools link or at the
website.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Vehicle Information Center Setup > Page 9390
2. From the Home Screen, enter "ECU VIEW or "VEHICLE PREP".
3. Select "CCN".
4. Select "Misc. Functions".
5. Select "Enable/Disable Dealer Contact Information".
6. Select "Enable" or "Disable" as desired.
7. If enabled, select "Program Dealer Contact Information" and follow on screen prompts.
8. "Reset will cause display to read: "Contact Dealer" as default.
9. Select finish to exit.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGSprovide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should
be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and
muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
Warnings Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEV)
WARNINGS - HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLES (HEV)
Hybrid Electric Vehiclesare equipped with a high voltage components and wiring. Each high
voltage component is labeled with the high voltage symbol. High voltage cables are orange in color
or protected by metal conduit.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with the high voltage system, you must thoroughly read and
follow all High Voltage Safety Procedures.
These procedures are located in the Service tab, section 08-Electrical. In addition, before
performing any diagnostic or service procedure near a high voltage component, you must perform
the High Voltage Power Down procedure located in the Service Tab, 08-Electrical/8 - Engine
Systems/Battery System - Standard Procedure. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
possible serious or fatal injury.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9393
HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
Chrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles
wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chrysler
Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page. All switches,
components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition. Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component
indicates that the component is complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the
component is being shown is not complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to
indicate the page where the component is shown complete. It is important to realize that no attempt
is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For
example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one. In addition, switches and other
components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9394
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9395
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams. LHD - Left Hand Drive Vehicles
RHD - Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX - Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT - Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC - Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC - Double
Over Head Cam Engine Export - Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North America
Module-Totally Integrated Power (TIPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and Controls
Many Vehicle Electronic Components Module-Front Control (FCM) - Controls Vehicle Electronic
Components Module-Integrated Power (IPM) - Provides Circuit Protection, Supplies Power and
Controls Some Vehicle Electronic Components Fuse/Relay Block (FRB) - Provides Circuit
Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicle Power Distribution Center (PDC) - Hard Wired Box
Provides Circuit Protection and Supplies Power To Vehicles Junction Block (JB) - Provides Circuit
Protection, Supplies Power and Provides Circuit Pass-Through Connectivity From Harness To
Harness
Circuit Functions
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9396
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models. CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE CHART
Circuit Information
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer. WIRE COLOR CODE
CHART
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9397
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental
Restraint System connectors. Always check parts availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
Section 8W-91 contains connector/ground/splice location illustrations. The illustrations contain the
connector name (or number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
Connector/ground/splice location charts in section 8W-91 reference the figure numbers of the
illustrations. The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in
which the wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in
the illustrations
Section Identification and Information
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9398
SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring. Splice diagrams in Section 8W-70 show the entire splice and provide references to other
sections the splices serves. Section 8W-70 only contains splice diagrams that are not shown in
their entirety somewhere else in the wiring diagrams. Section 8W-80 shows each connector and
the circuits involved with that connector. The connectors are identified using the name/number on
the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Release Connector Lock (2). 3. Disconnect the connector (3) being
repaired from its mating half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9399
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9400
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow. 3. Solder the connection
together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 4. Tape the diode to the
harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 5.
Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section. 2. Cut the wire
6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9401
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9402
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9403
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9404
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead
of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about six to eight inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers
voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9405
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter
with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating. In addition, make sure the power is disconnected
from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage
to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9406
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem area. 6. Verify the proper operation. For this
step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9407
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Electrical Diagrams
OVERHEAD CONSOLE - Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9408
Overhead Console 8W-49-01 (Except Navigation)
Overhead Console 8W-49-02 (Navigation)
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9409
Overhead Console 8W-49-03
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams by Number See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Vehicle Information Center - Description
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation Electronic Vehicle Information
Center - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display (29). The
display is located in the lower left part of the instrument cluster below the fuel (2) and engine
temperature (1) gauges.
The display in the lower right part of the instrument cluster (15) below the tachometer (13) shows
the vehicle odometer related functions. These functions include Trip Odometer (ODO), Trip A and
Trip B readouts. The instrument cluster pushbutton (21) can be used to scroll through the different
odometer functions. See: Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Description and Operation/Instrument Cluster
- Description for additional information on the instrument cluster and related functions.
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display. It is located
in the instrument cluster below the fuel and temperature gauges. Vehicles equipped with steering
wheel-mounted buttons (described) are also equipped with the EVIC. The EVIC consists of the
following:
- System Status
- Vehicle information warning message displays
- Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPM) - If Equipped
- Personal Settings (customer programmable features)
- Compass display
- Outside temperature display
- Trip computer functions
The EVIC system is comprised of several different components. Those components are:
- Instrument Cluster (sometimes referred to as Cab Compartment Node [CCN])
- ASBM EVIC Function Buttons
- Ambient Temperature Sensor
- Remote Compass Module (RCM)
- Controller Area Network (CAN) Data Bus
- Local Interface Network (LIN) Data Bus
The EVIC display is part of the Instrument Cluster assembly and is not serviced as a separate
component. If the display is inoperative the complete Instrument Cluster assembly must be
replaced, See: Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Vehicle Information Center - Description > Page 9412
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation Electronic Vehicle Information
Center - Operation
OPERATION
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) uses both non-switched and ignition switched
sources of battery current so that some of its features remain operational at any time, while others
may only operate with the ignition switch in the "ON" position. When the ignition switch is turned to
the "ON" position, the EVIC display will return to the last function being displayed before the
ignition was turned to the "OFF" position.
The EVIC system is comprised of several different components that communicate over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) and Local Interface Network (LIN) Data Buses. If the system is
inoperative a scan tool and the appropriate diagnostic information must be used to diagnose the
system.
The EVIC function buttons are used to operate the different functions of the EVIC system. Pressing
and releasing the MENU button allows the driver to select the Compass/Temperature, Trip
Computer, Personal Settings or System Status functions. The STEP button is used to toggle
through options or features of the Trip Computer, Personal Settings or System Status functions.
Pressing and releasing the RESET button allows the selection of setting or resetting of the function
currently displayed at that time. Pressing and releasing the C/T (compass/temperature) button will
cause the EVIC to return to the compass/temperature display mode from any other mode.
EVIC DISPLAY MODES
SYSTEM STATUS MODE
System display mode displays warnings and user interaction messages on the EVIC display. The
driver can scroll to view multiple messages by using the STEP button.
When the appropriate conditions exist, the EVIC displays the following messages:
- Turn Signal On (with a continuous warning chime if the vehicle is driven more than 1 mile [1.6 km]
with either turn signal on)
- Left Front Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
- Left Rear Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
- Right Front Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
- Right Rear Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
- RKE (Remote Keyless Entry ) Battery Low (with a single chime)
- Channel # Transmit.
- Channel # Training.
- Channel # Trained.
- Clearing Channels.
- Channels Cleared.
- Did Not Train.
- Left Front Low Pressure (with a single chime).
- Left Rear Low Pressure (with a single chime).
- Right Front Low Pressure (with a single chime).
- Right Rear Low Pressure (with a single chime).
- Check TPM System (with a single chime).
- Low Fuel
- Cal
- Oil Change Required (with a single chime)
- Low Washer Fluid
- Coolant Low
- Key in Ignition
- Lights On
PERSONAL SETTINGS MODE (CUSTOMER PROGRAMMABLE FEATURES)
Allows the driver to set and recall features when the transmission is in Park by pressing and
releasing the MENU button until Personal Settings is displayed in the EVIC. Pressing and releasing
the STEP button will scroll through the following personal settings choices:
- Language When in this display you may select one of three languages for all display
nomenclature, including the trip functions and the navigation system (if equipped). Press the
RESET button while in this display to select English, Espanol, or Francais. Then, as you continue,
the information will display in the selected language. NOTE: The EVIC will not change the
UConnect(TM) language selection.
- Unlock Doors Automatically on Exit When ON is selected, all doors will unlock when the vehicle is
stopped and the transmission is in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) position and the driver's door is
opened. To make your selection, press and release the RESET button until "ON" or "OFF"
appears.
- Remote Key Unlock When DRIVER DOOR 1ST PRESS is selected, only the driver's door will
unlock on the first press of the remote keyless
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Vehicle Information Center - Description > Page 9413
entry unlock button. When Driver Door 1st Press is selected, you must press of the remote keyless
entry unlock button twice to unlock the passenger's doors. When ALL DOORS 1ST PRESS is
selected, all of the doors will unlock on the first press of the remote keyless entry unlock button. To
make your selection, press and release the RESET button until "Driver Door 1st Press" or "All
Doors 1st Press" appears.
- Sound Horn with Remote Key Lock When ON is selected, a short horn sound will occur when the
remote keyless entry "Lock" button is pressed. This feature may be selected with or without the
flash lights on lock/unlock feature. To make your selection, press and release the RESET button
until "ON" or "OFF" appears.
- Flash Lights with Remote Key Lock When ON is selected, the front and rear turn signals will flash
when the doors are locked or unlocked with the remote keyless entry transmitter. This feature may
be selected with or without the sound horn on lock feature selected. To make your selection, press
and release the RESET button until "ON" or "OFF" appears.
- Delay Turning Headlights Off When this feature is selected, the driver can choose to have the
headlights remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds when exiting the vehicle. To make your selection,
press and release the RESET button until "0," "30," "60," or "90" appears.
- Headlights On with Wipers (Available with Auto Headlights Only) When this feature is selected
and the headlight switch is in the AUTO position, the headlights will activate approximately 10
seconds after the wipers are turned on. To make your selection, press and release the RESET
button until "ON" or "OFF" appears.
- Delay Power Off to Accessories Until Exit When this feature is selected, the power window
switches, radio, hands-free system (if equipped), DVD video system (if equipped), power sunroof (if
equipped), and power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes after the ignition switch is
turned off. Opening a vehicle door will cancel this feature. To make your selection, press and
release the RESET button until "Off," "45 sec.," "5 min.," or "10 min." appears.
Confirmation of Voice Commands - If Equipped When ON is selected, all voice commands from the
UConnect(TM) system are confirmed. To make your selection, press and release the RESET
button until "ON" or "OFF" appears.
- Display Units of Measure in The EVIC, odometer, and navigation system (if equipped) can be
changed between English and Metric units of measure. To make your selection, press and release
the RESET button until "US" or "METRIC" appears.
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE
Compass heading and outside temperature are displayed on the EVIC display screen. One of eight
compass headings to indicate the direction the vehicle is facing (N, S, E, W, NE, NW, SE, SW) and
one of 15 compass variance settings can be programmed. Outside temperature is displayed in °C
(degrees Celsius) or °F (degrees Fahrenheit).
For additional information regarding the compass, refer to Personal Settings (Customer
Programmable Features).
TRIP COMPUTER
Press and release the MENU button until one of the following Trip Functions displays in the EVIC:
- Average Fuel Economy
- Distance To Empty
- Elapsed Time
- Display Units of Measure in
Press the STEP button to cycle through all the Trip Computer functions.
The Trip Functions mode displays the following information:
- Average Fuel Economy Shows the average fuel economy since the last reset. When the fuel
economy is reset, the display will read "RESET" or show dashes for two seconds. Then, the history
information will be erased, and the averaging will continue from the last fuel average reading before
the reset.
- Distance To Empty (DTE) Shows the estimated distance that can be traveled with the fuel
remaining in the tank. This estimated distance is determined by a weighted average of the
instantaneous and average fuel economy, according to the current fuel tank level. DTE cannot be
reset through the RESET button. When the DTE value is less than 30 miles (48 km) estimated
driving distance, the DTE display will change to a text display of "LOW FUEL." This display will
continue until the vehicle runs out of fuel. Adding a significant amount of fuel to the vehicle will turn
off the "LOW FUEL" text and a new DTE value will display.
- Elapsed Time Shows the total elapsed time of travel since the last reset when the ignition switch
is in the ACC position. Elapsed time will increment when the ignition switch is in the ON or START
position.
- Display Units of Measure in: To make your selection, press and release the RESET button until
"US" or "METRIC" appears.
To Reset The Display Reset will only occur while a resettable function is being displayed. Press
and release the RESET button once to clear the resettable function being displayed. To reset all
resettable functions, press and release the RESET button a second time within 3 seconds of
resetting the currently displayed function (>Reset ALL will display during this 3 second window).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9414
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Testing and Inspection
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
CAUTION: Do not place any external magnets, such as magnetic roof mount antennas, in the
vicinity of the compass. Do not place any
electronic devices (cell phones, laptop computers, PDAs, portable DVD players, etc), on or near
the instrument panel as the Remote Compass Module (RCM) performance may be effected. Do not
use magnetic tools when servicing the RCM.
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) data is obtained from several components on the
Controller Area Network (CAN) and Local Interface Network (LIN) Data Bus circuits. The EVIC will
not function properly if the bus messages from any of these components is not receive. If no EVIC
data is displayed or the display indicates dashes "- -", check the CAN and LIN Data Bus circuit
communications, the Instrument Cluster functions, the Remote Compass Module (RCM) and the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). Should the RCM become disconnected, the instrument
cluster display will go blank.
The use of a scan tool and the proper diagnostic procedures information are recommended for
further testing of the Instrument Cluster, the RCM, the CAN Data Bus and the LIN Data Bus
circuits. Refer to the appropriate wiring information for complete circuit schematic or connector
pin-out information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Adjustments > Manual Compass Calibration
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Adjustments Manual Compass Calibration
MANUAL COMPASS CALIBRATION
CAUTION: Do not place any external magnets, such as magnetic roof mount antennas, in the
vicinity of the compass. Do not place any
electronic devices (cell phones, laptop computers, PDAs, portable DVD players, etc), on or near
the instrument panel as the Remote Compass Module (RCM) performance may be effected. Do not
use magnetic tools when servicing the RCM.
NOTE: Calibration is required anytime a new RCM is installed. Upon installation of the new RCM
the "CAL" message will appear in the
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) display. The RCM will automatically calibrate if the
vehicle is driven in two or more circles, slowly, and away from large metal objects. The RCM can
also be calibrated by performing the following procedure.
NOTE: Confirmation that the proper variance zone is programmed, is recommended whenever
manual compass calibration is performed.
See: for the appropriate procedure.
The electronic compass unit features a self-calibrating design, which simplifies the calibration
procedure. This feature automatically updates the compass calibration while the vehicle is being
driven. This allows the compass unit to compensate for small changes in the residual magnetism
that the vehicle may acquire during normal use. If the compass readings appear to be erratic or the
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) displays "CAL", perform the following manual
calibration procedure. Also, any time EVIC service replacement components are installed, they
must be calibrated using this procedure. Do not attempt to calibrate the compass near large metal
objects such as other vehicles, large buildings, or bridges; or, near overhead or underground power
lines.
Calibrate the compass manually as follows:
NOTE: Do not attempt to calibrate the compass near large metal objects such as other vehicles,
large buildings, or bridges; or, near overhead
or underground power lines.
1. Start the engine but leave the vehicle in "PARK". 2. Press and release the MENU push button
(1) until "Personal Settings" is displayed. 3. Once in the "Personal Settings" menu depress and
release the STEP button (4) several times until "Calibrate Compass (Yes)" is displayed. 4.
Momentarily depress and release the RESET push button (3) to initiate the calibration procedure.
The "CAL" symbol will come on solid in the
EVIC display.
5. Slowly drive the vehicle on a level surface, away from large metal objects and power lines,
through one or two complete circles not exceeding 8
km/h (5 mph). The "CAL" symbol will disappear from the display to indicate successful compass
calibration.
NOTE: A blank compass display indicates that vehicle degaussing (demagnetizing) may be
necessary.
NOTE: If the "CAL" message remains in the display, either there is excessive magnetism near the
compass, or the EVIC is inoperative.
Attempt the calibration procedure at least one more time before performing EVIC diagnosis.
NOTE: If the wrong direction is still indicated in the compass display, the area selected for
calibration may be too close to a strong magnetic
field. Repeat the manual calibration procedure in another location.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Adjustments > Manual Compass Calibration > Page 9417
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Adjustments Compass Variance Adjustment
COMPASS VARIANCE ADJUSTMENT
Compass variance, also known as magnetic declination, is the difference in angle between
magnetic north and true geographic north. In some geographic locations, the difference between
magnetic and geographic north is great enough to cause the compass to give false readings. If this
problem occurs, the compass variance must be set.
NOTE: If the vehicle is taken on long trips into a new variance zone the compass function may be
effected. Compass variance will need to be
updated to the new zone number to function properly.
NOTE: The default for the compass variance from the factory is 8.
To set the compass variance:
1. Using the Variance Settings Map, find your geographic location and note the zone number.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Adjustments > Manual Compass Calibration > Page 9418
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position. Press and release the MENU push button (1)
until "Personal Settings" is displayed. 3. Press the STEP push button (4) until "Compass Variance"
is displayed. The "Compass Variance" message and the current variance zone number
will be displayed.
4. Press and release the RESET push button (3) to toggle through the zone numbers (1-15), until
the zone number for your geographic location
appears in the display.
NOTE: The default for the compass variance from the factory is 8. During programming, the Zone
value will wrap around from Zone 15 to
Zone 1.
5. Press and release the Compass Temperature (C/T) push button (2) to enter the displayed zone
number into the compass unit memory. 6. Confirm that the correct directions are now indicated by
the compass.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Procedures
COMPASS DEMAGNETIZING
DEGAUSSING TOOL #6029
A degaussing tool (Special Tool 6029) is used to demagnetize, or degauss, the roof panel of the
vehicle. Equivalent units must be rated as continuous duty for 110/115 volts and 60 Hz. They must
also have a field strength of over 350 gauss at 7 millimeters (0.25 inch) beyond the tip of the probe.
To demagnetize the roof panel proceed as follows:
1. Be certain that the ignition switch is in the Off position, before you begin the demagnetizing
procedure.
2. Place a piece of paper approximately 22 by 28 centimeters (8.5 by 11 inches), oriented on the
vehicle lengthwise from front to rear, on the center
line of the roof at the windshield header. The purpose of the paper is to protect the roof panel from
scratches, and to define the area to be demagnetized.
3. Connect the degaussing tool to an electrical outlet, while keeping the tool at least 61 centimeters
(2 feet) away from the vehicle. 4. Slowly approach the center line of the roof panel at the windshield
header, with the degaussing tool connected. 5. Contact the roof panel with the plastic coated tip of
the degaussing tool. Be sure that the template is in place to avoid scratching the roof panel.
Using a slow, back-and-forth sweeping motion, and allowing 13 millimeters (0.50 inch) between
passes, move the tool at least 11 centimeters (4 inches) to each side of the roof center line, and 28
centimeters (11 inches) back from the windshield header.
6. With the degaussing tool still energized, slowly back it away from the roof panel. When the tip of
the tool is at least 61 centimeters (2 feet) from
the roof panel, disconnect the tool.
7. Calibrate the compass, See: Adjustments and adjust the compass variance, See: Adjustments.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9421
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Removal and Replacement
Electronic Vehicle Information Center Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the driver airbag. See: Restraint
Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Removal. 3. Using a trim
stick (special tool # C-4755) or equivalent, gently pry the switch and bezel assembly (3) away from
the steering wheel at the inner
retaining tab (1) and the outer bezel edge (2).
4. With the switch and bezel assembly free from the steering wheel, lift the assembly up and
disconnect the switch electrical connector.
5. Using trim stick (special tool # C-4755) or equivalent, gently pry the switch bezel retainers (2)
away from the switch tabs (1), while applying
pressure to the back side of the switch. Remove the switch from the bezel.
Electronic Vehicle Information Center Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9422
1. Position the steering wheel switch onto the switch bezel aligning the switch tabs (1) with the
bezel retainers (2). 2. Press the switch into the bezel, until the switch is held in place by all four
retainers.
3. Position the switch and bezel assembly (3) over the steering wheel and connect the switch
electrical connector. 4. Align the switch bezel tab (1) with the slot in the steering wheel and press
the switch and bezel assembly (3) into the steering wheel until it is
secured in place.
5. Install the driver airbag. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and
Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation. 6. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any SRS component. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Restraints System Verification Test.
7. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9423
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Tools and Equipment
SPECIAL TOOLS
DE GAUSER - 6029
RF Detector - 9001
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9428
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9429
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9430
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 4 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way > Page 9433
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C2 (AWD) (Fuel Tank Jumper) 2 Way
Connector C2 (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module contains the electric fuel pump, fuel pump
reservoir, fuel level sending unit, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter.
The fuel level sending unit is serviceable See: Service and Repair/Removal.
The fuel pump module, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter is serviced as an
assembly See: Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel pump modules.
The AWD fuel pump modules contains the main fuel pump module (1), auxiliary fuel pump module
(2), main fuel level sending unit, auxiliary fuel level sending unit, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure
regulator and fuel filter.
The main fuel level sending unit is located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Service and Repair/Removal. The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary
fuel pump module and is serviced as an assembly See: Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 9436
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Operation
OPERATION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module is located inside the fuel tank with a fuel level
sending unit and pressure regulator. The fuel pump module is a positive displacement, gerotor,
driven by a 12 volt DC permanent magnet electric motor.
The fuel pump module draws fuel through a internal filter and pushes it through the motor to an
outlet pipe. The fuel pump module contains two check valves. One valve relieves internal fuel
pump pressure and regulates maximum pump output. The second valve, in the pump outlet,
maintains pump pressure during engine off conditions.
The fuel pump pressure regulator contains a calibrated spring which forces a diaphragm against
the fuel filter return port. When pressure exceeds the calibrated amount, the diaphragm retracts,
allowing excess fuel pressure in the fuel pump module to purge into the fuel tank.
The maximum deadhead pressure is approximately 880 kPa (130 psi). The fuel pump pressure
regulator adjusts fuel system pressure to approximately 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi).
AWD
Operation of the all wheel drive (AWD) main fuel pump module is similar to the FWD with the
addition of a auxiliary fuel pump module with a auxiliary fuel level sending unit and draws fuel from
the base of the auxiliary fuel pump module (2) through an internal tube.
The auxiliary fuel pump module flow rate is greater than the vehicle fuel consumption rate so that
the auxiliary side of the tank is emptied before fuel is depleted from the primary side.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page 9437
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles have a serviceable fuel level sending unit located on the fuel
pump reservoir See: Service and Repair/Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel level sending units.
The main fuel level sending unit located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Service and Repair/Removal.
The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module. The
auxiliary fuel pump module and the fuel level sending unit is serviced as an assembly See: Service
and Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Removal
REMOVAL
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Fuel Tank - Removal.
NOTE: Prior to removing the main fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel tank
opening.
2. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 3. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 4. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
5. Mark the main fuel pump module orientation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9440
WARNING: The fuel pump module reservoir does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir will spill out when the
module is removed.
NOTE: Do not spill fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
6. Raise the main fuel pump module out of the fuel tank using caution not spill fuel inside the
vehicle.
7. Tip the main fuel pump module and drain enough fuel from the main fuel pump module reservoir
to gain access to the internal fuel line without
spilling fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
8. If equipped with AWD, disconnect the internal fuel line from the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9441
9. Remove the main fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
10. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9442
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Fuel Tank - Removal.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
2. Mark the auxiliary fuel pump module orientation (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing the auxiliary fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel
tank opening.
3. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 4. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 5. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
6. Raise the auxiliary fuel pump module and disconnect the internal fuel line. 7. Remove the
auxiliary fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9443
8. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9444
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. If equipped with AWD, Connect the internal fuel line to the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9445
3. Lower the main fuel pump module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the main fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be performed for
the fuel level gauge to work properly.
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the main fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel
Tank - Installation.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9446
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. Connect the internal fuel line to the auxiliary fuel pump module. 3. Lower the auxiliary fuel pump
module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the auxiliary fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be
performed for the fuel gauge to work properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9447
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the auxiliary fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel
Tank - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9448
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel. Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked and approved containers.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Remove the fuel pump module See: Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
2. Disconnect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector (1).
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not pull the fuel level sending unit by the wires or the float arm.
3. Using your finger, press the fuel level sending unit snap tab to the left while gently pushing up on
the bottom of the fuel level sending unit and
remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9449
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not handle the new fuel level sending unit by the float arm.
1. Position the new fuel level sending unit to the fuel pump module reservoir.
2. Gently push the fuel level sending unit down until the snap tab (2) engages.
CAUTION: Ensure the fuel level sending unit wires are routed so they do not get pinched between
the coils of the spring when the module is
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9450
completely compressed.
3. Connect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector. 4. Install the fuel pump module See:
Fuel Pump Module - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for DC/AC Inverter: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation
Technical Service Bulletin # J09 Date: 090325
Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation
March 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J09 Power Inverter Connector
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles NOT equipped with a 115 volt power inverter (sales
code JKV) built through February 6, 2009 (MDH 020614).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle
inventory. Federal law requires you to complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail
delivery. Dealers should also consider this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and
should perform this recall on vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using
the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector on about 16,800 of the above vehicles may
become contaminated, potentially causing the connector to melt and/or catch fire.
Repair
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector must be relocated and the 25 amp fuse for the
9-way white connector must be removed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
Parts Information
Special Tools
No special tools are required to perform this repair.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for DC/AC Inverter: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9460
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Move the driver's seat to the full forward position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for DC/AC Inverter: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9461
2. Working from the left rear door opening, locate the seat wiring harness where it comes through
the slit in the carpet under the driver's seat (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for DC/AC Inverter: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9462
3. Locate the taped back 9-way white connector under the carpet by accessing it through the
carpet slit (Figure 2).
4. Break the tape and pull the 9-way white connector through the carpet opening toward the seat
in-line connectors (Figure 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for DC/AC Inverter: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9463
5. Using a plastic tie strap, permanently tie back the white 9-way connector approximately 2 inches
(50 mm) from the back of the seat inline grey
connector.
CAUTION:
Assure that the 9-way white connector cannot lay on the carpet.
6. Move the seat back to its original position.
7. Open the hood.
8. Locate the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) in the engine compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for DC/AC Inverter: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9464
9. Open the cover on the TIPM and locate, remove and discard the 25 amp fuse shown in Figure 4.
10. Close the cover on the TIPM.
11. Close the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for DC/AC Inverter: > J09 > Mar > 09 > Recall Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9465
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for DC/AC Inverter: > NHTSA09V082000 > Mar >
09 > Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
DC/AC Inverter: Recalls Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler
LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: March 09, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V082000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Electrical System
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 16852
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 16,852 M/Y 2009 Dodge Journey equipped without optional 115
volt auxiliary power outlet. An unused electrical connector for the optional 115 volt auxiliary power
outlet option may become corroded and could short circuit.
CONSEQUENCE: If the fuse for this circuit does not blow, the connector could overheat and
potentially catch fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will re-route and stow the 115 volt auxiliary power outlet connector and pull the
25 amp fuse to remove power from this unused circuit free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin during March 2009. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. J09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for DC/AC Inverter: > J09
> Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation
Technical Service Bulletin # J09 Date: 090325
Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation
March 2009
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Safety Recall J09 Power Inverter Connector
Models
2009 (JC) Dodge Journey
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles NOT equipped with a 115 volt power inverter (sales
code JKV) built through February 6, 2009 (MDH 020614).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle
inventory. Federal law requires you to complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail
delivery. Dealers should also consider this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory and
should perform this recall on vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using
the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector on about 16,800 of the above vehicles may
become contaminated, potentially causing the connector to melt and/or catch fire.
Repair
The power inverter 9-way white electrical connector must be relocated and the 25 amp fuse for the
9-way white connector must be removed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM).
Parts Information
Special Tools
No special tools are required to perform this repair.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for DC/AC Inverter: > J09
> Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9475
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Dealers are encouraged to consider alternative scheduling and servicing approaches for this recall.
This repair does not require hoists or other full service facility special equipment and is a Chrysler
Mobile Service approved repair.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow Up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler
Service Procedure
1. Move the driver's seat to the full forward position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for DC/AC Inverter: > J09
> Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9476
2. Working from the left rear door opening, locate the seat wiring harness where it comes through
the slit in the carpet under the driver's seat (Figure 1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for DC/AC Inverter: > J09
> Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9477
3. Locate the taped back 9-way white connector under the carpet by accessing it through the
carpet slit (Figure 2).
4. Break the tape and pull the 9-way white connector through the carpet opening toward the seat
in-line connectors (Figure 2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for DC/AC Inverter: > J09
> Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9478
5. Using a plastic tie strap, permanently tie back the white 9-way connector approximately 2 inches
(50 mm) from the back of the seat inline grey
connector.
CAUTION:
Assure that the 9-way white connector cannot lay on the carpet.
6. Move the seat back to its original position.
7. Open the hood.
8. Locate the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) in the engine compartment.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for DC/AC Inverter: > J09
> Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9479
9. Open the cover on the TIPM and locate, remove and discard the 25 amp fuse shown in Figure 4.
10. Close the cover on the TIPM.
11. Close the hood.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for DC/AC Inverter: > J09
> Mar > 09 > Recall - Power Inverter Connector Relocation > Page 9480
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > DC/AC
Inverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for DC/AC Inverter: >
NHTSA09V082000 > Mar > 09 > Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
DC/AC Inverter: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 09V082000: Power Inverter Connector
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/Journey 2009 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler
LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: March 09, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V082000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Electrical System
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 16852
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 16,852 M/Y 2009 Dodge Journey equipped without optional 115
volt auxiliary power outlet. An unused electrical connector for the optional 115 volt auxiliary power
outlet option may become corroded and could short circuit.
CONSEQUENCE: If the fuse for this circuit does not blow, the connector could overheat and
potentially catch fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will re-route and stow the 115 volt auxiliary power outlet connector and pull the
25 amp fuse to remove power from this unused circuit free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin during March 2009. Owners may contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. J09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Vehicle Information Center Setup
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Vehicle Information Center
Setup
NUMBER: 08-002-09
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: February 4, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-014-07, DATED JULY 11,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITIONAL YEARS AND MODELS.
SUBJECT: Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Oil Change Indicator System - Dealer
Preferences During Prep
MODELS:
2008 (DR) Ram Truck
**2009 (HB) Durango**
**2009 (HG) Aspen**
**2009 (JC) Journey**
**2008 - 2009 (KA) Nitro**
**2008 - 2009 (KK) Liberty**
**2009 (LC) Challenger**
**2008 - 2009 (LX) 300 / Magnum / Charger**
**2008 - 2009 (RI) Caravan / Town & Country**
NOTE:
This Bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a programmable EVIC.
DISCUSSION:
**Many models now include an oil change indicator system**. This system displays an "Oil Change
Required" or "Oil Change" message at appropriate intervals on the instrument cluster.
The vehicles listed above may be equipped with a programmable display on the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center, (EVIC). The "Oil Change Required message may also include the dealerships
name and phone number which can be programmed into the vehicle with the StarSCAN(R) or
StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
NOTE:
**Other vehicles may be added at any time. Dealers can determine if the feature is available by
following the procedures below. If Enable/Disable Dealer Contact Information is active, the feature
can be used to enter the servicing dealer's information.**
The following procedure describes the steps to add, delete or change a dealership name and
phone number on the display.
NOTE:
If NOT programmed during vehicle prep, customer approval MUST be obtained before adding or
changing this information.
NOTE:
When performing this Procedure, the software release level in the StarSCAN(R) or
StarMOBILE(R); must be programmed with the latest level software. The software release level is
visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R) screen.
1. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or StarMOBILE(R). (in Pass-Through Mode)
NOTE:
To use the StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode requires that StarMOBILE(R) be connected to
the dealership network via a wired or wireless connection. For more information on how to use the
StarMOBILE(R) in Pass-Through Mode, see the StarMOBILE(R) training tutorials available on
DealerCONNECT > Service > Repair > StarSCAN(R) and StarMOBILE(R) Tools link or at the
website.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Vehicle Information Center Setup > Page 9489
2. From the Home Screen, enter "ECU VIEW or "VEHICLE PREP".
3. Select "CCN".
4. Select "Misc. Functions".
5. Select "Enable/Disable Dealer Contact Information".
6. Select "Enable" or "Disable" as desired.
7. If enabled, select "Program Dealer Contact Information" and follow on screen prompts.
8. "Reset will cause display to read: "Contact Dealer" as default.
9. Select finish to exit.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp >
Component Information > Service and Repair > EVIC Equipped Vehicles
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair EVIC Equipped Vehicles
Oil Change Required
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change indicator system. The Oil Change Required
message will flash in the EVIC for approximately 5 seconds after a single chime has sounded to
indicate the next scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change indicator system is duty
cycle based, which means the engine oil change interval may fluctuate dependent upon your
personal driving style.
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each time you turn the ignition switch to the ON
position. To turn off the message temporarily, press and release the MENU button on the
instrument cluster. To reset the oil change indicator system (after performing the scheduled
maintenance) perform the following procedure:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Do not start the engine). 2. Fully depress the
accelerator pedal slowly three times within 10 seconds. 3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK
position.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you start the vehicle, the oil change indicator
system did not reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp >
Component Information > Service and Repair > EVIC Equipped Vehicles > Page 9492
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair Non-EVIC Equipped Vehicles
Change Oil Message (Base and Mid Line Clusters)
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change indicator system. The CHANGE OIL message
will flash in the instrument cluster odometer for approximately 12 seconds after a single chime has
sounded to indicate the next scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change indicator system
is duty cycle based, which means the engine oil change interval may fluctuate dependent upon
your personal driving style.
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each time you turn the ignition switch to the ON
position. To turn off the message temporarily, press and release the TRIP ODOMETER button on
the instrument cluster. To reset the oil change indicator system (after performing the scheduled
maintenance) perform the following procedure:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Do not start the engine). 2. Fully depress the
accelerator pedal slowly three times within 10 seconds. 3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK
position.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you start the vehicle, the oil change indicator
system did not reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sender: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9496
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9497
Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams
Connector (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE (GAS) - (ENGINE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display > Outside
Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Ambient Temperature Sensor Description
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Description and Operation Ambient Temperature Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
The ambient temperature sensor (1) is a variable resistor located under the bottom right side of the
front bumper reinforcement (2). The sensor is attached to the power steering line bracket with a
pushpin style retainer and can be accessed through the right opening in the front fascia assembly.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if inoperative or damaged,
must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display > Outside
Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Ambient Temperature Sensor Description > Page 9503
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Description and Operation Ambient Temperature Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The ambient temperature sensor is a variable resistor that operates on a five-volt reference signal.
The resistance in the sensor changes as temperature changes, changing the temperature sensor
signal circuit voltage to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). Based upon the resistance in
the sensor, the instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN),
display senses a specific voltage on the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus circuit, which
corresponds to a specific temperature. The applicable instrument cluster display then displays the
proper ambient temperature.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display > Outside
Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9504
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Testing and Inspection
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor, a wiring circuit, the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus, the Local Area Network (LIN) data bus and the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM). When the sensor is exposed to temperatures above 60° C (130°
F), or if the sensor circuit is shorted, 60° C (130° F) will appear in the display in place of the
temperature. When the sensor is exposed to temperatures below - 40° C (- 40° F) or if the sensor
circuit is open, - 40° C (- 40° F) will appear in the display.
The ambient temperature sensor circuit can be diagnosed using the following Temperature System
Test, and Sensor Test. If the temperature sensor and circuit are confirmed to be OK, but the
temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, further testing of the instrument cluster may be
necessary. See: Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics for the appropriate procedure.
SENSOR TEST
1. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor harness
connector. 2. Measure the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor. At - 40° C (- 40° F), the
sensor resistance is 336 kilohms. At 55° C (130° F), the sensor
resistance is 2.488 kilohms. The sensor resistance should read between these two values. If OK,
further testing of the instrument cluster may be necessary. See: Instrument Cluster /
Carrier/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics for the appropriate
procedure. If not OK, replace the inoperative ambient temperature sensor.
SENSOR CIRCUIT TEST
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
NOTE: Temperature readings do not update immediately. Allow up to 60 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the "ON" position for
readings to meet test specifications.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the
ambient temperature sensor. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position. The display should
now read - 40° C (- 40° F). If OK, go to 3. If not OK, repair the shorted sensor
return circuit or ambient temperature sensor signal circuit to the ambient temperature sensor as
required.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Taking care not to damage the wire terminals,
connect a jumper wire between the two terminals in
the body half of the ambient temperature sensor harness connector.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position. The display should now read 60° C (130° F). If OK,
go to 5. If not OK, repair the open sensor
return circuit or ambient temperature sensor signal circuit to the ambient temperature sensor as
required.
NOTE: If the EVIC display does not show the ambient temperature in step 4, the vehicle may need
to be driven several miles at a speed
greater than 32 km/h (20 mph) for the temperature to update.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Remove the jumper wire. Turn the ignition switch
to the "ON" position and wait until the display
again reads - 40° C (- 40° F). Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Reconnect the ambient
temperature sensor. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position. The display should now read the
ambient temperature. If OK, the problem is intermittent. Perform further diagnosis while
manipulating the related wire harnesses and components. If not OK, go to 6
6. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes that may have been set while performing the test. Perform
further diagnosis of the CAN data bus circuit, the
LIN data bus circuit, the TIPM and the ambient temperature sensor (refer to the SENSOR TEST).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display > Outside
Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Temperature Sensor - Removal
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Service and Repair Ambient Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Working through the opening in the right
side of the front fascia, disconnect the wire harness connector from the ambient temperature
sensor (1). 3. Remove the fastener that secures the ambient temperature sensor to the power
steering line bracket. 4. Remove the ambient temperature sensor from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display > Outside
Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Temperature Sensor - Removal >
Page 9507
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Service and Repair Ambient Temperature Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Working through the opening in the right side of the front fascia, position the ambient
temperature sensor (1) in the vehicle. 2. Install the fastener that secures the ambient temperature
sensor (1) to the power steering line bracket. 3. Connect the wire harness connector to the ambient
temperature sensor. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9511
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9512
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 1 WAY
SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE - (BODY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
There are two unique park brake switches used on this vehicle, depending upon whether the
vehicle has a foot-operated or hand-operated park brake lever mechanism.
FOOT-OPERATED
Foot-Operated Park Brake Switch
The foot-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the cowl
side inner panel below the instrument panel, outboard of the steering column. This switch includes
a spade-type output terminal (3) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the
stationary contact within a molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive switch
location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact with an integral grounding lug (4) on
one end and an integral actuating lever and follower (2) on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The foot-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged,
it must be replaced.
HAND-OPERATED
Hand-Operated Park Brake Switch
The hand-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the floor
panel transmission tunnel below the center floor console. This switch includes a spade-type output
terminal (2) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out
and
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page 9515
connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the stationary contact within a
molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab (4) on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive
switch location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact (3) with an integral grounding lug
on one end and an integral actuating lever and follower on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The hand-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or
damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch - Description > Page 9516
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Operation
OPERATION
Both the foot-operated and hand-operated park brake switch are normally closed, mechanically
actuated leaf contact switches that are operated by the foot or hand park brake lever mechanism.
The switch is grounded through its mounting to the park brake lever mechanism and provides a
ground input to the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab
Compartment Node/CCN) on a park brake switch sense circuit whenever the park brake is applied,
and opens this circuit whenever the park brake is released. The park brake switch sense input to
the EMIC is used as a logic input by the EMIC for control of the brake indicator and may also be
used as a logic input for other electronic features in the vehicle.
The park brake switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that rely upon inputs
from the park brake switch. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the
electronic controls and communication related to park brake switch operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9517
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
PARK BRAKE SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: If the brake indicator stays ON with the ignition switch in the ON position and the park brake
released, or comes ON while driving,
the brake system must be diagnosed and repaired prior to performing the following tests. See:
Brakes and Traction Control/Testing and Inspection . If no brake system problem is found, the
following procedures will help to locate a shorted or open park brake switch sense circuit, or an
ineffective park brake switch.
INDICATOR ILLUMINATES DURING BULB TEST, BUT DOES NOT WHEN PARK BRAKE
APPLIED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Apply the parking brake. Check for continuity between the park brake switch terminal and a good
ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake
switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavities of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and the instrument panel wire harness connector for the instrument
cluster. There should be continuity. If not OK, repair the open park brake switch sense circuit
between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster as required.
INDICATOR REMAINS ILLUMINATED - BRAKE SYSTEM CHECKS OKAY
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Check for continuity between the terminal of the park brake switch and a good ground. There
should be no continuity with the park brake released, and continuity with the park brake applied. If
OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavity of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and a good ground. There should be no continuity. If not OK, repair the
shorted park brake switch sense circuit between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster
as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Apply the parking brake. 3. Reach under
the left end of the instrument panel to access and disconnect the wire harness connector from the
terminal of the park brake switch (2)
located on the park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side inner panel.
4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever mechanism. 5.
Remove the switch from the park brake lever mechanism.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the console from the floor panel
transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center
Console - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 9520
3. Pull the parking brake lever (1) upward to apply the parking brake. 4. Disconnect the wire
harness connector from the terminal of the park brake switch (2) located on the right side of the
park brake lever mechanism. 5. Remove the screw (3) that secures the switch to the park brake
lever bracket. 6. Remove the switch from the park brake lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 9521
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to position the park brake switch (2) onto the
park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side
inner panel. Be certain to engage the locating pin on the back of the switch insulator into the
locating slot in the lever mechanism bracket.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever
mechanism. Tighten the screw to 2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to
the terminal of the park brake switch. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the ON position and check for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake
applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Position park brake switch (2) onto the right side of the park brake lever (1) bracket. Be certain to
engage the locating pin on the back of the
switch insulator into the locating slot in the lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page 9522
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the switch to the lever bracket. Tighten the screw to
2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the terminal of the switch. 4.
Reinstall the console onto the floor panel transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center
Console - Installation
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 6. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and check
for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page
9528
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page
9529
Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page
9530
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9533
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9538
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9539
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9540
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (BODY) 4 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP - (BODY) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module C1 (Body) 4 Way > Page 9543
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagrams Fuel Pump Module C2 (AWD) (Fuel Tank Jumper) 2 Way
Connector C2 (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
MODULE-FUEL PUMP (AWD) - (FUEL TANK JUMPER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module contains the electric fuel pump, fuel pump
reservoir, fuel level sending unit, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter.
The fuel level sending unit is serviceable See: Service and Repair/Removal.
The fuel pump module, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure regulator, and fuel filter is serviced as an
assembly See: Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel pump modules.
The AWD fuel pump modules contains the main fuel pump module (1), auxiliary fuel pump module
(2), main fuel level sending unit, auxiliary fuel level sending unit, fuel pump reservoir, fuel pressure
regulator and fuel filter.
The main fuel level sending unit is located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Service and Repair/Removal. The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary
fuel pump module and is serviced as an assembly See: Service and Repair/Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page
9546
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module - Operation
OPERATION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) fuel pump module is located inside the fuel tank with a fuel level
sending unit and pressure regulator. The fuel pump module is a positive displacement, gerotor,
driven by a 12 volt DC permanent magnet electric motor.
The fuel pump module draws fuel through a internal filter and pushes it through the motor to an
outlet pipe. The fuel pump module contains two check valves. One valve relieves internal fuel
pump pressure and regulates maximum pump output. The second valve, in the pump outlet,
maintains pump pressure during engine off conditions.
The fuel pump pressure regulator contains a calibrated spring which forces a diaphragm against
the fuel filter return port. When pressure exceeds the calibrated amount, the diaphragm retracts,
allowing excess fuel pressure in the fuel pump module to purge into the fuel tank.
The maximum deadhead pressure is approximately 880 kPa (130 psi). The fuel pump pressure
regulator adjusts fuel system pressure to approximately 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi).
AWD
Operation of the all wheel drive (AWD) main fuel pump module is similar to the FWD with the
addition of a auxiliary fuel pump module with a auxiliary fuel level sending unit and draws fuel from
the base of the auxiliary fuel pump module (2) through an internal tube.
The auxiliary fuel pump module flow rate is greater than the vehicle fuel consumption rate so that
the auxiliary side of the tank is emptied before fuel is depleted from the primary side.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Module - Description > Page
9547
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
FWD
The front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles have a serviceable fuel level sending unit located on the fuel
pump reservoir See: Service and Repair/Removal.
AWD
The all wheel drive (AWD) vehicles with the saddle fuel tank configurations have a main (1) and
auxiliary (2) fuel level sending units.
The main fuel level sending unit located on the main fuel pump reservoir (1) is serviceable See:
Service and Repair/Removal.
The auxiliary fuel level sending unit (2) is integrated with the auxiliary fuel pump module. The
auxiliary fuel pump module and the fuel level sending unit is serviced as an assembly See: Service
and Repair/Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Removal
REMOVAL
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Fuel Tank - Removal.
NOTE: Prior to removing the main fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel tank
opening.
2. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 3. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 4. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
5. Mark the main fuel pump module orientation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9550
WARNING: The fuel pump module reservoir does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir will spill out when the
module is removed.
NOTE: Do not spill fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
6. Raise the main fuel pump module out of the fuel tank using caution not spill fuel inside the
vehicle.
7. Tip the main fuel pump module and drain enough fuel from the main fuel pump module reservoir
to gain access to the internal fuel line without
spilling fuel into the interior of the vehicle.
8. If equipped with AWD, disconnect the internal fuel line from the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9551
9. Remove the main fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
10. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9552
1. Drain and remove the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Fuel Tank - Removal.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module has to be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
2. Mark the auxiliary fuel pump module orientation (1).
NOTE: Prior to removing the auxiliary fuel pump module, use compressed air to remove any
accumulated dirt and debris from around fuel
tank opening.
3. Position the lock-ring remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the
lock-ring. 4. Install a 1/2 inch drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 5. Rotate
the breaker bar counterclockwise and remove the lock-ring.
6. Raise the auxiliary fuel pump module and disconnect the internal fuel line. 7. Remove the
auxiliary fuel pump module from the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9553
8. Remove and discard the rubber O-ring seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9554
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module - Installation
INSTALLATION
MAIN FUEL PUMP MODULE
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. If equipped with AWD, Connect the internal fuel line to the main fuel pump module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9555
3. Lower the main fuel pump module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The main fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the main fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be performed for
the fuel level gauge to work properly.
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the main fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9340 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9340. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel
Tank - Installation.
AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP MODULE
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel, Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked OSHA approved containers.
Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9556
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber O-ring seal must be replaced.
1. Clean the rubber O-ring seal area of the fuel tank and install a new rubber O-ring seal.
2. Connect the internal fuel line to the auxiliary fuel pump module. 3. Lower the auxiliary fuel pump
module into the fuel tank using caution not to bend the float arm.
NOTE: The auxiliary fuel pump module must be properly located in the fuel tank for the fuel level
gauge to work properly.
4. Align the rubber O-ring seal and rotate the auxiliary fuel pump module to the orientation marks
noted during removal. This step must be
performed for the fuel gauge to work properly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9557
5. Position the lock-ring over top of the auxiliary fuel pump module. 6. Position the lock-ring
remover/installer 9318 into the notches on the outside edge of the lock-ring. 7. Install a 1/2 inch
drive breaker bar into the lock-ring remover/installer 9318. 8. Rotate the breaker bar clockwise until
all seven notches of the lock-ring have engaged.
9. Install the fuel tank See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel
Tank - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9558
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Risk of injury to eyes and skin from contact with fuel. Wear protective clothing and eye
protection. Risk of poisoning from
inhaling and swallowing fuel. Pour fuel only into appropriately marked and approved containers.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in possible serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The fuel system is under constant high pressure even with engine off. Until the fuel
pressure has been properly released from the
system, do not attempt to open the fuel system. Do not smoke or use open flames/sparks when
servicing the fuel system. Make sure the area in which the vehicle is being serviced is in a well
ventilated area. Failure to comply may result in serious or fatal injury.
1. Remove the fuel pump module See: Fuel Pump Module - Removal.
2. Disconnect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector (1).
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not pull the fuel level sending unit by the wires or the float arm.
3. Using your finger, press the fuel level sending unit snap tab to the left while gently pushing up on
the bottom of the fuel level sending unit and
remove.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9559
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the terminals or the resistor card.
CAUTION: Do not handle the new fuel level sending unit by the float arm.
1. Position the new fuel level sending unit to the fuel pump module reservoir.
2. Gently push the fuel level sending unit down until the snap tab (2) engages.
CAUTION: Ensure the fuel level sending unit wires are routed so they do not get pinched between
the coils of the spring when the module is
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module - Removal > Page 9560
completely compressed.
3. Connect the fuel level sending unit electrical connector. 4. Install the fuel pump module See:
Fuel Pump Module - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Outside Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Ambient Temperature
Sensor - Description
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Description and Operation Ambient Temperature Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
The ambient temperature sensor (1) is a variable resistor located under the bottom right side of the
front bumper reinforcement (2). The sensor is attached to the power steering line bracket with a
pushpin style retainer and can be accessed through the right opening in the front fascia assembly.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if inoperative or damaged,
must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Outside Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Ambient Temperature
Sensor - Description > Page 9565
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Description and Operation Ambient Temperature Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The ambient temperature sensor is a variable resistor that operates on a five-volt reference signal.
The resistance in the sensor changes as temperature changes, changing the temperature sensor
signal circuit voltage to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). Based upon the resistance in
the sensor, the instrument cluster, sometimes referred to as the Cab Compartment Node (CCN),
display senses a specific voltage on the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus circuit, which
corresponds to a specific temperature. The applicable instrument cluster display then displays the
proper ambient temperature.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Outside Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9566
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Testing and Inspection
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor, a wiring circuit, the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus, the Local Area Network (LIN) data bus and the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM). When the sensor is exposed to temperatures above 60° C (130°
F), or if the sensor circuit is shorted, 60° C (130° F) will appear in the display in place of the
temperature. When the sensor is exposed to temperatures below - 40° C (- 40° F) or if the sensor
circuit is open, - 40° C (- 40° F) will appear in the display.
The ambient temperature sensor circuit can be diagnosed using the following Temperature System
Test, and Sensor Test. If the temperature sensor and circuit are confirmed to be OK, but the
temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, further testing of the instrument cluster may be
necessary. See: Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics for the appropriate procedure.
SENSOR TEST
1. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor harness
connector. 2. Measure the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor. At - 40° C (- 40° F), the
sensor resistance is 336 kilohms. At 55° C (130° F), the sensor
resistance is 2.488 kilohms. The sensor resistance should read between these two values. If OK,
further testing of the instrument cluster may be necessary. See: Instrument Cluster /
Carrier/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics for the appropriate
procedure. If not OK, replace the inoperative ambient temperature sensor.
SENSOR CIRCUIT TEST
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
NOTE: Temperature readings do not update immediately. Allow up to 60 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the "ON" position for
readings to meet test specifications.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the
ambient temperature sensor. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position. The display should
now read - 40° C (- 40° F). If OK, go to 3. If not OK, repair the shorted sensor
return circuit or ambient temperature sensor signal circuit to the ambient temperature sensor as
required.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Taking care not to damage the wire terminals,
connect a jumper wire between the two terminals in
the body half of the ambient temperature sensor harness connector.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position. The display should now read 60° C (130° F). If OK,
go to 5. If not OK, repair the open sensor
return circuit or ambient temperature sensor signal circuit to the ambient temperature sensor as
required.
NOTE: If the EVIC display does not show the ambient temperature in step 4, the vehicle may need
to be driven several miles at a speed
greater than 32 km/h (20 mph) for the temperature to update.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Remove the jumper wire. Turn the ignition switch
to the "ON" position and wait until the display
again reads - 40° C (- 40° F). Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position. Reconnect the ambient
temperature sensor. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON" position. The display should now read the
ambient temperature. If OK, the problem is intermittent. Perform further diagnosis while
manipulating the related wire harnesses and components. If not OK, go to 6
6. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes that may have been set while performing the test. Perform
further diagnosis of the CAN data bus circuit, the
LIN data bus circuit, the TIPM and the ambient temperature sensor (refer to the SENSOR TEST).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Outside Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Temperature Sensor Removal
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Service and Repair Ambient Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Working through the opening in the right
side of the front fascia, disconnect the wire harness connector from the ambient temperature
sensor (1). 3. Remove the fastener that secures the ambient temperature sensor to the power
steering line bracket. 4. Remove the ambient temperature sensor from the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Outside Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Temperature Sensor Removal > Page 9569
Outside Temperature Display Sensor: Service and Repair Ambient Temperature Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Working through the opening in the right side of the front fascia, position the ambient
temperature sensor (1) in the vehicle. 2. Install the fastener that secures the ambient temperature
sensor (1) to the power steering line bracket. 3. Connect the wire harness connector to the ambient
temperature sensor. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9573
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9574
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 1 WAY
SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE - (BODY) 1 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch Description
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
There are two unique park brake switches used on this vehicle, depending upon whether the
vehicle has a foot-operated or hand-operated park brake lever mechanism.
FOOT-OPERATED
Foot-Operated Park Brake Switch
The foot-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the cowl
side inner panel below the instrument panel, outboard of the steering column. This switch includes
a spade-type output terminal (3) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the
stationary contact within a molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive switch
location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact with an integral grounding lug (4) on
one end and an integral actuating lever and follower (2) on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The foot-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged,
it must be replaced.
HAND-OPERATED
Hand-Operated Park Brake Switch
The hand-operated park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the floor
panel transmission tunnel below the center floor console. This switch includes a spade-type output
terminal (2) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out
and
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch Description > Page 9577
connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the stationary contact within a
molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab (4) on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive
switch location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact (3) with an integral grounding lug
on one end and an integral actuating lever and follower on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The hand-operated park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or
damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Parking Brake Switch Description > Page 9578
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Parking Brake Switch - Operation
OPERATION
Both the foot-operated and hand-operated park brake switch are normally closed, mechanically
actuated leaf contact switches that are operated by the foot or hand park brake lever mechanism.
The switch is grounded through its mounting to the park brake lever mechanism and provides a
ground input to the Electro Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab
Compartment Node/CCN) on a park brake switch sense circuit whenever the park brake is applied,
and opens this circuit whenever the park brake is released. The park brake switch sense input to
the EMIC is used as a logic input by the EMIC for control of the brake indicator and may also be
used as a logic input for other electronic features in the vehicle.
The park brake switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that rely upon inputs
from the park brake switch. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the
electronic controls and communication related to park brake switch operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9579
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
PARK BRAKE SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
NOTE: If the brake indicator stays ON with the ignition switch in the ON position and the park brake
released, or comes ON while driving,
the brake system must be diagnosed and repaired prior to performing the following tests. See:
Brakes and Traction Control/Testing and Inspection . If no brake system problem is found, the
following procedures will help to locate a shorted or open park brake switch sense circuit, or an
ineffective park brake switch.
INDICATOR ILLUMINATES DURING BULB TEST, BUT DOES NOT WHEN PARK BRAKE
APPLIED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Apply the parking brake. Check for continuity between the park brake switch terminal and a good
ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake
switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavities of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and the instrument panel wire harness connector for the instrument
cluster. There should be continuity. If not OK, repair the open park brake switch sense circuit
between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster as required.
INDICATOR REMAINS ILLUMINATED - BRAKE SYSTEM CHECKS OKAY
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Check for continuity between the terminal of the park brake switch and a good ground. There
should be no continuity with the park brake released, and continuity with the park brake applied. If
OK, go to 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C2) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavity of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and a good ground. There should be no continuity. If not OK, repair the
shorted park brake switch sense circuit between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster
as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Apply the parking brake. 3. Reach under
the left end of the instrument panel to access and disconnect the wire harness connector from the
terminal of the park brake switch (2)
located on the park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side inner panel.
4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever mechanism. 5.
Remove the switch from the park brake lever mechanism.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the console from the floor panel
transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center
Console - Removal
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page
9582
3. Pull the parking brake lever (1) upward to apply the parking brake. 4. Disconnect the wire
harness connector from the terminal of the park brake switch (2) located on the right side of the
park brake lever mechanism. 5. Remove the screw (3) that secures the switch to the park brake
lever bracket. 6. Remove the switch from the park brake lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page
9583
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Parking Brake Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
FOOT-OPERATED
1. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to position the park brake switch (2) onto the
park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side
inner panel. Be certain to engage the locating pin on the back of the switch insulator into the
locating slot in the lever mechanism bracket.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever
mechanism. Tighten the screw to 2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to
the terminal of the park brake switch. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the ON position and check for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake
applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
HAND-OPERATED
1. Position park brake switch (2) onto the right side of the park brake lever (1) bracket. Be certain to
engage the locating pin on the back of the
switch insulator into the locating slot in the lever bracket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Switch - Removal > Page
9584
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the switch to the lever bracket. Tighten the screw to
2.5 Nm (24 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the terminal of the switch. 4.
Reinstall the console onto the floor panel transmission tunnel.See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center
Console - Installation
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 6. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and check
for proper brake indicator operation with the parking brake applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable. 2. Remove the center floor console to access the
gear selector unit. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Center Console - Removal.
3. Firmly grasp the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing and rotate it
counterclockwise about 30 degrees to unlock it. 4. Pull the socket and bulb straight out from the
keyed opening in the shifter housing. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the socket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Removal > Page 9589
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair Transmission Range Indicator Lamp - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the socket (1) on the side of the gear selector housing. 2. Push
the bulb straight into the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the
keyed opening in the side of the gear selector housing. 4. Insert the bulb and socket into the
housing until the socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it
into place. 6. Reinstall the center floor console. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center Console - Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION
CAUTION: The Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPM system
pressures have been established for the tire size equipped on the vehicle. Undesirable system
operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same
size, type, or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause sensor damage. Do not use aftermarket tire
sealants or balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with TPM, as damage to the sensors may
result.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. Use tire
pressure sensors in original style factory wheels
only. If aftermarket wheels are installed, and therefore do not contain tire pressure sensors, the
system will not function properly and the driver will be continuously notified of a system
malfunction.
CAUTION: After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure always reinstall the valve stem cap. This
will prevent moisture and dirt from
entering the valve stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Sensor.
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensor valve stem caps and cores are specially designed for the sensors.
Due to risk of corrosion, do not use a
standard valve stem cap or core in a tire pressure sensor in place of the original equipment style
sensor cap and core.
CAUTION: Any time a sensor is to be installed in a wheel, it is necessary to install a new
sensor-to-wheel seal, metal washer and valve stem
nut, to ensure air tight sealing.
CAUTION: When installing the valve core, be sure to tighten the core to specifications See:
Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Wheels/Specifications
. Overtightening by a little as three or four inch pounds can damage the sensor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Description
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM), one tire pressure sensor (6) is
mounted to each wheel (5) in place of the traditional tire valve stem. Each sensor has an internal
battery that lasts up to 10 years. The battery is not serviceable. At the time of battery failure, the
sensor must be replaced.
The TPM system operates on a 433 MHz radio frequency. The 433 MHz sensors (1) can be easily
identified by the part number.
CAUTION: Although additional sensors operating at 433 MHz sensors are available and are used
in other applications, they are not
interchangeable. Always make sure the correct sensor is being used and be sure to replace the
sensor with the correct part number.
NOTE: Once mounted inside a tire and wheel assembly you are not able to visually see the
difference between this sensor and other 315 MHz
and 433 MHz sensors. At that point, the TPM/RKE Analyzer 9936, with the Scan Tool may be used
to identify the sensor frequency or the tire can be dismounted allowing visual inspection of the
sensor body and part number.
The TPM sensors are designed for original style factory wheels. It is not recommended to install a
tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel (This could cause sealing and system performance
issues). Do not attempt to install a tire pressure sensor in an aftermarket wheel. If aftermarket
wheels are installed and do not contain tire pressure sensors, the system will not function properly
and the driver will be continuously notified of a system malfunction.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description >
Page 9596
The serviceable components of the tire pressure sensor are:
- Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2) and Metal Washer (1)
- Valve Stem Cap (4)
- Valve Stem Core
- Valve Stem Nut (with pressed-in washer) (3)
NOTE: Any time a sensor is installed on a wheel, a new Sensor-To-Wheel Seal (2), Metal Washer
(1) and Valve Stem Nut (3) must be installed
to ensure air tight sealing. A service kit is available.
The valve stem caps and cores are specifically designed for the tire pressure monitoring sensors.
Although similar to standard valve stem caps and cores, they are different. The valve stem cap has
a special seal inside to keep moisture and corrosion out. The valve stem core has a special nickel
coating to protect from corrosion.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Description >
Page 9597
Tire Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor Operation
OPERATION
The battery operated tire pressure sensor is both a transmitter and a receiver. The TPM sensor can
be forced to transmit by using a special tool such as a TPM-RKE Analyzer. Using a TPM-RKE
Analyzer can take up to a minute to force a transmission from a sensor.
NOTE: The TPM-RKE Analyzer will not define the mode.
The TPM sensor can be in one of the following operating modes:
- OFF MODE - A new TPM sensor will be in this mode. In this mode the sensor does not transmit
periodically on its own. By forcing a transmission from the sensor with the TPM-RKE Analyzer, it
will change to the STATIONARY MODE. The sensor will also automatically change from OFF
mode to the STATIONARY MODE once it experiences a great increase in pressure (i.e. installation
into a wheel/tire assembly and then inflated).
- WAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes when the vehicle is driven over
15mph (24km/h), but only after the vehicle was previously parked for a duration of 18 minutes or
greater. In WAL MODE the sensors transmit every 33 seconds and these transmissions contain
left/right information that allows the TPM Module to determine sensor location on the vehicle. WAL
MODE lasts for the first 10 minutes of consecutive driving, then NORMAL DRIVE mode ensues.
- FACTORY MODE- This is a special case of WAL MODE. If a TPM sensor has just been taken out
of OFF MODE, then for the first 3 minutes of the WAL period (10 minutes) the sensors transmit at
an accelerated rate of every 10 seconds. After the first 20 drives, then the sensors never again
transmit out of FACTORY MODE.
- NORMAL MODE - This is the operating mode the sensor assumes after the first 10 minutes of a
drive. In NORMAL MODE the sensors transmit every 66 seconds and cease transmitting left/right
information.
- SERVICE MODE- Once a vehicle stops, the sensors go into SERVICE MODE. After 18 minutes
of no driving then the sensors go into the STATIONARY MODE. If the vehicle was stopped for less
than 18 minutes and driving resumes, then the sensors go back to the NORMAL MODE.
- STATIONARY MODE - When a vehicle has been stopped for more then 18 minutes, then the
sensor is forced into STATIONARY MODE. In STATIONARY MODE the sensor never transmits
any pressure information. The sensor leaves STATIONARY MODE and enters WAL MODE when
the vehicle is driven above 15mph (24km/h).
Each sensor's (transmitter) broadcast is uniquely coded so that the TPM module can monitor the
state of each of the sensors on the four rotating road wheels. The TPM module can automatically
learn and store the sensor's ID while driving "within 20 minutes continuously above 15 mph (24
km/h)" after a sensor has been replaced. The vehicle must be stationary for more then 20 minutes
in order to initiate the learning sequence. The TPM module can also learn the sensor's ID using the
TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool following the procedure listed in the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. See: Maintenance 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly.
CAUTION: The cap used on this valve stem contains an O-ring seal to prevent contamination and
moisture from entering the valve stem.
Retain this valve stem cap for reuse. Do not substitute a regular valve stem cap in its place.
CAUTION: The valve stem used on this vehicle is made of aluminum and the core is nickel plated
brass. The original valve stem core must be
reinstalled and not substituted with a valve stem core made of a different material. This is required
to prevent corrosion in the valve stem caused by the different metals.
3. Dismount tire from wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions while paying special
attention to the following to avoid damaging the
pressure sensor: a. When breaking the tire bead loose from the wheel rim, avoid using the Bead
Breaker in the area of the sensor (1). That includes both outer and
inner beads of the tire.
b. When preparing to dismount the tire from the wheel, carefully insert the mounting/dismounting
tool 280° from the valve stem ± 10°, then
proceed to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use this process on both outer and inner tire beads.
4. Remove sensor nut (3) retaining sensor to wheel. While removing nut, hold pressure against
rear of metal valve stem to keep valve stem from
pushing rearward, damaging antenna strap.
5. Remove sensor (1) from wheel (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 9600
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before reinstalling an existing tire pressure sensor, replace seal (2) and metal washer (1) at
base of sensor valve stem (6) to ensure
proper sealing.
1. Wipe area clean around sensor/valve stem mounting hole in wheel (5). Make sure surface of
wheel is not damaged.
CAUTION: To avoid damaging sensor antenna strap (1), if equipped, hold pressure against rear of
metal valve stem (2) while sensor is
inserted through wheel mounting hole and nut is installed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 9601
2. Insert sensor (1) through wheel (2) as shown keeping pressure against rear of metal valve stem
(See Arrow). Potted side of sensor is to be
positioned toward wheel. Do not attempt to mount sensor otherwise, damage may occur.
3. Install sensor nut (with pressed-in washer) (3) by hand.
NOTE: Before tightening sensor nut, push downward on sensor housing (2) in an attempt to make
it flush with interior contour of wheel (1).
4. While holding sensor in position, tighten sensor nut to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Over-torquing the sensor nut by as little as 12 Nm (106 in. lbs.) may result in sensor
separation from the valve stem. Under this
condition, the sensor may still function. However, the condition should be corrected immediately.
5. Mount tire on wheel following tire changer manufacturers instructions, paying special attention to
the following to avoid damaging tire pressure
sensor: a.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 9602
Rotating Wheel Tire Changers - Once the wheel is mounted to the changer, position the sensor
valve stem (2) approximately 280° from the head of the changer (located at 1) in a clockwise
direction before rotating the wheel (also in a clockwise direction) to mount the tire. Use this
procedure on both the outer and inner tire beads.
b.
Rotating Tool Tire Changers - Position the wheel on the changer so that the sensor valve stem (1)
is located approximately 210° clockwise from the installation end of the mounting/dismounting tool
(2) once the tool is mounted for tire installation. Make sure the sensor is clear of the lower bead
breaker area (3) to avoid damaging the sensor when the breaker rises. Rotate the tool (2) in a
counterclockwise direction to mount the tire. Use this procedure on both the upper and lower tire
beads.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensor - Removal > Page 9603
6. Adjust air pressure to that listed on Tire Inflation Pressure Label (Placard) provided with vehicle
(applied to driver's side B-pillar). Make sure
original style and color valve stem cap is securely installed to keep moisture out of sensor.
7. Install tire and wheel assembly (1) on vehicle See: Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Tires and
Wheels - Installation. Tighten wheel mounting nuts (3) to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower vehicle. 9. Perform one of the following to make the system learn the new sensor ID.
a. Use the TPM-RKE Analyzer, Special Tool 9936, with the Scan Tool to program the WIN with the
tire pressure sensor ID. This is part of the
TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
b. Once the vehicle has remained stationary for more than 20 minutes, drive vehicle for a minimum
of 10 minutes while maintaining a continuous
speed above 15 mph (24 km/h). During this time, the system will learn the new sensor ID. This is
part of the TPM Diagnostic Verification Test, See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Vehicle Theft Security Verification Tests/Tire Pressure Monitor
(TPM) Verification Test.
NOTE: If a sensor cannot be trained, refer to appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9607
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 3 WAY
LAMP-PRNDL - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Backup Lamp Switch - Description
Backup Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Backup Lamp Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with a manual transmission (2) have a normally open, spring-loaded plunger
type backup lamp switch (1). Vehicles with an optional electronic automatic transmission have a
Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) that is used to perform several functions, including that of the
backup lamp switch. The TRS is described in further detail elsewhere in this service information.
Refer to the service and diagnostic information for the automatic transmission type installed in the
vehicle.
The backup lamp switch is located in a threaded hole on the left facing surface of the manual
transmission housing. The switch has a threaded body and a hex formation near the plunger end of
the switch. An integral connector receptacle at the end of the switch opposite the plunger connects
the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the engine wire
harness. When installed, only the switch connector and the hex formation are visible on the outside
of the transmission housing.
The backup lamp switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire
switch unit must be replaced. Refer to the service and diagnostic information for the manual
transmission type installed in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Backup Lamp Switch - Description > Page 9614
Backup Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Backup Lamp Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The backup lamp switch controls a path to ground for the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM)
on the reverse switch signal circuit. The TIPM reads this input through an internal pull-up, then
controls an output through a high side driver that regulates the flow of battery voltage to the backup
lamp bulbs as appropriate on the backup lamp feed circuit. The switch plunger is mechanically
actuated by the gearshift mechanism within the transmission, which will depress the switch plunger
and close the switch contacts whenever the REVERSE gear has been selected. The switch
receives ground at all times through a take out and eyelet terminal of the wire harness that is
secured to the body sheet metal.
The backup lamp switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that rely upon
inputs from the backup lamp switch. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose
the electronic controls and communication related to backup lamp switch operation requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 9615
Backup Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
BACKUP LAMP SWITCH
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Locate and disconnect the engine wire
harness connector from the backup lamp switch connector receptacle. 3. Check for continuity
between the two terminal pins in the backup lamp switch connector receptacle.
a. With the gear selector lever in the REVERSE position, there should be continuity. b. With the
gear selector lever in any position other than REVERSE, there should be no continuity.
4. If the switch fails either of these two continuity tests, replace the ineffective backup lamp switch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Brake Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Brake Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9620
Brake Lamp Relay: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 5 WAY
RELAY-BRAKE LAMP - (BODY) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Brake Light Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal
Brake Light Bulb: Service and Repair Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal
BULB
Each rear lamp unit for this vehicle consists of two pieces. An outer rear lamp unit that is secured
at the rear of each quarter panel includes bulbs for the park (or tail) lamps, the brake (or stop)
lamps and the turn signal lamps. An inner rear lamp is secured on each outboard side of the liftgate
outer panel adjacent to the outer lamp and also includes a bulb for the park (or tail) lamps as well
as a bulb for the backup (or reverse) lamps.
OUTER LAMP
NOTE: The outer rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. They are the tail/stop/rear side marker (1) and
the turn signal (2). The service
procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may differ.
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable. 2. Remove the outer rear lamp unit. See: Service
and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp - Removal. 3. Firmly grasp the appropriate bulb socket (1 or 2 ) on
the back of the lamp housing and rotate it counterclockwise about 30 degrees to unlock it. 4. Pull
the socket and bulb straight out of the lamp. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the socket.
INNER LAMP
NOTE: The inner rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. The upper socket contains the tail lamp bulb,
while the lower socket contains the backup
lamp bulb. The service procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may
differ.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the inner rear lamp unit. See:
Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp - Removal. 3. Firmly grasp the appropriate bulb socket (3)
on the back of the lamp housing and rotate it counterclockwise about 30 degrees to unlock it. 4.
Pull the socket and bulb straight out of the lamp. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the
socket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Brake Light Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9625
Brake Light Bulb: Service and Repair Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Installation
BULB
Each rear lamp unit for this vehicle consists of two pieces. An outer rear lamp unit that is secured
at the rear of each quarter panel includes bulbs for the park (or tail) lamps, the brake (or stop)
lamps and the turn signal lamps. An inner rear lamp is secured on each outboard side of the liftgate
outer panel adjacent to the outer lamp and also includes a bulb for the park (or tail) lamps as well
as a bulb for the backup (or reverse) lamps.
OUTER LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
NOTE: The outer rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. They are the tail/stop/rear side marker (1) and
the turn signal (2). The service
procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may differ.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the appropriate bulb socket (1 or 2). 2. Push the bulb straight into
the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the keyed opening on
the back of the outer rear lamp unit housing. 4. Insert the socket and bulb into the housing until the
socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 6.
Reinstall the outer rear lamp unit. See: Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp - Installation. 7.
Reconnect the battery negative cable.
INNER LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
NOTE: The inner rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. The upper socket contains the tail lamp bulb,
while the lower socket contains the backup
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Brake Light Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9626
lamp bulb. The service procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may
differ.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the appropriate bulb socket (3). 2. Push the bulb straight into the
socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the keyed opening on the
back of the inner rear lamp unit housing. 4. Insert the socket and bulb into the housing until the
socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 6.
Reinstall the inner rear lamp unit. See: Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp - Installation. 7.
Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Stop Lamp
Switch (Early Build) (Body) 6 Way
Brake Light Switch: Diagrams Stop Lamp Switch (Early Build) (Body) 6 Way
Connector (EARLY BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
SWITCH-STOP LAMP (EARLY BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Stop Lamp
Switch (Early Build) (Body) 6 Way > Page 9632
Brake Light Switch: Diagrams Stop Lamp Switch (Normal Build) (Body) 6 Way
Connector (NORMAL BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
SWITCH-STOP LAMP (NORMAL BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Stop Lamp Switch - Description
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Stop Lamp Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable and both are
illustrated and described in the paragraphs that follow.
EARLY PRODUCTION
This brake lamp switch (2) is a three circuit, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch that is secured
to the brake pedal support bracket on the dash panel under the instrument panel on the driver side
of the vehicle. The molded plastic switch housing has an integral connector receptacle (1)
containing six terminal pins and featuring a Connector Position Assurance (CPA) lock. The switch
is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out of the body wire harness.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) on one end of the switch housing. The
plunger has a one time telescoping self-adjustment feature that is activated after the switch is
installed by moving an adjustment release lever (5) on the opposite end of the switch housing
clockwise, until it locks into a position that is horizontal and parallel to the connector receptacle.
This brake lamp switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged, ineffective, or
removed from its mounting position for any reason, it must be replaced with a new unit.
LATE PRODUCTION
This brake lamp switch (1) is a three circuit, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch that is secured
to the brake pedal support bracket under the instrument panel on the driver side of the vehicle. The
molded plastic switch housing has an integral connector receptacle (4) containing six terminal pins.
The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out of the body
wire harness.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (2) on one end of the switch housing. The
plunger has a telescoping self-adjustment feature that is activated after the switch is installed by
pulling the brake pedal upward to its normal at-rest position. The telescoping plunger can be pulled
outward from the switch housing to repeat the self-adjustment procedure if necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Stop Lamp Switch - Description > Page 9635
This brake lamp switch cannot be repaired. If the switch is damaged or ineffective it must be
replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Stop Lamp Switch - Description > Page 9636
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Stop Lamp Switch - Operation
OPERATION
Both the early and late production brake lamp switches control three independent circuits. These
circuits are described as follows:
- Brake Lamp Switch Circuit - A normally open brake lamp switch circuit receives a battery voltage
input, and supplies this battery voltage to the Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL) and the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on a brake lamp switch output circuit only when the brake
pedal is depressed (brake lamp switch plunger released).
- Brake Lamp Switch Signal Circuit - A normally closed brake lamp switch signal circuit receives a
direct path to ground, and supplies this ground input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on a
brake signal 1 circuit only when the brake pedal is released (brake lamp switch plunger is
depressed).
- Speed Control Circuit - A normally closed speed control circuit receives a battery voltage input
from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on an ignition run/start control output circuit, and
supplies this battery voltage to the PCM on a brake signal 2 circuit only when the brake pedal is
released (brake lamp switch plunger is depressed).
The PCM sends electronic brake lamp switch status messages to other electronic modules in the
vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus for use as an additional logic input for
controlling many other vehicle functions and features.
The brake lamp switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls and communication that provide some features related to brake lamp switch
operation. The most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to brake lamp switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 9637
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
Early Production
Late Production
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
CAUTION: Do not remove the Eary Production-type brake lamp switch from the mounting bracket.
The self-adjusting plunger of this switch
is a one time only feature. If the switch is removed from the mounting bracket, it MUST be replaced
with a new switch.
2. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the brake lamp switch. 3. Using an ohmmeter,
perform the continuity tests at the terminal pins (1) in the brake lamp switch connector receptacle
as shown in the Brake Lamp
Switch Tests table.
4. If the switch fails any of the continuity tests, replace the ineffective brake lamp switch as
required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 9638
Brake Light Switch: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT - LATE PRODUCTION TYPE ONLY
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable and, only the late
production type switch can be readjusted following initial installation using this adjustment
procedure. If the early production type switch requires readjustment for any reason, it must be
replaced with a new switch. Both switches are illustrated and described elsewhere in this service
information to assist in positive identification. See: Description and Operation/Stop Lamp Switch Description.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer pad from
below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Removal.
3. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 4. Pull the brake lamp switch
plunger all the way out of the switch housing to its fully extended position.
CAUTION: Brake booster damage may occur if the brake pedal pull exceeds about 9 kilograms (20
pounds).
5. Release the brake pedal. Then pull the pedal lightly upward to its normal at-rest position. The
pedal will set the plunger to the correct position as
the pedal pushes the plunger into the switch housing. The switch plunger will make a light audible
ratcheting noise as it self-adjusts.
6. If equipped, reinstall the silencer pad below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Stop Lamp Switch - Removal
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair Stop Lamp Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable. Both switches are
illustrated and described elsewhere in this service information to assist in positive identification.
See: Description and Operation/Stop Lamp Switch - Description.
EARLY PRODUCTION
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer pad from
below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Removal.
3. Locate the brake lamp switch (3) on the brake pedal support bracket (2) under the instrument
panel. 4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the switch.
5. Rotate the brake lamp switch housing (2) counterclockwise about 30 degrees to align the tabs
on the switch locking collar with the keyed hole in
the brake pedal support bracket (1).
6. Pull the switch straight rearward from the keyed hole to remove it from the bracket. 7. Discard
the removed brake lamp switch. The brake lamp switch self-adjusting plunger is a one time only
feature. If the switch is removed
from the bracket, it MUST be replaced with a new switch.
LATE PRODUCTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Stop Lamp Switch - Removal > Page 9641
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer pad from
below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Removal.
3. Locate the brake lamp switch (2) on the brake pedal support bracket (4) under the instrument
panel. 4. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 5. Rotate the brake lamp
switch housing (2) counterclockwise about 30 degrees to align the tabs on the switch locking collar
with the keyed hole in
the brake pedal support bracket.
6. Pull the switch straight rearward from the keyed hole to remove it from the bracket. 7. Release
the brake pedal. 8. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1) from the switch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Stop Lamp Switch - Removal > Page 9642
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair Stop Lamp Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable. Both switches are
illustrated and described elsewhere in this service information to assist in positive identification.
See: Description and Operation/Stop Lamp Switch - Description.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
EARLY PRODUCTION
CAUTION: The brake lamp switch self-adjusting switch plunger is a one time only feature. If the
switch is removed from the mounting
bracket, it MUST be replaced with a new switch.
1. Obtain a new brake lamp switch. The adjustment lever on the new switch should be at about a
45 degree angle to the switch connector receptacle.
If the adjustment lever is parallel with the connector receptacle, the switch adjustment has already
been set and the switch must be scrapped. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO RESET OR READJUST THE
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH.
2. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 3. Align the tabs on the brake lamp
switch (2) locking collar with the keyed hole in the brake pedal support bracket (1) below the
instrument panel. 4. Insert the tabs on the brake lamp switch locking collar through the keyed hole
in the brake pedal support bracket until the switch housing is firmly
seated against the bracket.
5. Rotate the switch housing clockwise about 30 degrees to engage the tabs on the locking collar
with the bracket.
CAUTION: Release, but do not pull up on the brake pedal before the switch plunger adjustment
has been completed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Stop Lamp Switch - Removal > Page 9643
6. Release the brake pedal, but do not pull it upward. 7. Rotate the plunger adjustment release
lever (2) clockwise until it locks into place. The lever should be parallel to the brake lamp switch
connector
receptacle. This action will set the switch plunger length to a final adjustment position and cannot
be undone. If not performed properly the first time, a new brake lamp switch MUST be installed.
8. Reconnect the wire harness connector (4) to the brake lamp switch (3). 9. If equipped, reinstall
the silencer pad below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
10. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
LATE PRODUCTION
1. Be certain that the brake lamp switch (2) plunger is pulled all the way out of the switch housing
to its fully extended position. 2. Reconnect the wire harness connector (1) to the connector
receptacle on the switch. 3. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 4. Align
the tabs on the brake lamp switch locking collar with the keyed hole in the brake pedal support
bracket (2). 5. Insert the tab on the brake lamp switch locking collar through the keyed hole in the
support bracket until the switch housing is firmly seated against
the bracket.
6. Rotate the switch housing clockwise about 30 degrees to engage the tabs on the locking collar
with the support bracket.
CAUTION: Brake booster damage may occur if the brake pedal pull exceeds about 9 kilograms (20
pounds).
7. Release the brake pedal. Then pull the pedal lightly upward to its normal at-rest position. The
pedal will set the plunger to the correct position as
the pedal pushes the plunger into the switch housing. The switch plunger will make a light audible
ratcheting noise as it self-adjusts.
8. If equipped, reinstall the silencer pad below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
9. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Cargo Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Courtesy Lamp - Removal
Cargo Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair Courtesy Lamp - Removal
BULB
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a thin flat-bladed tool, gently pry
between one end of the lamp lens (1) and the lower liftgate trim panel to remove the lens from the
liftgate
lamp housing.
3. Carefully unsnap the bulb (2) from the two bulb holders within the lamp housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Cargo Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Courtesy Lamp - Removal > Page 9649
Cargo Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair Courtesy Lamp - Installation
BULB
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the ends of the bulb (2) with the two bulb holders within the liftgate lamp housing. 2.
Carefully press the bulb firmly and evenly into the bulb holders until it snaps into place. 3. Align the
lamp lens (1) with the lamp housing, then use firm and even hand pressure to snap the lens onto
the housing. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9653
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Diagrams
Connector - (LIFTGATE) 2 WAY
LAMP-CENTER HIGH MOUNTED STOP - (LIFTGATE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center Mounted Brake Lamp - Removal
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Service and Repair Center Mounted Brake Lamp - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the
Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL) (3) to the liftgate header panel (1). 3. Pull the CHMSL
away from the liftgate far enough to access and disconnect the connector (2) of the liftgate wire
harness (1) from the connector
receptacle on the back of the lamp.
4. Remove the CHMSL from the liftgate.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center Mounted Brake Lamp - Removal > Page 9656
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Service and Repair Center Mounted Brake Lamp - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check to be certain that the two U-nuts in the Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL)
opening of the liftgate header panel are properly
installed and in good condition.
2. Position the CHMSL (3) near the opening in the liftgate header panel. 3. Reconnect the
connector (2) of the liftgate wire harness (1) to the connector receptacle on the back of the lamp. 4.
Position the CHMSL into the liftgate header opening. 5. Install and tighten the two screws (4) that
secure the CHMSL to the liftgate header panel. Tighten the screws to 1.5 Nm (15 in. lbs.). 6.
Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9661
Glove Box Lamp: Diagrams
Connector - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
LAMP-GLOVE BOX - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Glove Box Lamp Bulb - Removal
Glove Box Lamp: Service and Repair Glove Box Lamp Bulb - Removal
BULB
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Open the glove box door. 3. Reach through
and behind the upper outboard corner of instrument panel glove box opening to access the bulb (2)
on the side of the glove box
lamp and switch unit (1).
4. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the bulb holder.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Glove Box Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9664
Glove Box Lamp: Service and Repair Glove Box Lamp/Switch - Removal
LAMP/SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Open the glove box door. 3. Reach through
and behind the upper outboard corner of instrument panel glove box opening to access and
depress the retaining latch on either side
of the glove box lamp and switch unit (1).
4. While holding the retaining latch depressed, push the glove box lamp and switch unit out through
the mounting hole in the face of the instrument
panel.
5. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the glove box lamp and switch. 6. Remove the lamp
and switch unit from the instrument panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Glove Box Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9665
Glove Box Lamp: Service and Repair Glove Box Lamp Bulb - Installation
BULB
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Reach through and behind the upper outboard corner of instrument panel glove box opening to
align the base of the bulb (2) with the bulb holder
on the side of the glove box lamp and switch unit (1).
2. Push the bulb straight into the bulb holder until the base is firmly seated. 3. Close the glove box
door. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Glove Box Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9666
Glove Box Lamp: Service and Repair Glove Box Lamp/Switch - Installation
LAMP/SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the glove box lamp and switch unit (1) to the instrument panel glove box opening. 2.
Reconnect the wire harness connector to the lamp and switch unit. 3. Feed the wire harness back
through the switch mounting hole. 4. Align the lamp and switch unit with the mounting hole in the
instrument panel. 5. Using hand pressure, push the lamp and switch unit firmly and evenly into the
mounting hole until it is fully seated. 6. Close the glove box door. 7. Reconnect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9671
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9672
Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9673
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Left
Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9676
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Dome Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dome/Reading Lamp Bulb - Removal
Dome Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair Dome/Reading Lamp Bulb - Removal
Dual Lamp
BULB - DUAL LAMP
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the dual dome/reading lamp (2)
from the headliner. See: Service and Repair/Dome/Reading Lamp - Removal. 3. With the lamp lens
(1) in the open position, carefully unsnap the bulb (3) from the two bulb holders within the lamp
housing.
Overhead Console
BULB - OVERHEAD CONSOLE
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the overhead console (1) from the
headliner. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead
Console - Removal.
3. Grasp the dome/reading lamp socket (3) firmly and push it to one side far enough to unsnap the
socket latch features from the lamp housing (4). 4. Pull the socket and bulb (2) out of the lamp
housing. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the lamp socket.
Single Lamp
BULB - SINGLE LAMP
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Dome Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dome/Reading Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9682
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Insert the tip of a small flat-bladed
screwdriver into the notch (1) on one side of the dome lamp bezel between the lens and the lamp
housing. 3. Gently pry the notched edge of the lens downward until it unsnaps from the housing. 4.
Swing the notched end of the lens downward far enough to access the bulb (2). 5. Carefully
unsnap the bulb from the two bulb holders within the dome lamp housing.
Light Emitting Diode Unit
LIGHT EMITTING DIODE UNIT
NOTE: Each Light Emitting Diode (LED) dome/reading lamp contains two articulating eyeball-type
LED pod units with integral
lens-actuated switches and printed circuit boards that are available for separate service
replacement. The rear LED dome/reading lamp also has a fixed auxiliary LED and printed circuit
board unit which is also available for separate service replacement.
ARTICULATED EYEBALL POD UNIT
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the LED dome/reading lamp unit.
See: Service and Repair/Dome/Reading Lamp - Removal. 3. Using a trim stick or another suitable
wide flat-bladed tool, gently pry the pod (1) upward far enough to disengage the pivot pin on one
side of the
pod from the pivot socket of the pod receptacle.
4. Lift the pod out of its receptacle within the dome/reading lamp housing. 5. On rear LED
dome/reading lamp units only, from the top of the lamp housing, disconnect the pod pigtail wire
connector from the fixed auxiliary
LED lamp printed circuit board in the center of the lamp.
FIXED AUXILIARY LED AND CIRCUIT BOARD UNIT
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Dome Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dome/Reading Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9683
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear LED dome/reading lamp
unit. See: Service and Repair/Dome/Reading Lamp - Removal. 3. Remove and disconnect the two
articulated eyeball LED pods (1) from the lamp housing. 4. Disconnect the lamp wiring from the
auxiliary LED wiring connector (3). 5. Remove the six screws (2) that secure the printed circuit
board to the lamp housing. 6. Remove the auxiliary LED and circuit board unit from the lamp
housing (4).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Dome Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dome/Reading Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9684
Dome Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair Dome/Reading Lamp Bulb - Installation
Dual Lamp
BULB - DUAL LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. With the dome/reading lamp lens (1) in the open position, align the ends of the bulb (3) with the
two bulb holders within the lamp housing (2). 2. Carefully press the bulb firmly and evenly into the
bulb holders until it snaps into place. 3. Reinstall the lamp into the headliner. See: Service and
Repair/Dome/Reading Lamp - Installation. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Overhead Console
BULB - OVERHEAD CONSOLE
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the base of the bulb (2) with the overhead console dome/reading lamp socket (3). 2. Push
the bulb straight into the socket until the base is fully seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the
keyed opening in the lamp housing (4). 4. Insert the bulb and socket straight into the hosing until
the socket latch features are both fully engaged. 5. Reinstall the overhead console (1) to the
headliner. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Overhead
Console - Installation
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Dome Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dome/Reading Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9685
Single Lamp
BULB - SINGLE LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the ends of the bulb (2) with the two bulb holders within the dome lamp housing. 2.
Carefully press the bulb firmly and evenly into the bulb holders until it snaps into place. 3. Swing
the notched end of the lens up into position against the housing, then press upward on the lens
firmly and evenly until it snaps into the
housing.
4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Light Emitting Diode Unit
LIGHT EMITTING DIODE UNIT
NOTE: Each Light Emitting Diode (LED) dome/reading lamp contains two articulating eyeball-type
LED pod units with integral
lens-actuated switches and printed circuit boards that are available for separate service
replacement. The rear LED dome/reading lamp also has a fixed auxiliary LED and printed circuit
board unit which is also available for separate service replacement.
ARTICULATED EYEBALL POD UNIT
1. On rear LED dome/reading lamp units only, from the top of the lamp housing, reconnect the pod
pigtail wire connector to the fixed auxiliary LED
lamp printed circuit board in the center of the lamp.
2. Align the LED lamp pod (1) with the receptacle within the dome/reading lamp housing. 3.
Engage the pivot pin on one side of the pod with the pivot socket on one side of the pod receptacle.
4. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed tool, gently pry the receptacle outward far
enough to engage the pivot pin on the other side
of the pod with the other pivot socket.
5. Using a trim stick or equivalent, flex the housing at point (1) and install lamp pod. 6. Reinstall the
LED dome/reading lamp unit. See: Service and Repair/Dome/Reading Lamp - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Dome Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dome/Reading Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9686
7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
FIXED AUXILIARY LED AND CIRCUIT BOARD UNIT
1. Position the auxiliary LED and circuit board unit (4) into the lamp housing. 2. Install and tighten
the six screws (2) that secure the printed circuit board to the lamp housing. Tighten the screws
securely. 3. Reconnect the lamp wiring to the auxiliary LED wiring connector (3). 4. Reinstall and
reconnect (1) the two articulated eyeball LED pods into the lamp housing. 5. Reinstall the rear LED
dome/reading lamp unit. See: Service and Repair/Dome/Reading Lamp - Installation. 6. Reconnect
the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Flashlight > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Flashlight > Component Information > Diagrams > Flashlight
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Flashlight > Component Information > Diagrams > Flashlight > Page
9692
Flashlight: Diagrams Flashlight (Body) 3 Way
Connector - (BODY) 3 WAY
LAMP-FLASHLIGHT - (BODY) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Flashlight > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Rechargeable Flashlight - Description
Flashlight: Description and Operation Rechargeable Flashlight - Description
DESCRIPTION
An optional removable and rechargeable flashlight (3) is encased within a molded plastic housing,
which is secured within a bezel/charging station (2) at the back of the left quarter inner trim panel
(1) by two tabs on the end opposite the clear flashlight lens and a push-push type latch
mechanism. The flashlight is powered by a rechargeable and replaceable lithium battery. A
momentary switch on the flashlight electronic circuit board is actuated by a plastic push button
located on the side of the flashlight housing. When the flashlight is turned ON it illuminates two
clear Light Emitting Diode (LED) units to create a wide and bright light beam. A red LED unit on the
side of the flashlight housing behind the push button illuminates as the battery becomes discharged
to indicate that the unit requires recharging.
The bezel/charging station unit, the flashlight battery and the flashlight unit are each available for
separate service replacement. If any other component of the flashlight or bezel/charging station are
damaged or ineffective, the complete flashlight unit or bezel/charging station unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Flashlight > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Rechargeable Flashlight - Description > Page 9695
Flashlight: Description and Operation Rechargeable Flashlight - Operation
OPERATION
The rechargeable lithium battery within the flashlight automatically recharges while the flashlight is
nested in its receptacle within the bezel charging station and the engine is running. The flashlight
has a pair of electrical contacts that mate with contacts within the charging station that provide a
source of recharging current. The red Light Emitting Diode (LED) unit on the side of the flashlight
behind the ON-OFF push button illuminates when the charge of the flashlight battery is becoming
depleted.
The flashlight is removed from the bezel/charging station by pushing it momentarily at the
depression marked PUSH on the flashlight housing, then releasing it and swinging it downward far
enough to disengage two slots on the lower end of the flashlight from two tabs within the charging
station. When the flashlight is removed from its receptacle in the bezel/charging station, it can be
used as an auxiliary light source in emergencies or other situations where a portable light source is
required. The flashlight is turned ON or OFF by momentarily depressing and releasing the ON-OFF
push button on the side of the flashlight housing. Reverse the removal procedure to restore the
flashlight to the bezel/charging station and to recharge the flashlight battery.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Flashlight > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Flashlight: Procedures
FLASHLIGHT BATTERY REPLACEMENT
1. Insert a small screwdriver or another suitable tool into each of the two notches (2) between the
upper (1) and lower (3) case halves of the flashlight
and use a twisting action to separate the case.
2. Remove the lower case (4) from the upper case (3) and set it aside. 3. Lightly lift the latch tab (2)
at the back of the upper case and slide the battery (1) rearward far enough to remove it from the
case. 4. Install the new battery by sliding it between the latch tab and the case until it is engaged by
the latch tab. The battery must be installed with the
positive (+) terminal oriented toward the upper case (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Flashlight > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 9698
Flashlight: Removal and Replacement
Rechargeable Flashlight Bezel/Charging Station - Removal
BEZEL/CHARGING STATION
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Pull the rear of the left quarter trim panel
(2) away from the D-pillar far enough to access the back of the bezel/charging station (1). See:
Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter
Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the body wire harness connector (4) from the connector receptacle on the back of
the bezel/charging station. 4. Compress the spring clip retainers (3) far enough to allow the
bezel/charging station to be pushed out of the mounting hole through the face of the
quarter trim panel. Six spring clip retainers are used, three on the forward side and three on the
rearward side of the unit.
5. Remove the bezel/charging station from the vehicle.
Rechargeable Flashlight Bezel/Charging Station - Installation
BEZEL/CHARGING STATION
1. Align the bezel/charging station (1) with the mounting hole near the rear of the left quarter trim
panel (2). 2. Using hand pressure, push the bezel/charging station into the mounting hole firmly
and evenly until all 6 of the spring clip retainers (3) snap into
place on the back side of the trim panel.
3. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (4) to the connector receptacle on the back of the
bezel/charging station. 4. Reinstall the left quarter trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment
Trim/Quarter Trim Panel - Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Fog Lamp Bulb - Removal
Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair Fog Lamp Bulb - Removal
BULB
CAUTION: Do not contaminate the bulb glass by touching it with your fingers or by allowing it to
contact other oily surfaces. Shortened bulb
life will result.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the lower inner front wheel house
splash shield. See: Body and Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash
Shield - Installation.
3. Disconnect the headlamp and dash wire harness connector from the front fog lamp bulb (2)
connector receptacle (1). 4. Firmly grasp the bulb on the back of the front fog lamp housing and
rotate it counterclockwise about 30 degrees to unlock it. 5. Pull the bulb straight out from the keyed
opening in the housing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Fog Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9704
Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair Fog Lamp Bulb - Installation
BULB
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
CAUTION: Do not contaminate the bulb glass by touching it with your fingers or by allowing it to
contact other oily surfaces. Shortened bulb
life will result.
1. Align the front fog lamp bulb (2) with the keyed opening on the back of the front fog lamp
housing. 2. Insert the bulb into the housing until it is firmly seated. 3. Rotate the bulb clockwise
about 30 degrees to lock it into place. The bulb connector receptacle should be pointed outboard
and horizontal in
orientation.
4. Reconnect the headlamp and dash wire harness connector to the front fog lamp bulb connector
receptacle (1). 5. Reinstall the lower inner front wheel house splash shield. See: Body and
Frame/Fender/Front Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and
Repair/Splash Shield - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9709
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9710
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9711
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9714
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Hazard Warning Switch - Description
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation Hazard Warning Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The hazard switch (3) is integral to the instrument panel switch pod (1), which is secured to the
instrument panel center bezel just above the heater and air conditioner controls. A red, stencil-like
International Control and Display Symbol icon for Hazard Warning identifies the hazard switch
button. The remainder of the hazard switch circuitry is concealed within the instrument panel switch
pod.
The hazard switch button has panel lamps dimmer controlled illumination for night visibility. The
switch button latches to a slightly lowered position when the hazard warning system is activated
and the icon on the switch button will illuminate at an increased intensity while the turn signals and
turn signal indicators are flashing. The switch button unlatches to a position flush with the other
push buttons in the switch pod when the hazard warning is deactivated.
All of the circuitry and components of the hazard switch are contained within a molded black plastic
instrument panel switch pod housing. A single connector receptacle is integral to the back of the
switch pod housing. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The hazard switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire
instrument panel switch pod unit must be replaced. See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster Switch
Pod - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Hazard Warning Switch - Description > Page 9720
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation Hazard Warning Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The status of the hazard switch is continually monitored by the circuitry within the instrument panel
switch pod. The switch pod receives battery voltage at all times on a fused battery feed circuit, and
a path to ground at all times through the instrument panel wire harness. The only other inputs to
the switch pod consists of electronic communication with the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the single wire Local Interface
Network (LIN) data bus.
Whenever the hazard switch is in its unlatched and raised position, the hazard warning system is
selected and the switch pod circuitry provides a hard wired output to the Totally Integrated Power
Module (TIPM). When the TIPM receives a hazard switch input it then controls hazard warning
system operation and flash rate by controlling battery voltage outputs through high side drivers on
the right and left, front and rear turn signal feed circuits. The TIPM also sends the appropriate
electronic messages back to the EMIC to control the illumination and flash rate of the right and left
turn signal indicators, as well as to control the click rate of an electromechanical relay soldered
onto the EMIC electronic circuit board that emulates the sound emitted by a conventional hazard
warning flasher.
The hard wired circuits for the instrument panel switch pod may be diagnosed using conventional
diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information. However,
conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the hazard warning
switch or the electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that
provide some features of the hazard warning system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate
means to diagnose the hazard switch or the electronic controls and communication related to
hazard warning system operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headlamp Bulb: Service and Repair
BULBS
HEADLAMP HIGH BEAM
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
CAUTION: Do not contaminate the bulb glass by touching it with your fingers or by allowing it to
contact other oily surfaces. Shortened bulb
life will result.
1. Align the headlamp bulb and base (5) with the keyed opening on the back of the front lamp unit
reflector. 2. Insert the bulb into the reflector until the base is firmly seated. 3. Rotate the bulb base
clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 4. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the
connector receptacle integral to the headlamp bulb base. 5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
HEADLAMP LOW BEAM
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
CAUTION: Do not contaminate the bulb glass by touching it with your fingers or by allowing it to
contact other oily surfaces. Shortened bulb
life will result.
1. Align the headlamp bulb and base (2) with the keyed opening on the back of the front lamp unit
reflector. 2. Insert the bulb into the reflector until the base is firmly seated. 3. Rotate the bulb base
clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 4. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the
connector receptacle integral to the headlamp bulb base. 5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
POSITION LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
NOTE: The following procedure applies only to vehicles manufactured for certain export markets.
Vehicles manufactured for domestic
markets do not have a position lamp bulb, socket or wiring provided in the front lamp unit.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the position lamp bulb socket (3). 2. Push the bulb straight into
the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the keyed opening on
the back of the front lamp unit housing. 4. Insert the socket and bulb straight into the housing until
the socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 6.
Reconnect the wire harness connector to the connector receptacle integral to the position lamp
bulb socket. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 9725
TURN SIGNAL/SIDE MARKER LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the park/turn signal lamp bulb socket (1). 2. Push the bulb straight
into the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the keyed opening
on the back of the front lamp unit housing. 4. Insert the socket and bulb straight into the housing
until the socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into
place. 6. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the connector receptacle integral to the
park/turn signal lamp bulb socket. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 9731
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C2 (Steering Wheel Jumper) 7 Way
Connector C2 - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9734
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9735
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9736
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9739
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 9745
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C2 (Steering Wheel Jumper) 7 Way
Connector C2 - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9748
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9749
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9750
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9753
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9758
Horn Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
SWITCH-HORN - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Horn Switch - Removal
Horn Switch: Service and Repair Horn Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING:
On vehicles equipped with an airbag, refer to restraint systems for warnings and cautions before
servicing the horn switch.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the driver airbag. See: Restraint
Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Removal. 3. Disconnect the
connector from the clockspring. 4. Remove the three mounting fasteners. 5. Remove the horn
switch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Horn Switch - Removal > Page 9761
Horn Switch: Service and Repair Horn Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the horn switch. 2. Install the three mounting fasteners. 3. Connect the electrical
connector to the clockspring. 4. Install the driver airbag. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation 5. Connect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > License Plate Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair > License Plate Lamp Bulb - Removal
License Plate Bulb: Service and Repair License Plate Lamp Bulb - Removal
BULB
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the license plate lamp from the
underside of the liftgate handle and light bar assembly. See: Service and Repair/License Plate
Lamp Removal.
3. Pull the base of the bulb straight out of the license plate lamp bulb socket (1).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > License Plate Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair > License Plate Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9767
License Plate Bulb: Service and Repair License Plate Lamp Bulb - Installation
BULB
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
1. Align the base of the license plate lamp bulb with the socket (1). 2. Push the bulb straight into
the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the keyed opening on
the top of the license plate lamp housing. 4. Insert the bulb and socket into the housing until the
socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 6.
Reinstall the lamp into the mounting hole on the underside of the liftgate handle and light bar
assembly. See: Service and Repair/License Plate
Lamp - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9772
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9773
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9774
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9775
Parking Lamp: Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9776
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9777
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9778
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9779
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9780
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Lamp
Assembly > Page 9781
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Lamp
Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way
Parking Lamp: Diagrams Left Front Lamp Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector C1 (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-LEFT FRONT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Lamp
Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 9784
Parking Lamp: Diagrams Left Front Lamp Assembly C2 (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector C2 - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-LEFT FRONT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Lamp
Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 9785
Parking Lamp: Diagrams Left Front Lamp Assembly C3 (Front End Module) 3 Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 3 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-LEFT FRONT - (FRONT END MODULE) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Lamp
Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 9786
Parking Lamp: Diagrams Left Front Lamp Assembly C4 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector C4 (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-LEFT FRONT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Lamp
Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 9787
Parking Lamp: Diagrams
Left Front Lamp Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector C1 (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-LEFT FRONT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Left Front Lamp Assembly C2 (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector C2 - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-LEFT FRONT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Lamp
Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 9788
Left Front Lamp Assembly C3 (Front End Module) 3 Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 3 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-LEFT FRONT - (FRONT END MODULE) 3 WAY
Left Front Lamp Assembly C4 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector C4 (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-LEFT FRONT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Lamp
Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 9789
Right Front Lamp Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector C1 (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-RIGHT FRONT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Right Front Lamp Assembly C2 (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector C2 - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-RIGHT FRONT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Lamp
Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 9790
Right Front Lamp Assembly C3 (Front End Module) 3 Way
Connector C3 - (FRONT END MODULE) 3 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-RIGHT FRONT - (FRONT END MODULE) 3 WAY
Right Front Lamp Assembly C4 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way
Connector C4 (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY-RIGHT FRONT (EXCEPT EXPORT) - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Lamp
Assembly C1 (Except Export) (Front End Module) 2 Way > Page 9791
Left Tail Lamp Assembly C2 (Body/Trailer Tow) 3 Way
Connector C2 - (BODY/TRAILER TOW) 3 WAY
LAMP-ASSEMBLY TAIL-LEFT - (BODY/TRAILER TOW) 3 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9796
Brake Lamp Relay: Diagrams
Connector - (BODY) 5 WAY
RELAY-BRAKE LAMP - (BODY) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Backup Lamp Switch - Description
Backup Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Backup Lamp Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with a manual transmission (2) have a normally open, spring-loaded plunger
type backup lamp switch (1). Vehicles with an optional electronic automatic transmission have a
Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) that is used to perform several functions, including that of the
backup lamp switch. The TRS is described in further detail elsewhere in this service information.
Refer to the service and diagnostic information for the automatic transmission type installed in the
vehicle.
The backup lamp switch is located in a threaded hole on the left facing surface of the manual
transmission housing. The switch has a threaded body and a hex formation near the plunger end of
the switch. An integral connector receptacle at the end of the switch opposite the plunger connects
the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the engine wire
harness. When installed, only the switch connector and the hex formation are visible on the outside
of the transmission housing.
The backup lamp switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire
switch unit must be replaced. Refer to the service and diagnostic information for the manual
transmission type installed in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Backup Lamp Switch - Description > Page 9802
Backup Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Backup Lamp Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The backup lamp switch controls a path to ground for the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM)
on the reverse switch signal circuit. The TIPM reads this input through an internal pull-up, then
controls an output through a high side driver that regulates the flow of battery voltage to the backup
lamp bulbs as appropriate on the backup lamp feed circuit. The switch plunger is mechanically
actuated by the gearshift mechanism within the transmission, which will depress the switch plunger
and close the switch contacts whenever the REVERSE gear has been selected. The switch
receives ground at all times through a take out and eyelet terminal of the wire harness that is
secured to the body sheet metal.
The backup lamp switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that rely upon
inputs from the backup lamp switch. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose
the electronic controls and communication related to backup lamp switch operation requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9803
Backup Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
BACKUP LAMP SWITCH
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Locate and disconnect the engine wire
harness connector from the backup lamp switch connector receptacle. 3. Check for continuity
between the two terminal pins in the backup lamp switch connector receptacle.
a. With the gear selector lever in the REVERSE position, there should be continuity. b. With the
gear selector lever in any position other than REVERSE, there should be no continuity.
4. If the switch fails either of these two continuity tests, replace the ineffective backup lamp switch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Stop Lamp Switch (Early Build) (Body) 6 Way
Brake Light Switch: Diagrams Stop Lamp Switch (Early Build) (Body) 6 Way
Connector (EARLY BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
SWITCH-STOP LAMP (EARLY BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Stop Lamp Switch (Early Build) (Body) 6 Way > Page 9809
Brake Light Switch: Diagrams Stop Lamp Switch (Normal Build) (Body) 6 Way
Connector (NORMAL BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
SWITCH-STOP LAMP (NORMAL BUILD) - (BODY) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Stop Lamp Switch - Description
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Stop Lamp Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable and both are
illustrated and described in the paragraphs that follow.
EARLY PRODUCTION
This brake lamp switch (2) is a three circuit, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch that is secured
to the brake pedal support bracket on the dash panel under the instrument panel on the driver side
of the vehicle. The molded plastic switch housing has an integral connector receptacle (1)
containing six terminal pins and featuring a Connector Position Assurance (CPA) lock. The switch
is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out of the body wire harness.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) on one end of the switch housing. The
plunger has a one time telescoping self-adjustment feature that is activated after the switch is
installed by moving an adjustment release lever (5) on the opposite end of the switch housing
clockwise, until it locks into a position that is horizontal and parallel to the connector receptacle.
This brake lamp switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged, ineffective, or
removed from its mounting position for any reason, it must be replaced with a new unit.
LATE PRODUCTION
This brake lamp switch (1) is a three circuit, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch that is secured
to the brake pedal support bracket under the instrument panel on the driver side of the vehicle. The
molded plastic switch housing has an integral connector receptacle (4) containing six terminal pins.
The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out of the body
wire harness.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (2) on one end of the switch housing. The
plunger has a telescoping self-adjustment feature that is activated after the switch is installed by
pulling the brake pedal upward to its normal at-rest position. The telescoping plunger can be pulled
outward from the switch housing to repeat the self-adjustment procedure if necessary.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Stop Lamp Switch - Description > Page 9812
This brake lamp switch cannot be repaired. If the switch is damaged or ineffective it must be
replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Stop Lamp Switch - Description > Page 9813
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Stop Lamp Switch - Operation
OPERATION
Both the early and late production brake lamp switches control three independent circuits. These
circuits are described as follows:
- Brake Lamp Switch Circuit - A normally open brake lamp switch circuit receives a battery voltage
input, and supplies this battery voltage to the Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL) and the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on a brake lamp switch output circuit only when the brake
pedal is depressed (brake lamp switch plunger released).
- Brake Lamp Switch Signal Circuit - A normally closed brake lamp switch signal circuit receives a
direct path to ground, and supplies this ground input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on a
brake signal 1 circuit only when the brake pedal is released (brake lamp switch plunger is
depressed).
- Speed Control Circuit - A normally closed speed control circuit receives a battery voltage input
from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on an ignition run/start control output circuit, and
supplies this battery voltage to the PCM on a brake signal 2 circuit only when the brake pedal is
released (brake lamp switch plunger is depressed).
The PCM sends electronic brake lamp switch status messages to other electronic modules in the
vehicle over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus for use as an additional logic input for
controlling many other vehicle functions and features.
The brake lamp switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls and communication that provide some features related to brake lamp switch
operation. The most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to brake lamp switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9814
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
Early Production
Late Production
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
CAUTION: Do not remove the Eary Production-type brake lamp switch from the mounting bracket.
The self-adjusting plunger of this switch
is a one time only feature. If the switch is removed from the mounting bracket, it MUST be replaced
with a new switch.
2. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the brake lamp switch. 3. Using an ohmmeter,
perform the continuity tests at the terminal pins (1) in the brake lamp switch connector receptacle
as shown in the Brake Lamp
Switch Tests table.
4. If the switch fails any of the continuity tests, replace the ineffective brake lamp switch as
required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9815
Brake Light Switch: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT - LATE PRODUCTION TYPE ONLY
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable and, only the late
production type switch can be readjusted following initial installation using this adjustment
procedure. If the early production type switch requires readjustment for any reason, it must be
replaced with a new switch. Both switches are illustrated and described elsewhere in this service
information to assist in positive identification. See: Description and Operation/Stop Lamp Switch Description.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer pad from
below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Removal.
3. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 4. Pull the brake lamp switch
plunger all the way out of the switch housing to its fully extended position.
CAUTION: Brake booster damage may occur if the brake pedal pull exceeds about 9 kilograms (20
pounds).
5. Release the brake pedal. Then pull the pedal lightly upward to its normal at-rest position. The
pedal will set the plunger to the correct position as
the pedal pushes the plunger into the switch housing. The switch plunger will make a light audible
ratcheting noise as it self-adjusts.
6. If equipped, reinstall the silencer pad below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Stop Lamp Switch - Removal
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair Stop Lamp Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable. Both switches are
illustrated and described elsewhere in this service information to assist in positive identification.
See: Description and Operation/Stop Lamp Switch - Description.
EARLY PRODUCTION
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer pad from
below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Removal.
3. Locate the brake lamp switch (3) on the brake pedal support bracket (2) under the instrument
panel. 4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (4) from the switch.
5. Rotate the brake lamp switch housing (2) counterclockwise about 30 degrees to align the tabs
on the switch locking collar with the keyed hole in
the brake pedal support bracket (1).
6. Pull the switch straight rearward from the keyed hole to remove it from the bracket. 7. Discard
the removed brake lamp switch. The brake lamp switch self-adjusting plunger is a one time only
feature. If the switch is removed
from the bracket, it MUST be replaced with a new switch.
LATE PRODUCTION
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Stop Lamp Switch - Removal > Page 9818
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If equipped, remove the silencer pad from
below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Removal.
3. Locate the brake lamp switch (2) on the brake pedal support bracket (4) under the instrument
panel. 4. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 5. Rotate the brake lamp
switch housing (2) counterclockwise about 30 degrees to align the tabs on the switch locking collar
with the keyed hole in
the brake pedal support bracket.
6. Pull the switch straight rearward from the keyed hole to remove it from the bracket. 7. Release
the brake pedal. 8. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1) from the switch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Stop Lamp Switch - Removal > Page 9819
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair Stop Lamp Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
Two unique brake lamp switches are used in this vehicle, depending upon whether the vehicle was
built during early or late production. These switches are not interchangeable. Both switches are
illustrated and described elsewhere in this service information to assist in positive identification.
See: Description and Operation/Stop Lamp Switch - Description.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
EARLY PRODUCTION
CAUTION: The brake lamp switch self-adjusting switch plunger is a one time only feature. If the
switch is removed from the mounting
bracket, it MUST be replaced with a new switch.
1. Obtain a new brake lamp switch. The adjustment lever on the new switch should be at about a
45 degree angle to the switch connector receptacle.
If the adjustment lever is parallel with the connector receptacle, the switch adjustment has already
been set and the switch must be scrapped. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO RESET OR READJUST THE
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH.
2. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 3. Align the tabs on the brake lamp
switch (2) locking collar with the keyed hole in the brake pedal support bracket (1) below the
instrument panel. 4. Insert the tabs on the brake lamp switch locking collar through the keyed hole
in the brake pedal support bracket until the switch housing is firmly
seated against the bracket.
5. Rotate the switch housing clockwise about 30 degrees to engage the tabs on the locking collar
with the bracket.
CAUTION: Release, but do not pull up on the brake pedal before the switch plunger adjustment
has been completed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Stop Lamp Switch - Removal > Page 9820
6. Release the brake pedal, but do not pull it upward. 7. Rotate the plunger adjustment release
lever (2) clockwise until it locks into place. The lever should be parallel to the brake lamp switch
connector
receptacle. This action will set the switch plunger length to a final adjustment position and cannot
be undone. If not performed properly the first time, a new brake lamp switch MUST be installed.
8. Reconnect the wire harness connector (4) to the brake lamp switch (3). 9. If equipped, reinstall
the silencer pad below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
10. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
LATE PRODUCTION
1. Be certain that the brake lamp switch (2) plunger is pulled all the way out of the switch housing
to its fully extended position. 2. Reconnect the wire harness connector (1) to the connector
receptacle on the switch. 3. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position. 4. Align
the tabs on the brake lamp switch locking collar with the keyed hole in the brake pedal support
bracket (2). 5. Insert the tab on the brake lamp switch locking collar through the keyed hole in the
support bracket until the switch housing is firmly seated against
the bracket.
6. Rotate the switch housing clockwise about 30 degrees to engage the tabs on the locking collar
with the support bracket.
CAUTION: Brake booster damage may occur if the brake pedal pull exceeds about 9 kilograms (20
pounds).
7. Release the brake pedal. Then pull the pedal lightly upward to its normal at-rest position. The
pedal will set the plunger to the correct position as
the pedal pushes the plunger into the switch housing. The switch plunger will make a light audible
ratcheting noise as it self-adjusts.
8. If equipped, reinstall the silencer pad below the steering column. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/Lower Silencer Panel - Installation.
9. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Combination Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 9826
Combination Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C2 (Steering Wheel Jumper) 7 Way
Connector C2 - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Combination Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9829
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9830
Combination Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9831
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Combination Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9834
Combination Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9839
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9840
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9841
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9844
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Hazard Warning Switch - Description
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation Hazard Warning Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The hazard switch (3) is integral to the instrument panel switch pod (1), which is secured to the
instrument panel center bezel just above the heater and air conditioner controls. A red, stencil-like
International Control and Display Symbol icon for Hazard Warning identifies the hazard switch
button. The remainder of the hazard switch circuitry is concealed within the instrument panel switch
pod.
The hazard switch button has panel lamps dimmer controlled illumination for night visibility. The
switch button latches to a slightly lowered position when the hazard warning system is activated
and the icon on the switch button will illuminate at an increased intensity while the turn signals and
turn signal indicators are flashing. The switch button unlatches to a position flush with the other
push buttons in the switch pod when the hazard warning is deactivated.
All of the circuitry and components of the hazard switch are contained within a molded black plastic
instrument panel switch pod housing. A single connector receptacle is integral to the back of the
switch pod housing. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The hazard switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire
instrument panel switch pod unit must be replaced. See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Integrated Accessory Switch Assembly/Service and Repair/Instrument Cluster Switch
Pod - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Hazard Warning Switch - Description > Page 9849
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation Hazard Warning Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The status of the hazard switch is continually monitored by the circuitry within the instrument panel
switch pod. The switch pod receives battery voltage at all times on a fused battery feed circuit, and
a path to ground at all times through the instrument panel wire harness. The only other inputs to
the switch pod consists of electronic communication with the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the single wire Local Interface
Network (LIN) data bus.
Whenever the hazard switch is in its unlatched and raised position, the hazard warning system is
selected and the switch pod circuitry provides a hard wired output to the Totally Integrated Power
Module (TIPM). When the TIPM receives a hazard switch input it then controls hazard warning
system operation and flash rate by controlling battery voltage outputs through high side drivers on
the right and left, front and rear turn signal feed circuits. The TIPM also sends the appropriate
electronic messages back to the EMIC to control the illumination and flash rate of the right and left
turn signal indicators, as well as to control the click rate of an electromechanical relay soldered
onto the EMIC electronic circuit board that emulates the sound emitted by a conventional hazard
warning flasher.
The hard wired circuits for the instrument panel switch pod may be diagnosed using conventional
diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information. However,
conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the hazard warning
switch or the electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that
provide some features of the hazard warning system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate
means to diagnose the hazard switch or the electronic controls and communication related to
hazard warning system operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 9855
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C2 (Steering Wheel Jumper) 7 Way
Connector C2 - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9858
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9859
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9860
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9863
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 9869
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C2 (Steering Wheel Jumper) 7 Way
Connector C2 - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9872
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9873
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9874
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9877
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9881
Horn Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
SWITCH-HORN - (STEERING WHEEL) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Horn Switch - Removal
Horn Switch: Service and Repair Horn Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING:
On vehicles equipped with an airbag, refer to restraint systems for warnings and cautions before
servicing the horn switch.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the driver airbag. See: Restraint
Systems/Air Bag Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Removal. 3. Disconnect the
connector from the clockspring. 4. Remove the three mounting fasteners. 5. Remove the horn
switch.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Horn Switch - Removal > Page 9884
Horn Switch: Service and Repair Horn Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the horn switch. 2. Install the three mounting fasteners. 3. Connect the electrical
connector to the clockspring. 4. Install the driver airbag. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag - Installation 5. Connect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Tail Light Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal
Tail Light Bulb: Service and Repair Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal
BULB
Each rear lamp unit for this vehicle consists of two pieces. An outer rear lamp unit that is secured
at the rear of each quarter panel includes bulbs for the park (or tail) lamps, the brake (or stop)
lamps and the turn signal lamps. An inner rear lamp is secured on each outboard side of the liftgate
outer panel adjacent to the outer lamp and also includes a bulb for the park (or tail) lamps as well
as a bulb for the backup (or reverse) lamps.
OUTER LAMP
NOTE: The outer rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. They are the tail/stop/rear side marker (1) and
the turn signal (2). The service
procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may differ.
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable. 2. Remove the outer rear lamp unit. See: Brake
Lamp/Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp - Removal. 3. Firmly grasp the appropriate bulb
socket (1 or 2 ) on the back of the lamp housing and rotate it counterclockwise about 30 degrees to
unlock it. 4. Pull the socket and bulb straight out of the lamp. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight
out of the socket.
INNER LAMP
NOTE: The inner rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. The upper socket contains the tail lamp bulb,
while the lower socket contains the backup
lamp bulb. The service procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may
differ.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the inner rear lamp unit. See:
Brake Lamp/Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp - Removal. 3. Firmly grasp the appropriate
bulb socket (3) on the back of the lamp housing and rotate it counterclockwise about 30 degrees to
unlock it. 4. Pull the socket and bulb straight out of the lamp. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight
out of the socket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Tail Light Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9890
Tail Light Bulb: Service and Repair Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Installation
BULB
Each rear lamp unit for this vehicle consists of two pieces. An outer rear lamp unit that is secured
at the rear of each quarter panel includes bulbs for the park (or tail) lamps, the brake (or stop)
lamps and the turn signal lamps. An inner rear lamp is secured on each outboard side of the liftgate
outer panel adjacent to the outer lamp and also includes a bulb for the park (or tail) lamps as well
as a bulb for the backup (or reverse) lamps.
OUTER LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
NOTE: The outer rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. They are the tail/stop/rear side marker (1) and
the turn signal (2). The service
procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may differ.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the appropriate bulb socket (1 or 2). 2. Push the bulb straight into
the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the keyed opening on
the back of the outer rear lamp unit housing. 4. Insert the socket and bulb into the housing until the
socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 6.
Reinstall the outer rear lamp unit. See: Brake Lamp/Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
INNER LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
NOTE: The inner rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. The upper socket contains the tail lamp bulb,
while the lower socket contains the backup
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Tail Light Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9891
lamp bulb. The service procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may
differ.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the appropriate bulb socket (3). 2. Push the bulb straight into the
socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the keyed opening on the
back of the inner rear lamp unit housing. 4. Insert the socket and bulb into the housing until the
socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 6.
Reinstall the inner rear lamp unit. See: Brake Lamp/Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Combination Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way
Connector C1 - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (INSTRUMENT PANEL) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Multifunction Switch C1 (Instrument Panel) 4 Way > Page 9898
Combination Switch: Diagrams Left Multifunction Switch C2 (Steering Wheel Jumper) 7 Way
Connector C2 - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-LEFT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description
Combination Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch is located on the left side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the interior and exterior lighting systems.
The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (2), control knob (1) and control
sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column. The
remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn
signal cancel actuator are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing (2) and controls (1) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3).
The Steering Control Module (SCM) is internal to the switch housing. The switch outputs are
internally connected directly to the SCM. A single connector receptacle containing seven terminal
pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and connects the right multi-function switch
(6) through a jumper wire harness (5) directly to the SCM. An integral connector receptacle on the
back of the switch housing connects the SCM to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated
take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The left multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
exterior lighting functions:
- Automatic Headlamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob
provides detent switching for the optional automatic headlamps.
- Front Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional front fog lamps.
- Headlamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the
headlamps.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching
for selection of the headlamp high or low
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9901
beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The left multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary switching
of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature (sometimes referred to as
flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the headlamp high beams as
an optical signalling device.
- Park Lamps - The left multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching for the park
lamps.
Rear Fog Lamps - For vehicles so equipped, the left multi-function switch control knob provides
detent switching for the optional rear fog lamps. Rear fog lamps are optional only for vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, where they are required.
- Turn Signal Control - The left multi-function switch control stalk provides both momentary
non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
The left multi-function switch also provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following interior lighting functions:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
defeat the illumination of all interior courtesy lamps when a door or the liftgate is opened.
- Interior Lamps On - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching to
illuminate all interior courtesy lamps simultaneously.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The left multi-function switch control ring provides simultaneous
adjustable control of the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting at one of six available
illumination intensity levels.
Parade Mode - The left multi-function switch control ring provides detent switching for a parade
mode that maximizes the illumination intensity of all instrument panel lighting for visibility when
driving in daylight with the exterior lamps turned on.
The left multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9902
Combination Switch: Description and Operation Left Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The left (lighting) multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and
features it provides using a minimal number of hard wired circuits. The switch receives clean
grounds from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed return outputs
to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM then sends electronic switch status
messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), and the EMIC relays electronic
switch request messages over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic
modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the left multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal Not
Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the exterior lighting
system. The failsafe mode automatically turns the exterior lighting ON when the ignition switch is in
the ON position, and OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the left multi-function switch and SCM may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component requires the
use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
exterior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Automatic Headlamps - The optional automatic headlamps feature is requested when the left
multi-function switch control knob is rotated to the automatic (AUTO) detent position with the
ignition switch in the ON position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left
multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN
data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the
CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Fog Lamps - The optional front fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The
switch control knob incorporates an internal cam mechanism that will only allow the front fog lamps
to be selected while the headlamp ON position is also selected, and will automatically move the
control knob to the front fog lamps OFF position when the control knob is rotated to deselect the
headlamps.
- Headlamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the headlamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The headlamp high beams are selected when the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pushed forward to the high beam selection detent position. The low beams
are selected when the control stalk is pulled rearward to the low beam selection detent position.
The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an
electronic beam select switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an
electronic beam select switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules
in the vehicle.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The headlamp optical horn is selected each time the left multi-function
switch control stalk is pulled fully rearward to a momentary position. The headlamp high beams will
remain illuminated for as long as the control stalk is held in this momentary position and the low
beams will be restored when the control stalk is released. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed
input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic beam select switch status message
over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic beam select switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Park Lamps - The headlamps are requested when the left multi-function switch control knob is
rotated to the park lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Fog Lamps - The optional rear fog lamps are requested when the left multi-function switch
control knob is pulled outward to the front fog lamps detent position and then rotated to the rear fog
lamps detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus
to other electronic modules in the vehicle. The switch control knob incorporates an internal cam
mechanism that will only allow the rear fog lamps to be selected while the front fog lamps ON
position is also selected, and will automatically move the control knob to the rear fog lamp OFF
position when the control knob is pushed in to deselect the front fog lamps.
- Turn Signal Control - The turn signals are requested when the left multi-function switch control
stalk is moved downward (left signal) or upward (right signal). The control stalk has a detent
position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic cancellation, and an
intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides three turn signal
blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will energize the turn signals
for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When the control stalk is moved
to a detent turn signal switch position, a cancel actuator extends through an opening in the side of
the clockspring case toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is
integral to the clockspring rotor rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the
cancel
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Left Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 9903
actuator when it is extended from the left multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated
during a turning maneuver, one of the turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal
cancel actuator. The cancel actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction
opposite that which is signaled. If the left turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam
will ratchet past the cancel actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch
the cancel actuator as the steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will
cancel the turn signal event and release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral
OFF position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and
sends an electronic exterior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic exterior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
INTERIOR LIGHTING
Following are descriptions of the how the left multi-function switch is operated to control the many
interior lighting functions and features it provides:
- Interior Lamps Defeat - The interior lamps defeat feature is requested when the left multi-function
switch control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps DEFEAT detent position. The SCM reads the
resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting
switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior
lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Interior Lamps On - The interior lamps ON feature is requested when the left multi-function switch
control sleeve is rotated to the interior lamps ON detent position. The SCM reads the resistor
multiplexed input from the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch
status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Panel Lamps Dimming - The panel lamps dimming function is active only when the left
multi-function switch control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting
ON, the panel lamps dimming level is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is
rotated to any one of five minor detent positions. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from
the left multi-function switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over
the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message
over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Parade Mode - The PARADE (or funeral) mode is active only when the left multi-function switch
control knob is in any exterior lighting ON position. With the exterior lighting ON, the PARADE
mode is requested when the left multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to the PARADE
mode detent position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the left multi-function
switch and sends an electronic interior lighting switch status message over the LIN data bus to the
EMIC, which relays an electronic interior lighting switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
Combination Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the left multi-function switch. 4. Remove the screw (2) that secures the left multi-function
switch (1) to the mounting bracket integral to the left side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
5. Slide the switch (2) away from the clockspring (1) far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the
switch housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
6. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (3) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the left multi-function switch. 7. Remove the switch from the clockspring.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Left Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 9906
Combination Switch: Service and Repair Left Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the left multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (1) integral to the
left side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (3) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the front of the left
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket (3) on the
clockspring. Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reconnect the instrument panel wiring harness connector to the back of the left multi-function
switch. 5. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Cancel Cam > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Turn Signal Cancel Cam - Description
Turn Signal Cancel Cam: Description and Operation Turn Signal Cancel Cam - Description
DESCRIPTION
The turn signal cancel cam is concealed within the clockspring case on the steering column. The
turn signal cancel cam consists of integral eccentrics on the outer circumference of the molded
plastic clockspring rotor. The clockspring mechanism provides turn signal cancellation as well as a
constant electrical connection between the horn switch, driver airbag, speed control switches,
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) switches and remote radio switches on the steering
wheel and the instrument panel wire harness on the steering column. The housing of the
clockspring is secured to the steering column and remains stationary. The rotor of the clockspring,
including the turn signal cancel cam lobes rotate with the steering wheel.
The turn signal cancel cam is serviced as a unit with the clockspring and cannot be repaired. If
ineffective or damaged, the entire clockspring unit must be replaced. See: Restraint Systems/Air
Bag Systems/Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Clockspring - Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Cancel Cam > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Turn Signal Cancel Cam - Description > Page 9911
Turn Signal Cancel Cam: Description and Operation Turn Signal Cancel Cam - Operation
OPERATION
When the left multi-function switch control stalk is moved to a latched turn signal ON position, a
turn signal cancel actuator is extended from the inside surface of the switch housing through a
small rectangular opening on the left side of the clockspring case toward the turn signal cancel
cam. As the steering wheel is rotated to complete the turn, one of the cam eccentrics will contact
the actuator, automatically cancelling the turn signal event and releasing the latched left
multi-function switch control stalk to the neutral or OFF position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Turn Signal Bulb > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal
Turn Signal Bulb: Service and Repair Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal
BULB
Each rear lamp unit for this vehicle consists of two pieces. An outer rear lamp unit that is secured
at the rear of each quarter panel includes bulbs for the park (or tail) lamps, the brake (or stop)
lamps and the turn signal lamps. An inner rear lamp is secured on each outboard side of the liftgate
outer panel adjacent to the outer lamp and also includes a bulb for the park (or tail) lamps as well
as a bulb for the backup (or reverse) lamps.
OUTER LAMP
NOTE: The outer rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. They are the tail/stop/rear side marker (1) and
the turn signal (2). The service
procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may differ.
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable. 2. Remove the outer rear lamp unit. See: Brake
Lamp/Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp - Removal. 3. Firmly grasp the appropriate bulb
socket (1 or 2 ) on the back of the lamp housing and rotate it counterclockwise about 30 degrees to
unlock it. 4. Pull the socket and bulb straight out of the lamp. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight
out of the socket.
INNER LAMP
NOTE: The inner rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. The upper socket contains the tail lamp bulb,
while the lower socket contains the backup
lamp bulb. The service procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may
differ.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the inner rear lamp unit. See:
Brake Lamp/Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp - Removal. 3. Firmly grasp the appropriate
bulb socket (3) on the back of the lamp housing and rotate it counterclockwise about 30 degrees to
unlock it. 4. Pull the socket and bulb straight out of the lamp. 5. Pull the base of the bulb straight
out of the socket.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Turn Signal Bulb > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9917
Turn Signal Bulb: Service and Repair Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Installation
BULB
Each rear lamp unit for this vehicle consists of two pieces. An outer rear lamp unit that is secured
at the rear of each quarter panel includes bulbs for the park (or tail) lamps, the brake (or stop)
lamps and the turn signal lamps. An inner rear lamp is secured on each outboard side of the liftgate
outer panel adjacent to the outer lamp and also includes a bulb for the park (or tail) lamps as well
as a bulb for the backup (or reverse) lamps.
OUTER LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
NOTE: The outer rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. They are the tail/stop/rear side marker (1) and
the turn signal (2). The service
procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may differ.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the appropriate bulb socket (1 or 2). 2. Push the bulb straight into
the socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the keyed opening on
the back of the outer rear lamp unit housing. 4. Insert the socket and bulb into the housing until the
socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 6.
Reinstall the outer rear lamp unit. See: Brake Lamp/Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
INNER LAMP
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
NOTE: The inner rear lamp unit contains two bulbs. The upper socket contains the tail lamp bulb,
while the lower socket contains the backup
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Turn Signal Bulb > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Tail Stop Turn Lamp Bulb - Removal > Page 9918
lamp bulb. The service procedures for each bulb are the same, only the bulb sizes and types may
differ.
1. Align the base of the bulb with the appropriate bulb socket (3). 2. Push the bulb straight into the
socket until the base is firmly seated. 3. Align the socket and bulb with the keyed opening on the
back of the inner rear lamp unit housing. 4. Insert the socket and bulb into the housing until the
socket is firmly seated. 5. Rotate the socket clockwise about 30 degrees to lock it into place. 6.
Reinstall the inner rear lamp unit. See: Brake Lamp/Service and Repair/Tail Stop Turn Lamp Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Vanity Lamp
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Left Vanity Lamp >
Page 9923
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Vanity Lamp
(Except Base) (Headliner) 2 Way
Vanity Lamp: Diagrams Left Vanity Lamp (Except Base) (Headliner) 2 Way
Connector (EXCEPT BASE) - (HEADLINER) 2 WAY
LAMP-VANITY-LEFT (EXCEPT BASE) - (HEADLINER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Vanity Lamp
(Except Base) (Headliner) 2 Way > Page 9926
Vanity Lamp: Diagrams Right Vanity Lamp (Except Base) (Headliner) 2 Way
Connector (EXCEPT BASE) - (HEADLINER) 2 WAY
LAMP-VANITY-RIGHT (EXCEPT BASE) - (HEADLINER) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vanity
Lamp - Removal
Vanity Lamp: Service and Repair Vanity Lamp - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with optional vanity lamps have a lamp on each side of a covered mirror
that is integral to each sun visor. Both
lamps are controlled by an integral switch that is automatically actuated by the mirror cover. The
bulb types and service procedures are identical for both of these lamps.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Open the lighted vanity mirror cover. 3.
Using a small flat-bladed screwdriver, gently pry between the lamp lens (2) and housing (1) far
enough to disengage the two tabs (1) at the
outboard side of the lens from the lamp housing.
4. Carefully unsnap the bulb (3) from the two bulb holders within the lamp housing. 5. Remove the
bulb from the lamp.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vanity
Lamp - Removal > Page 9929
Vanity Lamp: Service and Repair Vanity Lamp - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Always use the correct bulb size and type for replacement. An incorrect bulb size or
type may overheat and cause damage to the
lamp, the socket or the lamp wiring.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with optional vanity lamps have a lamp on each side of a covered mirror
that is integral to each sun visor. Both
lamps are controlled by an integral switch that is automatically actuated by the mirror cover. The
bulb types and service procedures are identical for both of these lamps.
1. Align the ends of the bulb (3) with the two bulb holders within the vanity lamp housing. 2.
Carefully press the bulb firmly and evenly into the bulb holders until it snaps into place. 3. Engage
the tabs on the inboard edge of the lens (2) within the lamp housing. 4. Using hand pressure, press
the outboard edge of the lens over the lamp housing until the two tabs (1) at the outboard edge of
the lens snap into
place.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9935
Heated Glass Element Relay: Diagrams
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Rear Defogger Switch - Description
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation Rear Defogger Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: Manual tri-zone temperature A/C-heater control shown. Other A/C-heater controls similar.
The momentary push-button switch (1) for the rear window defogger (EBL) system is located in the
A/C-heater control (2) in the center of the instrument panel. An amber indicator (3) will illuminate to
indicate when the EBL system is turned on.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Rear Defogger Switch - Description > Page 9940
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation Rear Defogger Switch - Operation
OPERATION
An amber indicator will illuminate when the rear window defogger switch is activated. When
activated, the switch sends a request signal to the totally integrated power module (TIPM) to
energize the internal EBL high side driver to provide battery current to the rear window defogger
grid lines and to the heated side view mirrors, when equipped.
NOTE: The EBL system turns off automatically after 10 minutes of initial operation. Each following
activation cycle of the EBL system will
last 5 minutes.
The EBL system will automatically turn off after an initial programmed time interval of about 10
minutes as long as the ignition switch is in RUN. After the initial time interval has expired, if the rear
window defogger switch is pressed to ON again during the same ignition cycle, the EBL system will
automatically turn off after about 5 minutes. The EBL system will also turn off if the ignition switch is
turned to any position other than RUN or by manually pressing the rear window defogger switch a
second time.
The rear window defogger switch is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear window defogger switch and indicator cannot be adjusted or repaired. The A/C-heater
control must be replaced if the rear window defogger switch or indicator is inoperative or damaged
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Control Assembly/Service and Repair/A/C and Heater Control Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9945
Heated Glass Element Relay: Diagrams
Connector - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
RELAY-REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER - (IN TIPM) 5 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rear Defogger Switch - Description
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation Rear Defogger Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: Manual tri-zone temperature A/C-heater control shown. Other A/C-heater controls similar.
The momentary push-button switch (1) for the rear window defogger (EBL) system is located in the
A/C-heater control (2) in the center of the instrument panel. An amber indicator (3) will illuminate to
indicate when the EBL system is turned on.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Rear Defogger Switch - Description > Page 9951
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation Rear Defogger Switch - Operation
OPERATION
An amber indicator will illuminate when the rear window defogger switch is activated. When
activated, the switch sends a request signal to the totally integrated power module (TIPM) to
energize the internal EBL high side driver to provide battery current to the rear window defogger
grid lines and to the heated side view mirrors, when equipped.
NOTE: The EBL system turns off automatically after 10 minutes of initial operation. Each following
activation cycle of the EBL system will
last 5 minutes.
The EBL system will automatically turn off after an initial programmed time interval of about 10
minutes as long as the ignition switch is in RUN. After the initial time interval has expired, if the rear
window defogger switch is pressed to ON again during the same ignition cycle, the EBL system will
automatically turn off after about 5 minutes. The EBL system will also turn off if the ignition switch is
turned to any position other than RUN or by manually pressing the rear window defogger switch a
second time.
The rear window defogger switch is diagnosed using a scan tool See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures.
The rear window defogger switch and indicator cannot be adjusted or repaired. The A/C-heater
control must be replaced if the rear window defogger switch or indicator is inoperative or damaged
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Control Assembly/Service and Repair/A/C and Heater Control Removal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch > Page 9956
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch > Page 9957
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch > Page 9958
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9961
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Right Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9962
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Connector C1 - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9963
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C2 (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9964
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Right Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9965
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Connector C1 - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C2 (Front Door) 10 Way
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9966
Connector C2 - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Except Base) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9967
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Base) (Front Door) 8 Way
Connector (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9968
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9969
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
For switch testing, remove the switch. See: Service and Repair/Power Window Switch - Removal.
Using an ohmmeter, refer to Window Switch Continuity Charts to determine if continuity is correct.
If the results are not obtained, replace the switch.
The master window switch has an Auto-Down feature. Actuation of the master switch to the second
down position will move the drivers side window completely down. The electronic switch will
automatically disconnect the motor approximately 1 second after the window bottoms out. Failure
of the electronic switch to detect stall current, will cause the switch to disconnect after
approximately 13 seconds. The auto down function can be canceled by any movement of that
switch.
MASTER WINDOW SWITCH TEST
PASSENGER WINDOW SWITCH TEST
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Window Switch - Removal
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Power Window Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
SWITCH - FRONT DOOR
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative remote cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent,
carefully pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
switch wire connector. 4. Remove switch assembly.
SWITCH - REAR DOOR
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent, carefully
pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect the
electrical connector. 4. Remove the switch from the handle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Window Switch - Removal > Page 9972
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Power Window Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
SWITCH - FRONT DOOR
1. Install the switch by snapping into place. 2. Connect switch wire connector. 3. Install the switch
to the door trim panel. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
SWITCH - REAR DOOR
1. Connect the electrical connector. 2. Install the switch to the door trim panel. 3. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Front Door Window Motor: Testing and Inspection
WINDOW MOTOR
1. Remove door trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim
Panel - Removal.
2. Connect positive (+) lead from a test battery to either of the two motor terminals. 3. Connect
negative (-) lead from test battery to remaining motor terminal. 4. The motor should now rotate in
one direction to either move window up or down.
a. If window happens to already be in full UP position and motor is connected so as to move it in
UP direction no movement will be observed. b. Likewise, motor connected to move window in
DOWN direction no movement will be observed if window is already in full DOWN position. c.
Reverse battery leads in 1 and 2 and window should now move. If window does not move, replace
motor.
5. If window moved completely up or down, the test leads should be reversed one more time to
complete a full window travel inspection. 6. If window does not move, check to make sure that it is
free. 7. It is necessary that the window be free to slide up and down in the glass channels. If the
window is not free to move up and down, the window lift
motor will not be able to move the glass.
8. To determine if the glass is free, disconnect the regulator from the glass lift plate. Remove the
two attaching screws, and slide the window up and
down by hand.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Window Regulator Motor - Removal
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Window Regulator Motor - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the door trim panel. See: Body
and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front
Door
Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Disconnect the electrical connector. 4. Remove the mounting fasteners and remove the motor.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Window Regulator Motor - Removal > Page 9980
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Window Regulator Motor - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the window motor and install the mounting fasteners. 2. Connect the electrical connector.
3. Install the door trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door
Trim Panel - Installation.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch > Page 9985
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch > Page 9986
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Left Rear Power Window Switch > Page 9987
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9990
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Right Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9991
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Connector C1 - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9992
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C2 (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector C2 - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9993
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Right Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way
Connector - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9994
SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR - (REAR DOOR) 6 WAY
Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C1 (Front Door) 14 Way
Connector C1 - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 14 WAY
Driver Window/Door Lock Switch C2 (Front Door) 10 Way
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9995
Connector C2 - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Except Base) (Front Door) 10 Way
Connector (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9996
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (EXCEPT BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 10 WAY
Passenger Window/Door Lock Switch (Base) (Front Door) 8 Way
Connector (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER (BASE) - (FRONT DOOR) 8 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Left Rear Power Window Switch (Rear Door) 6 Way > Page 9997
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 9998
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
For switch testing, remove the switch. See: Service and Repair/Power Window Switch - Removal.
Using an ohmmeter, refer to Window Switch Continuity Charts to determine if continuity is correct.
If the results are not obtained, replace the switch.
The master window switch has an Auto-Down feature. Actuation of the master switch to the second
down position will move the drivers side window completely down. The electronic switch will
automatically disconnect the motor approximately 1 second after the window bottoms out. Failure
of the electronic switch to detect stall current, will cause the switch to disconnect after
approximately 13 seconds. The auto down function can be canceled by any movement of that
switch.
MASTER WINDOW SWITCH TEST
PASSENGER WINDOW SWITCH TEST
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Window Switch - Removal
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Power Window Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
SWITCH - FRONT DOOR
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative remote cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent,
carefully pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
switch wire connector. 4. Remove switch assembly.
SWITCH - REAR DOOR
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim tool, or equivalent, carefully
pry up on the window switch until it disengages from the door trim panel. 3. Disconnect the
electrical connector. 4. Remove the switch from the handle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Window Switch - Removal > Page 10001
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Power Window Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
SWITCH - FRONT DOOR
1. Install the switch by snapping into place. 2. Connect switch wire connector. 3. Install the switch
to the door trim panel. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
SWITCH - REAR DOOR
1. Connect the electrical connector. 2. Install the switch to the door trim panel. 3. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Glass - Removal
Front Door Window Glass: Service and Repair Front Door Glass - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and re-install the window switches, if equipped. See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim Panel - Removal
2. Remove the interior window trim molding. 3. Remove the door speaker. See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Speaker/Service and Repair/Speaker Removal
4. Drill a hole large enough to get a small puch through into the carrier plate (3). 5. Lower glass to
approximately mid position and line up the glass lift plates (1) with the holes (2 and 3). 6. Using a
punch or equivalent, press tabs releasing glass from window regulator (2 and 3).
7. Remove glass from channel. 8. Raise glass (1) upward and out of the opening at top of door.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Glass - Removal > Page 10007
Front Door Window Glass: Service and Repair Front Door Glass - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Lower glass (1) down and in the opening at top of door. 2. Slide glass downward making sure
the glass holes properly lock into snaps (1). 3. Install the interior window trim molding. 4. Install the
door speaker. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact
Disc/Speaker/Service and Repair/Speaker Installation
5. Install door trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim
Panel - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair Liftgate Glass - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Windshield removal shown, backlite similar.
1. Before proceeding with the following repair procedure, review all warnings and cautions. See:
Windshield/Service Precautions 2. Remove liftgate trim panels. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood
and Trunk/Trunk / Liftgate/Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Liftgate Trim Panel - Removal
3. Remove rear window wiper arm, if equipped. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper
Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal 4. Disconnect the heated backlite electrical
connectors, if equipped. 5. Using a windshield cut-out wire or other suitable tool, separate the
adhesive. 6. Carefully remove backlite.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 10012
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair Liftgate Glass - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Allow the urethane at least 24 hours to cure before returning the vehicle to use.
CAUTION: Roll down the left and right front door glass and open the rear glass slider (if available)
before installing backlite to avoid
pressurizing the passenger compartment if a door is slammed before urethane is cured. Water
leaks can result.
NOTE: The backlite fence should be cleaned of most of its old urethane bonding material. A small
amount of old urethane, approximately 1-2
mm in height, should remain on the fence. Do not grind off or completely remove all old urethane
from the fence, the paint finish and bonding strength will be adversely affected. Support spacers
should be replaced with new parts. Replace any missing or damaged spacers around the perimeter
of the liftgate opening.
Glass Preparation - Installing A Previously Installed Backlite
1. Before proceeding with the following repair procedure, review all warnings and cautions. See:
Windshield/Service Precautions 2. Level old bead of backlite adhesive (3) to a thickness of
approximately 1 mm (0.04 in.) and remove loose adhesive.
3. Apply four new spacers (1) to the liftgate frame and place them 55 mm in from the window
opening; 70 mm from the upper edge and 150 mm
from the lower edge.
4. Install the lower spacers (2) to the backlite approximately 25 mm (1.0 in) from each side of the
glass.
NOTE: Remove the lower spacers 2 hours after installation of the glass.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 10013
5. Position backlite in center of liftgate opening and resting on the side and lower spacers.
6. Apply adhesive tape strips (1) around the perimeter of the liftgate opening to aid in installation.
NOTE: Windshield installation shown, backlite similar.
7. Verify the backlite gap is parallel to with the liftgate opening. 8. Cut tape with a sharp knife and
remove backlite.
NOTE: Typical primer installation shown.
9. Clean and dry area of glass (2) to be re-glued with a suitable glass preparation solvent and rag.
10. Using a flash light, verify that glass primer is without damage. 11. Re-prime any damaged area.
If old adhesive has been exposed for more than 12 hours, entire adhesive area needs to be
re-primed.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 10014
12. Apply primer (1) around the perimeter of the glass to a width of 15 mm (0.5 in.) (2). 13. Allow
primer to air dry for at least 10 minutes. 14. Using a flash light, verify that glass primer is without
damage.
Glass Preparation - Installing A New Backlite
1. Apply four new spacers (1) to the liftgate frame and place them 55 mm in from the window
opening; 70 mm from the upper edge and 150 mm
from the lower edge.
2. Install the lower spacers (2) to the backlite approximately 36 cm (1.0 in) from each side of the
glass.
NOTE: Remove the lower spacers 2 hours after installation of the glass.
3. Position backlite in center of liftgate opening and resting on the side and lower spacers.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 10015
4. Apply adhesive tape strips (1) around the perimeter of the liftgate opening to aid in installation.
NOTE: Windshield installation shown, backlite similar.
5. Verify the backlite gap is parallel to with the liftgate opening. 6. Cut tape with a sharp knife and
remove backlite.
NOTE: Typical primer installation shown.
7. Clean and dry area of glass (2) to be re-glued with a suitable glass preparation solvent and rag.
8. Apply primer to gluing surface at backlite seal.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 10016
9. Apply primer (1) around the perimeter of the glass to a width of 15 mm (0.5 in.) (2).
10. Allow primer to air dry for at least 10 minutes. 11. Using a flash light, verify that glass primer is
without damage.
Liftgate Opening Preparation
NOTE: Windshield opening shown, liftgate opening similar.
1. Clean and vacuum liftgate opening. 2. Level old bead of liftgate opening adhesive (1) to a
thickness of approximately 1 mm (0.04 in.) and remove loose adhesive.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 10017
NOTE: Windshield opening shown, liftgate opening similar.
3. Clean and dry area of liftgate opening to be re-glued with a suitable glass preparation solvent
and rag. 4. Re-prime any damaged area. If old adhesive has been exposed for more than 12 hours,
entire adhesive area needs to be re-primed. 5. Allow primer to air dry for at least 10 minutes.
Backlite Installation
1. Apply bead of adhesive (1) with a triangular nozzle directly to the backlite seal starting at bottom
in center of the backlite.
CAUTION: Always apply bead of adhesive to the backlite. Always install the backlite within 5
minutes after applying adhesive.
2. Bead dimensions should be approximately 9.5 mm wide (1) by 12.7 mm in height (2).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Glass - Removal > Page 10018
3. Allow end of adhesive bead (1) to run out parallel to the start of the bead and smooth ends flush.
4. Lift backlite into place in the center of the liftgate opening and use the tape as a guide to aid
installation of the backlite into the center of the
cutout.
5. Carefully lay down the backlite and press on.
CAUTION: It is no longer possible to move the backlite after installation. The backlite should never
be pressed into place by more than one
person, because the backlite can break if pressed simultaneously on both sides.
CAUTION: Roll down the left and right front door glass and open the rear glass slider (if available)
before installing backlite to avoid
pressurizing the passenger compartment if a door is slammed before urethane is cured. Water
leaks can result.
6. Install the rear wiper arm, if equipped. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Wiper Arm/Service and
Repair/Wiper Arm - Installation 7. Install the liftgate trim panels.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass - Removal
Quarter Window Glass: Service and Repair Quarter Glass - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Before proceeding with the following repair procedure, review all warnings and cautions See:
Windshield/Service Precautions. 2. Remove quarter panel trim See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter
Trim Panel - Removal.
NOTE: Windshield removal shown, quarter glass similar.
3. Using a windshield cut-out wire (4) or other suitable tool, separate the adhesive (2).
4. Release the tabs and the tabs on the alignment pin and carefully remove the quarter glass.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass - Removal > Page 10023
Quarter Window Glass: Service and Repair Quarter Glass - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Allow the urethane at least 24 hours to cure before returning the vehicle to use.
CAUTION: Roll down the left and right front door glass and open the rear glass slider (if available)
before installing quarter glass to avoid
pressurizing the passenger compartment if a door is slammed before urethane is cured. Water
leaks can result.
NOTE: The quarter glass fence should be cleaned of most of its old urethane bonding material. A
small amount of old urethane,
approximately 1-2 mm in height, should remain on the fence. Do not grind off or completely remove
all old urethane from the fence, the paint finish and bonding strength will be adversely affected.
Glass Preparation - Installing A Previously Installed Quarter Glass
1. Before proceeding with the following repair procedure, review all warnings and cautions. See:
Windshield/Service Precautions 2. Level old bead of quarter glass adhesive (3) to a thickness of
approximately 1 mm (0.04 in.) and remove loose adhesive.
NOTE: Typical primer installation shown.
3. Clean and dry area of glass (2) to be re-glued with a suitable glass preparation solvent and rag.
4. Using a flash light, verify that glass primer is without damage. 5. Re-prime any damaged area. If
old adhesive has been exposed for more than 12 hours, entire adhesive area needs to be
re-primed. 6. Apply primer (1) around the perimeter of the glass to a width of 15 mm (0.5 in.).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass - Removal > Page 10024
NOTE: Make sure the primer does not touch the locating pins and tabs.
7. Allow primer to air dry for at least 10 minutes. 8. Using a flash light, verify that glass primer is
without damage.
Glass Preparation - Installing A New Quarter Glass
NOTE: Typical primer installation shown.
1. Clean and dry area of glass (2) to be re-glued with a suitable glass preparation solvent and rag.
2. Apply primer to gluing surface at quarter glass seal. 3. Apply primer (1) around the perimeter of
the glass to a width of 15 mm (0.5 in.) (3).
NOTE: Make sure the primer does not touch the locating pins and tabs (2, 4).
4. Allow primer to air dry for at least 10 minutes. 5. Using a flash light, verify that glass primer is
without damage.
Quarter Glass Opening Preparation
NOTE: Windshield opening shown, quarter glass opening similar.
1. Clean and vacuum quarter glass opening. 2. Level old bead of quarter glass opening adhesive
(1) to a thickness of approximately 1 mm (0.04 in.) and remove loose adhesive.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass - Removal > Page 10025
NOTE: Windshield opening shown, quarter glass opening similar.
3. Clean and dry area of quarter glass opening to be re-glued with a suitable glass preparation
solvent and rag. 4. Re-prime any damaged area. If old adhesive has been exposed for more than
12 hours, entire adhesive area needs to be re-primed.
NOTE: Make sure the primer does not touch the locating pins and tabs.
5. Allow primer to air dry for at least 10 minutes.
Quarter Glass Installation
1. Apply bead of adhesive (1) with a triangular nozzle directly to the quarter glass seal starting at
bottom in center of the quarter glass.
CAUTION: Always apply bead of adhesive to the quarter glass. Always install the quarter glass
within 5 minutes after applying adhesive.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass - Removal > Page 10026
2. Bead dimensions should be approximately 9.5 mm wide (1) by 12.7 mm in height (2).
3. Allow end of adhesive bead (1) to run out parallel to the start of the bead and smooth ends flush.
4. Lift quarter glass into place in the center of the quarter glass opening and install over the
alignment tabs and pin. 5. Carefully lay down the quarter glass and press on.
CAUTION: It is no longer possible to move the quarter glass after installation. The quarter glass
should never be pressed into place by more
than one person, because the quarter glass can break if pressed simultaneously on both sides.
CAUTION: Roll down the left and right front door glass and open the rear glass slider (if available)
before installing quarter glass to avoid
pressurizing the passenger compartment if a door is slammed before urethane is cured. Water
leaks can result.
6. Install quarter panel trim. See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Luggage Compartment Trim/Quarter
Trim Panel - Installation
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Outer Belt Molding - Removal
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Outer Belt Molding - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Lower the window to the full down position. 2. Remove the rear door trim panel. See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door
Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Remove the front and rear mounting fasteners. 4. Remove the rear door belt molding (2) by
carefully pulling up on the molding and remove from the rear door (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Outer Belt Molding - Removal > Page 10032
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Outer Belt Molding - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear door belt molding (2) to the rear door (3). 2. Install the front and rear mounting
fasteners. 3. Install the rear door trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door
Trim Panel - Installation.
4. Verify proper window operation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Window Regulator - Removal
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Front Door Window Regulator - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim
Panel - Removal.
2. Remove the door module assembly. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Service and Repair/Front Door Carrier Plate
- Removal.
3. Remove the power window lift motor See: Power Window Motor/Front Door Window
Motor/Service and Repair/Window Regulator Motor Removal.
4. Remove the regulator mounting fasteners. 5. Remove regulator from door module assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Window Regulator - Removal > Page 10038
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Front Door Window Regulator - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position regulator on door module assembly and install mounting fasteners. 2. Install the power
window motor. See: Power Window Motor/Front Door Window Motor/Service and Repair/Window
Regulator Motor Installation.
3. Install the door module assembly. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Service and Repair/Front Door Carrier Plate Installation.
4. Install door trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Front Door Trim
Panel - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Regulator - Removal
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Rear Door Window Regulator - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear
Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear Door Trim
Panel - Removal.
2. Remove the door module assembly. See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear
Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair/Rear
Door Trim Panel - Removal.
3. Remove the power window lift motor. See: Power Window Motor/Front Door Window
Motor/Service and Repair/Window Regulator Motor Removal
4. Remove the regulator mounting fasteners. 5. Remove regulator from door module assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Regulator - Removal > Page 10043
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Rear Door Window Regulator - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install regulator to door module assembly. 2. Install the regulator mounting fasteners. 3. Install
the power window lift motor. See: Power Window Motor/Front Door Window Motor/Service and
Repair/Window Regulator Motor Removal.
4. Install the door module assembly. See: Power Window Motor/Front Door Window Motor/Service
and Repair/Window Regulator Motor Removal.
5. Install door trim panel. See: Power Window Motor/Front Door Window Motor/Service and
Repair/Window Regulator Motor - Removal. 6. Verify Proper operation of the window.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service Precautions
Windshield: Service Precautions
WINDSHIELD SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
WARNING: Do not operate the vehicle within 24 hours of windshield installation. It takes at least 24
hours for urethane adhesive to cure. If it
is not cured, the windshield may not perform properly in an accident.
Urethane adhesives are applied as a system. Use glass cleaner, glass prep solvent, glass primer,
PVC (vinyl) primer and pinch weld (fence) primer provided by the adhesive manufacturer. If not,
structural integrity could be compromised.
Chrysler does not recommend glass adhesive by brand. Technicians should review product labels
and technical data sheets, and use only adhesives that their manufactures warrant will restore a
vehicle to the requirements of FMVSS 212. Technicians should also insure that primers and
cleaners are compatible with the particular adhesive used.
Be sure to refer to the urethane manufacturer's directions for curing time specifications, and do not
use adhesive after its expiration date.
Vapors that are emitted from the urethane adhesive or primer could cause personal injury. Use
them in a well-ventilated area.
Skin contact with urethane adhesive should be avoided. Personal injury may result.
Always wear eye and hand protection when working with glass.
CAUTION: Protect all painted and trimmed surfaces from coming in contact with urethane or
primers.
Be careful not to damage painted surfaces when removing moldings or cutting urethane around
windshield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page
10047
Windshield: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The windshield is attached to the window frame (fence) with urethane adhesive. The urethane
adhesive is applied cold and seals the surface area between the window opening and the glass.
The primer adheres the urethane adhesive to the windshield.
It is difficult to salvage a windshield during the removal operation. The windshield is part of the
structural support for the roof. The urethane bonding used to secure the windshield to the fence is
difficult to cut or clean from any surface. If the rubber seals are set in urethane, it would also be
unlikely they could be salvaged. Before removing the windshield, check the availability of the
windshield and seals from the parts supplier.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Windshield - Removal
Windshield: Service and Repair Windshield - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Before proceeding with the following repair procedure, review all warnings and cautions See:
Service Precautions. 2. Remove the rear view mirror See: Body and Frame/Mirrors/Service and
Repair/Interior Rearview Mirror - Removal. 3. Remove the cowl grille See: Body and
Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage painted surfaces when removing moldings or cutting urethane
around the windshield.
4. Using an assistant and a wire-type windshield cut-out tool (1, 3 and 4), cut and separate the
urethane adhesive (2) securing the windshield to the
windshield fence.
5. Carefully remove the windshield from the vehicle. 6. Remove molding from the sides of the
windshield.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Windshield - Removal > Page 10050
Windshield: Service and Repair Windshield - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Do not operate the vehicle within 24 hours of windshield installation. It takes at least 24
hours for urethane adhesive to cure. If it
is not cured, the windshield may not perform properly if the vehicle is in an accident.
CAUTION: To help prevent water leaks, partially roll down the left and right door glass before
installing the windshield. This avoids
pressurizing the passenger compartment if a door is slammed before the urethane is cured.
1. If the windshield (1) is being reused, remove as much of the original urethane (3) as possible
from the glass surface using a razor knife (2).
CAUTION: To prevent corrosion, do not damage paint on windshield fence when removing original
urethane.
CAUTION: The windshield fence should be cleaned of most of its old urethane adhesive. A small
amount of old urethane, approximately 1 mm
(.039 in.) in height should remain on the fence. Do not completely remove all old urethane from the
fence, the paint finish and bonding strength will be adversely affected.
CAUTION: Support spacers located near the cowl at the bottom of the windshield fence should be
replaced with new spacers. Replace any
missing or damaged spacers around the perimeter of the windshield fence.
2. Using a razor knife (2), level the original bead of urethane (1) on the windshield fence (3) to a
thickness of approximately 1 mm (0.04 in.) and
remove any damaged adhesive backed spacers.
3. Install new adhesive backed spacers along the windshield fence as required. 4. Install a new
rubber seal along the sides of the windshield. 5. Using an assistant, position the windshield into the
windshield opening and against the windshield fence and spacers. 6. Verify the windshield lays
evenly against the fence at the top, bottom and sides of the opening. If not, the fence must be
formed to the shape of the
windshield.
7. Mark the windshield and the windshield fence with a grease pencil or pieces of masking tape to
use as a reference for installation. 8. Using an assistant, remove the windshield from the
windshield opening and place it on a suitable padded work surface.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Windshield - Removal > Page 10051
WARNING: Do not use solvent based glass cleaners to clean the windshield before applying glass
prep and primer or poor glass adhesion may
result.
9. Clean the inside of the windshield with an ammonia based glass cleaner and a lint-free cloth.
10. Apply glass prep adhesion promoter 25 mm (1 in.) wide (1) around the perimeter of the
windshield (2) and 5 mm (0.2 in.) from the edge of the
glass and wipe dry with a clean lint-free cloth until no streaks are visible.
11. Apply glass primer 25 mm (1 in.) wide (1) around the perimeter of the windshield (2) and 5 mm
(0.2 in.) from the edge of the glass. Allow at least
three minutes drying time.
12. Using a flashlight, verify that the primer is completely and evenly installed along the perimeter
of the windshield. 13. Re-prime any area that is not fully and evenly primed.
14. Clean the windshield fence with an ammonia based glass cleaner and a lint-free cloth. 15.
Apply pinch weld primer 15 mm (0.75 in.) wide (1) around the windshield fence (2). Allow at least
three minutes drying time. 16. Using a flashlight, verify that the primer is completely and evenly
installed along the windshield fence. 17. Re-prime any area that is not fully and evenly primed.
CAUTION: Always apply the bead of adhesive to the windshield. Always install the windshield
within 5 minutes after applying the adhesive.
NOTE: If the original urethane adhesive has been exposed for more than 12 hours, the entire
adhesive area will need to be re-primed prior to
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Windshield - Removal > Page 10052
installing new adhesive.
18. Apply approximately a 10 mm (0.4 in.) wide bead of adhesive (1) with a triangular nozzle
approximately 6 mm (0.230 in.) from the edge of the
glass (2) starting at the bottom center of the windshield.
19. Run the end of the adhesive bead (1) on the windshield (2) parallel to the start of the bead and
smooth the ends flush.
20. Using an assistant, position the windshield over the windshield opening. 21. Using the grease
pencil marks or tape as reference points, align the windshield to the windshield opening. 22.
Carefully lower the windshield into the windshield opening. Guide the windshield and the rubber
seals on the sides of the windshield into its
proper location.
CAUTION: It is not possible to move the windshield after installation. The windshield should never
be pressed into place by more than one
person, because the windshield can break if pressed simultaneously on both sides.
23. Push the windshield inward until the windshield comes into contact with the spacers located on
each side and the bottom of the windshield fence. 24. Install the cowl grill See: Body and
Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair. 25. Install the rear view mirror onto the
windshield See: Body and Frame/Mirrors/Service and Repair/Interior Rearview Mirror - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Check Valve, Washer > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Washer Check Valve - Description
Check Valve: Description and Operation Washer Check Valve - Description
DESCRIPTION
Diaphragm-type washer system check valves are standard equipment in this vehicle. The check
valves for both the front and rear washer systems are integral to their respective washer nozzles.
The check valve for the headlamp washer system, which is optional equipment only on vehicles
manufactured for certain export markets, is integral to the headlamp washer hose tee fitting. The
headlamp washer tee fitting is located behind the front fascia near the left headlamp washer
nozzle.
Each diaphragm-type check valve consists of a molded plastic valve body where a small
diaphragm is held against the lip of an integral sump well by a small plastic piston and a coiled
spring.
The front and rear check valves cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
washer nozzle unit must replaced. The headlamp washer system tee fitting with the integral check
valve also cannot be adjusted or repaired, and is serviced only as a unit with the headlamp washer
hose assembly.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Check Valve, Washer > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Washer Check Valve - Description > Page 10058
Check Valve: Description and Operation Washer Check Valve - Operation
OPERATION
Diaphragm-type washer system check valves provide more than one function. First, they prevent
washer fluid from draining out of the washer supply hoses back to the washer reservoir. This
drain-back would result in a lengthy delay from when the washer system is activated until washer
fluid was dispensed through the washer nozzles because the washer pump would have to refill the
washer plumbing from the reservoir to the nozzle. Such a drain-back condition could also result in
water, dirt, or other outside contaminants being drawn into the washer system through the washer
nozzle orifice. This water could subsequently freeze and plug the nozzle, while other contaminants
could interfere with proper nozzle operation and cause improper nozzle spray patterns. In addition,
the check valve prevents washer fluid from siphoning out through the washer nozzle after the
washer system is turned OFF.
When the washer pump pressurizes and pumps washer fluid from the reservoir through the washer
plumbing (5), the fluid pressure unseats a diaphragm (3) from over a sump well within the valve by
overriding the pressure applied to it by a piston (2) and coiled spring (1). With the diaphragm
unseated, washer fluid is allowed to flow toward the washer nozzle (4). When the washer pump
stops operating, the spring pressure on the piston seats the diaphragm over the sump well in the
valve and fluid flow in either direction within the washer plumbing is prevented.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Hose > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Hoses and Tubes - Description
Headlamp Washer Hose: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Hoses and Tubes Description
HEADLAMP
The headlamp washer system plumbing consists of a large diameter high pressure rubber hose (3)
that is routed from the outlet nipple of the headlamp washer pump/motor unit on the washer
reservoir to the barbed nipple of a tee fitting with an integral check valve located near the left
headlamp washer nozzle on the back side of the front fascia (1). The other two barbed nipples of
the tee fitting are connected to one short and one long length of hose that each terminate at a
headlamp washer nozzle (2) behind the fascia and below the two front lamp units. The hose is
secured and routed from left to right behind the fascia and above the fascia reinforcement by
several routing clips. The hose connections at the nozzles and the washer pump are secured using
molded plastic quick-connect fittings.
The headlamp washer hose is serviced only as a complete unit. The molded plastic washer hose
fittings and check valve cannot be repaired. If these fittings or the check valve are ineffective or
damaged, the entire headlamp washer hose unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Hose > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Hoses and Tubes - Description > Page 10063
Headlamp Washer Hose: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Hoses and Tubes Operation
HEADLAMP
Washer fluid in the washer reservoir is pressurized and fed by the headlamp washer pump/motor
unit through the headlamp washer system plumbing and fittings to the two headlamp washer
nozzles. Whenever routing the washer hose, it must be routed away from hot, sharp, or moving
parts; and, sharp bends that might pinch the hose must be avoided.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Motor Relay > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Relay - Description
Headlamp Washer Motor Relay: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Relay - Description
DESCRIPTION
The headlamp washer relay (1) is a conventional International Standards Organization (ISO)
skirted relay. Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions,
current capacities, terminal patterns (2), and terminal functions. This relay is contained within a
small, rectangular, molded plastic housing and is connected to all of the required inputs and
outputs through five integral male spade-type terminals that extend from the relay base plate.
The headlamp washer relay is located in a dedicated connector on a take out of the Front End
Module (FEM) wire harness, and is secured to the radiator closure panel to the left of the washer
reservoir in front of the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) in the engine compartment, near
the battery. The headlamp washer relay cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or
damaged, the unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Motor Relay > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Relay - Description > Page 10068
Headlamp Washer Motor Relay: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Relay - Operation
OPERATION
The headlamp washer relay is an electromechanical switch that uses a low current input from the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control a high current output to the headlamp washer
pump/motor unit. The movable common feed contact point is held against the fixed normally closed
contact point by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field is
produced by the coil windings. This electromagnetic field draws the movable relay contact point
away from the fixed normally closed contact point, and holds it against the fixed normally open
contact point. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure returns the movable contact
point back against the fixed normally closed contact point. A resistor is connected in parallel with
the relay coil in the relay, and helps to dissipate voltage spikes and electromagnetic interference
that can be generated as the electromagnetic field of the relay coil collapses.
The headlamp washer relay terminals are connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness. The inputs and
outputs of the headlamp washer relay include:
- Common Feed Terminal - The common feed terminal (30) is connected to battery current on a
fused B(+) circuit from a fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) at all times.
Coil Ground Terminal - The coil ground terminal (85) is connected to battery current on a fused run
relay output circuit from a fuse in the TIPM at all times. This circuit is energized by the run relay
only while the engine is running.
- Coil Battery Terminal - The coil battery terminal (86) is connected to a low side driver output from
the TIPM on a headlamp washer relay control circuit. The TIPM controls headlamp washer system
operation through this relay connection.
- Normally Open Terminal - The normally open terminal (87) is connected through a headlamp
washer relay output circuit to the headlamp washer pump/motor unit at all times. When the relay is
energized, the normally open terminal of the relay is connected to battery current from the fuse in
the TIPM.
- Normally Closed Terminal - The normally closed terminal (87A) is not connected to any circuit in
this application, but will have battery current present whenever the headlamp washer relay coil is
not energized.
The headlamp washer relay as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the relay may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or the communication between modules and other devices that provide
some features of the headlamp washer system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to
diagnose the headlamp washer relay or the electronic controls and communication related to
headlamp washer system operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Pump > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Headlamp Windshield Washer Pump - Description
Headlamp Washer Pump: Description and Operation Headlamp Windshield Washer Pump Description
HEADLAMP
The headlamp washer pump/motor unit (1) of vehicles so equipped is located on the top of a sump
area just above and outboard of the reversible front and rear washer pump on the rearward facing
side of the washer reservoir, on the upper left corner of the cooling module in the engine
compartment. A small permanently lubricated and sealed electric motor is coupled to the rotor-type
washer pump.
An inlet nipple (4) on the bottom of the pump housing (3) passes through a rubber grommet
seal/filter screen installed in a dedicated mounting hole of the washer reservoir. When the pump is
installed in the reservoir the quick connect outlet nipple (5) on the pump housing points toward the
left side of the vehicle and connects the unit to the headlamp washer hose.
The headlamp washer pump/motor unit is retained on the reservoir by the interference fit between
the pump inlet nipple and the grommet seal, which is a light press fit. The top of the washer pump
is also secured to the washer reservoir by a light snap fit into a receptacle molded into the reservoir
that allows for mounting of the washer pump without the use of fasteners. An integral connector
receptacle (2) on the top of the motor housing connects the unit to the vehicle electrical system
through a dedicated take out and connector of the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness.
The headlamp washer pump/motor unit cannot be repaired. If ineffective or damaged, the entire
headlamp washer pump/motor unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Pump > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Headlamp Windshield Washer Pump - Description > Page 10073
Headlamp Washer Pump: Description and Operation Headlamp Windshield Washer Pump Operation
HEADLAMP
Headlamp washer pump/motor unit operation is completely controlled by the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM) logic circuits based upon electronic wash request and lighting request
message inputs received from the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as
the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus. The EMIC
monitors electronic washer switch and lighting switch status messages received over the Local
Interface Network (LIN) data bus from the Steering Control Module (SCM). The SCM monitors
analog and resistor multiplexed inputs from the front washer switch circuitry contained within the
right (wiper) multi-function switch and the exterior lighting switch circuitry of the left (lighting)
multi-function switch to determine the proper washer switch and lighting switch status messages to
send.
The headlamp washer relay control coil operates on battery voltage received from the run relay, so
it is only functional while the engine is running. In addition, the TIPM will only allow the headlamp
washers to operate when the headlamps are turned ON. The TIPM uses a low side driver to
energize or de-energize the headlamp washer relay which, in turn, controls the operation of the
headlamp washer pump/motor unit.
The hard wired circuits and components of the headlamp washer pump/motor unit may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the headlamp washer pump/motor or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide some features of the headlamp washer system. The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the headlamp washer pump/motor unit or the
electronic controls and communication related to headlamp washer pump/motor unit operation
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Headlamp Windshield Washer Pump - Removal
Headlamp Washer Pump: Service and Repair Headlamp Windshield Washer Pump - Removal
HEADLAMP
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Siphon the washer fluid from the washer
reservoir into a clean container for reuse. 3. Remove the washer reservoir from the cooling module.
See: Windshield Washer Reservoir/Service and Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir Removal.
4. Pull lightly outward on the top of the washer pump/motor housing (1), away from the washer
reservoir to disengage the top of the motor from the
receptacle in the reservoir.
5. Using hand pressure, firmly grasp and pull the washer pump upward far enough to disengage
the pump inlet nipple from the rubber grommet
seal/filter screen in the reservoir. Care must be taken not to damage the reservoir.
6. Remove the rubber grommet seal/filter screen from the pump mounting hole in the washer
reservoir and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Headlamp Windshield Washer Pump - Removal > Page 10076
Headlamp Washer Pump: Service and Repair Headlamp Windshield Washer Pump - Installation
HEADLAMP
1. Install a new rubber grommet seal/filter screen into the headlamp washer pump/motor unit
mounting hole in the washer reservoir. Always use a
new rubber grommet seal on the reservoir.
2. Position the inlet nipple of the headlamp washer pump/motor unit (1) to the rubber grommet
seal/filter screen in the reservoir. 3. Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly downward on the
washer pump/motor unit until the inlet nipple is fully seated in the rubber grommet
seal/filter screen in the pump mounting hole of the reservoir.
4. Align the top of the washer pump/motor unit housing with the receptacle in the washer reservoir.
5. Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly on the top of washer pump/motor unit until the
motor housing snaps into the receptacle. 6. Reinstall the washer reservoir onto the cooling module.
See: Windshield Washer Reservoir/Service and Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir Installation.
7. Refill the washer reservoir with the washer fluid drained during removal. 8. Reconnect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Nozzle - Description
Headlamp Washer Spray Nozzle: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Nozzle Description
HEADLAMP
Vehicles equipped with the optional headlamp washer system have two fixed headlamp washer
nozzles (1), one secured to the front fascia beneath each front lamp unit.
Each nozzle includes two orifices (1) to ensure complete headlamp lens coverage by the fluid
streams emitted from the nozzle. The fixed body of the molded plastic nozzle is located below the
front fascia. An integral mounting bezel (2) is secured by two integral latch features (3) within the
mounting hole in the front fascia. A large diameter high pressure washer fluid supply hose from the
dedicated headlamp washer pump/motor unit is routed to the nozzle, where it is secured by a quick
connect fitting to the nipple fitting (4) at the base of the nozzle.
The headlamp washer nozzle cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
entire nozzle and mounting bezel must be replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Nozzle - Description > Page 10081
Headlamp Washer Spray Nozzle: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Nozzle - Operation
HEADLAMP
When the headlamp washer pump/motor unit is activated, pressure builds within the high pressure
hoses to each headlamp washer nozzle. Driven by this pressure, a control valve integral to each
nozzle allows a precisely metered quantity of washer fluid to be sprayed in several high pressure
streams against the lenses of both front lamp units. When the pressure drops, the control valve
closes and the nozzle spray ceases.
The headlamp washer system only operates when the engine is running and the headlamps are
turned ON. When those conditions have been met, the headlamp washer system operates
whenever the front (windshield) washer system is activated.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Headlamp Washer Nozzle - Removal
Headlamp Washer Spray Nozzle: Service and Repair Headlamp Washer Nozzle - Removal
HEADLAMP
CAUTION: Take proper precautions to ensure there is no cosmetic damage done to the paint finish
of the headlamp washer nozzle bezel or the
front fascia during the following procedure.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Remove the push pin retainers that secure the lower front edge
of the front wheel house splash shield. See: Body and Frame/Fender/Front
Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Removal.
3. Reach up behind the front fascia to access and securely clamp the headlamp washer supply
hose to prevent the contents of the washer reservoir
from draining during the following procedure.
4. From behind the front fascia, depress the two integral latches (1) of the washer nozzle bezel and
push the nozzle out through the face of the fascia.
5. From the face of the front fascia, pull the nozzle out from the mounting hole far enough to access
the headlamp washer nozzle supply hose (1)
quick connect fitting (4).
6. Pull the molded plastic lock (2) away from the quick connect fitting far enough to disengage the
hose from the washer nozzle nipple (3). 7. Remove the nozzle from the front fascia.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Headlamp Washer Nozzle - Removal > Page 10084
Headlamp Washer Spray Nozzle: Service and Repair Headlamp Washer Nozzle - Installation
HEADLAMP
CAUTION: Take proper precautions to ensure there is no cosmetic damage done to the paint finish
of the headlamp washer nozzle bezel or the
front fascia during the following procedure.
1. Pull the washer nozzle supply hose (1) quick connect fitting (4) out through the mounting hole of
the front fascia far enough to seat the molded
plastic lock (2) onto the fitting.
2. Push the quick connect fitting onto the headlamp washer nozzle nipple (3) until it snaps into
place with an audible click.
3. Position the headlamp washer nozzle into the mounting hole in the front fascia. 4. Align the
washer nozzle bezel with the mounting hole in the front fascia. 5. Using hand pressure, push the
bezel down into the fascia mounting hole until both bezel latch features are fully engaged on the
back side of the
fascia.
6. Reach up behind the front fascia to access and remove the clamp from the washer supply hose.
7. Reinstall the push pin retainers that secure the lower front edge of the front wheel house splash
shield. See: Body and Frame/Fender/Front
Fender/Front Fender Liner/Service and Repair/Splash Shield - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp
Washer Motor Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Relay - Description
Headlamp Washer Motor Relay: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Relay - Description
DESCRIPTION
The headlamp washer relay (1) is a conventional International Standards Organization (ISO)
skirted relay. Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions,
current capacities, terminal patterns (2), and terminal functions. This relay is contained within a
small, rectangular, molded plastic housing and is connected to all of the required inputs and
outputs through five integral male spade-type terminals that extend from the relay base plate.
The headlamp washer relay is located in a dedicated connector on a take out of the Front End
Module (FEM) wire harness, and is secured to the radiator closure panel to the left of the washer
reservoir in front of the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) in the engine compartment, near
the battery. The headlamp washer relay cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or
damaged, the unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp
Washer Motor Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Headlamp Washer Relay - Description >
Page 10090
Headlamp Washer Motor Relay: Description and Operation Headlamp Washer Relay - Operation
OPERATION
The headlamp washer relay is an electromechanical switch that uses a low current input from the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) to control a high current output to the headlamp washer
pump/motor unit. The movable common feed contact point is held against the fixed normally closed
contact point by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field is
produced by the coil windings. This electromagnetic field draws the movable relay contact point
away from the fixed normally closed contact point, and holds it against the fixed normally open
contact point. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure returns the movable contact
point back against the fixed normally closed contact point. A resistor is connected in parallel with
the relay coil in the relay, and helps to dissipate voltage spikes and electromagnetic interference
that can be generated as the electromagnetic field of the relay coil collapses.
The headlamp washer relay terminals are connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness. The inputs and
outputs of the headlamp washer relay include:
- Common Feed Terminal - The common feed terminal (30) is connected to battery current on a
fused B(+) circuit from a fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) at all times.
Coil Ground Terminal - The coil ground terminal (85) is connected to battery current on a fused run
relay output circuit from a fuse in the TIPM at all times. This circuit is energized by the run relay
only while the engine is running.
- Coil Battery Terminal - The coil battery terminal (86) is connected to a low side driver output from
the TIPM on a headlamp washer relay control circuit. The TIPM controls headlamp washer system
operation through this relay connection.
- Normally Open Terminal - The normally open terminal (87) is connected through a headlamp
washer relay output circuit to the headlamp washer pump/motor unit at all times. When the relay is
energized, the normally open terminal of the relay is connected to battery current from the fuse in
the TIPM.
- Normally Closed Terminal - The normally closed terminal (87A) is not connected to any circuit in
this application, but will have battery current present whenever the headlamp washer relay coil is
not energized.
The headlamp washer relay as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the relay may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or the communication between modules and other devices that provide
some features of the headlamp washer system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to
diagnose the headlamp washer relay or the electronic controls and communication related to
headlamp washer system operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 10095
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WASHER FLUID LEVEL-FRONT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Description
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Description and Operation Washer Fluid Level Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The washer fluid level switch (3) is a two-pin conductivity sensor with no moving parts mounted on
the rearward facing side of the washer reservoir on the upper left corner of the cooling module on
the Front End Module (FEM). Only the molded plastic switch mounting flange and the integral
connector receptacle (4) are visible when the switch is installed in the reservoir.
A short nipple formation (1) extends from the inner surface of the switch mounting flange, and a
barb on the nipple is pressed through a rubber grommet seal installed in the mounting hole of the
reservoir. Two over-molded pins or electrodes (2) extend from the back of the nipple formation. The
switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of
the FEM wire harness.
The washer fluid level switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged, the switch
must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Description > Page
10098
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Description and Operation Washer Fluid Level Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The washer fluid level switch uses fluid conductivity to monitor the level of the washer fluid in the
washer reservoir. Electricity is conducted between the two switch pins or electrodes only when they
are immersed in the washer fluid, which closes the switch circuit. When the fluid level in the washer
reservoir falls below the pins, electrical current cannot be conducted and the switch becomes an
open circuit, which signals a low fluid condition.
In order to prevent an electrical charge from accumulating in the electrical leads of the switch, the
switch receives current that is pulsed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) located in
the engine compartment near the battery. The TIPM monitors the switch return signal and is
programmed to respond to three consecutive open switch readings by sending an electronic
washer fluid indicator lamp-ON request message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the Controller Area Network (CAN)
data bus. The EMIC responds to this message by illuminating the washer fluid indicator and by
sounding an audible chime tone warning.
The washer fluid level switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take
out and connector of the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness. The switch is connected in series
between a sensor return circuit and the washer fluid switch sense input to the TIPM.
The washer fluid level switch and the hard wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the washer fluid level indicator or the electronic controls or communication between other modules
and devices that provide some features of the washer system. The most reliable, efficient, and
accurate means to diagnose the washer fluid level indicator or the electronic controls and
communication related to washer fluid level switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan
tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Removal
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair Washer Fluid Level Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the washer reservoir from the
back of the cooling module on the Front End Module (FEM). See: Windshield Washer
Reservoir/Service
and Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir - Removal.
3. Disconnect the FEM wire harness connector from the washer fluid level switch connector
receptacle (3) on the back of the reservoir. 4. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed
tool, gently pry the barbed nipple of the washer fluid level switch out of the rubber grommet
seal in the washer reservoir. Care must be taken not to damage the reservoir.
5. Remove the switch from the washer reservoir. 6. Remove the rubber grommet seal from the
switch mounting hole in the washer reservoir and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Removal > Page 10101
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair Washer Fluid Level Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new rubber grommet seal into the washer fluid level switch mounting hole of the washer
reservoir. Always use a new rubber grommet seal
on the reservoir.
2. Insert the nipple formation of the switch through the rubber grommet seal in the reservoir. 3.
Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly on the switch mounting flange until the barbed nipple
is fully seated in the rubber grommet seal in
the reservoir. The flat edge of the switch mounting flange should be oriented upward.
4. Reconnect the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness connector (3) to the switch connector
receptacle. 5. Reinstall the washer reservoir onto the back of the cooling module on the FEM. See:
Windshield Washer Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems >
Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Windshield Washer Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-RIGHT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Wiper Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-RIGHT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Right Multifunction Switch - Description
Wiper Switch: Description and Operation Right Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The right (wiper) multi-function switch is located on the right side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the front and rear wiper and washer
systems. The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (1), control knob (2) and
control sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the right side of the column.
The remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions and electrical connection are
concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing and controls (6) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3). A single connector receptacle containing seven
terminal pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and is connected by a jumper wire
harness (5) directly to the Steering Control Module (SCM), which is internal to the housing (2) of
the left multi-function switch (1).
The right (wiper) multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following wiper and washer system functions:
- Continuous Front Wipers - The right multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching
for two continuous front wipe modes, low speed or high speed.
- Intermittent Front Wipers - The right multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching
for the intermittent front wipe mode with five minor detent delay interval positions.
- Front Wiper Mist Mode - The right multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary
switching of the front wiper motor low speed circuit to provide a mist mode features (sometimes
referred to as pulse wipe), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily operate the front
wipers for one or more complete cycles.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Right Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 10110
- Front Washer Mode - The right multi-function switch control stalk provides momentary switching
for control of the front washer system operation.
- Intermittent Rear Wipe Mode - The right multi-function switch control sleeve provides detent
switching for a single fixed interval intermittent rear wiper mode.
- Rear Washer Mode - The right multi-function switch control sleeve provides one momentary
switch positions for control of rear washer system operation.
The right multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Right Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 10111
Wiper Switch: Description and Operation Right Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The right (wiper) multi-function switch uses a combination of resistor multiplexing and conventional
analog switching to control the many functions and features it provides. The switch receives a
clean ground from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed and
conventional analog return outputs to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM
then sends electronic switch status messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN),
and the EMIC relays electronic wiper and washer switch request messages over the Controller
Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the right multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal
Not Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the front and rear
wiper systems. The failsafe mode will maintain the last selected front and rear wiper system
operation for the remainder of the current ignition cycle, after which both wiper systems will default
to OFF.
The right multi-function switch as well as the hard-wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Following are descriptions of how the right multi-function switch is operated to control the many
front and rear wiper and washer system functions and features it provides:
- Front Wiper Control - The control knob on the end of the right multi-function switch control stalk is
rotated to one of the two continuous wiper detents, to one of five intermittent wiper detents, or to
the OFF position to select the front wiper mode. The SCM reads the input from the right
multi-function switch and sends electronic wiper switch status messages over the LIN data bus to
the EMIC, which relays an electronic wiper switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Wiper Mist Mode - The front wiper mist mode is requested when the right multi-function
switch control stalk is depressed downward towards the floor to a momentary MIST position. The
front wiper motor will continue to operate, one complete cycle at a time, for as long as the control
stalk is held in this position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the right
multi-function switch and sends an electronic wiper switch status message over the LIN data bus to
the EMIC, which relays an electronic wiper switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Washer Control - The right multi-function switch control stalk is pulled rearward towards the
steering wheel to a momentary WASH position to activate the washer pump/motor in the front
washer mode. The washer pump/motor will continue to operate for as long as the control stalk is
held in this position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the right multi-function
switch and sends an electronic washer switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic washer switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Wiper Control - The rear wiper mode is selected when the right multi-function switch control
sleeve is rotated to the fixed interval intermittent rear wipe detent position, or the OFF detent
position. The SCM reads the input from the right multi-function switch and sends an electronic
wiper switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic wiper
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Washer Control - The right multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to one of two
momentary WASH positions, either fully forward or fully rearward, to activate the washer
pump/motor in the rear washer mode. The washer pump/motor will continue to operate in the rear
washer mode until the control sleeve is released. The SCM reads the input from the right
multi-function switch and sends an electronic washer switch status message over the LIN data bus
to the EMIC, which relays an electronic washer switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 10112
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
RIGHT MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
The right multi-function switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
Steering Control Module (SCM) or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide some features of the front and rear wiper and washer systems.
The most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose the SCM or the electronic controls and
communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
1. Remove the right multi-function switch from the integral mounting bracket on the right side of the
clockspring. See: Service and Repair/Right
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
2. Using an ohmmeter, test the resistance between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
three Function Tests tables. For all functions except
those of the control stalk the values should be either less than 100 ohms (switch CLOSED) or
greater than 1 megohm (switch OPEN).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 10113
3. If the switch fails any of the tests, replace the ineffective right multi-function switch as required. If
the switch tests okay, but the switch input to the
Steering Control Module (SCM) remains incorrect, be certain to check for a short or open in the
jumper harness between the right multi-function switch and the SCM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Right Multifunction Switch - Removal
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair Right Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid personal or fatal injury, on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting
any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel
component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or
service. This is the only sure way to disable the supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the
proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Remove the screw (2) that secures the right multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket
integral to the right side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
4. Slide the switch away from the clockspring far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the switch
housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
5. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (1) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the right multi-function switch (2). 6. Remove the switch from the clockspring (3).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Right Multifunction Switch - Removal > Page 10116
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair Right Multifunction Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Position the right multi-function switch (2) close enough to the mounting bracket (3) integral to
the right side of the clockspring to reconnect the
jumper wire harness connector (1) to the connector receptacle on the inboard side of the switch
housing.
2. Align the slide tabs on the switch housing with the channel formations integral to the clockspring
mounting bracket, then slide the switch into the
bracket until it is firmly seated.
3. Install and tighten the screw (2) that secures the mounting tab on the back of the right
multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket on the
clockspring (3). Tighten the screw to 1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. Reinstall the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Installation and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Installation.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 10120
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
SENSOR-WASHER FLUID LEVEL-FRONT - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Description
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Description and Operation Washer Fluid Level Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The washer fluid level switch (3) is a two-pin conductivity sensor with no moving parts mounted on
the rearward facing side of the washer reservoir on the upper left corner of the cooling module on
the Front End Module (FEM). Only the molded plastic switch mounting flange and the integral
connector receptacle (4) are visible when the switch is installed in the reservoir.
A short nipple formation (1) extends from the inner surface of the switch mounting flange, and a
barb on the nipple is pressed through a rubber grommet seal installed in the mounting hole of the
reservoir. Two over-molded pins or electrodes (2) extend from the back of the nipple formation. The
switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of
the FEM wire harness.
The washer fluid level switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged, the switch
must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Description > Page 10123
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Description and Operation Washer Fluid Level Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The washer fluid level switch uses fluid conductivity to monitor the level of the washer fluid in the
washer reservoir. Electricity is conducted between the two switch pins or electrodes only when they
are immersed in the washer fluid, which closes the switch circuit. When the fluid level in the washer
reservoir falls below the pins, electrical current cannot be conducted and the switch becomes an
open circuit, which signals a low fluid condition.
In order to prevent an electrical charge from accumulating in the electrical leads of the switch, the
switch receives current that is pulsed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) located in
the engine compartment near the battery. The TIPM monitors the switch return signal and is
programmed to respond to three consecutive open switch readings by sending an electronic
washer fluid indicator lamp-ON request message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the Controller Area Network (CAN)
data bus. The EMIC responds to this message by illuminating the washer fluid indicator and by
sounding an audible chime tone warning.
The washer fluid level switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take
out and connector of the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness. The switch is connected in series
between a sensor return circuit and the washer fluid switch sense input to the TIPM.
The washer fluid level switch and the hard wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the washer fluid level indicator or the electronic controls or communication between other modules
and devices that provide some features of the washer system. The most reliable, efficient, and
accurate means to diagnose the washer fluid level indicator or the electronic controls and
communication related to washer fluid level switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan
tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Removal
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair Washer Fluid Level Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the washer reservoir from the
back of the cooling module on the Front End Module (FEM). See: Windshield Washer
Reservoir/Service
and Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir - Removal.
3. Disconnect the FEM wire harness connector from the washer fluid level switch connector
receptacle (3) on the back of the reservoir. 4. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed
tool, gently pry the barbed nipple of the washer fluid level switch out of the rubber grommet
seal in the washer reservoir. Care must be taken not to damage the reservoir.
5. Remove the switch from the washer reservoir. 6. Remove the rubber grommet seal from the
switch mounting hole in the washer reservoir and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Washer Fluid Level Switch - Removal > Page 10126
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair Washer Fluid Level Switch - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new rubber grommet seal into the washer fluid level switch mounting hole of the washer
reservoir. Always use a new rubber grommet seal
on the reservoir.
2. Insert the nipple formation of the switch through the rubber grommet seal in the reservoir. 3.
Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly on the switch mounting flange until the barbed nipple
is fully seated in the rubber grommet seal in
the reservoir. The flat edge of the switch mounting flange should be oriented upward.
4. Reconnect the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness connector (3) to the switch connector
receptacle. 5. Reinstall the washer reservoir onto the back of the cooling module on the FEM. See:
Windshield Washer Reservoir/Service and
Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Washer Hoses and Tubes - Description
Windshield Washer Hose: Description and Operation Front Washer Hoses and Tubes - Description
FRONT
The front washer plumbing consists of a small diameter rubber hose (2) that is routed along the left
front fender ledge (4) from the washer reservoir hose (5) located at the left front corner of the
engine compartment. The reservoir hose is attached to the front outlet nipple of the washer
pump/motor unit near the bottom of the reservoir. The hose is then secured by plastic push-in type
retainers to the left fender ledge within the engine compartment to the left side of the cowl plenum.
From the cowl plenum, the front hose is routed up toward the inner hood panel reinforcement (1).
The hose is secured to the left hood hinge and the left side of the inner hood panel reinforcement
by plastic push-in type retainers, then is routed through the rear hood silencer brackets across the
underside of the inner hood panel. Plastic in-line fittings, a molded rubber tee and a molded rubber
elbow provide the take outs for the two front washer nozzles.
Washer hose is available for service as roll stock, which may be cut to length. The molded plastic
or rubber washer hose fittings cannot be repaired. If these fittings are ineffective or damaged, they
must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Washer Hoses and Tubes - Description > Page 10131
Windshield Washer Hose: Description and Operation Rear Washer Hoses and Tubes - Description
REAR
The rear washer plumbing consists of a small diameter rubber hose (3) that is routed along the left
front fender shield (6) from the washer reservoir hose (5) located at the left front corner of the
engine compartment. The reservoir hose is attached to the rear outlet nipple of the washer
pump/motor unit near the bottom of the reservoir. The hose is then secured by a plastic clip
retainer to the front end sheet metal within the engine compartment and routed to just behind the
left strut tower, where it connects to the unibody hose (7).
The unibody hose (1) passes from the engine compartment through a hole with a rubber grommet
in the dash panel into the passenger compartment where it enters the body wire harness. The hose
and wire harness bundle is routed along the floor panel (3) near the left sill back to the base of the
left rear inner wheel house (2). The hose and wiring bundle is then routed over the wheel house
and along the quarter inner panel near the belt line, then up the D-pillar.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Washer Hoses and Tubes - Description > Page 10132
The unibody hose (3) exits the body wire harness near the top of the D-pillar, where it is connected
to the liftgate washer hose (2) by a quick connect fitting. The liftgate washer hose is routed up the
D-pillar to the upper liftgate opening header panel, then to the center of the upper liftgate opening.
The liftgate hose is routed through a hole with a rubber grommet in the upper liftgate opening
header panel and passes through another hole with a rubber grommet in the upper liftgate panel
(1) to the rear washer nozzle on the upper liftgate.
Washer hose is available for service as roll stock, which may be cut to length. The unibody washer
hose is integral to the body wire harness. The molded plastic washer hose fittings and routing clips
cannot be repaired. If these fittings or clips are ineffective or damaged, they must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Washer Hoses and Tubes - Description > Page 10133
Windshield Washer Hose: Description and Operation Front Washer Hoses and Tubes - Operation
FRONT
Washer fluid in the washer reservoir is pressurized and fed by the washer pump/motor unit through
the front washer system plumbing and fittings to the two front washer nozzles. Whenever routing
the washer hose or a wire harness containing a washer hose, it must be routed away from hot,
sharp, or moving parts; and, sharp bends that might pinch the hose must be avoided.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Washer Hoses and Tubes - Description > Page 10134
Windshield Washer Hose: Description and Operation Rear Washer Hoses and Tubes - Operation
REAR
Washer fluid in the washer reservoir is pressurized and fed by the washer pump/motor unit through
the rear washer system plumbing and fittings to the rear washer nozzle. Whenever routing the
washer hose or a wire harness containing a washer hose, it must be routed away from hot, sharp,
or moving parts; and, sharp bends that might pinch the hose must be avoided.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Locations > Page 10138
Windshield Washer Pump: Diagrams
Connector - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
PUMP-WASHER-WINDSHIELD - (FRONT END MODULE) 2 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front and Rear Windshield Washer Pump - Description
Windshield Washer Pump: Description and Operation Front and Rear Windshield Washer Pump Description
FRONT AND REAR
The washer pump/motor unit is located on the top of a sump area on the rearward facing side of
the washer reservoir, which is located on the upper left corner of the cooling module in the engine
compartment. A small permanently lubricated and sealed reversible electric motor (3) is coupled to
the rotor-type washer pump (4). The use of an integral valve body (7) allows the washer
pump/motor unit to provide washer fluid to either the front or the rear washer systems, depending
upon the direction of the motor/pump impeller rotation.
An inlet nipple (6) on the pump housing passes through a rubber grommet seal/filter screen
installed in a dedicated mounting hole of the washer reservoir sump. The filter screen prevents
most debris from entering the pump housing. When the pump is installed in the reservoir the front
barbed outlet nipple (5) on the pump valve body housing connects the unit to the front washer
hose, and the rear barbed outlet nipple (8) connects the unit to the rear washer hose. The letters F
and R molded into the valve body housing adjacent to each nipple provide further clarification of
the nipple assignments.
The washer pump/motor unit is retained on the reservoir by the interference fit between the pump
inlet nipple and the grommet seal, which is a light press fit. The top of the washer pump is also
secured to the washer reservoir by the use of a snap fit between the motor housing and a
receptacle molded into the reservoir that allows for mounting of the washer pump without the use of
fasteners. An integral connector receptacle (1) on the top of the motor housing connects the unit to
the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the Front End Module
(FEM) wire harness.
Service replacement washer pumps may also include a snap post (2) at the top of the pump motor
housing, but this feature is not used in this application. The washer pump/motor unit cannot be
repaired. If ineffective or damaged, the entire washer pump/motor unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front and Rear Windshield Washer Pump - Description > Page 10141
Windshield Washer Pump: Description and Operation Front and Rear Windshield Washer Pump Operation
FRONT AND REAR
The washer pump/motor unit features a reversible electric motor. The direction of the motor is
controlled by hard wired outputs from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). When battery
current and ground are applied to the two pump motor terminals, the motor rotates in one direction.
When the polarity of these connections is reversed, the motor rotates in the opposite direction.
When the pump motor is energized, the rotor-type pump pressurizes the washer fluid and forces it
through one of the two pump outlet nipples, and into the front or rear washer plumbing.
The TIPM controls the hard wired outputs to the pump motor based upon electronic washer request
messages received over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus from the ElectroMechanical
Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN). The EMIC receives
electronic washer switch status messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) bus connection
from the Steering Control Module (SCM) within the left (lighting) multi-function switch housing. The
SCM monitors hard wired analog and multiplex inputs from the washer switch circuitry contained
within the right (wiper) multi-function switch to determine the proper electronic messages to send.
Washer fluid is drawn through the pump inlet nipple from the washer reservoir to the inlet port of
the washer pump housing. An integral valve body is located in a housing on the outlet port side (2)
of the pump housing. A diaphragm (4) in this valve body controls which washer system plumbing
receives the washer fluid being pressurized by the pump.
When the pump impeller (1) rotates in the counterclockwise direction (viewed from the bottom), the
biased diaphragm is sealing off the rear washer system outlet and nipple so the pressurized
washer fluid is pushed out through the pump front outlet port and the front washer outlet nipple (5).
When the pump impeller rotates in the clockwise direction (viewed from the bottom), pressurized
washer fluid is pushed out through the pump rear outlet port and moves the diaphragm to open the
rear washer outlet nipple and seal off the front washer outlet nipple, then the pressurized washer
fluid is pushed out through the rear washer outlet nipple (3).
The washer pump/motor unit and the hard wired motor control circuits from the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the washer pump/motor unit or the electronic controls or communication between other modules
and devices that provide some features of the front and rear wiper and washer system. The most
reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the washer pump/motor unit or the electronic
controls and communication related to washer pump/motor unit operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front and Rear Windshield Washer Pump - Removal
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair Front and Rear Windshield Washer Pump Removal
FRONT AND REAR
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Siphon the washer fluid from the washer
reservoir into a clean container for reuse. 3. Remove the washer reservoir from the cooling module.
See: Windshield Washer Reservoir/Service and Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir Removal.
4. Pull lightly outward on the top of the washer pump/motor housing (2), away from the washer
reservoir to disengage the top of the motor from the
receptacle in the reservoir.
5. Using hand pressure, firmly grasp and pull the washer pump upward far enough to disengage
the pump inlet nipple from the rubber grommet
seal/filter screen in the reservoir. Care must be taken not to damage the reservoir.
6. Remove the washer pump/motor unit from the washer reservoir. 7. Remove the rubber grommet
seal/filter screen from the washer pump mounting hole in the reservoir and discard.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front and Rear Windshield Washer Pump - Removal > Page 10144
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair Front and Rear Windshield Washer Pump Installation
FRONT AND REAR
1. Install a new rubber grommet seal/filter screen into the washer pump mounting hole in the
washer reservoir. Always use a new rubber grommet
seal/filter screen on the reservoir.
2. Position the inlet nipple on the base of the pump housing of the washer pump/motor unit (2) to
the rubber grommet seal/filter screen in the
reservoir.
3. Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly downward on the top of washer pump/motor unit
until the inlet nipple is fully seated in the rubber
grommet seal/filter screen in the pump mounting hole of the reservoir.
4. Align the top of the washer pump/motor unit housing with the receptacle in the washer reservoir.
5. Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly on the top of washer pump/motor unit until the
motor housing snaps into the receptacle. 6. Reinstall the washer reservoir onto the cooling module.
See: Windshield Washer Reservoir/Service and Repair/Windshield Washer Reservoir Installation.
7. Refill the washer reservoir with the washer fluid drained from the reservoir during the removal
procedure. 8. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Windshield Washer Reservoir - Description
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Description and Operation Windshield Washer Reservoir Description
DESCRIPTION
The molded plastic washer fluid reservoir (1) is mounted on the upper left corner of the cooling
module on the back of the Front End Module (FEM) carrier (also known as the radiator closure).
The filler neck for the reservoir extends upward just past the upper radiator closure member and
through the upper radiator seal. This reservoir is constructed of opaque black plastic, which does
not allow the fluid level to be inspected without removing the reservoir filler cap (2).
The bright yellow plastic filler cap with a rubber seal and an International Control and Display
Symbol icon for Windshield Washer molded into it snaps over the open end of the washer reservoir
filler neck. The cap hinges on and is secured to an integral molded hook formation on the top of the
reservoir just to the left of the filler neck when it is removed for inspecting or adjusting the fluid level
in the reservoir.
The washer reservoir is secured to the cooling module through integral mounting brackets at the
top on the inboard and outboard sides by two screws. In addition, integral mounting tab provisions
on the bottom of the washer reservoir engage through slots or slotted loops integral to the cooling
module to secure the lower end of the reservoir.
There is a dedicated mounting hole in the top of the sump area on the rearward facing side of the
reservoir with a receptacle provided for the mounting of the reversible washer/pump motor unit (3)
without the use of fasteners. A separate dedicated mounting hole is provided in the rearward facing
side of the reservoir for the washer fluid level switch (4). An integral molded routing trough for the
washer hose and washer pump/motor unit wiring routes the hose and wiring bundle from the
washer pump to the outboard side of the reservoir.
A unique reservoir is used for vehicles manufactured for export markets with the optional headlamp
washer system. This reservoir has a dedicated sump area and mounting receptacle for the high
pressure headlamp washer pump (5) near the outboard side of the reservoir, directly above the
washer fluid level switch location. The location and mounting provisions for this reservoir are the
same as for those vehicles without the headlamp washer system.
A washer reservoir cannot be repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the unit must be replaced.
The reversible washer pump/motor unit, the washer fluid level switch, the headlamp washer
pump/motor unit, their rubber grommet seals, as well as the reservoir filler cap are each available
for individual service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Windshield Washer Reservoir - Description > Page 10149
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Description and Operation Windshield Washer Reservoir Operation
OPERATION
The washer fluid reservoir provides a secure, on-vehicle storage location for a large reserve of
washer fluid for operation of the front, rear and, if equipped, headlamp washer systems. The
washer reservoir filler cap provides a clearly marked and readily accessible point at which to add
washer fluid to the reservoir.
The washer/pump motor unit is located in a sump area near the bottom of the reservoir to be
certain that washer fluid will be available to the pump as the fluid level in the reservoir becomes
depleted. The washer fluid level switch is mounted far enough above the washer pump inlet nipple
in the sump area of the reservoir so that there will be adequate warning to the vehicle operator that
the washer fluid level is low, well before the washer system will no longer operate.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Windshield Washer Reservoir - Removal
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Service and Repair Windshield Washer Reservoir - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Siphon the washer fluid from the washer
reservoir into a clean container for reuse. 3. If equipped with certain optional engines, it may be
necessary to remove the air filter housing for access to the washer reservoir mounting
provisions and connections. See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Tune-up and Engine
Performance Checks/Air Cleaner Housing/Service and Repair/Air Cleaner Body - Removal.
4. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness connector (2)
and headlamp washer supply hose (1) from the
headlamp washer pump/motor unit (3). To disconnect the quick connect fitting (4), pull the molded
plastic lock (2) away from the headlamp washer supply hose quick connect fitting far enough to
disengage the hose from the washer pump nipple.
5. Disconnect the FEM wire harness connector (5) from the washer fluid level switch connector
receptacle on the back of the reservoir. 6. Disconnect the FEM wire harness connector (3) and the
front and rear washer supply hoses (4) from the reversible washer pump/motor unit. 7. Disengage
each of the FEM wire harness takeouts and washer supply hoses from the integral routing
provisions of the washer reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Windshield Washer Reservoir - Removal > Page 10152
8. Remove the two screws (1) that secure the washer reservoir inboard and outboard mounting
brackets to the back of the cooling module. 9. Lift the washer reservoir straight up to disengage the
mounting tabs from the cooling module.
10. Remove the washer reservoir from the left side of the cooling module.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Windshield Washer Reservoir - Removal > Page 10153
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Service and Repair Windshield Washer Reservoir - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the washer reservoir to the left side of the cooling module. 2. Engage the mounting
provisions at the bottom of the washer reservoir with the cooling module. 3. Install and tighten the
two screws (1) that secure the washer reservoir inboard and outboard mounting brackets to the
back of the cooling module.
Tighten the screws securely.
4. Engage each of the Front End Module (FEM) wire harness takeouts and washer supply hoses
into the integral routing provisions of the washer
reservoir.
5. Reconnect the FEM wire harness connector (3) and the front and rear washer supply hoses (4)
to the reversible washer pump/motor unit. 6. Reconnect the FEM wire harness connector (5) to the
washer fluid level switch connector receptacle on the back of the reservoir.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Windshield Washer Reservoir - Removal > Page 10154
7. If the vehicle is so equipped, reconnect the FEM wire harness connector and headlamp washer
supply hose (1) to the headlamp washer pump
/motor unit. To reconnect the quick connect fitting (4), first seat the molded plastic lock (2) onto the
washer supply hose quick connect fitting. Next, push the quick connect fitting onto the headlamp
washer pump/motor unit outlet nipple (3) until it snaps into place with an audible click.
8. If removed, reinstall the air filter housing. See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Tune-up
and Engine Performance Checks/Air Cleaner
Housing/Service and Repair/Air Cleaner Body - Installation.
9. Refill the washer reservoir with the washer fluid drained from the reservoir during the removal
procedure.
10. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Washer Nozzle - Description
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Description and Operation Washer Nozzle - Description
REAR
The fluidic rear washer nozzle is constructed of molded plastic and includes an integral check
valve. The rear washer nozzle is secured by two integral latch features (3) within a mounting hole
to the left of the Center High-Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL) in the lower surface of the brow above
the liftgate glass opening in the outer liftgate panel.
The outer surface of the washer nozzle is visible on the lower exterior surface of the liftgate, and a
rubber gasket (1) seals the nozzle to the spoiler mounting hole. The nozzle orifice (2) is oriented
downward towards the liftgate glass. The washer plumbing fitting (4) is concealed between the
liftgate inner and outer panels.
The rear washer nozzle cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, it must be
replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Washer Nozzle - Description > Page 10159
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Description and Operation Washer Nozzle - Operation
REAR
The rear washer nozzle is designed to dispense washer fluid into the wiper pattern area on the
outside of the liftgate glass. Pressurized washer fluid is fed to the nozzle from the washer reservoir
by the washer pump/motor through a single hose, which is attached to a barbed nipple on the back
of the nozzle. A fluidic matrix within the nozzle causes the pressurized washer fluid to be emitted
from the nozzle orifice as an oscillating stream to more effectively cover a larger area of the glass
to be cleaned.
The integral check valve in the nozzle prevents washer fluid from draining out of the washer supply
hose back to the washer reservoir. This drain-back would result in a lengthy delay after the washer
switch is actuated until washer fluid was dispensed through the nozzle because the washer pump
would have to refill the washer plumbing from the reservoir to the nozzle. Such a drain-back
condition could also result in water, dirt, or other outside contaminants being siphoned into the
washer system through the washer nozzle orifice. This water could subsequently freeze and plug
the nozzle, while other contaminants could interfere with proper nozzle operation and cause
improper nozzle spray patterns. In addition, the check valve prevents washer fluid from siphoning
through the washer nozzle after the washer system is turned OFF.
When the washer pump pressurizes and pumps washer fluid from the reservoir through the washer
plumbing, the fluid pressure unseats a diaphragm from over a sump well within the nozzle by
overriding the spring pressure applied to it by a piston. With the diaphragm unseated, washer fluid
is allowed to flow toward the nozzle orifice. When the washer pump stops operating, the spring
pressure on the piston seats the diaphragm over the sump well in the nozzle and fluid flow in either
direction within the washer plumbing is prevented.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Washer Nozzle - Description > Page 10160
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Description and Operation Front Washer Nozzle - Description
FRONT
The fluidic front washer nozzles (2) are constructed of molded plastic and include an integral check
valve. Each nozzle has two integral latches (3) that secure them in dedicated holes in the hood
panel near the base of the windshield. The domed upper surface of the washer nozzle is visible on
the outside of the hood panel, and the two nozzle orifices (1) are oriented towards the windshield
glass.
An integral diaphragm type check valve is contained within the body of each nozzle. The washer
plumbing fittings (4) for the washer nozzles extend below the hood panel and are accessible from
the engine compartment.
The front washer nozzles cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, they must
be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Washer Nozzle - Description > Page 10161
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Description and Operation Front Washer Nozzle - Operation
FRONT
The two front washer nozzles are designed to dispense washer fluid into the wiper pattern area on
the outside of the windshield glass. Pressurized washer fluid is fed to each nozzle from the washer
reservoir by the washer pump/motor unit through a single hose, which is attached to a barbed
nipple on each washer nozzle below the inner hood panel. A fluidic matrix within the washer nozzle
causes the pressurized washer fluid to be emitted from the nozzle orifice as an oscillating stream to
more effectively cover a larger area of the glass to be cleaned.
The integral check valve in each nozzle prevents washer fluid from draining out of the washer
supply hoses back to the washer reservoir. This drain-back would result in a lengthy delay after the
washer switch is actuated until washer fluid was dispensed through the nozzles, because the
washer pump would have to refill the washer plumbing from the reservoir to the nozzles. Such a
drain-back condition could also result in water, dirt, or other outside contaminants being siphoned
into the washer system through the washer nozzle orifice. This water could subsequently freeze
and plug the nozzle, while other contaminants could interfere with proper nozzle operation and
cause improper nozzle spray patterns. In addition, the check valve prevents washer fluid from
siphoning through the washer nozzles after the washer system is turned OFF.
When the washer pump pressurizes and pumps washer fluid from the reservoir through the washer
plumbing, the fluid pressure unseats a diaphragm from over a sump well within the nozzle by
overriding the spring pressure applied to it by a piston. With the diaphragm unseated, washer fluid
is allowed to flow toward the nozzle orifice. When the washer pump stops operating, the spring
pressure on the piston seats the diaphragm over the sump well in the nozzle and fluid flow in either
direction within the washer plumbing is prevented.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Washer Nozzle - Removal
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Service and Repair Washer Nozzle - Removal
Front
FRONT
1. From the underside of the hood (3), remove the push-in retainers that secure the rear edge of
the hood silencer pad to the inner hood reinforcement
as necessary to access the washer nozzle hose (2) connections.
2. From the underside of the hood, disconnect the washer nozzle hose from the barbed nipple (1)
of the washer nozzle.
3. From the underside of the hood, release the integral latch features of the washer nozzle (1) and
push the nozzle out through the mounting hole
toward the top side of the hood.
4. Remove the washer nozzle from the top of the hood panel.
Rear
REAR
NOTE: The rear washer nozzle latch feature is a one time component, and will be damaged if the
nozzle is removed from its mounting hole for
service. If removed from its mounting hole for any reason, the rear washer nozzle must be replaced
with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Washer Nozzle - Removal > Page 10164
1. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed tool, gently pry the rear washer nozzle (3)
to release the latch features that secure it in the
mounting hole of the liftgate outer panel (1).
2. Pull the rear washer nozzle out from the liftgate outer panel far enough to access the washer
supply hose (2). 3. Disconnect the hose from the barbed nipple on the back of the nozzle. 4. Cut 4
to 6 millimeters (0.15 to 0.23 inch) from the end of the hose to ensure a good fit to the barbed
nipple of the replacement rear washer nozzle. 5. Discard the removed nozzle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Washer Nozzle - Removal > Page 10165
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Service and Repair Washer Nozzle - Installation
Front
FRONT
1. From the top of the hood, position the washer nozzle (1) to the mounting hole on the outside of
the hood panel (2). 2. Align the anti-rotation tabs of the nozzle with the anti-rotation notches in the
mounting hole. 3. Using hand pressure, push firmly and evenly on the top of the washer nozzle
until the integral latch features lock into place on the underside of the
hood.
4. From the underside of the hood (3), reconnect the washer hose (2) fitting to the barbed nipple (1)
of the washer nozzle. 5. Reinstall the washer nozzle hose into its routing clips as necessary on the
underside of the hood. 6. Reinstall the push-in retainers that secure the rear edge of the hood
silencer pad to the inner hood reinforcement.
Rear
REAR
NOTE: The rear washer nozzle latch feature is a one time component, and will be damaged if the
nozzle is removed from its mounting hole for
service. If removed from its mounting hole for any reason, the rear washer nozzle must be replaced
with a new unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Washer Nozzle - Removal > Page 10166
1. Position the new rear washer nozzle (3) to the mounting hole in the liftgate outer panel (1). Be
certain that the rubber gasket is in position on the
back of the nozzle.
2. Reconnect the washer supply hose (2) to the barbed nipple on the back of the nozzle. 3. Push
the hose and nozzle nipple into the mounting hole in the liftgate outer panel and align the
anti-rotation tab to the mounting hole. 4. Using hand pressure, push firmly and evenly on the nozzle
until both integral latch features are fully engaged on the back side of the outer panel.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams
Windshield Washer Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-RIGHT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Wiper Arm - Description
Wiper Arm: Description and Operation Wiper Arm - Description
Front
FRONT
The front wiper arms are the rigid members located between the wiper pivots that protrude from the
cowl plenum cover/grille panel near the base of the windshield and the wiper blades on the
windshield glass. These wiper arms feature an over-center hinge that allows easy access to the
windshield glass for cleaning.
The wiper arm has a die cast metal pivot end (4) with a large tapered mounting hole (5) at one end.
A molded black plastic cap fits over the wiper arm retaining nut to conceal the nut and this
mounting hole following wiper arm installation.
The wide end of a tapered, stamped steel channel (3) hinges on and is secured with a hinge pin (6)
to the blade end of the wiper arm pivot end. One end of a long, rigid, stamped steel strap (2) with a
small hole near its pivot end is riveted and crimped within the narrow end of the stamped steel
channel. The tip of the wiper blade end of this strap is bent back under itself to form a small hook
(1). Concealed within the stamped steel channel, one end of a long tension spring is engaged with
a wire hook on the underside of the die cast pivot end, while the other end of the spring is hooked
through the small hole in the steel strap. The entire wiper arm has a satin black finish applied to all
of its visible surfaces.
The right and left wiper arms are unique and are not interchangeable. A wiper arm cannot be
adjusted or repaired. If damaged or ineffective, the entire wiper arm unit must be replaced.
Rear
REAR
The rear wiper arm is the rigid member located between the rear wiper motor output shaft that
protrudes through the liftgate outer panel below the center
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Wiper Arm - Description > Page 10174
of the liftgate glass opening and the wiper blade on the outside of the glass. The wiper arm is
constructed of molded black plastic. A hinged pivot end is also molded plastic.
A molded black plastic nut cover (2) with two pivot pins on one end and a snap feature on the other
fits over the wiper arm retaining nut to conceal the nut and mounting hole following wiper arm
installation. The wiper arm hinge and tension spring are concealed on the underside of the wide
end of the arm (1), while an integral latch feature (3) concealed on the underside of the narrow end
of the wiper arm accepts the pivot pin of the matching molded plastic wiper blade unit.
The rear wiper arm cannot be adjusted or repaired. If damaged or ineffective, the entire wiper arm
unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Wiper Arm - Description > Page 10175
Wiper Arm: Description and Operation Wiper Arm - Operation
Front
FRONT
The front wiper arms are designed to mechanically transmit the motion from the wiper pivots to the
wiper blades. The wiper arm must be properly indexed to the wiper pivot in order to maintain the
proper wiper blade travel on the glass. The tapered mounting hole in the wiper arm pivot end
interlocks with the serrations on the tapered outer circumference of the wiper pivot shaft, allowing
positive engagement and finite adjustment of this connection.
The mounting nuts lock the wiper arms to the threaded studs of the wiper pivot shafts. The
spring-loaded wiper arm hinge controls the down-force applied through the tip of the wiper arm to
the wiper blade on the glass. The hook formation on the tip of the wiper arm provides a cradle for
securing and latching the wiper blade pivot block to the wiper arm.
Rear
REAR
The rear wiper arm is designed to mechanically transmit the motion from the rear wiper motor
output shaft to the rear wiper blade. The wiper arm must be properly indexed to the motor output
shaft in order to maintain the proper wiper blade travel on the glass. The tapered hole in the wiper
arm pivot end interlocks with the serrations on the outer circumference of the tapered motor output
shaft, allowing positive engagement and finite adjustment of this connection.
A hex nut secures the wiper arm pivot end to the threads on the rear wiper motor output shaft and
the plastic cover snaps over this connection for a neat appearance. The spring-loaded wiper arm
hinge controls the down-force applied through the tip of the wiper arm to the wiper blade on the
glass. The latch formation on the tip of the wiper arm provides a cradle for securing and latching
the wiper blade pivot pin to the wiper arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Arm - Removal
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Arm - Removal
Front
FRONT
1. Lift the front wiper arm (1) to its over-center position to hold the wiper blade off of the glass and
relieve the spring tension on the wiper arm to
pivot shaft connection.
2. Carefully pry the plastic nut cap (2) off of the pivot end of the wiper arm. 3. Remove the nut (3)
that secures the wiper arm to the wiper pivot shaft.
4. If necessary, use a suitable battery terminal puller (3) to disengage the wiper arm (1) from the
pivot shaft (2). 5. Remove the front wiper arm pivot end from the pivot shaft.
Rear
REAR
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Arm - Removal > Page 10178
1. Unsnap and swing the molded plastic nut cover (2) off of the pivot end of the wiper arm (1). 2.
Remove the nut (4) that secures the wiper arm to the rear wiper motor output shaft (3).
CAUTION: The use of a battery terminal puller when removing the rear wiper arm is NOT
recommended as this may damage the rear wiper
arm.
3. Use a slight rocking action to disengage the rear wiper arm pivot end from the output shaft and
remove the wiper arm.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Arm - Removal > Page 10179
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Arm - Installation
Front Wiper Arm
FRONT
NOTE: Be certain that the wiper motor is in the park position before attempting to install the front
wiper arms. Turn the ignition switch to
the ON position and move the right (wiper) multi-function switch control knob to its OFF position. If
the wiper pivots move, wait until they stop moving, then turn the ignition switch back to the OFF
position. The front wiper motor is now in its park position.
1. The front wiper arms (1) must be indexed to the pivot shafts with the front wiper motor in the
park position to be properly installed. Position the
wiper arm pivot ends onto the wiper pivot shafts so that the tip of the wiper blade is aligned with the
wiper alignment lines located within the lower margin (blackout area) of the windshield glass.
2. Once the wiper blade is aligned, lift the wiper arm away from the windshield slightly to relieve the
spring tension on the pivot end and push the
pivot end of the wiper arm down firmly and evenly over the pivot shaft.
3. Install and tighten the nut (3) that secures the wiper arm to the pivot shaft. Tighten the nut to 24
Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 4. Wet the windshield glass, then operate the front wipers. Turn the front wipers
OFF, then check for the correct wiper arm position and readjust as
required.
5. Reinstall the plastic nut cap (2) onto the wiper arm pivot nut.
Wiper Arm
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Be certain that the rear wiper motor is in the park position before attempting to install the
rear wiper arm. Turn the ignition switch to
the ON position and move the rear wiper switch to its OFF position. If the wiper motor output shaft
moves, wait until it stops moving, then turn the ignition switch back to the OFF position. The wiper
motor is now in its park position.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Arm - Removal > Page 10180
1. The rear wiper arm (1) must be indexed to the rear wiper motor output shaft with the motor in the
park position to be properly installed. Position
the wiper arm pivot end onto the output shaft (3) so that the tip of the wiper blade is aligned with
the second rear window defogger grid line from the bottom of the liftgate glass.
2. With the rear wiper arm properly indexed, push the tapered mounting hole on the pivot end of
the wiper arm down over the output shaft. 3. Install and tighten the nut (4) that secures the rear
wiper arm to the output shaft. Tighten the nut to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.). 4. Fold and snap the molded
plastic nut cover (2) over the nut on the pivot end of the rear wiper arm. 5. Wet the lift glass and
operate the rear wiper. Turn the rear wiper switch to the OFF position, then check for correct wiper
arm position and readjust
as required.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Wiper Blade - Description
Wiper Blade: Description and Operation Wiper Blade - Description
Front
FRONT
Each wiper blade is secured by an integral latching pivot block (3) to the hook formation on the tip
of each wiper arm, and rests on the glass near the base of the windshield when the wipers are not
in operation. The wiper blade consists of the following components:
- Superstructure (1) - The superstructure includes several stamped steel bridges and links with
claw formations (6) that grip the wiper blade element. Also included in this unit is the latching,
molded plastic pivot block that secures the superstructure to the wiper arm. All of the metal
components of the wiper blade have a satin black finish applied.
- Element (2) - The wiper element or squeegee is the resilient rubber member of the wiper blade
that contacts the glass.
- Flexor (7) - The flexor is a rigid metal component running along the length of each side of the
wiper element where it is gripped by the claws of the superstructure.
The passenger side wiper blades are 47.50 centimeters (18.70 inches) long. The driver side wiper
blades are 60 centimeters (23.62 inches) long. They have non-replaceable rubber elements
(squeegees). The wiper blades cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective, worn, or damaged the
entire wiper blade unit must be replaced.
Rear
REAR
The rear wiper blade is secured by an integral pivot pin (2) to a receptacle at the tip of the rear
wiper arm, and rests near the base of the liftgate glass when the wiper is not in operation. The rear
wiper blade consists of the following components:
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Wiper Blade - Description > Page 10185
- Superstructure (1) - The superstructure includes a molded black plastic bridge and plastic links
with claw formations that grip the wiper blade element. Also included in this unit is the pivot pin that
secures the superstructure to the wiper arm.
- Element (3) - The wiper element or squeegee is the resilient rubber member of the wiper blade
that contacts the glass.
- Flexor - The flexor is a rigid metal component running along the length of each side of the wiper
element where it is gripped by the claws of the superstructure.
The rear wiper blade is 30.50 centimeters (12.00 inches) long with a non-replaceable element
(squeegee). The wiper blade superstructure cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective, worn, or
damaged the entire wiper blade unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Wiper Blade - Description > Page 10186
Wiper Blade: Description and Operation Wiper Blade - Operation
Front
FRONT
The wiper blades are moved back and forth across the glass by the wiper arms when the wipers
are being operated. The wiper blade superstructure is the flexible frame that grips the wiper blade
element and evenly distributes the force of the spring-loaded wiper arm along the length of the
element. The combination of the wiper arm force and the flexibility of the superstructure makes the
element conform to and maintain proper contact with the glass, even as the blade is moved over
the varied curvature that may be encountered across the glass surface.
The wiper element flexor provides the claws of the blade superstructure with a rigid, yet flexible
component on the element which can be gripped. The rubber element is designed to be stiff
enough to maintain an even cleaning edge as it is drawn across the glass, yet resilient enough to
conform to the glass surface and flip from one cleaning edge to the other each time the wiper blade
changes directions.
Rear
REAR
The rear wiper blade is moved back and forth across the liftgate glass by the wiper arm when the
rear wiper system is in operation. The wiper blade superstructure is the flexible frame that grips the
wiper blade element and evenly distributes the force of the spring-loaded wiper arm along the
length of the element. The combination of the wiper arm force and the flexibility of the
superstructure makes the element conform to and maintain proper contact with the glass, even as
the blade is moved over the varied curvature found across the glass surface.
The wiper element flexor provides the claws of the blade superstructure with a rigid, yet flexible
component on the element which can be gripped. The rubber element is designed to be stiff
enough to maintain an even cleaning edge as it is drawn across the glass, but resilient enough to
conform to the glass surface and flip from one cleaning edge to the other each time the wiper blade
changes directions.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Blade - Removal
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Wiper Blade - Removal
Front
FRONT
CAUTION: Do not allow the wiper arm to spring back against the glass without the wiper blade in
place or the glass may be damaged.
NOTE: The notched end of the wiper element flexor should always be oriented towards the end of
the wiper blade that is nearest to the wiper
pivot.
1. Lift the wiper arm (2) to raise the wiper blade and element (6) off of the glass, until the wiper arm
hinge is in its over-center position. 2. To remove the blade from the arm, depress the latch release
tab (4) on the pivot block (3) under the tip of the arm and slide the blade away from
the tip towards the pivot end of the arm far enough to disengage the pivot block from the hook
formation (5) on the end of the arm.
3. Extract the hook formation on the tip of the wiper arm through the opening in the wiper blade
superstructure (1) just ahead of the pivot block. 4. Gently lower the tip of the wiper arm onto the
glass.
Rear
REAR
1. Lift the rear wiper arm pivot cap (2) upward to allow the rear wiper blade to be raised off of the
glass.
NOTE: The rear wiper arm cannot be raised to its over-center hinge position unless the pivot cover
is raised first.
2. Lift the rear wiper arm to its over-center hinge position to raise the wiper blade and element off of
the liftgate glass.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Blade - Removal > Page 10189
3. To remove the wiper blade (1) from the wiper arm (3), grasp the end of the blade nearest to the
motor output shaft, then over-rotate it out from
under the arm and past its stop far enough to unsnap the blade pivot pin (2) from the receptacle (4)
on the end of the arm.
4. Gently lower the tip of the wiper arm onto the glass.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Blade - Removal > Page 10190
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Wiper Blade - Installation
Front
FRONT
CAUTION: Do not allow the wiper arm to spring back against the glass without the wiper blade in
place or the glass may be damaged.
NOTE: The notched end of the wiper element flexor should always be oriented towards the end of
the wiper blade that is nearest to the wiper
pivot.
1. Lift the wiper arm (2) off of the windshield glass, until the wiper arm hinge is in its over-center
position. 2. Position the wiper blade near the hook formation (5) on the tip of the arm with the
notched end of the wiper element flexor oriented towards the
end of the wiper arm that is nearest to the wiper pivot.
3. Insert the hook formation on the tip of the arm through the opening in the blade superstructure
(1) ahead of the pivot block (3) far enough to
engage the pivot block into the hook.
4. Slide the pivot block up into the hook formation on the tip of the wiper arm until the latch release
tab (4) snaps into its locked position. Latch
engagement will be accompanied by an audible click.
5. Gently lower the wiper blade and element (6) onto the glass.
Rear
REAR
1. Lift the rear wiper arm pivot cap (2) upward to allow the rear wiper arm to be raised off of the
glass.
NOTE: The rear wiper arm cannot be raised to its over-center hinge position unless the pivot cover
is raised first.
2. Lift the rear wiper arm to its over-center hinge position and off of the liftgate glass.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Blade - Removal > Page 10191
3. Position the rear wiper blade (1) with the pivot pin (2) aligned with the opening of the receptacle
(4) on the tip of the wiper arm (3). 4. Using hand pressure, press the wiper blade pivot pin firmly
and evenly into the wiper arm receptacle until it snaps into place. 5. Lower the wiper blade onto the
glass and snap the pivot cover back into place.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Wiper Motor
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Wiper Motor > Page 10196
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear
Wiper Motor (Liftgate) 4 Way
Wiper Motor: Diagrams Rear Wiper Motor (Liftgate) 4 Way
Connector - (LIFTGATE) 4 WAY
MOTOR-WIPER-REAR - (LIFTGATE) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear
Wiper Motor (Liftgate) 4 Way > Page 10199
Wiper Motor: Diagrams Front Wiper Motor (Headlamp And Dash) 4 Way
Connector - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 4 WAY
MOTOR-WIPER-FRONT - (HEADLAMP AND DASH) 4 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Wiper Motor - Description
Wiper Motor: Description and Operation Wiper Motor - Description
REAR
The rear wiper motor is concealed within the liftgate, below the liftgate glass and behind the liftgate
inner trim panel. The end of the motor output shaft (1) that extends through the liftgate outer panel
to drive the rear wiper arm and blade is the only visible component of the rear wiper motor. A
rubber bezel and grommet is engaged within the output shaft hole of the liftgate outer panel and
seals the output shaft where it passes through the panel. An integral connector receptacle (4)
connects the rear wiper motor to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and
connector of the liftgate wire harness. The rear wiper motor consists of the following major
components:
- Bracket (5) - The rear wiper motor bracket consists of a stamped metal mounting plate for the
wiper motor that is secured with screws to the wiper motor transmission housing, and through three
rubber isolators (2) to the liftgate inner panel.
- Motor (3) - The single-speed permanent magnet rear wiper motor is secured with screws to the
rear wiper motor transmission, which is secured to the motor bracket with screws. The wiper motor
includes the integral transmission, the motor output shaft, an automatic resetting circuit breaker,
and the rear wiper motor park switch that parks the rear wiper blade near the base of the liftgate
glass.
The rear wiper motor cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any component of the motor is ineffective or
damaged, the entire rear wiper motor unit must be replaced. The output shaft bezel and grommet
unit is available for individual service replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Wiper Motor - Description > Page 10202
Wiper Motor: Description and Operation Wiper Motor - Operation
REAR
The rear wiper motor operation is controlled by the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM), which
uses intelligent, high current, self-protected high side switches to control rear wiper system
operation for energizing or de-energizing the rear wiper motor. The TIPM uses internal
programming and electronic messages received over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus
from the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment
Node/CCN) to provide the appropriate rear wiper and washer system operating modes. The EMIC
uses electronic messages received from the Steering Control Module (SCM) over a Local
Interconnect Network (LIN) data bus to determine when to send electronic rear wiper system
requests to the TIPM.
The rear wiper motor park switch is a single pole, single throw, momentary switch within the wiper
motor that is mechanically actuated by the wiper motor transmission components. The park switch
alternately closes and opens a path to ground for the rear wiper motor electronic control logic
circuitry of the TIPM, depending upon the position of the rear wiper blade on the liftgate glass. This
input allows the electronic logic circuits of the TIPM to control all of the electronic features of rear
wiper motor operation and to keep the motor energized long enough to complete its current wipe
cycle and park the wiper blade after the wiper system or the ignition switch has been turned OFF.
The rear wiper motor is grounded at all times through a take out in the body wire harness that is
secured to a remote ground location. The automatic resetting circuit breaker protects the motor
from overloads. The rear wiper motor transmission converts the rotary output of the wiper motor to
the back and forth wiping motion of the rear wiper arm and blade on the liftgate glass.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the rear wiper motor may be diagnosed using conventional
diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information. However,
conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the electronic controls
or communication between other modules and devices that provide some features of the rear wiper
and washer system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the rear wiper
system or the electronic controls and communication related to rear wiper motor operation requires
the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Removal
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor - Removal
Front
FRONT
CAUTION: Do not apply pressure to, or pry on, the plastic drive link bushings. When removing a
drive link from, or installing a drive link
onto the ball stud on the wiper motor crank arm, apply pressure to, or pry on, only the metal
portions of the drive link around the bushing. If the bushing is damaged, the entire front wiper
linkage module MUST be replaced.
CAUTION: Do not remove the crank arm nut from the wiper motor output shaft. The crank arm is
indexed to the output shaft with the motor
in the park position during the manufacturing process, but there are no provisions made for
correctly indexing this connection in the field. If the crank arm to output shaft indexing is incorrect,
the entire front wiper motor and crank arm unit MUST be replaced.
1. Unlatch and open the hood. 2. Remove both front wiper arms from the wiper pivots. See: Wiper
Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal. 3. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
cable. 4. Remove the outer and inner cowl plenum cover/grille panels from the vehicle. See: Body
and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and
Repair/Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Removal and See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding /
Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal.
5. Disconnect the headlamp and dash wire harness connector from the wiper motor pigtail wire
connector (3). 6. Disengage the socket bushing (2) of the right wiper drive link from the ball stud on
the wiper motor crank arm using two large screwdrivers, one
on each side of the ball stud. Pry between the crank arm and the metal portion of the drive link until
the socket unsnaps from the ball.
7. Disengage the sleeve bushing of the left wiper drive link from the ball stud on the wiper motor
crank arm using two large screwdrivers, one on
each side of the ball stud. Pry between the crank arm and the metal portion of the drive link until
the sleeve unsnaps from the ball.
8. Remove the three screws (1) that secure the wiper motor to the center bracket (4) of the wiper
linkage module. 9. Remove the wiper motor from under the wiper linkage module bracket and out
of the cowl plenum.
Rear
REAR
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Removal > Page 10205
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the rear wiper arm (3) from the
rear wiper motor output shaft. See: Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Removal.
NOTE: The output shaft bezel and grommet (4) does not have to be removed to remove the rear
wiper motor from the liftgate.
3. Remove the trim panel from the liftgate inner panel (2). See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Trunk / Liftgate/Trunk / Liftgate Interior
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Liftgate Trim Panel - Removal.
4. Disconnect the wire harness connector (7) from the rear wiper motor (1). 5. Remove the three
screws (6) that secure the motor mounting bracket to the liftgate inner panel. 6. Remove the motor
from the liftgate. 7. Remove the bezel and rubber grommet on the outer liftgate panel from the
output shaft clearance hole. Be certain to take proper precautions to
protect the outer liftgate panel and its paint finish from damage during this procedure.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Removal > Page 10206
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor - Installation
Front
FRONT
CAUTION: Do not apply pressure to, or pry on, the plastic drive link bushings. When removing a
drive link from, or installing a drive link
onto the ball stud on the wiper motor crank arm, apply pressure to, or pry on, only the metal
portions of the drive link around the bushing. If the bushing is damaged, the entire front wiper
linkage module MUST be replaced.
CAUTION: Do not remove the crank arm nut from the wiper motor output shaft. The crank arm is
indexed to the output shaft with the motor
in the park position during the manufacturing process, but there are no provisions made for
correctly indexing this connection in the field. If the crank arm to output shaft indexing is incorrect,
the entire front wiper motor and crank arm unit MUST be replaced.
1. Position the front wiper motor to the center bracket (4) of the wiper linkage module from the
underside of the bracket. 2. Install and tighten the three screws (1) that secure the motor to the
bracket. Tighten the screws to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the headlamp and dash wire
harness connector to the wiper motor pigtail wire connector (3). Be certain to route the wire
harness take
out under the wiper linkage module.
4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 5. Turn the ignition switch (also known as the Wireless
Ignition Node/WIN) to the ON position.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury and vehicle damage, be certain there are no objects
including hands or fingers in the rotational
path of the wiper motor crank arm. The following step will activate the front wiper motor to ensure it
is in the Park position, and may cause the motor crank arm to complete up to one complete
revolution.
6. Turn the front wiper system ON, then back to OFF using the right (wiper) multi-function switch
control knob. 7. Wait until the wiper motor stops moving, then turn the ignition switch back to the
OFF position. 8. Position the sleeve bushing of the left wiper drive link onto the ball stud on the end
of the motor crank arm. Place a short 19 millimeter or 3/4 inch
socket over the bushing as an installation tool. Then use large channel-lock pliers to apply enough
pressure to the underside of the crank arm and the top of the socket to snap the bushing onto the
ball stud. Do not apply pressure directly to the plastic bushing.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Removal > Page 10207
CAUTION: Carefully inspect the installed sleeve bushing (2) to be certain it is centered over the
lower ball of the ball stud (3), and not trapped
between the lower ball and the crank arm (1). There should be a visible clearance between the
lower surface of the sleeve bushing and the crank arm. Refer to the accompanying illustration. The
sleeve bushing must be able to swivel freely on the lower ball during wiper operation. If the bushing
is trapped between the lower ball and the crank arm, the bushing and the drive link (4) may be
damaged.
9. Position the socket bushing of the right wiper drive link over the ball stud on the crank arm. Place
a short 19 millimeter or 3/4 inch socket over the
bushing as an installation tool. Then use large channel-lock pliers to apply enough pressure to the
underside of the crank arm and the top of the socket to snap the bushing onto the ball stud. Do not
apply pressure directly to the plastic bushing.
10. Reinstall the inner and outer cowl plenum cover/grille panels. See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl
Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel
Inner Cover - Installation and See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and
Repair/Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Installation.
11. Reinstall both front wiper arms onto the wiper pivots. See: Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation.
Rear
REAR
1. If the output shaft bezel and grommet (4) were removed from the outside of the liftgate, install
the rubber bezel and grommet into the clearance
hole of the liftgate outer panel. Be certain the arrow (5) molded onto the grommet is oriented
upward.
2. Position the rear wiper motor and bracket unit (1) onto the liftgate inner panel (2) as a unit. 3.
Install and tighten the three screws (6) that secure the mounting bracket to the liftgate. Tighten the
screws to 5 Nm (44 in. lbs.). 4. Reconnect the wire harness connector (7) to the motor connector
receptacle. 5. Reinstall the trim panel onto the liftgate inner panel. See: Body and Frame/Doors,
Hood and Trunk/Trunk / Liftgate/Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Removal > Page 10208
Panel/Service and Repair/Liftgate Trim Panel - Installation.
6. Reinstall the rear wiper arm (3) onto the output shaft. See: Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Installation. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Wiper Arm Linkage - Description
Wiper Motor Linkage: Description and Operation Wiper Arm Linkage - Description
DESCRIPTION
The front wiper linkage module is secured by three screws through three rubber grommet-type
insulators to two brackets and weld nuts on the cowl plenum panel and one bracket and weld nut
on the driver side strut tower. The module is concealed beneath the molded plastic cowl plenum
cover/grille panel between the base of the windshield and the rear edge of the hood panel. The
ends of the pivot shafts that protrude through dedicated openings in the cowl plenum cover/grille
panel to drive the wiper arms and blades and are the only visible components of the front wiper
linkage module. The front wiper linkage module consists of the following major components:
Bracket - The front wiper module bracket consists of a long tubular steel main member that has a
die cast pivot bracket formation near each end where the two wiper pivots are secured. A stamped
steel mounting bracket for the wiper motor is secured near the center of the main member. Each of
the two wiper pivot brackets secures the module to the cowl plenum with a screw through a rubber
insulator (4), and a third rubber insulator on the motor bracket secures the module with a screw in
the bracket on the driver side strut tower.
- Crank Arm - The front wiper motor crank arm (6) is a stamped steel unit with a hole on the driven
end that is secured to the wiper motor output shaft with a nut, and has a long ball stud secured to
the drive end to accept the wiper linkage.
- Linkage - Two stamped steel drive links (3) connect the wiper motor crank arm to the wiper pivot
lever arms. The right side drive link has a plastic socket-type bushing on each end. The left side
drive link has a plastic socket-type bushing on one end, and a plastic sleeve-type bushing on the
other end. The socket-type bushing on one end of each drive link is snap-fit over the ball stud on
the lever arm of its respective pivot. The left side drive link sleeve-type bushing end is then fit over
the motor crank arm ball stud, and the other socket-type bushing of the right side drive link is
snap-fit over the exposed end of the wiper motor crank arm ball stud.
- Motor - The front wiper motor (1) features a transmission housing from which the wiper motor
output shaft exits, and has three mounting bosses with internal threads to which the motor is
mounted to the center wiper linkage module bracket with screws. is secured with three screws near
the center of the main tubular member of the wiper module bracket. A nut secures the wiper motor
crank arm to the motor output shaft. The two-speed permanent magnet wiper motor features an
integral transmission, an internal park switch, and an internal automatic resetting circuit breaker. A
short pigtail wire and connector (5) connect the wiper motor to the vehicle electrical system through
a dedicated take out and connector of the headlamp and dash wire harness.
- Pivots - The two front wiper pivots (2) are secured within the die cast pivot brackets on the
outboard ends of the wiper linkage module main member. The lever arms that extend from the
center of the pivot shafts each have a ball stud on their end. The upper end of each pivot shaft
where the wiper arms will be fastened each has a finely splined and tapered driver with a threaded
stud extending from the top. The lower ends of the pivot shafts are installed through permanently
lubricated bushings in the pivot brackets.
The front wiper linkage module cannot be adjusted or repaired. The wiper motor is available for
separate service replacement. If any other component of the linkage module is ineffective or
damaged, the entire wiper linkage module unit must be replaced.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Wiper Arm Linkage - Description > Page 10213
Wiper Motor Linkage: Description and Operation Wiper Arm Linkage - Operation
OPERATION
The front wiper linkage module operation is controlled by the battery current inputs received by the
wiper motor from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The wiper motor speed is controlled
by current flow to either the low speed or the high speed set of brushes.
The park switch is a single pole, single throw, momentary switch within the wiper motor that is
mechanically actuated by the wiper motor transmission components. The park switch alternately
opens and closes the wiper park switch sense circuit to ground, depending upon the position of the
wipers on the glass. This feature allows the motor to complete its current wipe cycle after the wiper
system has been turned OFF, and to park the wiper blades in the lowest portion of the wipe
pattern. The automatic resetting circuit breaker protects the motor from overloads.
The wiper motor crank arm, the two wiper linkage members, and the two driven wiper pivots
mechanically convert the rotary output of the wiper motor to the back and forth wiping motion of the
wiper arms and blades on the glass.
The hard wired inputs and outputs of the wiper motor may be diagnosed using conventional
diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information. However,
conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the electronic controls
or communication between other modules and devices that provide some features of the wiper
system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the wiper system or the
electronic controls and communication related to wiper motor operation requires the use of a
diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wiper Arm Linkage - Removal
Wiper Motor Linkage: Service and Repair Wiper Arm Linkage - Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The front wiper linkage module includes the wiper motor. The wiper motor is also available
for separate service replacement and can
be removed from the wiper linkage module without removing the module from the vehicle. See:
Wiper Motor/Service and Repair/Wiper Motor - Removal .
1. Remove both front wiper arms from the wiper pivots. See: Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper
Arm - Removal. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Remove the outer and
inner cowl plenum cover/grille panels from the vehicle. See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding /
Trim/Service and
Repair/Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Removal and See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding /
Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl Panel Inner Cover - Removal.
4. Disconnect the headlamp and dash wire harness connector (2) from the wiper motor pigtail wire
connector. 5. Remove the three screws (1) that secure the front wiper linkage module (4) to the
driver side strut tower bracket (3) and the two cowl brackets (5). 6. Remove the front wiper linkage
module from the vehicle as a unit.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wiper Arm Linkage - Removal > Page 10216
Wiper Motor Linkage: Service and Repair Wiper Arm Linkage - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The front wiper linkage module includes the wiper motor. The wiper motor is also available
for separate service replacement and can
be removed from the wiper linkage module without removing the module from the vehicle. See:
Wiper Motor/Service and Repair/Wiper Motor - Removal .
1. Position the front wiper linkage module (4) into the vehicle as a unit. 2. Reconnect the headlamp
and dash wire harness connector (2) to the wiper motor pigtail wire connector. Be certain to route
the wire harness take
out under the wiper linkage module.
3. Install but do not tighten the three screws (1) that secure the front wiper linkage module to the
driver side strut tower bracket (3) and the two cowl
brackets (5).
4. Starting on the driver side and working toward the passenger side, tighten each of the three
screws. Tighten the screws to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.). 5. Reinstall the inner and outer cowl plenum
cover/grille panels. See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair/Cowl
Panel
Inner Cover - Installation and See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and
Repair/Cowl Panel Outer Cover - Installation.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 7. Reinstall both front wiper arms onto the wiper pivots.
See: Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Arm - Installation.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Wiper Switch: Diagrams
Connector - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION-RIGHT - (STEERING WHEEL JUMPER) 7 WAY
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Right Multifunction Switch - Description
Wiper Switch: Description and Operation Right Multifunction Switch - Description
DESCRIPTION
The right (wiper) multi-function switch is located on the right side of the steering column, just below
the steering wheel. This switch is the primary control for the front and rear wiper and washer
systems. The only visible components of the switch are the control stalk (1), control knob (2) and
control sleeve (3) that extend through the steering column shrouds on the right side of the column.
The remainder of the switch including its mounting provisions and electrical connection are
concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing and controls (6) are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. A single screw (7) through a mounting tab integral to the back of the
switch housing, and a slide tab integral to the bottom of the switch housing secure the switch to the
mounting bracket integral to the clockspring (3). A single connector receptacle containing seven
terminal pins is integral to the inboard end of the switch housing and is connected by a jumper wire
harness (5) directly to the Steering Control Module (SCM), which is internal to the housing (2) of
the left multi-function switch (1).
The right (wiper) multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the
following wiper and washer system functions:
- Continuous Front Wipers - The right multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching
for two continuous front wipe modes, low speed or high speed.
- Intermittent Front Wipers - The right multi-function switch control knob provides detent switching
for the intermittent front wipe mode with five minor detent delay interval positions.
- Front Wiper Mist Mode - The right multi-function switch control stalk includes momentary
switching of the front wiper motor low speed circuit to provide a mist mode features (sometimes
referred to as pulse wipe), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily operate the front
wipers for one or more complete cycles.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Right Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 10222
- Front Washer Mode - The right multi-function switch control stalk provides momentary switching
for control of the front washer system operation.
- Intermittent Rear Wipe Mode - The right multi-function switch control sleeve provides detent
switching for a single fixed interval intermittent rear wiper mode.
- Rear Washer Mode - The right multi-function switch control sleeve provides one momentary
switch positions for control of rear washer system operation.
The right multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is
ineffective, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced. The clockspring
(with the multi-function switch mounting bracket), the left multi-function switch (with the SCM), the
right multi-function switch and the jumper wire harness are each available for separate service
replacement.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Right Multifunction Switch - Description > Page 10223
Wiper Switch: Description and Operation Right Multifunction Switch - Operation
OPERATION
The right (wiper) multi-function switch uses a combination of resistor multiplexing and conventional
analog switching to control the many functions and features it provides. The switch receives a
clean ground from the Steering Control Module (SCM), then provides resistor multiplexed and
conventional analog return outputs to the SCM to indicate the selected switch positions. The SCM
then sends electronic switch status messages over a Local Interface Network (LIN) data bus to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN),
and the EMIC relays electronic wiper and washer switch request messages over the Controller
Area Network (CAN) data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
If the SCM detects no inputs from the right multi-function switch, it transmits an electronic Signal
Not Available (SNA) status message over the LIN data bus. The SNA status signals the EMIC to
request other electronic modules to implement a failsafe mode of operation for the front and rear
wiper systems. The failsafe mode will maintain the last selected front and rear wiper system
operation for the remainder of the current ignition cycle, after which both wiper systems will default
to OFF.
The right multi-function switch as well as the hard-wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, the most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose this component
requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Following are descriptions of how the right multi-function switch is operated to control the many
front and rear wiper and washer system functions and features it provides:
- Front Wiper Control - The control knob on the end of the right multi-function switch control stalk is
rotated to one of the two continuous wiper detents, to one of five intermittent wiper detents, or to
the OFF position to select the front wiper mode. The SCM reads the input from the right
multi-function switch and sends electronic wiper switch status messages over the LIN data bus to
the EMIC, which relays an electronic wiper switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Wiper Mist Mode - The front wiper mist mode is requested when the right multi-function
switch control stalk is depressed downward towards the floor to a momentary MIST position. The
front wiper motor will continue to operate, one complete cycle at a time, for as long as the control
stalk is held in this position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the right
multi-function switch and sends an electronic wiper switch status message over the LIN data bus to
the EMIC, which relays an electronic wiper switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Front Washer Control - The right multi-function switch control stalk is pulled rearward towards the
steering wheel to a momentary WASH position to activate the washer pump/motor in the front
washer mode. The washer pump/motor will continue to operate for as long as the control stalk is
held in this position. The SCM reads the resistor multiplexed input from the right multi-function
switch and sends an electronic washer switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC,
which relays an electronic washer switch request message over the CAN data bus to other
electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Wiper Control - The rear wiper mode is selected when the right multi-function switch control
sleeve is rotated to the fixed interval intermittent rear wipe detent position, or the OFF detent
position. The SCM reads the input from the right multi-function switch and sends an electronic
wiper switch status message over the LIN data bus to the EMIC, which relays an electronic wiper
switch request message over the CAN data bus to other electronic modules in the vehicle.
- Rear Washer Control - The right multi-function switch control sleeve is rotated to one of two
momentary WASH positions, either fully forward or fully rearward, to activate the washer
pump/motor in the rear washer mode. The washer pump/motor will continue to operate in the rear
washer mode until the control sleeve is released. The SCM reads the input from the right
multi-function switch and sends an electronic washer switch status message over the LIN data bus
to the EMIC, which relays an electronic washer switch request message over the CAN data bus to
other electronic modules in the vehicle.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 10224
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
RIGHT MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) before
attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing
further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the SRS. Failure to take the proper
precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
The right multi-function switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
Steering Control Module (SCM) or the electronic controls or communication between other
modules and devices that provide some features of the front and rear wiper and washer systems.
The most reliable, efficient and accurate means to diagnose the SCM or the electronic controls and
communication related to SCM operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
1. Remove the right multi-function switch from the integral mounting bracket on the right side of the
clockspring. See: Service and Repair/Right
Multifunction Switch - Removal.
2. Using an ohmmeter, test the resistance between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
three Function Tests tables. For all functions except
those of the control stalk the values should be either less than 100 ohms (switch CLOSED) or
greater than 1 megohm (switch OPEN).
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 10225
3. If the switch fails any of the tests, replace the ineffective right multi-function switch as required. If
the switch tests okay, but the switch input to the
Steering Control Module (SCM) remains incorrect, be certain to check for a short or open in the
jumper harness between the right multi-function switch and the SCM.
Dodge Journey Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Right Multifunction Switch - Removal
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair Right Multifunction Switch - Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid personal or fatal injury, on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting
any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel
component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to discharge before performing further diagnosis or
service. This is the only sure way to disable the supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the
proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds
from the steering column. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering
Column
Cover/Service and Repair/Steering Column Shroud - Removal and See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Steering Column Cover/Service and Repair/Steering
Column Shroud - Removal.
3. Remove the screw (2) that secures the right multi-function switch (1) to the mounting bracket
integral to the right side of the clockspring (3) on the
steering column.
4. Slide the switch away from the clockspring far enough to disengage the slide tabs on the switch
housing from the channel formations in the
mounting bracket.
5. Disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (1) from the connector receptacle on the inboard
end of the right multi-function switch (2). 6. Remove the switch from the clockspring (3).